You are on page 1of 1131

Handbook of Polymer

Reaction Engineering

Edited by
Th. Meyer, J. Keurentjes

Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes


Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

Further Titles of Interest


E. S. Wilks (Ed.)

Industrial Polymers Handbook


Products, Processes, Applications
2000

ISBN 3-527-30260-3

H.-G. Elias (Ed.)

Macromolecules
Vols. 14
2005

ISBN 3-527-31172-6, 3-527-31173-4, 3-527-31174-2,


3-527-31175-0

M. F. Kemmere, Th. Meyer (Eds.)

Supercritical Carbon Dioxide


in Polymer Reaction Engineering
2005

ISBN 3-527-31092-4

M. Xanthos (Ed.)

Functional Fillers for Plastics


2005

ISBN 3-527-31054-1

R. C. Advincula, W. J. Brittain, K. C. Caster, J. Ru


uhe (Eds.)

Polymer Brushes
2004

ISBN 3-527-31033-9

H.-G. Elias (Ed.)

An Introduction to Plastics
Second, Completely Revised Edition
2003

ISBN 3-527-29602-6

Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering


Edited by
Thierry Meyer, Jos Keurentjes

Editors
Dr. Thierry Meyer
Swiss Federal Institute of Technology
Institute of Process Science
EPFL, ISP-GPM
1015 Lausanne
Switzerland
Prof. Jos T. F. Keurentjes
Process Development Group
Eindhoven University of Technology
P.O. Box 513
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands

9 All books published by Wiley-VCH are


carefully produced. Nevertheless, authors,
editors, and publisher do not warrant the
information contained in these books,
including this book, to be free of errors.
Readers are advised to keep in mind that
statements, data, illustrations, procedural
details or other items may inadvertently be
inaccurate.
Library of Congress Card No.: Applied for
British Library Cataloging-in-Publication
Data: A catalogue record for this book is
available from the British Library
Bibliographic information published by
Die Deutsche Bibliothek
Die Deutsche Bibliothek lists this publication in the Deutsche Nationalbibliograe;
detailed bibliographic data is available in
the Internet at hhttp://dnb.ddb.dei.
8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co.
KGaA, Weinheim
All rights reserved (including those of
translation into other languages). No part of
this book may be reproduced in any form
nor transmitted or translated into machine
language without written permission
from the publishers. Registered names,
trademarks, etc. used in this book, even
when not specically marked as such, are
not to be considered unprotected by law.
Printed in the Federal Republic of Germany
Printed on acid-free paper
Composition Asco Typesetters, Hong Kong
Printing betz-druck gmbh, Darmstadt
Bookbinding Litges & Dopf Buchbinderei
GmbH, Heppenheim
ISBN-13 978-3-527-31014-2
ISBN-10 3-527-31014-2

Foreword
A principal dierence between science and engineering is intent. Science is used
to bring understanding and order to a specic object of study to build a body of
knowledge with truth and observable laws. Engineering is more applied and practical, focused on using and exploiting scientic understanding and scientic principles to make products to benet mankind. A polymer reaction engineer seeks the
applied and practical as the title implies, but the path to success is most often
through polymer science. This truth is steeped in history there are many examples of polymeric products commercialized without adequate understanding of the
chemistry and physics of the underlying polymerization. Polymer reaction engineers, faced with detriments in process safety, product quality or product cost, become the driving force behind many polymer science developments. As such, polymer reaction engineering is more a collaboration of polymer science and reaction
engineering. A collaboration where polymer reaction engineers develop a rm understanding of the many aspects of polymer chemistry and physics to successfully
apply chemical engineering principles to new product developments. Only through
the integration of science and engineering are such products realized.
This handbook is a testimony to this melding of polymer science and chemical
engineering that denes polymer reaction engineering. Thierry Meyer and Jos
Keurentjes have compiled a strong list of contributors with an even balance from
academia and industry. The text oers a comprehensive view of polymer reaction
engineering. The text starts with an overview describing the important integration
of science and engineering in polymer reaction engineering and ends with recent
and potential breakthrough developments in polymer processing. The middle
chapters are divided into three sections. The rst section is devoted to the science
and chemistry of the major types of polymerization. Included are step and chain
growth polymerizations with chapters devoted specically to several dierent chain
growth methods. The central section of the middle chapters is dedicated to polymer reaction engineering tools and methods. The very important topics of safety
and process control are detailed and help frame the conditions through which successful scale-ups are achieved. The last section of the middle chapters is focused on
the physics and physical nature of formed polymers including their physical and
mechanical structure. In these chapters, many of the processes that modify poly-

VI

Foreword

mers through man-made and natural change are discussed. The details of polymer
end use are also presented.
This tome represents the rst published handbook on polymer reaction engineering and should be well received in academia and industry. Polymer reaction
engineering became recognized as a separate engineering discipline in the 1970s.
It is well past due that such a handbook be published. The broad scope and depth
of coverage should make it an important reference for years to come.
Michael C. Grady, ScD
Senior Engineering Associate
DuPont
Philadelphia, Pennsylvania

VII

Contents
Volume 1
Foreword
Preface

V
XXIX

List of Contributors
1

1.1
1.2
1.3
1.4
1.5
1.5.1
1.5.2
1.6
1.7

2.1
2.2
2.2.1
2.2.2
2.2.3
2.2.4
2.2.5
2.2.6
2.3
2.3.1

XXXI

Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach


Th. Meyer and J. T. F. Keurentjes
Polymer Materials 1

A Short History of Polymer Reaction Engineering 4


The Position of Polymer Reaction Engineering 5
Toward Integrated Polymer Reaction Engineering 7
The Disciplines in Polymer Reaction Engineering 9
Polymerization Mechanisms 11
Fundamental and Engineering Sciences 12
The Future: Product-inspired Polymer Reaction Engineering
Concluding Remarks 15
References 15
Polymer Thermodynamics
Theodoor W. de Loos
Introduction 17

14

17

Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions 18


Thermodynamic Principles of Phase Equilibria 18
Fugacity and Activity 18
Equilibrium Conditions 20
Low-pressure VaporLiquid Equilibria 21
FloryHuggins Theory and LiquidLiquid Equilibria 21
High-pressure LiquidLiquid and VaporLiquid Equilibria 25
Activity Coecient Models 29
FloryHuggins Theory 30

VIII

Contents

2.3.2
2.3.3
2.3.4
2.4
2.4.1
2.4.2
2.4.2.1
2.4.2.2
2.4.2.3
2.4.2.4
2.4.2.5
2.5

Hansen Solubility Parameters 32


Correlation of Solvent Activities 34
Group Contribution Models 35
Equation of State Models 39
The SanchezLacombe Lattice Fluid Theory
Statistical Associating-uid Theory 44
SAFT and PC-SAFT Hard Chain Term 44
SAFT Dispersion Term 45
The PC-SAFT Dispersion Term 46
SAFT and PC-SAFT Applications 47
Extension to Copolymers 48
Conclusions 50
Notation 52
References 54

Polycondensation 57
Mario Rui P. F. N. Costa and Rolf Bachmann
Basic Concepts 57
A Brief History 57

3.1
3.1.1
3.1.2
3.1.3
3.1.4
3.1.5
3.1.6
3.1.7
3.1.8
3.2
3.2.1
3.2.2
3.2.3
3.3
3.3.1
3.3.1.1
3.3.1.2
3.3.1.3
3.3.1.4
3.3.1.5
3.3.1.6
3.3.1.7
3.3.2
3.3.2.1
3.3.2.2
3.3.2.3
3.3.3

40

Molecular Weight Growth and Carothers Equation 59


The Principle of Equal Reactivity and the Prediction of the Evolution of
Functional Group Concentrations 62
Eect of Reaction Media on Equilibrium and Rate Parameters 62
Polycondensation Reactions with Substitution Eects 64
Exchange Reactions 66
Ring-forming Reactions 67
Modeling of Polymerization Schemes 68
Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations 69
Removal of Volatile By-products 69
Solid-state Polycondensation 80
Interfacial Polycondensation 82
Polycondensation Processes in Detail 85
Polyesters 85
Structure and Production Processes 85
Acid-catalyzed Esterication and Alcoholysis 86
Catalysis by Metallic Compounds 87
Side Reactions in Aromatic Polyester Production 89
Side Reactions in the Formation of Unsaturated Polyesters 90
Modeling of Processes of Aromatic Polyester Production 91
Modeling of Processes for Unsaturated Polyester Production 92
Polycarbonates 93
General Introduction 93
Interfacial Polycondensation 94
Melt Transesterication 96
Polyamides 98

Contents

3.3.3.1
3.3.3.2
3.3.3.3
3.3.3.4
3.3.4
3.3.4.1
3.3.4.2
3.3.4.3
3.3.5
3.3.6
3.4
3.4.1
3.4.2
3.4.3
3.4.4
3.4.5

4.1
4.2
4.3
4.3.1
4.3.1.1
4.3.1.2
4.3.1.3
4.3.2
4.3.2.1
4.3.2.2
4.3.2.3
4.3.3
4.4
4.4.1
4.4.1.1
4.4.1.2
4.4.1.3
4.4.2
4.4.2.1
4.4.2.2
4.4.3
4.4.3.1

Introduction 98
Kinetic Modeling 98
Nonoxidative Thermal Degradation Reactions 100
Process Modeling 101
Polymerizations with Formaldehyde: Amino Resins (Urea and
Melamine) and Phenolics 102
Formaldehyde Solutions in Water 102
Amino Resins 102
Phenolic Resins 107
Epoxy Resins 108
Polyurethanes and Polyureas 109
Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions 113
Overview 113
Description of Reactions in Polycondensations of Several Monomers
with Substitution Eects 113
Equilibrium Polycondensations with Several Monomers 117
Kinetic Modeling of Irreversible Polycondensations 129
Kinetic Modeling of Linear Reversible Polycondensations 133
Notation 136
References 144
Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous
Robin A. Hutchinson
FRP Properties and Applications 153
Chain Initiation 154

153

Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics 156


Homopolymerization 157
Basic Mechanisms 157
Kinetic Coecients 161
Additional Mechanisms 169
Copolymerization 179
Basic Mechanisms 179
Kinetic Coecients 183
Additional Mechanisms 187
Diusion-controlled Reactions 190
Polymer Reaction Engineering 193
Types of Industrial Reactors 195
Batch Processes 195
Semi-batch Processes 196
Continuous Processes 196
Mathematical Modeling of FRP Kinetics 197
Method of Moments 198
Modeling of Distributions 201
Reactor Modeling 203
Batch Polymerization 204

IX

Contents

4.4.3.2
4.4.3.3
4.4.3.4
4.4.3.5
4.5

Continuous Polymerization 204


Complex Flowsheets 205
Computational Fluid Dynamics (CFD)
Model-based Control 206
Summary 206
Notation 206
References 209

Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension


B. W. Brooks

5.1
5.1.1
5.1.2
5.1.3
5.1.4
5.1.5
5.2
5.2.1
5.2.2
5.2.3
5.2.4
5.2.5
5.3
5.3.1
5.3.2
5.3.3
5.4
5.4.1
5.4.2
5.4.3
5.4.4
5.4.5
5.5
5.5.1
5.5.2
5.6
5.6.1
5.6.2
5.6.3
5.6.4

Key Features of Suspension Polymerization 213


Basic Ideas 213
Essential Process Components 214
Polymerization Kinetics 214
FluidFluid Dispersions and Reactor Type 215
Uses of Products from Suspension Polymerization 216
Stability and Size Control of Drops 216
Stabilizer Types 217
Drop Breakage Mechanisms 218
Drop Coalescence 222
Drop Size Distributions 223
Drop Mixing 224
Events at High Monomer Conversion 228
Breakage of Highly Viscous Drops 229
Polymerization Kinetics in Viscous Drops 229
Consequences of Polymer Precipitation Inside Drops 230
Reaction Engineering for Suspension Polymerization 234
Dispersion Maintenance and Reactor Choice 234
Agitation and Heat Transfer in Suspensions 235
Scaleup Limitations with Suspension Polymerization 237
Reactor Safety with Suspension Processes 238
Component Addition during Polymerization 238
Inverse Suspension Polymerization 239
Initiator Types 239
Drop Mixing with Redox Initiators 240
Future Developments 240
Developing Startup Procedures for Batch and Semi-batch Reactors 240
Maintaining Turbulence Uniformity in Batch Reactors 242
Developing Viable Continuous-ow Processes 242
Quantitative Allowance for the Eects of Changes in the Properties of
the Continuous Phase 242
Further Study of the Role of Secondary Suspending Agents 243
Further Characterization of Stabilizers from Inorganic Powders 243
Notation 243
References 244

5.6.5
5.6.6

205

213

Contents

6.1
6.2
6.2.1
6.2.2
6.2.3
6.3
6.4
6.4.1
6.4.2
6.4.3
6.4.3.1
6.4.3.2
6.4.3.3
6.4.3.4
6.5
6.5.1
6.5.1.1
6.5.1.2
6.5.2

Emulsion Polymerization 249


Jose C. de la Cal, Jose R. Leiza, Jose M. Asua, Alessandro Butte`, Guiseppe Storti,
and Massimo Morbidelli
Introduction 249
Features of Emulsion Polymerization 250
Description of the Process 250
Radical Compartmentalization 254
Advantages of Emulsion Polymerization 254
Alternative Polymerization Techniques 256
Kinetics of Emulsion Polymerization 258
Monomer Partitioning 259
Average Number of Radicals per Particle 260
Number of Polymer Particles 264
Heterogeneous Nucleation 264
Homogeneous Nucleation 266
Simultaneous Heterogeneous and Homogeneous Nucleation 267
Coagulative Nucleation 267
Molecular Weights 267
Linear Polymers 268
ZeroOne System (SmithEwart Cases 1 and 2) 268
Pseudo Bulk System (SmithEwart Case 3) 270

Nonlinear Polymers: Branching, Crosslinking, and Gel Formation


272

6.6
6.7
6.7.1
6.7.1.1
6.7.1.2
6.7.1.3
6.7.1.4

Particle Morphology 273


Living Polymerization in Emulsion 275
Chemistry of LRP 275
Nitroxide-mediated Polymerization (NMP) 277
Atom-transfer Radical Polymerization (ATRP) 277
Degenerative Transfer (DT) 278
Reversible AdditionFragmentation Transfer (RAFT) Polymerization
279

6.7.2
6.7.3
6.7.4
6.7.4.1
6.7.4.2
6.8
6.8.1
6.8.1.1
6.8.1.2
6.8.2
6.8.2.1
6.8.2.2
6.9
6.9.1

Polymerization of LRP in Homogeneous Systems 280


Kinetics of LRP in Heterogeneous Systems 282
Application of LRP in Heterogeneous Systems 284
Ab-initio Emulsion Polymerization 284
Miniemulsion Polymerization 285
Emulsion Polymerization Reactors 286
Reactor Types and Processes 286
Stirred-tank Reactors 286
Tubular Reactors 287
Reactor Equipment 288
Mixing 289
Heat Transfer 290
Reaction Engineering 290
Mass Balances 291

XI

XII

Contents

6.9.2
6.9.3

Heat Balance 292


Polymer Particle Population Balance (Particle Size Distribution)
294

6.9.4
6.10
6.10.1
6.10.1.1
6.10.1.2
6.10.1.3
6.10.1.4
6.10.1.5
6.10.1.6
6.11

Scaleup 295
On-line Monitoring in Emulsion Polymerization Reactors
On-line Sensor Selection 297
Latex Gas Chromatography 298
Head-space Gas Chromatography 298
Densimetry 298
Ultrasound 299
Spectroscopic Techniques 299
Reaction Calorimetry 302
Control of Emulsion Polymerization Reactors 305
Notation 312
References 317

Ionic Polymerization 323


Klaus-Dieter Hungenberg
Introduction 323

7.1
7.2
7.2.1
7.2.1.1
7.2.1.2
7.2.1.3
7.2.1.4
7.2.1.5
7.2.1.6
7.2.2

296

Anionic Polymerization 325


Anionic Polymerization of Hydrocarbon Monomers Living
Polymerization 326
Association Behavior/Kinetics 326
Molecular Weight Distribution of Living Polymers 331
Side Reactions 336
Copolymerization 338
Tailor-made Polymers by Living Polymerization Optimization 341
Industrial Aspects Production of Living Polymers 343
Anionic Polymerization of Vinyl Monomers Containing Heteroatoms
344

7.2.3

Anionic Polymerization of Monomers Containing Hetero Double Bonds


346

7.2.4
7.3
7.3.1
7.3.2
7.4

Anionic Polymerization via Ring Opening 346


Cationic Polymerization 351
Cationic Polymerization of Vinyl Monomers 351
Cationic Ring-opening Polymerization 353
Conclusion 356
Notation 357
References 359

Coordination Polymerization 365


Joao B. P. Soares and Leonardo C. Simon

8.1
8.1.1
8.1.2

Polyolen Properties and Applications 365


Introduction 365
Types of Polyolens and Their Properties 366

Contents

8.1.3
8.2
8.2.1
8.2.2
8.2.3
8.3

The Importance of Proper Microstructural Determination and Control


in Polyolens 369
Catalysts for Olen Polymerization 372
ZieglerNatta, Phillips, and Vanadium Catalysts 378
Metallocene Catalysts 379
Late Transition Metal Catalysts 381
Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts
383

8.3.1

Comparison between Coordination and Free-radical Polymerization


383

8.3.2
8.3.2.1
8.3.2.2
8.3.3
8.3.4
8.4
8.5
8.5.1
8.5.2
8.6
8.6.1
8.6.2
8.6.3
8.6.4

9.1
9.2
9.3
9.3.1
9.3.2
9.3.3
9.4
9.5
9.5.1
9.5.2
9.5.3
9.6
9.6.1
9.6.2

Polymerization Kinetics with Single-site Catalysts 383


Homopolymerization 383
Copolymerization 388
Polymerization Kinetics with Multiple-site Catalysts 392
Long-chain Branch Formation 395
Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances 399
Macroscopic Reactor Modeling Population Balances and the Method
of Moments 408
Homopolymerization 408
Copolymerization 413
Types of Industrial Reactors 416
Gas-phase Reactors 420
Slurry Reactors 422
Solution Reactors 423
Multizone Reactors 425
Notation 425
References 428
Mathematical Methods 431
P. D. Iedema and N. H. Kolhapure
Introduction 431

Discrete Galerkin hp Finite Element Method 432


Method of Moments 435
Introduction 435
Linear Polymerization 435
Nonlinear Polymerization 438
Comparison of Galerkin-FEM and Method of Moments 440
Classes Approach 444
Introduction 444
Computing the CLD of Poly(vinyl acetate) for a Maximum of One TDB
per Chain 444
Multiradicals in Radical Polymerization 446
Pseudo-distribution Approach 449
Introduction 449
CLD/DBD for Mixed-metallocene Polymerization of Ethylene 451

XIII

XIV

Contents

9.6.2.1
9.6.2.2
9.6.3
9.6.3.1
9.6.3.2
9.6.3.3

Formulation of Pseudo-distribution Problem 451


Construction of the Full 2D Distribution 456
CLD/Number of Terminal Double Bonds (TDB) Distribution for
Poly(vinyl acetate) More than one TDB per Chain 458
General Case 458
TDB Pseudo-distribution Approach for a Maximum of one TDB per
Chain 466
TDB Pseudo-distribution Approach for More than one TDB per Chain
467

9.6.4

Radical Polymerization of Ethylene to Low-density Polyethylene (LDPE)


469

9.6.4.1
9.6.5
9.6.5.1
9.6.5.2
9.7
9.7.1
9.7.2
9.7.3
9.8
9.8.1
9.8.2
9.8.3
9.8.4
9.8.5
9.8.6
9.8.7
9.8.8
9.8.9
9.8.10
9.8.11
9.9
9.9.1
9.9.2
9.9.3
9.9.3.1
9.9.3.2
9.9.3.3
9.9.3.4
9.9.4

Introduction 469
Radical Copolymerization 473
Introduction 473
Balance Equations 474
Probability Generating Functions 480
Introduction 480
Probability Generating Functions in a Transformation Method 480
Probability Generating Functions and Cascade Theory 481
Monte Carlo Simulations 485
Introduction 485
Weight-fraction Sampling of Primary Polymers: Batch Reactor,
Transfer to Polymer 486
Example 490
CSTR with Transfer to Polymer 491
Comparison of Galerkin-FEM Classes Model and CSTR with Transfer
to Polymer 492
Batch Reactor, Terminal Double Bond Incorporation 493
CSTR, Terminal Double Bond Incorporation 497
Incorporation of Recombination Termination 498
Incorporation of Random Scission, Linear Chains, Batch Reactor 498
Combined Scission/Branching 501
Scission in a CSTR 501
Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo
Sampling 502
Introduction 502
Branched Architectures from Radical Polymerization in a CSTR 503
Branched Architectures from Polymerization of Olens with Single
and Mixed Branch-forming Metallocene Catalysts in a CSTR 505
Introduction 505
Single-catalyst System 505
Synthesis of Topology 505
Mixed-catalyst System 508
Mathematical Methods for Characterization of Branched Architectures
510

9.9.4.1

Graph Theoretical Connectivity Matrices

510

Contents

9.9.4.2
9.9.4.3
9.10
9.10.1
9.10.1.1
9.10.2

Characterization of Architectures by Radius of Gyration 511


Characterization of Architectures by Seniorities and Priorities 512
Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors 517
Introduction 517
Modeling Challenges 517
Development and Optimization of Modern Polymerization Reactors
518

9.10.2.1
9.10.2.2
9.10.3
9.10.3.1
9.10.3.2
9.10.3.3
9.10.4
9.10.4.1
9.10.5

Benets of CFD 519


Limitations of CFD 519
Integration of CFD with Polymerization Kinetics 520
Classication and Complexity of CFD Models 521
Treatment of Polymerization Kinetics 522
Illustration of Homogeneous Reactor Model Formulation
Target Applications 523
Illustrative Case Studies 523
Concluding Remarks 528
Acknowledgments 530
References 530

10

Scaleup of Polymerization Processes


E. Bruce Nauman

10.1
10.2
10.3
10.4
10.5
10.6
10.7
10.8
10.9
10.10
10.11
10.12
10.13
10.14
10.15

Historic and Economic Perspective 533


The Limits of Scale 533
Scaleup Goals 534
General Approaches 535
Scaleup Factors 537
Stirred-tank Reactors 537
Design Considerations for Stirred Tanks 541
Multiphase Stirred Tanks 542
Stirred Tanks in Series 542
Tubular Reactors 543
Static Mixers 545
Design Considerations for Tubular Reactors 546
Extruder and Extruder-like Reactors 549
Casting Systems 549
Concluding Remarks 550
Notation 550
References 551

522

533

Volume 2
11

11.1
11.2
11.2.1

Safety of Polymerization Processes


Francis Stoessel
Introduction 553

553

Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization


Cooling Failure Scenario 554

554

XV

XVI

Contents

11.2.2
11.2.2.1
11.2.3
11.2.3.1
11.2.3.2
11.2.3.3
11.2.3.4
11.2.3.5
11.2.3.6
11.2.3.7
11.2.4
11.2.5
11.3
11.3.1
11.3.2
11.3.3
11.4
11.4.1
11.4.2
11.4.3
11.5

Criticality Classes Applied to Polymerization Reactors 557


Description of the Criticality Classes 558
Heat Balance of Reactors 559
Heat Production 559
Heat Exchange 560
Heat Accumulation 561
Convective Heat Transport due to Feed 561
Stirrer 561
Heat Losses 562
Simplied Expression of the Heat Balance 562
Dynamic Control of Reactors 562
Thermal Stability of Polymerization Reaction Masses 563
Specic Safety Aspects of Polymerization Reactions 564
Kinetic Aspects 564
Thermochemical Aspects 565
Factors Leading to Changing Heat Release Rates 568
Cooling of Polymerization Reactors 570
Indirect Cooling: Heat Exchange Across the Reactor Wall 570
Hot Cooling: Cooling by Evaporation 574
Importance of the Viscosity 578
Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes
579

11.5.1
11.5.2
11.5.2.1
11.5.2.2
11.5.2.3
11.5.2.4
11.5.3
11.5.3.1
11.5.3.2
11.5.4
11.5.4.1
11.5.4.2
11.5.4.3
11.5.4.4
11.5.4.5
11.5.4.6
11.5.4.7
11.5.4.8
11.5.4.9
11.5.4.10
11.6

Batch Processes 579


Semi-batch Processes 580
Initiation 581
Feed 582
Final Stage 583
Practical Aspects 583
Continuous Processes 584
Concentration Stability 584
Particle Number Stability 584
Design Measures for Safety 585
Process Design 586
Reactor Design 586
Control of Feed 587
Emergency Cooling 587
Inhibition 588
Quenching 588
Dumping 588
Controlled Depressurization 588
Pressure Relief 588
Time Factor 589
Conclusion 589
References 590
Notation 591

Contents

12

12.1
12.1.1
12.1.2
12.2
12.2.1
12.2.1.1
12.2.1.2
12.2.1.3
12.2.1.4
12.2.2
12.2.3
12.2.4
12.2.5
12.2.6
12.2.7
12.2.8
12.2.9
12.2.10
12.2.11
12.3
12.3.1
12.3.2
12.3.3
12.3.4
12.4
12.4.1
12.4.2
12.4.2.1
12.4.2.2
12.4.2.3
12.4.2.4
12.4.2.5
12.4.2.6
12.4.3
12.4.3.1
12.4.3.2
12.4.3.3
12.4.3.4
12.4.3.5
12.4.3.6
12.4.3.7
12.4.3.8
12.4.4

Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors


John R. Richards and John P. Congalidis
Introduction 595
Denitions 595
Measurement Error 597
Measurement Techniques 598
Temperature 599
Resistance Thermometers 599
Thermocouples 600
Expansion Thermometers 601
Radiation Pyrometers 601
Pressure Measurement 602
Weight 604
Liquid Level 605
Flow 608
Densitometry, Dilatometery, and Gravimetry 617
Viscosity 619
Composition 620
Surface Tension 622
Molecular Weight Distribution (MWD) 622
Particle Size Distribution (PSD) 623
Sensor Signal Processing 625
Sensors and Transmitters 625
Converters 626
Indicators 626
Filtering Techniques 627
Regulatory Control Engineering 627
General 627
Process Dynamics 630
First-order System 631
Second-order System 632
High-order and Dead Time Systems 636
First-order Plus Dead Time System 636
Integrating System 638
Integrator plus Dead Time System 639
Controllers 639
Proportional Control 640
Integral Control 641
Derivative Control 641
PI, PD, and PID Control 642
Digital Controllers 642
Controller Tuning 644
OnO Controllers 646
Self-operated Regulators 647
Valve Position Controllers 650

595

XVII

XVIII

Contents

12.4.5
12.4.6
12.4.7
12.5
12.5.1
12.5.1.1
12.5.1.2
12.5.2
12.5.3
12.5.4
12.5.5
12.5.6
12.5.6.1
12.5.6.2
12.5.7

Single-loop Controllers 650


Digital Control Systems 650
Actuators 652
Advanced Control Engineering 656
Feedforward Control 659
Steady-state Model Feedforward Control
Ratio Control 660
Cascade Control 661
FeedforwardFeedback Control 663
State Estimation Techniques 666
Model Predictive Control 668
Batch and Semi-batch Control 669
Operation and Variability 669
Statistical Process Control 671
Future Trends 671
Notation 672
References 675

13

Polymer Properties through Structure


Uday Shankar Agarwal

13.1
13.1.1
13.1.2
13.1.3
13.1.4
13.1.5
13.1.6
13.1.7
13.1.8

Thermal Properties of Polymers 679


Crystalline and Amorphous Polymers 680
Inuence of Polymer Structure on Crystallizability of Polymers 682
The Glass Transition Temperature 683
Inuence of Polymer Structure on Tg of Polymers 684
The Crystallization Temperature and the Melting Point 686
Tuning Polymer Crystallization for Properties 686
Morphology of Crystalline Polymers 688
Tailoring Polymer Properties through Modication, Additives, and
Reinforcement 690
New Morphologies through Block Copolymers 691
Polymeric Nanocomposites 692
Polymer Conformation and Related Properties 692
The Chain Conformation 692
Solubility of Polymers 694
Dilute Solution Zero-shear Viscosity 695
Polymers as Dumbbells 696
Polymers as Chains of Beads and Springs 697
Viscosity of Concentrated Solutions and Melts 698
Nonlinear Polymers 699
Rigid Rod-like Polymers 701
Polymer Rheology 702
The Viscous Response: Shear Thinning 702
Normal Stresses during Shear Flow 703
Extensional Thickening 705

13.1.8.1
13.1.8.2
13.2
13.2.1
13.2.2
13.2.3
13.2.3.1
13.2.3.2
13.2.4
13.2.5
13.2.6
13.3
13.3.1
13.3.2
13.3.3

660

679

Contents

13.3.4
13.3.4.1
13.3.4.2
13.3.5
13.3.5.1
13.3.6
13.3.7
13.3.8
13.3.9
13.4

The Elastic Response 706


Ideal Elastic Response 706
Rubberlike Elasticity 706
The Viscoelastic Response 707
Linear Viscoelasticity in Dynamic Oscillatory Flow 709
Inuence of Polymer Branching Architecture in Bulk Polymers 711
Polymers as Rheology Modiers 712
Rheological Control with Block Copolymers 714
Polymer-like Structures through Noncovalent Associations 715
Summary 715
Notation 716
References 718

14

Polymer Mechanical Properties


Christopher J. G. Plummer
Introduction 721
Long-chain Molecules 721

14.1
14.1.1
14.1.2
14.2
14.2.1
14.2.2
14.2.3
14.3
14.3.1
14.3.2
14.3.3
14.3.4
14.4
14.4.1
14.4.2
14.4.3
14.4.4
14.5

15

15.1
15.2
15.2.1
15.2.1.1
15.2.1.2
15.2.1.3
15.2.1.4
15.2.2

721

Simple Statistical Descriptions of Long-chain Molecules 722


Elasticity 724
Deformation of an Elastic Solid 724
Thermodynamics of Rubber Elasticity 725
Statistical Mechanical Approach to Rubber Elasticity 727
Viscoelasticity 729
Linear Viscoelasticity 729
TimeTemperature Superposition 734
Molecular Models for Polymer Dynamics 736
Nonlinear Viscoelasticity 740
Yield and Fracture 741
Yield in Polymers 741
Models for Yield 744
Semicrystalline Polymers 746
Crazing and Fracture 748
Conclusion 752
References 755
Polymer Degradation and Stabilization
Tuan Quoc Nguyen
Introduction 757

757

General Features of Polymer Degradation 759


Degradative Reactions 759
Initiation 760
Propagation 760
Chain Branching 761
Termination 762
Some Nonradical Degradation Mechanisms 763

XIX

XX

Contents

15.2.3
15.2.3.1
15.2.3.2
15.3
15.3.1
15.3.2
15.3.3
15.3.4
15.3.4.1
15.3.4.2
15.3.5
15.3.6
15.4
15.4.1
15.4.2
15.4.3
15.4.4
15.4.4.1
15.4.4.2
15.4.4.3
15.4.4.4
15.4.4.5
15.4.4.6
15.4.5
15.4.6
15.4.6.1
15.4.6.2
15.4.6.3
15.4.6.4
15.4.6.5
15.5
15.5.1
15.5.2
15.5.3
15.5.4
15.5.5
15.5.5.1
15.5.5.2
15.5.5.3
15.6
15.6.1
15.6.2
15.6.3
15.6.4
15.6.4.1

Physical Factors 763


Glass Transition Temperature 764
Polymer Morphology 766
Degradation Detection Methods 767
Mechanical Tests 768
Gel Permeation Chromatography 771
Fourier Transform Infrared Spectroscopy 773
Magnetic Resonance Spectroscopy 775
Nuclear Magnetic Resonance (NMR) 775
Electron Spin Resonance (ESR) 776
Oxygen Uptake 776
Chemiluminescence 778
Thermal Degradation 778
Thermal Stability 779
Polymer Structure and Thermal Stability 779
Computer Simulation 780
Thermal Oxidative Degradation of Polypropylene 782
Initiation 782
Propagation 784
Chain Branching 785
Termination 786
Secondary Reactions 786
Formation of Volatile Compounds 788
Homogeneous versus Heterogeneous Kinetics 789
Applications of Thermal Degradation 790
Analytical Pyrolysis 790
Introduction of New Chemical Functionalities 791
Chemical Modication of Polymer Structure 791
Metal Injection Molding (MIM) 792
Recycling 792
Photodegradation 793
Absorption of UV Radiation by Polymers 793
The Solar Spectrum 796
Photo-oxidation Prole 796
Inuence of Wavelength: the Activation and Action Spectrum
Photodegradation Mechanisms 802
Photoinitiation 802
The Norrish Photoprocesses 803
Photo-Fries Rearrangement 803
Radiolytic Degradation 805
Interaction of High-energy Radiation with Matter 805
Radiation Chemistry 807
Radiolysis Stabilization 810
Applications 811
Radiation Sterilization 812

799

Contents

15.6.4.2
15.7
15.7.1
15.7.1.1
15.7.1.2
15.7.1.3
15.7.2
15.7.3
15.8
15.8.1
15.8.1.1
15.8.1.2
15.8.1.3
15.8.2
15.8.3
15.8.4
15.8.4.1
15.8.4.2
15.9
15.10

Controlled Degradation and Crosslinking 812


Mechanochemical Degradation 813
Initiation by Mechanical Stresses 813
Eect of Tensile Stress on Chemical Reactivity 813
Breaking Strength of a Covalent Bond 814
Rate of Stress-activated Chain Scission 815
Extrusion Degradation 816
Applications 817
Control and Prevention of Aging of Plastic Materials
Antioxidants 818
Radical Antioxidants 818
Hindered Amine Stabilizers (HAS) 819
Peroxide Decomposers 821
Photostabilizers 822
PVC Heat Stabilizers 823
Other Classes of Stabilizers 824
Metal Deactivators 824
Antiozonants 824
Lifetime Prediction 824
Conclusions 826
Notation 827
References 830

16

Thermosets 833
Rolf A. T. M. van Benthem, Lars J. Evers, Jo Mattheij, Ad Hoand, Leendert J.
Molhoek, Ad J. de Koning, Johan F. G. A. Jansen, and Martin van Duin
Introduction 833
Thermoset Materials 833
Networks 834
Advantages 835
Curing Resins 835
Functionality 835
Formulation 836
Production 837
General Areas of Application 837
Phenolic Resins 838
Introduction 838
Chemistry 838
Resols 840
Novolacs 840
Epoxy-novolacs 841
Discoloration 841
Production 842
Properties and Applications 842
Amino Resins 843

16.1
16.1.1
16.1.2
16.1.3
16.1.4
16.1.5
16.1.6
16.1.7
16.1.8
16.2
16.2.1
16.2.2
16.2.2.1
16.2.2.2
16.2.2.3
16.2.2.4
16.2.3
16.2.4
16.3

818

XXI

XXII

Contents

16.3.1
16.3.2
16.3.2.1
16.3.3
16.3.4
16.4
16.4.1
16.4.2
16.4.2.1
16.4.3
16.4.3.1
16.4.3.2
16.4.3.3
16.4.4
16.5
16.5.1
16.5.2
16.5.2.1
16.5.2.2
16.5.3
16.5.4
16.5.4.1
16.5.4.2
16.5.4.3
16.5.5
16.5.5.1
16.6
16.6.1
16.6.2
16.6.3
16.6.3.1
16.6.4
16.6.5
16.6.5.1
16.6.5.2
16.6.5.3
16.7
16.7.1
16.7.2
16.7.2.1
16.7.2.2
16.7.2.3
16.7.3
16.7.4
16.7.5

Introduction 843
Chemistry 843
Polymerization Chemistry 845
Production 848
Properties and Applications 849
Epoxy Resins 849
Introduction 849
Chemistry 850
Cure 851
Production 853
Standard Liquid 853
Tay Process 854
Advancement Process 854
Properties and Applications 855
Alkyd Resins 855
Introduction 855
Chemistry 856
The Alkyd Constant 858
Autoxidative Drying 858
Production 859
Properties and Applications 861
Short Oil Alkyds 861
Long Oil Alkyds 861
Medium Oil Alkyds 861
Alkyd Emulsions 861
The Inversion Process 862
Saturated Polyester Resins 862
Introduction 862
Chemistry 863
Production 865
Monitoring the Reaction 865
Properties and Applications 866
Powder Coatings 866
Application 867
Crosslinking 868
Advantages 869
Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites
Introduction 869
Chemistry 869
Crosslinking 871
Styrene Emission 871
Vinyl Ester Resins 873
Production 874
Reinforcement 875
Fillers 878

869

Contents

16.7.6
16.7.6.1
16.7.6.2
16.7.6.3
16.7.6.4
16.7.6.5
16.7.6.6
16.7.6.7
16.7.6.8
16.7.6.9
16.7.6.10

Processing 879
Hand Lay-up and Spray-up 882
Continuous Lamination 882
Filament Winding 882
Centrifugal Casting 882
Pultrusion 883
Cold-press Molding 883
Resin Infusion 883
Resin-transfer Molding 883
Hot-press Molding 883
Casting, Encapsulation, and Coating (Non-reinforced Applications)
886

16.7.7
16.8
16.8.1
16.8.2
16.8.3
16.8.3.1
16.8.3.2
16.8.3.3
16.8.3.4
16.8.3.5
16.8.3.6
16.8.3.7
16.8.3.8
16.8.3.9
16.8.4
16.8.5
16.8.5.1
16.8.5.2
16.8.5.3
16.8.5.4
16.8.5.5
16.8.5.6
16.8.5.7
16.9
16.9.1
16.9.1.1
16.9.2
16.9.3
16.9.3.1
16.9.3.2
16.9.3.3
16.9.4
16.9.4.1

Design Considerations: Mechanical Properties of Composites 886


Acrylate Resins and UV Curing 889
Introduction 889
Chemistry 890
Production 891
Epoxy Acrylates 891
Polyester Acrylates 891
Urethane Acrylates 892
Inside-out 893
Outside-in 894
Comparing Inside-out with Outside-in 894
Stabilization 894
Dilution 895
Safety 895
Properties 895
Introduction to UV Curing 896
General Introduction to UV-initiated Radical Polymerization 896
Photoinitiators for Radical Polymerization 897
Resin 897
Reactive Diluent 898
Curing Process 899
Cationic Curing 900
Base-mediated Curing 901
Rubber 901
Introduction 901
Types of Rubber 902
Polymerization 903
Crosslinking 904
Sulfur Vulcanization 904
Peroxide Curing 905
Processing 906
Properties and Applications 907
Advantages and Disadvantages 907

XXIII

XXIV

Contents

16.9.4.2

Thermoplastic Vulcanizates
Notation 908
References 909

17

Fibers 911
J. A. Juijn

17.1
17.1.1
17.1.2
17.2
17.2.1
17.2.2
17.2.3
17.2.4
17.2.5
17.2.6
17.2.7
17.3
17.3.1
17.3.2
17.3.3
17.4
17.4.1
17.4.2
17.4.3
17.4.4
17.4.4.1
17.4.4.2
17.4.5
17.4.6
17.4.7
17.4.8
17.4.9
17.4.10
17.4.11
17.4.12
17.4.12.1
17.4.12.2
17.4.12.3
17.4.13
17.4.13.1
17.4.13.2
17.4.13.3
17.4.13.4

Introduction 911
A Fiber World 911
Scope of this Chapter 912
Fiber Terminology 912
Denitions: Fibers, Filaments, Spinning 912
Synthetic Yarns 914
Titer: Tex and Denier 914
Tenacity and Modulus: g denierC1, N texC1 , or GPa 915
Yarn Appearance 916
Textile, Carpet, and Industrial Yarns 917
Physical Structure 918
Fiber Polymers: Choice of Spinning Process 920
Polymer Requirements 920
Selection of Spinning Process 920
Spinnability 922
Melt Spinning 923
Extrusion 923
Polymer Lines and Spin-box 924
Spinning Pumps 925
Spinning Assembly 926
Filtration 926
Spinning Plate 926
Quenching 928
Finish 929
Spinning Speed 931
Winding 931
Drawing 931
Relaxation and Stabilization 934
Process Integration 934
Rheology 934
Shear Viscosity 934
Elasticity 936
Elongational Viscosity 936
Process Calculations 936
Mass Flow 937
Volume Flow 937
Extrusion Speed and Elongation in the Spin-line 937
Pressure Drop over the Spinning Holes 938

907

Contents

17.4.14
17.4.14.1
17.4.14.2
17.4.14.3
17.4.14.4
17.4.14.5
17.4.15
17.4.15.1
17.4.15.2
17.4.15.3
17.4.15.4
17.4.15.5
17.4.16
17.4.16.1
17.4.16.2
17.4.16.3
17.4.16.4
17.4.16.5
17.5
17.5.1
17.5.2
17.5.2.1
17.5.2.2
17.5.2.3
17.5.3
17.5.3.1
17.5.3.2
17.5.3.3
17.6
17.7
17.7.1
17.7.1.1
17.7.1.2
17.7.2
17.7.2.1
17.7.2.2
17.7.2.3
17.7.3
17.7.3.1
17.7.3.2
17.7.3.3
17.7.4

Polyester (Poly(ethylene terephthalate), PET) 938


PET Polymer 938
Spinning of PET 939
PET Staple Fiber 939
PET Textile Filament Yarns 940
PET Industrial Yarns 940
Polyamide (PA6 and PA66) 941
PA Polymer 941
PA Spinning 941
PA Staple Fiber 942
PA Textile Filament Yarns 942
PA Industrial Yarns 942
Polypropylene (PP) 943
PP Polymer 943
PP Spinning 943
PP Staple Fiber 943
PP Split Fiber 943
PP Filament Yarns 944
Solution Spinning 944
Preparation of Spinning Dope 944
Dry Spinning 944
Cellulose Acetate 945
Acrylics 946
Poly(vinyl alcohol) 946
Wet Spinning 946
Viscose Rayon 948
Acrylics 951
Poly(vinyl alcohol) 952
Comparison of Melt and Solution Spinning 953
High-modulus, High-strength Fibers 956
Air-gap Spinning 956
Aramids 956
Other Liquid-crystalline Polymers 960
Gel Spinning 961
Theory 961
Gel Spinning of Polyethylene 962
Other Gel-spun or Superdrawn Fibers 964
Carbon Fiber 965
Carbon Fiber from PAN 965
Carbon Fiber from Pitch 966
Applications of Carbon Fibers 966
Other Advanced Fibers 966
Notation 967
Acknowledgments 969
References 969

XXV

XXVI

Contents

18

18.1
18.2
18.2.1
18.2.1.1
18.2.1.2
18.2.1.3
18.3
18.4
18.4.1
18.4.1.1
18.4.2
18.4.2.1
18.4.2.2
18.4.2.3
18.4.2.4
18.4.3
18.4.4
18.5

19

19.1
19.1.1
19.1.2
19.2
19.3
19.4
19.5
19.6
19.7

20

20.1
20.2
20.2.1
20.2.2
20.2.3

Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers


Mara J. Barandiaran and Jose M. Asua
Introduction 971
Polymer Melts and Solutions 972
Devolatilization 973
Fundamentals 973
Implementation of Devolatilization 975
Equipment 975
Polyolens 979
Waterborne Dispersions 979
Post-polymerization 980
Modeling Post-polymerization 981
Devolatilization 981
Modeling 982
Rate-limiting Steps 985

Devolatilization under Equilibrium Conditions


Equipment 986
Combined Processes 988
Alternative Processes 989
Summary 989
Notation 990
References 991

971

986

Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers 995


Christiane de Witz, Carlos Sanchez, Cees Bastiaansen, and Dirk J. Broer
Introduction 995
Patterning Techniques 996
Photoembossing 998
Materials and their Photoresponsive Behavior 999
Single-exposure Photoembossing 1001
Dual-exposure Photoembossing 1007

Complex Surface Structures from Interfering UV Laser Beams


Surface Structure Development under Fluids 1010
Conclusion 1012
Acknowledgments 1012
Notation 1013
References 1013
Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers 1015
Peter Schoenmakers and Petra Aarnoutse
Introduction 1015
Process Analysis 1017
Near-infrared Spectroscopy 1017
In-situ Raman Spectroscopy 1018
At-line Conversion Measurements 1020

1007

Contents

20.3
20.3.1
20.3.1.1
20.3.2
20.3.2.1
20.3.2.2
20.3.2.3
20.3.3
20.3.3.1
20.3.3.2
20.3.3.3
20.3.3.4
20.3.3.5

Polymer Analysis 1022


Basic Laboratory Measurements 1022
Conversion 1022
Detailed Molecular Analysis 1023
FTIR Spectroscopy 1023
NMR Spectroscopy 1024
Mass Spectrometry 1025
Polymer Distributions 1030
Molecular Weight Distributions 1030
Functionality-type Distributions 1034
Chemical Composition Distributions (CCDs) 1037
Degree of Branching Distributions 1040
Complex Polymers (Multiple Distributions) 1041
Notation 1044
References 1045

21

Recent Developments in Polymer Processes


Maartje Kemmere
Introduction 1047

21.1
21.2
21.2.1
21.2.1.1
21.2.1.2
21.2.1.3
21.2.2
21.2.3
21.2.3.1
21.2.3.2
21.3
21.3.1
21.3.2
21.3.3
21.3.3.1
21.3.3.2
21.3.3.3
21.3.4
21.3.5
21.4

1047

Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide 1048


Interactions of Carbon Dioxide with Polymers and Monomers 1050
Solubility in Carbon Dioxide 1051
Sorption and Swelling of Polymers 1052
Phase Behavior of MonomerPolymerCarbon Dioxide Systems 1054
Polymerization Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide 1055
Polymer Processing in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide 1058
Extraction 1060
Impregnation and Dyeing 1061
Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization 1062
Ultrasound and Cavitation in Liquids 1063
Radical Formation by Cavitation 1065
Cavitation-induced Polymerization 1067
Bulk Polymerization 1067
Precipitation Polymerization 1069
Emulsion Polymerization 1070
Cavitation-induced Polymer Scission 1072
Synthesis of Block Copolymers 1073
Concluding Remarks and Outlook for the Future 1074
Acknowledgments 1076
Notation 1076
References 1077
Index

1083

XXVII

XXIX

Preface
Freshly started as chairman and secretary of the Working Party on Polymer Reaction Engineering it never crossed our mind to edit a book on this subject. This
changed when Wiley-VCH asked if the working party would be able to provide a
translation of the Handbuch der Technischen Polymerchemie, written in 1993 by
Adolf Echte. We decided to do so, but not exactly. Very rapidly we were convinced
that we needed a completely new book, covering the eld of polymer reaction engineering in a modern, broad and multidisciplinary approach. Many of the working
party members directly agreed to participate, others needed somewhat stronger
persuasion techniques, and for some chapters we hired authors from other institutions. In June 2003 we had completed the list of contributors, coming from
Europe, Canada and the USA. Now, roughly one year later, the new handbook is
there.
The quality an edited book like this very much depends on the quality of the individual contributions. It has been a great pleasure for us to see that all authors
have taken their writing jobs very seriously. With these contributions, we are sure
that this book represents the state of the art in polymer reaction engineering. It
is intended to attract equally readers that are new in the eld as well as readers
that may be considered expert in some of the topics but want to broaden their
knowledge. We are convinced that the multidisciplinary and synergetic approach
presented in this book may act as an eye-opener for research and development activities going on in strongly related areas. We hope the reader will take advantage
of this approach, where the references given in the various chapters may be a starting point for further reading.
Reading books, you often read the preface as well. We have seen numerous examples from which the frustration is quite obvious. Of course things may not always work out the way you plan, that has also been the case for this book. Maybe
we were just lucky, but we have greatly enjoyed doing this. Editing this book has
also been a starting point for the editors to become friends, including Swiss cheese
fondue and Dutch Friese nagelkaastaart in a friendly home setting. From that
perspective also Francine and Maartje have had their part both of the workload
but also of the fun of all this.
Finally, we would like to thank Karin Sora and Renate Doetzer from Wiley-VCH

XXX

Preface

for their help with the editing process. They really know to nd the balance between waiting and pushing in order not to diverge too far from the schedule.
Lausanne & Eindhoven, fall 2004
Thierry Meyer & Jos Keurentjes

XXXI

List of Contributors
P. Aarnoutse
Polymer-Analysis Group
Department of Chemical Engineering
(ITS)
Faculty of Science, University of
Amsterdam
Nieuwe Achtergracht 166
1018 WV Amsterdam
The Netherlands
Dr. U. S. Agarwal
Polymer Technology Group
Department of Chemical Engineering
and Chemistry
Eindhoven University of Technology
P.O. Box 513
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands
Prof. J. M. Asua
The University of the Basque Country
Institute for Polymer Materials
(POLYMAT)
Paseo Manuel Lardizabal 3
20018 Donostia-San Sebastian
Spain
Dr. R. Bachmann
Bayer AG
ZT-TE-SVT
51368 Leverkusen
Germany

Prof. M. J. Barandiaran
The University of the Basque Country
Institute for Polymer Materials
(POLYMAT)
Manuel Lardizabal, 3
20018 Donostia-San Sebastian
Spain
Dr. C. W. M. Bastiaansen
Eindhoven University of Technology
Den Dolech 2
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands
Prof. D. J. Broer
Philips Research Laboratories
Prof. Holstlaan 4
5656 AA Eindhoven
The Netherlands
and
Eindhoven University of Technology
Den Dolech 2
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands
and
Dutch Polymer Institute (DPI)
P.O. Box 902
5600 AX Eindhoven
The Netherlands

XXXII

List of Contributors

Polymer Technology
Department of Chemical Engineering
and Chemistry
Eindhoven University of Technology
P.O. Box 513
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands

Prof. J. C. de la Cal
The University of the Basque Country
Institute for Polymer Materials
(POLYMAT)
Paseo Manuel Lardizabal, 3
20018 Donostia-San Sebastian
Spain

Prof. B. W. Brooks
Loughborough University
Department of Chemical
Engineering
Loughborough
Leicestershire, LE11 3TU
United Kingdom

Dr. A. J. de Koning
DSM Research
Oude Postbaan 1
6167 RG Geleen
The Netherlands

Dr. A. Butte`
Swiss Federal Institute of
Technology
Zurich, ETHZ
Institut fur Chemie- und
Bioingenieurwissenschaten
Gruppe Morbidelli
ETH Hoenggerberg/HCI F135
8093 Zurich
Switzerland
Dr. J. P. Congalidis
E.I. du Pont de Nemours and
Company
DuPont Central Research and
Development
Experimental Station
Wilmington, DE 19880
USA
Dr. M. R. P. F. N. Costa
Faculty of Engineering
University of Porto
Rua Roberto Frias, s/n
4200-465 Porto
Portugal

Dr. T. W. de Loos
Delft University of Technology
Faculty of Applied Sciences
Department Chemical Technology
Julianalaan 136
2628 BL Delft
The Netherlands
C. de Witz
Philips Research Laboratories
Prof. Holstlaan 4
5656 AA Eindhoven
The Netherlands
Dr. L. J. Evers
DSM Melamine
Oude Postbaan 1
6167 RG Geleen
The Netherlands
Dr. A. Hoand
DSM Coating Resins
Ceintuurbaan 5
8022 AW Zwolle
The Netherlands
Dr. K.-D. Hungenberg
BASF AG
Polymer Technology, B1
67056 Ludwigshafen
Germany

List of Contributors

Prof. R. A. Hutchinson
Department of Chemical Engineering
Queens University
Dupuis Hall, 19 Division St.
Kingston, Ontario K7M 2G9
Canada

N. H. Kolhapure
DuPont Engineering Research and
Technology
1007 N. Market St.
Wilmington, DE 19898-0001
USA

Dr. P. D. Iedema
Department of Chemical Engineering
University of Amsterdam
Nieuwe Achtergracht 166
1018 WV Amsterdam
The Netherlands

Prof. J. R. Leiza
The University of the Basque Country
Institute for Polymer Materials
(POLYMAT)
Paseo Manuel Lardizabal 3
20018 Donostia-San Sebastian
Spain

Dr. J. F. G. A. Jansen
DSM Research
Oude Postbaan 1
6167 RG Geleen
The Netherlands
Dr. J. A. Juijn
Research Institute
Department QRI
P.O. Box 9600
6800 TC Arnheim
The Netherlands
Dr. M. F. Kemmere
Process Development Group
Department of Chemical Engineering
and Chemistry
Eindhoven University of Technology
P.O. Box 513
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands
Prof. J. T. F. Keurentjes
Process Development Group
Eindhoven University of Technology
P.O. Box 513
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands

J. Mattheij
DSM Melamine
Oude Postbaan 1
6167 RG Geleen
The Netherlands
Dr. T. Meyer
Swiss Federal Institute of Technology
Institute of Process Science
EPFL, ISP-GPM
1015 Lausanne
Switzerland
L. J. Molhoek
DSM Coating Resins
Ceintuurbaan 5
8022 AW Zwolle
The Netherlands
Prof. M. Morbidelli
Swiss Federal Institute of Technology
Zurich, ETHZ
Institut fur Chemie- und
Bioingenieurwissenschaften
Gruppe Morbidelli
ETH Hoenggerberg/HCI F135
8093 Zurich
Switzerland

XXXIII

XXXIV

List of Contributors

Prof. E. B. Nauman
The Isermann Department of Chemical
and Biological Engineering
Rensselaer Polytechnic Institute
Troy, NY 12180
USA
Dr. Q. T. Nguyen
Laboratory of Polymers (LP)
Ecole Polytechnique Federale
de Lausanne
1015 Lausanne
Switzerland
J. C. Plummer
Laboratory of Composite and Polymer
Technology (LTC)
Ecole Polytechnique Federale
de Lausanne
1015 Lausanne
Switzerland
Dr. J. R. Richards
E. I. du pont de Nemours and Company
DuPont Engineering and Research
Technology
Experimental Station
Wilmington, DE 19880
USA
Dr. C. Sanchez
Eindhoven University of Technology
Den Dolech 2
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands
and
Dutch Polymer Institute (DPI)
P.O. Box 902
5600 AX Eindhoven
The Netherlands

Prof. P. J. Schoenmakers
Polymer-Analysis Group
Department of Chemical Engineering
(ITS)
Faculty of Science, University of
Amsterdam
Nieuwe Achtergracht 166
1018 WV Amsterdam
The Netherlands
Prof. L. C. Simon
Department of Chemical Engineering
University of Waterloo
200 University Avenue West
Waterloo, Ontario N2L 3G1
Canada
Prof. J. B. P. Soares
Department of Chemical Engineering
University of Waterloo
200 University Avenue West
Waterloo, Ontario N2L 3G1
Canada
Prof. F. Stoessel
Swiss Institute for the Promotion of
Safety and Security
Chemical Process Safety Consulting
Klybeckstrasse 141
WKL-32.322
4002 Basel
Switzerland
Prof. G. Storti
Swiss Federal Institute of Technology
Zurich, ETHZ
Institut fur Chemie- und
Bioingenieurwissenschaften
Gruppe Morbidelli
ETH Hoenggerberg/HCI F125
8093 Zurich
Switzerland

List of Contributors

Prof. R. A. T .M. van Benthem


Coating Technology
Department of Chemical Engineering
and Chemistry
Eindhoven University of Technology
P.O. Box 513
5600 MB Eindhoven
The Netherlands

Dr. M. van Duin


DSM Research
Oude Postbaan 1
6167 RG Geleen
The Netherlands

XXXV

Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated


Approach
Th. Meyer and J. T. F. Keurentjes
1.1

Polymer Materials

Synthetic polymers can be denoted as the materials of the 20th century. Since
World War II the production volume of polymers has increased by a factor of 50
to a current value of more than 120 million tonnes annually (Figure 1.1). The consumption per capita has also increased over the years to a worldwide average of approximately 20 kg per annum in the year 2000. In terms of volumetric output, the
production of polymers exceeds that of iron and steel. The enormous growth of
synthetic polymers is due tot the fact that they are lightweight materials, act as insulators for electricity and heat, cover a wide range of properties from soft packaging materials to bers stronger than steel, and allow for relatively easy processing.

25
120

Annual Production
106 to/an

20

100
Consumption,
kg/hab

15

80
60

10
40
5

20

World Population ,
109 people

0
1940
Fig. 1.1.

1950

1960

1970
1980
Year

1990

2000

0
2010

Polymer production and the evolution of the population since 1940 [1].

Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes


Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach


Tab. 1.1.

Applications and 2002 Western European markets for the major thermoplastics [1].

Thermoplastic

Market
[10 3 tonnes]

Applications

LDPE

7935

PP

7803

PVC

5792

HDPE

5269

PET
PS/EPS

3234
3279

PA

1399

pallet and agricultural lm, bags, toys, coatings,


containers, pipes
lm, battery cases, microwave-proof containers, crates,
automotive parts, electrical components
window frames, pipes, ooring, wallpaper, bottles, cling
lm, toys, guttering, cable insulation, credit cards,
medical products
containers, toys, housewares, industrial wrappings and
lms, pipes
bottles, textile bers, lm food packaging
electrical appliances, thermal insulation, tape cassettes,
cups and plates, toys
lm for food packaging (oil, cheese, boil-in-bag), hightemperature engineering applications, textile bers
general appliance moldings
transparent all-weather sheet, electrical insulators,
bathroom units, automotive parts

ABS/SAN
PMMA

788
317

Moreover, parts with complex shapes can be made at low cost and at high speed by
shaping polymers or monomers in the liquid state.
The polymer market can be divided into thermoplastics and thermosets. The major thermoplastics include high-density polyethylene (HDPE), low-density polyethylene (LDPE), polyethylene terephthalate (PET), polypropylene (PP), polystyrene
(PS and EPS), poly(vinyl chloride) (PVC), polyamide (PA), poly(methyl methacrylate) (PMMA) and styrene copolymers (ABS, SAN). The most important applications of thermoplastics are summarized in Table 1.1. The total Western European
demand for thermoplastics was 37.4 million tonnes in 2002, a growth of about 9%
as compared to 2001 [1]. Thermoplastics are used not only in the manufacture of
many typical plastics applications such as packaging and automotive parts, but also
in non-plastic applications such as textile bers and coatings. These non-plastic applications account for about 14% of all thermoplastics consumed.
The major thermosets include epoxy resins, phenolics, and polyurethanes (PU),
for which the major applications are summarized in Table 1.2. It has to be noted,
Tab. 1.2.

Applications and 2002 Western European markets for the major thermosets [1].

Thermoset

Market [10 3 tonnes]

Applications

PU
Phenolics

3089
912

coatings, nishes, cushions, mattresses, vehicle seats


general appliance moldings, adhesives, appliances,
automotive parts, electrical components
adhesives, automotive components, E&E components,
sports equipment, boats

Epoxy resins

420

1.1 Polymer Materials


Domestic
22.3%
Automotive
7.0%
Large industry
5.2%
Electrical and
electronics
7.3%

Building and
construction
17.6%

Fig. 1.2.

Agriculture
2.5%

Packaging
38.1%

Plastic consumption in 2002 by industry sectors in Western Europe [1].

however, that about one-third of the market for thermosets is for relatively smallscale specialty products. The total Western European market for thermosets was
10.4 million tonnes in 2002, about 1% below the 2001 value.
The major application areas of polymers can be dened as follows (Figure 1.2).
Automotive industry Motorists want high-performing cars combined with reliability, safety, comfort, competitive pricing, fuel eciency, and, increasingly, reassurance about the impact on the environment. Lightweight polymeric materials are
increasingly used in this sector (Daimler Benzs Smart is a nice example), also contributing to a 10% reduction in passenger fuel consumption across Europe.
Building and construction Polymeric materials are used in the building and construction sector, for example for insulation, piping, and window frames. In 2002
this sector accounted for 17.6% of the total polymer consumption.
Electrical and electronic industry Many applications in this eld arise from newly
designed polymeric materials, for example for polymeric solar cells and holographic lms. It is interesting to note that, while the number of applications in
this eld is increasing, the weight of the polymers used per unit is decreasing.
Packaging The packaging sector remains the largest consumer of synthetic polymers, approximately 38% of the total market. This is mainly due to the fact that
these materials are lightweight, exible, and easy to process, and are therefore
increasingly being substituted for other materials. Although polymer packaging
ranks rst in terms of units sold, it is only third if judged on weight.
Agriculture As agricultural applications account for about 2.5% of the total of synthetic polymers consumed in Europe, they play only a marginal role. Irrigation and

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach

drainage systems provide eective solutions to crop growing, and polymeric lms
and greenhouses can increase horticultural production substantially. The use of socalled super absorbers for increased irrigation eciency in arid areas can be considered an important emerging market.

1.2

A Short History of Polymer Reaction Engineering

In Table 1.3 a comprehensive overview of the major developments in the polymer


industry is given. In the 19th century, polymers produced by Nature, such as cellulose, Hevea brasiliensis latex (natural rubber), and starch, were processed to manufacture useful products. This practice was often based on experimental discoveries.
As an example, in 1839 Goodyear discovered by mistake the sulfur vulcanization of
natural rubber, making it possible for Ford to develop the automotive market. In
those times no polymers were produced synthetically.
Early in the 20th century (1920), the rst empirical description of macromolecules was developed by Staudinger [2]. At the same time, new methods were developed to determine the specic characteristics of these materials. In the 1930s many
research groups (for examples see refs. 37) developed models for the chain length
distribution in batch reactors resulting from dierent polymer chemistries, a methodology that was further developed in the 1940s leading to more complex and comprehensive models, some of which are still being used today.

Tab. 1.3.

The history of polymers in brief.

19th century
1920
19301940

19401950
19501960

19601970
19701980
19801990
19902000
2000

natural polymer and derivatives (vulcanized rubber, celluloid)


concept of macromolecules postulated by Staudinger
rst systematic synthesis of polymers
synthesis of polyamides (nylon) by Carothers at DuPont
discovery of polyethylene at ICI (Fawcett and Gibson)
synthetic rubbers and synthetic bers
stereospecic polymerizations by Ziegler and Natta, the birth of
polypropylene
discovery of polymer single crystals (Keller, Fischer, Till)
development of polycarbonate
discovery of PPO at GE by Hay and commercialization of PPO/PS
blends (Noryl2 )
liquid-crystalline polymers
superstrong bers (Aramid2 , polyethylene)
functional polymers (conductive, light-emitting)
metallocene-based catalysts; novel polyolens hybrid systems
(polymer/ceramic, polymer/metals)
Nature-inspired catalysts
synthesis of polymers by bacteria and plants

1.3 The Position of Polymer Reaction Engineering

Around 1940, partly inspired by World War II, a more systematic search for new
synthetic polymer materials as a replacement for scarce natural materials led to the
development of nylon (DuPont) and polyethylene (ICI) [8, 9]. This was followed by
the development of synthetic rubbers and synthetic bers. In the same period,
Denbigh [10] was one of the rst to introduce chemical reaction engineering concepts into polymer science by considering polymerization reactions at both the
chemical and at the process levels. Processes were classied as homocontinuous
and heterocontinuous, depending on the mixing level. This pioneering approach
also acted as a catalyst for the further development of polymer reaction engineering (PRE).
The development of catalysts based on transition metals by Ziegler and Natta
[11] allowed the development of stereospecic propylene polymerization processes
and ethylene polymerization in the 1950s. Several process schemes were developed
at that time, of which some are still in use. The major problem in process development has been to deal with the heat of polymerization, an issue that was solved, for
example, by using an inert solvent as a heat sink or by ashing of monomer followed by condensation outside the reactor. In the same period, polycarbonate and
(somewhat later) poly(propylene oxide) (PPO) were developed. The main characteristic of the polymers developed so far was that they were bulk materials, to be produced in extremely large quantities.
In the 1970s, a paradigm shift occurred when polymers with more specic properties started to be produced. This included various liquid crystalline polymers
leading, for example, to the production of superstrong bers such as Aramid2 /
Kevlar 2 [12]. The development of functional polymers for the conduction of light
and electricity and optical switches also started then [13]. In the near future this
will probably lead to highly eective and exible polymer solar cells [14].
In the 1990s, metallocene catalysts were developed for polyolen production that
surpassed the ZieglerNatta catalysts in terms of selectivity and reactivity [15, 16].
Additionally, various hybrid materials were combining properties of both the polymer (lightweight, exible) and a solid material, which could be metal (conductive)
or ceramic (insulating), leading to materials with specic properties applicable, for
example, as protective coatings [17].
Current developments include the mimicking of nature (enzymes) for the synthesis of quite complex polymers like natural silk. Also, bacteria and plants are being modied to produce polymers of interest [18]. However, this can be expected
to require polymer reaction engineering developments that are as yet dicult to
foresee.

1.3

The Position of Polymer Reaction Engineering

Traditional chemical reaction engineering has its basis in the application of scientic principles (from disciplines such as chemistry, physics, biology, and mathematics) and engineering knowledge (transfer of heat, mass, and momentum) to

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach

Energy
Raw material
Safety

Natural gas

Coal, Oil

Capacity

Pollution
control

Water

Process
Scientific
methodology

Quality control
Air

Flexible production

Recycling
Clean processes

Optimization

Green solvents

Intensification

From empiricism to strategy

1980

Renewable feedstock
Integrated and
inherent safety

Plant operation

Market

Fig. 1.3.

Less energy
demanding processes

Integrated heat recovery

1990

Multidisciplinarity

2000

2010

Changing priorities in industrial chemical engineering research.

the solution of problems of practical, industrial, and societal importance. Since the
1970s, a changing focus in chemical reaction engineering can be observed, which
is summarized in Figure 1.3.
To deal with more stringent requirements in terms of energy consumption requires a shift from heat loss minimization toward novel intensied process concepts that intrinsically require less energy. Safety should now be considered as an
intrinsic plant property rather than a responsive action, and the plant needs to be
exible to be able to respond quickly to changes in the market. Last but not least,
new concepts will be required to provide a basis for sustainable future developments, that is, the use of renewable resources and processes based on green
solvents. As a result of this changing focus, a shift toward a multidisciplinary
approach can be observed.
For PRE this implies the combination of several disciplines such as polymer
chemistry, thermodynamics, characterization, modeling, safety, mechanics, physics, and process technology. PRE problems are often of a multi-scale and multifunctional nature to achieve a multi-objective goal. One particular feature of PRE
is that the scope ranges from the micro scale on a molecular level up to the macro
scale of complete industrial systems. PRE plays a crucial role in the transfer of information across the boundaries of dierent scale regions and to provide a comprehensive and coherent basis for the description of these processes [19].
As depicted in Figure 1.4, there is a direct link between time and size scale, from
which it is obvious that the micro and macro scales are not related to the same
time scale [20]. As an example, molecular dynamics calculations are addressing a
time scale in the order of femto- to nanoseconds, whereas process system integration evolves on the scale of years. Engineers have traditionally been working at the
meso scale, which is represented by the middle portion of Figure 1.4, using phe-

1.4 Toward Integrated Polymer Reaction Engineering


Time scale
System integration
Environmental, Global
modeling

Years
Engineering design
Process models

Days

Continuum
Models
Heterogeneous

Minutes

Phenomenological
Models
Microstructure

Milliseconds

Molecular level
Elementary reactions
Molecular modeling
Chemical equilibrium

Nanoseconds

Picoseconds

Atomic level
Fundamental
Quantum techniques
Quantum chemistry

Femtoseconds
1

10

100

1m

1mm

1m

1km

Size scale
Fig. 1.4.

Activities in PRE with their corresponding time and size scales.

nomenological and continuum models. Today these limits are pushed in two directions, both toward a more fundamental understanding and at the same time toward a more global scale. In the past, the micro-region has traditionally been
the domain of physicists and chemists, whereas the macro-region has been the
eld, rather, of process or plant engineers. Today, it becomes obvious that only using a multidisciplinary, parallel, and synergetic approach can lead to successful developments. Polymer reaction engineering will play an essential role as the core
and the coordinator of this complex process.

1.4

Toward Integrated Polymer Reaction Engineering

As will be obvious from the foregoing discussion, PRE is composed of many disciplines all linked together. These disciplines can be either mature or emergent, but
they have a common gateway (see Figure 1.5). Although there is not necessarily a
direct connection between them, there exists a common core in which the dierent
disciplines make their own specic contribution to a general objective.
The frontiers in PRE are determined by what we know, understand, and are able
to quantify, and these frontiers are moving with growing knowledge, competences,
and experience. Eorts to push these limits will induce innovative developments
leading to emerging technologies and products, and will also strengthen the multidisciplinary approach. In general terms, PRE can be dened as the science that

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach

Materials sciences
Thermodynamics

Novel processes

Inherent safety

Materials
Application

Environment
Recycling, Disposal

Modeling and
simulation

Polymer Reaction
Engineering
(PRE)

Process integration
optimization

New products

Polymer chemistry
Reaction kinetics

Post-reaction
processes

Novel processes

Nano-, MicroBio-

Measurement and control

Fig. 1.5.

The expanding sphere of polymer reaction engineering.

brings molecules to an end-use product. We can either consider it like a black box
(Figure 1.6) or we can try to dene the interconnected disciplines that compose
this black box (Figure 1.7). Provided the required product properties can be met,
we expect that sustainability is the common denominator for all the disciplines involved in this process.
The process of transforming raw materials into valuable end-use products is not
a one-way procedure but rather an iterative process in which we try to optimize all
the parameters involved. The selection of the proper chemistry and technology
should include an evaluation of environmental, safety, and economic parameters.
Moreover, questions regarding the possible use of renewable resources and minimizing the energy requirement will have to be answered. Dening PRE in this
manner appears to be very close to the procedure of life cycle analysis (LCA) [21].

Raw materials

Fig. 1.6.

Polymer Reaction
Engineering

PRE as a black box process.

End use product

1.5 The Disciplines in Polymer Reaction Engineering

Sustainability

Materials sciences
Thermodynamics

Raw materials

Novel processes

Inherent safety

Materials
Application

Energies
Needs

Environment
Recycling, Disposal

Profit
Modeling and
simulation

Laws
Economy

Satisfaction

Integrated PRE
Knowledge

Process integration
optimization

New products

Polymer chemistry
Reaction kinetics

Post-reaction
processes

Nano-, MicroBio-

Novel processes
Measurement and control

Renewable

Fig. 1.7.

Products

The integrated approach for sustainable PRE.

Life cycle analysis is a tool assisting decision making in the engineering process.
LCA includes the information on the history of the materials used, and the different process and raw material alternatives, as well as the nal product requirements. LCA is an instrument driven by environmental considerations against a
background of technical and economic specications, and involves the so-called 3P concept (people, planet, and prot). The LCA-based PRE methodology (Figure
1.8) [22] leads to an optimization of all the parameters involved and a reduction of
the costs. This seems to be contradictory at rst sight, but integrating all the aspects often leads to cost reductions. In our view, the use of this approach will lead
to a sustainable integrated PRE.

1.5

The Disciplines in Polymer Reaction Engineering

The dierent disciplines involved in PRE can be represented using the academia
industry dichotomy (Figure 1.9). The interests of the two types of players are not
identical: the dierences are similar to the dierences in their mission statements.
Nevertheless, we can observe that a great overlap is present in the middle zone,

10

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach

waste
management

Specification
- technical
- economic
- ecologic
- safety

recycling

Balances

raw material

product use

- energy
- material
- emission
- waste
- sewage

synthesis

processing

Evaluation leads to closed


loop assessment of costs

Fig. 1.8.

Life cycle analysis of parts, methods, products, and systems.

where interests, tools, and knowledge are similar, thus providing a strong basis for
partnership.
As stated above, PRE is composed of a large number of disciplines, which are
described in more detail in the following chapters of this handbook. These disciplines are interconnected by a synergetic and multidisciplinary approach, and com-

Academia
Fundamental
kinetics

Novel
technologies

Thermodynamics

Molecular
modeling

Measurement
and control
Reactor design

Environment

Polymer physics
Polymer chemistry

Safety
Quality
assurance

Applied
modeling

Process
modeling

Market
economics

Industry
Fig. 1.9.

Overlap of industrial and academic disciplines.

1.5 The Disciplines in Polymer Reaction Engineering

11

Polycondensation

Fig. 1.10. Product-driven PRE, based on an orthogonal


relationship between science and engineering.

mercial products are the nal achievement resulting from this methodology. This
could be expressed by an orthogonal representation (Figure 1.10) where polymer
sciences are linked with engineering sciences. Every type of polymerization will
have its own specic features, models, and engineering aspects involved. From Figure 1.10 it will be obvious that only teamwork, bringing together several elds of
expertise, can lead to the nal objective.
1.5.1

Polymerization Mechanisms

Polymerization reactions can be classied depending on the reaction mechanism


involved and can be either step-growth or chain-growth. These mechanisms dier
basically with the time scale of the process. In step-growth polymerization (like
polycondensation), the polymer chain growth proceeds slowly from monomer to
dimer, trimer, and so on, until the nal polymer size is formed at high monomer
conversions. Both the chain lifetime and the polymerization time are often in the
order of hours. In chain-growth polymerization (like ionic or free-radical polymerization), macromolecules grow to full size in a much shorter time (seconds being
the order of magnitude) than required for high monomer conversion. High molecular weights are already obtained at low monomer conversion, which is in great
contrast to step-growth polymerizations. Also, unlike step-growth polymerization,
chain-growth polymerization requires the presence of an active center.
Condensation polymers are the result of a condensation reaction between monomers, with or without the formation of a condensation by-product (Chapter 3). Examples of polymers produced by condensation are polyamide[6.6], (Nylon 6,6) the
result of the intermolecular condensation of hexamethylenediamine and adipic
acid, and polyamide[6], (Nylon 6) which is the product of intramolecular condensation of a-caprolactam. This type of reaction is generally sensitive to thermodynamic
equilibrium and requires the removal of the by-product, which is often volatile.

12

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach

The polymers produced by condensation reactions can be either linear or nonlinear, depending on the number of functional groups per monomer. The polymerization process can be performed in bulk (liquid or solid state) or as an interfacial
polymerization.
Free-radical polymerization (FRP) can be performed homogeneously (in bulk, solution, or suspension; Chapters 4 and 5) or heterogeneously (emulsion, precipitation; Chapter 6). The active site is always a radical that can be unstable (classical
FRP) or stabilized as in pseudo-living FRP. Radicals can be formed by the homolytic bond rupture of initiators (molecules sensitive to homolytic cleavage, such as
peroxides, photosensitive molecules, or bisazo compounds) or by complex mechanisms creating radicals from monomer units using thermal or high-energy
sources, such as X-rays, g-irradiation, or UV. This type of polymerization usually
comprises several steps: initiation, propagation, various transfer mechanisms,
and termination.
In ionic polymerizations a cation or anion is the active site (Chapter 7). A heterolytic process leads to charged parts of molecules that can induce the polymerization by nucleophilic or electrophilic processes. These reactions generally evolve at
low temperatures (even as low as 120 C) due to the high reactivity of ions. Also,
they are very sensitive to impurities present in the monomer or solvent. These reactions are not always terminated, so lead to living polymerization. This process is
often used to build tailor-made copolymers.
Coordination polymerizations require a transition metal catalyst (Chapter 8). Polyolens are often produced by this kind of reaction where the catalyst (Ziegler
Natta, for example) acts as the active site but also as the steric regulator, which
makes it possible to build polymers with a dened tacticity. Nowadays a great research eort is devoted to the synthesis of new transition metal-based catalysts,
such as metallocenes, to produce new products.
1.5.2

Fundamental and Engineering Sciences

Apart from the various polymerization mechanisms involved, a large number of


other disciplines will have to be involved, according to the matrix depicted in
Figure 1.10.
Thermodynamics is essential to understand the physicochemical properties of
the individual reactants, solvents, and products involved (Chapter 2). Also, it provides information on the interaction between the various components present in
the reaction mixture, from which phenomena such as phase behavior and partitioning can be derived. This information is usually accessible by using the appropriate equation of state for a given system studied. A close collaboration between
chemical physicists, chemists, and chemical engineers is required to take full advantage of this fundamental knowledge.
Polymer solutions (solid, bulk, solution, complex media) have to be characterized
by several specic analytical tools (Chapter 20). Techniques such as NMR, ESR,

1.5 The Disciplines in Polymer Reaction Engineering

electron microscopy, chromatography, electrophoresis, viscometry, calorimetry, and


laser diraction are widely used to determine polymer properties, often in combination. The main characteristics being analyzed are the chain length distribution,
degree of branching, composition, tacticity, morphology, particle size, and chemical
and mechanical properties. Polymer mechanics (Chapter 14) usually concerns the
nal product rather than the polymerization reaction. Nevertheless, as polymers
are usually judged on their end-use properties (Chapter 13), the nal product
needs specic and often customer-based analysis. This is described more specically for two application areas, namely the use of thermosets for coating applications (Chapter 16) and the production of polymeric bers (Chapter 17).
Measurement and control are indispensable to achievement of a robust and safe
process (Chapter 12). Since the early 1990s, a tremendous eort has been observed
in the development of new in-line analytical techniques, including spectroscopy
(UV, IR, Raman, laser, and so on), ultrasonic sensing, chromatography, and diraction or electrical methods. New control schemes appear where the reaction is performed just below the constraint limits, independently of the reaction kinetics. All
these techniques tend to lead to safer and more robust processes while increasing
productivity and product quality at the same time.
Safety cannot be treated as a separate discipline as it is already integrated from
the early chemistry and process development (Chapter 11). Safety deals with a wide
variety of technological aspects with respect to the environment (water, air, soil,
and living species). However, economic aspects are usually taken into consideration also. Modern process development intrinsically includes safety and environmental aspects in all stages of the development.
Modeling is probably the tool of excellence for engineers (Chapter 9). It is
used to simulate the reaction and the process system in order to shorten the time
for development. It is based on models that can be physical or chemical, semiempirical or empirical, descriptive or more fundamental. To describe the development of the molecular weight distribution upon reaction, moment methods or
equations based on population balance are often used.
Scaleup is a widely used term to dene the methodology that allows scaling up
of a process from small to larger scale (Chapter 10). Often the scaleup process begins with a scaledown approach in order to have reliable and representative equipment already at the laboratory scale. Scaleup is always dependent on the system
studied and requires a proper understanding of the performance of process equipment involved at dierent scales. In polymer reaction engineering, heat transfer
and mixing can be considered as two major issues in this perspective. Modern
computing techniques such as computational uid dynamics and process simulation become more and more important in the optimization of process parameters
and the equipment hardware.
Volatile organic compound (VOC) content in the nal product is related to product properties and legislation (FDA approval in the USA, for example). All the processes aiming to lower the residual VOC content in the product are denoted as removable (Chapter 18). These processes can dier from each other, depending on

13

14

1 Polymer Reaction Engineering, an Integrated Approach

the techniques involved. Devolatilization, post-process reaction, and extraction are


some of the methodologies employed for this purpose.
Stability and degradation of polymers (Chapter 15) become relevant especially
during post processing or moulding processes. Temperature, oxidation and mechanic stresses are the main contributors to product degradation.
Currently, there is a strong emphasis on the synthesis of novel functional polymers shaped on a nano scale (Chapter 19) and the development of sustainable
production processes (Chapter 21). The latter includes process intensication as a
methodology, the use of green solvents, and the use of renewable resources.
Many of the new processes under development are focusing on one or more of
these topics, for which the use of supercritical uids is currently being implemented on an industrial scale.

1.6

The Future: Product-inspired Polymer Reaction Engineering

Innovation times in industry have shown a steady decrease since the 1970s. Classic
thinking is that process development becomes increasingly important as industry
matures [23]. This is due to the fact that in an early phase of the lifetime of an industry, when product concepts are still being created, the rate of product innovation exceeds the rate of process innovation. This period continues until a dominant
design has emerged and opportunities for radical product innovation decrease. In
this phase, the shift is toward process innovations to reduce cost price.
The half-time of product innovation (time-to-market) in the early 1970s was
about ten years. Currently, two years is often considered long. This acceleration of
innovation time is the result of competitive pressure in the market. As a rule of
thumb, the rst company to enter the market with a new product can get up to
60% of market share, so there is a high reward for being rst.
As has been discussed above, chemical engineering has been the basis for polymer reaction engineering in the past. In recent discussions, however, it has been
emphasized that a need exists to refocus chemical engineering toward productdriven process engineering [24, 25]. The thinking about a process should then start
with the customer or consumer: which of the two depends on the structure of the
supply chain. The wishes of the consumer and consumer-perceived product properties have to be translated into physical and chemical product properties. In this
way, the main physical attributes of a product are determined, including an idea
about the microstructure. Next, a functional analysis is performed to determine
the lowest number of transformations needed to create the product; this is followed by a morphological analysis [26]. Finally, a conceptual process design exercise is performed to generate possible process routes to achieve the desired product
properties. This sequence of events is the core of product-inspired polymer reaction engineering. A key characteristic of this approach is the fact that it avoids the
classical unit operation trap, because it does not x the mindset to consider only
traditional reactor design and separation process steps to build a process.

References

1.7

Concluding Remarks

In the foregoing we have presented a general framework for sustainable polymer


reaction engineering. Its most important characteristic lies in the concerted multidisciplinary approach, rather than focusing on individual competencies. Given the
volume of polymer production, it will be of major importance that environmental
and safety issues become an integral part of the development process. In combination with tools such as life cycle analysis and product-inspired PRE, this will allow
the development of sustainable new polymer processes.

References
1 Association of Plastics Manufacturers
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9
10
11

12
13

14

in Europe, Annual report, 2002.


H. Staudinger, Chem. Ber., 1920, 53,
1073.
W. Kuhn, Berichte de Deutschen Chem.
Gesellsch., 1930, 63, 1503.
W. H. Chalmers, J. Am. Chem. Soc.,
1934, 56, 912.
H. Dostal, H. Mark, Trans. Faraday
Soc., 1936, 32, 54.
G. V. Schulz, Z. Physik. Chem., 1935,
B30, 379.
P. J. Flory, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 1936,
58, 1877.
W. H. Carothers, US Patent 2 130
948, 1937.
E. W. Fawcett, R. O. Gibson, J.
Chem. Soc., 1934, 386.
K. G. Denbigh, Trans. Faraday Soc.,
1947, 43, 648.
K. Ziegler, E. Holzkamp, H. Breil,
H. Martin, Angew. Chem., 1955, 67,
541.
P. W. Morgan, S. L. Kwolek,
Macromolecules, 1975, 8, 104.
H. Sasabe, T. Wada, Polymers for
electronic applications, in: Comprehensive Polymer Science, vol. 7, S. L.
Aggarwal (Ed.), Pergamon Press,
Oxford, 1989.
J. K. J. van Duren, J. Loos, F.
Morrissey, C. M. Leewis, K. P. H.

15

16

17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24

25
26

Kivits, L. J. IJzendoorn, M. T.
Rispens, J. C. Hummelen, R. A. J.
Janssen, Adv. Funct. Mater., 2002, 12,
665.
W. Kaminsky, H. Sinn (Eds.) Transition metals and organometallics as
catalysts for olen polymerisation,
Springer Verlag, Berlin, 1987.
J. M. Benedikt, B. L. Goodall,
Metallocene-catalyzed polymers, B.F.
Goodrich, Brecksville, 1998.
J. Sinke, Appl. Comp. Mater., 2003, 10,
293.
E. R. Howells, Chem. Ind., 1982, 508.
A. Penlidis, Can. J. Chem. Eng., 1994,
72, 385.
A. Sapre, J. R. Katzer, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1995, 34, 2202.
A. Azapagic, Chem. Eng. J., 1999, 73,
1.
P. Eyerer, J. Polym. Eng., 1996, 15,
197.
W. J. Abernathy, J. M. Utterback,
Technol. Rev., 1978, 80, 40.
E. L. Cussler, G. D. Moggeridge,
Chemical product design, Cambridge
University Press, Cambridge, 2001.
E. L. Cussler, J. Wei, AIChE J., 2003,
49, 1072.
C. J. King, AIChE Monograph Ser.,
1974, 70, 1.

15

17

Polymer Thermodynamics1
Theodoor W. de Loos
2.1

Introduction

The phase behavior of polymer solutions plays an important role in polymer production and processing. Many polymers are produced by solution polymerization.
Solvent choice, solvent recovery and the removal of traces of solvent from the polymer product are important factors in these processes. An example is the production of linear low-density polyethylene (LLDPE), which is a copolymer of ethylene
and a 1-alkene. Hydrocarbons are used as solvents in this process. The reactor conditions are limited at high temperature by the onset of a liquidliquid phase split,
characterized by a lower critical solution temperature, and at low temperature by
crystallization of LLDPE. The pressure must be high enough to keep the ethylene
in solution. Another well-known example is the production of low-density polyethylene (LDPE). In this process ethylene is compressed together with an initiator and
the LDPE is formed by radical polymerization. The reactor pressure chosen must
be high enough to dissolve the polymer in its monomer. In practice reactor pressures are higher than 200 MPa. Since the conversion of ethylene to LDPE is incomplete, LDPE has to be separated from unreacted ethylene, which is recycled to the
reactor. To save energy this is done by pressure reduction in two steps, which involve a high-pressure vaporliquid ash.
From a thermodynamic point of view polymer solutions are complicated solutions. A polymer is not a single component but a multicomponent mixture characterized by a molecular weight distribution or by average molecular weights, such as
the number-average molecular weight Mn or the weight-average molecular weight
Mw . In the case of a copolymer dierent types of copolymers are possible, for example random copolymers and block copolymers, and the comonomer content
may vary. Because of their asymmetric nature the entropy of mixing of polymer
solutions is much lower than in the case of a mixture of two low molecular weight
compounds; also, the pure solvent and the polymer have rather dierent free
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

18

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

volumes. Because of this, polymersolvent systems often show a liquidliquid


phase split.
In this chapter it is not possible to give an in-depth treatment of the thermodynamics of polymer solutions. For further reading, see Refs. 16.

2.2

Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions


2.2.1

Thermodynamic Principles of Phase Equilibria

The equilibrium conditions for phase equilibria can be derived in the simplest way
using the Gibbs energy G. According to the second law of thermodynamics, the
total Gibbs energy of a closed system at constant temperature and pressure is a
minimum at equilibrium. If this condition is combined with the condition that
the total number of moles of component i is constant in a closed system [Eq. (1),
where nai is number of moles of component i in phase a], the equilibrium conditions given by Eq. (2) can easily be derived for a system of p phases and N components [7].
X

nai constant

mai mib    mpi

for i 1; 2; . . . ; N

The chemical potential of component i in phase a is dened by Eq. (3), where g is


the molar Gibbs energy.
0 X
1
q
nai g a
B
C
i
@
A
mai
3
qnai
P; T; nj0i

2.2.2

Fugacity and Activity

In the thermodynamic treatment of phase equilibria, auxiliary thermodynamic


functions such as the fugacity coecient and the activity coecient are often
used. These functions are
C closely related to the Gibbs energy. The fugacity of component i in a mixture, fi , is dened by Eq. (4a) together with (4b).
C
dmi 1 RT ln fi at constant T
C
fi
lim 1
P!0 Pi

4a
4b

2.2 Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions

C
According to this denition, fi is equal
to the partial pressure Pi in the case of an
C
ideal gas. The fugacity coecient fi is dened by Eq. (5) and is a measure of the
deviation from ideal gas behavior.
C
C fi
fi
Pi

The fugacity coecient can be calculated from an equation of state by Eq. (6) or (7)
[8].

C P
RT
dP
6
Vi 
RT ln fi
P
0
0X
1
" 
#
n i RT

V
C
@
A
qP
RT
RT ln i
RT ln fi 

7
qn
V
PV
i V; T; nj0i
y
According to Eq. (4), the equilibrium relation in Eq. (2) can be replaced by Eq. (8).
C
C
C
fi a fi b    fi p

for i 1; 2; . . . ; N

C
The activity a i is dened as the ratio of fi and the fugacity of component i in the
standard state fi 0 at the same P and T [Eq. (9)].
C
fi P; T; x
ai 1 0
fi P; T; x 0

An ideal solution is dened by Eq. (10).


a iid 1 x i

10

The activity coecient of component i, gi [Eq. (11)], is a measure of the deviation


from ideal solution behavior, so the fugacity of a nonideal liquid solution can be
written as Eq. (12).
gi 1

ai
a iid

11

C
fi x i gi fi 0

12

The activity coecient gi can be calculated from a model for the molar excess
Gibbs energy g E, Eq. (13).
0 X
1
E
q
n
g
i
B
C
@
A
i
13
RT ln gi
qn i
P; T; n
j0i

19

20

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

In this approach the standard state fugacity fi 0 of a liquid component is usually the
fugacity of the pure liquid component, and is closely related to the vapor pressure
Pisat of that component. On the vapor-pressure curve of a pure component, we have
conditions according to Eqs. (14).
fi L Pisat ; T fi V Pisat ; T fVi Pisat ; TPisat

14

From Eq. (4a) we obtain Eq. (15), where viL is the molar volume of pure liquid i.
fi L P; T fi L Pisat ; T exp

dmiL
Pisat RT

!
fi L Pisat ; T exp

viL
dP
Pisat RT

!
15

Combining Eqs. (14) and (15), we get Eq. (16).


L

fi P; T

fVi Pisat ; TPisat

exp

viL
dP
sat
RT
Pi

!
16

At low pressure the fugacity coecient and the exponential term are close to 1, so
Eq. (17) holds.
fi L A Pisat

17

2.2.3

Equilibrium Conditions

For low-pressure vaporliquid equilibria (VLE) the equilibrium condition of Eq.


(18) is usually written as Eq. (19), in which fi 0 is calculated with Eq. (16) or (17)
C
and ji with Eq. (6) or (7); x i and yi are the liquid-phase and vapor-phase mole fraction of component i, respectively.
C
C
fi L fi V

18

C
x i gi fi yi ji P

19

The truncated virial equation or the ideal gas equation is often used as the equation of state. In the latter case all fugacity coecients are 1, so the simplest form
of Eq. (19) is Eq. (20).
x i gi Pisat yi P

20

In the case of low-pressure liquidliquid equilibria (LLE) the equilibrium condition


is given by Eq. (21).
C
C
fi 0 fi 00

or

x i gi fi 0 0 x i gi fi 0 00

21

2.2 Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions

The two liquid phases are indicated by prime ( 0 ) and double prime ( 00 ). If for both
liquid phases the standard fugacity is chosen as the pure liquid component, Eq.
(21) reduces to Eq. (22).
x i gi 0 x i gi 00

22

For the calculation of high-pressure vaporliquid equilibria or liquidliquid equilibria an equation of state is always used for both phases and the equilibrium condition used is given by Eq. (23).
C
C
fi a fi b

or

C
C
x i ji Pa x i ji Pb

or

C
C
x i ji a x i ji b

23

2.2.4

Low-pressure VaporLiquid Equilibria

Since polymers have no vapor pressure and as a consequence the vapor phase does
not contain polymer, the equilibrium conditions for low-pressure vaporliquid
equilibria of polymer solutions as given by Eq. (20) are only applicable to the
solvent s as in Eq. (24), or in a case where the weight fraction of polymer wp is
used as a composition variable as in Eq. (25), where Ws is the weight fraction based
activity coecient of the solvent.
P xs gs Pssat

24

P 1  wp Ws Pssat

25

The relation between a mole fraction based activity coecient gi and a weight fraction based activity coecient Wi of component i is given by Eq. (26), where wi and
Mi are the weight fraction and molecular weight of component i, respectively. gs
and Ws can be obtained from a correlation of experimental data using a suitable
model or from a predictive model (see Section 2.3).
N
X
wj
gi
wi
Mi
Wi x i
M
j
j1

26

2.2.5

FloryHuggins Theory and LiquidLiquid Equilibria

The FloryHuggins theory of polymer solutions [1] is based on a rigid lattice


model in which a polymer molecule is assumed to consist of r segments of the
size of a solvent molecule. The FloryHuggins expression for the Gibbs energy of
mixing Dmix G for Ns moles of solvent and Np moles of polymer is given by Eq. (27).
Dmix G
Ns ln js Np ln jp js jp Ns rNp w
RT

27

21

22

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

The rst two terms on the right-hand side of Eq. (27) represent the so-called combinatorial entropy of mixing, and the third term is an approximation for the enthalpy of mixing. In practice w, the FloryHuggins interaction parameter, is used
as an adjustable, temperature-dependent parameter. js and jp are the segment
fractions of solvent and polymer, respectively, dened by Eq. (28).

js

Ns
Ns rNp

and jp

rNp
Ns rNp

28

According to the original FloryHuggins theory w is given by Eq. (29), in which


ess ; epp , and esp are the interaction energies between two solvent molecules, two
polymer segments, and a solvent molecule and a polymer segment, respectively.

wz

2esp  ess  epp


T

29

Often r is approximated by the ratio of the molar volumes of pure liquid polymer
and pure solvent. The segment fractions of solvent and polymer are then equal to
the volume fractions of solvent and polymer, fs and fp . Equation (27) is derived using many assumptions and approximations (for a discussion, see Ref. 8), but on
the basis of this rather simple expression many features of the phase behavior of
polymer solutions can be explained. The expressions for the mole fraction based
activity coecients of solvent and polymer are Eqs. (30) and (31), respectively.


 
jp
1
1  jp jp2 w
ln gs ln 1  jp
r
r

30

ln gp ln1  jp r jp   r  11  jp r1  jp 2 w

31

As can be seen from Eq. (30), the activity coecient of the solvent is strongly dependent on r for low values of r, but at high values of r gs becomes practically independent of r. This implies that the equilibrium pressure of low-pressure VLE for
polymersolvent systems is hardly dependent on the molecular weight of the
polymer.
In the original formulation of the FloryHuggins theory Dmix G increases with
decreasing temperature, which leads to a liquidliquid phase split with an upper
critical solution temperature. Per mole of lattice sites, the entropy of mixing of a
polymersolvent system is much less than for a solventsolvent system; because
of this, polymersolvent systems show a stronger tendency to demix than solvent
solvent systems. This is illustrated in Figure 2.1, which shows schematically the
inuence of r on the location and shape of the liquidliquid two-phase region.
The gure shows that with increasing r, the two-phase region increases in size
and becomes more asymmetric. The critical point, the temperature maximum of

2.2 Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions


0.40

0.50

r=1000
0.60

r=100
0.70

0.80

0.90

r=10

1.00
0.00

0.10

0.20

0.30

0.40

0.50

0.60

p
Fig. 2.1. Liquidliquid equilibria for polymersolvent systems
at dierent polymer chain lengths r. Calculated from the Flory
Huggins theory.

the two-phase region, shifts with increasing r to lower values of w, higher temperature, and lower values of jp . At r y the critical point is found at a limiting value
of w 12 , T y, and jp 0. This follows directly from the critical point conditions
[Eq. (32), where G is the Gibbs energy per mole of lattice sites].
qG
qjp

P; T

!
q2G
0
qjp2

32

This leads to Eqs. (33) and (34) for the FloryHuggins expression [Eq. (27)].
w

crit



1
1 2
1 p

2
r

jpcrit

1
p
1 r

33
34

23

24

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

The theta temperature y is the highest possible upper critical solution temperature
(UCST) within the framework of the FloryHuggins theory.
Many polymersolvent systems, at temperatures above the UCST, show a second
region with liquidliquid immiscibilty (Figure 2.2), which is characterized by the
occurrence of a lower critical solution temperature (LCST) [9]. This phenomenon
can not be explained on the basis of the original FloryHuggins theory. Delmas
and Patterson [10] calculated binary critical curves of polymersolvent systems using the Flory equation of state [11, 12]. According to these authors the reason for
the occurrence of this LCST is the large dierence in thermal expansion of pure
liquid polymer and pure solvent, which leads to an increasing dierence in free
volume with increasing temperature and an LCST-type liquidliquid phase split at
temperatures below the critical point of the solvent. If the molecular weight of the
polymer is increased, the UCST and LCST approach each other. In some cases, this
can lead to the phase diagram of Figure 2.3, in which the liquidliquid region has
the shape of an hourglass, as in the polystyreneacetone system (Figure 2.4) [13].
However, another possibility is that the UCST and LCST never meet and that each
liquidliquid region shows a (dierent) y temperature for r y. This type of behavior is found for polystyrenemethylcyclohexane [14]; see Figure 2.5.
Another type of LCST is connected to specic interactions like hydrogen bonding. This type of LCST is found at temperatures below the UCST. The resulting
phase diagram is presented in Figure 2.6, which shows a closed-loop region of
liquidliquid immiscibility. This type of phase diagram is not predicted by the
original FloryHuggins theory, either.

L1+L2

L1+L2
Solvent

Polymer

Liquidliquid equilibria showing a low-temperature


two-phase region with a UCST and a high-temperature twophase region with a LCST.

Fig. 2.2.

2.2 Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions

L1+L2

L1+L2
Solvent
Fig. 2.3.

Polymer

Hourglass-shaped two-phase liquidliquid equilibria.

2.2.6

High-pressure LiquidLiquid and VaporLiquid Equilibria

Figure 2.7 shows schematically the phase behavior of a binary polymer solution at
constant composition in a P; T diagram. In the case of curve a, the mixture at low
temperature shows a liquidliquid region characterized by UCST behavior and at
high temperature a liquidliquid region characterized by LCST behavior. Both twophase regions are bounded at low pressures by a three-phase liquidliquidvapor
curve, which separates the liquidliquid region from a vaporliquid region. The
curve that separates a liquidliquid region from the one-phase liquid region is
often called a cloud-point curve. The liquidliquidvapor curve is found in many
cases very close to the vapor-pressure curve of the pure solvent because the polymer concentration in the vapor phase and in the solvent-rich liquid phase is low.
Curve b shows the case where the low-temperature liquidliquid region and the
high-temperature liquidliquid region are merged into a single liquidliquid region. In this case the cloud-point curve shows a pressure minimum. At pressures
below this minimum, hourglass-shaped two-phase regions are found. At higher
pressures the phase behavior is as represented by Figure 2.2. An example of this
behavior is shown by the polystyreneacetone system [15] (see Figure 2.8). In the
case of curve c the cloud point curve is found at much higher pressure and no
longer shows a minimum.
In going from case a to case c, the mutual solubility of polymer and solvent decreases. Stronger polymerpolymer or solventsolvent interactions lead to a lower
mutual solubility, while stronger polymersolvent interactions lead to a higher mutual solubility [15]. As discussed in Section 2.2.5, increasing molecular weight of

25

26

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Liquidliquid equilibria in the polystyreneacetone


system at the indicated polystyrene molecular weights
(in g mol1 ). Reproduced with permission from Ref. 13.

Fig. 2.4.

the polymer also leads to a decrease in mutual solubility for the same polymer
solvent system. An example of this eect is given by Zeman and Patterson [16] for
the polystyreneacetone system.
A similar eect is observed when the chain length of the solvent is increased.
Ehrlich and Kurpen [17] determined cloud-point curves of 5 wt.% LDPE in ethane,
propane, butane, and pentane. These results are reproduced in Figure 2.9, which
shows that with increasing molecular weight of the solvent the cloud-point pressure increases and dP=dT of the cloud-point curves change sign from positive to
negative. Since ethylene is a worse solvent than ethane, the cloud point pressures for the system ethylene LDPE [18, 19] are higher than for the system

2.2 Thermodynamics and Phase Behavior of Polymer Solutions

Fig. 2.5. Liquidliquid equilibria in the polystyrene


methylcyclohexane system at the indicated molecular weights
of polystyrene (in g mol1 ). Reproduced with permission from
Ref. 14.

ethane LDPE. For this type of systems it is not possible to make a clear distinction between vaporliquid equilibria and liquidliquid equilibria. The polymer-rich phase can be considered to be a liquid phase, but the solvent-rich phase
is liquidlike at low temperature, but vaporlike at high temperature. De Loos et al.
[20] measured cloud-point curves for LLDPE systems plus hexane, plus heptane,
and plus octane (see Figure 2.10). In this case also, the polymer is more soluble
in the higher molecular weight solvent, which is shown by the shift of the LCSTtype cloud-point curve to higher temperatures. An increased degree of branching
of the polymer leads to a better mutual solubility [21].

27

28

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

L1+L2

Solvent
Fig. 2.6.

Polymer

Closed-loop liquidliquid equilibria.

P
b

T
P; T phase diagram for a constant
composition polymersolvent system: (a)
system with separate low- and hightemperature regions of demixing; (b) system in
which the low- and high temperature regions
of demixing have merged, showing a minimum

Fig. 2.7.

cloud pressure; (c) system in which the lowand high-temperature regions of demixing have
merged, without a minimum cloud pressure.
The full curves are cloud-point curves; the
broken curves are liquidliquid vapor curves.

2.3 Activity Coecient Models

Fig. 2.8. Liquidliquid equilibria in the polystyreneacetone


system at the indicated pressures. M 20400 g mol1 .
Reproduced with permission from Ref. 16.

The addition of an anti-solvent such as a supercritical gas also produces changes


in the phase diagram to one like Figure 2.7 [2225]. However, in this case the
liquidliquidvapor equilibrium is represented by a region instead of by a curve.

2.3

Activity Coecient Models

In practice the original FloryHuggins theory is not accurate enough for a quantitative representation of polymersolvent phase equilibria. To improve this situation
a concentration-dependent w-parameter can be introduced and also the temperature dependence of w can be made more complicated than in Eq. (29). The terms
representing the combinatorial entropy of mixing, the rst two terms in Eq. (27),
can be replaced by results from more accurate theories [4, 26] and the dierence

29

30

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Cloud-point isopleths of LDPE in various n-alkane


solvent at 5 wt.% polymer. The short dashlong dash curve is
the solidication boundary of LDPE. Reproduced with
permission from Ref. 17.

Fig. 2.9.

in the free volume of polymer and solvent can be accounted for by adding a free
volume contribution [4]. Further, Eq. (27) can be extended to account for the polydispersity of the polymer.
The system-dependent parameters in these models can be adjusted to experimental data or predicted from a group contribution approach [4, 26].
2.3.1

FloryHuggins Theory

For a solution of a polydisperse polymer with m polymer components in one solvent, the FloryHuggins expression for the Gibbs energy of mixing per mole of lat-

2.3 Activity Coecient Models

Fig. 2.10. Cloud-point curves of poly(E-co-1-octene)n-alkane


systems at P 3 MPa. Mn 33 kg mol1 , Mw 124 kg mol1 ,
Mz 420 kg mol1 . The systems show LCST phase behavior.
Reproduced with permission from Ref. 20.

tice sites can be written as Eq. (35). The sum is only over the polymer components,
m
P
ji is the segment fraction of polymer component i, and jp
ji 1  js is the
i1
overall polymer segment fraction.
m
X
Dmix G
js ln js
ji ri1 ln ji js jp g sp
RT
i1

35

g sp f T; jp

36

To avoid confusion with the polymersolvent interaction parameter, the symbol g sp


[Eq. (36)] is used instead of w, which is independent of concentration. Equations
(37a)(37c) are examples of expressions used for the temperature and composition
dependence of g sp [2729].
g sp a

b
cT djp ejp2
T

c
T
g sp a
1  djp

37a

37b

31

32

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

a
g sp

b
c ln T
T
1  djp

37c

We can derive Eq. (38) for the solvent, and Eq. (39) for polymer component i,
where rn is number-average chain length of the polymer, which is dened by Eq.
(40) and which is proportional to the number-average molecular weight of the
polymer.
!


qg sp 2
1
38
j
lnxs gs ln js 1 
j g sp  js
rn p
qjp p


ri jp
qg sp 2
lnx i gi ln ji 1 
j
 ri js ri g sp  jp
39
rn
qjs i
m
X

rn

n i ri

i1
m
X

40
ni

i1

Using Eqs. (37) and (38), vaporliquid and liquidliquid equilibria can be calculated as discussed above. Reference 5 gives details of liquidliquid equilibrium calculations in polydisperse polymersolvent systems. In Figure 2.11 the experimentally determined phase behavior of three PEGwater systems is compared with the
calculated phase behavior of these systems using Eq. (37c) to represent g sp as a
function of temperature and polymer segment fraction. The parameters were tted
to the data [29].
The description of the inuence of pressure on polymersolvent phase behavior
is also possible using a pressure-dependent g sp [27, 3032]. However, this approach
is purely empirical.
2.3.2

Hansen Solubility Parameters

According to the regular solution theory of Hildebrand the w-parameter can be approximated by Eq. (41) [8], where vs is the molar volume of the solvent and ds and
dp are the solubility parameters of solvent and polymer, respectively. Since these
solubility parameters are pure component parameters, Eq. (41) combined with Eq.
(27) results in a predictive model. However, since many simplications are involved, the results of this model can be considered as only a rough estimate. Following the slogan like dissolves like, a good solvent for a polymer is a solvent for
which ds and dp have similar values.
w

vs
ds  dp 2
RT

41

2.3 Activity Coecient Models

Fig. 2.11. Closed-loop liquidliquid equilibria in the PEG


water system. Symbols: experimental data, M 3:35 kg mol1
(0), M 8 kg/mol (5), M 15 kg/mol (4); curves tted using
Eq. (37c). Reproduced with permission from Ref. 29.

Hansen suggested rening the solubility parameter theory by the introduction of


contributions from dispersive interactions (d), polar interactions ( p) and hydrogen
bond formation (hb), as in Eq. (42) [33].
w

vs
ds; d  dp; d 2 ds; p  dp; p 2 ds; hb  dp; hb 2 
RT

42

Recently, Lindvig et al. [34, 35] showed that Eq. (42) systematically overestimates
the innite dilution activity coecient of the solvent and proposed an alternative
expression, Eq. (43).
wa

vs
ds; d  dp; d 2 0:25ds; p  dp; p 2 0:25ds; hb  dp; hb 2 
RT

43

33

34

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

These authors showed that for a number of polymersolvent system with a 0:6
this method performs similarly to group contribution methods using volume fractions to represent the segment fractions in the FloryHuggins model. Values of
solubility parameters are tabulated by Barton [36].
2.3.3

Correlation of Solvent Activities

The combination of Eq. (35) with one of the Eqs. (36) or similar empirical equations is not very successful for describing the phase behavior of polymersolvent
systems with strong interactive species and of systems which only dier in molecular weight. Since the mid-1990s activity coecient models have been proposed
based on a combination of the FloryHuggins type of expression for the combinatorial entropy of mixing and segment-based local composition models to account
for the contribution from energetic interactions (the residual contribution to the
activity coecient).
In 1993 Chen [37] proposed a correlative model that used a combination of the
FloryHuggins expression for the combinatorial entropy of mixing and the nonrandom two-liquid (NRTL) theory [38]. The same approach was followed by Wu
et al. [39]. These authors used Freeds expression [41, 42] for the combinatorial
entropy of mixing, which is more accurate than the FloryHuggins expression, in
combination with the NRTL theory. The nonrandom factor model of Haghtalab
and Vera [42] was modied by Zafarini-Moattar and Sadeghi [43] for polymer solutions. In 2004, Pedrosa et al. [44] suggested use of the UNIQUAC theory [45] instead of the NRTL theory and tested various combinations of combinatorial contributions and residual contributions using a database of 70 low-pressure VLE
systems. These authors have concluded that the combination of a segment-based
NRTL or UNIQUAC residual term with a good combinatorial term is able to produce the best correlations of experimental VLE data and can also be used to predict
the inuence of the molecular weight of the polymer on polymersolvent VLE.
As an example we will give here the expression for the activity coecient of the
solvent for a model which combines the p free-volume combinatorial term with a
segment-based Wu-NRTL residual term [44]. The p free-volume combinatorial
term combines combinatorial contributions and free-volume contributions [45].
The activity coecient of the solvent is given by Eq. (44).
ln gs ln gscombfv ln gsres

44

The combinatorial/free-volume term is given by Eq. (45).


ln gscombfv ln

fsfv
f fv
1 s
xs
xs

The free-volume fraction fsfv is calculated from Eq. (46).

45

2.3 Activity Coecient Models


fv

xiv
fv
fi X i fv
xj vi

46

The free volume of a component is dened by Eq. (47), where vi is the molar
volume of liquid component i, vi; vdW is the hard-core volume or van der Waals
volume of this component and can be calculated using the Bondi tables [46], and
p is a correction factor, which is calculated from Eq. (48) in the p free-volume
model [45].
fv

vi vi  vi; vdW p

47

vs
vp

48

p1

The residual term is given by Eq. (49) together with Eqs. (50), where asp and a ps are
adjustable interaction parameters, a is the NRTL-nonrandomness parameter,
which was xed by Pedrosa et al. at 0.4.
"
gsres

2
tps Gps

tsp Gsp2

Xs X p Gps 2 X p Xs Gsp 2
 
a ij
tij exp
and Gij expatij
RT
ln

qs X p2

#
49
50

X i is the eective mole fraction of segments of species i and qi is the eective segment number of species i, which are given by Eqs. (51) and (52); rs 1 and rp r.
x i qi
Xi X
xj q j

51




1
qi ri 1  2a 1 
ri

52

2.3.4

Group Contribution Models

Thermodynamic properties can be predicted from group contribution methods.


In these models molecules are divided in functional groups. Group contribution
models for activity coecients consider the interactions between functional groups
rather than between molecules. Since the number of functional groups is much
lower than the number of possible molecules composed of these groups, only a
limited number of group interaction parameters have to be known to describe a
large number of systems. These group interactions are obtained from regression

35

36

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

of experimental data. This makes the group contribution methods purely predictive. However, since details of molecular structure are not considered, group contribution methods for activity coecients are in general less accurate than correlative
models.
Oishi and Prausnitz [47] proposed writing the solvent activity coecient for
polymersolvent systems as the sum of three terms [Eq. (53)].
ln gs ln gscomb ln gsfv ln gsres

53

The combinatorial contribution gscomb accounts for dierences in size and shape
fv
of the molecules. The free-volume contribution gs accounts for changes in free
volume due to mixing, caused by the large dierence between the free volumes of
pure solvent and polymer. For ordinary liquid mixtures in far from critical conditions, this term is usually negligible. The residual contribution gsres accounts for
energy interactions. In the approach of Oishi and Prausnitz, the combinatorial contribution is represented by the StavermanGuggenheim expression, a modication
of the FloryHuggins equation, also used in the UNIFAC group contribution
model [48]; for the residual contribution also, the corresponding expression of the
UNIFAC model is used. The free-volume contribution is calculated from the Flory
equation of state [49]. This group contribution model and those of Chen et al. [50]
and Danner and High [51] are discussed in Ref. 4. Here we will discuss the entropic free volume model of Elbro et al. [52] and Kontogeorgis et al. [53], and the
group contribution Flory (GCFlory) model of Bogdanic et al. [54, 55], which is a
modication of the model of Chen et al. [50].
In the entropic-free volume model, the activity coecient of the solvent is given
by Eqs. (44)(48) with p 1 [52]. The residual contribution is represented by the
residual contribution of the UNIFAC model with temperature-dependent interaction parameters [53]. The liquid molar volumes needed for the calculation of the
free volume of a component can be taken from experiment or calculated from the
Tait equation [4] or by the group contribution method of Elbro et al. [56]. This
model is relatively easy to use.
In the GCFlory model, the solvent activity coecient is calculated from Eq.
(53).
The combinatorial term is calculated by means of the original FloryHuggins expression, Eq. (54).
ln gicomb ln

fi
f
1 i
xi
xi

54

The free-volume and residual terms are calculated from a modication of the original Flory equation of state, Eq. (55), where ~v is the reduced volume, dened by Eq.
(56).
P

RT v~1/3 C E attr

v v~1/3  1
v

55

2.3 Activity Coecient Models

v~

v
v

56

The molar hard-core v  is calculated from the pure component hard-core molar
volumes vi using a linear mixing rule [Eq. (57)]. The same type of mixing rule is
used for the number of external degrees of freedom parameter C [Eq. (58)].
v

x i vi

57

x i Ci

58

X
i

The pure component hard-core volumes and C parameters are calculated from the
group contribution expressions in Eqs. (59) and (60),
X

vi 21:9662

ui
m Rm

59

Ci

ui
n


CT0 ; n CT; n

1
1

T T0



X
n

R
X n Cn0
Rm

60

m
i

where un is the number of groups of type n in molecule i and T0 is a reference


temperature. R n is the normalized van der Waals volume of group n as used in
the UNIFAC method. The attraction term E attr is related to the UNIFAC model
by Eq. (61), z is the lattice coordination number, chosen to be equal to 10, and qi ,
the surface area of molecule i, is given by Eq. (62)
2
E attr

X1
i

yj expDeji /RTDeji

6
6
j
X
zqi x i 6
4eii

7
7
7
yk expDeki /RT 5

 1/3


v~  1 X X i
xi
un CT; n
 3R ln
v~
n
i
qi

vi
n Qn

61
62

Q n is the normalized van der Waals surface of group n, as in UNIFAC. The interaction energy parameters eji and Deji are given by Eqs. (63), in which eij0 is calculated from a group contribution expression [Eq. (64), together with Eq. (65)].
eij

eij0
v~

and

Deij eij  eii

63

37

38

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

eji0

yi
m

yn j enm

64

enm enn emm 1/2 Denm

65

In these expressions the volume fraction fi of molecule i, the segment fraction yi


of molecule i, and the segment fraction yi
n of n in molecule i are dened by Eqs.
(66)(68).
xiv 
fi X i 
xj vj

66

x i qi
yi X
xj q j

67

j
i

u Q
Xn n
yi
n
ui
m Qm

68

Note that indices m and n refer to groups m and n, and i and j to molecules i
and j.
The resulting expressions for the free-volume contribution and the residual contribution in the activity coecient are Eqs. (69) and (70).
ln

fv
gi

ln gires

!
1/3
v~i  1
v~i
 Ci ln
31 Ci ln 1/3
v~  1
v~
2
X
1 4 1
eii ~
zqi
v  eii ~
vi  1  ln
yj expDeji /RT
2
RT
j
3
X yj expDeji /RT
5
X

y
expDe
/RT
k
ki
j

69

70

To apply this method, the liquid molar volumes of the mixture and of the pure
components need to be known. At a given pressure and temperature these values
can be calculated from the equation of state. However, since eji according to Eq.
(63) is volume-dependent, this involves an iterative procedure similar to that
described by Danner and High [4] for the method of Chen et al. [50]. Figure
2.12 shows the experimental solvent activity of the system poly(propylene oxide)
benzene at 347.85 K compared to the correlation by UNIQUAC and predictions by
the GCFlory model. The result of the correlation is almost perfect. The predicted
solvent activities by the GCFlory model are also very close to the experimental
values. In Figure 2.13 a comparison is shown of experimental solvent activity

2.4 Equation of State Models

Fig. 2.12. Activity of benzene in the poly(propylene oxide)


benzene system at 347.85 K. Mn 500 kg mol1 . Symbols:
experimental data; curves: UNIQUAC correlation and GCFlory
prediction. Reproduced with permission from Ref. 54.

coecients at innite dilution and predictions by the GCFlory model [54] for
homopolymersolvent systems, demonstrating that the results of predictions are
good. The predictions for copolymer solutions are slightly worse [55].

2.4

Equation of State Models

High-pressure phase equilibria in systems of polymers, solvents, and supercritical


gases are in almost all cases modeled using equations of state. A review of equations of state for polymer systems, including a discussion of their theoretical background, has been given by Lambert et al. [6]. One of the rst equations of state that
was used to model the high-pressure phase behavior of polymersolvent systems
was the Flory equation of state [11, 12]. Patterson and Delmas [10] showed that
this equation of state can be used to describe both LCST and UCST phase behavior.
The perturbed hard-chain theory (PCHT) was developed by Prausnitz and coworkers [5759]. It can be considered as an improvement of the approach of Flory

39

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

log cal

40

log exp
Fig. 2.13. Comparison of calculated activity coecients at
innite dilution using the GCFlory model with experimental
values for many polymersolvent systems. Reproduced with
permission from Ref. 54.

and co-workers and can be used to model the phase behavior of mixtures of small
and large molecules, including polymers, over a wide range of pressure and temperature [5760]. Here, we will discuss only the two equations of state methods:
the relatively simple SanchezLacombe (SL) lattice uid model [61, 62], and the
statistical associating-uid theory (SAFT) [63, 64], which has now become one of
the standard equations of state for polymer solutions.
2.4.1

The SanchezLacombe Lattice Fluid Theory

Like the FloryHuggins model, the SanchezLacombe lattice uid theory is based
on the assumption that segments of solvent molecules and polymer molecules occupy the lattice sites of a rigid lattice, but vacant lattice sites are also allowed. The
number of vacant lattice sites, and as a consequence the total number of lattice
sites, are pressure-dependent, and in this way compressibility is introduced.

2.4 Equation of State Models

The resulting equation of state for a pure component is given by Eq. (71).



1
1
p~v~ 1
 1 v~ ln 1 

~
r
v~
T
v~T~

71

The reduced volume v~, the reduced pressure p~, and the reduced temperature T~ are
dened by Eqs. (72a)(72c).
v~

v
n0 rn

v
rn

72a

p~

P
Pv 


P
e

72b

kT
T~ 
T

72c

The parameters with an asterisk ( ) are the so-called characteristic parameters. In


practice r, the number of segments per molecule, e  , the interaction energy parameter, and v  , the molar volume of a lattice site, are used as the independent purecomponent parameters; n is the number of moles of the component and n0 is the
number of moles of vacant lattice sites. If v is the volume per mole of segments,
the total volume of the system is given by V nrv. For high molecular weights r
is large, so it can be concluded from Eq. (71) that the density of polymer melts is
not very dependent on molecular weight and that the PVT behavior of polymer
melts follows the corresponding states principle (see Figure 2.14) [62].
For mixtures the same equation of state is used, but the characteristic parameters r; e  , and v  are composition-dependent. Neau [65] gives an overview of dierent mixing rules proposed in the literature. Often-used mixing rules are given in
Eqs. (73)(75). In Eq. (75) k ij is an adjustable binary interaction parameter which
equals zero for i j and which can tted to binary experimental data.
r

v
e

73

x i ri

ji vi

XX

ji jj

74
q
eii ejj 1  k ij

75

The segment fraction ji of component i is given by Eq. (76).


x i ri
ji X
x i ri

76

41

42

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Fig. 2.14. Corresponding states behavior of various liquid


polymer PVT data according to the SanchezLacombe model.
Symbols represent experimental data; curves are calculated
from Eq. (71). Reproduced with permission from Ref. 62.

Neau [65] also showed that the expressions for the chemical potential used in
earlier literature to calculate phase equilibria are thermodynamically inconsistent.
According to Neau, the correct expression for the fugacity coecient for the SL
model is Eq. (77).

2.4 Equation of State Models




1
1

ln j^i ln z ri 2
 ln 1 
v~
v~T~
"  
#
1 nr qe 

v~T~ e  qn i nj 0n i

z1
X
xj r j

!"




nr qv
v  qn i

nj 0n i

77

The compressibility factor z is given by Eq. (78).


z

p~v~
Pv
r
RT
T~

78

In Figure 2.15 [66] experimental isothermal cloud-point curves of the linear low
density polyethylene hexane system are compared with the results of a t of
these data using the SanchezLacombe equation of state. The pure component
parameters of hexane were calculated from the critical point of hexane and its
acentric factor [67]. The pure component parameters of the polymer were obtained
from a simultaneous t of PVT data and the data presented in Figure 2.15. The
equations solved were those described by Koak and Heidemann [68]. The binary
interaction parameter was linearly dependent on temperature. The polymer was

10
9
8

P / MPa

7
6
5
4
3
2
1
0
0.00

450 K
470 K
490 K
Critical Point
Cloud Point
Spinodal
Critical Point
0.05

0.10

0.15

0.20

0.25

Weight fraction LLDPE


Isothermal cloud-point curves of LLDPE n-hexane.
Symbols: experiments; curves: modied SanchezLacombe t.
[66].
Fig. 2.15.

0.30

0.35

43

44

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

represented by 36 pseudo-components. The SL theory is very well able to describe


the experimental phase behavior.
2.4.2

Statistical Associating-uid Theory

The statistical associating-uid theory (SAFT) developed by Chapman et al. [63, 64]
is based on the thermodynamic perturbation theory of Wertheim [69]. Since it
rst appeared, many dierent versions of SAFT have been published. The dierent
SAFT versions and their application have been reviewed by Muller and Gubbins
[70].
For polymer solutions the SAFT version of Huang and Radosz [71, 72] is the
most widely used. In 2000, a promising new version of SAFT for polymer solutions
called PC-SAFT (perturbed chain-SAFT), was proposed by Gross and Sadowski
[73]. Here we will restrict ourselves to these two SAFT versions.
The basics of both equations of state are equal, and can be written as separate
contributions to the molar Helmholtz energy a. The molar residual Helmholtz energy a res, which is the dierence between the molar Helmholtz energy of the system and the molar Heltmholtz energy of the same system in the ideal gas state in
the same conditions of temperature, pressure, and composition, is calculated as
the sum of the contributions of a hard chain term a hc , a dispersion term a disp , and
an association term a assoc [Eq. (79)].
a res a  a ig a hc a disp a assoc

79

From this expression the pressure and chemical potential can be derived [Eqs.
(80) and (81), respectively] using standard thermodynamic relationships
P
(A n i a).



qA
p
qV T; n
 
qA
mi
qn i V; T; nj0i

80
81

For polymer solutions the association term is normally not used. The two SAFT
versions discussed here do not explicitly account for polarity and dier only in the
way the dispersion contributions are calculated.
SAFT and PC-SAFT Hard Chain Term
In the molecular picture behind SAFT a chain consists of mi hard-sphere segments. These hard-sphere segments are bonded by covalent bonds. The hardsphere term of both SAFT versions is the sum of two contributions: a hard-sphere
contribution and a term due the connectivity of these hard-sphere segments, as
2.4.2.1

2.4 Equation of State Models

given by Eq. (82), where m is the average chain length of the molecules in the mixture [Eq. (83)] [64].
a hc
a hs a chain
m

RT
RT
RT
m

x i mi

82
83

The hard-sphere contribution a hs is represented by the BoublikMansoori hardsphere equation of state for mixtures of hard spheres, Eq. (84) [74, 75].
"
#
 3

a hs
6 z23 3z1 z2 z3  3z1 z2 z32
z2

2  z0 ln1  z3
RT pr
z3
z3 1  z3 2

84

In this equation zk is given by Eq. (85), where r is the number density, dii is
the temperature-dependent hard-sphere diameter obtained from Eq. (86); mi , the
hard-sphere diameter si, and the energy parameter ei are pure component parameters.
p X
x i mi dii k
zk r
6

 
3ei
dii T si 1  0:12 exp
kT

85
86

The chain term a chain is given by Eq. (87), where gdii hs is the so-called hardsphere radial distribution function at close contact [Eq. (88)] [74, 75].
a chain X

x i 1  mi lngdii hs 
RT
gijhs



didj
d i d j 2 3z22
1
3z2

1  z3 d i d j 1  z3
d i d j 1  z3 3

87
88

SAFT Dispersion Term


In the Huang and Radosz version of SAFT [71, 72] the ChenKreglewski dispersion term is used. This term is obtained from a t to the physical property data of
argon and is given by Eq. (89) [76], where t is a constant equal to 0.74048. The constants Dij are given by Chen and Kreglewski [76].
2.4.2.2

 i   j
4 X
9
a disp X
u
z3
Dij

kT
RT
t
i1 j1

89

45

46

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

For mixtures, the van der Waals one-uid mixing rules or the volume fraction mixing rules can be used.
The van der Waals mixing rules are given by Eq. (90), where the combining rules
are Eqs. (91) and (92), in which k ij is an adjustable binary interaction parameter.
XX
u

kT

XX


uij 3
d
kT ij
90

x i xj dij3

dij


x i xj

di dj
2

91

p
uij 1  k ij uii ujj

92

The volume fraction mixing rules are given by Eq. (93), with volume fractions dened by Eq. (94).
XX
uij
u

fi fj
kT
kT
j
i

93

x i mi d 3i
fi X
xj m j d 3j

94

The combing rule for uij is again given by Eq. (92).


The PC-SAFT Dispersion Term
In SAFT the dispersion term represents the interactions between individual segments, while in PC-SAFT the dispersion term represents the interactions of chains
of segments. The expression for a disp derived by Gross and Sadowski is Eq. (95),
where the terms on the right-hand side are dened by Eqs. (96) and (97).
2.4.2.3

a disp
a1
a2

RT
RT RT

95

  X
6
a1
u
s3
a i mh i
2prm 2
kT
RT
i0
"
#1
a2
8h  2h 2
20h  27h 2 12h 3  2h 4
prm 1 m
1  m
RT
1  h 4
1  h 2 2  h 2
m

u
kT

2

s3

6
X
i0

bi mh i

96

97

2.4 Equation of State Models

The reduced uid density h is dened by Eq. (98), in which NAv is Avogadros
number.
h

pNAv
rmd 3
6

98

The parameters a i and bi are dependent on m, as Eqs. (99) and (100) state.
a i m a 0i

m1
m  1m  2
a 1i
a 2i
m
m2

99

bi m b0i

m1
m  1m  2
b1i
b2i
m
m2

100

The constants a 0i b2i are tted to the thermophysical properties of n-alkanes and
are given by Gross and Sadowski [73].
SAFT and PC-SAFT Applications
Both SAFT and PC-SAFT contain pure component parameters: the energy parameter e or u, the hard-sphere diameter s, or the hard-sphere volume v 00 , and the number of segments m per molecule. For small (solvent) molecules these parameters
are obtained from a t of vapor pressure data and saturated liquid volume data.
Since they do not have a vapor pressure, this t is not possible for polymers, and
the pure component polymer parameters are obtained from a t to PVT data of the
molten polymer or from a t to PVT data and binary phase equilibrium data. For
the description of a mixture one needs one binary interaction parameter k ij per
binary, which has to be tted to phase equilibrium data. If necessary, k ij can be
made temperature-dependent. In general, phase equilibria are very sensitive to
the k ij value.
In Figure 2.16 [77], experimental results from a system of ethylene HDPE are
compared with modeling results using SAFT and SanchezLacombe models. In
both cases k ij is taken to be linearly dependent on temperature. Due to the polydispersity of the polymer, the cloud-point curves show a dip in which the critical point
is located. If in the modeling the polymer is assumed to be monodisperse, this
behavior cannot be reproduced. The gure shows that both SAFT and Sanchez
Lacombe models give a reasonable description of the experimental phase behavior,
although at high and low polymer concentrations the deviations become larger.
The same system was modeled by Tumakaka et al. [78] using SAFT and PCSAFT. The results are presented in Figure 2.17, which clearly shows that in this
case PC-SAFT gives a better result than SAFT. In the same paper these authors
present PC-SAFT modeling results for LDPE solvent systems at constant polymer concentration. The pure LDPE parameters were tted to the experimental
data of ethane LDPE. These parameters were subsequently used to describe the
LDPE ethane, propene, propane, butane, and 1-butene systems, using a
2.4.2.4

47

48

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Fig. 2.16. Isothermal cloudpoint curves of the


HDPE ethylene system. Mn 43 kg mol1 , Mw 118
kg mol1 , Mz 231 kg mol1 . Symbols: experimental data;
curves: modeling results: (a) SAFT model; (b) Sanchez
Lacombe model. Reproduced with permission from Ref. 77.

temperature-independent k ij . The results are very good (see Figure 2.18), but it
should be kept in mind that the modeling is restricted to one polymer concentration.
Extension to Copolymers
For the modeling of the phase behavior of copolymersolvent systems, the copolymer can be treated as a homopolymer with eective pure component parameters.
Examples of this approach are given by McHugh and co-workers [79, 80]. The disadvantage of this approach is that the pure component polymer parameters depend
on the type and composition of the copolymer. Pure component polymer parameters are obtained from binary polymersolvent phase equilibrium data. With these
parameters it is possible to model the phase behavior of the same polymer with
another solvent.
A better approach is the copolymer SAFT approach of Radosz and co-workers
[8183], in which the copolymer parameters are estimated on the basis of the molecular weight and structure only. For an AB-type copolymer there are three binary
interaction parameters, the interaction parameters between A segments and segments of the solvent molecule, the interaction parameter between B segments
2.4.2.5

2.4 Equation of State Models

Fig. 2.17. Isothermal cloud-point curves of the


HDPE ethylene system. Mn 43 kg mol1 , Mw 118
kg mol1 , Mz 231 kg mol1 . Symbols: experimental data;
curves: modeling results. Reproduced with permission from
Ref. 78.

and segments of the solvent molecule, and the interaction parameter between A
and B segments. The rst two binary interaction parameters can be obtained from
the phase behavior of the two homopolymer systems, while the third has to be
tted to some copolymersolvent data. Once these parameters are known, predictions can be made for copolymersolvent systems with the same type of copolymer
but with a dierent copolymer composition. The same approach was followed by
Gross et al. [84] for the PC-SAFT model. The result is known as copolymer PCSAFT. The two parameters that characterize the polymer structure are the fraction
of type A segments in the polymer molecule and the bonding fraction which gives
the fraction of bonds between segment types A and B. The original literature gives
details.
Figures 2.19 and 2.20 show experimental cloud-point curves and PC-SAFT modeling of the ethylene poly(E-co-EA) and ethane poly(E-co-BA) systems, respectively [85], at a polymer concentration of 5 wt.%. The model correctly predicts
the change in the location of the cloud point with changing comonomer concentration in the polymer. Especially interesting is the ethylene poly(E-co-EA) system,
in that the curve of cloud-point pressure as a function of the EA concentration in
the polymer shows a minimum. This behavior is correctly described by the model.

49

50

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Fig. 2.18. Constant composition cloud-point curves of LDPE


solvent systems at 5 wt.% polymer. Symbols: experimental
data; curves: modeling results using PC-SAFT with one
temperature-independent k ij for each system. Reproduced with
permission from Ref. 78.

2.5

Conclusions

Polymersolvent systems behave in many respects in the same way as systems of


low molecular weight components. Dierences between polymersolvent systems
and low molecular weight systems are mainly caused by the fact that polymers
have no vapor pressure, that polymers are composed of many components of
dierent molecular weights, and that there is a large dierence between the free
volumes of the solvent and of the polymer.
The thermodynamic models for polymersolvent systems are less advanced than
for systems of low molecular weight compounds. In general low-pressure vapor
liquid equilibria can be described very well with a variety of models. Once the adjustable parameters in these models are tted to experimental data, reliable predictions can be made for other conditions, for example at a dierent temperature or
for a system with the same solvent and the same type of polymer with a dierent

2.5 Conclusions

Fig. 2.19. Constant composition cloud-point


curves for poly(E-co-EA)ethylene systems with
dierent repeat-unit compositions at 5 wt.%
polymer. The copolymer molecular weight is in

the range 113157 kg mol1 . Symbols:


experimental data; curves: PC-SAFT
calculations. Reproduced with permission from
Ref. 85.

molecular weight. Vaporliquid-equilibria can be predicted with dierent group


contribution models. Most recent models give reliable predictions of comparable
accuracy for dierent polymersolvent systems. A disadvantage of this type of
model is that the parameters for the groups of interest should be available.
In general the thermodynamic modeling of low-pressure liquidliquid equilibria
is more dicult than for vaporliquid equilibria. This also holds for polymer
solvent systems. Reliable prediction methods are not available. The correlation of
liquidliquid data using the extended FloryHuggins type models [2729] gives
reasonably good results. Again, once the adjustable parameters in these models
are known, predictions can be made for other conditions.
High-pressure uid-phase equilibria can only be modeled using equations of
state. However, the equation of state models contain adjustable binary interaction
parameters that have to be tted to data. Small variations in these parameters in
general have a large inuence on the predicted phase equilibria. The most promising models for high-pressure phase equilibria of polymer solutions are the SAFT
and the PC-SAFT ones.

51

52

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Fig. 2.20. Constant composition cloud-point


curves for poly(E-co-BA)ethylene systems with
dierent repeat-unit compositions at 5 wt.%
polymer. The copolymer molecular weight is in

the range 155283 kg mol1 . Symbols:


experimental data; curves: PC-SAFT
calculations. Reproduced with permission from
Ref. 85.

Notation

Symbols
a
A
C
d
DC
f
g
G
Gij
G
k
k ij
m
M
n

activity, molar Helmholtz energy


Helmholtz energy
number of external degrees of freedom
temperature-dependent hard-sphere diameter
constant
fugacity
molar Gibbs energy; interaction parameter; radial distribution
function
Gibbs energy
NRTL parameter
Gibbs energy per mole of lattice sites
Boltzmanns constant
binary interaction parameter
number of polymer components; number of segments
molecular weight
number of moles

Notation

N
p
P
q
Q
r
rn
R
Rm ; Rn
T
u
v
V
w
x; y
X
z

number of components
correction factor
pressure
eective segment number; surface area
normalized van der Waals surface
number of segments in a molecule
number-average chain length
gas constant
normalized van der Waals volume
absolute temperature
energy parameter
molar volume
volume
weight fraction
mole fraction
segment fraction
lattice coordination number; compressibility factor

Greek
a
a; b; p
g
d
e
y
jC
f
m
W
s
t
z
h
u
w

NRTL nonrandomness parameter


phase
activity coecient (mole fraction basis)
solubility parameter; density
energy parameter
theta temperature; segment fraction
segment fraction; volume fraction
fugacity coecient
chemical potential
activity coecient (weight fraction basis)
temperature-independent hard-sphere diameter
NRTL interaction parameter; constant in SAFT
density-related variable [Eq. (85)]
reduced density
number of groups
interaction parameter

Subscripts
d
hb
i; j
mix
p
s
vdW

dispersion
hydrogen bonding
component
mixing
polymer; polar
solvent
van der Waals

53

54

2 Polymer Thermodynamics

Superscripts
0

standard state
hard core, indicates characteristic parameter
reduced
association
attraction
chain formation contribution
combinatorial
critical
dispersion
excess
free volume
hard chain
hard sphere
ideal mixture
ideal gas
liquid
residual
saturated
gas; vapor

@
assoc
attr
chain
comb
crit
disp
E
fv
hc
hs
id
ig
L
res
sat
V
Acronyms
LCST
LDPE
LLDPE
LLE
NRTL
PCHT
poly(E-co-BA)
poly(E-co-EA)
SAFT
SL
UCST
VLE

lower critical solution temperature


low-density polyethylene
linear low-density polyethylene
liquidliquid equilibria
nonrandom two-liquid
perturbed hard-chain theory
poly(ethylene-co-BA)
poly(ethylene-co-EA)
statistical associating-uid theory
SanchezLacombe lattice uid model
upper critical solution temperature
vaporliquid equilibria

References
1 P. J. Flory, Principles of Polymer

Chemistry, Cornell University Press,


USA, 1953.
2 H. Tompa, Polymer Solutions, Butterworth, UK, 1956.

3 H. Fujita, Polymer Solutions, Elsevier,

The Netherlands, 1990.


4 R. P. Danner, M. S. High, Handbook

of Polymer Solution Thermodynamics,


DIPPR/AIChE, USA, 1993.

References
5 R. Koningsveld, W. H. Stockmayer,

10
11
12
13
14

15
16
17
18
19

20

21

22
23

E. Nies, Polymer Phase Diagrams,


Oxford University Press, Oxford, 2001.
S. M. Lambert, Y. Song, J. M.
Prausnitz in Equations of State for
Fluids and Fluid Mixtures, J. V.
Sengers, R. F. Kayser, C. J. Peters,
H. J. White (Eds.), Elsevier, The
Netherlands, 2000, Chapter 14.
J. M. Smith, H. C. Van Ness, M. M.
Abbott; Introduction to Chemical
Engineering Thermodynamics; 6th ed.,
McGraw-Hill, USA, 2001.
J. M. Prausnitz, R. N.
Lichtenthaler, Edmundo Gomes de
Azevedo; Molecular Thermodynamics of
Fluid Phase Equilibria, 3rd ed.
Prentice-Hall Inc., Englewood Clis,
USA, 1999.
J. S. Rowlinson, F. L. Swinton,
Liquids and Liquid Mixtures, 3rd ed.,
Butterworth, UK, 1982.
D. Patterson, G. Delmas, Trans.
Faraday Soc. 1969, 65, 708.
P. J. Flory, R. A. Orwoll, A. Vrij, J.
Am. Chem. Soc. 1964, 86, 3507.
P. J. Flory, J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1965,
87, 1833.
K. S. Siow, G. Delmas, D. Patterson,
Macromolecules 1972, 5, 29.
S. Saeki, N. Kuwahara, S. Konno,
M. Kaneko, Macromolecules 1973, 6,
246.
C. F. Kirby, M. A. McHugh, Chem.
Rev. 1999, 99, 565.
L. Zeman, D. Patterson, J. Phys.
Chem. 1972, 76, 1214.
P. Ehrlich, J. J. Kurpen, J. Polym.
Sci. Pt. A. 1963, 1, 3217.
P. Ehrlich, J. Polym. Sci. Pt. A. 1965,
3, 131.
T. Swelheim, J. de Swaan Arons,
G. A. M. Diepen, Recl. Trav. Chim.
Pays-Bas 1965, 84, 261.
Th. W. de Loos, J. de Graaf, J. de
Swaan Arons, Fluid Phase Equilib.
1996, 117, 40.
Th. W. de Loos, W. Poot, R. N.
Lichtenthaler, J. Supercrit. Fluids
1995, 8, 282.
M. A. McHugh, T. L. Guckes,
Macromolcules 1988, 34, 9.
E. Kiran, W. Zhuang, Y. L. Sen, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci. 1993, 47, 895.

24 N. Koak, Th. W. de Loos, R. A.

25

26

27

28
29

30

31

32
33
34

35

36

37
38
39

40
41

42
43

Heidemann, Fluid Phase Equilib. 1998,


145, 311.
M. H. ter Horst, S. Behme, G.
Sadowski, Th. W. de Loos, J.
Supercrit. Fluids 2002, 23, 181.
N. Pedrosa, J. Gao, I. M. Marrucho,
J. A. P. Coutinho, Fluid Phase
Equilib. 2004, 219, 127.
S. Vanhee, R. Koningsveld, H.
Berghmans, K. Solc, J. Plolym. Sci.
B., Polym. Phys. Ed. 1994, 32, 2307.
R. Koningsveld, L. A. Kleintjens,
Macromolecules 1971, 4, 637.
Y. C. Bae, J. J. Shim, D. S. Soane,
J. M. Prausnitz, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1993, 47, 1193.
Th. W. de Loos, R. N.
Lichtenthaler, G. A. M. Diepen,
Macromolecules 1983, 16, 117.
C. Qian, S. J. Mumby, B. E.
Eichinger, Macromolecules 1991, 24,
1655.
S. Enders, Th. W. de Loos, Fluid
Phase Equilib. 1997, 139, 335.
C. M. Hansen, J. Paint Technol. 1967,
39, 104.
T. Lindvig, M. L. Michelsen, G. M.
Kontogeorgis, AIChE J. 2001, 47,
2573.
T. Lindvig, M. L. Michelsen, G. M.
Kontogeorgis, Fluid Phase Equilib.
2002, 203, 247.
A. F. M. Barton, Handbook of
Solubility Parameters and Other
Cohesion Parameters, CRC Press, USA,
1990.
C.-C. Chen, Fluid Phase Equilib. 1993,
83, 301.
H. Renon, J. M. Prausnitz, AIChE J.
1968, 14, 135.
Y.-T. Wu, Z.-Q. Zhu, D.-Q. Lin, L.-H.
Mei, Fluid Phase Equilib. 1996, 121,
125.
M. G. Bawendi, K. F. Freed, J. Chem.
Phys. 1988, 88, 2741.
J. Dudowicz, K. F. Freed, W. G.
Madden, Macromolecules 1990, 23,
4803.
A. Haghtalab, J. H. Vera, AIChE J.
1988, 34, 803.
M. T. Zafarani-Moattar, R.
Sadeghi, Fluid Phase Equilib. 2002,
34, 803.

55

56

2 Polymer Thermodynamics
44 N. Pedrosa, J. Gao, I. M. Marrucho,

45

46

47
48

49
50

51
52

53

54
55
56

57
58
59
60
61
62
63

64

J. A. P. Coutinho, Fluid Phase


Equilib. 2004, 219, 127.
G. M. Kontogeorgis, P. Coutsikos,
D. Tassios, A. Fredenslund, Fluid
Phase Equilib. 1994, 92, 35.
A. Bondi, Physical Properties of
Molecular Crystals, Liquids and Glasses,
Wiley, New York, 1968.
T. Oishi, J. M. Prausnitz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Process Des. Dev. 1978, 17, 333.
A. Fredenslund, J. Gmehling, M. L.
Michelsen, P. Rasmussen, J. M.
Prausnitz, Ind. Eng. Chem. Process
Des. Dev. 1977, 16, 450.
P. J. Flory, Discuss. Faraday Soc. 1970,
49, 7.
F. Chen, A. Fredenslund, P.
Rasmussen, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1990, 29, 875.
M. S. High, R. P. Danner, AIChE J.
1990, 36, 1625.
H. S. Elbro, A. Fredenslund, P.
Rasmussen, Macromolecules 1990, 93,
2927.
G. M. Kontogeorgis, A. Fredenslund, D. Tassios, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res. 1993, 32, 362.
G. Bogdanic, A. Fredenslund, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res. 1994, 33, 1331.
G. Bogdanic, A. Fredenslund, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res. 1995, 34, 324.
H. S. Elbro, A. Fredenslund, P.
Rasmussen, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1991, 30, 2576.
S. Beret, J. M. Prausnitz,
Macromolecules 1975, 6, 878.
S. Beret, J. M. Prausnitz, AIChE J.
1975, 21, 1123.
M. D. Donohue, J. M. Praunitz,
AIChE J. 1978, 24, 849.
D. D. Liu, J. M. Pruasnitz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Process Des. Dev. 1980, 19, 205.
I. C. Sanchez, R. H. Lacombe, J.
Phys. Chem. 1976, 80, 2352.
I. C. Sanchez, R. H. Lacombe,
Macromolecules 1978, 11, 1145.
W. G. Chapman, K. E. Gubbins, G.
Jackson, M. Radosz, Fluid Phase
Equilib. 1989, 52, 31.
W. G. Chapman, K. E. Gubbins, G.
Jackson, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng, Chem.
Res. 1990, 29, 1709.

65 E. Neau, Fluid Phase Equilib. 2002,

203, 133.
66 Th. W. de Loos, I. Nagy, R. A. Krenz,

67
68
69
70
71
72
73
74
75

76
77

78

79
80

81

82
83
84

85

R. A. Heidemann, Proceedings 7th


International Symposium on Supercritical Fluids, Trieste, Italy, June 1316,
2004, ISASF, 2004.
K. Gauter, R. A. Heidemann, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res. 2000, 39, 1115.
N. Koak, R. A. Heidemann, AIChE J.
2001, 47, 1219.
M. S. Wertheim, J. Chem. Phys. 1987,
87, 7323.
E. A. Muller, K. E. Gubbins, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res. 2001, 40, 2193.
S. H. Huang, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 1990, 29, 2284.
S. H. Huang, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 1991, 30, 1994.
J. Gross, G. Sadowski, Fluid Phase
Equilib. 2000, 168, 183.
T. Boublik, J. Chem. Phys. 1970, 53,
471.
G. A. Mansoori, T. W. Leland, N. F.
Carnahan, K. E. Starling, J. Chem.
Phys, 1971, 54, 1523.
S. S. Chen, A. Kreglewski, Ber.
Bunsenges Phys. Chem. 1977, 81, 1048.
N. Koak, R. M. Visser, Th. W. de
Loos, Fluid Phase Equilib. 1999, 158
160, 835.
F. Tumakaka, J. Gross, G. Sadowski,
Fluid Phase Equilib. 2002, 194197,
541.
B. M. Hasch, M. A. McHugh, J.
Polym. Sci. B 1995, 33, 715.
S. H. Lee, B. M. Hasch, M. A.
McHugh, Fluid Phase Equilib. 1996,
117, 61.
M. Banaszak, C. K. Chen, M.
Radosz, Macromolecules, 1996, 29,
6481.
C. Pan, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res., 1998, 37, 3169.
C. Pan, B. Folie, M. Radosz, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res., 1999, 38, 2842.
J. Gross, O. Spuhl, F. Tumakaka, G.
Sadowski, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 2003,
42, 1266.
F. Becker, M. Buback, H. Latz, G.
Sadowski, F. Tumakaka, Fluid Phase
Equilib. 2004, 215, 263.

57

Polycondensation1
Mario Rui P. F. N. Costa and Rolf Bachmann
3.1

Basic Concepts
3.1.1

A Brief History

The concept of producing larger molecules starting from smaller ones containing
suitable groups (such as carboxyls and hydroxyls), by reaction to create a bond between inert chemical moieties by splitting o a smaller molecule (a condensation),
can be traced back to the middle of the nineteenth century [1]. It was discovered
when preparing oligomers of ethylene glycol, but, in spite of the good impact the
work had at that time, it fell into oblivion a little later. Phenolformaldehyde (in
the form of resins and varnishes) was the rst commercial product (in 1907) consisting of an entirely synthetic polymer [2]; its formation was also an example of
polycondensation; but this early development was purely empirical and contributed very little to scientic progress.
Staudingers concept of the existence of macromolecules came two decades later
[3]. It paved the way to the systematic study aimed at producing synthetic bers
carried out by Carothers at DuPont in the late 1920s and early 1930s [4], from
which stems the still-used concepts of addition and condensation polymerizations.
In his famous book, Flory [5] justly criticized this terminology, since closely
related polymerization mechanisms involving reactions of groups with active hydrogen atoms with epoxides and isocyanates do not lead to the splitting of a byproduct; he proposed a classication into step growth and chain growth polymerization. These expressions became widely used, even if they are quite vague;
much better would be random and sequential polymerization [6].
A survey of important examples of polycondensation reactions can be found in
Table 3.1.

1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

58

3 Polycondensation
Tab. 3.1.

A survey of technically important polycondensation reactions.

Functional groups or monomers

Connecting group

By-product

aCOOH
Carboxylic acid

aOH
hydroxyl

aCOOa
ester

H2 O

aCOOR
Ester

aOH
hydroxyl

aCOOa
ester

RaOH

aCOOH
Carboxylic acid

aNH2
primary amine

aCONHa
amide

H2 O

ClCOCl/aCOCl
Phosgene/chloroformate

aOH
hydroxyl

O
C

HCl
O

carbonate
Na2 S/aSNa
Di-sodium sulde
monomer/sodium sulde
end group

aCl
chloro end group (as in
ClC6 H4 Cl)

aSa
sulde

NaCl

NaOa
Sodium alkoxide/phenoxide,
e.g.,

aCl
chloro end group, e.g.,

aOa
ether

NaCl

NaO

CH3
C
CH3

aNbCbO
Isocyanate

Cl
ONa

O
S
O

aOH
hydroxyl

Cl

O
C

none
NH

urethane
aNbCbO
Isocyanate

aNH2
primary amine

O
C
NH

none
NH

urea
CH CH2
O

1,2-epoxide
aCH2 OH
Methylol

aNHa
secondary amine

none

OH
N CH2 CH

b-hydroxy-t-amine
(NH2 )2 CO/NH2 CONHa
urea/N-alkylurea

CH2NH

O
C

H2 O
NH

N,N 0 -dialkylurea
AraCH2 OH
Aromatic methylol

Ar 0 aCH2 OH
aromatic methylol

AraCH2 aAr 0

HCHO

In some polycondensations, new functional groups are created by reactions of


the monomers. Thus, methylol end groups are formed by the initial reactions of
formaldehyde with other monomers, and their condensation reactions shown
in the last two rows of Table 3.1 occur in later stages of formaldehyde/urea and
formaldehyde/phenol polymerizations (see Section 3.3.4).

3.1 Basic Concepts

3.1.2

Molecular Weight Growth and Carothers Equation

Carothers was mainly interested in polyesterications, and later in polyamidations,


of compounds with the structures AXA and BYB, or sometimes AXB, in which X
and Y are inert chemical moieties whereas A and B are the active carboxyl and hydroxyl or amine groups, giving rise to a connecting ester or amide group Z and
splitting o a by-product (water) W [Eq. (1)].
AB!ZW

If reacting groups A and B do not belong to the same molecule, and thus do not
create a ring, this reaction leads to a decrease of one polymer molecule (comprising the starting monomers).
A count of the polymer molecules and their mass in the system can easily be
carried out with the help of p, the conversion of reference groups A. Starting with
1 mol of monomer AXB, the remaining moles of polymer are 1  p. Polymer mass
per mole of AXB is equal to its molecular weight MAXB , minus the mass lost in byproduct formation, p  MW , yielding Eq. (2), allowing the number-average molecular weight (mass of polymer/moles of polymer) to be predicted.

Mn

MAXB  pMW
1 p

With two monomers, on introduction of the initial stoichiometric ratio


r B0 /A0 between mole concentrations of groups A and B, a similar reasoning
leads to Eq. (3).

Mn

MAXA rMBYB  2pMW


1 r  2p

High molecular weights (say, above 20 000, needed for use as bers) are possible
only by reaching high conversions when monomer molecular weights are a few
hundreds. With two dierent monomers, stoichiometric ratios very close to unity
are also needed. Well-known relationships for number-average degree of polymerization xn are obtained from Eqs. (2) and (3) by replacing the molecular weights of
monomers by 1 and the molecular weight of by-product by 0.
The eect of ring formation on Mn of open chain molecules can be taken into
account by introducing pc , the conversion of end groups yielding rings, in Eqs.
(2) and (3). For instance, when there are two monomers AXA and BYB, Eq. (4) is
obtained.

Mn

MAXA 1  pc r  pc MBYB  2 p  pc MW
1 r  2 p  pc

59

60

3 Polycondensation

Average degrees of polymerization and sol fraction in


XA f polycondensations without intramolecular reaction, versus
conversion p of A groups with monomer functionalities f 2
and f 3, for equilibrium or batch reaction starting from
monomer.

Fig. 3.1.

Prediction of pc and the average molecular weight of rings is not a trivial task.
Carothers has stated that the fraction of rings in bulk polycondensations is negligible, except when ve- or six-membered rings (or higher in the case of rings containing Si, P, and similar heavier elements lower in the periodic table) can result.
Recent experimental results show this concept is not valid in the case of irreversible polycondensations (see Section 3.1.7).
Monomers with three or more functional groups lead to the formation of
branched polymers. A network of macroscopic dimensions (a gel) appears for
high enough conversions and monomer branching. In Figure 3.1 are presented
classical predictions (see Section 3.4.3), of average degrees of polymerization and
weight fraction of nite molecules (sol fraction) for the single monomer polycondensations of XA3 and XA2 . Notice that, in contrast with linear polycondensations,
which require high conversions for obtaining high values of x n , low-value maxima
(4 if f 3) at gel point are observed with these nonlinear polycondensations.
Close to full conversion, the sol is nearly pure unconverted monomer.
Stockmayer [7] has obtained the distribution for the fractions of the initial monomer units present in each nite polymer molecules (Eq. (5), where Px is the set of
isomers with x repeating units X).
xPx /X 

f fx  x!
xp x1 1  p x f 22
x! fx  2x 2!

3.1 Basic Concepts

Fig. 3.2. Equilibrium distributions of monomer units x Px =X 


for XA f polycondensations without intramolecular reaction
versus conversion p of A groups with monomer functionalities
f 2 and 3.

If the functionality f 2, the even more notorious SchulzFlory [8] distribution is


obtained [Eq. (6)].
xPx /X  x1  p 2 p x1

This latter distribution has a relative maximum for x G x n, in contrast to the general Stockmayer distribution, which decreases monotonically (see Figure 3.2).
More complex chemical systems lead to molecular weight distributions that are
qualitatively similar: linear polycondensations have most often geometrical or
nearly geometrical distributions with polydispersities M w /M n close to 2, whereas
nonlinear polycondensations lead to extremely broad distributions near the gel
point, but always dominated in number and even in weight by the lower molecular
weight species.
This chapter concentrates on processes for making either high molecular weight,
mainly linear polymers, or else low molecular weight, branched oligomers which
will be later used to form networks. In any case, consideration of initial stoichiometry, and possible change of functionality due to side reactions, is essential to predict average molecular weights, and to avoid premature gelation in the processes
described here.
It is also possible to prepare low molecular weight mixtures of ring molecules for
further reactive processing (using, for instance, anion polymerization), starting

61

62

3 Polycondensation

with monomers [8] or even with recycled polymer [9], by dilution with inert solvents and a suitable catalyst (see also Section 3.1.7). The discussion of these otherwise interesting processes falls outside the scope of this chapter.
3.1.3

The Principle of Equal Reactivity and the Prediction of the Evolution of Functional
Group Concentrations

Carothers successful synthesis of high molecular weight, aliphatic polyesters could


only be carried out thanks to his care in reducing the eect of the hydrolysis reaction through use of high vacuum. Further research carried out by his former collaborator P. J. Flory in order to assess the eect of molecular weight on chemical
kinetics would eventually lead to the establishment of the principle of equal reactivity. A parallel research, which also has contributed to the establishment of the
same concept and to the prediction of equilibrium chain length distribution
(CLD), has been led by G. V. Schulz [10] in Germany.
Assuming there is no mutual interference of end groups in the same molecule
(which does often happen with groups attached to aromatic rings), the specic rate
of consumption, RA , of end groups A by an irreversible reaction reaction with
groups B can be written as Eq. (7).
RA kAB

Equation (7) states that a single apparent second-order rate constant k should describe all intermolecular reactions of the involved groups A and B for a certain concentration of catalyst(s) (which may be A or B themselves) and solvent, regardless
of the polymer molecule to which they belong. A change of composition of the reaction medium will often cause k also to change.
If the reaction is reversible, a more general expression [Eq. (8)] for RA should be
used.
RA kAB  k Z Z

In the case where, as often happens, a by-product W exists, the apparent rst-order
reverse rate constant k Z is related, through Eq. (9), to apparent equilibrium ratio K
and by-product concentration W .
k Z kW /K

3.1.4

Eect of Reaction Media on Equilibrium and Rate Parameters

Polycondensations must be carried out in bulk or with a concentration of solvent


as low as possible (viscosity being the limiting factor) in order to minimize the formation of rings. If the end groups have polarities and/or hydrogen acceptor or do-

3.1 Basic Concepts

nor anities very dierent from the bonds, this is likely to lead to changes in the
value of apparent constant k, which will be observed as a dependence on conversion or stoichiometric ratio.
Known examples are the apparent increase in reactivity with conversion in esterications and the strong eect of water concentration on apparent equilibrium and
rate constants in amidation systems (see Sections 3.3.1 and 3.3.3 respectively).
Should some thermodynamic model of the chemical system be available, knowledge of activity coecients g of chemical groups A; B; Z and by-product W would
allow the apparent equilibrium ratio K to be related to the thermodynamic K 0 (a
true constant, a function only of temperature) through Eq. (10).
K K0

gA gB
ZW 

g Z gW
AB

10

This kind of computation can be done using the UNIFAC contribution group
method [11], but its empirical character and lack of available parameters at high
temperatures limit drastically its usefulness.
Solvent or bulk media eects can be modeled by taking advantage of group contribution methods [12]. Multiple kinetic experiments with dierent media compositions are needed in order to compare the free energy of interaction involving the
hypothetical transition state group (see Ref. 13 for an example). No such studies
have ever been tried with polymerization reactions.
Progress in computational quantum mechanics should ultimately make the
practical use of these correction methods more widespread.
In nonlinear polycondensations, it is possible to observe a limiting conversion,
the topological limit [14] when unreacted groups in network are too far apart to
meet. Rate constants will fall before reaching the topological limit if glass transition temperature Tg is attained (the glass eect). This situation occurs with many
thermosetting systems of practical interest, epoxies being the most studied, as discussed in the reviews by Mita and Horie [15] and Dusek [14].
A new theory for describing this phenomenon, leaving aside the long-used free
volume concept, was recently put forward by Corezzi et al. [16]. It is based upon
the AdamGibbs [17] entropy theory of glass transition. Formation of more covalent bonds by polymerization decreases the number of available statistical congurations of the chemical system, thus decreasing congurational entropy, suggesting Eq. (11) relating structural relaxation time tr to number-average degree of
polymerization x n .
tr t0 expb g Tx n 
bg

b g0
T  T0

11

Function b g T is empirical and could be dierent from that in Eq. (11) [16]. There
is for the moment no published use of this theory to t apparent kinetic constants.

63

64

3 Polycondensation

A possible suggestion is the following (untested) correlation with yet another two
parameters, k 0 and Cg , based on the Rabinowitch equation for diusional eects
on chemical reactions [Eq. (12)].
1/k 1/k 0 Cg tr

12

In Duseks terminology, diusion control of chemical reactions may be specic,


when the bond formation rate depends on the mobilities of individual reacting
molecules or substructures, or else nonspecic, when the reaction rate depends
only on the average properties of the system.
Experimental evidence points toward prevalence of nonspecic rate control: for
instance, gel conversion in epoxide resin cure is the same regardless of glass eect
[18].
Lacking a better alternative, an empirical dependence of rate parameters on conversion, for a given starting composition, must be tried. Examples of this approach
will be discussed along with their respective chemical systems (bulk polyester and
polyamide formation). It is seen that the glass eect could be taken into account
using a similar procedure.
3.1.5

Polycondensation Reactions with Substitution Eects

When the reaction of a functional group changes the reactivity of its neighbors, a
substitution eect exists.
A rst-shell substitution eect (FSSE) is the simplest kind of departure from
ideal behavior. It is the situation where reactivity is aected only by the reaction of
the functional groups attached to the same monomer unit. FSSEs are encountered
in many polycondensations, as reactivities of functional groups in monomers are
often dierent from the reactivities of end groups in polymers because of mutual
steric, resonance, or electrostatic interactions.
For instance, a glycol HOaXaOH shows no substitution eect in an esterication reaction if the reactivity of the hydroxyls in aCOOaXaOH is the same: a single
kind of group aOH needs to be considered and the description of the reaction
scheme is much simpler.
A second-shell substitution eect (SSSE) occurs when the reactivity of a functional group is aected by the reaction of all the groups attached not only to the
same monomer unit, but also to the units linked to that one. This behavior has
been recognized in urea/formaldehyde formation (see Section 3.3.4.2).
Linear polycondensations AXA BYB with FSSEs in both root units X and Y are
examples found in some important processes, such as the esterication of terephthalic acid and ethylene glycol leading to poly(ethylene terephthalate) (PET). Four
dierent rate constants ki are needed to describe forward reactions, and possibly an
equal number of apparent rate constants (kiZ , i 1 . . . 4) are required to describe
reverse reactions:

3.1 Basic Concepts


k1

AXA BYB T AXZY B W


k1Z
k3

AXZ BYB T BYZX Z W


k3Z

k2

AXA BYZ T AXZY Z W


k2Z

k4

13

AXZ BYZ T ZXZY Z W


k4Z

Recall that apparent rst-order rate constants of the reverse reactions kiZ are related
to the apparent second-order rate constants of the forward reactions ki through the
apparent equilibrium ratios Ki and the concentrations of by-product:
Ki

ki
kiZ W 

14

If there is no by-product, as happens with isocyanate hydroxyl reactions, W  1


(dimensionless) should be used in Eq. (14).
This example illustrates several diculties encountered in modeling reversible
polycondensation reactions with substitution eects. A major problem is the possible change in the nature of bonds because another bond connecting a dierent
unit has been destroyed. There is no closed set of rate equations in terms of
the concentrations of functional groups AXA; BYB; ZD ; ZA ; ZB , and ZP ,
even with the help of the two stoichiometric restrictions X  AXA ZD 
ZA  ZP  and Y  BYB ZD  ZB  ZP . Introduction of more complex
chemical entities does not alleviate the problem.
For instance, sequence ZB XZB (a particular kind of monad, a repeating unit X
with its pendent chemical groups) is formed by destruction of either of the sequences ZB XZP YZP or ZB XZP YZA (which are dyads, sets of two connected repeating
units) by reverse reactions at the rightmost Z group as written above. In order to
predict the concentrations of monads, one needs the concentrations of dyads; this
demands knowledge of the concentrations of triads, and so on. This hierarchy of
equations can not be broken without obtaining the whole chain length distribution; for further details see Section 3.4.5.
In fact, the above kinetic model considers SSSEs for the reverse reaction.
An FSSE model taking into account reverse reaction must consider equality
of rate constants of reverse reactions k1Z k2Z k3Z k4Z k Z . Since ZA 
2AXZA YZA XA AXZA YZP  and ZB  2BYZB XZB YB BYZB XZP , rates of
formation of groups can be written as shown in Eqs. (15).
RAXA 4k1 AXABYB  2k2 AXAZD  ZB  k Z ZD  ZA 
RBYB 4k1 AXABYB  2k3 BYBZD  ZA  k Z ZD  ZB 
RZD 4k1 AXABYB  ZD 2k2 AXA 2k3 BYB
k4 2ZD  ZA  ZB   k Z ZD   ZA   ZB 

15

RZA 2k2 AXAZD  ZB  2k4 ZD 2  ZA 2k3 BYB k4 ZB   2k Z ZA 


RZB 2k3 BYBZD  ZA  2k4 ZD 2  ZB 2k2 AXA k4 ZA   2k Z ZB 

65

66

3 Polycondensation

In conclusion, descriptions of substitution eects not only require knowledge of


more kinetic parameters, but also may lead to added mathematical diculties,
even for just the prediction of basic characteristics of the chemical system, such
as the concentrations of functional groups.

3.1.6

Exchange Reactions

Exchange reactions without formation of by-products, such as the acidolysis and


aminolysis reactions present in polyamidations, do not increase number-average
molecular weight, but can be an important cause of relaxation of chain length distributions toward the equilibrium. Kotliar has presented a general review of these
reactions [19].
Direct bond exchanges in the complete absence of by-product (such as amide
amide exchange) are at best very slow (if they indeed exist) and, as these reactions
can be safely neglected, only exchange reactions involving an end group and a
bond should be of any importance. The exchange of bonds Z1 and Z2 (necessarily
formed with a common by-product W), can be described through Eqs. (16).
k1

XA YC T XZ1 Y W
k1Z

E
k12

k2

XB YC T XZ2 Y W
k2Z

16

XA X 0 Z2 Y T XZ1 Y X 0 B
E
k21

These reactions modify the counts of functional groups of similar chemical nature
(for example, distinguishable kinds of amides/amines/carboxylic acids). If there
is only a single kind of bond, there is no net creation or destruction of functional groups or bonds, but a reshuing of pieces of the reacting molecules takes
place.
In order not to violate the condition of chemical equilibrium, rate constants
of forward and reverse exchange reactions can be related to equilibrium constants
of the condensation reactions in which the same functional groups are involved.
In this example, the equilibrium ratio of the exchange reaction must be in accord
with Eq. (17).
E
k12
K1

E
k21 K2

17

This operation will reduce the number of kinetic parameters in the kinetic scheme.
Also, several of the various equilibrium constants can also be related through a reasoning due to Gordon and Scantlebury [20] for the XA f polycondensation, which
consists of checking the formation of the same nal products through successive
equilibria but with dierent intermediate stages.

3.1 Basic Concepts

3.1.7

Ring-forming Reactions

Prediction of the entropy of cyclization for the gaussian chain molecular model
by Jacobson and Stockmayer [21] could relate rate and equilibrium constants of
intramolecular ring-forming reactions to their analogous intermolecular counterparts. Their theory has later been rened [22, 23] as it provides a good test for
statisticalmechanical treatments of chain molecules.
Measured ring concentrations for thermodynamically controlled (reversible) polycondensations in bulk are usually only a few percent, so this is not a major factor
in those systems.
For irreversible polycondensations, recent studies by Kricheldorf [24, 25] using
MALDI mass spectroscopy have in several circumstances detected quite an appreciable concentration of ring molecules. Unfortunately, dependence of ionization
and thus of instrumental response factor of polymer molecules on the nature of
the end groups [26] prevents a quantitative exploration of those ndings. But it
can be concluded that extension of kinetic modeling in order to take into account
the presence of rings is more important than was previously acknowledged.
The rationale for this unexpected concentration of rings is the irreversible character of their formation. Unless there is a slight excess of some of the end groups,
presence of both kinds of end groups in the same molecule will inevitably lead to
competition of ring formation with respect to polycondensation. The limiting factor for molecular weight increase becomes ring formation, not closeness to stoichiometry of the reagents.
In what follows, Cn is a ring with n bonds and L n is a linear molecule containing
n  1 bonds. The formation of that ring moiety can occur by intramolecular reaction of functional groups, or by a back-biting reaction, analogous to the exchange
reactions discussed in the previous section, according to the schemes represented
in Eqs. (18) and (19).
k c n

L n !
 Cn W
cZ

18

k aE

L m Cn !
 L mn
cE

19

k n

Except for small rings, rate constants k cZ , representing breakage of bonds in the
ring, and k aE , describing the addition of rings to the end of chains through the exchange reactions, should be identical to their open-chain counterparts, k Z and k E
respectively. The reverse constants depend on the size of the ring. According to
the JacobsonStockmayer theory, valid for gaussian chains (and therefore only for
rings with at least some tens of bonds, and bulk media or with low solvent concentration) k c and k cE should be related to the corresponding parameters for intermolecular relations through Eqs. (20)(21).
kjc n kj k c n

20

67

68

3 Polycondensation

kijcE n kijE k c n
k c n

1
3/2pnb 2 3/2
NAL

21
22

In Eq. (22), the small contributions of the distances of the ends of functional
groups b were assimilated to the length of a bond, and NAL is the Avogadro
Loschmidt number.
If there is only one kind of bond, an equilibrium constant of cyclization K c n
can be dened from the equilibrium in Eq. (23).
K c n

Cn L m 
k c n/n
L nm 

23

3.1.8

Modeling of Polymerization Schemes

Methods for predicting molecular weight distributions at chemical equilibrium and


for irreversible polycondensations are presented with some detail below; see Sections 3.4.3 and 3.4.4.
Systems at chemical equilibrium are amenable to description by the domain of
calculus of probabilities known as the theory of branching processes [27]. Batch reactions starting from monomers can sometimes be described by the same solutions, increasing the practical importance of such an approach. Exchange reactions
also drive molecular weight distributions toward equilibrium. Many reactions of
great technological interest, such as melt polyesterications, can be tackled using
this approach.
Applicability of statisticalprobabilistic methods far from chemical equilibrium
cannot be guaranteed, and the kinetic approaches described in Sections 3.4.4 and
3.4.5 are a better choice.
Use of statisticalprobabilistic methods for describing polycondensations started
with Flory, who used them to compute the equilibrium chain length distribution of
linear systems and later was able to predict gelation conditions for multifunctional
monomers. Stockmayer [7] could extend this method to the computation of chain
length distributions and average molecular weights of nonlinear polymers.
Gordon [20, 28] recognized that nonlinear polymers in the absence of intramolecular reaction can be described by a GaltonWatson branching process. Relatively
complex chemical systems, presenting substitution eects, became tractable, and
even some properties of polymer networks relevant to rubber elasticity theory [29]
and average radius of gyration [30] as well as other polymer properties [3133]
could be computed.
Alternative approaches to Gordons branching theory have later been developed,
mainly the so-called recursive method [34, 35], which is in a number of ways
simpler to understand and use, but lacks the power of the older theory in many
situations.

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

Reversible polycondensations can be tackled using the concept of molecular fragments introduced in Section 3.1.5. It is possible to establish closed sets of rate
equations for those fragments in many important cases (the main diculty being
the presence of higher-order substitution eects). For a more detailed discussion,
together with a short analysis of the much simpler case of linear polycondensations with a single kind of bond (a single monomer AXB or two monomers with
dierent groups AXA BYB), see Section 3.4.5.
It is noteworthy that CLD in those chemical systems (and probably in similar alternating polyesterications and polyamidations) is nearly always fairly close to
equilibrium, the main discrepancies occurring as far as the concentrations of the
rst linear oligomers are concerned. So, a method which predicts those concentrations correctly is what is really needed in practice. The main factor controlling the
CLD should be the presence of multifunctional impurities, which should be carefully tracked by the kinetic model.
Prediction of the whole CLD should be possible only with Monte Carlo methods,
with their usual drawbacks [36]. Nevertheless, polycondensations are easier to simulate by Monte Carlo than other polymerizations, since all reactions have more or
less the same time scale.
These simulations are invaluable for investigating the eect of space correlations
between reacting groups and their eect on ring formation and elastic properties
[37]. Prediction of molecular size distribution (which hopefully can be determined
by size exclusion chromatography) is also a useful result [38] which is dicult to
obtain otherwise.

3.2

Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

This section deals with situations where mass transfer eects of by-products (devolatilization, solid-state polymerization) and monomers (interfacial polymerization)
become so important as to cause a spatial change in polymer molecular weight
distributions.
3.2.1

Removal of Volatile By-products

Devolatilization in irreversible polycondensations is carried out in the later stages


of the process and is similar to other polymerizations. For reversible polycondensations, however, it diers from the devolatilization of other polymers in a number of
ways.


Reaction and removal of by-product are intimately connected.


Monomers may be removed in substantial quantities.
 Removal of volatiles takes place during the whole course of the reaction.


69

70

3 Polycondensation

In the rst stages of the reaction, reversible polycondensates readily form boiling
liquids and care has to be taken to avoid removal of monomers, foaming, or product entrainment.
Equilibrium constants are of the order of unity for polyesters and polycarbonates, and of the order of hundreds for polyamides. In order to obtain end-group
conversions above 0.99, this implies a concentration of by-product W  below 104
times the concentration of bonds in the former two systems. The high temperature
of the processes increases the vapor pressure of the by-products and their equilibrium solubility decreases, but even so partial pressures of some millibars for polyester and polycarbonate processes are required; they may be obtained by using a
combination of vacuum and inert stripping gas. These low partial pressures and
consequently nearly innite dilution often justify the application of Henrys law to
describe the vaporliquid equilibrium according to Eq. (24), in which PW is the
equilibrium vapor pressure of by-product W, HW is its Henry constant for the polyS
mer melt (in the usual range of 101000 bar), wW is mass fraction in the melt, PW
is the vapor pressure of pure W, and WW is its weight fraction activity coecient.
S
PW HW wW PW
WW wW

24

The second part of Eq. (24) is useful below the critical temperature of the byproduct, when some thermodynamic model is available. For instance, given the
densities of melt and by-product respectively as rP ; rW , FloryHuggins theory leads
to Eq. (25).
WW

rP
exp1 w
rW

25

Similar expressions hold for the volatile monomers, which at high dilutions can be
treated independently. At low conversions, the innite dilution is not applicable
and the multicomponent FloryHuggins equation [Eq. (26)], for example, should
be used instead. Here the fYi are the volume (or segment) fractions of the various
components, i 1 up to NY being the volatile components and the polymer being
component NY 1; the yYi are their mole fractions, VYi the molar volumes, and
the wij the binary interaction parameters.
0
1
W Yi

N
N
Y 1 f
Y 1
Y 1 N
Y 1
X
X
X
B
C
f NX
rP
Yj
expB
VYi

fYi wij  Yi
yYi fYk wjk C
@
A
rYi
V
y
Y
Y
j
i j1 k j1
j1
j1

26

j0i

At high conversions, mass transfer resistance to by-product removal is a key factor,


not because of low diusivities D of the by-products (in the range 109 to 1011
m 2 s1 ), and consequent mass transfer coecients, but because of low interfacial
areas.
Because of the huge increase in viscosity of the melt when the reacting mixture
changes from the initial mixture of monomers/oligomers to high polymer, a possi-

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

ble solution is the use of dierent continuous stirred reactors (CSTRs) in series,
with dierent kinds of stirrers. Other processes consist of simple unstirred bubble
columns.
In either case, these reacting mixtures at the beginning of the processes resemble boiling liquids. Stirring helps the formation of bubbles by cavitation and breaks
existing bubbles, increasing interfacial area. Inert gas injection will also help (but
loss of volatile monomers becomes more dicult to counterbalance). These mechanisms become inecient for high enough molecular weight with the consequent
higher viscosity (above 200 Pa s), and special lm-forming equipment must be
used.
Equipment for devolatilization of residual monomers and solvents without
chemical reaction is used in most polymerization processes, vented extruders being a common choice. They are also used in the nal stages of reversible polycondensations [39], as well as other specially developed devices that we discuss next.
The basic design of these latter systems consists in a partially lled horizontal
cylindrical vessel in which the reaction mixture moves axially with the help of a
screw or a rotor with blades. The impeller periodically extracts part of the bulk
liquid, leaves it exposed as a thin lm to the gas phase for a short time t f , and remixes it again with the main stream as it ows toward the outlet.
According to the mechanism of creation of lm, three classes of devices can be
distinguished [4042]:


Wiped-lm reactors (WFRs) [43], where the impeller blades throw the polymer
melt against the inner surface of the vessel (Figure 3.3), subjecting it to a high
shear rate (in the range 10 3 10 4 s1 ) in the gaps between their tips and the
wall. This high shear is favorable to conveying pseudoplastic, high-viscosity polymers, but can conversely bring about problems for chains which break under
shear, such as polybutylene terephthalate. Vented extruders work using a similar
principle in their central section (where deeper screws lead to partial lling of
the channel) and their reactor models can be considered a variant of this class.
 Rotating disk contactors (RDCs) (Figure 3.4), in which the disks periodically dip
into the pool of reacting mixture. The polymer lm they carry is exposed to the
gas phase before being mixed again with the bulk liquid.
 Falling-strand or falling-lm evaporators.

Fig. 3.3.

Diagrammatic representation of a wiped-lm reactor.

71

72

3 Polycondensation

Fig. 3.4.

Diagrammatic representation of a rotating disk contactor.

The currently used description of homogeneous diusion of volatile by-products in


polymer media during reversible polycondensations is due to Secor [44]. It considers polymer molecules immobile. The ux of small molecules has a negligible convective contribution; only the diusional ux with respect to the polymer needs
be considered, and the microscopic mass balance of a generic volatile component
(usually, but not always, a by-product) Yi and a group A i belonging to the polymer
may be written, neglecting density variations, as in Eq. (27).
qYi 
DYi 2 Yi  RYi
qt

27

qA i 
RA i
qt
As the resistance to mass transfer in the gas phase may be neglected, the diusive
ux of evaporation N_ Yi , in moles per unit area and unit time, will be obtained with
the help of a mass transfer coecient kfYi . There are two equivalent alternative definitions [Eq. (28)], one using a driving force in terms of mole concentrations, the
other in terms of activities (asterisks mark a concentration or activity value at the
interface, considered to lie at y 0).
qYi 
a
kfYi Yi   Yi   kfY
aYw  aYi
N_ Yi DYi
i
qy jy0

28

Combining this expression with the microscopic mass balances in the polymer
lm, it is possible to predict mass transfer coecients for simple geometries and
to take into account possible coupling with chemical reactions. For instance, if the
polymer lm is immobile, has a constant depth L, and mass transfer occurs along
the y direction with a plane geometry, time-averaged mass transfer coecient of

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

volatile species kfi after an exposure time t f would be computed by solving Eq. (27)
with initial and boundary conditions as given in Eqs. (29).
Yi jt0 Yi 0 ;

A i jt0 A i 0

Yi jy0 Yi   ;

qYi 
0
qy jyL

DYi

tf

kfYi t f

29

qYi  y; t
dt
qy
jy0

Yi 0  Yi  

In view of the kinds of gasliquid contact described above, an obvious model is


provided by the penetration theory (innite depth L), where a portion of uid with
uniform concentration prole is suddenly exposed to the gas phase, and is replaced
by fresh uid after an exposure time t f . For an innite lm depth L and negligible
chemical reaction, this yields the well-known result [Eq. (30)] for the time-averaged
mass transfer coecient.
s
DYi
pt f

30

kfYi 2

Pell and Davis [45] were the rst to actually measure a diusion coecient for a
volatile by-product of a polycondensation, using PET formation in lms of varying
depth (although obtaining values of D much higher than those nowadays accepted). An early example of discussion of coupling of diusion/chemical reactions
in these systems may be found in Ref. 46.
The rst model associating the axial transport along the reactor (direction z) with
the cross-ow transfer of volatile by product (direction y) (see Figure 3.5) is due to
Amon and Denson [47] (Ault and Mellichamp [46] considered that all the polymer
was in the lm) and was developed for WFRs. It assumes plug ow in the pool,
which implies a negligible hold-up of the liquid in the lm. A time-averaged mass

Volatile by-product

x
y
JT

Low M
polymer inlet

Polymer outlet

z=0

Fig. 3.5.

Simple model for a WFR.

z=L y

73

74

3 Polycondensation

transfer coecient is obtained at each axial position by solving Eqs. (27) and (29),
and the mass balance of the pool is written as Eqs. (31), where u z is the axial supercial velocity (volumetric ow rate of polymer Q divided by cross-section area of
the pool) and a v is the lm area per unit volume.
uz

dYi 
RYi  kfYi a v Yi   Yi  
dz

uz

dA i 
RA i
dz

31

Yi jz0 Yi 0
Since the main mass transfer area is the lm on the barrel wall, the exposure time
would be calculated [47] through Eq. (32), where d T is the inner barrel diameter, L x
is the lm perimeter (L x G pd T , if the nip is small) and n_ is the screw rotational
speed in rotations per unit time.
tf

Lx
pd T n_

32

A better model [48] takes into account the movement of the lm along the wall
with velocity u x pd T n_ between coordinates x 0 and x L x and therefore adds
a convection term, leading to Eqs. (33), where the A i f and Yi f are the concentrations of the species in the lm. There is no need to consider cylindrical geometry
for the lm, since its thickness is low.
qYi f
qt

ux

qYi f
qx

DYi

q 2 Yi f
qy 2
L

qYi 
qYi 
ux
uz
R Yi
qt
qz
L

qA i 
qA i 
ux
uz
RA i
qt
qz
L
Yi jz0 Yi 0 t

RYi

qA i f
qt

ux

qA i f
qx

RA i

Yi f t; y dy  u z Yi 

L
0

A i f t; y dy  u z A i 

33

A i jz0 A i 0 t

Yi f jx 0 t; y; z Yi t; z A i f jx 0 t; y; z A i t; z
qYi f
qy

0
jyL

Yi f t; 0 Yi  

With some modications, a model of single-screw vented extruders can also be developed. We will present here a slightly extended version of the treatment by Roberts [49] and Biesenberger and Sebastian [50]. Fundamental studies on uid mechanics and mass transfer without reaction are reported in Refs. 51 and 52.

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

Unwrapped views:
Film

Fig. 3.6.

Scheme of ow and mass transfer in single-screw vented extruders.

A scheme of ow and mass transfer in single-screw vented extruders, also illustrating some key geometrical parameters, is shown in Figure 3.6.
As polymer ows inside the channel along a trajectory in a helix, with a total
length LB /sin y, in which y is the angle of the screw, the coordinate z will be taken
along this helicoidal path. Dimensions of the channel will be LW (width) by H
(depth), with a fraction fL lled with liquid. As the movement of screw pushes
the polymer pool, a fraction passes through the space between the barrel and the
screw, forming the desired evaporating lm. If the uid is Newtonian, the lm
width is h/2, where h is the clearance. The average transverse velocity of the screw
dragging the lm, vT , is given by Eq. (34).
34

vT pd T n_ sin y

The lm which is wiped from the channel re-enters at a distance d upstream of its
departure point given by Eq. (35) [50] and the time of exposure of the lm t f is
given by Eq. (36).
d pd T fL cos y

35

t f 1  fL /n_

36

The concentrations A i f z and Yi f z respectively for nonvolatile and volatile


components in the lm, back-mixed at axial position z, are obtained by solving
Eq. (27) for t t f with initial conditions described by Eqs. (37) (a more exact model
would consider convection as in Eq. (33)):
Yi jt0 Yi z d;

A i jt0 A i z d

37

75

76

3 Polycondensation

Assuming plug ow in the channel (a trivial change would be to add an axial dispersion coecient), the mass balances in the channel taking into account also the
devolatilization from the pool (mass transfer coecients kfpYi ) thus becomes those
given in Eqs. (38).

uz

kfpYi
dYi 
vT h
RYi
Yi   Yi  
Yi f  Yi  
dz
fL LW H
fL LW

uz

dA i 
vT h
RA i
A i f  A i 
dz
fL LW H

Yi jz0 Yi 0

38

A i jz0 A i 0

The presence of the delay d may be circumvented by using a Taylor expansion


about z [50] in order to obtain a system of second-order ODE. Also according
to Refs. 49 and 50, the exposure time of the pool may be estimated through Eq.
(39).

t fP

H
pd T n_ sin y

39

Another integration of Eq. (27) for t t fP with a trivial modication of Eq. (30) will
provide an estimation of the mass transfer coecients of the pool kfpYi .
Twin-screw extruders have the advantage of being self-cleaning and can work
with extremely high viscosity, above 10 6 Pa s [53], making them a good choice for
polyamide and polyurethane nal stages of reaction, thanks to the possibility of
using reduced space times. Their detailed modeling is more dicult than with
single-screw devices, and few fundamental studies [54] have been carried out.
Rates of mass transfer have been predicted for a co-rotating twin screw using penetration theory and experiments have been done with a transparent device (for
observing whether bubbles were present or not in the devolatilization zone). Observed results of kf a v were proportional to the speed of rotation to the power of
0.5, as penetration theory predicts, but were three times lower than theoretical predictions, which has been attributed to the very low liquid hold-up and consequent
lack of coverage.
In contrast to WFRs and vented extruders, use of staged models for describing
rotating disk contactors is a natural choice [55], since the J compartments with liquid hold-ups Vm j can be approximated as CSTRs. Taking into account the possibility of back-ow, the overall volume ow rate leaving the jth CSTR, Q j , will be divided into a fraction b j going back to CSTR j  1 and 1  b j going to tank j 1,
except for the rst CSTR, in which b 1 0. Also, Q J1 0, and the gas phase will
be considered well mixed with uniform temperature (see Figure 3.7). Thus, mass
balances at a steady state of volatile and nonvolatile components in the jth compartment ( j 1, J) may be written as in Eqs. (40).

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

Fig. 3.7.

Staged model of an RDC.

Q j1 1  b j1 A i j1 Q j1 b j1 A i j1 Q j A i j  RA i Vm j


Q j1 1  b j1 Yi j1 Q j1 b j1 Yi j1

40

Q j Yi j  RYi Vm j kfYij avj Vm j Yi j  Yi  


Mass transfer coecients can be computed using penetration theory as described
above.
Murakami et al. [56] obtained correlations for hold-up and mixing time in RDCs.
Fractional dead space (between 0 and 18% for their experimental data) can be predicted from the mixing time. This dead space should obviously be kept to a minimum, because polymer staying there will degrade due to secondary reactions
to possibly discolored or gelled material, and product quality may be seriously
harmed. Local lm thickness and hold-up have been correlated to physical properties (surface tension, viscosity) and geometrical parameters [57]. Residence time
distribution has been shown to become narrower when viscosity grows [58].
Interfacial area [58] can be correlated with relative lling level H/d T and the
number of disk rings per unit length ( J/LT ) [Eq. (41)].
av

J 1:72  1:87H/d T
LT 0:085 0:955H/d T

41

An experimental study on mass transfer in disk-ring contactors of diameter dR


using low-viscosity acrylamide solutions as a model uid [60] has led to the correlation of Eq. (42), but this correlation should only be used as a rst approximation
[40], in view of the complexities introduced by polymer viscoelasticity.
 2 0:5
kf dR
d n_
1:59 R
Sh
D
D

42

Falling-lm or falling-strand devolatilizators receive increasing attention as they require no heavy and expensive machinery: Polymer is simply pumped through
small slits or holes. Ecient surface renewal is achieved by shear thinning during
the fall [59]; strands and lms become very thin and may be completely depleted of

77

78

3 Polycondensation

volatiles. Depletion or possible tearing determine the optimal height of strands/


lms for a given viscosity and initial lm diameter. Reaction considerably increases
the eciency of these devices (by a factor of up to ten) as it replenishes the volatile
by-product. Guides to the strands/lms, such as wires, thin rods, or grids, will further enhance the role of the reaction while reducing the eect of shear thinning
and tearing.
In all these devices, an additional component of interfacial area is provided by
the gas bubbles, which can result from sparging with inert gas (widely used for
devolatilization without chemical reaction) or from boiling. Observed rates of
mass transfer are often several times higher than predicted [50] and this discrepancy has been linked to the presence of bubbles.
The LaplaceKelvin equation predicts that an isolated gas bubble should redissolve if its size is below a critical threshold, and conversely it should grow if its radius r b exceeds the critical value given by Eq. (43) [50], where s is the surface tension, Pme is the local pressure over the bubble (it may be simply the hydrostatic
pressure, but in other circumstances it may be controlled by medium elasticity
[61]), and Pb is the pressure inside the bubble, equal to the sum of the partial vapor
pressures due to inert gases and volatile components if physical equilibrium and
gas-phase ideality hold. So, it is possible that no bubbling occurs if the pressure is
high enough or the content of volatiles is too low, but this is often not the case.
rbc

2s
Pb  Pme

43

Bubble nucleation in polymer media is usually heterogeneous [62]. It starts when


shear stress manages to detach the small bubbles which are stuck in cracks and
crevices of vessel walls, internals, or suspended dust. Once the source of heterogeneous nucleation is spent, only high supersaturation will restart boiling. Of course,
in many practical situations there are already small air bubbles in the polymer, and
they will start foaming too. Favelukis et al. [63] have conrmed this view, and have
developed a theory for bubble growth which may explain the higher mass transfer
rates obtained with vented extruders and similar devices for high rotation speeds.
A predictive theory for bubble nucleation was developed in this same research [64].
Gestring and Mewes [65] have studied polymer degassing both with and without
bubbling using a transparent drum with a rotating blade (similar to the screw of a
vented extruder). Measured values of mass transfer rates without bubbling are
three times lower than predicted by penetration theory, because neither pool nor
lm is well stirred which could explain the failure of predictions in Ref. 54. Rates
of mass transfer in the presence of foaming were about 40 times higher than in
the bubble-free regime.
Trace devolatilization with the help of a stripper agent has a greatly enhanced efciency. An important recent result is that, when it forms, foam grows until a
limiting volume is reached, regardless of initial volatile content and presence of
stripper gas [66], and thus the devolatilization section in vented extruders should

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

have enough room for that expansion, and residence time should also be sucient
to allow the nal density to be reached.
A patent [67] for enhancing mass transfer in this class of reactors proposes
the introduction of inert gas into the polymer in order to force the formation of
bubbles (the forced gas sweeping process). An experimental and theoretical model
has also been presented [68] and will be briey summarized here.
The reactor was a rotating disk contactor for making bisphenol A (BPA) polycarbonate. The reactor model uses a staged approach, and the crux is the prediction of
the mass transfer rate of by-product (phenol). The two relationships expressed in
Eqs. (44) for the volume of a gas bubble Vb as a function of the gas ow rate Q g
[69] and of its rising velocity u b in a laminar regime [70] were the key data.

 1/4 
15mQ g 3/4
4p
2rg
3



Q g d b 1/2
2gd b
ub
1
Cd
u b Vb
Vb

Cd

44

16
1
Re

In these equations m; r, respectively, are the viscosity and density of the liquid, g is
the acceleration of gravity, d b is the bubble diameter, and Cd is the drag coecient.
The mass transfer coecient was predicted using penetration theory, and the exposure time was computed [Eq. (45)] as the rising time of a bubble in the melt (at
height hR above the gas injection point).
tf

hR
ub

45

The interfacial area per unit volume was obtained from the number of bubbles Nb
and the melt volume Vm [Eqs. (46)].
a v pdb2

Nb
Vm

46

Q g tf
Nb
Vb
The observed bubble frequency agreed with the theoretical predictions, as also did
the proles of x n versus reaction time.
It is interesting to nish this complex section with such a case study, suggesting
that for some problems classical Chemical Engineering of the 1960s can still
help in present-day industrial and scientic problems.

79

80

3 Polycondensation

The design and operation of most polycondensation reactors for devolatilization


of volatile by-products (namely vented extruders) is clearly a very dicult problem
because of the complexity of the ows (with or without foaming). Further progress
is likely to require a heavy use of computational uid dynamics, as simplied
models seem to have arrived at their limits.
3.2.2

Solid-state Polycondensation

Current industrial processes for the production of high molecular weight, linear,
aromatic polyesters and polyamides, for use as plastics and bers, use solid-state
polycondensation (SSP) for their last stages. This is the kind of process that will
be treated in this section: the polycondensation of semi-crystalline, low molecular
weight polymers to high molecular weight ones, occurring below the melting temperature of high polymer, but well above the glass transition temperature. We will
disregard polycondensation of crystalline monomers, which is also covered in the
review by Pilati [71].
Because of the need to provide enough interfacial area to allow the removal of
volatile by-products, the polymer has to be in a powdery form. One of the several
optimization problems of these processes is to specify an economical starting particle size.
A practical diculty is the possible tendency of the particles to stick, which will
make the process unfeasible. It is counteracted by starting with polymers with sufciently high crystallinity, and by adding glass beads. Another problem may be the
sublimation of oligomers, as in nylon-6, which may clog the bed. A precrystallization step for PET, to make it attain at least 40% crystallinity before SSP starts, is
present in industrial processes since early 1970s.
The main reason for using SSP is the achievement of molecular weights higher
than would be possible in melt polycondensation, owing to the selectivity gain of
polycondensation with respect to degradation reactions. Therefore, in a batch SSP,
a maximum in molecular weight versus time is expected, and this maximum will
occur at shorter times and will lead to lower molecular weights as the temperature
is increased.
The key assumptions made in order to interpret SSP are due to Gostoli, Pilati et
al. [72, 73] (see Figure 3.8):


All chain end groups belong to the amorphous regions.


No reactions occur in crystalline regions.
 Chemical reactions follow the same kinetics as in melt, taking into account
the change in the volume of the reaction media aecting functional group
concentrations.
 Equilibrium CLD holds locally.


The overall polydispersity of polymer will be greater than the equilibrium value (2

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

Fig. 3.8. Phase separation in solid-state polycondensation;


A, B are the end groups, W is volatile by-product.

for linear polycondensations) because of the radial prole of Mn in the diusioncontrolled regime.
In the same way as in heterogeneous catalysis, eective diusion coecients
DYie (for uxes with respect to the total geometric area) are decreased relative to
the values in the melt DYi because of the obstruction due to the crystalline phase
at a volume fraction fcr and because of the tortuosity factor tD (which depends on
the structure of the solid, values of 1.5 to 3 being common); the relationship is
given in Eq. (47).
DYie DYi

1  fcr
tD

47

Notice that volume and mass fractions wcr of the crystalline phase are dierent because of the slight dierence in density with respect to the amorphous phase.
An unavoidable complication is thus the description of the build-up of the crystalline phase, which aects mass transfer and chemical reactions by increasing
functional group concentrations in the amorphous phase. The rate of crystallization is often described by the Avrami equation [Eq. (48)].
wcr 1  expkcr t ncr

48

The exponent ncr is a function of nucleation and growth type, which is not constant
for the entire course of crystallization. Mallon and Ray [74] have put forward in-

81

82

3 Polycondensation

stead of Avrami equation an empirical rate law in terms of residual amorphous


phase volume fraction.
The microscopic mass balance of polymer functional groups and volatile components given in Eqs. (27) has to be modied in order to take into account the variable reaction volume due to polymer crystallization. Here we do not follow the
notation in Ref. 74; rather, we use concentrations and rates of reaction per unit
volume of amorphous phase instead of concentrations per unit volume of particle
A i p A i /1  fcr , and so on, in order to use the same kinetic rate laws [Eqs.
(49)] as in the melt.


q1  fcr Yi 
1  fcr
DYi
Yi  1  fcr RYi
qt
tD

49

q1  fcr A i 
1  fcr RA i
qt
Examples of the use of this approach with PET and nylon-6,6, including a successful comparison with available experimental data, can be found in Ref. 74.
Industrial-scale SSP is carried out in moving packed bed, uidized bed, and
stirred bed reactors; Mallon and Ray have published a brief discussion of idealized
models of these reactors [75]. Fluidized beds have a serious drawback because of
the high consumption of gas needed to keep the bed in a uidized state, and residence time distribution is unfavorable to high conversions. Stirred beds in series
are a possible solution, depending on economic details.
A model for SSP of nylon-6,6 in a moving bed reactor, considering its complex
geometry and its start-up and shutdown operation [76], can serve as a guide for
dealing with more complex real-life situations.
3.2.3

Interfacial Polycondensation

Typical chemical systems are fast reactions between two difunctional monomers,
AXA BYB. The rst monomer (diamine, bisphenolate) is dissolved in a water solution (in alkaline media in both cases), and the other monomer, with low water
solubility (acid chloride, phosgene), is usually dissolved in an organic solvent. Either the neutral form of AXA is in an appreciable amount (in the case of amines),
or a phase transfer catalyst is needed (as in polycarbonate synthesis), since ionized
forms will not dissolve in the organic phase. A decrease in the pH is often used to
quench interfacial polyamidation.
The chain extension of water dispersions of isocyanates with water-dissolved
amines, in order to make polyurea dispersions, shares some similarities with the
former (amine acid chloride) systems.
Another common feature among these chemical systems is the presence of a
parasite reaction consuming end groups B by reaction with water.

3.2 Mass Transfer Issues in Polycondensations

Addition of a monofunctional chain stopper to the organic phase is advisable in


order to control the nal M n .
In most cases (namely polyamides and polyureas), the polymer is insoluble in
monomer BYB or in its solvent, and precipitates as soon as it forms, often yielding
a shell through which AXA has to diuse. Polycarbonates are an exception, as they
are completely soluble in the methylene chloride solvent chosen for their production. Also, the organic phase is continuous in this latter case, which is a rather exceptional situation for interfacial polycondensations.
Also with the exception of polycarbonates, interfacial polycondensation is mostly
used in the production of specialty products, such as membranes [8082] and microcapsules [8387].
Early important contributions on interfacial polycondensations are described by
Morgan [77] as well as in Refs. 78 and 79. These studies show that the reaction
occurs in a layer close to the interface, on the organic side; the adjective interfacial is thus rather misleading. Reaction is very fast and mass transfer resistance
is an important factor.
Models have for a long time concentrated on describing the velocity of consumption of water-soluble monomer and consequent rate of lm growth [8387].
Although a possible framework for describing the simpler case of polycarbonate formation has been presented by Mills [88], the rst attempt at predicting
molecular weight distributions for more typical interfacial polycondensation systems is due to Karoda, Kulkarni et al. [89, 90], based on experimental data by
Johnson [91]. This work will be the basis of the analysis next presented in this
section.
Assuming an apparent second-order rate constant in the organic phase k of the
order 10 2 to 10 4 m 3 /kmol s [77] and a concentration of functional groups B in
the bulk organic phase Bb 1 kmol m3 , the characteristic reaction time for consumption of monomer AXA is of the order of 104 to 102 s. In the absence of
polymer, the diusion coecient of AXA in organic solvent BYB, assuming a
molecular weight of up to a few hundreds, should be of the order of 1010 to
1011 m 2 s1 , and this yields a characteristic width of reaction zone LR 108 to
107 m. So, polymerization occurs in a thin shell beneath the lm of precipitated
polymer. There will be no functional groups B at the water interface and a steep
gradient of concentration of monomer BYB will be rapidly established inside the
organic phase.
Instead of solving microscopic mass balances for the concentration proles, Karode et al. [89, 90] use average concentrations in the reaction zone and consider its
thickness LR constant (see Figure 3.9).
Furthermore, the rate of movement of the interface between the organic phase
and the precipitated polymer lm is considered to be slow, so that a pseudo-steady
approximation for the diusion of AXA through the polymer lm and for diusion
of BYB inside the organic phase should be valid. Mass balances of monomers in
the reaction zone and in bulk aqueous and organic phases resulting from these assumptions are given in Eqs. (50).

83

84

3 Polycondensation

[AXA]blk

[BYB]blk

[BYB]blk

He [AXA]blk
[AXA]

[BYB]

Hi [AXA]

[BYB]

LP
Swollen

aqueous

polymer

phase

film

Reaction zone

Fig. 3.9.

Bulk

LR

x
Bulk
organic
phase

Model for interfacial polycondensation.

LR

dAXA
He AXAblk  Hi AXA
LR RAXA DAXA
dt
Lp

LR

dBYB
LR RBYB kf BYB BYBblk  BYB
dt

50

dAXAblk
He AXAblk  Hi AXA
Vaq
av; aq DAXA
dt
Lp
Vorg

dBYBblk
av; org kf BYB BYBblk  BYB
dt

There are two partition coecients He and Hi for monomer AXA:


He is the ratio of bulk concentration in the aqueous phase AXAblk to concentration in the outer interface of polymer lm (thickness L p ).
 Hi is the ratio of monomer concentration in the polymer lm to concentration in
the organic phase.


Vaq and Vorg are the volumes of aqueous and organic phases and av; aq ; av; org are
their interfacial areas per unit volume (trivially related). No mass transfer resistance is assumed to exist outside the polymer lm (although it can be easily included), but it is considered inside the organic phase, with the help of a mass
transfer coecient kf BYB (which can be obtained by penetration theory). Introduc-

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

ing the rates of reaction of polymer species (see Section 3.4.4), their mass balances
can be written as Eq. (51).
IJ

dPn 
RPnIJ  k nuc; n PnIJ   PnIJ sat I; J A; B; C
dt

51

Polymer precipitation is taken into account through the model of Kamide et al. [92]
with a phenomenological rate of nucleation k nuc; n (nil for n 1, taken as independent of molecular weight for n > 1) [93]. The saturation concentrations of polymer species are taken as the values of their concentrations in the lower branch of
the spinodal curve for the liquidliquid equilibrium with organic solvent. The earlier paper by Karode et al. [89] considered only spinodal decomposition.
A coherent lm is predicted to form when the sum of projected areas for all
phase-separated polymer nuclei (assumed spherical) is equal to the interfacial
area. Film thickness is predicted through the overall mass balance of precipitated
polymer.
Besides thermodynamic data on the liquidliquid equilibria of polymer/solvent
and hydrophilic monomer polymer/solvent, this model needs the rate of nucleation k nuc , considered as an adjustable parameter, it also tries to t the diusion coecient of monomer in the polymer lm DAXA , and, as it postulates a constant
width of the reaction zone, it has also to t the kinetic parameters.
In spite of its limitations in predictive power (a natural consequence of the complexity of the phenomena involved), this approach has given an important new insight on these processes. Film permeation properties should depend on the mode
of phase separation, nucleation giving better crystallinity. Molecular weight depends on the competition between reaction and precipitation of polymer: a more
powerful solvent should lead to higher molecular weight. The existence of a sharp
maximum of average molecular weight as a function of the concentration of monomer in the organic phase when the two monomer uxes toward the reaction zone
are balanced, remarked upon by P. W. Morgan, could at last be explained by this
model 40 years later.

3.3

Polycondensation Processes in Detail


3.3.1

Polyesters
Structure and Production Processes
Two kinds of polyesters will be discussed in this section:
3.3.1.1

Linear, crystalline, high molecular weight (M n between 15 000 and 100 000), used
as plastics and bers, the most important being poly(ethylene terephthalate)
(PET) and poly(butylene terephthalate) (PBT);

85

86

3 Polycondensation


Unsaturated low molecular weight (Mn between 1000 and 10 000), often
branched, used as macromonomers for synthesis of thermosets (polyester resins), or thermosetting materials by themselves (alkyd resins). They are prepared
from several monomers, namely phthalic and maleic anhydrides, adipic acid, isophthalic acid, natural fatty acids or triglycerides, and a great variety of multifunctional alcohols. In a few special cases, they may be saturated and/or linear for
use as macromonomers in the production of polyurethanes or other polymers.

Acid-catalyzed Esterication and Alcoholysis


The two main reactions in these processes are esterication and alcoholysis, which
share similar mechanisms, with a hypothetical tetrahedral intermediate.
Reactions between anhydrides and alcohols are much faster than carboxyl
alcohol reaction, and full conversion of anhydrides (unless they are in excess) will
occur in less than one minute while being melted and blended with the rest of
the mixture. This stage is slightly exothermal and care is needed to avoid sudden
boiling of the reacting mixture. Kinetic parameters of this reaction (apart from
selectivities with respect to hydroxyls) are usually not needed.
Acidolysis reactions have a dierent mechanism, involving mixed anhydrides
[94]. Their rate is comparable to the esterication reactions only above 250 C.
Esterication also occurs in high-temperature alcoholysis of aromatic esters, as
carboxyl end groups are formed by side reactions, and should also be considered
in the kinetic modeling of these processes.
In spite of being the rst reaction ever studied [95], esterication has been under
investigation ever since, and much knowledge has accumulated, even if some
points are still less clear. The basic kinetic model for polyesterication was established by Flory and is summarized in his classic book [5]. Esterication was shown
to be acid-catalyzed, it is rst-order with respect to hydroxyls and, with respect to
carboxyls, its order is either one in the presence of foreign strong protic acids, or
two in their absence [Eq. (52)].
3.3.1.2

R COOH kscat OHCOOH 2

no foreign acid

R COOH kfcat OHCOOHCat-H strong foreign acid Cat-H

52

However, these rate laws can only be observed at low concentrations of hydroxyl
and carboxyl groups; otherwise a higher dielectric constant, association through
hydrogen bonds, and generic nonidealities will introduce changes in the apparent
values of the kinetic constants in Eq. (52). Experimental verication of these rate
laws is more delicate than it seems at rst sight (the eect of reverse hydrolysis reaction must be adequately taken into account or eliminated by the experimental
set-up) and has been repeated by Hamann et al. [96], but proposal of other kinetics
has continued. In their extensive review, Fradet and Marechal [97] have found that
the overall order of esterication in the chemical literature is claimed to vary from
zero to six!
It is nevertheless useful to have some relationship, even empirical, that could extend the validity of Eq. (52) to the whole range of concentrations of functional

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

groups, and such a relationship (Eq. (53) where p is carboxyl conversion) has been
proposed by Chen and Wu [98, 99].
k kA expap

53

In Eq. (53) the empirical parameter a is a function of the initial stoichiometric ratio
r. It was theoretically linked to the dependence of the dissociation equilibrium constant of the carboxylic acid on the dielectric constant of the medium and to the dependence of the latter on the carboxylic acid concentration through conversion p. A
good t of experimental data has been obtained with the parameter a varying in the
range 0.2 to 1.2 both for the self-catalyzed and the foreign acid-catalyzed esterications of adipic acid with dierent diols.
In their modeling of unsaturated polyester resin formation, Beigzadeh et al.
[100] and Zetterlund et al. [101] have also found the ChenWu relationship more
useful than the rather cumbersome empirical models of Paatero et al. [102] or Lehtonen et al. [103]. Zetterlund et al. [101] have also presented interesting experimental data on the simultaneous self- and cross-catalysis by two carboxyl groups,
namely those formed by the addition of maleic and phthalic anhydride to 1,2
propanediol; they show there is an anti-synergistic eect: that is, the total rate reaction of the two carboxyl groups is lower than the sum of the rates of reaction of the
individual acids with the same concentration and at the same temperature.
Catalysis by Metallic Compounds
Self-catalyzed esterication is often too slow to be of practical use, especially because hydroxyl-terminated polymers are either sought or are a consequence of the
process (aromatic polyesterications are carried out with a large excess of hydroxyls
at the beginning of the process, because of the low solubility of the diacid), and
strong protic acids are not advisable, as they would catalyze polymer hydrolysis if
allowed to remain with the polymer. Even volatile catalysts such as methanesulfonic acid are avoided. Therefore, metallic salts are currently used as catalysts,
both for esterication and alcoholysis. Strong bases, such as lithium hydroxide,
can also be used, but for alcoholysis only (as in polycarbonate formation).
Metals in metallic complexes can catalyze esterication and alcoholysis through
two distinct mechanisms [117]:
3.3.1.3

Metals of groups IIIII (such as Zn, Mn, Ce, Pb), usually introduced as carboxylates, complex the oxygen in carbonyl esters preferentially.
 Metals of groups IIIVI (namely Ti, Sb, Ge, Bi), usually introduced as alkoxides,
dialkyltin oxides R2 SnO and carboxylates such as dibutyltin dilaurate, coordinate
with the acylic oxygen of esters.
Their activity with respect to esterication and alcoholysis has been compared by
Habib and Malek [105, 106] and Chung [107], who found volcano-shaped relationships with dierent optima of activity of the several metals in terms of metal electronegativity according to Tanaka [108] for the glycolysis of dimethyl terephthalate

87

88

3 Polycondensation

(DMT) and for the polycondensation of bis(2-hydroxyethyl) terephthalate (BHET).


A much more careful analysis [117] has considered the catalyst concentrations
and the dierences between the catalyzed reactions.
There are striking dierences [109, 110] between the two groups of metals as
regards sensitivity to inhibition by carboxyls (which poison the rst group) or by
hydroxyls (which poison the second group). Titanium has the best balance of properties, because it is little inhibited by carboxyls and hydroxyls (which poison Sb)
and also eciently catalyzes esterication. It is also active at surprisingly low concentrations [117].
The choice of catalyst also depends on secondary reactions (Ti causes yellowing),
toxicity (a problem for Sb) and price (expensive Ge will nevertheless yield a white
polymer).
The metal responsible for the catalysis is usually involved in several complexes.
An FTIR/NMR study of alcohol exchange with titanates in bulk or concentrated
solutions in apolar solvents [111] has shown that these compounds are present in
stable dimers, trimers, and other associations. These complexes exchange alkoxide
groups very rapidly, even at temperatures below ambient.
Kinetic models have to take into account both the existence of these polynuclear
complexes and the poisoning phenomena, and are more complicated than for acidcatalyzed reactions. Alcoholysis of DMT, BHET, and other aromatic and aliphatic
esters is now becoming better understood. A key step was to recognize that in systems such as DMT ethylene glycol (EG) there are two reversible alcoholysis reactions, one consisting in the attack of methyl esters either by EG or the hydroxyethyl
end groups, the other in the attack of the hydroxyethyl ester groups which produces oligomers detected by HPLC [Eq. (54)].
kEG

HOCH2 CH2 OH XCOOCH3 !


 XCOOCH2 CH2 OH CH3 OH
kEG =KEG

kHE

54

!
XCOOCH2 CH2 OH XCOOCH3 

 XCOOCH2 CH2 OOCX CH3 OH
kHE =KHE

Besnoin and Choi [112] were the rst to actually use experimentally measured
oligomer concentrations to validate this kinetic scheme for Zn catalyst, as was
soon conrmed and perfected by others [113117].
These reactions are rst order with respect to the esters and hydroxyls, but the
order with respect to the catalyst becomes zero at catalyst concentrations over a
few millimoles per gram (no power rate law [114]). Moreover, the ratio kEG /kHE
much depends on the catalyst (it may vary from 1 to 5) and even on the catalyst
concentration. Mixtures of divalent metal catalysts can have considerable synergistic eects [117], which cannot be explained unless polynuclear complexes participate in the reaction.
It is noteworthy that, in the similar system dimethyl 2,6-naphthalenedicarboxylate 1,3-propanediol, the reactivity of hydroxyl groups in monomer and in hydroxypropyl chain ends is the same [118].
There are also studies for DMT 1,4-butanediol with Ti and divalent metal catalysts, for which an order of one with respect to Ti and the hydroxyl and ester

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

groups has been reported [119]. The analysis of rate data is more dicult because
of the relatively high importance of the secondary reaction leading to THF formation (see below).
Models for Ti-catalyzed esterication are still more complex. Titanates are hydrolyzed by water and form oligomeric a(RO, R 0 O)aTiOa structures (unless the hydroxyl excess is large). These structures are more active than the monomeric titanate [120]. Too much water will lead to a drop in activity [110], probably due to
formation of insoluble products. Order one was found with respect to acid, hydroxyl, and Ti (at a concentration of a few parts per million) [121], but there is a
slight inhibition eect by the ester groups.
The increase in activity brought about by vestiges of water has also been observed both for Ti and Zr (this latter is even more active) in the model reaction of
octadecanoic acid octadecanol [122]. No simple rst-order rate law with respect
to hydroxyls and carboxyls was found in that research.
Dialkyltin catalysts (such as dibutyltin dilaurate) have catalytic properties for esterication and alcoholysis similar to Ti and Zr [123]. The SnaC bond is fairly stable, but the upper acceptable temperature limit is around 220 C. On the other
hand, thanks to the added exibility provided by the organic group and the possibility of oligomerization, it is possible to prepare catalysts that are quite insensitive
to deactivation by vestiges of humidity [124]. Nowadays these catalysts are often
used in alkyd resin production.
Side Reactions in Aromatic Polyester Production
The important side products formed in nonthermooxidative secondary reactions
in PET formation are acetaldehyde, vinyl end groups, and diethylene glycol (DEG)
units, together with carboxyl end groups. DEG units decrease the melting point,
crystallinity and thermal stability. Acetaldehyde, even at parts-per-million level, is
detectable by its avor in drink bottles. Vinyl esters and acetaldehyde lead to chromophoric products. Carboxyl end groups promote hydrolytic and thermal instability. Additionally, these side reactions lead to a decrease in molecular weight, which
is particularly undesirable for product use in markets such as tire cord and soft
drink bottles.
Side reactions can be minimized to a certain extent by choice of operating conditions and catalysis. Knowledge of this chemistry has obvious economic advantages,
and many details (for example, the inuence of catalysts and stabilizers) cannot be
found in the open literature.
Thermal scission of ethylene diester groups is a likely source of carboxyl and
vinyl end groups [125] (Scheme 3.1):
3.3.1.4

O
C
O

O
H
C
CH O
CH2

Scheme 3.1.

OH
C
O

CH O

CH2

Vinyl end group formation from PET.

O
C

89

90

3 Polycondensation

This is a rst-order reaction, with no eect of catalysts or additives.


Further alcoholysis of vinyl esters yields acetaldehyde [Eq. (a)].
XCOOCHbCH2 HOCH2 CH2 OOCY ! XCOOCH2 CH2 OOCY CH3 CHO
a
DEG units are observed to form mainly in the rst stages of the process. The presence of a hydroxyl ester group is indispensable, as it can be shown experimentally
that DEG forms in negligible amounts if ethylene glycol is heated alone in the absence of acid catalysts [126]. Reimschuessel [127] has suggested the attack of ethylene glycol or a hydroxyethyl end group as a possible source of the DEG moieties
(see Scheme 3.2). The analogous intramolecular etherication is the source of
side product dioxane [125] (see Scheme 3.3).

O
C

O
C
OH

Scheme 3.2.

CH2 O
O CH2

H O

CH2
CH2
OX

O
C
CH2 O
CH2
CH2
O
CH2
OX

Formation of DEG moieties in PET.

O
C
OCH2CH2
O
OH

O
+

C
OH

CH2 CH2
O
O
CH2 CH2

CH2CH2
Scheme 3.3.

Dioxane formation in PET.

Poly(butylene terephthalate) is also subject to analogous side reactions [128],


the formation of 1-butenyl end groups (Scheme 3.4) followed by splitting-o of
1,3-butadiene or tetrahydrofuran (Scheme 3.5). This latter reaction is not aected
by the metallic catalyst, but is catalyzed by the carboxyl end groups, making production of PBT by direct esterication of terephthalic acid and 1,4-butanediol disadvantageous.
Side Reactions in the Formation of Unsaturated Polyesters
A recent review on the chemistry of unsaturated polyesters has been published by
Malik et al. [129]. Besides cistrans isomerization [130], the other important side
reaction is Ordelt reaction [131133] (see Scheme 3.6) which increases branching
and consumes double bonds. Both reactions are reversible and acid-catalyzed.
3.3.1.5

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

O
H
CH2 CH2 C
O
CH CH2
C
O CH2
O

OH
+
C
O

H2C CH CH CH2
Scheme 3.4.

CH2 O
H2C CH CH2

HO

O
C

O
C

Vinyl end group formation from PBT.

O
C
O
Scheme 3.5.

CH2 CH2
CH2
CH2
O

THF splitting-o from PBT.

HC CH
R OH +
COOR''
R'OOC
Scheme 3.6.

OH
+
C
O

CH2 CH2
CH2 CH2
HO

RO
HC CH2
R'OOC
COOR''

Ordelt reaction.

Modeling of Processes of Aromatic Polyester Production


Continuous processes are currently used in the manufacture of PET. Several models have been developed, with the aim of contributing to a better design and operation. A brief discussion of their main assumptions and predictive capacities follows. Since polycondensation in solid-state and in lm-forming devices has been
analyzed previously, only the specic aspects of the initial process stages still needs
to be covered.
Earlier models for continuous processes based on DMT [134, 135] study the inuence of variables, such as the initial stoichiometric ratio, reactor temperatures,
and average residence times for CSTRs in series connected with distillation columns, on process performance. They show it is possible to optimize conversion
and minimize formation of side products. Even if kinetics and physical equilibria
are now much better known, their qualitative conclusions should still hold.
PBT production, for which no published process models have been found,
should be described by a similar approach.
Yamada et al. [136] and more recently Kang et al. [137] have presented models of
the direct esterication process of terephthalic acid (TPA) with ethylene glycol (Figure 3.10). As TPA has a low solubility because of its high melting point, the rst
reactor in the train (esterication reactor) is operated at a higher pressure and
3.3.1.6

91

92

3 Polycondensation

Fig. 3.10. Simple model for WFR used for the direct
esterication process of terephthalic acid (TPA) with ethylene
glycol.

temperature than the pre-polycondensation reactor in order to counterbalance


this lack of solubility. The calculations show it is also possible to optimize conversion and minimize side reactions by a choice of average reaction times, temperatures, and pressures. There are, however, no actual plant data to validate these conclusions. The kinetic model uses a fragment approach similar to what was
recommended in previous sections, although without taking into account the inuence of alcoholysis and acidolysis on monomer concentrations. Also, no thermodynamic model has been used for predicting the solubility of TPA, only an interpolation between values in pure ethylene glycol and dierent oligomers.
An integrated view of recent processes for PET has presented by Yao and Ray
[138]. Most of the DEG units are shown to be produced essentially in the esterication and pre-polycondensation reactors, with very little change afterwards. Minimizing vinyl ester formation, thus improving molecular weight and product quality, is achieved by decreasing residence time in the nishing wiped-lm reactor,
but increasing the residence time in the solid-state polymerization reactor, which is
operated at a lower temperature under a stream of inert gas.
Modeling of Processes for Unsaturated Polyester Production
Nava gives a brief description of the industrial processes [139]. Polyester resins
should ideally be produced with a certain predened viscosity in their solution in
acrylic/vinyl monomers and with a known, reproducible, distribution of double
bonds. Trans double bonds are much more reactive in free-radical polymerization,
and the amounts of each one should be known. Carboxyl end groups are in some
processes further converted to metal carboxylates (typically, by adding MgO) in order to thicken the solution, so it is also important to control their concentration.
Therefore, it is worth developing models for these processes, and a few recent
studies have appeared in this area [101, 104], but for now they only aim at predicting the concentrations of functional groups, which is not a minor task in view of
the large number of parameters needed. Modeling of the full process requires consideration of the losses of volatile monomers (lack of reliable vaporliquid equilibria data is a problem), and the aforementioned problems of taking into account the
low solubility of isophthalic and terephthalic acids are also pending.
3.3.1.7

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

Description of the branched structure of the resins is less problematic than in


the case of alkyds, because the conversion of double bonds by Ordelt reaction is in
the range 10 to 20%, so the molecules are almost comb-like and the approximations used by Yang and Pascault [140] should be reasonable.
Modeling of alkyd resin production is a rather formidable task because of the
high number of distinguishable chemical groups, the branched structure of the
polymer, a nonnegligible amount of intramolecular reaction, and side reactions of
the double bonds in fatty acids. The usual problems found in previously discussed
polyesterications, namely lack of data for liquidvapor and liquidsolid equilibria
and associated mass transfers, are also present.
Industrial processes [141143] use batch stirred reactors, connected to partial
condensers in order to recover volatile glycols. Azeotropic distillation with xylene
(for instance) is often used. Monomers may be added in several steps to overcome solubility problems. Vacuum and inert gas sparging is also used in dierent
stages. Catalysts (mostly alkyltin salts) are used to convert most of the carboxyl
groups, as specications often require less than 1 mg g1 KOH acid value. Long
reaction times are sometimes avoided through dierent techniques for eliminating
residual carboxyls.
The same plant usually produces dierent varieties of resins, according, for instance, to fatty acid content. New compositions are often sought in order to improve end use properties or to compensate for uctuations of raw material prices.
Therefore, it is often necessary to look for initial amounts of monomers which satisfy stoichiometric constraints (such as mole ratio and fatty acid content), will not
lead to gelation, and meanwhile keep an acceptably high M n (for instance).
An early review of the foundations of the macromolecular chemistry of alkyds
has been presented by Kienle [143] and simple methods for predicting gelation
conversion have been reviewed by Jonason [144]. These predictions are not very accurate, but good data on intramolecular reactions and dierences of reactivity of
functional groups will be needed if better control of physico-chemical properties
is sought.
3.3.2

Polycarbonates
General Introduction
Polycarbonates are polyesters of carbonic acid formed by reaction of diols (aromatic, aliphatic or a mixture of both) with a derivative of carbonic acid. The rst
preparations of polycarbonates were reported by Einhorn in 1898 [155], by reaction
of phosgene with resorcinol or hydroquinone in a pyridine solution. Bischo and
van Hedenstrom in 1902 [156] obtained the same aromatic polycarbonates via
transesterication with diphenyl carbonate (DPC). Thus the main routes to polycarbonates were established early, but the properties of the products seemed uninteresting. Around 1930 aliphatic polycarbonates were studied by Carothers and van
Natta [157]. These carbonates have low melting points and thermal resistance and
are not commercially interesting as stand-alone thermoplastics. Low molecular
3.3.2.1

93

94

3 Polycondensation

weight, aliphatic polycarbonates with hydroxy end groups, however, are widely
used as a diol component for the synthesis of polyurethanes and polyurethane
urea elastomers.
Following the work of Whineld and Dickson [158], who in 1941 succeeded
in preparing high molecular weight, high melting polyesters, the chemistry of
polycarbonates was re-examined. This led to the preparation of a linear, high
molecular weight polycarbonate derived from bisphenol A [BPA, or 2,2-di(4hydroxyphenyl)propane] by Schnell at Bayer [159, 160] and shortly afterwards by
Fox at General Electric [161]. BPA polycarbonate (BPA-PC) proved to be an outstanding engineering thermoplastic that diers from the other polyesters in that
it is noncrystalline with a high glass transition temperature (about 150 C) and retains its high transparency and toughness after molding. It has thermal stability up
to over 300 C as well as excellent mechanical, optical, and electrical properties, inherent re resistance, and food compatibility. Improvements of several polymer
properties such as heat resistance, melt ow, and birefringence were achieved
with dierent (co)monomers [163, 164]. However, BPA-PC remains the commercially most important polycarbonate.
The original processes phosgenation in pyridine solution and melt
transesterication were soon replaced by interfacial polycondensation with phosgene, which proceeds at low temperatures and allows the easy production of high
molecular weight polymer. It still remains the predominant production process although interest in the simpler, nonphosgene-based and environmentally more attractive transesterication process revived in the 1990s; problems with the earlier
melt carbonates, in particular the poor resin color, could be overcome. Polycarbonate demand has enjoyed steady growth and total production capacity in 2003 was
about 2.5 million tons per year. Approximately 12% is produced by transesterication and the percentage is expected to increase. The presentation here focuses on
the engineering aspects of BPA homopolymer production. Detailed reviews of the
synthesis and application of polycarbonates are given in Refs. 164171.
Interfacial Polycondensation
In the interfacial process, BPA and phosgene react at the boundary of two immiscible liquids, an aqueous alkaline BPA solution and an organic phase containing
phosgene. The overall reaction is shown in Scheme 3.7.
3.3.2.2

CH3
C
CH3

n NaO

Scheme 3.7.

ONa + n COCl2

-2n NaCl
O

CH3
C
CH3

O
C
O

Overall stoichiometry of bisphenol A polycarbonate formation.

The synthesis proceeds in two steps: phosgenation of BPA forming oligomeric


carbonates with phenolic and chloroformate end groups; and polycondensation of
the oligomers (see Scheme 3.8). For the phosgenation, BPA is rst dissolved in an

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

...

...

...

O
C Cl

O
C Cl

+ NaO

O
C Cl

Scheme 3.8.

...

Na

4 NaOH

...

...

...

O
C

...

+ NaCl

+ NaCl

Na + NaCl + Na2CO3 + H2O

Formation of polycarbonate by interfacial polycondensation.

aqueous alkaline solution as sodium bisphenolate, and phosgene is dissolved in a


solvent of chlorinated hydrocarbons (such as dichloromethane and monochlorobenzene) which also dissolves polycarbonate. The reaction is started by dispersing
the two phases. Alternatively, liquidgas phosgene (boiling point 4 C) is fed into a
slurry of BPA in the presence of an organic solvent. At high BPA concentrations a
fourth solid phase may be present [172]. Part of the phosgene is hydrolyzed with
NaOH to NaCl and Na2 CO3 and an excess of phosgene (1020 mol%) is required
to compensate for hydrolysis and provide an excess of chloroformate end groups
for the following reaction step. Reaction temperatures are between 20 and 50 C
and the pH is kept between 9 and 13 by the addition of NaOH.
In the polycondensation step, a monofunctional phenol (such as 35 mol% phenol, p-tert-butylphenol, p-cumylphenol) is added as a chain terminator to control
the molecular weight of the nal polycarbonate. Reaction partners are now end
groups (chloroformate and phenolic aOH; see above) and reaction rates decrease.
The nal polycondensation stages are catalyzed by tertiary amines. The amines react with the chloroformate end groups to form intermediate quaternary acylium
salts which then react with phenolate to form carbonate and OH ions, hydrolyzing the chloroformate end groups, or to form a urethane in a side reaction [164].
Detailed mechanistic studies of the catalyst reaction were performed by Aquino et
al. [173] and Kosky et al. [174].
Numerous variations of the interfacial process have been published. The reactions can be carried out in batch in stirred tank reactors or continuously in series
of CSTRs and tubular reactors. Intensive mixing with dispersion and redispersion
is required throughout the reaction stages. After the reaction is complete, the brine
phase is separated and the polymer solution washed to remove residual amine and
base. Several processes for devolatilization are in use, including solventless precipitation, steam precipitation, spray drying, falling-strand devolatilization, and vacuum extrusion in devolatilizing extruders.
Phosgenation is generally mass transfer-limited [175, 176] and its rate depends
on mixing as well as on pH and the volume ratio of the organic and aqueous
phases. Although the polycondensation reaction of end groups is slower, both rates
still show the same dependencies due to the interfacial nature of the reaction. The
following phenomena contribute to the reaction process:

95

96

3 Polycondensation








Dispersion of the two phases. Rates always depend on mixing. Eective kinetic
rate constants can be formulated as a function of energy dissipation or interfacial
area.
The type of emulsion. Both types of emulsions, oil in water (o/w) as well as water
in oil (w/o), can be found.
The partition of phenols between the phases and its pH dependence [177]. Silva
and Kosky [178] studied the reaction of hydrolysis taking into account the dierent phases and the partitioning of BPA between them. Monofunctional phenols
with better solubility in the organic phase show a better eciency as chain terminators.
Mass transfer to and across the boundaries.
Intrinsic (kinetic) reaction rates.

Due to the low reaction temperature and the use of chain terminator, the molecular weight distribution in interfacial synthesis is kinetically controlled and may be
far from thermodynamic equilibrium. In two parametric studies Mills [179] and
Munjal [180] have tried to model the full molecular weight distribution of polycarbonate. Varying the ratio of mass transfer/kinetic rates, they show how mass transfer limitations can lead to a higher polydispersity or a higher oligomer content.
Melt Transesterication
The melt process is based on the transesterication of diphenylcarbonate (DPC)
and BPA (see Scheme 3.9).
3.3.2.3

O
n HO

OH + n

OCO

O
O

OC

+ 2n

OH

n
Scheme 3.9.

Formation of bisphenol A polycarbonate by transesterication.

The melt process requires no solvent and polycarbonate is produced directly


without the need for cleaning, drying, and devolatilization. The only by-product,
phenol, is removed and can be recycled to the production of DPC or BPA. The process, however, requires high temperatures (190320 C) so that the polymer remains molten and the viscosity can still be handled. With improved quality of the
starting materials and improved high-viscosity reactors these temperatures no longer aect polycarbonate quality and most grades can now be produced via the melt
process. The transesterication is a reversible reaction with an equilibrium constant close to unity, so that the by-product phenol has to be removed for the reaction to proceed. Pressures below 0.1 hPa may have to be applied for the nal stage.

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

Small amounts of basic catalyst (< 0.01 mol% of alkyl-ammonium, or


phosphonium-salts) are mixed together with the DPC and BPA and the reaction
is started at the lower temperature. Conversion is driven by the removal of phenol
and the pressure is successively reduced while the temperature is increased. Simple reactors such as CSTRs, tubular reactors or falling-lm evaporators can be used
for the rst stages. Viscosity increases dramatically from 5 mPa s up to 1000 Pa s
as conversion increases and special reactors are needed for dealing with the high
viscosity at high conversions [149151].
The melt process depends on the reaction rates, the thermodynamic phase equilibrium, and mass transfer between the phases. Detailed mechanistic studies of the
Li-catalyzed melt process have been published by Choi et al. [152], and of the solubility of DPC and phenol in polycarbonate by Webb [153]. The liquidgas equilibrium has to take into account at least two components: phenol and DPC.
For a semi-batch operation for the rst stages, optimal variations of pressure and
temperature can be calculated based on the above relationships plus the assumption of phase equilibrium, or on a simple relationship for the mass transfer of
each volatile component Yi (Eq. (55), with the mass transfer rates per unit volume
Ji of component Yi , mass transfer coecient of component i kfi , interface area per
unit volume a v , and equilibrium concentration Yi   at the interface).
Ji kfi a v Yi   Yi  

55

Mass transfer coecients may be obtained by tting to process data. Including


DPC loss, production capacity (reaction time), and unwanted side products in a
cost function, the optimization leads to a balancing of mass transfer and reaction
rate. This means that an optimal process is neither entirely mass-transfer nor kinetically controlled. To avoid side reactions that impair product quality, the lowest
temperature that kinetics and mass transfer allow is chosen. The results of the
semi-batch optimization can be transferred to the design of a staged, continuous
process [154].
The balancing of reaction versus mass transfer rate can similarly be applied for
the last stages. The relative DPC loss compared to phenol removal is quite high for
these stages. A high fraction of phenol end groups compared to OH end groups is
desirable for product quality. Therefore, excess DPC has to be used at the beginning of the reaction. Unfortunately, a high fraction of phenol end groups reduces
the concentration of one reaction partner and hence reaction rates [146].
Mass transfer and hence the speed with which phenol can be removed are reduced with increasing viscosity. Reactors are needed that provide a high rate of
surface renewal. These may be wiped-lm evaporators, single- or twin-screw extruders, reactors of the rotating disk type or falling-strand evaporators [145, 149,
150]. Whereas the rst three reactor types create surface actively, in falling-strand
evaporators the melt is simply pumped through small holes. High surface renewal
rates are achieved by small holes, but also by shear thinning of the falling strands
[59]. The eect of shear thinning lms can also be achieved in rotating disk reactors with disks that contain holes. Apart from surface renewal, mass transfer is de-

97

98

3 Polycondensation

termined by diusion. Measurement of diusion coecients is dicult because of


the parallel reaction. An alternative is the determination of diusion constants using molecular dynamics simulations [148].
3.3.3

Polyamides
Introduction
Since their discovery by Carothers [181], aliphatic polyamides such as nylon-6,6
and nylon-6 are important textile bers and plastics. Similar polyamides produced
by melt reaction of aliphatic diacids diamines, or by hydrolytic polymerization of
lactams, have some interest as engineering plastics, and will also be discussed in
this section.
Aliphatic, low molecular weight, branched polyamides of dimer fatty acids with
di- and triethylenediamine are among the most widely used curing agents for
epoxide resins. The chemistry of their formation is similar to that observed for
the aforementioned crystalline linear polyamides.
Aromatic polyamides are specialty products [182], used for high-performance bers and composites, which are produced by solution or interfacial processes from
acid chlorides and amines.
3.3.3.1

Kinetic Modeling
The only published kinetic data on nylon-6,6 reaction are due to Ogata [183, 184],
and there is in general a great scarcity of information on the amide acid reaction.
Much more data are available on nylon-6 formation, such as in Refs. 185187.
Because of the obvious identity in average chemical group composition of both
polymers, it should be possible to reconcile both kinetic laws [188]. However,
nylon-6,6 data have been obtained at high water concentrations and relatively low
temperatures, and data on nylon-6 are in the opposite situation. Degradation
reactions of nylon-6,6 through adipic acid chain ends (see Section 3.3.3.3) complicate the interpretation of kinetic data at higher temperatures. Schaer, McAuley
et al. [189] have recently obtained experimental data on the nylon-6,12 system,
which does not present these problems, and these kinetics are now much better
understood.
Apparent equilibrium and kinetic constants in these systems are seen to depend
on water concentration. It obviously changes the activity coecients of functional
groups, but no thermodynamic model has ever been used to completely describe
the mixture. The activity of water can be directly measured from knowledge of its
vapor pressure, and it has been claimed that a correlation based upon a Flory
Huggins model can predict it [190], but no model exists for taking into account
the group interactions. Some interesting ideas can be found in Ref. 191, but no
actual thermodynamic model has been developed, concentrations of hypothetical
species having been used throughout that paper.
The crux of the treatment by Schaer et al. [189] lies in the empirical correlation
3.3.3.2

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

expressed by Eq. (56), where bA and mA are assumed to be constant parameters;


activity coecients are based on mole fractions.
gCOOH gNH2
bA mA H2 O
gCONH

56

As the overall composition of the system may be described by two variables, such
as [H2 O] and [COOH], a dependence on [COOH] might be added in Eq. (56).
However, this is not needed, as no eect of the mole ratio [COOH]/[NH2 ] on the
apparent equilibrium constant has ever been detected. Insertion of the above relationship into the mass action law provides a relationship between apparent equilibrium constant K a and true thermodynamic constant K 0 [Eq. (57)].
K a K 0 gH2 O bA mA H2 O

57

It is seen that parameter bA is absorbed by the unknown thermodynamic constant,


and only the ratio g A mA /bA can actually be found from experimental data. The
correlations found for the activity coecient of water are given in Eqs. (58).


3613
Nylon 6,12
gH2 O exp 9:624 
T
gH2 O



2258
Nylon 6,6
exp 6:390 
T

58

Choosing a reference temperature T0 549 K, Eq. (57) is rewritten as Eq. (59).

K a K a0

K a0




1 g A H2 O
DH 1
1

exp 
gH2 O /gH2 O T0
R T T0



bA
DH DS
exp 

RT0
R
gH2 O T0

59

Parameters describing equilibrium (DH; K a0 , and g A ) have been tted simultaneously with a mass transfer time constant for water k m, appropriate to their experimental set-up, and activation energy Ec and pre-exponential factors kc0 or ku0 describing forward reaction through a third- or second-order rate law:

R CONH
R CONH






Ec 1
1
H2 OCONH

kc0 exp 
COOH NH2 COOH 
Ka
R T T0




Ec 1
1
H2 OCONH

NH2 COOH 
60
ku0 exp 
Ka
R T T0

99

100

3 Polycondensation
Tab. 3.2.

Equilibrium and rate parameters for nylon formation.

Parameter

Units

Estimate

95% condence interval

DH
K a0
gA
Ec
kc0
km

kcal mol1

g mmol1
kcal mol1
g 2 mmol2 h1
h1

1.82
63.1
2:03  102
22.6
3:19  104
24.3

G1.42
G6.2
G0:45  102
G7.7
G0:71  104
G15.4

The optimum values of parameters for the third-order model are shown in Table
3.2. Their approximate correlation matrix can be found in the same reference. It
shows that parameters describing equilibrium are highly correlated with g A , and
the pre-exponential factor is highly correlated with k m . Further, there is little
change in parameters for the second-order model, which yields ku0 2:64  10 7
mg mol1 h1 and has a similar sum of weighed squared residuals. Thus, it is not
yet possible to determine the reaction order without performing experiments with
excess of diamine or diacid, which have not yet been reported at the time of writing. The authors state the parameters thus obtained for nylon-6,12 should hold for
the other aliphatic polyamides, just correcting the equilibrium constant, which is
lower by a factor of 0.4 to 0.5 in nylon-6,12 relative to nylon-6,6.
There are several studies concluding that the apparent order of reaction changes
from two to three as conversion grows. The reason might be a nonideality eect
similar to the one observed in esterications.
Miller [192] has carried out an experimental study on aminolysis and acidolysis
reactions using carefully dried model compounds. As in esterications, acidolysis
is slower and is explained by a mechanism involving the formation of intermediate
anhydrides. Its activation energy is 27 kcal mol1 , whereas aminolysis has the
much smaller activation energy of 13 kcal mol1 . The rate of aminolysis was
shown to be rst order in carboxylic acid.
These results are valuable not only for dealing with block polymers, but also in
kinetic modeling, particularly with cyclic lactams: a narrow CLD will not occur because of the reorganization brought about by aminolysis.
Hydrolysis of caprolactam is autocatalytic. Mallon and Ray [191] have suggested
that its initial rate is determined by the presence of impurities.
The same authors have also remarked that the rate constant of addition of caprolactam to amine end groups is about what would be expected for an aminolysis
reaction.
It should also be possible to predict the concentrations of higher cyclic
oligomers, but the only usable data concern the equilibrium concentrations, and
experimental conrmation has not yet been possible [191].
Nonoxidative Thermal Degradation Reactions
The main degradation reaction of nylon-6 is decarboxylation through interaction
of a carboxyl end group and caprolactam or an amide in the polymer chain (see
3.3.3.3

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

Scheme 3.10) [193, 194]. A slow deamination reaction has also been shown to
occur.
X

HO C N
OH
O C

CH2

CH2

X
CH2 k2

H2C

CH2 CH2
Scheme 3.10.

O C

- H2 O

CH2

H2C

k1

CH2 - CO
2
CH2

C
H2C
H2C

CH2
CH2
CH2

Nonoxidative thermal degradation of nylon-6.

Nylon-6,6 also degrades in the absence of oxygen, to a much greater extent than
nylon-6, and it eventually gels, as explained by the simplied mechanism in
Scheme 3.11 [195, 196].
XNHCO(CH2)4COOH
k1
O

NH Y
O

O
C
X NH

k2

CH2

CH2

k3

- CO2

Scheme 3.11.

X
N

k4
+ 2 NH2

+ NH2

XNH

CH2 CH2
X

- H2O

+ 2 NH3

Nonoxidative thermal degradation of nylon-6,6.

Cyclopentanone units are created, with a decrease in molecular weight, either


from carboxyl end groups or by intrachain reaction. Losses of CO2 and NH3 lead
to an imbalance of end groups, a nuisance for dyeing, and also to crosslinking.
Process Modeling
Recent progress in kinetic and reactor modeling make it possible to assist the reactor design and process operations with unprecedented exactness. A recent analysis
of the nylon-6,6 process [138] looked for improvements based on expansion of the
solid-state polymerization, but the gain was minor compared to what happened
with PET. The reason is the much reduced sensitivity of polyamides to by-product
removal as compared to polyesters, since the equilibrium constant of the former is
much greater.
Since the early 1970s, many researchers have modeled nylon-6 processes [197],
as reviewed by Kumar and Gupta [198]. There is an interesting optimization problem inherent to this process, which consists in adding just as much water as is
needed to start polymerization, and to get rid of it in the later stages. Because of
3.3.3.4

101

102

3 Polycondensation

the autocatalytic nature of the caprolactam hydrolysis, back-mixing increases conversion.


A simple and widely used reactor is the VK column (simplied continuous column), essentially a vertical tube at atmospheric pressure [193, 199], stirred by the
boiling action of water leaving the reactor mixture in the top zone.
Extensive pilot-plant tests carried by Jacobs and Schweigman [199], and further
data from industrial plant, have lead to a simple model of the VK column, consisting in one or two CSTRs in series, followed by a plug-ow reactor.
Other designs [200] have improved performance by preventing water evaporation at the top of the column through the use of above-atmospheric pressure.
The bottom one-third of the columns has a homogenizing function, not only
physical but also chemical, through the aminolysis reaction [201].
Vacuum stripping with a low residence time is used to eliminate most of the
large amount of caprolactam which remains because of the chemical equilibrium
of the back-biting reaction. An alternative is a hot-water extraction step, which will
also extract higher cyclic oligomers.
3.3.4

Polymerizations with Formaldehyde: Amino Resins (Urea and Melamine) and


Phenolics
Formaldehyde Solutions in Water
Formaldehyde is a gas at room temperature. It may be sold as a low molecular
weight, solid polymer (paraformaldehyde), and more conveniently as 37% or 55%
water solutions, which usually contain some methanol. Under such conditions,
nearly all the formaldehyde is transformed into methanediol and higher oligomers
(see Scheme 3.12), usually end-capped by methanol, in order to reduce the average
molecular weight and prevent precipitation of paraformaldehyde.
3.3.4.1

HCHO + H2O
(CH2O)xOH + HOCH2OH
HCHO + CH3OH
(CH2O)xOH+ HOCH2OCH3
Scheme 3.12.

HOCH2OH
(CH2O)x+1OH + H2O
HOCH2OCH3
(CH2O)x+1OCH3 + CH3OH

Formaldehyde/water/methanol equilibria.

These reactions are not very fast at room temperature: characteristic reaction
times are of the order of minutes.
The various equilibrium constants have been measured using NMR [202] and a
model describing the vaporliquid equilibrium in that system has been developed.
Amino Resins
Reaction between a water solution of formaldehyde with urea, melamine, and similar molecules (such as acrylamide) leads to hydroxymethylation of the nitrogens
3.3.4.2

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

[Eq. (b)] and further condensations produce the so-called amino resins [Eq. (c)], of
which 80% are based on urea [203], the rest being nearly all produced from melamine (1).
XaNH2 HCHO ! XaNHaCH2 OH

XaNHaCH2 OH YaNH2 ! XaNHaCH2 Y H2 O

NH2
N
H2N

N
N
NH2

1
Scheme 3.13.

Melamine.

Since melamine is made from urea and ammonia, it is more expensive. Melamine resins are therefore chosen when one can get an appreciable benet from
their better hydrolytic or thermal resistance.
Ureaformaldehyde (UF) resins are mainly used as adhesives for wood. Laminated sheets (tables and counter tops) are a major application for melamine resins,
which stay in the outer decorative surface. Molding compounds, their rst big application, is still a major market, taking advantage of their extreme hardness and
heat resistance. Coatings, textile nishing, paper additives, leather tanning and
foundry binders, for which methanol- or butanol-etheried resins are usually employed, are important markets discussed in Ref. 203.
A major problem with the use of UF resins is their formaldehyde emission due
to hydrolysis. Formation of melamine resins is much less reversible and therefore
food contact with them is allowed.
Besides earlier classic data on the kinetics of reactions between urea, formaldehyde, and UF oligomers by de Jong and de Jonge [204206], only experiments by
Price et al. [207] at higher temperatures in a sealed reactor are of immediate use to
establish a kinetic model of the chemical system. Kumar and Sood [208] have proposed an FSSE model for the early stage of this polycondensation. A modied version of that model introduces the groups presented in Scheme 3.14, where their
ve urea monads U0 . . . U4 have been kept but three formaldehyde monads have
been used instead of two. Formation of tetrasubstituted urea is known to be negligible.
Both de Jong and de Jonge, and Price et al., have considered that hydrolysis
reactions are unimolecular. Kumar and Sood [208] have considered it could be bimolecular, which seems to be reasonable. Available experimental data could not decide for any of the alternatives, since the water concentration was always the same;
this matter needs to be solved, because higher initial concentrations of formalde-

103

104

3 Polycondensation

U0 =

O
C

H2N

O
C

U3=
H2N
F0 =
H

O
C

NH2

U1 =

U4 =
N

H2N

O
C

U2 =

NH-

-HN

O
C
NH-

O
C
-HN

F2 = -CH2-

F1 = -CH2OH
H

Scheme 3.14.

Monads in the FSSE model of urea/formaldehyde polycondensation.

hyde are often used nowadays. Chemical transformations according to this new
model are shown in Scheme 3.15.

U 0 + F0

k1

U 1 + F1 + W

k6

U 0 + F1

h2

U 1 + F0

U + F1 + W

2
k

U 1 + F1

h1

U + F2 + W

2
k
h2

U 1 + F0

U 3 + F1 + W

U 1 + F1

h1

U 2 + F0

k4

h1

Scheme 3.15.

U 3 + F2 + W

U 4 + F1 + W

U 2 + F1

h1

h2

U + F2 + W

4
k
h2

k5

U 3 + F0

U 1 + F2 + W

h1

k10

U 4 + F1 + W

U 3 + F1

U 4 + F2 + W

h2

Kinetic scheme of FSSE model of urea/formaldehyde polycondensation.

A possible simplication consists in distinguishing only rate constants of forward reactions according to the number of hydrogens involved, and therefore
k1 2k2 4k5 and k3 k4 , k6 2k7 4k10 and k8 k9 , reducing the number of
unknown parameters.
Since the only information in the experimental data of Price et al. [207] is formaldehyde concentration versus time, it is not possible to estimate rate constants k6
to k10 from them. Although only at low temperatures, rate constants k1 ; k3 , and kh1
(this one measured from the rate of formation/hydrolysis of both monomethylol
urea and dimethylolurea) are nevertheless available from other sources, such as
Ref. 209. A crucial check of the FSSE hypothesis is the equality of the rst-order
hydrolysis constants of methylol groups in mono- and dimethylolurea: the rate constants per mole of the chemical substances should be double for dimethylolurea.
The value of this ratio is 1.68, standard deviation 0.42, for 15 values reported by
Landqvist with dierent buers (pH 6, 7, 9.2, 10) at temperatures 20, 30 and 40 C.

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

However, that ratio is 6.9 according to de Jong and de Jonge; the activation energy
of the hydrolysis is the same (20 kcal mol1 ), though, according to both research
studies.
The equilibrium constants of the rst and second hydroxymethylations of urea
are, respectively, 990 and 253 at 35 C, and there is a decrease of about 3 in the forward rate constants of the successive substitutions. Interestingly, the rate constants for the reaction of methylenediurea with formaldehyde or monomethylolurea are identical, respectively, to those observed for urea formaldehyde and
urea monomethylolurea [210, 211].
So, there seems to be enough evidence to take FSSEs into account for urea, but
unfortunately it seems there might be no such thing as a single aCH2 OH group,
and SSSEs should be needed for fully describing this chemistry.
For simplicity, we will keep using the above model in the discussion.
Rate constants are known to depend on pH (although not much between pH 4
and 9); there is catalysis by OH and H , so these constants should be written as
in Eq. (61) [204].
ki ki0 kiOH bOH c kiH bH c

61

Rate constants k6 to k10 in this scheme can be estimated from data of reactions in
acid media between urea, mono- and dimethylolurea [206]. In the same work, reaction between methylols was found negligible (the temperature was at most
50 C). For these reactions, the terms ki0 ; kiOH can be neglected; the reactions are
very slow at pH > 4.
More recent work has concentrated on analysis supported by quantitative 13 C
NMR [212216] and size exclusion chromatography [217] has completed this view
of the chemistry. At high temperatures and alkaline pH, methylol groups form
methylol ether bridges and uron rings 2 (Scheme 3.16).

HOCH2N

N
HOCH2

O
C
O
H

Scheme 3.16.

O
C

N
CH2

N
CH2

O
C
NH-CH2OCH2N
O
C
O

N
CH2

O
C

+ H2O

+ H2O

2
Reactions at alkaline pH in urea/formaldehyde polycondensation.

The preparation and possible industrial uses of uron UF resins may be found in
Ref. 218. NMR shows that these intra- or intermolecular ether bonds are destroyed
with liberation of formaldehyde at acid pH.

105

106

3 Polycondensation

Another question, that should not be overlooked, is the incomplete solubility of


the polymer in water. Except at low conversions, the reaction medium resembles a
colloidal dispersion [219]. Gelation may be physical, before or instead of being
chemical [220].
Amino resins are nearly always made in batch processes, consisting of thermostated reaction kettles connected to a condenser. The current method of synthesis
has three stages [221]:


synthesis of methylolated oligomers at pH 8 to 8.5;


acid condensation at pH 4 to 5;
 addition of urea to decrease the nal stoichiometric ratio to 1 to 1.3.


The goal is to reduce formaldehyde emissions [222], while keeping the properties
of products (such as wood panels) at an acceptable level. Since the formaldehyde/
urea molar ratio had to be decreased, the process has also become more dicult to
control.
Modeling of the process has increased its potential importance in this context,
but the diculties of putting it into practice are considerable, because of the daunting complexity of the chemistry. Notice that it should be integrated with the modeling of the cure stage (a complex combination of heat, mass, and mechanical
modeling, in the case of wood panel manufacture). Cure is performed with ammonium chloride as catalyst, which also acts as a formaldehyde scavenger. Its chemistry is not fully understood, because of the much higher temperatures than in resin
synthesis, which lead possibly to ladder structures.
Melamine resins have a similar chemistry, the main dierence being the reduced importance of hydrolysis reactions. They are prepared using two stages, alkaline addition of formaldehyde, and acid polycondensation.
The initial stage of the melamine/formaldehyde reaction has been studied by
Nastke et al. [223], who succeeded in providing evidence not only of hydroxymethylation, but also of the formation of methylene and methylene ether bridges using
polarography. The functionality of melamine is six, with a negative substitution effect of about 40% [224, 225].
As with UF, formaldehyde addition is acid- and base-catalyzed (sensitive to pH),
and equilibrium constants are 100 to 200. Methylene bridges are also formed only
at acid pH. Direct analysis of methylene ether bridges has also been performed by
NMR [226].
A simplied model (no reaction reversibility) of melamineformaldehyde formation based on Tomitas kinetic scheme [225] has been presented [227] and afterwards extended to reaction in a CSTR [228], also considering reaction reversibility.
There is no experimental validation, but it is noteworthy for the use of a program
to calculate the CLD of a nonlinear reversible polycondensation in order to overcome the astronomical number of reaction possibilities in the rates of formation
of individual oligomers.

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

Phenolic Resins
Two subclasses have to be distinguished [229]:
3.3.4.3

resols, which are highly branched, low molecular weight (1501500) polymers
with a formaldehyde/phenol stoichiometric ratio between 1.2 to 3, formed at alkaline pH;
 novolacs, made at acid pH, with a formaldehyde/phenol stoichiometric ratio between 0.5 and 0.8, which have a dierent and much less branched structure than
resols. They are low molecular weight (5005000) thermoplastics, further crosslinked with hexamethylenetetramine.
Phenolic resins are mainly used as wood adhesives, laminates, molded parts, insulating varnishes, abrasives, and rigid foams.
Novolacs can be made using either strong acid catalysts (sulfuric acid is preferred) or at pH 4 to 7 using carboxylates of divalent metals (such as Zn, Mn,
Mg). These catalysts complex phenol and methanediol and lead to formation of omethylolphenol in a rst step. Subsequent addition steps may also be orthodirected (Scheme 3.17), or more randomly distributed (in the case of Zn).
H

M2+
OH
CH2
OH

OH

OH
- M2+

CH2OH

- H2 O

- M2+

OH
CH2

...

- H2 O
+

OH

Formation of ortho-directed methylene bridges.

Scheme 3.17.

Novolacs prepared with acid catalysts have a more random structure. The
branching density is low because nonterminal rings are less reactive. This is
caused by molecular coiling, which is especially important in high ortho-novolacs.
Phenol groups tend to associate through hydrogen bonds and change the molecular conformation (Scheme 3.18). Nonterminal units are often assumed to stay

CH2
O
O

H
O

H
H

CH2

Scheme 3.18.

CH2
H O
H
H O

CH2

CH2

Hypothetical intramolecular hydrogen bonds in novolac resins.

107

108

3 Polycondensation

preferentially inside the molecular coils and decrease their reactivity because of
this.
Mathematical models describing formation of novolacs both in batch and continuous reactors have been developed by Frontini et al. [230] and Kumar et al. [231].
They consider the existence of at most one methylol group per molecule, and lump
together all isomers with the same unit counts. A Monte Carlo method [232] can
also be used in order to obtain a more detailed description at molecular level.
The initial addition of formaldehyde to phenol in alkaline media could for the
rst time be successfully described, thanks to Zavitsas and collaborators [233]. Resol formation in further reactions is a complex process, owing to the several dierent aromatic reaction sites and substitution eects [234]; a total of 19 can be distinguished [235, 236]. Concentrations of fragments have been computed, assuming
irreversible reactions. Number-average and weight-average molecular weights have
been predicted using the recursive approach. Experimental determination of the
necessary structural and kinetic parameters is a huge task, which requires extensive use of 13 C NMR and synthesis of model compounds. The research information [237, 238] allows modeling of these reacting systems to be elaborated with
better chemical support. Fairly good agreement of model and experimentally measured functional group concentrations in resol formation at various stoichiometric
ratios has been claimed [239] and it is expected that a trustworthy quantitative description of these systems may eventually be achieved. Validation of these predictions is plagued by experimental diculties, and has mainly been carried out
through measurement of individual oligomer and functional group concentrations.
Reaction is exothermal (DH 80 kJ mol1 ). Heat of reaction is removed using
water reux, sometimes with a small amount of inert solvent (aromatics are inert
only if they carry deactivating groups), and relatively small batch reactors ( 2 to 10
m 3 ) are usually preferred.
Resol reactors have been the subject of studies, such as Ref. 240, concerning operation in accident situations. In novolac production, formaldehyde can be fed continuously in order to increase safety.
3.3.5

Epoxy Resins

The three-membered cyclic ether group oxirane, a 1,2-epoxide, or an epoxy group


reacts with substances containing an active hydrogen group, such as amines, phenols, and carboxylic acids, or can be polymerized with anion or cation initiators,
therefore yielding a great variety of potentially useful polymers. Nearly all of them
are thermosetting, and used as coatings and adhesives. Their cure processes,
which should be considered in close connection with the method of producing
the nal material, will not be discussed in this section. Instead, a brief review
of processes to make the macromonomers containing epoxy groups, the so-called
epoxy resins, will be presented.
The most widely used epoxy resins are formed through the reaction between
epichlorohydrin (ECH; 3 in Scheme 3.19) and bisphenol A.

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

ClCH2CH CH2
O
3

CH3
C
CH3

CH2 CHCH2O
O
Scheme 3.19.

CH3
C
CH3

HO

-NaCl

OH

OCH2CHCH2O
n

CH3
C
CH3

OCH2CH CH2
O

Formation of epoxy resin by reaction of bisphenol A with epichlorohydrin.

The so-called tay process consists in the two-phase reaction of an alkaline solution of bisphenol A with ECH in stoichiometric excess [241]. The main reaction
as described above is accompanied by side reactions, such as hydrolysis and alcoholysis of chlorine and epoxides in ECH. These reactions create molecules with
functionality one or even zero, and must of course be minimized.
The kinetics has been studied by Enikolopyan et al. [242] and Gao [243], among
others. Branching formation occurs to a low extent and can usually be neglected;
the reaction can be described as a linear irreversible polycondensation AXA BYC,
with A aOH, B aCl, and C epoxide (ECH and oligomers have dierent
reactivities).
The similar epoxidation of novolacs with ECH has been additionally studied by
Oyanguren and Williams [244]. In this system, intramolecular ring formation has
been measured.
The so-called advancement process consists in the melt reaction of bisphenol
A (or a similar monomer) with a bifunctional epoxy resin in the presence of a catalyst, with the goal of producing a higher molecular weight, bifunctional, epoxy
resin. This process leads to branching, due to the reaction of the pendent hydroxyl
group with epoxide, and eventually gelation occurs. Its kinetics has recently been
studied by Smith and Ishida [276]. The activation energy of the branching reaction
was found to be higher (20 as compared to 18 kcal mol1 ) than that of chain extension, and both constants have been determined both for the catalyzed and noncatalyzed reaction.
3.3.6

Polyurethanes and Polyureas

Urethane polymers were discovered by Baeyer in 1937 [246, 247], using the addition of alcohols to isocyanates leading to carbamates (or urethanes), 4 in Scheme
3.20.

R NCO

+ HO

R'

O
C O R'
H

Scheme 3.20.

Addition of alcohols to isocyanates.

109

110

3 Polycondensation

The analogous, much faster, reaction with primary amines produces Nsubstituted ureas 5 (Scheme 3.21).

R NCO

+ H2N

R'

O
C NH R'

H
Scheme 3.21.

Addition of primary amines to isocyanates.

Reaction with water produces an amine and carbon dioxide through an unstable
carbamic acid intermediate (Scheme 3.22).

R NCO

+ H2O

O
C O H

H
R

Scheme 3.22.

+ CO2

H
Reaction of water with isocyanates.

As the amine reacts again with isocyanate, this reaction will lead to branching, as
will consecutive reactions with carbamates, leading to allophanates 6 (Scheme
3.23) and with ureas, leading to biurets 7 (Scheme 3.24).

R NCO + R

O
C O R'

C N
O

Scheme 3.23.

Reaction of urethanes with isocyanates leading to allophanates.

R NCO + R

O
C NH R'

O
C NH R'
C N

O
Scheme 3.24.

O
C O R'

Reaction of ureas with isocyanates leading to biurets.

Trimerization of isocyanates, leading to the thermostable isocyanurate ring 8,


occurs with basic catalysts (multifunctional amines, carboxylates, alkoxides, and
so on) through allophanate intermediates [252254] (Scheme 3.25).
Isocyanate groups also react to form uretdiones 9. This is an equilibrium reaction, which is mainly important at high isocyanate concentration (Scheme 3.26).
Most urethane polymers are thermosets [247, 248]. They are mainly used in the
production of foams, taking advantage of the reaction of water and of the precipitation of insoluble ureas, which stabilize the foam even before the system

3.3 Polycondensation Processes in Detail

O
C O
C N

R'
R'

+ R NCO

O
C

O
O

C N
O

H
N
C
O

R
O

N
N
R

R
+ R' OH
O

8
Scheme 3.25.

Formation of isocyanurates.

O
C
2 R NCO

R N

N R
C
O

Scheme 3.26.

111

Formation of uretdiones.

gels chemically. Amine- or hydroxyethyl-capped branched polyols of molecular


weight of the order of a few thousands are preferred. They are most often starshaped poly(oxypropylene), in combination with shorter polyols such as glycerine,
additives such as surfactants and demolding agents, blowing agents, and water.
Rigid foams use more branched polyols than do exible foams.
Another important use is the fabrication of plastics by RIM (reaction injection
molding) (see Figure 3.11), which exploits the very fast reaction which can be

Fig. 3.11. Scheme for an RIM machine with a jet impingement


mix-head (on a very exaggerated scale), in its recirculation and
injection modes.

112

3 Polycondensation

achieved either with amines or with hydroxyls, in the presence of catalysts such as
dibutyltin carboxylates, tertiary amines, or a combination of the two [250]. The excellent book by Macosko [249] extensively covers this technology, which is particularly well adapted to the fabrication of big, at, molded parts, and also to complex
elastomeric objects (viscosity is very low during mold lling). The whole production cycle can take less than one minute from injection to demolding.
As with the other thermosets in this chapter, these processes will not be discussed in this section. We will nevertheless give a few hints of the reaction engineering of the production of polymers and macromonomers based on this chemistry; other relevant uses are adhesives, binders, coatings, thermoplastic elastomers,
and bers.
The catalysis of isocyanate reactions has been extensively studied because of
its critical importance in many of these processes. Noncatalyzed (or rather, selfcatalyzed) reactions may sometimes be fast enough in practice: isocyanate reactions with amines are so fast that only recent studies using stopped-ow methods
could lead to useful data [255, 256], metallic or tertiary amine catalysts being ineffective in this case.
As often happens with polymerization reactions, simple rate laws can seldom
describe the whole course of reaction because of catalysis or inhibition by the
urethane groups formed or by the initial reagents. Self-association of metallic catalysts, or their loose complexation by products or reagents, also prevents correlation
of rates of reaction by simple proportionality or even power-law relations. Catalysis
of isocyanate reaction with hydroxyls [250, 251] is by far the best understood.
It might be thought that modeling of polyurethane processes would be relatively
straightforward, given that reactions are mostly irreversible and the methods described in Section 3.4.4 should deal with them without diculties.
In reality, allophanate and biuret formation is reversible at temperatures above
130 C [252]. Formation of isocyanurates causes a reorganization of the CLD akin
to what happens in reversible polycondensations because of exchange reactions.
Many polyurethanes are block polymers prepared with a diisocyanate, a short
diol such as 1,4-butanediol or 1,6-hexanediol, or a diamine (the chain extender),
and a diol with molecular weight between 500 and 4000, based on a polyether,
polyester, polycarbonate, poly(butadiene) or other. Most often, the preparation is
performed in two steps: rstly, reaction of the longer polyol with the isocyanate,
then with the chain extender in the second stage.
An important and desirable feature of polyurethanes and polyureas is the phase
separation of the small isocyanate/chain extender blocks, which is possible provided the thermodynamics is favorable: this means a high enough concentration
and chain length of hard blocks. These hard blocks act as physical crosslinks
at a temperature lower than their melting point, and thermoplastic elastomers (including elastic bers) can therefore be obtained.
From the point of view of the prediction of structure, this brings about a complex
problem, which shares some characteristics with solid-state polycondensation, and
has been tackled through the use of Monte Carlo methods [257, 258, 259].
Reactors for these processes range from simple batch or continuous stirred tank

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

reactors for very low molecular weight or solvent-based processes, to tubular reactors with static mixers or extruders. Owing to the strong exothermicity of the main
reaction, cooling has to be used in order to prevent side reactions from becoming
too important.
Many processes at low temperature and in homogeneous phase can nevertheless
be analyzed through the methods described in Section 3.4.4, as they now stand.

3.4

Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions


3.4.1

Overview

Rate equations allowing the prediction of concentrations of reactive groups, including more complex molecular fragments (monads, dyads and so on) from mass balance equations are established in Section 3.4.2 for irreversible reactions or systems
with at most FSSEs if reversible reactions exist. Stoichiometric coecients are introduced in order to obtain a fairly general formalism, later exploited in Section
3.4.4.
Knowledge of the distributions of numbers of bonds connecting repeating units
makes it possible to describe molecular structure at chemical equilibrium. In Section 3.4.3, the main results concerning molecular weights and network properties
of chemical systems verifying FSSEs are presented, using the theory of branching
processes. The presence of rings is also allowed. The results of Section 3.4.2 are
useful in order to predict average numbers of bonds for each monad, needed for
predicting average molecular weights.
Irreversible polycondensations can be tackled quite easily using a general kinetic
approach developed in Section 3.4.4, allowing prediction of average molecular
weights before or after gelation, and even molecular weight distributions (lumping
together isomers with the same numbers of groups).
Prediction of molecular weight distributions for reversible, linear, alternating
polycondensation is discussed in Section 3.4.5. Mathematical diculties grow considerably in the presence of SSSEs. There seems to be no alternative to Monte
Carlo methods for dealing with reversible nonlinear polycondensations or even linear polycondensations where more than two kinds of bonds are present.
3.4.2

Description of Reactions in Polycondensations of Several Monomers with


Substitution Eects

The goal of this section is to present a general nomenclature of chemical entities


and reactions which provides a concise form for writing the rate equations and
mass balances of chemical species. The existence of substitution eects seriously
complicates the task, because the same molecular entity has to be labeled in a dif-

113

114

3 Polycondensation

ferent way, not because it has intrinsically changed, but because its neighbors have
reacted.
We introduce the following nomenclature for the species (monomer units or
functional groups) and vectors h; g; e storing their indices:
Xh i
A gi ; A gi
We i
Z iR
Zei ; Zei

monomer units, h i A 1 . . . NX
functional groups which react forming bond ZiR ; indices gi ; gi A
1 . . . NA
by-products, e i A 1 . . . NW
bonds, i A 1 . . . NR

half-bonds, e
i ; ei A 1 . . . NZ

The NA functional (or end) groups A i will be distinguished (even if chemically similar) according to the monomer unit Xh i where they are attached. h is yet another
vector of indices, with size NA .
NR reactions involving pairs of functional groups create connections between
monomer units, possibly (with the well-known exceptions of epoxides and isocyanate reactions) also forming by-products. A total number NW of by-products Wi
will be considered for the sake of generality. By-product We i is formed by the reaction between functional groups A gi and A gi creating the bond ZiR .
Vectors e; g and g have sizes NR . This denition allows for more than one possible kind of bond between two given monomer units, as happens for instance if a
carboxylic acid reacts with glycerol, which possesses distinguishable primary and
secondary hydroxyls.
In some of these NR reactions, such as in the case of self-condensations of silanols in silicone formation and of methylols in formaldehyde polymerizations, an
end group may react with itself. The number of such reactions in this subset will
be dened as NRs .
For each bond, it is useful to dene a positive sense in the direction of the unit
with higher or equal index, which will be coincident for the NRs reactions considered above. So, there is a total number of NZ 2NR  NRs kinds of directed bonds
Z i , incident on monomer units Xzi ; the set of monomer units and bonds are the
vertices and edges of a directed graph (or digraph). Vector z, of size NZ , therefore
contains the indices of the repeating units to which each directed bond points.
There is a one-to-one correspondence between directed bonds and half-bonds
hanging from the repeating units at each side.
The directed bonds associated with ZiR will be named Zei and Zei , using yet another pair of vectors of indices, e and e , of sizes NZ . Hence, the vectors z and h,
dening respectively their incident and adjacent monomer units, will be related
through hgi zei and hgi zei .
In order to avoid multiple levels of indexing in equations, the notation given by
Eqs. (62) (loosely inspired by indirect addressing of computer assembly languages)
will be used hereafter.
A gi 1 Ai

Zei 1 Zi

We i 1 Wi

Xh i 1 XiA

Xzi 1 XiZ

62

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

For the NR reactions which create new bonds from functional groups and also (very
often) a by-product, we will introduce apparent second-order rate constants of the
forward reaction (ki , i 1; NR ), as well as apparent rst-order rate constants of the
backward reactions (kiZ ), related to the former through the equilibrium ratios Ki
and the concentration of the corresponding by-product, if it exists, according to
Eq. (63).
kiZ

Wi 
ki
Ki

63

This may look rather articial, but it helps in situations such as the thermal decomposition of urethanes or ureas, which are rst-order reactions. By convention,
in such cases we will introduce a nil by-product W0 (assuming that the indices are
counted starting from one) with a constant unit concentration.
If the groups react independently, by denition there is no substitution eect. The
condensation reaction creating a bond (the same as two half-bonds) can be written
as Eq. (64).
ki

Ai Ai T Zi Zi Wi

64

kiZ

To account for rst-shell substitution eects (FSSEs), a more general expression


[Eq. (65)] can be written, using stoichiometric coecients n:
NW
NA
NZ
X
X
X
ninA ninA An
nW
ninZ ninZ Zn 0
in Wn
n1

n1

65

n1

ninA ; ninZ correspond, respectively, to functional groups An and oriented bonds Zn


coming out of the monomer unit in which stood Ai , and a similar convention is
used for ninA ; ninZ.
A
Z
Z
No FSSE means that, for every reaction i, nigA
 n 1, nie n 1, and,
igi
iei
i
i
moreover, all other stoichiometric coecients are nil. Likewise, it is useful to introduce the stoichiometric coecients of by-products, nW
in .
This trick only works with FSSEs. Higher-order substitution eects (see Sections
3.1.5 and 3.4.5) are much more dicult to describe.
In the absence of FSSEs, the exchange of bonds ZiR and ZjR , necessarily forming
the same by-product (e i ej ), can be described through Eqs. (66).
kijE




X  Ai X  Z j Z j X !
 X Zi Zi X A j X
E
kji

X Ai X

Z j Z j X

kijE

66


!
 X Zi Zi X
E

A j X

kji

In the presence of FSSEs, they would be written with an algebraic notation as in


Eqs. (67).

115

116

3 Polycondensation
NA
X

AE
AE
AE
nijn
nijn
njin
An

n1

NZ
X
ZE
ZE
ZE
nijn
nijn
nijn
Zn 0
n1

67
NA
X

NZ
X
AE
AE
AE
ZE
ZE
ZE
nijn
nijn
nijn
An
nijn
nijn
 nijn
Zn 0

n1

n1

AE ZE
Stoichiometric coecients nijn
; nijn
are the changes in numbers of functional
groups An and bonds Zn , respectively, connected to the root unit X  where either
AE ZE AE ZE
; nijn
; nijn
; nijn
are the changes in
Ai or Ai were attached, and nijn
numbers of functional groups An and bonds Zn , respectively, connected to the root
unit X where stood the living group A j or A j. The other stoichiometric coefAE ZE AE ZE
; nijn
; nijn
; nijn
are the changes in the numbers of groups
cients nijn
attached to root unit X  which gets connected to the unit where stood the attacking group, and they are nil if there are no substitution eects.
The above reactions modify the counts of functional groups of similar chemical
nature (for example, distinguishable kinds of amides/amines/carboxylic acids). If
there is only a single kind of bond, there is no net creation or destruction of functional groups or bonds, as shown by the cancellation of the stoichiometric coecients in Eq. (67), but a reshuing of pieces of the reacting molecules takes place.
Rates of production by chemical reaction of the various groups are obtained using Eqs. (68)(70).

R An

NR
X
ninA ninA ki Ai Ai   kiZ Zi 
i1

NR X
NR
X

EA
EA
EA
de ij kijE Ai Z j nijn
nijn
nijn

i1 ji1
EA
EA
EA
njin
njin

kjiE A j Zi njin

R Zn

68

NR
X
ninZ ninZ ki Ai Ai   kiZ Zi 
i1

NR X
NR
X

ZA
ZA
ZA
de ij kijE Ai Z j nijn
nijn
nijn

i1 ji1
ZA
ZA
ZA
njin
njin

kjiE A j Zi njin

RWn

NR
X

Z
k i nW
in Ai Ai   ki Zi 

69
70

i1

The reaction volume changes mostly because of by-product removal, and little because of density changes. The relative rate of change of reaction volume RV can be

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

estimated as the sum of products of the molar volume of by-products by their rate
of elimination by phase change.
The mass balances of the functional groups in a batch reactor can thus be written as Eqs. (71).
dAn 
RAn  RV An 
dt

71

dZn 
RZn  RV Zn 
dt
A convenient way of computing the concentrations of groups at chemical equilibrium consists in integrating the system of ODE [Eq. (71)] until close to steady
state.
3.4.3

Equilibrium Polycondensations with Several Monomers

Instead of the elegant but often error-prone Gordons notation, we will introduce a
more straightforward description, hopefully easier to translate into computer programs. The goal is to obtain a set of formulae for predicting average molecular
weights, molecular weight distributions, and other polymer properties, valid for generic chemical systems.
These computations assume there is some way of predicting how molecular
fragments (usually monads, unless higher-order substitution eects have to be
tackled) are mutually connected. More specically, it is necessary to know the distributions of the numbers of bonds connecting the fragments, for each kind of fragment. In fact, one may need only some of the moments of the aforementioned distributions for making a few calculations.
A kinetic method may be used for this prediction, but mainly as a means to
avoid solving equations derived from mass action laws for concentrations of fragments. This has been one of our motivations for presenting the formalism in Section 3.4.2.
Each directed bond Z i is supposed to start a pendent chain Vi xZ ; xA with
counts of end groups and directed bonds xA and xZ , respectively. Notice that the
molecular graphs have to be considered as digraphs, otherwise xZ would be meaningless: it would be impossible to know the counts of the monomer units according to their chemical nature.
All isomeric trees with the same counts of groups are lumped into the same
chemical species leading to vector count distributions with NZA NZ NA independent variables.
Vectors of dummy Laplace variables sA and sZ will be associated with the counts
of unreacted groups and directed bonds. Variables sA and sZ will be often ranged
together as subvectors of a vector s, of size NZA .

117

118

3 Polycondensation

Vector xX containing the counts of the monomer units can be obtained from xZ
through Eq. (72).
xX Z ZX t xZ

72

ZZX is a matrix containing the incidence vectors z dened by Eq. (73).


ZijZX

if j zi

if j 0 zi

73

The chemical system is further described through knowledge of the molar fractions of monomers or monomer units, yX i , (summing to 1) and of the molecular weights of monomer units, unreacted groups, and half-bonds, respectively
MX i ; MA i and MZ i . Hence, the molecular weight MVi xZ ; xA  of a tree Vi xZ ; xA
can be computed through Eq. (74).

MVi xZ ; xA 

NZ
NA
X
X
MX jZ MZ j xZ j
MA j xA j
j1

74

j1

X i xZ ; xA is, according to the concept introduced in Section 3.1.5, a monad with


vectors of group counts xZ and xA . Its concentration, normalized by the concentration of repeating units X i , can be thought of as a probability: the probability that a
certain repeating unit is attached to those counts of groups, as stated in Eq. (75).
PfX i is connected to xZ ; xA groupsg X i xZ ; xA /X i 

75

Let F X i sZ ; sA ; F A i sZ ; sA and F Z i sZ ; sA be the probability generating functions


(pgf ) of the counts of the dierent kinds of connecting and unreacted functional
groups directly linked to a unit X i , an unreacted group A i or a directed bond Z i
[Eq. (76)].
y
X

F J sZ ; sA



xZ1 0
y
X

y
X

y
X



xZN 0 xA1 0
Z

y
X
xAN 0
A

xZ

xAN

PfJ is connected to xZ ; xA groupsgsZ1 1    sAN A


A

xAN 0
A

J Xi; Ai; Zi

76

These pgf values are mutually related through Eqs. (77) and (78), in which 1N
means a vector with N components equal to 1.
Aj

F s

s1
Aj

qF X jA
q log sA j

qF X jA
q log sA j js1

jA
jA
s1
A j LA j s/lA j
NZA

77

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

F Z j s s1
Zj

qF X jZ
q log sZ j

qF X jZ
q log szj js1

jZ
jZ
s1
Z j LZ j s/lZ j

78

NZA

Notice the use of L with lower indexes for the derivatives of the pgf values with
respect to the logarithms of dummy Laplace parameters, as well as of l for their
moments, a useful convention which will be encountered often in the rest of this
chapter.
If a pgf relative to the count of monomer units is desired, for a vector of dummy
Laplace variables sX , it can be found by obtaining the pgf with respect to the counts
of directed bonds with Eq. (79).
sZ ZZX sX

79

The average numbers of bonds Z j ; lZX ij , and of unreacted functional groups A j ; lAX ij ,
attached to a monomer unit X i , will be often needed, and can be obtained using
Eqs. (80) and (81).
lZX ij
lAX ij

qF X i
q log sZ j js1

NZA

qF X i
q log sA j js1

NZA

80

81

The mass of polymer per mole of monomer units, MP , can therefore be computed
using Eq. (82).

MP

NX
X
i1

"
y X i MX i

NZ
X

lZX ij MZ j

j1

NA
X

#
lAX ij MA j

82

j1

For the classic self-polycondensation of XA f , with equal and independent groups


A; p, the conversion of A groups, is introduced in Eqs. (83).
F X 1  psA psZ  f
F Z F A 1  psA psZ  f 1
lZX f p

lAX f 1  p

83

MP MX f pMZ f 1  pMA
Expressions for the less trivial case XA f YBg C illustrated diagrammatically
in Figure 3.12, A reacting with B or C, B not reacting with C (such as adipic
acid glycerol, f g 2), with constant reactivity of end groups A; B, or C, are
presented in Table 3.3.

119

120

3 Polycondensation

Fig. 3.12.

Example of proposed notation: polycondensation XA2 YB2 C.

Tab. 3.3. Probability generating functions F describing polycondensation XA f YBg C and its
gelation condition.
"
#
"
#
1  pA sA pAB sZAB pAC sZAC  f
F XX
X
F
1  pB sB pB sZBA  g 1  pC sC pC sZCA 
F XY

3
F ZAB
6 ZAC 7
6F
7
FZ 6
7
4 F ZBA 5
F ZCA
2 AA 3
F
6 A 7
A
6
F 4 F B 7
5

Gelation condition

gpBg pACg g  1 pBg pABg pCg pABg

F AC

1 
6 1 
6
6
4 1 
1 
2
1 
6
4 1 
1 

3
pB sZBA  g1 1  pC sC pC sZCA 
7
pB sZBA  g
7
7
f 1
5
pAB sZAB pAC sZAC 
f 1
pAB sZAB pAC sZAC 
3
pA sA pAB sZAB pAC sZAC  f 1
7
pB sB pB sZBA  g1 1  pC sC pC sZCA  5
g
pB sB pB sZBA 
pB sB
pB sB
pA sA
pA sA

1
f 1

Group counts have multinomial distributions for these simple systems and can
be easily related to conversions of functional groups (which are the probabilities of
reaction).
The theory of branching processes leads to a system of NZ algebraic equations
[Eqs. (84)] for the pgf of pendent trees of the dierent kinds:
Vi sZ ; sA sZ i F Z i VsZ ; sA ; sA  i 1; . . . ; NZ

84

The vector v of the NZ probabilities of extinction (the fractions of nite pendent


chains) v V1NZA contains the solutions of system (84) for s 1NZA .
Gelation occurs when system (84) has a double root v 1NZA for s 1NZA, implying that its Jacobian becomes nil [Eq. (85)].
"

#
qF Z i



 I jLzZj i 1NZA   Ij 0

qnj

85

For the polycondensation of a single monomer, this leads to the well-known result
of Eq. (86).

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

pg

1
f 1

86

Prediction of the gel point for XA f YBg C is also presented in Table 3.3.
The pgf values of trees starting with a prescribed monomer unit X i , an unreacted
group A i , or a directed bond Z i , are obtained from the theory of branching processes through Eqs. (87) and (88).
GYi sZ ; sA sYi F Yi VsZ ; sA ; sA  Y Z; A

87

G X i sx ; sA sX i F X i VZZX sX ; sA ; sA 

88

The chain length or molecular weight distribution of polymer is usually described


primarily with the help of the molar concentration of species with x monomer
units, Px , in which x is the degree of polymerization. Since we are dealing with
several kinds of units, an overall degree of polymerization can be dened, which is
the sum of the degrees of polymerization corresponding to the various monomer
units (the components of vector xX ). Notice that vector xZ with the counts of directed bonds has more information about the molecular composition.
There is a basic diculty when trying to use Eqs. (87) and (88): they provide pgf
values of monomer units or groups, not directly molar concentrations of polymer
molecules, even as generating functions. These latter will have to be computed relative to the molar concentrations of the various groups or monomer units, and
thus will come multiplied also by the number of those groups in the distributions.
For instance, if there is only one kind of monomer unit and so just one kind of
directed bond, G X as computed by Eq. (88) will provide the generating function of
xPx /X  with respect to x; for an alternating polycondensation of two monomers,
G X 1 sZ1 ; sZ2 as computed by Eq. (88) will provide the generating function of
x1 Px1 ; x2 /X1  with respect to x1 and x2 .
Fractions of units and groups of the various kinds in nite molecules (in sol),
after gelation, ySX i ; ySZ i and ySA i , can be computed by replacing s 1NZA in the
above equations to give Eq. (89).
ySYi F Yi v; 1NA Y X; Z; A

89

Prediction of the elastic properties of networks using rubber elasticity theory is


based upon the knowledge of concentrations of elastically active network junctions
(EANJs) and chains (EANCs), respectively me and ne [260, 261]. EANJs are the intersection of at least three chains leading to the gel, whereas EANCs are the chains
linking EANJs (see Figure 3.13).
These concentrations can be easily predicted, given the probabilities of extinction
and the moments with respect to the numbers of pendent chains as previously dened. Dening xZy as the count of innite pendent chains and the correspondent
dummy Laplace variable as sZy , its pgf for the chains stemming out of a monomer
unit X i is F X i v sZy 1NZ  v; 1NA , and so me and ne can be computed using Eqs.
(90) and (91).

121

122

3 Polycondensation

Finite pendent chain

Infinite pendent
chain
EANJ
Junction

EANC
EANJ

Chain connecting to gel


Fig. 3.13.

Elastically active and inactive junctions and chains in a polymer network.

(
NX
NZ
X
X
me
X i  1  F X i v; 1NA 
nj 1  nj LZXji v; 1NA
j1

i1

)
NZ X
NZ
1X
Xi
nj nk 1  nj 1  nk LZ j Zk v; 1NA

2 j1 k1
ne

90

(
NX
NZ
X
1X
X i 
lZX ij  nj 1  nj LZXji v; 1NA 
2 i1
j1


NZ X
NZ
X

)
nj nk 1  nj 1 

nk LZXjiZk v; 1NA

91

j1 k1

For instance, assuming the so-called phantom network model, shear modulus
Ge would be predicted for gaussian chains to be given by Eq. (92).
Ge RTne  me

92

In the presence of gel, it is convenient to introduce the pgf of nite pendent chains,
named V^i sZ ; sA , and the pgf of counts of nite pendent chains connected to units
or groups, which can be found using Eqs. (93) and (94).

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

F^Yi sZ ; sA F Yi n1 s Z1 ; . . . ; nNZ sZNZ ; sA /ySYi F Yi v5sZ ; sA /ySYi


Y X; Z; A

93

^ sZ ; sA ; sA  i 1; NZ
V^i sZ ; sA sZ i F^Z i V

94

So, the various pgf values with respect to the dierent kinds of groups in the
^ X i sZ ; sA ; G
^Z i sZ ; sA ; G
^A i sZ ; sA , can be computed using
molecules of the sol, G
Eqs. (95).
^Yi sZ ; sA F^Yi bV
^ sZ ; sA ; sA c
G

Y X; Z; A

95

After computing the probabilities of extinction, the moments in Eq. (96) can be
evaluated.
l^YZij ...Zk LYZi j ...Zk v; 1NA /ySYi

Y Z; A

96

Pgf values of nite pendent chains with respect to molecular weight, for which the
dummy Laplace variable associated with molecular weight is sM , can be found from
Eq. (97) (notice the conventional use of a power of a scalar to a vector):
M

ZN
MZ M
V^Mi sM V^i sM 1 X1Z ; . . . ; sM Z

MX NZ Z

MA

MAN

; sM 1 ; . . . ; sM

M MX z

V^i sM z

MA
; sM

97

Prediction of average molecular weights is now possible by introducing GM sM ,


the pgf values of the mass fractions of the polymer molecules in the sol, wi , with
respect to their molecular weight Mi , dened below; the index i in the innite sum
sweeps all nite polymer molecules.
GM sM

y
X

Mi
sM
wi

NY
X

MY
MA
^ M sM ; sM
wYi sM i F^Yi V


98

Y X; Z; A i1

i1

The mass fractions of the units and groups in Eq. (98) above are relative to the
mass of the sol.
The weight fraction of the sol wS , relative to the overall mass of the polymer
computed by Eq. (82), is therefore given by Eqs. (99)(102).
wS

NX
X

y X i ySX i MX i

j1

i1

wX i

y X i ySX i MX i
MP wS
MZ i

wZ i

NZ
X

NX
X

l^ZX ij MZ j

NA
X

!,
l^AX ij MA j

MP

99

j1

100

X
y X j ySX j l^Z ji

j1

MP wS

101

123

124

3 Polycondensation

MA i

NX
X

X
y X j ySX i l^A ji

j1

wA i

102

MP wS

Before carrying out the evaluation of distributions and average molecular weights,
a special reasoning must be carried out in order to compute number-average molecular weight and degrees of polymerization. When it is taken into account that,
with the reaction of every pair of end groups in nite molecules, one polymer molecule is consumed, the number of moles of polymer molecules per mole of monomer units before gelation is given by Eq. (103).

yP 1 

NX
NZ
X
1X
yXi
lZX ij
2 i1
j1

103

After gelation, the more general expression [Eq. (104)] is needed.

yP

NX
X

y X i ySX i

i1

NZ
1X
1
l^X i
2 j1 Z j

!
104

The number-average molecular weight of the sol can thereafter be computed


through Eq. (105).
NX
X

Mn

y X i ySX i MX i

NZ
X

MZ i l^ZX ij

j1

i1
NX
X

y X i ySX i

i1

NA
X
j1

NZ
1X
1
l^X i
2 j1 Z j

!
MA i l^AX ij
105

An expression for the number-average degree of polymerization of the sol follows


from Eq. (105) by setting the molecular weights of monomer units equal to one
and the molecular weights of bonds and unreacted groups equal to zero [Eq. (106)].
NX
X

xn

y X i ySX i

i1
NX
X
i1

y X i ySX i

NZ
1X
l^X i
1
2 j1 Z j

106

The moments with respect to molecular weight lM ; lMM , and so on, can be now
obtained through dierentiation of Eq. (98) with respect to log sM and setting
sM 1. First of all, the systems of linear algebraic equations (107)(113) must be
solved.

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions


j

miZ  di  l^ZZ ij 1 MZ i MXiZ 


miA 

j
di

107

l^ZZ ij 1 l^ZAji MA i 

108

"
miZZ 

j
di

l^ZZ ij 1

2MZ i MXiZ

NZ
X

mZl l^ZZli

j
di

"

j
di

109

"
#
NA
NZ X
NA
X
X
Z i 1
Zi
Zi
Z
^
^
^
 lZ j 
MZ i MXXiZ
MAm lAk
m l MAm lZl Am

l^ZZ ij 1

NZ X
NA
X

110

l1 m 1

m1

miAA 

#
Z ^Z i
mZl mm
lZl Zm

l 1 m1

l 1

miZA 

NZ X
NZ
X

mlA MAm l^ZZliAm

l1 m1

NA X
NA
X

#
MAl MAm l^AZliAm

111

l1 m1

112

miMA  di  l^ZZ ij 1 MA2 i 

113

miMZX  di  l^ZZ ij 1 MXiZ MZ i 2 


j

Weight-average and z-average molecular weights are now obtained explicitly


through Eqs. (114) and (115).
qGM
Mw
q log sM jsM 1
"
#
NY
NZ
NA
X X
X
X
Y
Z
A ^Yi

w Yi M Yi
mj mj lZ j
MA j l^A ji

lM

Y X; Z; A i1

j1

114

j1

lMM Mw MZ

X
YX; Z; A

NY
X

"
w Yi

MY2i

j1

i1

2MYi

NZ
NA
X
X
mjZ mjA l^YZij
MA j l^YZij

j1

NZ X
NZ
X
mjZ mjA mkZ mkA l^YZij Zk
j1 k1

NZ
X
mjZZ 2mjZA mjAA mjMXZ mjMA l^YZij
j1

NZ X
NA
X
mjZ mjA MAk l^YZij Ak
j1 k1

NA X
NA
X
j1 k1

MA j MAk l^AYjiAk

NA
X

#)
MA2 j l^AYji

115

j1

Except for extremely simple polycondensations, formulae for predicting average


molecular weights are very cumbersome and numerical evaluation is a must.

125

126

3 Polycondensation

The weight-average and z-average degrees of polymerization, x w and x z , are


obtained in the same way as for number-average degrees of polymerization: the
molecular weights of the monomer units are set equal to one and the molecular
weights of bonds and unreacted groups are set equal to zero. For the polycondensation of a single monomer XA f , this leads to Eqs. (116) and (117).
xw

1 p2v  1
1  p1 v f  2

xz 1

116

2f pv f p 2 v f  11  p pv f 2
1  p 2pv1  p f  11  p pv f 2 
f  1 f  2 p 2 v 2

117

1  p 2pv1  p f  11  p pv f 2  2

The number-average degree of polymerization x n is obtained through a stoichiometric reasoning as previously discussed [Eq. (118)].
xn

1  p pv
1  p pv1  f /2

118

Values of average degrees of polymerization versus conversion of end groups p


shown for f 2 and f 3 in Figure 3.1 have been computed using the above
expressions.
Pgf values of the various distributions with respect to the counts of monomer
units, bonds, or unreacted functional groups can be obtained from Eq. (98) by setting equal to one the molecular weight of the species in question and to zero the
molecular weights of all the other species. Analytical inversion by computing derivatives with respect to dummy Laplace variables on s 0 is feasible with the simplest chemical systems, for which the resulting recurrence formulae are not too
complex, as happens with the Stockmayer distribution.
Numerical inversion of generating functions of the concentration distributions is
y
P
s x Px 
usually a better way to predict them. Unless the cost of evaluating Gs
x 0

is too high and more sophisticated methods based upon Laplace transform inversion are needed, an accurate evaluation can be obtained using the method independently developed by Mills [262] and ourselves [263] (see also Ref. 264 for a thorough analysis of round-o and truncation errors of similar approaches). It consists
in computing the inversion contour integral on a circle C in a complex plane centered on the origin with radius jsj slightly below 1, using the trapezium rule and
Fast Fourier Transform for evaluating the sums [Eq. (119)].

Px 



N 1
y
X
jsjx X
2pimx
Gsm 
exp 
PxNn jsj Nn
N
N m0
n1

119

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

The second term in Eq. (119) can be neglected for large enough N or small enough
jsj. A recent surge on this approach has led to exploitation of other more complex
but hopefully more ecient methods [265], mainly developed for Laplace transform inversion, and so more adapted to high average molecular weights. The error
of those formulae is more complex to control, unlike Eq. (119).
Besides molecular weight distribution, it is also possible to access readily some
information about the distribution of molecular sizes and other polymer properties, such as the angular dependence of light scattering intensity. The evaluation
of averages involving the distances of every pair of monomer units is required,
and a starting point for that purpose is the evaluation of the trail generating functions [3133], allowing the counting of path lengths.
Equilibrium polycondensation of a single monomer XA f taking FSSEs into
account has been analyzed by Gordon and Scantlebury [268] using TBP, and experimental results concerning the POCl3 /P2 O5 system have been successfully described. More general calculations are better carried out using the method described by Kuchanov et al. [267], summarized below for the polycondensation of
XA f (but only in the absence of gel).
Chemical equilibrium will be attained in two hypothetical stages:
1. All the rings are formed, but no fused rings, such as naphthalene, are allowed
and molecules look like cactus [266]. The fraction of repeating units X in
rings of size n n 1; y at the end of this stage is assumed to be y Xc n, summing 1  yc , which will be found afterwards from mass action laws. No other
reactions of functional groups A occur.
2. The unreacted monomer and the rings start a polycondensation with an innity
of monomers with a single group A and dierent functionalities, which are f for
the unreacted monomer coming from stage 1 and n f  2  1 for the rings.
Dening sCn as the dummy Laplace variables associated to the counts of rings
(including sC0 for the count of units X in the chains connecting rings) and sZl
as the variable counting the bonds not belonging to rings, the generating function of the trees with either a ring or a unit not belonging to any ring can be
found from TBP as shown in Eqs. (120).
V F Zl V b 0 sC0 sA 1  ar ar V f 1

y
X

b n sCn sA 1  ar ar V n f 21

n1

G 1  yc sC0 sA 1  ar ar V f

y
X

y Xc nsCn sA 1  ar ar V n f 2

n1

b0

f 1  yc
;
f  2yc

bn

f  2 y Xc n
f  2yc

120

A pgf for the counts of repeating units X will result from substituting sC0 in Eq.
(120) by sX and sCn by sXn. Variable ar in the expressions (120) is the probability of

127

128

3 Polycondensation

reaction of the unreacted functional groups after ring formation in stage 1. It is


necessary to eliminate it, and to introduce the mass action laws for the rings. This
last step is not straightforward, as it requires the application of graph theory in order to compute the concentrations of linear polymer molecules L n  in Eq. (23).
The nal result, which reduces to the distribution found by Jacobson and Stockmayer in their classic paper [21] for f 2, is Eq. (121).
Px  X  f  2yc
y Xc n
y
X
n1



x f  1!arx1 1  ar x f 22 f 1  yc x
f  2yc
x!x f  2 2!

nK c n n
q ;
X 

nK c nq n X  yc ;

f f  1ar 1  yc
f  2yc

yc

f p  ar
21  ar

121

A solution is also known for the analogous system of the alternating polycondensation XA f YBg [267].
Dilution with an inert solvent will make [X] decrease without aecting the cyclization constants much, and the fraction of rings will increase, until it becomes
practically unity, a phenomenon which has experimental support obtained using
polysiloxanes as model polymers. In bulk systems, the fraction of rings is usually
only a few per cent.
With nonlinear polycondensations of aliphatic monomers, gel points in bulk are
aected by a few per cent due to cyclizations, and elastic properties are also affected (that eect using TBP has been modeled by Dusek et al. [269]). Application
of the approach described above could lead to improved modeling where small
numbers of rings are present.
Taking cyclizations into account raises the question of introducing information
about the spatial location of atoms in models of network formation. The classic gelation theory described here considers a uniform distribution in space of all the
chemical properties. Stauer, one of the main contributors to the progress of percolation theory, has strongly criticized this view, claiming that Gordons theory is
inapplicable in the vicinity of gel point [270]. Gordon has not accepted that argument [271], claiming his theory to be universal and capable of describing gel formation in any homogeneous system.
A new theory, starting with classic gelation theory and using TBP as a particular
case, has been developed by Kuchanov [272, 273], and considers the molecular
graphs to be embedded in ordinary three-dimensional space not in a lattice, as
is usually done in percolation theory. Generating functions are replaced by generating functionals of the ensemble of positions of the functional groups and repeating
units. Dependence of space coordinates is eventually eliminated by averaging, so
the algebraic equations become integral equations. In spite of its power, it has not
become a widely used instrument for dealing with real complex chemical sys-

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

tems, and we leave it here only for reference, as even a basic but comprehensible
description would be too extensive.
3.4.4

Kinetic Modeling of Irreversible Polycondensations

In his pioneering study of nonlinear polycondensation [7], Stockmayer has already


checked his statistical solution [Eq. (5)] by solving the mass balance equations in a
batch reactor for the concentrations of functional groups A and the set of isomeric
polymer molecules Px with x repeating units X [Eqs. (122)].
(
x1
dPx 
1X
k
y f  2 2x  y f  2
dt
2 y1
2Py Pxy   Ax f  2 2Px 
dA
kA 2 ;
dt

Px jt0 X ;

)
122

Ajt0 f X 

The two solutions are identical. Hence, for a long time no importance was attributed to the use of a kinetic approach for describing batch polycondensations starting from monomers, and the statistical approach was preferred. Of course, chemical engineers had to deal with semi-batch and continuous stirred tank reactors
where the statistical approach, although possible, is cumbersome and error-prone,
so a few papers appeared in the 1960s dealing with kinetically controlled linear
polycondensations [274276].
In reality, Kuchanov [277, 278] has shown that,with polycondensations presenting FSSEs, kinetic and statistical approaches give distinct results for average molecular weights and gel points. Dusek [279] has pointed out that this behavior is
even more visible when dealing with polyadditions (linear polyaddition leads to a
Poisson CLD, whereas a simplistic use of a statistical approach would lead to a
geometrical/SchulzFlory CLD) and has conrmed this result using Monte Carlo
simulation of XA f polycondensation with FSSEs [280]. Sarmoria and Miller [35]
have tried to extend the recursive approach to systems presenting FSSE by considering network building starting from dyads and larger fragments. But chemical
systems can be found in which this latter idea does not provide useful results
[281], so that use of statistical approaches outside the description of chemical equilibrium now seems more like a waste of time.
Kuchanovs kinetic approach divides polymer molecules into classes Px having
a vectorial count of groups x. In this approach, groups An should include not
only the unreacted functional groups, but also the bonds and repeating units, and
even larger molecular fragments when needed. We will use NXZA as the number of
kinds of groups in that generalized sense.

129

130

3 Polycondensation

It is possible to obtain a rate equation for the members of each class by adding
the contributions of the various condensation reactions, leading to a version of
Smoluchowskis coagulation equation.
Ring-forming reactions involving functional groups in the same monomer can
be described by a simple extension of the preceding FSSE model, just by considering unimolecular reactions and new fake functional groups, which are pairs of
groups [Eq. (123)].
ki

Ai   !

N
XZA
X

nin An

i 1; NR

123

n1

The rate of formation of groups requires a modication of Eq. (68), since it is no


longer possible to include breakage or exchange reactions. Adding the unimolecular reactions dened above, the new general rate equation becomes Eq. (124).


R An

NR
NR
X
X

n

n
k
A
A


nin ki Ai   
i
i
i
in
in
i1

124

i1

The multiple sums in the rate of formation of Px, which will not be presented,
are simplied through consideration of its generating function [Eqs. (125), (126)]

NR
X

GRP s
ki G
ni Gni
i1

qG
qG
qG
qG

Ai  
Ai 
q log si q log si q log si
q log si

NR
X
i1

ki

qG
G   1
q log si   ni

125

where

Gni

N
XZA
Y

snin

J ; ; 

126

n1

Equation (125) replaces a similar expression in Ref. 282 with the advantage of
considering only the reactions actually taking place, and not every combination of
pairs of unreacted groups, which does not make sense now, as repeating units are
also An moieties.
Insertion of Eq. (125) into mass balance equations, such as a continuous stirred
tank reactor (CSTR) with constant volume, leads to a nonlinear rst-order PDE
[Eq. (127)].

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions



NR
qG X
qG
qG
qG
qG

ki G
G

A


A

i
i
ni ni
qt
q log si q log si q log si
q log si
i1


NR
X

ki

i1

qG
GF s  Gs
Gni  1  RV G

q log si 
t

Gsjt0 G0 s

127

Solution of the above equation by the method of characteristics [283] is described


in Ref. 282, earlier examples being found in Refs. 284286. They will not be reproduced here, for the sake of brevity. If Gs is to be evaluated, in order to take advantage of the numerical inversion formula Eq. (119), or if average degrees of polymerization in the presence of gel have to be predicted, numerical solution of Eq. (127)
leads to a two-point boundary solution problem with twice as many unknowns
as the number of derivative terms log sn (the number of active groups in the
polymer).
A much simpler problem, as Galina was apparently the rst to remark [287], is
P
, in
the prediction of the moments of Px  with respect to the counts of groups, lmn...
the absence of gel. Dierentiation of Eq. (126) with respect to log sn and setting
s 1NZXA leads to an ODE system with known initial conditions, which has a
straightforward numerical solution [Eq. (128)].
dljkP
dt

NR
X

k m n
mk nmk nmj nmj Am Am 

m1

P
P
n
mj nmj lmk Am  lmk Am 

P
P
P
P
P
P
n
mk nmk lm j Am  Lm j Am  lm j lmk lm j lmk 


NR
X

P

P

 
km lm
  j nmk lm  k nmj Am   nmj nmk

m1

ljkPF  ljkP
t

 RV ljkP

128

As there is no gel, a rate equation for the overall concentration of polymer P


(zeroth-order moment) is obtained from Eq. (126), setting s 1NZXA [Eqs. (129)].
NR
X
Pf  P
qP

ki Ai Ai   RV P
t
qt
i1

Pjt0 P0

129

Number-average and weight-average molecular weights are found by the wellknown expressions (130).

131

132

3 Polycondensation
N
ZXA
X

Mn

N
ZXA N
ZXA
X
X

MAn An 

n1

Mw

P

m1 n1
N
ZXA
X

P
MAm MAn lmn

130
MAn An 

n1

This approach can only deal with ring-forming reactions either for a limited number of the smallest rings, or alternatively, for linear polycondensations. The important practical case of the irreversible polycondensation of AXA BYB BYC (C
being an inert group) leads to the rate laws in Eqs. (131) for the molecules with
the six possible combinations of end groups PnAA ; PnAB ; . . . PnCC and rings Cn , where
index n counts the most frequent kind of repeating units in the molecule:
n1
X

RPnAA k 4

RPnBB k 4

AA
PmAA Pnm


m1

m1

n1
X

n1
X

BB
PmBB Pnm


m1

"
RPnAB k

n1
X

n
X

BB
4
PmAA Pnm1

m1

!
AB
PmAA Pnm


2PnBB A

PnAB A

AB
2
PmBB Pnm

m1

2PnAA B

n1
X

AB
PmAB Pnm

m1

B  kc nPnAB 

RCn kc nPnAB 
RPnAC k 2

n
X

BC
PmAA Pnm1


m1

RPnBC k 2

n1
X

n1
X

!
AC
PmAB Pnm


PnAC B

m1

AC
PmBB Pnm


m1

RPnCC k

n1
X

n1
X

!
BC
PmAB Pnm


PnBC A

m1

BC
PmAC Pnm


m1

RA RB kAB 

y
X

kc nPnAB 

131

n1

Modern computers will not have much diculty with the brute force approach
of solving the mass balances after inserting the above relationships for n 1 up
to an upper value N of a few hundreds or even thousands (notice that this implies
11N 2 ON multiplications and sums every time this set of rates of reaction is
evaluated). A relatively large value of N is needed if the mole ratio is close to one,
in order that extrapolation of CLD and evaluation of the innite sum using the last

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

equation of Eqs. (131) may be done accurately. A more elegant method uses generating functions [288] and avoids the problem of the lack of closure of the above
equations for any nite N.
When the kinetic approach was at an early stage, it was thought that it could provide no information about polymer or network properties. More recently, a description of batch polycondensation using TBP which is rigorously equivalent to the one
obtained by the kinetic approach was found [289], taking into account the times of
birth of molecules, so that the fundamental restriction does not hold. Through
more elementary reasonings, it is nevertheless possible to estimate probabilities
of extinction and thus network elastic properties [282] or average radius of gyration
[290].
3.4.5

Kinetic Modeling of Linear Reversible Polycondensations

The reversible alternating polycondensation with FSSEs in both monomers (see


Section 3.1.5), disregarding exchange reactions, is a convenient case study for discussing problems of modeling this kind of systems. It can be described by the rate
laws of Eqs. (132) and (133).
RP1AA 4k1 P1AA P1BB   2k2 P1AA P1AB  ZB  k1Z P1AB  k2Z ZA 
RP1BB 4k1 P1AA P1BB   2k3 P1BB P1AB  ZA  k1Z P1AB  k3Z ZB 
RP1AB 4k1 P1AA P1BB   P1AB 2k2 P2AA  2k3 P1BB 

132

k4 2P1AB  ZA  ZB   k1Z P1AB  2k2Z P2AA  2k3Z P2BB 


2k4Z ZA  ZB   2P2AA   2P2BB 
n b 2:

AB
RPnAA 2k2 P1AA Pn1
 2k4

n2
X

AA
PmAB Pnm
  2PnAA 2k3 P1BB  k4 P1AB  ZB 

m1

"


PnAA 2k2Z

2k4Z n

 2

k3Z PnAB 

k4Z

ZA  

n
X

#
PmAB 

2PmAA 

m2

AB
 2k4
RPnBB 2k3 P1BB Pn1

n2
X

BB
PmAB Pnm
  2PnBB 2k2 P1AA  k4 P1AB  ZA 

m 1

"


PnBB 2k3Z

2k4Z n

 2

k2Z PnAB 

k4Z

ZB  

n
X
m2

#
PmAB 

2PmBB 

133

134

3 Polycondensation

RPnAB 4k2 P1AA PnBB  4k3 P1BB PnAA 


n1
X

k4

AB
PmAB Pnm


n1
X

!
BB
PmAA Pnm1


m2

m1

 PnAB 2k2 P1AA  2k3 P1BB  k4 2P1AB 


AA
BB
ZA  ZB  k2Z k3Z k4Z 2n  3 2k2Z Pn1
 2k3Z Pn1


"
k4Z ZA  ZB   2

n
X

PnAB   2

m2

n1
X

#
PmAA  PmBB 

133

m2

It may be observed from these expressions that, in general, it is not possible to obtain a closed nite set of rate equations for the rst oligomers rate equations for
oligomers with chain length n always depend on concentrations of oligomers with
chain length n 1. Only when the rate constants of reverse equations are equal
do the above expressions simplify (FSSE for reverse reaction), and the abovementioned diculty disappears.
On introduction of generating functions of the CLD, dened in Eq. (134), the
concentrations of end groups, trimers, and tetramers conform with Eqs. (134) and
(135).

GAA

y
X

s n2 PnAA  GBB

n2

y
X

s n2 PnBB  GAB

n2

y
X

s n2 PnAB 

ZA  2GAA 1 GAB 1 ZB  2GBB 1 GAB 1


P2AA  GAA 0 P2BB  GBB 0

134

n2

P2AB  GAB 0

135

The rate equations in terms of those generating functions become Eqs. (136).
RGAA 2k2 P1AA sGAB P1AB  k4 s 2 GAA GAB  2GAA 2k3 P1BB 
k4 P1AB  ZB   2k2Z GAA  2k4Z s
k4Z

qGAA
k3Z GAB
qs

ZA   2GAA  GAB
1s

RGBB 2k3 P1BB sGAB P1AB  k4 s 2 GBB GAB  2GBB 2k2 P1AA 
k4 P1AB  ZA   2k3Z GBB  2k4Z s
k4Z

ZB   2GBB  GAB
1s

qGBB
k2Z GAB
qs

3.4 Modeling of Complex Polycondensation Reactions

RGAB 4k2 P1AA GBB 4k3 P1BB GAA k4 2P1AB sGAB P1AB 
2
4sGAA GBB   2k2 P1AA  2k3 P1BB  k4 2P1AB  ZA  ZB 
s 2 GAB

k2Z k3Z k4Z GAB  2k4Z s


2k2Z  k4Z

qGAB
ZA  ZB   2GAB GAA GAB
k4Z
qs
1s

GAA  P2AA 
GBB  P2BB 
2k3Z  k4Z
s
s

136

Rate laws for ZA  and ZB  become Eq. (137):


RZA 2k2 P1AA ZB  2P1AB   2k3 P1BB ZA  k4 2P1AB 2  ZA ZB 
 k2Z ZA  2P2AA   k3Z ZB   2P2BB 


5
k4Z X Y ZA  ZB   P1AA   P1BB   2P1AB 
2
RZB 2k2 P1AA ZB  2k3 P1BB ZA  2P1AB  k4 2P1AB 2  ZA ZB 
 k2Z ZA   2P2AA   k3Z ZB  2P2BB 


5
k4Z X Y ZA  ZB   P1AA   P1BB   2P1AB 
2

137

A rate law for by-product [Eq. (138)] is usually required.


RW 4k1 P1AA P1BB  2k2 P1AA ZA  2k3 P1BB ZA  k4 ZA ZB   k1Z P1AB 
 k2Z ZA   k3Z ZB   k4Z

y
X

2n  4PnAA  PnBB  2n  3PnAB 

n2

4k1 P1AA P1BB  2k2 P1AA ZA  2k3 P1BB ZA  k4 ZA ZB 
 k1Z P1AB   k2Z ZA   k3Z ZB 


3
 k4Z X  Y   ZA  ZB   P1AA   P1BB   2P1AB 
2

138

Insertion of these rate laws in mass balances of ideal reactors (batch/plug ow or


transient CSTR) leads to systems of semi-linear, rst-order, partial dierential
equations, with a single family of characteristics [Eq. (139)].
ds
2sk4Z
dt

139

The relationship of Eq. (138) allows integration along characteristics, relating initial values GAA 0; s 0 ; GAB 0; s 0 , and GBB 0; s 0 to GAA t; s; GAB t; s, and GBB t; s,

135

136

3 Polycondensation

but a serious problem remains: integration along characteristics and prediction of


concentration of rst oligomers have to be done at the same time.
Only the solution with equal reactivity has been published [291]. A sketch of an
iterative method to solve this more complex problem is described below (no actual
calculations have been published at the time of writing).
1. Two auxiliary characteristics s t s t, starting at s es js0 j and s
es js0 j, respectively, for t 0, are introduced in order to provide an accurate numerical estimation of oligomer concentrations through Eq. (140).
GI 0

GI s GI s
Oes2 I AA; BB; AB
2

140

Parameter es should be a small value (say 106 to 108 ). Owing to Eq. (139), it is
easy to relate the auxiliary characteristics to the main characteristic st starting with s s0 through Eq. (141).
s t s t es st

141

2. The resolution of a system of ODE comprising Eq. (139), the balances of end
groups ZA , ZB , by-product W and dierential equations for GAA t; s, GAB t; s,
GBB t; s, GAA t; s , GAB t; s , GBB t; s , GAA t; s , GAB t; s and GBB t; s ,
will eventually allow the evaluation of all unknown variables of this problem.
As s0 is to be found iteratively in order that the characteristic starting with
s s0 will attain the prescribed value of s at the prescribed time t, this is a
boundary value problem, but very straightforward to solve.
If there are more than two functional groups per repeating unit, the approach described above is no longer useful, as there is no simple way of describing formation of chemical species through breaking of larger ones, owing to their branched
structure.
Nevertheless, in most situations resembling industrial practice, such as CSTRs
in series, the CLD of these chemical systems will stay close to equilibrium (see
Ref. 291). The distributions of monads depend only on the equilibrium ratios and
it is not necessary to use models with SSSEs for the reverse reactions (the source of
the most challenging mathematical problems), as the same distributions will be
found using equal values of the rate constants of the reverse reaction.

Notation

1N
av
b

vector with N components equal to one


lm area per unit volume [m1 ]
length of a Kuhn segment connecting two half-bonds in the same
repeating unit [m]

Notation

bA
Cd
Cg
D
db
dR
dT
Ec
ei

empirical parameter in Eq. (56) (dimensionless)


drag coecient (dimensionless)
parameter in Eq. (12) [s1 ]
binary diusivity [m 2 s1 ]
bubble diameter [m]
diameter of ring (in a RDC devolatilizer) [m]
inner diameter of tube, or of the barrel of an extruder [m]
activation energy of amidation reaction [J mol1 ]
index of by-product formed by reaction leading to bond Z iR ; no byproduct if it is nil

indices of half-bonds of bond Z iR


e
i ; ei
F X i sZ ; sA ; F A i sZ ; sA ; F Z i sZ ; sA probability generating functions (pgf ) of the
counts of the dierent kinds of connecting and unreacted functional
groups directly linked to, respectively, a monomer unit X i , an unreacted group A i , or a half-bond Z i
f
monomer functionality (number of functional groups it contains)
equilibrium zero strain shear modulus of polymer network [Pa]
Ge
Gs
moment generating function of molar concentrations of polymer molecules with respect to their counts of monomer units and unreacted
functional groups
J
generating functions of stoichiometric coecients of reaction
Gni
i J ; ;  , as dened by Eq. (126)
Xi
G sX ; sA ; G A i sX ; sA ; G Z i sX ; sA pgf of trees starting, respectively, with a prescribed monomer unit X i , an unreacted group A i , or a half-bond Z i
GM sM
pgf of mass fractions of polymer molecules in a sol
g
acceleration due to gravity [m s2 ]
ratio mA /bA [m 3 mol1 ]
gA

indices of functional groups A gi ; A gi reacting to create bond Z i
gi ; gi
H
depth of liquid in the channel of a vented extruder [m]
partition coecients of hydrophilic monomer in interfacial polymerHe ; Hi
ization relating, respectively, the bulk concentration in the water
phase and the concentration in the outer interface of the polymer
lm, and the concentrations in organic phase in the two interfaces of
polymer lm (dimensionless)
Henry constant of component W in terms of pressure versus weight
HW
fraction [Pa]
h
clearance between the screw and barrel in a vented extruder [m]
index of a repeating unit carrying functional group A i
hi
hR
height of the liquid above the gas injection point in an RDC [m]
J
number of compartments in a staged model of an RDC devolatilizer
mass transfer rate per unit volume of component j [mol m3 s1 ]
Jj
K
apparent equilibrium ratio of bond formation from end groups
(dimensionless)
thermodynamic equilibrium constant of bond formation from end
K0
groups (dimensionless)

137

138

3 Polycondensation

Ka
K a0
K c n
k
k0
kA
k aE
k c n
k cE n
kcr
k cZ
kc0
kfYi
a
kfY
i

ki0
kijE
kijE ; kijE
kiH
kiOH
km
k nuc; n
kscat ; kfcat
ku0
kZ
kiZ
ki
L
Lp
LR
LW
Lx

apparent equilibrium ratio of amidation (dimensionless)


reference value of the apparent equilibrium ratio of amidation
(dimensionless)
apparent equilibrium ratio of cyclization [mol m3 ]
apparent second-order rate constant [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
parameter in Eq. (12) [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
empirical parameter in ChenWu relation, Eq. (53) [mol m3 s1 ]
rate constant of breakage of a bond in a ring molecule through reaction with a functional group [mol m3 s1 ]
rst-order rate constant of L n cyclization [s1 ]
rate constant of formation of Cn by the back-biting cyclization reaction
[s1 ]
rate coecient of crystallization in Avrami equation [sncr ] (see below)
apparent rst-order rate constant of breakage of a bond in a ring
molecule [s1 ]
third-order pre-exponential factors of amidation rate constant
[kg 2 mol2 s1 ]
mass transfer coecient of species Yi in terms of molar concentrations [m s1 ]
mass transfer coecient of species Yi in terms of activities
[mol m2 s1 ]
noncatalytic contribution to the rate constant in Eq. (61) [mol m3 s1 ]
rate constant of exchange reaction forming bond Z iR and destroying
bond Z jR
rate constants of exchange reaction forming bond Z iR and replacing
bond Z jR , when the attacking group is, respectively, Ai or Ai
acid-catalyzed reaction constant in Eq. (61) [m 6 mol2 s1 ]
catalytic term of hydroxyls in Eq. (61) [m 6 mol2 s1 ]
water mass transfer rate constant [s1 ]
rate coecients of nucleation of polymer species with chain length n
[s1 ]
rate constants of self-catalyzed and foreign acid-catalyzed esterication
[m 6 mol2 s1 ]
second-order pre-exponential factor of amidation rate constant
[m 3 mol1 s1 ]
apparent rst-order rate constant of bond group breakage [s1 ]
apparent rst-order rate constant of breakage of bond group ZiR [s1 ]
rst-order rate constant of intramolecular reaction i destroying group
Ai   [s1 ]
lm thickness [m]
thickness of polymer lm in interfacial polymerization [m]
thickness of reaction zone [m]
width of the channel in an extruder [m]
lm perimeter [m]

Notation

M
Mi

relative molecular weight


relative molecular weight of generic polymer species i, where i is an
arbitrary
 y index
y
P
P
Mn
Mi Pi 
Pi  number-average molecular weight of polymer
i1

i1

mass of polymer per mole of monomer units [kg mol1 ]


relative
 ymolecular weight of by-product W
y
P
P
Mw
Mi2 Pi 
Mi Pi  weight-average molecular weight of polymer
i1
i1

y
y
P
P
Mz
Mi3 Pi 
Mi2 Pi  z-average molecular weight of polymer
MP
MW

i1

i1

empirical parameter in Eq. (56) [mol1 m 3 ]


mA
number of functional (or end) groups
NA
AvogadroLoschmidt number [mol1 ]
NAL
Nb
number of bubbles
ux of component j [mol m2 s1 ]
N_ j
number of distinctive chemical bonds
NR
number of symmetrical chemical bonds
NRs
number of kinds of monomer units
NX
number of by-products
NW
number of volatile (or precipitating) components
NY
number of half-bonds
NZ
NZA NZ NA overall number of kinds of functional groups and half-bonds
NZXA NZ NX NA overall number of kinds of functional groups, monomer
units, and half-bonds
n_
screw rotational speed (as rotations per unit time) [s1 ]
Avrami exponent
ncr
pressure inside a bubble [Pa]
Pb
local pressure over a bubble [Pa]
Pme
vapor pressure of W [Pa]
PW
S
PW
vapor pressure of pure W [Pa]
p
conversion of reference functional groups A
conversion of functional groups A having given rise to rings
pc
Q
volumetric ow rate of polymer [m 3 s1 ]
volumetric ow rate of gas [m 3 s1 ]
Qg
R
ideal gas constant [J mol1 K1 ]
Re
Reynolds number for the rising movement of a bubble
rate of formation by chemical reaction of species j [mol m3 s1 ]
Rj
RV
combined relative rate of change of reaction volume by chemical reaction and transfer of by-product [s1 ]
r
stoichiometric ratio in alternating polycondensations
radius of a bubble [m]
rb
s
vector of dummy Laplace variables associating sA and sZ (dened
below)

139

140

3 Polycondensation

sA

vector of dummy Laplace variables associated with the counts of unreacted functional groups
dummy Laplace variables associated with the counts of rings (includsCn
ing sC0 for the count of units X in the chains connecting rings) for the
equilibrium polycondensation of a single monomer XA f
sM
dummy Laplace variable associated with molecular weight
vector of dummy Laplace variables associated with the counts of halfsZ
bonds
dummy Laplace variable associated with xZy
s Zy
sZl
dummy Laplace variable associated with the counts of bonds not belonging to rings for the equilibrium polycondensation of a single
monomer XA f
T
absolute temperature [K]
reference temperature [K]
T0
t
time [s]
exposure time [s]
tf
exposure time of liquid in the pool of a vented extruder [s]
t fP
bubble rising speed [m s1 ]
ub
average velocity in directions x; z [m s1 ]
ux ; uz
V
volume of reacting mixture [m 3 ]
volume of a bubble [m 3 ]
Vb
Vi sZ ; sA pgf of pendent chains Vi
V^i sZ ; sA pgf of nite pendent chains Vi
Vj
molar volume of species j [m 3 mol1 ]
^
pgf of nite pendent chains Vi with respect to molecular weight
VMi sM
overall melt volume [m 3 ]
Vm
volume of liquid in compartment j in a staged model of an RDC devoVmj
latilizer [m 3 ]
v
vector of the NZ probabilities of extinction (the fractions of nite pendent chains)
average transverse velocity of the screw dragging the lm [m s1 ]
vT
wcr
weight fraction of crystalline material
weight fraction of j
wj
weight fraction of the sol, relative to the overall mass of the polymer
wS
x
degree of polymerization, the number of repeating units in a polymer
molecule
x
coordinate along the perimeter, when discussing mass transfer from a
liquid owing over a cylindrical wall [m]
vector storing the counts of functional groups
xA
xi
degree of polymerization of generic polymer species i, where i is an
arbitrary
 y index
y
P
P
xn
x i Pi 
Pi  number-average degree of polymerization of polymer
i1
i1

y
y
P
P
xw
xi2 Pi 
x i Pi  weight-average degree of polymerization of polymer
i1

i1

Notation

xX
xZ
xZ y
y
yc
yP
ySX i ; ySZ i
y Xc n

ZZX
z
zi

vector containing the counts of monomer units


vector storing the counts of half-bonds
number of innite pendent chains connected to a junction
Cartesian coordinate normal to the interface [m]
overall molar fraction of repeating units X in rings for a single monomer polycondensation
number of moles of polymer molecules per mole of monomer units
before gelation
and ySA i fractions of units and groups of the various kinds in nite
molecules (in a sol), after gelation
molar fraction of repeating units X in rings of size n for a single
monomer y X i molar fractions of monomers or monomer units
polycondensation
matrix dened in Eq. (73) from incidence vectors z dened below
Cartesian coordinate parallel to the interface [m]
index of the monomer unit to which half-bond Z i points

Greek
empirical parameter of ChenWu relation [Eq. (53)] (dimensionless)
probability of reaction of unreacted functional groups after ring formation in the rst stage (absence of open-chain molecules) of a hypothetical two-stage equilibration of XA f
b g ; b g0
parameters in Eq. (11) describing the glass eect [K]
fraction of volume ow rate in compartment j going to the preceding
bj
compartment j  1
activity coecient of species j
gj
FloryHuggins parameter (multicomponent mixture)
wij
DH
enthalpy of reaction [J mol1 ]
DS
entropy of reaction [J mol1 K1 ]
d
upstream distance of re-entry of lm wiped by the screw in a vented
extruder [m]
small starting value of s in characteristic line
es
y
screw angle
ratio of rate constants of similar intramolecular and intermolecular
k c n
reactions [mol m3 ]
q . . . qF I
LIJ...K s
derivatives of pgf F I s (or other moment generq log sJ . . . q log sK
ating functions) with respect to logarithms of dummy Laplace
parameters
y
y
P
P
q
. . . qF I
I
lJ...K

1N
...
xJ . . . xJ Ix moments of distribuq log sJ . . . q log sK
x1 0
xN 0
I
tions, where F s is the moment generating function of vector distribution Ix
a
ar

141

142

3 Polycondensation

rst and second moments of molecular weight of distribution of


polymer
m
dynamic viscosity [N m1 s1 ]
concentrations of elastically active network junctions (EANJ)
me
[mol m3 ]
n
stoichiometric coecient (the change in number of moles caused by
chemical reaction)
stoichiometric coecients of functional groups An and oriented bonds
ninA ; ninZ
Zn coming out of the monomer unit in which Ai was situated for
the reaction forming Z iR
A Z
nin ; nin
stoichiometric coecients of functional groups An and oriented bonds
Zn coming out of the monomer unit in which Ai was situated for
the reaction forming Z iR
AE ZE
nijn ; nijn
changes in numbers of functional groups An and bonds Zn , respectively, connected to the root unit X  where either Ai or Ai were
attached, for the exchange reaction forming Z iR at the expense of Z jR
AE ZE AE ZE
nijn
; nijn
; nijn
; nijn
changes in numbers of functional groups An
and bonds Zn , respectively, connected to the root unit X where the
living group A j or A j was situated, for the exchange reaction
forming Z iR at the expense of Z jR
AE ZE AE ZE
nijn
; nijn
; nijn
; nijn
changes in numbers of groups attached to the
root unit X  which gets connected to the unit where the attacking
group was situated, for the exchange reaction forming Z iR at the expense of Z jR
W
nin
stoichiometric coecients of by-products for the reaction forming Z iR

nin
stoichiometric coecient of group An for the ith intramolecular
reaction
concentration of elastically active network chains [mol m3 ]
ne
density of j [kg m3 ]
rj
s
surface tension [N m1 ]
t
space time based upon feed ow rate, Vm /Q F for a CSTR [s]
tr
structural relaxation time [s]
parameter in Eq. (11) [s]
t0
tortuosity for by-product diusion in a solid polymer particle
tD
(dimensionless)
volume fraction of crystalline material
fcr
volume fraction of j
fj
fraction of channel extruder lled with liquid
fL
w
FloryHuggins parameter (binary mixture) (dimensionless)
weight fraction activity coecient of W
WW
lM ; lMM

Chemical symbols
A; B
functional groups
A gi 1 Ai ; A gi 1 Ai functional groups reacting in bond Z iR formation

Notation

Aj

active component (molecular species or fragment) j; nonvolatile,


nonprecipitating
ring molecule with n bonds
Cn
linear polymer molecule with n  1 bonds and a pair of active end
Ln
groups
length of tube
LT
generic polymer species, where i is an arbitrary index
Pi
IJ
Pn
linear polymer molecule with end groups I and J and n repeating
units of the most frequent kind
U 
molar concentration of species U
Vi xZ ; xA pendent chain starting with a half-bond Z i and containing vector
counts of bonds and functional groups, respectively, xZ and xA
W
by-product of condensation reaction
We i 1 Wi by-product of condensation reaction leading to bond Z iR
X; Y
monomer units
Xh i 1 XiA monomer unit carrying functional group A i
Xz i 1 XiZ monomer unit to which each half-bond Z i points
volatile (or precipitating) component j
Yj
Z
bond group; Z iR is the ith distinctive bond in the chemical system
bond group in fragment AXZA YZ (polycondensation AXA BYB)
ZA
bond group in fragment BYZB XZ (polycondensation AXA BYB)
ZB
bond group in dimer AXZD YB (polycondensation AXA BYB)
ZD
Zei 1 Zi ; Zei 1 Zi half-bonds of bond Z iR
ZP
bond group in fragment ZXZP Z (polycondensation AXA BYB)
Subscripts
aq
b
blk
c
cr
F
g
org
sat

aqueous
of a bubble
bulk
critical
crystalline
in feed
at gel point
organic
at saturation

Superscripts
*
x

used for describing values of concentration at the interface


average value of x

Acronyms
BHET
BPA

bis(2-hydroxyethyl) terephthalate
bisphenol A

143

144

3 Polycondensation

CLD
CSTR
DEG
DMT
DPC
EANC
EANJ
ECH
EG
FSSE
ODE
PBT
PDE
PET
pgf
RDC
RIM
SSP
SSSE
TBP
TPA
UF
WFR

chain length distribution


continuous stirred tank reactor
diethylene glycol
dimethyl terephthalate
diphenyl carbonate
elastically active network chains, the chains connecting EANJs (see
below)
elastically active network junctions, the intersection of at least three
chains leading to a gel
epichlorohydrin
ethylene glycol
rst-shell substitution eect
ordinary dierential equation
poly(butylene terephthalate)
partial dierential equation
poly(ethylene terephthalate)
probability generating function
rotating disk contactor
reaction injection molding
solid-state polycondensation
second-shell substitution eect
theory of branching processes
terephthalic acid
ureaformaldehyde polymer
wiped-lm reactor

References
1 A. V. Lourenc
o, Comptes Rendus

3
4
5

He bd. Seances Acad. Sciences 1859, 49,


619; A. V. Lourenco, Comptes Rendus
He bd. Seances Acad. Sciences 1860, 50,
91.
L. H. Baekeland, J. Ind. Eng. Chem.
1909, 1, 149; reprinted in Chemtech,
1976, 6, 40.
H. Staudinger, Ber. 1920, 53, 1073.
W. H. Carothers, J. Am. Chem. Soc.
1929, 51, 2548.
P. J. Flory, Principles of Polymer
Chemistry, 1st ed., Cornell University
Press, Ithaca, New York, 1953.
J. L. Stanford, R. F. T. Stepto, J.
Chem. Soc., Faraday Trans. 1975, 71,
1292.
W. H. Stockmayer, J. Chem. Phys.
1943, 11, 45.

8 D. J. Brunelle, J. E. Bradt, US

Pat. 5 039 783 to General Electric, 1991.


9 R. B. Burch, S. R. Lustig, M. Spinu,

Macromolecules 2000, 33, 5053.


10 G. V. Schulz, Z. Phys. Chem. 1938,

A182, 127.
11 M. R. P. F. N. Costa, J. Villermaux,

Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1989, 28, 711.


12 M. H. Abraham, Pure Appl. Chem.

1985, 57, 1055.


13 E. A. Macedo, R. C. Gonc
alves, A. N.

es, C. M. Ventura, L. C.
Simo
Albuquerque, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1995, 34, 1910.
14 K. Dusek, Polym. Gels Networks 1996,
4, 383.
15 I. Mita, K. Horie, J. Macromol. Sci.
Rev. Macromol. Chem. Phys. 1987, C27,
91.

References
16 S. Corezzi, D. Fioretto, D. Puglia,

17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24

25

26

27
28
29
30
31
32
33
34
35
36
37

38

39

J. M. Kenny, Macromolecules 2003, 36,


5271.
G. Adam, J. Gibbs, J. Chem. Phys.
1965, 43, 139.
S. Lunak, J. Vladyka, K. Dusek,
Polymer 1978, 19, 931.
A. M. Kotliar, J. Polym. Sci.:
Macromol. Revs. 1981, 16, 367.
M. Gordon, G. R. Scantlebury,
Trans. Far. Soc. 1964, 60, 604.
H. Jacobson, W. Stockmayer, J.
Chem. Phys. 1950, 18, 1600.
P. J. Flory, J. A. Semlyen, J. Am.
Chem. Soc. 1966, 88, 14.
P. J. Flory, U. W. Suter, M. Mutter,
J. Am. Chem. Soc. 1976, 98, 5733.
H. R. Kricheldorf, M. Rabenstein,
M. Maskos, M. Schmidt,
Macromolecules 2001, 34, 713.
H. R. Kricheldorf, S. Bohme, G.
Schwarz, Macromolecules 2001, 34,
8879.
C. Puglisi, F. Samperi, R. Alicata,
G. Montaudo, Macromolecules 2002,
35, 3000.
T. E. Harris, The Theory of Branching
Processes, Springer, Berlin, 1963.
M. Gordon, Proc. Roy. Soc. 1962,
A268, 240.
G. R. Dobson, M. Gordon, J. Chem.
Phys. 1965, 43, 705.
M. Gordon, G. N. Malcolm, Proc.
Roy. Soc. 1966, A295, 29.
K. Kajiwara, J. Chem. Phys. 1971, 54,
296.
K. Kajiwara, M. Gordon, J. Chem.
Phys. 1973, 59, 3623.
W. Burchard, Adv. Polym. Sci. 1982,
48, 1.
C. W. Macosko, D. R. Miller,
Macromolecules 1976, 9, 199.
C. Sarmoria, D. R. Miller,
Macromolecules 1991, 24, 1833.
K. Platkowski, K. H. Reichert,
Polymer 1999, 40, 1057.
B. E. Eichinger, O. Akgyray, chap. 8
in Computer Simulation of Polymers,
E. A. Colbourn (Ed.), Longman,
Harlow, UK, 1994.
H. Tobita, N. Hamashima, J.
Polym. Sci. B: Polym. Phys. 2000, 38,
2009.
J. E. Crawford, R. W. Edwards, E. D.

40
41

42

43
44
45
46
47
48
49
50

51
52
53
54
55

56

57
58
59
60
61

Henze, W. C. L. Wu, U.S. Pat. 3 522


214, 1970.
K. Ravindranath, R. A. Mashelkar,
Chem. Eng. Sci. 1986, 41, 2969.
R. Albalak, An Introduction to
Devolatilization, in Polymer
Devolatilization, R. J. Albalak (Ed.),
Marcel Dekker, New York, 1996.
P. S. Mehta, An Overview of
Devolatilizers, in Polymer
Devolatilization, R. J. Albalak (Ed.),
Marcel Dekker, New York, 1996.
F. Widmer, Adv. Chem. Ser. 1973, 128,
51.
R. M. Secor, AIChE J. 1969, 15, 861.
T. M. Pell Jr, T. G. Davies, J. Polym.
Sci. B: Polym. Phys. 1973, 11, 1671.
J. W. Ault, D. A. Mellichamp, Chem.
Eng. Sci. 1972, 27, 2233.
M. Amon, C. D. Denson, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Fundam. 1980, 19, 415.
B. R. Choi, H. H. Lee, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Fundam. 1996, 35, 1550.
G. W. Roberts, AIChE J. 1970, 16,
878.
J. A. Biesenberger, D. H. Sebastian,
Principles of Polymerization Engineering,
chap. 6, Wiley, New York, 1983.
G. A. Latinen, Adv. Chem. Ser. 1962,
34, 235.
R. W. Coughlin, G. P. Canevari,
AIChE J. 1969, 15, 560.
W. A. Mack, R. Herter, Chem. Eng.
Prog. 1976, 72(1), 64.
G. P. Collins, C. D. Denson, G.
Astarita, AIChE J. 1985, 31, 1288.
K. Ravindranath, R. A. Mashelkar,
in Frontiers in Chemical Engineering,
Vol. 1, p. 652, L. K. Doraiswamy, R.
A. Mashelkar (Eds.), Wiley Eastern,
Delhi, 1984.
Y. Murakami, K. Fujimoto, K.
Kakimoto, M. Sekino, J. Chem. Eng.
Jpn. 1972, 5, 257.
K. Vijayaraghvan, J. P. Gupta, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Fundam. 1982, 21, 333.
M. Dietze, H. Kuhne, Chemiefasern
1969, 3, 19.
H. Brod, Chem. Eng. Technol. 1988,
21, 937942.
D. D. Ravetkar, D. D. Cale, Chem.
Eng. Sci. 1981, 36, 399.
R. L. Denecour, A. N. Gent, J. Polym.
Sci. A-2 1968, 6, 1853.

145

146

3 Polycondensation
62 S. T. Lee, J. A. Biesenberger, Polym.
63
64
65
66

67
68
69
70
71

72

73
74
75
76

77

78

79
80
81

82
83
84

Eng. Sci. 1989, 29, 782.


M. Favelukis, Z. Tadmor, R. Semiat,
AIChE J. 1999, 45, 691.
A. Yarin, D. Lastochkin, Y. Talmon,
Z. Tadmor, AIChE J. 1999, 45, 2590.
I. Gestring, D. Mewes, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 2002, 57, 3415.
C.-T. Yang, T. G. Smith, D. I. Bigio,
C. Anolick, AIChE J. 1997, 43, 1861
and 1874.
K. H. Song, S. H. Lee, K. H. Park,
Korean Pat. Appl. 1999-73 161, 1999.
B.-G. Woo, K. Y. Choi, K. H. Song,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 2001, 40, 3459.
ler,
J. F. Davidson, B. O. G. Schu
Trans. Inst. Chem. Eng. 1960, 38, S105.
P. Snabre, F. Magnifotcham, Eur.
Phys. J. 1998, B4, 369.
F. Pilati, Solid-State Polymerization,
in Comprehensive Polymer Science, p.
201, G. Allen, J. C. Bevington
(Eds.), Pergamon Press, Oxford, 1989.
C. Gostoli, F. Pilati, G. C. Sarti, B.
Di Giacomo, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1984,
29, 2873.
F. Pilati, C. Gostoli, G. C. Sarti,
Polym. Proc. Eng. 1986, 4, 303.
F. K. Mallon, W. H. Ray, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1998, 69, 1233.
F. K. Mallon, W. H. Ray, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1998, 69, 1775.
K. Z. Yao, K. B. McAuley, D. Berg,
E. K. Marchildon, Chem. Eng. Sci.
2001, 56, 4801.
P. W. Morgan, Condensation Polymers:
by Interfacial and Solution Methods,
Wiley, New York, 1965.
J. H. Bradbury, P. J. Crawford, A.
N. Hambly, Trans. Faraday Soc. 1968,
65, 1338.
F. MacRitchie, Trans. Faraday Soc.
1969, 65, 2503.
V. Enkelmann, G. Wegner,
Makromol. Chem. 1976, 177, 3177.
J. Cadotte, R. King, R. Majerle, R.
Petersen, J. Macromol. Sci. Chem.
1981, A15, 727.
R. J. Petersen, J. Membrane Sci. 1993,
83, 81.
R. G. Pearson, E. L. Williams, J.
Polym. Sci. 1985, 23, 9.
M. Sirdesai, K. C. Khilar, Can. J.
Chem. Eng. 1988, 42, 2616.

85 S. K. Yadav, A. K. Suresh, K. C.

Khilar, AIChE J. 1990, 36, 431.


86 S. K. Yadav, K. C. Khilar, A. K.

Suresh, AIChE J. 1996, 42, 2616.


87 M. Kubo, Y. Harada, T. Kawatsu, Y.

88
89

90

91

92
93
94

95
96

97
98
99
100

101

102

103

104

105

Yonemoto, J. Chem. Eng. Jpn. 2001,


34, 1506.
P. L. Mills, Chem. Eng. Sci. 1986, 41,
1045.
S. K. Karode, S. S. Kulkarni, A. K.
Suresh, R. A. Mashelkar, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1997, 52, 3243.
S. K. Karode, S. S. Kulkarni, A. K.
Suresh, R. A. Mashelkar, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1998, 53, 2649.
E. D. Johnson, A study of the kinetics
and mechanism of interfacial polymerization, Ph.D. dissertation, CarnegieMellon University, Pittsburgh, 1985.
K. Kamide, H. Ijima, S. Matsuda,
Polym. J. 1993, 25, 1113.
L. J. Gonzalez-Ortiz, J. M. Asua,
Macromolecules 1996, 29, 4520.
J. Huang, J.-P. Leblanc, H. K. J.
Hall, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym. Chem.
1992, 30, 345.
M. Berthelot, L. Peau de SaintGilles, Ann. Chim. Phys. 1863, 68, 225.
S. Hamann, D. H. Solomon, J.
Swift, J. Macromol. Sci. Chem. 1968,
A-2, 153.
A. Fradet, E. Marechal, Adv. Polym.
Sci. 1982, 43, 51.
S.-A. Chen, K. C. Wu, J. Polym. Sci.
A: Polym. Chem. 1982, 20, 1819.
C. T. Kuo, S.-A. Chen, J. Polym. Sci.
A: Polym. Chem. 1989, 27, 2793.
D. Beigzadeh, S. Sajjadi, F. A.
Taromi, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym. Chem.
1995, 33, 1505.
P. B. Zetterlund, W. Weaver, A. F.
Johnson, Polym. React. Eng. 2002, 10,
41.
E. Paatero, K. Narhi, T. Salmi, P.
Nyholm, K. Immonen, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1994, 49, 3601.
J. Lehtonen, T. Salmi, K. Immonen,
E. Paatero, P. Nyholm, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 1996, 35, 3951.
J. Lehtonen, K. Immonen, T. Salmi,
E. Paatero, P. Nyholm, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1996, 51, 2799.
O. M. O. Habib, J. Malek, Coll. Czech.
Chem. Commun. 1976, 41, 2724.

References
106 O. M. O. Habib, J. Malek, Coll. Czech.
107
108
109
110

111

112
113
114

115

116

117

118
119

120

121

122
123

Chem. Commun. 1976, 41, 3077.


J. S. Chung, Kor. J. Chem. Eng. 1989,
6, 354.
K. Tanaka, A. Ozaki, J. Catalysis 1967,
8, 1.
S. C. Hovenkamp, J. Polym. Sci. A:
Polym. Chem. 1971, 9, 3617.
J. Otton, S. Ratton, V. Vasnev, G. D.
Markova, K. M. Nametov, V. I.
Bakhtumov, S. V. Vinogradova,
V. V. Korshak, J. Polym. Sci. A:
Polym. Chem. 1989, 27, 3535.
L. I. Komarova, N. N. Lapina, B. V.
Lokshin, V. I. Bakhmutov, G. D.
Markova, V. A. Vasnev, Bull. Acad.
Sci. USSR Div. Chem. Sci. 1991, 39,
1767.
J.-M. Besnoin, G. D. Lei, K. Y. Choi,
AIChE J. 1989, 35, 1445.
G. D. Lei, K. Y. Choi, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res. Sci. 1992, 31, 769.
M. J. Barandiaran, J. M. Asua, J.
Polym. Sci. A: Polym. Chem. 1989, 27,
4241.
E. Santacesaria, F. Trulli, L.
Minervini, M. Di Serio, R. Tesser,
S. Contessa, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1994,
54, 1371.
M. Di Serio, R. Tesser, F. Trulli,
E. Santacesaria, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1996, 62, 409.
B. Apicella, M. Di Serio, L. Fiocca,
R. Po, E. Santacesaria, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1998, 69, 2423.
U. Stier, F. Gahr, W. Opermann, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci. 2001, 80, 2039.
F. Pilati, P. Manaresi, B.
Fortunato, A. Munari, V.
Passalacqua, Polym. 1983, 24, 1479.
S. I. Chervina, E. G. Maksimenko,
R. S. Barshtein, N. V. Shabanova,
A. Kh. Bulai, Yu. I. Kotov, I. Ya.
Slonim, Kin. Cat. 1987, 28, 947.
J. Otton, S. Ratton, V. Vasnev, G. D.
Markova, K. M. Nametov, V. I.
Bakhtumov, L. I. Komarova, S. V.
Vinogradova, V. V. Korshak, J.
Polym. Sci. A: Polym. Chem. 1988, 26,
2199.
F. Leverd, A. Fradet, E. Marechal,
Eur. Polym. J. 1987, 23, 699 and 705.
A. Kh. Bulai, I. Ya. Slonim, B. M.
Arshava, R. S. Barshtein, V. G.

124
125
126
127
128

129

130
131
132
133
134
135
136
137

138
139

140
141

142

143
144

Gorbunova, Kin. Cat. 1990, 32,


541.
J. Otera, N. Dan-oh, H. Nozaki, J.
Org. Chem. 1991, 56, 5307.
L. H. Buxbaum, Angew. Chem. Int. Ed.
Engl. 1968, 7, 182.
A. V. Popoola, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1991, 43, 1875.
H. K. Reimschuessel, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Prod. Res. Dev. 1980, 19, 117.
F. Pilati, P. Manaresi, B. Fortunato, A. Munari, V. Passalacqua,
Polym. 1981, 22, 1566.
M. Malik, V. Choudhary, I. K.
Varma, J. Macromol. Sci. Rev.
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 2000, C40, 139.
J. Grobelny, Polymer 1995, 36, 4215.
Z. Ordelt, Makromol. Chem. 1963, 63,
153.
Z. Ordelt, Makromol. Chem. 1963, 68,
166.
A. Fradet, E. Marechal, Makromol.
Chem. 1982, 183, 319.
K. Ravindranath, R. A. Mashelkar,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1982, 26, 471.
K. Ravindranath, R. A. Mashelkar,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1984, 29, 437.
T. Yamada, Y. Imamura, O. Makimura, Polym. Eng. Sci. 1985, 25, 788.
C.-K. Kang, B. C. Lee, D. W. Ihm,
D. A. Tremblay, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1997, 63, 163.
Z. Yao, W. H. Ray, AIChE J. 2001, 47,
401.
H. Nava, Polyesters, Unsaturated, in
Kirk-Othmer Encyclopedia of Chemical
Technology (on-line version), John
Wiley, New York, 2004; http://www.
mrw.interscience.wiley.com./kirk/
articles/polysell.a01/sect4.html
Y. S. Yang, J. P. Pascault, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1997, 64, 133 and 147.
F. N. Jones, Alkyd Resins, in
Ullmanns Encyclopedia of Industrial
Chemistry, Wiley-VCH, Weinheim,
2001.
N. Tuck, The Chemistry of Alkyds, in
Waterborne and Solvent Based Alkyds
and their End User Applications, chap.
I, John Wiley, New York, 2000.
R. H. Kienle, Ind. Eng. Chem. 1949,
41, 726.
M. Jonason, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1960,
11, 129.

147

148

3 Polycondensation
hling, K. Schebesta, U.
145 S. Ku

146

147
148

149

150

151
152

153
154

155
156
157
158
159

160
161
162
163

164

Hucks, H. Schuchardt, R.
Bachmann, T. Fischer, K.
ber, F. F. Rhiel, G. Zaby,
Kohlgru
EP 0 798 329 to Bayer-AG, 2001.
P. J. McCloskey, A. Nisoli, W. W.
Reilly, US Pat. 6 399 739 to General
Electric Company, 2002.
K. Komiya, Y. Kawakami, H. Okamoto,
US Pat. 5 596 067 to Asahi, 1997.
llerO. Hahn, D. Mooney, F. Mu
Plathe, K. Kremer, J. Chem. Phys.
1999, 111, 6061.
K. Tominari, A. Kanezawa, T.
Sakashita, K. Miura, T. Shimoda,
US Pat. 5 525 701 to General Electric
Company, 1996.
hling, U. Hucks, G. Zaby, C.
S. Ku
Wulff, US Pat. 5 652 313 to BayerAG, 1997.
K. Komiya, S. Fukuoka, EP 0 892 001
to Asahi, 2002.
B.-G. Woo, K. Y. Choi, W. H. Song,
S. H. Lee, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 2001, 80,
1253.
S. W. Webb, AIChE J. 1993, 39, 701
706.
U. Hucks, R. Bachmann, F. F.
Rhiel, T. Fischer, S. Kratschmer,
WO 02/077 066 A1, 2002.
A. Einhorn, Liebigs Ann. Chem. 1898,
300, 135.
m,
C. A. Bischoff, A. van Hedenstro
Ber. 1902, 35, 3431.
W. H. Carothers, F. J. van Natta, J.
Am. Chem. Soc. 1930, 52, 314.
J. R. Whineld, J. D. Dickson, Br.
Pat. 578 079, 1946.
H. Schnell, L. Bottenbruch, H.
Krimm, Belg. Pat. 532 543 to Bayer
AG, 1954.
H. Schnell, Angew. Chem. 1956, 68,
633.
D. W. Fox, Australian Pat. 221 192 to
General Electric Company, 1959.
D. W. Fox, US Pat. 3 153 008 to
General Electric Company, 1964.
D. Freytag, G. Fengler, L.
Morbitzer, Angew. Chem. Int. Ed.
Engl. 1991, 30, 1598.
H. Schnell, The Chemistry and Physics
of Polycarbonates (Polymer Reviews, Vol.
9), Interscience Publishers, New York,
1964.

165 H. Vernaleken, Polycarbonates,

166

167

168

169

170

171

172

173
174
175
176

177
178

Interfacial Synthesis, in Polymer


Applications and Technology, Vol. 2,
p. 65, F. Millich, C. E. Carrahers
(Eds.), Marcel Dekker, New York, 1977.
D. W. Fox, Polycarbonates, in KirkOthmer Encyclopedia of Chemical
Technology, 3rd ed., Vol. 18, p. 479,
John Wiley, New York, 1982.
ller,
D. Freytag, U. Grigo, P. R. Mu
W. Nouvertne, Polycarbonates, in
Encyclopedia of Polymer Science and
Engineering, 2nd ed., Vol. 11, pp. 651
692, H. Mark, G. Menges, N.
Bikales, C. G. Overberger, J. I.
Kroschwitz (Eds.), Wiley, New York,
1988.
D. C. Clagett, S. J. Shafer,
Polycarbonates, in Comprehensive
Polymer Science; The Synthesis,
Characterization, Reactions, and
Applications of Polymers, Vol. 5, p. 345,
G. Allen, J. C. Bevington (Eds.),
Pergamon Press, Oxford, 1989.
V. Serini, Polycarbonates, in
Ullmanns Encyclopedia of Industrial
Chemistry, 5th ed., p. 207, B. Elvers,
S. Hawkins, G. Schulz (Eds.), VCH,
Weinheim, 1992.
D. G. LeGrand, J. T. Bendler (Eds.),
Handbook of Polycarbonate Science and
Technology, Marcel Dekker, New York,
2000.
D. J. Brunelle, in Encyclopedia of
Polymer Science and Engineering, 3rd
ed., Vol. 7, pp. 396426, H. Mark,
N. Bikales, J. I. Kroschwitz (Eds.),
Wiley, New York, 2003.
P. G. Kosky, J. M. Silva, E. A.
Guggenheim, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1991, 30, 462.
E. Aquino, W. J. Brittain, D. J.
Brunelle, Polymer Int. 1994, 33, 161.
P. G. Kosky, E. P. Boden, J. Polym.
Sci. A: Polym. Chem. 1990, 28, 1507.
J.-T. Gu, C. S. Wang, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci. 1992, 44, 849.
C. Wulff, H. Kauth, G. Weymans, Z.
Kricsfalussy, W. Alewelt, J. Heuser,
EP 0 517 044 to Bayer AG, 1995.
Ya. I. Korenman, A. A. Gorokhov, J.
Appl. Chem. USSR, 1974, 46, 2571.
J. M. Silva, P. K. Kosky, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 1991, 30, 468474.

References
179 P. L. Mills, Chem. Eng. Sci. 1985, 41,
180
181
182

183
184
185
186
187

188

189

190

191
192
193
194

195

196

197

198

2939.
S. Munjal, Polym. Eng. Sci. 1994, 34,
93101.
W. H. Carothers, G. T. Berchet, J.
Am. Chem. Soc. 1930, 52, 5289.
J. N. Weber, Aromatic, Polyamides in
Kirk-Othmer Encyclopedia of Chemical
Technology (on-line version), John
Wiley, New York, 2002; http://www.
mrw.interscience.wiley.com./kirk/
articles/genewebe.a01/sect10-fs.html
N. Ogata, Makromol. Chem. 1960, 42,
52.
N. Ogata, Makromol. Chem. 1961, 43,
117.
nchen)
F. Wiloth, Z. Phys. Chem. (Mu
1955, 4, 66.
C. Giori, B. T. Hayes, J. Polym. Sci. A:
Polym. Chem. Ed. 1970, 8, 335 and 351.
K. Tai, H. Teranishi, Y. Arai, T.
Tagawa, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1979, 24,
211.
D. D. Steppan, M. F. Doherty, M. F.
Malone, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1987, 33,
2333.
M. A. Schaffer, K. B. McAuley, M. F.
Cunningham, E. K. Marchildon,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 2003, 42, 2946.
M. A. Schaffer, E. K. Marchildon,
K. B. McAuley, M. F. Cunningham,
Polym. Eng. Sci. 2003, 43, 639.
F. K. Mallon, W. H. Ray, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1998, 69, 1213.
I. K. Miller, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. Ed. 1976, 14, 1403.
H. K. Reimschuessel, J. Polym. Sci.,
Macromol. Rev. 1977, 12, 65.
H. K. Reimschuessel, G. J. Dege, J.
Polym. Sci.: Polym. Chem. Ed. 1970, 8,
3265.
D. D. Steppan, M. F. Doherty, M. F.
Malone, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1991, 42,
1009.
M. A. Schaffer, E. K. Marchildon,
K. B. McAuley, M. F. Cunningham,
J. Macromol. Sci. Rev., Macromol.
Chem. Phys. 2000, C40(4), 233.
H. K. Reimschuessel, K.
Nagasubramanian, Chem. Eng. Sci.
1972, 1119.
A. Kumar, S. K. Gupta, J. Macromol.
Sci. Rev., Macromol. Chem. Phys. 1986,
C26(2), 183.

199 H. Jacobs, C. Schweigman, in

200
201

202

203

204
205
206
207

208
209
210
211
212

213
214
215
216
217
218
219

Proceedings of the 5th European/2nd


International Symposium on Chemical
Reaction Engineering, Amsterdam, May
24, p. B7.1, 1972.
German Pat. 1 167 021 to Vereinigte
Glanzstoe Fabriken, 1962.
C. S. Wang, N. X. Huang, Z. L.
Tang, K.-D. Hungenberger,
Macromol. Theory Simul. 2002, 11, 687.
M. Albert, I. Hahnenstein, H.
Hasse, G. Maurer, AIChE J. 1996, 42,
1741.
L. L. Williams, Amino Resins and
Plastics, in Kirk-Othmer Encyclopedia of
Chemical Technology (on-line version),
John Wiley, New York, 2002; http://
www.mrw.interscience.wiley.com./
kirk/articles/aminwill.a01/sect1.html
J. I. de Jong, J. de Jonge, Rec. Trav.
Chem. 1952, 71, 643.
J. I. de Jong, J. de Jonge, Rec. Trav.
Chem. 1952, 71, 661.
J. I. de Jong, J. de Jonge, Rec. Trav.
Chem. 1953, 72, 139.
A. F. Price, A. R. Cooper, A. S.
Meskin, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1980, 25,
2597.
A. Kumar, A. Sood, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci. 1990, 40, 1473.
N. Landqvist, Acta Chem. Scand.
1956, 10, 244.
J. I. de Jong, J. de Jonge, Rec. Trav.
Chem. 1953, 72, 213.
J. I. de Jong, J. de Jonge, Rec. Trav.
Chem. 1953, 72, 207.
R. M. Rammon, W. E. Johns, J.
Magnuson, A. K. Dunker, J. Adhes.
1986, 19, 115.
M. G. Kim, L. W. Amos, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 1990, 29, 208.
M. G. Kim, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. Ed. 1999, 37, 995.
M. G. Kim, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 2000,
75, 1243.
M. G. Kim, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 2001,
80, 2800.
S. Katuscak, M. Tomas, O. Schiessl,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1981, 26, 381.
C. Soulard, C. Kamoun, A. Pizzi, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci. 1999, 72, 277.
T. J. Pratt, W. E. John, R. M.
Rammon, W. L. Plagemann, J. Adhes.
1985, 17, 275.

149

150

3 Polycondensation
220 A. K. Dunker, W. E. John, R. M.

221
222
223

224
225
226

227

228
229

230

231
232

233

234
235
236
237

Rammon, B. Farmer, S. J. Johns, J.


Adhes. 1986, 19, 153.
K. Siimer, T. Pehk, P. Christjanson,
Macromol. Symp. 1999, 148, 149.
G. E. Myers, Holzforschung 1990, 44,
117.
R. Nastke, K. Dietrich, G. Reinisch,
G. Raer, J. Macromol. Sci.Chem.
1986, A23, 579.
M. Gordon, A. Alliwell, T. Wilson,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1966, 10, 1153.
B. Tomita, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. Ed. 1977, 15, 2347.
M. L. Scheepers, P. J. Adriansens,
J. M. Gelan, R. A. Carleer, D. J.
Vanderzande, N. K. de Vries, P. M.
Brandts, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. Ed. 1985, 33, 915.
S. K. Gupta, A. K. Gupta, A. K.
Ghosh, A. Kumar, Modeling of
Melamine Formaldehyde Polymerization, in Frontiers in Chemical Engineering, p. 824, L. K. Doraiswamy, R. A.
Mashelkar (Eds.), Wiley Eastern,
Delhi, 1984.
A. Kumar, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1987,
34, 1367 and 1383.
P. W. Koft, Phenolic Resins, in KirkOthmer Encyclopedia of Chemical
Technology (on-line version), John
Wiley, New York, 2003; http://www.
mrw.interscience.wiley.com./kirk/
articles/phenkoft.a01/abstract-fs.html
P. M. Frontini, T. R. Cuadrado,
R. J. J. Williams, Polymer 1982, 23,
267.
A. Kumar, S. K. Gupta, N. Somu,
B. Kumar, Polymer 1982, 23, 215.
S. Ishida, Y. Tsutsumi, K. Kaneko, J.
Polym. Sci. A: Polym. Chem. Ed. 1981,
19, 1609.
A. A. Zavitsas, R. D. Beaulieu, J. R.
LeBlanc, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. Ed. 1968, 6, 2541.
S. K. Gupta, A. Kumar, P. K. Pal,
Polymer 1981, 22, 1691.
P. K. Pal, A. Kumar, S. K. Gupta,
Brit. Polym. J. 1980, 12, 21.
M. G. Kim, L. W. Amos, E. E. Barnes,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1990, 29, 2032.
G. Astarloa-Aierbe, J. M. Echeverria,
J. L. Egiburu, M. Ormaetxea, I.
Mondragon, Polymer 1998, 39, 3147.

238 C. C. Riccardi, G. Astarloa-Aierbe,

239

240
241

242

243
244
245
246
247

248
249

250
251
252

253

254
255
256
257

J. M. Echeverria, I. Mondragon,
Polym. 2002, 43, 1631.
L. B. Manfredi, C. C. Riccardi,
O. de la Osa, A. Vazquez, Polym. Intl.
2001, 50, 796.
E. Kumpinsky, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1994, 33, 285.
H. Lee, K. Neville, Handbook of Epoxy
Resins, 1st ed., McGraw-Hill, New
York, 1967.
N. S. Enikolopyan, M. A. Markevitch, L. S. Sakhonenko, S. Z.
Rogovina, V. G. Oshmyan, J. Polym.
Sci. A: Polym. Chem. Ed. 1982, 20,
1231.
J. G. Gao, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1993, 48,
237.
P. A. Oyanguren, R. J. J. Williams,
Polym. 1992, 33, 2736.
M. E. Smith, H. Ishida,
Macromolecules 1994, 27, 2701.
O. Baeyer, Angew. Chem. 1947, A59,
257.
H. Ulrich, Urethane Polymers, in
Kirk-Othmer Encyclopedia of Chemical
Technology (on-line version), John
Wiley, New York, 2000; http://www.
mrw.interscience.wiley.com./kirk/
articles/uretulri.a01/sect2.html
G. Oertel, Polyurethane Handbook,
2nd ed., Hanser, Munich, 1993.
C. W. Macosko, RIM, fundamentals of
Reaction Injection Molding, 1st ed.,
Hanser, Munich, 1989.
A.-C. Draye, J. J. Tondeur, J. Mol.
Cat. A. Chem. 1999, 138, 135.
K. Schwetlick, R. Noack, F. Stebner,
J. Chem. Soc. Perkin Trans. 2, 1994, 599.
M. Sprkova, M. Kubn, P. Spacek, I.
Krakovsky, K. Dusek, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci. 1994, 52, 895.
M. Sprkova, M. Kubn, P. Spacek, I.
Krakovsky, K. Dusek, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci. 1994, 53, 1435.
K. Schwetlick, R. Noack, J. Chem.
Soc. Perkin Trans. 2 1995, 395.
M. C. Pannone, C. W. Macosko, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci. 1987, 34, 2409.
M. C. Pannone, C. W. Macosko,
Polym. Eng. Sci. 1988, 28, 660.
T. A. Speckhard, J. A. Miller, S. L.
Cooper, Macromolecules 1986, 19,
1558.

References
258 J. A. Miller, T. A. Speckhard, S. L.
259

260
261
262
263
264
265

266
267

268
269

270
271
272
273

274
275
276

Cooper, Macromolecules 1986, 19, 1568.


J. A. Miller, T. A. Speckhard, J. G.
Homan, S. L. Cooper, Polymer 1987,
28, 758.
L. C. Case, J. Polym. Sci. 1960, 45, 397.
J. Scanlan, J. Polym. Sci. 1960, 43,
501.
P. L. Mills, Comp. Chem. Eng. 1986,
10, 399.
M. R. P. F. N. Costa, J. Villermaux,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1988, 27, 421.
J. Abate, W. Whitt, Oper. Res. Lett.
1992, 12, 245.
A. Brandolin, M. Asteasuain, C.
Sarmoria, A. Lopez-Rodriguez, K. S.
Whiteley, B. del Amo Fernandez,
Polym. Eng. Sci. 2001, 41, 1156.
S. I. Kuchanov, S. V. Korolev, M. G.
Slinko, Polym. J. 1983, 15, 785.
S. I. Kuchanov, S. V. Korolev, M. G.
Slinko, Vysokomol. Soyed. 1982, A42,
2160; Polym. Sci. USSR 1982, 24,
2477.
M. Gordon, G. R. Scantlebury, Proc.
Roy. Soc. 1966, A292, 380.
K. Dusek, M. Gordon, S. B. RossMurphy, Macromolecules 1978, 11,
236.
D. Stauffer, Pure Appl. Chem. 1981,
53, 1479.
M. Gordon, J. A. Torkington, Pure
Appl. Chem. 1981, 53, 1461.
S. I. Kuchanov, Dokl. Akad. Nauk.
SSSR 1987, 294, 633.
S. I. Kuchanov, S. V. Korolev, S. V.
Panyukov, Adv. Chem. Phys. 1988, 72,
115.
W. H. Abraham, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Fundam. 1963, 2, 221.
H. Kilkson, Ind. Eng. Chem. Fundam.
1964, 3, 281.
H. Kilkson, Ind. Eng. Chem. Fundam.
1968, 7, 354.

277 S. I. Kuchanov, Methods of Kinetic

278

279
280
281

282
283

284
285
286
287
288

289
290

291

Calculations in Polymer Chemistry,


Khimiya, Moscow, 1978 (in Russian).
S. I. Kuchanov, Ye. S. Povolotskaya,
Vysokomol. Soyed. 1982, A24, 2190;
Polym. Sci. USSR 1982, 24, 2512.
K. Dusek, J. Somvarsky, Polym. Bull.
1983, 13, 313.
J. Mikes, K. Dusek, Macromolecules
1982, 15, 93.
S. I. Kuchanov, A. G. Kholostyakov,
J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym. Chem. 1999,
37, 2145.
M. R. P. F. N. Costa, R. C. S. Dias,
Chem. Eng. Sci. 1994, 49, 491.
R. Courant, D. Hilbert, Partial
Dierential Equations (Methods of
Mathematical Physics, Vol. II), pp. 97
105, Interscience Publishers, New
York, 1962.
L. M. Pismen, S. I. Kuchanov,
Polym. Sci. USSR 1971, 13, 890.
S. I. Kuchanov, L. M. Pismen,
Polym. Sci. USSR 1972, 14, 147.
S. I. Kuchanov, L. M. Pismen,
Polym. Sci. USSR, 1972, 14, 985.
H. Galina, A. Szustalewicz,
Macromolecules 1989, 22, 3124.
F. D. Magalhaes, M. R. P. F. N.
Costa, in 3rd Berlin International
Workshop on Polymer Reaction
Engineering, p. 311, K. H. Reichert,
W. Geiseler (Eds.), DECHEMA
Monographs, VCH, Weinheim, 1989.
S. I. Kuchanov, T. V. Zharnikov, J.
Stat. Phys. 2003, 111, 1273.
M. R. P. F. N. Costa, R. C. S. Dias, in
6th International Workshop on Polymer
Reaction Engineering, DECHEMA
Monographs, Vol. 134, pp. 197205,
K. H. Reichert, H.-U. Moritz (Eds.),
Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 1998.
M. R. P. F. N. Costa, J. Villermaux,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1989, 28, 702.

151

153

Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous1


Robin A. Hutchinson

Free-radical polymerization (FRP) is one of the most important commercial processes for preparing high molecular weight polymers. It can be applied to almost
all vinyl monomers under mild reaction conditions over a wide temperature range
and, although requiring the absence of oxygen, is tolerant of water. Multiple monomers can be easily copolymerized via FRP, leading to the preparation of an endless
range of copolymers with properties dependent on the proportion of the incorporated comonomers. This chapter will provide an overview of the kinetics and mechanisms, and the techniques used to construct mathematical representations of
bulk and solution FRP. The description will also serve as a good base for the suspension and emulsion FRP chapters that follow.

4.1

FRP Properties and Applications

Polymers produced via free-radical chemistry include the following major families:


Low-density polyethylene (LDPE) and copolymers, used primarily in lms and


packaging applications. LDPE has density of <0.94 g cm3 , and is produced via
high-pressure free-radical polymerization; polyethylenes of higher density (and
polypropylene) are produced via transition metal catalysis, as described elsewhere (see Chapter 8).
 Poly(vinyl chloride) and copolymers, used primarily to produce pipe and ttings,
ooring material, and lms and sheet.
 Polystyrene and its co- and terpolymers with acrylonitrile and butadiene. Homopolymer is used for packaging and containers, while the acrylonitrile-containing
polymers are used for various molded products in the appliance, electronics, and

1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

154

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

automotive industries. Styrenebutadiene is the most widely used synthetic


rubber.
 Acrylic- and methacrylic-based polymers. Poly(methyl methacrylate) (PMMA),
due to its transparency and weatherability, is used extensively in signs, lighting
xtures, and windows. Polyacrylates and copolymers are used extensively in the
adhesives and coatings markets, and are also combined with acrylonitrile to
make acrylic bers.
 Poly(vinyl acetate) and copolymers, used extensively in adhesives, coatings, and
paper and textile treatment.
 Fluoropolymers including polytetrauoroethylene and copolymers, used widely
in the wire and cable industry. They also have many specialty applications as
coatings due to their inertness and low-surface tension.
In addition to these major product families, there exist many other smaller-volume
(but often high-value) polymeric products synthesized via free-radical chemistry.
These products are manufactured via heterogeneous (emulsion, suspension) or
homogeneous (bulk, solution) polymerization in a wide range of reactor congurations ranging from tubular to well-mixed tanks (and everything in between) in processes that may be continuous, batch, or semi-batch. FRP kinetics together with reactor design and operating conditions controls the composition and architecture of
the polymer produced. As with other chemistries, the nal product consists of a
mixture of polymer chains with varying length, composition, and structural properties such as branch points and branch lengths. The processing and end-use properties of the polymer depend upon the distributions of these characteristics, not just
the average values. Thus it is necessary to develop methods to relate the fundamental kinetic mechanisms of free-radical polymerization to these distributed characteristics.

4.2

Chain Initiation

Free-radical polymerization, like other chain growth mechanisms, involves the sequential addition of vinyl monomers to an active center. The dening characteristic
of FRP is that the active centers are free radicals. Each growing polymeric radical
increases in size rapidly; a typical chain is initiated, grows to high molecular
weight, and is terminated in the time scale of, at most, a few seconds. When the
macromolecule stops growing it cannot generally react further (barring side reactions), and is considered dead. These dead chains have a residence time of minutes or hours in the polymerization reactor, and the nal polymer product is an
intimate mixture of chains formed under time and/or spatially varying conditions.
The free radicals that initiate polymerization are in most cases generated by thermal or photochemical homolytic cleavage of covalent bonds. Commercial initiators
include azo and peroxy compounds. The driving force for the dissociation of azo

4.2 Chain Initiation

155

initiators is the formation of the stable nitrogen molecule and resonance stabilized
tertiary radicals, as shown for 2,2 0 -azobisisobutyronitrile (AIBN) in Scheme 4.1.

N N

H3C

N2

CH3

2 C

CH3

CH3

CH3

CH3
Scheme 4.1.

CN

CN

CN

Decomposition of AIBN.

Many types of peroxides (R-O-O-R 0 ) are also utilized, including diacyl peroxides,
peroxydicarbonates, peroxyesters, dialkyl peroxides, and inorganic peroxides such
as persulfate, the latter being used mainly in water-based systems. The rate of peroxide decomposition as well as the subsequent reaction pathway is greatly aected
by the nature of the peroxide chemical structure, as illustrated for tert-butyl peroxyesters in Scheme 4.2. Pathway (a), the formation of an acyloxy and an alkoxy radical via single bond scission, is favored for structures in which the carbon atom in
the a-position to the carbonyl group is primary (for example, tert-butyl peroxyacetate, R CH3 ). Pathway (b), concerted two-bond scission, occurs for secondary
and tertiary peroxyesters (for example, tert-butyl peroxypivalate, R C(CH3 )3 ) [1,
2]. The tert-butoxy radical formed in both pathways may decompose to acetone
and a methyl radical, or abstract a hydrogen atom to form tert-butanol.
The exact nature of the decomposition pathway is important, as it plays a role in
the eciency of the primary radicals in initiating new polymer chains. When an
initiator decomposes, the primary radicals are nearest neighbors surrounded by a
cage of other molecules through which they must diuse to escape from each
other before they recombine. Once one radical leaves the cage it is extremely unlikely that the pair will encounter each other again. In-cage reactions for pathway
(a) in Scheme 4.2 will lead to the re-formation of the original initiator molecule,
while the in-cage reactions for pathway (b) lead to the formation of an ether which
is not capable of forming free radicals by another dissociation step.

CH3

O
O

+O

(a)
CH3

CH3

CH3

O
R

(b)
CH3

.
R

CH3

+ CO2 +

CH3

Decomposition of tert-butyl peroxyesters. The


preferred pathway depends on the nature of the R substituent.
Scheme 4.2.

In general, peroxide decomposition can yield both carbon- and oxygen-centered


primary radicals that add to the carboncarbon double monomer bond to form a
new propagating chain, abstract hydrogen atoms from other molecules (including

CH3
CH3

156

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

polymer) in the system, or recombine to form inactive compounds. The relative


rates of these processes are dependent on both the nature of the primary radicals
and the monomer system. The mechanistic pathway followed will inuence endgroup structures of the polymeric products, aecting nal properties such as thermal stability. Further details on initiator decomposition kinetics and mechanistic
pathways can be found in the excellent monograph by Moad and Solomon [3].
The above discussion highlights the fact that the simple initiation process of
most polymer texts is the exception rather than the rule, with the fraction of primary radicals that initiate a new polymer chain a complex function of the reaction
system. Nonetheless, the kinetic treatment is usually simplied by the introduction
of a fractional initiator eciency ( f ), formally dened by Eq. (1), where n is the
number of moles of primary radicals generated per mole of initiator; n 2 for
most common initiators.

Initiation Rate of Propagating Chains


nRate of Initiator Disappearance

The initiator eciency is normally in the range 0.40.9, with a low value indicating
inecient usage of the initiator and potentially a high formation rate of undesired
by-products.
The kinetic descriptions in this chapter are developed for thermal unimolecular
scission of a compound to yield two radicals, as this is the most common means of
generating radicals in industrial systems. Thermal initiation of monomers is an additional mechanism capable of forming primary radicals at higher temperatures, as
discussed for styrene (see Section 4.3.1.3). Other initiation systems are also available, and bear a brief mention at this point. Initiators with multiple peroxide linkages n > 2 have been the subject of recent academic study [4]. Photoinitiators
that produce radicals by ultraviolet irradiation are commonly used to initiate crosslinking and curing reactions in polymeric systems, as the rate of initiation can be
controlled through the intensity and location of the light source. And nally, a redox (reductionoxidation) process is often used to initiate chains in emulsion polymerization (see Chapter 6).

4.3

Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

It is important to achieve an understanding of how the basic FRP mechanisms


control polymerization rate and average polymer chain length. This section starts
with the derivation of appropriate kinetic expressions for a single monomer
system. Complicating (but industrially important) secondary reactions are then
introduced, followed by the extension to multi-monomer systems. Dispersed
throughout are up-to-date estimates for important free-radical polymerization rate
coecients, and descriptions of how they are obtained experimentally.

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

4.3.1

Homopolymerization

Many commercial polymers, including polystyrene, PMMA, and LDPE, are synthesized via homogeneous free-radical polymerization of a single monomer. Homopolymer properties are controlled by average chain length and chain-length distribution as well as, in some cases, structural characteristics such as branching level.
Basic Mechanisms
The basic set of FRP mechanisms includes initiation, propagation, termination,
and transfer to monomer and solvent or transfer agent, as shown in Scheme 4.3.
4.3.1.1

Initiator Decomposition

d
I
2 f I

Chain Initiation

i
I + M
P1

Chain Propagation

Pn + M Pn +1

kp

Chain Termination
k

By Combination

tc
Pn + Pm
Dn+m

By Disproportionation

td
Pn + Pm
Dn + Dm

Chain Transfer
k mon

To Monomer

tr
Pn + M
Dn + M *

k mon

i
M * + M
P1

k sol

To Solvent or Agent
Scheme 4.3.

tr
Pn + S
Dn + S *

k sol

i
S * + M
P1

Basic free-radical homopolymerization mechanism.

The subscript n denotes the number of monomeric units in growing polymer


radicals (Pn ) and dead polymer chains (Dn ). Each reaction has an associated kinetic
rate law expression and a specic rate coecient. The free-radical initiator (I) unimolecularly decomposes (with rate coecient kd ) to form two primary radicals (I  )
with eciency f. Chain initiation occurs when the primary radical adds to monomer M, and chain growth continues via successive addition of monomer units to
the radical center (chain propagation, with rate coecient k p ). Bimolecular coupling of two growing chains results in the loss of two radicals from the system
and the formation of either one (termination by combination, k tc ) or two (termination by disproportionation, k td ) dead polymer chains. Chain stoppage may also occur via a transfer mechanism, where the growing radical abstracts a weakly bonded

157

158

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

atom (usually hydrogen) from monomer or other molecules (solvent or chaintransfer agent, denoted by S) in the system to generate a dead polymer chain as
well as a new radical that initiates another polymer chain.
A key assumption implicit in the formulation of Scheme 4.3 is that the rates
of propagation, transfer, and termination reactions are independent of n, the
length(s) of the radical(s) involved. It is known that propagation and likely transfer
reactions involving very short chains (n 1; 2; 3) are faster by a factor of 10 than
addition to long-chain radicals [5], but this eect diminishes rapidly with chain
length and has a negligible eect on the overall kinetics of the system. Chain termination, the coupling of two polymeric radicals, is a very fast chemical process
that is controlled by the rate at which the two radicals nd each other in the reaction system. The nature of this diusion control makes termination the most complex reaction in the polymerization process since the apparent rate coecient can
vary greatly with system conditions such as monomer conversion and solution viscosity (see Section 4.3.3). Although termination may also exhibit some chainlength dependence, most engineering treatments of FRP neglect this complex dependence. For further discussion of the individual mechanisms of Scheme 4.3 and
their rate coecients, see Section 4.3.1.2.
The set of rate laws that can be written from Scheme 4.3 is given by Eqs. (2)(6).
Initiator Decomposition

R d kd I

Chain Initiation

R init 2f kd I

Chain Propagation

R p k p MPtot 

4
2

Chain Termination

R term k tc k td Ptot  k t Ptot 

Chain Transfer

R tr ktrmon M ktrsol SPtot 

5
6

Here Ptot represents the concentration of all polymer radicals in the system [Eq.
(7)].

Ptot 

y
X
Pn 

n1

In some literature the right-hand side of the termination rate expression [Eq. (5)] is
written as 2k t Ptot  2 . The mode of termination combination or disproportionation
has no eect on the overall termination rate, and thus the two events can also be
expressed by the nomenclature of Eq. (8), where d is the fraction of the termination
events that occur by disproportionation.
k t k tc k td ;

k td
k tc k td

The following assumptions are widely accepted and usually valid in FRP systems:

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

The small radical species I  ; M  , and S  are not consumed by side reactions and
do not accumulate in the system, but are converted to polymeric radicals with
100% eciency. Thus, the total rate of polymer radical formation is given by
(R init R tr . The net formation of polymeric radicals is R init , since transfer
events both consume and create a polymeric radical species.
 With a continuous source of new radicals in the system, an equilibrium is
achieved instantaneously between radical generation and consumption, such
that R init R term . This characteristic, proven to be true for almost all FRP conditions [6], is a result of the fast dynamics of radical reactions compared to that of
the overall polymerization system. Often referred to as radical stationarity or the
quasi-steady-state assumption (QSSA), it leads to the well-known analytical expression for total radical concentration [Eq. (9)].



Ptot 


R init
kt

1=2

2f kd I
kt

1=2
9

The consumption of monomer by chain-initiation or transfer events is negligible


compared to that by propagation. This result, called the long-chain hypothesis
(LCH), must be true if high molecular weight polymer is being produced. Thus
the rate of polymerization (disappearance of monomer) can be taken as equal to
the rate of propagation (R pol R p ) with the rate of heat generation proportional
to the rate of this exothermic reaction.

Under these (generally valid) assumptions, the classic expressions for rate of polymerization (R pol ), kinetic chain length (u, the average number of monomer units
on a living chain), and instantaneous degree of polymerization (DPninst , the average
number of monomer units on a dead polymer chain formed at any instant) are
given in Eqs. (10)(12), respectively.


1=2

R pol

2f kd I
k p MPtot  k p M
kt

Rp
k p M

R term R tr k t Ptot  ktrmon M ktrsol S

DPninst

k p M
k td 0:5k tc Ptot  ktrmon M ktrsol S

10

11

12

The dierence between Eqs. (11) and (12) arises because termination by combination yields a single polymer chain such that the chain length of dead polymer
formed (DPninst ) is greater than the chain length of polymer radicals (u) in the system at the same instant.
Table 4.1 lists the range of concentration and rate coecient values typically encountered in homogeneous free-radical polymerization systems at low conversion.
These can be combined with Eqs. (9)(12) to illustrate the tradeos involved be-

159

160

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous


Tab. 4.1. Typical values of coecients and concentrations in
low-conversion homogeneous FRP systems.

Coecient/Concentration

Typical range

kd [s1 ]
f
k p [L mol1 s1 ]
k t [L mol1 s1 ][a]
ktrmon =k p
ktrsol =k p
[I] [mol L1 ]
[M] [mol L1 ]
[S] [mol L1 ]

106 104
0.40.9
10 2 10 4
10 6 10 8
106 104
106 103
104 102
110
110

[a] At

low conversion.

tween the desire for high throughput (R pol ) and the need to produce high MW
(DPn ) polymer.


The denominator of Eq. (12), the rate of dead chain formation, must be of the
order 105 108 chains L1 s1 in order to produce polymer with a DPn of
10 2 10 4 . Individual polymer radicals exist on average only for a fraction of a second, as calculated by the expression u=k p M). Thus after the rst few seconds of
polymerization, the concentration of dead polymer chains is higher than that of
polymeric radicals, and by the end of a typical polymerization the concentration
of dead chains is orders of magnitude higher than [Ptot ]. Final polymer MW and
MWD (molecular weight distribution) are controlled by how the concentrations
and kinetic coecients in Eq. (12) vary with polymer conversion.
 The theoretical MW limit for a system is controlled by transfer events, and is calculated by setting [Ptot ] to zero in Eq. (12). For bulk FRP with no solvent, limiting
values of DPn are 10 4 10 6 . However, this theoretical limit can only be approached in homogeneous FRP by reducing rates of polymerization to extremely
low levels. For most systems both termination and transfer events play an important role in controlling polymer MW.
 To produce high MW polymer (DPn of 10 2 10 4 ) it is necessary to keep total radical concentration low, so that [Ptot ] is of the order 108 106 mol L1 . This dictates the choice of initiator such that R init (the product of kd and [I]) is also of
order 108 106 mol L1 s1 .
 Transfer can occur to monomer, solvent or any other species in the system. In
some cases, chain-transfer agents are added deliberately to limit and control polymer DPn . These agents are generally chosen such that the rate of abstraction is
much higher than that which occurs with monomer or solvent (k tr =k p 103
10 0 ) and thus can be added in trace quantities (f 1 mol L1 ). The use of transfer
agents allows for independent manipulation and control of R pol and DPn , but is
only possible if the desired MW is less than that achieved for the corresponding
transfer-free reaction.

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics




Initial rates of polymerization (monomer consumption rates) at low conversion


are of order 104 102 mol L1 s1 . Approximately 10 3 10 5 s are required to
take a batch system to complete conversion. Faster rates can be achieved by increasing R init , but at the expense of decreased polymer MW. Achievable values
of R pol are also often limited by the heat removal capabilities of the reactor system, as the heat released by monomer addition is of the order 50100 kJ mol1 .

It should be cautioned that these statements are generalities for a typical FRP system. Rate coecients vary with monomer, initiator, and solvent choice (see Section
4.3.1.2) as well as polymerization conditions, and the kinetic treatment is complicated by the occurrence of side reactions (Section 4.3.1.3) and the variation of k t
with conversion and other system conditions (Section 4.3.3). These factors necessitate the use of more-powerful modeling techniques to quantitatively describe FRP
systems (Section 4.4). Nonetheless, Eqs. (9)(12) provide an idea of the factors controlling rate and MW, and are very useful for a qualitative examination of FRP
systems.
Kinetic Coecients
The coupling of polymer MW and polymerization rate is further illustrated via rearrangement of Eq. (12) to give Eq. (13).
4.3.1.2

1
0:5k tc Ptot  k td Ptot  ktrmon ktrsol S

inst
k p M
k p M
k p M
kp
DPn

0:5k tc R pol
kp2 M 2

k td R pol
kp2 M 2

ktrmon ktrsol S

k p M
kp

13

R pol [Eq. (10)] and DPn are both dependent on k 2p =k t , with DPn also a function of
mode of termination (disproportionation versus combination) and chain transfer.
Although R pol and DPn are easily measured experimentally, it is not possible to resolve the quantities into estimates for individual rate coecients. Even the estimation of the ratio k 2p =k t from R pol requires independent knowledge of initiator characteristics f and kd , and the assumption that radicals are not being consumed or
retarded by adventitious impurities in the system. These factors have led to considerable scatter in rate coecients reported in the literature (for example, Ref. 7), especially for individual rate coecients [8, 9]. Yet individual values, and knowledge
of how they vary with temperature, are required for model development and an accurate representation of multi-monomer systems. The emergence of specialized
experimental techniques since 1988 has greatly improved this situation and led to
an improved understanding of free-radical polymerization kinetics. The following
discussion highlights some of these advances, as well as summarizing key FRP
rate coecients as expressed by the Arrhenius law [Eq. (14)].
k i A i expEi 0:1DVi P=RT

14

161

162

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Activation energies (Ei ) and volumes (DVi ) are reported with units of kJ mol1 and
cm 3 mol1 respectively, with T in K and P in bar. All second-order rate coecients
are reported with units of L mol1 s1 .
Initiation Thermal scission of an initiator is the most common means of generating radicals in FRP (see Section 4.2). This unimolecular reaction is characterized
by a rst-order rate coecient (kd , s1 ) so that, for a constant-volume batch system,
Eq. (2) may be integrated to yield Eq. (15), with I0 the initial concentration at
t 0.

I I0 expkd t

15

The decomposition kinetics is often expressed by the half-life of the initiator, the
time needed for the concentration to decrease to half of its initial value [Eq. (16)].
t 1=2 ln 2=kd

16

The requirements for an initiator can vary widely: an initiator with a half-life of 10
h might be used in an academic study so that [I] does not change signicantly during the course of an experiment, while an initiator used for high-pressure ethylene
polymerization typically has a half-life on the order of a few seconds. Activation energies for thermal homolysis of peroxide and azo compounds are in the range of
100150 kJ mol1 , and thus decomposition rates are very temperature-sensitive:
the t 1=2 of benzoyl peroxide drops from 13 h at 70 C to 0.4 h at 100 C. The dependence on pressure is much less, in the range of 0 to 15 cm 3 mol1 [1, 2], but still
important for high-pressure LDPE systems. Special care must be taken in handling
and transport of thermal initiators, especially those with faster decomposition
rates.
Values of kd at a particular temperature and pressure can be determined by measuring initiator concentration as a function of reaction time using a technique such
as infrared spectroscopy. The experimental diculty increases as half-life shortens,
where special care must be taken to eliminate transient nonisothermal eects. Decomposition kinetics are summarized for a wide range of initiators in the Polymer
Handbook [7] and in trade literature available from commercial suppliers. Of special note is the recent work of Buback and co-workers that systematically examines
not only how Ed and DVd vary with alkyl substituent for the peroxyester family
(Scheme 4.2), but also how the substituent choice aects the decomposition pathway and initiator eciency [1, 2].
Propagation In general, chain growth or propagation proceeds in a highly selective manner to yield a polymer chain consisting of head-to-tail linkages (Scheme
4.4). In order for high polymer to be formed the propagating radical must not be
too stable: addition must occur at a suciently high rate in comparison with competing transfer and termination events.

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

R1
CH2

R1

C
R2

Scheme 4.4.

R1
CH2 C

H2C
R2

R2

R1
CH2

C
R2

Free-radical chain propagation.

A number of nonsteady polymerization rate techniques have been introduced to


measure k p , many prone to signicant error [8, 9]. The introduction of a new
method, that couples pulsed-laser-induced polymerization (PLP) with size exclusion chromatographic (SEC) analysis of the resulting polymer [10], has greatly improved the reliability of k p data. In this technique, a mixture of monomer and photoinitiator is illuminated by short laser pulses separated by a time of t 0 , typically
0.010.2 s. Propagation and termination (but no initiation) occur between pulses,
with the radical concentration and the rate of termination both decreasing with
time according to Eq. (5). Those growing macroradicals formed by a laser pulse
which escape termination will all have the same chain length (within a narrow
Poisson distribution) that increases with time. There is a high probability that
these surviving radicals will be terminated at t 0 , when a new population of short
radicals are generated by the next laser pulse. Thus, a signicant fraction of dead
chains formed have a chain length DP0 corresponding to a lifetime of t 0 seconds
[Eq. (17)].
DP0 k p Mt 0

17

Since radicals have a certain probability of surviving the laser ash and of terminating at a later pulse, the relative concentration of polymer with chain lengths
2DP0 ; 3DP0 ; . . . is also increased. As a result, PLP produces a well-structured
MWD with peaks at chain lengths of DP0 and its multiples, as shown in Figure
4.1. With known values for t 0 and [M] (kept constant, as samples are pulsed only
long enough to allow a conversion of 13%), Eq. (17) yields a direct estimate of k p
from the experimentally-determined value of DP0 .
PLP-SEC has proven to be a very simple and robust experimental technique for
determining k p and its temperature dependence, provided adequate care is taken
with SEC analysis. Data collected from various research laboratories around the
world have been compiled in a series of papers for styrene [11] and methacrylates
[1214]. These papers provide benchmark k p data for these monomer systems, illustrate the good agreement between facilities (typically 1020%), and make recommendations for best experimental practices.
Table 4.2 summarizes the Arrhenius parameters for free-radical propagation of
a wide range of monomers, as determined by PLP-SEC. An extensive review by
Beuermann and Buback [15] contains further discussion and data for additional
monomers. The data for acrylates are limited, due to measurement diculties arising from additional secondary mechanisms that occur (see Section 4.3.1.3). What

163

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous


1.2

2DP0

1
wt log(MW)

164

0.8

DP0

0.6
0.4
0.2
0
3.5

4.5

5.5

6.5

Log MW

A typical PLP-generated MWD, as measured by SEC


for poly(butyl methacrylate) produced by PLP of bulk butyl
methacrylate at 25 C and a laser repetition rate of 10 Hz. DP0
is determined from the inection point of the peak, obtained by
dierentiating the distribution.
Fig. 4.1.

is striking is not only the large variation in k p and activation energies between
monomer families, but also the similar behavior within a monomer family. All
methacrylates exhibit a similar temperature (Ep of 21 to 23 kJ mol1 ) and pressure
(DVp of 15 to 17 cm 3 mol1 ) dependence, and the k p values for alkyl methacrylates at 50 C increase with increasing size of the alkyl ester group (methyl to dodecyl) by a factor of less than 2. The alkyl acrylate family exhibits exactly the same
trends, although the activation energies (17 to 18 kJ mol1 ) and volumes (10 to
12 cm 3 mol1 ) are lower than for methacrylates, and the values of k p at 50 C

Tab. 4.2.

Arrhenius k p parameters for various monomers determined by PLP-SEC.[a]

Monomer

Ep
[kJ molC1 ]

DVp
[cm 3 molC1 ]

Ap
[L molC1 sC1 ]

Ethylene
Styrene
Methyl methacrylate
Butyl methacrylate
Dodecyl methacrylate
Glycidyl methacrylate
Cyclohexyl methacrylate
2-Hydroxypropyl
methacrylate
Vinyl acetate
Methyl acrylate
Butyl acrylate
Dodecyl acrylate

34.3
32.5
22.4
22.9
21.0
22.9
23.0
20.8

27.0
12.1
16.7
16.5
16.0
15.0
16.2
n.d.

1:88  10 7
4:27  10 7
2:67  10 6
3:78  10 6
2:50  10 6
6:19  10 6
6:29  10 6
3:51  10 6

54
238
648
757
995
1230
1204
1504

20.7
17.7
17.4
17.0

10.7
11.7
n.d.
11.7

1:47  10 7
1:66  10 7
1:81  10 7
1:79  10 7

6625
22 900
27 900
32 000

[a] All

values taken from Ref. 15; n.d., not determined.

k p at 50 C/1 atm
[L molC1 sC1 ]

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

are 30 to 40 times greater. The propagation behavior is aected more signicantly


by electron-donating or -withdrawing substituents present in functional monomers
such as glycidyl and 2-hydroxypropyl methacrylates. The PLP-SEC method has also
been utilized to show that there is little to no solvent inuence on propagation kinetics of most monomers [15]. However, the propagation kinetics of acrylic acid in
water is a strong function of concentration, a result that may be explained by a
change in local monomer concentration around the propagating radical center
[16].
With accurate estimates of k p now available, the possibility of correlating the coecient with the structural characteristics of the propagating radicals and monomers is receiving attention. While some progress has been made in relating activation energy to reaction enthalpy corrected for polar and resonance factors [17],
more work is required for quantitative predictions.
Termination With independent measures of k p available, k t can now be estimated
from the lumped ratio of k 2p =k t . Specialized techniques involving pulsed-laserinduced polymerization have also been developed to yield accurate estimates of
the ratio k p =k t [15]. Termination rates in FRP are always diusion-controlled so
that the apparent value of k t depends on the conditions under which it has been
measured, including the lengths of the radicals involved in the reaction. Nonetheless, the assumption of chain-length independence is usually made for modeling
of commercial FRP systems, since the errors introduced are not large. For a more
detailed discussion of the diusion-controlled nature of the termination reaction,
including its strong conversion dependence, see Section 4.3.3.
Most measurements of k t have been carried out at low monomer conversion,
and thus it is useful to tabulate available data in this regime. Signicant scatter,
as much as an order of magnitude, is found in the data contained in the Polymer
Handbook [7], as reected in the vinyl acetate k t data in Table 4.3. The uncertainty

Tab. 4.3.

Arrhenius kt parameters for various monomers.[a]

Monomer

Et
[kJ molC1 ]

DVt
[cm 3 molC1 ]

At
[L molC1 sC1 ]

k t at 50 C/1 atm
[L molC1 sC1 ]

Ethylene
Styrene
Methyl methacrylate
Butyl methacrylate
Dodecyl methacrylate
Vinyl acetate
Methyl acrylate
Butyl acrylate
Dodecyl acrylate

4.6
6.5
4.1
4.1[b]
4.1[b]

6.7
4.0
1.7

15.6
14
15
15[b]
15[b]

20
16
21

1:6  10 9
2:2  10 9
4:3  10 8
8:5  10 7
2:8  10 7

6:0  10 9
5:1  10 8
2:1  10 7

2:9  10 8
2:0  10 8
9:4  10 7
1:9  10 7
6:2  10 6
(550)  10 7 [c]
5:1  10 8
1:2  10 8
1:1  10 7

[a] All

values taken from Ref. 15, unless otherwise indicated.


equal to MMA value.
[c] From Ref. 7.
[b] Assumed

165

166

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

arises from a number of measurement and interpretation factors [18]. The rest of
the data in Table 4.3 are based on PLP studies, and have a higher level of accuracy
(within a factor of 2); these are taken from the recent review by Beuermann and
Buback [15], adjusted to conform to the convention used in Eq. (5) for the termination rate. Note the large dierence in magnitude between values for styrene, methyl methacrylate, and methyl acrylate (k t of 1  10 8 5  10 8 L mol1 s1 )
and values for dodecyl acrylate and dodecyl methacrylate (@0:5  10 7 1  10 7
L mol1 s1 ). This has been attributed to dierences in segmental diusion rates
and/or steric hindrance of the large ester side groups. The reported activation
energies and volumes are consistent with the diusion-controlled nature of the
reaction.
The mode of termination is also of importance, as it aects the molecular architecture of the polymer formed, and thus some of its properties. Polymer polydispersity (Mw/Mn ) is 1.5 if all chains are terminated by combination of two radicals,
and 2 if chains are terminated by disproportionation or chain transfer. As shown in
Scheme 4.5, termination by combination results in head-to-head linkages in the
polymer chain, whereas disproportionation results in the formation of an unsaturated end group that may undergo further reaction.

R1

R1
CH2

C
R2

C
R2

CH2

R1

R1

CH2 C

R2

R2
Scheme 4.5.

R2
R1

R1
CH2 CH

CH2

CH

R2

Free-radical chain termination by combination and disproportionation.

The relative importance of termination by disproportionation versus combination expressed by d [Eq. (8)] is dicult to measure. The value depends largely on
the structure of the monomer: d is in the range of 0.50.8 for a-methylvinyl monomers such as the methacrylates and 0.050.2 for styrene and acrylates [3]. A weak
temperature dependency has been proposed, but is dicult to verify within the
scatter of the data [19].
Chain transfer Chain transfer in radical polymerization involves the transfer of
the radical center from a polymeric radical to another molecule. It can occur to all
of the substances present in the polymerization system, and always causes a reduction in u and DPninst . Scheme 4.3 includes only transfer to monomer and solvent (or
added transfer agent), but transfer to initiator and dead polymer can also occur.
The former is often neglected since [I] is small relative to the concentration of
other species, while the latter can be an important reaction impacting MWD and

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

nal polymer properties (see Section 4.3.1.3). As well as reducing chain length, the
fragments from the transfer reactions (I  and M  in Scheme 4.3) are incorporated
as end groups in the nal polymer product.
The rate and MW equations in Section 4.3.1.1 were derived assuming that the
radicals formed by transfer reinitiate new polymeric radicals quickly, within about
the same time period as that required for a propagation step (k imon A k isol A k p ).
This assumption is valid for transfer to most species, and can be veried by examining whether addition of the transfer agent has an eect on polymerization rate.
If the low-conversion polymerization rate is signicantly decreased, the species is
classied as a retarding agent or inhibitor, and Eqs. (9)(13) no longer describe
the kinetics of the system; see Section 4.3.1.3.
The chain-transfer ability of a compound can be studied by varying its concentration while holding all other variables xed. By stopping the reaction at very low
conversion such that concentrations and diusion-controlled k t values (and thus
R pol and DPninst ) are kept constant, Eq. (13) can be rearranged as Eq. (18).
1
1
k sol S

tr
DPn DPn 0 k p M

18

A plot of 1=DPn against S=M should yield a straight line with slope k trsol =k p and
intercept 1=DPn 0 , where DPn 0 is the average chain length measured in the absence of transfer agent. The form of this equation leads to the denition of a chaintransfer constant C for each species, including monomer, in Eq. (19).
Ctrsol

ktrsol
;
kp

Ctrmon

ktrmon
kp

19

It is these ratios and their temperature dependence that are tabulated in standard
references (for example, Ref. 7).
Solvent/transfer agent For some homogeneous FRP systems, solvent is added not
for its chain-transfer ability, but as a diluent to control viscosity and/or heat transfer. In other systems, a small amount of chain-transfer agent (CTA) is added specically to control and reduce the MW of the polymer. Thus values for Ctrsol may
vary widely from a low of 106 104 to a high of 101 10 1 , depending on the
number of weakly bonded atoms (generally hydrogen or halogen) on the transfer
agent and their ease of abstraction. For very active compounds (for example, thiols
and halogenated compounds) with Ctrsol > 101 it is necessary to account for the
consumption of CTA during the course of the polymerization, since a changing ratio of S=M will cause a corresponding drift in polymer MW. In such cases careful control of CTA addition to the system is required. If it is added at higher concentrations, telomerization (formation of low-MW species) will occur rather than
polymerization.
Table 4.4 summarizes values for a few typical solvents and CTA compounds at
50 C. Most organic compounds have low transfer rates (Ctrsol of 106 104 ) so that

167

168

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous


Tab. 4.4.

Transfer constants (k trsol =k p ) to solvents and transfer agents at 50 C.[a]

Benzene
Toluene
Ethyl acetate
Triethylamine
CCl 4
1-Butanethiol

Styrene

Methyl
methacrylate

Methyl
acrylate

Vinyl
acetate

Ethylene[b]

2  106
1  105
5  104
5  104
1  102
20

4  106
2  105
1  105
8  104
2  104
0.6

2  105
1  104
6  105
4  102
2  104
1.5

1  104
2  103
2  104
4  102
0.8
50

9  104 [b]
1:3  102 [b]
5  103 [b]
1:8  102 [b]
1.0[b]
6.0[b]

values at 50 C [7]; there can be an order of


magnitude range in literature data.
[b] Ethylene values at 130 C and 1360 atm [20].
[a] Representative

transfer is important only when they are present in high concentration (that is, as
solvent). They tend to be more reactive toward a radical such as ethylene or vinyl
acetate than a resonance-stabilized radical such as that of styrene. For a given
radical type, aliphatic compounds that yield tertiary radicals will be more eective transfer agents than those that produce secondary radicals. Halomethanes
and thiols, used as MW-controlling agents due to their high transfer rates, react faster with nucleophilic radicals such as styrene or vinyl acetate than with
(meth)acrylates. Abstraction reactions from organic solvents generally have higher
activation energies than propagation, with (Etr  Ep ) in the range of 2050 kJ mol1
[21, 22]. The Polymer Handbook [7] and the monograph by Moad and Solomon [3]
provide a summary of available data for a wider range of monomerCTA (solvent)
pairings.
Monomer Transfer to monomer cannot be avoided, and the maximum upper limit
of chain length that can be achieved in a polymerization is Ctrmon , assuming the absence of all other transfer and termination events. The details of the mechanism
depend upon the specic monomer involved. For monomers that contain aliphatic
hydrogens such as vinyl acetate and (meth)acrylates, the transfer process involves
H-atom abstraction to form an unsaturated new radical, as shown for vinyl acetate
in Scheme 4.6. The polymer chain that grows from this radical thus contains an
unsaturated end group that may undergo further reaction. Transfer to monomer
rates are generally very low, and are dicult to measure experimentally since the
ratio with propagation (R trmon =R p ) is independent of [M]. Table 4.5 summarizes

CH2

C CH3

H
Scheme 4.6.

O
H2C

O
O

C CH3
CH2

C CH3

CH2

H
Free-radical chain transfer to monomer (vinyl acetate).

O
H2C

C
H

C CH2

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics


Tab. 4.5.

Transfer constants (k trmon =k p ) to monomer.[a]

Styrene
Methyl methacrylate
Butyl acrylate
Vinyl acetate
Ethylene[b]

C trmon

E tr C E p [kJ molC1 ]

Reference

5  105
2  105
6  105
2  104
4  104 [b]

23.7
15.2

43.9

7
23
24
7
25

values at 50 C, unless otherwise noted; values


reported in Ref. 7 can show an order of magnitude range.
[b] At 250 C and 2000 bar.
[a] Representative

the range of values found in the literature. Ctrmon increases with temperature, with
(Etrmon  Ep ) in the range of 1040 kJ mol1 .
Additional Mechanisms
The basic mechanisms of Scheme 4.3 are common to and occur in every FRP
system. Other mechanisms are more system specic, dependent not only on the
choice of monomer but also the process operating conditions. These additional
mechanisms complicate the kinetic analysis and often play an important role in
controlling polymerization rate and polymer structure under typical industrial operating conditions.
4.3.1.3

Thermal initiation Primary radicals in most FRP systems are generated by scission of an added initiator. Free-radical polymerizations can also be initiated by the
monomer itself, or by reactions involving trace impurities in the system. Generally
the rate of radical generation by these processes is very low negligible compared
with R init from the added initiator. Styrene, however, exhibits signicant thermal
polymerization at temperatures of 100 C or more. Indeed, it is not necessary to
add initiator to styrenic systems at high temperatures, as the rate of thermal initiation is sucient to make an industrially viable process [26]. Acrylates and methacrylates have also been reported to undergo thermal polymerization, but at a significantly slower rate than styrene.
The mechanism behind the thermal polymerization of styrene is still under debate, but is believed to involve the reversible formation of a dimeric species by a
DielsAlder reaction, followed by the subsequent hydrogen transfer to a third styrene molecule to form two radicals that can initiate polymerization (Scheme 4.7).
This complex mechanism can be approximated by a third-order dependency on styrene concentration [Eq. (20)] [27].
k therm

3M ! 2I 
R therm k therm M 3 ;


k therm

L2
mol 2  s

2:2  10 5 exp114:8=RT

20

169

170

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

CH
CH

Scheme 4.7.

Thermal initiation of styrene.

This expression from the mid-1970s has stood the test of time, although the preexponential factor has been increased by a factor of 23 to t 260340 C data obtained in a more recent study [26].
Retardation and inhibition Some substances retard or suppress free-radical polymerization by reacting with primary or polymer radicals to yield nonradical products or radicals that are too stable to add further monomer. By decreasing the
concentration of reactive radicals in the system, polymerization rate is slowed (retardation) or stopped completely (inhibition).
Phenolic inhibitors (for example, hydroquinone, monomethylhydroquinone) are
commonly added to monomers at parts-per-million levels in order to prevent polymerization during transport and storage by rapidly and eectively scavenging any
radicals (Eq. (21), in which R  represents I  or Pn ) that may form.
kinhib

R  Z ! dead products;

R inhib kinhib Ptot  I  Z

21

Ideally an inhibitor (Z) stops all polymerization until completely consumed


(R inhib g R p ), at which time polymerization proceeds at a normal rate, as shown
schematically in Figure 4.2. In many academic studies, monomer is distilled or
passed over a column to remove inhibitor before polymerization. This purication
is not done in industry if the concentration of inhibitor in the monomer is much
lower than the concentration of initiator added to the system, since the excess of
initiator-generated radicals quickly consumes the inhibitor.
Retardation, the slowing of polymerization rate by consumption of radicals, can
take dierent forms and thus must be considered on a case-by-case basis. If R inhib
is of similar magnitude to R p , polymerization will proceed at a lower rate until all
of the retarding species is consumed (curve a in Figure 4.2). The kinetic expressions (Section 4.3.1.1) cannot be applied since termination is no longer the

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

Conversion

Normal
Polymerization

Inhibition

Retardation

Time
Conversiontime plots for normal, retarded, and
inhibited free-radical polymerizations. Retardation cases a and
b are described in the text.
Fig. 4.2.

sole mechanism of radical consumption; application of radical stationarity yields


R init R term R inhib .
A dierent form of retardation occurs when a radical species formed from transfer (S  in Scheme 4.3) reinitiates at a slow rate. In addition to the slower reaction
rate with monomer to form a polymer radical, the termination of S  with other
radicals in the system may also need to be considered (Scheme 4.8). Explicit balances must be written for S , and the extra mechanisms must be included when
deriving expressions for [Ptot ], R pol , and DPn . As solvent/transfer agent is generally
not completely consumed, the retardation eect will last the duration of the polymerization (curve b in Figure 4.2). The degree of retardation depends on the
value of k isol , which can vary with monomer type; many carbon-centered radicals
show much lower reactivity toward vinyl esters (for example, vinyl acetate) than
(meth)acrylates [3].
k sol

tr
Pn + S
Dn + S *

k sol

i
S *+ M
P1

k sol

t
S *+ Pn
Dn

Scheme 4.8.

Retardation of polymerization by solvent or transfer agent.

Oxygen inhibits or retards vinyl polymerizations by the formation of peroxy radicals that are generally unreactive. However, subsequent monomer addition can occur in some systems; this copolymerization forms polymeric peroxides that aect
the thermal stability of the nal polymer product. Good practice requires the removal of air by sparging or freezethaw cycles before a reaction is started, and exclusion of air during polymerization by operating under an inert atmosphere (for
example, nitrogen) or reuxing solvent.

171

172

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Depropagation The addition of a radical to a double bond the propagation


reaction is potentially a reversible process [Eq. (22)].
kp

Pn M Pn1 ;
kdep

R dep kdep Ptot 

22

The relative importance of the reverse reaction is governed by the free energy
change, DGp DHp  TDSp , where DHp represents the enthalpy and DSp represents the entropy change upon propagation; polymerization can only occur spontaneously when DGp is negative. With most common monomers, depropagation is
negligible at typical reaction temperatures. For some systems, however, the enthalpy and entropy terms for propagation are delicately balanced so that depropagation has a signicant eect on polymerization rate (R pol ) at higher temperatures
[Eqs. (23)].
R pol R p  R dep k p M  kdep Ptot  kpe MPtot 
kpe k p 

23

kdep
M

Examining the reaction from a thermodynamic viewpoint leads to the denition of


Meq , the monomer concentration for a particular temperature at which the eece
tive propagation rate coecient (k p ) and polymerization rate become zero [Eq.
(24)].
K eq





kp
DGp
DHp DSp
1

exp
exp

Meq
kdep
RT
RT
R

24

This equation can also be rearranged to Eq. (25), to dene the ceiling temperature
Tc at which, for a given monomer concentration, the polymerization rate becomes
zero:
Tc

DHp
DSp R lnM

25

It also provides a link between the thermodynamic and kinetic coecients according to Eqs. (26).

DHp Ep  Edep ;

DSp R ln

Ap
A dep


R lnM

26

Values of DHp for common monomers are tabulated in Table 4.6; an expanded list
may be found in Ref. 7. DSp is more dicult to measure experimentally, but is typically in the range of 100 to 140 J mol1 K1 . Table 4.6 also contains estimates
of Tc calculated at M 1 mol L1 . Ethylene, vinyl acetate, and acrylates have very
high values, and depropagation does not occur under viable polymerization condi-

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics


Depropagation behavior of common monomers.

Tab. 4.6.

a-Methylstyrene
Styrene
Methyl methacrylate
Methyl acrylate
Vinyl acetate
Ethylene
[a] From

CDH p [kJ molC1 ] [a]

Tc [ C][b]

35
73
56
80
88
102

19
335
194
394
460
577

Ref. 7.
for M 1 mol L1 , assuming DSp 120 J mol1 K1 .

[b] Calculated

tions. Styrene has a slightly lower ceiling temperature and depropagation must be
considered above 250 C. This temperature range, while higher than that generally
employed for styrene polymerization, is used for some commercial processes [26].
The addition of a methyl group to a monomer greatly reduces Tc , as seen by
comparing values for a-methylstyrene to styrene and methacrylates to acrylates.
e
Figure 4.3 is a plot of k p measured for dodecyl methacrylate (bulk monomer) by
e
the PLP-SEC technique [28]. At 180 C, the highest temperature examined, k p is
1 1
1 1
4000 L mol s , less than half of the k p value of 9400 L mol s extrapolated
from the lower-temperature data. With known Arrhenius coecients for propagation (Table 4.2), the temperature dependence of kdep may be estimated directly from

4
3.8

log[kpeff (L/mol-s)]

3.6
3.4
3.2
3
2.8
2.6
2.4
2.0

2.2

2.4

2.6

2.8

3.0

1000/T (K -1)

Fig. 4.3. Eective propagation rate coecient for bulk dodecyl


methacrylate measured by PLP. The line indicates the forward
rate coecient (k p ) calculated according to the Arrhenius
parameters of Table 4.2. Experimental data are taken from
Ref. 28.

3.2

3.4

3.6

173

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

174

these data. The corresponding values for DHp (54 kJ mol1 ) and DSp (123
J mol1 K1 ) agree well with thermodynamic estimates. The depropagation behavior of many methacrylate monomers is similar [28], and depropagation must be
considered at temperatures above 120 C, especially for systems with low monomer
concentration [29].
Long-chain branching All of the mechanisms presented to this point do not
change the basic linear architecture of the polymer chains, with each repeat unit
linked to two others. Branched polymers, those in which the repeat units are not
linked solely in a linear array, can have signicantly dierent physical properties
than their linear counterpoints, depending upon the number and distribution of
the branches along the polymer backbone as well as their length. Understanding
the mechanisms by which these branches are formed, therefore, is a key component to manipulation and control of polymer structure. Branches can be formed
either by intramolecular reactions, discussed in the next subsection, or intermolecular reactions. The reaction of a polymeric radical with another polymer chain, or
long-chain branching, can occur by three distinct mechanisms. The common feature
is the re-activation of a dead polymer chain. As well as creating branched structures, these reactions signicantly broaden the polymer chain-length distribution.
Intermolecular transfer to polymer The transfer of a radical center from a polymeric
radical to another polymer chain is shown in Scheme 4.9. Addition of monomer
to the mid-chain radical produces a polymer with a branch point, with the length
controlled by the number of propagation events before chain transfer or radical
radical termination occurs. An additional subscript can be added to track the number of long-chain branches formed [Eq. (27)].
pol

mk tr

Pn; b Dm; c ! Dn; b Pm; c1 ;

pol

pol

R tr k tr Ptot m1

27

This reaction does not change the number of monomer units that have been polymerized or the number of polymer chains in the system, and thus has no eect on
DPn . The rate expression in Eq. (27) is written assuming that all repeat units on all

R1

R1
CH2

CH2 C

CH2

CH2

CH2

R1

R1
CH2 C

R1

R1

CH2

H2C

CH
R1

CH2 C

CH2

H2C
R1 CH

Scheme 4.9.

Long-chain branch formation by chain transfer to polymer.

CH2 C

CH2

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

dead polymer chains have an equal probability of reaction, as represented by m1, the
total concentration of polymerized monomer units in the system [Eq. (28)].

m1

y X
y
X

nDn; b 

28

n1 b0

Note that the reaction is not proportional to the number of chains in the system,
but to the number of repeat units contained in the chains. This has two important
consequences. First, the importance of transfer to polymer increases with polymer
conversion (x p ) in the system, as seen in Eq. (29) by looking at the ratio of branching to monomer consumption.
pol

pol
pol
k tr x p
R tr
k Ptot m1
tr

R pol k p Ptot M k p 1  x p

29

Thus polymerizations operating at high monomer conversion will have signicantly higher branching than low-conversion systems. Second, longer polymer
chains those with more repeat units are more likely to participate in a branching reaction than short chains. Since the re-activated chains increase in length
through subsequent propagation, this leads to a broadening of the molecular
weight distribution reected by an increase in the weight-average MW (Mw ); even
low levels of branching can increase polydispersity values (Mw/Mn ) to 515 compared to 23 for linear polymers.
As well as conversion, the importance of transfer to polymer depends upon the
monomer system. The reaction can be important in systems with very reactive radicals such as ethylene [3032], vinyl acetate [3335], and acrylate [36, 37] polymerizations, but seldom occurs in styrene and methacrylate systems. Transfer to polymer usually occurs via abstraction of a methine hydrogen as shown in Scheme 4.9,
but may also involve other easily abstracted H-atoms, such as the acetate methyl
pol
pol
hydrogens on poly(vinyl acetate). Transfer constants to polymer (Ctr k tr =k p )
are not as readily determined as other transfer constants because the process does
not decrease DPn . Long-chain branching (LCB) levels are usually quite low, less
than 2 per 1000 repeat units, making it dicult to employ NMR. Indirect methods
such as multi-detector SEC [32, 38] are often used, leading to a signicant scatter
pol
in reported Ctr values [7]. Like other transfer events, the relative importance increases with temperature.
Reaction with unsaturated polymer chains Termination by disproportionation, transfer to monomer, and chain scission (discussed later in this section) create polymer
chains with terminal unsaturation (denoted in Eq. (30) by D ). These reactive
chains, sometimes called macromonomers, can add to a growing radical to form a
long-chain branch.
pol

kp

Pn; b Dm;
c ! Pnm; bc1 ;

pol

R pol
p k p Ptot Dtot 

30

175

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

176

R1
CH2

R1

R1
H2C

CH2 C

R1
CH2

R2

R2
Long-chain branch formation by addition to a
terminally unsaturated polymer chain.

Scheme 4.10.

This reaction is fundamentally dierent than transfer to polymer in several respects. It is an addition rather than a transfer (H-abstraction) reaction (Scheme
4.10). The reaction rate is dependent on the number of unsaturated chain ends
rather than the number of repeat units in the chains so that its importance relative

=M according to Eq. (31).


to propagation is controlled by the ratio Dtot
pol

pol

Rp
k p Ptot Dtot


k p Ptot M
R pol

31

Unlike transfer to polymer, the mechanism combines two polymer chains (and
all of their repeat units) into one, aecting both DPn and DPw . Reaction with
terminally unsaturated chains can be important in vinyl acetate [33] and highertemperature methacrylate [3] polymerizations.
Reaction with multifunctional monomers Another way to introduce branching is
through addition of a multifunctional monomer to the polymer system. An example is the addition of small levels of ethylene glycol dimethacrylate (EGDMA) to
methyl methacrylate (MMA), as shown in Scheme 4.11. Reaction of the rst dou-

O
C

OCH3

CH2

O CH2CH2 O

C
O

C CH2

H2C C

CH3

H3C

H3C

CH3
C CH2

CH2

O CH2CH2 O

C
H3C
CH3

CH3
C

O
C
CH2

C
H3C

OCH3

O
C
H2C C

C
CH2

C
O O
CH2
CH2
O

O O CH3
C
C

CH2

H3C

CH3
Addition of ethylene glycol dimethacrylate to a
methyl methacrylate radical. The pendent double bond is
attacked by another polymer radical to form a crosslink.

Scheme 4.11.

CH2

O O
H2C
CH2
O
O
C
C
CH3

CH2

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

177

ble bond incorporates EGDMA in the PMMA chain, with the second reactive site
remaining as a pendent double bond. Reaction of this pendent bond with another
polymer radical creates a branched structure termed a crosslink, since the branch
is tetrafunctional rather than trifunctional in nature.
The addition of a small amount of difunctional monomer such as EGDMA to
MMA [39, 40] or divinylbenzene to styrene is a means to increase polymer MW
without decreasing radical concentration. Addition of higher levels leads to an interconnected branched, or network, polymer.
Short-chain branching (intramolecular transfer to polymer) Intramolecular H-atom
abstraction, often called back-biting, occurs via the formation of a six-membered
ring, as shown in Scheme 4.12 for butyl acrylate (nBA). Monomer addition to the
resulting interior radical leaves a short-chain branch (SCB) consisting of two repeat
units. This mechanism has long been known important for high-pressure LDPE
production at 150300 C [30], where the number of short-chain branches is in
the range of 2050 per 1000 ethylene repeat units. This level of SCB signicantly
decreases the polyethylene crystallinity and gives LDPE some of its unique properties; LDPE density is 0.92 g cm3 compared to 0.98 g cm3 for linear polyethylene.
Multiple back-biting events lead to other SCB structures; in addition to the common butyl branch in LDPE, ethyl and 2-ethylhexyl branches have been identied
using 13 C NMR [30, 41, 42].

COOBu COOBu COOBu


R
CH

CH

CH

COOBu COOBu COOBu

COOBu
R

CH
H
HC
COOBu

CH

COOBu
CH

C
H
CH

COOBu

Formation of a mid-chain radical by


intramolecular chain transfer to polymer. Monomer addition to
the new radical structure creates a short-chain branch in the
polymer.

Scheme 4.12.

In ethylene/nBA copolymerization it is observed that the methine hydrogens on


nBA units in the polymer chain are much more susceptible to abstraction than hydrogen abstraction from a CH2 unit in the backbone [43]. This result, along with
the observed high concentration of branch points formed at conditions of very low
polymer concentration during nBA homopolymerization [36], indicates that the intramolecular (back-biting) mechanism is also important in acrylate polymerizations. There is strong evidence to suggest that monomer addition to the resulting
mid-chain radical, due to its higher stability, is much lower than addition to a
chain-end radical [44]. Thus the mechanism aects nBA polymerization rate as
well as polymer structure [37]. The same type of back-biting reaction has also

178

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

been shown to occur during styrene polymerization at high temperatures (260


340 C) [26].
Chain scission The radical structure formed by intra- or intermolecular transfer
to polymer is less reactive than a chain-end radical. Under higher-temperature conditions, the radical can undergo b-fragmentation (chain scission) as shown in
Scheme 4.13 for butyl acrylate [45]. The scission can occur in either direction,
yielding a short-chain radical or a short-chain unsaturated trimer species. As well
as lowering polymer MW, the scission event produces an unsaturated chain end
that can react further, as discussed previously (see Scheme 4.10).

COOBu COOBu COOBu


CH2
C
CH
CH

COOBu COOBu COOBu


CH

CH

COOBu

HC

COOBu
CH2

COOBu
CH

C
H

COOBu COOBu

CH
COOBu

CH

CH

COOBu COOBu
H2C

HC

COOBu
CH2

b-Scission of butyl acrylate mid-chain radical.

Scheme 4.13.

Scission events can occur in any system where mid-chain radicals are formed.
However, scission is more temperature-activated than H-abstraction and thus becomes important only at elevated temperatures. The reaction is not believed to occur during butyl acrylate polymerization at 75 C [37], but is shown to be important
at 140 C [29, 45]. Scission is a dominant mechanism in styrene polymerizations
at 260340 C [26], and also occurs during LDPE production [30]. Scission of midchain radicals formed via intermolecular transfer to polymer can have a signicant
eect on the breadth and the shape of polymer MWD [46].
Kinetic treatment of these more complex mechanisms is often dicult. Equations (32)(34) are a network of reactions developed to treat intramolecular transfer, short-chain branch formation, and b-scission for butyl acrylate polymerization
[47].
kbb

Pn ! Q n ;

R bb kbb Ptot 

kptert

Q n M ! Pn1 SCB;

32
RSCB

kptert MQ tot 

33

0:5kb

Q n ! Dn2
P2
0:5kb

Q n ! Pn3 D3 ;

R b kb Q tot 

34

The kinetic coecients are estimated by measuring the level of quaternary carbons
(equated to short-chain branch level) and terminal unsaturations (D ) by NMR.

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

Termination of the mid-chain radical (Q n ) is also considered in the scheme. While


the mechanism provides improved understanding of this complex system, many
questions still remain: does the mid-chain radical terminate at the same rate as
chain-end radicals; what is the reactivity of the unsaturated chain end; and does
the mid-chain radical scission with equal probability in each direction? The reaction engineering challenge is to consider the set of mechanisms required to represent the basic rate behavior and polymer architecture of the system without introducing unneeded complexity.
4.3.2

Copolymerization

Reaction of two or more monomers by free radical polymerization is an eective


way of altering the balance of properties of commercial products. Addition of the
polar monomer acrylonitrile to styrene (or methyl acrylate to ethylene) produces a
polymer that combines the strength of the base homopolymer with much improved oil and grease resistance. The adhesive and cohesive properties of coatings
resins are balanced by controlling the mix and relative proportions of monomers in
the recipe.
FRP leads to the formation of statistical copolymers, where the arrangement of
monomers within the chains is dictated purely by kinetic factors. However, reactivity of a monomer in copolymerization cannot be predicted from its behavior in homopolymerization. Vinyl acetate polymerizes about 30 times more quickly than
styrene (see Table 4.2), yet the product is almost pure polystyrene if the two monomers are copolymerized together in a 50:50 mixture. a-Methylstyrene cannot be homopolymerized to form high-MW polymer due to its low ceiling temperature (see
Table 4.6), yet is readily incorporated into copolymer at elevated temperatures.
These and other similar observations can be understood by considering copolymerization mechanisms and kinetics.
Basic Mechanisms
In copolymerization, the presence of more than one type of monomer adds an extra degree of complexity to the kinetics. The dierent monomers form dierent
radical structures, and the relative rates of chain growth depend on the structure
of both monomer and radical. It is these propagation mechanisms that control
polymer composition (the relative amounts of each monomer unit incorporated
into the copolymer) and sequence distribution (the way in which these monomer
units are arranged within the chain). Developing a set of mechanisms to describe
how radical structure aects termination and transfer rates is required to represent
copolymer chain length and molecular weight distributions.
The most common treatment of free radical copolymerization kinetics assumes
that the reactivity of the polymer radical depends solely on the nature of its terminal monomer unit; that is, that the identity of the penultimate unit on the radical
does not aect its reactivity. This assumption provides a good representation of
polymer composition and sequence distribution, but not necessarily polymeriza4.3.2.1

179

180

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

tion rate (see Section 4.3.2.2). This so-called terminal model is widely used to model
free-radical copolymerization according to the set of mechanisms in Scheme 4.14.
k

Initiator Decomposition

d
I
2 f I

Chain Initiation

j
I + M j
P1 j

Chain Propagation

ij
Pni + M j
Pn +j 1

ki

kp

Chain Termination
ktc

By Combination

ij
Pni + Pmj
Dn + m

By Disproportionation

ij
Pni + Pmj
Dn + Dm

ktd

Chain Transfer
To Monomer

ktrmon

ij
Pni + M j
Dn + P1 j

ktrsol

To Solvent or Agent

i
Pni + S
Dn + S *

k isol

j
S * + M j
P1 j

Basic free-radical copolymerization mechanism,


assuming terminal radical kinetics.

Scheme 4.14.

In this scheme monomer-j (denoted by Mj ) adds to the initiator primary radical


to form a polymer radical of type-j and unit length. The dead polymer and radical-i
chains of length n (Dn and Pni ) are made up of a mixture of the monomer types in
the system, with their relative amounts governed by the copolymer composition
equation developed below. Chain growth occurs by addition of Mj to radical-i (Pni )
with the propagation rate coecient k pij dependent on both radical and monomer
type. The rate coecients for transfer and termination reactions can also be dependent on the nature of the radical center, as indicated by subscripts. However, since
radicalradical termination is a diusion-controlled reaction, the rate coecient
cop
can usually be assumed to be independent of radical type, such that kt k tij for
all i and j.
Most of the kinetic coecients in Scheme 4.14 are binary parameters, dependent
on the radical and monomer type. Thus the polymerization behavior of three or
more monomers can be estimated reliably from knowledge of the corresponding
binary copolymerizations. For a two-monomer system assuming the long-chain hypothesis, the consumption rates of the two monomers are written as in Eqs. (35).
1
2
M1  k p21 Ptot
M1 
R pol1 k p11 Ptot
1
2
R pol2 k p12 Ptot
M2  k p22 Ptot
M2 

35

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics


i
where Ptot
represents the concentration of all polymer radicals of type-i in the system [Eq. (36)].

i
Ptot


y
X
Pni 

36

n1

The ratio of the two consumption rates dictates the instantaneous composition
) of the polymer being formed [Eq. (37)].
(Fpinst
i
Fpinst
1
Fpinst
2

1
2
R pol1 k p11 Ptot
M1  k p21 Ptot
M1 

1
2 M 
R pol2 k p12 Ptot M2  k p22 Ptot
2

37

Application of the quasi-steady-state assumption yields the ratio of the radical types
as in Eq. (38), and substitution and rearrangement leads to the well-known polymer composition equation [Eq. (39)], where f1 and f2 are the mole fractions of M1
and M2 in the monomer mixture, and monomer reactivity ratios r1 and r2 are dened as k p11 =k p12 and k p22 =k p21 .
1
Ptot
 k p21 M1 
2  k M 
Ptot
p12
2

Fpinst
1

38

r1 f12 f1 f2
2 f1 f2 r2 f22

39

r1 f12

Equation (39) denes the composition of the copolymer formed at any instant during polymerization, and is dependent only on the ratios of the propagation rate coecients and not on their absolute values.
Copolymer properties depend on the distribution of the monomer units along
the chain as well as the average composition. Reactivity ratios also control copolymer sequence distribution. The probability P11 that an M1 unit follows an M1 unit
in the copolymer is equal to the rate of M1 M1 formation divided by the sum of the
rates of all additions to radical-1 [Eq. (40)].

P11

1
k p11 Ptot
M1 
1
1 M 
k p11 Ptot M1  k p12 Ptot
2

r1 f1
r1 f1 f2

40

The probability P12 that an M2 unit follows an M1 is given by Eq. (41).


P12 1  P11

f2
r1 f1 f2

41

Similar expressions, Eqs. (42) and (43), can be derived for addition to radical-2:

181

182

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

P22

2
k p22 Ptot
M2 
2
2 M 
k p22 Ptot M2  k p21 Ptot
1

P21 1  P22

r2 f2
r2 f2 f1

f1
r2 f2 f1

42

43

These probabilities can be used to calculate NM1 ; n i , the fraction of all M1 sequences that are exactly n i units long. This is simply the probability of having
n i  1M1 M1 linkages followed by an M1 M2 linkage, according to Eq. (44).
n i 1
NM1 ; n i P11
P12 ;

n 1

NM2 ; nj P22j P21

44

Thus the fraction of M1 sequences that consists of an isolated M1 unit is P12 , the
fraction that consists of isolated M1 M1 diads is P11 P12 , the fraction of triads is
2
P12 , and so forth. The number-average length of M1 sequences (N 1 ) is given by
P11
Eq. (45) and the fraction of all M1 units contained in a sequence of length n i is
n i 1 2
2
P12 ; that is, the fraction of M1 contained in isolated diads is 2P11 P12
.
n i P11
N1

1
1

;
1  P11 P12

N2

1
1

1  P22 P21

45

Implicit in these expressions is the approximation, valid for long-chain polymer,


that the number of M1 M2 linkages in a chain is equal to the number of M2 M1 linkages. Thus the ratio of M1 to M2 units in the chain must equal the ratio of the respective average sequence lengths [Eq. (46)].
Fpinst
1
Fpinst
2

N1
N2

46

Substitution and rearrangement of this equation yields the polymer composition


equation, Eq. (39). Thus it is possible to estimate reactivity ratios for binary copolymers from triad distributions measured by NMR analysis.
While copolymer composition and sequence distribution are only functions of
the reactivity ratios, the same is not true for polymerization rate. The overall rate
of monomer consumption is given by Eq. (47), where [Mtot ] indicates the total
monomer concentration (M1  M2 ).
1
2
1
2
R pol k p11 Ptot
M1  k p21 Ptot
M1  k p12 Ptot
M2  k p22 Ptot
M2 
!
2
2
XX

k pij fri fj Ptot Mtot 

47

i1 j1

The fraction of radical-i in the system, fri [Eq. (48)] can be calculated from Eq. (38).

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

fri

i
Ptot
Pi
tot
2
Ptot Ptot

1
Ptot

48

[Ptot ], the total radical concentration, is calculated from an overall radical balance
similar to Eq. (9) and given by Eq. (49).

Ptot 





R init 1=2
2f kd I 1=2

cop
cop
kt
kt

49

The form of Eq. (47) is analogous to the homopolymerization rate expression [Eq.
(10)], with a copolymer-averaged rate coecient for propagation (generalized for a
system with Nmon dierent monomers) dened in Eq. (50).
k pcop

Nmon X
Nmon
X

k pij fri fj

50

i1 j1

For a two-monomer system, application of the QSSA [Eq. (38)] and simplication
lead to Eq. (51).
k pcop

r1 f12 2f1 f2 r2 f22


r1 f1 =k p11 r2 f2 =k p22

51

Using Eqs. (47)(51), the copolymerization reaction rate can be analyzed as for
cop
homopolymerization (see Section 4.3.1.4), with k p now a function of monomer
composition.
Kinetic Coecients
The traditional method for determining reactivity ratios involves determination of
copolymer composition for a range of monomer feeds at very low conversion; that
is, measuring Fp1 as a function of f1 . NMR measurement of sequence distributions
provides additional information about chain microstructure, but suers from
greater experimental noise and signal assignment uncertainty from tacticity effects. There is a large body of published r1 r2 data for monomer pairings, summarized in Ref. 7. The scatter for these ratios is much less than found in k p and k t
data, but care still must be exercised when extracting values from this and similar
compilations. Some error can arise from the methodology used to estimate r1 and
r2 from Fp1 versus f1 data. The estimation is best accomplished by nonlinear least
squares techniques [48, 49], and a statistical analysis also provides a guide to the
optimal monomer compositions at which experimentation should be performed
to improve the estimates [48]. Error can also occur if polymer conversion is suciently high for f1 to deviate signicantly from the zero-conversion value (in which
case an integrated form of Eq. (39) must be used [50]), or if the experimental system does not remain homogeneous (often observed with acid monomers).
4.3.2.2

183

184

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous


Tab. 4.7.

Monomer reactivity ratios at 50 C[a], r1 is tabulated horizontally and r2 vertically.

Monomer-1

Monomer-2

Styrene
Alkyl methacrylate
Alkyl acrylate
Vinyl acetate
[a] Representative

Styrene

Methacrylate

Acrylate

Vinyl acetate

0.4
0.2
0.02

0.6

0.4
0.03

0.8
2.2

0.03

40
20
6

values Ref. 7.

There are only a few systems for which the terminal model upon which Eq. (39)
is based does not provide a good description of copolymer composition. The resulting polymers exhibit an alternating structure (for example, styrenemaleic anhydride), or the observed reactivity ratios in the system vary with monomer concentration or solvent choice. Since they often include a polar monomer with strong
electron-withdrawing or electron-donating properties, alternative kinetic models
that include the formation of monomer complexes have been developed to represent these systems [3, 51]. The majority of systems, however, are well behaved
and well represented by the terminal model. Table 4.7 summarizes values of reactivity ratios for styrene, alkyl methacrylate, alkyl acrylate, and vinyl acetate systems.
Reactivity ratios for alkyl methacrylates and acrylates (for example, methyl, butyl,
dodecyl) exhibit a family type behavior, with the composition data of various systems tted well by a single curve [52]. Values for ethylene copolymer systems at
typical production conditions are summarized in Table 4.8: While r1 (1 ethylene)
values for alkyl methacrylates, alkyl acrylates, acrylic acid, and methacrylic acid
could not be distinguished within experimental error [53], there were signicant
dierences in the r2 values [54].
It is informative to consider some of the implications of these values. In Figure
4.4 the relationship between polymer and monomer composition is plotted for various copolymer systems:

Tab. 4.8. Monomer reactivity ratios for ethylene (monomer-1)


systems at 240 C and 2000 bar [53, 54].

Monomer-2

r1

r2

Alkyl methacrylates
Methacrylic acid
Alkyl acrylates
Acrylic acid
Vinyl acetate [a]

0.058
0.058
0.058
0.058
1.0

7
11
4
8
1.0

[a] From

Ref. 7.

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics


1
0.9
0.8
0.7

Fp 1

0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
MMA-Sty
MMA-MA
MMA-VAc
Eth-VAc

0.2
0.1
0
0.0

0.1

0.2

0.3

0.4

0.5

0.6

0.7

0.8

0.9

1.0

f1
Fig. 4.4. Relationship between monomer composition f1 and
corresponding instantaneous polymer composition Fpinst
for
1
various monomer pairings (MMA methyl methacrylate,
Sty styrene, MA methyl acrylate, VAc vinyl acetate,
Eth ethylene).

For the case where r1 r2 1:0 (ethylenevinyl acetate; methacrylate


methacrylate), the monomers have equal reactivity to propagation and will be
incorporated into polymer at the same ratio as they are in the monomer phase
(Fp1 f1 ).
 Where r1 > 1 and r2 < 1, the copolymer will always be richer in monomer-1 than
in the monomer phase, so that monomer-1 will become depleted in a batch polymerization. The further the reactivity ratios deviate from unity, the greater the
deviation between polymer and monomer composition. Systems that exhibit
this behavior include methacrylateacrylate polymerizations, and styrene, methacrylates, or acrylates polymerized with vinyl acetate or ethylene.
 With both r1 and r2 less than unity (styreneacrylate, styrenemethacrylate),
cross-propagation is favored over homopropagation and the copolymer tends
toward an alternating structure. The system has an azeotropic composition at
which the copolymer composition is exactly equal to the monomer composition.


Reactivity ratios exhibit a weak temperature dependence that is often dicult to


measure. With increasing temperature, the ratios tend to approach unity as demonstrated for styrenebutyl acrylate [55], butyl acrylatemethyl methacrylate [56],
and ethylene copolymer systems [53, 54]. The temperature dependence of the latter
agrees well with activation energies reported for addition of monomers to small
radicals [57].

185

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

1000.0

cop

(L/mol-s)

10000.0

kp

186

100.0

10.0
0.00

0.10

0.20

0.30

0.40

0.50

0.60

0.70

0.80

0.90

1.00

f 1 (MMA)
Fig. 4.5. Relationship between monomer composition f1 and
corresponding copolymer-averaged propagation rate coecient,
cop
k p . Lines are calculated assuming terminal-model kinetics and
points are experimental data for: MMAnBA (, e) [62] and
MMAstyrene (---, C) [59] at 20 C.

While the terminal model eectively represents copolymer composition for most
systems, it does not provide as good of a description of polymerization propagation behavior. Rate abnormalities have previously been attributed to termination
reactions and represented by introducing physically unrealistic cross-termination
mechanisms [58]. Careful experimental work by Fukuda and co-workers [51], however, demonstrated that the rate deviations are due to the inadequacy of the terminal model to describe propagation, with further evidence obtained by applicacop
tion of the PLP-SEC technique to measure k p . Many common systems show
deviation from terminal propagation kinetics, including styrenemethacrylate [51,
59], styreneacrylate [60, 61], and acrylatemethacrylate [52, 62] systems. As
cop
shown in Figure 4.5, the measured k p values can be higher or lower than the terminal model predictions, with the deviation substantial in some cases.
The implicit penultimate unit eect model, which accounts for the inuence
of the penultimate monomer unit of the growing polymer radical on the propagation kinetics [51], provides a good representation of this behavior [Eqs. (52)].
k pcop
k p11

r1 f12 2f1 f2 r2 f22


r1 f1 =k p11 r2 f2 =k p22

k p r1 f1 f2 
111
r1 f1 f2 =s1 

k p22

k p r2 f2 f1 
222
r2 f2 f1 =s2 

52

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

The extra parameters s1 and s2 , called radical reactivity ratios, capture the eect of
the penultimate unit on the addition rate of monomer [Eqs. (53)].
k p211
k p111

s1

s2

k p122
k p222

53

A value of greater than unity for si indicates that a comonomer unit-j in the penultimate position increases the addition rate of monomer-i to radical-i compared to
the homopolymerization case.
The kinetics of diusion-controlled termination in copolymerization is also dicult to study. The original interpretation of low-conversion rate data was based on a
chemically controlled model utilizing a cross-termination factor [Eq. (54)].
cop

kt

Nmon X
Nmon
X
i1 j1

k tij fri frj ;

k t 12
k t 11 k t22

54

Assuming terminal propagation kinetics, the best t for F was found to be much
greater than unity for styrenemethacrylate, styreneacrylate, and other systems
cop
such that kt was greater than either homotermination value. When the deviation
of propagation kinetics from the terminal model is taken into account, however,
cop
the estimates for kt become well behaved and bounded by the homotermination values [51]. A penultimate model [51, 63] that accounts for the inuence
of polymer composition on segmental diusion is required to t recent acrylate
cop
methacrylate low-conversion kt data [63, 64]. In order to use this representation
(Eq. (55), with the cross-termination coecients k t 12; 12 and k t21; 21 tted to experimental data), it is necessary to track the four possible penultimate radical types in
the system, with frij i; j 1; 2 the penultimate radical fraction.
cop

f kt0:5
f kt0:5
f kt0:5
f
kt 0:5 kt0:5
11; 11 r11
21; 21 r21
22; 22 r22
12; 12 r12

55

While the terminal model and reactivity ratios provide a good description of copolymer composition, the kinetic studies summarized in this section indicate that adcop
ditional parameters and penultimate radical fractions are required to represent k p
cop
and kt . (For a discussion of transfer to monomer in copolymer systems, see Ref.
65.) These mechanistic complexities are often not considered when developing
FRP models for polymer reaction engineering applications. It is expected that this
situation will change as more data become available.
Additional Mechanisms
The secondary mechanisms presented for homopolymerization in Section 4.3.1.3
also occur in multi-monomer systems. The kinetics of depropagation, chain transfer to polymer, and chain scission are strongly inuenced by not only the nature of
the monomer and terminal radical, but also the penultimate unit on the polymer
radical.
4.3.2.3

187

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous


kp

11
~~~ M 1M 1 .
~~~ M 1 + M 1

188

kdep 11
kp12

~~~ M 1 + M 2 ~~~ M 1M 2 .
kp

22
~~~ M 2 + M 2
~~~ M 2 M 2 .

kp

21
~~~ M 2 + M 1

~~~ M 2 M 1 .

Depropagation in copolymerization for the case


where M2 does not depropagate and M1 depropagates only
when an M1 -unit is in the penultimate position.
Scheme 4.15.

Depropagation It is not possible to produce high MW homopolymer close to the


ceiling temperature of the monomer (see Eq. (25) and Table 4.6). Addition of a
non-depropagating monomer (M2 ) to the system disrupts this behavior, as illustrated by Scheme 4.15. Depropagation of radical-1 becomes a competitive process
with addition of monomer-2, with monomer-1 units at the radical end becoming
irreversibly trapped in the growing chain as soon as monomer-2 adds. Furthermore, depropagation of monomer-1 will occur only if an M1 unit is also in the penultimate position; depropagation to the less-stable M2 radical can be assumed to be
unlikely (kdep21 A 0). Thus MMA can be successfully copolymerized with ethylene at
290 C [57], and a-methylstyrene with various comonomers at temperatures well
above its ceiling temperature [66, 67].
Depropagation in copolymerization aects polymer composition, sequence probabilities, and polymerization rate. With Scheme 4.15, the relative rates of monomer
consumption are given by Eq. (56) (compare with Eq. (37) in the absence of depropagation).

Fpinst
1
Fpinst
2

R pol1

R pol2

fr11
P 1 
fr11 fr21 tot
1 M  k P 2 M 
k p12 Ptot
2
p22 tot
2

1
2
k p11 Ptot
M1  k p21 Ptot
M1   kdep11

56

The ratio fr11 = fr11 fr21 accounts for the fraction of radical-1 that ends in a 11
diad. The eect of depropagation becomes larger as total monomer concentration
decreases and as the fraction of the depropagating monomer in the system increases. Lowry [68] rst derived the composition expressions for the situation
where only one monomer depropagates, and general expressions have been developed for the situation where all four of the propagation reactions are reversible
[66, 69]. Depropagation must be considered when examining the kinetics of
starved-feed semi-batch copolymerization involving methacrylates at the highertemperature conditions typically used to produce acrylic coatings [29, 70].
Chain transfer to polymer The rate of chain transfer to polymer is dependent on
both the reactivity of the radical and the abstractability of the hydrogen atom on
the monomer unit in the polymer chain. For the case of intermolecular chain
j
transfer (long-chain branching), this is represented by Eq. (57), where m1 represents the total concentration of polymerized monomer-j units in the system and

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics

nj represents the number of monomer-j units on a particular chain of length n


[Eqs. (58)].
pol

mj k tr

ij

pol

Pn;i b Dm; c ! Dn; b Pm; c1 ;

m1

y X
y
X

nj Dn; b ;

n1 b0

Nmon
X

R tr

Nmon X
Nmon
X

pol

i
k trij Ptot
m1

57

i1 j1

58

nj

j1

Active radicals (ethylene, acrylate, vinyl acetate) are more likely to abstract from a
polymer chain than styrenic or methacrylate radicals, and acrylate and vinyl acetate
monomer units on a chain are more likely to have an H-atom abstracted. Thus it is
not uncommon for the intermolecular transfer to polymer rate of one pairing (for
example, acrylate radical to acrylate monomer unit) to dominate the system, with
pol
the overall transfer rate R tr decreasing rapidly with increasing content of the lessreactive monomer.
The situation is more complicated in the case of intramolecular transfer, which
occurs through the formation of a six-membered ring. In the case of acrylate (1)/
methacrylate (2), it can be assumed that the methacrylate radical is not reactive
enough to back-bite and that the acrylate radical can only abstract hydrogen if the
antepenultimate unit on the chain is also an acrylate unit. Thus back-biting can occur only for two monomer sequences (M1 M1 M1 and M1 M2 M1 ) at the radical end,
as shown in Scheme 4.16 [70]. The overall back-biting rate must be corrected for
the sequence probabilities [Eqs. (40)(43)] at the chain end, according to Eq. (59).
COOBu COOBu
C

COOBu

COOBu COOBu

CH

CH

C
R

HC

H
CH

COOBu

COOBu COOBu
C

H3C

COOBu
C

COOBu

COOBu COOBu
C
R

HC
COOBu
Back-biting reaction in high temperature
copolymerization of butyl acrylate and butyl methacrylate
(R H or CH3 ).

Scheme 4.16.

COOBu

H3C
H

COOBu
C

CH
COOBu

189

190

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous


1
R bb kbb Ptot
P11 P11 P12 P21

59

Back-biting mechanisms have also been examined for styrene/acrylate [71] and
ethylene copolymer systems [43].
Chain scission There is evidence that the rate of b-fragmentation of a mid-chain
radical is aected by the nature of the units adjacent to the mid-chain radical. Harada et al. [72] studied the copolymerization of cyclohexyl acrylate and methyl methacrylate at high temperatures. As in Scheme 4.16, H-abstraction only happens to
the acrylate unit. If the adjacent units are acrylate and methacrylate, two types of
fragmentation with dierent reaction rates are possible, as illustrated in Scheme
4.17. It was observed that the number of the unsaturated end groups per chain is
increased by increasing the methacrylate content in the polymerization. Thus it
was deduced that fragmentation greatly favors the generation of tertiary (methacrylate chain end) radical species, a result in agreement with the high rate of fragmentation observed in methacrylate macromonomer systems [73].

CH3

CH3

C
CH2

HC

C
CH2

fast

CH2

CH2

H2C

CO2CH3

CO2CH3

CO2CH3 CO2CH3 CO2CH3

CH2
C

HC
CO2CH3

CH3

slow

C
CH2

C
CH2

CO2CH3

CH2
CO2CH3

HC
CO2CH3

Fragmentation of a mid-chain radical with


adjacent MA and MMA units (after Ref. 72).

Scheme 4.17.

Fragmentation after intramolecular transfer results in the formation of a longchain radical and trimer species or a dimer radical and an unsaturated dead chain
(Scheme 4.13). Consideration of all possible pathways and structures becomes
complex, but the resulting model requires no additional parameters from the homopolymerization back-biting/scission case and provides a good representation of
high temperature acrylatemethacrylate copolymerization [70].
4.3.3

Diusion-controlled Reactions

The kinetic schemes in this chapter have been written assuming that k t is independent of the sizes of the radicals involved in the termination reaction. This is not

4.3 Polymerization Mechanisms and Kinetics


1.0E+09

1.0E+08

kt (L/mol-s)

1.0E+07

1.0E+06

1.0E+05

MMA
nBA
DA

1.0E+04

1.0E+03

1.0E+02
0

0.1

0.2

0.3

0.4

0.5

0.6

0.7

0.8

0.9

Conversion

Fig. 4.6. Typical variation of k t with conversion for methyl


methacrylate (MMA), butyl acrylate (nBA), and dodecyl acrylate
(DA). Based upon data from [15].

strictly true, since the termination rate is limited by the rates at which the radical
ends can encounter each other. For a diusion-controlled reaction, the apparent
rate coecient is aected not only by pressure and temperature, but also by system
viscosity (a function of solvent, polymer concentration, and MW) and the lengths
of the two terminating radicals. This complex behavior, as well as experimental difculties in measuring k t , has led to a large scatter in reported values, even at low
conversion [7]. Through the application of pulsed-laser experimental techniques
[15] and a critical examination of available data [18], the situation is starting to
improve.
For most commercial free radical polymerization, the errors involved by neglecting the dependence of k t on radical chain length are not large. The change in k t
with conversion (increasing viscosity), however, cannot be neglected. Figure 4.6
shows the three to four orders of magnitude decrease in k t typically observed. The
shape of the curve reects the changing nature of the rate-controlling diusion
mechanism. The usual division is as follows:


Low conversion: the system viscosity is still low, and the two chains diuse together quickly. The rate of reaction is controlled by segmental diusion, the internal reorganization of the chain that is required to bring the reactive ends together. In this region k t is of the order of 10 8 L mol1 s1 for many common
monomers (Table 4.3), with the value remaining relatively constant up to 10
20% conversion. Solvent choice can have a signicant eect on the value [18].

191

192

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Lower values of 10 6 L mol1 s1 for dodecyl (meth)acrylate is attributed to shielding of the radicals by the long-chain dodecyl ester groups; for these monomers k t
remains relatively constant up to 60% conversion [64]. Even lower k t values are
measured for termination during polymerization of sterically hindered monomers such as the itaconates [74] and acrylate trimer species [44]. The variation
of low-conversion k t with polymer composition in copolymer systems can be represented by Eq. (55).
 Medium to high conversion: the large increase in system viscosity with polymer
formation leads to a change in the controlling mechanism. The rate of reaction is
controlled by how quickly the two chains nd each other among the tangle of
dead polymer chains in the system. This so-called center-of-mass or translational
diusion mechanism is complex, aected by the lengths of the reacting chains
as well as the system viscosity. The value of k t can drop by several orders of magnitude in this regime.
 Very high conversion: at high conversion, the system may become so viscous that
the polymer radicals move more quickly through propagation (addition of new
monomer units) than by translation. This phenomenon, called reaction diusion, leads to a second plateau region in the k t versus conversion plot, with k t
proportional to k p 1  x p . If the glass transition temperature of the reaction
mixture exceeds the reaction temperature, the propagation reaction and apparent
initiator eciency [75] may also become diusion-controlled.
The overall behavior of k t with conversion is often modeled as a composite of the
various diusional processes [Eq. (60)].
1
1
1

k t k t; SD k t; TD k t; RD

60

The subscripts SD; TD, and RD refer to segmental diusion, translational diusion, and reaction diusion. k t; SD can be set to the low conversion values summarized in Table 4.3, and k t; RD is set proportional to propagation, with proportionality
coecient CRD tted to experimental data [Eq. (61)].
k t; RD CRD k p 1  x p

61

Many semi-empirical approaches have been used to model k t; TD as a function of


system viscosity, conversion, or free volume. The latter treatment relates the chain
diusivity to the system free volume vf by Eq. (62), with parameters Ci tted to experimental data.
k t; TD z C1 expC2 vf

62

This eect of polymer MW on system viscosity may be captured by expressing C1


as a function of Mw . It is observed experimentally that addition of a powerful
chain-transfer agent to MMA lowers polymer MW and system viscosity, thereby in-

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering


1
0.9
0.8

Conversion

0.7
0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2

MMA
nBA

0.1
0
0

500

1000

1500

2000

time (s)
Fig. 4.7. Typical timeconversion plots for methyl methacrylate
and butyl acrylate batch polymerizations. The sharp increase in
rate seen for MMA, known as the gel eect, is due to the large
decrease in k t with conversion.

creasing k t , while addition of a small amount of EGDMA crosslinking agent has


the opposite eect [39]. Details and variations of this modeling approach can be
found in the literature [40, 7679].
A good model for k t is necessary to capture the timeconversion behavior in homogeneous batch FRP systems. The large decrease in k t at intermediate conversion results in an increase in radical concentration [Eq. (9)] and a corresponding
increase in R pol [Eq. (10)] that causes an upward curvature in the timeconversion
plot (Figure 4.7). This accelerated rate is accompanied by a large heat release that
can be dicult to remove from the viscous reaction system. The severity of the gel
eect is directly related to the magnitude of the decrease in k t , as seen by comparing the nBA and MMA rate proles in the gure. The decrease also leads to an increase in DPninst [Eq. (13)] for systems where MW is controlled by termination.

4.4

Polymer Reaction Engineering

The design of an industrial polymerization process begins with a clear understanding of objectives and an appreciation of constraints. Design and operation
requirements are very dierent for a process manufacturing several grades of a
high-volume commodity homopolymer, and one that produces dozens of dier-

193

194

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

ent (and often new) low-volume higher-value products of varying composition


and structure. Typical product specications for a homogeneous FRP process
may include average molecular weight/molecular weight distribution, copolymer
composition/copolymer composition distribution, degree of branching/branching
distribution, and sequence length distribution. Depending on the nature of the
product, any of these properties can simultaneously be product specications.
However, the polymer is ultimately not sold on basic structural characteristics but
rather on end-use properties. This poses the challenge of relating structural features to properties. Invariably the end-use properties are a product of not one but
several structural features; therefore establishing relationships is a complex task,
and the ensuing relationships are usually restricted to a narrow range of materials.
Establishing structureproperty relationships remains an active area of research.
Together with an understanding of the key properties and their desired values is
a need to understand quantitatively how much variation is acceptable for each
property. In an industrial polymerization environment, there will naturally be
some degree of process variability that will translate into product variability. Knowing the extent to which deviations from the target value of a property aect the
manufacturers ability to sell that product is a critical piece of design information.
Unlike many chemical systems, o-spec polymeric material cannot be easily recycled or altered by downstream unit-operations. The diculty of characterizing
polymer structure on-line makes design of a robust easy-to-operate process especially important.
Design of a process involves several decisions such as the type of reactor used,
the ow and contacting patterns for the reagents, the choice of homogeneous versus heterogeneous process types, and so on. Heat removal and mixing issues are
two key factors that strongly inuence design and operation of homogeneous FRP
processes.
Heat removal Free-radical polymerizations are highly exothermic, with adiabatic
temperature rises for bulk monomers typically @200500 C. (Values of DHp for
common monomers are tabulated in Table 4.6.) In addition, the overall activation
energy for a radical polymerization, calculated from the activation energies of
initiation, propagation, and termination [see Eq. (10)] is on the order of 80 G 15
kJ mol1 . The sudden and dramatic increase in the heat produced in the gel-eect
region can result in loss of eective temperature control. If there is a process disturbance leading to a thermal runaway condition, the heat generation rate can exceed the heat removal rate to such an extent that the reaction behaves close to adiabatically. The resulting temperature increase can pose serious safety concerns such
as reactor overpressurization and possible explosion, requiring processes to be
designed to safely release the pressure prior to failure (rupture) of the process
equipment.
Heat removal is also an important issue to consider during process scale-up. As
reactor size increases, the system dynamics become increasingly slow, and therefore it takes longer for desired changes (for example decreasing the reactor temperature) to occur. This may in itself not be a serious problem, provided the reactor

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering

cooling system is able to maintain control, albeit at a higher than desired temperature. However, large variations in the temperature prole can translate into dierences in the nal product properties, particularly molecular weight distribution.
The monograph by Biesenberger and Sebastian [80] provides an excellent discussion of thermal eects, including thermal runaway.
Mixing Mixing can directly aect the kinetics, molecular weight, and composition
in radical polymerizations by homogenizing local concentration gradients, but it
can also indirectly play an important role through its role in reducing thermal gradients in a reactor. In small-scale experiments, most transport phenomena (heat
transfer, mixing) occur suciently fast for overall behavior to be dictated primarily
by reaction kinetics. However, as scale increases, kinetic and transport eects become increasingly coupled. Homogeneous FRP reactions oer a particularly challenging problem because of the large increase in viscosity accompanying the
conversion from bulk monomer (@1 cp for liquids) to polymer (> 10 5 cp). The increase in viscosity can greatly aect the reaction kinetics (see Section 4.3.3) as well
as the heat removal and quality of mixing in the system. Some processes are designed to not require mixing. For example, PMMA can be polymerized in large
sheets. By having large surface areas available for heat transfer, adequate temperature control is achieved without the need to provide mixing during polymerization.
Other bulk polymerizations (for example, styrene) employ more than one reactor
in series, since dierent reactor congurations and agitators will be required as
the viscosity increases. Solution polymerizations oer low viscosity but the trend
in industry is to eliminate (or greatly reduce) the use of organic solvents. Mixing
can also be an issue at lower viscosities such as those found in LDPE systems,
where the high-temperature conditions make for very fast reactions (for example,
initiator half-life of <1 s) on the order of characteristic mixing times.
4.4.1

Types of Industrial Reactors

There are three major classications of chemical processes, categorized by the


method by which the reactants are added to the reaction vessel. Varying the
contacting pattern can dramatically alter the local reaction conditions (for example, concentrations of individual species, including monomers, initiators, chaintransfer agents, and so on), and is therefore a potentially powerful design tool for
controlling properties such as molecular weight distribution, copolymer composition distribution, and degree of branching. Because of the ability to manipulate local monomer concentrations, the rate of polymerization can also be controlled,
thereby providing safer and more robust operation.
Batch Processes
All of the reactants are added to the reactor prior to starting the polymerization. No
material is added to or removed from the reactor during operation. When the polymerization is complete, the contents are discharged and the reactor prepared for
4.4.1.1

195

196

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

the next batch. Batch polymerizations are the simplest to run, but oer the least
control over the polymerization. For polymerizations with more than one monomer, the relative consumption rates of the dierent monomers will be governed
by their respective reactivities, possibly resulting in broad copolymer composition
distributions and inhomogeneous product. Another feature of batch polymerizations is that reactant concentrations change throughout the polymerization. Molecular weight distribution drift is therefore a common phenomenon and can lead to
very broad distributions in the nal product. From an economic perspective, batch
polymerizations suer from downtime between batches, although much progress
has been made in automating many of the reactant weighing, charging, and discharging steps to minimize this interval. Automation has also improved reproducibility of batch reactions. For operations where changes to the formulation or the
polymerization conditions are common, batch processes have the advantage of being exible and readily adaptable to new products.
Semi-batch Processes
These processes (also called semi-continuous) are similar to batch processes, except that reactants can be added and/or products removed during the polymerization. Usually only a portion of the total reactant charge is initially fed into the reactor. The polymerization is then started, and reactants are added during reaction in
order to control a desired property (for example molecular weight distribution, copolymer composition distribution) or the reaction rate. Any reactant can be fed,
and it is common practice to add monomer(s), initiators, and/or chain-transfer
agents. Two of the most common applications for semi-batch operation in homogeneous FRP are control of copolymer composition distribution and control of reaction rate. In a batch reaction, copolymer composition drifts according to the inherent reactivities of the monomers. However in semi-batch operation, drift can be
substantially reduced by maintaining a (near) constant concentration ratio of the
respective monomers in the reactor. Production of low molecular weight co- or terpolymers (for example coatings) is also readily done using this type of approach.
Initiator and monomers are continuously fed in the desired ratio to provide composition and MW control while maintaining starved conditions (low monomer concentration) in the reactor. This mode of operation also ensures that at any time the
monomer concentration in the reactor is low, and therefore the maximum potential hazard in the event of a thermal runaway reaction is minimized. A potential
concern with operating in a starved mode is that polymer concentrations are high,
resulting in higher rates of transfer to polymer and branching reactions.
4.4.1.2

Continuous Processes
Reactants are fed, and products and unconsumed reactants are removed, continuously. The process may take place in a single reactor or in a train (series) of reactors in which the monomer conversion is gradually increased. Most continuous
processes are operated at steady-state conditions, meaning all reactant concentrations and process conditions (temperature, pressure, and so on) are time-invariant.
This can be an enormous advantage for certain types of properties if the reactor is
4.4.1.3

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering

also well mixed (no spatial variations); because concentrations are constant, there
is no molecular weight distribution drift, and no composition distribution drift.
Thus, narrower molecular weight distributions can be produced in a well-mixed
continuous reactor for linear polymer systems than in batch systems. Branching
reactions, however, broaden the MWD in a well-mixed continuous reactor to a
greater extent than in a batch system due to the residence time distribution [80,
81]. For large-volume polymers with a limited number of variations to the polymerization conditions (for example, formulation changes), continuous processes are
favored because of their low operating cost, high throughput rates, more uniform
product quality, and simplicity of operation.
4.4.2

Mathematical Modeling of FRP Kinetics

Mathematical modeling is a powerful methodology to improve the understanding


and operation of polymer processes. A good process model can be used to predict
the inuence of operating conditions on reaction rate and polymer properties, to
guide (along with appropriate experimentation) the selection and optimization of
standard operating conditions for existing and new polymer grades, to guide process development from lab to pilot-plant to full-scale production, to help discriminate between kinetic and physical (for example, heat and mass transfer) eects, to
perform design and safety studies, to train plant personnel, and to understand and
optimize transitions and other dynamic behavior (that is, process control).
The modeling approach and level of detail should be dictated by the application.
Whereas an empirical model linking measured inputs and outputs may be the best
solution for control of an existing industrial reactor, it would be totally inappropriate for design of a new process or to choose operating conditions for a new polymer grade. On the other hand, it makes little sense to develop a model that can
predict detailed polymer architecture for control purposes when the only measure
of polymer structure is a melt index value obtained from the lab two hours after
the sample was produced. While empirical modeling has its uses, the focus of
this section is the development of fundamental models based upon rst-principles
descriptions of chemical and physical phenomena. Although a perfect description
of an actual process is, in the end, an unattainable goal, the attempt often leads to
valuable insights that can aid process and product development, scale-up, and optimization. Techniques to model the FRP mechanisms and kinetics of Section 4.3
are presented rst, followed by a discussion of issues related to reactor modeling.
Wherever possible, examples have been selected to emphasize industrial application. Although a few historical references are included, the main focus is on advances made since the mid-1990s.
The objective of kinetic modeling is to build a description of how polymer architecture and polymerization rate depend on reaction conditions (temperature, pressure) and species concentrations from a dened set of kinetic mechanisms; a dynamic model is required to examine how properties change as a function of time.
The mechanisms to be included in a model depend upon its end-use. For simple

197

198

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

mass and energy balances, it is only necessary to consider those that consume
monomer, initiator, and radicals initiation, propagation, and radicalradical termination. To track polymer molecular weight, all mechanisms that include radical
transfer must also be included. Additional balances are needed to follow other molecular properties, such as the density of short- or long-chain branches, end-group
functionality, and the creation and reaction of terminal double bonds.
Method of Moments
The equations in Section 4.3, while useful for examining rate of polymerization
and instantaneous chain length, are not written in an appropriate form for substituting into a generalized reactor model. In addition, they do not provide a means
of tracking higher MW averages that are strongly aected by long-chain branching
reactions. One of the challenges in modeling polymerization systems is how to reduce a very large number of individual species (living and dead chains with lengths
from 1 to >10 5 , often with other distributed attributes such as the number of
branch points) to a tractable solution. The classical approach to this problem is
to reduce the system of equations through denition of the principal moments
of the various distributions [82]. Construction of moment balances allows the
tracking of average polymer properties: for molecular weight this would be Mn
(number-average), Mw (weight-average), and possibly Mz , and for branched systems it is possible to track the number-average (B n ) and weight-average (B w ) number of branches per chain. Only the basics of the mathematical treatment for a homopolymerization system will be given here: more details can be found in recent
comprehensive reviews [83, 84].
Consider a free radical system that includes the basic set of mechanisms shown
in Scheme 4.3 as well as long-chain branching [Eq. (27)]. The moments for the radical (l j ) and dead (zj ) polymer distributions are dened in Eqs. (63) and (64).
4.4.2.1

lj

y
X

n j Pn 

63

n j Dn 

64

n1

vj

y
X
n1

It is also helpful to dene moments for the bulk polymer (mj ), the total polymer in
the system including live radicals [Eq. (65)].

mj

y
X

n j Dn  Pn 

65

n1

With Dn  g Pn  there is little dierence in magnitude between mj and zj . Its introduction, however, eliminates the moment closure problem created by the LCB
mechanism [40, 81, 85]. Many of the moments have precise physical meanings.

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering

The zeroth live moment, l 0 , is the concentration of polymer radicals in the system
(denoted by [Ptot ] in Section 4.3), and the rst live moment, l1 , is the concentration
of monomer units contained in all growing radicals. Similarly, m 0 is the concentration of all polymer chains in the system, and m1 is the concentration of monomer
units bound in all polymer chains. These moment denitions collapse the innite
set of equations for polymeric species into a manageable subset used to calculate
MW averages, where m w is the molecular weight of the monomeric repeat unit
[Eqs. (66)].
Mn m w

m1
;
m0

Mw m w

m2
;
m1

Mz m w

m3
m2

66

For this example, equations for the kinetic expressions for m 0 ; m1, and m 2 will be
developed for the calculation of Mn and Mw .
The rst step is to formulate balances for live radicals, dead chains, and total
chains of length n, accounting for all of the consumption and generation terms
from the kinetic mechanisms [Eqs. (67)(69)].
(
RPn

2f kd I

ktrmon M

)
y
y
X
X
sol
Pj  ktr S
Pj  dn  1
j1

j1

k p MPn1   Pn 
(
ktrmon M

ktrsol S

)
y
X
k td k tc
Pj  Pn 
j1

y
y
X
X
pol
pol
k tr nDn 
Pj   k tr Pn 
jDj 
j1

(
R Dn

ktrmon M
pol

k tr Pn 
(
RPn Dn

ktrsol S

y
X

)
y
n1
X
1 X
k td
Pj  Pn  k tc
Pj Pnj 
2
j1
j1
pol

jDj   k tr nDn 

j1

2f kd I

67

j1

y
X

Pj 

68

j1

ktrmon M

)
y
y
X
X
sol
Pj  ktr S
Pj  dn  1
j1

j1

k p MPn1   Pn 
!
y
n1
X
1 X
Pj  Pn  k tc
Pj Pnj 
 k tc
2
j1
j1

69

The origin of the various terms in these balances should be evident by looking
at the mechanisms of Scheme 4.3 and Eq. (27). The Kronecker delta function
[dx 1 if x 0 and sx 0 if x 0 0 ] accounts for the generation of new polymeric radicals (P1 ), and the terms for transfer to polymer account for the probabil-

199

200

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

ity that transfer to a certain chain Dn is proportional to chain length n. The expression for termination by combination accounts for the possibility of creating Dn
from any combination of two smaller radical fragments whose lengths sum to n.
The next step in the procedure is to substitute these species balances into the
moment denitions in Eqs. (63)(65). The use of generating functions [82, 86, 87]
eliminates the tedium (and possible errors) of performing the required series summations, and leads to Eqs. (70)(78) for the moments.
Live moments:
Rl 0 2 f kd I  k td k tc l02
Rl1 2f kd I

ktrmon Ml 0

70
ktrsol Sl 0

k p Ml 0
pol

 fktrmon M ktrsol S k td k tc l 0 gl1 k tr l 0 v2  l1 v1


Rl2 2f kd I

ktrmon Ml 0

ktrsol Sl 0

71

k p Ml 0 2l1
pol

 fktrmon M ktrsol S k td k tc l 0 gl2 k tr l 0 v3  l2 v1

72

Dead moments:
1
R v0 ktrmon Ml 0 ktrsol Sl 0 k td l02 k tc l02
2

73
pol

R v1 fktrmon M ktrsol S k td k tc l 0 gl1  k tr l 0 v2  l1 v1


R v2

fktrmon M

ktrsol S

k td k tc l 0 gl2

k tc l12

pol
k tr l 0 v3

74
 l2 v1

75

Bulk moments:
1
Rm 0 2f kd I ktrmon Ml 0 ktrsol Sl 0  k tc l02
2

76

Rm1 2f kd I ktrmon Ml 0 ktrsol Sl 0 k p Ml 0

77

Rm 2 2f kd I ktrmon Ml 0 ktrsol Sl 0 k p Ml 0 2l1 k tc l12

78

The set of moment expressions to be considered consists of either the live and dead
moments [Eqs. (70)(75)] or the live and bulk moments [Eqs. (70), (71) and (76)
(78)], substituting m1 and m 2 for z1 and z2 in Eq. (71). Choice of the former, while it
is common practice in the literature, suers from the problem that the equations
for l2 and z2 depend on z3 . The Hulburt and Kutz [88] method is often used to approximate z3 , assuming that the molecular weight distribution can be represented
by a truncated series of Laguerre polynomials by using a gamma distribution
weighting function [Eq. (79)].
v3

v2
2v0 v2  v12
v0 v 1

79

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering

Using the bulk moments not only eliminates the need for this approximation, but
also reduces the set of equations by one, since Eq. (72) is not required to solve for
Mw . An additional balance [Eq. (80)] can be added to either set of equations to track
the concentration of LCB formed by the transfer to polymer mechanism,
pol

RLCB k tr l 0 m1

80

Thus, a set of six equations [Eqs. (70), (71), (76)(78), and (80)] can be used to collapse the molecular weight distribution into its principle averages to calculate Mn ,
Mw , and LCB density.
The set of moment equations developed here can be extended to include additional complex mechanisms, such as reactivity of terminal double bonds [Eq. (30),
Scheme 4.10] [81], crosslinking (Scheme 4.11) [40], and chain b-scission following
intermolecular H-abstraction [89]. The methodology can also be extended to copolymerization systems, either by dening copolymer-averaged rate coecients as
in Eqs. (50) and (54) [6, 8587], or by dening additional moment quantities (for
examples, see Refs. 40, 81, 85). Furthermore, since it is easy to implement as part
of larger-scale reactor modeling, it is the standard methodology used in process
simulation packages (see, for example, Refs. 90, 91). For discussion regarding the
nal step of model development, substitution of the kinetic expressions for the moments into reactor balances, see Section 4.4.3.
Modeling of Distributions
The major limitation of models based on the method of moments is that they only
track average quantities. While adequate for most situations, more detail may be
needed if the objective of the study is to improve our knowledge of the kinetics
for example, to examine the combined eect of chain-scission and long-chain
branching on polymer architecture, or to incorporate chain-length dependent termination kinetics into the mechanistic scheme. In such cases, the kinetic and
modeling assumptions can be tested more rigorously through a detailed comparison with full molecular weight distributions (MWDs) measured experimentally.
Recent advances in modeling tools now make it possible to simulate the complete
MWD, as well as how a second distributed quantity (for example, LCB) varies with
chain length.
The modeling of complete MWDs has long been possible for linear polymer systems, that is, those without any branching. In the absence of long-chain branching
and employing the QSSA, a recursive relationship can be derived for Pn and Dn
from Eqs. (67) and (68), leading to Eqs. (81) and (82) for the weight-fraction distribution of polymer formed at any instant in time [92].
4.4.2.2

wninst t 0:5n  1bt bt bn

k td l 0  ktrmon M ktrsol S
;
k p M

1
1bt

k tc l 0 
k p M

n
81

82

201

202

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Assuming the formation of long-chain polymer (t b f 1), the values for instantaneous DPn and DPw are given by Eqs. (83).
DPninst

1
;
t 0:5b

DPwinst

2t 3b
t b 2

83

The instantaneous PDI is 2 for a system where there is no termination by combination (b 0), and 1.5 if termination by combination is the only chain-ending
mechanism (t 0). These expressions can be integrated to follow the evolution of
the MWD with time or conversion and compare against experimental data, as was
done by Balke and Hamielec [92] for batch isothermal FRP of MMA.
Unfortunately, the methodology cannot be easily extended to branched systems,
due to the interaction of the polymer radical and dead polymer chain distributions
through reaction (for example, H-abstraction, terminal double bond polymerization, crosslinking). The methods for modeling MWDs with branching can be divided into three main groups. The rst, utilizing Monte Carlo techniques, has
been greatly advanced through the eorts of Tobita. Assuming a given set of
mechanisms, the probabilities of connections between primary polymer molecules
(the linear chain that would exist if all of its branch points were severed) is calculated, and the resulting MWD solved using Monte Carlo techniques [93].
A second group of models is based upon the numerical fractionation concept
developed by Teymour and Campbell [94]. This seminal work identies a succession of branched polymer generations based on the degree of complexity of
their architecture, tracking the population of chains in each generation using
the method of moments. The complete MWD is approximated by combining the
MWDs for individual generations which themselves are reconstructed from the
leading moments assuming a distributional form. Numerical fractionation was
specically developed to examine the problem of gel formation in polymer systems. Thus, the generations were dened to follow the geometric progression in
chain length caused by connection of two molecules in the same generation: while
chains from the zeroth generation progress to the rst generation by participating
in a branching event, a chain from the rst generation can only progress to the second by joining (through crosslinking, terminal double bond polymerization, or termination by combination) with another molecule from the same generation [94]. It
has been shown that this classication scheme leads, in certain cases, to errors in
the shape of the overall MWD: through comparison with distributions calculated
by rigorous numerical solution, Butte et al. [95] have shown that the denition of
generations proposed by Teymour and Campbell can create an articial high MW
shoulder due to the accumulation of chains with a wide distribution of the number
of branches (and thus high polydispersity) in the rst branched generation. The
authors conclude that a more accurate approximation is obtained by classifying
the chains according to their number of branches. Both Monte Carlo [96] and a
modied numerical fractionation technique [95] can also be used to calculate the
LCB number as a function of chain length, an important quantity often presented
experimentally.

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering

The commercial software Predici2 package uses yet another numerical technique, calculating MWDs using a discrete Galerkin technique with variable grid
and variable order [97]. In 2000, the package was extended to follow branch point
concentrations as a function of chain length through the introduction of balance
equations [98]. The possibility of performing these tasks calculation of complete
MWD as well as LCB distribution in a commercial software package is especially
noteworthy because it makes it possible for a wider range of practitioners to perform detailed kinetic modeling. These new modeling capabilities, in combination
with improved characterization techniques, will hasten progress to a better understanding and representation of complex polymer architecture [46, 99].
4.4.3

Reactor Modeling

The kinetic expressions of Section 4.4.2 are substituted into overall material and
energy balances to construct a model to represent an FRP process. For a wellmixed reactor system, Eqs. (84)(89) comprise the general system of equations for
homopolymerization.
dVM
qin Min   qout M  VR pol
dt

84

dVI
qin Iin   qout I  VR d
dt

85

dVS
qin Sin   qout S  VRtrsol
dt

86

dVl i 
qin li; in   qout l i  VRl i
dt

87

dVm i 
qin m i; in   qout m i  VRmi
dt

88

dVrc p T  Tref
qin rc p in Tin  Tref  qout rc p out T  Tref
dt
DHp VR pol  Q

89

In these balances, which must be accompanied by appropriate initial conditions


and a volume balance, V is the reactor volume, qin and qout are the inlet and outlet
volumetric ow rates, r and c p are the density and heat capacity of the mixture, and
Q is the rate of heat removal from the reactor system. The various source terms
have been presented earlier: Eq. (10) for the monomer and energy balance, Eq. (2)
for the initiator balance, Rtrsol ktrsol Sl 0 in the solvent balance, Eqs. (70) and (71)
for the live moment balances, and Eqs. (76)(78) for the bulk moment balances.

203

204

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Batch Polymerization
Inow and outow terms are set to zero, but the change in volume with conversion must be considered for the constant-mass system [Eq. (90)].
4.4.3.1

dV
V dr

dt
r dt

90

Volume contraction due to the dierence in polymer and monomer densities can
be as high as 20% for bulk polymerization, and should not be neglected when solving the material balances. Solution of the initiator balance and substitution into
the monomer balance lead to a dierential equation for conversion, Eq. (91), where
the volume contraction factor is dened as e rnal  r0 =rnal where rnal is the
system density at 100% conversion of monomer to polymer and r0 is the initial
density of the system.
dx p

dt

kp
1=2

kt

2f kd I0
1  ex p

!1=2



kd t
1  x p exp 
2

91

Continuous Polymerization
Equations (84)(89) can be solved to provide a description of the dynamic behavior
of a continuous well-stirred system. Analytical solutions may be derived for the
steady-state case by setting all derivative terms to zero. Assuming no inow of radicals, Eq. (92) results for l 0.
4.4.3.2

qout l 0  V2f kd I  k t l 0  2

92

For most cases, the radical lifetime is much shorter than the average residence
time. Thus outow of radicals can be neglected, resulting in the familiar expression, Eq. (93), for l 0.

l 0 



2f kd I 1=2
kt

93

[I] can be calculated from the steady-state solution of Eq. (83), namely Eq. (94),
where y V=qout is the reactor residence time and e rout  rin =rout is the fractional density change between inlet and outlet streams.

I

qin Iin 
Iin 

qout Vkd 1 ykd 1  e

94

Substitution of these expressions into the monomer balance leads to a nonlinear


relationship between conversion and y [Eq. (95)].

4.4 Polymer Reaction Engineering

x p yk p l 0 y

kp
1=2
kt

!

2f kd Iin 
1  e1 ykd

1=2
95

Assuming no inow of polymer into the reactor and the long-chain hypothesis, the
pol
steady-state values for DPn and DPw in the absence of LCB (k tr 0) are given by
Eq. (83). LCB and reaction with terminal double bonds broaden the MWD signicantly [81].

Complex Flowsheets
These are often constructed to represent systems with nonideal mixing and fast reaction. A classic example is the high-pressure high-temperature free radical production of ethylene copolymers, generally conducted in a homogeneous phase consisting largely of supercritical ethylene monomer. These conditions make for very
fast reactions (for example, initiator half-life of <1 s), promote numerous side reactions (long-chain branching, short-chain branching, and chain scission), and introduce the potential of thermal runaway. Recent models of these systems combine
a detailed description of polymerization kinetics with a complex owsheet of continuous well-mixed tanks in series with recycle to represent mixing in a multizone,
multifeed autoclave reactor [100102]. Models for multifeed tubular systems also
include heat transfer and pressure drop along the length of the system [103]. The
general strategy is to tune the model (based upon a set of proposed kinetic
mechanisms captured by the method of moments) by tting kinetic coecients
and mixing and heat transfer parameters to a set of industrial data, and then to
use the model to interpret and optimize industrial operating conditions. Advances
in computing power have allowed the complexity of these models to increase.
4.4.3.3

Computational Fluid Dynamics (CFD)


CFD simulation is emerging as an alternative and more fundamental approach to
examining polymerization systems with complex mixing and reaction. Once again,
much of the work is focused on high-pressure ethylene polymerization systems.
A major challenge is incorporating both macromixing (turbulent diusion and
convection) as well as micromixing (molecular diusion) into the representation
[104]. The rst eorts in this area [104, 105] concern themselves with the prediction of temperature and conversion proles in the reactors; to simplify the calculational load they consider only initiation, propagation, and termination reactions.
More recently, Kolhapure and Fox [106] incorporated a more complete kinetic
scheme to allow the prediction of polymer MW, polydispersity, and average branching number. These CFD studies can point the way to improved reactor design and
operation; for example, by examining the importance of initiator distribution at the
injection point, and dening conditions for stable reactor operation [106]. An article in 2000 discussed the implementation of CFD calculations within a process
simulation package [107]. Although not yet applied to polymerization systems,
this advancement shows enormous promise.
4.4.3.4

205

206

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Model-based Control
Model-based control of polymerization systems has also garnered its share of attention. The goal of these eorts is the development of robust strategies to guide and
control the manufacture of polymer safely and reproducibly in the face of unmeasured disturbances and frequent product grade transitions. The main challenge in
controlling polymerization systems is the lack of on-line measurements of polymer
structure. A review by Congalidis and Richards [108] provides a good summary of
literature focusing on this dicult issue; for further discussion, see Chapter 12 of
this book. In most cases, the implementation of detailed fundamental models is
not warranted for control application. However, simple models can often be combined with limited on-line measurements (for example, in Refs. 109112) to improve control performance. Fundamental models can also be used to test empirical
models developed for control purposes [113].
4.4.3.5

4.5

Summary

Polymer reaction engineering issues can pose major challenges for industrial-scale
polymer synthesis. As reactor size increases, transport phenomena such as heat
and mass transfer become more dicult, and large-scale homogeneous FRP processes are often limited by transport eects. In many cases, the nal reaction rate,
molecular weight, and copolymer composition are determined by the coupled effects of reaction kinetics and transport phenomena. Mathematical modeling, in
conjunction with a strong experimental program, is a powerful means to improve
our mechanistic and process understanding. The use of empirical models has utility in the control of polymerization reactors, and can be an important contributor
to product quality and process robustness. Continuing development of new measurement techniques, together with an ability to relate measurements to functional
properties, will be a critical area of future research.
While many current free-radical polymerization processes have been in industrial use for years, the next several years may see the emergence of new industrial
technologies. Promising technologies for homogeneous FRP include living radical
polymerization chemistries and polymerization in supercritical carbon dioxide.
The adoption of new technology requires identifying an application or product for
which the new technology is clearly advantaged, and successfully overcoming the
numerous scaleup challenges in converting the process to industrial scale. These
processes will require a detailed understanding of polymerization kinetics combined with fundamental reaction engineering principles.
Notation

Ai
CtrXXX

pre-exponential factor for mechanism-i


ratio of chain-transfer rate coecient (k trXXX , XXX mon, pol, sol) to
propagation [Eq. (19)]

Notation

heat capacity [kJ kg1 K1 ]


dead polymer chain of length n with terminal unsaturation
dead polymer chain of length n with b branch points
number-average degree of polymerization
weight-average degree of polymerization
activation energy for mechanism-i [kJ mol1 ]
mole fraction of monomer-i contained in polymer chains being formed
initiator eciency [Eq. (1)]
mole fraction of monomer-i in the monomer mixture
mole fraction of polymer radicals ending in monomer unit-i
mole fraction of polymer radicals ending in monomer unit-j with penultimate unit-i
[I]
initiator concentration [mol L1 ]
equilibrium propagationdepropagation constant
K eq
rate coecient for intramolecular H-abstraction [s1 ]
kbb
kd
rate coecient for initiation decomposition [s1 ]
rate coecient for depropagation [s1 ]
kdep
rate coecient for primary-radical initiation [L mol1 s1 ]
ki
rate coecient for inhibition [L mol1 s1 ]
k inhib
rate coecient for propagation [L mol1 s1 ]
kp
rate coecient for addition of monomer-j to radical-i [L mol1 s1 ]
k pij
rate coecient for addition of monomer-k to penultimate radical-ij
k pijk
[L mol1 s1 ]
cop
kp
copolymer-averaged propagation rate coecient [L mol1 s1 ]
e
eective propagation rate coecient, corrected for depropagation
kp
[L mol1 s1 ]
pol
rate coecient for radical addition to a terminally-unsaturated chain
kp
[L mol1 s1 ]
tert
addition rate of monomer to mid-chain radical [L mol1 s1 ]
kp
rate coecient for termination [combination disproportionation)
kt
[L mol1 s1 ]
cop
kt
copolymer-averaged termination rate coecient [L mol1 s1 ]
rate coecient for termination by combination [L mol1 s1 ]
k tc
rate coecient for termination by disproportionation [L mol1 s1 ]
k td
rate coecient for thermal initiation of styrene [L 2 mol2 s1 ]
k therm
rate coecient for transfer to species XXX (mon, pol, sol) [L mol1 s1 ]
k trXXX
rate coecient for radical b-scission [s1 ]
kb
[M]
monomer concentration [mol L1 ]
equilibrium monomer concentration [mol L1 ]
[M]eq
Mn
number-average molecular weight [g mol1 ]
weight-average molecular weight [g mol1 ]
Mw
molecular weight of the reaction mixture [g mol1 ]
mw
Ni
number-average length of monomer-i sequences
NMi ; nj fraction of monomer-i sequences that are exactly nj units in length
probability of unit-j following unit-i in a polymer chain
Pij
cp
Dn
Dn; b
DPn
DPw
Ei
Fpinst
i
f
fi
fri
frij

207

208

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

Pn
Pn; b
[Ptot ]
i
]
[Ptot
Qn
qin
qout
Rd
R dep
R inhib
R init
RLCB
Rp
pol
Rp
R pol
R term
R therm
R trXXX
Rl i
ri
[S]
si
T
Tc
t 1=2
V
wn
xp
[Z]

polymer radical of length n


polymer radical of length n with b branch points
total concentration of radicals [mol L1 ]
total concentration of polymer radicals of type-i [mol L1 ]
mid-chain polymer radical of length-n (formed by intramolecular or intermolecular H-abstraction)
reactor inlet volumetric ow [L s1 ]
reactor outlet volumetric ow [L s1 ]
rate of initiator disappearance [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of depropagation [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of inhibition [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of radical generation from initiator [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of long-chain branch formation [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of propagation [mol L1 s1 ]
addition rate of terminally unsaturated polymer chains mol L1 s1 ]
total rate of monomer consumption [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of radicalradical termination [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of thermal initiation of styrene [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of transfer to species XXX (mon, pol, sol) [mol L1 s1 ]
rate of change of moment l i [mol L1 s1 ]
monomer reactivity ratio for radical-i (for example, r1 k p11 =k p12 )
solvent (transfer agent) concentration [mol L1 ]
radical reactivity ratio for monomer-i in the penultimate copolymerization model (for example, s1 k p211 =k p111 )
temperature [K]
ceiling temperature of monomer [ C]
initiator half-life [s1 ]
reactor volume [L]
weight fraction of chains of length-n
fractional monomer conversion to polymer
inhibitor concentration [mol L1 ]

Greek
b
DGp
DHp
DSp
DVi
d
e
zk
y
lk
mk

ratio of chain termination (combination) to propagation [Eq. (82)]


free energy change of polymerization [kJ mol1 ]
heat of polymerization [kJ mol1 ]
entropy of polymerization [J mol1 K1 ]
activation volume for mechanism-i [cm 3 mol1 ]
fraction of termination by disproportionation
volume contraction factor
kth moment of the dead polymer chains [mol L1 ]
average residence time [s]
kth moment of the polymer radicals [mol L1 ]
kth moment of the total (dead radical) polymer chains [mol L1 ]

References

kinetic chain length of polymer radicals


density [kg L1 ]
ratio of chain termination (disproportionation) and transfer to propagation [Eq. (82)]
average number of monomer units on a living chain
copolymerization cross-termination factor

n
r
t
u
F
Acronyms
AIBN
BMA
CFD
CTA
DMA
EGDMA
FRP
LCB
LCH
LDPE
MA
MMA
MW
MWD
nBA
PDI
PLP
PMMA
QSSA
SCB
SEC
Sty

2,2 0 -azobisisobutyronitrile
butyl methacrylate
computational uid dynamics
chain-transfer agent
dodecyl methacrylate
ethylene glycol dimethacrylate
free radical polymerization
long-chain branching
long-chain hypothesis
low-density polyethylene
methyl acrylate
methyl methacrylate
molecular weight
molecular weight distribution
Butyl acrylate
polydispersity index (Mw/Mn )
pulsed-laser polymerization
poly(methyl methacrylate)
quasi-steady-state assumption
short-chain branching
size exclusion chromatography
styrene

References
1 M. Buback, S. Klingbeil, J.

Sandmann, M.-B. Sderra, H.-P.


Vogele, H. Wackerbarth, L.
Wittkowski, Z. Phys. Chem. 1999,
210, 199221.
2 M. Buback, J. Sandmann, Z. Phys.
Chem. 2000, 214, 583607.
3 G. Moad, D. H. Solomon, The
Chemistry of Free Radical
Polymerization, Elsevier Science, New
York, 1995.

4 M. Asteasuain, A. Brandolin, C.

Sarmoria, Polymer 2004, 45, 321335.


5 A. A. Gridnev, S. D. Ittel,

Macromolecules 1996, 29, 58645874.


6 H. Tobita, A. E. Hamielec, Polymer

1991, 32, 26412647.


7 J. Brandrup, E. H. Immergut, E. A.

Grulke (Eds.), Polymer Handbook, 4th


Edition, John Wiley & Sons, New York,
1999.
8 M. Buback, L. H. Garcia-Rubio, R. G.

209

210

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

10

11

12

13

14

15
16
17
18

19

20

Gilbert, D. H. Napper, J. Guillot,


A. E. Hamielec, D. Hill, K. F.
ODriscoll, O. F. Olaj, J. Shen, D.
Solomon, G. Moad, M. Stickler, M.
Tirrell, M. A. Winnik, J. Polym. Sci.:
Part C: Polym. Lett. 1988, 26, 293297.
M. Buback, R. G. Gilbert, G. T.
Russell, D. J. T. Hill, G. Moad, K. F.
ODriscoll, J. Shen, M. A. Winnik,
J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed. 1992,
30, 851864.
O. F. Olaj, I. Bitai, F. Hinkelmann,
Makromol. Chem. 1987, 188, 1689
1702.
M. Buback, R. G. Gilbert, R. A.
Hutchinson, B. Klumperman, F.-D.
Kuchta, B. G. Manders, K. F.
ODriscoll, G. T. Russell, J.
Schweer, Macromol. Chem. Phys.
1995, 196, 32673280.
S. Beuermann, M. Buback, T. P.
Davis, R. G. Gilbert, R. A.
Hutchinson, O. F. Olaj, G. T.
Russell, J. Schweer, A. M. van
Herk, Macromol. Chem. Phys. 1997,
198, 15451560.
S. Beuermann, M. Buback, T. P.
Davis, R. G. Gilbert, R. A.
Hutchinson, A. Kajiwara, B.
Klumperman, G. T. Russell,
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 2000, 201,
13551364.
S. Beuermann, M. Buback, T. P.
Davis, R. G. Gilbert, R. A.
Hutchinson, A. Kajiwara, M.
Kamachi, I. Lack, G. T. Russell,
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 2003, 204,
13381350.
S. Beuermann, M. Buback, Prog.
Polym. Sci. 2002, 27, 191254.
I. Lack, S. Beuermann, M. Buback,
Macromolecules 2003, 36, 93559363.
H. Fischer, L. Radom, Angew. Chem.
Int. Ed. 2001, 40, 13401371.
M. Buback, M. Egorov, R. G.
Gilbert, V. Kaminsky, O. F. Olaj,
G. T. Russell, P. Vana, G. Zifferer,
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 2002, 203,
25702582.
M. D. Zammit, T. P. Davis, D. M.
Haddleton, K. G. Suddaby,
Macromolecules 1997, 30, 19151920.
G. A. Mortimer, J. Polym. Sci.: Part
A-1 1966, 4, 881900.

21 P. V. T. Raghuram, U. S. Nandi, J.

22
23

24
25

26

27
28

29

30
31
32

33

34
35
36

37

38
39
40
41

Polym. Sci.: Part A-1 1969, 7, 2379


2385.
G. A. Mortimer, J. Polym. Sci.: Part
A-1 1970, 8, 15351542.
M. Stickler, G. Meyerhoff,
Makromol. Chem. 1978, 179, 2729
2745.
S. Maeder, R. G. Gilbert,
Macromolecules 1998, 31, 44104418.
M. Buback, C.-R. Choe, E.-U.
Franck, Makromol. Chem. 1984, 185,
16851697.
J. D. Campbell, F. Teymour, M.
Morbidelli, Macromolecules 2003, 36,
54915501.
A. W. Hui, A. E. Hamielec, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1972, 16, 749769.
R. A. Hutchinson, D. A. Paquet,
Jr., S. Beuermann, J. H. McMinn,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1998, 37, 3567
3574.
M. C. Grady, W. J. Simonsick, Jr.,
R. A. Hutchinson, Macromol. Symp.
2002, 182, 149168.
P. Ehrlich, G. A. Mortimer, Adv.
Polym. Sci. 1970, 7, 386448.
P. Feucht, B. Tilger, G. Luft, Chem.
Eng. Sci. 1985, 40, 19351942.
L. I. Kulin, N. L. Meijerink, P.
Starck, Pure Appl. Chem. 1988, 60,
14031415.
W. W. Graessley, R. D. Hartung,
W. C. Uy, J. Polym. Sci.: Part A-2 1969,
7, 19191935.
D. Britton, F. Heatley, P. A. Lovell,
Macromolecules 1998, 31, 28282837.
S. Grcev, P. Schoenmakers, P.
Iedema, Polymer 2004, 45, 3948.
N. M. Ahmad, F. Heatley, P. A.
Lovell, Macromolecules 1998, 31,
28222827.
C. Plessis, G. Arzamendi, J. R. Leiza,
H. A. S. Schoonbrood, D. Charmot,
J. M. Asua, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 2001,
40, 38833894.
P. Tackx, J. C. J. F. Tacx, Polymer
1998, 39, 31093113.
W.-H. Li, A. E. Hamielec, C. M.
Crowe, Polymer 1989, 30, 15181523.
R. A. Hutchinson, Polym. React. Eng.
1993, 1, 521577.
T. Usami, S. Takayama, Macromolecules 1984, 17, 17561761.

References
42 J. C. Randall, JMS Rev. Macromol.
43

44
45

46
47
48
49
50
51
52

53

54

55
56

57
58

59

60

61
62

Chem. Phys. 1989, C29, 201317.


E. F. McCord, W. H. Shaw, Jr., R. A.
Hutchinson, Macromolecules 1997,
30, 246256.
T. Hirano, B. Yamada, Polymer 2003,
44, 347354.
J. Chiefari, J. Jeffery, R. T. A.
Mayadunne, G. Moad, E. Rizzardo,
S. N. Thang, Macromolecules 1999, 32,
77007702.
R. A. Hutchinson, Macromol. Theory
Simul. 2001, 10, 144157.
A. F. N. Peck. MSc Thesis, Queens
University, Kingston, ON, 2003.
P. W. Tidwell, G. A. Mortimer, J.
Polym. Sci.: Part A 1965, 3, 369387.
A. M. van Herk, T. Droge, Macromol.
Theory Simul. 1997, 6, 12631276.
V. E. Meyer, G. G. Lowry, J. Polym.
Sci.: Part A 1965, 3, 28432851.
T. Fukuda, K. Kubo, Y.-D. Ma, Prog.
Polym. Sci. 1992, 17, 875916.
M. Buback, A. Feldermann, C.
Barner-Kowollik, I. Lack,
Macromolecules 2001, 34, 54395448.
M. Buback, L. Wittkowski,
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 2000, 201,
419426.
M. Buback, L. Wittkowski, S. A.
Lehmann, F.-O. Mahling, Macromol.
Chem. Phys. 1999, 200, 19351941.
L. K. Kostanski, A. E. Hamielec,
Polymer 1992, 33, 37063710.
M. Hakim, V. Verhoeven, N. T.
McManus, M. A. Dube, A. Penlidis,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 2000, 77, 602609.
M. Buback, H. Dietzsch, Macromol.
Chem. Phys. 2001, 202, 11731181.
A. D. Jenkins, K. F. ODriscoll, J.
Polym. Sci.: Part A: Polym. Chem. 1995,
33, 11891190.
M. L. Coote, L. P. M. Johnston, T. P.
Davis, Macromolecules 1997, 30, 8191
8204.
T. P. Davis, K. F. ODriscoll, M. C.
Piton, M. A. Winnik, Polym. Int.
1991, 24, 6570.
Y.-D. Ma, P.-S. Kim, K. Kubo, T.
Fukuda, Polymer 1994, 35, 13751381.
R. A. Hutchinson, J. H. McMinn,
D. A. Paquet, Jr., S. Beuermann, C.
Jackson, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1997,
36, 11031113.

63 M. Buback, C. Kowollik,

Macromolecules 1999, 32, 14451452.


64 M. Buback, A. Feldermann, Aust. J.

Chem. 2002, 55, 475481.


65 H. A. S. Schoonbrood, S. C. J.

66
67
68
69
70
71

72

73

74

75

76

77

78
79

80

81

82
83

Pierik, B. van den Reijen, J. P. A.


Heuts, A. L. German, Macromolecules
1996, 29, 67176723.
P. Wittmer, ACS Adv Chem Ser. 1971,
99, 140174.
N. T. McManus, A. Penlidis, M. A.
Dube, Polymer 2002, 43, 16071614.
G. G. Lowry, J. Polym. Sci. 1960, 42,
463477.
C. Badeen, M. A. Dube, Polym. React.
Eng. 2003, 11, 5377.
D. Li, MSc Thesis, Queens University,
Kingston, ON, 2003.
C. Plessis, G. Arzamendi, J. R. Leiza,
H. A. S. Schoonbrood, C. Charmot,
J. M. Asua, Macromolecules 2001, 34,
51475157.
T. Harada, P. B. Zetterlund, B.
Yamada, Polym. Prepr. 2002, 43(2),
160161.
C. L. Moad, G. Moad, E. Rizzardo,
S. H. Thang, Macromolecules 1996, 29,
77177726.
P. Vana, L. H. Yee, C. BarnerKowollik, J. P. A. Heuts, T. P. Davis,
Macromolecules 2002, 35, 16511657.
G. T. Russell, D. H. Napper, R. G.
Gilbert, Macromolecules 1988, 21,
21412148.
S. K. Soh, D. C. Sundberg, J. Polym.
Sci.: Polym. Chem. Ed. 1982, 20, 1345
1371.
B. M. Louie, G. M. Carratt, D. S.
Soong, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1985, 30,
39854012.
D. Achilias, C. Kiparissides,
Macromolecules 1992, 25, 37393750.
N. Tefera, G. Weickert, K. R.
Westerterp, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1997,
63, 16491660.
J. A. Biesenberger, D. H. Sebastian,
Principles of Polymerization Engineering,
John Wiley & Sons, New York, 1983.
A. Baltsas, D. S. Achilias, C.
Kiparissides, Macromol. Theory Simul.
1996, 5, 477497.
W. H. Ray, J. Macromol. Sci. Rev.
Macromol. Chem. 1972, C8, 156.
D. S. Achilias, C. Kiparissides, J.

211

212

4 Free-radical Polymerization: Homogeneous

84

85
86
87
88
89

90

91

92
93
94
95

96
97
98

Macromol. Sci. Rev. Macromol. Chem.


Phys. 1992, C32, 183234.
M. A. Dube, J. B. P. Soares, A.
Penlidis, A. E. Hamielec, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 1997, 36, 9661015.
D. J. Arriola, PhD Thesis, University
of Wisconsin-Madison, 1989.
T. Xie, A. E. Hamielec, Macromol.
Chem. Theory Simul. 1993, 2, 421454.
T. Xie, A. E. Hamielec, Macromol.
Chem. 1993, 2, 455483.
H. M. Hulburt, S. Katz, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1964, 19, 555574.
R. C. Zabisky, W. M. Chan, P. E.
Gloor, A. E. Hamielec, Polymer 1992,
33, 22432262.
S. Ochs, P. Rosendorf, I. Hyanek,
S. X. Zhang, W. H. Ray, Comp. Chem.
Eng. 1996, 20, 657663.
A. Pertsinidis, E. Papadopoulos, C.
Kiparissides, Comp. Chem. Eng. 1996,
20, S449S454.
S. T. Balke, A. E. Hamielec, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1973, 17, 905949.
H. Tobita, J. Polym. Sci.: Part B:
Polym. Phys. 1993, 31, 13631371.
F. Teymour, J. D. Campbell, Macromolecules 1994, 27, 24602469.
A. Butte, A. Ghielmi, G. Storti, M.
Morbidelli, Macromol. Theory Simul.
1999, 8, 498512.
H. Tobita, Macromol. Theory Simul.
1996, 5, 129144.
M. Wulkow, Macromol. Theory Simul.
1996, 5, 393416.
P. D. Iedema, M. Wulkow, H. C. J.
Hoefsloot, Macromolecules 2000, 33,
498512.

99 M. Busch, Macromol. Theory Simul.

2001, 10, 408429.


100 W.-M. Chan, P. E. Gloor, A. E.

101

102
103

104
105
106
107

108
109

110

111

112
113

Hamielec, AIChE J. 1993, 39, 111


126.
H. Nordhus, O. Moen, P. Singstad,
J. Macromol. Sci. Pure Appl. Chem.
1997, A34, 10171043.
P. Pladis, C. Kiparissides, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1999, 73, 23272348.
A. Brandolin, M. H. Lacunz, P. E.
Ugrin, N. J. Capiati, Polym. React.
Eng. 1996, 4, 193241.
K. Tsai, R. O. Fox, AIChE J. 1996, 42,
29262940.
N. K. Read, S. X. Zhang, W. H. Ray,
AIChE J. 1997, 43, 104117.
N. H. Kolhapure, R. O. Fox, Chem.
Eng. Sci. 1999, 54, 32333242.
F. Bezzo, S. Macchietto, C. C.
Pantelides, Comp. Chem. Eng. 2000,
24, 653658.
J. P. Congalidis, J. R. Richards,
Polym. React. Eng. 1998, 6, 71111.
R. K. Mutha, W. R. Cluett, A.
Penlidis, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1997,
36, 10361047.
S.-M. Ahn, M.-J. Park, H.-K. Rhee,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1999, 38, 3942
3949.
Y. Yabuki, T. Nagasawa, J. F.
MacGregor, Comp. Chem. Eng. 2000,
24, 585590.
M.-J. Park, H.-K. Rhee, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 2004, 58, 603611.
S.-S. Na, H.-K. Rhee, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci. 2000, 76, 18891902.

213

Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension1


B. W. Brooks
5.1

Key Features of Suspension Polymerization

Many important polymers are made commercially via suspension polymerization


of vinyl monomers. These include poly(vinyl chloride), poly(methyl methacrylate),
expandable polystyrene, styreneacrylonitrile copolymers and a variety of ionexchange resins and specialist materials. The annual polymer production from suspension processes is very high.
5.1.1

Basic Ideas

There are two key requirements for any commercial free radical polymerization
process. The polymerization rate must be reasonably high and the polymer product must have the correct molecular weight distribution. The conditions that are
necessary to achieve those goals can be predicted from the kinetics of homogeneous free radical polymerization (see Chapter 4). But those conditions cannot be
obtained easily in large-scale production when bulk processes are used. Uniform
mixing and temperature control are dicult to achieve because the high heat
of polymerization is combined with a large viscosity of the reaction medium. As
most polymers are poor thermal conductors, heat transfer from large reactors is
usually poor because the ratio of surface area to volume decreases as the reaction
mass increases.
In suspension polymerization, drops of a monomer-containing phase are dispersed in a continuous liquid phase. Monomer solubility in the continuous phase
is often low and polymer is produced inside the drops. Although the drop viscosity
increases with monomer conversion, the eective viscosity of the suspension remains low and ecient agitation is possible. The ratio of surface area to volume
for small drops is relatively high and local heat transfer is good. If the continuous
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

214

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

phase is aqueous and well mixed, heat transfer from the reactor is also good. That
permits eective control of temperature and of those variables which depend on
temperature, which include reaction rates, polymer molecular weight, and copolymer composition.
Suspension stability is maintained by good agitation and by the use of drop
stabilizers. Removal of the stabilizing agents, after polymerization, may not be
complete and some contamination of the nal product is sometimes inevitable.
Suspension polymerization usually requires larger reactor volumes than bulk processes because the vessels often contain about 50% of the continuous phase. Suspension polymerization has been reviewed previously by Munzer and Trommsdor
[1], Bieringer et al. [2], Warson [3], Brooks [4], Yuan et al. [5], Vivaldo-Lima et al.
[6], and Arshady [7].
5.1.2

Essential Process Components

The chemical events that occur inside drops of the dispersed phase are similar to
those found in bulk polymerization. The drops contain monomer (or monomers),
radical generators (often called initiators), and polymer. Sometimes chain-transfer
agents are added also. The continuous phase is often regarded as chemically inert,
but drop stabilizers are usually present in it and, in some cases, those stabilizers
participate in the polymerization process. For a discussion of stabilizer types, see
Section 5.2.1.
5.1.3

Polymerization Kinetics

Higher conversions of monomers can be accommodated more readily in suspension processes than in bulk processes because suspensions are more mobile than
molten polymers. Therefore, simple rate expressions may not be applicable because the values of some rate coecients diminish at high polymer concentrations
(see Section 5.3.2).
It is often assumed that the polymerization chemistry which occurs in the dispersed phase is identical to that which occurs in the equivalent bulk process. That
assumption may be valid if the monomers and initiator are virtually insoluble in
the continuous phase. Then, polymerization rates, molecular weight distributions,
and copolymer compositions can be predicted from conventional kinetic schemes.
But drop stabilizers may react with species inside the drops (for example, to form
graft copolymers).
When all the monomers in a suspension polymerization are virtually immiscible
with the continuous phase, then the instantaneous copolymer composition can be
predicted from idealized relationships which apply to homogeneous systems. However, the use of those relationships is not straightforward if one, or more, of the
monomers is partially soluble in the continuous phase, because the actual composition of the drops may then be unknown. The eective monomer concentrations,

5.1 Key Features of Suspension Polymerization


Tab. 5.1. Apparent reactivity ratios in solution and suspension copolymerization (reproduced
with permission from Ref. 4).

Monomer 1
Monomer 2

AS
S

AN
MA

VC
VA

MMA
MAA

r1 (soln)
r2 (soln)
r1 (susp)
r2 (susp)
Temp [ C]

1.18
0.85
1.0
1.0
60

1.02
0.7
0.75
1.54
50

1.68
0.23
2.47
1.99
70

0.35
1.63
0.63
1.07
69

Abbreviations: AS, p-acetoxystyrene; S, styrene; AN, acrylonitrile; MA,


methyl acrylate; VC, vinyl chloride; VA, vinyl acetate, MMA, methyl
methacrylate; MAA, methacrylic acid.

which should be used in these relationships, might be predicted if the appropriate


partition coecients for the two phases can be obtained. That is not often possible
but models that allow for water solubility of monomers have been developed for
the copolymerization of vinyl chloride and vinyl acetate [8] and for the copolymerization of styrene and acrylonitrile [9].
Apparent reactivity ratios obtained directly from suspension polymerization experiments may not be identical to those expected from the equivalent bulk processes if some monomer migrates to the continuous phase. Ashady et al. [10]
found values for reactivity ratios that were not expected from results observed in
bulk or solution copolymerization. Izumi and Kitagawa [11] showed that reactivity
ratios for suspension copolymerization, of acrylonitrile and methyl acrylate, were
dierent from those obtained from either solution or emulsion polymerization.
Table 5.1 compares reactivity ratios obtained from solution copolymerization with
those observed in suspension copolymerization.
If the initiator in suspension polymerization is slightly soluble in water, then
simultaneous emulsion polymerization may occur when free stabilizer remains in
the continuous phase [12, 13].
5.1.4

FluidFluid Dispersions and Reactor Type

Batch, or semi-batch, reactors are often used for suspension polymerization on an


industrial scale. Dispersions in tubular ow reactors are dicult to maintain and a
continuous stirred tank would produce drops containing partially polymerized material that would coalesce in the receiving equipment. However, new types of ow
reactors are being developed for suspension polymerization (see Section 5.4.1).
Many of the published studies on drop behavior in agitated liquidliquid dispersions are applicable to suspension polymerization. But sometimes their use is limited because they do not account for changing physical properties of drops or for
the presence of drop stabilizers.

215

216

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

5.1.5

Uses of Products from Suspension Polymerization

Advantages of suspension polymerization are not restricted to temperature control.


Some polymers, such as poly(vinyl chloride) (PVC), are immiscible with their
monomers. Subsequent polymer coagulation makes bulk processes dicult to control. In suspension polymerization, however, that problem is avoided. There, coagulation is largely conned to the drop interiors and aggregation of polymerizing
drops is restricted. That is why suspension polymerization is used for the largescale production of PVC. In that case, the initial drop diameters, and the nal particle sizes, range between 10 and 100 mm.
If a polymer product is required in particulate form, then suspension polymerization is especially suitable. The energy required to disperse monomer drops is
lower than that required to break up the nished polymer. Also, drop size control
before polymerization is easier to achieve than particle size manipulation of granulated polymer. Suspension polymerization provides a good route to functionalized
particles such as those used in ion-exchange resins. Expandable polystyrene beads
are also made by suspension polymerization. When a product is to be used in
bead form, initial drop diameters can be as large as 12 mm [1].

5.2

Stability and Size Control of Drops

For many applications, the size range of the nal product particles is very important. For example, bead diameters aect ow rates through ion-exchange columns.
But particle size can also be important when the polymer is to be converted to a
macroscopic object. Heat transfer rates to polymer particles during extrusion and
mass transfer rates of plasticizers in particulate polymers both depend on particle
size.
During suspension polymerization, drop size depends on the physical properties
of the two phases, the phase ratio, the nature of the suspension ow, and the condition of the phase interface. Interfacial tension and drop stability depend largely
on the nature of the drop stabilizer. If no stabilizer were used to protect the drops,
the suspension would be unstable and the nal polymer particles would reach an
undesirable size.
The adsorption of stabilizer molecules at the interface between monomer and
the continuous phase reduces the interfacial tension and hence reduces the energy
required to form drops. Drop stability against coalescence depends largely on the
ability of the stabilizer to form a thin protective lm at the interface. That gives
the drops better elastic properties [14]. The eect of the elastic properties is enhanced by increasing the concentration of the suspending agent, until a certain
surface coverage of the drops is reached. At that point, a critical surface coverage
is established and a further increase in the suspending agent concentration will
have a very little eect on the drop stability [15].

5.2 Stability and Size Control of Drops

5.2.1

Stabilizer Types

Many drop stabilizers in suspension polymerization are water-miscible polymers.


These materials are sometimes called protective colloids. They include naturally occurring substances, such as gelatin and pectin, and a wide range of synthetic polymers such as partially hydrolyzed poly(vinyl acetate)s. Modied natural products
such as cellulose ether derivatives are also widely used. Munzer and Trommsdor
provide a detailed list of patented stabilizers [1]. Polymeric stabilizers do not all act
in the same way but steric eects are often important [16]. Although transfer of
stabilizer molecules from the continuous phase to the drop surfaces can sometimes be fast, the development of drop stability may be slow [17]. That may arise
because rearrangement of stabilizer molecules on the drop surface is necessary.
Water-miscible polymers are not expected to be good drop stabilizers when the continuous phase is nonaqueous (see Section 5.5).
Partially hydrolyzed poly(vinyl acetate) (PVA), a common stabilizer, is often
called poly(vinyl alcohol), but that is a misnomer because not all the acetate groups
are hydrolyzed. The extent of hydrolysis (DH) has signicant eects on the behavior of the PVA. This is especially important in the suspension polymerization of
vinyl chloride. PVA with a DH between 70% and 80% is a good stabilizer for drops
in aqueous media. Drops retain their integrity even when agitation levels are reduced [18]. But when the DH is less than 60%, drop sizes become sensitive to reduction in agitation intensity [18]. Although PVAs with a low DH are poor drop
stabilizers in aqueous media, they are still useful because they aect product morphology by inuencing events inside the vinyl chloride drops (see Section 5.3.3).
Attempts have been made to measure the distribution of the stabilizer between
the two phases and the interface [19]. PVA often becomes grafted onto polymer
that is formed inside the drops, leading to the formation of a skin on the nal
particle surface. This is important because subsequent removal of the skin is not
easy.
Although organic substances are commonly used as drop stabilizers, it is well
known that some particulate inorganic solids can also stabilize drops in suspension [20]. There are many reports of inorganic solids (such as calcium phosphate,
aluminium hydroxide, and zinc phosphate) being used in the suspension polymerization of styrene [1]. In some cases, small amounts of surfactants (such as sodium
alkylsulfonates) are added to assist the dispersion of those solids. The eect of electrolytes can also be important [21]. Inorganic stabilizers are advantageous when
only low levels of contamination are required because they can sometimes be removed eectively from the nal polymer particles. Also, inorganic particles are
able to stabilize relatively large drops, such as those formed in the manufacture of
expandable polystyrene beads.
Although some inorganic solids are eective stabilizers for drops in suspension polymerization, other solids are not stabilizers and may even be destabilizers.
OShima and Tanaka [22] suggested that the contact angle between dispersed liquid and inorganic solid is a crucial factor in determining whether an inorganic

217

218

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

solid is a stabilizer or a destabilizer in suspension polymerization. Solids that provide a relatively large contact angle (such as aluminium hydroxide) would be stabilizers in aqueous media. In contrast, those which have a relatively small contact
angle (such as carbon black) would tend to be destabilizers. In practical operation,
the contact angle will probably vary with any given inorganic solid if dierent
monomers are used. In many cases it is not easy to measure contact angles.
Two theories, screen theory and coverage theory, have been suggested to explain the
mechanism of drop stabilization by inorganic solids [21]. According to the screen
theory, nely divided inorganic solids which are dispersed in water form a screen.
Dispersed monomer drops smaller than the mesh of the screen are free to move
through the meshes, while those bigger than the mesh cannot pass through the
meshes and are stopped from coalescing further. In the coverage theory, it is suggested that dispersed inorganic solids cover the surfaces of monomer drops and
form a layer which prevents drop coalescence. Both theories are plausible but
many workers believe that the stabilization is obtained mainly by a coverage eect.
However, not all inorganic solids are adsorbed by the monomer drops. When Wolters et al. [23] used hydroxyapatite and calcium carbonate in the suspension polymerization of styrene, the adsorption equilibrium was found to be far on the side
of desorption. Also, Wang and Brooks [24] noticed that many of their stabilizing
particles settled on the bottom of the vessel when stirring of a liquidliquid dispersion ceased.
If some particles remain in the continuous phase, it is not feasible for the coverage theory to provide a description for every case of suspension polymerization in
which an inorganic solid is used as a stabilizer. Wang and Brooks suggested a
crowding theory which takes account of the dynamic eects of stabilizer particles
[24]. In that model, particles are not required to be permanently adsorbed on drop
surfaces but they become eective when two drops come close together. Although
crowding theory does not explain all the observations, it is compatible with a wide
range of experimental results. The addition of surfactants often improves the dispersion action of the ne particles, but it is possible to stabilize dispersions solely
with mono-sized spherical colloidal particles [25].
5.2.2

Drop Breakage Mechanisms

In an agitated suspension, the dispersed phase can be broken into small drops
when its surface is disrupted. That disruption can be caused either by frictional
forces (via viscous shear) or by inertial forces (via turbulence) [26]. The ratio of
the external disrupting force to the interfacial tension force is often expressed as
the Weber number, We. Drop deformation increases as We increases. When We exceeds a critical value, a drop will break into smaller drops.
The uids in agitated vessels are often turbulent. If the turbulence in local regions can be regarded as isotropic, a criterion for the drop breakage mechanism
can be developed [26, 27]. In turbulent ow, random eddies are superimposed on
the main ow. Eddy sizes are inuenced by the location of the vessel walls and are

5.2 Stability and Size Control of Drops

restricted by the impeller diameter [28]. Kinetic energy is transferred to smaller


eddies in a sequential fashion, until it reaches the smallest ones. This transfer is
assumed to occur without energy dissipation. However, when the kinetic energy
reaches the small eddies, it is dissipated as heat to overcome the viscous forces.
In theories of local isotropy, it is assumed that the small eddies are statistically
independent of each other. Velocity uctuations are determined by the local rate
of energy dissipation per unit mass of uid (e) and by the kinematic viscosity (n).
Kolmogorov [29], by dimensional reasoning, derived an expression [Eq. (1)] for
the length of the smallest eddy (h).
h n 3=4 e1=4

Rushton et al. [30] suggested that local isotropy could exist when the Reynolds
number is >10 4 . The macroscale of turbulence, L (approximately equal to the impeller diameter), is then much larger than the microscale of turbulence. Here, the
Reynolds number (Re) is dened by Eq. (2), where N is the impeller speed, D is the
impeller diameter, and n is the kinematic viscosity of the dispersion.
Re ND 2 =n ND 2 r=m

Pressure uctuations can deform the drops and they may break if the inertial
forces exceed the interfacial tension forces. Kolmogoro [27] and Hinze [31] derived an expression for the maximum drop diameter, d max , that should be observed
when turbulence is isotropic. Here, d g h and the viscous forces may be neglected
in comparison with the inertial forces; d max , can then be related to a critical Weber
number, We crit , by Eq. (3).
We crit rc u 2 dd=s

The inertial forces are related to e. Thus, We crit is given by Eq. (4).
5=3
We crit C1 rc e 2=3 d max
=s

Rushton et al. [30] showed that Eq. (5) holds, so that Eqs. (6) [32] and (7) follow.
e C3 N 3 D 2
d max C4 s=rc

5
3=5

6=5

d max =D C4 We0:6

4=5

6
7

In order to use this expression, it is often necessary to relate d max (which is dicult
to measure) to the Sauter mean diameter, d32 (which is more readily determined).
A linear relationship between d32 and d max has been demonstrated by Sprow [33],
Coulaloglou and Tavlarides [28], Kuriyama et al. [34], and Zerfa and Brooks [35].

219

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

30
Volume fraction of dispersed phase

d 32 /D ( x 10 )

220

0.01
0.05
0.1
0.2
0.3
0.4

20

10

0
0

10
0.027(1 + 3.06

20
)We

- 0.6

30
4

( x 10 )

Correlation of vinyl chloride drop size with volume


fraction j and Weber number We. Reproduced by permission of
Elsevier Science Ltd. From Ref. 35.

Fig. 5.1.

In the suspension polymerization of vinyl chloride, Zerfa and Brooks found the
relationship in Eq. (8).
0:58
d32 d max

Equation (6) has been veried with a large number of liquidliquid dispersions
where the volume fraction of the dispersed phase is not high, that is, in noncoalescing systems [28]. But, unlike many laboratory studies, real suspension polymerizations are operated with a high volume fraction of dispersed phase, j. Then,
drop coalescence and breakage happen simultaneously and damping of the turbulent uctuations may occur. To allow for this, a factor f j is often introduced into
Eq. (7). Experimental expressions for f j are reviewed by Yuan et al. [5], and by
Zerfa and Brooks [35]. The latter workers showed that, in the suspension polymerization of vinyl chloride, d32 was given by Eq. (9).
d32 =D 0:0273:06jWe0:6

Equation (9) applied when values of j ranged between 0.01 and 0.4, as shown in
Figure 5.1. An expression with similar form is given by Borwankar et al. [15].
When drop coalescence is signicant, Shinnar [32] showed that there will be a
minimum drop size, d min , that is proportional to N 0:75 . The extent of drop coalescence is reduced by addition of an appropriate drop stabilizer. If the surface coverage of the drops by the stabilizer exceeds a critical value then the dispersion can
remain stable after agitation ceases [15].
It must be remembered that correlations between average drop sizes and We
only apply at steady state. The steady-state drop size distribution (DSD) can take
some time to become established [18, 3638]. That may not be a serious problem
with nonreacting dispersions but, in suspension polymerization, the physical prop-

5.2 Stability and Size Control of Drops

erties change with time so that the DSD can continue to change during the process
[37].
When the diameter of the drops is less than the Kolmogorov length h, stresses
from viscous shear will be much larger than those from inertial eects. Drop
breakage is then the result of viscous shear [26]. Here, again, a drop will break if
the deformation variable, sometimes described as a generalized Weber group [31],
exceeds a critical value [39]. Taylor showed [40] that the extent of drop distortion,
before breakup, depended on the ratio of phase viscosities (Eq. (10), where md and
mc are the viscosities of the dispersed and the continuous phase, respectively).
We crit mc qu=qrd=s f1 md =mc

10

Shinnar and Church [26, 32] demonstrated that for locally isotropic ow where
qu=qr 2 e=n, d max is given by Eqs. (11) and (12).
d max snc1=2 =mc e 1=2 f md =mc

11

d max z snc1=2 =mc N 3=2 D1 f md =mc

12

When viscosity-increasing agents were present in the continuous phase for the suspension copolymerization of styrene and divinylbenzene, Jegat et al. [41] found
that drop breakage could occur via viscous shear when ow in the suspension was
turbulent. In that case, the Kolmogorov length would have been larger that that
found when low-viscosity aqueous solutions are used.
The form taken by f md =mc depends on the nature of the ow. In laminar ow,
the contributions of rotational and elongational components can be expressed via
the value of a parameter a, which ranges between 0 and 1. For simple shear a 0,
and for pure elongational (hyperbolic) ow a 1 [43]. With low a values, We crit
(now equivalent to the critical capillary number Cacrit ) passes through a minimum
as md =mc increases. After the minimum is reached, relatively small increases in
md =mc are accompanied by large increases in We crit . When a 0, We crit tends to
an innitely high value if md =mc > 4 so that drop breakage no longer occurs [42,
43]; see Figure 5.2.
Correlations that are found in idealized laboratory studies only provide rough
guides to events that occur in commercial reactors. Local ow in large stirred vessels is often ill dened. Also, drop breakage can produce more than two new drops.
Chatzi and Kiparissides [44] suggested that the formation of a daughter drop is accompanied by the formation of a number of smaller satellite drops. Drop stabilizers inuence turbulence near drop surfaces and non-Newtonian behavior leads
to further complications. Therefore, it is not surprising that the many published
studies on drop behavior in liquidliquid suspensions lead to a variety of dierent
results. Leng and Quarderer [39] found that d max depended on N 0:8 . By using data
from the literature, for the suspension polymerization of methyl methacrylate, they
also showed that d max depended on mc0:5 when drop breakage occurred by viscous
shear. Presumably, the drop size was not able to respond to changes in md =mc that

221

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension


1.6

1.2

Ca crit

222

0.8
0.4

0
0

log10 (viscosity ratio) + 3


Fig. 5.2. Critical capillary number against log10 of viscosity
ratio (md =mc ) for laminar ow. (A) a 0 (simple shear ow);
(B) a 1 (hyperbolic ow). Data from Refs. 42 and 43.

would have occurred during polymerization. However, average drop size was found
to be a linear function of interfacial tension, as expected, when viscous shear was
important. Borwankar et al. [15] suggested that the relationship between d max and
agitator speed may depend on agitator type.
When polymer-containing drops are broken, their elastic properties must be
taken into account. Arai et al. [45] derived a correlation for drop breakup from a
Voigt model to represent the elastic properties. The validity of the correlation was
conrmed experimentally using a dispersed phase with a wide range of viscosity.
Wang and Calabrese [46] carried out experiments with drops made from wellcharacterized model uids. They showed that the inuence of interfacial tension
on drop breakage decreased as the dispersed-phase viscosity increased.
5.2.3

Drop Coalescence

The volume fraction of drops in commercial suspension polymerization reactors is


usually high and drop coalescence cannot be ignored. In liquidliquid dispersions
the drop size distributions (DSDs) depend on the breakage and on coalescence
processes.
From experiments in which both drop breakage and coalescence occurred, Kuriyama et al. [34] found that drop sizes reached a steady value within an hour, when
the initial drop viscosity was low. But with a high drop viscosity, the drop size reduction continued for longer periods of time and the nal drop size was higher.
Although model, nonreacting, uids were used for those experiments, the results
are relevant to suspension polymerization. In their study of drop coalescence in the
suspension polymerization of styrene, Konno et al. [47] found that the Sauter
mean diameter increased as the polymer viscosity increased. They also concluded
that the stabilizer does not eectively prevent the coalescence of drops with diameters larger than d max .
The overall rate of drop coalescence is related to the collision frequency of the
drops and to the coalescence eciency. By comparing drop collisions in agitated

5.2 Stability and Size Control of Drops

dispersions with molecular collisions in homogeneous uids, previous workers


have developed expressions for collision rates between drops of dierent sizes [48,
49]. If drops adhere for sucient time to allow them to deform, and to permit
drainage of the continuous phase that is trapped between them, then coalescence
may occur [26]. By taking account of these events, expressions can be obtained for
the coalescence eciency [50]. Expressions, for coalescence and for collision rates
are not easy to use because they often contain parameters that are dicult to quantify. Alvarez et al. [50] constructed a model for drop breakage and coalescence, in
the suspension polymerization of styrene, which takes account of viscosity eects.
That model assumes that breakage of a drop, exposed to a turbulent ow eld, is a
result of uctuations with a wavelength equal to the drop diameter. Fluctuations
with wavelengths that are smaller or larger than the drop diameter do not lead to
drop breakage.
5.2.4

Drop Size Distributions

Even when expressions for drop breakage and coalescence rates are available, their
successful use must allow for variations of turbulence intensity within the reactor.
Maggioris et al. [51] describe a two-compartment population balance model for an
agitated suspension polymerization reactor. That model distinguishes between the
impeller region and the remainder of the reactor. Both regions are assumed to be
well mixed and CFD simulations predicted drop size distributions that were compatible with experimental results from nonpolymerizing model liquidliquid dispersions. For some combinations of stabilizer type and stirrer speed, bimodal
drop size distributions were predicted by the model and found in the experiments.
Yang et al. [52] showed how the size distribution of nonreacting styrene drops
changed with agitation time. Bimodality developed and the relative size of the two
peaks in the distribution depended on the amount of drop stabilizer that was used.
Calabrese et al. [46, 53] showed that, in dilute agitated suspensions for which coalescence is negligible, the equilibrium drop size distribution broadened considerably as dispersed-phase viscosity increased.
If no chemical reaction occurs, then the rates of drop breakage and drop coalescence eventually become equal and a stable DSD is obtained [54]. Considerable
periods of time might be required for that to occur [18], especially when the drops
have a high viscosity [55]. But, in the case of suspension polymerization, the physical properties of the drops change with monomer conversion. In a batch process,
early increases in drop viscosity reduce the rates of breakage and coalescence before a steady-state DSD can be established. Then, the DSD continues to change,
and the average drop size increases, as the polymer content of the drops increases.
Consequently, the nal particle size distribution (PSD) is quite dierent from the
steady-state DSD that would be expected from nonpolymerizing drops. That was
shown to be the case by Jahanzad et al. [37] in the suspension polymerization of
methyl methacrylate. There, the DSDs of polymerizing drops were broader than
that of the DSDs in the corresponding nonpolymerizing monomer drops. But the

223

224

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

average drop size in the nonpolymerizing drops was only slightly smaller than that
in the polymerizing suspension when a large amount of stabilizer was used, because excess stabilizer reduced drop coalescence in both systems. Similar results
were obtained by Konno et al. [47]. With smaller amounts of stabilizer, a growth
stage exists in which drop coalescence continues when drop breakage rates are
low [50]. The increase in average drop size can be substantial and continues until
the identication point is reached when drop viscosity is too high to permit further
drop coalescence. Jahanzad et al. [37] also showed that, although the diameters of
most drops and particles ranged between 10 and 300 mm, a second peak appeared
in the particle size distribution. The average diameter of particles that accounted
for that second peak was about 1 mm. Most of those smaller particles probably developed from satellite drops which are formed during the breakage process. The
existence of small satellite drops is compatible with the ideas of Chatzi and Kiparissides [44] and with the work of Sathyagal et al. [56]. But some of the very small
particles could have been formed directly in the aqueous phase because the water
solubility of the free radical initiator (lauroyl peroxide) may be high enough to induce some emulsion polymerization. That can by important with monomers that
are more water-soluble, such as methyl methacrylate, vinyl acetate, and vinyl chloride. If emulsion polymerization becomes prevalent, then a signicant amount of
the drop stabilizer will be adsorbed on the surfaces of the small particles. The
amount of stabilizer that is available to stabilize the drops is then reduced [57].
In batch reactors, the rate of drop coalescence is aected by changes in drop
viscosity. Therefore, any induced kinetic eects that alter the polymer molecular
weight (and, thereby, change the viscosity) could inuence the coalescence rate
and the DSD. Promoting chain transfer is one way for that to happen.
When drop viscosity remains low, coalescence events can depend on the nature
of the drop stabilizer. Low viscosities may be encountered when the polymers, or
copolymers, are immiscible with their monomers. The polymers then precipitate
inside the drops and their apparent viscosity does not increase substantially until
appreciable conversions have been attained. That is the case with the suspension
polymerization of vinyl chloride. When hydrolyzed poly(vinyl acetate) (PVA) is
used as the drop stabilizer, Zerfa and Brooks [18] showed that DSDs depended on
stirrer speed. With good PVA stabilizers, that had a high degree of hydrolysis, a
reduction in stirrer speed had little eect on the DSD, as shown in Figure 5.3. But
when a poor PVA stabilizer, with a low degree of hydrolysis, was used, a reduction in stirrer speed led to a broadening of the DSD. There, the DSD became similar to that expected when the stirrer speed was maintained at its lowest value,
as shown in Figure 5.4. Clearly, the good stabilizer protected the drops from
coalescence.
5.2.5

Drop Mixing

Most of the coalescence events described in Section 5.2.3 occur when drops have a
uniform chemical composition, but sometimes it is necessary to add material to a

5.2 Stability and Size Control of Drops

Drop number

200

150
100
50
0
15

35

55

75

95

Drop diameter (microns)

Drop number

200

150
100
50
0
15

35

55

75

95

Drop diameter (microns)

Drop number

200

150
100
50
0
15

35

55

75

95

Drop diameter (microns)


Fig. 5.3. Change in drop size with stirrer speed with PVA
72.5% hydrolyzed. (A) N 350 rpm (5.8 s1 ); (B) N 650
rpm (10.8 s1 ); (C) N reduced from 650 to 350 rpm. Data from
Ref. 18.

reactor in which a suspension already exists. That can happen if control of copolymer composition is important. In batch operation, copolymer composition usually
changes with overall conversion because monomers react at dierent rates [58].
This drift in copolymer composition may be limited by adding one of the mono-

225

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

Drop number

200

150
100
50
0
15

35

55

75

95

Drop diameter (microns)

Drop number

200

150
100
50
0
15

35

55

75

95

Drop diameter (microns)

200

Drop number

226

150

100
50
0
15

35

55

75

95

115

Drop diameter (microns)


Change in drop size with stirrer speed with PVA 55%
hydrolyzed. (A) N 350 rpm (5.8 s1 ); (B) N 650 rpm
(10.8 s1 ); (C) N reduced from 650 to 350 rpm. Data from
Ref. [18].
Fig. 5.4.

mers to the reactor incrementally (that is, by using a semi-batch procedure). But,
when new dispersible material is added to an existing suspension, the new material and existing drops can remain segregated for a signicant period of time.
Then, new drops may form with a monomer composition that diers from that of

5.2 Stability and Size Control of Drops

the original drops. The new monomer cannot mix with existing drops (which contain the initiator and have adsorbed most of the drop stabilizer). Adding extra drop
stabilizer, with the new monomer, might not be helpful because there is the danger of stabilizing new drops with the wrong monomer composition that contain
little, or no, radical generator.
Hashim and Brooks [59] studied the addition of styrene to a suspension of stabilized drops. The drops were composed of polystyrene solutions in styrene. The initial drop viscosity aected the drop size and the rate of coalescence between drops.
As the dispersed-phase viscosity increased, the drop size distribution broadened; at
some stirrer speeds, the mixing rate increased. It appears that there is a critical
drop size which determines the coalescence eciency. Above that size, the drop
mixing rate increases as the drop viscosity decreases. Below the critical drop size,
the mixing rate is inuenced noticeably by the drop size; as the drop size increases,
the coalescence rate also increases.
Drop mixing may become an issue when volatile monomers are used. The enthalpy of polymerization for most of the vinyl monomers that are used in suspension polymerization ranges between 30 and 90 kJ mol1 . Therefore, a high heat removal rate is usually necessary to maintain a constant reactor temperature. This is
dicult to achieve by heat transfer through the reactor walls in commercial operations because large reactors have a relatively small surface area to volume ratio.
Heat removal can be improved by allowing the monomer to vaporize. The vapor
is then condensed, cooled, and returned to the reactor as a liquid. If the polymerization process is to be maintained, drops of returning monomer must gain access
to initiator and drop stabilizer. With the suspension polymerization of vinyl chloride, Zerfa and Brooks [60] found that monomer returning from a reux condenser formed drops that acquired initiator without the need for coalescence with
existing stabilized drops. The presence of small particles, formed by simultaneous
emulsion polymerization, appeared to provide a mechanism for transfer of initiator
(bis(4-t-butylcyclohexyl) peroxy dicarbonate) through the continuous phase. With
high reux rates, the drop size distribution became bimodal whereas, in the absence of reux, a monomodal DSD is expected [60]. New drops, from reuxed
monomer, had limited access to the drop stabilizer (PVA) and were larger than
the old drops.
A special drop mixing problem arises with the suspension polymerization of
vinyl chloride. Because the monomer is very reactive and has a high enthalpy of
polymerization, operators are reluctant to mix initiator in the monomer before a
suspension is formed. Therefore, as a safety precaution, the initiator is often dispersed in the aqueous phase of a stabilized suspension. Then the subsequent mixing of monomer and initiator can be quite slow. Zerfa and Brooks [61, 62] showed
that many monomer drops remained uninitiated when monomer in other drops
had polymerized to a considerable extent. That did not happen when initiator was
dissolved in the monomer before it was dispersed: see Figure 5.5. This nonuniformity in drop behavior aected the nal polymer properties. Also, addition of initiator via the aqueous phase promoted simultaneous emulsion polymerization and
modied the PSD. Drop mixing rates were quantied by using dyed monomer

227

228

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

Eect of the method of initiator


addition to vinyl chloride: (A) initiator
predissolved in drop phase; (B) initiator
predispersed in continuous phase. Panels:

Fig. 5.5.

1, 5 min; 2, 20 min; 3, 60 min. N 350 rpm


(5.8 s1 ); j 0:1; PVA concentration 0.06%.
Reproduced by permission of John Wiley &
Sons, Inc. From Ref. 62.

drops in the experiments. The mixing rate was found to depend on both the concentration of the PVA and the grade that was used [61].

5.3

Events at High Monomer Conversion

Suspension polymerization provides a practical method of achieving high monomer conversions. Therefore, studies of polymerization and drop behavior that deal
with events at low monomer conversion may not be applicable to suspension polymerization.

5.3 Events at High Monomer Conversion

5.3.1

Breakage of Highly Viscous Drops

In batch reactors drop breakage and coalescence are aected by the polymerization
process because the viscosity of the polymerizing uid often increases. Many aspects of the interaction of drop behavior with the polymerization process have
been discussed already (see Section 5.2).
5.3.2

Polymerization Kinetics in Viscous Drops

Free radical polymerization kinetics has received much attention and many aspects
of the process are well understood (see Chapter 4). Most academic investigations
have been carried out in idealized conditions where the extent of monomer conversion is low. The classical expression for the rate of polymerization (R p ), in a
single-phase reaction, is Eq. (13), where k p is the propagation rate coecient, CM
is monomer concentration, R i is the initiation rate and k t is the termination rate
coecient [63].
R p k p CM R i =k t 1=2

13

If radicals are generated by the thermal decomposition of an added initiator then,


at steady-state conditions, Eq. (14) applies, where f is an eciency factor, kd is the
initiator decomposition rate coecient and CI is the initiator concentration.
R i 2f kd CI

14

Chain termination is often diusion-controlled and the value of k t diminishes substantially as the polymer concentration increases. At high polymer concentrations,
k p decreases also [64]. The reduction in k t leads to an increase in the polymerization rate, a phenomenon often described as a gel eect.
Although most workers agree that the chain termination reaction is diusioncontrolled, reliable quantitative relationships between the rate coecients and
measurable properties of the reaction medium are not generally available. Radical
diusion can depend on solution viscosity, polymer volume fraction and polymer
molecular weight. The latter three entities are interrelated in complicated ways;
meaningful experiments, which may relate them to the rate coecients, are not
easy to devise [65]. However, Brooks et al. showed that eects of viscosity changes
on polymerization rate could be distinguished from the eects of polymer volume
fraction [66]. In some cases, the value of f may also depend on polymer content
[67].
The value of kd can often be determined independently but traditional steadystate experiments give values for k p =k t0:5 and do not provide separate values for k p
and k t . This restriction becomes a problem for reactor modeling because, in the
presence of polymer, both k p and k t diminish (even in isothermal conditions).

229

230

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

Pulse laser techniques, combined with accurate molecular weight measurement,


have been used to determine independent values for k p but those techniques are
only feasible in the absence of preformed polymer [68, 69].
When a gel eect is observed, kinetic analysis can be dicult because k t becomes dependent on chain length [70] and the pseudo-steady state assumption
may not be valid [71]. Tefera et al. [72] showed that, when a high monomer conversion is attained, a number of dierent models for the gel and glass eects gave an
adequate description of isothermal timeconversion data over the entire conversion range for a single type and loading of initiator. But models that ignored the
eect of polymer molecular weight on the diusion of macro radicals failed to describe the timeconversion data if the concentration of the initiator varied. It has
been shown that autoacceleration in free radical polymerization can be observed
even when low molecular weight polymer is being formed, indicating that chain
entanglements are not necessary for a gel eect to occur [73].
In practice, isothermal conditions are not always maintained in suspension polymerization and temperature increases can lead to a marked reduction in initiator
concentration. As the monomer conversion increases, the glass transition temperature of the polymer solution also increases and the drops can become glassy. The
chain propagation reaction then becomes diusion-controlled and the value of k p
decreases signicantly. An increase in reaction temperature may become necessary
in order to achieve complete monomer conversion. Although most workers agree
that k p is reduced at high monomer conversions, Faldi et al. [74] have suggested
that diusion control may not be the only reason for that to occur. Qin et al. [75]
developed a three-stage model to account for the gel and glass eects. The match
with experimental data, for methyl methacrylate and styrene polymerizations, up to
high monomer conversion was satisfactory for isothermal conditions. Achilias and
Kiparissides [76] showed, however, that data for polymerization of those monomers were compatible with a model that did not require break points for the gel
and glass eects. The initiator eciency, f , has been shown to depend on the size
of the initiator radicals at high monomer conversion [76].
If crosslinking or copolymer precipitation occurs, bulk polymerization may be
dicult to handle. A suspension process may then be the only feasible way in
which the copolymerization can be carried out [4]. Suspension processes also provide a means of investigating copolymerization kinetics at high conversion. The
monomer sequence in styrenemethyl methacrylate copolymers at high conversion have been found to dier from those observed at low conversion [77].
5.3.3

Consequences of Polymer Precipitation Inside Drops

Polymers that are insoluble in their monomers will precipitate during polymerization. The resulting fouling problems that occur in bulk polymerization are greatly
reduced by using suspension polymerization. This is one of the reasons for
choosing a suspension process for PVC manufacture, as discussed previously (see
Section 5.1.5). Manipulation of polymer precipitation, inside the drops, during

5.3 Events at High Monomer Conversion

Fig. 5.6.

Schematic representation of polymer formation inside vinyl chloride drops.

polymerization can inuence the properties of the nal product, especially the porosity, which in the case of PVC aects the ability of the polymer to take up plasticizers. Structural changes that occur inside the drops of polymerizing vinyl chloride monomer (VCM) have been discussed by a number of authors [78, 79].
PVC starts to precipitate from the monomer phase when the conversion exceeds
0.1% conversion, forming a separate polymer-rich phase inside the drops. The precipitating polymer aggregates to form unstable microdomains, which aggregate
further to give domains. Subsequent aggregation of domains results in the formation of primary particles. The primary particles grow by polymerization within
them and by buildup of microdomains or domains on their surfaces. Eventually
multiple contacts lead to the formation of a continuous network of primary particles throughout the polymer particle/monomer droplet; see Figure 5.6. At about
70% conversion the monomer-rich phase disappears and further polymerization
occurs in the polymer-rich phase [80, 81]. The nal polymer grains have irregular
shapes, unlike particles that form from polymers that are completely miscible with
their monomers. Some components of the drop stabilizers are chosen because they
are miscible with the monomer and they can inuence the agglomeration of primary particles [82]. Those components are sometimes called secondary suspending agents (SSAs).
As a direct consequence of the process described above, and of the density dierence between PVC and VCM, PVC grains have a complicated morphology and they
can be highly porous. The particle size, the PSD, the morphological characteristics,
and the degree of porosity of PVC grains depend on polymerization conditions.
These include the agitation in the reactor, the type and concentration of suspend-

231

232

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

ing agent(s), the secondary suspending agents, the polymerization temperature,


the monomer conversion, and the ratio of monomer to water.
Eects of agitation on the mean particle size of PVC resins have been studied by
many researchers, using dierent reactor capacities, and many correlations have
been developed [83, 84]. The eects of agitation on PVC porosity have also received
much attention [80]. As with the suspension polymerization of other monomers,
the choice of suspending agent(s) aects the particle size distribution of the nal
polymer. In the case of PVC, however, the suspending agents also aect the substructure and porosity of the particles. The primary suspending agent system is
often based on PVA, substituted cellulose, or a mixture of the two. Wolf and
Schuessler [85] concluded that the plasticizer absorption (which depends on porosity) of the resulting PVC was related to the surface activity of the suspending
agent, regardless of type. Ormondroyd [86] demonstrated the eect of PVA structure on the particle size, cold plasticizer absorption, and bulk density of the PVC
produced. Cheng [87] and Cheng and Langsam [88] used hydroxypropyl methylcellulose (HPMC) as a suspending agent and analyzed the inuence of molecular
weight and chemical structure of the cellulose on the particle morphology of the
resulting PVC. Cebollada et al. [81] showed how HPMC structure and concentration inuenced the particle properties of PVC. SSAs are regularly used in the production of suspension PVC to impart higher porosity to the PVC grains. That
improves the subsequent uptake of plasticizer and also promotes the removal of
unreacted VCM at the end of polymerization. PVA with a low degree of hydrolysis
and nonionic surfactants, such as sorbitan monolaurate, have been used commercially as SSAs [89]. The mechanism by which such SSAs function is not entirely
clear [80, 9092].
When nonionic surfactants, such as Span85, Span60 and Span20, are used as
SSAs, with PVA as the main stabilizer, the mean particle size of PVC resins increases quickly as the concentration of nonionic surfactant increases [82]. The
degree of agglomeration of primary particles increases with polymerization temperature and with conversion. A nonionic surfactant with a greater hydrophilelyophile balance (HLB) value is more eective in raising the particle size [82].
The increase in the mean particle size of the nal PVC is probably caused by increased coalescence of VCM/PVC droplets during the polymerization process, as a
result of a lowering of water-drop interfacial tension by the SSA. Nonionic surfactants such as Span20, Span60, and Span85 have more anity with VCM than the
PVA has, and they will be absorbed faster than PVA on the VCM/water interface.
Part of the interface, which would otherwise be occupied by PVA molecules, will
become occupied by nonionic surfactant molecules. Thus, the colloid protective
ability of the composite suspending agent would decrease because the nonionic
surfactants with a low molecular weight have a lower colloid protective ability
than that of PVA. In some cases, graft copolymers of PVA and PVC form a skin
(or membrane) around the polymer particles [93]. Zerfa and Brooks [60] showed
that, at low monomer conversion, PVC porosity increases if a high monomer reux
rate is used. Porosity, surface roughness, and particle shape were found to depend
on the origin of the PVA [62]. Particle shape can also be inuenced by the method

CPA (g DOP/100g PVC)

5.3 Events at High Monomer Conversion


100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
0

20

40

60

80

100

Polymerisation conversion (%)


Fig. 5.7. Eect of polymerization conversion on the cold
plasticizer absorption (CPA) of PVC. Reproduced by permission
of John Wiley & Sons, Inc. From Ref. 82.

of initiator addition [62]. High conversions of VCM are not always desirable because the porosity of PVC particles usually decreases linearly with monomer conversion, as shown in Figure 5.7 [60, 82].
When a nonionic surfactant is used as an SSA, in conjunction with PVA, the
porosity of PVC increases as the concentration of nonionic surfactant increases.
Here, increased porosity may be the result of incomplete drop coalescence creating
voids at the sites where droplets are not well contacted [82]. Nonionic surfactant
with a lower HLB value (hence with a higher anity for VCM and a higher solubility in VCM) is more eective in raising the product porosity. The surface of primary particle aggregates becomes coarser as surfactant is added [82]. This could
be the consequence of an altering interfacial tension between the PVC-rich phase
and the monomer. That might be expected to decrease the contact deformation of
the primary particles and increase the pore space. When nonionic SSAs are used,
PVC porosity decreases linearly with an increase of polymerization temperature
[82]. The porosity increases as the concentration of nonionic surfactant increases,
and a surfactant with a lower HLB value is more eective in raising the porosity.
The increase in porosity may be caused by a combination of increased coalescence
of VCM/PVC droplets and the nonionic surfactants steric eect inside the droplets
[82]. Bao et al. showed that particle morphology and PVC properties can be controlled by using blends of PVA suspending agents with diering degrees of hydrolysis [94]. The use of PVA, with a low degree of hydrolysis, as an SSA increased
particle porosity in the suspension copolymerization of vinyl chloride and propylene [95]. In that case, the SSA was more soluble in the organic phase than the primary stabilizer (a cellulose ether).
In vinyl chloride polymerization, particle porosity facilitates the subsequent uptake of plasticizers, but in other cases particle porosity is induced to enhance access
to functional groups within the polymer. That is useful when polymer beads are
required for use in ion-exchange columns, or in analytical instruments. A diene
comonomer can be added to a monomer, to promote crosslinking and phase sepa-

233

234

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

ration inside the drops [9699]. Appropriate functional groups can be incorporated
in the monomers.

5.4

Reaction Engineering for Suspension Polymerization

The discussion above (see Sections 5.2 and 5.3) provides guidelines for the design
of suspension polymerization processes on an industrial scale. However, extrapolating from idealized small-scale studies to full-scale commercial operation is not
straightforward. Maintenance of uniform reactor conditions cannot be guaranteed
inside large reactors and controlled heat transfer from reactors can be dicult.
5.4.1

Dispersion Maintenance and Reactor Choice

Many suspension polymerization processes employ stirred vessels. Oldshue et al.


[100] showed that agitator type and vessel geometry have an important inuence
on internal liquid ow. This must be taken into account in the design of large vessels for suspension polymerization. Maggioris et al. [51] and Vivaldo-Lima et al.
[101] devised two-compartment population balance models to account for the large
spatial variations of the local turbulent kinetic energy. These permit the prediction
of drop size evolution in a suspension polymerization reactor with a high volume
fraction of dispersed phase. Basic expressions were modied to allow for evolving
physical properties of the suspension. Maggioris et al. [51] showed that it was feasible to estimate the volume ratio of the impeller and circulation regions, the ratio
of turbulent dissipation rates, and the exchange ow rate of the two compartments
at dierent agitation rates and continuous-phase viscosities. Although many industrial suspension polymerizations are described as batch processes, they are not
genuine batch operations because some material enters the reactor after polymerization has started. In some cases, substantial reux of monomers occurs and condensed monomer returns to the reactor continuously. In others, a semi-batch process is used to control product composition. In both these situations, unconverted
monomer with low viscosity is being mixed with drops of higher viscosity. The complexities of these mixing processes have been discussed above; see Section 5.2.5.
Reactor congurations other than conventional stirred tanks have been proposed
for suspension polymerization. Draft tubes, or internal loops, can be used for
suspension polymerization [102], but drop size changes can occur [103] and ow
patterns may be complicated [104]. Tanaka et al. [105] used a loop reactor for the
suspension polymerization of styrene. They employed a double agitation method
to control the transient droplet diameter distribution and the nal particle size distribution. Ni et al. [106] developed an oscillatory baed reactor for batch suspension polymerization of methyl methacrylate. Fluid mixing was achieved by eddies
that are generated when a uid passes through a set of equally spaced, stationary,
orice baes that are located inside a tube. Periodically formed vortices were con-

5.4 Reaction Engineering for Suspension Polymerization

trolled by choosing appropriate values for oscillation frequency, oscillation amplitude, bae diameter, and bae spacing. The nal particle size distribution and
polymer molecular weight were comparable with those of a product obtained
from a conventional stirred tank reactor.
Although most industrial polymerization processes are batch or semi-batch operations, some continuous-ow processes have been proposed [107]. Use of ow reactors may aect the nature of the drop size distribution and the molecular weight
distribution. If ow through a back-mixed region occurs, the drops will be subject
to a distribution of residence times and the nature of the mixing for the dispersed
phase is important. Baade et al. [108] and Taylor and Reichert [109] showed that
complete segregation of drops, in the suspension polymerization of vinyl acetate,
produced an increase in polymer molecular weight. Also, the distribution of molecular weights became broader than that expected in a batch reactor. Complete
mixing of the drops gave a molecular weight distribution which was narrower than
that found in batch reactors. An oscillatory baed reactor can also be used for
continuous-ow suspension polymerization. Ni et al. [110] describe the eect of
superimposed oscillations on the main ow through a tube. Radial mixing of the
uid occurs but near plug-ow is obtained. A constant level of turbulence intensity
in the reactor can lead to particle size distributions similar to those expected from a
batch reactor.
5.4.2

Agitation and Heat Transfer in Suspensions

In single-phase processes, reactor agitation inuences the rate of heat transfer to,
and from, the surroundings and determines the quality of mixing. With suspension polymerization reactors, the agitation must also be good enough to generate,
and to maintain, a two-phase dispersion. When conventional stirred tanks are
used, a standard reactor geometry may be adequate to promote convective heat
transfer. Here, the height of the total suspension (H), the impeller diameter (D)
and the clearance underneath the impeller (G) are related to the tank diameter
(T) as follows:


HAT
D A T=3
 G A T=3


The use of baes limits nonuniformity in the turbulence and restricts vortex formation. Vortices are undesirable because the centrifugal eect favors drop congregation and may promote unwanted drop coalescence. That can lead to polymer
deposition either on the agitator or the reactor walls (depending on the relative
density of the aqueous and nonaqueous phases). When vertical baes are close to
the walls their width (B) is often given by:


B A T=10

235

236

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

With suspension polymerization, reactor fouling is sometimes a problem. In such


cases, it can be helpful to have a small gap between the outer bae edge and the
reactor wall. That may reduce accumulation of coagulated solids at the wallbae
junction.
Some form of turbine impeller is often suitable for suspension polymerization
when the apparent viscosity of the suspension is not very high. But the power input to the suspension, via the impeller, must be sucient to create and to maintain
the required drop size distribution. The required stirrer speed for the appropriate
turbulence level can be estimated from Eqs. (6)(7) (see Section 5.2.2). But, in reality, the turbulence will not be uniform. Drop breakage and drop coalescence may
occur in dierent regions of the reactor [5]. The necessary power input can be predicted from correlations between the power number and the Reynolds number
[30]. However, those correlations are usually developed for single-phase uids and
care must be taken when using them for suspensions, where the eective viscosity
of the suspension may be unknown. The Reynolds number in most large-scale suspension polymerization reactors is usually high enough to generate turbulent ow,
and in that region the use of baes increases the required power input.
Heat removal from suspension polymerization reactors can be a problem, especially after the startup period in batch operation when a gel eect causes autoacceleration in the polymerization. If the monomers are volatile at the working
pressure of the reactor, then some heat can be removed relatively quickly by monomer vaporization (as discussed above for vinyl chloride polymerization; see Section
5.2.5). When most of the heat transfer occurs via a cooling jacket, special strategies
may be necessary to manage the heat transfer. Pinto and Giudici [111] suggested
that a mixture of initiators, with dierent half-lives and activation energies, could
be used. Then it may become possible to match the heat generation rate with the
cooling capacity of the reactor jacket. The feasibility of such an approach depends
on the accuracy of the reactor model that is used. Mejdell et al. [112] showed that
the reaction rates predicted from models for the industrial suspension polymerization of vinyl chloride were subject to signicant noise because the heat capacity of
the suspension was large and the resolution of temperature measurements was
limited. If the reactor cooling capacity is chosen to cope with heat generation rates
in the later stages of batch operation, when autoacceleration occurs, then the heat
removal capacity of the reactor will not be fully utilized in the early stages of the
polymerization. Longeway and Witenhafer [113] suggested that the reactor could
be operated at a higher temperature in the early stages, to make full use of the
cooling capacity. They constructed a model that predicted a reduction in total reaction time for a given monomer conversion. It should be remembered that the overall heat transfer coecient for a jacketed reactor depends on the nature of the wall
material. Transfer coecients for stainless steel reactors are approximately double
the coecients found for glass-lined carbon steel reactors [114].
It is commonly assumed that, in suspension polymerization, heat transfer between polymerizing drops and the continuous phase is rapid and both phases
have the same temperature. However, Lazrak and Ricard [115] showed that, with
methyl methacrylate polymerization, the internal temperature of drops could be

5.4 Reaction Engineering for Suspension Polymerization

higher than that of their surroundings when drop diameters exceeded 1 mm. Temperature dierences were large enough to cause changes to polymer quality.
5.4.3

Scaleup Limitations with Suspension Polymerization

Many aspects of scaleup (or scaledown) of suspension polymerization reactors are


similar to those encountered with other polymerization processes. These concern
parameters that control polymerization rate, product composition, and polymer
molecular weight. In the case of suspension polymerization, however, special consideration must be given to maintaining the required drop/particle size distribution. In the case of VCM polymerization, the maintenance of particle porosity is
also an issue. In principle, correlations between dimensionless entities, such as
the Weber number correlations (see Section 5.2.2), should help reactor designers
to relate observations in laboratory experiments to events that occur on a large
scale. But, even if fundamental requirements for drop breakage and drop coalescence are known (which is not always the case), it is dicult to ensure similarity
of conditions inside reactors with greatly diering sizes. Some key relationships
are discussed by Yuan et al. [5] and by Leng and Quarderer [39]. Scaleup criteria
should allow for any variations of volumetric phase ratio that may occur. Sometimes those can be included in modications to the Weber number correlations
(see Section 5.2).
In addition to the problem of matching turbulence homogeneity in reactors of
dierent sizes, there can be a serious diculty in maintaining constant average turbulence intensities. This arises because a high Reynolds number (Re ND 2 r=m) is
easier to achieve in a large reactor than in a small reactor. Often, it not practical to
use a stirrer speed, in a small reactor, which is high enough to compensate for the
relatively small value of D 2 . A good estimate for the physical properties of the
whole suspension is necessary in order to predict values for the Reynolds number.
When the suspension viscosity is high, it is possible for the uid in a large reactor
to be fully turbulent but for the uid in a small reactor to be in the transition region (between laminar and turbulent ow). In such cases, the drop breakage mechanism can change with reactor size. Scaleup is most likely to be successful when
the reactors have a similar basic shape. An unbaed spherical laboratory reactor
will not behave in the same way as a large baed cylindrical reactor. When drop
formation depends on reactors with a special geometry, such as that required for
a crossow membrane [16] or a pulsed column [106], then new scaleup criteria
may become necessary.
Heat transfer rates per unit mass of suspension increase as reactor size
decreases. Consequently, it may not be possible to achieve the same time
temperature prole in a large reactor as is obtained with a small reactor, especially
when autoacceleration occurs. If some heat transfer occurs via monomer evaporation, then the rate of monomer reux can depend on reactor size. In the case of
VCM polymerization, this can result in particle porosity changing with reactor
size (see Section 5.3.3).

237

238

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

5.4.4

Reactor Safety with Suspension Processes

The potential for thermal runaway exists with most commercial free-radical polymerization processes that employ batch reactors. This arises because the heat of
reaction is high and there is no eective steady state. Although temperature control in suspension polymerization reactors is often better that that found in bulk
polymerization, the possibility of thermal runaway cannot be ignored. This was
demonstrated by Nemeth and Thyrion [116] who showed that very sharp temperature rises could occur in the suspension polymerization of styrene, largely because
spontaneous free-radical generation occurs with that particular monomer as the
temperature increases. When models are used to predict temperature rises in polymerization reactors, it is important to allow for small changes that occur in the
physical properties of the polymerizing uid. Otherwise, large overestimates of
temperature rises are obtained [117].
Axial mixing throughout the reactor is particularly important when the density
of the continuous phase lies between the density of the monomer and the density
of the polymer. In those cases the polymerizing drops may gradually sink during
the process. If good mixing is not maintained, highly viscous drops can accumulate and coalesce at the bottom of the reactor. The process then reverts to a bulk
polymerization, with all its inherent disadvantages. Such a potential risk arises
with suspension polymerization of styrene in the production of pre-expanded
beads. Even though styrene has a relatively high boiling point, the reactor is maintained at a positive pressure because a volatile blowing agent (for example, pentane) must remain in the drop phase. If the suspension fails, heat transfer from
the coalesced drops is quickly reduced and the temperature of the polymerizing
mass begins to rise. The subsequent increase in vapor pressure of the water can
cause the total pressure to reach unsafe values. Disaster may be avoided if a pressure release device (for example, a bursting disk) functions well, but it is essential
that the design, and location, of such a device do not permit excessive fouling by
polymer deposits. Regular reactor cleaning is important.
In small-scale suspension polymerization, inhibitors are often removed from the
monomer before it is dispersed in the continuous phase. In large-scale operation,
however, the inhibitor may not be removed. Its presence lowers the risk of premature polymerization, which can be dangerous when large amounts of monomer are
being handled. Consequently, the particle size distribution obtained from the large
reactor may dier from that in the small reactor because drop breakage can occur
before signicant amounts of polymer are formed (that is, when the drop viscosity
is still relatively low).
5.4.5

Component Addition during Polymerization

Scaleup often involves more than an increase in reactor size. Even when geometric
similarity is maintained, it may be dicult to reproduce exact laboratory proce-

5.5 Inverse Suspension Polymerization

dures when a large reactor is used. Many scaleup criteria do not apply to transient events because they employ relationships that assume steady-state conditions.
Thus, the time required to disperse added material may depend on reactor size.
That can be important in suspension polymerization where new material is added
to the continuous phase but it is required to reach the dispersed phase or the phase
interface. The new material may include fresh monomer(s), blowing agents, or
modiers for polymer properties. At startup conditions, the initial dispersion of
drop stabilizers and initiator may require dierent amounts of time with reactors
of dierent sizes. Consequently, the DSD and nal PSD may depend on the scale
of operation, because polymerization (and a change in drop properties) occurs during the drop creation process.

5.5

Inverse Suspension Polymerization

When a water-miscible polymer is to be made via a suspension process, the continuous phase is a water-immiscible uid, often a hydrocarbon. In such circumstances the adjective inverse is often used to identify the process [118]. The drop
phase is often an aqueous monomer solution which contains a water-soluble initiator. Inverse processes that produce very small polymer particles are sometimes
referred to as inverse emulsion polymerization but that is often a misnomer
because the polymerization mechanism is not always analogous to conventional
emulsion polymerization. A more accurate expression is either inverse microsuspension or inverse dispersion polymerization. Here, as with conventional suspension polymerization, the polymerization reaction occurs inside the monomercontaining drops. The drop stabilizers are initially dispersed in the continuous
(nonaqueous phase). If particulate solids are used for drop stabilization, the surfaces of the small particles must be rendered hydrophobic. Inverse dispersion polymerization is used to make water-soluble polymers and copolymers from monomers such as acrylic acid, acylamide, and methacrylic acid. These polymers are
used in water treatment and as thickening agents for textile applications. Beads
of polysaccharides can also be made in inverse suspensions but, in those cases,
the polymers are usually preformed before the suspension is created. Physical
changes, rather than polymerization reactions, occur in the drops. Conventional
stirred reactors are usually used for inverse suspension polymerization and the
drop size distribution can be fairly wide. However, Ni et al. [119] found that good
control of DSD and PSD could be achieved in the inverse-phase suspension polymerization of acrylamide by using an oscillatory baed reactor.
5.5.1

Initiator Types

The thermal decomposition of single-component initiators (such as inorganic persulfates) can be used to generate the free radicals in the aqueous drops, but in

239

240

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

some cases a redox initiator system is used. Redox reactions produce free radicals
at relatively low temperatures, which is advantageous when the polymerization is
very fast at higher temperatures. This type of polymerization is not always strictly
analogous to simple conventional suspension polymerization. In some circumstances, there is evidence to suggest that the polymerization rate is diminished
when large amounts of an oil-soluble surfactant are used to stabilize the monomer
drops, and that a small amount of polymerization occurs in the oil phase [120].
The polymerization kinetics can be complicated when redox systems are used
and the mechanism of radical generation may depend on the specic reductant
oxidant pair that is chosen [121].
5.5.2

Drop Mixing with Redox Initiators

At least one of the two major components of a redox initiator (reductant or oxidant)
must be segregated from the monomer while the suspension is being formed.
Otherwise, polymerization would begin before the desired DSD was attained.
Often, drops of an aqueous solution of monomer and oxidant are initially dispersed in an oil and stabilized with an appropriate agent. Then aqueous reductant
is added to start the reaction [122, 121]. Therefore, the initial suspension has two
types of aqueous drops which must become mixed before polymerization can begin. Liu and Brooks [123] used a freezefracture technique with electron microscopy to show how large reductant drops became mixed with small monomercontaining oxidant drops in the early stages of acrylic acid polymerization (Figure
5.8). The actual volumes and concentrations used for the two aqueous solutions affect the rate of viscosity increase in the drops and the polymerization rate [124].

5.6

Future Developments

Future work on suspension polymerization will be concerned with new products


and with new processes. Much of the new work on recipes and product properties
is material-specic and will continue to appear in the patent literature. The development of new processes requires further fundamental investigation. Improvements to existing processes need closer attention to ways in which reactors are
operated. These should include the following aspects.
5.6.1

Developing Startup Procedures for Batch and Semi-batch Reactors

Suspension polymerization can rarely be described as a conventional batch process


because uniform physical conditions cannot be created instantly. The way in which
the ingredients are brought together can aect the polymer properties. Therefore,
improvements in the control of product quality may depend on developing better

5.6 Future Developments

Fig. 5.8. Inverse dispersion polymerization of acrylic acid.


Freezefracture SEM image of dispersion 2 min after adding
aqueous reductant. Reproduced by permission of Elsevier
Science Ltd. From Ref. 123.

reactor startup procedures. The initial sequence in which the initiator and drop stabilizer are put into the reactor can aect copolymer composition and polymerization rates because inter-drop mixing can be restricted during polymerization. That
is especially important when the initiator and monomer are not premixed before
entry to the reactor. Good control of copolymer composition will continue to be difcult when monomer reactivity ratios vary widely. If late addition of some monomer is used to maintain constant composition at high conversions, then drop segregation must be overcome. Here, a careful choice of drop stabilizer, and possibly
the use of solvents, may be helpful.
Desirable changes in PSD may be obtained by exercising better control of drop
viscosity in the initial drop formation stage. That might be achieved by careful use
of radical inhibitors which reduce initial polymerization rates (and associated viscosity increases) and allow the initial DSD to develop in a desired way. The decision to remove (or not remove) radical inhibitors from monomers, before they are
put into the reactor, should not be made in an arbitrary way. Radical inhibitors that
dissolve preferentially in the continuous phase might also be used to eliminate the
initial formation of emulsion particles. That could be important because those
emulsion particles, which represent a small mass fraction of the drop phase, have

241

242

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

a large surface area and they can distort the distribution of drop stabilizer during
the initial drop development stage.
5.6.2

Maintaining Turbulence Uniformity in Batch Reactors

Turbulence in conventional stirred vessels is far from uniform and prediction


(or control) of DSD is dicult. Thus, the nal PSD is often very wide. That is undesirable when the nal particles are used directly (for example, in ion-exchange
resins). In those cases, a narrow PSD is often required. New reactor geometries
and agitation methods could ensure the correct values for the overall Reynolds
and Weber numbers and also give more uniform distribution of turbulence conditions. That will lead to a lower proportion of o-specication material. Here, the
use of new reactors, such as the oscillatory baed reactor, could be helpful.
5.6.3

Developing Viable Continuous-ow Processes

Continuous-ow reactors are often developed to produce high tonnages with low
reactor maintenance but, with suspension polymerization, continuous-ow reactors could oer other advantages. If near plug-ow conditions could be attained,
the drop formation and polymerization stages could be separated to give better
control of the DSD. Also, temperature programming would become feasible so
that variation of drop viscosity with monomer conversion could be manipulated
to achieve better control of drop coalescence and of the nal PSD. For a
continuous-ow reactor to operate successfully the following conditions must be
attained simultaneously: a suitable residence time (often a few hours); small regions of localized turbulence; restricted overall back-mixing; and good heat transfer. New designs of oscillatory baed reactors [106] may make such processes feasible on an industrial scale.
5.6.4

Quantitative Allowance for the Eects of Changes in the Properties of the Continuous
Phase

In suspension polymerization, the continuous phase is often regarded as inert.


Consequently, events that occur in that phase are sometimes neglected, even when
they are potentially important. The overall Reynolds number is often high enough
to ensure that drop breakage is via turbulence and that conventional Weber number correlations apply. But when the volume fraction of drops is high, or when a
signicant fraction of the drop stabilizer remains in the continuous phase, the
eective viscosity of the suspension becomes high. Then, the Kolmorgorov length
may exceed the drop diameter, and drop breakage via viscous shear becomes important. More work is required to determine the relationships between drop sizes
and agitation conditions when the uid ow is not fully turbulent. Maintenance

Notation

of uniform viscous shear (as opposed to maintenance of uniform turbulence)


throughout the reactor will bring a new set of challenges.
As more complex copolymers are developed, the range of monomer properties in
any one recipe will widen. The chances of all monomers being insoluble in the
continuous phase are small. Therefore the eects of monomer distribution between the phases, especially on the copolymer composition, will be important. Prediction of phase distribution is not easy in systems that are thermodynamically
nonideal and it may become necessary to develop new sensors that monitor the
composition of the continuous phase.
5.6.5

Further Study of the Role of Secondary Suspending Agents

The porosity and structure of polymer particles are important for many product
applications. Then, the use of SSAs is often important. However, to gain a better
understanding of their role, it is necessary to determine what fraction of those
stabilizers is inside drops of the dispersed phase and how they aect structure inside the particles. The importance of grafting of SSAs to the polymer should be
claried.
5.6.6

Further Characterization of Stabilizers from Inorganic Powders

Particulate stabilizers will continue to have a place in suspension polymerization


because they can often be removed after polymerization, but our understanding of
their action is far from complete. Some of the theories do not always agree with
experimental results. Further systematic studies are required to determine the effect of the size and surface condition of the stabilizer particles on their ability to
stabilize drops. Also, the location of those particles at the end of polymerization
is important. In some cases, it may be advantageous to treat stabilizer particles
so that they remain with the polymer product in order to confer some desirable
property.

Notation

B
C1 ; C3 ; C4
CI
CM
d
d max
d min
d32
D

bae width [m]


constants (dimensionless)
initiator concentration [mol m3 ]
monomer concentration [mol m3 ]
drop diameter [m]
maximum drop diameter [m]
minimum drop diameter [m]
Sauter mean diameter [m]
impeller diameter [m]

243

244

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension

f
G
H
kd
kp
kt
N
Re
Ri
Rp
T
We
We crit

eciency factor (dimensionless)


clearance underneath impeller [m]
height of the total suspension [m]
initiator decomposition rate coecient [s1 ]
propagation rate coecient [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
termination rate coecient [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
impeller speed [s1 ]
Reynolds number (dimensionless)
initiation rate [mol m3 s1 ]
polymerization rate [mol m3 s1 ]
tank diameter [m]
Weber number (dimensionless)
critical Weber number (dimensionless)

Greek
parameter to dene ow (dimensionless)
local energy dissipation rate per unit mass of uid [m 2 s3 ]
Kolmogorov length [m]
viscosity [kg m1 s1 ]
kinematic viscosity [m 2 s1 ]
density [kg m3 ]
interfacial tension [kg m2 ]
volume fraction of dispersed phase (dimensionless)

a
e
h
m
n
r
s
j
Subscripts
c
d

continuous phase
dispersed phase

References
1 M. Munzer, E. Trommsdorff, in

Polymerization Processes, Ed. C. E.


Schildknecht, I. Skeist, Chapter 5,
p. 106, Wiley. New York, 1977.
2 H. Bieringer, K. Flatan, D. Reese,
Angew. Makromol. Chem., 1984, 123,
307334.
3 H. Warson, Polym. Paint. Col. J.,
1983, 24, 541544.
4 B. W. Brooks, Makromol. Chem.
Makromol. Symp., 1990, 35/36, 121
140.

5 H. G. Yuan, G. Kalfas, W. H. Ray,

7
8
9

Rev. Makromol. Chem. Phys., 1991,


C31(2/3), 215299.
E. Vivaldo-Lima, P. E. Wood, A. E.
Hamielec, Ind. Eng. Chem. Rev. 1997,
36, 939965.
R. Ashady, Colloid Polym. Sci., 1992,
270, 717732.
M. Langsam, J. T. Cheng, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1985, 30, 12851308.
C. G. Hagberg, Polym. Mater. Sci.
Eng., 1988, 58, 614621.

References
10 R. Ashady, G. W. Kenner, A.

11
12

13

14

15

16

17

18
19

20
21
22
23

24
25

26
27
28
29
30

Ledwith, J. Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem.


Ed., 1974, 12, 20172025.
Z. Izumi, H. Kitagawa, J. Polym. Sci.
A-1, 1967, 5, 19671975.
A. Lopez, B. W. Brooks, Instn. Chem.
Engrs Research Event, Nottingham,
1997, pp. 12251228.
S. X. Zhou, Z. X. Weng, Z. M.
Huang, Z. R. Pan, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 2001, 79, 14311438.
M. J. Rosen, Surfactants and Interfacial
Phenomena, 2nd ed., Wiley, New York,
1989.
R. P. Borwankar, S. I. Chung, D. T.
Wasan, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1986, 32,
57495762.
P. J. Dowding, B. Vincent, Colloids
and Surfaces A, Phys. Eng. Aspects,
2000, 161, 259269.
M. Zerfa, B. W. Brooks, Colloids and
Surfaces A, Phys. Eng. Aspects, 1998,
132, 267273.
M. Zerfa, B. W. Brooks, Chem. Eng.
Sci., 1996, 51, 35913611.
M. D. Horrill, B. W. Brooks, Inst.
Chem. Engrs Research Event, Leeds,
1996, 545547.
S. U. Pickering, J. Chem. Soc., 1907,
2001.
Z. Wang, B. W. Brooks, Polymer
International, 1992, 28, 239244.
E. OShima, M. Tanaka, Kagaku
Kogaku Ronbunshu, 1982, 8, 188.
D. Wolters, W. Meyer-Zaika, F.
Bandermann, Macromolecular
Materials and Engineering, 2001, 286,
94106.
Z. Wang, B. W. Brooks, Polymer
International, 1993, 30, 317326.
R. Aveyard, B. P. Binks, J. H. Clint,
Advances in Colloid and Interface
Science, 2003, 100, 503546.
R. Shinnar, J. M. Church, Ind.
Engng. Chem., 1960, 52, 253256.
A. N. Kolmogorov, Dokl. Acad. Nauk
SSSR, 1949, 66, 825828.
C. A. Coulaloglou, L. L. Tavlarides,
A.I.Ch.E.J., 1976, 32, 289297.
A. N. Kolmogorov, Dokl. Acad. Nauk
SSSR, 1941, 30, 301304.
J. H. Rushton, E. W. Costich, H. J.
Everett, Chem. Engng. Prog., 1950, 46,
395404 and 467476.

31 J. O. Hinze, A.I.Ch.E., 1955, 1, 289

295.
32 R. Shinnar, J. Fluid, Mech., 1961, 10,

259275.
33 F. B. Sprow, Chem. Engng. Sci., 1967,

22, 435442.
34 M. Kuriyama, M. Ono, H. Tokanai,

35
36

37

38

39
40
41

42
43
44
45

46
47
48
49
50

51

52

H. Konno, Chem. Engng. Res. Des.,


1996, 74, 431437.
M. Zerfa, B. W. Brooks, Chem. Eng.
Sci., 1996, 51, 32233233.
B. W. Brooks, H. N. Richmond,
Chem. Engng Sci., 1994, 49, 1053
1064.
F. Jahanzad, S. Sajjadi, B. W.
Brooks, Macromolecular Symposia,
2004, 206, 255262.
F. Langner, H. U. Moritz, K. H.
Reichert, Chem. Ing. Tech., 1979, 51,
746747.
D. E. Leng, G. J. Quarderer, Chem.
Engng, Commun., 1982, 14, 177201.
G. I. Taylor, Proc. R. Soc. Lond., 1934,
A 146, 501523.
C. Jegat, A. Bois, M. Camps, J. Polym.
Sci.: Polym. Phys. Ed, 2001, 39, 201
210.
H. P. Grace, Chem. Eng. Commun.,
1982, 14, 225277.
B. J. Bentley, L. G. Leal, J. Fluid.
Mech., 1986, 167, 241283.
E. G. Chatzi, C. Kiparissides,
A.I.Ch.E.J., 1992, 41, 16401652.
K. Arai, M. Konno, Y. Matunaga, S.
Saito, J. Chem. Eng. Japan, 1977, 10,
325330.
C. Y. Wang, R. V. Calabrese,
A.I.Ch.E.J., 1986, 32, 667676.
M. Konno, K. Arai, S. Saito, J.
Chem. Eng. Japan, 1982, 15, 131135.
F. B. Sprow, A.I.Ch.E.J., 1967, 13,
954998.
W. J. Howarth, Chem. Eng. Sci., 1964,
19, 3338.
J. Alvarez, J. J. Alvarez, M. A.
Hernandez, Chem. Eng. Sci., 1994,
49, 99113.
D. Maggioris, A. Goulas, A. H.
Alexopoulos, E. G. Chatzi, C.
Kiparissides, Chem. Eng. Sci., 2000,
55, 46114627.
B. Yang, K. Takahashi, M. Takeishi,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 2000, 39, 2085
2090.

245

246

5 Free-radical Polymerization: Suspension


53 R. V. Calabrese, C. Y. Wang, N. P.

54

55

56

57
58
59
60
61
62
63

64
65
66

67
68

69
70

71
72

73

Bryner, A.I.Ch.E.J., 1986, 32, 677


681.
P. O. Hong, J. M. Lee, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Proc. Des. Dev., 1985, 24, 868
872.
B. W. Brooks, H. N. Richmond,
Chem. Engng. Sci., 1994, 49, 1843
1853.
A. N. Sathyagal, D. Ramkrishna,
Chem. Engng. Sci., 1996, 51, 1377
1391.
M. F. Cunningham, Polym. React.
Eng., 1999, 7, 231257.
F. W. Billmeyer, Textbook of Polymer
Science, Wiley, New York, 1971.
S. Hashim, B. W. Brooks, Chem.
Engng. Sci., 2002, 57, 37033714.
M. Zerfa, B. W. Brooks, Chem.
Engng. Sci., 1997, 52, 24212427.
M. Zerfa, B. W. Brooks, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1996, 60, 20772086.
M. Zerfa, B. W. Brooks, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1997, 65, 127134.
C. H. Bamford, W. G. Barb, A. D.
Jenkins, P. F. Onyon, The Kinetics
of Vinyl Polymerisation by Radical
Mechanisms, Butterworths, London,
1958.
J. H. Duerksen, A. E. Hamielec, J. W.
Hodgins, A.I.Ch.E.J., 1967, 13, 1081.
B. W. Brooks, Proc. R. Soc. Lond.,
1977, A 357, 183192.
J. T. S. Bogunjoko, B. W. Brooks,
Makromol. Chem., 1983, 184, 1603
1621.
N. Tefera, G. Weickert, Makromol.
Chem. Phys., 1994, 195, 30673085.
O. F. Olaj, I. Bitai, H. Hinklemann,
Makromol. Chem., 1987, 188, 1689
1702.
M. Buback, C. Kowollik,
Macromolecules, 1998, 31, 32113215.
N. Tefera, G. Weickert, R.
Bloodworth, J. Schweer, Macromol.
Chem. Phys., 1994, 195, 30673085.
D. S. Achilias, C. Kiparissides,
Polymer, 1994, 35, 17141721.
N. Tefera, G. Weickert, K. R.
Westerterp, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1997,
63, 16491661.
G. A. ONeil, M. B. Wisnudel, J. M.
Torkelson, Macromolecules, 1996, 29,
74777490.

74 A. Faldi, M. Tirrell, T. P. Lodge, E.

75
76
77
78

79

80
81

82
83
84
85
86
87
88

89

90
91

92

93

94

Vonmeerwall, Macromolecules, 1994,


27, 41844192.
J. G. Qin, W. P. Guo, Z. Zhang,
Polymer, 2002, 43, 11631170.
D. S. Achilias, C. Kiparissides,
Macromolecules, 1992, 25, 37393750.
J. San Roman, E. L. Madruga, Angew.
Makromol. Chem., 1980, 86, 1731.
M. W. Allsopp, in Manufacture and
Processing of PVC, Ed. R. H. Burgess,
Chapter 7, Applied Science, London,
1982.
R. C. Stephenson, P. V. Smallwood,
in Encyclopedia of Polymer Science and
Engineering, 2nd ed., Vol. 17 and
Supplement, Wiley, New York, 1989.
P. V. Smallwood, Polymer, 1986, 27,
16091618.
A. F. Cebollada, M. J. Schmidt, J. N.
Farber, N. J. Capiati, E. M. Valles, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1989, 37, 145166.
Y. Z. Bao, B. W. Brooks, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 2002, 85, 15441552.
M. H. Lewis, G. R. Johnson, J. Vinyl
Technol., 1981, 3, 102.
D. H. Lee, J. Chem. Eng. Japan, 1999,
32, 97103.
F. Wolf, I. Schuessler, Plaste und
Kautschuk, 1971, 18, 492494.
S. Ormondroyd, Br. Polym. J., 1989,
20, 353359.
J. T. Cheng, J. Macromol. Sci., Phys.,
1981, 3B20, 65380.
J. T. Cheng, M. Langsam, J.
Macromol. Sci., Chem., 1984, A21,
395409.
M. Clark, in Particulate Nature of
PVC, Ed. G. Butters, Applied
Science, London, 1982.
B. E. Toernell, J. M. Uustalu, J.
Vinyl Technol., 1982, 4, 5356.
H. Nilsson, C. Silvergen, B.
Tornell, J. Vinyl Technol., 1985, 7,
123127.
C. Kiparissides, I. Moustakis, A.
Hamielec, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1993,
49, 445459.
J. A. Davidson, D. E. Witenhafer, J.
Polym. Sci. Polym. Phys. Ed., 1980, 18,
5169.
Y. Z. Bao, J. G. Liao, Z. M. Huang,
Z. X. Weng, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 2003,
90, 38483855.

References
95 M. Langsam, P. A. Mango, J. Appl.
96
97

98

99

100

101

102
103
104

105
106
107

108

109
110

Polym. Sci., 1986, 31, 23612376.


W. P. Hohnstein, H. Mark, J. Polym.
Sci., 1946, 1, 127145.
O. Okay, E. Soner, A. Gungor, T. I.
Balkas, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1985, 30,
20652074.
Y. Ohtsuka, H. Kagaguchi, T.
Hamasaki, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1982,
27, 17711782.
W. Kangwansupamonkon, S.
Damronglerd, S.
Kiatkamjornwong, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 2002, 85, 654669.
J. Y. Oldshue, D. O. Mechler, D. W.
Grinnell, Chem. Eng. Prog., 1982,
198, 6874.
E. Vivaldo-Lima, P. E. Wood, A. E.
Hamielec, A. Penlidis, Canad. J.
Chem. Eng., 1998, 76, 495505.
M. Tanaka, T. Izumi, J. Chem. Eng.
Japan, 1985, 18, 354358.
M. Tanaka, E. Oshima, Canad. J.
Chem. Eng., 1988, 66, 2935.
Y. Sato, Y. Murakami, T. Hirose, Y.
Hashiguchi, S. Ono, M. Ichikawa,
J. Chem. Eng. Japan, 1979, 12, 448
453.
M. Tanaka, T. Takahashi, I. Kimura,
Chem. Eng. Tech., 1996, 19, 97102.
X. Ni, Y. Zhang, I. Mustafa, Chem.
Engng. Sci., 1999, 54, 841850.
K. H. Reichert, H. U. Moritz, C.
Gabel, G. Deiringer, in Polymer
Reaction Engineering, Ed. K. H.
Reichert, W. Geiseler, pp. 153174,
Hanser, Munich, 1983.
W. Baade, H. U. Moritz, K. H.
Reichert, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1982,
27, 22492267.
T. W. Taylor, K. H. Reichert, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1985, 30, 227250.
X. Ni, K. R. Murray, Y. M. Zhang,

111
112

113

114

115

116
117
118

119

120
121
122

123
124

D. Bennett, T. Howes, Powder


Technol., 2002, 124, 281286.
J. M. Pinto, R. Giudici, Chem.
Engng. Sci., 2001, 56, 10211028.
T. Mejdell, T. Pettersen, C.
Naustdal, H. F. Svendsen, Chem.
Engng. Sci., 1999, 54, 24592466.
G. D. Longeway, D. E. Witenhafer,
J. Vinyl Additive Technol., 2000, 6, 100
103.
R. H. Perry, D. W. Green, Perrys
Chemical Engineers Handbook, 7th ed.,
McGraw Hill, New York, Section 1127, 1997.
N. Lazrak, A. Ricard, 5th
International Workshop on Polymer
Reaction Engineering, Dechema
Monograph 131, pp. 291299, VCHVerlagsgesellschaft, Weinheim, 1995.
S. Nemeth, F. Thyrion, Chem. Eng.
Technol., 1995, 18, 315323.
B. W. Brooks, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.,
1983, 28, 619623.
J. W. Vanderhoff, E. B. Bradford,
H. L. Tarkowski, J. B. Shaer, R. M.
Wiley, ACS Adv. Chem. Ser., 1962, 34,
32.
X. Ni, J. C. Johnstone, K. C. Symes,
B. D. Grey, D. C. Bennett,
A.I.Ch.E.J., 2001, 47, 17461757.
Z. Liu, B. W. Brooks, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 1997, 66, 21912197.
Z. Liu, B. W. Brooks, J. Polym. Sci.,
1999, A37, 313324.
M. V. Dimonie, N. N. Marinescu,
D. S. Vasilescu, O. Shaffer, H.
Caldararu, A. Caragheorgheopol,
J. J. Languri, Macromol. Sci., 1992,
A29, 277.
Z. Liu, B. W. Brooks, Polymer, 1999,
40, 21812188.
Z. Liu, B. W. Brooks, J. Polym. Sci.,
1997, 66, 21912197.

247

249

Emulsion Polymerization1
Jose C. de la Cal, Jose R. Leiza, Jose M. Asua, Alessandro Butte`,
Giuseppe Storti, and Massimo Morbidelli
6.1

Introduction

Emulsion polymerization leads to the production of a ne dispersion of a polymer


in a continuous medium, which most often is water; the dispersion is called latex.
With a worldwide annual production in excess of 20 million tonnes, emulsion
polymerization is used in the production of a wide range of specialty polymers,
including adhesives, paints, binders for nonwoven fabrics, additives for paper, textiles, and construction materials, impact modiers for plastic matrices, and diagnostic tests and drug delivery systems [14]. The development of this industry
has been due to both the possibility of producing polymers with unique properties
and the environmental concerns and governmental regulations relating to substitution of solvent-based system by waterborne products.
In a scenario of reduction of margins, increasing competition, and public sensitivity to environmental issues, emulsion polymer producers are forced to achieve
ecient production of high-quality materials in a consistent, safe, and environmentally friendly way. Emulsion polymers are products-by-process whose main
properties are determined during polymerization. A critical point is to know how
these process variables aect the nal properties of the product. One possibility
is to consider the reactor as a black box and to develop empirical relationships
between process variables and product properties. Long-term success can only be
guaranteed by applying knowledge-based strategies that use the polymer microstructure (here, the term microstructure is used in a broad sense, including aspects
such as copolymer composition, molecular weight distribution (MWD), branching,
crosslinking, gel fraction, particle morphology, and particle size distribution (PSD)
of the dispersion) as a link between the reactor variables and the nal properties
(Figure 6.1).
The implementation of the approach illustrated in Figure 6.1 has important eco1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

250

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.1.

Polymer properties as a function of formulation and process type.

nomic implications and is scientically challenging. On the one hand, the needs/
opportunities of the market, expressed as desired properties of the nal product,
should be translated in terms of the desired polymer microstructure. This requires
quantitative microstructure/properties relationships. On the other hand, this polymer microstructure should be achieved in the reactor. This involves a deep understanding of the emulsion polymerization process, the highest level of understanding being the development of predictive mathematical models. In addition,
ecient, safe, and consistent production requires accurate on-line monitoring, optimization, and control. Last but not least, ecient methods for removal of residual
monomer and volatile organic compounds (VOCs) should be developed to produce
environmentally friendly products.
This chapter is focused on the challenge of achieving the ecient, safe, and
consistent production of emulsion polymers of the desired microstructure. First,
the main features of emulsion polymerization are discussed in Sections 6.2 and
6.3. Sections 6.46.7 are devoted to the understanding of the kinetics of the process. Finally, the emulsion polymer reaction engineering is addressed in Sections
6.86.11.

6.2

Features of Emulsion Polymerization


6.2.1

Description of the Process

Table 6.1 presents a typical formulation for emulsion polymerization. The polymer
is mainly made out of a mixture of hard monomers (leading to polymers with a
high glass transition temperature, Tg ; for example, styrene) and soft monomers
(low Tg; for example, butyl acrylate) of low solubility in water. In addition, small
amounts of functional monomers such as acrylic and methacrylic acids are included in the formulation as they provide some special characteristics, such as improved adhesion. Crosslinking agents and chain-transfer agents (CTAs) are used to
control the molecular weight distribution of the polymer.

6.2 Features of Emulsion Polymerization


Tab. 6.1.

Typical formulation for emulsion polymerization.

Ingredient

Content [wt.%]

Monomer(s)
styrene
methyl methacrylate
vinyl chloride
vinyl acetate
butadiene
butyl acrylate
2-ethylhexyl acrylate
Veova 10
ethylene
(meth)acrylic acid
crosslinking monomers
Deionized water
Initiators
Emulsiers
Chain-transfer agents

5055

45
0.5
0.53

Typically, emulsion polymerization is carried out in stirred-tank reactors, which


commonly operate in a semicontinuous mode, although both batch and continuous operations are also used.
In a batch emulsion polymerization, the mixture of monomers is dispersed in
water using emulsiers. The monomer droplets are stabilized by the surfactant
adsorbed on their surface. In principle, any type of surfactant may be used, but in
practice anionic surfactants, nonionic surfactants, and mixtures thereof account for
the great majority of the systems used. The available surfactant partitions between
the surface of the monomer droplets and the aqueous phase; in most formulations, the amount of surfactant exceeds that needed to completely cover the monomer droplets and saturate the aqueous phase. The excess of surfactant forms
micelles that are swollen with monomer (Figure 6.2(a)).
Polymerization is commonly initiated by water-soluble initiators (both thermal, for example, potassium persulfate, and redox, for example, tert-butyl
hydroperoxide/ascorbic acid) although oil-soluble initiators (for example, AIBN)
may also be used. When a water-soluble initiator such as potassium persulfate is
added to the monomer dispersion, radicals are formed and as these radicals are
too hydrophilic to enter the organic phases of the systems, they react with the
monomer dissolved in the aqueous phase, forming oligoradicals. The growth rate
of the oligoradicals is generally modest because of the low concentration of monomer in the aqueous phase. After adding some monomer units, the oligoradicals become hydrophobic enough to be able to enter the micelles (entry into the monomer droplets is not likely because their total surface area is about three orders of
magnitude smaller than that of the micelles). Because of the high concentration
of monomer in the micelle, the oligoradical that has entered the micelle grows

251

252

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.2.

Intervals in the batch emulsion polymerization.

fast, forming a polymer chain. The new species formed upon entry of a radical into
a micelle is considered to be a polymer particle. The process of formation of polymer particles by entry of radicals into micelles is called heterogeneous nucleation
[5]. The oligoradicals that do not enter into micelles will continue growing in the
aqueous phase, and upon reaching some critical length they become too hydrophobic and precipitate. The emulsier present in the system will adsorb onto the
newly formed interface, thus stabilizing the polymer. Then, monomer will diuse
into the new polymer particle. The process of formation of polymer particles by
precipitation of oligoradicals is called homogeneous nucleation [6]. Both homoge-

6.2 Features of Emulsion Polymerization

neous and heterogeneous nucleation may be operative in a given system. In general, homogeneous nucleation is predominant for monomers of relatively high
water solubility (for example, methyl methacrylate 1.5 g/100 g of water and
vinyl acetate 2.5 g/100 g of water) and heterogeneous nucleation is predominant
for water-insoluble monomers (for example, styrene 0.045 g/100 g of water).
Irrespective of the mechanism of particle nucleation (heterogeneous or homogeneous) the newly formed particles are very small and suer a tremendous increase
in surface area upon particle growth. It is arguable that the emulsier molecules
may diuse fast enough to adsorb on the surface of these fast-growing particles,
stabilizing them [79]. Therefore, in the so-called mechanism of coagulative nucleation, the species formed by entry of radicals into micelles and by precipitation of
growing radicals in the aqueous phase are considered to be precursor particles that
only become stable upon growth by coagulation and polymerization.
During nucleation, monomer droplets, monomer swollen micelles, and monomer swollen polymer particles coexist in the reactor (Figure 6.2(b)). Polymer
particles compete eciently for radicals, and hence monomer is consumed by polymerization inside the polymer particles. It is worth mentioning that polymerization proceeds according to the same mechanisms as are discussed in Chapter 4 for
free-radical polymerization in homogeneous systems. The monomer that is consumed by polymerization in the polymer particles is replaced by monomer that diffuses from the monomer droplets through the aqueous phase. Therefore, the size
of the particles increases and that of the monomer droplets decreases. The number
of micelles decreases because they become polymer particles upon entry of a radical and also because they are destroyed to provide surfactant to stabilize the increasing surface area of the growing polymer particles. After some time, all the
micelles disappear. This is considered to be the end of the nucleation; only limited
formation of new particles may occur after this point because heterogeneous nucleation is not possible and there is no free surfactant available in the system to stabilize the particles formed by homogeneous nucleation. The stage of the batch emulsion polymerization in which particle nucleation occurs is called Interval I. At the
end of Interval I, which typically occurs at a monomer conversion of about 510%
(depending on the surfactant/monomer ratio), 10 17 10 18 particles per liter are
formed. Unless coagulation occurs, the number of particles remains constant during the rest of the process.
In Interval II, the system is composed of monomer droplets and polymer particles (Figure 6.2(c)). The monomer consumed by polymerization in the polymer
particles is replaced by monomer that diuses from the monomer droplets
through the aqueous phase. The mass-transfer rate of monomers with water solubility equal or greater than that of styrene (0.045 g/100 g of water) is substantially
higher than the polymerization rate, and hence monomer partitions between the
dierent phases of the system according to the thermodynamic equilibrium.
Therefore, in the presence of monomer droplets, the concentration of the monomer in the polymer particles reaches a maximum value. As discussed below (see
Section 6.4.1), this saturation value arises from the energy (interfacial tension)
needed to increase the surface area of the polymer particles upon swelling. Conse-

253

254

6 Emulsion Polymerization

quently, the monomer concentration in the polymer particles is roughly constant


during Interval II. The transport of reactants (monomers, chain-transfer agents)
with water solubility lower than that of the styrene from monomer droplets to polymer particles may be diusionally limited.
Because of the polymerization and monomer transport, the polymer particles
grow in size, and after some time the monomer droplets disappear. This marks
the end of Interval II. The monomer conversion at which Interval II ends depends
on the capability of the polymer particle to be swollen by monomer. The higher the
maximum swelling, the earlier the monomer droplets disappear. In general, the
more water-soluble the monomer, the higher the maximum swelling, and hence
the lower the monomer conversion at the end of Interval II. Thus, the transition
from Interval II to Interval III occurs at about 40% conversion for styrene and at
about 15% conversion for vinyl acetate. This means that most monomer polymerizes in Interval III (Figure 6.2(d)). In this interval, monomer concentration in the
polymer particles decreases continuously. The nal product is a waterborne, concentrated (5060 wt.% solids) dispersion of tiny (80500 nm in diameter) polymer
particles called latex.
In a semicontinuous reactor in which monomers, surfactant, initiator, and water
may be continuously fed into the reactor, emulsion polymerization does not follow
the sequence of events described above. Thus, slow monomer feed and fast surfactant feed may lead to a system composed of polymer particles and micelles (Figure
6.3(a)). The system will contain only monomer-swollen polymer particles if both
monomer and surfactant are fed slowly (Figure 6.3(b)). On the other hand, a fast
monomer feed and a low surfactant feed will lead to a system containing monomer
droplets and polymer particles (Figure 6.3(c)).
6.2.2

Radical Compartmentalization

From a mechanistic point of view, the compartmentalization of radicals among a


huge number of polymer particles is likely to be the most distinctive feature of
emulsion polymerization. This refers to the fact that the radicals are distributed
among the dierent particles, and hence radicals in dierent particles cannot terminate between them. Consequently, the overall concentration of radicals is higher
than in homogeneous (bulk and solution) free-radical polymerization, leading to a
higher polymerization rate. In addition, the compartmentalization of radicals in a
large number of particles results in a longer lifetime of the radicals, which leads to
higher molecular weights.
6.2.3

Advantages of Emulsion Polymerization

Free-radical polymerization is a very exothermic process, liable to suer thermal


runaways. Compared with bulk and solution polymerization, emulsion polymeriza-

6.2 Features of Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.3.

Species present in semicontinuous emulsion polymerization.

tion is advantageous because the low viscosity of the latex allows high heat removal rates. In addition, because of its high heat capacity, the water absorbs large
amounts of heat with only a moderate increase in temperature. This allows combination of high polymerization rates and good temperature control. Compared with
solution polymerization, emulsion polymerization is environmentally friendly, as
water is used as the reaction medium. In addition, the low viscosity of the system
allows easy removal of both unreacted monomer and VOCs. Because of the compartmentalization of the radicals, emulsion polymerization overcomes the limita-

255

256

6 Emulsion Polymerization

tions imposed by the kinetics of bulk and solution polymerization, and high polymerization rates and high molecular weights can be achieved simultaneously.
Some valuable products with applications in paper coating, leather treatment,
binders for nonwoven fabrics, additives for paper, textiles and construction materials, impact modiers for plastic matrices, and diagnostic tests and drug delivery
systems, can only be produced by emulsion polymerization. In addition, when
needed (for example, for rubber for tires) latexes are easy to process into dry polymer. The main disadvantage of emulsion polymerization is that the product contains emulsier and residues of initiator, which give it water sensitivity.

6.3

Alternative Polymerization Techniques

Dispersed polymers are also achieved by inverse emulsion polymerization, miniemulsion polymerization, dispersion polymerization, and microemulsion polymerization. Inverse emulsion polymerization is used in the preparation of solventbased dispersions of polymers produced from water-soluble monomers. The
process is similar to conventional emulsion polymerization but the dispersed
phase is an aqueous solution of the monomer and the continuous phase is an organic solvent [10]. In miniemulsion polymerization [11], the size of the monomer
droplets is substantially reduced (dd 501000 nm) by combining a suitable emulsier and an ecient emulsication apparatus, and stabilizing the resulting monomer miniemulsion against diusional degradation by using a costabilizer (hydrophobic, low molecular weight compound). The available surfactant adsorbs on
the large surface area of the droplets, and hence no micelles are formed. When
the initiator is added to the system, the radicals enter the monomer droplets,
which become polymer particles. Droplet nucleation minimizes the diusional
limitations encountered in conventional emulsion polymerization and allows the
incorporation of water-insoluble compounds (monomers, polymers, catalysts, catalytic chain-transfer agents, inorganic materials, agents for controlled radical polymerization) in the reaction loci. In the last few years, plenty of new applications
have been discovered. These applications include:











production of high-solids, low-viscosity latexes;


stable operation in continuous polymerization reactors;
controlled radical polymerization in dispersed media;
catalytic polymerization;
encapsulation of inorganic solids;
incorporation of hydrophobic monomers;
production of hybrid polymer particles;
miniemulsion polymerization in nonaqueous media;
anionic polymerization;
step polymerization in aqueous dispersed media;

6.3 Alternative Polymerization Techniques

Fig. 6.4.




Dispersion polymerization.

production of low molecular weight polymers in dispersed media;


preparation of latexes with special particle morphology.

In dispersion polymerization [12], the monomers, the initiator and the stabilizer
(or stabilizer precursor) are dissolved in a solvent which is not a solvent for the
polymer (Figure 6.4(a)). Polymerization starts in a homogeneous phase and the
polymer is precipitated, forming unstable nuclei (Figure 6.4(b)). The nuclei are stabilized by the stabilizer present in the system (Figure 6.4(c)). This stabilizer may be
included in the formulation or formed in the reactor by grafting onto the stabilizer
precursor (the case shown in Figure 6.4). Nucleation ends when the number of stable polymer particles increases to a point at which all new nuclei are captured by
the existing stable particles. Because of the compartmentalization of the radicals
among the polymer particles, the polymerization locus changes from the continuous to the dispersed phase. Dispersion polymerization allows the production of
monodispersed micron-size particles, which are too large for emulsion polymerization and too small for suspension polymerization.
Microemulsion polymerization [13] involves the polymerization of oil-in-water
and water-in-oil monomer microemulsions. Microemulsions are thermodynamically stable and isotropic dispersions, whose stability is due to the very low interfacial tension achieved using appropriate emulsiers. Particle nucleation occurs
upon entry of a radical into a microemulsion droplet. Microemulsion polymerization allows the production of particles smaller than those obtained by emulsion polymerization. This leads to a higher number of polymer particles, which results in
a more compartmentalized system. Under these conditions the lifetime of the polymer chains increases, leading to ultra-high molecular weights.

257

258

6 Emulsion Polymerization

6.4

Kinetics of Emulsion Polymerization

Conventional emulsion polymerization occurs in a three-phase system (polymer


particles, aqueous phase, and monomer droplets) and polymerization may, in principle, occur in any phase. However, the concentrations of both monomer and radicals in the polymer particles are much higher than those in the aqueous phase (see
below), and hence the extent of the polymerization in the aqueous phase is in most
cases negligible. On the other hand, the concentration of the radicals in the monomer droplets is very low because the monomer droplets are not ecient at capturing the radicals formed in the aqueous phase. The polymerization in the polymer
particles follows the same mechanisms as in bulk polymerization and the rate of
polymerization per polymer particle Rpp is given by Eq. (1), where k p is the propagation rate constant [m 3 mol1 s1 ], Mp the concentration of monomer in the
polymer particles [mol m3 ], n the average number of radicals per particle and NA
Avogadros number.
Rpp k p Mp

n
NA

mol/particle s

The overall polymerization rate Rp takes into account the existence of many polymer particles in the system according to Eq. (2), where Np is the number of polymer particles in the reactor, and V the volume of the reactor.
Rp k p Mp

n Np
NA V

mol/m 3 s

Most emulsion polymerization processes involve several monomers. However,


there is considerable evidence that for many polymerization systems, propagation
depends on the nature of the monomer and on the last two units of the growing
chain [14]. The lack of available values for the large number of parameters involved
in this model makes it advisable to use simpler models, such as the terminal
model [15], in which polymerization is governed by the nature of the monomer
and the terminal unit of the growing chain. In this case, the polymerization rate
Rpi of a given monomer is expressed as Eq. (3), where kpji is the propagation rate
constant of radicals with terminal unit j with monomer i [m 3 mol1 s1 ], and Pj
the time-averaged probability of nding an active chain with ultimate unit of type j
that for a two-monomer system is given by Eq. (4) [16].
!
X
n Np
mol/m 3 s
kpji Pj Mi p
3
Rp i
N
A V
j
P1

kp21 M1 p
kp21 M1 p kp12 M2 p

P2 1  P1

In order to calculate the polymerization rate, Mi p ; n and Np should be available.

6.4 Kinetics of Emulsion Polymerization

6.4.1

Monomer Partitioning

During Intervals I and II of a batch emulsion polymerization, monomers partition


among monomer droplets, aqueous phase, and polymer particles. The monomer
that is consumed by polymerization in the polymer particles is replaced by monomer that diuses from the monomer droplets through the aqueous phase. In Interval III, there are no droplets and the monomer is mostly located in the polymer
particles. In semibatch processes, monomers are continuously fed into the reactor, usually under starved conditions, that is to say at high fractional conversions
(polymer/monomer ratios close to 90:10 (by weight). Under these circumstances,
only the newly fed monomer droplets are present in the reactor and the lifetime
of these droplets is short because the monomers diuse through the aqueous
phase to the polymer particles, where they are consumed by polymerization. The
concentration of monomer in the polymer particles depends on the relative values
of mass-transfer and polymerization rates. Except for poorly emulsied, highly
water-insoluble monomers, the rate of mass-transfer is faster than the polymerization rate, and hence the concentrations of the monomers in the dierent phases
are given by the thermodynamic equilibrium.
The amount of monomer that can be absorbed in the polymer particles is limited
and the excess of monomer forms droplets. The limiting swelling of the polymer
particles is due to the contribution of the surface energy to the total free energy of
the system. Because of the interfacial tension, the surface energy increases as particles swell and, at some point, this compensates for the decrease in the free energy
due to the monomerpolymer mixing. From values of the maximum swelling for
homopolymerization [17] (Table 6.2) it can be seen that the higher the water solubility of the monomer, the higher the equilibrium swelling. The swelling equilibrium depends on the particle size, but for particle sizes common in emulsion polymerization this eect is negligible [18, 19].
For a multimonomer system, the calculation of the concentrations of the
monomers in the dierent phases involves the simultaneous solution of the thermodynamic equilibrium equations and the material balances. Several equilibrium
equations may be used, those based on partition coecients [20] and on the
Tab. 6.2.

Swelling equilibrium data for homopolymerization

[17].
p

Monomer

fM [a]

Styrene
n-Butyl methacrylate
n-Butyl acrylate
Methyl methacrylate
Vinyl acetate
Methyl acrylate

0.6
0.6
0.65
0.73
0.85
0.85

[a] fp

volume fraction of monomer in the polymer particles.

259

260

6 Emulsion Polymerization

MortonFloryHuggins equation [21] being the most commonly applied. For a


multimonomer system, the parameters of the MortonFloryHuggins are not usually available, and it has been shown [22] that for solids contents typical of commercial latexes (> 50 wt.%) the use of the MortonFloryHuggins equation does
not provide signicant advantages over the use of partition coecients. In the latj
ter case, the system of algebraic equations (5) and (6) needs to be solved, where Ki
is the partition coecient of monomer i between phase j and the aqueous phase,
j
fi the volume fraction of monomer i in phase j, fww the volume fraction of water in
the aqueous phase, fpp the volume fraction of polymer in the polymer particles,
Vp the volume of polymer particles, Vd the volume of monomer droplets, Vw the
volume of the aqueous phase, and Vi ; Vpol , and W are the volumes of monomer i,
polymer, and water, respectively.
Equilibrium equations:
j

Ki

fi
fiw

j polymer particles; droplets

Material balances:
fpp

fi 1

fww

fiw 1

fid 1

i
p

Vp fi Vd fid Vw fiw Vi
Vw fww W
Vp fpp Vpol
Ecient methods for solving Eqs (5) and (6) are given elsewhere [19, 20].
6.4.2

Average Number of Radicals per Particle

The average number of radicals per particle n is given by Eq. (7).


X

nNn
n X
Nn

Figure 6.5 illustrates the mechanisms controlling n. In most emulsion polymerization systems, radicals are produced in the aqueous phase from thermal or redox

6.4 Kinetics of Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.5.

Processes controlling the average number of radicals per particle.

initiators. Often, these radicals are too hydrophilic and cannot directly enter the hydrophobic phases (polymer particles, monomer droplets, micelles). Therefore, they
must stay in the aqueous phase until they polymerize, thus adding a number of
monomer units and becoming hydrophobic enough to enter the organic phases.
As the concentration of monomer in the aqueous phase is low, the period needed
to reach the critical length for entry may be long and a substantial fraction of
the radicals may terminate in the aqueous phase, resulting in a low initiation eciency. In conventional emulsion polymerization, the total area of the polymer particles is much larger than that of the monomer droplets; therefore most of the
radicals are captured by the polymer particles. There is some debate about the
mechanism for radical entry; diusional [23] and propagational [24]. The diusional model is more general, whereas the propagational model is a simpler
approach applicable to many homopolymerizations. The rate of radical entry can
3
also be expressed as Eq. (8), where ka is the entry rate coecient [maqueous
phase
mol1 s1 ] and Rw the concentration of radicals in the aqueous phase
[mol m3
aqueous phase ].
Rate of entry ka Rw

radicals/particle s

Equation (8) is a simplication because it assumes that all radicals are able to enter
the polymer particles, but the radicals directly produced from inorganic initiators
are too hydrophilic to be able to enter a hydrophobic phase. On the other hand,
the radicals generated from radical desorption (see below) are hydrophobic and
able to enter the polymer particles regardless of their length.
Once inside the polymer particles, the radicals undergo the classical mecha-

261

262

6 Emulsion Polymerization

nisms of free-radical polymerization: propagation, termination, chain transfer, and


so on. Obviously, in order to suer a bimolecular termination reaction, the particle
should contain two or more radicals, as radicals in dierent particles cannot terminate between them. The rate of termination in a particle with n radicals is given by
Eq. (9).
2kt
nn  1 2cnn  1
Rate of Termination
vp NA


radicals
particle s

One consequence of the compartmentalization of radicals in the particles is that


the overall concentration of radicals in the system is much greater than in solution
and bulk polymerization, and hence the polymerization rate is higher.
Chain-transfer reactions to monomers and chain-transfer agents lead to the formation of small and mobile radicals that can exit the polymer particle. Radical desorption leads to a decrease in the average number of radicals per particle. Equation (10), where kd is the rate coecient for radical exit [Eq. (11)] [25], gives the
rate of radical exit from a population of particles with an average number of radicals per particle n. In Eq. (11), l is an overall mass-transfer rate coecient, g=h the
ratio between the rate of generation of small radicals by chain transfer and the rate
of consumption of these radicals (mostly by propagation), m the partition coecient of the small radicals between the polymer particles and the aqueous phase,
Mw the concentration of monomer in the aqueous phase, k tw the termination
rate constant in the aqueous phase, and Rw the concentration of radicals in the
aqueous phase.
Rate of Exit kd n radicals/particle s

10



lNp
gNA
kd l
s1
1
hm
lNp k p Mw 2k tw Rw

11

The rate of radical exit from particles with n radicals is the product of kdn and n
[Eq. (12)], and kdn is given by Eq. (13).
Rate of Exit kdn n radicals/particle s
0
1
n
lN
p
A
gNA @
n
kdn l
1
lNp k p Mw 2k tw Rw
hm

12

s1

13

In Eq. (13), the term n=n takes account of the fact that in particles with n radicals,
the desorption rate is proportional to n but the re-entry of newly desorbed small
radicals is proportional to n.
Because radical entry, exit, and termination are stochastic events, particles have a
dierent number of radicals and the number of radicals in a given particle varies
stochastically with time. Equation (14) gives the population balance of particles

6.4 Kinetics of Emulsion Polymerization

with n radicals; it includes the concentration of radicals in the aqueous phase, and
hence the material balance for these radicals is needed from Eq. (15), where f is
the eciency factor of the initiator radicals, kI the rate coecient for initiator decomposition [s1 ], [I] the concentration of the thermal initiator in the aqueous
phase [mol m3
aqueous phase ], and k tw the termination rate in the aqueous phase
3
1 1
s ].
[maqueous
phase mol
dNn
ka Rw Nn1 kdn1 n 1Nn1 cn 2n 1Nn2
dt
 ka Rw Nn kdn nNn cnn  1Nn
n 0; 1; 2; 3 . . .

particles/s

Np
Np
dRw
2f kI I kd n
 2k tw Rw2  ka Rw
dt
NA Vw
NA Vw

14
3
mol/maqueous
phase s 15

For most practical cases, the pseudo steady-state assumption can be applied to the
radicals in the polymer particles and in the aqueous phase. Therefore, Eqs. (14)
and (15) are converted into algebraic equations by making the left-hand sides equal
to zero. The exact solution for n, under pseudo steady-state conditions, has been
given in terms of Bessel functions [26], but their use is not friendly. A simpler
and still accurate equation for n is Eq. (16), with C dened in Eq. (17). [27].
n

2ka Rw
kd kd2 4ka Rw Cc 0:5
22ka Rw kd
2ka Rw kd c

16

17

Equations (16) and (17) should be solved together with Eq. (15). The solution of
this system of algebraic equations includes the three limiting cases of the pioneering work of Smith and Ewart [28]. When the exit rate of radicals is zero (kd 0)
and the termination of the entering radical and that existing in the polymer particle is instantaneous, the average number of radicals per particle is n 0:5. This is
known as SmithEwart Case 2 and corresponds to systems in which (1) there is no
chain transfer to small molecules (that is, monomers and CTAs) or these small
molecules are highly water insoluble, and (2) the polymer particles are relatively
small (typically dp < 200 nm). Because for SmithEwart Case 2 n is constant, the
polymerization rate is directly proportional to the number of polymer particles.
In systems in which the entry rate per particle is limited and the rate of radical
desorption is relatively high (large kd ), n f 0:5. This is known as SmithEwart
Case 1 and corresponds to systems with (1) relatively water-soluble monomers or
relatively water-soluble CTAs, (2) small particles (dp < 100 nm), (3) a low rate of
generation of radicals from the initiator, and (4) a large number of particles. Under
these circumstances, n can be easily calculated by means of Eq. (18).

263

264

6 Emulsion Polymerization

ka Rw
2ka Rw kd

18

Under SmithEwart Case 1 conditions, for a given solids content and if termination in the aqueous phase is negligible, n o 1=Np . Therefore, the polymerization
rate is independent of the number of polymer particles. If termination in the aqueous phase is signicant, the polymerization rate increases with the number of polymer particles.
For large particles (dp > 200 nm), high initiator concentrations or redox initiators, and slow termination rates (gel eect), n g 0:5 (SmithEwart Case 3) and n
can be calculated as follows:


ka Rw 0:5
n
2c

19

For a given solids content under SmithEwart Case 3 kinetics, n is inversely proportional to the number of polymer particles, and hence the polymerization rate
is independent of the number of polymer particles if aqueous-phase termination
is negligible. Otherwise, the polymerization rate increases with Np .
6.4.3

Number of Polymer Particles

Particle nucleation may occur through heterogeneous nucleation, homogeneous


nucleation, and coagulative nucleation (Figure 6.6). The rate of particle generation
depends on the mechanism considered.
Heterogeneous Nucleation
The rate of formation of polymer particles by heterogeneous nucleation is expressed by Eq. (20), where R nuc is the nucleation rate, kam the rate coecient for
radical entry into the micelles, and Nm the number of micelles in the reactor given
by Eq. (21).
6.4.3.1

1 dNp
Nm
R nuc kam Rw
V dt
V
Nm

Sw  CMCVw NA
nm

particles/m 3 s

micelles

20
21

In Eq. (21), CMC is the critical micellar concentration [mol m3


aqueous phase ] and
hence CMC  Vw is the amount of surfactant dissolved in the aqueous phase; nm
is the aggregation number (average number of molecules of surfactant per micelle); and Sw [mol] is the amount of surfactant that is in the aqueous phase forming micelles and dissolved in such a phase. Sw can be calculated by means of the
overall material balance for the surfactant, Eq. (22), where ST [mol] is the total

6.4 Kinetics of Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.6.

Particle nucleation mechanisms in emulsion polymerization.

amount of surfactant in the reactor, as [m 2 mol1 ] the parking area that is, the
area of the saturated surface of the polymer particles covered by 1 mol of surfactant
and A p [m 2 ] the total surface area of the polymer particles given by Eq. (23).
Sw ST 
Ap

Ap
as

4:83Np0:33

22
Vpol
fpp

!0:66
23

265

266

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Assuming no termination of radicals in the aqueous phase and that during nucleation n 0:5, Smith and Ewart [28] solved Eqs. (20)(23), obtaining Eq. (24) for
the dependence of the number of particles on surfactant and initiator concentrations, where rv [m 3 s1 ] is the volumetric growth rate of one polymer particle.


 
 

2f kI INA fpp 0:4 as ST 0:6
Np
o
Vw
rv
Vw

24

The fulllment of this equation, in particular the 0.6th power dependence of Np


with respect ST , is often considered as a proof of the occurrence of micellar nucleation. However, one should be aware of the assumptions used in the derivation of
Eq. (24). Actually, when radical desorption is taken into account, the solution of
Eqs (20)(23) leads to Eq. (25) [29, 30], where z approaches unity as the water
solubility of the monomer increases.


 
 

2f kI INA fpp 1z as ST z
Np
o
Vw
rv
Vw

0:6 a z a 1

25

Homogeneous Nucleation
In homogeneous nucleation, particles are formed by precipitation of the growing
oligoradicals once they exceed the critical length that makes them insoluble in
water. The water solubility of the oligoradicals depends on their composition. In
this context, the critical length of the oligoradicals formed from an inorganic
water-soluble initiator such as potassium persulfate (that is, one containing an
inorganic fragment) will be longer than that of the oligoradicals formed from
desorbed radicals that are much more hydrophobic. Therefore, the rate of formation of particles by homogeneous nucleation, R nuc , is the rate of polymerization of
oligoradicals of critical length as expressed by Eq. (26), where Mw is the concentration of monomer in the aqueous phase, and R jcrit and Micrit are the number of
oligoradicals of critical length (with jcrit > icrit ) formed from the initiator and from
desorbed radicals, respectively.
6.4.3.2

R nuc k p Mw

R jcrit Micrit
V

particles/m 3 s

26

R jcrit and Micrit are calculated from the balances of radicals of type R and M in the
aqueous phase assuming that pseudo steady-state conditions apply [Eqs. (27) and
(28)].
jcritd1 d1
a2

R jcrit a1
Micrit

kd nNp icrit
a
k p Mw 1

2f kI INA
k p Mw

radicals

radicals

27

28

6.5 Molecular Weights

In these equations, d is the critical length for entry of radicals generated from the
initiator, a1 is the probability of propagation of radicals able to enter the polymer
particles (generated from desorbed radicals, and from the initiator, with lengths
equal or greater than d) and a2 the probability of propagation of radicals generated
from the initiator, with length smaller than d).
These probabilities are given by Eqs. (29) and (30).
k p Mw

a1

k p Mw 2k tw Rw ka
a2

Np
Nm
kam
NA Vw
NA Vw

k p Mw
k p Mw 2k tw Rw

29

30

Simultaneous Heterogeneous and Homogeneous Nucleation


In systems including rather water-soluble monomers and surfactant concentrations high enough for micelles to be present, particle nucleation may be formed
by both heterogeneous and homogeneous mechanisms. In this case, the overall
nucleation rate is given by Eq. (31).
6.4.3.3

R nuc kam Rw Nm k p Mw R jcrit Micrit 

 
1
particles/m 3 s
V

31

Coagulative Nucleation
In this mechanism, the species formed by entry of radicals into micelles and
by self-precipitation of radicals are considered nonstable precursor particles. The
actual particles are formed by coagulation and polymerization growth. The detailed
modeling of coagulative nucleation is rather complex [31, 32]. A simplied model
can be derived by considering that the precursor particles disappear by mutual coagulation, that they are captured by the existing polymer particles, and that the rate
of nucleation of mature particles is proportional to a k4 th power of the precursor
concentration [Eqs. (32) and (33), where k1 ; k2 ; k3 , and k4 are adjustable parameters
that depend on the type and amount of surfactant] [33].
6.4.3.4

Npr2
dNpr
Np
kam Rw Nm k p Mw R jcrit Micrit  k1 Npr
 k2
dt
V
V
 k4
Npr
R nuc k3
V

32
33

6.5

Molecular Weights

The molecular weight distribution of the polymer has a profound eect on its nal
properties [34, 35]. Emulsion polymerization is a compartmentalized system in

267

268

6 Emulsion Polymerization

which dierent particles may have a dierent number of radicals. In addition, the
number of radicals in a given particle varies with time. Therefore, the length of the
macromolecules formed in a given particle depends on the number of radicals in
the particle at the moment in which the macromolecule was formed. Furthermore,
the architecture of the polymer formed depends on both the formulation and the
kinetics of the process. Thus, for monofunctional monomers with a polymerization scheme that does not include chain transfer to polymer, linear polymers are
obtained. On the other hand, branched and crosslinked polymers are obtained
when multifunctional monomers are included in the formulation and when chain
transfer to polymer is operative.
Mathematical models for the calculation of the molecular weight distribution of
linear [36] and nonlinear [3740] polymers are available, but a detailed discussion
of this issue is out of the scope of the present chapter. Instead, some simplied
equations for the calculation of the molecular weights of linear polymers in the
limiting cases of Smith and Ewart [28] will be presented.
6.5.1

Linear Polymers

As discussed above, the MWD depends on the number of radicals per particle.
Smith and Ewart [28] distinguished three limiting cases: In Case 1 n f 0:5; in
Case 2 n 0:5; and in Case 3 n g 0:5. In Cases 1 and 2, the probability of having
particles with more than one radical is almost negligible, and hence the system
may be considered to be formed by particles with no radicals and particles with
one radical (zeroone system). In Case 3, the average number of radicals is large
and the kinetics is close to bulk polymerization.
ZeroOne System (SmithEwart Cases 1 and 2)
In a zeroone system, the inactive polymer chains are formed in particles containing one radical by chain transfer to monomer and by instantaneous termination
upon entry of one radical.
The balance for inactive chains of length m in particles with one radical (N1 ) is
given by Eq. (34), where R m is the total number of radicals of length m in particles
N1 .
6.5.1.1

dMm
k tr; M Mp R m ka Rw R m
dt

m 1; 2; 3; . . .

macromolecules/s

34

Integration of Eq. (34) allows calculation of the whole molecular weight distribution. However, this is computationally demanding and often the MWD is represented in terms of the moments of the distribution, the kth-order moment of the
distribution being dened by Eq. (35).
nk

y
X
m1

m k Mm

35

6.5 Molecular Weights

Combination of Eqs. (34) and (35) yields Eq. (36), where Ruk is the generation rate
of the kth-order moment of the distribution of inactive chains and mk is the kthorder moment of the distribution of active chains.

Ruk k tr; M Mp ka Rw

mk
V

36

The balance for active chains of length m in particles with one radical (N1 ) is obtained from Eq. (37).

X
dR m 
ka Rw N0 k tr; M Mp
R m  kd N1 dm1 k p Mp Rm1  R m
dt
 k tr; M Mp R m  ka Rw R m 0

37

The rst moments of the distribution of active polymer chains can be calculated
from Eq. (37) by applying the pseudo steady-state assumption to the active chains
[Eqs. (38)].

m0

m1

R m N1 nNp

ka Rw N0 k tr; M Mp k p Mp  kd N1

m 2 m1 1

ka Rw k tr; M Mp


!
2k p Mp

38

ka Rw k tr; M Mp

The cumulative number-(Mn ) and weight-(M w ) average molecular weights can be


calculated from the moments of the MWD by means of Eqs. (39), where PM is the
average molecular weight of the repeating unit in the polymer chain.

Mn

n1
PM ;
n0

Mw

n2
PM
n1

39

On some occasions, it is interesting to know the average molecular weights produced at a given moment in the process. These instantaneous average molecular
weights can be calculated by means of Eqs. (40).

Mni

Rv1
PM ;
Rv0

Mwi

Rv2
PM
Rv1

Combination of Eqs. (36), (38), and (40) yields Eqs. (41).

40

269

270

6 Emulsion Polymerization

M ni

M wi

ka Rw N0 k tr; M Mp k p Mp  kd


m1
PM
PM
m0
ka Rw k tr; M Mp
k p Mp
ka Rw k tr; M Mp

PM

41

2k p Mp
m2
PM 1
PM A 2M ni
m1
ka Rw k tr; M Mp

For the SmithEwart Case 2, ka Rw g k tr; M Mp and then Eq. (42) holds.
M ni A

k p Mp
ka Rw

PM

42

If radical termination in the aqueous phase is negligible, from Eq. (15) we obtain
Eq. (43) and hence Eq. (44).

ka Rw 2f kI I
M ni A

NA Vw
Np

k p Mp Np PM
2f kI INA Vw

43

44

Consequently the molecular weight, as well as the polymerization rate, increases


with the number of polymer particles, and hence it is possible to increase both Rp
and the molecular weights at the same time by conveniently adjusting the formulation to increase the number of polymer particles. This is a specic feature of
emulsion polymerization that cannot be achieved in any homogeneous (bulk or solution) free-radical polymerization.
For the SmithEwart Case 1, k tr; M Mp g ka Rw and then Eq. (45) applies.
M ni A

kp
PM
k tr; M

45

Therefore the molecular weights are controlled by chain-transfer reactions and are
independent of Np .
Pseudo Bulk System (SmithEwart Case 3)
For SmithEwart Case 3, the number of radicals per particle is large and the kinetics approaches bulk polymerization. In this case, the concentration of radicals in
the polymer particles is given by Eq. (19) and the molecular weight is mainly controlled by chain transfer and bimolecular termination. The rate of generation of
polymer of length m in particles with i radicals is given by Eq. (46).
6.5.1.2

6.5 Molecular Weights


n1
X
dMmi
cc
i
k tr; M Mp Rmi 2cd i  1Rmi
i  1
Rki Rmk
dt
iNi
k1

macromolecules/s
46

From Eq. (46) the moments of the inactive chains can be calculated according to
Eqs. (47), and the moments of the active chains can be calculated by applying the
pseudo steady state in the material balance of the active radicals [Eqs. (48) and
(49)].
Rn0 2cd cc

m02
m
k tr; M Mp 0
Np V
V

Rn1 2cd 2cc

m 0 m1
m
k tr; M Mp 1
Np V
V

Rn2 2cd 2cc

m0m2
m2
m
2cc 1 k tr; M Mp 2
Np V
Np V
V

X 
dR m 
ka Rw Np k tr; M Mp
R m dm1 kp Mp Rm1  R m
dt
X
cc cd
Rm 0
 k tr; M Mp R m  2
Rm
Np
!1=2
X
ka Rw Np2
R m nNp
m0
2cd 2cc

47

48

m1

ka Rw Np k p Mp m 0 k tr; M Mp m 0


k p Mp m 0
A
m0
m
2cd 2cc
k tr; M Mp
2cd 2cc 0 k tr; M Mp
Np
Np

m2

ka Rw Np k p Mp 2m1 m 0 k tr; M Mp m 0


2k p Mp m1
A
m0
m
2cd 2cc
k tr; M Mp
2cd 2cc 0 k tr; M Mp
Np
Np

49

The instantaneous number and weight-average molecular weights are then given
by Eqs. (50).

Mni

Mwi

k p Mp
PM
m
2cd cc 0 k tr; M Mp
Np

m m
m2
2cd 2cc 0 2 2cc 1 k tr; M Mp m 2
Np
Np

PM
m 0 m1
2cd 2cc
k tr; M Mp m1
Np

50

271

272

6 Emulsion Polymerization

If bimolecular termination is predominant, then the instantaneous average molecular weights reduce to Eqs. (51).
M ni

k p Mp Np
2cd cc m 0

PM

M wi





m
cc m1
2cd cc
cc
1
2
PM A Mni
PM
m1 cd cc m 0
cd cc
2cd cc

51

Therefore:
M wi 2Mni

if bimolecular termination is only by disproportionation; and

3
M wi M ni
2

if bimolecular termination is only by combination:

Because for a given polymer content cc and cd are proportional to Np , the molecular
weights are independent of the number of particles.
On the other hand, if chain-transfer reactions are predominant over bimolecular
termination, the instantaneous molecular weights are given by Eqs. (52).
M ni

kp
PM
k tr; M

52

M wi 2Mni
For this case, the molecular weights are also independent of Np and depend only
on the ratio k p =k tr; M , and polydispersity is equal to 2.
6.5.2

Nonlinear Polymers: Branching, Crosslinking, and Gel Formation

In contrast to linear polymers, which, once they are formed, preserve their structure (molecular size) during the rest of the process, the molecular weight of the
nonlinear polymers evolves throughout the whole process because they may become active and inactive several times during that process. Thus, inactive nonlinear chains formed earlier in the process may become active through either a
chain-transfer reaction to polymer or a propagation to pendent double bonds, further polymerizing and modifying their structure. The microstructure of these nonlinear polymers is more complex than that of linear polymers, and besides the
MWD of the polymer, other properties such as the level of branching and crosslinking density are required to fully characterize the polymer. In addition, large
polymer networks (gel) are formed in some cases.
The accurate calculation of the structure of these nonlinear polymers is not an
easy task in homogeneous systems [41, 42], and it is even more complex in emul-

6.6 Particle Morphology

sion polymerization, because of the compartmentalized nature of the system. Nevertheless, some solutions have been reported [3740, 4346]. The discussion of
these approaches is outside the scope of this chapter.
Branches are formed by chain transfer to polymer (either intermolecular or intramolecular) or by propagation to pendent double bonds (PDBs). Terminal double
bonds may be formed by chain transfer to monomer, termination by disproportionation, and b-scission at relatively high temperatures. PDBs may also be present if multifunctional monomers are used in the formulation. Intermolecular
chain transfer to polymer and propagation to PDBs produces long-chain branches
(LCBs), and intramolecular chain transfer to polymer, so-called backbiting, produces short-chain branches (SCBs). Chain transfer to polymer occurs through hydrogen abstraction either from the backbone or from a side group.
A crosslink point is a tetrafunctional unit that links two polymer chains, namely
an H-shaped structure. The mechanisms leading to tetrafunctional units are:
intermolecular chain transfer to polymer followed by bimolecular termination by
combination of branched radicals, or
 propagation of a growing branched radical on a terminal or pendent double
bond, or
 polymerization of formulations including multifunctional monomers (often
called crosslinkers).


In the free-radical polymerization of vinylic monomers, gel is formed if the following conditions are fullled: (1) a mechanism leading to LCBs is operative, for example chain transfer to polymer, and (2) a mechanism that links polymer chains
is also operative, for example termination by combination or propagation to pendent double bonds. Obviously, if multifunctional monomers are homopolymerized
or copolymerized with vinylic monomers, gel is also formed. In this case, the predominant reaction linking polymer chains and leading to polymeric networks is
the propagation to pendent double bonds of the multifunctional monomers.
Under these circumstances, polymer chains of increasing density of branching
and crosslinking are formed and their molecular weight will rapidly increase, leading to the formation of gel polymer.

6.6

Particle Morphology

Latexes made out of composite polymer particles, that is, particles containing different phases, present denitive advantages in many applications. Thus, particles
formed by an elastic core and a hard shell are used as impact modiers for polymer matrices. Hard coresoft shell particles are particularly useful for paints because they have a low minimum lm formation temperature and are not sticky at
higher temperatures. Hollow particles are ecient opaciers, and hybrid polymer
polymer particles, such as epoxyacrylic polymer particles, combine the properties

273

274

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.7.

Development of particle morphology.

of the constituent polymers in a synergetic way. The properties of these materials


largely depend on the particle morphology.
Figure 6.7 illustrates the processes occurring during formation of the particle
morphology during seeded semicontinuous emulsion polymerization. The reactor
is initially charged with previously formed latex (seed). Then, the new monomer is
fed into the reactor and the conditions are adjusted so that polymerization occurs
inside the existing polymer particles. The position at which each polymer chain is
formed depends on the radical concentration prole inside the polymer particles. If
the entering radicals are anchored to the surface of the polymer particle, the new
polymer chains will be mainly located in the outer layer of the particle. As the concentration of the newly formed polymer chains increases, phase separation occurs,
leading to the formation of clusters. Polymerization occurs in the clusters as well
as in the polymer matrix, and therefore both the size and the number of clusters
increase. The resulting system is not thermodynamically stable because of the high
surface energy associated with the large polymerpolymer interfacial area. In order
to minimize the free energy, the clusters migrate toward the equilibrium morphology. During this migration, the size of the clusters may vary because of (1) polymerization in the cluster, (2) diusion of polymer into or from the cluster, and (3)
coagulation with other clusters. The motion of the clusters is ruled by the balance
between the van der Waals attraction/repulsion forces and the resistance to ow
that arises from the viscous drag. The van der Waals forces between clusters are
always attractive. On the other hand, the van der Waals forces between clusters
and the aqueous phase may be either attractive, bringing the clusters toward the
surface of the particle, and repulsive, bringing the clusters toward the center of
the polymer particle. It is worth mentioning that the van der Waals forces are pro-

6.7 Living Polymerization in Emulsion

portional to the interfacial tensions. The nal morphology heavily depends on the
kinetics of cluster migration [4749]. Metastable morphologies can be achieved by
working under starved conditions (high internal viscosity of the particles) and promoting grafting reactions (low interfacial tensions). Equilibrium morphologies
may be attained if the internal viscosity of the particle is low, and if the polymers
are very incompatible (high interfacial tensions resulting in high van der Waals
forces). The equilibrium morphology is the one that minimizes the interfacial energy of the system; it depends on the polymerpolymer and polymerwater interfacial tensions [47].

6.7

Living Polymerization in Emulsion

Free-radical polymerization (FRP) is a widespread technique for preparing longchain polymers (see Chapter 4). Its success is mainly due to the broad range of
monomers that can be readily polymerized by this technique, to its tolerance toward functional monomers, and to the mild reaction conditions required to run
the polymerization. Moreover, as discussed in the preceding sections in this chapter, emulsion polymerization (and in general every polymerization reaction carried
out using water as the continuous medium) has alleviated all the residual inconveniences of FRP. In fact, the corresponding processes do not involve a large demand for organic solvents, they easily achieve large monomer conversions, and
they exhibit reduced problems of heat removal, thus making the process intrinsically safer.
On the other hand, careful control of the polymer microstructure (in the broad
sense dened in Section 6.1) is still an issue. With reference to the macromolecule
structure (that is, average molecular weight, polydispersity, composition, monomer
sequences, chain architecture, degree of crosslinking, and chain-end functionalization), a novel process has recently been proposed with much greater potential in
terms of control capacity: living radical polymerization (LRP). By this specic
process it becomes possible to obtain block copolymers by FRP, lling the gap between the free-radical polymerization technique and other polymerization techniques such as living anionic or cationic polymerization.
6.7.1

Chemistry of LRP

In conventional FRP, termination mainly by bimolecular combination limits the


chain lifetime to a small fraction of the entire process time. Therefore, changes in
the operating conditions (such as monomer concentration and composition, viscosity, temperature, and so on) aect the structure of the polymer chains produced at
dierent stages of the process, thus increasing the product heterogeneity. In a living polymerization, instead, these changes are equally distributed among all the
polymer chains, which grow uniformly during the whole reaction. Moreover, as

275

276

6 Emulsion Polymerization

the living chains are still able to restart propagating when the monomer is completely depleted, living polymerization represents a route to the production of block
copolymers by successive additions of monomers, an approach clearly not possible
in FRP.
So far, the only living processes industrially available are anionic and cationic
polymerization [50, 51], which generally suer little or no termination. In these
processes, the initiation step is very fast compared to the process time and, hence,
all the chains start growing almost simultaneously. The degree of polymerization,
DP, increases linearly with monomer conversion and is inversely proportional to
the initiator concentration. At the same time, Poisson-like distributions of the polymer chain length are obtained with nal polydispersity values close to the ideal
value of (1 1/DP). Finally, the polymer retains the ionic end groups till the end
of the polymerization and the reaction is simply restarted by further addition of
monomer. However, this kind of polymerization is often impractical from the industrial viewpoint, since the main requirements are high purity of all the reactants,
very low temperatures, and the use of solvents. Moreover, it does not work with
several widely used monomers, such as styrene.
On the other hand, as previously pointed out, FRP does not suer the same limitations. It can be applied to a broad range of monomers, nearly all vinyl and vinylidene monomers, it is easily operated in the presence of impurities, such as residual inhibitor residues and traces of oxygen, and over a wide temperature range [52,
53]. Therefore, it is quite natural to attempt to establish living conditions in such a
process. However, it is not practical to approach such conditions by simply reducing the radical concentration so as to minimize the rate of bimolecular termination
(a second-order reaction with respect to radical concentration, the propagation being a rst order reaction). Besides the drawback of the corresponding reduction of
the polymerization rate, this would lead to the production of polymer chains with
extremely high molecular weight, since the instantaneous DP is given by the ratio
between the frequencies of propagation and termination (compare Chapter 4). Using LRP, this control is instead restored by introducing an additional but reversible
termination reaction with a capping species, generically indicated as X. In this
case, each chain experiences a sequence of activationdeactivation steps and the instantaneous DP grown during the generic active step is given by the ratio between
the rates of propagation and reversible termination (k p M=kt X, where kt indicates the rate constant of the reversible termination). If the rate of this new termination is so large as to be dominant with respect to that of the irreversible termination reactions and comparable with that of propagation, polymer growth will be
distributed all over the process.
Living polymerization is typically started by introducing into the system an initiator providing the capping species, indicated as RX. This initiator reactivates itself many times and adds some monomer units before going back to the so-called
dormant state in the form RMn X, where Mn indicates a polymer chain made
of n monomer units. In other words, the living process can be regarded as the insertion of a well-dened number of monomer units between the groups R and X,
which are always acting as polymer chain ends and, thus, dened a priori. The av-

6.7 Living Polymerization in Emulsion

erage DP of the polymer is given by the ratio between the converted monomer,
M0 XT (where XT is the monomer conversion and M0 the initial amount of monomer), and the total number of polymer chains. Note that some irreversibly terminated chains are produced anyhow, since these reactions are always taking place in
competition with the activation/deactivation reactions. If the fraction of terminated
chains remains negligible compared to the initial amount of initiator, RX, this last
value corresponds also to the concentration of the dormant chains in the system
and the DP grows linearly with conversion (DP M0 XT =RX). Moreover, if the
number of active periods each chain experiences is large enough (that is, if the
number of monomer units added per active period is small enough), the polymer
growth is distributed throughout the duration of the process and all the chains
grow uniformly, leading to low polydispersity of the chain length distributions.
Dierent living mechanisms are available and the main ones are briey enumerated in the following sections.
Nitroxide-mediated Polymerization (NMP)
The ability of stable nitroxide radicals to react with carbon-centered radicals and
to act as radical inhibitors was already known at the beginning of the 1980s [54],
when Solomon and co-workers showed that the reversible reaction of nitroxides
with growing polymer chains can be used to produce low-DP polymers [55]. But
it is only in the 1990s with the work of Georges and co-workers [56, 57] that this
novel polymerization technique, and in general LRP, received the attention they
deserved.
This living mechanism [Eq. (a)] consists of the reversible combination of the
growing radical chains, R n , and the so-called persistent radical species, X (the nitroxide radical group), to form dormant polymer chains, R n X:
6.7.1.1

kde

Rn X S RnX
kac

Today, many dierent routes are known which use dierent persistent radicals
[5458]. Among these, TEMPO is by far the most widely used, even though it suffers very limited applicability to monomers unlike styrene, and requires high operating temperatures (about 120140 C). More recent studies were aimed to reduce
the operating temperature and to broaden the monomer applicability so as to enlarge the spectrum of block copolymers accessible by this technique [58]. Despite
these eorts, the range of application remains quite limited.
Atom-transfer Radical Polymerization (ATRP)
Atom-transfer radical polymerization (ATRP) was rst reported by Kato et al. [59]
and by Wang et al. in 1995 [60, 61]. This mechanism is based on the so-called
atom-transfer radical addition reaction, and it is catalyzed by a metal: the homolytic
cleavage of the bond in an organic halide occurs through transfer of the halogen to
the metal complex, accompanied by oxidation of the metal atom. The catalytic cycle
is closed by back-transfer from the transition metal to the nal adduct of the halogen. It is clear that, if the radical produced can undergo a few propagation steps
6.7.1.2

277

278

6 Emulsion Polymerization

before participating in the back-transfer, and if this product is still able to undergo
another transfer cycle, this reaction can be used to produce the same exchange between active and dormant states as is found in NMP. The resulting reversible reaction is represented by Eq. (b), where X indicates the halogen atom, Men the metal
with the corresponding oxidation state and Li the ligand.
kde

R n X Men1 =Li S R n X Men =Li


kac

ATRP owes most of its success to its high compatibility with many dierent monomers, such as styrene, acrylates, methacrylates, (meth)acrylamides, and acrylonitrile, which made this technique readily available for the production of several
new block copolymers [62]. Even though the majority of the work has been done
with copper as the transition metal, styrene ATRP has been carried out using Fe-,
Ru-, Ni-, Pd-, and Co-based systems [62]. Note that ATRP does not require the high
reaction temperature typical of NMP and this is also part of the success of this
polymerization technique. Dierent ligands have been used to solubilize the copper atom and it has been noticed that they not only prepare the copper for the reaction, but can also modify the reactivity of the metal toward both the activation
and deactivation reactions. Actually, the presence in the system of a metal, the
need for complex ligands to solubilize it, and the deep color typically imparted by
this complex to the nal polymer (if not removed) represent the major drawbacks
of this process. Thus far, chlorine and bromine have been used successfully as the
halogen atoms, whereas iodine gives rise to side reactions [63].
Degenerative Transfer (DT)
As mentioned above, in both NMP and ATRP the exchange between the active and
the dormant state is based on a reversible (although dierent) termination mechanism. Therefore, the exchange directly aects the radical concentration. In LRP by
DT, instead, this exchange is carried out by direct transfer of the o-end group between an active and a dormant chain. When an iodine atom is used as end group,
the reaction can be summarized by Eq. (c), where R n I indicates the generic dormant species with iodine.
6.7.1.3

kex

Rn Rm I ! Rm RnI

Therefore, the main dierence from the previous two systems is that this living
mechanism does not form new radicals and a conventional initiator is needed to
start and sustain the reaction. The initial amount of this species has to be properly selected. As a matter of fact, since the living reaction of Eq. (c) is not aecting
the radical concentration, the nal concentration of the chains terminated by bimolecular combination will be half of the initial concentration of initiator. Therefore,
the initial concentration of the species carrying the iodine group (in the following
simply called the transfer agent) determines the nal DP of the polymer, provided that the initiator concentration is small compared to that of the transfer
agent.

6.7 Living Polymerization in Emulsion

Only a few papers have appeared in the literature dealing with LRP by DT [64
66], and the applications are almost completely limited to the homopolymerization
of styrene. In this case, it was possible to obtain good control of the nal CLD, with
polydispersity values as low as 1.31.4. Better performances are dicult to obtain
with styrene, mainly because of the limited transfer activity of the iodine atoms.
This is the main reason for the very poor results obtained when applying this process to the polymerization of acrylates (for example, n-butyl acrylate), and for the
complete lack of control reported for other monomers [6466].
Reversible AdditionFragmentation Transfer (RAFT) Polymerization
The RAFT process can be regarded as a special case of degenerative transfer. As
shown in Eq. (d), the reaction proceeds through the direct interaction of an active
and a dormant chain with the formation of a reaction intermediate involving both
chains [67, 68]. At this stage, the reaction can either go back, forming the initial
radical again, or proceed forward with the transfer of the Y CZY moiety
from the dormant to the active chain, which is now identied as the transfer
species.
6.7.1.4

kadd

kfrag

 R m YC . ZYR n ! R m R n YCZY
R n R m YCZY !

kfrag

Note that the best results have been reported when using a sulfur atom as the Y
group [6770]. The process is started by introducing into the system a so-called
RAFT agent, the structure of which can be described as RY CZ Y. The correct choice of the R group, or leaving group, is of paramount importance, not only
because this is going to be one polymer chain end (the other end being occupied
by the RAFT group), but mainly because it inuences the initial reactivity of the
RAFT agent. From Eq. (d), it is in fact clear that in the rst addition reaction an
intermediate species is formed, having the R group on one side and the polymer
radical on the other. The fate of such a species that is, the probability that the
following fragmentation reaction proceeds backward or forward depends mainly
upon thermodynamic considerations, namely upon which, the polymer radical or
the leaving-group radical, is the more stable. In other words, if the leaving group
generates a radical that is too unstable compared to the polymer radical, the
RAFT is always going to proceed backward, and thus no control is actually
achieved. Similar considerations apply in block polymerization of two monomers,
where the rst block can be regarded as a special case of the R group. Accordingly,
care must be given to the correct choice of which monomer has to be polymerized
rst.
Even though the most satisfactory results have been obtained by RAFT polymerization of styrene (Figure 6.8 shows an example of the application of RAFT to bulk
styrene polymerization, indicating the good control of polymer growth), the process is also very eective for many other monomers, such as acrylates and methacrylates [6770]. Moreover, the operating temperatures used to carry out this polymerization are usually close to those typical of conventional radical polymerization

279

280

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Example of application of RAFT to bulk


polymerization of styrene. Left: degree of polymerization (DP)
and polydispersity versus conversion; right: evolution of
molecular weight distribution as measured by GPC [71].

Fig. 6.8.

[6770]. The low temperature, along with the wide range of compatible monomers, makes this mechanism one of the most promising techniques to be applied
on an industrial scale for the production of new materials, in competition with
ATRP. Once more, a signicant drawback is the need to remove the sulfur atoms,
which confer to the nal polymer a deep color ranging from yellow to red, from the
product.
6.7.2

Polymerization of LRP in Homogeneous Systems

As already pointed out, the nal aim of LRP is to strictly control the architecture of
the polymer chain by minimizing the fraction of dead chains in the system while
maintaining uniform growth of the whole population of chains. The homogeneity
of chain lengths is the key factor in homopolymerization and it is usually expressed in terms of polydispersity ratio, Pd (dened as the ratio between weight
and number-average molecular weight; Pd 1 when all chains are of the same
length). The fraction of dead chains becomes even more important when the process is intended to produce block copolymers, in which case terminated homopolymer chains represent a signicant drawback with respect to the product quality. To minimize terminations, dierent strategies are eective for the dierent
living mechanisms, as briey reviewed below.
For clarity, let us start by discussing the application of NMP to a bulk system. As
previously pointed out, a successful LRP requires the termination reaction between
the growing radical chain and the nitroxide (referred to simply as the deactivation
reaction hereafter) to be dominant with respect to bimolecular irreversible termination. It has been exhaustively demonstrated that, in spite of the fact that these bimolecular reactions, deactivation and termination, are both very fast and controlled

6.7 Living Polymerization in Emulsion

by diusion, deactivation soon becomes the favored reaction path anyway. This is
often referred to as the persistent radical eect [72, 73]. To explain this behavior,
let us rst point out that, because of the nature of NMP, where new radical chains
can be created from dormant ones by activation, this mechanism does not require
a radical initiator. Accordingly, when the reaction starts, dormant chains start to
activate, building up a radical concentration. At the same time, the two bimolecular
termination reactions, termination and deactivation, start to operate. But, while deactivation simply produces a dormant chain again, termination subtracts polymer
chains from the activation/deactivation equilibrium and, according to simple stoichiometric arguments, trapping radicals (nitroxides) are accumulated. The ultimate eect of this accumulation of trapping radicals is that deactivation becomes
faster and faster, thus shortening the active lifetime of the active radicals and their
concentration, but also decreasing the nal amount of irreversibly terminated
chains. Fischer et al. derived Eq. (53) to evaluate the concentration of radicals for
an NMP [72], where RX0 is the initial concentration of dormant chains.

R

kac RX0
3kde kt t

1=3
53

This equation conrms that the radical concentration steadily decreases in time.
Albeit the living action in ATRP takes place by a dierent reaction mechanism,
the same arguments presented above for NMP can be used. It can be easily veried
that the concentration of the metal in the reduced form, Men [compare the corresponding reaction scheme, Eq. (b)], remains roughly constant during the whole
process, and therefore the activation process can be approximated as a monomolecular process as in NMP.
On the other hand, degenerative transfer and RAFT are characterized by completely dierent kinetics when the polymerization is performed in a homogeneous
system. Given the nature of the living mechanism of these two systems, based on a
transfer reaction, radical concentration is not aected by the living system. Thus,
the persistent radical eect is totally absent and the kinetics of DT and RAFT is
identical to that of a conventional nonliving system. Accordingly, an initiator is
necessary to sustain the reaction and the concentration of radical chains is set by
the equilibrium between initiation and bimolecular termination; that is, the well
known formula in Eq. (54), where Ri represents the rate of radical generation,
holds in this case also.
R Ri =kt 1=2

54

No matter which is the living mechanism under consideration, it is fundamental


to keep the radical concentration as low as possible to ensure a nal fraction of
dead chains which is negligible with respect to the dormant polymer. In a bulk or
solution polymerization, the nal concentration of dead chains is a function of the
radical concentration only: high polymerization rates correspond to high dead

281

282

6 Emulsion Polymerization

chain concentrations. It can be shown [72] that the time needed to obtain 90% conversion after proper tuning of the process parameters so as to obtain a dened fraction of dead chains, f, is given by Eq. (55), where the factor C is dierent for the
dierent living mechanisms (NMP/ATRP: C 4=3; RAFT/DT: C 1).
t 90; f C

kt ln 10 2
fkp2 RX0

55

Using typical parameter values for styrene homopolymerization at 80 C, reaction


times of the order of magnitude of 100 h are needed to have f 0:05. Even if it
can be shown that low polydispersity values can be achieved also at higher f values
(> 0.20.3) [72, 73], these values cannot be accepted in copolymerization. While
increased reaction temperatures and thus propagation rates generally should promote smaller dead chain contents [compare Eq (55)], in the case of styrenic copolymers this leads to limited improvements only, since undesired side reactions negatively aecting the polymer quality (such as chain transfer and thermal initiation)
become more and more important.
6.7.3

Kinetics of LRP in Heterogeneous Systems

A possible way out of this problem comes from the application of LRP to segregated systems, namely emulsion polymerization. Let us focus on a system characterized by the presence of very small polymer particles and a water-soluble initiator.
When a radical is formed and, after a few propagation steps, absorbs or enters a
particle without radicals, this same radical goes on propagating until the particle
experiences a second entry. At this point, given the very small size of the particle
and the diusion-limited nature of the termination reaction, the two radicals react
with each other almost instantaneously to produce a dead chain. Thus, the particle
goes back to a state without radicals until another entry takes place. This particular
kinetic condition is often referred to as a zeroone system (compare Section 6.5)
and, under the assumption of negligible radical desorption, the corresponding average number of active chains per particle is equal to 0.5 (SmithEwart Case 2).
Kinetic behavior similar to that of a zeroone system is readily established with
DT and RAFT as living mechanisms [74]. Since a transfer reaction is taking place
in both cases, the same kinetics as in a nonliving process is again operative. Therefore, the fraction of dead chains in the system can be adjusted by tuning the frequency of entry properly, while the transfer reaction rate independently controls
the homogeneity of polymer growth. It is again important to notice that in emulsion polymerization the rate of formation of dead chains by irreversible termination is regulated by the frequency of entry only, while the polymerization rate is
not aected. Accordingly, in principle it is possible to maintain the same high
polymerization rates typical of emulsion systems, while keeping under control the
ratio between dormant and dead chains, and thus the nal quality of the polymer.

6.7 Living Polymerization in Emulsion

Fig. 6.9. Expected kinetics for LRP in emulsion: (a) RAFT/DT;


(b) NMP/ATRP. i number of radicals per particle;
r; fc ; fac ; fde frequencies of radical entry, bimolecular
termination, activation, and deactivation, respectively.

The corresponding time evolution of the number of active chains per particle, i, is
therefore as sketched in Figure 6.9(a). Note that the living reactions are not involved at all. Accordingly, the average number of active chains per particle remains
close to 0.5.
Comparable propagation rates are not found when using NMP or ATRP [74, 75].
Referring once more to NMP for simplicity, it is not possible to have one radical
per particle for a signicant time period, since each activation event will produce
a transient and a persistent radical: keeping in mind the extremely small size of a
typical polymer particle produced in emulsion, the radicals recombine almost immediately. In other words, the principle behind radical segregation cannot hold
when NMP is active, since two radicals are generated each time an activation reaction occurs in the particle. Note that the average time particles spend with zero and
one radical is 1=fa and 1=fd , respectively, the frequencies of activation and deactivation being fa kac RXp and fd kde Xp . This reduction of the polymerization rate
cannot be counteracted by increasing the rate of the activation reaction: when fa
approaches fd , a second activation is more likely to take place instead of a deactivation, the probability of this event being equal to fa = fa fd . Accordingly, the two
transient radicals may terminate with each other and accumulate two persistent
radicals in the particle, thus increasing the frequency of deactivation. In other
words, each particle accumulates persistent radicals till the rate of the second activation becomes small enough (that is, when fa f fd ), and the average number of
radicals per particle has a value much smaller than 0.5, that typical of DT and
RAFT in emulsion. Note that, when fa f fd , this average number of radicals can
be readily estimated as fa =fd . Actually, it has been shown that the process kinetics
approaches that of the corresponding bulk process, thus canceling the advantages
of operating in emulsion from a kinetic point of view [75]. The corresponding
sketch of the time evolution of the number of active chains per particle is shown
in Figure 6.9(b). An average value of active chains per particle, much smaller than
0.5, is readily veried.

283

284

6 Emulsion Polymerization

6.7.4

Application of LRP in Heterogeneous Systems


Ab-initio Emulsion Polymerization
Besides the kinetic considerations illustrated in Section 6.7.3, performing a LRP by
ab-initio emulsion polymerization is still the objective of major research eorts by
many groups, mainly because this process is generally simpler and more commercially established, albeit less versatile, than other emulsion processes. Nonetheless,
this process turns out to be much more complicated than others (for example,
miniemulsion) when applied to LRP, since the multiphase environment greatly
complicates the global kinetics of the process. The need to have the RX species,
which is generally very hydrophobic, inside the polymeric reaction locus demands
fast material transport of this species out of the monomer droplets, where it is initially stored, across the water phase to the polymer particles, where the reaction
actually takes place. This transport must satisfy two fundamental requirements
[74]: (1) RX must be readily available in the particles so that all the chains can start
growing from the beginning of the process, and (2) RX must be uniformly distributed among all the particles.
Despite the initial rather unsuccessful eorts to conduct an NMP in emulsion,
mainly due to stability problems, this process proved to give good results [76].
Great care must be put into the choice of the nitroxide: the use of nitroxides that
are too hydrophobic leads to uncontrolled reactions, while nitroxides that are too
hydrophilic lead to long induction periods, mainly due to the signicant duration
of LRP in water [77]. It has also been observed that polymerization in the monomer droplets plays a fundamental role. Although this always happens to a small
extent also in non-LRP, the impact of this process is very limited, due to the large
dierence in radical concentrations (and therefore reaction rates) between monomer droplets and polymer particles. On the contrary, in systems like NMP and
ATRP, segregation is not eective at enhancing the radical concentration in the
polymer particles, and thus polymerization in monomer droplets proceeds as in
particles [78].
Unfortunately ATRP, which is more versatile than NMP, can with diculty be
applied to ab-initio emulsion polymerization, mainly because its chemistry, which
involves one more species (the metalligand complex), becomes even more complicated [79]. Earlier attempts failed just because anionic surfactants reacted with
the metal [80]. However, switching to nonionic ones did not bring substantial
improvements. Micron-sized particles were often observed, with the exception of
n-butyl methacrylate (BMA), where submicron particles were obtained, although
rather susceptible to coagulation [81].
As shown earlier, the RAFT mechanism is better suited to emulsion polymerization, where it is possible to exploit the segregation typical of these systems. However, even in this case, its application to ab-initio emulsion polymerization did not
enjoy much success. The reasons for such behavior are always the same: (1) poor
transport of very hydrophobic species from monomer droplets to particles, and (2)
the possible occurrence of some polymerization in the monomer droplets that
6.7.4.1

6.7 Living Polymerization in Emulsion

makes these species even more insoluble [82]. A notable exception is again the
polymerization of BMA [83]. As for NMLP, more water-soluble RAFT agents failed
to solve the problem, since they mainly move the polymerization into the water
phase. A simple solution to this problem could come from the use of surface-active
RAFT agents. These are suciently water-soluble to diuse fast across water, but
their surface activity is high enough to keep them away from the aqueous-phase
chemistry. The best example of such a species is represented by xanthates [84],
even though they suer from low activity in controlling the polymer growth. The
poor results in terms of polydispersity are even worse because these RAFT agents
remain anchored to the surface, although this can turn out to be an eective way to
produce coreshell particles.
Miniemulsion Polymerization
Among dierent alternatives, a very eective way to operate an LRP in segregated
systems is indeed miniemulsion. In this case, small monomer droplets are the primary locus of reaction and all the diculties from interphase transfer vanish, since
monomer and all the other hydrophobic species required to run an LRP are already
in the main reaction locus. However, further diculties have been reported, such
as incomplete droplet nucleation and colloidal stability problems [74, 82, 85]. More
subtle is the evidence of instabilities in the miniemulsion due to the kinetics of
LRP. In contrast to conventional systems, where long chains are created from the
beginning, in LRP all the polymer chains are short initially. This might lead to
superswelling states of the droplets and, eventually, to destabilization [86].
Despite these diculties, literature abounds with examples of styrene miniemulsion polymerizations by NMP; all show good control of the MWD and the aforementioned problem of slow polymerization rates [76]. Due to the improvements
in nitroxide eciency, studies involving polymerization of acrylates have also appeared [87]. However, a fast buildup of nitroxides is often observed in this case,
which depresses the polymerization rate. A possible solution is represented by the
removal of the excess of nitroxides, which has also given good results in styrene
polymerization [87].
ATRP is also very eective when applied to miniemulsion systems. Still, care is
needed in the choice of surfactant (nonionic) and ligand (not too water-soluble).
Also, it proved eective to run a so-called reverse ATRP, that is, starting from
the metal in the oxidized form, since the original metal complex (such as Cu(I))
is rather sensitive to oxidation during miniemulsion formation by sonication
[88].
Finally, RAFT also has been successfully applied to miniemulsion polymerization with several monomers [82]. Figure 6.10 shows a typical result of a block copolymerization of MMA and styrene, which proved to give good control of polymer
growth together with high polymerization rates. Still, some problems remain unsolved. Among them is the evidence of long induction times, generally attributed
to high desorption rates as a consequence of the initial exchange reaction to very
short species. This has been shown to be easily solved by using oligomeric RAFT
agents [74].
6.7.4.2

285

286

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.10. Example of application of RAFT to miniemulsion


polymerization for the formation of poly(methyl methacrylate)b-polystyrene [74]. Left: conversion prole; right: evolution of
molecular weight distribution as measured by GPC.

6.8

Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

Emulsion polymers are products-by-process whose microstructure and properties are determined during the polymerization. Therefore, the reactor type, the operation mode, and the control strategy play a key role in achieving an ecient, safe,
and consistent production of high-quality emulsion polymers.
6.8.1

Reactor Types and Processes

In principle, both stirred-tank reactors and tubular reactors, and combinations


thereof, may be employed.
Stirred-tank Reactors
The stirred-tank reactor is the reactor most commonly used in emulsion polymerization. This reactor may operate in batch, semibatch, or continuous mode.
A batch reactor is a closed system in which time is the only independent variable. The batch operation can be used for small-scale production of homopolymers
from monomers with a relatively low heat of polymerization. However, the drawbacks associated with this type of operation limit its industrial use. These drawbacks are:
6.8.1.1

Control of the polymer properties is impracticable.


Productivity is low, considering the load, unload, and cleaning times.
 Because all of the monomer is initially charged into the reactor, the heat generation rate is high and the control of the reactor temperature is very dicult.
 Batch-to-batch variations due to irreproducible particle nucleation may jeopardize
product consistency. The use of seeded polymerization mitigates the problem.


6.8 Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

In semibatch operation, some fraction of the reactants (the initial charge) is


charged into the reactor initially, and the rest of the formulation is fed in continuously over a period of time. Most commercial emulsion products are manufactured in semibatch reactors. The main characteristic of this process is its
great exibility. By varying the composition and amount of the initial charge,
as well as the composition and ow rates of the feeds, both temperature and polymer quality can be controlled. A wide range of products are accessible using this
technique, which allows any polymer property to be tailored, including copolymer
composition, molecular weight distribution, polymer architecture, particle morphology, and particle size distribution. In addition, a large portfolio of products
can be produced with a single reactor. The main drawback of this operation mode
is the relatively low productivity, which is being compensated by using larger
reactors.
In continuous operation mode, both feed and euent streams ow continuously. The main characteristic of a continuous stirred tank reactor (CSTR) is the
broad residence time distribution (RTD), which is characterized by a decreasing exponential function. The same behavior describes the age of the particles in the reactor and hence the particle size distribution (PSD) at the exit. Therefore, it is not
possible to obtain narrow monodisperse latexes using a single CSTR. In addition,
CSTRs are liable to suer intermittent nucleations [89, 90] that lead to multimodal
PSDs. This may be alleviated by using a tubular reactor before the CSTR, in which
polymer particles are formed in a smooth way [91]. On the other hand, the copolymer composition is quite constant, even though it is dierent from that of the feed.
The broad RTD together with the problem of heat removal in large stirred tanks
make it dicult to achieve high conversions in a single tank. An arrangement of
multiple stirred tanks in series allows better heat removal and presents a narrower
residence time distribution, which in turn leads to a narrower PSD. Moreover,
copolymer composition and molecular weight can be controlled by intermediate
feeds of monomer or chain-transfer agents. CSTRs in series are used for hightonnage productions such as styrenebutadiene rubber (SBR), but are not well
adapted to the production of specialties because of the diculties associated
with grade transitions.
Tubular Reactors
From a safety point of view, tubular reactors are advantageous because they have a
large area/volume ratio and hence the heat removal capacity is higher than that of
the CSTR.
A continuous plug-ow reactor is somewhat similar to a batch stirred-tank reactor, where reaction time is equivalent to the space time (t) in the tube. For this reactor type, grade transition between dierent polymer grades is instantaneous, but
the control of polymer properties is almost impracticable. An important disadvantage of the tubular reactor is the inadequate mixing that can lead to phase separation, reactor plugging, and wall fouling [92]. Several modications have been performed to improve radial mixing and minimize the associated problems, but to
date tubular reactors have not been widely utilized for industrial production. The
6.8.1.2

287

288

6 Emulsion Polymerization

most important modied tubular reactors include loop reactors, pulsed-ow reactors, wicker-tube reactors, and CouetteTaylor ow reactors.
The continuous-loop reactor is probably the only tubular reactor used in commercial production of emulsion polymers [93, 94] and its use is limited to production of vinyl acetate homopolymers and copolymers (with ethylene and Veova 10)
[9597]. A continuous-loop reactor consists of a tubular loop that connects the inlet
and the outlet of a recycle pump. The macromixing of such reactors is between
that of plug-ow and well-mixed reactors. Commonly, the loop recirculation rate
is signicantly greater than the feed rate. Under these circumstances, the residence time distribution is very close to that of a CSTR [98]. Its high heat-transfer
area/reactor volume ratio allows ecient heat removal and hence high conversions
in short residence times can be achieved. This results in a substantial reduction in
the reactor volume. The main disadvantage of this reactor is that highly mechanically stable formulations are required to prevent shear-induced coagulation at high
recycling rates.
Pulsed-ow reactors consist basically of a column in which a periodic external
pulsation is provided. The goal of the pulsed ow regime is to achieve highly eective mixing, minimizing phase segregation, wall fouling, and tube plugging [99,
100]. The introduction of sieved plates, Raschig rings, or baes is reported to improve mixing [101, 102]. However, these internal elements may be sources of coagulation, and cleaning coagulum from these reactors will be very dicult.
The wicker-tube reactor consists of a coiled tube which meanders between solid,
xed, cylindrical supports. The heat removal capacity is high and it is claimed that
the multiple changes in ow direction allow the production of a polymer dispersion with a very low coagulum content [103, 104].
The CouetteTaylor reactor consists of two concentric cylinders of which the
outer one is xed and jacketed, while the inner one rotates as a stirrer. In this
way, the reaction takes place in the annulus formed between the two cylinders.
For a specic conguration, if the inner cylinder exceeds a certain speed the uid
inside the gap develops counter-rotating toroidal vortices. The boundaries of the
vortices represent a barrier for axial mixing, while radial mixing inside each vortex
is good. Consequently the CouetteTaylor reactor may be modeled as a hydrodynamically formed train of continuous stirred tank reactors. Good radial mixing,
which reduces phase segregation and plugging, and high heat removal capacity are
the main characteristics of these reactors [105108].
6.8.2

Reactor Equipment

Despite the availability of dierent reactors, commercial emulsion polymerization


is mostly carried out in stirred-tank reactors or in reactors that have a similar
macromixing behavior, such as the loop reactor. The mixing problems associated
with tubular reactors, together with a lack of exibility in controlling product properties, lowers the attractiveness of tubular reactors for commercial production.
Therefore the discussion will be limited to stirred-tank reactors.

6.8 Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

The stirred-tank reactors used for the production of emulsion polymers have
sizes ranging from 5 to 50 m 3 . Stainless steel vessels with a height/diameter ratio
between 1.1 and 1.3:1 are usually employed. These reactors must be equipped for
mixing and heat transfer.
Mixing
For agitator selection it is critical to dene correctly the mixing requirements. In
practice, the most common cause of agitator failure is not miscalculation of the
power or rotational speed, but incorrect denition of the agitator main task. In
emulsion polymerization, the mixing equipment must ensure that the tasks of
emulsication and blending are performed well, and it must facilitate mass and
heat transfer without causing coagulation [109].
The power consumption of an impeller is the product of the pumping capacity
(circulation ow rate) and the velocity head, which is directly related to shear rate
and turbulence. Depending on the type and size of the impeller, either the ow or
the turbulence can be favored [110]. Axial ow impellers usually produce a uid
motion that is downward at the central axis of the vessel and upward in the wall
region. They are designed to produce a high ow/power ratio with little turbulent
loss. The designs of axial-ow impellers are derived from three-blade propellers.
Radial-ow turbines produce a radial uid motion from the impeller to the wall,
where the radial ow separates into an upper and a lower circulation loop. They
are characterized by a relatively low ow/power ratio, with much of the energy dissipated by turbulence around the impeller. Radial-ow turbines have at blades or
a disk with at blades.
In emulsion polymerization, a high shear rate may cause coagulation. However,
a certain amount of turbulence is required for emulsication and to avoid phase
segregation. Moreover, high uid circulation is needed in order to guarantee
the macroscopic uniformity and to enhance mass and heat transfer. In this way,
mixed-ow turbines with features of both radial and axial ow can be useful. The
most common of these impellers is the 45 angled blade turbine. Multiple impellers on the same shaft can also be employed.
In any case, the agitation requirements in emulsion polymerization are often related to the operation mode. In batch operations, vigorous agitation is required in
the initial stages to avoid monomer segregation and promote good phase dispersion. Later on, a lower agitation intensity is needed to avoid shear-induced coagulation. In semicontinuous operations, multiple impellers are normally used to ensure agitation as the level goes up. In addition, it is very important for mixing of
the entering reactants to be instantaneous: this requires a high circulation ow
rate. If neat monomer is fed in, a certain amount of turbulence is required to facilitate dispersion. This requirement may be avoided by feeding a pre-emulsion. The
location of the addition point of the reactants is important, to avoid monomer
pools and other problems derived from the accumulation of initiators, which increases ionic strength and thus promotes coagulation, and the accumulation of
emulsiers, which leads to local nucleations and/or occulations. Continuous operation requires mixing characteristics similar to those of the semibatch process.
6.8.2.1

289

290

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Empirical correlations for the key aspects of mixing, such as power consumption, emulsication, liquid circulation, and mixing time, can be found elsewhere
[111]. The advances in computational uid dynamics (CFD) combined with new
techniques of measuring the local ow pattern are likely to transform the whole
eld.
Heat Transfer
Polymerization reactions are highly exothermic and the heat generated must be
removed in order to control reactor temperature. In commercial emulsion polymerization, the heat removal rate from the reactor is often the factor limiting productivity. Both safety and product quality depend on the heat removal capacity of
the reactor. For industrial reactors, it is often not sucient to operate with a simple
cooling jacket and other devices must be incorporated in the design [112]:
6.8.2.2

improved jacket design to increase turbulence, and hence the heat-transfer coecient (dimpled, half-pipe);
 cooled baes (the use of internal coils is not an option because they tend to increase fouling and coagulation);
 external loop heat exchangers for the reaction medium in this case, a mechanically stable formulation is required; external heat exchangers can be used also to
cool the feedstreams in continuous and semicontinuous operations;
 reux condensers.
Increasing the agitation speed to increase the internal heat-transfer coecient is
not an option because a high impeller speed can lead to coagulum formation.
In any case, heat-transfer requirements are largely determined by the operation
mode. Batch is the most critical operation because high polymerization rates are
achieved due to the high monomer concentration. In semibatch mode, the heat
generated can be easily controlled by the monomer feed rate. In these reactors, extra cooling is provided by the cold feed. In continuous mode, the continuous cold
feed facilitates the control of the reactor temperature, particularly when the reactor
temperature is high.

6.9

Reaction Engineering

Independently of the operation mode (batch, semibatch, or continuous), in wellmixed stirred-tank reactors the properties do not vary signicantly with the position in the reactor, and time is the only independent variable. Therefore, the necessary balances for the reactor design may be made at macroscopic level that is, for
the reactor as a whole.

6.9 Reaction Engineering

6.9.1

Mass Balances

Considering inlet and outlet streams in the reactor, the mass balance [Eq. (56)] for
any species i results,
dNi
Fie  Fis Ri V
dt

56

where Ni [mol] is the total amount of compound i in the reactor; Fie [mol s1 ] the
inlet molar ow rate of component i; Fis [mol s1 ] the outlet molar ow rate of i,
(Ri ) [mol s1 m3 ] the net generation rate of i in the reactor, and V [m 3 ] the reactor
volume.
Equation (56) applies for the particular combination of monomers, initiator,
water, and emulsier, and for amounts of each polymerized monomer. Equation
(56) also applies to the number of polymer particles and of precursor particles
and the moments of the molecular weight distribution, although in those cases
units other than moles should be used. The specic forms of the net generation
rates are discussed below. Usually, the polymerization rate of monomer j is expressed as the rate of monomer consumption (Rpj ), and hence RMj Rpj .
For batch processes, Fie Fis 0, and for semicontinuous operation Fis 0. For
the continuous operation Fis can be calculated from Eq. (57), where V is constant
in a continuous operation and Q s is the volumetric outlet ow rate.
Fis Q s

Ni
V

57

In emulsion polymerization, the density of the reaction medium does not change
signicantly. Therefore, the volumetric inlet and outlet ow rates can be considered to be the same. The advance of the polymerization is usually given in terms
of the conversion Xi of monomer i [Eq. (58)]. Here Polymeri and Monomeri are either in grams or in moles.

Xi

Polymeri
Polymeri Monomeri


58
in the reactor

When more than one monomer is polymerized, an overall conversion can be calculated from Eq. (59), where XT can be gravimetric or molar depending on the units
used for Polymeri and Monomeri (grams or moles, respectively).
2

3
Polymeri
5
X
XT 4 X
Polymeri
Monomeri
X

59
in the reactor

291

292

6 Emulsion Polymerization
Tab. 6.3.

Usual conversion denitions.[a]

Conversion

Fractional conversion of monomer i


Overall fractional conversion
Overall global conversion

Batch

Ni0  Ni
Ni0
P
Ni0  Ni
P
Ni0

Semicontinuous

Ni0 Fie dt  Ni

Ni0 Fie dt

P
Ni0 Fie dt  Ni

P
Ni0 Fie dt

P
Ni0 Fie dt  Ni
P
NTi

Continuous
(steady state)
Fie  Fis
Fie
P
Fie  Fis
P
Fie

[a] N

i0 number of moles of monomer i at time zero; NTi the total


amount of monomer i [mol] to be fed in a semicontinuous operation.
In order to calculate the gravimetric conversions, it is necessary to
multiply each term by the molecular weight of the corresponding
monomer.

The calculation of the monomer conversion depends on the operation mode. Table
6.3 summarizes the expressions for the dierent reactors. The instantaneous copolymer composition refers to the composition of the copolymer that is being
formed at a given time. Referred to monomer 1 this composition is given by Eq.
(60), where Rpi is the polymerization rate of monomer i.
Rp1
y1i X
Rpi

60

The cumulative composition is the average composition of the copolymer formed


up to a given time, as stated in Eq. (61), where Npoli is the amount [mol] of monomer i polymerized.
Npol1
y1cum X
Npoli

61

In continuous operations under steady-state conditions, y1i y1cum during the


whole process.
6.9.2

Heat Balance

Assuming that the energy balance for the reacting systems is essentially an enthalpy balance, this reduces to Eq. (62), where cpi and cpie [J mol1 K1 ] are the
heat capacity of compound i in the reactor and under the entry conditions, respectively. Rpi [mol m3 s1 ] is the polymerization rate of monomer i, (DHri ) [J mol1 ]

6.9 Reaction Engineering

is the polymerization heat of monomer i under the reactor conditions, T [K] is


the reactor temperature, Te [K] the temperature of the feeds, Q loss [J s1 ] the heat
losses to the surroundings (for example, through the reactor lid), Q stirring [J s1 ]
the heat produced by the agitator, and Q transfer [J s1 ] the heat removed through
the heat removal devices (cooling jacket, cooling baes, external heat exchanger
and reux condenser).
X

Ni cpi

X
dT X

Rpi DHri V 
Fie cpie T  Te
dt
Q transfer Q loss Q stirring

62

For heat removal through the cooling jacket Q transfer is given by Eq. (63), where U
[J m2 s1 K1 ] is the overall heat-transfer coecient, A [m2 ] the total heattransfer area and DTml the logarithmic mean temperature dierence between the
cooling uid and the reaction medium.
Q transfer UADTml

63

DTml is given by Eq. (64), where Twe and Tws [K] are the inlet and outlet temperatures of the cooling uid (normally water) in the jacket. If Twe A Tws then
DTml A T  Tw .
DTml

T  Twe  T  Tws
T  Twe
ln
T  Tws

64

The overall heat-transfer coecient includes several resistances in series, but the
internal resistance usually controls the heat-transfer rate (hi A U). The internal
heat-transfer coecient is a function of several factors such as the impeller type
and dimensions, the impeller speed, the reactor diameter, and physical properties
of the uid. Empirical correlations based on dimensionless groups can be used.
Equation (65) presents the usual form of these expressions [111], where Nu; Pr
and Re are the Nusselt, Prandtl, and Reynolds numbers, j and jw the viscosity of
the reaction medium at the reactor and wall temperatures respectively, and a; b; c,
and d are constants.
Nu a Re b Pr c

j
jw

d
65

Due to changes in the properties of the reaction media (for example, viscosity) the
overall heat-transfer coecient changes during the process. In semicontinuous operation, the heat-transfer area varies during the operation.

293

294

6 Emulsion Polymerization

A practical method to determine the heat transferred in any cooling device is to


measure the ow rate and the inlet and outlet temperatures of the cooling uid,
which are related by Eq. (66) where m_ w [kg s1 ] is the mass ow rate and cpw
[J kg1 K1 ] the heat capacity.
Q transfer m_ w cpw Twe  Tws

66

Combination of Eqs. (62) and (63) or (66) allows the estimation of the polymerization rate from temperature measurements. This method, which is called reaction
calorimetry (see Section 6.10.1.6), is a powerful noninvasive on-line monitoring
technique and it has been extensively applied to polymerization reactors [113, 114].
6.9.3

Polymer Particle Population Balance (Particle Size Distribution)

Particle size distribution strongly aects rheology [115], which in turn inuences
heat removal rate, mixing, mass transfer, and stability of the latex. On many occasions all of these aspects determine the scaleup and the feasibility of the operation.
In addition, particle size distribution aects lm formation and some application
properties [116, 117].
There are several ways in which the PSD can be represented, and often this depends on the method used to measure it. Thus, histograms are used when the
PSD is determined by transmission electron microscopy. However, the mathematical analysis is simpler if the PSD is dened in terms of the number density of
3
], nv. The units of nv are the
polymer particles of unswollen volume v [mparticle
number of particles per unit of unswollen volume of particle. From this denition,
the number of particles with unswollen volumes between v1 and v2 is given by Eq.
(67), and the total number of particles by Eq. (68).
Np v1 ! v2

v2

nv dv

67

v1

Np

nv dv

68

Equation (69) gives the macroscopic population balance for a CSTR, where the lefthand side accounts for the accumulation of particles in the reactor, the rst term
on the right-hand side accounts for the entry of particles into the reactor, the second for the exit of particles from the reactor, the third for the formation and loss of
particles of unswollen volume v due to particle growth, the fourth for the loss of
particles by coagulation with other particles and the fth term accounts for the formation of particles of unswollen volume v by particle coagulation. In Eq. (69) nv
and ne v are the reactor and inlet number density of polymer particles, Q s [m 3 s1 ]
3
s1 ] the voluis the volumetric ow rate, V [m 3 ] the reactor volume, rv v [mparticle
metric growth rate of each particle of volume v, kv; v 0 the coagulation rate con-

6.9 Reaction Engineering

stant for particles of volumes v and v 0 , and v0 the volume of particles formed by
nucleation.

qnv Q s
Qs
qrv vnv nv y
kv; v 0 nv 0 dv 0
ne v 
nv 


V
V
qt
qv
V v0

1 vv0

kv  v 0 ; v 0 nv  v 0 nv 0 dv 0
2V v0

69

This equation is a partial-dierential-integral equation and the nucleation term is


best incorporated as a boundary condition at volume v0 as in Eq. (70) [118], where
R nuc is the nucleation rate given by Eqs. (20), (26), (31), and (33).
nv0

R nuc
V
rv v0

70

The rst and second terms on the right-hand side of Eq. (69) should be removed
for batch reactors, as well as for semicontinuous reactors to which no particles are
fed. On the other hand, the coagulation terms may be neglected for stable formulations. Equations (69) and (70) are conveniently solved by using orthogonal collocation [119, 120].
6.9.4

Scaleup

The main objective of scaleup is to reproduce the laboratory results in commercialscale reactors in such a way that the end-use polymer properties can be maintained. In this way, a successful scaleup takes place when the latex is produced on
a large scale at planned rates, at the projected manufacturing cost, and to the desired quality standards [121]. To achieve this goal, knowledge of the mechanisms
that control the reactor behavior and the product properties is required [122].
Then, the design variables that aect these controlling mechanisms must be maintained constant from the smaller scale to the commercial equipment. In theory,
this could be done by applying the principle of similarity by means of dimensionless groups characterizing the phenomena of interest. However, when several
mechanisms are involved in the process, it is impossible to maintain all the dimensionless groups constant simultaneously. In this case, it is very important to know
which similarities to keep and which to sacrice.
The ow into the vessel, together with heat and mass transfer, must be considered in emulsion polymerization reactors because all of these mechanisms can
have a great inuence on polymer properties and reactor behavior. Unfortunately,
the mixing and heat-transfer parameters do not scale equally. In Table 6.4 several
scale factors are shown for a change from a 50 L pilot-scale vessel to a full-scale
vessel of 50 m 3 . The calculated values assume geometric similarity with a constant
impeller/tank diameter ratio and a constant height/tank diameter ratio. This table

295

296

6 Emulsion Polymerization
Tab. 6.4.

Several scale factors during scaleup.

Parameter [a]

Pilot scale
(50 L)

Plant scale of 50 m 3 (scaleup procedure)

P (power)
N (impeller rpm)
Q (impeller ow)
P=V (power/volume)
q=V (heat transfer rate/volume)
ND (tip speed)
Q=Q S (impeller ow/feed rate)
Q=H (impeller ow/head)
Re (Reynolds number)

1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1
1

10 3
0.21
215
1
0.08
2.1
0.21
46.8
21.5

[a] Units

10 8
10
10 4
10 5
1
100
10
1
10 3

100
0.1
100
0.1
0.05
1
0.1
100
10

10 5
1
10 3
100
0.21
10
1
10
100

0.1
0.01
10
0.0001
0.01
0.1
0.01
10 3
1

are as given in the Notation section.

shows, in dierent columns the change in selected parameters when one of them
is held constant.
It is often essential to maintain the same rate of heat transfer in the large-scale
unit. Nevertheless this scaleup criterion is impractical because it demands excessive impeller tip speeds and high power costs. For this reason, to compensate the
negative eect in the heat-transfer rate when another scaleup criterion is selected,
additional cooling devices are necessary in most cases [123].
With respect to mixing characteristics, it is very important to identify the parameters that have a major eect on the polymer properties. This task is dicult in
emulsion polymerization, where mixing aects several polymer properties. Monomer droplet and particle size, mass transfer between the dierent phases, coagulation and kinetics may be aected by mixing parameters. The power per volume or
the tip speed are the more usual scaleup criteria, but an adequate combination of
several mixing parameters can be better to maintain product quality. In some
cases, changes in the formulation can be utilized to maintain dynamic similarity.
Changes in viscosity during the process aect mixing, and scaleup becomes more
dicult. Intermediate pilot plant experiments are required in most cases to make a
successful scaleup. Computational uid dynamics will probably transform scaleup
in the near future.

6.10

On-line Monitoring in Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

In the production of dispersed polymers, the main objectives to be fullled are:




Safety: The reactor temperature must be kept under safe limits to avoid thermal
runaways. In addition, violation of environmental regulations both in the plant
environment and in the nished products must be avoided.

6.10 On-line Monitoring in Emulsion Polymerization Reactors




Production rate: The goal is to maximize the production rate of the available
reactors.
 Product quality: The required quality is given by the end-use properties such as
viscosity, scrub resistance, tensile strength, exibility, elasticity, toughness, and
glosss.
In order to implement the process conditions that lead to the required specications of safety, production rate, and product quality, it is necessary to develop suitable control strategies. Reaction control strategies rely on both ecient monitoring
techniques and state estimation and ltering techniques. In this section the main
focus is on the instrumentation available for monitoring emulsion polymerization
reactors. Detailed reviews for on-line monitoring techniques for polymerization reactors are available [124126].
Polymer latexes are products-by-process, and therefore the required structural
and morphological properties of the polymer that yield the adequate end-use properties are produced in the reactor. In polymer latexes the properties that one would
like to control during the polymerization include: monomer(s) conversion, copolymer composition, MWD, PSD, particle morphology, branching and crosslinking,
gel content, and particle size distribution. Not all of these properties can be monitored on-line, although some can be made observable by combining available
measurements and mathematical models. Examples of observable properties are
copolymer composition by means of calorimetric or density measurements [127
129] and instantaneous molecular weights from measurements of unreacted
monomer and CTAs (gas chromatography [130] or reaction calorimetry [131] in
linear polymers).
Other properties, such as molecular weight distribution of nonlinear polymers
and particle morphology, are currently neither measurable nor observable.
6.10.1

On-line Sensor Selection

One of the issues when monitoring an emulsion polymerization reactor is selection of the most appropriate technique [124, 126]. For instance, monomer conversion and copolymer composition can be monitored on-line by means of densimetry, refractive index, gas chromatography, calorimetry, ultrasound, uorescence,
ultraviolet reection, and other spectroscopic methods such as Raman, mid-range
infrared, and near-infrared.
Figure 6.11 can be used as a guide for the selection of a technique for monitoring monomer conversion and copolymer composition. The main idea behind this
plot is the fact that the amount of information provided by the available techniques
is dierent and furthermore, the implementation of these techniques involves different degrees of diculty (including here robustness in a harsh environment,
maintenance, and know-how required). The ideal technique would be located
in the upper left-hand corner, but unfortunately no such technique is currently
available.

297

298

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Fig. 6.11.

Guideline chart for sensor selection.

In the rest of Section 6.10.1, a brief description of the monitoring techniques


shown in Figure 6.11 will be presented, emphasizing the advantages and disadvantages of each one, and nally examples of application for emulsion polymerization
reactors will be given.
Latex Gas Chromatography
In this technique, a latex sample from the reactor is rst diluted and then injected
into the GC to analyze unreacted monomers and CTAs [132, 133]. Although successful implementation of this technique for latexes with a high solids content
has been reported [134], the setup is liable to suer clogging. Additional disadvantages of this monitoring technique include the time delays associated with the
analysis itself when multicomponent copolymerizations are monitored. This drawback can be partially alleviated by using capillary columns and modern gas chromatography equipment with reduced analysis time.
6.10.1.1

Head-space Gas Chromatography


This GC-based monitoring technique circumvents the lack of robustness of the
latex GC technique by analyzing the reactor head-space [135, 136]. However, the
estimation of the monomer concentrations in the polymer particles requires that
equilibrium between the latex and gas phase is attained. In addition, the values of
the equilibrium parameters are required, which introduces an additional uncertainty to the measurements. Note also that formulation ingredients such as CTAs
are not measurable by this means.
6.10.1.2

Densimetry
This technique is based on the density change that occurs when monomer is converted to polymer. This dierence, which is obviously a maximum in bulk polymerization, allows emulsion polymerizations of relatively high solids content to be accurately monitored [137]. The main disadvantage of on-line densimetry is that, as
for latex GC, a sample of the reaction medium must be introduced in the thermostated measurement cell and the system is liable to suer clogging. A further dis6.10.1.3

6.10 On-line Monitoring in Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

advantage of densimetry is that it provides only overall conversion measurements


for copolymerization, and hence partial conversions and copolymer compositions
must be inferred using a model [129]. An advantage of densimetry in comparison
to GC is that there is no delay in the measurement of density, which can be monitored almost continuously.
Ultrasound
The principle of ultrasound relies on the propagation of the ultrasonic wave pressure. The measurable properties are the ultrasonic velocity and the attenuation of
the wave, which are a function of the medium where the wave propagates and
hence of the density, viscosity, and compressibility. The attenuation measurements
are not very reliable for on-line monitoring because the attenuation of the wave in
dispersed systems is complex and depends on the dispersion medium, the viscous
losses within the particles and at the interface between the particle and the continuous phase, thermal losses, sound scattering in dispersed media, and the dynamic
relaxation of the polymeric material [138, 139]. Furthermore, there are technical
problems in measuring the attenuation at high solids and the presence of gas
bubbles can make the measurements dicult. Sound propagation velocity is better
suited to monitor emulsion polymerization reactors and it has been proven in systems with high conversion and high solids content [140142]. In principle, the
main advantages of this technique are that it is noninvasive in nature (although
care should be taken with emitterreceiver transducers located inside the reactor),
it is fast and cheap, and, in addition to monomer conversion, other latex properties
such as particle size, monomer solubilities, and critical micellar concentration can
also be measured [141].
The main disadvantage is that to exploit the information on the sound velocity and attenuation fully, calibration is required to obtain accurate predictions of
monomer conversion or other properties such as particle size because the theoretical models linking those characteristics to sound propagation velocity are not
predictive.
Nevertheless, on-line sound velocity is one of the more promising techniques for
monitoring industrial-size polymerization reactors because of the fast and robust
measurement and easy maintenance at a relatively low cost.
6.10.1.4

Spectroscopic Techniques
Since the mid-1990s, there has been plenty of activity regarding the use of spectroscopic techniques for on-line evaluation of polymer properties [143146]. This has
been possible due to the recent development of ber-optic probes, which allow insitu measurements in remote and harsh environments (high temperatures, pressures, toxic environments, and so on). An additional advantage is that a ber-optic
probe can be installed in an existing reactor within a short time without expensive
modications. Fluorescent, ultraviolet (UV), infrared (IR), near-infrared (NIR),
mid-infrared (MIR) and Raman spectroscopic techniques can be used for polymerization reaction monitoring. These can be divided between absorption- and
emission-based techniques. IR, NIR, and MIR are absorption-based.
6.10.1.5

299

300

6 Emulsion Polymerization

IR is not well suited to monitor polymerizations in dispersed media because


water gives a strong absorption, and hence important bands are overlapped or
hidden by that of the water. In addition, transmission through ber-optics is still
relatively poor in the infrared region, which makes IR not as suitable as other techniques for remote monitoring.
NIR spectroscopy corresponds to the spectral region 140004000 cm1 . The
main advantages of NIR are that no sample preparation is required and that the
NIR signal can be easily transmitted through ber-optics made of silica, which
have a low cost. The main disadvantage of NIR comes from the fact that in this region, absorption bands are broad because they do correspond not to specic bonds
or groups of molecules, but to combinations of them. This makes the accurate
quantitative analysis dicult. Furthermore, the detection of the minor compounds
in polymerization formulations is not easy. Although NIR has been used to monitor emulsion polymerization reactions [147], diculties due both to broad bands
associated with water absorption and to the eect of the particle size have been reported [141, 148, 149]. Another diculty of NIR is the short penetration depth of
the NIR signal. Furthermore, the presence of big monomer droplets might cause
inaccuracies in the quantitative analysis due to inhomogeneous sampling of the
reactor by the NIR probe.
The MIR spectral region is from 4000 to 400 cm1 . This region is very rich in
fundamental absorptions and hence the potential of this technique is high. However, the use of MIR spectroscopy to monitor emulsion polymerization reactors is
scarce, mainly because remote monitoring is not possible at low cost as currently
only a few exotic materials are known to be able to transmit in this region. In addition, water is absorbed in this region and it may hide bands that are important for
further analysis.
Raman spectroscopy is an emission-based technique. Although conventional dispersive Raman spectroscopy (laser wavelengths between 500 and 700 nm) has not
been successfully used to monitor polymerization reactions due to the tremendous
eect of uorescence on the spectra, FT-Raman (laser wavelength in the NIR region, 1034 nm) or modern dispersive Raman equipments (laser wavelengths over
800 nm) overcome this diculty. Currently, Raman spectroscopy can be considered
as the spectroscopic technique with the greater potential to monitor polymerization
reactors, and especially emulsion polymerization reactors, in situ. Raman spectroscopy presents several advantages over the absorption techniques (MIR and NIR).
The most important ones are:


Water is a weak scatterer and hence Raman is well suited to monitor polymerization in dispersed media.
 It is very sensitive to CbC bonds. This makes it possible to follow, with high accuracy, the disappearance of monomer by polymerization.
 Low-cost ber-optic technology can be used to monitor polymerization reactors
remotely.
 The penetration depth of the Raman signal is greater than for NIR and hence in
emulsion polymerization interference by monomer droplets can be avoided.

6.10 On-line Monitoring in Emulsion Polymerization Reactors


a)

Weight Fraction MMA

0.006
0.005
0.004
0.003
0.002
0.001
0
0

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

Conversion
b)

Weight Fraction BA

0.05

0.04

0.03

0.02

0.01

0
0

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

Conversion
Fig. 6.12. On-line monitoring of a seeded semibatch emulsion
copolymerization of MMA/BA. Evolution of (a) MMA; (b) BA.

Figure 6.12 shows an example of monitoring a semibatch emulsion polymerization


of MMA/BA of high solids content (55 wt.%) by means of on-line FT-Raman spectroscopy [150]. It should be pointed out that this monomer system was challenging
because the chemical structures of the monomers are very similar, and hence most
of the bands overlap. Chemometric (partial least squares, PLS) analysis was neces-

301

6 Emulsion Polymerization
c)

Solids Content (%)

302

60

50

40

30

20

10
0

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

Conversion
Fig. 6.12.

(c) solids content. g, gravimetry and gas chromatography; , FT-Raman.

sary to quantitatively determine the concentrations of monomers and the solids


content. Furthermore, in some cases nonlinear calibration techniques are necessary because PLS, a multivariate linear calibration, may not be sucient if the
degree of nonlinearity between the spectra and the properties of interest is signicant.
Reaction Calorimetry
Reaction calorimetry is probably the cheapest, easiest, and most robust monitoring
technique for polymerization reactors, due to the large enthalpy of polymerization
of most monomers. The technique is noninvasive (basically, only temperature sensors are required), and it is industrially applicable [151, 152]. It yields continuous
information on the heat released by polymerization and hence it is also very useful
for safety issues. The main drawback is that only overall polymerization rates can
be obtained. Consequently, the determination of the individual rates requires estimation techniques [114, 153155].
Reaction calorimetry is based on the energy balance in the reactor, given by Eq.
(71),
6.10.1.6

Ni cpi

dT
Q r Q feed Q transfer Q loss Q stirring
dt

71

where the term on the left-hand side is the heat accumulated in the reactor, Q r is
the heat generation rate due to polymerization, Q feed is the sensible heat genera-

6.10 On-line Monitoring in Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

tion rate due to the feeding of reagents into the reactor, Q transfer is the heat ow
across the reactor wall, and Q loss and Q stirring represent the rate of heat losses and
of heating due to stirring, respectively. The generation rate of the heat of reaction,
Q r , can be calculated from the other terms, provided that these can be calculated
with sucient accuracy. In emulsion polymerization reactors, the largest of these
terms is Q transfer .
In heat-ow calorimetry, Q transfer is calculated from the measurements of the reactor (T) and jacket (Tw ) temperatures by applying Eq. (72), where U is the overall
heat-transfer coecient and A the heat-transfer area.
Q transfer UAT  Tw

72

The implementation of heat-ow calorimetry requires knowledge of the evolution


of U. This is the weakest point of this technique.
In heat-balance calorimetry, eqs. (71) and (72) are coupled with the energy balance in the jacket to produce Eq. (73), where m w is the mass of cooling uid in
the jacket, m_ w the mass ow rate of cooling uid in the jacket, cpw its specic heat
capacity, Twe the inlet jacket temperature and Tws the outlet jacket temperature.
m w cpw

dTws
UATws  T m_ w cpw Twe  Tws
dt

73

Heat-balance calorimetry allows the simultaneous estimation of U and Q r , provided that Twe  Tws could be accurately measured. Therefore, heat-balance calorimetry is best suited for large-scale industrial reactors because a signicant dierence between the jacket inlet and outlet temperatures is necessary, and this is the
case in industrial reactors. The advantage of this approach is that a-priori information of the overall heat-transfer coecient is not necessary and hence it is more
robust and reliable than heat-ow calorimetry.
Oscillation calorimetry also allows simultaneous determination of the heat of reaction and the overall heat-transfer coecient from temperature measurements of
the reactor and the jacket. This is done by taking advantage of the dierent dynamics of heat transfer (fast) and heat of the reaction (slow) when an oscillation of
either the reactor or jacket temperature is created articially. The analysis of the oscillatory temperature signals allows calculatation of the UA term and Q r simultaneously [156, 157]. The oscillation of the jacket and reactor temperatures can be
achieved in dierent ways, but perhaps the most practical one is by imposing a sinusoidal oscillation in the set-point of the reactor temperature. This approach can
only be applied to small reactors (< 20 L) with high ow rates of the cooling uid,
because the oscillating signal is strongly attenuated as the reactor size increases.
The higher reactor time-constants make the estimation of Q r and UA very uncertain [158].
The amount of free monomer and the copolymer composition in emulsion polymerization reactors can be inferred from measurement of the heat of reaction, Q r

303

6 Emulsion Polymerization

a)
350
Free Monomer (g)

Gravimetry

300

Chromatography
Calorimetry

250
200
150
100
50
0
0

50

100

150

200

250

300

350

Time (min)

b)
1.0
________

Terpolymer Composition

304

Calorimetry

Full Points GC

0.8

Open Points NMR

0.6
BA

0.4
MMA

0.2

VAc

0.0
0.0

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

1.0

Conversion
Fig. 6.13. On-line monitoring of emulsion polymerization
reactor by means of calorimetric measurements: (a) free
monomer in VAc/BA/AA semibatch emulsion polymerization;
(b) terpolymer composition in the VAc/MMA/BA semibatch
emulsion polymerization.

[127, 128]. Figure 6.13(a) shows the evolution of the free monomer concentration
as inferred from on-line reaction calorimetry compared with the o-line measurement (gravimetry and gas chromatography) for a VAc/BA/AA high solids content
semibatch emulsion polymerization. In Figure 6.13(b), the estimation of the terpolymer composition from calorimetric measurements is compared with NMR
and GC measurements for a VAc/MMA/BA emulsion terpolymerization [159].

6.11 Control of Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

6.11

Control of Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

The objective of reactor control is to achieve an ecient, safe, and consistent production of high-quality materials. The quality of the emulsion polymers is given by
its end-use properties such as mechanical strength; tack, peel, and shear resistances; brightness; impact strength; weatherability; drawability; and elastic modulus. These end-use properties depend on the molecular and morphological properties of the latex, which are the variables that can be controlled in the reactor.
Therefore, the relationship between the structural and morphological properties
of the polymer latex and the end-use properties is required to establish which are
the characteristics of the polymer latex to be produced/controlled in the reactor
(Figure 6.1). The development of rst-principle structureproperties relationships is very challenging as the basis is not yet well established. Thus, the current industrial practice is a trial and error methodology. In order to reduce this
time-consuming methodology semiempirical approaches can be used. An example
of this type of approach was recently reported to relate the MWD of an acrylic latex
of a given composition and the adhesive properties [160, 161].
However, this relationship only provides a way to estimate the end-use properties
from a given microstructural property (MWD in the example); in practice, one
would like to know the microstructure that will yield a given set of end-use properties (see Figure 6.14). This can be achieved by inverting the model using appropriate techniques of optimization or neural networks [160, 161].
Once the desired molecular and morphological properties of the latex are established, a closed-loop control strategy can be implemented. A typical closed-loop
control strategy used to control copolymer composition and molecular weight distribution is shown in Figure 6.14.
In the control scheme, x are state variables of the polymerization reactor, y are
measurable properties of the polymer latex, ymeas are properties that are monitored
on-line, and u are the manipulated variables of the process (basically ow rates of
monomers and chain-transfer agents).

Fig. 6.14. Closed-loop control strategy for optimal control of


composition and MWD in emulsion polymerization reactors.

305

306

6 Emulsion Polymerization

The closed-loop control strategy requires calculation of the set-point, that is, the
trajectories or proles of the state variables as a function of a measured variable
(overall conversion). These proles can be calculated by means of an optimization
algorithm. In what follows, a brief description of the calculation of the optimal trajectories for copolymer composition and the MWD control is presented. The goal
of the optimization algorithm is to calculate the set-point trajectories of the state
(controlled) variables that ensure the production of an emulsion polymer of the desired copolymer composition and MWD in the minimum process time. To achieve
this goal, the objective function to be minimized is as expressed in Eq. (74), where
Rp is the polymerization rate and XT is the overall conversion.
Min

 1

M p

1
dXT
Rp


74

The minimization of Eq. (74) is subjected to the following constraints:


Constraint 1: product composition and MWD The polymer produced must have
the desired copolymer composition and the nal MWD.
The condition to produce a latex with a given copolymer composition is that the
ratio of the monomer concentrations in the polymer particles must be kept at
the value that ensures the production of the desired composition. This comonomer ratio can be calculated from the MayoLewis equation, Eq. (75), where r1 and
r2 are the reactivity ratios and y1i is the instantaneous composition referred to
monomer 1.

M1 p
M2 p

2y1i  1 G f2y1i  1 2  4r1 y1i  1 y1i r2 g 1=2


2r1 y1i  1

75

The calculation of the condition to produce a latex with a given MWD is based on
the fact that for linear polymers produced by free-radical polymerization, the polymer chains do not suer any modication once they are formed. This opens the
possibility of decomposing the desired nal MWD in a series of instantaneous
MWDs to be produced at dierent stages of the reaction [130]. When chain transfer to a CTA is the main termination event, each of those MWDs can be characterized by the number-average chain length, X ni , according to Eq. (76).
X ni

k p1 M1 p k p2 M2 p
ktr; CTA CTAp

76

Therefore the problem reduces to calculating the sequence of the values of X ni that
provide the desired nal MWD. In order to calculate the X ni values that should be
produced at each value of XT , the nal MWD is discretized as in Eq. (77), where
XTf is the nal overall conversion; X nij is the instantaneous number-average chain
length produced in the conversion increment j, Wj n is the instantaneous MWD

6.11 Control of Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

produced in the conversion increment j, and k is the number of increments into


which XTf is divided.
Wc n

k
k
1 X
DXT X
n
n

Wj nDXTj
exp 
XTf j1
XTf j1 X nij
X nij

!
77

Note that in the discretization the most probable distribution is used because, if
chain transfer to CTAs is the main termination event, the instantaneously formed
polymer obeys this distribution (polydispersity index 2).
For a given number of conversion increments, the required values of X nij can be
calculated by minimizing the Eq. (78), where Wcd n and Wc n are the desired
and the calculated MWDs.
X

Wcd n  Wc n 2
Min
X ni

78

This is a nonlinear optimization in which the number of values of n should be


greater than the number of conversion increments. A priori any MWD, Wcd n,
with polydispersity index equal or greater than 2 can be prepared by this method.
Strictly speaking, the maximum molecular weight achievable with this technique is
that produced with the minimum amount of CTA that ensures the termination by
chain transfer to CTAs is the main termination event. In practice, this is very close
to the molecular weight obtained without CTA. On the other hand, MWDs containing very low molecular weights may require the use of amounts of CTA that exceed
the maximum allowable quantities (usually lower than 1 wt.% based on monomer)
used in industrial practice. The minimization of Eq. (78) provides the values of X nij
to be produced at dierent DXT [Eq. (79)].
X ni o

M1 p M2 p
CTAp

f XT

79

Equations (75) and (79) are used as the constraints in the optimization algorithm
to produce a copolymer of constant instantaneous composition Y1i and a given
MWD, Wcd n.
Constraint 2: Safety considerations Polymerizations are exothermic processes that
can cause runaways, so the maximum amounts of the monomer that can be present in the reactor should be limited for safety reasons. Therefore, to design safe
processes an analysis of the risk parameters must be made in order to obtain the
limits in reaction conditions for safe operation: namely, the limits in monomer
concentration and temperature that ensure that the pressure buildup in the reactor
will not exceed the maximum pressure that the reactor can withstand. The risk
parameters are the onset temperature, the adiabatic temperature increase, and the
maximum temperature and pressure that may be reached during a polymerization

307

308

6 Emulsion Polymerization

process under adiabatic conditions. To assess risk parameters, adiabatic calorimeters of low thermal inertia (phi-factor, F, less than 15%) are used.
The onset temperature of the polymerization reaction, Tonset , is dened as the
temperature at which the self-heating rate is equal to a given arbitrary onset criterion. This criterion depends on the sensitivity of the equipment and is used as a
reference to calculate the adiabatic temperature increase, DT, which depends on
the total amount of monomer in the formulation, MiTOT , the heat of polymerization (DHri ), and the heat capacity of the reaction medium according to Eq. (80),
where Ni and cpi are the amount and the heat capacity, respectively, of each reagent
i present in the reaction medium.
X
DT

MiTOT DHri
X
Ni cpi

80

The adiabatic temperature increase, DT, is calculated for the experiments carried
out in the adiabatic calorimeters by subtracting the Tonset from the maximum temperature achieved, Tmax .
DT Tmax  Tonset

81

Thus, the dependence of the risk parameters on process variables such as the
monomer concentration in the polymer particles, particle size, solids content and
initiator/monomer ratio are of paramount importance to establish the safe regions
of operation of an emulsion polymerization reactor, and furthermore to develop optimal control strategies under safe conditions.
A typical result obtained in an adiabatic calorimeter for an emulsion polymerization reaction is shown in Figure 6.15. From the evolution of the temperature, the
onset of the adiabatic reaction and the maximum temperature achieved can be determined. Therefore, adiabatic temperature increases under these conditions can
be easily calculated. The evolution of the pressure provides an indication of the
maximum pressure reached.
Figure 6.16 shows the evolution of the risk parameters as a function of
the polymer/monomer ratio for the emulsion polymerization of VAc/BA/AA
(78.5:18.5:3) as obtained in a VSP2 reactor (Fauske & Associates). The particle size
of the seed and the initiator/monomer ratio were the same in all the experiments.
The plot shows that the onset temperature decreases as the monomer concentration in the polymer particles increases. Tmax ; DT, and pressure (the latter not
shown) increase upon increasing the monomer content. The analysis can
be extended for other process variables such as solids content, particle size, and
initiator/monomer ratios.
An example of the safety limits for the VAc/BA/AA emulsion polymerization
system is shown in Figure 6.17. The plot, which is based on the data displayed in
Figure 6.16, is constructed assuming that the polymerization will be carried out at

6.11 Control of Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

a)
120

T (C)

100

80

60

40

20
0

50

100

150

200

250

300

200

250

300

time (min)

b)
P (atm)

4
3,5
3
2,5
2
1,5
1
0,5
0

50

100

150

time (min)

Fig. 6.15. Time evolution of (a) temperature; (b) pressure


during emulsion polymerization of VAc/BA/AA (78.5:18.5:3)
with initial monomer/polymer ratio 50:50; initiator/monomer
ratio 0.002 wt.%; nal solids content 50 wt.%; seed
particle size 156 nm.

80 C (Twork ) and that the maximum temperature allowed to run the process, Tlimit ,
is 100 C. Note that this temperature must be calculated on the basis of the maximum pressure that the reactor can withstand, and is also a function of the process
variables.
The graph shows that the region of polymer/monomer ratio below 3:1 (concentration of monomer in the polymer particles higher than Mp 2:90 mol L1 ) will
not be safe. In other words, if higher monomer concentrations are used in the
process and the cooling system fails, there is a risk of exceeding the Tlimit tempera-

309

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Temperature (C)

140
120

Tonset
T

100

Tmax

80
60
40
20
0
0

10

Polymer/Monomer
Fig. 6.16. Evolution of the risk parameters as a function of the
polymer/monomer ratio for a VAc/BA/AA emulsion
polymerization of high solids content.

140
Temperature (C)

310

120

work

+ T
T

limit

100
80
T

work

60
SAFE REGION

40
T

20
0
0

2
DANGER

Polym er / M onom er
[M ]

Fig. 6.17. Safety regions for a VAc/BA/AA emulsion


polymerization. Polymerization temperature 80 C; maximum
temperature allowed for the process 100 C.

10

6.11 Control of Emulsion Polymerization Reactors

ture (Twork DT > Tlimit ) and the runaway will take place. Above the limit polymer/
mononor 3 (Mp < 2:90 mol L1 ) the process can be operated safely because in
none of the cases does the [Twork DT] operating line exceed the limit of the safe
operation temperature.
Constraint 3: Nonremoval of monomer and CTA The monomers and CTA already
charged in the reactor cannot be removed (Eqs. (82)(84), where the subscripts f
and pol stand for free and polymerized amounts, respectively).

dM1f M1pol 
b0
dXT

82

dM2f M2pol 
b0
dXT

83

dCTA f CTA pol 


b0
dXT

84

Constraint 4: Limitation on monomer and CTA addition The maximum amounts


of the monomer and CTA that can be added to the reactor are the total amounts
of these compounds in the formulation, M1TOT ; M2TOT , and CTATOT , respectively
[Eqs. (85)(87)].

M1f M1pol a M1TOT

85

M2f M2pol a M2TOT

86

CTA f CTA pol a CTATOT

87

The optimization provides the amounts of monomers and CTAs in the reactor at
any overall conversion. These proles are independent of the kinetics of the process and can be regarded as master curves. Once the trajectories of the amounts
of monomers and CTAs as a function of the conversion are calculated, the implementation of the closed-loop strategy (Figure 6.14) reduces to tracking these proles. To do so, on-line measurements of the overall conversion and of the free
amount of monomers and CTA are necessary. Reaction calorimetry plus state estimation is probably the easiest, cheapest, and most robust option from an industrial
perspective.
At each sampling time a nonlinear controller calculates the values of the manipulated variables u (ow rates of monomer and CTA) that must be added during the
sampling interval to ensure tracking of the master trajectories and hence to produce the desired polymer. A number of nonlinear controllers have been reported
in the literature for this purpose: nonlinear model predictive controllers (NMPCs)
[162], nonlinear geometric controllers (NGCs) [163], and internal model controllers (IMCs) [164] being the ones that have gained more attention in the specialized
literature.

311

6 Emulsion Polymerization
0.015

2
Butyl acrylate
Styrene

1.5

0.012

CTA

0.009
1
0.006
0.5
0.003

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

Total amount of CTA (mol/L)

Total amounts of monomers (mol/L)

312

Overall Conversion

Optimal trajectories for the amount of monomer


and CTA to produce S/n-BA 50:50 copolymer with a bimodal
MWD.
Fig. 6.18.

An example of the performance of an on-line control strategy like the one depicted above is shown in Figures 6.18 and 6.19 [165]. A copolymer with constant
composition, styrene/n-butyl acrylate (S/BA) 50:50 and a bimodal MWD with
two peaks (50 wt.% of the polymer in each peak) of dierent polydispersities were
sought: Mw1 1:05  10 6 and PI1 2:5 and Mw2 1:15  10 5 and PI2 3. Figure 6.18 presents the optimal proles of styrene, n-butyl acrylate, and tert-dodecyl
mercaptan (TDM) to produce the copolymer with the properties mentioned. It can
be seen that to maintain the comonomer ratio the required amount of n-BA was
always greater than that of styrene. Moreover, during the production of the rst
50% of the polymer, the amount of TDM required was low since the mode with
the high molecular weight was prepared rst; at 50% conversion, a sudden addition of TDM was required to start producing the low molecular-weight mode. Figure 6.19 presents a comparison between the desired and obtained copolymer composition and MWD during the controlled experiment.

Notation

A
Ap
as
c
cc

total heat-transfer area [m 2 ]


total surface area of the polymer particles [m 2 ]
saturated surface of the polymer particles covered by 1 mol of surfactant
[m 2 mol1 ]
overall termination rate coecient in the polymer particles [Eq. (9)] [s1 ]
rate coecient for bimolecular termination by combination [s1 ]

Notation

a)

Copolymer Composition

1.0

0.8

0.6

0.4

0.2

0.0
0.0

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

1.0

Overall Conversion

b)
Desired

df/dlog(M )

0.6

X=0.18

0.5

X=0.47
X=0.60

0.4

X=0.77

0.3

X=0.96

0.2
0.1
0.0
3.0

3.5

4.0

4.5

5.0

5.5 6.0
log (M )

6.5

7.0

Experimental results of the on-line controlled


emulsion polymerization of S/n-BA: (a) cumulative copolymer
composition; (b) MWD produced at dierent conversions.
Fig. 6.19.

cd
CMC
cpi
cpie
cpw
CTAp
CTA f

rate coecient for bimolecular termination by disproportionation [s1 ]


critical micellar concentration [mol m3 ]
heat capacity of compound i in the reactor [J mol1 K1 ]
heat capacity of compound i under the entry conditions [J mol1 K1 ]
heat capacity of the cooling uid [J kg1 K1 ]
concentration of CTA in polymer particle [mol m3 ]
free amount of CTA in the reactor [mol]

313

314

6 Emulsion Polymerization

CTA pol
CTATOT
D
dd
dp
f
fac
fc
fde
Fie
Fis
H
hi
(DHri
I
[I]
icrit
jcrit
j
Ki
kv; v 0
ka
kac
kadd
kam
kd
kd n
kde
kex

kfrag

kfrag
kI
kp
k pi
kpji
kt
kt

ktr; CTA
k tr; M
k tw

amount of CTA polymerized [mol]


total amount of CTA in the formulation [mol]
impeller diameter [m]
diameter of the monomer droplets [nm]
diameter of the polymer particles [nm]
eciency factor of the initiator radicals
frequency of activation in living polymerization [s1 ]
frequency of bimolecular termination [s1 ]
frequency of deactivation in living polymerization [s1 ]
inlet molar ow rate of component i [mol s1 ]
outlet molar ow rate of component i [mol s1 ]
velocity head [J kg1 ]
internal heat-transfer coecient [J m2 s1 K1 ]
polymerization heat of monomer i under the reactor conditions [J mol1 ]
amount of initiator [mol]
concentration of initiator in the aqueous phase [mol m3 ]
critical length of the oligoradicals formed from desorbed radicals
critical length of the oligoradicals formed from initiator
partition coecient of monomer i between the phase j and the aqueous
phase.
coagulation rate constant for particles of volumes v and v 0
[m 3 particle1 s1 ]
entry rate coecient [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
activation rate coecient in NMP or ATRP [s1 or m 3 mol1 s1 ]
addition rate coecient in RAFT [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
rate coecient for radical entry into the micelles [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
rate coecient for radical exit [s1 ]
rate coecient of radical exit from particles with n radicals [s1 ]
deactivation rate coecient in NMP or ATRP [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
exchange rate coecient in DT [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
fragmentation rate coecient in RAFT, backward reaction [s1 ]
fragmentation rate coecient in RAFT, forward reaction [s1 ]
rate coecient for initiator decomposition [s1 ]
propagation rate constant [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
average propagation rate constant of monomer i in copolymerization
[m 3 mol1 s1 ]
propagation rate constant of radicals with terminal unit j with monomer
i [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
termination rate coecient in the polymer particles [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
reversible termination rate coecient in living polymerization
[m 3 mol1 s1 ]
average chain transfer to CTA rate constant in copolymerization
[m 3 mol1 s1 ]
chain transfer to monomer rate coecient [m 3 mol1 s1 ]
termination rate coecient in the aqueous phase [m 3 mol1 s1 ]

Notation

m
Micrit
Mif
Mipol
Mi p
MiTOT
Mm
Mmi
Mn
Mni
Mp
mw
m_ w
Mw
Mwi
Mw
N
n
n
NA
nv
ne v
Ni
Ni0
nm
Nm
Nn
Np
Npoli
Npr
NTi
Nu
P
Pj
PM
Pr
q
Q
Q feed
Q loss
Qr

partition coecient of small radicals between polymer particles and the


aqueous phase [Eq. (11)]
number of oligoradicals of critical length formed from desorbed radicals
amount of free monomer i in the reactor [mol]
amount of monomer i polymerized [mol]
concentration of monomer i in the polymer particles [mol m3 ]
total amount of monomer i in the formulation [mol]
number of inactive chains of length m
number of inactive chains of length m in particles with i radicals
cumulative number-average molecular weight
instantaneous number-average molecular weight
monomer concentration in the polymer particles [mol/m 3 ]
mass of the cooling uid in the jacket [Kg]
mass ow rate of the cooling uid [Kg/s]
cumulative weight-average molecular weight
instantaneous weight-average molecular weight
monomer concentration in the aqueous phase [mol/m 3 ]
impeller rpm
number of radicals in a particle
average number of radicals per particle
Avogadros number
number of polymer particles per unit of unswollen volume of particle
[particles m3
particle ]
inlet number density of polymer particles [particles m3
particle ]
total amount of compound i in the reactor [mol]
moles of monomer i in the reactor at time zero [mol]
aggregation number of surfactant [molecules/micelle]
number of micelles
number of polymer particles with n radicals
number of polymer particles
moles of monomer i polymerized [mol]
number of precursor particles
total amount of monomer i to be feed in a semicontinuous operation
[mol]
Nusselt dimensionless number
impeller power consumption [J s1 ]
time-averaged probability of nding an active chain with ultimate unit of
type j
average molecular weight of the repeating unit in the polymer chain
Prandtl dimensionless number
heat transfer rate [J s1 ]
impeller ow [m 3 s1 ]
sensible heat generation rate due to feeding into the reactor [J s1 ]
rate of heat losses to the surroundings [J s1 ]
heat generation rate by polymerization reaction [J s1 ]

315

316

6 Emulsion Polymerization

Qs
Q stirring
Q transfer
Re
Ri
ri
R jcrit
Rm
Rmi
R nuc
Rp
Rpi
Rpp
RX
rv
rv v
Rnk
Rw
ST
Sw
t
T
DT
Te
Tg
Tlim
Tmax
DTml
Tonset
Tw
Twe
Tws
U
V
Vi
Vd
Vw
Vp
vp
Vpol
W
Wc n
Wcd n

volumetric ow rate [m 3 s1 ]


rate of heat production by the agitator [J s1 ]
heat removal rate [J s1 ]
Reynolds dimensionless number
net generation rate of component i [mol m3 s1 ]
reactivity ratio of monomer i
number of oligoradicals of critical length formed from initiator
number of radicals of length m
number of radicals of length m in particles with i radicals
nucleation rate of polymer particles [particles m3 s1 ]
overall polymerization rate [mol m3 s1 ]
polymerization rate of monomer i [mol m3 s1 ]
polymerization rate per polymer particle [mol particles1 s1 ]
amount of the capping species in controlled polymerization [mol]
volumetric growth rate of one polymer particle [m 3 s1 ]
volumetric growth rate of a particle of volume v [m 3 s1 ]
generation rate of the kth moment of the distribution of inactive chains
concentration of radicals in the aqueous phase [mol m3 ]
total amount of surfactant in the reactor [mol]
amount of surfactant in the aqueous phase [mol]
reaction time [s]
reactor temperature [K]
adiabatic temperature increase
temperature of the feed [K]
glass transition temperature [K]
maximum temperature achievable for a safe operation [K]
maximum temperature obtained during an adiabatic polymerization
reaction [K]
logarithmic mean temperature dierence
temperature at which the polymerization start under adiabatic conditions [K]
jacket temperature [K]
inlet temperature of the cooling uid in the jacket [K]
outlet temperature of the cooling uid in the jacket [K]
overall heat-transfer coecient [J m2 s1 K1 ]
reactor volume [m 3 ]
volume of monomer i [m 3 ]
volume of the droplet phase [m 3 ]
volume of the aqueous phase [m 3 ]
volume of the polymer particles [m 3 ]
volume of a swollen polymer particle [m 3 ]
volume of polymer [m 3 ]
volume of water [m 3 ]
cumulative weight MWD
desired cumulative MWD

References

Wj n
[X]
Xi
X ni
X nij
XT
XTf
DXTj
y1cum
y1i

instantaneous weight MWD of the polymer formed at conversion increment j


concentration of living agent in controlled polymerization [mol m3 ]
conversion of monomer i
instantaneous number-average chain length
instantaneous number-average chain length of the polymer formed in
conversion increment j
overall conversion
nal overall conversion
jth overall conversion increment
cumulative copolymer composition referred to monomer 1
instantaneous copolymer composition referred to monomer 1

Greek
a1
a2
g
d
h
l
mk
nk
r
t
j
F
P
fM
j
fi
P
fp
fww
C
jw

parameter of Eq. (29)


parameter of Eq. (30)
generation rate of small radicals by chain transfer [Eq. (11)] [mol m5 ]
critical length for entry of radicals generated from the initiator
consumption rate of small radicals generated by chain transfer [Eq. (11)]
[m2 ]
overall mass-transfer rate coecient [m 3 s1 ]
kth-order moment of the distribution of active chains
kth-order moment of the distribution of inactive chains
frequency of radical entry [s1 ]
space time [s]
viscosity of the reaction medium at the reactor temperature [kg m1 s1 ]
fraction of the heat of reaction used to heat the reactor walls
volume fraction of monomer in the polymer particles
volume fraction of monomer i in phase j
volume fraction of polymer in the polymer particles
volume fraction of water in the aqueous phase
parameter of Eq. (17)
viscosity of the reaction medium at the wall temperature [kg m1 s1 ]

References
1 J. M. Asua (Ed.), Polymeric Dispersions:

Principles and Applications, Kluwer


Academic Press, Dordrecht, 1997.
2 P. A. Lovell, M. S. El-Aasser (Eds.),
Emulsion Polymerization and Emulsion
Polymers, John Wiley, Chichester, UK,
1997.
3 H. Warson, C. A. Finch, Applications

of Synthetic Resin Latices, 3 vols., John


Wiley, Chichester, UK, 2001.
4 D. Urban, K. Takamura (Eds.),
Polymer Dispersions and Their Industrial
Applications, Wiley-VCH, Weinheim,
Germany, 2002.
5 W. D. Harkins, J. Am. Chem. Soc.
1947, 69, 14281444.

317

318

6 Emulsion Polymerization
6 W. J. Priest, J. Phys. Chem. 1952, 56,
7

8
9

10

11
12

13
14
15
16

17
18
19

20

21

22

23

24

10771082.
R. M. Fitch, C. H. Tsai, Polymer
Colloids, R. M. Fitch (Ed.), Plenum
Press, New York, 1971.
J. Ugelstad, F. K. Hansen, Rubber
Chem. Technol. 1976, 49, 536609.
P. J. Feeney, D. H. Napper, R. G.
Gilbert, Macromolecules 1987, 20,
29222930.
J. W. Vanderhoff, E. B. Bradford,
H. L. Tarkowski, J. B. Shaffer, R. M.
Wiley, Adv. Chem. Ser. 1962, 34, 32
51.
J. M. Asua, Prog. Polym. Sci. 2002, 27,
12831346.
K. E. J. Barret (Ed.), Dispersion Polymerization in Organic Media, John
Wiley, London, 1975.
C. Larpent, Surfactant Sci. Ser. 2003,
115, 145187.
T. Fukuda, Y. D. Ma, H. Inagaki,
Macromolecules 1985, 18, 1726.
F. R. Mayo, F. M. Lewis, J. Am. Chem.
Soc. 1994, 66, 15941601.
J. Forcada, J. M. Asua, J. Polym. Sci.:
Polym. Chem. Ed. 1985, 23, 1955
1962.
J. L. Gardon, J. Polym. Sci.: Polym,
Chem. Ed. 1968, 6, 28592879.
J. Guillot, Makromol Chem. Rapid.
Commun. 1980, 1, 697702.
P. D. Armitage, J. C. de la Cal, J. M.
Asua, J Appl Polym Sci. 1994, 51,
19851990.
S. Omi, K. Kushibiki, M. Negishi,
M. Iso, Zairyo Gijutsu 1985, 3, 426
441.
J. Ugelstad, P. C. Mork, H. R.
Mfutakamba, E. Soleimany, I.
Nordhuus, K. Nustad, R. Schmid,
A. Berge, T. Ellingsen, O. Aune,
G. W. Poehlein, R. H. Otewill, J. W.
Goodwin (Eds.), NATO ASI Series
1983, 1, 5199.
L. M. Gugliotta, G. Arzamendi, J. M.
Asua, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1995, 55,
10171039.
F. K. Hansen, J. Ugelstad, J. Polym.
Sci: Polym. Chem. Ed. 1978, 16, 1953
1979.
I. A. Maxwell, B. R. Morrison, D. H.
Napper, R. G. Gilbert, Macromolecules 1991, 24, 16291640.

25 J. M. Asua, Macromolecules 2003, 36,

62456251.
26 J. T. OToole, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.

1965, 9, 12911297.
27 B. G. Li, B. W. Brooks, J. Polym. Sci.,

28
29

30
31

32

33

34
35

36

37

38
39

40

41
42
43
44
45

Part A: Polym. Chem. 1993, 31, 2397


2402.
W. V. Smith, R. H. Ewart, J. Chem.
Phys. 1948, 16, 592599.
M. Nomura, M. Harada, W. Eguchi,
S. Nagata, ACS Symp Ser. 1976, 24,
102121.
F. K. Hansen, J. Ugelstad, Makromol
Chem. 1979, 180, 24232434.
J. R. Richards, J. R. Congalidis,
R. G. Gilbert, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1989, 37, 27272756.
P. H. H. Araujo, J. C. de la Cal, J. M.
Asua, J. C. Pinto, Macromol. Theory
Simul. 2001, 10, 769779.
A. Urretabizkaia, G. Arzamendi,
J. M. Asua, Chem. Eng. Sci. 1992, 47,
25792584.
D. Satas, Adhesive Age 1972, 15, 19
23.
O. Elizalde, M. Vicente, J. R. Leiza,
J. M. Asua, Polym. React. Eng. 2002,
10, 265283.
G. Lichti, R. G. Gilbert, D. H.
Napper, in I. Piirma (Ed.), Emulsion
Polymerization, Academic Press, New
York, 1982, pp. 93144.
H. Tobita, A. E. Hamielec,
Makromol. Chem, Macromol. Symp.
1994, 3536, 193212.
F. Teymour, J. D. Campbell,
Macromolecules 1994, 27, 24602469.
C. Plessis, G. Arzamendi, J. R. Leiza,
D. Charmot, H. A. S. Schoonbrood,
D. Charmot, J. M. Asua, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 2001, 40, 38833894.
A. Butte, G. Storti, M. Morbidelli,
Macromol. Theory. Simul. 2002, 11, 37
52.
P. J. Flory, Faraday Discussions of the
Chemical Society 1974, 57, 718.
H. Tobita, Macromolecules 1993, 26,
836841.
D. Charmot, J. Guillot, Polymer
1992, 33, 352360.
G. Arzamendi, J. M. Asua, Macromolecules 1995, 28, 74797490.
H. Tobita, Acta Polym. 1995, 46, 185
203.

References
46 A. Ghielmi, S. Fiorentino, G.

47
48
49
50
51
52

53

54
55
56

57

58

59

60
61
62
63
64
65

66
67

68

Storti, M. Morbidelli, J. Polym. Sci.


Part A: Polym. Chem. 1998, 36, 1127
1156.
L. J. Gonzalez-Ortiz, J. M. Asua,
Macromolecules 1995, 28, 31353145.
L. J. Gonzalez-Ortiz, J. M. Asua,
Macromolecules 1996, 29, 383389.
L. J. Gonzalez-Ortiz, J. M. Asua,
Macromolecules 1996, 29, 45204527.
M. Szwarc, Nature 1956, 178, 1168.
M. Szwarc, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. 1998, 36, ix.
G. Moad, D. H. Solomon, The
Chemistry of Free-Radical Polymerization, Pergamon, Oxford, 1995.
R. G. Gilbert, Emulsion Polymerization. A Mechanistic Approach, Academic
Press, London, 1995.
G. Moad, E. Rizzardo, D. H.
Solomon, Polym. Bull. 1982, 6, 589.
D. H. Solomon, E. Rizzardo, P.
Cacioli, US Patent 4 581 429, 1986.
M. K. Georges, R. P. N. Veregin,
P. M. Kazmaier, G. K. Hamer,
Macromolecules 1993, 26, 2987.
M. K. Georges, R. P. N. Veregin,
P. M. Kazmaier, G. K. Hamer, M.
Saban, Macromolecules 1994, 27, 7228.
D. Benoit, V. Chaplinski, R.
Braslau, C. J. Hawker, J. Am. Chem.
Soc. 1999, 121, 5929.
M. Kato, M. Kamigaito, M. Sawamoto, T. Higashimura, Macromolecules 1995, 28, 2093.
J. S. Wang, K. Matyjaszewski, J. Am.
Chem. Soc. 1995, 117, 5614.
J. S. Wang, K. Matyjaszewski, Macromolecules 1995, 28, 7901.
V. Coessens, T. Pintauer, K. Matyjaszewski, Prog. Polym. Sci. 2001, 26, 337.
T. E. Patten, K. Matyjaszewski, Adv.
Mater. 1998, 10, 901.
K. Matyjaszewski, S. G. Gaynor, J. S.
Wang, Macromolecules 1995, 28, 2093.
S. G. Gaynor, J. S. Wang, K.
Matyjaszewski, Macromolecules 1995,
28, 8051.
A. Goto, K. Ohno, T. Fukuda,
Macromolecules 1998, 31, 2809.
A. Goto, K. Sato, Y. Tsujii, T.
Fukuda, G. Moad, E. Rizzardo, S. H.
Thang, Macromolecules 2001, 34, 402.
G. Moad, J. Chiefari, B. Y. K.

69

70

71

72
73
74
75
76
77
78

79
80
81
82

83

84

85

86

Chong, J. Krstina, R. T. A. Mayadunne, A. Postma, E. Rizzardo,


S. H. Thang, Polym. Int. 2000, 49,
993.
R. T. A. Mayadunne, E. Rizzardo, J.
Chiefari, J. Krstina, G. Moad, A.
Postma, S. H. Thang, Macromolecules
2000, 33, 243.
B. Y. K. Chong, T. P. T. Le, G. Moad,
E. Rizzardo, S. H. Thang, Macromolecules 1999, 32, 2071.
A. Butte, G. Storti, M. Morbidelli,
Modern Styrenic Polymers, Polystyrenes
and Styrenic Copolymers, John Wiley,
Chichester, UK, 2003.
H. Fischer, J. Polym. Sci. A: Polym.
Chem. 1999, 37, 1885.
H. Fischer, Macromolecules 1997, 30,
5666.
A. Butte, G. Storti, M. Morbidelli,
Macromolecules 2001, 34, 5885.
B. Charleux, Macromolecules 2000, 33,
5358.
M. F. Cunningham, C. R. Chimie
2003, 6, 1351.
J. Cao, J. He, C. Li, Y. Yang, Polym. J.
2001, 33, 75.
M. F. Cunningham, M. Xie, K. B.
McAuley, M. K. Georges, B.
Keoshkerian, Macromolecules 2002,
35, 59.
M. Li, K. Matyjaszewski, J. Polym.
Sci. A: Polym. Chem. 2003, 41, 3606.
S. G. Gaynor, J. Qiu, K. Matyjaszewski, Macromolecules 1998, 31, 5951.
J. Qiu, S. G. Gaynor, K. Matyjaszewski, Macromolecules 1999, 32, 2872.
S. W. Prescott, M. J. Ballard, E.
Rizzardo, R. G. Gilbert, Aust. J.
Chem. 2002, 55, 415.
J. Chiefari, Y. K. Chong, F. Ercole,
J. Krstina, J. Jeffery, T. P. T. Le,
R. T. A. Mayadunne, G. F. Meijs,
C. L. Moad, G. Moad, E. Rizzardo,
S. H. Thang, Macromolecules 1998, 31,
5559.
W. Smulders, R. G. Gilbert, M. J.
Monteiro, Macromolecules 2003, 36,
4309.
H. de Brouwer, J. G. Tsavalas, F. J.
Schork, M. J. Monteiro, Macromolecules 2000, 33, 9239.
Y. Luo, J. G. Tsavalas, F. J. Schork,
Macromolecules 2001, 34, 5501.

319

320

6 Emulsion Polymerization
87 C. Farcet, B. Charleux, R. Pirri,
88

89

90

91
92
93
94
95
96

97

98

99
100

101

102

103

104

105

Macromol. Symp. 2002, 192, 249.


K. Matyjaszewski, J. Qiu, N. V.
Tsarevsky, B. Charleux, J. Polym.
Sci. A: Polym. Chem. 2000, 38, 4724.
R. Greene, R. A. Gonzalez, G. W.
Poehlein, ACS Symp. Ser. 1976, 24,
341358.
C. Kiparissides, J. F. MacGregor,
A. E. Hamielec, Can. J. Chem. Eng.
1980, 58, 4855.
H. C. Lee, G. W. Poehlein, Chem.
Eng. Sci. 1986, 41(4), 10231030.
B. A. Paquet, W. H. Ray, AIChE J.
1994, 40(1), 7387.
K. Geddes, Chemistry & Industry 1983,
6, 223227.
K. Geddes, Surface Coatings Int. 1993,
76, 330339.
C. Abad, J. C. de la Cal, J. M. Asua,
Polymer 1995, 36, 42934299.
P. H. H. Araujo, C. Abad, J. C. de la
Cal, J. C. Pinto, J. M. Asua, Polym.
React. Eng. 1999, 7, 303326.
C. Abad, J. C. de la Cal, J. M. Asua,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1995, 536, 419
424.
C. Abad, J. C. de la Cal, J. M. Asua,
in Polymeric Dispersions: Principles and
Applications, J. M. Asua (Ed.), Kluwer
Academic Press, Dordrecht, 1997, pp.
333348.
J. Meuldijk, A. L. German, Polym.
React. Eng, 1999, 7(2), 207230.
F. H. A. H. Van den Boomen, I.
Meuldijk, D. Thoenes, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1999, 54(1516), 32833290.
C. Sayer, M. Palma, R. Guidici, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res. 2002, 41(7), 1733
1744.
J. Meuldijk, G. J. G. Van Strey, F. A.
H. C. Van Doormalen, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 1992, 47(911), 26032608.
M. Apostel, W. Pauer, H. U. Moritz,
J. Kremestotter, K. D. Hungenberg,
Chimia 2001, 55(3), 229230.
C. Herbel, S. Fukhauser, W.
Huebinger, W. Kastenhuber, J.
Kremeskoetter, WO 99 44737, PCT
Int. Appl., 1999.
W. Schmidt, S. Kossak, J. Langenbuch, H. U. Moritz, C. Herrmann,
D. Kremeskoetter, Dechema Monographs, 1998, 134, 509519.

106 T. Inamura, K. Sato, S. Ishikura, M.

107

108

109

110

111

112

113

114

115

116

117

118
119
120

121

Nomura, Polym. Int. 1993, 30(2), 203


206.
X. Wei, K. Yoshikawa, I. Yokota, S.
Sato, M. Nomura, Polym. Mat. Sci.
Eng. 1999, 80, 528529.
X. Wei, H. Takahashi, S. Sato, M.
Nomura, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 2001,
80(11), 19311942.
G. W. Poehlein, in Polymeric
Dispersions: Principles and Applications,
J. M. Asua (Ed.), Kluwer Academic
Press, Dordrecht, 1997, pp. 305332.
K. J. Karpenter, in Handbook of Batch
Process Design, P. Sharrat (Ed.),
Chapman and Hall, London, 1997.
S. Nagata, Mixing Principles and
Applications, John Wiley, New York,
1975.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec, in
Polymeric Dispersions: Principles and
Applications, J. M. Asua (Ed.), Kluwer
Academic Press, Dordrecht, 1997, pp.
289304.
H. U. Moritz, Polymer Reaction
Engineering, K. H. Reichert, W.
Geiseler (Eds.), Verlag Chemie,
Weinhem, Germany, 1989.
I. Saenz de Buruaga, A. Echevarria,
P. D. Armitage, J. C. de la Cal, J. R.
Leiza, J. M. Asua, AIChE J. 1997, 43,
10691081.
A. Guyot, F. Chu, M. Schneider, C.
Graillant, T. F. McKenna, Prog.
Polym Sci. 2002, 27, 15731615.
A. C. I. A. Peters, G. C. Overbeck,
A. J. P. Buckmann, J. C. Padget, T.
Annable, Prog Org Coatings 1996, 29,
183194.
A. C. I. A. Peters, G. C. Overbeck, T.
Annable, Prog Org Coatings 2000, 38,
137150.
J. B. Rawlings, Ph.D. Thesis,
University of Wisconsin, 1985.
J. B. Rawlings, W. H. Ray, Polym.
Eng. Sci. 1988, 28, 237256.
P. H. H. Araujo, J. C. de la Cal,
J. M. Asua, J. C. Pinto, Macromol
Theory Simul. 2001, 10, 769779.
A. Bisio, in Scale-up of Chemical
Processes: Conversion from Laboratory
Scale Tests to Successful Commercial Size
Design, A. Bisio, R. L. Kabel (Eds.),
John Wiley, New York, 1985.

References
122 G. B. Tatterson, Scale-up and Design

123

124

125

126

127

128

129

130

131

132

133

134
135

136
137

138

139

of Industrial Mixing Processes, McGrawHill, New York, 1994.


H. F. Rase, Chemical Reactor Design for
Process Plants: Vol I. Principles &
Techniques, John Wiley, New York,
1977.
C. H. Chien, A. Penlidis, JMS-Rev.,
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 1990, 30(1), 1
42.
W. Hergeth in Polymeric Dispersions:
Principles and Applications, J. M.
Asua (Ed.), Kluwer Academic Press,
Dordrecht, 1997, pp. 243256.
O. Kammona, E. G. Ghatzi, C.
Kiparissides, JMS-Rev., Macrom.
Chem. Phys. 1999, 39(1), 57134.
A. Urretabizkaia, E. D. Sudol, M. S.
El-Aasser, J. M. Asua, J. Polym. Sci.
Part A: Polym. Chem. 1993, A31,
29072913.
L. M. Gugliotta, M. Arotcarena,
J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua, Polymer 1995,
36, 20192023.
P. Canu, S. Canegallo, M. Morbidelli, G. Storti, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1994, 54, 18991917.
A. Echevarria, J. R. Leiza, J. C. de la
Cal, J. M. Asua, AIChE J. 1998, 44(7),
16671679.
M. Vicente, S. Ben Amor, L. M.
Gugliotta, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 2001, 40, 218
227.
A. Guyot, J. Guillot, C. Graillat,
M. T. Llauro, J. Macromol. Sci.
Chem. 1984, A21, 683699.
J. R. Leiza, M. Montes, J. C. de la
Cal, J. M. Asua, Process Control and
Quality 1993, 4, 197210.
A. Urretabizkaia, J. R. Leiza, J. M.
Asua, AIChE J. 1994, 40, 18501864.
M. Alonso, F. Recasens, L.
Puigjanser, Chem. Eng. Sci. 1986, 41,
10391044.
M. J. Ahmed, D. E. Mackey, ACS
Symp. Ser. 1989, 404, 296305.
S. Canegallo, G. Storti, M. Morbidelli, S. Carra, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
1993, 47, 961979.
J. Alig, P. Hauptmann, S. Wateraigi, Teubner Texte zur Physik 1986,
9, 364373.
P. Hauptmann, F. Dinger, R.

140

141

142

143

144
145

146

147

148

149

150

151
152

153

154

155

156

Sauberlich, Acta Polym. 1983, 34,


303304.
S. Canegallo, M. Apostolo, G.
Storti, M. Morbidelli, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci. 1995, 57, 13331346.
K. Horning, W. D. Hergeth, S.
Waterwig, Acta Polym. 1989, 40, 257
260.
K. Horning, W. D. Hergeth, K. G.
Hausler, S. Waterwig, Acta Polym.
1991, 42, 174177.
J. B. Callis, M. Eaton, M. L. Callis,
C. Wu, J. D. S. Danielson, Process
Control and Quality 1995, 8, 140.
S. Mijovic, J. Andjelic, Polymer 1995,
36, 37833786.
C. Kiparissides, E. G. Chatzi, O.
Kammona, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1997,
63, 799809.
M. Agnely, D. Charmot, J. Sawatzki,
N. Dupuy, C. Bauer, B. Amran, J. P.
Huvenne, Appl. Spectrosc. 2000, 54,
528535.
P. D. Gossen, J. F. MacGregor, R. H.
Pelton, Appl. Spectrosc. 1993, 47,
18521870.
M. M. Reis, P. H. H. Araujo, C.
Sayer, R. Giudici, Polymer 2003, 44,
61236128.
M. M. Reis , P. H. H. Araujo, C.
Sayer, R. Giudici, Macromol. Rapid.
Commun. 2003, 24, 620624.
O. Elizalde, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua,
Macromol. Symp. 2004, 206, 135
149.
E. D. Tolin, D. A. Fluegel, US
Patent 3 275 809, 1966.
B. F. Beekingham, B. N. Heudy,
J. V. Simons, GB Patent 1 549 841,
1979.
I. Saenz de Buruaga, M. Arotcarena, P. D. Armitage, L. M.
Gugliotta, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua,
Chem. Eng. Sci. 1996, 51, 2781
2786.
P. Guinot, N. Othman, G. Fevotte,
T. F. McKenna, Polym. React. Eng.
2000, 8, 115134.
N. Othman, A. M. Santos, G.
Fevotte, T. F. McKenna, Macromol.
Symp. 2000, 150, 109114.
R. Carloff, A. Pro, K. H. Reichert,
Chem. Eng. Techn. 1994, 17, 406
413.

321

322

6 Emulsion Polymerization
dtke, K. H. Reichert,
157 A. Tietze, Lu
Chem. Eng. Sci. 1996, 51, 3131
3137.
158 S. Kraemer, R. Gesthuisen, S.
Engell, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua, Comp.
Chem. Eng., in press, 2004.
159 I. Saenz de Buruaga, J. R. Leiza,
J. M. Asua, Polym. React. Eng. 2000, 8,
3975.
160 O. Elizalde, M. Vicente, J. R. Leiza,
J. M. Asua, Polym. React. Eng. 2002,
10, 265283.

161 O. Elizalde, M. Vicente, C. Plessis,

162
163
164

165

J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua, J. Coat.


Technol. 2004, 1, 4551.
B. W. Bequette, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1991, 30, 13911413.
C. Kravavis, M. Soroush, AIChE J.
1990, 30, 249264.
C. G. Economou, M. Morari, B.
Plasson, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 1986,
25, 403411.
M. Vicente, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua,
AIChE J. 2001, 47, 15941606.

323

Ionic Polymerization1
Klaus-Dieter Hungenberg

This chapter will deal with ionic chain growth polymerization for monomers which
are of some industrial importance. It will deal mainly with those polymer reaction
engineering aspects which are relevant for designing processes and products. As it
cannot cover the entire subject, the systems dealt with are chosen as examples of
the most important features of ionic polymerization.

7.1

Introduction

There are several recent monographs [17] on anionic and cationic polymerization
covering various mechanistic, kinetic and preparative aspects, so here just some
fundamental issues which are relevant for reaction engineering will be discussed.
Like free-radical polymerization ionic polymerization is also a chain polyaddition. After the formation of an active center (radical, anionic, or cationic species),
monomer molecules are added to this active center to form long-chain molecules.
However, from a kinetic point of view there are two major dierences between radical and ionic polymerization.
The rst dierence is that free-radical polymerization is monomer-based, which
means that the kinetics is (almost) exclusively determined by the monomer M.
Once a radical R  is formed and added to the monomer molecule to build the
growing chain R- - -M  , the reactivity of this growing chain in all reactions is determined by the nature of the monomer irrespective of the nature of the initiating
radical, which just forms the tail of that growing chain. So, from a practical point
of view, in radical polymerization it is sucient to determine the kinetic scheme
and parameters and their dependences on the system variables temperature and
pressure for a monomer system with one kind of radical initiator. Furthermore,
all active radical centers from one monomer are identical, and they are hardly in1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

324

7 Ionic Polymerization

uenced by the nature of the surroundings, nor by the solvent nor by penultimate
units of the chain; at least, the inuences of penultimate units [8] or solvents [9]
are quite small. In contrast, ionic polymerization is site-based: that is, the nature
of the active center strongly depends on the nature of the initiator. Propagation is
by monomer insertion at an ion pair [Eq. (1) or (2)], where the counter ion comes
from the initiator system.

X
@@Pn X M ! @@Pn1

or

@@Pn Y M ! @@P
n1 Y

So the kinetic scheme and parameters not only depend on M, but they may dier
considerably according to the initiator used. Furthermore, the active centers are
not uniform as in free-radical polymerization, but because of their ionic nature
there usually exists a complex chemical equilibrium between dierent species,
even if the initiator has a unique structure. This equilibrium [Eq. (3)] between
free ions, solvent-separated ion pairs, contact ion pairs, covalent polarized bonds,
and between associated and non-associated species, as well as the concentration of
these species strongly depend on the polarity or solvating power of the solvent system, the solvent itself, and the presence of other salts.
X Y $ X ==Y $ X ; Y $ X d Y d $ 1=n XYn

All these species can in principle participate in all the reactions with dierent rate
coecients. These facts make ionic polymerizations dicult to access for kinetic
modeling from a practical point of view in an industrial environment.
There is another important dierence between free-radical and ionic polymerization. In free-radical polymerization, there are system-immanent, unavoidable termination reactions, the bimolecular disproportionation and combination between
two radicals. Because these termination reactions are very fast (k t 10 7 10 9
M1 s1 ) compared to propagation (k p 10 0 10 3 M1 s1 ) and radical formation
by initiator decomposition (kd 103 101 s1 ) the pseudo-steady-state hypothesis
can be applied.
In ionic systems, in general, there are no such system-immanent termination reactions between species carrying the kinetic chain and, if there are reactions which
terminate the active species, they often occur on a similar time scale to initiation
and propagation, or they are even slower.
Examples of such reactions, which irreversibly terminate the kinetic chain, are
elimination reactions where the eliminated species is not able to re-initiate the polymerization, such as in the elimination of LiH or NaH during anionic polymerization of styrene or butadiene [1013]. In cationic polymerization, the collapse of ion
pairs to covalent species, as in reaction (4) where the CaF bond is too strong for
the ion pair to be reformed again, is a true termination reaction.

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

@@CH2 C HPh PF


6 ! @@CH2 CHPhaF PF5

Many other similar eliminations are not true termination reactions, but are transfer reactions, when the eliminated species can re-initiate a new chain, as in reaction (5).
@@CH2 aC CH3 2 ;

SO3 H ! @@CH2 aCCH3 bCH2 H2 SO4

So, ionic polymerization oers the possibility, by proper choice of the reaction conditions, of running as a living polymerization. Living polymerization in its pure
form is dened not only by the absence of any termination reaction destroying
the active center, but also by the absence of any transfer reaction, so that the kinetic
chain length and the length of the individual chain are the same and increase linearly with conversion.
However, especially in many cationic systems, the active center may be preserved
throughout the reaction, but transfer reactions to other molecules such as monomers, polymers, solvent, and so on may stop the individual chain and initiate a
new growing chain [Eqs. (6)(8)].

- - -Pn M ! - - -Pn1

- - -Pn

T ! - - -Pn T

T  M ! - - -P1

propagation

transfer

re-initiation

So, the growth of the individual chains may be terminated by transfer reactions.
The active center itself is preserved, but a new chain is started. Thus, transfer reactions change the molecular weight of the polymer, but they do not change the concentration of active centers. The conversion kinetics is only changed by transfer reactions if the re-initiation is much slower than the propagation step.
Another dierence between free-radical and ionic polymerization that must also
be kept in mind is economic rather than scientic. Most of the monomers can be
polymerized by radical or ionic mechanisms (see Table 7.1), but in most cases the
requirement for purity of monomers and solvents in ionic polymerization is much
higher, and initiators are more expensive, so ionic polymerization is chosen only if
the monomers do not polymerize by a radical pathway, or if ionic polymerization
oers other advantages, such as access to molecular structures like block copolymers or specially designed molecular weight distributions.

7.2

Anionic Polymerization

Anionic polymerization involves a wide variety of reactions leading to high molecular weight molecules with the participation of an anionic species. The most
important systems are those for the anionic polymerization of diene rubbers [14

325

326

7 Ionic Polymerization
Tab. 7.1.

Monomers with dierent initiation mechanisms.

Monomers

Ethylene
a-Olens
1,1-Dialkyl olens
1,3-Dienes
Styrene, a-methylstyrene
Halogenated olens
Vinyl esters
Acrylates, methacrylates
Acrylonitrile, methacrylonitrile
Acrylamide, methacrylamide
Vinyl ethers
N-Vinylcarbazole
N-Vinylpyrrolidone
Aldehydes, ketones

Type of initiation
Radical

Cationic

Anionic




















16], styrenic polymers, and block copolymers of styrene and dienes [1721] as well
as the ring-opening polymerization of cyclic ethers, lactones, or lactams. Here especially, polymers from ethylene oxide and propylene oxide are important as base
materials for polyurethanes [2224].
7.2.1

Anionic Polymerization of Hydrocarbon Monomers Living Polymerization

There are two main reasons why anionic polymerization of hydrocarbon monomers such as styrene, a-methylstyrene, butadiene, isoprene, and so on has gained
scientic and industrial importance:


These monomers may be polymerized under such conditions that termination


and transfer reactions are absent, resulting in a so-called living polymerization.
 The microstructure of the polydienes so produced can be varied over a wide
range.
So the microstructure of dienes strongly depends on the counter ion (see Table
7.2.) and the solvent or the presence of additives, which are capable of shifting the
equilibrium in Eq. (3) from the right to the left (see Table 7.3.). An attempt to rationalize the inuence of polar additives on the microstructure is given in Ref. 25.
Generally, the vinyl content increases with the fraction of free ions.
Association Behavior/Kinetics
There are numerous publications [1, 5, 6] dealing with the equilibrium of Eq. (3)
between free ions as one extreme possibility for the structure of the initiating and/
7.2.1.1

7.2 Anionic Polymerization


Tab. 7.2. Microstructure of polybutadienes produced in hydrocarbon solvent with dierent
counter ions (from [25a]).

Alkali metal

cis-1,4 [ %]

trans-1,4 [ %]

1,2 [ %]

Li
Na
K
Rb
Cs

35
10
15
7
6

52
25
40
31
35

13
65
45
62
59

or polymerizing species, and aggregation of more or less covalently bonded species


as the other extreme. All these species may participate in the polymerization, and
the rates for the same reaction may dier by several orders of magnitude depending on the species involved. For example, the propagation rate coecient for
anionic polymerization of styrene in THF at 25 C is 8  10 4 M1 s1 for the free
ion, 200 M1 s1 for the ion pair [26], and values of 0.0155 and 0.024 M0:5 s1
are reported [27, 28] for the overall propagation rate coecient k p  K 1=2 of the
equilibrium system from monomeric and dimeric polystyryllithium in benzene
and cyclohexane.
In particular, the question of association in lithium-based polymerization in nonpolar solvents, one of the most important industrial systems, and the determination of the kinetic scheme and parameters, are still under debate. In general, the
association behavior is formulated as in Eq. (9), where n gives the association number, which generally is between 2 and 6, depending on the structure of P (monomer or initiator), solvent, and temperature (see Table 7.4).
K ass

PaLin !
 nPaLi

Tab. 7.3. Vinyl content of polybutadienes produced in hydrocarbon solvent with butyllithium as
initiator with dierent additives (from [28a]).

Additive

Molar ratio additive/lithium

1,2 [ %]

Diethyl ether
Diethyl ether
THF
THF
THF
Diglyme
Diglyme
Diglyme

10:1
5:1
6:1
3:1
1:1
4:1
2:1
1:1

16
10
43
25
17
87
85
78

327

328

7 Ionic Polymerization
Tab. 7.4.

Association number for dierent Li organyls.[a]

Li alkyl

Solvent

n-BuLi

benzene
cyclohexane
THF
cyclohexane
benzene
THF
benzene
hexane
cyclohexane
benzene
THF
benzene
cyclohexane
hexane
benzene
hexane
cyclohexane
cyclohexane
benzene
hexane

66.3
6
22.8
4
4
1.1
4
4
2
2
1
2
2
2
2
2
24
24.3
23.7
2

sec-BuLi

t-BuLi
Menthyl-Li
Benzyl-Li
Poly(styryl)-Li

Poly(isoprenyl)-Li

Poly(butadienyl)-Li

[a] Compilation

of data given in Ref. 6, pp. 16, 20, 138.

With the assumption that association is high and the concentration of the monomeric species is low, the concentration of the monomeric species is given by Eq.
(10), where PaLi is either the initiating lithium alkyl or the propagating species.

PaLi

K ass
PaLi0
n

1=n
10

Assuming that the associated species are not reactive, or at least they are much less
reactive than the non-associated one, the reaction rates for initiation and propagation are given by Eq. (11), where k is either ki or k p.


K ass 1=n
1=n
1=n
r kPaLiM k
PaLi0 M kobs PaLi0 M
n

11

This correlation of the association number with the reciprocal of the reaction order
may be too simple. Extensive discussions on this subject are summarized in Refs.
1, 5, 6, and 2933. Here, just an overview of the various interpretations is given
without trying to judge which is the right one, but in every case of ionic polymerization, when one is trying to set up a realistic mechanistic process model, similar
questions must be answered. Therefore the anionic polymerization of hydrocarbon
monomers in hydrocarbon solvents, which is one of the best-investigated anionic

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

systems, is used here as an example to point out which aspects may become important for reactor and process layout.
One reason for the debate is the high sensitivity of ionic systems to impurities,
which may cause experimental errors leading to various interpretations of the data.
However, from a mechanistic point of view also there are arguments that this simple correlation does not seem to be a general rule. For styrene with t-butyllithium
initiation is reported to be independent of monomer concentration [34]; for dienes
various orders are reported with dierences between fractional reaction order and
degree of aggregation (see Table 7.1 in Ref. 6). Furthermore, cross-aggregation between initiating and propagating species is likely to occur and must be considered, as well as intermediate equilibria between hexamers, tetramers, dimers, and
monomers. In Ref. 35 this problem is addressed for the cross-association of styryland butadienyllithium. There are a number of recent publications reporting much
higher association numbers of up to 100 and more [3639], which are under discussion [40, 41]. Bywater discussed [42, 43] the diculties in separating K ass and
k p . Nevertheless, there are some reports on the separate determination of K ass ,
[4447], which however are contradictory. With the exception of those in Ref. 47,
most of the data are from investigations at rather low temperatures (< 30 C) compared to industrial conditions, which are at considerably higher temperatures (60
100 C). So, extrapolating the association behavior from low to higher temperatures
may cause errors.
In addition it must be stated that Eq. (10) is only valid if the concentration of
non-associated species is low. Otherwise the equilibrium of Eq. (9) must be considered a priori: for example, for n 2 in the case of styrene, the concentration of
non-associated PaLi is given by Eq. (12).
s


K ass
K ass 2 K ass
12

PaLi0
PaLi 
4
4
2
Figure 7.1 gives the temperature dependence of K ass and k p for styrene from Ref.
44. When the fraction a of non-associated polystyryllithium is calculated with the

10000000

1000

-1

K ass / M

kp / M s

10

10

-1

10000

0.01

0.1

0.00001
0.00000001
0.0025

0.003

0.0035

0.001
0.004

1/T / 1/K

Fig. 7.1.

Association equilibrium constant K ass and propagation rate constant k p as f T [44].

329

7 Ionic Polymerization
10

330

0.1

0.01

0.001
0.000001

0.0001

Kass / M

0.01

Fraction a of non-associated species as a function


of K ass for dimerization for various polystyryllithium
concentrations (b, 0.0001 M; , 0.001 M; , 0.01 M). Broken
lines: exact solution according to Eq. (12); full lines:
approximate solution according to Eq. (10).
Fig. 7.2.

simplication in Eq. (10) and the correct solution in Eq. (12), Figure 7.2 shows that
there may be considerable deviations for values of K ass 105 M and higher. So,
for industrial temperatures the fraction of associated species may be rather low
and a rst-order kinetic law with respect to lithium concentration may result [10,
33].
Table 7.5 gives some examples of the temperature dependence of the propagation rate coecient for Li-initiated styrene polymerization according to Eq. (11)
with n 2. From Figure 7.3 it can be seen that there are deviations of one order
of magnitude between the results of dierent authors, even when considering the
same solvent and a rather limited temperature range of 460 C. In Ref. 48 data for
styrene and butadiene are given up to 70 C assuming n 2 for styrene and n 2
or 4 for butadiene. More diculties will arise when extrapolating to higher temperatures and tackling the problem of temperature dependence of the association behavior. In Ref. 10 an attempt is made to describe the propagation over a wider tem-

Literature values for propagation rate coecient kp0 k p K=2 0:5 for Li-initiated
styrene polymerization in hydrocarbon solvents.
Tab. 7.5.

kOp; 0 [MC0:5 sC1 ]

Ea [kJ molC1 ]

Solvent

Temperature [ C]

Ref.

4:5  10 8
2:6  10 9
2:9  10 11
5:2  10 8
5:1  10 7
6:8  10 8

60.3
64.0
78.6
60.3
56.9
63.6

none
none
cyclohexane
benzene
toluene
toluene

2050
421
3050
1030
2050
3060

49
50
51
27
52
53

7.2 Anionic Polymerization


1
acc. to [49]
acc. to [50]
acc. to [51]
acc. to [27]
acc. to [53]
acc. to [52]

0.01

1/2

kp K / M s

-1 -1

0.1

0.001

0.0001
0.003

0.0031

0.0032

0.0033

0.0034

1/T / K

-1

0.0035

0.0036

0.0037

Fig. 7.3. Comparison of literature values for propagation rate


coecient kp0 k p K=2 0:5 for lithum-initiated styrene
polymerization in hydrocarbon solvents.

perature range, from 10 C up to 100 C, with k p 1  10 11 e7900=T M1 s1 and
K 3:2  10 38 e27600=T M according to Eq. (12), which collapses to a simple rstorder kinetic with respect to initiator above 40 C.
There is no judgment on the quality of the various results, but this overview can
serve as an example for the diculties in ionic polymerization kinetics in general,
and careful checking of literature kinetic data is strongly recommended before they
are used for reactor layout.
This somewhat extensive discussion on the association behavior of lithiuminitiated polymerization, the best-investigated ionic system, shows the diculties
in kinetic modeling of ionic polymerization. Contrary to free-radical polymerization, the existence of all possible dierent species must be considered for every system under investigation.
Molecular Weight Distribution of Living Polymers
The living nature of the anionic polymerization of hydrocarbon monomers has
been revealed by Szwarc [54, 55]. There is still an ongoing debate on the exact definition of living polymerization [5, 6, 5557]. For the scope of this chapter we will
refer pragmatically to living polymers if the active end groups of the individual
chains retain the propensity of growth for at least as long a period as needed for
the completion of the intended synthesis [5]: that is, initiation and propagation
[(Eqs. (13) and (14)] are the only reactions, irreversible termination and transfer reactions being absent.
7.2.1.2

331

332

7 Ionic Polymerization

I M ! P1

initiation

13


P1 M ! Pi1

propagation

14

In the sense of this denition, the associated species discussed above can also be
called living, even if they do not participate in a propagation reaction, but they are
in equilibrium with the active non-associated species on a much shorter time scale
than the overall reaction. For simplicity, in the following discussion the association
is not considered explicitly, but if it is known quantitatively it can be considered by
making the rate coecients a function of [PaLi].
From the reactions in Eqs. (13) and (14), the set of dierential equations (15)
(20) can be derived.


dI 
k i I M
dt

15

y
X
dM
k i I M k p M
Pi  RP
dt
i1

16

dP1 
k i I M k p P1 M
dt

17

dPi 
k p Pi1 M k p Pi M
dt

18

y
X

Pi  I 0  I 

19

iPi  M0  M

20

i1
y
X
i1

For fast initiation (k i g k p ), all initiator is transferred to growing chains immediately, so monomer conversion and the kinetic chain length are given by Eqs. (21)
(23).
M M0 ek p I 0 t

21

M0  M M0  M0 ekP I 0 t


M0

xM
I 0
I 0
I 0

22

Pi  I 0

23

n
with
y
X
i1

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

The resulting frequency distribution hi of chain lengths i can be derived by solving the system of dierential equations sequentially starting with P1 t0 I 0
and the denition of the kinetic chain length given above [Eq. (24)].
Pi 
Pi  ni1 en

hi X

i  1!
Pi  I 0

24

The weight distribution is given by Eq. (25).


wi

ni1 en
i  1!n 1

25

The average number- and weight-average degrees of polymerization and the polydispersity for this Poisson distribution are given by Eqs. (26)(28).
Pn

M0  M
1n
I 0

Pw 1 n
D

26

n
A 1 Pn
1n

27

Pw
A1
Pn

28

If, however, k i g k p does not hold, meaning if the initiation rate coecient is in
the order of k p or even less, there is no immediate conversion of initiator to growing chains and the simplication of Eq. (23) becomes invalid and must be replaced
by Eq. (19). The solution for this general case is given in Refs. 58 and 59. From
Eqs. (15) and (16), the variation of monomer conversion as a function of initiator
conversion is given by Eq. (29) with r k p =k i > 1.
M  M0 1  rI   I 0 rI 0 ln

I 
I 0

29

The variation of M and I with time cannot be solved analytically in this case, but
must be found numerically. The frequency and weight distributions of the socalled Gold distribution are given by Eqs. (30) and (31), with R r  1, q r=R
and u r  1 lnI 0 =I . The averages of this distribution are given by Eqs.
(32) and (33).

hi

Ni 

y
X
Ni 
i1

 i
y
r qu X
uj
e
R
j!
ji
r1  eu=R

30

333

7 Ionic Polymerization

wi





y
iNi 
r i ru=r1 X
uj
ru
u=R
e

1

r1

e
y
X
r1
R
j!
ji
iNi 

31

i1

1  r1  eu=r1
Pn

ru
r1

32

1  eu=r1

ru 1  ru
2ru 2r  1r  11  eu=r1
r

1
r

1
Pw
ru
1  r1  eu=r1
r1

33

A Poisson distribution will also result when using bifunctional initiators [60], with
the peak maximum at 2M0 =I 0 . Figure 7.4 gives a comparison of the Poisson distribution for n 50 (k i > k p ), the Gold distribution for (k i < k p , r k p =k i 100),
and the SchulzFlory or most probable distribution resulting from step growth polymerization or free-radical polymerization with termination by disproportionation.
This most probable distribution is given by Eq. (34), where p is the conversion of
end groups in step growth polymerizations or polycondensation or the probability
of propagation in chain growth polymerization.
hi p i1 1  p

(34)

The width of the distributions reects the sharpness of the initiation reaction; with
k i > k p all chains start at the same time and the distribution is very narrow, just
reecting some statistics of monomer addition. If chain initiation is delayed for
some chains (k i < k p ), the distribution is skewed and will become narrower if reac-

0.06
0.05

Poisson

0.04

h(i)

334

0.03

Gold

0.02

Schulz-Flory

0.01
0
0

50

100

150

i
Fig. 7.4. Comparison of various distributions for Pn 51:
SchulzFlory distribution with p 0:98, Pw 102; Gold
distribution with r k p =k i 100, u 86:513, Pw 64; and
Poisson distribution for n 50. The corresponding weightaverages are 102, 64, and 52.

200

7.2 Anionic Polymerization


1.4

1
0.8

1.3

xM

0.6
1.2
0.4
1.1

0.2

0
0

0.2

0.4

0.6

0.8

xI

Polydispersity D and monomer conversion xM as a


function of initiator conversion xI for r 10 (full lines) and
r 100 (broken lines) according to Eqs. (29), (32), and (33).
I0 0:101 M, M0 3 M. Number- and weight-averages at
xM 1 are 31 and 34 for r 10, and 51 and 64 for r 100.
Fig. 7.5.

tion proceeds and more chains will be initiated and propagate. The broadest distribution is the most probable distribution if, as in step growth polymerization, there
is no initiation but only chain propagation.
Slow initiation has some important consequences, which are shown in Figure
7.5. The monomer may be consumed before initiator conversion is complete. This
may be important when using functionalization techniques or synthesizing block
copolymers. Moreover, the polydispersity may be considerably higher than 1, the
value which is usually assumed to be typical for living polymerization and used as
a criterion for livingness.
Besides the reactivity ratio r, the equilibrium between dierent species
associated and non-associated ones or free ions and ion pairs, active and dormant
species which may have dierent reactivities in propagation reactions, can also
have an impact on broadening the molecular weight distribution [6173].
The MWD discussion up to now has concerned batch reactors, but there are also
a number of publications dealing with other reactors. In ideal plug ow reactors
under steady-state conditions, polymers with the same characteristics of the MWD
as in batch reactors are built the time axis is transformed to the length axis of the
plug ow reactor [74, 75], and for fast initiation the MWD is a Poisson distribution.
For laminar plug ow reactors [75, 76] some broadening of the distribution is observed, depending on M0 =I 0 and conversion. The long-term stability of laminar
ow tubular reactors is questioned [76], because of the possibility of very long
chains growing near the reactor walls, where the residence time approaches innity, if radial diusion of the monomer occurs from the inner tube to the walls.
The MWD resulting from semi-batch operations of a stirred tank reactor with
monomer feed under various conditions is treated in Refs. 7782. In a homogeneous continuous stirred tank reactor (HCSTR), the steady-state concentrations of
monomer and initiator can be derived from the monomer and initiator mass bal-

335

336

7 Ionic Polymerization

ance, neglecting volume changes, by Eqs. (35) and (36), which must be solved simultaneously. Mf and I f are the feed concentrations, V is the reactor volume,
and vin; I ; vin; M are the volume feed ows of initiator and monomer.
vin; M
Mf t
V
M
k i I  kP k i M 2 I t 2 M

35

vin; I
I f t
I  V
k i Mt 1

36

In a CSTR, the narrow Poisson distribution resulting from the chemistry is superimposed by the broad residence time distribution of the HCSTR chains can leave
the reactor after seconds of growth as very short chains, but there are also chains
which reside in the reactor for very long time, growing to very long molecules. This
results in a SchulzFlory distribution [83] [Eqs. (37)(40)], where t is the mean
residence time and [M] is the steady state-monomer concentration.

j1
1=t
kP M
h j
kP Mt 1=t kP M 1=t

w j j

1=t
kP Mt 1=t

2 

37
j1

kP M
kP M 1=t

38

Pn 1 kP Mt

39

Pw 1 2kP Mt

40

Equation (37) is equivalent to Eq. (34) with the propagation probability given by Eq.
(41).
p

kP M
kP M 1=t

41

In a segregated stirred tank reactor (SCSTR) [74] the width of the distribution
ranges from that of an HCSTR for rather low conversion or mean residence time,
up to a value approaching that of a batch reactor for high conversions or long
mean residence times. The inuence of termination, chain transfer, and longchain branching in batch and CSTR reactors is described in Refs. 84 and 85.
Side Reactions
Pure living polymerization of hydrocarbon monomers usually occurs at low temperatures, where side reactions are not important. At higher temperatures, however, two side reactions do become important, elimination of LiH and transfer to
compounds with an acidic hydrogen [5, 6, 31, 86, 87].
7.2.1.3

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

337

There have been some investigations on the stability of alkyllithium derivatives and of growing chains. Generally, linear alkyllithiums are more stable than
branched ones, with rst-order decomposition half-lives of 16 h at 8798 C
[88, 89]. From Ref. 89, k tt 1:0  10 10 exp11798=T s1 for s-BuLi and k tt
9:5  10 10 exp13407=T s1 for n-BuLi can be evaluated. As with all rate coecients of ionic polymerization, this elimination also depends on the reaction system. The lithium hydride (LiH) elimination from butyllithium in the presence of
polar additives such as lithium butoxide is reported to be several times faster than
from pure lithium alkyl [90, 91], and in ethereal solvents proton abstraction or
ether cleavage may occur [92].
Growing chains such as polydienyl- and polystyryllithium are less stable. For
polystyryllithium, the LiH elimination is followed by proton transfer to another
polystyryllithium [93], resulting in an allylic anion, which is unable to propagate (see Scheme 7.1). The same holds for polystyrylsodium [94]. Quantitative
data for LiH elimination are given in Refs. 13 (k tt 295  e5280=T s1 ) and 10
(k tt 3:92  10 6 e8700=T ). In Ref. 95 the inuence of THF was investigated, but
rather similar values were obtained (k tt 2:4  10 6 e8459=T ). It must be noted
that these termination reactions are much slower than propagation, that is to say
the half-life for the active chains is much higher (hours) than the half-life for propagation (seconds) at temperatures of 80 C and higher.

Bu

Li

Bu

k tt

LiH

Li
Bu
+

PsLi

i
Scheme 7.1.

Bu

Termination in anionic polymerization of styrene.

Polybutadienyllithium is somewhat more stable than polystyryllithium (k tt


6:7  105 s1 versus 1:9  104 s1 at 93 C [13]), but contrary to styrene, the side
reactions here may cause coupled and branched polymers [9598].
The other class of important side reactions is transfer to compounds with acidic
hydrogen atoms, such as toluene, ethyl benzene and so on (Scheme 7.2).
Some quantitative data have been given for chain transfer from polystyryllithium
to aromatic solvents [10, 33, 47, 99101], and from polydienyllithium to alkenes
[102, 103] and toluene, and for the inuence of polar additives [104]. There is usually no eect on the polymerization rate, because the number of active chain ends

PsH

338

7 Ionic Polymerization

Bu

Li

Li

Bu
+

k tr

+
i
Li

Li
+

kp

1
Scheme 7.2.

Transfer to ethylbenzene in anionic polymerization of styrene.

is maintained, but the chain length of the macromolecules, that is, the molecular
weight, is reduced. The presence of transfer reactions limits the production of
block copolymers by sequential addition of monomers to the living chains. However, in Refs. 33 and 99 it is pointed out that the presence of transfer reactions
may be advantageous, for example, for homopolymerzation of styrene in a CSTR,
because they reduce the amount of initiator necessary to get the desired molecular
weight.
The eect of side reactions, such as termination by monomer, impurities, or
spontaneous termination and transfer to monomer or impurities, on the molecular
weight distribution are dealt with in Refs. 66 and 105119; they generally result in
some broadening of the distribution.
Copolymerization
The most important copolymers are those from styrene and butadiene, either as
statistical copolymers or block copolymers. From a kinetic point of view the association behavior discussed above becomes even more complex because of the
possible cross-association between the dierent growing chain ends. This issue has
seldom been addressed [35, 120].
But in spite of this complex association behavior, in most cases the simple Mayo
terminal model [Eq. (42)] with two copolymerization parameters, which was developed originally for free-radical polymerization, is in many cases sucient to describe anionic copolymerization also.
7.2.1.4

F1

r1 f12 f1 f2
2f1 f2 r2 f22

r1 f12

42

However, there is one important dierence between free-radical and living anionic
polymerization, and this is the lifetime of the growing chain. This dierence becomes important when considering the dependence of copolymer composition on
conversion. Equation (42) gives the copolymer composition or mole fraction F1 of
monomer M1 in the polymer as a function of mole fraction f1 in the monomer

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

feed for incremental conversion. Because of the dierent reactivity of the monomers, usually f1 and consequently F1 change with increasing conversion.
In free-radical polymerization, where the lifetime of the growing polymer chain
is in the order of seconds or less, compared to hours for the overall polymerization
reaction, and where new chains are initiated throughout the overall reaction time
by decomposition of radical initiators such as peroxides or azo compounds, those
chains which are initiated at dierent times or levels of conversion will dier in
their composition, but those which are initiated at the same time will have the
same composition. This dierence in composition from chain to chain is called
rst-order chemical heterogeneity.
If, however, as in living polymerization, all chains start at the same time and live
throughout the polymerization, every chain will see all the changes in monomer
feed composition, and consequently the composition will change along the chain
and not from chain to chain. This is known as second-order chemical heterogeneity. The dierences between these two kinds of heterogeneities, one between
dierent chains, the other within dierent fractions of one chain, are shown in
Scheme 7.3.

Increasing conversion

First-order chemical heterogeneity

I-BBBBBSBB

I-BBBBBSBB
I-SBSBSSBS

I-BBBBBSBB
I-SBSBSSBS
I-SSSSBSSS

Second-order chemical heterogeneity


R-BBBBBSBB-Li

R-BBBBBSBBSBSBSSBS-Li

R-BBBBBSBBSBSBSSBSSSSSSSSS-Li

Scheme 7.3. Chemical heterogeneity with increasing


conversion for free-radical (rst-order) and living
polymerization (second-order).

The severity of the chemical heterogeneity strongly depends on the copolymerization parameters. In free-radical polymerization there is just one pair of parameters, which may depend somewhat on temperature, for one pair of monomers;
whereas in ionic polymerization these parameters for every pair of monomers
strongly depend on the counter ion and solvent polarity (see Table 7.6).
These extreme values have a very drastic eect on the shift not only in composition but also in rates. Taking the absolute rate coecients given by Ohlinger
[35] for Li-initiated copolymerization of butadiene and styrene at 20 C in toluene
(kSS 0:45, kSB 110, kBB 0:084, kBS 0:0066 M1 s1 ), the resulting overall

339

7 Ionic Polymerization
Tab. 7.6. Copolymerization parameters for Li-initiated copolymerization of styrene ( M1 ) and
butadiene ( M2 ).[a]

T [ C]

Solvent

r1

r2

25
20
30
50
30
78
0
25
25

bulk
toluene
benzene
cyclohexane
heptane
THF
THF
THF
diethyl ether

0.04
0.004
0.035
0.025
0.1
11
0.2
0.3
0.4

11.2
12.9
10
15.1
7
0.04
5.3
4
1.7

[a] Examples

taken from Ref. 6, p. 247.

conversion versus time curves are given in Figures 7.6 and 7.7. The interesting feature is that even though the homopolymerization of styrene is faster than that of
butadiene, during copolymerization nearly all the butadiene is consumed at a
lower rate than in homopolymerization before styrene is incorporated to any appreciable extent, and after the butadiene is consumed the overall polymerization rate
becomes that of pure styrene.

1
xS = 1
0.8

xS = 0
xS = 0.35

conversion

340

0.6
xS = 0.5
0.4

xS = 0.65

0.2

0
0

5000

10000

15000

20000

t/s

Batch copolymerization of styrene and butadiene with


n-butyllithium (1 g) at 20 C in toluene (10 kg) with various
styrene feed fractions xS (20 mol monomer overall). Simulation
of overall conversion with data from Ref. 35.
Fig. 7.6.

25000

30000

7.2 Anionic Polymerization


0.8

x S = 0.65
0.6

xS inpolymer

x S = 0.5

0.4

x S = 0.35

0.2

0
0

5000

10000

15000

20000

25000

30000

t/s

Fig. 7.7. Batch copolymerization of styrene and butadiene with


n-butyllithium (1 g) at 20 C in toluene (10 kg) with various
styrene feed fractions xS (20 moles monomer overall).
Simulation of mole fraction of styrene in copolymer with data
from Ref. 35.

The reason is that kSB has a high value and kBS has a low value. This combination is responsible for nearly all chain ends existing as butadienyllithium ends,
which predominantly propagate by addition of butadiene (kBB > kBS ). If one of the
occasional propagation reactions by addition of styrene gives a styryllithium chain
end, there will be a very fast addition of butadiene to regenerate butadienyllithium
ends. Thus, in a batch copolymerization, very few styrene units are incorporated
into the chains during the rst part of the reaction and they exist as isolated units.
Incorporation of styrene will increase only when nearly all the butadiene is consumed. Overall, therefore, there is a block of nearly pure butadiene with some isolated styrene units, followed by a rather short block where styrene and butadiene
are incorporated at almost the same rates a so-called tapered block, followed by
a nal block of nearly pure styrene (see Scheme 7.3). From Table 7.6 one can see
that a similar but reverse situation is valid in polar solvents; here styrene is consumed rst and then butadiene, but again a copolymer with nearly pure blocks of
homopolymer will result.
Tailor-made Polymers by Living Polymerization Optimization
Anionic living polymerization oers a unique opportunity for tailor-made polymers
because all the chains and their living ends are accessible throughout the course of
the reaction. In general, there are two important tasks in tailoring polymers: one
concerns their chemical distribution and the other the molecular weight distribution.
7.2.1.5

341

342

7 Ionic Polymerization

The structure of copolymers in terms of composition or sequence length distribution may vary between two extremes copolymers with a very high level of
chemical heterogeneity within each chain, and homogeneous copolymers with the
comonomer units randomly distributed along the chain.
The various pathways to block copolymers are described in a number of reviews
and monographs [6, 121127]. In principle, block copolymers are accessible by sequential addition of monomers to either monofunctional or bifunctional [128, 129]
initiators (see Scheme 7.4, where the route from a monofunctional initiator to
a three-block copolymer is shown as an example). The amount of undesired byproducts homopolymers or di-block copolymers depends on the reactivity ratios
relative to propagation given in the scheme. These are obviously the ratios for
transfer and termination at higher temperatures, but also the ratios for initiation
and the cross-propagation reactions. From Figure 7.5 and Eq. (29) it can be seen
that the monomer for forming one block may be consumed before the initiator or
the ends of the previously formed block are completely transferred to the ends of
the new block, and so the yield of tri-block copolymers is reduced.

Reactivity ratios
i
for side reactions

R-Li

ki
k p,S

+nS

SSSSSS

R-So-L
-Li + R-Li
-L

k S Bu
k p , Bu

+ m Bu

R-So-Bup-L
-L + R-Li
-Li + R-Buq-Li

k Bu S
k p ,S

k tt
k p ,i

SSSSBBBBB + BBBBB

k tr
k p ,i

+lS

R-So-Bup -Sr Li + R-Buq-Ss-Li + R-S


- t-Li
Scheme 7.4.

Dead chains

SSSSBBB +
SSSSBBBSSSS

Pathway to SBS tri-block copolymer and possible side products.

The optimal production of tri-block copolymers in a series of CSTRs, where the


reactors are operated in an isokinetic way, is described in Ref. 130.
To produce a copolymer with a more random structure in spite of the extreme
values of the copolymerization parameters, there are several possibilities. One is

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

to use small amounts of polar additives such as THF, ethers, alkoxides, and so on
as modiers [131, 132], to bring the extreme r-values nearer to unity. Another obvious method is to polymerize in a continuous stirred tank reactor, where there is
no shift in composition. For the steady state, the copolymerization equation can
be written as a function of feed (index 0) and reactor concentrations [Eq. (43)].
M1 0  M1 

M2 0  M2 

M1 
1
M2 
M2 
1
r2
M1 

r1

43

A third possibility is model-based feed control [133], where butadiene is fed to a


mixture of styrene and butadiene in such a way that a certain monomer ratio is
maintained.
The other important task is to tailor the molecular weight distribution of the
polymer, and especially for this task the livingness in anionic polymerization is
advantageous [134]. Optimized reactor operations for broadened or bimodal distributions in a tubular reactor are described in Refs. 135 and 136. Semi-batch operation with a programmed initiator feed [137, 138] and oscillating feeds to homogeneous CSTRs oer the possibility of a wide range of MWDs [139144].
Industrial Aspects Production of Living Polymers
In general, the requirements for purity of the reagents, solvents, and monomers
are much higher in anionic polymerization than in free-radical polymerization.
Necessary distillations and/or adsorption towers, often with activated aluminum,
increase the costs for feed preparation compared to free-radical processes.
Anionic polymerization of styrene has attracted much attention during recent
years and several publications and patents have been published on this issue. The
main reason for this interest is the high rate of polymerization which can be
achieved compared to free-radical polymerization, and the low content of residual
styrene and oligomers in the nal polymer [145147].
There are several concepts for an anionic process, which in many cases are operated in an adiabatic or at least non-isothermal mode. Some are using recirculated
loop reactors [148151] or single-pass tubular reactors [75, 152, 153], which may
be segmented [154]. A spray tower [155] has a similar residence time distribution,
but heat removal is by a countercurrent nitrogen stream. Boiling CSTRs are described in Refs. 33 and 156. One problem seems to be fouling or gel formation in
regions of the reactor where the ow of living chains is limited [76].
Polybutadiene rubbers are produced either with transition metal catalysts to give
high-cis-butadiene rubber or with lithium alkyls to give medium-cis-butadiene
rubber (see Table 7.7). The latter is mainly used as the rubber component in the
production of HIPS (high impact polystyrene).
These rubbers are generally produced in aliphatic solvents [6, 157159] in a
CSTR or a series of CSTRs. The vinyl content, which is usually about 10% in aliphatic solvents, can be varied by the addition of polar compounds (see Table 7.3)
over a wide range.
7.2.1.6

343

344

7 Ionic Polymerization
Tab. 7.7. Microstructure of polybutadienes produced in hydrocarbon solvent with dierent
catalyst systems.

Catalyst

cis-1,4 [ %]

trans-1,4 [ %]

1,2 [ %]

Nd
Co
Ni
Ti
Li

98
96
96
93
36

1
2
3
3
52

1
2
1
4
12

Copolymers from styrene and butadiene (SBRs) with a more or less random comonomer distribution are produced either in an emulsion polymerization process
(cold or hot E-SBR), a free-radical polymerization, which however gives crosslinked
polymers, or in a solution process using lithium initiators (S-SBR). There are continuous processes [157, 158, 160166] as well as (semi-) batch processes (167, 168)
with a controlled feed of butadiene [133, 169] to maintain a constant monomer ratio. Randomizers are often used [131, 170] to control the comonomer distribution.
Block copolymers and also star-shaped [171] block copolymers from styrene and
dienes are generally produced batch-wise with the monomers added in appropriate
sequences. These sequences depend on the functionality of the initiator (mono- or
bifunctional initiators) [172175], on the use of coupling agents [176, 177], and on
the sharpness of the transition between the various blocks. Another reason for apportioning the monomer feed is the limited heat removal capacity of the reactor.
7.2.2

Anionic Polymerization of Vinyl Monomers Containing Heteroatoms

The possibilities of living polymerization described above have always attracted researchers toward extending this technique to other vinyl monomers such as acrylates (i), methacrylates (ii), cyanoacrylates (iii), nitriles (iv), and vinyl aldehydes or
ketones (v) (see Scheme 7.5). However, almost no industrial applications have

CH3

CN

COOR

COOR

COOR

ii

iii

CN

COR

iv
Scheme 7.5.

v
Monomers with heteroatoms for anionic polymerization.

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

been developed up to now for this group of monomers. Some overviews can be
found in Refs. 5 and 7. An interesting example of the application of these monomers are the cyanoacrylates, which can be polymerized by very weak bases such as
water or skin proteins and which are used as superglues.
The reason for this deciency in application is the presence of side reactions,
which can only be suppressed by proper selection of the structure of the monomer
itself and the reaction conditions, especially the polymerization temperature. The
propagating center in the anionic polymerization of (meth)acrylates is the ester
enolate anion, which is formed according to Eq. (44).

CH3

COOMe

A CH2

44

OMe

H3C

The most important side reaction is the attack at the ester group, which can be
inter- or intramolecular [Eqs. (45) and (46)].
H

CH3

COOMe

CH3

CH3

CH3
OMe
O

H3C

45

CH3

CH2

OMe

O
MeO

Me

COR

CH3

CH2

O
H3C

+ HC O
3

O
OMe

OMe

46

Another side reaction is the enolization of acrylate polymer chains [Eq. (47)].
H
A

CH2 C
COOR

CH2 C

AH

47

COOR

Whether these side reactions are termination or transfer reactions depends on the
ability of the anions to re-initiate the polymerization and on the fate of the vinyl
ketone formed in Eq. (45). Generally, this vinyl ketone is rapidly incorporated into
the chain, and a relatively unreactive dormant end group is produced. The alkoxide
from reactions such as Eq. (45) is usually not reactive enough to initiate another
chain.
These side reactions can be suppressed to some extent at temperatures below
0 C, which make them hardly accessible in industrial applications. The t-butyl
group is reported to prevent side reactions. In general, the kinetic formalism for
the heteroatom-containing monomers is the same as that described in Section

345

346

7 Ionic Polymerization

7.2.2, but side reactions are more important. Some recent developments in the polymerization of these monomers have been described in Refs. 178 and 179, and
these papers also cover the relevant mechanistic literature.
However, the anionic polymerization of (meth)acrylate monomers has not yet
gained industrial importance.
7.2.3

Anionic Polymerization of Monomers Containing Hetero Double Bonds

Besides monomers containing carboncarbon double bonds, monomers with heteroatoms at the double bond can also be polymerized via an anionic mechanism.
The only monomer with some industrial importance is formaldehyde. It is polymerized [180] via its carbonoxygen double bond to give polyacetal homopolymer
or polyoxymethylene [Eq. (48)].
nCH2 O ! aCH2 aOan

48

The polymerization is a precipitation polymerization from gaseous formaldehyde


in an inert solvent such as cyclohexane at fairly low temperatures to prevent depolymerization reactions. Amines such as tri-n-butyl amine are used as initiators. The
polymer precipitates in the dispersing agent as powder. After completion of the
polymerization, it is necessary to stabilize the hydroxyl end groups, for example
by esterication with acetic anhydride to prevent the unzipping reaction of Eq.
(49).
aaCH2 aOan CH2 aOH ! aaCH2 aOan1 CH2 aOH CH2 O

49

7.2.4

Anionic Polymerization via Ring Opening

There are a number of heterocyclic monomers, for example, epoxides, cyclic suldes, lactones and lactides, lactams, cyclic carbonates, and cyclosiloxanes, which
can be polymerized by ring-opening reactions; many of them can be polymerized
by an anionic as well as by a cationic mechanism. They cannot all be covered here,
but there are a number of monographs and reviews on this subject [181185].
In polymerization via double bonds the driving force for chain growth is the energy dierence between one double and two single bonds, which in most cases is
high enough to overcome the loss in entropy when going from monomers to polymers. In ring-opening polymerization the number and nature of the bonds remain
the same, and there is just the release of ring strain to make chain growth of cyclic
monomers an exothermic reaction. The Gibbs free energy of polymerization DGP
is given in Eq. (50).
DGP DHP  TDSP

(50)

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

The equilibrium constant KP for the chain growth step Pi M ! Pi1 is dened in
Eq. (51) and the equilibrium monomer concentration Me in Eq. (52).
kp
Pi1 
1

A
kd Pi Me Me

KP

51

lnMe DHP  TDSP =RT

52

For monomer concentrations below this equilibrium concentration, no polymerization occurs. As for most polymers, the changes for entropy and enthalpy are both
negative (see Table 7.8), there exists a limiting temperature TC above which polymerization is thermodynamically forbidden. TC is given by Eq. (53), where the
standard state refers to unit concentration.
DHP
DHP0

0
DSP
DSP R lnM

TC

53

From Table 7.8 it can be seen that for most of the cyclic monomers, the reversibility of the propagation must be taken seriously into account. It has been shown
[186] that, even for a living polymerization without any termination or transfer re-

Tab. 7.8. Standard thermodynamic parameters for some cyclic monomers for anionic
polymerization [182].

Monomer
O

Atoms in ring

States [a]

DHp0 [kJ molC1 ]

DSp0 [ J molC1 KC1 ]

[M]e [M]

gc

140

174

4  1016

lc

82.4

74

3  1011

ss

14

13.5

1:6  102

lc

7.1

27.6

ss

22.9

41.1

lc

13.8

4.6

O
O
P

OMe

N
H

1.58

O
O

N
H

1:16  102

2:2  103

[a] State of monomer (rst letter) and polymer (second letter): g gaseous, l liquid, s solution, c
condensed.

347

7 Ionic Polymerization

action but where the propagation step is reversible, the limiting molecular weight
distribution is not a Poisson distribution but a most probable distribution with
D 2.
As the cyclic monomer and the linear polymer chain consist of the same bonds,
there are two further side reactions which are inherent to the system inter- and
intramolecular chain transfer to polymer (Scheme 7.6).

X
X

348

kinter
X
X

kintra
+

kp
X

Scheme 7.6.

Chain growth, inter- and intramolecular transfer in ring-opening polymerization.

By intermolecular chain transfer there is no change in Pn , because the number


of chains remains the same, but a scrambling of the molecular weight distribution
will occur, leading to the most probable MWD as a limiting distribution. Intramolecular chain transfer will lead to macrocycles, which also can participate in
propagation reactions. The equilibrium concentration according to the Jacobsen
Stockmayer theory [187] of these non-strained macrocycles of size n is given by
Eq. (54).
Mn e

kp n
A n5=2
k p n

54

The anionic polymerization of lactams [188, 189] is usually via a so-called activated
anionic mechanism with a two-component catalyst system from a strong base and
an N-acyllactam. It is interesting in the sense that the active center of the growing
chain is an N-acyllactam end group to which a lactamate anion, formed from the
monomer, is added (Scheme 7.7). First, there is H-abstraction from the monomer
to give the lactamate anion. In principle, this anion could add to another lactam
molecule, but this step is rather slow. Instead it will add much faster to the Nacyllactam activator. A subsequent proton transfer gives the active N-acyllactam
end group and the lactamate anion is regenerated. The chain propagation consists
of the same sequence of elementary reactions.
This activated anionic polymerization is living in the sense that the number of
active centers is preserved; but the inevitable intermolecular chain transfer to poly-

7.2 Anionic Polymerization

349

initiation
H O
N

O
+

O
R

H O
N

O H O
N

propagation
O H O
N
*

O
+

O
*

O H O
N

O H O
N

N
n

Scheme 7.7.

O
+

H O
N

O H O
N

O
NH

O
+

Activated anionic mechanism for ring-opening polymerization of lactams.

mer, here the transamidation, together with the propagationdepropagation of the


cyclic monomer and macrocycles, will broaden the molecular weight distribution
[189].
This polymerization has attracted much attention because it is very fast compared to the hydrolytic polymerization of e-caprolactam, which takes several hours,
whereas the anionic polymerization is complete within minutes, even below the
melting point of the polymer. However, no large-scale process is known [190,
191]. The anionic polymerization of caprolactam is described in melt in extruders
[192, 193], in direct polymerization to bers [194] and in casting and RIM processes [195]. The latter processes, particularly, are performed below the melting
temperature, so the equilibrium monomer (and oligomer) concentration is
much lower (13%) compared to the hydrolytic polymerization (1012%), where
a monomer extraction step is necessary.
The polymerization of ethylene oxide was one of the rst living polymerizations
[196]. Polymers from oxiranes, polyoxyalkylenes, are used in a wide range of mo-

7 Ionic Polymerization

350

lecular weights and applications [2224]. The most important ones are rather low
molecular weight polymers, which are used either as nonionic surfactants [197] or
as raw materials for polyurethanes [23, 24].
Scheme 7.8 is a general reaction scheme for the copolymerization of ethylene
oxide and propylene oxide with multifunctional alcohols as initiators.
OH

OH
OH + KOH

HO
OH

O K

HO

OK

OK

OK

OK

O K

+ H2O
initiatior formation

OH

HO

OK

OK

OK

OK

copolymerization
EO / PO

R
OK

H2O

OH

R
O

O K

HO

R
nO K

Termination

H2 O

mOH

R
n OH +

mO K

chain transfer
Scheme 7.8.

Anionic ring-opening copolymerization of ethylene and propylene oxide.

Usually potassium alkoxides, often from multifunctional alcohols, are used as


initiators. They are formed in a separate step starting from the respective alcohol
and potassium hydroxide. The resulting water must be removed to ensure maximum conversion to the potassium alkoxide. Remaining water will terminate growing chains, forming hydroxyl end groups. Chains with alkoxide end groups can
undergo chain transfer reaction with hydroxyl-terminated chains. This proton exchange, which may also happen with multifunctional initiator molecules, is the
fastest reaction in this scheme. The acidity of the participating species is rather
similar; the dierences are generally those between primary and secondary hydroxyl groups, so the equilibrium constant for the proton exchange is around unity.

7.3 Cationic Polymerization

This equilibrium between active and non-active chains is very fast, so in general
a Poisson distribution will result. For the case where the rst addition is dierent
from the subsequent ones, either the Gold distribution [58] in Eq. (30) or a distribution given by Weibull [198] can be used. A recursive formula for a more complex
distribution assuming dierent reactivities for each addition of ethylene oxide is
given in Ref. 199.
However, it has been shown that normally the chain length dependence of the
propagation rate coecient is not important, with the exception of the rst unit
[200, 201]. Both distributions can be used to describe ethoxylation reactions [202].
There are a number of recent publications on the kinetics and copolymerization kinetics of ethylene and propylene oxide initiated with several alcohols and
KOH [203209]. The copolymerization parameters are generally in the ranges of
rE 24, rP 0.150.3, showing the higher reactivity of ethylene oxide.
One important side reaction, which may occur at higher temperatures, is the isomerization of propylene oxide to allyl alcohol [210, 211], leading to an unsaturated
end group (1) which may aect polyurethane production.
R O CH2CH CH2

The industrial process [23, 212, 213] of ethoxylation and propoxylation is usually a
semi-batch process. The starter alcohol and KOH are mixed and water is removed
by distillation. In a second step, monomers are fed into the reactor, where the feed
rate is chosen so as to be able to remove the heat of polymerization and to keep the
latent heat of polymerization of unreacted monomers in a safe state. By this process, homopolymers and random copolymers are accessible. Block copolymers are
produced by successive feeds of the respective monomers. Catalyst is removed by
addition of acids and subsequent crystallization and ltration of precipitated salts.
An optional fourth step is the removal of volatile compounds by distillation.

7.3

Cationic Polymerization

There are many monomers that can be polymerized via a cationic mechanism (see
Table 7.1), but the most important polymers from an industrial point of view are
homo- and copolymers from isobutene and from some heterocyclic monomers
such as trioxane, tetrahydrofuran, and epoxides. There is a detailed discussion on
the mechanistic features in Refs. 15, 7, and 181183.
7.3.1

Cationic Polymerization of Vinyl Monomers

Cationic polymerization of vinyl monomers is by electrophilic addition of the


monomer to a growing carbenium ion. The reactivity of vinyl monomers in cati-

351

352

7 Ionic Polymerization

onic polymerization follows the electron-donating ability of the substituents at the


double bond. Electron-donating substituents increase the nucleophilicity of the
double bond in the addition reaction and stabilize the resulting carbenium ion.
The general order of reactivity in cationic polymerization is given in Eq. (55).
Me
H2C

CH
N

CH

H2C

CH

H2C

Me
H2C

CH

H2C
Me

OR

55

OMe

Initiation is by either strong protonic acids (perchloric acid, triic acid, and so on)
or Lewis acids together with a co-initiator such as BF3/H2 O, AlX3/RX. As discussed
for anionic polymerization, for cationic polymerization also several dierent species may be involved in propagation, but it has been pointed out (Ref. 2, pp. 190,
205) that the reactivity dierences between the various species carbenium ions
and ion pairs are not very great. Covalent species are not active in propagation.
In general, propagation rate coecients in cationic polymerization are very large.
A very comprehensive review is given in Ref. 214. For isobutene, values of
1:5  10 8 M1 s1 are reported at 0 and 78 C [215]. For such high rate coecients the polymerization may become diusion-controlled, which has been addressed [216] for a tubular reactor.
In cationic polymerization of alkenes, there is an equilibrium between active
ions or ion pairs and inactive covalent species, where the ionization constant is
rather low (105 M1 in the isobutene/BCl3 system). The dynamics of this equilibrium strongly aects the width of the molecular weight distribution. For the sequence of reactions [Eq. (56)] the polydispersity of the distribution is given by Eq.
(57) [217], if there are no other side reactions such as transfer or irreversible termination.
k ass
M
H3 CaCHA !
 H3 CaCH A !

M

k ion

D Pw =Pn 1 I 0 k p =kass

kp

H2C

56

57

Bimodal distributions may result, if free ions and ion pairs have the same reactivity
but dierent lifetimes [218].
However, transfer reactions are nearly unavoidable side reactions in cationic
polymerization and may involve b-proton transfer even to rather weak bases like
the monomer itself, to transfer agents and solvent as well as FriedelCrafts alkylation of aromatic rings, if monomers like styrene are polymerized. Proton transfer
yields unsaturated chains [Eq. (58)], with the double bond in either the endo or exo
position. These may lead to branched polymers, if the double bonds are accessible
to homo- or copolymerization.

7.3 Cationic Polymerization

*
+

58

*
n

As proton transfer usually has the higher activation energy, the molecular weight
of the polymer decreases with temperature. Tabulated transfer coecients may be
taken from Refs. 219 and 220.
The problem of living or non-living cationic polymerization of alkenes is addressed in Refs. 220 and 221. It is shown that, depending on the molecular weight,
even for transfer constants up to 5  104 the system exhibits the behavior of a living system, such as a linear increase of molecular weight with conversion, rather
narrow distributions, and so on.
Copolymerization parameters for cationic polymerization can be found in Refs.
3, 222, and 223. Note that the scattering of data in higher and so the reliability
of copolymerization parameters for cationic polymerization are much less than for
radical polymerization.
Commercial polymers [2, p. 683, 157, 224] from isobutene involve isobutene
homopolymers and butene rubbers. Polyisobutene homopolymers comprise a
wide range of polymers with molecular weights from a few thousand grams per
mole up to 10 6 g mol1 , and butene rubbers are copolymers of isobutene with
13 mol% of isoprene. High molecular weight homopolymers are produced in the
continuous BASF belt process at 100 C in boiling ethylene to remove the heat of
polymerization. The ethylene evaporates during polymerization and the polymer is
scraped from the belt. Volatiles are removed in twin-screw extruders. Homopolymers and rubbers are also produced in the Exxon slurry process in methyl chloride
at 95 C. The polymerization rate is controlled by initiator feed and cooling is
with liquid ethylene and/or propylene. The polymer slurry is withdrawn from the
top of the reactor and worked up downstream.
Medium and low molecular weight polymers are produced in solution processes
in light hydrocarbons in CSTR reactors or in recirculating tubular (loop) reactors.
The molecular weight is controlled by monomer purity, initiator, water content,
and temperature.
7.3.2

Cationic Ring-opening Polymerization

Monographs and reviews of this subject can be found in Refs. 181185 and 225
227. The most important polymers from cationic ring-opening polymerization are
polyoxyalkylenes with one or four CH2 groups produced by the polymerization of
trioxane and tetrahydrofuran. The smaller epoxides, ethylene and propylene oxide,
though able to polymerize by a cationic and anionic mechanism, are not polymerized cationically, because of the existence of side reactions leading to dioxane or

353

354

7 Ionic Polymerization

dioxolane [228]. In contrast to these smaller homologs, THF and trioxane can only
be polymerized by a cationic mechanism [23, 229].
Initiation can be by strong protonic acids such as perchloric acid and uorosulfonic acid, oxonium salts like triethyloxonium (Et3 O , A BF4 or SbCl6 ), and
Lewis acids, for example BX3 , PF5 , SBF5 , and so on. Lewis acids usually need a
co-initiator, which in many cases is water, which is present to some extent in
the monomer even after purication. Hetero polyacids of the general formula
Hn Xm Mtz Oy with X P or Si and Mt Mo; W or V, have gained more and more
importance, especially for THF. The active chain end is usually an oxiranium ion
(2).
+

R O

Ions and ion pairs are both active in propagation, but their respective contribution
usually cannot be distinguished because of the high exchange rates between the
two. Covalent species may reversibly result from association with counter ions

such as CF3 SO
3 or ClO4 . They may participate in propagation reactions, but their
reactivity is much less than that of the ionic species (see Table 7.9). A detailed discussion on the kinetics of propagation for THF is given in Ref. 182.
Because of the low energy gain from ring strain, the equilibrium monomer concentration for the ve- and six-membered rings such as THF and trioxane during
polymerization is rather high (see Figure 7.8).
As already discussed (see Section 7.2.4), inter- and intramolecular transfer reactions to polymer are of great importance with regard to the molecular weight distribution (Scheme 7.6). In complete thermodynamic equilibrium, the conversion
should be given by the equilibrium monomer concentration and the molecular
weight distribution should be the most probable one with D 2, because of the
intermolecular chain transfer, which is responsible for scrambling of the molecular

Tab. 7.9.

Propagation rate coecients for some monomers for ionic and covalent species [2].

Monomer

Counter ion

Solvent

T [ C]

Propagating species

k p [MC1 sC1 ]

THF

CF3 SO
3

CCl4

25

CH2 Cl2

25

CH3 NO2

25

ionic
covalent
ionic
covalent
ionic
covalent
covalent
ionic
covalent
ionic

4  102
6  105
3:1  102
1:7  104
2:4  102
5  104
1:4  104
4  104
1:9  103
1:8  105

Oxepane

CF3 SO
3

H3 NO2

25

Oxazoline

CH3 C6 H4 O

CD3 CN

40

7.3 Cationic Polymerization

2.5

ln[M]

2
1.5
1
0.5
0
0.0028

0.003

0.0032

0.0034

0.0036

1/T / 1/K
Fig. 7.8.

Equilibrium THF concentration during polymerization according to Ref. 252.

weight distribution. Intramolecular chain transfer will give macrocycles, the concentration of which should be proportional to n 5=2 [Eq. (54)], if ring formation is
reversible and all equilibrium conditions are fullled. Examples of this ideal equilibrium between linear and cyclic polymers are found for 1,3-dioxolane and siloxanes [230, 231].
However, for THF it has been shown [232] that, even after monomer conversion
has reached the equilibrium concentration, there is still a buildup of cyclic monomers [Eq. (59)]: that is, the system is not yet in equilibrium with respect to macrocycles and transfer reactions may still proceed.

+O
+

59

So, in spite of these transfer reactions, linear polymers with a narrow molecular
weight distribution can be formed by kinetic control, if, as for THF, the transfer
rate coecient to polymer is rather small. Chain growth, and consequently conversion and kinetic chain length, may have reached their equilibrium faster than
the other equilibrium reactions. Depending on reactivity ratios in propagation and
transfer, the polymerization can be stopped at low conversions, yielding the desired
linear and narrow product [233].
In contrast, transfer rates for trioxane to polymer are extremely fast. This can
be seen from the observation that during copolymerization of trioxane with 1,3dioxolane, ethylene oxide, and similar comonomers, the comonomer is nearly completely consumed at an early stage of reaction [229, 234236]. One would therefore
expect longer sequences of these comonomers. However, it has been shown, from

355

356

7 Ionic Polymerization

NMR and stability studies, that the comonomers are randomly distributed along
the chains [237, 238]. This is attributed to the fact that intermolecular chain transfer (transacetalization), contrary to THF polymerization, proceeds on a time scale
similar to propagation, and the same holds for the intramolecular chain transfer
leading to cyclic polymer [239, 240]. Cationic polymerization of trioxane is usually
a precipitation polymerization leading to crystalline polymers, and the size of the
macrocycles is determined by the size of the crystalline lamellae [240].
The polymerizationdepolymerization equilibrium is not between the growing
chain and the originally propagating monomer, trioxane, but to formaldehyde [Eq.
(60)] [241, 242]. Thus formaldehyde should be considered as a comonomer [236,
243], which will be accumulated until its equilibrium concentration and pressure
is reached.

RaOCH2 aOCH2 aOCH2 aOaCH


2 T RaOCH2 aOCH2 aOaCH2 CH2 O

60

This unzipping depolymerization occurs during polymerization, but it may also occur under thermal stress with the neutralized polymer; unzipping then starts from
neutral but unstable end groups such as aOH or aCHO or from statistical chain
scission. Unzipping will stop at comonomer units such as those from ethylene oxide, dioxepane, and similar monomers, which are not able to depolymerize, and a
then stable copolymer will result. Homopolymers, which are usually polymerized
anionically from formaldehyde (see Section 7.2.3) will not be stable unless unstable
end groups are transformed to stable ones.
There are several industrial processes for poly-THF and polyoxymethylene.
Cationic polymerization of poly-THF may be batch-wise or continuous [23, 244]
using strong protonic acids in a temperature range of 30 to 60 C, depending
on the desired molecular weight. Newer processes use solid catalysts like zirconium oxide together with acetic anhydride to form poly-THF with two acetate end
groups, which later are hydrolyzed to give the dihydroxy polymer. Other acidic catalysts such as zeolites or acid montmorillonite clay are also described [245247].
The cationic copolymerization of trioxane with ethylene oxide, 1,3-dioxolane, and
suchlike is initiated either with strong protonic acids or Lewis acids, for example
BF3 . Molecular weight is controlled by the catalyst concentration and monomer
purity, and also by chain transfer agents such as methylal [248], which may lead
to more stable end groups. Most processes are run below the melting temperature
of the polymer (164167 C) in precipitating agents or in bulk, and are carried out
in kneaders or double-screw reactors [249, 250], but there are also some descriptions of melt processes [251].

7.4

Conclusion

Ionic polymerization oers several advantages. In many cases, it is much faster


than free-radical polymerization or polycondensation. This is either because of

Notation

very high rate coecients for propagation, especially in the case of cationic polymerization, or because of the high stationary concentration of active centers, for
example in living anionic polymerization compared to free-radical polymerization.
Furthermore, because of its site-based nature, it oers more control over the structure of the resulting polymer by changing the reactivity of the active center when
using dierent counter ions, solvents, complexing agents, or salts as additives. So a
wide range of structural isomers can be obtained, and copolymerization parameters may be varied over a wide range, resulting in structures ranging from block
copolymers to random copolymers from the same pair of monomers, which is not
possible by free-radical polymerization.
However, from a kinetic and modeling point of view, this site-based nature of
ionic polymerization also has some disadvantages. Because the reactivity of the
active center strongly depends on the nature of the initiator and on all the other
factors in the polymerizing system, the kinetic scheme and parameters of every
system are dierent, and so in general they must be determined again for every
change in the system.
The high sensitivity to impurities necessitates much more eort to purify monomers and solvents. This may prevent the wider employment of ionic polymerization. Generally, ionic polymerization is used for monomers which cannot be polymerized by free radicals, or for the production of polymer structures which are
otherwise not accessible.

Notation

D
fi
Fi
hi
i
I f
kt
k tt
kAB
kass
k ion
kp
kd
ki
K
K ass
[M]
Meq

polydispersity index
mole fraction of monomer i in the monomer mixture
mole fraction of monomer i in polymer chains being formed
frequency distribution of chain length
degree of polymerization
initiator feed concentration
rate coecient for termination [M1 s1 ]
rate coecient for thermal termination, for example, LiH elimination
[s1 ]
rate coecient for chain propagation [M1 s1 ] for monomer B
added to chain ending with A
rate coecient of association
rate coecient of ionization, dissociation
rate coecient for chain propagation [M1 s1 ]
rate coecient for decomposition [s1 ]
rate coecient for chain initiation [M1 s1 ]
equilibrium constant, general
equilibrium constant of association
monomer concentration [M]
equilibrium monomer concentration

357

358

7 Ionic Polymerization

Mf
Mn
Mw
Ni 
n
Pn
Pw
r1 ; r2
r
Rp
R
T
TC
v_ in; I
v_ in; M
wi
xM
xI

monomer feed concentration


number-average molecular weight [g mol1 ]
weight-average molecular weight [g mol1 ]
concentration of polymer chains with degree of polymerization i
association number or ring size
number average degree of polymerization
weight average degree of polymerization
copolymerization parameters according to the terminal model
ratio of k p =k i for living polymerization
rate of propagation [M s1 ]
gas constant
temperature
ceiling temperature
initiator feed ow [L s1 ]
monomer feed ow [Ls1 ]
mass distribution of chain length
monomer conversion
initiator conversion

Greek
DGp
DHp
DSp
t
n

Gibbs free energy of polymerization


enthalpy of polymerization
entropy of polymerization
residence time
average kinetic chain length

Acronyms
s- (t-, n-)Bu
CSTR
HCSTR
M, M 
T, T 
THF
PaLi
PsH
MWD
Pi
HIPS
NMR
RIM
SBR
SCSTR

sec.- (tert.-, n-)butyl


continuous stirred tank reactor
homogeneous continuous stirred tank reactor
monomer molecule ( , with active center)
transfer agent ( , with active center)
tetrahydrofuran
growing polymer chain with lithium counter ion
polystyrene molecule ending with hydrogen
molecular weight distribution
polymer chain with degree of polymerization i
high-impact polystyrene
nuclear magnetic resonance
reaction injection molding
styrenebutadiene rubber
segregated continuous stirred tank reactor

References

References
1 B. L. Erusalimski, Mechanisms of

8
9

10

11
12
13

14

15

Ionic Polymerization, Consultants


Bureau, New York, 1986.
K. Matyjaszewski (ed.), Cationic
Polymerization, Marcel Dekker, New
York, 1996.
J. P. Kennedy, E. Marechal,
Carbocationic Polymerization, WileyInterscience, New York, 1982.
J. P. Kennedy, B. Ivan, Designed Polymers by Carbocationic Macromolecular
Engineering Theory and Practice,
Hanser Publishers, Munich, 1992.
M. Szwarc, M. Beylen, Ionic
Polymerization and Living Polymers,
Chapman & Hall, New York, 1993.
H. L. Hsieh, R. P. Quirk, Anionic
Polymerization, Marcel Dekker, New
York, 1996.
M. Szwarc, Ionic Polymerization
Fundamentals, Hanser Publishers,
Munich, 1996.
T. Fukuda, K. Kubo, Y.-D. Ma, Prog.
Polym. Sci., 1982, 17, 875.
B. R. Morrison, M. C. Piton, M. A.
Winnik, R. G. Gilbert, D. H.
Napper, Macromolecules, 1993, 26,
4368; M. D. Zammit, T. P. Davis,
G. D. Willet, K. F. ODriscoll, J.
Polym. Sci., Part A: Polym. Chem.,
1997, 35, 2311.
K.-D. Hungenberg, F. Bandermann, L. Janko, K. Knoll, in K. H.
Reichert, H. U. Moritz (eds.),
DECHEMA Monographs, Vol. 131 (5th
Int. Workshop on Polymer Reaction
Engineering, 1995), p. 387, VCH,
Weinheim, 1995.
G. Spach, J. Chem. Soc. (Lond.), 1962,
355.
R. A. Finnegan, H. W. Kutta, J. Org.
Chem., 1965, 30, 4138.
W. J. Kern, J. N. Anderson, H. E.
Adams, T. C. Bouton, T. W. Bethea,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1972, 16, 3123.
W. Cooper, in: W. M. Saltman (ed.),
The Stereo Rubbers, Wiley-Interscience,
New York, 1977.
J. Lal, J. E. Mark, Advances in
Elastomers and Rubber Elasticity,
Plenum Press, New York, 1986.

16 F. R. Eirich, Science and Technology of

17

18

19

20
21

22

23

24

25

25a

26

27
28
28a

Rubber, Academic Press, New York,


1978.
H. Gausepohl, H. Haberkorn, K.-D.
Hungenberg, R. Kick, K. Knoll, P.
Wittmer, in G. Becker, D. Braun,
(eds.), Kunststo-Handbuch, Vol. 4,
Polystyrol, Chapter 7, Hanser
Publishers, Munich, 1996.
J. Scheirs, D. B. Priddy (eds.),
Modern Styrenic Polymers: Polystyrenes
and Styrenic Copolymers, John Wiley,
Chichester, 2003.
A. Noshay, J. E. McGrath, Block
Copolymers, Overview and Critical
Survey, Academic Press, New York,
1977.
G. Holden, Thermoplastic Elastomers,
Hanser Publishers, Munich, 2000.
R. P. Quirk, D. J. Kinning, L. J.
Fetters, in G. Allen, J. C. Bevington, S. L. Aggarwal, (eds.), Comprehensive Polymer Science, Pergamon
Press, Oxford, 1989.
F. E. Bailey, Jr., J. V. Koleske,
Alkylene Oxides and Their Polymers,
Marcel Dekker, New York, 1991.
F. E. Bailey, J. V. Koleske, Polyoxyalkylenes, in Ullmanns Encyclopedia of
Industrial Chemistry, Vol. 28, 6th ed.,
VCH, Weinheim, 2003.
W. Diller, P. Gupta, P. Haas, K.
Schauerte, R. Sundermann, K.
Uhlig, n Kunststo-Handbuch, Vol. 7,
Polyurethane, Hanser Publishers,
Munich, 1996.
D. Hesterwirth, D. Beckelmann,
F. Bandermann, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.,
1999, 73, 1521, 1533.
F. C. Foster, J. L. Binder, Adv.
Chem. Ser., 1957, 19, American
Chemical Society, Washington DC.
H. Hostalka, R. V. Figini, G. V.
Schulz, Makromol. Chem., 1964, 71,
71.
D. J. Worsfold, S. Bywater, Can. J.
Chem. 1960, 38, 1891.
D. J. Worsfold, J. Polym. Sci., A-1,
1967, 5, 2783.
E. W. Duck, J. M. Locke, J. Inst.
Rubber Ind., 1968, 2, 223.

359

360

7 Ionic Polymerization
29 S. Bywater, Macromol. Chem. Phys.,
30
31

32

33
34
35
36

37

38

39
40

41
42
43
44

45

46

47

48

49

1998, 199, 1217.


S. Bywater, Prog. Polymer. Sci., 1994,
19, 287.
R. N. Young, R. P. Quirk, L. J.
Fetters, Adv. Polym. Sci., 1984,
56, 1.
M. van Beylern, S. Bywater, G.
Smets, M. Szwarc, D. J. Worsfold,
Adv. Polym. Sci., 1988, 86, 87.
D. B. Priddy, M. Pirc, B. J. Meister,
Polym. React. Eng., 19923, 1, 343.
J. E. L. Roovers, S. Bywater,
Macromolecules, 1975, 8, 251.
R. Ohlinger, F. Bandermann,
Makromol. Chem., 1980, 181, 1935.
R. N. Young, L. J. Fetters, J. S.
Huang, R. Krishnamoorti, Polym.
Int., 1994, 33, 217.
L. J. Fetters, N. P. Balsara, J. S.
Huang, H. S. Jeon, K. Amdal, M. Y.
Lin, Macromolecules, 1995, 28, 4996.
L. J. Fetters, J. S. Huang, R. N.
Young, J. Polym. Sci., Part A: Polym.
Chem., 1996, 34, 1517.
A. L. Frischknecht, S. T. Milner, J.
Chem. Phys., 2001, 114, 1032.
A. A. Arest-Yakubovich, J. Polym.
Sci., Part A: Polym. Chem., 1997, 35,
3613.
S. Bywater, Macromolecules, 1998, 31,
6010.
S. Bywater, J. Polym. Sci., Part A:
Polym. Chem., 1998, 36, 1065.
S. Bywater, Macromol. Chem. Phys.,
1998, 199, 1217.
T. Tanlak, A. Ahmad, M. N. Treybig,
R. G. Anthony, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.,
1978, 22, 315.
T. D. Edgar, S. Hasan, R. G.
Anthony, Chem. Eng. Sci., 1970, 25,
1463.
D. C. Timm, J. W. Rachow, ACS Adv.
Chem. Ser. 1974, 133, 122; D. C.
Timm, L. F. Kubicek, Chem. Eng. Sci.,
1974, 29, 2145.
S. Auguste, H. G. M. Edwards, A. F.
Johnson, Z. G. Meszena, P. Nicol,
Polymer, 1997, 38, 4357.
S. Auguste, H. G. M. Edwards, A. F.
Johnson, Z. G. Meszena, P. Nicol,
Polymer, 1996, 37, 3665.
J.-J. A. Your, G. D. Karles, J. G.
Ekerdt, I. Trachtenberg, J. W.

50

51
52

53

54
55
56
57

58
59
60
61
62

63
64
65

66
67
68
69
70

71
72

Barlow, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 1989,


28, 1456.
W. H. Christiansen, J. G. Ekerdt, I.
Trachtenberg, J. W. Barlow, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res., 1990, 29, 463.
T. R. Landon, R. G. Anthony, AIChE
J., 1972, 18, 843.
E. Ceaucescu, R. Bordeianu, I.
Cerchez, M. Balanescu, P. Ghioca,
Rev. Roum. Chim., 1981, 26, 509.
Y. L. Spirin, A. R. Gantmakher, S. S.
Medvedev, Doklady Akad. Nauk
S.S.S.R., 1962, 146, 368.
M. Szwarc, Nature, 1956, 178, 168.
M. Szwarc, M. Levy, R. Milkovich, J.
Am. Chem. Soc., 1956, 78, 2656.
R. P. Quirk, B. Lee, Polym. Int., 1992,
27, 359.
S. Penczek, P. Kubisa, in Encyclopedia
of Polymer Science and Engineering,
Supplement Volume, 2nd ed., WileyInterscience, New York, 1989.
L. Gold, J. Chem. Phys. 1958, 28,
91.
V. S. Nanda, R. K. Jain, J. Polym. Sci.,
Pt. A, 1964, 2, 4583.
H. Hocker, Makromol. Chem., 1982,
157, 187.
ller, Macromolecules,
A. H. E. Mu
1994, 27, 1685.
ller, R. Zhuang, G.
A. H. E. Mu
Litvinenko, Macromolecules, 1995, 28,
4326.
R. V. Figini, Makromol. Chem., 1964,
71, 193.
R. V. Figini, Makromol. Chem., 1967,
107, 170.
R. V. Figini, H. Hostalka, K. Hurm,
G. Lohr, G. V. Schulz, Z. Physikal.
Chem., 1965, 45, 269.
B. D. Coleman, T. G. Fox, J. Am.
Chem. Soc., 1963, 85, 1241.
B. D. Coleman, T. G. Fox, J. Polym.
Sci., 1968, 4, 345.
D. C. Pepper, Makromol. Chem., 1995,
196, 963.
K. Matyjaszewski, J. Polym. Sci., 1993,
31, 995.
K. Matyjaszewski, R. Szymanski, M.
Teoderescu, Macromolecules, 1994, 27,
7565.
S. Zhu, W.-J. Wang, J. Polym. Sci., Pt.
B: Polym. Phys., 1999, 37, 961.
G. I. Litvinenko, A. A. Arest-

References

73

74
75
76
77
78
79
80
81

82
83
84

85
86
87

88
89
90
91
92

93
94
95

Yakubovich, Macromol. Chem., Theory


Simul., 1992, 1, 321.
G. I. Litvinenko, A. A. ArestYakubovich, Macromol. Chem., Theory
Simul., 1995, 4, 347.
Z. Tadmore, J. A. Biesenberger,
I&EC Fundamentals, 1966, 5, 336.
D.-M. Kim, E. B. Nauman, I&EC
Research, 1999, 38, 1856.
D.-M. Kim, E. B. Nauman, I&EC
Research, 1997, 36, 1088.
W. H. Abrahams, I&EC Fundamentals,
1963, 2, 221.
B. D. Coleman, F. Gornick, G.
Weiss, J. Chem. Phys. 1963, 39, 3233.
M. Szwarc, M. Litt, J. Phys. Chem.
1958, 62, 568.
T. A. Orono, F. Wenger, J. Chem.
Phys., 1961, 35, 532.
D. A. Couso, L. M. Alassia, G. R.
Meira, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1985, 30,
3249.
R. Tappe, F. Bandermann, Angew.
Makromol. Chem., 1988, 160, 117.
J. A. Biesenberger, Z. Tadmor, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1965, 9, 3409.
H. Fathi, A. E. Hamielec, D. J.
Davison, Polym. React. Eng., 1996, 4,
243.
J. E. Puskas, Macromol. Chem., Theory
Simul., 1993, 2, 141.
M. D. Glasse, Prog. Polym. Sci., 1983,
9, 133.
A. A. Arest-Yakubovich, G. I.
Litvinenko, Prog. Polym. Sci., 1996,
21, 335.
W. H. Glaze, J. Lin, E. G. Felton, J.
Org. Chem., 1965, 30, 1258.
W. H. Glaze, J. Lin, E. G. Felton, J.
Org. Chem., 1966, 31, 2643.
W. H. Glaze, G. M. Adams, J. Am.
Chem. Soc., 1966, 88, 4653.
R. A. Finnegan, H. W. Kutta, J. Org.
Chem., 1965, 30, 4138.
B. L. Wakeeld, The Chemistry of
Organolithium Compounds, Pergamon
Press, Oxford, 1974.
J. W. Burley, R. N. Young, J. Chem.
Soc. (B), 1971, 1018.
G. Spach, M. Levy, M. Szwarc, J.
Chem. Soc. (London), 1962, 355.
G. T. Viola, M. Bortolotti, A.
Zazzetta, J. Polym. Sci., Part A: Polym.
Chem., 1996, 34, 13.

96 R. W. Pennisi, L. J. Fetters,

Macromolecules, 1988, 21, 1094.


97 W. Nentwig, H. Sinn, Makromol.

Chem., Rapid Commun., 1980, 1, 59.


98 J. N. Anderson, W. J. Kern, T. W.

99
100
101
102
103

104

105

106

107

108
109
110
111
112
113
114
115
116
117

Bethea, H. E. Adams, J. Appl. Polym.


Sci., 1972, 16, 3133.
D. B. Priddy, Adv. Polym. Sci., 1994,
111, 67.
A. L. Gatzke, E. Vanzzo, Chem.
Commun., 1967, 1180.
A. L. Gatzke, J. Polym. Sci., A-1, 1969,
7, 2281.
I. A. Lifshits, Y. B. Podolnyi,
Vysokomolek. Soedin., B, 1971, 13, 149.
I. A. Lifshits, Y. B. Podolnyi,
Vysokomolek. Soedin., A, 1970, 12,
2655.
A. A. Arest-Yakubovich, I. V.
Zolotareva, N. I. Pakuro, E. V.
Kristalnyi, B. I. Nakhmanovich,
Vysokomolek. Soedineni., A, 1996, 38,
418.
L. H. Peebles Jr., Molecular Weight
Distributions in Polymers, Interscience
Publishers, London, 1971.
N. A. Dotson, R. Galvan, R. L.
Laurence, M. Tirrel, Polymerization
Process Modeling, VCH, Weinheim,
1996.
A. F. Johnson, M. A. Moshin, Z. G.
Meszena, P. Graves-Morris, J.
Macromol. Sci. Revs. Macromol.
Chem. Phys., C, 1999, 39, 527.
D.-Y. Yan, J. Chem. Phys., 1984, 80,
3434.
D.-Y. Yan, G.-F. Cai, J. Macromol. Sci.,
Chem., A, 1986, 23, 37.
S. C. Jain, V. S. Nanda, Eur. Polym. J.,
1977, 13, 137.
D.-Y. Yan, C.-M. Yuan, J. Macromol.
Sci., Chem., A, 1986, 23, 769.
D.-Y. Yan, C.-M. Yuan, J. Macromol.
Sci., Chem., A, 1986, 23, 781.
C.-M. Yuan, D.-Y. Yan, Makromol.
Chem., 1986, 187, 2629.
C.-M. Yuan, D.-Y. Yan, Makromol.
Chem., 1986, 187, 2641.
D.-Y. Yan, C.-M. Yuan, Makromol.
Chem., 1987, 188, 341.
D.-Y. Yan, C.-M. Yuan, Makromol.
Chem., 1987, 188, 333.
D.-Y. Yan, C.-M. Yuan, Polymer, 1988,
29, 924.

361

362

7 Ionic Polymerization
118 D.-Y. Yan, C.-M. Yuan, Eur. Polymer
119
120
121
122
123
124
125

126

127

128

129
130

131

132
133
134
135
136
137

138
139
140
141

142

J., 1988, 24, 924.


G.-F. Cai, D.-Y. Yan, M. Litt,
Macromolecules, 1988, 21, 578.
D. J. Worsfold, J. Polym. Sci., A-1,
1967, 5, 2783.
R. C. Bening, in Ref. 18.
K. Knoll, in Ref. 17.
J. E. McGrath, J. Polym. Sci., Polym.
Symp., 1977, 60, 29.
M. Morton, J. Polym. Sci., Polym.
Symp., 1977, 60, 1.
N. Hadjichristidis, S. Pispas, G.
Floudas, Block Copolymers, WileyInterscience, New-York, 2002.
F. J. Balta Calleja, Z. Roslaniec
(eds.), Block Polymers, Marcel Dekker,
New York, 2000.
A. Noshay, J. E. McGrath, Block
Copolymers, Academic Press, New
York, 1977.
F. Bandermann, H.-D. Speikamp, L.
Weigel, Makromol. Chem., 1985, 186,
2017.
L. H. Tung, G. Y. S. Lo, D. E. Beyer,
Macromolecules, 1978, 11, 616.
D. Hesterwerth, F. Bandermann,
Angew. Makromol. Chem., 1991, 84,
111.
T. A. Antkowiak, A. E. Oberster,
H. G. Halasa, D. P. Tate, J. Polym.
Sci., Part A-1, 1972, 10, 1319.
C. F. Wofford, H. L. Hsieh, J. Polym.
Sci., Part A-1, 1969, 7, 461.
BASF AG, DE 19 801 101, 1999.
F. Bandermann, Angew. Makromol.
Chem., 1971, 18, 137.
W. Gebert, F. Bandermann, Angew.
Makromol. Chem., 1977, 57, 153.
G. R. Meira, A. F. Johnson, Polym.
Eng. Sci., 1981, 21, 415.
F. Bandermann, R. Dunsing, K. F.
Elgert, Chem. Ing. Techn., 1974, 46,
615.
F. Bandermann, R. Dunsing, Chem.
Ing. Techn., 1974, 46, 617.
B. Langner, F. Bandermann, Angew.
Makromol. Chem., 1978, 71, 101.
J. Klahn, F. Bandermann, Angew.
Makromol. Chem., 1979, 83, 1.
R. G. Gosden, S. Auguste, H. G. M.
Edwards, A. F. Johnson, Polym.
React. Eng., 1995, 3, 331.
R. G. Gosden, Z. G. Meszena, M. A.

143

144

145
146
147
148
149
150
151
152
153
154
155
156
157

158

159
160

161
162
163
164
165
166
167
168
169
170
171

Moshin, S. Auguste, A. F. Johnson,


Polym. React. Eng., 1997, 5, 45, 205.
Z. G. Meszena, Z. Viczian, R. G.
Gosden, M. A. Moshin, A. F.
Johnson, Polym. React. Eng., 1999, 7,
71.
R. G. Gosden, K. Sahakara, A. F.
Johnson, J. Chen, R. F. Li, X. Z.
Wang, Z. G. Meszena, Polym. React.
Eng., 2001, 9, 249.
Dow Chemical, US 4 883 846, 1989.
BASF AG, WO 98/07765, 1998.
BASF AG, US 5 990 236, 1999.
Dow Chemical, US 4 572 819, 1986.
BASF AG, US 5 902 865, 1999.
Sulzer Chemtech, US 5 602 216, 1997.
D. B. Priddy, M. Pirc, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 1989, 37, 393, 1079.
BASF AG, US 5 717 040, 1998.
Bayer AG, US 4 200 713, 1980.
BASF AG, US 5 391 655, 1995.
Shell Oil, US 5 587 438, 1996.
Dow Chemical, US 4 725 654, 1988.
D. Threadingham, W. Olbrecht,
J. P. Lambert et al., Rubber, 3.
Synthetic, in Ullmanns Encyclopedia of
Industrial Chemistry, Vol. 31, 6th ed.,
Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 2003.
A. Echte, Handbuch der Technischen
Polymerchemie, VCH, Weinheim,
1993.
Firestone, US 3 317 918, 1956.
M. Demirors, StyreneButadiene
Copolymers, in Encyclopedia of Polymer
Science and Technology, Vol. 4, 3rd ed.,
Wiley-Interscience, New York, 2003.
Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co.,
US 5 100 965, 1992.
Goodyear Tire & Rubber Co.,
US 5 448 003, 1995.
Bridgestone, US 5 578 542, 1996.
Bridgestone, US 5 625 017, 1997.
Bridgestone, EP 0 768 323 A1, 1996.
Firestone Tire & Rubber Co.,
EP 0 171 517, 1985.
Phillips Petroleum Company,
US 2 975 160, 1961.
Phillips Petroleum Company,
US 3 294 768, 1966.
T. C. Buton, S. Futamara, Rubber
Age (N.Y.), 1974, 106, 33.
H. L. Hsieh, W. H. Glaze, Rubber
Chem. Technol., 1970, 43, 22.
G. Holden, N. R. Legge, Thermopastic

References

172
173
174
175
176
177
178

179
180
181

182

183

184

185
186
187
188

189
190

191
192
193
194

Elastomers Based on Polystyrene


Polydiene Block Copolymers, Hanser
Publishers, Munich, 1987.
BASF AG, EP 25 942, 1981.
BASF AG, US 4 861 742, 1989.
L. Fetters, Macromolecules, 1979, 12,
344.
P. Guyot, Polymer, 1981, 22, 1724.
Labona, PCT Int. Appl. 89/10 378,
1989.
Sumitomo, US 4 845 173, 1989.
M. van Beylen, S. Bywater, G.
Smets, M. Szwarc, D. J. Worsfolg,
Adv. Polym. Sci., 1988, 86, 89.
D. Baskaran, Prog. Polym. Sci., 2003,
28, 521.
Polyacetal, PERP report Nexant, Chem
Systems, New York, 2002.
J. E. McGrath (ed.), Ring-Opening
Polymerization Kinetics, Mechanisms,
and Synthesis, ACS Symp. Ser. 286,
American Chemical Society,
Washington DC, 1985.
D. J. Brunelle (ed.), Ring-Opening
Polymerization Mechanisms, Catalysis,
Structure, Utility, Hanser Publishers,
Munich, 1993.
K. J. Ivin, T. Saegusa (eds.), RingOpening Polymerization, Vols. 13,
Elsevier, New York, 1984.
J. S. Riffle, K. Matyjeszwski (eds.),
Makromol. Chemie, Macromol. Symp.
42/43, 1991.
F. Franta, P. Rempp (eds.), Makromol.
Chemie, Macromol. Symp. 32, 1990.
A. Miyake, W. H. Stockmayer,
Makromol. Chem., 1965, 88, 90.
H. Jacobsen, W. H. Stockmayer, J.
Chem. Phys., 1950, 18, 1600.
F. Fahnler, in Kunststo-Handbuch,
Vol. 3/4, Polyamide, p. 48, Hanser
Publishers, Munich, 1998.
K. Hashimoto, Prog. Polym. Sci.,
2000, 25, 1411.
M. J. Kohan, Polyamides, in
Ullmanns Encyclopedia of Industrial
Chemistry, Vol. 31, 6th ed., Wiley-VCH,
Weinheim, 2003.
Atona, EP 1 165 661, 2000.
S. K. Ha, J. L. White, Int. Polym.
Processing, 1998, 13, 136.
B. J. Kim, J. L. White, Int. Polym.
Processing, 2002, 17, 33.
BASF, US 6 441 109, 2002.

195 Gh. Rusu, K. Ueda, E. Rusu, M.

Rusu, Polymer, 2002, 42, 5669.


196 P. J. Flory, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 1940,

62, 1561.
197 N. M. van Os (ed.), Nonionic

198
199
200

201
202
203
204
205

206

207

208

209

210
211
212

213

Surfactants, Marcel Dekker, New York,


1998.
W. Weibull, B. Nycander, Acta
Chem. Scand., 1954, 8, 847.
G. Natta, E. Mantica, J. Am. Chem.
Soc., 1952, 74, 3152.
E. Santacesaria, M. DiSerio, R.
Garaffa, G. Addino, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res., 1992, 31, 2413.
A. J. Lowe, B. Weibull, J. Polym. Sci.,
1954, 12, 493.
W. Hreczuch, G. Bekierz, Tenside
Surf. Deterg., 1995, 32, 55.
F. Heatley, G. Yu, C. Booth, T. G.
Blease, Eur. Polym. J., 1991, 27, 573.
M. Adal, P. Flodin, Tenside Surf.
Deterg., 1994, 31, 1.
M. DiSerio, G. Vairo, P. Iengo, F.
Felippone, E. Santacesaria, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1996, 35, 3848.
E. Santacesaria, M. DiSerio, P.
Iengo, in Reaction Kinetics and the
Development of Catalytic Processes, G. F.
Froment, K. C. Waugh, (eds.),
Elsevier, New York, 1999.
M. DiSerio, R. Tesser, A. Dimiccoli,
E. Santacesaria, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.,
2002, 41, 5196.
M. DiSerio, S. Di Martino, E.
Santacesaria, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.,
1994, 33, 509.
A. de Lucas, L. Rodriguez, M.
Perez-Collado, Polym. Int., 2002, 51,
1066.
L. E. Pierre, C. C. Price, J. Am.
Chem. Soc., 1956, 78, 3432.
D. M. Simons, J. J. Verbanc, J. Polym.
Sci., 1960, 44, 303.
S. D. Gagnon, Polyethers (Propylene
Oxide Polymers), in Kirk-Othmer
Encyclopedia of Chemical Technology,
Vol. 19, 4th. ed., John Wiley, New
York, 1996.
D. M. Bach, E. M. Clark, R.
Ramachandran, Polyethers (Ethylene
Oxide Polymers), in Kirk-Othmer
Encyclopedia of Chemical Technology,
Vol. 19, 4th. ed., John Wiley, New
York, 1996.

363

364

7 Ionic Polymerization
214 P. H. Plesch, Prog. Reaction Kinetics,
215
216

217

218

219

220
221
222

223

224

225

226
227
228
229

230
231
232

233

1993, 18, 1.
R. B. Taylor, F. Williams, J. Am.
Chem. Soc., 1969, 91, 3728.
A. A. Berlin, S. A. Volfson, Polym.
Sci. USSR (Engl. Transl.), 1994, 36,
505.
K. Matyjaszewski, D.-H. Lin,
Makromol. Chem., Macromol. Symp.,
1991, 47, 221.
K. Matyjaszewski, R. Szymanski, M.
Teodorescu, Macromolecules, 1994, 27,
7565.
P. H. Plesch, The Chemistry of
Cationic Polymerization, Pergamon
Press, Oxford, 1963.
P. Sigwalt, Makromol. Chem.
Macromol. Symp., 1991, 47, 179.
K. Matyjaszewski, P. Sigwalt, Polym.
Int., 1994, 35, 1.
dos, J.
J. P. Kennedy, T. Kelen, F. Tu
Polym. Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed., 1975,
13, 2277.
dos, B. Turcsnayi,
T. Kelen, F. Tu
J. P. Kennedy, J. Polym. Sci., Polym.
Chem. Ed., 1977, 15, 3047.
K. S. Whiteley, T. G. Higgs, H.
Koch, R. L. Mayer, W. Immel,
Polyolens, in Ullmanns Encyclopedia
of Industrial Chemistry, Vol. 28, 6th ed.,
Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 2003.
S. Penczek, P. Kubisa, K. Matyjaszewski, Adv. Polym. Sci., 1985, 68/69,
35.
S. Penczek, P. Kubisa, K. Matyjaszewski, Adv. Polym. Sci., 1980, 37, 1.
T. Saegusa, S. Kobayashi, Prog.
Polym. Sci., 1973, 6, 107.
S. Kobayashi, K. Morikawa, T.
Saegusa, Polym. J., 1979, 11, 405.
K. Weiermel, E. Fischer, K.
Gutweiler, D. D. Hermann,
Kunststoe, 1964, 54, 410.
J. M. Andrews, J. A. Semlyen,
Polymer, 1972, 13, 142.
J. A. Semlyen, P. V. Wright, Polymer,
1965, 10, 643.
J. M. McKenna, T. K. Wu, G.
Pruckmayr, Macromolecules, 1977, 10,
877.
T. G. Croucher, R. E. Welton,
Polymer, 1976, 17, 205.

234 V. Jaacks, ACS Adv. Chem. Series,

1969, 91, 371.


235 Y. Yamashita, T. Tusda, M. Okada,

236
237
238
239

240

241
242
243

244

245
246

247

248

249

250
251

S. Iwatsuki, J. Polym. Sci., A-1, 1966,


4, 2121.
G. Opitz, Plaste Kautschuk, 1973, 20,
597.
D. Fleischer, R. C. Schulz,
Makromol. Chem., 1975, 176, 677.
M. Kucera, J. Pichler, Polymer, 1964,
5, 371.
I. Ishigaki, Y. Morita, K.
Nishimura, A. Ito, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 1974, 18, 1927.
M. Hasegawa, K. Yamamoto, T.
Shiwaku, T. Hashimoto,
Macromolecules, 1990, 23, 2629.
W. Kern, V. Jaacks, J. Polym. Sci.,
1960, 48, 399.
W. K. Buseld, D. Merigold,
Makromol. Chem., 1970, 138, 65.
G. L. Collins, R. K. Greene, F. M.
Berardinelli, W. H. Ray, J. Polym.
Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed., 1981, 19,
1597.
A. Echte, Handbuch der Technischen
Polymerchemie, VCH, Weinheim,
1993.
DuPont, PCT Int. Appl. 92/14 773,
1992.
G. Pruckmayr, P. Dreyfuss,
Polyethers, Tetrahydrofuran, in KirkOthmer Encyclopedia of Chemical
Technology, Vol. 19, 4th ed., John Wiley,
New York, 1996.
P. Dreyfuss, M. P. Dreyfuss, G.
Pruckmayr, Tetrahydrofuran
Polymers, in Encyclopedia of Polymer
Science, Vol. 16, 2nd ed., WileyInterscience, New York, 1989.
H. Nagahara, K. Hamanaka, K.
Yoshida, T. Iwaisako, J. Masamoto,
Chem. Lett., 2000, 2.
G. Sextro, Polyoxymethylenes, in
Ullmanns Encyclopedia of Industrial
Chemistry, Vol. 28, 6th ed., Wiley-VCH,
Weinheim, 2003.
J. Masamoto, Prog. Polym. Sci., 1993,
18, 1.
M. Kucera, E. Spousta, Makromol.
Chem., 1964, 76, 183, 190; 1965, 82,
60; 1966, 90, 215.

365

Coordination Polymerization1
Joao B. P. Soares and Leonardo C. Simon
8.1

Polyolen Properties and Applications


8.1.1

Introduction

Polyolens are among the most important commodity plastics today due to their
low production costs, reduced environmental impact, and a very wide range of applications. They are found in products as diverse as prosthetic implants, gas pipelines, automobile parts and accessories, synthetic fabrics, lms, containers, and
toys.
It may seem surprising that polymers composed only of carbon and hydrogen
atoms can be so exible, but the versatility of polyolens can be easily explained
by the way the monomer molecules ethylene, propylene, and higher a-olens
are connected to form the polymer chains. It is true for any polymer, but dramatically so for polyolens, that chain microstructure is the key to understanding their
physical properties.
Polyolens are produced in practically all types of reactor congurations
autoclaves, tubular reactors, loop reactors, uidized-bed reactors making them a
prime choice for polymer reaction engineering studies. Polymerization may take
place in either gas or liquid phases. For liquid-phase reactors, the monomers can
be either liquid (as in the case of propylene and higher a-olens) or dissolved in an
inert diluent. Industrial catalysts for olen polymerization are mainly heterogeneous, but some processes also use soluble catalysts. There are many dierent
types of catalysts for olen polymerization and they can be used to synthesize polymer chains with very dierent microstructures and properties.
Despite the fact that polyolens use comparatively simple monomers and have
been around for many years, it can be said with condence that the degree of
sophistication of polyolen manufacturing and characterization techniques has
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

366

8 Coordination Polymerization

no equal among other synthetic polymers. In this chapter, we will introduce the
reader to this fascinating eld of polymer reaction engineering by giving an overview of the dierent scientic and technological aspects related to olen polymerization with coordination catalysts.
8.1.2

Types of Polyolens and Their Properties

Polyethylenes are the commercial polyolens with the highest tonnage. Figure 8.1
compares the molecular structures of some polyethylene resins made by coordination and free-radical polymerization. (Free-radical polyolens are not the main
topic of this chapter and will be described only in contrast with polyolens made
with coordination catalysts.)
The oldest type of commercial polyolen is low-density polyethylene (LDPE)
made by free-radical polymerization. Low-density polyethylene is made using
supercritical ethylene under severe polymerization conditions in autoclaves
(15002000 atm, 180290 C) or tubular reactors (15003500 atm, 140180 C). Because of backbiting and chain transfer to polymer reactions, LDPE has both shortand long-chain branches. These branches decrease the crystallinity and density of
the polymer typically in the range 0.9150.935 g cm3 and aect several other
mechanical and rheological properties. Low-density polyethylene is used predominantly for making lms because of its limp feel, transparency, and toughness.
Additionally, the long-chain branches give excellent processability and high melt
tension to LDPE.
High-density polyethylene (HDPE) was rst made with ZieglerNatta catalysts.
When produced as a homopolymer, HDPE has no short-chain branches, but a

LDPE

LLDPE / VLDPE

0.915-0.935 g/cm3

0.915-0.94 g/cm3 / 0.88 - 0.912 g/cm3

Fig. 8.1.

Polyethylene microstructures.

HDPE

0.96-0.97 g/cm3

8.1 Polyolen Properties and Applications

very small amount of a-olen comonomer can be copolymerized with ethylene


to form short-chain branches that decrease its density. Typically, the density of
HDPE resins is in the range from 0.96 to 0.97 g cm3 . Since HDPE has few or no
short-chain branches, it has much greater rigidity than LDPE and can be used in
structural applications.
Linear low-density polyethylene (LLDPE) is a copolymer of ethylene and a-olens
(generally 1-butene, 1-hexene, or 1-octene) with densities in the range 0.9150.94
g cm3 . Products with even lower densities, down to 0.88 g cm3 , are sometimes
called very low-density polyethylene (VLDPE) but are chemically identical to
LLDPE. Copolymerization of ethylene with increasing amounts of a-olens disrupts the order of the linear polyethylene chains by introducing short-chain
branches. As a consequence, the density, crystallinity, and rigidity of LLDPE are
lower than for HDPE. Linear low-density polyethylene is used predominantly in
lms, and shares the market with LDPE.
Polypropylene is the second most important commercial polyolen. While freeradical polymerization can only produce atactic polypropylene, ZieglerNatta catalysts can make highly isotactic polypropylene. The chain regularity of isotactic
polypropylene is responsible for its high melting temperature and crystallinity,
making it ideal for injection molding and extrusion applications due to its excellent
rigidity, toughness, and temperature resistance. Metallocene catalysts can produce
several types of polypropylenes with other stereosequences, as illustrated in Figure
8.2 for some representative catalysts. Isotactic polypropylene is by far the leader
among the commercial stereoisomers of polypropylene, but syndiotactic polypropylene and some stereoblock elastomeric polypropylenes made with metallocene catalysts have attracted some interest lately [13].
Olens are commonly polymerized in a single reactor or in two or more reactors
in series. Single reactors are used when a polyolen with more uniform composition is required, while reactors in series are employed for the commercial produc-

atactic

Cp2ZrCl2

isotactic

Et(Ind)2ZrCl2

syndiotactic

iPr(Flu)(Cp)HfCl2

isotacticstereoblock

(NMCp)2ZrCl2

isotacticatacticstereoblock

Et(Me4Cp)(Ind)TiCl2

hemi-isotactic

iPr(Cp)(Ind)ZrCl2

Fig. 8.2.

Polypropylene microstructures and some metallocene catalysts used in their synthesis.

367

368

8 Coordination Polymerization

rubber domains

propene + ethene
PC

PC

propene
catalyst +
diluent

product
TC

TC

c.w.

c.w.
homopolymer matrix

Fig. 8.3.

Process for the production of high-impact polypropylene.

tion of homopolymers and copolymers with more elaborate microstructural distributions. A series of reactors allows for signicant exibility during polymerization,
since each reactor can be kept in dierent polymerization conditions to make a
polymer that can be considered a blend of two or more components (reactor
blends). High-impact propylene/ethylene copolymers are the most typical example
of this polymerization technique. Propylene is fed to the rst reactor, producing
isotactic polypropylene particles. A mixture of propylene and ethylene is fed to the
second reactor to make a propyleneethylene amorphous copolymer phase which
is dispersed within the isotactic polypropylene particles already formed. The amorphous copolymer fraction is responsible for increasing the impact strength of the
homopolymer matrix formed in the rst reactor, as illustrated in Figure 8.3.
Another important example of polyolens produced with reactors in series comprises HDPE resins for pipe applications. It will be shown later that when ethylene
and a-olens are copolymerized with a heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalyst in a
single reactor, the low molecular weight chains are also the ones that contain the
highest a-olen fraction. For pipe applications this is undesirable because it decreases the environmental stress cracking resistance of the polymer [4, 5]. One
way of overcoming this problem is to produce a high molecular weight copolymer
in the rst reactor in the absence of chain-transfer agent and a lower molecular
weight homopolymer in the second reactor in the presence of chain-transfer agent.
Coordination catalysts are also used to make elastomers, notably ethylene
propylenediene (EPDM) rubbers [6]. In this case, homogeneous catalysts are preferred to heterogeneous ones because they generally produce polymers with a
more uniform distribution of crystallinity. The unreacted double bonds of the
dienes are used during rubber crosslinking reactions. Figure 8.4 shows some typical examples of dienes used for the manufacture of EPDM rubbers.

8.1 Polyolen Properties and Applications

5-ethylidene-2-norbornene

1,4-hexadiene

CH - CH3

CH2 = CH - CH2 - CH = CH - CH3

dicyclopentadiene

Fig. 8.4.

Dierent dienes used for the production of EPDM.

8.1.3

The Importance of Proper Microstructural Determination and Control in Polyolens

Since polyolens are composed of only carbon and hydrogen atoms, the way
these atoms are connected in other words, the microstructure of a polyolen
determines their properties. At the most elementary level, the microstructure of a
polyolen is dened by its distributions of molecular weight, chemical composition, long-chain branching, and stereoregularity. Therefore, determining the microstructure of polyolens can be considered the rst and most important step toward
the understanding of their properties.
High-temperature gel permeation chromatography (GPC) is the standard technique for measuring the molecular weight distribution of polyolens. Since gel
permeation chromatography is a very well-established technique it will not be discussed here. Several publications provide additional discussions on the GPC technique [79].
The chemical composition distribution of polyolens is measured (indirectly)
by either temperature rising elution fractionation (Tref ) or crystallization analysis
fractionation (Crystaf ). These two techniques provide similar information on the
chemical composition distribution of polyolens and can be used interchangeably
in the vast majority of cases. Both methods are based on the fact that the crystallizability of HDPE and LLDPE depends strongly on the fraction of a-olen comonomer incorporated into the polymer chains, that is, chains with an increased aolen fraction have a decreased crystallizability. A similar statement can be made
for polypropylene and other polyolen resins that are made with prochiral monomers: resins with high stereoregularity and regioregularity have higher crystallizabilities than atactic resins.
In Crystaf, polyolen chains are crystallized from a dilute solution by slowly
lowering the solution temperature. Chains with fewer a-olen units crystallize at
higher temperatures, while chains with a higher a-olen fraction crystallize at
lower temperatures. This information is used to generate a Crystaf prole relating
crystallization temperatures to the fraction of polymer that crystallizes at those

369

8 Coordination Polymerization

Differential
Crystaf Profile

Cumulative
Crystaf Profile

Crystaf vessel

dw/dTc

370

w
Tc

Tc

Tc
Chemical Composition
Distribution

Calibration Curve

Tc

-olefin fraction

-olefin fraction

Estimation of the chemical composition distribution


of a polyolen using a Crystaf prole and a calibration curve.

Fig. 8.5.

temperatures. The Crystaf prole is then converted into the chemical composition
distribution by means of a calibration curve relating the fraction of a-olen in the
copolymer to the crystallization temperature, as illustrated in Figure 8.5. Temperature rising elution fractionation operates in a similar way to Crystaf, but involves
one additional step, when the chains crystallized during the crystallization period
described above are eluted from the Tref column to generate the Tref prole. A
Tref calibration curve, similar to the Crystaf calibration curve, is used to transform
the Tref curve into the chemical composition distribution. More details of the Tref
and Crystaf analytical procedures can be obtained from many recent publications
[7, 10, 11].
For our purposes in this chapter, it suces to say that the chemical composition
distribution of LLDPE made with heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts is generally bimodal or multimodal, as illustrated in Figure 8.6. This clearly indicates that
heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts have at least two but probably more
distinct active-site types with dierent reactivity ratios for a-olen incorporation:
one site type produces polymer with a low a-olen content, while the other site
type makes polymer with a much higher a-olen content. The presence of two or
more active sites on heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts is also conrmed by the
fact that they produce polyolens with broad molecular weight distributions and
polydispersities much higher than the theoretical value of 2 that would be expected
for polymers made with coordination catalysts containing a single site type, as will

8.1 Polyolen Properties and Applications

Weight fraction

Easier to crystallize

More difficult
to crystallize

Mol % -olefin comonomer


Crystallization temperature
Chemical composition distribution of a polyolen
made with a heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalyst.
Fig. 8.6.

be discussed in more detail below. In addition, the chains with the lower a-olen
fractions are also the ones with the higher molecular weight averages, as depicted
in Figure 8.7 [12]. In this way, the distributions of molecular weight and chemical
composition of polyolens made with heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts are always coupled and are, in fact, considered the ngerprint of these resins.
The molecular weight distribution of polypropylene made with heterogeneous
ZieglerNatta catalysts is also broad, with polydispersities higher than 2. In addition, some catalysts will also produce polypropylene with a distribution of stereoregularities that can be traced back to the presence of multiple active-site types
with distinct stereochemical control characteristics [13].
On the other hand, several homogeneous ZieglerNatta and metallocene catalysts make HDPE, LLDPE, and polypropylene with narrow distribution of chemical
composition and molecular weight with the theoretical polydispersity of 2. The average a-olen fraction for these polymers is constant and independent of molecular
weight, which conrms that they are made by a single-site catalyst [14]. In fact, the
ability to make polyolens with narrow microstructural distributions, and consequently with a much better control of polymer microstructures and properties,
is one of the main reasons why metallocene catalysts have had such an impact on
the polyolen manufacturing industry since the 1980s.
An equally important contribution of metallocene catalysts to polyolen synthesis is the ability to produce polyethylene and polypropylene with long-chain
branches. These narrow-MWD resins have excellent processability and melt
strength due to the presence of few long-chain branches (often less than 1 per
1000 carbon atoms) and have had a marked impact on the polyolen industry
[15]. The only absolute way of measuring long-chain branches in polyolens is by
carbon-13 nuclear magnetic resonance ( 13 C NMR) but, due to the low levels of
long-chain branches generally present in these resins, these measurements are

371

8 Coordination Polymerization

0.06

2x105

0.04
105

Mw

Normalized response (a.u.)

372

8x104
0.02
6x104

0.00

4x104
0

10

x, mole % butene
Average weight-average molecular weight of ethylene
1-butene copolymers made with a heterogeneous ZieglerNatta
catalyst as a function of average 1-butene content [11a].

Fig. 8.7.

very often subject to signicant experimental error. Nonetheless, very good evidence of the presence of long-chain branches can be found by studying the rheological response of these resins. Long-chain branch formation with polyolens will
be discussed in detail below in Section 8.3.4.

8.2

Catalysts for Olen Polymerization

The class of catalysts we currently call ZieglerNatta was rst used by Ziegler in
1953 to polymerize ethylene at low pressure, and further developed by Natta in
1954 to produce isotactic polypropylene. Both Ziegler and Natta were awarded the
Nobel Prize in chemistry in 1963; since then, this eld has grown incessantly, with
the development of improved catalysts and new industrial processes.
Many other catalysts capable of polymerizing olens have become available since
the original ZieglerNatta catalyst based on crystalline titanium chloride was introduced. More recently, the discovery of soluble metallocene/aluminoxane catalysts
opened the doors to a new revolution in the production of polyolens. These catalyst systems are able to make polyolens in very high yields and with a degree of
microstructural control not possible to achieve using conventional ZieglerNatta
catalysts.
Most industrial processes today still use heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts,
although the market share of metallocene resins is increasing due to the enhanced

8.2 Catalysts for Olen Polymerization

properties of polyolens made with these catalysts and the fact that polymerization
processes that were originally designed to use ZieglerNatta catalysts can be converted, with minimal changes, to operate with metallocenes the so called dropin technology.
Although traditional heterogeneous and homogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts
are commonly used as the standard example of coordination polymerization, coordination catalysts include any complex of transition metals and organic ligands:
Phillips catalysts are heterogeneous, chromium-based complexes that are not classied as ZieglerNatta catalysts; metallocenes are complexes of a transition metal
in most cases an early transition metal and cyclopentadienyl or cyclopentadienylderivative ligands; late transition metal catalysts may have a variety of ligands containing heteroatoms, such as phosphorus, nitrogen, or oxygen, directly bonded to
the transition metal.
The active site in coordination catalysts for olen polymerization is, therefore, a
transition metal surrounded by ligands. The catalytic properties depend on the ne
tuning between the transition metal and the ligands in terms of geometry and electronic character. In most cases the active site is produced by the activation of a
complex called a pre-catalyst, or catalyst precursor. The pre-catalyst is commonly
stable and easy to handle; sometimes it is stable even to moisture and oxygen.
The creation of the active site by reaction of the pre-catalyst with an activator or
cocatalyst is made just prior to its injection in the polymerization reactor or inside
the polymerization reactor itself. The activator alkylates the pre-catalyst complex to
form the active sites and stabilizes the resulting cationic active site. Common activators are based on organoaluminum or organoborane compounds [16]. Because
the activator works as a Lewis acid (electron acceptor), it is also used to scavenge
polar impurities from the reactor. These impurities are electron donors, such as
oxygen, sulfur and nitrogen compounds, and moisture, that poison the cationic
active site. Figure 8.8 shows a simplied chemical equation for the activation
mechanism and the corresponding equation used for modeling in the Section 8.3.

L
X
A
X
L

L
R
A
L

AlR3

Al

AlR2X2

C*

A = transition metal center (Ti, Zr, Ni, )


L = ligands
X = halogen (Cl, Br)
AlR3 = alkylaluminum cocatalyst
R = alkyl group (methyl, ethyl)
Fig. 8.8.

Catalyst activation by reaction of a pre-catalyst and a cocatalyst.

373

374

8 Coordination Polymerization

L
R
A
L

L
R
A
L

L
A
L
R

C*

P*1

L
A
L

(
L
A
L

Pol

R
P*1
Fig. 8.9.

nM

P*1+n

Monomer coordination and insertion.

Polymerization with coordination catalysts proceeds via two main steps: monomer coordination to the active site, and monomer insertion into the growing polymer chain, as illustrated in Figure 8.9. Before insertion, the double bond in the
olen monomer coordinates to the coordination vacancy of the transition metal.
After the olen is inserted into the growing polymer chain, another olen monomer can coordinate to the vacant site; thus the process of insertion is repeated to
increase the size of the polymer chain by one monomer unit at a time until chain
transfer takes place [17]. In the case of copolymerization, there is a competition between the comonomers to coordinate to the active sites and to be inserted into the
growing polymer chains. Dierent rates of coordination and insertion of comonomers determine the nal chemical composition of the copolymer chain.
Insertion of a prochiral a-olen such as propylene creates a chiral carbon bonded
to the active site. Dierently from free-radical polymerization, coordination polymerization can be regio- and stereoselective, depending on the design of the ligands bonded to the transition metal. Regioselectivity determines the sequence of
12 or 21 insertions while stereoselectivity determines whether the polymer is
isotactic, syndiotactic, or atactic (Figure 8.10).
Several chain-transfer mechanisms are operative in coordination polymerization:
transfer by b-hydride elimination; transfer by b-methyl elimination; transfer to
monomer; transfer to cocatalyst; and transfer to chain-transfer agent commonly
hydrogen or other small molecules. The type of termination reaction determines
the chemical group bound to the active site and the terminal chemical group in the
polymer chain. The rst three types produce unsaturated chain ends, while the last
two types produce saturated chain ends. Figure 8.11 illustrates these ve transfer
mechanisms.
Reaction of the active site with polar impurities deactivates the catalyst. Due to
the cationic nature of the active sites, nucleophilic groups with a lone pair of elec-

8.2 Catalysts for Olen Polymerization

Regioselectivity
1,2-insertion
Pol
L
A
L

L
A
L

Pol

2,1-insertion
Pol
L
A
L

L
A
L

2 1

1
2

Pol

Stereoselectivity

Pol
L
A
L

L
A
L
Pol

Pol
L
A
L

L
A
L
Pol

Fig. 8.10.

Regio- and stereoselectivity in coordination polymerization.

trons (generally substances containing oxygen, nitrogen, or sulfur) can coordinate


irreversibly with the active site, causing irreversible catalyst deactivation. Bimolecular catalyst deactivation happens when two active sites form a stable complex
that is inactive for monomer polymerization. This type of bimolecular intermediate
is favored at high catalyst concentrations and is reversible [18]. The term latent
state can be used to describe certain catalytic intermediates that reduce the catalyst activity. The formation of latent states is dicult to probe and the mechanisms
are generally not well understood. Figure 8.12 shows chemical equations for this
catalyst deactivation mechanism.

375

376

8 Coordination Polymerization

chain transfer by -hydride elimination


L
A
L

L
H
A
L

L
H
A
L

Pol

Pol

Pol
P*H

P*r

Dr

chain transfer by -methyl elimination


L
A
L

CH3
L
A
L

Pol

P*

P*r

L
CH3
A
L

Pol

Pol

Dr

chain transfer to hydrogen


L
A
L

Pol
P*r

L
H
A 2
L

H2

P*H

H2

H
L
A
L

Pol

Pol

Dr

chain transfer to monomer


L
A
L

L
A
L

Pol

P*r

P *r

L
A
L

Pol

Dr

chain transfer to cocatalyst


L
A
L

Pol

P*r
Fig. 8.11.

P*A

Al

Pol

D Al

Chain termination mechanisms.

L
R
A
L
2 C*
Fig. 8.12.

L
A
L
R

AlR3

L
L
R
A
A
L
R
L
2 Cd

Catalyst deactivation by bimolecular reactions.

AlR2

Pol

8.2 Catalysts for Olen Polymerization

Dr

H2

Dr

AlR3
C*

Dr

P*r

P*H

P*H

P*Me

M
M
M

Fig. 8.13.

Catalytic cycle for polymerization.

The catalytic cycle is a convenient graphical way to describe the central role
played by the active site in the mechanism of polymerization. Changes in the nature of the active site will aect the catalytic mechanism and consequently the
activity and the selectivity of the polymerization. Changes in the polymerization reactor conditions, such as temperature and monomer concentration, play a vital role
in the catalyst mechanism because they aect the rate constants of each of these
steps. Figure 8.13 shows a catalyst cycle for olen polymerization with coordination catalysts.
Catalytic activity is a measurement of how fast the monomer can be polymerized. Unfortunately, it may be expressed in several ways in the literature,
which very often makes it dicult to compare experimental results from dierent
research groups. A common, but not recommended, way is to express catalyst
activity as the mass of polymer made by one mole of catalyst per unit of time, for
instance kgpolymer (mol catalyst h)1 . Since polymerization rate is proportional to
monomer concentration, this value of the catalyst activity cannot be used for dierent monomer concentrations. A better way is to normalize the catalyst activity with
respect to the moles of monomer present in the reactor, that is, to express the catalyst activity in units of kgpolymer (mol catalyst h molmonomer )1 . Since the measured
polymerization rate does not necessarily have a rst-order dependence on monomer concentration, this form may also be oversimplied, but it is certainly preferable to the rst one. In addition, since coordination catalysts generally deactivate
during polymerization, one should be very careful when extrapolating these average catalyst activities to dierent polymerization times. In general, it is advisable
that the complete plot of catalyst activity as a function of polymerization time be
available for the proper quantication of polymerization kinetics with coordination
catalysts. Such proles are illustrated in Figure 8.14 for characteristic polymerization cases. Another commonly used parameter when accessing catalyst activity is
the turnover frequency, in time1 units, which stands for the time necessary for
one monomer insertion to take place.

377

8 Coordination Polymerization

polymerization rate

378

Decay type
Build-up type

polymerization time
Polymerization kinetics with coordination catalysts
showing dierent deactivation rates.
Fig. 8.14.

8.2.1

ZieglerNatta, Phillips, and Vanadium Catalysts

The low-pressure ethylene polymerization catalyst introduced by Ziegler was


TiCl4 /AlR3 , where R is commonly an alkyl group such as methyl or ethyl. A catalyst for stereospecic polymerization of propylene, TiCl3 /AlR3 , was disclosed by
Natta shortly after Zieglers discovery. The active sites for polymerization are
located at the surface and edges of the crystalline structure of titanium chloride.
Dierences of atomic arrangements around the titanium atoms on the titanium
chloride surface aect the chemical properties and consequently the activity and
the selectivity of the polymerization catalyst. First-generation ZieglerNatta catalysts consisted of particulate titanium chloride crystals. Two major advances in heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts were the use of supports and internal donors.
Inert supports such as magnesium chloride can improve the morphology of the
nal polymer particle in the reactor, increase catalytic activity by many times, and
consequently decrease the load of transition metal in the nal polymer. Internal
donors help to control the selectivity of the catalyst by blocking certain sites and
therefore are necessary to control polymer structure. The evolution of heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts is a truly fascinating story that has been reported in
detail in many references [19, 20].
Phillips catalysts are based on Cr(IV) supported on silica and alumina. The true
structure of the Phillips catalyst is not well understood. A mixture of chromium
oxide and silicon oxide (CrO3/SiO2 ) is used to create the active sites. The catalyst
does not require addition of chemical activators before the polymerization, since
the active site is produced prior to the polymerization by thermal activation at
high temperatures (600 C, for instance) [21, 22]. Phillips catalysts are used in
both gas-phase and slurry processes. Polyethylene made with Phillips catalysts

8.2 Catalysts for Olen Polymerization

has a very broad molecular weight distribution, with polydispersities ranging from
12 to 24. Interestingly, hydrogen is not an eective chain-transfer agent and generally decreases catalyst activity.
Vanadium catalysts are used to manufacture ethylenepropylenediene rubbers.
The catalyst is produced by activating a mixture of VCl3 and VCl4 with AlR3 (alkylaluminum) compounds. Vanadium catalysts are very sensitive to reaction conditions [23]. Changes in the composition of the solvent, polymerization time, and
temperature can aect catalyst activity and selectivity.
8.2.2

Metallocene Catalysts

Metallocene catalysts have structures similar to ferrocene (Cp2 Fe), which is a


widely known complex with a sandwich structure, where the transition metal
lies between two cyclopentadienyl (Cp) rings. Cp2 ZrCl2 (Figure 8.15) is a well
studied example of a metallocene catalyst for olen polymerization. Metallocenes
are soluble and therefore can be used as homogeneous catalysts, but they can also
be supported on inert carriers such as silica, alumina, and magnesium chloride,
among other inorganic and organic supports, and used as heterogeneous catalysts
[24].
The cocatalysts commonly used with ZieglerNatta catalysts (AlEt2 Cl, AlEt3 ) are
not able to activate metallocene catalysts very well. Even though metallocenes
can be activated with these cocatalysts, they generally deactivate very fast, and
consequently have no commercial interest. The use of bulky activators, such as
methylaluminoxane (MAO), is necessary to produce highly active metallocene catalysts. In fact, it can be said that it was the discovery of MAO as a good cocatalyst
for metallocenes that made possible the metallocene revolution that we are currently experiencing in polyolen manufacture [25]. Other bulky Lewis acids such
as trispentauorophenylborane (B(C6 F5 )3 ) are also very good cocatalysts for metallocenes.
A large variety of metallocene catalysts can be obtained by altering the simple
structure of Cp2 ZrCl2 . The nature of the transition metal and the structure of the
ligand have a large eect on catalyst behavior. The shape, geometry, and chemical
structure of the ligand can aect the activity and selectivity of the catalyst. The
symmetry imposed by ligands around the active site determines the geometry for
monomer coordination and insertion, and consequently the relative orientation of
catalyst and growing polymer chain. The possibility of variations in the chemical

Cl

Zr
Fig. 8.15.

Cl
Structure of a typical metallocene catalyst, Cp2 ZrCl2 .

379

380

8 Coordination Polymerization

C2v

Cs (meso)

C2 (racemic)

(atactic PP)

(atactic PP)

(isotactic PP)

Ex: Cp2ZrCl2

Et(Ind)2ZrCl2

Ex: Et(Ind)2ZrCl2
X

Cs

C1

(syndiotactic PP)

(no unequivocal prediction)

Ex: iPr(Flu)(Cp)HfCl2

Ex: (Flu)(MeCp)ZrCl2

Symmetry requirements for the production of


polypropylenes with dierent stereoregularities.
Fig. 8.16.

substitutions and/or presence of bridging groups on the cyclopentadienyl rings


creates an endless set of possible structures, especially if substitutions of ligands
with heteroatoms are considered. The size and the type of the bridge connecting
the cyclopentadienyl rings aect the opening on the opposite side of the transition
metal, and consequently the relative rates of the elementary steps in the polymerization mechanism. This eect is called the biting angle. The literature on metallocene catalysts is very rich one may even say opulent and thousands of metallocene catalyst structures have been documented since the early 1980s [1, 2, 26].
The appropriate selection of ligand structure has a major eect on the selectivity
of the polymerization mechanism. A practical and very interesting example is the
control of tacticity in polypropylene. There are two mechanisms to explain control
of stereoregularity: chain-end or enantiomorphic site control. In the former, the orientation of the growing polymer chain determines the orientation of the monomer
during insertion. In the latter, this orientation is determined by the active site, as
determined by the arrangements between the transition metal and its ligands [27].
Since the stereochemical control of most metallocenes is of the enantiomorphic
type, it is possible to classify them according to the type of polypropylene chain
they will produce based merely on the symmetry of the ligands around the active
site, as elegantly illustrated in Figure 8.16.
Furthermore, certain ligands can change the orientation during the growth of a
polymer chain, for instance oscillating between congurations that produce atactic
and isotactic polypropylene blocks. By the proper choice of polymerization conditions it is possible to produce polypropylenes that have chains varying from mainly
atactic through block atacticisotactic to mainly isotactic congurations [28].

8.2 Catalysts for Olen Polymerization

CH3

H3C

CH3
H3C
H3C

Si

H3C

CH3
N

H3C
Fig. 8.17.

CH3

Ti

CH3
CH3

A half-sandwich metallocene.

Another important class of metallocene catalysts, the half-sandwich metallocenes (Figure 8.17) have a more open structure because only one cyclopentadienyl
ring is coordinated to the transition metal. Catalysts with open structures have very
high reactivity ratios toward the incorporation of longer a-olens and are used for
the production of ethylene/1-octene copolymers [29]. More importantly, these catalysts can form polyolens containing long-chain branches via a mechanism that
is analogous to the copolymerization of long a-olens, as will be described in Section 8.3.4.
8.2.3

Late Transition Metal Catalysts

This family of coordination catalysts is characterized by having a transition metal


from groups 8, 9, or 10. A great advantage of some polymerization catalysts based
on late transition metals is that the active sites are more tolerant to polar comonomers (and impurities) than the early transition metals used with metallocenes. The
tolerance toward polar comonomers is attributed to the electronic conguration of
the central metal and its interaction with its ligands. This feature is very attractive
for modifying the chemical composition of polyolens by copolymerization with
vinyl alcohols, acrylates, or other vinyl polar comonomers. A few polar functional
groups can signicantly increase the hydrophilicity of polyolens and enhance several of their properties, such as dyeability, adhesion, and compatibility with other
polar polymers.
Late transition metal catalysts are very active and produce high molecular weight
polyethylene. The catalyst can be used in homogeneous solution or supported in
inert carriers such as silica. The active site can be generated by activation of a metal
halide complex such as (diimine)NiCl2 with organoaluminum compounds such as
(CH3 )3 Al or MAO. As for metallocenes, the active species are cationic. These catalysts have a well dened structure and in homogeneous systems can behave as
single-site catalysts.

381

382

8 Coordination Polymerization
Forward
Chain
Walking
P

Forward
Chain
Walking
P

Chain Walking
followed by Insertion

Monomer
Insertion
P

Backward
Chain
Walking

P
Ethyl Branch
Insertion

A = metal active center


P = polymer chain

Fig. 8.18.

Chain walking mechanism.

A class of late transition metal catalysts based on Ni and Pd with bulky diimine
ligands has an interesting feature called the chain walking mechanism [30].
With the appropriate choice of ligands and reactor conditions, it is possible to produce branched polyethylene from pure ethylene without addition of comonomers.
The chain walking mechanism involves simultaneous isomerization and polymerization steps, as indicated in Figure 8.18. Isomerization reactions cause the active
site to move along the growing polymer chain without terminating chain growth.
A short-chain branch is created when monomer insertion takes place after the
active site has moved away from the chain end. The number of carbons in this
short branch equals the number of carbons by which the active site has moved
away from the chain end. Branches from methyl to hexyl or longer are produced
during ethylene polymerization, although methyl branches are predominant [31].
The number of branches produced by the chain walking mechanism can be
controlled by varying the polymerization temperature and monomer concentration.
Increasing the polymerization temperature or decreasing the monomer concentration favors chain walking and increases the number of short-chain branches.
By choice of appropriate polymerization conditions, ethylene can be used to make
polyethylene with properties varying from very low density (highly branched) to
high density (few or no branches).
The molecular weight of polyethylene made with some late transition metal
catalysts based on iron can be very high (> 1 000 000 g mol1 ) [30]. At low temperatures polymerization of a-olens with certain diimineNiCl2 catalysts behave
as a living polymerization: that is, the number-average molecular weight increases
linearly with polymerization time and the polydispersity index (PDI) is approximately 1.

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts

8.3

Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts


8.3.1

Comparison between Coordination and Free-radical Polymerization

One of the main dierences between the polymerization kinetics with coordination
catalysts and free-radical initiators is that the former depends on the characteristics
of the active site as well as on monomer type, while the latter is almost exclusively
regulated by monomer type. As we will see, even though this may not constitute a
problem for establishing an operative mechanism for coordination polymerization,
it creates a signicant challenge for model parameter estimation.
In free-radical polymerization, the initiator fragment moves away from the growing chain and therefore can inuence chain growth and termination during only
the rst few monomer insertion steps. Consequently, the values of the polymerization kinetic parameters depend mainly on the monomer type, thus permitting the
creation of tables of rate constants and activation energies as a function of monomer type, independently of the type of initiator used during polymerization.
In contrast, in coordination polymerization chain growth and termination take
place by insertion of the monomer or chain-transfer agent into a metalcarbon
bond, as proposed by the Cossee mechanism. Consequently, electrical and steric
eects around the active site aect polymerization kinetics as much as does the
monomer type. The mechanisms of free-radical and coordination polymerization
are contrasted in Figure 8.19.
In this way, rate constants for coordination polymerization depend not only on
the monomer type but also on the nature of the active sites present during polymerization. Since the nature of the active sites is a rather complex (and unfortunately poorly understood) function of polymerization conditions such as temperature, catalyst/cocatalyst ratio and type, presence and concentration of catalyst
modiers, and solvent type, among other factors, this makes the determination of
general tables of polymerization rate constants and activation energies for coordination polymerization virtually impossible. On the other hand, the same phenomena, that is to say those that make it dicult to predict the behavior of coordination
polymerization a priori, are also responsible for the remarkable exibility of coordination catalysts, since polymers with completely dierent properties can be made
with only a few monomer types by simply varying the way these monomers are
inserted into the polymer chain via active-site design.
8.3.2

Polymerization Kinetics with Single-site Catalysts


Homopolymerization
Several metallocene, late transition metal, and homogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts behave as single-site catalysts, while all heterogeneous ZieglerNatta and
Phillips catalysts have more than one site type. The mechanism for coordination
8.3.2.1

383

384

8 Coordination Polymerization

Free-radical polymerization is monomer-based:


R* + M

RM*

RM* + M

RMM*

R(M)n* + M

R(M)n+1*

Coordination polymerization is site-based:

CH2 - CH2

Ti

CH2

CH2

Fig. 8.19. Comparison of the monomer propagation step in


free-radical and coordination polymerization.

polymerization can be divided into ve main classes of reaction: catalyst activation


with the cocatalyst; catalyst initiation with monomer; chain propagation; chain
transfer; and poisoning and deactivation [32].
No bimolecular termination reactions termination by combination or
disproportionation as observed in free-radical polymerization take place with coordination catalysts. Some catalysts, under certain polymerization conditions, may
polymerize dead polymer chains containing terminal vinyl unsaturations, leading
to the formation of chains with long-chain branches. We will discuss the mechanism of long-chain branch formation with coordination catalysts in Section 8.3.4.
Coordination catalysts must be activated via reaction with a cocatalyst, which is
generally present in great excess. (In some references, the complex that is reacted
with the cocatalyst is called the pre-catalyst and the product of the reaction between
the pre-catalyst and the cocatalyst is named the catalyst. Even though this terminology is more rigorous, we will adopt the looser terminology by which the transition metal compound is called the catalyst, even before reaction with the cocatalyst.) The cocatalyst/catalyst molar ratio is commonly 5:120:1 for heterogeneous
ZieglerNatta catalysts, but it can be as high as 1000:1 or more for metallocene
catalysts. Little is known, from a quantitative point of view, about the kinetics of
catalyst activation for coordination polymerization. Qualitatively, it has been shown
that the cocatalyst is required to reduce and alkylate the active site. This reaction is
generally assumed to proceed very quickly and to be rst order with respect to catalyst, C, and cocatalyst or activator, Al, to form the active site C  [Eq. (1)].

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts


ka

C Al ! C 

After the catalyst is activated by reaction with the cocatalyst, it is ready to polymerize the monomer, M, forming a living polymer chain P1 of length 1 [Eq. (2)].
ki

C  M ! P1

A subsequent monomer propagation reaction with a growing polymer of chain


length r, Pr , increases its length to r 1 [Eq. (3)].
kp

Pr M ! Pr1

In general, the rst monomer insertion step is considered to have a dierent reaction rate constant, k i , from the subsequent monomer propagation steps, k p . Since
in practice these constants are very dicult (if not impossible) to estimate independently, most kinetic models make the reasonable simplifying assumption
that k i G k p .
The most important transfer reactions in coordination polymerization are: (1) bhydride elimination; (2) transfer to chain-transfer agent; (3) transfer to monomer;
and (4) transfer to cocatalyst.
b-Hydride elimination is a rst-order reaction in which the hydrogen atom attached to the b-carbon in the living chain is abstracted by the active center, forming
a metal hydride center, CH , and a dead polymer chain containing a terminal vinyl
unsaturation, D
r [Eq. (4)].
k tb

Pr ! CH D
r

The metal hydride center is available for polymerization and will undergo an initiation reaction in the presence of monomer [Eq. (5)], similarly to that of [Eq. (2)].
k iH

CH M ! P1

The independent estimation of k i and k iH can be very involved; often the simplifying assumption k i G k iH is adopted.
For polypropylene polymerization, b-hydride transfer will produce a dead polymer chain with a vinylidine chain end. On the other hand, vinyl-terminated chains
are produced when b-methyl-transfer reactions take place [Eq. (6)].
k tbCH3


D
Pr 
! CCH
r
3

Chain-transfer agents are commonly used to control the molecular weight of the
polymer. By far the most common chain-transfer agent used in olen polymerization is hydrogen [Eq. (7)].
k tH

Pr H2 ! CH Dr

385

386

8 Coordination Polymerization

Chain transfer to hydrogen leads to the production of a dead chain with a saturated
chain end, Dr , and a metal hydride active site that can be initiated with monomer
according to Eq. (5).
Transfer to monomer also occurs during olen polymerization, leading to a
vinyl-terminated chain for the case of polyethylene (and a vinylidine-terminated
chain for the case of polypropylene) [Eq. (8)].
k tM

Pr M ! P1 D
r

Finally, the cocatalyst may also act as a chain-transfer agent [Eq. (9)]. If the cocatalyst is trimethylaluminum, (CH3 )3 Al, this elementary step produces a methylatedactive center, which can also be initialized by the monomer in a subsequent step:
k tAl


Pr Al ! CCH3
Dr; Al

Coordination catalysts are very sensitive to polar impurities and may also be deactivated due to mono- or bimolecular mechanisms. Even though these elementary
reactions are not very well understood from a quantitative point of view, we will
show next some simple reaction mechanisms proposed to describe them.
Reactions with polar impurities, I, leading to the formation of a deactivated site,
Cd , and a dead polymer chain have been modeled with the very simple equations
[Eqs. (10) and (11)].
kdI

Pr I ! Cd Dr
kdI

C  I ! Cd

10
11

Likewise, monomolecular and bimolecular deactivation reactions have been described with the simple kinetic schemes described by Eqs. (12)(14).
kd

Pr ! Cd Dr
 kd

C ! Cd
 kd

2C ! 2Cd

12
13
14

These deactivation equations are not easy to prove, but have been successful in describing several olen polymerization processes with ZieglerNatta and metallocene catalysts.
The term single-site catalyst has a very precise meaning in coordination polymerization. From the point of view of catalyst structure, single-site catalysts are
those where all active sites are represented by the same chemical species and have
the same polymerization kinetic parameters. In other words, single-site catalysts
can be represented with a single set of the elementary reactions described by Eqs.
(1)(14) or any other equivalent set of polymerization mechanism equations. From
a polymer microstructure point of view, single-site catalysts will produce linear

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts

polymers that have a theoretical polydispersity of 2 instantaneously. These two conditions are not independent. In fact, the second condition is the consequence of
the rst.
The qualication instantaneously used above should not be taken lightly, since
this may lead to signicant misunderstanding of catalyst behavior. An instantaneous property refers to the property of the polymer made at a given instant in
time under a set of invariant polymerization conditions. If these conditions change
throughout the polymerization, so will the instantaneous property under examination. Therefore, even though polymer made with a single-site coordination catalyst
has a polydispersity of 2 instantaneously, the polydispersity of the accumulated
polymer may be much higher (but never lower) than 2 if reaction conditions are
allowed to vary during the polymerization, as indicated in Figure 8.20 for the case
of decreasing chain-transfer agent concentration as a function of polymerization
time. It is only when the polymerization is operated at steady state that the instantaneous properties of the polymer will be equal the accumulated ones.
Polymers made by a mechanism where the chain can either grow by propagation
or terminate by transfer reactions, as quantied by Eqs. (1)(14), follow Florys
most probable chain length distribution [33] [Eq. (15)].
wr



r
r
exp

rn2
rn

15

1.4

chain transfer agent

time

1.2

0.8

w (r )

time

0.6

0.4

0.2

0
1

1.5

2.5

log r
Fig. 8.20. Instantaneous chain length distributions of a
polymer made with a single-site catalyst when the
concentration of chain transfer agent the reactor decreases with
increasing polymerization time.

3.5

4.5

387

388

8 Coordination Polymerization

In Eq. (15), wr is the weight distribution of chains of length r and rn is the


number-average chain length of the polymer population. Therefore, from a polymer microstructure point of view, a coordination catalyst is considered to have
only one site type if it produces polymer with a chain length distribution that follows Eq. (15) instantaneously.
Copolymerization
The polymerization model most commonly adopted for olen copolymerization is
the terminal model, particularly for studies of polymerization kinetics. In the terminal model, only the last monomer molecule added to the chain end inuences
polymerization and transfer rates. Besides the fact that it is logically expected, there
is also signicant experimental evidence supporting the terminal model for olen
polymerization. Since monomer propagation and chain-transfer reactions take
place by insertion between the chemical bond formed by the metal in the active
site and the polymer chain end, it is certainly reasonable to assume that both the
nature of the active site and the type of monomer last added to the chain will aect
these reactions. On the other hand, higher-order models such as the penultimate
and pen-penultimate models have not found widespread use in coordination
polymerization.
Copolymerization models are similar to homopolymerization models, with the
added complexity that more polymerization rate constants are required. An accepted form of the terminal model for the binary copolymerization of olens is
shown in Table 8.1. Notice that, except for the fact that the polymerization rate constants now depend on the monomer and the chain end type, the mechanism is essentially the same as the one described in Section 8.3.2.1 for homopolymerization.
For the case of linear binary copolymers, the instantaneous bivariate chain length
and chemical composition distribution, wr; y, is described by Stockmayers distribution [Eqs. (16)(19)] [34].
8.3.2.2




r
r
r
r
ry 2
exp

exp

rn2
rn
2pk
2k
q
k FA 1  FA 1  4FA 1  FA 1  rA rB

wr; y

rA

k p; AA
;
k p; AB

rB

k p; BB
k p; BA

y FA  FA

16
17
18
19

As indicated in Eq. (19), y is the deviation from the average molar fraction of
monomer type A in the copolymer, F A . As usual, the instantaneous value of F A
can be calculated using the molar fraction of monomer A in the reactor, fA , and
the reactivity ratios rA and rB by the MayoLewis equation, Eq. (20) [35].
FA

rA  1 fA2 fA
rA rB  2 fA2 21  rB fA rB

20

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts


Tab. 8.1.

Terminal model for binary copolymerization of olens.[a]


ka

Activation

C A ! C

Initiation

C  A ! P1; A
k i; B
C  B ! P1; B

Propagation

Pr; A A ! Pr1; A


k p; AB
Pr; A B ! Pr1; B
k p; BA
Pr; B A ! Pr1; A
k p; BB
Pr; B B ! Pr1; B

b-Hydride elimination

Pr; A ! CH D


r; A
k tb; B
Pr; B ! CH D
r; B

Transfer to hydrogen

Pr; A H2 ! CH Dr; A


k tH; B
Pr; B H2 ! CH Dr; B

Transfer to monomer

Pr; A A ! P1; A D


r; A
k t; AB
Pr; A B ! P1; B D
r; A
k t; BA
Pr; B A ! P1; A D
r; B
k t; BB
Pr; B B ! P1; B D
r; B

Transfer to cocatalyst


Pr; A Al ! CCH3
Dr; Al
kAl; B

Pr; B Al ! CCH3
Dr; Al

Deactivation with impurities

Pr; A I ! Cd Dr; A


kdI; B
Pr; B I ! Cd Dr; B

Monomolecular deactivation

Pr; A ! Cd Dr; A


kd; B
Pr; B ! Cd Dr; B

k i; A

k p; AA

k tb; A

k tH; A

k t; AA

kAl; A

kdI; A

kd; A

[a] A and B represent the two monomer types. All other symbols are the
same as those used for homopolymerization, but the reaction rate
constants indicate the type of chain end and reacting monomer with
the generic nomenclature k i; j where i is the chain end type and j
represents the monomer type.

In the same way that Florys distribution is the necessary outcome of adopting the
homopolymerization model described by Eqs. (1)(14), Stockmayers distribution
is the consequence of adopting the binary copolymerization mechanism described
in Table 8.1.
The attentive reader may have noticed that Stockmayers distribution is an extension of Florys distribution for the case of copolymers. In fact, upon integration in
the interval y a y a y, Stockmayers distribution reduces to Florys distribution as demonstrated by Eq. (21).

r




r
r
r
ry 2
r
r
exp 
exp 
dy 2 exp 
wr
2
rn
2pk
rn
rn
2k
y rn
y

21

Therefore, the chain length distributions of linear binary (or multicomponent) copolymers also follow Florys most probable distribution and have, instantaneously,
a polydispersity of 2.

389

8 Coordination Polymerization

Similarly, an expression for the chemical composition distribution alone can


be obtained by integrating Eq. (16) over all chain lengths, that is, in the interval
0 a r a y:
w y

y
0




r
r
r
r
ry 2
3
dr r
exp 
exp 
5=2
rn2
rn
2pk
2k
2k
y 2 rn
4
1
rn
2k

22

It is dicult to overestimate the explanatory power contained in these few simple


expressions. Equation (16) teaches us that longer polymer chains also have narrow
chemical composition distributions, as illustrated in Figure 8.21. This result simply reects the fact that statistical deviations from the average copolymer composition become less likely as the chain increases in length, as would be expected since
chains with innite length should all have exactly the same average copolymer
composition. Equation (16) also shows that the tendency to form comonomer
blocks (rA rB ! y) will necessarily broaden the chemical composition distribution
of copolymers, while the tendency toward monomer alternation (rA rB ! 1) will
narrow the chemical composition distribution and in the limit make all chains
have the composition F A 0:5, as illustrated in Figure 8.22. In fact, the chemical
composition distribution is best apprehended by plotting Eq. (22) as a function of
the lumped parameter rn =k. Figure 8.23 shows that the chemical composition dis-

0.01
0.009

r = 250
r = 500
r = 1000

0.008
0.007
0.006

w (r ,y )

390

0.005
0.004
0.003
0.002
0.001
0
-0.1

-0.08

-0.06

-0.04

-0.02

0.02

y
Fig. 8.21. Chemical composition distribution for several chain
lengths, as described by Stockmayers bivariate distribution.
Distribution parameters: rn 1000, FA 0:5, rA rB 1.

0.04

0.06

0.08

0.1

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts


0.035

r1r2 = 0.01
r1r2 = 1.0
r1r2 = 5

0.03

w (r , y )

0.025

0.02

0.015

0.01

0.005

0
-0.1

-0.08

-0.06

-0.04

-0.02

0.02

0.04

0.06

0.08

0.1

y
Fig. 8.22. Chemical composition distribution for the same
chain length and varying rA rB , as described by Stockmayers
bivariate distribution. Distribution parameters: rn 1000,
FA 0:5, r 1000.

40

rn / = 1000
rn / = 2000
rn / = 4000

35
30

w( y)

25
20
15
10
5
0
-0.1

-0.08

-0.06

-0.04

-0.02

0.02

y
Chemical composition distribution as a function of
the lumped parameter rn =k in Eq. (22).
Fig. 8.23.

0.04

0.06

0.08

0.1

391

392

8 Coordination Polymerization

tribution becomes broader as the value of rn =k decreases, reecting the fact that
polymers with shorter number-average chain lengths and a tendency to form
blocks (see Eq. (17): k increases when rA rB increases) have broader chemical composition distributions. In conclusion, the width of the instantaneous chemical
composition distribution of binary copolymers made by coordination polymerization is a function of a single lumped parameter rn =k and, for a given copolymer
composition, depends only on the number-average chain length and reactivity ratio
product rA rB .

8.3.3

Polymerization Kinetics with Multiple-site Catalysts

All heterogeneous ZieglerNatta and Phillips catalysts have two or more active-site
types and many soluble ZieglerNatta and metallocene catalysts may also show
multiple-site behavior [36, 37]. In addition, several metallocene catalysts, when
supported on organic and inorganic carriers, may behave like multiple-site catalysts even if they behaved as single-site catalysts in solution polymerization. Therefore, several of the catalysts used industrially for polyolen manufacturing have in
fact two or more active-site types.
The kinetics of polymerization with multiple-site catalysts is generally considered to be the same as with single-site catalysts, as described by Eqs. (1)(14) for
homopolymerization and in Table 8.1 for copolymerization, with dierent polymerization kinetic parameters assigned to each site type. In some cases, the polymerization mechanism may be extended to include site transformation steps, where
sites of one type may change into sites of another type, such as the one described
with the reversible reaction in Eq. (23), where D could be a catalyst modier such
as an electron donor, for instance.
C1 D $ C2

23

Since these additional site transformation steps may aect the relative ratio of
site types present in the reactor but do not inuence the general polymerization
behavior with multiple-site catalysts, for the sake of simplicity they will not be further considered in this chapter.
It is usually straightforward to detect the presence of multiple-site types on a coordination catalyst because these catalysts will produce polymer with polydispersity
higher than 2 even under invariant polymerization conditions. The simplest way to
visualize this phenomenon is to assume that every dierent site type on a multiplesite catalyst produces polymers that follow a distinct Florys distribution: that is,
those with a distinct number-average chain length, rn; i [38]. In this way, the chain
length distribution for the whole polymer is a combination of distinct Florys distributions weighted by the mass fraction of polymer made on each site type, m i
[Eq. (24)].

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts


1
0.9
0.8
0.7

w (r )

0.6
0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
1

1.5

2.5

3.5

4.5

log r
Fig. 8.24. Chain length distribution of a polymer made with a
coordination catalyst containing three dierent active-site types.
See Figure 8.25 for the corresponding chemical composition
distribution. Distribution parameters: rn; 1 500, rn; 2 1000,
rn; 3 2000, m1 0:3, m2 0:3, m3 0:4.

wr

n
X

mi

i1

r
rn;2 i



r
exp 
rn; i

24

The graphical representation of Eq. (24) for a coordination catalyst having three
distinct site types is shown in Figure 8.24. It is important to remember that the
use of Eq. (24) is a direct consequence of assuming that the mechanism of polymerization for multiple-site catalysts is described with the same set of equations,
Eqs. (1)(14), used to describe single-site catalysts. In other words, Florys distribution is the logical consequence of the mechanism adopted for coordination polymerization.
For polymers made with multiple-site catalysts, the instantaneous number- and
weight-average chain lengths are given by Eqs. (25) and (26).

rn

rw 2

n
X
mi

!1

r
i1 n; i
n
X
i1

m i rn; i

25

26

393

8 Coordination Polymerization
25

20

w (fraction of ethylene)

394

15

10

0
0.8

0.82

0.84

0.86

0.88

0.9

0.92

0.94

0.96

0.98

fraction of ethylene
Fig. 8.25. Chemical composition distribution
of polymer made with a coordination catalyst
containing three dierent active-site types.
See Figure 8.24 for the corresponding chain

length distribution. Distribution parameters:


rn =k1 2000, rn =k2 4000,
rn =k3 8000, FA; 1 0:88, FA; 2 0:90,
FA; 3 0:93, m1 0:3, m2 0:3, m3 0:4.

Therefore, the polydispersity index of a polymer made with a catalyst having n site
types is given by Eq. (27), which is always greater than or equal to 2.
n
X
rw
PDI 2
m i rn; i
rn
i1

n
X
mi

r
i1 n; i

27

Similarly, the bivariate molecular weight and chemical composition distributions


of binary copolymers made with multiple-site catalysts can be described as a
weighted superposition of Stockmayers distributions [39]. If we consider only the
chemical composition component of the distribution, as described by Eq. (22), the
distribution of polymer made with a multiple-site catalyst becomes Eq. (28).

w y

n
X

3
m i s
 
  5=2
k
y 2 rn
i1
1 i
4 2
rn i
2 k i

28

Figure 8.25 shows the chemical composition distribution obtained with Eq. (28) of
a polyolen made with a catalyst having three distinct active-site types, whose
chain length distribution has already been presented in Figure 8.24. Notice the
characteristic bimodal distribution of ethylene/a-olen copolymers made with het-

w (r, y)

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts

Fig. 8.26. Bivariate distribution of chain


length and chemical composition of a
polymer made with a coordination catalyst
containing three dierent active-site types.

Distribution parameters: rn; 1 500,


rn; 2 1000, rn; 3 2000, FA; 1 0:88,
FA; 2 0:90, FA; 3 0:93, m1 0:3, m2 0:3,
m3 0:4, r1 r2 1 r1 r2 2 r1 r2 3 1.

erogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts. These two gures illustrate a very important


aspect of olen polymerization with heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts, the
fact that the sites that make polymer chains with higher number-average chain
lengths also have a lower reactivity ratio toward comonomer incorporation. This
seems to be a universal property of heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts and is
dramatically illustrated in Figure 8.26 for the bivariate distribution of chain length
and chemical composition of a model polymer. Much research has been done to
overcome this phenomenon, which can very often be seen as a limitation of heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts, since low molecular weight chains with high aolen fractions are easily extracted from the polymer particles and may cause reactor fouling, a high extractable content in lms a serious limitation for food and
medical applications and odor problems during processing.
The multiplicity of active sites on heterogeneous ZieglerNatta and Phillips catalysts is a truly complex phenomenon and other explanations proposed to describe
the observed broad chain length and chemical composition distributions have also
been proposed, but most rely on similar approaches to the one described herein.
The references at the end of the chapter give more information on this topic [40,
41].
8.3.4

Long-chain Branch Formation

The mechanism of long-chain branch (LCB) formation with coordination polymerization catalysts is terminal branching. In this mechanism, a dead polymer chain
containing a terminal unsaturation generally a vinyl group is copolymerized
with a growing polymer chain to form an LCB (Figure 8.27) [15]. We have already
seen that dead polyethylene chains with terminal unsaturations will be formed by

395

8 Coordination Polymerization

Pr+s,4

Pr,2

CH

Zr

Zr

CH


B

396

Ds,1=
Fig. 8.27.

Mechanism of long-chain branch formation with coordination catalysts.

b-hydride elimination and transfer to monomer reactions, as described by Eqs. (4)


and (8), respectively. Since these chains can be reincorporated into the growing
polymer chains via LCB-formation reactions, they are frequently called macromonomers. Macromonomers can be made in situ via b-hydride elimination and
transfer to monomer reactions or they can be added, as an additional comonomer
type, to the polymerization reactor.
In this way, long-chain branch formation can be seen as a copolymerization reaction with a very long a-olen and, as expected, catalysts that have a high reactivity
ratio toward a-olen incorporation can also form polymers with high LCB contents. Several metallocene catalysts and some homogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts are eective in forming polymer chains with LCBs. In contrast, heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts make only linear polyolens.
The polymerization mechanism described by Eqs. (1)(14) for homopolymerization needs to be augmented by only one additional equation, Eq. (29), to include
long-chain branch formation.
kLCB

Pr; i D
s; j ! Prs; ij1

29

In Eq. (29), the subscripts i and j indicate the number of LCBs per chain, while the
subscripts r and s are their respective chain lengths. Therefore, when a linear growing chain (i 0) reacts with a linear macromonomer ( j 0), a chain with one LCB
is formed (i j 1 1). Similar equations are easily developed for copolymerization.
The weight distribution of chain length for polymer populations containing i
LCBs per chain, wr; i is given by Eq. (30) [42], in which the parameter t is given
by Eq. (31).
wr; i
t

1
r 2i1 t 2i2 exptr
2i 1!

rate of chain transfer rate of LCB formation


rate of propagation

30
31

8.3 Polymerization Kinetics and Mechanism with Coordination Catalysts


0.0004
Linear
0.00035

0.0003

w (r , y )

0.00025
1 LCB
0.0002
2 LCB
3 LCB

0.00015

4 LCB
5 LCB

0.0001

0.00005

0
0

2000

4000

6000

8000

10000

12000

14000

16000

18000

20000

r
Chain length distributions of the several polymer
populations of branched polyolens made with a single-site
coordination catalyst (1=t 1000).
Fig. 8.28.

Therefore, in the absence of LCB formation, t 1=rn , and Eq. (30) reduces to
Florys most probable distribution, Eq. (15). Figure 8.28 shows the chain length
distribution for several polymer populations with increasing numbers of LCBs per
chain. As expected, the chain length average increases with an increasing number
of LCBs per chain.
An analytical solution for the instantaneous chain length distribution for the
whole polymer produced in a CSTR is also available [Eq. (32)] [15]. The function
I1 is the modied Bessel function of the rst kind of order 1, given by Eq. (33).
Bessel functions are easily found in mathematical tables and are readily available
is most scientic software applications [43, 44].
wr

I1 x


p 
1  at exprt
rt a
p
I1 2
1a
1 a a
y
X
x=2 12k
k!Gk 2
k0

32

33

The parameter a is dened by Eq. (34), where f is the molar fraction of macromonomer in the reactor, measured with respect to the total concentration of polymer; s is the reciprocal of the average reactor residence time; kLCB is the rate constant for LCB formation; and Y is the concentration of growing polymer chains in
the reactor.

397

8 Coordination Polymerization
0.00035

0.0003

= 0.1
0.00025

0.0002

w (r )

398

0.00015

0.0001

= 0.3

0.00005

= 0.5

0
0

5000

10000

15000

20000

25000

30000

35000

40000

Fig. 8.29. Overall chain length distribution for branched


polyolens made with a single-site coordination catalyst
(1=t 1000).

f
1 s=kLCB Y

34

Figure 8.29 shows how the chain length distribution of the whole polymer is affected by the value of the parameter a. First, notice that a belongs to the interval
[0, 1]. All chains are linear when a 0 since this implies that either f 0 (without macromonomers, no LCBs can be formed) or s=kLCB Y ! y. The latter condition is obeyed when either s ! y (that is, the reactor residence time tends to
zero) or kLCB Y 0. Both cases imply that no macromonomers are accumulated
in the reactor. On the other hand, LCB formation is maximal when a 1, a condition obeyed only when all dead polymer chains in the reactor contain terminal unsaturations, f 1, and the residence time in the reactor is innite, s ! 0, or the
rate of LCB formation is innite, kLCB Y ! y. Therefore, Eq. (32) captures, in a
very elegant way, all the factors determining LCB formation with a coordination
catalyst.
The parameter a can also be related to the number of LCBs per chain for the
whole polymer, B, by Eq. (35).
B

a
1a

35

8.4 Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances

Notice that the average number of LCBs per chain can vary from 0 when a 0 to
innity when a 1. Since most long-chain-branched polyolens made with coordination catalysts are only sparsely branched, with values of B rarely exceeding unity,
the upper limit of the paramter a should be considered only as a theoretical possibility never to be reached in practical situations.
Chain length averages and polydispersity index for the whole polymer can also
be related to the parameters a or B via Eqs. (36)(38).
1
r n 1 2B
t

36

2
r w 1 2B1 B
t

37

PDI 21 B

38

These equations demonstrate that the polydispersity index of long-chain-branched


polyolens is always greater than 2 and that the chain length averages increase
with an increasing number of LCBs per chain.
It is also interesting to calculate the mass fraction of polymer populations containing i LCBs per chain, m i , by Eq. (39).
mi

2i! a i 1  a2i 1
i!i 1!
1 a 2i2

39

Notice that, for sparsely branched polymers, most of the chains are linear, but the
number of more highly branched species increases as a ! 1, as illustrated in Figure 8.30.
Similarly, an extension [Eq. (40)] of Stockmayers distribution can be derived for
binary copolymers containing LCBs formed by terminal branching [45].
wr; y; i

r


1
r
ry 2
r 2i1 t 2i2 exprt
exp 
2i 1!
2pk
2k

40

These equations give a very accurate portrait of the chain microstructure of these
polyolens. They are, in fact, a window into their chain architecture and can be
very useful in understanding the constitution of these complex polymers.

8.4

Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances

Most commercial processes for the manufacture of polyolens use solid catalysts,
such as heterogeneous ZieglerNatta and Phillips catalysts. Many metallocene catalysts have also been supported on inorganic carriers, typically silica, for industrial

399

8 Coordination Polymerization
1
= 0.05
= 0.1

0.9

= 0.2
= 0.4
= 0.8

0.8
0.7
0.6

mi

400

0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0
0

0.5

1.5

2.5

3.5

4.5

i (LCB/chain)
Fig. 8.30.

Mass fraction of chains with i LCB per chain, as a function of the parameter a.

use [24]. As in any solid-catalyzed reaction, interparticle and intraparticle massand heat-transfer resistances may become a limiting step in heterogeneous olen
polymerization processes.
Olen polymerization with heterogeneous catalysts has several very distinct characteristics that should be discussed from a qualitative point of view before a more
quantitative treatment is presented. Eective heterogeneous catalysts for olen
polymerization are highly porous, as is usual with most heterogeneous catalysts.
When a fresh catalyst particle is rst fed to the reactor it is evidently free of polymer, but its pores quickly become lled with polymer molecules formed as monomer diuses from the bulk phase in the reactor to the surface of the active sites on
the catalyst pores. At this point, the three alternatives illustrated in Figure 8.31 are
possible: (1) the polymer phase clogs the catalyst pores and inhibits any additional
polymerization from happening; (2) the structure of the catalyst is not strong
enough to resist the expansion forces of the fast-forming polymer chains and explodes in several smaller particles, generating nes; (3) the growing polymer
chains are capable of fragmenting the catalyst particle in an ordered way and act
as a binder between the catalyst fragments, forming an expanding polymer particle
composed of polymer chains surrounding catalyst fragments.
The last alternative is the only one that has industrial interest; much catalyst research is behind the design of catalyst particles that can be properly fragmented to
form uniform polymer particles. This leads to the so-called replication phenomenon, whereby the size distribution of the catalyst particles is neatly replicated by
the size distribution of the polymer particles exiting the reactor, as illustrated in

8.4 Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances

catalyst particle with


pores clogged with polymer

catalyst fragmentation
and formation of fines

desired expanding
catalyst-polymer
particle

Fig. 8.31. Particle growth and fragmentation for


polymerization with heterogeneous coordination catalysts.

Figure 8.32. Proper replication of the catalyst particles is essential for stable reactor
operation and also for the handling of the polymer particles in post-reactor processes. Reactor residence time distribution in CSTRs may have an important eect
on the replication phenomenon; the references at the end of the chapter provide
more details on this subject [4650].
This picture of particle fragmentation and growth has been captured in its most
important details by the multigrain model [36, 5160] which was originally developed to describe the crystalline structures of TiCl3 and TiCl4 /MgCl2 ZieglerNatta
catalysts, but has also been used extensively to describe metallocene and late transition metals catalysts supported on inorganic carriers. In the multigrain model,
the polymer particle is divided into two levels of mass-transfer resistances: the microparticles or primary particles, and the macroparticle or secondary particle. The
secondary particle is the porous catalyst particle itself that is fed to the reactor. It
is considered to be formed by the agglomeration of several nonporous primary
particles having polymerization active sites on their surfaces. As polymer grows
around the primary particles, the secondary particle expands as a function of polymerization time and activity. The multigrain model is illustrated in Figure 8.33.
Notice that the multigrain model does not deal directly with the initial seconds
of particle fragmentation, when the catalyst pores are being lled with polymer
chains that start to fragment the catalyst particles. Since many industrial catalysts
are in fact pre-polymerized in milder conditions in a separate reactor before being
fed to the polymerization reactor, this should not be seen as a limitation of the
multigrain model for most industrial applications. Catalyst pre-polymerization in

401

8 Coordination Polymerization

Polymerization

Catalyst

Polymer

Cumulative %

402

Particle size
Replication phenomenon for polymerization with
heterogeneous coordination catalysts.
Fig. 8.32.

milder conditions is generally recommended to avoid the formation of intraparticle


hot spots and the improper fragmentation of the catalyst particles when subjected
to the more severe polymerization conditions existing in industrial polymerization reactors. Several older and some more recent simulation studies deal with
these initial instants of polymerization, but they are beyond the scope of this
chapter. These initial particle-fragmentation models are more interesting for prepolymerization studies, since the amount of polymer made during this very short
initial stage is unlikely to have a marked inuence on the overall properties of the

Secondary Particle
or
Macroparticle

Primary Particle
or
Microparticle

Catalyst
fragment
Fig. 8.33.

The multigrain model.

Growing
polymer
shell

8.4 Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances

polymer produced in the reactor. A 2001 review covers some of these alternative
models [36].
The multigrain model equation for spherical secondary particles is the classic
diusion-reaction equation in a sphere, Eq. (41), where Ms is the monomer concentration in the secondary particle as a function of polymerization time, t, and
radial position, rs .


qMs
1 q
qMs
2
De rs2
 RVp
rs qrs
qt
qrs

41

The eective diusivity in the secondary particle, De , can be estimated using the
conventional expression for eective diusivity in porous heterogeneous catalysts,
Eq. (42), where Db is the monomer bulk diusivity in the reaction medium, and e
and t are the void fraction and tortuosity of the polymer particle, respectively. The
fact that both e and t are likely to vary as a function of the degree of fragmentation
and expansion of the secondary particle is certainly one of the diculties in getting
a good estimate for De .
De

eDb
t

42

Finally, RpV is the average volumetric rate of polymerization in the secondary


particle at a given radial position. Since, in the multigrain model, the polymerization is assumed to take place only at the surface of the primary particles, this term
couples the models for the primary and secondary particles.
Equation (41) is subjected to the following boundary conditions given by Eqs. (43)
and (44), where Rs is the radius of the secondary particle, ks is the mass-transfer
coecient in the external lm surrounding the secondary particle, and Mb is the
monomer concentration in the bulk phase. Equations (43) and (44) are the classic
boundary conditions for heterogeneously catalyzed chemical reactions, namely
symmetry at the center of the particle and stationary convective mass transfer
through the mass-transfer boundary layer surrounding the particle, respectively.
Finally, the initial condition is given by Eq. (45).
qMs
rs 0; t 0
qrs
De

qMs
rs Rs ; t ks Mb  Ms
qrs

Ms rs ; t 0 Ms0

43
44
45

The initial concentration in the secondary particle, Ms0 , may be set to zero for a
monomer-free catalyst condition, but this generally leads to sti dierential equations that may be very hard to solve. It is also common to assume a pseudo-steady-

403

404

8 Coordination Polymerization

state concentration at t 0 to obtain the initial condition for Eq. (41). Unless one
is interested in the monomer proles for the very rst seconds of polymerization,
this approximation generally leads to a system of partial dierential equations that
is simpler to integrate.
Spherical primary particles are modeled with a similar equation [Eq. (46)].


qMp
1 q
2 qMp
Dp rp
2
rp qrp
qt
qrp

46

In Eq. (46), the subscript p refers to values in the primary particles. Equation (47)
has been suggested to estimate the eective diusivity of monomer in the primary
particle, where Da is the diusivity of monomer in amorphous polymer and w and i
are correction factors to account for the decrease in diusivity due to chain crystallinity and immobilization of the polymer amorphous phase due to the crystallites.
As can be very well imagined, these parameters are also hard to determine and Dp
is generally used as an adjustable parameter in the model.
Dp

Da
wi

47

Notice that Eq. (46) does not contain a polymerization reaction term. Because the
multigrain model assumes that polymerization takes place at the surface of the catalyst fragment embedded within the primary particle, the reaction term appears as
one of the two required boundary conditions [Eq. (48)]. Equation (48) states that
the rate of monomer diusion at the surface of the catalyst fragment, R c , equals
the rate of monomer consumption due to polymerization at rate of Rpc , and Eq.
(49) imposes the condition that the concentration at the surface of the primary particle equals the equilibrium concentration of monomer absorbed onto the polymer
phase, Meq .
4pR 2c Dp

qMp
4
rp R c ; t pR 3c R pc
3
qrp

Mp rp R p ; t Meq a Ms

48
49

The equilibrium concentration of monomer in polymer can be related by Eq. (50)


to the monomer concentration in the secondary particle at a given radial position
and time if a partition coecient, KMP , between the two phases is known.
Meq

Ms
KMP

50

The polymerization rate at the surface of the catalyst fragment is given by Eq. (51),
where C  is the concentration of active sites at the surface of the catalyst fragment.

8.4 Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances


Tab. 8.2. Temperature proles in the primary and secondary particles according to the
multigrain model.

Secondary particle

Primary article



qTs
1 q
qTs
2
rp Cp
ke rs2
DHp RpV
rs qrs
qt
qrs
qTs
rs 0; t 0
qrs
qTs
ke
rs Rs ; t hTb  Ts
qrs
Ts rs ; t 0 Ts0



qTp
qTp
1 q
2
ke rp2
rp qrp
qt
qrp
4
2 qTp
4pRc ke
rp R p ; t DHp pRc3
3
qrp
rp Cp

Tp rp R p ; t Ts
Tp rp ; t 0 Tp0

R pc k p C  Mrp R c ; t

51

Finally, the initial condition for the primary particle is stated in Eq. (52).
Mp rp ; t 0 Mp0

52

Once again, a pseudo-steady-state approximation may be adopted to reduce the


stiness of the system of dierential equations for short polymerization times.
The multigrain model also includes a set of equations to describe the temperature proles in the primary and secondary particles. These equations are summarized in Table 8.2. Mathematical models for solving this system of partial dierential equations with moving boundaries are involved and have been discussed in
the literature [36, 5160].
This versatile model has been used extensively to describe polymerization with
heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts. Although it is dicult to make general
statements for such complex systems, it can be said with condence that most
of the mass- and heat-transfer resistances will take place at the beginning of the
polymerization when the concentration of active sites on the secondary particles
is at its maximum. As polymer is formed, it pushes apart the active sites in what
can be visualized as a dilution eect. In this way, as the secondary particle grows,
the catalyst concentration decreases, and naturally intraparticle mass- and heattransfer eects become less prevalent. For the same reason, particle hot spots are
more likely to be observed with highly active catalyst particles at the beginning of
the polymerization. This eect is highly undesirable since it may lead to softening
of the polymer phase and result in particle agglomeration and severe reactor fouling, especially in gas-phase reactors.
The equations presented so far for the multigrain model are mass- and energybalance equations in a spherical catalyst particle used for conventional heterogeneously catalyzed reactions subjected to a moving boundary due to polymer
formation. To predict polymer properties such as chain length and chemical composition, these monomer and temperature proles must be coupled with an additional set of equations that describes polymerization and termination mechanisms

405

406

8 Coordination Polymerization

taking place on the surface of the catalyst. The method of moments is generally the
preferred technique used in conjunction with the multigrain model, but its discussion will be deferred to Section 8.5. Instead, we will use Stockmayers bivariate distribution, Eq. (16), to illustrate how polymer properties can be conveniently predicted from the multigrain model.
First, it should be remembered that Stockmayers distribution is an instantaneous distribution; that is, it describes the distributions of chain length and chemical composition for polymer made at a given instant in time at a given spatial location in the reactor. Now, consider the polymerization of ethylene and an a-olen,
1-hexene for instance, taking place in a spherical porous catalyst particle. Hydrogen is used as the chain-transfer agent. Assume also that the catalyst has only one
type of active site, as would be observed when supporting a metallocene on a porous silica particle, for instance. The primary and secondary particles at a given instant in time are subject to mass-and heat-transfer resistances that result in radial
monomer concentration and temperature proles. Assuming that ethylene propagates at a much higher rate than 1-hexene and that both have comparable diusivities, the radial prole for ethylene will be much steeper than for 1-hexene. Similarly, the radial prole for hydrogen can be assumed to be very at, since the
hydrogen diusivity is high and its reaction rate is low. (Notice that a low reaction
rate of the chain-transfer agent as compared to the polymerization rate for the
monomers is a requirement for the production of high molecular weight polymers.) Given that the monomer concentration and temperature aect the parameters of the Stockmayer distribution, rn =k, each radial position i in the secondary
particle is associated with a unique Stockmayers distribution, wi r; y, as depicted
in Figure 8.34. Polymer richer in the slow reacting comonomer, 1-hexene, is produced near the center of the particle because the molar ratio of 1-hexene/ethylene
increases from the surface to the center of the particle. Likewise, chains with lower
molecular weight are produced at the center of the particle because the molar ratio
of hydrogen/(ethylene 1-hexene) increases from the surface to the center of the
particle. These concentration gradients will, therefore, broaden the distributions
of molecular weight and chemical composition of polymer made with a heterogeneous catalyst, even a single-site catalyst, due to the spatial variations of concentrations within the particle.
The summation of all these distributions over the polymer particle, weighted by
the amount of polymer made at each radial position, gives the distribution for the
whole particle at a given instant in time wp r; y, as described by Eq. (53), where
Rp; i is the rate of polymerization at radial position i and m is the number of radial
positions used in the discretization of the macroparticle.
m
X

wp r; y

Rp; i wi r; y

i1
m
X
i1

53
Rp; i

8.4 Single Particle Models Mass- and Heat-transfer Resistances

w (fraction of ethylene)

30

407

1.2

25

15

0.8

w (r )

20

10

0.2

0
0.7

0.72

0.74

4
3
2

0.4

0.6

0.76

0.78

0.8

0.82

fraction of ethylene

log r

12 3 4

H2
C6H12
C2H4
Fig. 8.34. Using Stockmayers distribution with the multigrain
model to predict the distribution of chain length and chemical
composition of polyolens.

These instantaneous distributions can then be integrated in time to obtain the


cumulative distribution in the reactor per polymer particle, Wp r; y [Eq. (54)].
m
X
Rp; i wi r; y dt
Wp r; y

i1

m
X

54
Rp; i dt

i1

For the case of catalysts containing multiple-site types, such as heterogeneous


ZieglerNatta catalysts, a similar approach applies, by dening one Stockmayers
distribution for each active-site type. In this case, the overall distribution of chain
length and chemical composition in the particle at a given instant equals the summation of the distributions over all site types and all radial positions in the particle
[Eq. (55)], where the subscript j indicates the site type of a catalyst containing n
site types.

408

8 Coordination Polymerization
m X
n
X

wp r; y

Rp; i; j wi; j r;
i1 j1
m X
n
X

y
55

Rp; i; j

i1 j1

Many other single-particle model formulations exist with lower or higher levels of
sophistication. Most of these models generate qualitative results that are similar to
the ones described in this section. As usual with any modeling eort, the degree of
model sophistication must be justied by the quality of the experimental data available to support the model assumptions. Our recent (2001) review gives coverage of
these alternative models [36].

8.5

Macroscopic Reactor Modeling Population Balances and the Method of Moments

Population balances coupled with the method of moments can be considered the
method of choice in most olen polymerization simulation models. Population
balances are molar balances (steady-state or dynamic) of all the important chemical
species present in the reactor: living and dead polymer chains, catalyst sites, monomers, and chain-transfer agents. Solving the dynamic population balances for living and dead chains of length r allows the recovery of the complete chain length
distribution as a function of polymerization time. Alternatively, instead of solving
the whole population balance, one may use the method of moments to solve for
only a few moments of the chain length distribution, a technique that requires
much less computational eort. In this case, it is possible to model how chain
length averages vary as a function of polymerization time, but the information
about the complete distribution is irretrievably lost for more complex cases.
In this section, we will rst illustrate how to use the method of moments for
homopolymerization and then show how these equations can be easily adapted to
copolymerization using the method of pseudo-kinetic constants.
8.5.1

Homopolymerization

In the following model development, we will use the polymerization kinetics


mechanism described by Eqs. (1)(14) to derive the population balances and moment equations for homopolymerization with a catalyst containing only one site
type. Catalysts containing two or more site types are handled similarly by dening
a set of equations with distinct polymerization kinetic constants for each dierent
site type.
For living polymer chains of length r b 2 made in a CSTR, the dynamic population balance can be derived as Eq. (56).

8.5 Macroscopic Reactor Modeling Population Balances and the Method of Moments

dPr
Prin k p MPr1  Pr  k tb k tH H2 k tAl Al k tM M kdI I kd sPr
dt
56
In Eq. (56) and in the subsequent ones, the notation x in represents the feed ow
rate of a given chemical species to the reactor, and s is the reciprocal of the average
residence time in the CSTR. Notice that Eq. (56) is simply the molar balance for
chains of length r: chains are generated by propagation of a chain of length r  1
or by transfer from a feed stream (coming from a previous reactor in a series of
reactors, for instance), and are consumed by either propagation to chains of length
r 1, by transfer and deactivation reactions leading to dead polymer chains, Dr , or
by exiting the reactor in an outlet stream.
Similarly, for chains of unit length, Eq. (57) applies.
dP1
P1in k i C  k iH CHi M  k p P1 M
dt
 k tb k tH H2 k tAl Al k tM M kdI I kd sP1

57

The population balances for C  and CH are needed to solve Eqs. (56) and (57).
P
They are given in Eqs. (58) and (59) respectively, where Y 0 y
r 1 Pr .
dC 
C in ka CAl k tAl Al k tM MY 0  k i M kdI I kd sC 
dt

58

dCH
in
CH
k tb k tH HY 0  k iH M kdI I kd sCH
dt

59

Often, the reaction between catalyst and cocatalyst is considered instantaneous.


Consequently, the term ka CAl can be dropped from Eq. (58) and it is assumed
that C  t 0 Ct 0 .
The concentration of deactivated catalyst sites at any time is obtained via a molar
balance [Eq. (60)].
Cd t C  t 0  C  t  CH t  Y 0 t

60

Population balances for dead polymer chains are also easily derived from the polymerization mechanism equation, Eq. (61).
^ r dDr dD dDr; Al
dD

r
dt
dt
dt
dt
^r
^ in k tH H2 kdI I kd k tb k tM M k tAl AlPr  sD
D
r

61

409

410

8 Coordination Polymerization

In Eq. (61), dead chains with all types of chain ends (Dr ; D
r , and Dr; Al ) have been
^ r for simplicity. Separate population balances for
combined in a single variable D
dead chains with dierent chain end types could also be kept, if necessary.
Molar balances for monomer, chain-transfer agent, impurities, catalysts, and cocatalyst [Eqs. (62)(66)] are also required to solve the system of ordinary dierential equations dened by Eqs. (56)(61).
dM
M in  k p Y 0 k tM Y 0 k i C  k iH CH sM G M in  k p Y 0 sM
dt

62

dH2
H2in  k tH Y 0 sH2
dt

63

dI
I in  kdI Y 0 C  CH sI
dt

64

dC
C in  ka Al sC
dt

65

dAl
Al in  ka C k tAl Y 0 sAl
dt

66

Because of the long-chain approximation, the simplication k p Y 0 g k tM Y 0 k i C 


k iH CH in Eq. (62) is very often applied.
Elegant ways of solving the population balances dened by Eqs. (56)(66) have
been developed to model how the complete chain length distribution of polyolens
varies as a function of polymerization time in batch, semibatch, or continuous reactors [61, 62].
When only chain length averages are required, the method of moments is the
most adequate technique for solving this problem. The ith moment, mi , of a given
distribution, f x, is dened by Eq. (67).
mi

x i f x

67

Therefore, the zeroth moment is simply the total number (or concentration) of living polymer chains [Eq. (68)].

Y 0

y
X
r 1

Pr P1

y
X

Pr

68

r 2

Notice that, for coordination polymerization, Y 0 will be approximately equal to


the number of active sites at a given time in the reactor, since initiation reactions
tend to be very fast in these systems.

8.5 Macroscopic Reactor Modeling Population Balances and the Method of Moments

Taking the rst derivative of Eq. (68), one obtains Eq. (69).
y
dY 0 dP1 X
dPr

dt
dt
dt
r 2

69

Substituting Eqs. (56) and (57) into Eq. (69) generates the nal expression for the
zeroth moment of living polymer chains in a CSTR. After some algebraic manipulation, Eq. (70) is obtained.
dY 0
Y 0in K i M  K t K d sY 0
dt

70

Here the several kinetic parameters were lumped into the constants K t ; K d , and K i
according to Eqs. (71)(73), to allow for a more concise notation.
K t kbt k tH H2 k tM M k tAl Al

71

K d kd kdI I

72

K i k i C  k iH CH

73

Similarly, the rst moment of the living chains corresponds to the weight of these
chains [Eqs. (74) and (75)].

Y 1

y
X

rPr 1  P1

y
X

rPr

74

r 2

r 1
y
dY 1 dP1 X
dPr

r
dt
dt
dt
r 2

75

Once again, substituting Eqs. (56) and (57) into Eq. (75) leads to the nal expression for the rst moment of living polymer chains in a CSTR, Eq. (76).
dY 1
Y 1in K i M  K t K d sY 1 k p MY 0
dt

76

The equations for the second moment of living polymer, Eqs. (77)(79), are derived
in an analogous manner.
Y 2

y
X
r 1

r 2 Pr 1 2  P1

y
X
r 2

r 2 Pr

77

411

412

8 Coordination Polymerization
y
dY 2 dP1 X
dPr

r2
dt
dt
dt
r 2

78

dY 2
Y 2in K i M  K t K d sY 2 k p M2Y 1 Y 0
dt

79

A similar procedure leads to the moment equations for the chain length distribution of dead polymer molecules [Eqs. (80) and (81)].

X i

y
X

r i Pr

80

r 1
y
dX i X
dXr

ri
dt
dt
r 2

81

Substituting Eq. (61) into Eq. (81) produces the general expression for the ith moment of the dead polymer chains, Eq. (82).
dX i
X iin K t K d Y i  P1  sX i
dt

82

Notice that P1 is subtracted from Y i for exactness since dead chains of length
1 are simply monomer units and should not be counted as dead polymer chains.
This correction, however, is negligible for high polymers and can be omitted for
most modeling applications.
Equation (70), (76), (79), and (82) can be solved with the molar balances for the
reactants, Eqs. (62) to (66), to calculate the leading moments of the chain length
distribution. The values of the moments, as a function of polymerization time,
can then be used to compute the chain length averages with the expressions described below.
The number-average chain length, rn , is easily related to the zeroth and rst moments of the distributions of chain length of living and dead polymer by Eq. (83).
y
X

rn

rDr Pr

r 1
y
X

Dr Pr

X 1 Y 1
X 1
G 0
0
0
X Y
X

83

r 1

Since, for most coordination polymerizations, the amount of dead polymer far exceeds the amount of living polymer in the reactor, the approximation indicated in
Eq. (83) is very commonly used.

8.5 Macroscopic Reactor Modeling Population Balances and the Method of Moments

The weight-average chain length, rw , is likewise obtained from the ratio of the
second to the rst moments of living and dead chains, obtained from Eq. (84).
y
X

rw

r 2 Dr Pr

r 1
y
X

rDr Pr

X 2 Y 2
X 2
G 1
1
1
X Y
X

84

r 1

Finally, the polydispersity index, PDI, is given by Eq. (85).

PDI

rw X 2 Y 2 X 0 Y 0
X 2 X 0

G
2
rn
X 1 Y 1
X 1 2

85

For the case of multiple-site catalysts, population balances are derived for each catalyst site type, and the chain length-averages for the whole polymer are found by
averaging the values calculated for each site type [Eqs. (86) and (87)].
n
X

rn

Xj

j1
n
X

n
X

j1
n
X

G
0

Xj

rw

Yj
Yj

j1

j1

n
X
2
2
Xj Yj

n
X

j1
n
X

j1
n
X

G
1

Xj

Yj

j1

Xj

86
0

Xj

Xj

87
1

Xj

j1

Population balances and the method of moments can also be combined with the
multigrain model and other polymer particle growth models. In this case, the population balances are dened for each position in the particle to obtain the radial
proles of chain length averages [36, 5160].
8.5.2

Copolymerization

Population balances for copolymerization can be developed using the polymerization kinetics presented in Table 8.1. This approach generates equations that are
similar to the ones obtained for homopolymerization but contain more terms to
account for the eect of chain ends on the kinetics of propagation and termination.

413

414

8 Coordination Polymerization

We will rst show how to derive such population balances for living polymer
chains, but instead of applying the same approach to all other species we will introduce the concept of pseudo-kinetic rate constants [63, 64]. When pseudo-kinetic
rate constants are dened, the equations derived for homopolymerization can also
be used for copolymerization with only one minor modication, thus considerably
simplifying the time required for model development.
The population balance for living polymer chains terminating in monomer type
A with r b 2 is given by Eq. (88).
dPr; A
Pr;inA k p; AA Pr1; A  Pr; A A k p; BA Pr1; B A  k p; AB Pr; A B
dt
 k tb; A k tH; A H2 k tAl; A Al k t; AA A k t; AB B kdI; A I kd; A sPr; A
88
Similarly, for living polymer chains terminating in monomer type B with r b 2,
Eq. (89) applies.
dPr; B
Pr;inB k p; BB Pr1; B  Pr; B B k p; AB Pr1; A B  k p; BA Pr; B A
dt
 k tb; B k tH; B H2 k tAl; B Al k t; BA A k t; BB B kdI; B I kd; B sPr; B
89
Equations (88) and (89) can be added to obtain the dierential equation for Pr
Pr; A Pr; B , Eq. (90).
dPr
Pr;inA Pr;inA k p; AA Pr1; A A k p; AB Pr1; A B k p; BA Pr1; B A
dt
k p; BB Pr1; B B  k p; AA Pr; A A k p; AB Pr; A B k p; BA Pr; B A k p; BB Pr; B B
 k tb; A Pr; A k tb; B Pr; B  k tH; A Pr; A k tH; B Pr; B H2
 k tAl; A Pr; A k tAl; B Pr; B Al
 k t; AA Pr; AA A k t; AB Pr; A B k t; BA Pr; B A k t; BB Pr; B B
 kdI; A Pr; A kdI; A Pr; B I  kd; A Pr; A kd; B Pr; B  sPr

90

Applying the denitions in Eqs. (90)(93) to Eq. (90), one obtains Eq. (94).
fA

Pr; A
;
Pr; A Pr; B

fA

A
;
AB

M AB

fB 1  fA

fB 1  fA

91

92
93

8.5 Macroscopic Reactor Modeling Population Balances and the Method of Moments

dPr
Prin k p; AA fA fA k p; AB fA fB k p; BA fB fA k p; BB fB fB Pr1 M
dt
 k p; AA fA fA k p; AB fA fB k p; BA fB fA k p; BB fB fB Pr M
 k tb; A fA k tb; B fB Pr  k tH; A fA k tH; B fB Pr H2
 k tAl; A fA k tAl; B fB Pr Al
 k t; AA fA fA k t; AB fA fB k t; BA fB fA k t; BB fB fB Pr M
 kdI; A fA kdI; A fB Pr I  kd; A fA kd; B fB Pr  sPr

94

Equation (94) can be expressed in the more compact form of Eq. (95), where the
pseudo-kinetic constants are dened by Eqs. (96)(102).
dPr
Prin k^p MPr1  Pr  k^tb k^tH H2 k^tAl Al k^tM M k^dI I k^d sPr
dt
95
k^p k p; AA fA fA k p; AB fA fB k p; BA fB fA k p; BB fB fB

96

k^tb k tb; A fA k tb; B fB

97

k^tH k tH; A fA k tH; B fB

98

k^tAl k tAl; A fA k tAl; B fB

99

k^tM k t; AA fA fA k t; AB fA fB k t; BA fB fA k t; BB fB fB

100

k^dI kdI; A fA kdI; A fB

101

k^d kd; A fA kd; B fB

102

Notice that Eqs. (56) and (95) are equivalent, with the only dierence that Eq. (95)
uses pseudo-kinetic constants in place of the actual kinetic constants found in Eq.
(56). The beauty of this modeling approach is that it is not necessary to develop
new equations for copolymerization (binary or higher): the equations developed
for homopolymerization, including the moment equations, are equally applicable
to copolymerization, provided that pseudo-kinetic constants are used to replace
the actual polymerization kinetic constants.
To calculate the pseudo-kinetic constants one must know the values of fA and fA
at each polymerization time. Values for fA are easily calculated from the molar balance for the monomers, Eq. (103).
dA
Ain  k i C  k i; H CH A  k p; AA fA k p; BA fB AY 0
dt
 k t; AA fA k t; BA fB AY 0  sA

103

Since most of the monomer is consumed in polymerization reactions, Eq. (103) is


commonly reduced to the simpler form of Eq. (104).

415

416

8 Coordination Polymerization

dA
Ain  k p; AA fA k p; BA fB AY 0  sA
dt

104

The analogous equation for monomer B is Eq. (105).


dB
B in  k p; BB fB k p; AB fA BY 0  sB
dt

105

The long-chain approximation can be used to calculate the values of fA via Eqs.
(106)(108).
k p; AB Pr; A B k p; BA Pr; B A

106

and therefore:
k p; AB fA fB k p; BA fB fA k p; BA 1  fA fA
fA

k p; BA fA
k p; BA fA k p; AB fB

107
108

The use of Eq. (108) to calculate fA assumes that this value is not a function of
chain length; compare Eq. (91). It has been shown that this hypothesis is valid for
high polymers [63, 64].
Finally, the average copolymer composition [Eq. (109)] is easily obtained from
Eqs. (104) and (105).
FA

A
;
AB

FB 1  FA

109

8.6

Types of Industrial Reactors

The polymerization of olens with coordination catalysts is performed in a large


variety of polymerization processes and reactor congurations that can be classied
broadly into solution, gas-phase, or slurry processes. In solution processes, both
the catalyst and the polymer are soluble in the reaction medium. These processes
are used to produce most of the commercial EPDM rubbers and some polyethylene
resins. Solution processes are performed in autoclave, tubular, and loop reactors.
In slurry and gas-phase processes, the polymer is formed around heterogeneous
catalyst particles in the way described by the multigrain model. Slurry processes
can be subdivided into slurrydiluent and slurrybulk. In slurrydiluent processes, an inert diluent is used to suspend the polymer particles while gaseous
(ethylene and propylene) and liquid (higher a-olens) monomers are fed into the
reactor. On the other hand, only liquid monomer is used in the slurrybulk pro-

8.6 Types of Industrial Reactors

(d)
(a)
(b)
(c)

(e)

Reactor congurations used with olen


polymerization: (a) Autoclave; (b) Loop; (c) Fluidized-bed;
(d) Vertical gas-phase; (e) Horizontal gas-phase.
Fig. 8.35.

cess. Polyethylene and polypropylene can be produced in slurrydiluent reactors,


while slurrybulk reactors are restricted to polypropylene and its copolymers.
Slurry processes involve the use of autoclaves or loop reactors. Gas-phase reactors
are also used to polymerize ethylene, propylene, and higher a-olens. They can be
classied into uidized-bed and stirred-bed reactors. A gaseous stream of monomer and nitrogen uidizes the polymer particles in uidized-bed reactors, while
mechanical stirring is responsible for suspending the polymer particles in gasphase stirred-bed reactors. Gas-phase stirred-bed reactors are further subdivided
into horizontal and vertical reactors. These dierent reactor congurations are illustrated in Figure 8.35.
Several polymerization processes use only one reactor, but two or more reactors
can also be operated in series (tandem reactor technology) to produce polyolens
with more complex microstructures [5]. Each reactor in the series is maintained
under dierent operating conditions to produce products that are sometimes called
reactor blends. Although, in principle, the post-reactor blending of dierent
resins could lead to the same product, in reactor blends the chains are mixed on
the molecular scale, permitting better contact between the polymer chains made
in dierent reactors at a lower energy cost.
The oldest example of this procedure is the manufacture of high-impact polypropylene, as already described (see Section 8.1.2). Other applications have become
more popular lately, especially for the production of bimodal resins. Figure 8.36
illustrates a tandem process using two gas-phase vertical stirred-tank reactors. Several other reactor combinations are used industrially [65]. For heterogeneous processes, the rst reactor(s) in the series can be either slurry or gas-phase, but commonly the second reactor (or set of reactors) is a gas-phase reactor. This is
especially important when the production of polymers with lower crystallinity

417

418

8 Coordination Polymerization
unreacted
monomer

catalyst
cocatalyst

offgas

N2
Reactor 1

Reactor 2
powder
silo
polymer
pellets

propylene

propylene

ethylene

ethylene

hydrogen

hydrogen

Fig. 8.36.

N2
Extruder

Example of a gas-phase tandem reactor process.

occurs in the second set of reactors, because this fraction is more easily extracted in
slurry reactors, leading to fouling problems. Of course, these processes should be
operated in such a way as to avoid particle agglomeration caused by the formation
of sticky polymers of lower crystallinity.
For heterogeneous catalysts, tandem reactor technology also relies on the fact
that each polymer particle is in fact a microreactor operated in semibatch mode,
into which monomers and chain-transfer agents are fed continually, while the polymer formed never leaves the microreactor. In this way, polymer populations with
dierent average properties are produced in each reactor and accumulate in the
polymer particle microreactor, as illustrated in Figure 8.37. In theory, an optimal
balance does exist between the fractions of these dierent populations to meet
certain performance criteria. This creates a truly fascinating reactor and product
design problem because the fractions of the dierent polymer populations per particle will be a function of the residence time distribution in the individual reactors
in the reactor train.
Consider rst the case of two tubular reactors in series, making high-impact
polypropylene. Reactor 1 produces isotactic polypropylene, while random
ethylenepropylene copolymer is made in Reactor 2. Assuming that both reactors
are ideal plug-ow reactors, the residence time of all the polymer particles in each
reactor is exactly the same. Consequently, if the distribution of active sites in the

8.6 Types of Industrial Reactors

Product from
reactor 1

Product from
reactors 1 and 2
(reactor blend)

catalyst and
cocatalyst
monomers and
chain transfer
agents
monomers and
chain transfer
agents

Fig. 8.37.

Production of reactor blends in tandem reactors.

catalyst particles is uniform, the fractional polypropylene content in the ethylene


propylene copolymer is exactly the same in each polymer particle exiting Reactor 2.
Figure 8.38 illustrates this situation.
A very dierent picture emerges when using two CSTRs in series. Because the
residence time distribution of an ideal CSTR, Et, with average residence time tr ,
is given by the usual exponential decay equation [Eq. (110)], then some particles
will leave Reactor 1 after a short time while others will only leave after spending a
considerably longer time in the reactor.


1
t
Et exp 
tr
tr

419

110

Since the same will happen in Reactor 2, in the end the ratio of polypropylene to
ethylenepropylene copolymer per particle exiting Reactor 2 will also vary widely,
which may be undesirable in some applications. Some of the reactor congurations shown in Figure 8.35 can reduce this phenomenon, particularly the conguration adopted for the gas-phase horizontal reactor, because the residence time distribution of this reactor is the equivalent to about three to four CSTRs in series.
(Remember that the residence time of an innite series of ideal CSTRs is that of
a plug-ow reactor.) A more recent solution for this problem, in fact a completely
new alternative to tandem reactor technology, is the multizone reactor that will be
described in more detail below (see Section 8.6.4).

420

8 Coordination Polymerization

Fig. 8.38.

Reactor blends produced in two plug-ow reactors and two CSTRs in series.

These polymerization processes were originally designed to polymerize olens


with heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts, with the exception of some solution
processes that were designed to work with homogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts
for the production of EPDM rubbers or some types of polyethylene resins. However, heterogeneous ZieglerNatta processes can be adapted to the use of metallocene catalysts with minimal changes if the metallocenes are supported on an inert
carrier such as silica. Although some dierences in particle morphology have been
noticed when heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts are replaced by supported
metallocenes, these ZieglerNatta processes are also currently being used with
metallocene catalysts on an industrial scale. In fact, the possibility of using metallocenes in conventional ZieglerNatta reactors is one of the main reasons for the
fast adoption of metallocenes by the polyolen manufacturing industry.
8.6.1

Gas-phase Reactors

Gas-phase reactors for olen polymerization are divided into two classes: uidizedbed reactors and stirred-bed reactors. The stirred-bed reactors can be further classied into vertical and horizontal.

8.6 Types of Industrial Reactors

Gas-phase reactors, especially uidized-bed reactors, are the most common conguration for the polymerization of ethylene to produce HDPE and LLDPE. They
are also a very common choice for the second reactor in the production of highimpact polypropylene.
Fluidized-bed reactors were developed by Union Carbide (Unipol Process)
currently Univation and British Petroleum (BP). Some details in their conguration may vary, but their main characteristics are the same. In uidized-bed
reactors, gaseous monomers, chain-transfer agent, inerts, and catalysts are fed continuously into the reactor. The polymerization temperature should be kept well
below the melting point of the polymer to avoid particle agglomeration, loss of uidization, and bed collapse. Since polymer particles are formed in the gas phase in
absence of diluent, there is no need for further separation steps when the product
is exiting the reactor (except for removal of unconverted monomer), which is a
clear advantage of gas-phase processes over slurry and solution processes.
The heat of polymerization can be removed by heat exchangers placed on an external recirculation loop. However, low boiling point hydrocarbons and a-olen comonomers can be introduced into the reactor in the liquid phase to absorb the heat
of polymerization by their latent heat of evaporation in an operation procedure
called condensed mode. Since most polymerization reactors are limited by their
heat removal capability, this technique permits a substantial increase in reactor
productivity.
There are two principal designs for stirred-bed gas-phase reactors: vertical (originally developed by BASF/Targor) and horizontal (originally developed by Amoco
Chisso). These reactors have several of the advantages of uidized-bed reactors but
the polymer bed is suspended by mechanical agitation. Therefore, impeller design
is of the utmost importance in these reactors to avoid reactor fouling and particle
agglomeration. Stirred-bed reactors are generally smaller than uidized-bed reactors, thus permitting grade transition with less production of o-specication material. Both vertical and horizontal designs can be operated in condensed mode to
increase productivity. As mentioned above, the narrower residence time distribution of horizontal gas-phase stirred-bed reactors is advantageous for the production
of reactor blends with a narrow distribution of their dierent components. Narrow
residence time distributions are also useful if frequent grade transitions are required.
Gas-phase reactors have several advantages, notably:


Good temperature control due to high turbulence and heat-transfer coecients,


and heat removal by the latent heat of vaporization of inerts and monomers.
 Lower operational costs due to lack of diluent recovery operations and, in the
case of uidized-bed reactors, due to the absence of moving parts.
 Grade exibility for molecular weight control, since hydrogen concentration is
regulated by varying the partial pressure of hydrogen in the reactor. In slurry
and solution reactors, the low solubility of hydrogen in the diluent may reduce
the range of possible molecular weights for a given catalyst.
 Higher comonomer incorporation (that is, production of copolymer with lower

421

422

8 Coordination Polymerization

crystallinity). This is possible since there is no risk of copolymer dissolution in


the reaction medium. However, care should be taken not to form sticky polymer
particles that can lead to particle agglomeration or reactor fouling.
 The narrower residence time distribution of horizontal stirred-bed reactors leads
to higher yields per pass, formation of less o-specication material, and more
uniform impact copolymers and reactors blends.
Some disadvantages of gas-phase reactors are:


For the particular case of uidized-bed reactors, uidization is not a trivial process and therefore demands better process control and the design of catalyst particles that uidize well.
 Severe fouling and polymer particle agglomeration can occur, with occasional reactor shutdown. Fluidized-bed reactors, in particular, are prone to the formation
of polymer sheets on the walls (sheeting) or polymer chunks that may lead
periodic interruption of reactor operation.
 Fluidized-bed reactors are generally very large, which makes grade transition
more time-consuming and might lead to the production of signicant amounts
of o-specication products.
8.6.2

Slurry Reactors

Slurry processes for olen polymerization are performed in autoclave or loop reactors. Both reactor congurations are rather old and date from the beginning of
commercial olen polymerization. Most rst-generation olen polymerization processes used autoclave reactors, while the Phillips process employed a loop reactor.
Slurrydiluent processes use an inert diluent to suspend the polymer particles.
Although the diluent does not directly aect the polymerization, it has been shown
that dierent diluents might change catalyst behavior, probably due to electronic
interaction with the active sites. Gaseous monomers and hydrogen are continuously bubbled through the diluent. Liquid a-olen comonomers, diluent, catalysts,
and cocatalyst are continuously fed into the reactor. Alternatively, liqueed propylene can be fed into the reactor (slurrybulk process). Except from this dierence,
all other conditions are similar to the slurrydiluent process.
Both autoclave and loop reactors have a residence time distribution of CSTRs
(loop reactors are operated at very high recirculation ratios), so they share several
of the same characteristics. There is a tendency nowadays to favor the loop reactor
conguration for the production of polypropylene in slurrybulk mode.
Some advantages of slurry reactors are:


Their simplicity of design and low cost make them a common choice for
laboratory-scale studies for screening catalysts and investigation of polymerization kinetics, particularly autoclave congurations.
 The large amount of diluent used (or liquid monomer) acts as a heat sink, per-

8.6 Types of Industrial Reactors

mits very good temperature control, and minimizes the risk of runaway polymerizations.
 In loop reactors, the high recirculation rate leads to high turbulence and high
heat-transfer coecients. Additionally, the high heat-transfer area available in
these reactors permits ecient removal of heat of polymerization and therefore
high polymer yields.
However, slurry processes also have several disadvantages, such as:


It is necessary to remove the diluent from the polymer formed and recycle it
back to the polymerization reactor after purication, thus increasing operational
costs and environmental hazards.
 With ZieglerNatta catalysts, molecular weight is generally controlled by transfer
to hydrogen. Since the solubility of hydrogen in the diluent is not very high,
there is less exibility for controlling molecular weight with this type of reactor.
This is not as important for Phillips catalysts, where molecular weight control is
achieved via support treatment, but can become a limiting factor with Ziegler
Natta catalysts. Metallocenes are generally very sensitive to the presence of hydrogen and therefore less inuenced by this reduced solubility that ZieglerNatta
catalysts.
 Less crystalline copolymer chains can dissolve in the diluent particularly
the ethylenepropylene copolymer fraction in high-impact polypropylene
causing fouling and increasing the viscosity of the diluent. Therefore, certain
low-crystallinity grades cannot be produced with these reactors.
It has been speculated that, for the case of metallocene catalysts, some of the limitations encountered with slurry reactors (both CSTR and loop) when producing
copolymers of lower crystallinity can be minimized or completely eliminated. As
discussed above, heterogeneous ZieglerNatta catalysts produce LLDPE with very
broad chemical composition distributions containing low-crystallinity tails. Such
low-crystallinity tails are absent in most polyolens made with metallocene catalysts, thus minimizing the risk of copolymer dissolution during polymerization in
slurry reactors.
8.6.3

Solution Reactors

Solution processes use autoclave, tubular, or loop reactors. As compared to slurry


and gas-phase polymerization, solution processes are commonly operated at a
much higher temperature to keep the polymer dissolved in the reaction medium,
and at much lower average residence times (520 min, as opposed to 14 h). Since
polymerization conditions are more uniform in solutions reactors there are
no inter- and intraparticle heat- and mass-transfer resistances, for instance this
conguration is commonly used for the production of EPDM rubbers with soluble
ZieglerNatta vanadium-based catalysts. Composition homogeneity is a require-

423

424

8 Coordination Polymerization

ment of most EPDM rubbers since the formation of populations with higher crystallinity is generally not acceptable in the rubber industry.
Solution reactors can be also used to produce polyethylene resins with soluble
ZieglerNatta or metallocene catalysts.
The short residence time used in solution reactors because of their high operation temperature is often an advantage during grade transition. The fact that the
polymer is in solution is also benecial for process control, since solution viscosity
can be used as a measure of polymer molecular weight, for instance. However,
high solution viscosities are also a limiting factor for these reactors, reducing the
achievable polymer concentration in solution, especially for high molecular weight
resins. Solution reactors can also operate in a wider range of temperatures than
slurry and gas-phase reactors, for which the temperature should be high enough

Internal
gas/solid separator

RISER
upward
pneumatic
transport

DOWNCOMER
packed bed
moving downward

Gas
fan
Product
discharge
Catalyst
inlet

Heat exchanger
Fig. 8.39.

Schematic of a multizone circulating reactor [50].

Notation

to permit high polymerization rates but not so high as to soften the polymer and
cause particle agglomeration and reactor fouling. This wider temperature range allows for more exibility in terms of catalyst types and polymer structural control.
In addition, solution reactors can be used to produce polymer from very high to
very low crystallinity, since there are no problems with reactor fouling caused by
sticky low-crystallinity polymers.
8.6.4

Multizone Reactors

The multizone circulating reactor (see Figure 8.39) is a novel concept for propylene
polymerization, developed by Basell. This reactor combines a fast uidization reactor with a moving packed-bed reactor and can produce reactor blends in a single
reactor instead of in a series of reactors [65]. The reactor operates in a cycle: polymer is transferred from the bottom of the xed-bed section (downcomer) to the
bottom of the uidized-bed section (riser). A gas stream, containing monomers
and inerts, conveys the polymer particles to the top of the riser and a centrifugal
separator settles them at the top of the downer. Finally, the particles ow by gravity
from the top to the bottom of the downer, where the cycle is repeated again.
The polymer particles can pass through these two sections of the reactor several
times before exiting the reactor. If these two (or more) zones are kept in dierence
polymerization conditions, a multimodal reactor blend polymer can be produced.
It is claimed that because the polymer particles can be made to circulate between
the dierent reactor zones several times before exiting the reactor, a more uniform
distribution of blend components will result than in an equivalent resin made
on two reactors in series. Of course, this is what would be expected from a reactor
blend made in several reactors in series.

Notation

A
Al
B
C
C

CCH
3
Cd
CH
D
Da
Db
De
Dp
Dr

monomer type A
cocatalyst or activator
number of LCBs per chain for the whole polymer; monomer type B
catalyst
active center
methylated active center
deactivated site
metal hydride center
catalyst modier (electron donor)
diusivity of monomer in amorphous polymer [cm 2 s1 ]
monomer bulk diusivity in the reaction medium [cm 2 s1 ]
eective diusivity in the secondary particle, [cm 2 s1 ]
eective diusivity in the primary particle, [cm 2 s1 ]
dead chain with a saturated chain end

425

426

8 Coordination Polymerization

D
r
^r
D
Dr; Al
Et
f
fA
FA
H2
i
I
I1
ka
kd
Kd
kdI
ki
Ki
k iH
kLCB
KMP
kp
k p; ij
ks
Kt
k tb
k tb-CH3
k tAl
k tH
k tM
m
mi
M
Mb
Meq
Mp
Mp0
Ms
Ms0
n

dead polymer chain containing a terminal vinyl unsaturation


dead polymer chains with all possible types of chain ends
dead polymer chain formed via a transfer to cocatalyst reaction
reactor residence time distribution
molar fraction of macromonomer in the reactor, measured with respect
to the total concentration of polymer
molar fraction of monomer A in the reactor
average fraction of comonomer A in the copolymer
hydrogen
number of long-chain branches per polymer chain
polar impurity
modied Bessel function of the rst kind of order 1
rate constant for catalyst activation [s1 ]
rate constant for monomolecular or bimolecular deactivation [s1 ]
lumped deactivation constant, dened in Eq. (72)
rate constant for deactivation by impurity [L mol1 s1 ]
initiation rate constant [L mol1 s1 ]
lumped initiation constant, dened in Eq. (73)
initiation rate constant for a metal-hydride center [L mol1 s1 ]
rate constant for LCB formation [L mol1 s1 ]
monomer partition coecient between bulk and polymer phases
propagation rate constant [L mol1 s1 ]
propagation rate constant for monomer type i and chain end type j
[L mol1 s1 ]
mass-transfer coecient in the external lm surrounding the secondary
particle [cm s1 ]
lumped chain-transfer constant, dened in Eq. (71)
b-hydride elimination rate constant [s1 ]
b-methyl elimination rate constant [s1 ]
rate constant for transfer to cocatalysts [L mol1 s1 ]
rate constant for transfer to hydrogen [L mol1 s1 ]
rate constant for transfer to monomer [L mol1 s1 ]
number of radial positions used in the discretization of the macroparticle
mass fraction of polymer made on site type i, mass fraction of polymer
with i long-chain branches per chain
monomer
monomer concentration in the bulk phase [mol L1 ]
equilibrium concentration of monomer absorbed onto the polymer
phase [mol L1 ]
monomer concentration in the primary particle [mol L1 ]
initial monomer concentration in the primary particle [mol L1 ]
monomer concentration in the secondary particle [mol L1 ]
initial concentration of monomer in the secondary particle [mol L1 ]
number of active-site types in a multiple-site catalyst

Notation

PDI
PDI
Pr
r
rA ; rB
Rc
rn
rn
Rp; i
Rpc
RpV

polydispersity index
polydispersity index for branched polymers
growing polymer of chain length r
chain length
reactivity ratios
radius of the primary particle [cm]
number-average chain length
number-average chain length for branched polymers
rate of polymerization at radial position i [mol L1 s1 ]
polymerization rate at surface of catalyst fragment [mol L1 s1 ]
average volumetric rate of polymerization in the secondary particle at a
given radial position [mol L1 s1 ]
radial coordinate in the primary particle [cm]
rp
radial coordinate in the secondary particle [cm]
rs
radius of the secondary particle [cm]
Rs
rw
weight-average chain length
rw
weight-average chain length for branched polymers
s
reciprocal of the average reactor residence time [s1 ]
t
polymerization time [s]
average reactor residence time [s]
tr
wr
weight distribution of chains of length r (Florys most probable chain
length distribution)
wr; i
weight distribution of chains of length r containing i long-chain
branches
wr; y
weight distribution of chains of length r and chemical composition y
(Stockmayers bivariate distribution)
wr; y; i weight distribution of chains of length r, chemical composition y, and i
long-chain branches
w y
weight distribution of chains with chemical composition y
wr
instantaneous chain length distribution for the whole polymer produced
in a CSTR in the presence of branching reactions
wp r; y instantaneous distribution of chain length r and chemical composition
y in the polymer particle
Wp r; y cumulative distribution of chain length r and chemical composition y in
the polymer particle
ith moment of the dead polymer chains
X i
y
deviation from the average molar fraction of monomer type A in the
copolymer
Y
concentration of growing polymer chains in the reactor
ith moment of the living polymer chains
Y i
Greek
a
e

dened in Eq. (34)


void fraction of the polymer particle

427

428

8 Coordination Polymerization

correction factor to account for the decrease in diusivity due to chain


immobilization of the polymer amorphous phase due to the crystallites
dened in Eq. (17)
ith moment of a chain length distribution
dened in Eq. (31); tortuosity of the polymer particle
fraction of chains terminated in monomer of type i
correction factor to account for the decrease in diusivity due to chain
crystallinity

i
k
mi
t
fI
w

Subscripts
i; j
r; s

site type; number of long-chain branches


chain length

Superscripts
feed ow rate of a given chemical species to the reactor [mol L1 s1 ]
pseudo-kinetic constant

in
^
Acronyms
Cp
Crystaf
CSTR
EPDM
GPC
HDPE
LCB
LDPE
LLDPE
MAO
Tref

cyclopentadienyl
crystallization analysis fractionation
continuous stirred-tank reactor
ethylenepropylenediene rubber
gel permeation chromatography
high-density polyethylene
long-chain branch
low-density polyethylene
linear low-density polyethylene
methylaluminoxane
temperature rising elution fractionation

References
1 G. W. Coates, Chem. Rev., 2000, 100,

1223.
2 L. Resconi, L. Cavallo, A. Fait, F.
Piemontesi, Chem. Rev., 2000, 100,
1253.
3 K. Angermund, G. Fink, V. R.
Jensen, R. Kleinschmidt, Chem. Rev.,
2000, 100, 1457.
4 J. B. P. Soares, R. F. Abbott, J. D.

Kim, J. Polym. Sci.: Part B: Polym.


Phys., 2000, 38, 1267.
hm, J. C. Boot,
5 J. Scheirs, L. L. Bo
P. S. Leevers, Trends Polym. Sci., 1996,
4, 408.
6 G. Ver Strate, in Encyclopedia of
Polymer Science and Engineering, Vol. 6,
J. I. Kroschwitz (Ed.), John Wiley &
Sons, New York, 1986, p. 522.

References
7 J. B. P. Soares. Fractionation, in

10

11

12
13
14
15
16
17
18

19
20
21

22

Encyclopedia of Polymer Science and


Technology, 3rd Edition, Wiley-VCH,
Weinheim, 2004, pp. 75131.
D. Campbell, R. A. Pethrick, J. R.
White, Polymer Characterization, 2nd
edition, Stanley Thornes Publishers,
Cheltenham, 2000.
W. W. Yau, J. J. Kirkland, D. D. Bly,
Modern Size-Exclusion Liquid Chromatography: Practice of Gel Permeation and
Gel Filtration Chromatography, John
Wiley & Sons, New York, 1979.
S. Anantawaraskul, J. B. P. Soares,
P. M. Wood-Adams, Fractionation
of semi-crystalline polymers by
crystallization analysis fractionation
(Crystaf ) and temperature rising
elution fractionation (Tref ). Adv.
Polym. Sci., in press.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec, in
Experimental Methods in Polymer
Characterization, R. A. Pethrick (Ed.),
John Wiley & Sons, Chichester, 1999,
p. 15.
A. Faldi, J. B. P. Soares, Polymer,
2001, 42, 3057.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Polymer, 1996, 37, 4606.
A. E. Hamielec, J. B. P. Soares, Prog.
Polym. Sci., 1996, 21, 651.
J. B. P. Soares, Macromol. Mater. Eng.,
2004, 289, 70.
E. Y.-X. Chen, T. J. Marks, Chem.
Rev., 2000, 100, 1391.
G. Henrici-Olive, S. Olive, Angew.
Chem. Int. Ed. Engl., 1971, 10(2), 10.
H. H. Britzinger, D. Fischer, R.
lhaupt, B. Rieger, R. M.
Mu
Waymouth, Angew. Chem. Int. Ed.
Engl., 1995, 34, 1143.
K. Soga, T. Shiono, Prog. Polym. Sci.,
1997, 22, 1503.
R. Mulhaupt, Macromol. Chem. Phys.,
2003, 204, 289.
H. L. Krauss, in Transition Metals and
Organometallics as Catalysts for Olen
Polymerization, W. Kaminsky, H.
Sinn (Eds.), Springer-Verlag, Berlin,
1988, pp. 163168.
P. C. Thune, J. Loos, A. M. de Jonga,
P. J. Lemstrab, J. W.
Niemantsverdriet, Topics in Catalysis,
2000, 13, 67.

23 S. Gambarotta, Coord. Chem. Rev.,

2003, 237, 229.


24 G. G. Hlatky, Chem. Rev., 2000, 100,

1347.
25 H. Sinn, I. Schimmel, M. Ott, N.

26
27

28
29
30
31

32
33

34
35
36
37
38
39

40
41
42
43

von Thienen, A. Harder, W.


Hagendorf, B. Heitmann, E. Haupt,
in Metalorganic Catalsyts for Synthesis
and Polymerization, W. Kaminsky
(Ed.), Springer, Berlin, 1999, pp. 105
122.
H. Butenschon, Chem. Rev., 2000,
100, 1527.
S. A. Miller, R. Waymouth, in
Ziegler Catalysts, G. Fink, R.
Mulhaupt, H. H. Brintzinger
(Eds.), Springer, Berlin, 1995, pp.
441454.
H. G. Alt, A. Koppl, Chem. Rev.,
2000, 100, 1205.
S. Chum, W. J. Kruper, M. J. Guest,
Adv. Mater., 2000, 12, 1759.
S. D. Ittel, L. K. Johnson, Chem.
Rev., 2000, 100, 11691203.
L. C. Simon, C. P. Williams, J. B. P.
Soares, R. F. de Souza, Chem. Eng.
Sci., 2001, 56, 4181.
J. B. P. Soares, Chem. Eng. Sci., 2001,
56, 4131.
P. J. Flory, Principles of Polymer
Chemistry, Cornell University Press,
Ithaca, 1953.
W. H. Stockmayer, J. Chem. Phys.,
1945, 13, 199.
P. C. Hiemenz, Polymer Chemistry,
Marcel Dekker, New York, 1984.
T. F. McKenna, J. B. P. Soares,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 2001, 56, 3931.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Polym. React. Eng., 1995, 3, 261.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Polymer, 1995, 36, 2257.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Macromol. Theory. Simul., 1995, 4,
305.
J. B. P. Soares, Polym. React. Eng.,
1998, 6, 225.
T. Keii, Macromol. Theory Simul.,
1995, 4, 947.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Macromol. Theory Simul., 1996, 5, 547.
M. R. Spiegel, J. Liu, Mathematical
Handbook of Formulas and Tables,
McGraw-Hill, New York, 1999.

429

430

8 Coordination Polymerization
44 D. A. McQuarrie, Mathematical

45
46
47

48
49
50
51
52

53

54

Methods for Scientists and Engineers,


University Science Books, Sausalito,
California, 2003.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Macromol. Theory Simul., 1997, 6, 591.
J. B. P. Soares, A. E. Hamielec,
Macromol. Theory Simul., 1995, 1085.
A. Prasetya, L. Liu, J. Litster, F.
Watanabe, K. Mitsutani, G. H. Ko,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1999, 3263.
J. J. Zacca, J. A. Debling, W. H. Ray,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1996, 51, 4859.
J. J. Zacca, J. A. Debling, W. H. Ray,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1997, 52, 1941.
J. A. Debling, J. J. Zacca, W. H. Ray,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1997, 52, 1969.
J. A. Debling, W. H. Ray, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1995, 34, 3466.
S. Floyd, K. Y. Choi, T. W. Taylor,
W. H. Ray, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1986,
32, 2935.
S. Floyd, K. Y. Choi, T. W. Taylor,
W. H. Ray, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1986,
31, 2231.
S. Floyd, R. A. Hutchinson, W. H.

55

56

57
58
59
60
61
62
63
64
65

Ray, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1986, 32,


5451.
S. Floyd, T. Heiskanen, T. W.
Taylor, G. E. Mann, W. H. Ray, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1987, 33, 1021.
R. A. Hutchinson, C. M. Chen, W.
H. Ray, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1992, 44,
1389.
R. A. Hutchinson, W. H. Ray, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1990, 41, 51.
R. A. Hutchinson, W. H. Ray, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1991, 43, 1271.
R. A. Hutchinson, W. H. Ray, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1991, 43, 1387.
R. A. Hutchinson, W. H. Ray, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 1987, 34, 657.
P. Canu, W. H. Ray, Comp. Chem.
Eng., 1991, 15, 549.
M. Wulkov, Macromol. Theory Simul.,
1996, 5, 393.
T. Xie, A. E. Hamielec, Makromol.
Chem., Theory Simul., 1993, 2, 421.
T. Xie, A. E. Hamielec, Makromol.
Chem., Theory Simul., 1993, 2, 455.
M. Covezzi, G. Mei, Chem. Eng. Sci.,
2001, 56, 4059.

431

Mathematical Methods
P. D. Iedema and N. H. Kolhapure
9.1

Introduction

In this chapter some mathematical methods to solve kinetic modeling problems


are explained. A very sound basis for this was already laid many years ago by Flory
[1]. Here, we want to present modern mathematical tools that have recently been
developed through the use of computers. The focus is on the link between kinetic
rate data and reactor type on one hand, and distributive properties in one or
more dimensions on the other. These distributive or microstructural properties
are concerned not only with countable quantities, such as the number of monomer
units in a polymer molecule, but also with structure in the case of branched polymer molecules. With structure, we discuss the connectivity of branch points and
the lengths of the segments between them. In the greater part of the text, reactors
are treated in a simplied manner. We consider continuous and batch reactors, but
all of them ideally mixed. The eect of incomplete mixing (segregation, macroand micromixing) is addressed in classical textbooks such as Biesenberger [2] and
Dotson et al. [3]. Some recent attempts to include the impact of micromixing on
distributions are available in the literature [5759], but this eld is still in its infancy. Nevertheless, to still provide a sound basis for issues of mixing, we devote
one section to the use of computational uid dynamics in polymer reaction engineering problems.
The microstructural properties that we address are chain length, number of
monomer units of one kind (copolymer), number of branch points, number of unsaturated bonds, and number of reactive monomer units (end groups in polycondensation). Problems may require solution of one or more of these properties
simultaneously. Here, we will denote this as the dimensionality of the problem
at hand. For instance, growth in addition polymerization can be described by a
simple 1D (chain length) reaction equation and population balance.
kp

R n M ! R n1

Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes


Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

432

9 Mathematical Methods

dR n
k p MR n1  R n
dt

In contrast, growth in polycondensation of a trifunctional monomer A with a bifunctional monomer B requires a 3D description. The 3D distribution R n; i; k , where
subscripts denote chain length, number of A end groups, number of B end groups,
respectively, obeys:
kc

R n; i; k R m; j; l ! R nm; ij1; kl1

n1 X
i X
k
X
dR n; i; k
jk  l 1li  j 1R m; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1
kc
dt
m1 j0 l 0

Note that this describes a reaction between single end groups of two dierent
molecules; end group combinations within one (longer) molecule require a similar
approach.
These examples illustrate the importance of the dimensionality of the problem at
hand. In general, low dimensionality can be dealt with using analytical or dierential methods, while higher dimensionality soon requires a Monte Carlo sampling
approach. Note that all of these methods, except MC, start with a population balance. Here we will mainly discuss ways to solve such balances of lower or higher
dimensionality. This chapter will start with the description of lower-dimensional
problems and show to what extent these can be successful. This often involves the
reduction of the problem to lower dimensionality, inevitably leading to averaging
over one or more dimensions. The most well-known is the method of moments,
which, however, does not solve full distributions. This is followed by the introduction of a fairly recent mathematical method based on dierential equations that
does solve full distributions: the Galerkin hp nite element method (FEM). Subsequently, we will present advanced applications of the Galerkin-FEM (G-FEM)
method, being classes and pseudo-distribution modeling. A completely dierent
approach originating from polymer network modeling is then discussed: probability generating functions. To conclude the methods for countable properties, we
give an overview of full Monte Carlo simulation methods as introduced by Tobita
[1115, 4851], mostly for cases where analytical or dierential equation approaches fail. A separate section then is spent on very recently developed conditional Monte Carlo methods to synthesize branched architectures. Finally, a section
is devoted on applications of computational uid dynamics in polymer reaction
engineering.

9.2

Discrete Galerkin hp Finite Element Method

The discrete Galerkin hp nite element method (FEM) is a powerful numerical


method to solve chain length distributions for a wide set of polymerization prob-

9.2 Discrete Galerkin hp Finite Element Method

lems. It has been implemented in the commercially available package PREDICI.


A great proportion of the problems discussed in this chapter are solved with this
approach. A detailed description of the mathematics of the method is given by
Wulkow [4]. Below the main mathematical features are given following the description in Ref. 4.
Any set of population balance equations (see, for example, Table 9.2, below) can
be written as a set of countable ordinary dierential equations [Eqs. (5)].
us0 t fs fu1 t; . . . ; us tot tg s 1; . . . ; stot

Here, the us t are the concentrations of all the macromolecules with length n at
time t, represented by vector us t; stot is the dimension (chain length) of the system, for polymer systems typically very large, up to 10 6 . For an approximation u1
of the solution ut t after a time step from t to t t a semi-(linear)-implicit
Euler scheme is applied [Eq. (6), where j ut, A is the derivative f u j, and I
the identity matrix].
I  tADu tf j

u1 j Du
The solution of this equation is approximated by a nite element Galerkin method.
This is realized by a multilevel algorithm, according to which a subdivision of the
j
s-axis is constructed (see Figure 9.1). On each interval h a local expansion us of us is
used, where j is the level number and l is the interval number:
j

usj jh j

( h1j , p1j )

pl
X

a kl t k; l s

k0

( hmj , pmj )

Fig. 9.1. Division of chain length axis into intervals of length


h, where distribution is approximated by Chebyshev
polynomials of order p.

433

434

9 Mathematical Methods

(h1,p1)

(h2,p2)

(h3,p3)

(h4,p4)

(h5,p5)
smax

(h1,p1+1)

(h2,p2)

(h3L,1) (h3R,1) (h4,p4+1)

(h5,p5)

Fig. 9.2. Renement strategy. Orders of intervals (h1 ; p1 ) and


(h4 ; p4 ) increased by 1. Interval (h3 ; p3 ) is split into two
intervals with order 1 (order may be higher according to
optimization strategy). Other intervals remain unchanged.

The polynomials t k; l are discrete Chebyshev polynomials of degree k. The number


j
of expansion coecients pl may dier from interval to interval, such that tting it
to a concentration distribution can be solved by varying grid and order. Note that
this feature gives the name to the method: Galerkin h (varying intervals) p (varying order). The node-order-distribution on the nal grid is chosen in such a way
that the work necessary to compute the whole distribution is minimal:
DF fhl ; pl . . . hm ; pm g

The construction is started with an initial grid D 0 on the interval [0; s max ], where
s max may be very large. It proceeds from level to level by renements or increases
of the order, using information from the previous level. An example is shown in
Figure 9.2.
The Galerkin hp method is very exible, being able to solve simple distributions
with few broad intervals, but also complicated, including multimodal distributions
with steep anks requiring intensive local adaptation. Such adaptations are managed automatically with the method. The algorithm as implemented in PREDICI
utilizes chain length truncation. A truncation index is calculated, being the maximum chain length up to which a distribution is calculated. From the index for a
old
, a new index is calculated from the moments of the
calculated distribution, s max
distribution:
s
 2
m
m
m1
2
new
k 10
9
1 k

s max
m0
m0
m0
When higher accuracy is required in tail calculations weight- or wlog s-based
truncation indices can be calculated, where moments m 0 ; m1 , and m 2 are replaced
by mk ; mk1, and mk2 , with k 1 or 2, respectively. For example, a Flory distribution
with average n n 100 is represented until s max 1100. A rst demonstration of
the capabilities of the Galerkin-FEM method will be given in Section 9.4 in a comparison with the method of moments. Further and extensive use is made of the

9.3 Method of Moments

method in the classes and pseudo-distributions approach, to be discussed in Sections 9.5 and 9.6.

9.3

Method of Moments
9.3.1

Introduction

The method of moments is the most well-known method for solving polymerization problems [13]. The equations are derived from the population balances.
This is realized in a straightforward way for the radical polymerization system of
Table 9.1, a 1D problem. Table 9.2 presents the original population balances and
Table 9.3 the resulting moment equations, up to the 4th moment. The linear part
of this problem can be solved without additional assumptions, but the nonlinear
part leads to a closure problem. This will be discussed next. Some results and a
discussion on the validity of the method will be given in Section 9.4, in a comparison with the Galerkin-FEM method.
9.3.2

Linear Polymerization

Suppose we want to describe a recombination reaction of two living copolymer


chains with one dead chain [Eq. (10)], which is a 2D problem.
p

kc; ps

s
R n; i Rm;
j ! Pnm; ij

10

The rst subscripts (n; m) denote chain length, the second (i; j) the number of
monomer units of one type per chain; superscripts indicate terminal units, identied as either monomer 1 or monomer 2, so p 1 or 2 and s 1 or 2; kc; ps is the

Tab. 9.1. Reaction equations for radical polymerization with transfer to polymer and random
scission by H-abstraction.

Mechanism

Reaction equation

Rate factor

Initiation
Propagation
Disproportionation termination
Recombination termination
Transfer to monomer
Transfer to chain transfer agent S
Transfer to polymer
Random scission by H-abstraction

I2 ! 2I  I  M ! R1
R n M ! R n1
R n R m ! Pn Pm
R n R m ! Pnm
R n M ! Pn R1
R n S ! Pn R1
R n Pm ! Pn R m LCB
R n Pm ! Pn R ml Pl

kd ; k i f
kp
k td
k tc
km
kS
k trp m
k rs m

435

436

9 Mathematical Methods
Tab. 9.2. (Population) balances for radical polymerization with transfer to polymer and random
scission by H-abstraction.
y
X
dM
M0  M  k p tM
R n M0  M  k p tMl 0
dt
n1
dI2
I20  I2  kd tI2
t
dt
dI
t I 2kd tI2  k i tIM
dt
dS
t S0  S  ks tSl 0
dt
dR1
R1 k i tIM ks tSl 0  k p tR1 M k rs tl 0 m 0
t
dt

(a)

(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)

y
X
dR n
k p MR n k p MR n1  k tp R n m1 k tp l 0 Pn k rs l 0
Pk  k rs l 0 m1
dt
kn1

k tc k td l 0 R n  ks SR n  k m MR n  R n =t
y
X
dPn
k tp l 0 nPn k tp m1 R n k rs l 0
Pk k rs m1 R n  k rs l 0 n  1Pn
dt
kn1

(f )

(g)

n1
1 X
k td l 0 R n k tc
R mn R m ks SPn k m MPn  Pn =t
2 m 1

rate coecient for combination between chains with terminal units p and s. The
full population balance reads as [5] (the duet means that this is one out of
possibly more contributions to the population balance of Pn; i ):
2 X
2
n1 X
i
X
X
dPn; i
p
kc; ps
R m; j R snm; ij

dt
r 1 q1
m1 j0

11

The moments of distributions R and P are dened as:


p

lab

y X
y
X
n1 j1

na i b R n; i

mab

y X
y
X

na i b Pn; i ;

p 1; 2

12

n1 j1

The population balance of Eq. (11) is expressed in moments by performing the


summations as in Eq. (12) and collecting all the terms. In its most general form
the result can be expressed as [5]:
b   
2 X
2
a X
X
dmab
1X
a b r r
l l
kc; ps

2 p1 s1
g
d g; d ag; bd
dt
g0 d0

13

Usually, when number- and weight-average molecular weights are to be calculated,

9.3 Method of Moments


Tab. 9.3. Moment equations for radical polymerization with transfer to polymer and random
scission by H-abstraction.

dl 0
1
k p MR1  k tc k td l 20  ks Sl 0  k m Ml 0  l 0
t
dt
dl1
1
k p Ml 0  k tp m1 l1 k tp m 2 l 0 k rs l 0 m 2  m1  k rs l 0 m1  m 0
2
dt
1
 k tc k td l 0 l1  ks Sl1 1  k m Ml1  l1
t


dl 2
1
1
1
2k p Ml1  k tp m1 l 2 k tp m3 l 0 k rs l 0 m3  m 2 m1 k rs l 2 m1  m 0
3
2
6
dt
1
 k tc k td l 0 l 2  ks Sl 2  k m Ml 2  l 2
t


dl3
1
1
1
3k p Ml 2  k tp m1 l3 k tp m4 l 0 k rs l 0 m4  m3 m 2 k rs l3 m1  m 0
4
2
4
dt
1
 k tc k td l 0 l3  ks Sl3  k m Ml3  l3
t


dl4
1
1
1
1
4k p Ml3  k tp m1 l4 k tp m5 l 0 k rs l 0 m5  m4 m3  m1
5
2
3
30
dt
1
k rs l4 m1  m 0  k tc k td l 0 l4  ks Sl4  k m Ml4  l4
t


dm 0
1
1
k tc k td l 20 ks Sl 0 k m Ml 0  m 0
k rs l 0 m1  2m 0
2
t
dt


dm1
1
1
k rs l 0 m 2  m1  m 0 k rs l1 m1  m 0  k rs l 0 m 2  m1 k tp l1 m1
2
2
dt
1
 k tp l 0 m 2 k tc k td l 0 l1 ks Sl1 k m Ml1  m1
t


dm 2
1
1
1
k rs l 0 m3  m 2 m1  m 0 k rs l 2 m1  m 0  k rs l 0 m3  m 2 k tp l 2 m1
3
2
6
dt
1
 k tp l 0 m3 k tc l 0 l 2 l12 k td l 0 l 2 ks Sl 2 k m Ml 2  m 2
t


dm3
1
1
1
k rs l 0 m4  m3 m 2  m 0 k rs l3 m1  m 0  k rs l 0 m4  m3 k tp l3 m1
4
2
4
dt
1
 k tp l 0 m4 k t l 0 l3 3l1 l 2 k td l 0 l3 ks Sl3 k m Ml3  m3
t


dm4
1
1
1
1
k rs l 0 m5  m4 m3  m1  m 0 k rs l4 m1  m 0  k rs l 0 m5  m4
5
2
3
30
dt

(a)
(b)

(c)

(v)

(e)

(f )
(g)

(h)

(i)

( j)

1
k tp l4 m1  k tp l 0 m5 k t l 0 l4 4l1 l3 3l 22 k td l 0 l4 ks Sl4 k m Ml4  m4
t

it is sucient to have a; b 0; 1; 2. Although these forms seem to be complex, they


can be derived straightforwardly and solved without any additional assumption or
model for linear polymerization that is, when rate factors are independent of
chain length, comonomer content, and so on. In fact, contributions to the population balances from all other kinetic mechanisms propagation, transfer to solvent
or monomer, disproportionation can be treated in similar but simpler ways. For
linear polymerization the method of moments provides exact solutions for number

437

438

9 Mathematical Methods

and weight averages of molecular weight and copolymer composition. Most well
known are the averages for homopolymerization expressed as:
Mn m 0

m1
m0

Mw m 0

m2
m1

14

9.3.3

Nonlinear Polymerization

In nonlinear polymerization rate factors depend on chain length or other microstructural properties, which leads to special problems when utilizing the method
of moments [6]. We here address transfer to polymer in radical polymerization
leading to long-chain branching (LCB) and random scission. The reaction equation
for transfer to polymer in a 1D formulation with the rate factor proportional to
chain length, k tp m is Eq. (15).
k tp m

R n Pm ! Pn R m

15

The population balance contribution for dead chains is given by:


y
y
X
X
dPn
nPn ; l 0
Rn
k tp m1 R n  l 0 nPn m1
dt
n1
n1

16

y
P
na Pn , and constructing the moment
Dening moments as in Eq. (12), ma
n1
equations from Eq. (16) yields:

dma
k tp m1 la  l 0 ma1
dt

17

This illustrates a typical closure problem. In linear polymerization, dierential


equations of the ath moment contain RHS terms with ath or lower moments,
which allows direct solution of the set. In contrast, as shown by Eq. (17), nonlinear
polymerization leads to higher moments on the RHS. This implies that the set
cannot readily be solved without additional assumptions. Another example is random scission of linear dead chains into two living chains (macroradicals):
k rs n

Pn ! R m R nm

18

Again, the rate factor is proportional to chain length. The 1D population balance
reads:
y
X
dR n
nPn
k rs
dt
mn1

19

9.3 Method of Moments

Constructing equations for 0th through 4th moments by summing over chain
length leads to:
dl 0
0;
dt

20

dl1
1
k rs m 2  m1 ;
2
dt


dl 2
1
1
1
k rs m3  m 2 m1 ;
3
2
6
dt


dl3
1
1
1
k rs m4  m3 m 2 ;
dt
4
2
4


dl4
1
1
1
1
k rs m5  m4 m3  m1 :
5
2
3
30
dt

21
22
23
24

Hulburt and Katz [7] have developed a method to obtain estimates of the higher
moments in terms of lower ones using a distribution approximation method.
Most previous work has been based on the 3rd-moment closure. A general expression is constructed for moment mi , where l is the highest order of the series of
Laguerre polynomials in the approximation, while a and g are parameters to be
specied:
mi

i g  1! m 0
g  1! g=a i
"
#
l
m
X
km X
j m!m g  1!m i g  1  j!

1
i
j!m  j!m g  1  j!
m3 g=a
j0

25

The series is truncated at l i  1, so that the computation of mi requires the coefcient k i1 . This implies that ml and higher moments equal zero. Coecients k i
follow in their turn from the lower moments m0...i1 by:

ki

i
X
1 j
j0

g  1!
g=a ij
m ;
j!i g  1  j! i  j! ij

26

m
a2
, which leads to
so k 0 m 0 . It is further assumed that: a 1 ; g
m0
m 2 =m 0  a 2
k1 k2 0.
Thus, closure expressions have been obtained for m3 ; m4, and m5 :
m3

m2
2m 2 m 0  m 21
m 0 m1

27

439

440

9 Mathematical Methods

m4

2m 21  3m 2 m 0 3m 21 m 2  6m22 m 0 4m 0 m1 m3
m02 m12

m5

12m14 m 2  42m12 m 22 m 0 36m 20 m 32 20m13 m 0 m3  30m1 m 20 m 2 m3 5m12 m 20 m4 3m12  4m 2 m 0


m 20 m13

28

29

9.4

Comparison of Galerkin-FEM and Method of Moments

Certain features of both methods can nicely be illustrated in a simple nonlinear


problem: radical polymerization with transfer to polymer in a continuous stirredtank reactor (CSTR) with termination by either disproportionation or recombination. Data and results are shown in Figures 9.39.5. Typical for the moment
method is the occurrence of a point beyond which no stable solution exists. In
this case this happens for k tp 1000 m 3 (kmol s)1 for the case with disproportionation and k tp 160 m 3 (kmol s)1 when recombination is by the termination
mechanism. In both cases the second moment of dead chains, m 2 , goes to innity
at that point. Such instabilities are not found by the G-FEM method. At higher k tp
we observe further clear discrepancies, especially for the living chains having much
higher Mw according to G-FEM. However, the living chain Mw values are not calculated correctly in all cases by the G-FEM method. This is best demonstrated by
comparing the chain length distributions (CLDs) of living and dead chains for the
recombination case shown in Figures 9.1 and 9.2. One observes that the CLD tail
of the living chains extends over a much wider range than that of the dead chains.
This is due to the existence of computation limits in the G-FEM PREDICI package:
concentrations Pn below a specied minimum are put equal to zero. For dead
chains this limit is located at chain lengths of around 10 7 , where concentrations
are more than 10 orders of magnitude smaller than the highest dead chain concentrations. Living chain concentrations drop less rapidly with length; in terms of
n 2 R n they even rise at high n, and consequently they are calculated up to a higher
limit: n 10 9 . Now, some of the living chains are produced from dead ones of the
same length through transfer to the polymer. The computation limit of dead
chains is therefore visible as a discontinuity in the living CLD, beyond which it is
no longer calculated correctly. This also results in an error in the total living chain
concentration, l 0 , which ultimately would aect the overall population balance, including the dead chain CLD [6]. Checking the monomer balance with the dead
polymer balance (m1 ), one learns that for the case shown the result is still reliable.
For larger k tp we see that gradually more of the monomer units polymerized become contained in living chains, of which the CLD is not computed correctly, so
that the overall solution is no longer valid. Estimation procedures for monomer
units contained in tails beyond the computation limit are described by Iedema
et al. [6]. In the case of disproportionation this problem automatically resolves
itself by increasing k tp (>1800 m 3 /(kmol s)1 ). This is because living chain concen-

9.4 Comparison of Galerkin-FEM and Method of Moments


1.8

x 10-5 kmole/m3

n2Rn

Concentration

1.6
1.4
1.2
1
0.8
0.6

Computation
limit P n

0.4
0.2
0 0
10

1.8

Concentration

1.6

10

10

10

Chain Length

10

10

10

12

10

kmole/m3

n2Pn

1.4
1.2

Computation
limit

1
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0 0
10

10

10

Chain Length

Radical polymerization in CSTR with


transfer to polymer. Reactor and kinetic data:
initiator feed: I2; f 5  103 kmol m3 ;
monomer feed Mf 16:75 kmol m3 ;
residence time: t 30 s; kd 0:5 1 s1 ;
Fig. 9.3.

10

10

k p 1:4  10 5 m 3 (kmol s)1 ; k tc 5  10 10


m 3 (kmol s)1 ; k tp 180 m 3 (kmol s)1 ;
conversion x 0:249. The discontinuity in the
living CLD is due to a vanishing dead chain
concentration.

trations increase more rapidly within the computation limit of 10 9 and reach the
same magnitude as the dead chain tail concentrations; see Figure 9.3. Thus, living
and dead CLDs nicely overlap over the whole range and are correctly calculated,
even while a considerable proportion of the monomer units are now polymerized
in living chains.

441

442

9 Mathematical Methods

105

10

kg/mole

Living chains,
recombination termination only

Mw

Galerkin-FEM

103
102

1010

Moments method
(closure 3)
20

40

60

80

ktp (
140

100

120

m3/(kmole.s)

kg/mole

140

160

180

Moments method
(closure 3)

120

Mw100
80
60

Galerkin-FEM

40
Dead chains,
recombination termination only

20
0

20

40

60

80

100

ktp (m3/(kmole.s))

120

140

160

180

Radical polymerization; for data, see Figure 9.3.


Comparison of Galerkin-FEM and method of moments. The
deviation is strongest for living chains.

Fig. 9.4.

We conclude that the method of moments yields accurate solutions for all
moments (hence Mn ; Mw ; Mz ) in the case of linear polymerization. In those cases
where Flory distributions form the solution of instantaneous or steady-state polymerizations, full CLDs can be constructed as simple combinations of Flory distributions. This is not possible when distributions are resulting from combination reactions between other distributions, such as recombination termination. In
nonlinear polymerization the method of moments requires estimation of higher
moments, by which errors are introduced unavoidably. In those situations the

9.4 Comparison of Galerkin-FEM and Method of Moments


7

10

kg/mole
Living chains

10

Galerkin-FEM

Mw 10

Moments method
(closure 3)

10

Dead chains

Living
chains

10

10

Dead chains

10

Disproportionation termination only

10

Concentration

0.9

500

1000

1500

ktp (m3/(kmole.s))

2000

2500

3000

kmole/m3
0.01

0.8

0.008

0.7

0.006

0.6

0.004
0.002

0.5

0 5
10

0.4

Dead

Living
10

10

10

10

Close-up

0.3
0.2
0.1
0 0
10

10

10

10

Chain Length

Fig. 9.5. Radical polymerization; see Figure 9.3. Termination is


through disproportionation only. The living chain concentration
is the same order of magnitude as the dead chain concentration at high chain length.

10

10

10

443

444

9 Mathematical Methods

Galerkin-FEM method is preferred, although care must be taken when extremely


long chain lengths have to be calculated.

9.5

Classes Approach
9.5.1

Introduction

The classes approach is applicable to multidimensional problems where the range


of the second and higher dimensions is restricted to a small range. In the examples
of this approach we will discuss presently, these second dimensions are the numbers of terminal double bonds (TDBs) on a chain in the case of poly(vinyl acetate)
(PVAc) and the numbers of radical sites on a chain in the case of low-density polyethylene (LDPE). The idea simply is to solve the problem rigorously in the rst
dimension, chain length, for separate classes with a xed value for the second dimension. Thus, a 2D problem is reduced to a set of 1D problems, where the size of
the set is determined by the number of values of the second variable the number
of classes for which the solution is desired. Obviously, this is only feasible when
the number of classes is limited, since the equations have to be implemented separately for each class. A dierent classes approach is followed by Pladis and Kipparissides [8], who combined it with a method of moments.
9.5.2

Computing the CLD of Poly(vinyl acetate) for a Maximum of One TDB per Chain

The most general set of reaction equations is given in Table 9.4 in terms of all
three concentration distribution variables chain length, number of TDBs, num-

Tab. 9.4.

Reactions for radical polymerization of vinyl acetate.


kd

Initiator dissociation

I2 ! 2I

Initiation

I M ! R1; 0; 0

Propagation
Termination by disproportionation
(without TDB creation)
Termination by disproportionation (with TDB creation)

R n; i; k M ! R n1; i; k
k td
R n; i; k R m; j; l ! Pn; i; k Pm; j; l

Termination by recombination

R n; i; k R m; j; l ! Pnm; i j; kl

ki

kp

k td

R n; i; k R m; j; l ! Pn; i1; k Pm; j; l


k tc

km

Transfer to monomer

R n; i; k M ! Pn; i; k R1; 1; 0

Transfer to polymer

R n; i; k Pm; j; l ! Pn; i; k R m; j; l1

Terminal double bond propagation

R n; i; k Pm; j; l ! R nm; i j1; kl1

k tp m

Notation: m; n: chain length; i; j: number of terminal double bonds


(TDB) per chain; k; l: number of branches per chain.

kdb j

9.5 Classes Approach

ber of branches; hence it is a 3D problem [9]. Most of the equations in the table are
self-evident except the TDB propagation reaction, which deserves closer examination. It refers to the incorporation of dead chains with a TDB in the growing living
chain. The reaction equation is:
kdb j

R n; i; k Pm; j; l ! R nm; ij1; kl1

30

In fact, this represents a combination reaction that sums chain lengths, while
numbers of branches are summed along with the addition of one extra branch created by the reaction; TDBs are summed as well, except for one TDB consumed in
the reaction. It is evident that the reactivity of the dead chain inserted is proportional to the number of TDBs it carries. Now, TDB propagation introduces a nonlinearity of a dierent kind than that caused by the step involving transfer to polymer discussed previously. In that case the nonlinearity is due to the dependence of
the transfer rate on chain length, a variable already present in a 1D description of
chain length alone. In contrast, here the rate depends on a second distribution variable, the number of TDBs per chain, which is not dealt with explicitly in the 1D
description of chain length. Mathematically speaking, in order to solve the problem
in one dimension, chain length, one has to solve it in the second dimension, TDB
number, as well. Two methods exist to deal with the TDB-dependent reactivity. The
rst is the classes approach, to be discussed here, and the second is the pseudodistribution approach, to be presented in Section 9.6. The full 3D molecular
weightterminal double bond-branching population balance equations belonging
to the reactions as given in Table 9.4 are listed in Table 9.5. Note that this system
is an exact representation of the reactions in Table 9.4, no assumptions have yet
been made, and it is valid for cases with an arbitrary number of TDBs per chain.
In the present case of a CSTR, the complete population balances of all distributions Q n contain an outow term of the general shape Q n =t, where t represents
the average residence time (equal to volume/volumetric ow). The overall moments l 0 and m1 are dened as usual and in the 3D case follow as:

l0

y X
y X
y
X
i0 k0 n1

R n; i; k

m1

y X
y X
y
X

nPn; i; k

31

i0 k0 n1

Since we will not address branching here, the set has to be reduced to 2D, by summation over the branching index k. The second dimension, the number of TDBs
per chain, is concerned with the manner in which they are created. One of two possible mechanisms is transfer to monomer, producing a monoradical with a TDB
according to the reaction equation shown in Table 9.4. Subsequent propagation of
this monoradical leads to a chain with a TDB. The second mechanism is disproportionation, directly leading to chain with a TDB. Now, chains with more than one
terminal double bond can be created in two ways: insertion of chains with a TDB
created by disproportionation termination, or by termination by recombination. If

445

446

9 Mathematical Methods

Tab. 9.5. Full 3D set of population balance equations for radical polymerization of vinyl acetate in living and
dead chain concentration variables R n; i; k and Pn; i; k . (for indices, see Table 9.4); summation over the branching
index k, yielding a 2D formulation of exactly the same form, provides the basis for the TDB classes model.

Initiator dissociation
Initiation
Propagation

dI2
I2
kd I2 
dt
t
dI
I
dR1; 0; 0
2kd I2  k i MI  ;
k i MI
dt
t
dt
dR n; i; k
k p MR n1; i; k  R n; i; k
dt
[a]

Termination by
disproportionation
(TDB creation)

dR n; i; k
k td l 0 R n; i; k ;
dt

dPn; i; k
1
k td l 0 R n; i1; k R n; i; k
2
dt

Termination by
recombination

dR n; i; k
k tc l 0 R n; i; k ;
dt

n1 X
i X
k
dPn; i; k
1 X
k tc
R m; j; l R nm; ij; kl
2 m 1 j0 l 0
dt

Transfer to monomer
Transfer to polymer
Terminal double bond
propagation

dR n; i; k
dPn; i; k
dR1; 1; 0
k m MR n; i; k ;
k m l 0 M;
k m MR n; i; k
dt
dt
dt
dR n; i; k
dPn; i; k
k tp l 0 nPn; i; k1  m1 R n; i; k ;
k tp l 0 nPn; i; k m1 R n; i; k
dt
dt
y X
y X
y
n1 X
i1 X
k
X
X
dR n; i; k
kdb R n; i; k
iPn; i; k
jPm; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1
dt
n1 i0 k0
m 1 j0 l 0

dPn; i; k
kdb il 0 Pn; i; k
dt
[a] The rst term between brackets equals zero in the case in which no
account is taken of TDB creation by disproportionation.

disproportionation does not lead to reactive TDBs and recombination is absent,


chains may carry one TDB as a maximum, which is the case being generally dealt
with in modeling studies of PVAc [1018]. The specic situation of a maximum
of one TDB per chain here serves as an example of the classes approach, while
the more general case of more than one TDB will be addressed in the context of
pseudo-distribution modeling (Section 9.6). Only two TDB classes are required to
fully describe the problem of one TDB as a maximum: 0 and 1 TDB per chain.
Consequently, population balances for only four distributions have to be solved

R n ; Pn ; R
n ; Pn and this can be done in an exact way without additional assumptions. The equations are shown in Table 9.6. The resulting CLDs for a realistic set
of kinetic data are shown in Figure 9.6 for the total dead chain concentrations, with
and without TDB.
9.5.3

Multiradicals in Radical Polymerization

In most models of radical polymerization, living chains are explicitly taken into
account, except for instance in the Monte Carlo simulation approach by Tobita
[1115]. Usually, macroradicals are assumed to possess only one radical site

9.5 Classes Approach


Tab. 9.6. Full set of population balance equations for the PVAc problem in the case of a
maximum of one terminal double bond per chain.

Propagation
Termination by
disproportionation

Transfer to monomer

Transfer to polymer

Terminal double
bond propagation

1.2

dR n
dRn
k p MR n1  R n
k p MRn1  Rn
dt
dt
dR n
dPn
k td l 0 R n ;
k td l 0 R n
dt
dt

dR n
dPn
k td l 0 Rn ;
k td l 0 Rn
dt
dt
dR
dRn
dPn
1
k m l 0 M;
k m MRn ;
k m MRn
dt
dt
dt
dR n
dPn
k m MR n
k m MR n
dt
dt
dR n
dPn
k tp l 0 nPn  m1 R n ;
k tp l 0 nPn m1 R n
dt
dt

dR n
dPn
k tp l 0 nPn  m1 Rn ;
k tp l 0 nPn m1 Rn
dt
dt
!
y
n1
X
X
dR n

kdb R n
Pn
Pm R nm
dt
n1
m 1
dPn
kdb l 0 Pn
dt

kmole/m3

n 2 ( Pn + Pn= )

1
0.8

kdb = 0
kdb = 2500 m3/(kmole.s)
kdb = 6200 m3/(kmole.s)

0.6
0.4

kdb = 31000 m3/(kmole.s)

0.2
0
Radical polymerization of vinyl
acetate in a CSTR: sensitivity of chain length
distribution to rate of TDB propagation.
Reactor and kinetic data: initiator feed:
I2; f 3:85  103 kmol m3 ; monomer feed
Fig. 9.6.

Mf 9 kmol m3 ; residence time: t 4000 s;


kd 9  106 s1 ; k p 9500 m 3 (kmol s)1 ;
k m 2:38 m 3 (kmol s)1 ; k td 10 8 m 3
(kmole s)1 ; k tp 5 m 3 (kmol s)1 ;
conversion x 0:5.

447

448

9 Mathematical Methods
Tab. 9.7. Reaction equations for radical polymerization of ethylene: 2D chain length
multiradical approach.
kd

Initiator dissociation
Initiation

I2 ! 2I
ki
I M ! R1; 1

Propagation

R n; i M ! R n1; i

Termination by disproportionation

R n; i R m; j ! R n; i1 R m; j1

Termination by recombination

R n; i R m; j ! R nm; ij2

Transfer to monomer
Transfer to solvent

R n; i M ! R n; i1 R1; 1
km i
R n; i S ! R n; i1 R1; 1

Transfer to polymer

R n; i R m; j ! R n; i1 R m; j1

kpi

k td ij
k tc ij

km i

k tp jm

Notation: m; n: chain length; i; j: number of radical sites per chain.

(monoradical assumption). In principle, this is only correct for linear polymerization. In nonlinear polymerization, for example, transfer to polymer or TDB propagation, multiradicals can easily be created. For instance, transfer to polymer is frequently assumed to occur only in dead chains, but obviously it also takes place in
living chains. In order to investigate the eects of taking multiradicals into account, we apply the classes approach. This anticipates the expectation that transition regimes exist, where the monoradical assumption no longer holds, while the
numbers of radical sites per chain is still low.
We take the example of radical polymerization with transfer to polymer; reaction
and population balance equations are listed in Tables 9.7 and 9.8. Note that the sec-

Tab. 9.8. (Population) balance equations for radical polymerization of ethylene: 2D chain
lengthmultiradical approach.

Initiator dissociation
Initiation
Propagation
Termination by
disproportionation
Termination by recombination
Transfer to monomer
Transfer to solvent
Transfer to polymer
la

y X
y
X
n1 i0

na R n; i

dI2
I2
kd I2 
dt
t
dI
I
dR1; 1
2kd I2  k i MI  ;
k i MI
dt
t
dt
dR n; i
k p iMR n1; i  R n; i
dt
dR n; i
k td l 0 fi 1R n; i1  iR n; i g
dt
n1
i1
P P
dR n; i
1
k tc
ji  j 2R m; j R nm; ij2
2 m 1 j1
dt
dR n; i
dR1; 1
k m Mfi 1R n; i1  iR n; i g;
k m l 0 M
dt
dt
dR n; i
dR1; 1
ks Sfi 1R n; i1  iR n; i g;
k m l 0 S
dt
dt
dR n; i
k tp l 0 nfR n; i1  R n; i g l1 fi  1R n; i1 iR n; i g
dt

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

ond subscript of R n; i denotes the number of radical sites per chain; hence chains
with i 0 represent what is usually called dead chains. The transfer-to-polymer
reaction is obviously responsible for the creation of multiradicals, as appears from
the term R n; i1 on the RHS. Two classes models are formulated, one with two
classes (the usual living and dead chains) and one with ve classes (up to four
radical sites per chain). Note that the implementation of the termination reactions
requires the implementation of 4 2 pairs of reaction equations of the form:
k tc IJ

IJ2

J
R nI R m
! R nm ;

k td IJ

J
J1
R nI R m
! R nI1 R m

32

where RnI denotes the 1D distribution of the class with I radical sites per chain.
Thus we see that many more classes rapidly lead to a huge implementation task
and the classes method is not appropriate for such problems.
We calculated CLDs with the two classes models for various transfer-to-polymer
rates. Up to k tp 500 m 3 (kmol s)1 results are identical, proving the validity of
the monoradical-assumption in this range. For k tp 5000 m 3 (kmol s)1 , on the
contrary, we see large dierences, as shown in Figure 9.7. According to the veclasses model, chains are much shorter and also conversion is lower. This is due
to dierences in an increase in the reactivity of multiradical chains in dierent
reactions. From the reaction equations we see that propagation increases linearly
with the number of radical sites, but termination with the product of radical sites.
Hence, accounting for multiradicals leads to an increased termination/propagation
ratio and thus to shorter chains and lower conversion under the conditions simulated. Note that the relative heights of the distributions in Figure 9.7 suggest that
for k tp 5000 m 3 (kmol s)1 even more than ve classes are required for a proper
description.
We conclude, however, that the classes approach in this case produces useful
information on the multiradical issue, even when employing a limited number of
classes.

9.6

Pseudo-distribution Approach
9.6.1

Introduction

This strategy is based on the Galerkin-FEM method. The simultaneous description


of CLD and DBD leads to a two-dimensional problem with the property coordinates chain length and number of branches. In order to avoid the computationally
expensive 2D problem, a mathematical reduction technique is applied to the original model, which allows the computation of average branching degrees per chain
length (and the respective variances). For that reason branching moment distributions are introduced. The population balances for these distributions can be solved

449

9 Mathematical Methods
10-3 kmole/m3

2-classes model
5-classes model

Concentration

0.3

0.2

n2Rn,0
n2Rn,0

0.1

n2Rn,1
n2Rn,1

0 0
10

Concentration

450

10

10

10

10

Chain Length n

10

10

12

10

10-3 kmole/m3

2-classes model
5-classes model

n2Rn,4

n2Rn,1

n2Rn,3

n2Rn,2
2

n2Rn,1

10

10

10

10

10

Chain Length n
Radical polymerization with transfer
to polymer: multiradical problem. CLDs of
chains with 0 . . . 4 radical sites per chain.
Comparison of two- and ve-classes model.
Accounting for multiradicals leads to lower
Fig. 9.7.

conversion and shorter chains. Kinetic data:


kd 0:57 s1 ; k p 1:38  10 5 m 3 (kmol s)1 ;
k m 138 m 3 (kmol s)1 ; ks 790 m 3
(kmol s)1 ; k tc k td 2:82  10 8 m 3
(kmol s)1 ; k tp 5000 m 3 (kmol s)1 .

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

as a 1D problem. Thus the original 2D problem is replaced by a series of 1D problems, getting exact information on averages concerning the second (number of
branches) distribution. The distributions of the original kinetic model will be called
real distributions whereas the additional branching moment distributions are
named pseudo-distributions.
We will introduce this approach in the case of the 2D CLD/DBD computation for
mixed-metallocene polymerization of ethylene. Subsequently, we present applications of the approach to the 3D problems of radical polymerization of vinyl acetate
(CLD/DBD/number of terminal double bonds distribution), AB radical copolymerization (CLD/comonomer composition distribution/sequence length distribution),
and nally the 2D problem of radical polymerization of polyethylene, where random scission is a complicating factor.
9.6.2

CLD/DBD for Mixed-metallocene Polymerization of Ethylene


Formulation of Pseudo-distribution Problem
Long branches are created in this system by incorporation of chains with a terminal double bond (TDB) at the catalyst site (constrained-geometry catalyst, CGC)
[1930]. The reaction equations are listed in Table 9.9 and the denitions of the
growing and dead chain branching moment distributions are elucidated in Table
9.10. Note that the 0th branching moment distributions represent the original normal chain length distributions. From the branching moment distributions F and
C certain averages may be derived. For example, the average number of branches
of chains of length n; Bn , as well as the branching density, rn , can be computed
from the ratio (for each n) of the 1st and 0th branching moment distribution:
9.6.2.1

Tab. 9.9.

Reaction mechanisms and rate coecients.

Reaction

Reaction equation
initiation[a]


CCGC
;

CCGC !

CCGC
M ! R1;b 0

Linear cat. activation and initiation[a]
Clin ! Clin
;

Clin
M ! R1;l 0
b
b
Branching cat. propagation
R n;
i M ! R n1; i
l
l
Linear cat. propagation
R n;

M
!
R
i
n1; i
b

Branching cat. b-hydride elimination
R n;
!
C

Pn;b i
CGC
i
l

l [b]
Linear cat. transfer to monomer
R n;
i M ! Clin Pn; i
b

b
[b]
branching cat. terminal double bond propagation R n;

P
!
R
m; j
i
nm; ij1

Branching cat. activation and

[a] Catalyst
[b] Note

activation and initiation are taken as one step.


that Pn; i Pn;bi Pn;li .

Rate coecient
ka; CGC
k i; CGC
ka; lin
k i; lin
k p; CGC
k p; lin
kw; CGC
km; lin
k p; TDB

451

452

9 Mathematical Methods
Notation for mixed-metallocene systems.

Tab. 9.10.

b
R n;
i
R nl
Pn;bi ; Pn;l0 ; Pn; i

Pn;b i ; Pn;l 0 ; Pn; i


m0
l 0b

y X
y
X

Pn; i

n1 i0

n1 i0

y X
y
X

y
X

b
R n;
i

n1 i0

R nb

polymer growing on branching catalyst


polymer growing on linear catalyst (0 branches)
dead polymer with terminal double bond from branching/linear cat.
and their sum, resp.
dead polymer without terminal double bond from branching/linear
cat and their sum, resp.
y X
y
X
m0
Pn; i

y
X

l 0l

R nl

n1

b
R n;
i

i0

Pnb

y
X

Pn;bi

Pnl Pn;l0

Pn

i0

Pnb

y
X

Pn; i

i0

Pn;b i

Pnl Pn;l 0

Pn

i0

Fnb1

y
X

y
X

Pn; i

i0

y
X

b
iR n;
i

i0

Cn1

y
X

iPn; i

Cn1

i0

Fnb2

y
X

y
X

iPn; i

i0
b
i 2 R n;
i

i0

Cn2

y
X

i 2 Pn; i

i0

Bn Cn1 =Pn ;

Cn2

y
X

i 2 Pn; i

i0

rn Cn1 =nPn

33

In fact, F and C represent the moments of the branching distributions of living


and dead chains at the given chain length, n. Thus, the branching polydispersity
Dn follows from the second branching moment according to:
Dn

Cn2 =Cn1
Cn1 =Pn

34

In order to derive the balance equations for the branching moment distributions,
the following steps have to be performed [31]:


For each reaction step of the kinetic model, the two-dimensional population
balance is derived.

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach




The two-dimensional balance is reduced to a one-dimensional balance by applying the above summations over the branching index (in the same type of operation as obtaining moments from distributions).
 The resulting terms have to be expressed in terms of the branching moment
distributions and are added to the system of equations.
All equations are solved simultaneously. This procedure can in principle be applied
to any polyreaction model where additional properties have to be considered. The
key is how a certain reaction step changes the additional property.
The total set of balance equations for all the reaction mechanisms involved in
the mixed-metallocene problem is:
dM


fk i; lin Clin
k i; CGC CCGC
k p; lin km; lin l 0b k p; CGC km; CGC l 0l gM
dt

M0  M
t

35

l
dR n;
0

l
l
k i; lin MClin
dn  1 k p; lin R n1;
0  R n; 0 M
dt
l
 kb; lin km; lin MR n;
0
b
dR n;
i

dt

l
R n;
0
t

36


b
dn  1 k p; CGC R n1
 R nb M
k i; CGC MCCGC
b
kb; CGC km; CGC MR n;
i

k p; TDB

b
m0 R n;
i

n1 X
i
X

b
Pm;
j R nm; ij1

m1 j0

dPn;l0
Pn;l0
l
l b
km; lin M kb; lin R n;
0  k p; TDB Pn; 0 l 0 
dt
t
dPn;bi
dt

b
b b
km; CGC M kb; CGC R n;
i  k p; TDB Pn; i l 0 

dB
B
k p; TDB m0 l 0b 
dt
t

b
R n;
i

37

38

Pn;bi
t

39

40

Here di is the Kroneckers delta function which has value of 1 for i 0 and 0 for
i 0 0. Note that growing chains at the linear catalyst do not carry branches; hence
the second index is always zero. Now, we will derive the equations for the pseudodistributions in a stepwise manner. Reactions not aecting the number of
branches per chain, that is, those describing propagation, transfer to monomer,

453

454

9 Mathematical Methods

and b-hydride elimination, will be presented rstly. The reaction creating branching, TDB propagation, is more complex and will be discussed subsequently.
Propagation step In this case the degree of branching is not altered, so this is a
simple step from this point of view. The contribution to the balance of ath branching moment distributions of living chains in reduced or pseudo-distribution notation follows, by multiplication with ia and taking the summation over the branching index i:

 i
y
dFan X
dR n

k p MFan1 Fan
ia
dt
dt
i0

41

Transfer to monomer, b-hydride elimination Again, the degree of branching is not


aected, hence the contributions to the pseudo-distribution balances of the living
and dead chains are given by:

dFan
k m MFan ;
dt
dFan
kb Fan ;
dt

dCan
k m MFan ;
dt

dCan
kb Fan ;
dt

42

43

TDB propagation The one-dimensional contributions for this mechanism describing chain length are obtained from the TDB propagation terms in the 2D equations by summing over the number of branches, i:

dR nb
k p; TDB R nb m0
dt

44

dPn
k p; TDB Pn l 0b
dt

45

n1
X
dR nb

k p; TDB
R nb Pnm
dt
m1

46

The rst branching moment distribution follows by multiplication of Eqs. (44)(46)


with the number of branches i, and subsequent summation:
dFnb1
k p; TDB Fnb1 m0
dt

47

dCn1
k p; TDB Cn1 l 0b
dt

48

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

The production term requires some more extensive algebraic manipulation:


y
n1 X
i1
X
X
dFnb1
b

k p; TDB
i
R m;
j Pnm; ij1
dt
m 1 j0
i0

k p; TDB

n1 X
y
X

0
y
X

b @
R m;
j

m1 j0

k p; TDB

n1 X
y
X

k p; TDB

b
R m;
j

y
X

i j 1Pnm;
i

i0

n1
X

y
X

m1

j0

n1
X

A
iPnm;
ij1

i j

m1 j0

k p; TDB

b
jR m;
j

y
X

Pnm;
i

y
X

b
R m;
j

y
X

i 1Pnm;
i

j0

i0

i0

b
1
b
Fmb1 Pnm
Rm
Cnm
Rm
Pnm

49

m1

The second branching moment distribution follows by multiplication of the TDB


propagation terms in the 2D equations with the squared number of branches i 2
and subsequent summation:
dFnb2
k p; TDB Fnb2 m0
dt

50

dCn2
k p; TDB Cn2 l 0b
dt

51

The production term again requires some more extensive algebraic manipulation:
y
n1 X
i1
X
X
dFnb2
b

i2
R m;
k p; TDB
j Pnm; ij1
dt
m1 j0
i0

k p; TDB

n1 X
y
X

b
R m;
j

m1 j0

k p; TDB

n1 X
y
X
m1 j0

0
y
X
@
i2P

nm; ij1

1
A

i j

b
R m;
j

y
X

i j 1 2 Pnm;
i
i0

455

456

9 Mathematical Methods

0
B
B
B
B
n1 B
X
B
k p; TDB
B
B
m1B
B
B
@

y
X
j0

b
R m;
j

y
X

k p; TDB

m1

y
X

b
R m;
j

y
X

i 2 Pnm;
i

C
C
C
C
y
y
y
y
C
X
X
X
X
b

2
jR m; j
iPnm; i 2
jR m; j
Pnm; i C
C
C
j0
j0
i0
i0
C
C
y
y
y
y
X
X
X
X
C
b

A
2
R m; j
iPnm; i
R m; j
Pnm; i
j0

i0

j0
n1
X

Pnm;
i

i0

i0

j0

i0

2
1

b
Fmb2 Pnm
Rm
Cnm
2Fmb1 Cnm
1
b1 1
b
b
2Fm Pnm 2R m Cnm R m
Pnm

!
52

The principles of the pseudo-distribution model are applicable to any reactor. Results are presented for a semi-batch reactor using kinetic data from a realistic
mixed-metallocene system in Figure 9.8.
Construction of the Full 2D Distribution
The pseudo-distribution approach thus allows us to calculate the 1D CLD and
the average number of branches versus chain length. The question arises of how
to obtain the full bivariate chain lengthnumber of branches distribution from
the pseudo-distribution model. The issue is that construction of branching distributions at each chain length requires an assumption to be made about the shape
of the branching distribution, or more precisely for chains originating from the
branching catalyst (Pnb ). For instance, if we suppose that each monomer unit in a
chain of given length has equal probability of being branched, then the branching
distribution can be described by a binomial distribution. However, from the branching polydispersity as calculated from Eq. (34) we observe that the distribution for
dead chains from the branching catalyst is narrower than a binomial distribution.
An alternative approximation method is required, generating branching distributions at a given chain length with correct values for both the average number of
branch points N n and the branching polydispersity Dn. A three-parameter binomial
distribution modied by raising of it to a power an (the third parameter) varying
with chain length, the variable power binomial distribution [VPBD] can satisfy
these requirements:
9.6.2.2


pn; N

n
N

rn N 1  rn nN

an
53

Note that in the VPBD the parameter a permits the distribution width to be
changed: a > 1 leads to a narrower distribution. The tting procedure is described
in more detail by Iedema et al. [20]. The VPBD method turns out to yield identical
solutions to the classes (Section 9.5) and pgf (Section 9.7) methods as applied to the
mixed-metallocene problem. The resulting full bivariate CLD/DBD for the case of a
CSTR is shown in Figure 9.9, together with the VPBD t.

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


1.4

Semibatch, rCGC = 0.2

dw/d{log(MW)}

1.2
1
0.8
0.6

600 s

0.4
0.2

t = 100 s

0 3
10

10

10

10

10

Molecular Weight
x 10-3

0.8

0.6

600 s
500 s
400 s

Batch time

Branching density b

300 s
200 s

0.4

100 s

0.2
0 2
10

Semibatch, rCGC = 0.2


3

10

Chain Length

10

Fig. 9.8. Mixed-metallocene polymerization of


ethylene in a semibatch reactor; branching
(constrained geometry) catalyst: CGC-Ti; linear
catalyst: Et[Ind]2 ZrCl2 . Reactor and kinetic
data: initial concentration CGC-Ti: 8  107
kmol m3 ; initial concentration Et[Ind]2 ZrCl2 :
3:2  106 kmol m3 ; monomer molar feed

10

ow: 8  107 kmol s1 ; batch time: 600 s;


k i; CGC =k p; CGC k i; lin =k p; lin 1; k p; CGC M
k p; lin M 500 s1 ; kb; CGC 0:3 s1 ; kb; lin
0:7 s1 ; km; CGC =k p; CGC 0; km; lin =k p; lin
0:0014; kH; CGC 250 m 3 kmol1 s1 ;
kH; lin 0; k p; TDB 1750 m 3 kmol1 s1 .

We conclude that the pseudo-distribution approach can be applied successfully,


provided a good approximation can be made for the branching distribution at given
chain length from the branching moments. The method is valid for batch reactors
as well, in contrast to, for example, the pgfcascade method (Section 9.7), which is
restricted to steady state reactors. It is to be preferred over classes methods in
cases, like the metallocene one, where the second distribution dimension may assume high values as well.

457

9 Mathematical Methods

an

10-2

Fraction

458

10-4

VPBD power

10 1

10 2

n4

10 3

10

10 5

10-6
CSTR
rCGC = 0.2
[H2] = 1.13 10-3 kmole/m3

10-8
10-10

102

10-12
0

103
10

20

30

Number of
Branche s N

104

40

Mixed-metallocene polymerization of
ethylene in a CSTR. Kinetic data are the same
as in Figure 9.8. Residence time CSTR: 300 s;
feed concentrations identical to initial
concentrations in Figure 9.8. Bivariate chain
length/number of branches distribution.
Hydrogen present. Based on molecular weight
distribution and branching distribution from

Fig. 9.9.

50

60

105

n
ai
Ch

100
101

th
ng
e
L

the Galerkin-FEM model. Assumption: variable


power binomial distribution of number of
branch points at each chain length of dead
chains from CGC-Ti with power an as shown in
the insert. The discontinuity at N 1 indicates
the existence of a ridge at N 0, due to the
contribution of branchless chains from
Et[Ind]2 ZrCl2 .

9.6.3

CLD/Number of Terminal Double Bonds (TDB) Distribution for Poly(vinyl acetate)


More than one TDB per Chain
General Case
This problem has been introduced in the discussion of the classes approach. For
reaction equations and a full set of population balances, see Tables 9.5 and 9.6.
Here, we address the more general problem of more than one TDB per chain [9].
This occurs as a consequence of insertion of TDB chains created by disproportionation or of recombination termination. We start with the full 3D set of Table PVAc2
and then reduce it to a 1D formulation by developing the TDB and branching moment expressions. The (N; M)th branching-TDB moments or pseudo distributions
for living and dead chains are dened by:
9.6.3.1

N; M
Fn;:;:

y
X
i0

y
X
k0

!
M

k R n; i; k

N; M
Cn;:;:

y
X
i0

y
X
k0

!
M

k Pn; i; k

54

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

459

Tab. 9.11. The general (N; M)th double moment formulation of the population balance equation set of Table
9.10, obtained by multiplying by the TDB number and branching number indices, i N and k M , and subsequent
summation over these indices.

Propagation
Termination by disproportionation

Termination by recombination

dFnN; M

y
X
i0

iN

y
X

k M R n; i; k

k0

N; M
k p MFn1
 FnN; M

dt
dt
N; M
dFn
k td l 0 FnN; M
dt

y
y
X
X
dCnN; M
1
k td l 0
iN
k M R n; i1; k FnN; M
2
dt
i0
k0

!
[a]

dFnN; M
k tc l 0 FnN; M
dt
y
y
n1 X
i X
k
X
X
dCnN; M
1 X
k tc
iN
kM
R m; j; l R nm; ij; kl
2
dt
m 1 j0 l 0
i0
k0

Transfer to monomer

Transfer to polymer

dFnN; M
k m MFnN; M ;
dt
dCnN; M
k m MFnN; M
dt

dF1N; M
k m l 0 M
dt

y
y
X
X
dFnN; M
k tp l 0 n
iN
k M Pn; i; k1  m1 FnN; M
dt
i0
k0

y
y
X
X
dCnN; M
k tp l 0 n
iN
k M Pn; i; k1 m1 FnN; M
dt
i0
k0

Terminal double bond


propagation

1
y X
y X
y
X
iPn; j; l
B R n; i; k
C
y
y
B
C
n1 j0 l 0
X
X
dFnN; M
C
N
MB
kdb
i
k B
C
n1 X
i1 X
k
B
C
dt
X
i0
k0
@
A

jPm; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1


m 1 j0 l 0

dCnN; M
kdb l 0 CnN1; M
dt
[a] The rst term between brackets equals zero in the case where TDB creation by
disproportionation is not accounted for.

Performing the corresponding summations on the equations in Table 9.6, one obtains the (N; M)th moment formulation of Table 9.11. Some of the summation
terms in these equations will not be evaluated for the general (N; M) case, but we
will determine them by assigning values to N and M. Since we will not address
branching, we take M 0 here, but in principle this can be treated in a similar
way. We will focus now on the TDB moment distributions and successively derive
the model equations for the zeroth, rst, and second moments, or N 0; 1, and 2.
Solving the model thus essentially means solving the population balances of the
real concentration distributions R n and Pn and the pseudo-distributions FnN; M and
CnN; M .

460

9 Mathematical Methods
Tab. 9.12. The (0; 0)th moment distribution formulation of the population balance equation set
of Table 9.11 (taking N 0 and M 0); this set is solved by the TDB moment distribution
model.

Propagation
Termination by
disproportionation
Termination by
recombination
Transfer to monomer
Transfer to polymer
Terminal double bond
propagation

dR n
k p MR n1  R n
dt
dR n
dPn
k td l 0 R n ;
k td l 0 R n
dt
dt
n1
dR n
dPn
1 X
k tc l 0 R n ;
k tc
R m R nm
2 m 1
dt
dt
dR n
dR1
dPn
k m MR n ;
k m l 0 M
k m MR n
dt
dt
dt
dR n
dPn
k tp l 0 nPn  m1 R n ;
k tp l 0 nPn m1 R n
dt
dt
!
y
n1
X
X
dR n
dPn
kdb R n
kdb l 0 Cn1; 0
Cn1; 0
Cm1; 0 R nm ;
dt
dt
n1
m 1

The resulting equations for N 0 and M 0 are listed in Table 9.12. Here, the
(0; 0)th moments are the usual 1D chain length distribution variables, dened by:

Rn

y X
y
X

R n; i; k Fn0; 0 Pn

i0 k0

y X
y
X

Pn; i; k Cn0; 0

55

i0 k0

All of the derivations are straightforward, but the TDB propagation deserves closer
examination. From Table 9.11 we have the general (N; M) formulation in:
y
y
X
X
dFnN; M
iN
kM
kdb
dt
i0
k0

R n; i; k

y X
y X
y
X

iPn; j; l

n1 j0 l0

n1 X
i1 X
k
X

!
jPm; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1

m1 j0 l 0

56
Taking M 0 and N 0, the rst term between the brackets can be rewritten as:
y X
y
X

R n; i; k

y X
y X
y
X

!
iPn; i; k

n1 i0 k0

i0 k0

y X
y
y
X
X

R n; i; k
Cn1; 0
i0 k0

n1

y
X
n1

!
Cn1; 0

y X
y
X
i0 k0

R n; i; k R n

y
X
n1

Cn1; 0

57

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

461

The second term between the brackets can be rewritten as:


y X
y X
n1 X
i1 X
k
X

jPm; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1

i0 k0 m1 j0 l 0

8
0
19
= X
n1 <X
y X
k X
y
y
n1
X
X
@ jPm; j; l

R nm; ij1; kl1 A


Cm1; 0 R nm 58
;
:
m1 k0 l0 j0
m1
ij1
Thus, we nd the TDB propagation term for the living chains to be given by:
y
n1
X
X
dR n
1; 0
kdb R n; i; k
Cn1; 0
Cm
R nm
dt
n1
m1

!
59

Applying M 0 and N 0 to the dead chains formulation yields:


dPn
kdb l 0 Cn1; 0
dt

60

The RHS expressions of Eqs. (59) and (50) contain higher TDB moment (1; 0) distributions (Cn1; 0 ) than the (0; 0) moment distributions, R n and Pn , they describe.

Tab. 9.13. The (1; 0)th moment distribution formulation of the population balance equation set of Table 9.11
(taking N 1 and M 0); this set is solved by the TDB moment distribution model.

Termination by disproportionation

dFn1; 0
1; 0
k p MFn1
 Fn1; 0
dt
dFn1; 0
k td l 0 Fn1; 0 ;
dt

Termination by recombination

dFn1; 0
k tc l 0 Fn1; 0 ;
dt

Propagation

Transfer to monomer
Transfer to polymer
Terminal double bond
propagation

!


y
X
dCn1; 0
1
1
k td l 0
iR n; i1 Fn1; 0 k td l 0 Fn1; 0 R n [a]
2
2
dt
i0
n1
X
dCn1; 0
k tc
Fm1; 0 R nm
dt
m 1

dFn1; 0
dF11; 0
dCn1; 0
k m MFn1; 0 ;
k m l 0 M;
k m MFn1; 0
dt
dt
dt
dFn1; 0
dCn1; 0
k tp l 0 nCn1; 0  m1 Fn1; 0 ;
k tp l 0 nCn1; 0 m1 Fn1; 0
dt
dt
(
)
y
n1
X
X
dFn1; 0
;
1; 0
1; 0
2; 0
1; 0 1; 0
1; 0
kdb Fn
Cn
Cm R nm Cm Fnm  Cm R nm
dt
n1
m 1
dCn1; 0
kdb l 0 Cn2; 0
dt

[a] The rst term between brackets equals zero in the case where TDB
creation by disproportionation is not accounted for.

462

9 Mathematical Methods

This is a direct consequence of the fact that the reactivity of the dead chains depends on the number of TDBs they carry. Hence, at this point we are already confronted with the closure problem present in the TDB moment model, anticipating
that solving these higher moments leads to even higher moments in the equations.
Next, we will derive the higher moment equations. For N 1 and M 0 we obtain the set of population balance equations for the pseudo-distributions of order
(1; 0) as listed in Table 9.13.
The termination by recombination equation is derived by developing the summation term as:
!
y
n1 X
i
X
1X
i
R m; j R nm; ij
2 i0 m1 j0
0
1
n1 X
y
y
X
1X

R m; j @
iR nm; ij A
2 m1 j0
ij
n1 X
y
y
X
1X
R m; j
i jR nm; i

2 m1 j0
i0

n1
y
y
y
y
X
X
X
X
1X
jR m; j
R nm; i
R m; j
iR nm; i

2 m1 j0
j0
i0
i0

n1
n1
X
1X
1; 0
Fm1; 0 R nm R m Fnm

Fm1; 0 R nm
2 m1
m1

61

This yields for the recombination contribution to the population balance:


n1
X
dCn1; 0
Fm1; 0 R nm
k tc
dt
m1

62

With respect to TDB propagation, with M 0 and N 1 the rst term between
brackets becomes that in Eq. (64)
y X
y
X

iR n; i; k

!
iPn; i; k

n1 i0 k0

i0 k0

y X
y X
y
X

y X
y
X
i0 k0

iR n; i; k

y
X
n1

!
Cn1; 0

y
X
n1

!
Cn1; 0

y X
y
X

iR n; i; k Fn1; 0

i0 k0

y
X

Cn1; 0

n1

63
and the second term, somewhat more complicated, becomes

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


y X
y
X
i

n1 X
i1 X
k
X

i0

m1 j0 l0

k0

y
X
i0

(
i

n1 X
i
X

!
jPm; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1
)

jPm; j R nm; ij1

m1 j0

8
0
19
n1 X
y
y
<X
=
X
@ jPm; j
iR nm; ij1 A

:m 1 j0
;
i j1
(

n1 X
y
X

y
X
jPm; j
i j  1R nm; i

m1 j0

n1 X
y
X
m1

n1
X

!)

i0

j Pm; j

j0

y
X

R nm; i

y
X
j0

i0

y
X
jPm; j
i  1R nm; i

i0

2; 0
1; 0
Cm
R nm Cm1; 0 Fnm
 Cm1; 0 R nm

64

m1

Thus, we nd the TDB propagation terms for the living and dead chains to be:
(
)
y
n1
X
X
dFn1; 0
1; 0
1; 0
2; 0
1; 0 1; 0
1; 0
Cn
Cm R nm Cm Fnm  Cm R nm
65
kdb Fn
dt
n1
m1
dCn1; 0
kdb l 0 Cn2; 0
dt

66

The higher moments observed earlier on the RHS are seen again.
We nally present the result for one higher moment distribution, N 2, M 0,
for which we obtain the set of population balance equations for the pseudodistributions of order (2; 0) as listed in Table 9.14.
First, the termination by recombination term is developed:
y
n1 X
i
X
1X
i2
R m; j R nm; ij
2 i0
m1 j0

0
1
!
n1 X
y
y
n1 X
y
y
X
X
1X
1X
2
2
@
A

R m; j
i R nm; ij
R m; j
i j R nm; i
2 m1 j0
2 m1 j0
i j
i0

463

464

9 Mathematical Methods

Tab. 9.14. The (2; 0)th moment distribution formulation of the population balance equation set of Table 9.11
(taking N 2 and M 0); this set is solved by the highest TDB moment version of the TDB moment
distribution model.

Termination by
disproportionation

dFn2; 0
2; 0
k p MFn1
 Fn2; 0
dt
dFn2; 0
k td l 0 Fn2; 0 ;
dt

Termination by
recombination

dFn2; 0
k tc l 0 Fn2; 0 ;
dt

Propagation

Transfer to monomer

Transfer to polymer

Terminal double bond


propagation

!


y
X
dCn2; 0
1
1
k td l 0
i 2 R n; i1 Fn2; 0 k td l 0 Fn2; 0 Fn1; 0 R n [a]
2
2
dt
i0
n1
X
dCn2; 0
1; 0
k tc
Fm2 R nm Fm1; 0 Fnm

dt
m 1

dFn2; 0
dF12; 0
k m MFn2; 0 ;
k m l 0 M
dt
dt
2; 0
dCn
k m MFn2; 0
dt
dFn2; 0
dCn2; 0
k tp l 0 nCn2; 0  m1 Fn2; 0 ;
k tp l 0 nCn2; 0 m1 Fn2; 0
dt
dt
8
y
X
>
>
Fn2; 0
Cn1; 0
>
>
<
2; 0
dFn
n1
kdb
n1  3; 0
2; 0
1; 0
>
dt
X
>
Cm R nm Cm1; 0 Fnm
2Cm2; 0 Fnm
>
>

:
2; 0
1; 0 1; 0
2C
R

2C
F

Cm1; 0 R nm
nm
m
m
nm
m 1

9
>
>
>
>
=
 >;
>
>
>
;

dCn2; 0
kdb l 0 Cn3; 0
dt
[a] The rst term between brackets equals zero in the case where TDB
creation by disproportionation is not accounted for.

n1 X
y
y
y
y
y
y
X
X
X
X
X
1X

j 2 R m; j
R nm; i
R m; j
i 2 R nm; i
jR m; j
iR nm; i
2 m1 j0
j0
j0
i0
i0
i0

n1
n1
X
1X
2; 0
2; 0
1; 0
1; 0
Fm
R nm R m Fnm
2Fm1; 0 Fnm

Fm2 R nm Fm1; 0 Fnm

2 m1
m1

67
This yields for the recombination contribution to the population balance:
n1
X
dCn2; 0
2
1; 0
k tc
Fm
R nm Fm1; 0 Fnm

dt
m1

68

The rst term in the equation describing TDB propagation is derived in a similar
way to Eq. (62), while the second term follows as:

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

 X
y X
y 
y
y
X
X
dR n; i; k
i
i2

dt
i0 k0
i0
k0

y
X

(
i

n1 X
i1 X
k
X

!
jPm; j; l R nm; ij1; kl1

m1 j0 l0

n1 X
i
X
jPm; j R nm; ij1

m1 j0

i0

8
0
19
n1 X
y
y
<X
=
X
@ jPm; j
i 2 R nm; ij1 A

:m1 j0
;
i j1
(

n1 X
y
X
m1 j0

n1
X

y
X
jPm; j
i j  1 2 R nm; i

!)

i0

2; 0
1; 0
2; 0
Cm3; 0 R nm Cm1; 0 Fnm
2Cm2; 0 Fnm
 2Cm
R nm

m 1
1; 0
 2Cm1; 0 Fnm
Cm1; 0 R nm

69

The total contribution of TDB propagation to the population balance is thus given
by:
(
y
X
dFn2; 0
Cn1; 0
kdb Fn2; 0
dt
n1

n1  3; 0
2; 0
2; 0
1; 0
X
Cm R nm Cm1; 0 Fnm
2Cm2; 0 Fnm
 2Cm
R nm

1; 0
2Cm1; 0 Fnm
Cm1; 0 R nm
m1

70
For the dead chains we have:
dCn2; 0
kdb l 0 Cn3; 0
dt

71

It is obvious that even higher TDB moment distribution balances can be constructed, but we will restrict ourselves to the ones developed for up to the second
moments. When applying the TDB moment model, in principle two solution strategies are possible: one using the zeroth and rst TDB moments only and the second with zeroth, rst, and second TDB moments. In the rst case we have to nd a
closure relationship for the second moment, and in the second case, one for the
third moment. Below, we show that the system becomes simpler in the case of a
maximum of one TDB per chain.

465

466

9 Mathematical Methods

Closure relations

We have adopted a simple form for these relationships:

Cn2; 0 Dn

Cn1; 0 1; 0
C
Pn n

72

Cn3; 0 Dn0

Cn2; 0 2; 0
C
Cn1; 0 n

73

Here the functions Dn and Dn0 are in fact polydispersities of the branching moment
distributions and in principle are to be determined as functions of chain length n.
Inserting these closure relationships in Eqs. (65), (66), and (70), (71), reduces them
to:
(


)
y
n1 
X
X
dFn1; 0
Cm1; 0
1; 0
1; 0
1; 0 1; 0
1; 0
kdb Fn
Cn
Cm Fnm Dm
 1 Cm R nm
dt
Pm
n1
m1
65a
dCn1; 0
dt

kdb l 0 Dn

Cm1; 0
Pn

Cn1; 0

66a

(
y
X
dFn2; 0
kdb Fn2; 0
Cn1; 0
dt
n1
2
39


Cm2; 0
>
2; 0
n1 C 1; 0 F 2; 0 2C 2; 0 F 1; 0 D 0
X
 1 Cm R nm 7=
m
nm
m
6 m nm
1; 0
C

4
5
m
>
;
m 1
1; 0
2Cm1; 0 Fnm
Cm1; 0 R nm
70a
dCn2; 0
C 2; 0
kdb l 0 Dn0 n1; 0 Cn1; 0
dt
Cn

71a

An exact determination of Dn and Dn0 is not possible, but they can be estimated
from results of other methods, for instance a TDB classes model in regions with
few TDBs per chain.
TDB Pseudo-distribution Approach for a Maximum of one TDB per Chain
This case allows a few simplications. Firstly, only the rst TDB moment distributions, Fn1; 0 and Cn1; 0 , have to be solved in addition to the real concentration distributions, since all higher TDB moment distributions are identical to these. Second,
the TDB propagation contributions to the population balances become greatly simplied and their closure problem vanishes, since with Cn2; 0 Cn1; 0 Eqs. (65) and
(66) become:
9.6.3.2

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


y
n1
X
X
dFn1; 0
1; 0
Cn1; 0
Cm1; 0 Fnm
kdb Fn1; 0
dt
n1
m1

dCn1; 0
kdb l 0 Cn1; 0
dt

!
74

75

This implies that under the condition of a maximum of one TDB per chain, the
set of population balance equations of the TDB branching moment variant of the
model is solvable without requiring any additional closure assumption. The results
obtained with the pseudo-distribution model are identical to those obtained with
the classes model shown before (see Figure 9.6).
TDB Pseudo-distribution Approach for More than one TDB per Chain
It is interesting here to compare results for the case of insertion of disproportionation-produced TDBs leading to more than one TDB per chain to the case of a
maximum of one TDB per chain. The chain length distributions for the two cases
and high TDB propagation rates are depicted in Figure 9.10 (left-hand side), which
reveals that the CLDs are quite dierent. Most interestingly, for the case of a maximum of one TDB per chain, the CLD features a shoulder that becomes higher
with increasing kdb . This shoulder is absent in the other case, which can be explained by realizing that here the longer chains become more reactive with length
because of the higher number of TDBs on longer chains (see Figure 9.10, righthand side). Since these chains are more reactive they will be consumed by the
TDB propagation reaction more intensively, thereby producing more living chains,
which is consistent with our ndings (see Figure 9.10, left-hand side). When extending the trend of increasing TDB propagation rate, we would expect a transition
to a situation with vanishing dead chain concentrations, while retaining very few
but extremely long living chains. Thus, we observe the eect of dead chains with
many TDBs acting as crosslinkers between living chains. It should be noted that
under such conditions our model is no longer fully representative. The model
should at least be extended by allowing living chains with TDBs to be subject to
TDB propagation and, consequently, the existence of multiradicals.
The graph on the right in Figure 9.10 shows the numbers of TDBs per chain as a
function of chain length for both cases of TDB production. Here, the contrast is
very sharp. While for the maximum of one TDB per chain case the average number of TDBs per chain decreases with chain length, in the case of more than one
TDB it increases linearly with n in the double-logarithmic plot. The decrease in
the former case is caused by the simultaneous transfer-to-polymer reaction [9].
The latter implies a reduction to a constant TDB density, the number of TDBs
per monomer unit in a dead chain. As noted before, this results into a linear
increase in dead chain reactivity with chain length, similarly to the transfer-topolymer reaction.
9.6.3.3

467

468

9 Mathematical Methods

Fig. 9.10. Radical polymerization of vinyl


acetate in a CSTR. The reactor and kinetic data
are the same as in Figure 9.6. Left: chain
length distributions for dead and living chains.

The part of the living chain CLD from the TDB


moment model beyond 10 10 is estimated.
Right: numbers of TDBs per chain for various
kdb .

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


Tab. 9.15. Reaction mechanisms for LDPE (rst subscript: chain length; second subscript:
number of branch points).

Mechanism

Reaction equation

Rate factor

Initiation
Propagation
Disproportionation termination
Recombination termination
Transfer to monomer
Transfer to chain-transfer agent S
Transfer to polymer
Pre-scission (formation of secondary
macroradicals)
Scission of macroradicals

I2 ! 2I I M ! R1; 0
R n; i M ! R n1; i
R n; i R m; j ! Pn; i Pm; j
R n; i R m; j ! Pnm; ij
R n; i M ! Pn; i R1; 0
R n; i S ! Pn; i R1; 0
R n; i Pm; j ! Pn; i R m; j1 LCB
R n; i Pm; j ! Pn; i Rm; j

kd ; k i f
kp
k td
k tc
km
kS
k trp
k rs

Rn; i ! R nm; ij Pm; j

ksec

9.6.4

Radical Polymerization of Ethylene to Low-density Polyethylene (LDPE)


Introduction
This problem has received considerable attention for a long time. Modeling is complicated, since branching is involved, and the importance of random scission for
LDPE has now been recognized [31, 32, 54]. We address the 2D problem of CLD/
DBD calculation here. The full set of reaction equations is given in Table 9.15, notation in Table 9.16, and population balance equations in Table 9.17. For merely
9.6.4.1

Tab. 9.16.

Notation for LDPE system.

R n; i
Rn; i
Pn; i
m0

Primary radical chains


Secondary radical chains
Dead polymer chains
y X
y
X

Pn; i

l0

n1 i0

Rn

y
X

R n; i

y X
y
X

y
X

Rn

y
X

y
X

Rn; i

y X
y
X

iR n; i

F1
n

y
X

Pn

i0

Bn Cn =Pn
rn Cn =Pn n.

F2
n

y
X

y
X

Pn; i

i0

iRn; i

Cn1

i0

i 2 R n; i

Rn; i

n1 i0

i0

i0

Fn2

l0

n1 i0

i0

Fn1

R n; i

y
X

iPn; i

i0

i 2 Rn; i

i0

number of branches per chain


branching density

Cn2

y
X
i0

i 2 Pn; i

469

470

9 Mathematical Methods
Tab. 9.17.

Population balance equations for LDPE.

2D population balance equations


dR n; i
k p MR n1; i  R n; i  k td k tc l 0 R n; i k trp nl 0 Pn; i1  m1 R n; i
dt
ks SR n; i  k rs m1 R n; i
k m M 8
9
=
y <
y
X
X

ksec
gm; n
bm; j; njiR m; j 
:
;
m n1
ji

(a)

k m M ks Sl 0 dn  1di k i f MIdn  1di


n1 X
i
dPn; i
1 X
k td l 0 R n; i k tc
R m; j R nm; ij k trp nl 0 Pn; i m1 R n; i
2 m 1 j0
dt

(b)

k m M k8s SR n; i k rs nl 0 Pn; i m1 9


R n; i
y <
y
=
X
X

ksec
gl; n
bm; j; njiR m;
j
:
;
ji
l n1

dR n;
i


nk rs l 0 Pn; i  ksec R n;
i
dt
1D concentration distribution equations
dR n
k p MR n1  R n  k td k tc l 0 R n k trp nl 0 Pn  m1 R n  k m M ks SR n
dt

 k rs m1 R n ksec

y
X

(c)

(d)

gm; nRl k m M ks Sl 0 dn  1 k i f MIdn  1

m n1
n1
dPn
1 X
k td l 0 R n k tc
R m R nm k trp k rs m1 R n  nl 0 Pn k m M ks SR n
2 m 1
dt

ksec

y
X

(e)


gm; nR m

m n1

dR n
nk rs l 0 Pn  ksec R n
dt
1D pseudo-distribution equations, 1st branching moment

y 
dFn1 X
dR n; i
1

k p MFn1
i
Fn1  kM M kS SFn1  k td k tc l 0 Fn1
dt
dt
i0

(f )

(g)

k trp fm1 Fn1 l 0 nCn1 Pn g  k rs m1 Fn1


(
" j
#)
y
y
X
X
X

ksec
gm; n
R m;
ibm;
j;
nji
kM M kS Sl 0 dn  1
j
m n1

j0

i0

k i f Mdn  1

y 
n1
1
X
dCn X
dPn; N

kM M kS SFn1 k td l 0 Fn1 k tc
i
Fm1 R nm
dt
dt
m 1
i0
(
" j
#)
y
y
X
X
X

k trp k rs m1 Fn1  l 0 nCn1 ksec
gn; m
R m;
ibm;
j;
nji
j
nm1
y dR 
X
n; i

nk rs l 0 Cn1  ksec F1


i
n
dt
dt
i0

dF1
n

j0

(h)

i0

(i)

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


Tab. 9.17. (continued)

1D pseudo-distribution equations, 2nd branching moment




y
dFn2 X
dR n; i
2

k p MFn1
i2
Fn2  kM M kS SFn2  k td k tc l 0 Fn2
dt
dt
i0

( j)

k trp fm1 Fn2 l 0 nCn2 2Cn1 Pn g


(
" j
#)
y
y
X
X
X

gm; n
R m;
i 2 bm; j; nji
ksec
j
m n1

j0

i0

 k rs m1 Fn2 kM M kS Sl 0 dn  1 k i f Mdn  1


y
n1
X
dCn2 X
dPn; i
1

kM M kS SFn2 k td l 0 Fn2 k tc
i2
Fm2 R nm Fm1 Fnm

dt
dt
m 1
i0
(
" j
#)
y
y
X
X
X

2
2
2
gn; m
R m; j
i bm; j; nji
k trp k rs m1 Fn  l 0 nCn ksec
nm1

j0

  
y
X
dR n; i

nk rs l 0 Cn2  ksec F2


i2
n
dt
dt
i0

dF2
n

(k)

i0

(l)

computational reasons it is assumed that the scission reaction proceeds in two


steps, a pre-scission reaction yielding a secondary macroradical Rn; i , and a subsequent breakage of this radical:
k rs n1

Pn; i R m; j 
! Rn; i Pm; j

76

ksec
Rn; i !

77

R nm; ij Pm; j

The term (n  1) in the pre-scission equation [Eq. (76)] is due to the fact that we
are dealing with random (pre-)scission here: that is, every CaC bond has equal
probability of being attacked to form a secondary radical. The population balance
contribution from this reaction is similar to that from a transfer-to-polymer reaction (see Table 9.17). The 2D population balance contribution from the actual scission step reads as (Table 9.17):
9
8
=
y <
y
X
X
dR n; i

gm; n
bm; j; njiRm;

ksec
j
;
:
dt
mn1
ji

78

Here, the functions g and b are the most general form of probability functions, expressing the way in which the fragment lengths are distributed (g) and how the
branch points are redistributed on these fragments (b). The function gm; j; n describes the probability that a chain of length n with j branch points breaks into a
fragment with length m, while bm; j; nj j is the conditional probability that a fragment of length m created by scission of a chain n=i carries exactly j branch points.
The fragment length distribution function reects the scission mechanism acting.

471

472

9 Mathematical Methods

The Galerkin-FEM approach allows us to choose any model describing such mechanisms, either chemical or mechanical, if they are expressed in terms of fragment
lengths as functions of overall chain length or numbers of branch points [54]. An
overview of such models is given elsewhere [32]. In the most realistic models the
eect of branching and architectures is accounted for; this gives rise to predominantly long and short fragments. The fundamental problem here, to start with, is
that the second dimension of the 2D population balance problem, the branching
distribution, has to be solved to calculate the rst dimension, CLD. Moreover, not
only the branching distribution, but also the character of the branched architectures, determine the scission function. One way of addressing this problem is
employing an empirical approximation relationship for the fragment length function gn; m found for topological scission of LDPE architectures [33]:
1
2s m 2
gn; m n1 (
X
1
m1

2s m

1
2s n  m 2

79

2s n  m 2

with s the average segment length, according to:


s

nn
1 2  LCB=m 0

80

In Eq. (80), LCB is the overall concentration of long chain branches, following
from a balance coupled with the transfer-to-polymer reaction (see Table 9.17). The
fragment length distribution gn; m for topological scission is a function of chain
and fragment length only, and independent of the number i of branch points on
the original chain. Note that this is an approximation method that ts to the dierential equation approach. Obviously, it accounts for branching architectures in an
averaged manner. Fully accounting for architectures is not possible with the dierential equation method, since it does not describe connectivity in molecules. Doing
this in more rigorous ways, full [1115] or conditional [3335] Monte Carlo (MC)
simulations can be used (see Section 9.8). We stress here that the strength of the
dierential method discussed here is its ability to implement any function describing scission in overall molecular dimensions, such as chain length. This is
not readily possible in MC simulations.
In order to solve the one-dimensional chain length distribution problem, the
scission contribution of Eq. (78) is summed over the number of branch points on
i
P
bn; i; mj j 1, so this population balance assumes
fragments, j. By denition
a one-dimensional form: j0
y
X
dR m
gn; mR n
ksec
dt
nm1

81

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

The 1D population balance for the pseudo-distribution or rst branching moment


distribution Fn follows by taking the rst branching moment of Eq. (78):

y
X

jR m; j

j0

dt

(
"
#)
y
y
i
X
X
X
dFm

gn; m
R n; i
jbn; i; mj j

ksec
dt
nm1
j0
i0

82

Depending on the branch point redistribution function, the term in square brackets
(in fact the expectation value of the number of branches on a fragment) can be
evaluated. Similarly, we nd for the second branching moment expression:

y
X

j 2 R m; j

j0

dt

(
"
#)
y
y
i
X
X
X
dFm2

2

ksec
gn; m
R n; i
j bn; i; mj j
dt
nm1
j0
i0

83

The task is now to nd empirical expressions for the rst and second branching
moment summation terms between brackets in Eqs. (82) and (83) similar to Eq.
(79) for the fragment lengths. The shape of these is strongly dependent on the scission mechanism [32]. Note that nding solutions for this problem is important for
calculation of the branching density and the branching polydispersity as functions
of chain length. From this the shape of the branching distribution at constant
chain length can be estimated, which then produces an estimation of the full
CLD/DBD.
Finally, in Figure 9.11 we show MWDs for two dierent scission models. The
linear scission case assumes scission of unbranched chains. The topological scission case employs the fragment length function of Eq. (79). A marked dierence is
observed.
9.6.5

Radical Copolymerization
Introduction
We now address the problem of nding the 3D distribution of chain lengths,
copolymer composition, and sequence length distribution in radical copolymerization. We have several options here. One could be explicitly solving the 3D conseq
centration variable at the sequence level, Pn; i; s , denoting the concentration of sequences of length s on chains with a total number of monomer units n (usually
called chain length), and number of monomer units of one kind i. Note that i=n
is then the fractional copolymer composition. We will not do this, but instead
choose a simpler option and solve a dierent 3D concentration variable at the
seq
chain level, Pn; i; s . Subscripts n and i have the same meaning as in Pn; i; s , but s
here denotes the number of monomer sequences of one kind. Solving this prob9.6.5.1

473

9 Mathematical Methods

0.6
0.6
0.5
0.5

dW/d{log(n)}

474

0.4
0.4
0.3
0.3
0.2
0.2
0.1
0.1
0
0.0 0
10

1e+0

101

1e+1

102

1e+2

103

1e+3

104

1e+4

105

1e+5

Chain Length

106

1e+6

107

1e+7

108

1e+8

Radical polymerization of ethylene in a CSTR. Linear


and topological scission with the same polydispersity of 26 as
experimental MWD from SEC-MALLS [35]. Solid line,
experimental MWD; dash-dot line, topological scission result;
dash-dot-dot line, linear scission result.
Fig. 9.11.

lem in the full three dimensions would yield the average sequence length on
chains Pn; i; s , simply following as i=s. We will show next how to solve the problem
using pseudo-distributions and thus nd the average copolymer composition and
sequence length as a function of chain length, n. Reaction equations are listed in
Table 9.18, notation and denitions in Table 9.19. Note that macroradicals are
specied according to terminal unit, with an upper index A or B.
Balance Equations
All the reactions listed in Table 9.18 have contributions to the set of balance equations. We will give a few examples of the generation of these contributions from
some of the reaction equations.
9.6.5.2

Tab. 9.18.

Reaction equations for radical copolymerization.

Initiation
kd

Propagation
kAA

Termination
kc

A
A
R n;
i; s A ! R n1; i1; s

A
A
R n;
i; s R m; j; t ! Pnm; ij; st

I A ! R1;A 1; 0

B
B
R n;
i; s B ! R n1; i; s

B
B
R n;
i; s R m; j; t ! Pnm; ij; st

I B ! R1;B 0; 0

A
B
R n;
i; s B ! R n1; i; s

A
B
R n;
i; s R m; j; s ! Pnm; ij; st

I2 ! 2I
ki

ki

kBB

kAB

kBA

B
A
R n;
i; s A ! R n1; i1; s1

kc

kc

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


Tab. 9.19.

Notation and denitions.


l 0A

Overall moments

y X
y X
y
X

A
R n;
i; s

l 0B

n1 s1 i1

Pn; i

2D concentrations

y
X

Pn; i; s

R nA

1D concentrations

Pn; s

GnA

1st moment distributions


number of A sequences

FnA

y X
y
X

y X
y
X

A
R n;
i; s

R nB

m0

y X
y X
y
X

y
X

Pn; i; s

A
iR n;
i; s

GnB

y X
y
X
A
s
R n;
i; s

R nA

i1

Number of A units per chain as a function of n


Number of A sequences per chain as a function of n
Average sequence length of A as a function of n
Average sequence length of B as a function of n

y X
y
X

y X
y
X

B
R n;
i; s

Pn

B
iR n;
i; s

Ln
Cn

s1 i1

kBA A

dt

y X
y
X

B
B
Rn1;
i1; s1 kBA AR n1

84

s2 i2

For the rst moment distribution of the number of A units we have:

y X
y
X
s1 i1

dt

!
A
iR n;
i; s

y X
y
y
X
X
dGnA
B
B
kBA A
iR n1;
iR n1;
i1; s1 kBA A
i1
dt
s2 i2
i2

85
The last term here contains the two-dimensional distribution multiplied by i:
B
i.R n1;
i1 , which upon summation over i, due to its index (i  1), produces the
B
B
and Gn1
. Hence, we get:
sum of two one-dimensional distributions: R n1
dGnA
B
B
kBA AR n1
Gn1

dt

y X
y
X

Pn; i; s

iPn; i; s

y X
y
X
s
Pn; i; s
s1

i1

nnA Ln =Pn
snA Cn =Pn
lnA nnA =snA
lnB n  nnA =snA nnB =snA

kBA

Rn;A i; s

y X
y
X

s1 i1

A
BxA-propagation: Rn,B i, s B A m RnB1,
In this reaction all the indices iniB1, sB1
crease by 1. The contribution to the balance equations from which the length distribution is calculated simply follows by taking the double sum over i and s:

y X
y
X

A
R n;
i; s

s1 i1

y X
y
X
B
s
R n;
i; s
s1

y X
y
X
s1 i1

s1 i1

FnB

Pn; i; s

n1 s1 i1

s1 i1

s1 i1

s1

B
R n;
i; s

i1

s1 i1

1st moment distributions


of number of A units

y X
y X
y
X
n1 s1 i1

s1

475

86

i1

476

9 Mathematical Methods

Obviously, in this case the problem in obtaining the rst moment distribution of
the number of A sequences is exactly identical to that for the A units, so we have:
dFnA
B
B
Fn1

kBA AR n1
dt

87

k AA

A
AxA-propagation: Rn,A i, s B A m RnB1,
Here, only two of the three indices iniB1, s
crease by 1. The length distribution is again calculated simply by taking the double
sum over i and s which is identical to the length distribution term found in the previous propagation case, Eq. (84):

y X
y
X

!
A
R n;
i; s

s1 i1

kAA A

dt

y X
y
X

A
A
R n1;
i1; s kAA AR n1 ;

88

s2 i2

For the rst moment distribution of the number of A units, for this propagation
step we have:

y X
y
X

!
iRn;A i; s

s1 i1

dt

y X
y
y
X
X
dGnA
A
A
iRn1;
iRn1;
kAA A
i1; s kAA A
i1 ; 89
dt
s2 i2
i2

which again is equal to the one found before, Eq. (85). Hence we end up with an
expression containing two one-dimensional distributions on the right-hand side:
dGnA
A
A
Gn1

kAA AR n1
dt

90

For this propagation step the situation for the rst moment distribution of A sequences is dierent, since we now have

y X
y
X
i1 s1

dt

!
A
sR n;
i; s

y X
y
y
X
X
dFnA
A
A
sR n1;
sR n1;
kAA A
i1; s kAA A
s;
dt
s2
i2 s2

91

where in the last term the summation over s proceeds with a two-dimensional disA
tribution Rn1;
s simply having s as the index. This yields:
dFnA
A
;
kAA AFn1
dt
containing only one one-dimensional distribution.

92

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach


kBB

B
BxB propagation Rn,B i, s m RnB1,
Only the chain length index is increased. Using
i, s
a similar argument to previously, we can say that the right-hand side expressions
for both the number of A units and the number of A sequences moment distributions will produce two-dimensional distributions as intermediate results having i
and s as indices. Summation of these will nally produce expressions like Eq. (92):

dGnB
B
kBB BGn1
dt

93

dFnB
B
kBB BFn1
dt

94
kc

A
Termination by combination: Rn,A i, s B Rm,
This is the reaction
j, t m P nBm, iBj, sBt
equation for termination between macroradicals with identical terminal groups.
The balance equation describing the production of dead chains Pn; i; s is:

n1 X
i1 X
s1
X
dPn; i; s 1
A
A
R m;
k tAA
j; t R nm; ij; st
2
dt
m1 j1 t1

95

The rst moment distribution of the number of A units leads to:

y X
y
X
s1 i1

dt

!
iPn; i; s

(
)
n1 X
y
i1 X
y X
s1
X
X
dLn 1
A
A

k tAA
i
R m; j; t R nm; ij; st
2
dt
m1 i1
j1 s1 t1
(
)
n1 X
y
i1
X
X
1
A
A
i
R m; j R nm; ij
k tAA
2
m1 i1
j1

96

The last term can be rearranged to give for the rst moment of the number of A
units:
0
1
(
)
n1 X
y
i1
n1 X
y
y
X
X
X
X
dLn 1
1
A
A
A
@R A
A
k tAA
i
R m;
iR nm;
j R nm; ij k tAA
m; j
ij
2
2
dt
m1 i1
m1 j1
j1
i j
n1 X
y
y
X
X
1
A
A
R m;
i jR nm;
k tAA
j
i
2
m1 j1
i0

n1
y
y
y
y
X
X
X
X
X
1
A
A
A
A
k tAA
jR m;
R nm;
R m;
iR nm;
j
i
j
i
2
m1
j1
j1
i1
i1
n1
n1
X
X
1
A
A A
A
k tAA
GmA R nm
Rm
Gnm k tAA
GmA R nm
2
m1
m1

97

477

478

9 Mathematical Methods

An expression for the contribution from the termination reaction to the rst moment distribution of the number of A sequences is obtained in an identical
manner:
n1
X
dCn
A
k tAA
CmA R nm
dt
m1

98

For the termination between B-terminated macroradicals the expressions obtained


are exactly the same as Eqs. (97) and (98). For the reaction between A- and Bterminated macroradicals we nd:
n1
X
dLn
B
A B
k tAB
GmA R nm
Rm
Gnm
dt
m1

99

n1
X
dCn
B
A B
CmA R nm
Rm
Cnm
k tAB
dt
m1

100

The consumption terms for the macroradicals corresponding to the termination


reactions have simpler forms like the balance equation in three dimensions:
dRn;A i; s
dt

k tAA Rn;A i; s

n1 X
i1 X
s1
X

A
A
Rm;
j; t  k tAB Rn; i; s

m1 j1 t1

Rn;A i; s k tAA l0A k tAB l0B

n1 X
i1 X
s1
X

B
Rm;
j; t

m1 j1 t1

101

From this the moment distribution expressions for the number of A units and for
the number of A sequences easily follow as:
dFnA
FnA k tAA l 0A k tAB l 0B
dt

102

dGnA
GnA k tAA l 0A k tAB l 0B
dt

103

Once the pseudo-distributions have been solved, the average copolymer composition nnA =n and sequence lengths lnA can be calculated with the expressions given
in Table 9.19. Note that the average number of B units nnB can simply be derived
from nnA , since nnB n  nnA . For large numbers of sequences per chain we may
further assume that these are equal for both monomers: snB snA . Thus, the average
sequence length for B; lnB, can also be inferred easily. Some illustrative calculations
have been carried out for a batch copolymerization and the results (together with
kinetic and reactor data) are shown in Figure 9.12.

9.6 Pseudo-distribution Approach

Copolymer composition

1
0.8

0.6
0.4

0.2
0 101

102

103
104
Chain length

105

106

Sequence length

104
103
102

101
A
100
10-1
101

102

103
104
Chain length

Fig. 9.12. Average copolymer composition and


sequence length as functions of chain length
for batch copolymerization. Kinetic data:
kd 6:25  103 s1 ; k i 3:75  104 m 3
(kmol s)1 ; k pAA 1000 m 3 (kmol s1 );
k pAB 100 m 3 (kmol s)1 ; k pAA 1000 m 3
(kmol s)1 ; k pBA 10 6 m 3 (kmol s)1 ;
k pBB 10 5 m 3 (kmol s)1 ; kc 3  10 5 m 3

105

106

(kmole s)1 ; cA0 2 kmol m3 ; cB0 2


kmol m3 ; cI0 102 kmol m3 ; batch time:
400 s. Shorter chains (produced early in the
batch) contain equal amounts of A and B with
sequence lengths of 2.5 on the average. Long
chains (late in the batch) possess more B, with
sequences of up to 2000.

479

480

9 Mathematical Methods

9.7

Probability Generating Functions


9.7.1

Introduction

Probability generating functions (pgf ) are dened as polynomials in the transformation variable z [where the coecients p i represent a probability distribution
(that is, a length distribution)]:

Gz

y
X

pi z i

104

i0

Distribution moments and coecients can be obtained from Gz according to:


 
qG
;
m 0 G1; m1
qz z1
!
1 q iG
pi
i! qz i

m2

q2G
qz 2

!
105
z1

106

z0

We will discuss pgfs as used in a transformation procedure to solve population balance equations [3], and as employed in the cascade theory of polymer networks
[3744].
9.7.2

Probability Generating Functions in a Transformation Method

According to the transformation procedure, the population balance equations in


terms of discrete variables (chain length, number of branch points) are transformed into a set of equations in z. The transformed set is solved and subsequently
inverted to the original discrete variable domain. This process makes use of some
interesting properties of certain mathematical expressions as transformed into the
z-domain. Transformations and inversions are tabulated in textbooks [3]. As an example we take linear AB step polymerization in a batch reactor with equal initial
end group concentration P0 :
k

Pn Pm ! Pnm

107

n1
y
X
X
dPn
Pm Pnm  2kPn
Pn
k
dt
m1
n1

108

The total chain concentration is m 0


Eq. (106) we obtain Eq. (109), yielding:

y
P
n1

Pn , so by taking the zeroth moment of

9.7 Probability Generating Functions

dm 0
km 0 2
dt

109

m 0 P0 =1 ktP0

110

Since by denition [Eq. (104)] G1 m 0 , while the convolution property prescribes:

n1
X

!
Pm Pnm

fGPn g 2

111

m1

Eq. (108) becomes:


dGz
kfG 2 z  2GzG1g
dt

112

By putting z 1, Eq. (110) for the total concentration m 0 is reproduced. To solve


Eq. (112) we rst realize that under initial conditions the pgf is given as: Gz; 0
P0 z; integration then leads to:
Gz P0 fG1=P0 g 2 z=1  zf1  G1=P0 g

113

This expression in the z-domain has a standard inverse form in the chain length
domain, which represents a Flory distribution as the well-known solution to this
problem:
Pn P0 fG1=P0 g 2 f1  G1=P0 g n1

114

This pgf transformation procedure is an elegant method that has found many applications [3]. However, its ability to solve complete distribution problems is restricted to cases where explicit inversion is possible. In other cases only the main
moments can be calculated, which then often can also be realized directly by the
method of moments.
9.7.3

Probability Generating Functions and Cascade Theory

The cascade theory has been developed to deal with problems concerning polymer
network formation [3744]. Consider the polymer network made by polycondensation of f -functional monomers, represented as a rooted tree in Figure 9.13.
Let end group conversion be given as a; then for a three-functional monomer
the pgf of the connectivity between the zeroth and rst generation is given by:
F0 z 1  a 3 3a1  a 2 z 3a 2 1  az 2 a 3 z 3 1  a az 3

115

481

9 Mathematical Methods

(1-) 2z0

2(1-)z 1 2z2
2
F1(z) =

(1-+ z) 2

(1-) 3z0

3(1-) 2z1

3 2(1-)z 2

3z3

Generation

482

F0(z) = (1-+ z)3


Fig. 9.13. Principle of probability generating functions and
cascade theory for a three-functional polymer network.

Likewise, the pgf for connectivity between rst and second (and all subsequent)
generations is given by:
F1 z 1  a az 2

116

In general, for f -functional monomers we thus have:


F0 z 1  a az f
F1 z 1  a az f 1

117

From the connectivity pgfs at subsequent generation levels the branch point probability distributions at a certain level can be inferred. For instance, in the example
with f 3 at level 2 the branch point pgf reads as:
F0 z 1  a aF1 3

118

where F1 is given by Eq. (116); coecients of z i in Eq. (118) represent the probabilities of nding i branch points at level 2. Thus, at an arbitrary level we have:
G0 z F0 F1 F1 . . . F1 z

119

From Eqs. (117), number- and weight-average chain lengths can be derived using
Eqs. (105) [37], but a more elegant method is to construct self-consistent equations
[45, 46] to solve the pgf. In the three-functional example above, the probabilities of
a given node on an arbitrary generation level being connected to zero, one, or two

9.7 Probability Generating Functions

further nodes are expressed by the coecients for z 0 ; z 1, and z 2 , respectively, in


pgf Gz. In addition, being connected to a further node implies the possibility of
being connected to even further nodes. This possibility is described by the identical
pgf Gz. The connectivity to further nodes if connected to two nodes is expressed
by G 2 z, since statistics of these connectivities are identical, but independent.
Note that the contributions of further connectivities are thus correctly described
by the coecients of the z terms. The self-consistent equation becomes:
G 1  a 2 a1  azG a 2 z 2 G 2

120

We will illustrate this procedure on a simple linear step-polymerization ( f 2) to


obtain the CLD and on single metallocene ethylene polymerization to nd the 2D
distribution of chain lengths and numbers of branch points.
Linear step-polymerization is treated as above with f 2, yielding the selfconsistent pgf equation:
G 1  a azG

121

and hence:
G 1  a=1  az

122

Applying Eqs. (105) to Eq. (121) we nd the number- and weight-average for the
number of links between monomer units, which after adding 1 yields the familiar
expressions for n n and nw already found by Flory [1]:
 
qG
a
1
1

qz z1 1  a
1a

 2   
q G
qG
a
2a 2
1a
nw

1
2
qz z1
qz z1 1  a 1  a 2
1a
nn

123

Series expansion in z of Eq. (122) yields for G:


G

y
X
1  aa i z i

124

i0

of which the coecients represent a Flory distribution 1  aa i1 , realizing again


that chain length is one more than the number of links. The derivation of the
CLD/DBD 2D distribution for the metallocene system is based on the fact that all
segments between branch points possess the same statistics. The pgf method is
then applied to the connectivity of segments rather than monomer units as in the
polycondensation problem. A pgf is constructed for the probability of nding connectivity points (branch points) on a segment going in a direction opposite to the
growth direction. The self-consistent pgf equation follows from an argument in

483

484

9 Mathematical Methods

which the probability of a segment having a branch point plays a central role. Assuming steady state and taking the (0; 0)-moment of the population balance equations (35)(40), we nd this branching probability to equal:
b

kb k p; TDB tl 0
B

B m 0 l 0 2kb t 1k p; TDB l 0 kb 1=t

125

A given segment is connected to an initiation point (hence not to a branch point)


with probability 1  b, and it is connected to a branch point with probability b. In
the case of a branch point the segment is connected to two further segments obeying the same statistics and hence pgf. Thus we have:
G 1  b bzG 2

126

which has a quadratic form this time, having Eq. (127) as the solution [45]:
q
1  1  4b1  bz
127
G
2b
This can be expanded to give:
G

y
X

2i!
b i 1  b i1 z i
i!i

1!
i0

128

where the coecients for z i represent the probability distribution of the numbers
of branch points per molecule. Here, the factor 2i!=i 1! is called the Catalan
number, which has already been derived by Flory [1] and represents the number of
dierent ways a molecule with i branch points can be constructed. Since the number of segments between branch points plus terminal segments per molecule is
2i 1, obtaining the length distribution further requires the length distribution of
the segments to be taken into account. This should obey a Flory distribution, being
dictated by the competition of propagation on the one hand, and termination by
b-hydride elimination and TDB incorporation on the other. Hence the numberaverage segment length and probability distribution of segments with length ni
follow as:


kpM
1
ni
nns

exp

129
p
n
nns
nns
kb k p; TDB m
0 1=t
From Eq. (129) the probability of nding polymers with i branch points (2i 1
segments) is easily inferred. The conditional probability of polymers with 2i 1
segments, all with a Flory distribution with average nns , of having total length n is
known to be:
pnji



n
exp

nns
nns 2i1 2i!
n 2i

130

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

This result can be understood as the product of 2i 1 segmental probability distributions [Eq. (129)], leading to n in the exponential, multiplied by a prefactor representing the number of possibilities of distributing n monomer units among 2i 1
segments. Combining Eqs. (129) and (130) gives the full expression for the 2D distribution of CLD and DBD:
pn; i

n 2i
nns 2i1



1
n
b i 1  b i1 exp  s
i!i 1!
nn

131

As regards a successful application of the pgf cascade method, we conclude that:




connectivity statistics should be identical for all units (monomer units or segments), and
 a convenient series expansion of the pgf from the self-consistent equation should
be possible.

9.8

Monte Carlo Simulations


9.8.1

Introduction

This method is employed for problems where analytical or dierential equations


approaches are not feasible in view of high dimensionality, or only lead to approximate solutions or averages for one or more dimensions. Examples of such limitations have been discussed above. The Galerkin-FEM method in the pseudodistribution mode was confronted with closure problems in the case of PVAc with
more than one TDB per chain. The pgf-method is applicable only to systems with
identical statistics of the constituting elements. In principle, Monte Carlo simulation does not suer from such limitations. Here, we will introduce classical MC,
but subsequently mainly discuss some successful applications of advanced MC
methods.
Classical MC simply describes the reactions of single monomer units. In the
case of branching, a reaction event can be either a propagation, a termination or
a branching step, according to the relative probabilities of these reactions. This
method has, for instance, been applied to a single metallocene system for branched
polyethylene to provide the bivariate CLD/DBD [47]. The disadvantage of this
approach is that it requires billions of reaction steps to generate suciently large
populations of molecules, typically 10 6 , to derive accurate statistics. Computationally less demanding is application of MC to larger constituent units than molecules: segments or primary polymers [1115, 47]. In the aforementioned metallocene example this could be realized for a continuous reactor in a simple manner
because of the identical statistical properties of all segments. This increased computation speed by a factor of 15 [47]. However, when the tails of very broad CLDs

485

486

9 Mathematical Methods

are to be described, typically involving concentrations more than six decades lower
than the highest chain concentrations in the system, the numbers of molecules to
be generated become excessive, even with primary polymer sampling. Tobita has
achieved a great improvement in MC sampling in this respect by applying sampling based on weight-fraction instead of number-fraction distributions [1115].
We will now discuss this method as applied on mostly branched radical polymerization systems involving transfer to polymer, terminal double bond incorporation,
recombination termination, and random scission for both continuous and batch
reactors.
9.8.2

Weight-fraction Sampling of Primary Polymers: Batch Reactor, Transfer to Polymer


[48]

A branched molecule is thought to be composed of primary polymers (pps) in


which growth of linear chains has started from monoradicals or from secondary
radical sites at other pps, created by transfer to polymer, and stopped by a certain
termination mechanism. Primary polymers can possess one or more branch points
at which other pps have been growing. Primary polymer sampling is generally
based on the assumption of instantaneous growth of pps. In a batch reactor the
length distribution of such pps is then determined by the kinetic conditions (conversion) at the birth time, y. The MC process starts with sampling such a birth
time y, and under number-fraction sampling its length is sampled from the (usually Flory) number-fraction distribution at y. Since molecules may start growing at
any moment, we may (but must not necessarily) consider this rst sampled pp as
the rst one of the whole molecule. The rst pp may, by transfer to polymer reactions, receive one or several branch points in the remaining time between y and
the batch end time c, and thus become attached to pps created at later birth times.
These rst, second, third and further pps may in their turn receive branch points
and become attached to more pps at later stages. The MC process stops when the
last pps no longer obtain branch points.
A slightly modied approach does not regard the rst sampled pp as the rst
one in the molecule. Instead it accounts for the possibility that the rst sampled
pp has started growing from a branch point created on a previously formed pp (between 0 and y), rather than being initiated from a monoradical. Since in all cases
the connectivity is based on the same values for the branching probability at the
various birth times, the results are identical.
Since most pps are present in short chains, this sampling procedure generates
mostly short molecules; hence a very great many molecules have to be created to
predict long CLD tails accurately. If, instead, one sampled monomer units on pps
and was able to predict their connectivity to other parts of the molecule, then most
molecules generated would have sizes around the maximum of the weight-fraction
distribution. In other words, such a method is signicantly more eective at nding long CLD tails. This is the rationale of weight-fraction sampling, since the
probability of selecting a monomer unit at random from a pp population is propor-

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

tional to the length n of the pps. Since in that method a monomer unit is sampled
at random in a molecule, it cannot always be on the rst pp of the molecule. The
MC process consequently proceeds in the second manner described above. The
rst monomer unit sampled at y forms part of a pp in the zeroth generation, as
do the pps to which it (eventually) is connected by branch points from it, on the
one hand, and (eventually) to the pp on which it started growing on, on the other.
The MC algorithm determines the birth times and lengths of pps in subsequent
generations.
We will demonstrate the MC procedure on a very simple radical polymerization
process with transfer to polymer, while disproportionation is the only termination
mechanism (see Figure 9.14). The algorithm employs conversion x, rather than
time, as the independent variable. Consequently, it starts with sampling the birth
conversion x y of a zeroth-generation pp by sampling a random number between 0 and end conversion c. Its length is determined by sampling from the
weight-fraction distribution (usually according to Flory):
wn y



n
exp

ny
ny 2
n

132

The average chain length ny is given by:


ny k p Myl 0 y=k td l 0 y 2 k p My=k td l 0 y

pp:
brith conversion z(1),
0 < z(1) < z(0)

pp with u(1)
z(0) < u(1) <

branch points sampled with Eq. (138)


with (,) from Eq. (137)

pp:
brith conversion z(0),
0 < z(0) <

pp with u(1)
z(0) < u(1) <

133

initial unit

pp with u(0)
< u(0) <

pp: brith conversion ,


length from wn(), Eq. (132)

pp with u(0)
< u(0) <
Fig. 9.14. Monte Carlo sampling of primary polymers and their
connectivity for radical polymerization with transfer to polymer
in a batch reactor. Conversion c, rst pp sampled at birth
conversion x y.

pp with u(1)
u(0) < u(1) <

487

488

9 Mathematical Methods

Sampling can be realized by using the cumulative distribution of wn y, a function


of y; cwn y, with values between 0 and 1, selecting a random number between 0
and 1 (rand1), and nding y by requiring that cwn y rand1. A faster method
utilizes the property that sampling twice from the number-fraction distribution
and adding results exactly reproduces a weight-fraction distribution [49]. Sampling
from nn can be performed rapidly using the simple formula:
n ceilny lnf1=rand1g

134

where ceil denotes the value obtained when rounding a real number to the nearest
higher integer, a standard operation available in most mathematical packages such
as MATLAB. Doing this twice and adding the values generates a weight-fraction
sample value. The probability of receiving branch points for this pp depends on
its average branching density between y and c and is proportional to its now
known length, n. The former can be derived from the monomer and branch points
balance (Table 9.1):
dM
dx
k p l 0 tM !
k p l 0 t1  x
dt
dt

135

dr
k tp l 0 t
dt

136

Combination and integration between y and c yields the average branching density ry; c:


dr
1
1y
C tp
! ry; c C tp ln
dt
1r
1c

137

The number of branch points m on this pp is sampled from a binomial distribution containing average branching density ry; c and pp length n:

pm

n
m


r m rnm

138

Sampling can be performed by employing standard random number generators


for a binomial distribution (for example, in MATLAB: m binorndn; r). Next, to
the pps attached at each of these branch points a birth conversion u, y < u < c, and
a length must be assigned. The former should follow from the formation intensity
distribution of branching density over the conversion interval yc as given by
Eq. (137). This implies that we should sample u from the conditional (given that
this branch point exists at a pp formed at y) probability distribution, as expressed by:

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

 

1y
1y
ln
CPa ujy ln
1u
1c

139

The sampling can be performed by selecting a random number between 0 and 1


(rand1) and inferring u from it by requiring that CPa (a function of u between 0
and 1) equals rand1. The shape of Eq. (139) is such that on average u is chosen
closer to c than to y. This agrees with the fact that branch formation intensity is
higher at high conversion. The length of the pp grown at x u is sampled from
the number-fraction distribution:

nn y



1
n
exp 
;
ny
ny

140

since a single chain end (instead of an arbitrary unit on the chain) is chosen at random as its starting point. Sampling is easily realized by employing Eq. (133). This
eventually leads to a number of pps in generation 0 with specied birth conversions and lengths. Included in the procedure for this generation is the accounting
for the eventuality of the rst pp [pp(y)] being attached to a pp created earlier, at z,
0 < z < y. This follows from the relative probability of the rst pp of being initiated by a transfer-to-polymer reaction [Eq. (141)].
Pb k tp l 0 m1 =k tp l 0 m1 2kd I2 k tp m1 =k tp m1 k td l 0

141

The latter equality follows from the quasi-steady-state-assumption. Note that Pb in


a batch reactor is a function of conversion. If other transfer mechanisms are present, the denominator is extended with the corresponding contributions to the initiation process. Whether or not the pp is attached to another pp indeed follows by
selecting a random number between 0 and 1 and determining whether the inequality rand1 < Pb is false or true. If connected (true) then the birth conversion
of the earlier pp simply follows from the conditional distribution (given that the
rst sampled pp is created at x y and grows from an earlier one):
CPi zjy z=y

142

CPi is linear with z since from the perspective of the pp created at x z its probability of undergoing transfer to polymer is simply linearly proportional to conversion. This implies that all values for the birth conversion between 0 and y are
equally probable. Sampling can be performed in the same way as described for
CPa [Eq. (139)]. Finally, the length of the pp grown at x u is sampled from the
weight-fraction distribution wn z, Eq. (132), since any of the monomer units in
this pp can undergo branching. This then concludes the MC process at generation
0. If this generation has generated new pps attached in either way to the rst one,
the generation number is increased by one. Note that pps attached alongside the
rst pp can only become attached to pps created at higher conversion. In contrast,

489

490

9 Mathematical Methods

the pp (created at x z) to which (eventually) the pp sampled rst is attached by


its chain end can have further branch points created at birth conversions x > z, but
in addition it can be itself attached to a pp pp (x < z) created earlier; see Figure
9.14. The number of branch points on the pp formed at x z also follows from
the binomial distribution, Eq. (138), but now with an average branching density
rz; c and a length one less than its sampled length, since one of its monomer
units already possesses a branch point (by which its is connected to the rst pp
sampled).
9.8.3

Example

We demonstrate the algorithm with the synthesis of a molecule with 10 branch


points as shown in Figure 9.15. Alongside all the pps between brackets are listed
the generation number, birth conversion, and length, respectively. The rst pp is
sampled at x y 0:4 and has length 300 [wn distribution, Eq. (132)]. It possesses
three branch points [binomial distribution, Eq. (138)]. Birth conversions of these
three pps are sampled using Eq. (139) to be: u 0:65; 0:45, and 0.62. The lengths
of the three pps are sampled from the distribution nn at these conversions [Eq.
(140)]: 60, 130, and 80, respectively. The pp sampled rst turns out [using probability Pb from Eq. (141)] to be connected to an earlier pp. Birth conversion of this
earlier pp equals z 0:3, as sampled from CPi , Eq. (142). Its length is 230 [wn distribution, Eq. (132)]. This nishes generation 0, which has generated four pps in
total. In the rst generation two of these pps according to Eq. (138) turn out to

(1, 0.22, 180)

(2, 0.42, 80)


(0, 0.3, 230)

(1, 0.37, 140)

(1, 0.6, 110)

(0, 0.4, 300)

(0, 0.65, 60)

(0, 0.45, 130)

(0, 0.62, 80)

(1, 0.51, 60)

(2, 0.65, 100)


Fig. 9.15. Example of full Monte Carlo sampling of a branched
molecule for radical polymerization with transfer to polymer.

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

posses branch points: the one with u 0:45 (one branch point) and the one with
z 0:3 (three additional branch points). Primary polymer (0, 0.45, 130) can have
only branch points at later (> 0.45) birth conversion: at u 0:51, length 60. Primary polymer (0, 0.3, 230) can have branch points at later (>0.3) birth conversion:
u 0:6, length 110, and u 0:37, length 140). In addition, Primary polymer (0,
0.3, 230) turns out to be attached [Eq. (142)] to an even earlier (<0.3) pp: birth conversion 0.22, length 180. This concludes generation 1, which generated four pps in
total. In the second generation only two of these turn out to have one extra branch
point each. After nding birth conversions and lengths for these two, the algorithm stops.
9.8.4

CSTR with Transfer to Polymer [14]

The algorithm is similar to that for the batch reactor, but now the residence time
distribution (RTD) has to be taken into account, while the expressions for the (conditional) probability are also slightly modied. The RTD in terms of the reduced
residence time y t=t, where t is the average residence time, is given by:
Fy expy

143

In contrast to the batch reactor, here we take the reduced residence time y as the
independent variable. The y of the rst pp is sampled from this distribution [using
sampling formula Eq. (133)], while its length is chosen from the weight-fraction
distribution, wn , Eq. (132) [using sampling formula Eq. (133) twice and adding].
Note that in a CSTR this distribution is at steady-state. Essentially, the longer a pp
stays in the reactor, the higher its probability of receiving branch points. Stated another way, the branching density in a pp is proportional to residence time y:
ry ry

144

This is consistent with Eq. (143) since:

Fyry

145

It follows from the steady-state variants of the balances of monomer and branching
density, Eqs. (135)(137), that the average branching density r is related to (steadystate) conversion x, according to:
r C tp x=1  x

146

The actual number of branch points on the rst pp again follows from the binomial distribution, Eq. (138). The residence time u of each of these pps that has

491

492

9 Mathematical Methods

grown on the rst pp should be less than y, or 0 < u < y. They are sampled from
the conditional (given the connection to the pp created at y) probability:
CPa ujy u=y;

147

because of the linear dependence on exposure time, branching density being constant. The sampling procedure is identical to that for CPa and CPi in the batch MC
algorithm. The lengths of these pps follow from the (steady-state) number-fraction
distribution, nn , according to Eq. (140), for the same reasons as have been explained for the batch reactor. The probability that the rst pp has itself been initiated at a secondary radical site on a previously created pp is given by Pb as formulated in Eq. (141); in a CSTR Pb is a constant. Previous here means a longer
residence time than y: y < z < y. Residence time z is sampled (as before) from a
conditional probability expression containing the RTD:

CPi zjy

1  Fz
1  Fy

148

Sampling is easily performed by applying Eq. (143) and adding y to the value
found.
9.8.5

Comparison of Galerkin-FEM Classes Model and CSTR with Transfer to Polymer

We implemented the Monte Carlo code in MATLAB and performed simulations


for a CSTR using the kinetic data shown in Figure 9.16. For comparison, calculations with the Galerkin-FEM two- and ve-classes multiradical models were made.
For a sample of 20,000 molecules good agreement could be observed with the
Galerkin-FEM models. The CLD tail is interesting (Figure 9.17). We observe a signicant contribution of living chains to the overall concentration in both GalerkinFEM models. In both models transfer to polymer of living chains was included,
which in the ve-classes model yielded a considerably higher concentration of living chains. It is the overall concentration of the ve-classes model that is most in
line with the MC simulations. We conclude that the two-classes model underestimates the tail and there deviates from the MC results. The extremely large molecules of the tail turned out to be very time-consuming in the MC simulations performed with a code written in MATLAB (not speed-optimized). One molecule with
CL > 10 8 took a time of around 10 min (1.5 GHz Athlon CPU Processor), and the
whole population of 290,000 took several hours. Note that we applied a cut-o
limit: molecules getting beyond 2  10 5 branch points in one generation were
stopped, which happened 40 times in the whole population and led to a maximum
number of branches per molecule of around 2:6  10 6 . The Galerkin-FEM veclasses model converged within 30 s. Obviously, the Galerkin-FEM method is

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

0.5

Monte Carlo
Galerkin-FEM,
5-classes multiradical

dw/d{log(MW)}

0.4

0.3

0.2

0.1

0 0
10

10

10

10

10

10

10

Chain Length
Good agreement between MC
simulations (290,000 molecules) and GalerkinFEM ve-classes model (all living and dead
chains). Reactor and kinetic data: initiator feed
I2; f 5  103 kmol m3 ; monomer feed
Mf 16:75 kmol m3 ; residence time: t 30
Fig. 9.16.

s; kd 0:5 s1 ; k p 1:4  10 5 m 3 (kmol s)1 ;


k td 5  10 10 m 3 (kmol s)1 ; k tp 2000 m 3
(kmol s)1 ; conversion x 0:249; average
branching density r 0:00463; average pp
length n n 144; branching probability
Pb 0:679.

much faster to calculate CLD only. On the other hand, MC simulations provide the
full bivariate CLD/DBD. However, it must be noted that we did not extract the full
architectural information. This would require construction of incidence matrices
[33], which probably limits calculations to around 10,000 branch points in a molecule.
9.8.6

Batch Reactor, Terminal Double Bond Incorporation [15]

The problem of incorporation of chains with a terminal double bond (TDB) exists
in polymerizations discussed above, such as radical polymerization of vinyl acetate
and olen polymerization with a constrained-geometry metallocene catalyst (CGC).
Tobita [15] has developed an MC algorithm for this problem for the PVAc case. It is
assumed that TDBs are created by transfer to monomer only, while recombination
is absent, which results in a maximum of one TDB per chain. We largely follow
Tobitas explanation, but dier in that we will assume that disproportionation is
the termination mechanism, while transfer to solvent and to polymer are not yet
being accounted for. Later we will address the real PVAc problem, which in fact
has two branching mechanisms: TDB propagation and transfer to polymer.

493

9 Mathematical Methods

0.015

dw/d{log(MW)}

494

Monte Carlo

0.01
GF-5

0.005

GF-5, dead
GF-2, dead

GF-2

GF-5, living
0 6
10

GF-2, living
7

10

10

Chain Length

Tail of the CLD of Figure 9.16. At


chain lengths > 10 7 living chain concentrations become of the same order of magnitude
as dead chains. The Galerkin-FEM two-classes
Fig. 9.17.

10

model (no multiradicals) underestimates the


tail. The rapid decline of the MC curve at
3  10 8 is due to the cut-o procedure.

Similarly to the MC algorithm for transfer to polymer in a batch reactor, conversion x is employed as the independent variable. The procedure starts in generation
0 by sampling a birth conversion y for the rst pp: 0 < y < c, where c is the end
conversion, while its length follows by sampling from the weight-fraction distribution wn , Eq. (132), then the average chain length ny is given by:
ny

k p Myl 0 y
k m Myl 0 y k td l 0 y 2

k p My
k m My k td l 0 y

149

Now, we consider the possibility that this pp will be incorporated in a pp that


grows later, at u: y < u < c. This depends, in the rst place, on the probability
that the rst pp, grown at x y, possesses a TDB:
PTDB y

k m Myl 0 y
k m Myl 0 y k td l 0 y

k m My
k m My k td l 0 y

150

In the second place, we have to know which fraction of the pps with a TDB grown
at x y will actually be incorporated as conversion increases, since together with

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

PTDB y this determines the probability of the randomly chosen pp at x y becoming connected to a later pp. We should consider what happens to pps with a TDB
after their creation at x y. A fraction of them is incorporated, but as the rate
at which this happens depends on their concentration, this rate will decrease. In
fact, the fractional decrease of these pps exactly follows the decrease in the fraction
of TDBs of pps created at x y. The TDB mole-fraction, FTDB y; u, starts at
Cm k m =kp for all birth conversions, so also at x y, while it decreases according
to the balance describing the TDB consumption starting from y:
dFTDB y; t
k p; TDB l 0 tFTDB y; t
dt

151

With Eq. (135) this is transformed in terms of birth conversion u (y < u < c),
giving:
Cp; TDB FTDB y; u
dFTDB y; u
;

1u
du

152

where Cp; TDB k p; TDB =k p . By integration between y and c one obtains:


FTDB y; c Cm



1  c Cp; TDB
1y

153



1  c Cp; TDB
of TDB chains is still present.
1y
Or, the probability that such pps created at x y have reacted at x c to produce
a branch point equals one minus this fraction. The overall probability Pb; TDB y; c
of a randomly chosen pp(y) to be incorporated in a later pp(c) thus becomes that
given by:
Thus, we see that at x c a fraction

)

1  c Cp; TDB
Pb; TDB y; c PTDB y 1 
1y


154

Whether or not it is connected follows by the checking of the inequality rand1 <
Pb; TDB y; c. Now, the birth conversion u at which incorporation takes place has to
be determined. This is realized by using the conditional probability distribution in
the pp has reacted
u, CPa; TDB ujy, over the interval y to c, namely
 givenCthat
1  c p; TDB
during the interval represented by the fraction
:
1y
Pb; TDB y; u

CPb; TDB ujy


Pb; TDB y; c

"(

),(
)#




1  u Cp; TDB
1  c Cp; TDB
1
1
1y
1y
155

495

496

9 Mathematical Methods

Sampling proceeds in the same manner as discussed in the cases with transfer to
polymer [see Eq. (139)]. Connectivity in generation 0 can also occur, when the pp
sampled rst itself incorporates pp chains with a TDB during its growth at x y.
Obviously, such chains should have been created at birth conversions z before y;
hence 0 < z < y. The probability of receiving branch points in this way in fact
equals the instantaneous branching density rTDB y, which is given by the ratio of
TDB propagation to monomer propagation rate:
rTDB y

k p; TDB l 0 ynTDB y Cp; TDB nTDB y

k p 1  yM0 l 0 y
1  yM0

156

Here, nTDB y is the average concentration of TDBs in the reactor, which follows
from a TDB balance (production and consumption):
dnTDB t
k m Mt  k p; TDB l 0 tnTDB t
dt

157

With Eq. (135) and M M0 1  y, it follows that:


Cp; TDB nTDB y
dnTDB y
Cm M0 
;
dy
1y

158

which yields Eq. (159) by integration:


nTDB

Cm M0 f1  y  1  y Cp; TDB g
Cp; TDB  1

159

With this Eq. (133) becomes:


rTDB y

Cp; TDB Cm f1  1  y Cp; TDB 1 g


Cp; TDB  1

160

Given the length of the pp rst sampled and rTDB y, the number of branch points
can be sampled from a binomial distribution, Eq. (138), using a standard binomial
distribution random number generator. This yields a certain number of branch
points connecting the pp to the same number of pps formed earlier, of which birth
conversion and lengths have to be determined. The former follows from the conditional probability that a pp created between 0 and z (0 < z < y is connected to the
pp growing at x y, CPi zjy. This probability is proportional to the mole fraction
of TDBs on pps created between 0 and z still present at x y. The average TDB
mole fraction of these pps at x y follows from Eq. (153) by integration between
0 and z:
F TDB z; y

1
y

z
0

FTDB z; y dz

161

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

Thus, the normalized CPi zjy becomes:

1 z
FTDB z; y dz
1  1  z 1Cp; TDB
y
CPi zjy 0y

1
1  1  y 1Cp; TDB
FTDB z; y dz
y 0

162

Conversion births z are determined by sampling as described previously. The


shape of Eq. (162) prescribes that on average z is found to be closer to y than to
0, reecting the fact that pps generated early have a high chance of being incorporated by pps earlier than y. The lengths of the pps are sampled from the
number-fraction distribution in the usual manner [Eq. (133)]. This then concludes
generation 0, and the procedure is repeated for higher generations until no more
connections are found.
9.8.7

CSTR, Terminal Double Bond Incorporation

The greatest dierence from the batch reactor is again the taking into account of
the RTD according to the exponential form of Eq. (143). The residence time t (or
reduced RT x t=t) is taken as the independent variable. The algorithm starts
with the sampling of x and the determination of the length from wn with ny after
Eq. (149) and the double sampling after Eq. (134). The pp sampled rst may
through its eventual TDB become connected to a pp that starts growing after the
rst one, hence having an RT shorter than x. Similarly to the batch reactor, the
probability of this connectivity is the product of PTDB; c , the probability of a randomly chosen pp having a TDB, and a factor denoting the decrease of TDB fraction
FTDB due to TDB incorporation. PTDB; c follows from Eq. (150), but is a constant in
the CSTR case. The TDB fraction must be considered as a function of residence
time, FTDB t, with starting value FTDB 0 Cm , as transfer to monomer is the
only source of TDBs. The balance equation for FTDB t:
dFTDB t
k p; TDB l 0 FTDB t,
dt

163

which is similar to Eq. (151), with the starting condition, the steady-state equality:
l0

x
;
k p t1  x

164

and the denition of the reduced RT leads to:




 
x
x ;
FTDB x Cm exp Cp; TDB
1x

165

497

498

9 Mathematical Methods

This time, the exponential term describes the decline of unreacted TDB with residence time x; hence one minus this term denotes the fraction of pps having generated a connection as a function of x. Thus, the probability of an arbitrary pp being
connected as a function of x becomes:

PTDB x PTDB; c

FTDB x
1
Cm


166

The residence time u, 0 < u < x, of the pp connected has to determined next. It
simply follows from the conditional (given that its TDB has reacted) probability
CPa ujx:
CPa ujx

PTDB u
PTDB x

167

The chain length of this pp follows from wn .


9.8.8

Incorporation of Recombination Termination [14]

Recombination termination is implemented in the same way in the batch reactor


and in the CSTR. First to note is that termination through recombination happens
to two pps growing simultaneously, which implies that birth conversions or residence times are identical for the two. The algorithm starts with a check on which
of the new pps created in a certain generation by some mechanism is connected to
another one by recombination. This probability is obtained from the relative reaction rates; for example, in the case of transfer to polymer only:
Ptc k tc l 20 =k tc l 20 k td l 20 k tp m1 l 0 k tc l 20 =k tc l 0 k td l 0 k tp m1

168

When recombination is at hand (rand1 < Ptc ), determination of the birth conversion or residence time is performed in no other way, as before. The total length of
the two pps connected can be found by sampling once from wn and once from nn ,
and addition. The correctness of this can be understood by realizing that the second pp can be connected to the rst one only by one chain end.
9.8.9

Incorporation of Random Scission, Linear Chains, Batch Reactor [50]

Here we will follow Tobitas explanation of the MC algorithm for radical polymerization with random scission for nonbranched systems, though it includes recombination termination. Later, the link to branching by transfer to polymer will be
elucidated. Random scission is assumed to happen to dead chains breaking into a
living and a dead fragment. The living fragment starts growing again and will be
terminated by some mechanism such as recombination. This implies that a scis-

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

sion point acts as an initiation point for a new pp, which further obeys the same
growth statistics as pps growing from initiator radicals or secondary radical sites on
other pps. Scission and subsequent growth may occur several times to pp chains,
so nally they may be constructed of various segments, created at various times.
The construction process of pps undergoing scission and growth steps is depicted schematically in Figure 9.18 for the case of a batch reactor. The algorithm
starts by randomly sampling a birth conversion y0 of Seg-0, the rst pp sampled,
between 0 and end conversion c. For this rst pp we may arbitrarily choose its
growth direction: to the right in Figure 9.18. Now in principle, the length of Seg-0
is sampled from wn by sampling twice from nn , but this is not denitively the value
it nally will get, since scission may occur. Therefore, the connecting unit between
these two is explicitly considered as the initially selected monomer unit. Next, the
part to the right of this unit is examined and a check is made on whether scission
has taken place. To this end the scission density h (or scission probability of mono-

initially selected unit

Ptc

Prs

scission

2
Seg-2

birth conversion

Seg-2

Seg-0

Seg-1

end conversion

initiation from
scission

initiation from
scission

0 recombination
2

CPa ,rs (1 | 0 )

CPi ,rs ( 2 | 0 )

scission at 1

scission at 0
Chain length

Example of the construction of a linear pp chain


undergoing scission and recombination in radical polymerization. The square on the LHS marks the (non-scission) initiation
point of this chain at birth conversion y2 .
Fig. 9.18.

499

500

9 Mathematical Methods

mer units) is dened; its derivation exactly follows that of the branching density in
the case of transfer to polymer. Realizing that
dh
k rs l 0 t
dt

169

and applying Eq. (135), we nd




1  y0
hy0 ; c Crs ln
1c

170

where Crs k rs =k p , which is similar to Eq. (137). It has been demonstrated [51]
that for equal scission probability hy0 ; c of all monomer units in a chain the
number average of fragments equals 1=hy0 ; c, while its length distribution is
Flory [Eq. (171)].
nns y0 ; c hy0 ; c expfhy0 ; cng

171

The scission check can now be performed by comparing the RHS of Seg-0,
nn y0 ; c from Eq. (140) with nns y0 ; c: if nn y0 > nns y0 ; c, scission has taken
place, otherwise it has not. Given that scission has taken place, the birth conversion y1 > y0 ) at which scission takes place is determined by the expression for
the conditional probability distribution, Eq. (139) in view of the similarity between branching and scission. If scission has taken place, then the probability is 12
that the chain end forms the initiation site for a new pp Seg-1 with growth direction to the right, while its length is sampled from nn y1 . Seg-1 is checked for scission using Eqs. (139) and (171). If scission did not happen, termination has taken
place to this segment. It is connected to a further pp by recombination with probability Ptc [Eq. (168)]; but in Figure 9.18 it is not connected, so Seg-1 is a terminal
segment at the RHS of the initially selected unit.
Next, the chain part in the direction left of the initial unit on Seg-0 is considered.
Its length is again determined by checking whether scission has taken place [comparing lengths from Eqs. (139) and (172)]. If not, then the chain end represents an
initiation site. The probability Prs that this is a site following a scission at y0 is
given by the rate of scission relative to the other reaction rates (compare Eq. (141)
for the branching probability Pb ):
Prs y0

k rs l 0 y0 m1 y0
k rs m1 y0

k rs l 0 y0 m1 y0 2kd I2 y0 k rs m1 y0 k td k tc l 0 y0

172

Figure 9.18 shows the situation where Seg-0 has grown at a scission point on Seg2 0 after scission of the latter at birth conversion y2 < y0 , to be selected as a random
number between 0 and y0 . The growth direction of Seg-2 0 has then to be selected.
There is a probability of 12 that it is in the direction indicated, to the LHS. Its length
is determined by comparing lengths with Eqs. (139) and (171). In this case no scis-

9.8 Monte Carlo Simulations

sion took place, and hence the possibility of termination by recombination must be
checked, using Eq. (168). Recombination happened to Seg-2 00 , also created at y2 .
On checking whether scission occurred, this turned out to be not the case, and
thus Seg-2 00 becomes the other terminal end, at the LHS of the initial unit. Note
that the RHS of the pp rst sampled, Seg-0, if it had not undergone scission, might
have been connected to another segment by recombination. Then, the algorithm
would have followed the same lines as for Seg-2.
9.8.10

Combined Scission/Branching

The combined scission/branching algorithm starts in generation 0 with the scission procedure. Once the linear chain eventually consisting of several segments
with dierent birth conversions has been constructed, the numbers of branch
points on these various segments are determined using the binomial distribution
[Eq. (138)] with the proper branching densities and lengths. To determine whether
scission has taken place on the pps connected via these branch points, the RHS
part of the scission algorithm has to be employed. Eventually, scission did not
take place, and then the check for recombination should be performed. Now, the
terminal at the RHS of the initially selected unit (Seg-1 in Figure 9.18) is always a
free end, so it is never connected. In contrast, the terminal at the LHS has been
assessed as a initiation site not being created by scission. Hence, this site may
have been created either by an initiator radical or at a dead pp backbone by transfer
to polymer, with probability Pb from Eq. (141). If it is connected to a pp at a smaller
birth conversion (u < y2 in Figure 9.18), then the scission algorithm is fully repeated with the connection point as the initially selected unit. This concludes generation 0.
9.8.11

Scission in a CSTR

As usual in a CSTR, the independent variable is residence time: in the example of


Figure 9.18, y0 for Seg-0. Now, the average scission density h is a constant; following by a similar argument to that for branching [Eq. (146)] gives:
h Crs x=1  x

173

For individual pps the scission density is a function of residence time (compare Eq.
(144) for branching density):
hy hy

174

The RTD itself follows Eq. (143). Knowing hy0 , the scission check can be made by
comparing lengths from Eqs. (139) and (171). Given that scission has taken place
on the RHS of Seg-0, the shorter residence time y1 0 < y1 < y0 at which scission

501

502

9 Mathematical Methods

takes place is determined by a similar expression (Eq. (147)) to that for branching,
giving the conditional scission probability distribution:
CPa; rs y1 jy0 y1 =y0

175

The LHS part of the branching algorithm is also slightly modied. The probability
Prs of Seg-0 being started on a scission point at Seg-2 0 again follows from Eq. (172),
but it is constant in a CSTR. The residence time y2 , now longer than y0 , is sampled
from a conditional probability distribution similar to Eq. (148):
CPi; rs y2 jy0

1  Fy2
1  Fy0

176

9.9

Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling


9.9.1

Introduction

Except for the full Monte Carlo simulations, all of the previously described mathematical methods were meant to compute microstructural properties in terms of
countable quantities: number of monomer units (chain length), number of branch
points, and so on. However, when dealing with branched polymer molecules, the
connectivity structure, or topology, is a highly important issue for both characterization and properties of branched polymers. It is obvious that, given the number
of monomer units and branch points in a molecule, a high variability exists in topology. This section is devoted to prediction methods of branched architectures.
We present two methods, both based on conditional Monte Carlo sampling, the
rst applicable to radical polymerization with transfer to polymer, the second to
metallocene-catalyzed polymerization of polyolens. Both are applicable to CSTRs
only. Note that the full Monte Carlo method described previously also generates information on connectivity. It has as such been utilized to predict radii of gyration
[1115, 4851] for radical polymerization systems. In principle, this method can
be extended to other polymerization systems as well. However, conditional MC
methods take full advantage of the fact that it is often much easier to nd the
CLD/DBD, which then makes it possible to focus directly on the more interesting
large molecules with many branch points.
Although topology is less easy to quantify than countable microstructural properties, highly interesting properties can still be inferred that provide direct characterizations of branched structures. One of these is the well-known radius of gyration,
and another is a recently introduced topological characterization originating from
rheology: the bivariate seniority/priority distribution [52]. Here, methods will be
described to obtain radius of gyration and seniority/priority values from architectures as synthesized by the algorithms to be described. In all cases architectures
will be represented in descriptive matrices from graph theory [53].

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

9.9.2

Branched Architectures from Radical Polymerization in a CSTR

For a given combination of chain length and number of branch points (n; N) a
great number of molecular topologies is possible, but the specic chemistry of
radical polymerization leads to a specic probability distribution of topologies.
The synthesis algorithm [33] generates this distribution. Like the full MC method
it is based on the primary polymers (pps) being the linear constitutive elements of
branched molecules (Figure 9.19). A molecule with N branch points is composed
of N 1 pps. The length distribution of pps (Flory) follows in much the same way

pp 2
pp 1
pp 3

Start: Seletion of n, N combinations from 3-D n-Nconcentration distribution (Galerkin-FEM)


Selection of N+1 primary
polymers from Flory distribution
Sampling of monomers on pps to determine
time order: pp1, pp2, pp3, ..., ppN+1.
Start with pp1

pp 4
Connection
algorithm

Connection algorithm: connects


ppi to structure containing pp1...i-1

i < N+1
N

Y
End: Architecture

Architecture

Scission 
fragment length
distribution

Rheology:
Seniority/
Priority

Synthesis algorithm for branched architectures in


radical polymerization. Right: algorithm ow diagram. Upper
left: connection of primary polymers. Lower left: a resulting
architecture with specied connectivity structure and lengths
between segments.
Fig. 9.19.

Radius of
gyration

503

504

9 Mathematical Methods

as in the full MC method [Eq. (140)]. Note that pps are attachable to other ones by
only one terminal. The mechanism making pps attachable at two ends is termination by recombination, but for the time being this will not be considered. The
method allows for the fact that pps may undergo scission. Note nally that a primary polymer may carry several branch points. The population of pps thus produced possesses a length distribution that is controlled by the chemistry of the
system.
The rst step of the algorithm is sampling N 1 pps from the calculated distribution, which is realized by selecting N numbers ni at random in the interval
1 < ni < n. This generates N 1 intervals 1  n1 , n1 1  n2 ; . . . ; nN1  nN ;
nN 1  n, representing the desired pp lengths. Thus, a length distribution is
obtained that approximates to a Flory distribution for large N and n [33].
The next step is nding the growth time sequence of pps in the molecule to be
composed. This determines which pp may have grown from which other already
existing pp. Notice that pp growth may be regarded as instantaneous in this radical
system. Now, the time order in which pps are sampled is not independent of their
length, since more possibilities exist of attaching smaller pps to a longer one than
of attaching longer pps to a smaller one. This implies that the longer pps of a
molecule, on average, are created before the short ones. In the algorithm, the
early-time preference of long pps is realized by sampling of monomer units on
pps. This is performed by selecting a random number between 1 and n and determining its location on the sequence of N 1 segments used for pp length sampling. This is the pp rst in time order. It is removed from the sequence and the
sampling is repeated for the remaining segments until the complete time order is
determined.
The connection part of the algorithm is simple after the time order has been determined; see Figure 9.19. The second pp selected is attached to pp1 ; the third may
be attached to pp1 and pp2 , and so on. The algorithm accounts for the fact that a
pps probability of receiving a branch point is proportional to its length, which reects branch formation by transfer to polymer. Furthermore, it accounts for the
pps dierences in residence time. A pp early in time order meaning a pp with a
long residence time has a higher chance of receiving branch points than a later
pp. This implies that branch point distribution is heterogeneous, since pps with a
longer residence time possess a higher branching density. However, this is counteracted by the circumstance that within a molecule the pps early in time order
are longer on average. Note further that within a molecule, longer pps are associated with longer residence times, although obviously within the whole pp population in a CSTR no such relationship exists. We should realize here that the situation for a batch reactor might be dierent. When conditions change in a batch
reactor, the pp length distribution might also change, which should be accounted
for in the sampling procedure. The present algorithm is strictly applicable to a
CSTR, since it assumes one (steady-state) pp length distribution. The algorithm
generates topologies accounting for all the important chemical and reactor conditions inuencing them: the specic n; N combination, pp length distribution, and
coupling procedure representing transfer to polymer. The specic population of

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

architectures this produces indeed has properties dierent from those exhibited by
the population of all possible architectures [33].
9.9.3

Branched Architectures from Polymerization of Olens with Single and Mixed


Branch-forming Metallocene Catalysts in a CSTR [35]
Introduction
A polymer with length n and N branches may assume a large number of architectures. Due to the statistical nature of chemistry the architectures may feature large
dierences. We developed a Monte Carlo method virtually synthesizing the polymer according to the proper kinetic rules, which reects the chemistry of the process. We rst discuss a method for a single-catalyst system, which is essentially
simpler than the method for a mixed system that will be presented next. Flow diagrams are shown in Figure 9.20.
9.9.3.1

Single-catalyst System
In this case the method is based on the separation of the synthesis activities concerning topology and segment lengths. It will be shown next that the topology is
created by a series of insertion events, during which structures with certain numbers of branch points are coupled. The probabilities of existence of these structures
are only determined by the numbers of branch points they carry, not by the lengths
of these segments. We can see this by realizing that in the single-catalyst system all
chain segments in a molecule of given n and N should obey the same statistics,
since all of them have grown under the same kinetic conditions. This fact implies
that interchanging any pair of segments does not aect the probability of existence
of a structure as long as it retains the same topology. For a complete architecture
this argument is equally valid. As long as the topology is the same and as long as
the total number of monomer units is constant, all molecules are equally probable.
This implies that we can determine rst the topology and afterward the length of
the segments.
9.9.3.2

Synthesis of Topology
In order to determine the topology of a molecule, as a rst step of the algorithm we
consider the rst insertion of a terminally double-bonded polymer structure into a
growing chain attached to the branching catalyst. The number of branch points on
the inserted chain, N1 , and the number of branch points on the growing chain (to
be formed after the rst insertion) must add up to N  1. The situation is depicted
in Figure 9.21. Note that with a single catalyst, at steady state in a CSTR, the statistical properties of the inserted chains and growing chains are identical. Insertions
are possible in N  1 dierent ways, each way having its own probability. These
probabilities can be calculated from the two-dimensional chain length/number of
branch points distribution using the following arguments. The frequency of insertion of a species with a terminal double bond is proportional to its concentration.
Therefore, the insertion probability of a polymer chain containing a certain num9.9.3.3

505

506

9 Mathematical Methods
Start
N

Sampling N1

Start
N

N 1 from

Sampling N1

( N1 ) P N (eq 178)
N2 = N N1

N = N1

N2 = N N1

Update of topology
(connectivity matrix)

N = N2

N 1 from

( N1 ) P n , N (eq 183)

Sampling n1

n 1 ffrom
o

(n1 , N1 ) P n , N (eq 181, for N1 selected)


y

n2 = n n1

N1 > 0
n

Sampling k n n1 -1 from
m

Start
N, n

N2 > 0
n

N = N1

Segment length
algorithm

Final topology
(adjacency matrix)

n1 , N N1 1

(eq 184)

Update of architecture
(connectivity matrix)

N = N2
2N + 1 segment
lengths

Full incidence matrix

(k ) P n

N1 > 0
n

Full architecture

N2 > 0
n

Rheology

Full architecture

Radius of gyration

Rheology

Radius of gyration

Fig. 9.20. Flow diagrams of synthesis algorithm for branched


architectures from metallocene-based polymerization. Left:
single-metallocene system. Right: two-catalyst system.

ow

Structure being inserted


Structure to grow on
branching catalyst

th

N- N 1-1
-

Linear
segment
on branching
catalyst

Dir
ect
ion

of

N 1, n 1

==

of
gr

Branching catalyst

Branching catalyst

Dir
ect
ion

N1

gro
wt h

Structure to grow on branching


catalyst

N- N 1 -1, n -n 1 -k -1

Synthesis algorithm for branched architectures from


metallocene-based polymerization. Left: single-metallocene
system. Right: two-catalyst system.
Fig. 9.21.

Structure being inserted,


from either catalyst

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

ber of branches is proportional to that structures concentration Therefore, the


insertion probability of a polymer chain containing a certain number of branch
points, say N1, should be proportional to the concentration of chains with N1
branch points. However, the probability of insertion of a chain with N1 branch
points is not the only factor playing a role. Additionally we need to know the probability of the growing chain, after the rst insertion, obtaining precisely that number of branch points to arrive at N branch points in total: N  N1  1. Now, during
the growth process of a polymer chain, the probability that after the rst insertion
it will receive this particular additional number of branch points is independent of
its growth history. This means that it is independent of whether it grows after the
rst, second, or any other insertion, and it also is independent of the number of
branch points on chains previously inserted. Therefore, the probability that the
polymer will grow to obtain the N  N1  1 additional branch points is simply proportional to the concentration of such chains. Hence, under the condition that a
polymer with N branch points is formed, the probability of a rst insertion with
N1 branch points equals the normalized product of the concentrations of polymers
with a terminal double bond and N1 branch points and polymers with N  N1  1
branch points. For the formation of polymers with a terminal double bond this
leads to the conditional branch point probability density function (PDF):
<N1 j PN

PN1 PN1N1
N 1
X

Pj PN1j

with PN

y
X

Pn; N

177

n1

j0

Note that here Pn; N represents the concentration at the branching catalyst CGC
Ti, Pn;b N . In this case in the absence of linear catalyst, Pn; N Pn;b N . For a chain
without a terminal double bond, the branch point probability density function (NPDF) is modied to:
<N1 jPN

P N1 PN1N1
N 1
X
Pj PN1j

178

j0

The PDF of Eq. (178) expresses the probability of an insertion of a chain with N1
branch points under the condition that a polymer with N branch points and a terminal double bond is formed. This formula is symmetrical by denition. It turns
out that this PDF (apart from round-o errors) is identical to the PDF dened in
Eq. (177). This is due to the kinetics of the system, which allows the concentration
of polymers with a terminal double bond to be written as a fraction of the concentration of polymers without terminal double bonds [35], as formulated in:
Pn; N
Pn; N

with c as an arbitrary constant.

179

507

508

9 Mathematical Methods

The PDF <N1 jPN is a symmetric distribution with peaks at N1 0 and


N1 N  1. This implies that the probability of inserting a chain with zero or
N  1 branch points is much higher than that of chains with and intermediate
number of branch points. Once the number of branch points on the chain inserted
is known, the problem is divided into two smaller sub-problems. The architecture
of the inserted chain with N1 branch points as well as the architecture of the growing chain with N  1  N1 branch points must be determined. For both the inserted and the growing chain the same line of reasoning can be used as above for
a smaller number of branches, N1 and N  N1  1, respectively. In our algorithm
the procedure described above in a recursive manner continues until no more
structures with branch points have to be attached. Then the topology is known.
The lengths of the segments are determined in exactly the same manner as for
the radical polymerization case. Note, however, that with N branch points we here
have 2N 1 segments.
Mixed-catalyst System
The synthesis of architectures in this case has similarities to, but also marked
dierences from, that of the single-catalyst case. Notice that although the mixed
system algorithm is constructed to deal with those systems, it obviously should be
able to describe the single catalyst correctly as a limiting case as well. In the latter
case both algorithms should lead to the same results. Again, the procedure starts
at the most recent insertion (Figure 9.21) of a branched structure into a growing
structure. Now, the main dierence from the single-catalyst case is that separation
of topology and segment length distribution is no longer possible. This is due to
the fact that in the mixed-catalyst case segments originate from two dierent catalysts and therefore possess dierent statistical properties. This also implies that the
interchange of arbitrary pairs of segments is not allowed now. Hence, the assignment of lengths to segments can no longer be performed in an independent way
and has to be included in the topology generation procedure. This means that for
the structure to be inserted we have to specify both the number of branch points
N1 , and the chain length n1 . Note that the inserted structures originate from both
linear and branching catalyst and therefore have mixed statistical properties. The
insertion of a structure can be realized in many dierent ways. The probabilities
of these dierent options follow from the bivariate chain length/number of branch
points distribution in a manner to be explained next. The insertion probability of
a polymer chain containing a certain combination of number of branch points N1
and chain length n1 is proportional to this structures concentration: <insertion
Pn1 ; N1 . Note that this concentration includes chains from both catalysts: Pn1 ; N1
Pnb1 ; N1 Pnl 1 . Again, knowing these probabilities, <i alone is not sucient to determine the probabilities of all the dierent options. Additionally we need to know
the probability of the growing structure possessing precisely that number of
branch points to obtain N branch points and n monomer units in total, <growing .
Now, for a given N1 and n1 , several versions of the growing structure can satisfy
this condition, since the insertion can take place at various positions. We denote
this position as the length k of the linear segment between the catalyst site and
9.9.3.4

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

the insertion point. The value of k may vary between 2 and n  n1  2, while each
insertion option has its own probability. The sum of all these probabilities yields
the desired growing structure probability, <g . The individual probability for a certain k should be proportional to the probability of nding a linear segment (zero
branches) with length k at CGCTi, and hence the concentration Pk;b 0 . In addition,
it should be proportional to the probability of nding a branched structure with
b
.
N  N1  1 branch points and length n  n1  k, the concentration Pnn
1 k; NN1 1
Thus, the growing structure probability <g follows as the sum of products:
nn
P1 1 b b
Pk; 0 Pnn1 k; NN1 1 . Again, this can only be done when assuming that
<g
k1

at each time instant the probability of future growth of a structure is completely


independent of its growth history. Hence, under the condition that a polymer
with N branch points and n monomer units is formed, the probability of a rst
insertion with N1 branch points and n1 monomer units equals the normalized
product of the probabilities <i and <g . For chains with a terminal double bond
this leads to the bivariate chain length/number of branch points probability density
function (n; N-PDF):

Pn1 ; N1

nn
1 1
X

<n1 ; N1 jPn; N

Pk; 0 Pnn1 k; NN1 1

k1
n2 X
N 1
X

Pi; j

i1 j1

ni1
X

180
b
b
Pk; 0 Pnik; Nj1

k1

The n; N-PDF for chains without TDB likewise is:

Pn1 ; N1
<n1 ; N1 jPn;b N

nn
1 1
X

b
Pk;b 0 Pnn
1 k; NN1 1

k1
n2 X
N1
X
i1 j1

Pi; j

ni1
X

181
b
Pk;b 0 Pnik;
Nj1

k1

Again, due to the similarity between the distributions of chains with and without
TDBs [Eq. (179)]. The PDFs possess the same shape. Now, it is instructive to derive
monovariate N-PDFs from the n; N-PDFs. Doing this for the single-catalyst case
should then generate N-PDFs identical to the monovariate N-PDFs as obtained
from the single catalyst algorithm. The N-PDF describing the probability that a
structure with N1 branch points will be inserted to form a molecule with N branch
points in total is obtained from the n; N-PDF by taking the sum over chain lengths
n1 :

<N1 jPn;b N

n1
X
n1 1

<n1 ; N1 j Pn;b N

182

509

510

9 Mathematical Methods

One may realize that this can be performed for various total chain lengths n. This
implies that in principle this N-PDF <N1 j Pn;b N is still a function of n. Now, the
monovariate N-PDF created by the single-catalyst algorithm, <N1 j PNb , does not
depend on n. A clearly interesting test for the mixed system algorithm is to check
whether it indeed yields an n-independent N-PDF for the single-catalyst system,
which turns out to be the case.
Equations (181) and (182) give the PDFs describing the probability of having
a rst insertion of a branched structure with n1 monomer units and N1 branch
points. Hence, this rst step in the algorithm should provide n1 and N1 . The
sampling from the bivariate distribution proceeds in two sub-steps. First, N1 is
sampled from the monovariate N-PDF derived from the bivariate n; N-PDF as described above. Secondly, for the sampled N1 a chain length PDF is extracted from
the full bivariate n; N-PDF as the cross-section at N1 . From this n-PDF the n1 is
sampled. The rst step of the algorithm is completed by determining the length
of the linear segment, k. This is realized by sampling from the PDF that describes
the probability of nding such a linear segment of length k. This probability was
already introduced above as being proportional to both the concentration of these
linear segments Pk;b 0 and the concentration of the complementary branched strucb
. Hence, sampling proceeds from the PDF being formed by
tures Pnn
1 k; NN1 1
the normalized product of the two concentrations:
b
<kjPnn

1 ; NN1 1

b
Pk;b 0 Pnn
1 k; NN1 1
nn
1 1
X

183

b
b
Pk; 0 Pnn1 k; NN1 1

k2

After the last insertion as the rst step in the algorithm the problem is split into
two sub-problems, the tasks of nding the architectures of the inserted structure
and that of the growing branched structure. These tasks proceed in exactly the
same manner as the rst step and they may each lead to further architecturending steps. For instance, nding the architecture of the inserted chain involves
the derivation of the n; N-PDF <n2 ; N2 jPnb1 ; N1 . The procedure described above in
a recursive manner continues until no more structures with branch points have to
be attached. Notice that at that instant of time in contrast to the single-system
algorithm not only the topology is known, but also the segment lengths, and
hence the architecture synthesis process is fully complete.
9.9.4

Mathematical Methods for Characterization of Branched Architectures


Graph Theoretical Connectivity Matrices
Branched topologies as generated by the conditional Monte Carlo methods described in this section are most conveniently represented in matrix forms from
graph theory [33, 53]. We name two of them the adjacency matrix A and the incidence matrix C (see Figure 9.22). They both describe connectivity. Note that in
9.9.4.1

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

1
a 2
b
3
c 4

N = 10
5

d
a

e
2
1

3 b
g

d 5
e 6

10

i
4

f 7
g
8
h 9

h
8

i 10 Comb

Caylee tree
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
. 1 1 1 . . .
1 . . . 1 1 .
1 . . . . . 1
1 .
. 1
A Cayley tree =
. 1
. .
.
.
.

.
.
.

a b
1 1
1
.
.
1

511

8
.
.
1

9 10
. . 1
. . 2
. . 3

.
.
.
1

.
.
.
.

.
.
.
.

.
.
.
.

.
.
.
.

. 1 1 4
. . . 5
. . . 6
. . . 7

1
.
.

.
1
1

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

c
1
.
.

d
e f
g h
.
.
.
.
.
1 1 .
.
.
.
. 1 1 .

1 2 3 4 5 6
. 1 . . . .
1 . 1 . . .
. 1 . 1 . .
A comb

i
.
.
.

.
.
.

1
.
.

.
1
.

.
.
1

.
.
.

.
.
.

1 1 4
.
. 5
.
. 6

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

1
.
.

.
1
.

.
.
1

.
.
.

9
.
.
.

10
. 1
. 2
. 3

.
.
1
.

.
.
.
1

.
.
.
.

.
.
.
.

4
5
6
7

.
.
.
.

1
.
.
.

.
1
.
.

1
.
1
.

.
1
.
1

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

. 1 . 1 . 8
. . 1 . 1 9
. . . 1 . 10

a b c
1 .
.
1 1 .
.
1 1

1
2
3

.
.
CCayley tree =
.

8
.
.
.

.
.
=
.
.

. 8
. 9
. 10

.
.
.

7
.
.
.

d
.
.
.

e
.
.
.

f
.
.
.

g
.
.
.

h
.
.
.

i
.
.
.

1
2
3

.
.
.

.
.
.

4
5
6

.
.
Ccomb =
.

.
.
.

1 1 .
.
. 1 1 .
. . 1 1

.
.
.

7
8
9

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

.
.
.

1
.
.

1 .
. 7
1 1 . 8
.
1 1 9

1 10

Fig. 9.22. Branched topologies of molecules with N 10


branch points (terminal segments not shown). Extreme cases:
Cayley tree and comb. Adjacency and incidence matrices, A and
C of the topologies shown, are represented below.

1 10

512

9 Mathematical Methods

addition to C, a vector of segment lengths corresponding to the segments in the


vector fa; b; c; . . .g completes the architectural information. The mathematical
methods for characterization to be discussed here are designed in such a way that
they utilize either of these two representations as input.
Characterization of Architectures by Radius of Gyration
Molecular architectures can be structurally classied as being more comb-like or
Cayley tree-like. Structure has impact on the radius of gyration, which is larger
for linear molecules than for branched molecules of the same weight (number of
monomer units), since the latter are more compact. The ratio between branched
and linear radius is usually described by a contraction factor. Furthermore, Cayley tree-like structures are more compact than comb-like structures [33, 56]. We
will show here how to obtain the contraction factor from the architectural information. The squared radius of gyration hs 2 i is expressed in monomer sizes. According to a statistical-mechanical model [55] it follows from the architecture as represented in graph theoretical terms, the Kirchho matrix, K, which is derived from
the incidence matrix, C [33]:
9.9.4.2

hs 2 i n1 TrL1
n1

184

1
Here, n is the number of monomer units and TrL1
n1 denotes the trace of Ln1 ,
being the matrix with n  1 reciprocals of the eigenvalues of the Kirchho matrix
K. The full n  n sized matrix K is calculated from:

K CgC T

185

where C T is the transpose of C (size n  n  1 and g is a vector of length


n  1 related to the size of monomer units. For the computation of the radius of
gyration, we apply a coarse graining method to save on computational eort to nd
the smallest eigenvalues of K [56]. Thus, the Kirchho matrix reduces in size, now
based on the number of branch points, 2N 2  2N 2. In this case the vector g of length (2N 1) contains the N  1 interbranch segment lengths and the
N 2 free arm lengths of the molecule.
It should be realized that the incidence and Kirchho matrices contain purely
topological information (connectivity between branch points). Thus, we see that
the radius of gyration is determined by both topology (K) and segment length distribution (g). We now dene a purely topological structure qualier topological
radius, based on a topological Kirchho matrix:
K CC T

186

Note that the combCayley tree ranking of molecules within a certain population
in Eq. (186) is dierent in principle from that in Eq. (185), since the former excludes segment length eects.

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

9.9.4.3

Characterization of Architectures by Seniorities and Priorities

Introduction The rheological meaning of the concepts of seniority and priority


has been explained previously elsewhere [46, 52]. Here, we will introduce them as
merely topological qualiers. The seniority s j of a segment j is dened as the molecular distance to the nearest free arm. The seniority of a free arm is 1; the value
for a segment ending on a terminal branch point is 2. Priority is dened as follows.
Each inner segment is connected to two trees, each of these trees having a number
of terminal segments (free arms). The priority is the smaller of these numbers of
terminal segments. Our method of nding the distribution is based on a graph
theoretical representation of branched molecules.
Seniority The seniority of a molecular segment between two branch points (inner segment) is related to the longest chemical path (LCP) of that segment. In
terms of graph theory we say that segments ending on a terminal branch point
(outer segments) are attached to one and all other segments are attached to two
parts of the tree that represents the molecule. The LCP is dened as the highest
number of segments in the path to a terminal segment; the inner segments have
two such LCPs one on each side. In a comb most segments have much longer
LCPs than those in a Cayley tree. The seniority of a segment is dened as the
shorter of the two LCPs of that segment. The seniority of an outer segment is 1;
the value for a segment ending on a terminal branch point is 2. The algorithm
nds the seniority distribution by checking all the possible end-to-end paths of
the molecule while numbering the inner segments according to the order in which
they are passed in the path. (Note that to nd the number of segments with seniority 1, the outer segments, is a trivial problem since any molecule with N branch
points possesses N 2 outer segments).
The following steps are taken in the algorithm:

1. Find the Nt sets of Nt terminal branches Jt by identifying all columns of A, for


which the sum equals 1; start with one vertex Jt j, j A f1:Nt g, corresponding to
column J of A.
2. Find adjacent vertices; from a selection of nj columns of A, for each of these
columns J j, j A f1:nj g, check the nonzero entries being found in nij rows
nj
P
nij row indices Ii,
Ii, i A f1:nij g for each j; this produces in total ni
j1

i A f1:ni g; thus from a vertex set J j, j A f1:nj g, all the vertices adjacent to the
vertices in the set are found and stored in a new vertex set Ii, i A f1:ni g.
3. Assign sequence numbers to edges; for each of the vertices J j a set of nij adjacent vertices Ii is found, associated with nij directed edges pointing from vertex J j to vertices Ii; for certain J j this is the set of edges eJI , where J J j
and I Ii, i A f1:nij g; thus nding the edges eIJ for this J j means that they
are spotted on a path and should receive a sequence number ns; for all other
J j other edge sets are found, but all ni edges found from one vertex set J j,

513

514

9 Mathematical Methods

1
ns(e12) = 2
ns(e21) = [3 4]

ns(e24) = [3 3]
ns(e54) = 2
ns(e45) = [3 4] ns(e42) = 3

S=2

S=3

S=2
2

S=2

ns(e32) = 2
ns(e23) = [3 4]

Sequence numbers per segment for each of the


three possible path sequences through one architectural
alternative of a ve-branch molecule and the resulting
seniorities.
Fig. 9.23.

j A f1:nj g, are assigned the same sequence number; by denition, ns equals 2


for the (one) edge found from the starting vertex.
4. Update adjacency matrix; for each I; J pair found in step 2: AI; J
A J; I 0.
5. The new vertex set Ii, i A f1:ni g, found in step 2 is the starting point for a new
cycle of nding subsequent adjacent vertex sets, but this should happen in the
updated A; thus, the new set of columns follows as J Ii, where all zero columns in the updated A are left out; the algorithm then repeats steps 25 until A
has only zeros.
6. Collect all sequence numbers for all 2N  1 edges in both directions, the vector ns eij ; for any directed edge nd maxfns eij g; nd the seniority of each
edge by taking the minimum of [maxfns eij g; maxfns eji g].
For illustration, the algorithm has been applied to the simple N 5 problem of
Figure 9.23.
Find terminal branches: Nt 3, Jt f1 3 5g; start with Jt 3.
Nonzero entry in column J 3 is in row 2, hence nij 1, i 1, I1 2.
The edge found is eJI e32 and it assigned the sequence number 1: ns e32 2.
2

0
61
6
6
A is updated with A2; 3 A3; 2 0: A 6 0
6
40
0

1
0
0
1
0

0
0
0
0
0

0
1
0
0
1

3
0
07
7
7
07
7
15
0

New vertex set from updated A: J I 2; repeat from step 2;


Non-zero entries in column J 2 are in rows 1 and 4, hence nij 2, i 1; 2;
I1 1; I2 4;
The edges found are e21 and e24 and they are assigned the sequence number 3:
ns e21 ns e24 2;
A is updated with A2; 1 A1; 2 0 and A2; 4 A4; 2 0:

9.9 Prediction of Branched Architectures by Conditional Monte Carlo Sampling

0
60
6
6
A 6 0
6
40
0

0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
0

0
0
0
0
1

0
07
7
7
07
7
15
0

New vertex set from J I1 1 and I2 4; since column 1 has all zeros, the
new J 4; repeat from step 2.
Nonzero entry in column J 4 is in row 5, hence nij 1, i 1; I1 5.
The edge found is eJI e45 and it assigned the sequence number 1: ns e45 4.
A is updated with A4; 5 A5; 4 0, so A has all zeros and the collection of
sequence numbers stops.
This run yields the sequence fe32 e21 e24 e45 g with the associated sequence
numbers f2 3 3 4g (see Figure 9.23). Similarly, starting with vertex 1 and vertex
5 yields the sequences fe12 e23 e24 e45 g and fe54 e42 e21 e23 g with sequence numbers f2 3 3 4g and f2 3 4 4g, respectively. Collecting the sequence numbers per
edge yields the vectors ns eij shown in Figure 9.23 and then taking maxima and
minima according to step 6 of the algorithm yields the seniority distribution dS .
This seniority algorithm is a transparent one in the sense that it explicitly calculates the segments longest chemical paths, on which the denition of the seniority
is based. However, it involves a lengthy procedure since the sequence numbering
has to be applied as many times as there are terminal branches. In the case of
N 1534 (perfect Cayley tree with six generations) this number amounts to 768.
For this reason a faster and simpler algorithm has been developed, in which no explicit longest chemical path evaluation takes place, but instead a decomposition of
the graph is realized. It consists of the following steps (see Figure 9.24):
1. Find the set of Nt terminal branches Jt by identifying all the columns or rows of
A for which the sum equals 1 (asterisk positions in Figure 9.24).
2. Assign seniority values to (terminal) edges; each of the vertices Jt is adjacent to
a penultimate vertex Ipu , (some dierent Jt to the same Ipu ,) so that the set Ipu
may have fewer elements than Nt : Ipu a Nt (in the gure the penultimate
vertices have an asterisk in the second conguration); all vertices Jt to Ipu represent Nt edges; to all of these edges a seniority value is assigned: S 2 iu ,
where iu is the updated number of the adjacency matrix (0 the rst time).
3. Update A by putting zeros in rows and columns Jt . The eect is two-fold: the
original terminal vertices (asterisks in the rst conguration of Figure 9.24) vanish, being replaced by new ones (asterisks in the second conguration), but the
structure is also decomposed at certain vertices, namely those marked by an asterisk on a non-terminal position. Note that thus all asterisks in fact denote terminal vertices: that is, they have sums of rows and columns equal to 1 in A.
4. Repeat steps 1 through 3 until A is all zeros.
We have ensured that this decomposition algorithm reproduces exactly the same
seniority distributions as the longest chemical path algorithm.

515

516

9 Mathematical Methods

*2

*2

*3

*2

*2
*

5
5

*
*

*4

3
5

p24 = 4
p42 = 3
4

p12 = 2
p21 = 5

4
4

three on positions where the structure is


broken (into four parts); segments adjacent to
these vertices get S 3. By the second and
third updates similarly the segments with
S 4 and S 5 are identied.

2
p32 = 2
p23 = 5

dP = {3 1}

Fig. 9.24. Decomposition algorithm to nd


seniority distributions for a molecule with
N 36. The rst conguration has 11 terminal
segments, yielding 11 segments with S 2.
The rst update produces the second conguration with nine terminal vertices, including

p54 = 2
p45 = 5

ds = {38 11 12 8 4} (incl. ones)

Fig. 9.25. Two-sided and real priorities for one architectural


alternative of a ve-branch molecule.

Priority Priority values are found for each segment (again, inner segments only)
by constructing balances of terminal segments on each side of the segments.
An example has been worked out, based on Figure 9.25. The full set of balance
equations reads:

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors

p12 2

p24 p12 p32

p45 p24 1

p32 2

p21 p42 p32

p42 p54 1

p54 2

p23 p42 p12

These eight equations with eight unknowns can be solved to yield the results
shown in Figure 9.25. Thus the number of free segments on each side of each segment is obtained. The lower value is the priority of that segment.
In general the set of equations can be written as:

p B1 :r

where r

2N1
X

Bij 1:

j1

Here, B is a matrix of 2N  1  2N  1 coecients that is obtained from the


adjacency matrix A. This yields the two priorities per edge, one for each direction,
of which the smallest value is the priority.

9.10

Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors


9.10.1

Introduction

Chemically reacting ows in polymerization reactors display complex behavior due


to the interactions between physical and chemical processes. These processes occur over a wide range of length and time scales, and often result in tight coupling
between uid dynamics and chemistry. Early numerical simulations of these ows
were based on combinations of idealized ow reactor models such as the CSTR,
the plug-ow reactor (PFR) and the batch reactor (BR). These models either neglect radial mass and heat transfer or include only eective transfer coecients,
and solve a system of governing dierential equations as an initial value problem.
They often assume that the reactants are mixed rapidly and thus the concentrations can be considered to be uniform at small scales. For diverse polymerization
processes, however, inadequate mixing of chemical species or interphase mass
transfer limitations coupled with fast reactions can signicantly aect reactor performance (yield, stability, operability) and product quality (selectivity). The state-ofthe-art computational uid dynamics (CFD) models provide cost-eective tools to
better understand complex reacting ows while designing and operating reliable
industrial reactors.
Modeling Challenges
The accurate mathematical formulation of polymerizing ows is a challenging task
for several reasons. For example, turbulent ows require complete resolution of all
9.10.1.1

517

518

9 Mathematical Methods

length scales in the turbulence physics, such as large-scale transport due to convection and turbulent diusion (macromixing), mid-scale transport due to dispersion
(mesomixing), and small-scale transport due to molecular diusion (micromixing).
Polymerization mechanisms, on the other hand, often involve a large number of
chemical species representing complex reaction networks. The disparate chemical
time scales result in a sti set of equations, and require enormous computational
eort to integrate the species rate expressions. Since reactions occur on the molecular level, the turbulencechemistry interactions can change the progress of fast,
exothermic reactions [60, 61] and may initiate runaway conditions, or overheat
polymerizing particles, thus aecting the nal polymer properties.
These challenges are further compounded while modeling multiple phases in
heterogeneous polymerization reactors such as bubble column reactors (BCRs)
or uidized bed reactors (FBRs). A range of complexities associated with the dynamics of each phase, the interaction between and within phases, sub-grid-scale
heterogeneities (such as size distributions within each phase), and coupling with
reactions at the micro-scale need to be addressed. For example, bubble size distribution is important to correctly model interfacial area and local mass-transfer coefcients, which can further aect polymerization reactions. Although phenomenological models describing such physical eects have greatly improved over the
years, this area still lacks reliable multiphase turbulence closures, or experimentally validated intraphase and interphase transport models.
As with any other emerging technology, CFD capabilities have been understood
to a certain degree for reacting ows, and applied at the industrial level to model
polymerization reactors. A complete review of the application of CFD for homogeneous and heterogeneous reactors would be quite extensive, and the capabilities for
multiphase reacting ows are still evolving. This section, therefore, focuses on the
relatively well-developed CFD models for single-phase reacting ows. We present a
comprehensive CFD algorithm for reactor modeling and a brief review of multiphase ow capabilities, followed by illustration of single-phase CFD capabilities using representative industrial test cases for the two fundamental classes of polymerization (that is, addition and condensation) processes.

9.10.2

Development and Optimization of Modern Polymerization Reactors

Figure 9.26 shows the traditional commercialization process for new polymerization technology, involving a number of development stages from discovery to commercial production. Each stage is used to gain a scientic understanding of the
new technology and to make real-world assessments of design decisions required
for commercialization success. This interactive route progresses through expensive
and time-consuming experimental and pilot-plant testing. In recent years, the focus has shifted to employ CFD as an alternative or a complement to this traditional
route while reducing the process risks and increasing condence in the new technology. Experience has shown that CFD, when implemented correctly and e-

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors

519

Optimize/improve Reacting CFD


existing reactors Technology
New process
Technology
Kinetics data

Lab Scale
Tests

Pilot Plant
Tests

Scale-up

Plant
Trials

Reacting CFD Design/scale-up


new reactors
Technology
Stage 1

Stage 2

Stage 3

Stage 4

Discovery

Commercial
Scale
Input
Validate
Implement
Stage 5

Commercial Production

CFD application strategy for design, scaleup and


optimization of polymerization reactors.
Fig. 9.26.

ciently, can be a cost-eective tool for design and scaleup of new reactors and optimization of existing reactors.
Benets of CFD
In the early days of its development, using even simple CFD techniques for reactor
design and analysis was impractical due to limited computational power. With todays high-performance computers as well as ecient numerical and chemstry algorithms, the use of CFD is expanding for detailed reacting ow analysis in the
initial stages of design. The sophisticated analysis can be used to investigate reactor conditions that are outside the range of existing experimental facilities, or study
dynamics of reactors for extreme conditions that are dicult to reproduce experimentally due to instabilities. In general, CFD can help process engineers make
well-informed design and operational decisions while meeting stringent environmental and safety laws as well as higher-quality standards for specic end-uses.
9.10.2.1

Limitations of CFD
The validation of a CFD simulation against key experimental and pilot-plant data
remains an integral and essential part of design. For entirely new reactor designs,
it is dicult to estimate the accuracy of a simulation without prior knowledge of
similar ow regimes. Despite the development of easy-to-use commercial CFD
codes, the initial setup for complex polymerization reactors requires signicant investments of time and expense. This investment increases enormously due to the
computing and meshing limitations when modeling complicated geometric shapes
with rotating parts (for example, CSTRs), with changes in liquid levels (for example, in semi-BRs), with changes in ow regimes (for example, dilute to dense, turbulent to laminar in BRs), or with compressibility eects. Commercial codes oer
no direct way of incorporating the possible dependence of kinetic data on physical
properties or the interdependence of physical properties on operating conditions.
9.10.2.2

520

9 Mathematical Methods

Moreover, the convergence and stability of solution techniques are severely hampered while solving sti chemistry, or changes in physical properties (such as viscosity or density) during ow simulation. The grid size required to resolve all
length scales (for example, the turbulencechemistry interactions) often becomes
prohibitive for reactors involving complex chemistry or complicated geometries.
9.10.3

Integration of CFD with Polymerization Kinetics

Figure 9.27 presents a comprehensive CFD algorithm based on the classical CFD
approach. This algorithm formulates ow characteristics using Eulerian Reynoldsaveraged NavierStokes (RANS) equations for the conservation of mass and momentum, and energy equations for the convective, conductive, and radiative heat
eects. Homogeneous or heterogeneous reactors can be modeled by increasing
the complexity of physical models according to the ow physics, coupled with
the exact treatment of reactions. The governing model equations result in a set
of coupled, nonlinear, partial dierential equations, which are dicult to solve
analytically in closed form, except for a few special cases. For most engineering
ow problems, the equations can be solved numerically with appropriate boundary
conditions using discretization techniques such as nite dierence, nite volume,
nite element, or boundary element methods.
Commercial CFD codes perform a numerical simulation of the reactor geometry
using a representative axisymmetric two- or three-dimensional mesh with a large
number of computational cells (that is, nite elements used to solve model equa-

2D/3D geometry
Mesh
Micro

Boundary
Conditions
Properties
Physical
Thermodynamic
Kinetic
data

Fig. 9.27.

CFD Formulation
Continuity equation
Momentum balances
Turbulence model
Mass transfer
Heat transfer
Chemistry,
MWD
Chemistry algorithms
ISAT technique
Chemical look-up tables
Built-in integrators

mixing

Micromixing Model
Full PDF
MEM model

Multi-phase
Multi-phase model
physics
e.g. Multi-fluid model
PSD

Population Balances
Moment methods
Discrete-sectional methods
Monte Carlo methods

Generalized CFD algorithm for modeling polymerization reactors.

Increasing
physical details

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors

tions). A typical simulation requires 100,000 to several million cells to accurately


resolve all length scales. The use of a ner mesh adds enormous computational expense in terms of memory and CPU time. Cells can be distributed selectively so
that denser cells are clustered in a region of interest to resolve sti concentration
gradients or small-scale phenomena. This approach also requires a reasonable approximation of the turbulent ow characteristics using turbulence models that are
adapted to the NavierStokes equations.
Classication and Complexity of CFD Models
Other CFD approaches, namely direct numerical simulation (DNS) and large-eddy
simulation (LES), solve the governing transport equations without any approximation, but require enormous computational expense for even simple reacting ows.
DNS and LES are limited in their ability to capture the micromixing eect on slow
diusion/fast reaction processes, and are restricted to the fundamental understanding of turbulence or verication of mixing closures for use in engineering
models [62]. Another sophisticated approach is to solve joint probability density
function (PDF) transport equations of species and temperature using a stochastic
Monte Carlo algorithm [61, 63]. On the other hand, simplied Lagrangian micromixing models [64] (for example, the interaction-by-exchange-with-the-mean model
[65, 66], or engulfment models using experimentally measured mixing characteristics [67], etc.) have been proposed for investigating the inuence of micromixing
on reactions using residence time distributions. Micromixing models are particularly attractive to the polymerization industry because of their simplicity. Inherent
assumptions regarding the turbulent ow eld, however, make them inadequate to
describe the strong coupling between uid dynamics and complex reaction networks or to provide generalized scaleup rules. The complementary capabilities of
the Lagrangian micromixing models and the Eulerian CFD framework can be integrated to describe turbulent micromixing in detail [68].
For heterogeneous polymerization reactors, the ow properties of multiple
phases or mixtures of several components must be included in the CFD simulation. The motion of bubbles (or droplets or catalyst particles) in a ow is modeled
by transport equations for the additional phases as well as interphase and intraphase heat and mass transfer. Recent reviews of BCRs and FBRs will provide detailed understanding of various phenomena in multiphase ows and the governing
transport equations [6974]. Commercial CFD codes provide formulations based
on the volume of uid model with multiple uids or phases, the mixture model
with a single uid, or the Eulerian model. Micromixing models are often necessary to account for the sub-grid-scale interfacial and concentration heterogeneities,
whereas the distribution of particle sizes is described by solving population balances within the CFD framework. Various closure methods are used to model
population balances depending upon the particle dynamics. For example, a recently proposed direct quadrature method of moments (DQMOM) provides an accurate and cost-eective representation of particulate processes (that is, nucleation,
growth, aggregation, and breakage) and predicts the complete particle size distribution using a small number of transport equations [75]. The technology for multi9.10.3.1

521

522

9 Mathematical Methods

phase reacting ows is still evolving and has yet to realize its full potential for
important applications in the polymerization industry.
Treatment of Polymerization Kinetics
The CFD algorithm treats polymerization reactions exactly by integrating the species rate expressions, which form a set of highly sti ordinary dierential equations (ODEs). Although there is no theoretical limitation preventing the use of
detailed polymerization chemistry (with an arbitrary number of species), there is a
practical limit dictated by the high computational expense of direct integration of
the rate expressions involving the exponential functions. Thus, appropriate ODE
solvers along with other simplications must be used. For example, the total number of species can be reduced by assuming the quasi-steady-state approximation for
free radicals, or by including only reactions that are sensitive to the transport processes. Inherent time scale dierences of reaction and transport processes can be
used to handle them separately by employing the fractional time-stepping formulation [63]. Even with these simplications, repeated integrations for all grid points
at each time step present a computationally formidable problem, particularly for
three-dimensional simulations. Alternative ecient chemistry algorithms such
as multilinear interpolation using a chemical look-up table [76, 77] or the in-situ
adaptive tabulation (ISAT) [78] are often explored to reduce computational time.
For example, the ISAT improves the computational eciency by a factor of up to
100 by tabulating the look-up tables only in the accessed composition region for a
given ow simulation. More details of the CFD models and the chemistry algorithms for polymerizing ows (advantages, disadvantages, and implementation in
commercial codes) can be found in Ref. 79.
9.10.3.2

Illustration of Homogeneous Reactor Model Formulation


The application of the CFD algorithm for single-phase turbulent reacting ows
is illustrated in the following case. The multienvironment micromixing (MEM)
model describes concentration uctuations that arise from two poorly mixed reactants in a tubular reactor. The theoretical framework and the parameter selection
for the MEM model are discussed in greater detail by Fox [68]. The formulation of
a three-environment model (Figure 9.28) to quantify the turbulent mixing between
environment 1 (E-1) and environment 2 (E-2) follows.
Formation of a reacting environment (E-3) is governed by the transport equations for volume fraction of environments ( pn ):
9.10.3.3

E-1, p1
(Pure species I)
r1 = - (1-p1) p1

r1

E-3, p3, (3)


(Reacting)
r 3 = r1 + r2

r2

E-2, p2
(Pure species M)
r2 = - (1-p2) p2

Mixing rate = C (/k)


Mixing parameter C = 1 for the fully-developed turbulent flow.
Fig. 9.28.

Mixing parameter Cf 1 for the fully-developed turbulent ow.

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors



qpn
qpn
q
qpn
hUi i
Gn p

GT
qt
qx i qx i
qx i

n 1; 2; 3

187

The species mixing, heat transfer and reactions in E-3 are governed by the transport equations for the volume-weighted species concentration and temperature in
3
E-3 s3
a fa  p3 :


qs3
qs3
q
qs3
a
GT a
Ma3 p; s3 p3 Sa f3
hUi i a
qx i
qt
qx i
qx i

188

Repeated roman indices imply summation, and a denotes the species or temperature in E-3. The NavierStokes equations, the standard ke equations, describe the
turbulence physics, and compute the mean velocity hUi i along with the turbulent
parameters (kinetic energy k, dissipation rate e, diusivity GT ). The micromixing
functions Gn p and Ma3 p; s3 are dened in terms of the probability uxes rn
for environment n, and the chemical source terms Sa f3 are estimated on the
basis of the species rate expressions. This formulation is used to investigate the
turbulencechemistry interactions in the example in Section 9.10.4.1.
9.10.4

Target Applications

Many aspects of reacting ows have been studied for developing CFD models of
polymerization reactors. Table 9.20 documents representative examples of these
studies for various polymerization processes by summarizing reactor type, number
of phases, number of species, CFD techniques, and engineering challenges that
are addressed using CFD. Table 9.21 reports potential CFD applications for other
polymerization processes.
Specic examples of single-phase turbulent reacting ows in a tubular jet reactor
are discussed in Section 9.10.4.1. We select representative industrial problems of
engineering interest for the two fundamental classes of polymerization reactions,
namely addition and condensation polymerization. For each example, we present
a general overview of the problem and detailed reacting ow analyses, followed by
useful process design and operational information.
9.10.4.1

Illustrative Case Studies

Free-radical polymerization [79, 93] Low-density polyethylene (LDPE) accounts for


almost two-fths of the global polyethylene production capacity, reaching about
45 million tons per year in 1996. LDPE is exclusively produced by free-radical polymerization in a tubular or autoclave reactor, each of which accounts for about 50%
of the total capacity. In the tubular reactor, a small amount of initiator is injected
into a turbulent monomer ow for initiating the exothermic free-radical chemistry.
Under extreme operating conditions (T @ 140300 C, p @ 10003500 atm), these

523

524
Tab. 9.20.

9 Mathematical Methods

Target applications in the polymerization (PP) industry.

PP product,
PP process

Reactor, phases,[a]
species

CFD techniques

Design, process
engineering challenges

References

Polyethylene,
Free-radical PP

PFR, S, 6

joint PDF method,


simple chemistry
joint PDF method,
detailed chemistry

local hot-spots, MWD

80

initiator loss, MWD,


local/global decomp.
(reactor stability)
Initiator consumption,
conversion

81

conversion, MWD,
temp. distribution,
design changes
laminar striation
thinning, MWD

8486

PFR, S, 16

autoclave, S, 3

Eulerian CFD,
eddy-dissipation,[b]
simple chemistry
Eulerian CFD,
simple chemistry

autoclave, S,
3 to 6
Polypropylene,
Free-radical PP

static mixer
reactor, S, 0

Polyolen,
Catalyzed PP

FBR, M, 6

Polyolen,
Catalyzed PP

FBR, S, 0

Polystyrene,
PVC, etc.,
Suspension PP

BR, M, 0

cis-Polyisoprene,
Anionic PP

PFR, S, 6

Polyamide, etc.,
Condensation PP

Multijet
reactor, S, 6

[a] S:

single-phase; M: multiphase.

Tab. 9.21.

[b] Ref.

Eulerian CFD,
micromixing theory,[c]
no chemistry
multi-uid model,
DQMOM,
simple chemistry
Eulerian CFD,
heat transfer,
no chemistry
Eulerian CFD,
compartment-mixing,
population balance,
no chemistry
Eulerian CFD,
representative simple
chemistry
Eulerian CFD,
eddy-dissipation,[b]
simple chemistry

83

57

polymer particle
overheating

75

heat removal,
polymer particle
overheating
PSD control

88

MWD prediction

91

reactor fouling

92

89, 90

82. [c] Ref. 87.

Potential applications in the polymerization industry.

PP product, PP process

Reactor type

Design, process engineering challenges

a-Olens, Metallocene PP
Polysulfone, Linear
condensation PP
Ethylenevinyl acetate, Freeradical PP
Polyamide-6, Hydrolytic PP
Polyisobutylene, Cationic PP
Polyester, Polyesterication
Latex, Emulsion PP

PFR
CSTR

reactor fouling
sensitivity of chain-length distribution

PFR

initiator loss, MWD, phase separation

CSTR/PFR
PFR
semi-BR
CSTR

yield, selectivity
reactor stability
polymer molecular properties
polymer properties, yield

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors

reactors are sensitive to local mixing conditions and serve as an excellent test case
to study the performance and stability of commercial reactors involving singlephase turbulent reacting ows.
In this example, the mixing between initiator (E-1) and monomer (E-2) is quantied using the MEM model introduced in Section 9.10.3.3. The ISAT algorithm
is customized for a total of 16 species in the LDPE chemistry, including chain initiation, propagation, termination, chain transfer, and other branching reactions as
well as simplied ethylene decomposition reactions (reported in Table 9.22). More
details of the kinetic scheme, the rate expressions, and the rate constants as well as
the customized ISAT algorithm can be found in Ref. 81. The poorly mixed region
is modeled using a two-dimensional axisymmetric computational domain of length
10 m and radius 1.9 cm. The standard ke model describes the turbulence, as viscosity eects are negligible due to the fully-developed turbulent ow. The MEM
model and the ISAT algorithm (about ten-fold faster than the direct integration)
are solved using an interactive interface via external routines in the Fluent2 v5.3

Tab. 9.22.

Comprehensive free-radical polymerization reactions for modeling chemical source

terms [81].
Detailed low-density polyethylene polymerization chemistry:
Organic peroxide initiation

fni ; kdI

ni

Ini ! 2Ani

(ni 1; 2)

kIni

Ani M ! R1
Propagation

kp

Ri M ! Ri1
k tc

Termination by combination

Ri Rj ! Pij

Termination by disproportionation

Ri Rj ! P
i Pj

Chain transfer to monomer

Ri M ! P
i R1

k td

k trm

Ri CTA ! Pi RCTA

Chain transfer to polymer

Ri Pj ! Pi Rj0

k trp

kSCB

Ri ! Ri

(SCB)

b-Scission

kLCB
Ri0 M ! Ri1
kb
0
Rij ! Ri P
j

Simplied ethylene decomposition chemistry:


Initiation

2M ! C2 H3 C2 H5

Propagation

C2 H5

LCB formation

k1

C2 H5


k2 ; k20

! M H
k3

M ! C2 H6 C2 H3
k4

H M ! H2 C2 H3

Termination

(DB)

kCTA

Chain transfer to transfer-agent


Backbiting (SCB formation)

(DB)

k5
C2 H3 ! C CH3
k6
CH3 M ! CH4 C2 H3
kt
CH3 CH3 ! C2 H6
kt
C2 H3 CH3 ! C2 H2 CH4
kt
C2 H3 C2 H3 ! C2 H2 M

(LCB)
(DB)

525

526

9 Mathematical Methods

software. An unsteady coupled implicit solver is used to limit the eects of truncation errors on the solution. The interface also includes the interdependence of the
kinetic, physical, and thermodynamic properties of the reaction mixture.
Figures 9.29(b)(f ) present the detailed reacting ow analysis and the performance evaluation using a typical CFD simulation for the feed temperature (Tfeed )
of 250 C. As seen in Figure 9.29(b), center-mode initiator injection causes sharp
radial concentration gradients near the injection point. This phenomenon leads
to the higher termination of initiator free radicals and loss of @64% of the initiator compared to the plug-ow conditions. Contours of the mean monomer massfraction (Figure 9.29(c)) and the mean temperature (Figure 9.29(d)) show a conversion of @5% and a steady-state temperature rise of @57 C, respectively. The poor
micromixing also aects other reaction rates. For example, the localized release
of the exothermic energy due to higher propagation rates leads to local temperature uctuations in E-3 (Figure 9.29(e)), whereas non-uniform chain-transfer rates
cause a broader MWD, as indicated by higher polydispersity (Figure 9.29(f )). Thus,
the CFD algorithm is able to capture the eect of the turbulencechemistry interactions on the reactor performance, which cannot be predicted by the traditional
reactor models. Detailed CFD simulations are used to validate and increase the accuracy of a simplied one-dimensional MEM model. The high computational eciency of the simplied approach is extremely useful to evaluate the performance
for a range of operating and mixing conditions. For example, proles in Figure
9.29(g) summarize high-temperature initiator eciency for a range of feed temperatures and mixing conditions, whereas the reactor stability map in Figure 9.29(h)
identies unsafe regions of reactor operation. Thus, in this example, CFD oered a
low-cost alternative to replace pilot-plant tests and explore a variety of options for
optimizing initiator consumption while developing oine strategies to control
the reactor safety and product quality in industrial reactors.
Condensation polymerization [92] Several industrially signicant resins polyamides (for example, nylon), polyester, polyurethanes, polyacetals, phenol-aldehydes, polyurea, and silicones are produced by condensation polymerization.
In this example, a multi-jet tubular reactor is used for the polycondensation between monomers A and B, each having two reactive groups. Multiple turbulent
jets of B are impinged onto radial ow of A at the inlet of the reactor to achieve
the rapid mixing required for starting the step-growth polymerization. The reaction
forms polymer linkages L and condenses out a small molecule by-product C forming a by-product complex SC (Table 9.23). Solvent S acts as a catalyst and dissolves
all chemical species, thereby maintaining single-phase ow. Subsequent secondary
and branching reactions control the structure and MWD of the nal polymer. The
inlet region (length L @ 3:5D and residence time t) is sensitive to various uid
dynamic processes and can aect the reactor operability due to deposition of
products.
The continuity and NavierStokes equations, the standard ke turbulence model,
and the transport equations for species concentration and enthalpy are solved using a three-dimensional computational domain for the inlet region (Figure 9.30(a)).

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors


Co-axial jet, djet = 0.2 mm
Monomer, QM (m3/s)
Uz = 13.16 m/s
p1 = 0
p2 = 1

527

L = 10 m
Grid size: 400 x 19

D = 3.8 cm

Outlet

For velocity profiles: = 560 kg/m3; = 0.0016 kg/m.s


Tfeed = 250 C
QI
p1,0 =
QI + QM

Initiator, QI (m3/s)
Uz = 4.52 m/s
p1 = 0.1
p2 = 0.9

(a) Two-dimensional axisymmetric computational domain

Poorly micromixed region (0 to 0.2 m)


(Scale-up factor: D ~ 1:85, L ~ 1:40)

(b) Initiator mass fraction (blue to red: (01.15) 10 3)

(c) Monomer mass fraction (blue to red: 0.951)

(g) Optimization of high-temperature initiator


efficiency

(d) Mean temperature (blue to red: 250307C)

(e) Local temperature in the reacting


environment (blue to red: 250329C)

(f ) Polydispersity (blue to red: 07.15)

(h) Reactor stability map for commercial-scale


operation

Fig. 9.29. Typical reacting CFD simulation results and


performance evaluation for the coaxial jet tubular LDPE reactor
(scaleup factor for diameter is 1:50).

528

9 Mathematical Methods
Tab. 9.23. Primary condensation polymerization reactions for modeling
chemical source terms [92].


4
4
k1 1:2810
exp
t

8:9410
RgT

Condensation reaction:

A B S ! L SC
DHr =RTA0 51:3


6
4

Solvent regeneration:

A SC !

AC S
6
5

Transfer reaction:

AC S ! A SC

k2 4:6910
exp
t

8:3310
RgT

k3 3:8610
exp
t

1:5010
RgT

The chemistry is simplied to include only condensation, solvent regeneration,


and transfer reactions (reported in Table 9.23) that are important in the region of
interest. Finite-rate/eddy-dissipation formulation [82] in the Fluent2 v6.0 software
is used to model the turbulencechemistry interactions. This formulation uses
the minimum of the Arrhenius and eddy-dissipation rates to account for mixing
limitations.
CFD simulations are performed to visualize the velocity, pressure, concentration
(with and without chemical reactions), and temperature distributions for a range of
operating rates. For example, Figure 9.30(b) shows the non-uniform radial distribution of the reacting species A at the turndown ratio of 0.6 compared to the maximum operating rate. The presence of a recirculation zone near the inlet results in
a higher mass fraction of the polymer linkage (gL ). This phenomenon is highlighted in the inset of Figure 9.30(c) by clipping the contours to the maximum gL
in the recirculation zone (gLmax; rc ). Visual observations of internals in a fouled reactor conrm the deposition of products in regions of higher polymer linkage mass
fraction (that is, contours at the reactor entrance and the bottom wall of the reactor) indicated by CFD simulations. Although nonreacting CFD simulations indicate improved mixing at lower operating rates (Figure 9.30(d)), the reactor operation is limited due to high values of gLmax; rc . The lower operating limit is predicted
to be a @0.42 turndown ratio corresponding to the experientially estimated gLmax; rc
of 7%. The operation at higher rates (turndown ratio > 0:75 in Figure 9.30(d)) is
limited by the maximum available premix pressure for stream B. Thus, the analysis is helpful in predicting the feasible operating range, and can be used to optimize other process conditions as well as design parameters for enhancing the
operating exibility.
9.10.5

Concluding Remarks

CFD is emerging as a powerful tool for the design and optimization of polymerization reactors with the rapid growth in high-performance computing resources. Experimentally validated CFD models can now be used to complement the traditional
design procedure for cost-eective development of new reactors or for the productivity improvement of existing reactors. While limitations in handling detailed
chemistry in real time still exist, the ability to visualize and quantify the reactor

9.10 Computational Fluid Dynamics for Polymerization Reactors

529

Cross-section locations for post-processing


0.1 0.25 0.35
0.5
0.75
1.0
djet

x/L

Stream B, UB
D

gB = 1
gT = 1.33
pr = 1.22
Stream A, UA

Injection slot

gA = 0.1; gB = 0.9
gT = 1
pr = 0.85

Outlet

L / D ~ 3.5
gT = T/TA0
pr = p/(pB)max
pr = p/( pB)max

(a) Schematic diagram of the multi-jet tubular reactor

Reactor cross-sectional map

Symmetry plane
(b) Mass fraction of reactant A

Clipped between 0 & 0.045

3D contours inside the reactor

(c) Mass fraction of polymer linkage L; inset contours


highlight formation of high polymer mass at the inlet
inle

(d) Reactor performance as a function of the turndown


ratio

Fig. 9.30. Typical reacting CFD simulation results and


performance evaluation for the multijet tubular condensation
polymerization reactor.

530

9 Mathematical Methods

performance without expensive experimentation is accelerating use of these


models in the polymerization industry.
As with other emerging technologies, CFDs capabilities have been understood
to a certain degree for reacting ow modeling. It can predict single-phase turbulent
reacting ows in industrial reactors with sucient detail and increased accuracy.
Multiphase reacting ow modeling, however, lacks experimentally veriable physical models to describe the complex multiphase uid dynamics (for example,
multiphase turbulence) and its interaction with heterogeneous reactions. Thus, advanced physical models and ecient numerical algorithms are needed to realize
CFDs full potential for applications involving heterogeneous polymerizations.
Finally, the emerging high-performance supercomputing technology is likely to
have a major impact in polymer reaction engineering for modeling plant-scale reactors with an increased level of physical, mechanical, and chemical details.
Steady-state or dynamic CFD calculations can be integrated with a general-purpose
process simulator, using an interface that allows the automatic exchange of critical
variables. This approach will open up new opportunities for real-time design modications to develop safe, reliable, and ecient polymerization processes and to
control polymer quality by carrying out sophisticated design and analysis at a substantially reduced cost.

Acknowledgments

N.K. thanks Professor R. O. Fox and his research group at the Iowa State University, Dr. C. LaMarca and colleagues in the DuPont Engineering Research and Technology department for the review of Sec. 9.10, and DuPont management for the
support.

References
1 Flory, P. J. (1953). Principles of

4
5

Polymer Chemistry, Cornell University


Press, Ithaca, NY.
Biesenberger, J. A., Sebastian, D. H.
(1983). Principles of Polymerization
Engineering, Krieger, Florida, ISBN
0-89464-603-6.
Dotson, N. A., Galvan, R.,
Laurence, R. L., Tirrell, M. (1995).
Polymerization Process Modeling. VCH,
Weinheim, ISBN 1-56081-693-7.
Wulkow, M. (1996). Macromol. Theory
Simul., 5, 393416.
Keramopoulos, A., Kiparissides, C.
(2002). Macromolecules, 35, 4155
4166.
Iedema, P. D., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.

7
8
9

10

11

12

(2002). Macromol. Theory Simul., 11,


410428.
Hulburt, H. M., Katz, S. (1964).
Chem. Eng. Sci., 19, 555.
Pladis, P., Kiparissides, C. (1998).
Chem. Eng. Sci., 53(18), 33153333.
Iedema, P. D., Grcev, S., Hoefsloot,
H. C. J. (2003). Macromolecules, 36,
458476.
Zhu, S., Hamielec, A. E. (1994). J.
Polym. Sci.: Part B: Polym. Physics, 32,
929943.
Tobita, H., Hatanaka, K. (1996). J.
Polym. Sci.: Part B: Polym. Physics, 34,
671681.
Tobita, H. (1997). Polymer, 38, 1705
1717.

References
13 Tobita, H. (1994). J. Polym. Sci.: Part
14
15

16

17

18

19

20
21

22

23

24

25

26

27

28

29
30
31

32

B. Polym. Physics, 32, 901910.


Tobita, H. (1994). J. Polym. Sci.: Part
B. Polym. Physics, 32, 911919.
Tobita, H., Hatanaka, K. (1996). J.
Polym. Sci.: Part B. Polym. Physics, 34,
671678.
Chatterjee, A., Kabra, K., Graessly,
W. W. (1977). J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 21,
17511762.
Nagasubramanian, K., Graessley,
W. W. (1970). Chem. Eng. Sci., 25,
15491558.
Nagasubramanian, K., Graessley,
W. W. (1970). Chem. Eng. Sci., 25,
15591569.
Iedema, P. D., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.,
Smit, J. (2004). Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.,
43, 3650.
Iedema, P. D., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.
(2003). Macromolecules, 36, 66326644.
Beigzadeh, D., Soares, J. B. P.,
Duever, T. A. (1999). Macromol. Rapid
Commun., 20, 541545.
Soares, J. B. P., Hamielec, A. E.
(1996). Macromol. Theory Simul., 5,
547572.
Beigzadeh, D., Soares, J. B. P.,
Hamielec, A. E. (1997). Polym. React.
Eng. J., 5, 141180.
Beigzadeh, D., Soares, J. B. P.,
Hamielec, A. E. (1999). Polym. J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 71, 1753.
Beigzadeh, D., Soares, J. B. P.,
Duever, T. A., Hamielec, A. E.
(1999). Polym. React. Eng. J., 7, 195
205.
Beigzadeh, D., Soares, J. B. P.,
Duever, T. A. (2001). Macromol.
Symp., 173, 179194.
Soares, J. B. P., Kim, J. D., Rempel,
G. L. (1997). Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 36,
11441150.
Kim, J. D., Soares, J. B. P., Rempel,
G. L. (1998). Macromol. Rapid
Commun, 19, 197199.
Soares, J. B. P. (2002). Macromol.
Theory Simul., 11, 184198.
Simon, L. C., Soares, J. B. P. (2002).
Macromol. Theory Simul., 11, 222232.
Iedema, P. D., Wulkow, M.,
Hoefsloot, H. C. J. (2000). Macromolecules, 33, 71737184.
Kim, D.-M., Busch, M., Hoefsloot,

33

34
35

36
37

38

39
40

41

42

43

44

45
46
47

48
49
50
51
52
53

H. C. J., Iedema, P. D. (2004). Chem.


Eng. Sci. 59, 699718.
Iedema, P. D., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.
(2001). Macromol. Theory Simul., 10,
855869.
Iedema, P. D., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.
(2001). Chimia, 55, 256258.
Hoefsloot, H. C. J., Iedema, P. D.
(2003). Macromol. Theory Simul., 12,
484498.
Tackx, P., Tacx, J. C. J. F. (1998).
Polymer, 39(14), 31093113.
Gordon, M., Malcolm, G. N. (1966).
Proc. R. Soc. London. Ser. A, Math.
Phys. Sci., 295, 2954.
Gordon, M. (1962). Proc. R. Soc.
London. Ser. A, Math. Phys. Sci., 272,
240259.
Dusek, K., Somvarsky, J. (1985).
Polym. Bull., 13, 313319.
Dusek, K., Gordon, M., RossMurphy, S. B. (1978). Macromolecules,
11, 236245.
Kuchanov, S. I., Pismen, L. M.
(1972). Vysokomol. Soyed., A14(1),
131142.
Kuchanov, S. I., Pismen, L. M.
(1972). Vysokomol. Soyed., A14(4),
886893.
Dusek, K., Scholtens, B. J. R.,
Tiemersma-Thoone, G. P. J. M.
(1987). Polym. Bull., 17, 239.
Tiemersma-Thoone, G. P. J. M.,
Scholtens, B. J. R., Dusek, K.,
Gordon, M. J. (1991). Polym. Sci.,
Part B: Polym. Physics, 29, 463.
Read, D. J., Soares, J. B. P. (2003).
Macromolecules, 36, 10 03710 051.
Read, D. J., McLeish, T. C. B. (2001).
Macromolecules, 34, 19281945.
Costeux, S., Wood-Adams, P.,
Beigzadeh, D. (2002). Macromolecules,
35, 25142528.
Tobita, H. (1993). J. Polym. Sci.: Part
B. Polym. Physics, 31, 13631371.
Tobita, H. (1996). Macromol. Theory
Simul., 5, 11671194.
Tobita, H. (2001). J. Polym. Sci.: Part
B. Polym. Physics, 39, 391403.
Tobita, H. (1995). Polymer, 36, 2585.
Bick, D. K., McLeish, T. C. B. (1996).
Phys. Rev. Lett., 76(14), 25872590.
Rouvray, D. H. (1988). Discrete Appl.
Math., 19, 317338.

531

532

9 Mathematical Methods
54 Hutchinson, R. A. (2001). Macromol.
55
56

57

58

59

60

61

62
63
64
65
66

67
68
69

70

71

72
73

Theory Simul., 10, 144157.


Eichinger, B. E. (1980). Macromolecules, 13, 1.
Iedema, P. D., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.
(2001). Macromol. Theory Simul., 10,
870880.
Fourcade, E., Wadley, E. R.,
Hoefsloot, H. C. J., Green, A.,
Iedema, P. D. (2001). Chem. Eng. Sci.,
56, 67296741.
Iedema, P. D., Willems, C., Van
Vliet, G., Bunge, W., Mutsers, S. M.
P., Hoefsloot, H. C. J. (2001). Chem.
Eng. Sci., 56, 36593669.
Fourcade, E., Hoefsloot, H. C. J.,
van Vliet, G., Bunge, W., Mutsers,
S. M. P., Iedema, P. D. (2001). Chem.
Eng. Sci., 56, 65896603.
Baldyga, J., Bourne, J. R. (1999).
Turbulent Mixing and Chemical
Reactions, John Wiley and Sons, UK.
Fox, R. O. (2003). Computational
Models for Turbulent Reacting Flows,
Cambridge University Press,
Cambridge.
Fox, R. O. (1996). Rev. Inst. Franc.
Petrole, 51, 215.
Pope, S. B. (2000). Turbulent Flows,
Cambridge University Press, New York.
Villermaux, J., Falk, L. (1994). Chem.
Eng. Sci., 49, 5127.
Harada, M. (1962). Mem. Fac. Eng.
Kyoto University, 24, 431.
Villermaux, J., Devillon, J. C.
(1972). In Proc. 2nd Int. Symp. Chem.
React. Eng., Amersterdam, B, p. 1.
Baldyga, J., Bourne, J. R. (1988).
Chem. Eng. Res. Design, 66, 33.
Fox, R. O. (1998). Chem. Eng. Proc.,
37(6), 521.
Enwald, H., Peirano, Almstedt,
A.-E. (1996). Int. J. Multiphase Flows,
22(S1), 21.
Mathiesen, V., Solberg, T.,
Arastoopour, H., Hjertager, B. H.
(1999). AIChE J., 45, 2503.
Hatzantonis, H., Yiannoulakis, H.,
Yiagopoulos, A., Kiparissides, C.
(2000). Chem. Eng. Sci., 55, 3237.
Joshi, J. B. (2001). Chem. Eng. Sci., 56,
5893.
Li, J., Kuipers, J. A. M. (2003). Chem.
Eng. Sci., 58, 711.

74 Deen, N. G., Annaland, M., Kuipers,

75
76

77
78
79
80
81

82

83
84

85
86

87

88
89

90

91

92

93

J. A. M. (2004). Chem. Eng. Sci., 59,


1853.
Fan, R., Marchisio, D. L., Fox, R. O.
(2003). AIChE Symp. Series, 20A, 1.
Chen, J. Y., Kollman, W., Dibble,
R. W. (1989). Combust. Sci. Technol.,
64, 315.
Maas, U., Pope, S. B. (1992). Combust.
Flame, 88, 239.
Pope, S. B. (1997). Combust. Theory
Modeling, 1, 4163.
Kolhapure, N. H., Fox, R. O. (2001).
DECHEMA Monogr., 137, 247.
Tsai, K., Fox, R. O. (1996). AIChE J.,
42, 2926.
Kolhapure, N. H., Fox, R. O., Dai,
A., Mahling, F.-O. (2005). AIChE J.,
51(2) scheduled for publication.
Magnussen, B. F., Hjertager, B. H.
(1976). In 16th Symposium (Int.)
Combust., The Combustion Institute,
Vol. 1, p. 719.
Read, N. K., Zhang, S. X., Ray, W. H.
(1997). AIChE J., 43, 104.
Torvik, R., Gravdahl, A. R.,
Fredriksen, G. R., Meon, O.,
Laurell, J. (1995). DECHEMA
Monogr., 131, 401.
Tosun, G., Bakker, A. (1997). Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res., 36, 296.
Zhou, W., Marshall, E., Oshinowo,
L. (2001). Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 40,
5533.
Ottino, J. M. (1989). The Kinematics
of Stretching, Chaos and Transport,
Cambridge University Press,
Cambridge.
McKenna, T. F., Spitz, R., Cokljat,
D. (1999). AIChE J., 45, 2392.
Vivaldo-Lima, E., Wood, P. E.,
Hamielec, A. E., Penlidis, A. (1998).
Can. J. Chem. Eng., 76, 495.
Alexopoulos, A. H., Maggioris, D.,
Kiparissides, C. (2002). Chem. Eng.
Sci., 57, 1735.
Meszena, Z. G., Johnson, A. F.
(2001). Macromol. Theory Simul., 10,
123.
Kolhapure, N. H., Tilton, J. N.,
Pereira, C. J. (2004). Chem. Eng. Sci.,
59, 5177.
Kolhapure, N. H., Fox, R. O. (1999).
Chem. Engng. Sci., 54, 3233.

533

10

Scaleup of Polymerization Processes1


E. Bruce Nauman
10.1

Historic and Economic Perspective

Since the mid-1960s the world has seen remarkable increases in production rates
for commercial polymers. Single-train line rates have increased by factors of 20 to
40 for polymers such as polyethylene, polypropylene, and polystyrene. A rate of
1 t h1 that would have been economical in 1964 has become 2040 t h1 . Part of
this improvement is attributable to improved catalysis and innovative processes,
but the greatest increase in productivity is due to classical scaleup. Larger plants
produce more polymer using substantially the same manpower and with reduced
capital investment per ton of annual capacity. The selling prices of the major commodity polymers have increased by factors of 3 to 4 since the 1960s, but the US
consumer price index has increased by a factor of 6. The result has been an ongoing decrease in the real cost of polymers that leads to their greater use and a continuing incentive to build still larger plants.
The success of the petrochemical industry in the 20th century is attributable in
large part to the scalability of typical chemical processes. This chapter discusses
the technical basis for achieving capacity increases without major changes in technology. These techniques are broadly applicable to the development of new polymers and new polymerization processes. They continue to be applied to existing
processes, although no process is innitely scalable. Eventually, a limit must be
reached.

10.2

The Limits of Scale

Consider the scaleup of a stirred tank reactor. It is common practice to scale using
geometric similarity so that the larger reactor will have the same shape as the small
reactor. Suppose the volume scaleup factor is given by Eq. (1).
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

534

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

V large
Vsmall

All linear dimensions such as reactor diameter, impeller diameter, and liquid
height will scale as S 1/3 . Surface areas will scale as S 2/3 while volume itself scales
as S 1 . The total amount of heat transferred to a jacket will increase as S increases,
but heat transfer per unit volume of reactor contents will decrease. Sooner or later,
the reactor will become adiabatic. Similarly, any mass transfer to an external surface will become limiting. These limitations are well known and can be avoided,
for example, by employing processes without external mass transfer and by using
enough inerts so that the adiabatic temperature rise is acceptable. However, there
is still a mixing limit that will ultimately emerge. In very large vessels, it will become impossible to mix the reactive components in a time that is reasonable compared to the reaction half-life. Consider a pilot-scale vessel that has a mixing time
of 30 s using a small electric motor. Suppose it is desired to maintain this mixing
time when the reactor is scaled, using geometric similarity, by a factor of 10 in
linear dimensions and by a factor of 1000 in volume. Standard correlations show
that it is necessary to maintain the same rotational speed of the agitator, say 100
rpm, in both large and small vessels. The agitator power increases by a factor of
S 5/3 100 000, so that a 0.5 kW motor scales to 50 000 kW.
The lesson from this is that even a simple phenomenon such blending of two
uids requires longer and longer times as the size of the process increases. Eventually, the operation becomes unfeasible.

10.3

Scaleup Goals

The goals of a process scaleup are to obtain acceptable product quality with good
manufacturing economics. Product quality is usually best at the laboratory scale
because mixing and heat transfer are excellent and because the academic training
of chemists puts a high premium on yield and selectivity. The same product quality can be achieved upon scaleup by employing many bench chemists working in
parallel, but the economics will be poor. The scaleup engineer seeks to design a
single-train process that meets anticipated market demands or else is the largest
capacity unit for which adequate quality can be achieved.
A single-train process may include some equipment in parallel. Shell-and-tube
heat exchangers are a ubiquitous example. They are relatively inexpensive and are
sold as integral units. Another example in the polymer industry is pelletization.
The maximum economic size for extrusion and pelleting has lagged behind the
maximum size for polymerization reactors. Thus it is common for a polymerization reactor to feed two or three pelleting lines. These lines are expensive, so the
economics of scaleup are compromised. However, the major cost of a polymerization line is in the feed preparation, reaction, and recovery sections, and these are
generally single-train. They have one control system, one operating crew and

10.4 General Approaches

with the possible exception of additives added in the extrusion or pelleting steps
make one product at a time. They are single-train by the practical, working denition of single train.
Since the ability to mix and transfer heat generally decreases upon scaleup, the
uniformity of a product usually decreases as well. This typically means an increase
in polydispersity of a polymer. It is easy to make polystyrene having a polydispersity of 2 by a laboratory-scale, free-radical process. Industrial processes have diculty going below 2.2 and operate best when making products with a polydispersity
of 2.5 and higher. Such products are sellable and are even preferred for injection
molding. However, had the early polystyrene markets required the low polydispersity achievable in the laboratory, the commercial processes would have failed. Residual volatiles are a similar example. Coagulation and vacuum drying in the laboratory have always been able to produce the low volatilities that are now possible on
a commercial scale after 50 years or so of process development. For a new polymer,
product quality goals and qualication tests must be based on what is possible to
achieve in commercial-scale equipment, not on what is possible in the laboratory.
This may require a change in the laboratory-scale operating conditions so that the
product is economically achievable in a commercial process. The intentional lessening of product goals in the laboratory or pilot plant to enable economic scaleup
is called diplomatic scaleup because it may require diplomacy to convince the
bench chemist and management.

10.4

General Approaches

There are many ways of increasing the capacity of a chemical reactor. The simplest
methods are scaling in parallel or scaling in series. When applied to a tubular reactor, the tube diameter is held constant, and capacity is increased by adding tubes in
parallel or in series. There are several scaleup possibilities:


Add identical reactors in parallel. The shell-and-tube design used for heat exchangers is a common and inexpensive way of increasing capacity. Gas-phase,
heterogeneously catalyzed reactions are usually scaled in this way since temperatures and pressures are identical in the small and large scales. The ultimate
scaleup limit is uniform distribution of feed across a large tube bank, but the
limit has not been reached with 10 000 tubes. In the polymer industry, 1000tube heat exchanges are used as post-reactors and devolatilization preheaters for
polystyrene. Shell-and-tube designs are also used in solution process loop reactors, but instability or fouling problems arise if the discharge stream has a
much higher viscosity than the feed stream.
 Make the reactor longer or add reactors in series. Capacity can be increased in
the high-pressure process for LDPE by adding an extra mile to the tubular reactor. Adding stirred-tank or stirred-tube reactors in series is sometimes used to
scale up polystyrene processes. For incompressible uids, scaling in series is lim-

535

536

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

ited by pressure drop. For compressible uids, lengthening a reactor can lead to
a dramatic increase in density so that the ratio of heat transfer area to volume
decreases dramatically.
 Simultaneously increase two or more characteristic dimensions of the reactor.
Scaling with geometric similarity, so that all linear dimensions increase by a factor of S 1/3 , is common for stirred-tank reactors but uncommon for tubes. Geometric similarity for a tube means keeping the same length-to-diameter ratio,
L/d t , upon scaleup. It is also possible to scale while maintaining a constant pressure drop across the reactor. Turbulent reactors require a reduction in length-todiameter ratio to scale at constant pressure drop. Scaling with geometric similarity gives a constant pressure drop in laminar-ow reactors.
Scaling in parallel or series is preferred when heat transfer is a dominant consideration. The third method, scaling with geometric similarity, is cheaper for reactions
that permit adiabatic operation.
Two other methods of scaleup are:


Lower product quality expectations to what is readily achievable in a commercial


reactor, ideally an adiabatic reactor with premixed feed. This is the diplomatic
form of scaleup mentioned in Section 10.3.
 Go from batch to continuous operation. Scaleup is easier, especially for postreactor processing techniques that are typically continuous. For a stirred-tank
reactor, the reaction rate will decline because the entire reaction is conducted at
the highest conversion and thus, typically, at the lowest reaction rate. However,
the decline in rate is more than compensated for by the full time utilization
of the reactor compared to occasional utilization in a batch process.
In what follows, we will draw heavily on Ref. 1, in which scaleup is treated in the
general context of reactor design. Another general reference work is by Bisos and
Kabel [2] while McGreavy [3] briey discusses scaleup of polymerization processes.
Many references purport to discuss scaleup but only give modeling equations that
contain scale-dependent parameters, the values of which are left as an exercise to
the reader. Another common approach is to enumerate the various dimensionless
numbers that govern a reaction system. One quickly concludes that scaleup of a
pilot-scale reactor is impossible because it is not feasible to maintain the various
dimensionless numbers at the same values as they had in a pilot plant, except by
scaling in parallel. The secret, of course, is to know when constancy of a dimensionless number can be sacriced without compromising the scaleup. As an obvious example, the Reynolds number will usually increase upon scaleup, but laminar
ow patterns are largely indierent to Reynolds number until some critical value is
reached. Similarly, the Froude number is unimportant in a baed stirred tank. In
contrast, dimensionless groups involving temperature (for example, T/Tact where
Tact is the Arrhenius activation temperature) must be kept nearly constant upon
scaleup of a chemical reaction.

10.6 Stirred-tank Reactors

10.5

Scaleup Factors

Equation (1) dened S as the ratio of large and small volumes. A more rigorous
denition bases S on the ratio of holdup (inventory) in the large and small reactors.
This accounts for possible density variations. However, the goal in almost all scaleups is to achieve the same reaction environment in the large and small scales and
thus the same density. For this case, S is dened in Eq. (2).
Holdup Scaling Factor

Holdup in Large System r^VLarge VLarge

A
S 2
Holdup in Small System r^VSmall VSmall

The throughput scaling factor, ST , is the ratio of production rates for the large and
small reactors [Eq. (3)].
Throughput Scaling Factor

Throughput for Large System


Throughput for Small System
rin Q in Large
rin Q in Small

Q Large
ST
Q Small

The mean residence time, t, is the ratio of holdup to throughput. Reaction systems
are almost always scaled with a constant value for t. This means that ST S is the
almost universal way in which ow reactors are scaled. Batch reactors are usually
scaled using the same batch reaction time.

10.6

Stirred-tank Reactors

The conventional stirred-tank reactor is an agitated vessel, typically a jacketed pressure vessel, and often with provisions for reux of a solvent or monomer. The
continuous-feed version is the CSTR. Continuous operation is typical of highvolume polymers but large batch and fed-batch stirred-tank reactors are occasionally used. Reactors other than stirred tanks may be functionally equivalent to
stirred tanks. Loop reactors are widely used in the polymer industry, especially for
solution and slurry olen polymerizations; the agitator in the stirred tank is replaced with a circulation pump. The loop many consist of jacketed pipe or there
may be heat exchangers and even ash vessels in the loop. The loop may consist
of many legs for space considerations, but the legs are connected in series and
there is only one circulation pump.
Fluidized-bed reactors can also be treated as stirred tanks for many purposes;
so can the stirred-tube reactors used for styrenic polymerizations. A reactor will behave like a stirred tank when the contents are approximately uniform in tempera-

537

538

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

ture and composition and when the contents have a nearly exponential distribution
of residence times. If the reaction is rst order or pseudo-rst order, or if the conversion is low, the yield behavior will be similar to that of an ideal, perfectly mixed
CSTR provided only that the contents are approximately isothermal and have an
exponential distribution of residence times. It is not necessary for the contents to
be well mixed on the molecular level. Mixing on the molecular level, that is, micromixing, is of great academic interest but has so far not been identied as important
in commercial polymerization vessels. Instead, circulation times (mixing times)
are limiting. Typical mixing times in large vessels are a few minutes. In turbulent
vessels, the distance scale over which diusive mixing is limiting is on the order of
the Kolmogorov scale, typically a few tens of microns, and diusive mixing occurs
in a fraction of a second. The Kolmogorov scale varies with power per unit volume
and thus remains constant for a conventional scaleup. Although the underlying
mechanisms are dierent, circulation times are typically much greater than diusion times in laminar ow vessels as well.
The scaling of stirred-tank reactors is usually based on geometric similarity so
that the large vessel looks like the small reactor, and all linear dimensions scale
as S 1/3 . Table 10.1 gives a variety of scaleup factors for this form of scaleup. In the
general case, the agitator rotational speed, NI , is independently adjustable. The
throughput scaleup factor, ST , is also independently adjustable but has no appreciable eect on the scaleup factors in Table 10.1 because the internal circulation
due to the agitator is normally much higher than the throughput of a CSTR.
Thus, batch stirred tanks and normally designed CSTRs behave in much the
same way with respect to the parameters listed in Table 10.1. The scaleup factors

Tab. 10.1.

Scaleup factors for turbulent stirred tanks.

Vessel diameter
Impeller diameter
Vessel cross-section
Vessel volume
Reynolds number
Froude number
Agitator speed
Power in turbulent ow
Power in laminar ow
Power per volume
Mixing time
Circulation rate
Heat transfer area, A ext
Inside coecient, h
Coecient  area, hA ext
Driving force, DT

General
scaling
factor

Scaling factor for


constant power per unit
volume

Numerical
scaling factor
for S F 512

S 1/3
S 1/3
S 2/3
S
NI S 2/3
NI2 S 1/3
NI
NI3 S 5/3
NI2 S
NI3 S 2/3
NI1
NI S
S 2/3
2/3
NI S 1/9
2/3
NI S 7/9
2/3 2/9
NI S

S 1/3
S 1/3
S 2/3
S
S 4/9
S1/9
S2/9
S
S
1.0
S 2/9
S 7/9
S 2/3
S1/27
S 17/27
S 10/27

8
8
64
512
8
0.5
0.25
512
512
1
4
128
64
0.79
50.8
10.1

10.6 Stirred-tank Reactors

for power and heat transfer coecients shown in Table 10.1 are based on generally
accepted correlations for turbulent stirred tanks. Nauman [1] gives details.
As shown in Table 10.1, power in the turbulent regime varies as NI3 S 5/3 . As a
practical matter, NI must be lowered upon scaleup. Agitation experts have many
criteria for setting NI , but scaling with constant power per unit volume is a good
general rule. For fully turbulent vessels, this means that NI will vary as S2/9 . Table
10.1 gives specic scaling factors for scaleups with constant power per unit volume, and also gives numerical examples for such scaleups with S 512. In these
examples, the power calculation assumes turbulent ow. Note that for turbineagitated vessels, ow is substantially turbulent ow when the impeller Reynolds
number, rNI D 2 /m, is above about 100. Power in laminar ow scales as NI2 S.
The specialized literature, and especially Paul et al. [4], provide details on closeclearance impellors (for example, anchors and helical ribbons) and correlations
suitable for deep laminar ow. As a generalization, heat and mass transfer to the
external environment is very low in such devices. However, it is usually possible to
achieve a suciently high circulation rate in the vessel for the tank to be reasonably well mixed.
The volumetric scaleup by a factor of 512 anticipates an increase in throughput
by the same factor. Is this possible while maintaining reasonable product quality?
The results in Table 10.1 suggest three possible problems. The rst is mass transfer to the external environment. For geometric similarity, surface areas increase by
a factor of only S 2/3, or 64, while throughput and volume increase by a factor of
512. A limitation can arise if a condensation product has to be removed across the
free surface at the top of the vessel. A practical example is the removal of byproduct
ethylene glycol in the glycolysis route to PET. Similarly, very high boiling rates in a
reux reactor can cause slugging and liquid entrainment. A potential solution to
such mass transfer problems is the use of an external recycle loop, as shown in
Figure 10.1. The recycled material is ashed into the dome of the stirred tank, creating extra surface area by foaming (that is, by ash devolatilization).
A second possible limitation is heat transfer. If the vessel contents are cooled
through a jacket or by internal coils, the cooling demand increases by a factor of
512 but the surface area increases by a factor of only 64. Additionally, the heat
transfer coecient decreases when scaling at constant power per unit volume.
The result is that the driving force at the wall must increase by a factor of about
10 when scaling with S 512 and constant power per unit volume. This may be
acceptable when the pilot unit operates with a DT of 2 C but becomes problematic
when the pilot plant operates with a 20 C DT. There are many solutions. In a
CSTR, use cold feed. Some processes for PMMA use a 40 C feed to control the
reaction exotherm. Diluents and low per-pass conversions can also be used: this
approach is typical of solution polyolen processes. Reux boiling can be used: it
is common in styrenic polymerizations where the reux solvent is normally returned as a liquid. In some polypropylene processes, the returning propylene is
ashed into the rst reaction vessel. Finally, the external loop shown in Figure
10.1 can be used. Indeed, a loop reactor with the elimination of the stirred tank
performs identically to a CSTR provided that the circulation rate is high compared

539

540

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

Vapor

Condensate

Lowers distance
scales for heat transfer
and mixing.

Shell-andTube Heat
Exchanger

Stirred
Tank

Circulation
Pump

Allows a controlled
dilution rate for
incoming feed.
Can be detuned at the
small scale to simulate
achievable results at the
large scale.

Reactor Outlet

Static Mixer
Fig. 10.1.

CSTR Inlet and Fed


Batch Additives

A Generalized Loop Reactor.

to the throughput. Heat transfer can be better managed using a shell-and-tube exchanger in the loop than by the jacket or internal coils in a stirred tank. A ash can
be built into the loop for mass transfer or to cool the reaction mass. At large scales,
loop reactors are economically superior to stirred vessels and are preferred by sophisticated companies for high-volume processes.
The third possible limitation is mixing time. As the scale increases, it becomes
increasingly dicult to mix fresh feed (whether in a CSTR or a fed-batch reactor)
with the contents in the vessel. In the example of S 512, constant power per unit
volume causes the mixing time to increase by a factor of 4. Does this hurt the product? Test for this by decreasing the agitator speed in the pilot plant to give a mixing
time that can reasonably be achieved upon scaleup. Diplomatic scaleup may be
possible. If fast mixing times are really required, multiple injection points can be
used. Loop reactors do not solve the mixing time problem as they are subject to exactly the same limitations of impeller speed, power, and mixing time. However,
they do allow the dilution of feed at a controlled rate. Also, faster mixing times
achieved through the use of multiple injection points are easier to implement in a
loop reactor.

10.7 Design Considerations for Stirred Tanks

The real question in the scaleup of a stirred-tank reactor is simply whether the
contents of the vessel will remain reasonably well mixed upon scaleup. If there is
good compositional homogeneity, then there will be thermal homogeneity as well,
since thermal diusivities are typically two orders of magnitude higher than molecular diusivities. The absolute value of the temperature in the larger vessel can
be regulated by scalable techniques such as boiling, cold feed, or external heat
transfer if wall cooling is inadequate.

10.7

Design Considerations for Stirred Tanks

Removal of the heat of reaction is the critical factor in vinyl polymerizations. It is


less important for ring-opening polymerizations, such as for Nylon 6, and is unimportant for condensation polymerizations, such as for PET and polycarbonate. The
removal of heat through the walls of a stirred tank or by internal cooling coils is
dicult to scale and not recommended. Scaleup of even a moderately exothermic
reaction can lead to a vessel half-full of cooling coils for which the normal correlations for heat transfer are overly optimistic. Scalable techniques include cold feed,
reux (autorefrigeration) of monomer or solvent, use of diluents, low per pass conversions, and external heat exchange in shell-and-tube reactors.
Reux reactors remove the heat of polymerization through the heat of vaporization of monomer or solvent. Boiling by homogeneous nucleation scales directly
with volume. Vapor bubbles break the free surface of the reactor. The vapor is condensed and returned directly to the reactor or is recycled to the feed. Concerns
about boiling reactors include polymerization on the dome of the reactor and fouling of the condensate heat exchanger. The issue is simple. If the polymer is soluble
in the monomer or solvent mixture as it condenses, there is little problem. This
fact seems self-evident, although it took 30-odd years for a company otherwise
noted for its engineering skills to be shamed into recognizing it by a European
subsidiary. If the polymer in insoluble in the condensate, fouling can be expected.
PET nishing reactors (which are more like tubes than stirred tanks) exemplify
this problem, and 30-plus years of research have failed to yield a good solution.
Perhaps the best solution is a hot spare that can be switched into duty as the other
condenser is cleaned.
Another limitation of a boiling reactor is the eect of pressure on boiling point.
A very tall reactor will have higher temperatures at the bottom that will typically
give lower molecular weight polymer and higher polydispersity in the product.
Field erection of stirred tanks is much more expensive than shop erection, and
the maximum size of a stirred-tank reactor may be limited by the size that can be
shipped. Thus plants immediately adjacent to water may be able to have larger reactors than plants accessed only by rail or road. Rail and road shipments limit reactor sizes to about 100 m 3 . Much larger vessels are eld-erected, but these designs
are usually more suited as low-pressure storage tanks or fermentation reactors
than as polymerization reactors that are typically rated for 1020 atm pressure.

541

542

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

10.8

Multiphase Stirred Tanks

Polymerization reactors are occasionally multiphase. The boiling reactor is an example where scaleup has been easy because homogeneous nucleation depends
on temperature and pressure but is otherwise independent of scale. As discussed
above, potential limits exist for very large vessels, but these have not yet been encountered. The precipitation of rubber particles in a HIPS process is another example where the phase separation mechanism, that is, spinodal decomposition, is
homogeneous and thus potentially independent of scale. The local concentrations
that drive spinodal decomposition are due to a combination of chemical reaction
and mass transfer between the entering feed and the vessel contents. A scaleup
limitation could occur, for example if the mixing time in the CSTR became too
large, but some compensation is possible by slightly altering conversion in the reactor. As a practical matter, vessels diering by more than 25 000-fold in volume
have achieved substantially the same results in HIPS polymerizations.
Sparged reactor vessels present a greater problem for scaleup, although sparging
is not very common in continuous polymerization reactors. The European targeted
research activity on polymer materials (TRA-PM) has addressed the scaleup of multiphase reactions with the comment: A newer integrated, but still semi-empirical
approach uses experience-based equipment selection, laboratory experiments generating starting parameters for CFD calculation, numerical calculations using advanced CFD tools, pilot scale experiments to verify CFD calculations and nal
design and scale-up with CFD.
This approach may become possible as CFD codes become better able to solve
the convective diusion equations for heat and mass transfer in the presence of a
chemical reaction and in addition to their more established but not completely perfect role in the prediction of the uid mechanics. At the moment, this procedure
lacks validation even for single-phase stirred-tank reactors.

10.9

Stirred Tanks in Series

One way to double the output of a stirred tank process is to increase each linear
dimension by 2 1/3 1:26, but this may lead to heat transfer or mixing limitations. Another way is to add a stirred tank in parallel, but better results and a
more exible process are usually achieved by adding a stirred tank in series. Some
polystyrene processes use ve stirred-tank and stirred-tube reactors in series. Some
polypropylene processes use two or three loop and stirred-tank reactors in series.
Modern uidized-bed processes for polypropylene use two beds in series.
One advantage of using tanks in series is the improvement in residence time
distribution from the exponential distribution of a single stirred tank toward that
of piston (plug) ow. The series arrangement leads to higher conversion and thus
eases the burden of downstream recovery and recycling. The usual case is for two

10.10 Tubular Reactors

reactors in series to produce more than two reactors in parallel, although operation
at very high conversions (for example, 70% for styrene) may be an exception because of the gel eect.
A major advantage of using tanks in series is the ability to have a dierent reaction environment in the various tanks. This advantage is especially useful in polypropylene processes where the last reactor adds ethylene for impact modication.

10.10

Tubular Reactors

Scaling tubes in parallel is the standard method for low-viscosity uids when the
reaction exotherm is signicant, and particularly for gas-phase reactions where
the pressure drop is important. Shell-and-tube designs allow tubular polymerization reactors to be scaled in parallel, subject to the limitation of distributing the
feed across the tube bundle. Distribution becomes a problem when the viscosity
of the feed is much less than the viscosity of the product. This viscous ngering
problem that arises in secondary oil recovery is also a problem in multitubular
polymerization reactors. The relatively inviscid material entering cannot displace
polymerized or devolatilized material that may form in the tubes. The result can
be many tubes that are completely plugged, with a few tubes gushing unreacted
feed. Static mixers cannot eliminate this problem since they too oer parallel paths
for ow, some of which can plug. The known, practical solution is to limit per pass
conversion so that the outlet viscosity is within about an order of magnitude of the
inlet viscosity. Polystyrene post-reactors and devolatilization preheaters function
satisfactorily when the entering feed is about 70% polymer. Solution HDPE processes function satisfactorily when the per pass conversion is limited to about
15%. Multitubular devolatilization preheaters can function with entering polymer
concentrations below 15% by using a motor-controlled, backpressure valve that prevents ashing in the tube bundle.
When scaling in parallel, the number of tubes scales directly with the inventory
scaleup factor, S. Factors for other forms of scaleup for incompressible uids are
given in Table 10.2. This table includes three geometric scaleup factors. They are
for volume, S, radius SR , and length, SL . They are related by Eq. (4) so that only
two are arbitrarily adjustable.
S SL SR2

Thus the general scaling equation for pressure drop in a single tube in laminar
ow can be given in several equivalent forms [Eqs. (5)].
2
6
SDP ST S4
R SL ST S SL ST SSR

The results in Table 10.2 emphasize the constraint of Eq. (4) by eliminating SL
from the scaleup factors in the column that species ST S.

543

544

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes


Tab. 10.2.

Scaleup factors for tubes.

Flow regime

Laminar
diameter scaling factor
Length scaling factor
Reynolds number
Length-to-diameter ratio
Pressure scaling factor, DP
Laminar with Gz < 75
Inside coecient, h
Coecient  area, hA ext
Driving force, DT
Laminar with Gz > 75
Inside coecient, h
Coecient  area, hA ext
Driving force, DT
Turbulent
Diameter scaling factor
Length scaling factor
Length-to-diameter ratio
Reynolds number
Pressure scaling factor, DP
Heat transfer area, A ext
Inside coecient, h
Coecient  area, hA ext
Driving force, DT

General
scaleup
factors

General
factor for
ST F S

Series
scaleup

Geometric
similarity

Constant
pressure
scaleup

SR
SL
ST S1
R
SL S1
R
ST S4
R SL

SR
SS2
R
SS1
R
SS3
R
S 2 S6
R

1
S
SL
S
S2

S 1/3
S 1/3
S 2/3
1
1

S 1/3
S 1/3
S 2/3
1
1

S1
R
SL
ST S1
L

S1
R
SS2
R
SR2

1
S
1

S1/3
S 1/3
S 2/3

S1/3
S 1/3
S 2/3

1/3

1/3

1/3

ST S1
R SL
1/3 2/3
ST SL
2/3 2/3
ST SL

SR
4/3
SSR
4/3
SR

1
S
1

S1/9
S 5/9
S 4/9

S1/9
S 5/9
S 4/9

SR
SL
SL S1
R
ST S1
R
1:75 4:75
ST SR SL
SS1
R
ST0:8 SR1:8
ST0:8 SR0:8 SL
ST0:2 SR0:8 S1
L

SR
SS2
R
SS3
R
SS1
R
2:75 6:75
S SR
SS1
R
S 0:8 S1:8
R
1:8 2:8
19 S SR
S0:8 SR2:8

1
S
S
SL
S 2:75
S
S 0:8
S 1:8
S0:8

S 1/3
S 1/3
1
S 2/3
S 1/2
S 2/3
S 0:2
S 0:87
S 0:13

S 11/27
S 5/27
S2/9
S 0:59
1
S 0:59
S 0:07
S 0:66
S 0:34

The general scaleup factor for the Reynolds number is given by Eq. (6).
d t uLarge
ReLarge

ST S1
R
ReSmall d t uSmall

Scaleup at constant Reynolds number, with ST S, would require SS1


R 1, so
SR S and SL S1 . The scaled-up reactor would have to be fatter but shorter,
which is a strange form of scaleup. For scaleups other than in parallel, the Reynolds number will increase, although typically not by enough to cause turbulence
or even transitional ow in polymer systems.
Scaling a tube in series is conservative with respect to heat transfer. The necessary wall driving force remains constant in laminar ow and decreases in turbulent
ow. The major diculty is the pressure drop that scales as S 2 for laminar ow
and as S 2:75 in turbulent ow. Polymer solutions are mildly shear thinning, so
these factors somewhat overestimate the pressure drop. Still, the pressure drop in
the pilot-scale reactor had better be small.

10.11 Static Mixers

Scaling a laminar-ow, tubular reactor with geometric similarity has the interesting consequence of constant pressure drop. Thus, scaling with geometric similarity
is great for adiabatic reactors. A constant pressure drop is obtained for gases as
well as liquids. However, even though temperature eects may be negligible, the
reactor will have radial concentration gradients due to the laminar velocity prole.
Molecular diusion will alleviate this prole and usually helps the performance of a
laminar-ow reactor. The benecial eects of diusion will diminish upon scaleup.
Geometrically similar scaleup of laminar ow in tubes cannot be recommended
unless radial diusion was negligible in the pilot-scale reactor. Diusion depends
on the dimensionless group Dt/dt2 where D is the molecular diusivity. If this
group is less than about 0.001, then diusion has little eect except possibly for
subtle reactions such as crosslinking.
A geometrically similar scaleup in turbulent ow gives a pressure drop that increases as S 1/2 . More energy goes into pumping. The pumping energy increases as
ST S 1/2 and the pumping energy per unit throughput increases as S 1/2 . The extra
energy causes more eddy diusion and gives a better environment for reaction.
Unlike molecular diusion in a laminar-ow system, the benet from eddy diusion increases with size, but turbulence is unlikely when the continuous phase
contains a high molecular weight polymer.
For laminar ow of a Newtonian uid, scaleup at constant pressure drop is identical to scaleup with geometric similarity. For constant pressure drop in turbulent
ow, the reactor diameter increases somewhat faster, S 11/27 , than for scaleup with
geometric similarity. The reactor length increases somewhat more slowly, S 5/27 , so
that the reactor becomes shorter and fatter and heat transfer becomes substantially
more dicult.
Scaleup with constant heat transfer is theoretically possible with any form of
scaleup, provided the wall driving force can be adjusted as shown in Table 10.2.
As a practical matter, the required DT soon becomes excessive if signicant heating or cooling was needed in the pilot unit.

10.11

Static Mixers

Rather dierent considerations apply when a tube containing a static mixer is


scaled up. If the tube diameter increases upon scaleup, then the number of mixing
elements should also increase, but the increase is minor. For a scaleup based on
geometric similarity, the extra number of elements is given by Eq. (7).
Nextra

logS
3  log2

This result assumes the static mixer is of the Kenics type that repeatedly divides
the uid into two portions (that is, one that follows the 2 N model for striation
thickness). See Ref. 5 for details and results for other types of static mixers. Equa-

545

546

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

tion (7) is a slowly increasing function of S; for example, an increase by a factor of


512 in throughput requires only three extra elements.

10.12

Design Considerations for Tubular Reactors

As discussed above, shell-and-tube reactors and heat exchangers can be employed


in polymerization and recovery trains, provided the inlet and outlet streams have
similar viscosities. Subject to this caveat, scaleup is simple and inexpensive. Static
mixers are sometimes used to enhance heat exchange, but their benet is marginal
compared to the alternative of using open tubes with a somewhat smaller diameter
and greater length to give the same pressure drop. In this connection, there is no
minimum tube diameter. Some companies have used 0.5-inch (12.5-mm) tubes in a
variety of polymer processes since the 1960s. An insistence on large-diameter tubes
can lead product property problems.
Tubular reactors are rarely scaled in series because of pressure limitations. The
great exception to this statement is the high-pressure process for LDPE, where reactor lengths are measured in kilometers. The diameter of the tube is strictly limited to about 5 cm to avoid thermal runaway. A few tubes in parallel, possibly with
separate ethylene compressors, can be used to achieve greater capacity, but conventional shell-and-tube designs present a serious problem of tube-to-tube instability.
Scaleup to large-diameter tubes is generally possible only when the adiabatic
temperature rise is acceptable. A practical example of such scaleup is the adiabatic
post-reactor that is sometimes added to polystyrene reaction trains as an inexpensive way of boosting capacity. Tubular pilot reactors should be run adiabatically; or
if some removal of heat is needed, they should be run at the same value of the thermal diusion group, aT t/dt2 where aT is the thermal diusivity. This means running the pilot unit at the same value of t and d t but with a lower ow rate and a
shorter tube than expected in the scaled-up reactor. It is equivalent to scaling in
series. This approach will also give the same value of the molecular diusion
group, Dt/dt2 , where D is the molecular diusivity.
Typical vinyl polymerizations, for example of ethylene, propylene, vinyl chloride,
styrene, and methyl methacrylate, have adiabatic temperature rises between 200
and 1600 C. This leads to the possibility of parametric sensitivity and thermal runaway. Figure 10.2 demonstrates parametric sensitivity for styrene polymerization
in a tube that is assumed to be well mixed in the radial direction, as might result from the use of static mixers (that is, the model consists of simultaneous,
ordinary dierential equations for composition and temperature). The dramatic
transition from a controlled reaction to a thermal runaway corresponds to a mere
1 mm dierence in tube diameter. Although inlet and wall temperatures can be
varied, reaction in a large-diameter tube is not feasible for this and similarly energetic reactions absent an excellent control system [6]. A detailed model of this
polymerization in an open tube (the model consists of simultaneous, partial dierential equations for composition, temperature, and velocity) shows that hydrody-

10.12 Design Considerations for Tubular Reactors

500.0
0.062

Temperature, C

400.0

300.0

0.061

200.0

100.0

0.060

0.0
0.00

0.60

1.20

1.80

2.40

3.00

3.60

Axial Position, m
Temperature proles for the polymerization of
undiluted styrene in a tubular reactor with good radial mixing.
Tin 135 C and Twall 20 C. The parameter in the plot is the
tube diameter in meters.
Fig. 10.2.

namic instabilities can arise in the absence of static mixers due to large viscosity
dierences between the wall and centerline. For the illustrated case of Tin 135 C
and Twall 20 C, a hydrodynamic instability occurs at a smaller tube diameter
than for a thermal runaway. Installation of static mixers merely postpones the
problem until the marginally larger diameters shown in Figure 10.2 are reached.
The overall conclusion is that single-tube polymerization from undiluted styrene
is not feasible if the tube diameter exceeds about 0.06 m or if the conversion exceeds about 20%. Figure 10.3 illustrates the conversion and stability limits for
open tubes (tubes without a static mixer). Scaling in series using a long tube appears to be feasible for styrene polymerization, as it is for ethylene polymerization.
However, high pressures are not required for the styrene polymerization, and
stirred-tube reactors or boiling stirred tanks have been preferred.
Scaleup of polycondensation reactions involving multifunctional monomers (for
example, phenol/formaldehyde) in tubular reactors has proven especially dicult.
Even though the overall stoichiometry (for example, formaldehyde at 75 mol% of
the entering phenol concentration) is set to avoid crosslinking, locally crosslinked
regions near the tube walls can result when the diusion group, Dt/dt2 , is too
large. The ultimate result is a plugged tube. This empirical observation has been
conrmed in modeling studies. A similar problem may exist in anionically catalyzed polymerizations although modeling studies and some experimental studies
indicate that such polymerizations should be possible in tubular reactors.

547

548

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

Fig. 10.3. Polymerization of undiluted styrene in an open tube


with radial mixing only by molecular diusion. The mean
residence time used for conversion calculations is 1 hour.

10.14 Casting Systems

10.13

Extruder and Extruder-like Reactors

Extruders are sometimes used for polymer modication reactions such as grafting.
As a general rule, scaleup is dicult and expensive. The diculty is primarily due
to the very limited ability of extruders to exchange heat with an external source.
Most production-scale extruders operate almost adiabatically, with energy input
from the motor appearing as enthalpy of the product. This is in addition to any
reaction exotherm. The expense is due to the very high cost of reaction volume in
an extruder. As a practical matter, residence times are limited to a few minutes.
Like stirred tank reactors, extruders are generally scaled using geometric similarity
so that the ability to transfer heat decreases upon scaleup. Similarly, the screw
speed must generally decrease, or at least not decrease, upon scaleup. Extruders
operate in the laminar-ow regime, and the scaleup factor for power, as a function of screw diameter, is less dramatic than in stirred tanks, particularly for shearthinning polymer melts. As a rough approximation, power varies as conveying capacity, NI D 3 , so that the enthalpy input to the polymer is approximately constant.
However, extruders with a screw diameter of less than about 50 mm are generally
considered unscalable because the ratio of external area to volume is too large to
approximate to the nearly adiabatic operation expected upon scaleup.
The nishing reactors used to drive polycondensation reactions (for example, for
PET) to high molecular weights are extruder-like devices that generate surface area
for the removal of the condensation byproduct (such as ethylene glycol). Conven1/2
tional devolatilization theory suggests they scale as NI D 2 .

10.14

Casting Systems

We consider here two kinds of casting systems, mold casting and casting onto a
moving web. Reliable scaleup of mold casting requires an absence of polymerization byproducts, especially gaseous byproducts, and a manageable heat of reaction.
The polyurethane formulations used for RIM (reactive injection molding) have no
byproduct and a negligible heat of polymerization so that the molding process can
be scaled to quite large parts. Similarly, the ring-opening polymerization of caprolactam has no byproducts and an adiabatic temperature rise of about 60 C that can
be tolerated in the molding process. Again, quite large parts can be molded. Methyl
methacrylate has a substantial heat of reaction so that a large casting of pure
monomer would boil and ruin the part. Addition of the polymer, PMMA, to the
casting mixture lowers the possible temperature rise. It also increases the viscosity
so that the gel eect is enhanced. In PMMA, the gel eect is pronounced but the
polymerization stops well short of complete conversion because the mixture solidies. The result is that an adiabatic casting of a PMMA/methyl methacrylate mixture never reaches the boiling point of the monomer and a defect-free part is possible, even a large one.

549

550

10 Scaleup of Polymerization Processes

Web casting can be used for polymerizations that do have reaction byproducts
and large reaction exotherms. Examples of web-cast products include photographic
lms and coated abrasives. Here, the desired product is obtained directly as a lm
or sheet. Web casting can be used in belt-plus-aker operations where the web acts
a temporary polymerization reactor. Web casting is scaled up at constant web thickness and at constant residence time on the web. Production increases are achieved
by using wider webs or longer, higher-speed webs. The major issues for scaleup are
primarily the mechanical and control systems need to achieve a desired and uniform lm thickness.

10.15

Concluding Remarks

The scaleup of polymerization processes is conceptually identical to the scaleup


of ordinary chemical reactions. The principal dierence is that polymer systems
are more likely to be highly viscous and in laminar ow. Although polymer melts
can be markedly non-Newtonian, this is rarely a critical factor in the scaleup of
polymer reaction and recovery systems. Vinyl polymerizations have strong exotherms so that parametric sensitivity and thermal runaways can be a problem, but
so do many other chemical reactions. Condensation polymerizations tend to be
equilibrium-limited, but so do many other chemical reactions.
Laminar ow decreases heat and mass transfer both to the environment and
within the uid as molecular and thermal diusion replaces eddy diusion as the
primary mechanism, and their benets diminish upon scaleup. The large viscosity
dierences possible during polymerizations can lead to hydrodynamic instabilities
within a tube or between tubes. These problems are seldom found in ordinary
chemical reactions and prevent the easy application of shell-and-tube designs. The
net result is that scaling in series, either by increasing reactor length or by adding
reactors in series, is more common in the polymer industry than in the ordinary
chemical industry. The complications of laminar ow can also be avoided by suspending the polymer phase in a continuous, low-viscosity phase. Examples include
the gas-phase and slurry processes for polyolens as well as suspension and emulsion polymerizations.
Despite the complications that sometimes result from laminar ow, history has
shown that polymer processes can be scaled up with the same technical certainty
and the same good economics as for ordinary chemicals. If anything, the gains in
single-train production rates have been higher in polymers than in their associated
monomers.

Notation

A ext
dt

external area available for heat transfer


tube diameter

References

D
D
Gz
H
L
N
NI
Q
Re
S
SL
SR
ST
t
T
DT
u
V

impeller or extruder screw diameter


molecular diusivity
Graetz number, dt2 u/aT L
inside heat transfer coecient
tube length
number of elements in a static mixer
rotational velocity of impeller (rotations per unit time)
volumetric ow rate
Reynolds number, rd t u/m or rNI D 2 /m
volume or inventory scaling factor
length scaling factor
radius scaling factor
throughput scaling factor
mean residence time
temperature
temperature driving force
mean velocity
volume

Greek
m
r
r^

viscosity
density
volume-average density

References
1 Nauman, E. B., Chemical Reactor

Design, Optimization and Scaleup,


McGraw-Hill, NewYork, 2002.
2 Bisio, A., Kabel, R., Editors, Scaleup
in the Chemical Process Industries,
Wiley, New York, 1985.
3 McGreavy, C., Editor, Polymer Reactor Engineering, Blackie, London,
1994.
4 Paul, E. L., Atiemo-Obeng, V. A.,
Kresta, S. M., Editors, Handbook of

Industrial Mixing, Wiley, New York,


2004.
5 Thakur, R. K., Vial, Ch., Nigam,
K. D. P., Nauman, E. B., Djelveh, G.,
Static mixers in the process
industries, Chem. Eng. Res. Des., 81,
787826 (2003).
6 Mallikarjun, R., Nauman, E. B.,
Optimal processes for crystal
polystyrene, Polym. Plast. Tech. Eng.,
28, 137149 (1989).

551

553

11

Safety of Polymerization Processes1


Francis Stoessel
11.1

Introduction

Polymerization that is, polycondensation and polyaddition performed on an industrial scale presents a number of specic reaction and process engineering aspects which dierentiates these processes from reactions of low molecular weight
molecules. This is also true for aspects of the dynamic control of polymerization
reactors. Therefore the concepts developed for low-molecular-weight chemistry
must be adapted to the specic problems of polymerization reactions. The scope
of the present chapter is the assessment of risks linked with the performance of
polymerization reactions on an industrial scale. Moreover, the focus is on the control of the course of reaction by means of chemical reaction engineering [1]. Risks
linked with handling of raw material or products are not treated in this chapter.
Part of the chapter is based on a comprehensive text by Moritz [2], who is acknowledged for his authorization to use it here.
Barton and Nolan [3] and later Maddison and Rogers [4] analyzed the causes of
chemical runaway incidents based on statistics from the British Health and Safety
Executive. A classication by reaction type (Figure 11.1) reveals how prominent
polymerizations are. From 134 cases where the causes could be identied, 64 were
due to polymerization reactions, including polycondensations and polyadditions.
From these 64 polymerization incidents, 13 (20%) involved phenolformaldehyde
resin production. This led the British Plastics Federation (BPF) to publish a booklet, Guidance for the Safe Production of Phenolic Resins [5]. A further investigation
among more recent incidents involving polymer reactions showed that most of
the incidents occur in vinyl chloride, vinyl acetate, and polyester resins. Since polymerization is the type of reaction where most runaway situations occur, it is worth
devoting special attention to process safety. Understanding how a reaction may
leave its normal course and enter a runaway course is essential for the design
of safe and economic processes. This behavior has its roots in the thermodynamics
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

554

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Esterification
Oxidation
Diazotization
Amination
Alklation
Halogenation
Salt formation
Hydrolysis
Sulpfonation
Nitration
Polymerization
0
Fig. 11.1.

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

Number of runaway incidents, classied by reaction type.

and chemical engineering aspects of the reactions. This will be explained in the
present chapter.
In Section 11.2, general principles of reactor safety and heat balance of reactors
are presented, with an emphasis on specic aspects of polymerizations. Section
11.3 is devoted to safety-related thermodynamics and reaction engineering aspects
of polymerization reactions. In Section 11.4, cooling of polymerization reactors is
reviewed. The chapter is concluded by a section describing safety aspects of industrial processes, together with technical risk-reducing solutions.

11.2

Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization

Accidents happening in polymerization reactors are practically always due to a lack


of control of the course of reaction caused by a disturbance of the heat balance,
which results in a temperature increase leading to loss of control of the reactor
and a runaway reaction. In this section a systematic procedure based on a failure
scenario with six key questions, allowing assessment of the criticality of a process,
is presented. Since the heat balance is at the center of our concerns in matters of
thermal control of reactors, the dierent terms of the heat balance will be examined. Finally, aspects of the dynamic stability of reactors and of the thermal stability of reaction masses are analyzed.
11.2.1

Cooling Failure Scenario

A common practice in the assessment of risks due to runaway reactions is to use


the cooling failure scenario as developed by Gygax [1, 6]. This is a worst-case as-

11.2 Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization

Temperature
Tend
Tad

Decomposition
on
Reaction

MTSR

Main
i
Reaction
n

Reacti

TMRad

T ad
2

Tp
1
Normal
Process

Cooling
r
l n Failure
Time

Fig. 11.2. Cooling failure scenario, presenting the


consequences to the desired reaction of loss of cooling and
triggering of a secondary decomposition reaction. The numbers
represent the key questions used in the assessment of thermal
risks (see text).

sumption that is useful for the risk assessment. It is assumed that, while the reactor is at reaction temperature, a cooling failure occurs. If at this instant unconverted monomer is still present in the reactor, the temperature will increase due
to the completion of the reaction. This temperature increase is proportional to the
amount of nonreacted material. At the temperature reached at the end of this period, a secondary decomposition reaction may be triggered and the heat produced
by this reaction may lead to a further increase in temperature. The following questions help to develop the runaway scenario and to determine the data required for
the risk assessment. This scenario (Figure 11.2) was developed for chemical reactions in general and is well suited to polymerization reactions.
1. Can the process temperature be controlled by the cooling system? This is a typical question which should be answered during process development. To ensure
thermal control of the reaction, the power of the cooling system must be sucient to dissipate the heat produced in the reactor at any time. Special attention
must be devoted to the strong change in the viscosity of the reaction mass during polymerization and to possible fouling at the reactor wall (see Section 11.4).
An additional condition, which must be fullled, is that the reactor is operated
in the dynamic stability region as described in Section 11.2.4.
2. What temperature can be attained after runaway of the desired reaction? The

555

556

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

3.

4.

5.

6.

answer to this question necessitates a study of the kinetics of the reaction, in


order to determine the degree of accumulation of monomer in the reactor as a
function of time. The concept of MTSR (maximum temperature of the synthesis reaction) was developed for this purpose. In the case of polymerization reactions, the accumulation of monomer is not the only factor which must be
known; the number of living chains must also be considered.
What temperature can be attained after runaway by decomposition? The thermal data of the secondary decomposition reactions allow calculation of the adiabatic temperature rise and determination of the nal temperature, starting from
the level of the MTSR. This temperature gives a direct indication of the possible consequences of a runaway. In polymerization reactions, the temperature
reached after loss of control of the reaction itself will often determine the consequences. Polymerization reaction masses are often thermally stable, so this
question is often not relevant. Exceptions are polycondensation reactions, especially hot melts or reactive resins.
At which moment does the cooling failure have the worst consequences? Since
the amount of unconverted reactants and the thermal stability of the reaction
mass may vary with time, it is important to know at which instant the accumulation, and therefore the thermal potential, is highest. This will be the worst
case, and obviously the safety measures have to account for it.
How fast is the runaway of the desired reaction? Generally, industrial reactors
are operated at temperatures where the desired reaction is fast. Hence, a temperature increase above the normal process temperature will cause a signicant
acceleration of the reaction: therefore, in most cases, this period of time is
short. For polymerization reactions, where decomposition of the reaction mass
is not critical, this time will determine the choice of technical risk reduction
measures. The concept of time to maximum rate under adiabatic conditions
(TMR ad ) as used for decomposition reactions can be applied to the polymerization itself, starting from the process temperature. It allows estimation of the
probability of entering a runaway situation, as explained below for decomposition reactions.
How fast is the runaway of the decomposition starting at the MTSR? The dynamics of the decomposition reaction play an important role in the determination of the probability of an incident. The TMR ad concept was developed for that
purpose [7, 8]. The principles of using the time to explosion (TMR ad ) is that the
longer the time to explosion, the greater is the chance of recovering the situation. This means that for a longer time to explosion, the probability of triggering
the runaway is lower and, conversely, for a shorter TMR ad this probability is
higher.

The questions mentioned in this scenario can be answered using the results of calorimetric experiments which can be directly used in the determination of the characteristic temperature levels: after a cooling failure they will give us rst the temperature due to the runaway of the desired reaction, and then the temperature
reached after the runaway of the decomposition reaction (Tend ).

11.2 Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization

11.2.2

Criticality Classes Applied to Polymerization Reactors

For reactions presenting a thermal potential we can consider the relative position
of four temperature levels [9]:


The process temperature (TProcess ) is the initial temperature in the cooling failure
scenario. In the case of a non-isothermal process, the initial temperature will
be taken at the instant when the cooling failure has the heaviest consequences
(worst case) according to Question 4 in the scenario, above.
 The maximum temperature of synthesis reaction (MTSR) depends essentially
on the degree of accumulation of unconverted monomer and catalytic activity.
Therefore it is strongly dependent on the process design. In polymerization processes, this temperature is often high enough to become critical.
 The maximum temperature for technical reasons (MTT) represents the technical
limit of the equipment. In an open system, as for solution and emulsion polymerizations, it can be the boiling point. For a closed system, it is the temperature
at which the pressure reaches the maximum permissible, that is, the set pressure
of a safety valve or bursting disk. This could be the case for mass polymerization.
This temperature (MTT) is often the critical factor for polymerization reactions.
 The temperature at which the TMR ad is 24 h (TD24 ): this temperature is dened
by the thermal stability of the reaction mixture. It is the highest temperature at
which the thermal stability of the reaction mass is unproblematic. This is often a
secondary factor since polymerization masses are usually thermally stable.
These four temperature levels allow division of the scenarios into ve dierent
classes, going from the least critical (1) to the most critical (Figure 11.3).

Temperature
MTT

MTT
MTSR

MTSR

TD24
MTT
MTSR

MTT
MTSR

MTSR
MTT

TP
Class

5
Criticality
lt

Fig. 11.3.

Criticality classes of failure scenarios.

557

558

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

11.2.2.1


Description of the Criticality Classes

Class 1: After loss of control of the synthesis reaction, the MTT cannot be
reached and the decomposition reaction cannot be triggered. Only if the reaction
mass was maintained for a long time under heat accumulation conditions, could
the MTT be reached. Then the evaporative cooling may serve as an additional
safety barrier. The process is thermally safe.
Class 2: After loss of control of the synthesis reaction, the MTT cannot be
reached and the decomposition reaction cannot be triggered. The situation is
very similar to Class 1, but if the reaction mass is maintained for a longer time
under heat accumulation conditions, the decomposition reaction could be triggered and reach the MTT. In this case, reaching this temperature could be a hazard if the heat release rate at the MTT is too high with respect to vaporization or
pressure rise. If the reaction mass is not kept for a longer time under heat accumulation conditions, the process is thermally safe.
Class 3: After loss of control of the synthesis reaction, the MTT will be reached,
but the decomposition reaction cannot be triggered. In this situation, the safety
of the process depends on the heat release rate of the synthesis reaction and on
the pressure, respectively, at the MTT.
Class 4: After loss of control of the synthesis reaction, the MTT will be reached
and the decomposition reaction could theoretically be triggered. In this situation,
the safety of the process depends on the heat release rate of both the synthesis
reaction and the decomposition reaction at the MTT. Evaporative cooling or the
emergency pressure relief may serve as a safety barrier.
Class 5: After loss of control of the synthesis reaction, the decomposition reaction will be triggered and the MTT will be reached during the runaway of the decomposition reaction. It is very unlikely that the evaporative cooling or the emergency pressure relief can serve as a safety barrier in this case. The heat release
rate of the decomposition at the MTT determines the thermal safety of the process. This is the most critical of all the scenarios.

For polymerization reactions the relative positions of the MTSR and the MTT are
dominant: decomposition reactions play a role only in specic cases, such as resins. Thus the most important classes are 1 to 3, whereas the consequences of exceeding the MTT level may be dramatic.
These criticality classes are very useful in the decision making process of choosing the protection strategy for a reactor. Depending on the criticality class of the
scenario, dierent measures can be applied to avoid, to control, or to stop the
runaway:


Class 1: No special measure is required for this class of scenario. The evaporative
cooling or the emergency pressure relief could serve as a barrier.
 Class 2: No special measure is required. The reaction mass should not be held
for longer time under heat accumulation conditions. The evaporative cooling or
the emergency pressure relief could eventually serve as a barrier.

11.2 Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization




Class 3: The reaction medium temperature exceeds the technical possibilities of


the reactor. Thus technical measures are required. In a rst approach one should
try to avoid conditions in which a runaway situation develops. If this cannot be
ensured, then emergency measures are required.
 Class 4: Similar to Class 3. The same measures apply here but the additional
heat release rate due to the secondary reaction has also to be taken into account.
 Class 5: In this class the MTT is very unlikely to serve as a safety barrier. Therefore only emergency measures can be used. Since in most cases the decomposition reactions release very high energies, particular attention has to be paid to the
design of safety measures. It is worthwhile to consider an alternative design of
the process in order to reduce the severity, or at least the probability, of triggering
a runaway reaction.
11.2.3

Heat Balance of Reactors

The heat balance is important as well for the design of reactors, for their scaleup,
for the risk assessment, and especially for the assessment of the reactor stability.
The heat balance is also at the center of the evaluation of calorimetric experiments
as used for safety studies. Thus understanding the heat balance of a reactor is essential for the design of safe processes. Hereafter the dierent contributions to
the heat balance, such as the heat release rate of the reaction, the heat exchange
at the wall of the reactor, the heat dissipated by the stirrer, the heat accumulation
in the reactor, the eects of the sensible heat of the feed, and the heat losses, will
be discussed in detail. The dierent terms of the heat balance are expressed as heat
release rates or thermal power.
Heat Production
The heat production corresponds to the rate of heat release by the reaction. Therefore it is proportional to the reaction enthalpy and to the reaction rate [Eq. (1)].
11.2.3.1

qRX rA  DHR  V

This term will be of primary importance with respect to reactor safety: mastering
the heat release by the reaction is the key to reactor safety. For a single reaction of
order n, the reaction rate can be expressed as Equation (2).

rA k 0  exp



EA
 CAn
RT

Two features of these expressions are important for safety purposes: the heat release rate of a reaction is an exponential function of temperature. Secondly the
heat release rate is proportional to the volume of the reaction mass. Therefore it
will vary with the cube of the linear dimension of the vessel (L 3 ) containing the

559

560

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

reacting mass. It can also be expressed in a form allowing enhancement of the conversion rate [Eq. (3)].

qRX NA0  DHR

dX
dt

Consequently, the heat of reaction is obtained by integration, which allows one to


express the conversion as thermal conversion in Equation (4).
t
0
Xth y

qRX  dt

qRX  dt

qRX  dt

Q RX

The thermal conversion is often used in the kinetic evaluation of calorimetric experiments. It is also very useful for safety assessments, since it gives direct information on the accumulation of reactants that could react even after a cooling failure. The thermal conversion is used for the calculation of the MTSR.
Heat Exchange
There are several mechanisms for heat exchange between a reacting medium and a
heat carrier: radiation, conduction, and forced or natural convection. Here we shall
consider convection only.
The heat exchanged with a heat carrier across the reactor wall by forced convection is proportional to the heat exchange area and to the driving force, that is, the
temperature dierence between the reaction medium and the heat carrier. The proportionality coecient is the overall heat transfer coecient [Eq. (5)]
11.2.3.2

qEX U  A  T  TC

In the case of signicant change in the physical chemical properties of the reaction
mixture, which is quite common with polymerization reactions, the overall heat exchange coecient U will also become a function of time. This is essentially due to
the viscosity change during polymerization and to possible fouling at the reactor
wall, which may sometimes become important. With respect to safety, two important features must be considered here: the heat removal is a linear function of
temperature and since it is proportional to the heat exchange area, it varies as the
square of the linear dimension of the equipment (L 2 ). This means that when the
dimensions of a reactor have to be changed, as for scaleup, the heat removal capacity increases more slowly than the heat production rate. Therefore the heat balance
becomes more critical for larger reactors. The contribution of heat exchange to the
heat balance is examined in more detail in Section 11.4.1.

11.2 Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization

Heat Accumulation
Heat accumulation represents the variation of the energy content of a system with
temperature [Eq. (6)].
11.2.3.3

qAC MR  cp 

dT
dt

This includes all system compounds, the reaction mass as well as the reactor itself,
or at least the parts directly in contact with the reacting system. However, in safety
assessments, and as a worst case assumption, the heat capacity of the reactor itself
is often neglected. Since heat accumulation is the consequence of a dierence between heat production rate and cooling rate, it results in a variation of the temperature of the reactor contents.
Convective Heat Transport due to Feed
If a feed stream to a reactor is at a dierent temperature from the contents of the
reactor, there is convective heat transport to the reactor. The thermal eect of the
feed stream must be accounted for in the heat balance [Eq. (7)].
11.2.3.4

qFeed m_ Feed  cp; Feed  TFeed  T

This eect is also called sensible heat. It can also be used as an additional means
of cooling in semi-batch and in continuous reactors. When the temperature dierence between reactor and feed is important and/or the feed rate is high, this term
may play an important role. In such cases, when the feed is stopped an abrupt increase in the reactor temperature may result. This term is also important in calorimetric measurements, where the appropriate correction must be performed.
Stirrer
The mechanical energy dissipated by the agitator is converted into viscous friction
energy and nally altered into thermal energy. In most cases this term may be
neglected when compared to the heat released by a chemical reaction. But with
viscous reaction masses, as for example with polymerization reactions, this term
must be integrated in the heat balance. It can be estimated from Equation (8).
11.2.3.5

qS Ne  r  n 3  dS5

Computation of the thermal energy dissipated by a stirrer requires knowledge


of the Newton number, also called the power number, which depends on the
stirrer type and the ow regime characterized by the Reynolds number. The contribution of the stirrer power to the heat balance is examined in more detail in
Section 4.3.

561

562

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Heat Losses
Industrial reactors are thermally insulated for safety reasons (hot surfaces) and for
economic reasons (heat losses). Nevertheless, at higher temperatures heat losses
may become important. Their calculation may become tedious, since heat losses
are often due to a combination of losses by radiation and by natural convection. If
estimation is required, a simplied expression using a global overall heat transfer
coecient may be useful [Eq. (9)].
11.2.3.6

qLoss h  T  TAmb

The simplest way of estimating the overall heat transfer coecient (h) is by direct
measurement at plant scale.
Simplied Expression of the Heat Balance
An overall heat balance taking all the terms explained above into account can be
established [Eq. (10)].
11.2.3.7

qAC qRX qFeed qS  qEX  qLoss

10

But in most cases a simplied heat balance, which comprises only the most important terms on the right-hand side of Equation (10), is sucient for safety purposes.
Such an expression will be used in Section 11.2.4. The problems linked with the
cooling of polymerization reactors are presented in detail in Section 11.4.
11.2.4

Dynamic Control of Reactors

In fact a chemical reactor is governed simultaneously by its heat balance and its
mass balance. If we consider a single reaction of order n, we obtain a set of equations [Eqs. (11)].
8
dT
dXA U  A  T  TC
>
>
DTad 

>
<
dt
M R  cp
dt


>
>
dX
EA
>
n
: A k 0  exp
 CA0
 1  XA n
dt
RT

11

In this system of coupled dierential equations, the mass balance corresponds to


the reaction rate and the heat balance is a simplied version showing only the
heat production by the reaction and the heat removal by the cooling system, both
terms resulting in heat accumulation. This system presents the property of parametric sensitivity, meaning that a small change in one of the parameters may lead
to dramatic changes in the solution of the system of equations, that is, in the behavior of the reactor. This is an old [1012], but always real, problem [13, 14]. This
behavior may be observed for batch reactors and for tubular reactors (plug ow reactors) and also for bed reactors [15, 16]. Calorimetric methods make it possible to

11.2 Principles of Chemical Reactor Safety Applied to Polymerization

0.8

0.6
B

0.4
0.2

T(C)

0
0

50

100

150

200

Multiplicity of solutions for an exothermal reaction


performed in an adiabatic CSTR. The straight line represents
the heat balance and the S-shaped line the mass balance.
A: cold branch operating point. B: instable operating point.
C: hot branch operating point.
Fig. 11.4.

determine the data used to assess the dynamic stability of a reactor as a function of
the production scale [1719]. When performing this type of assessment, it is important to consider also variations in the overall heat transfer coecient and in the
temperature of the cooling system, which may vary with time or even with season.
A further specic aspect of the reactor heat balance is the multiplicity of solutions to the system of equations. This situation may arise with a CSTR in which
an exothermal reaction is performed. The mass balance [Eq. (12)] is coupled with
the heat balance [Eq. (13)], which gives a system of equations [Eq. (14)] that is represented graphically in Figure 11.4.
FA0  XA rA  V

12

qRX rA  V  DHR FA0  cp  TR  T0

13

XA

cp
1
 TR  T0
 TR  T0
DTad
DHR

14

In such cases, the temperature of the reactor may jump from the low-temperature
solution to the high-temperature solution, which can be catastrophic if the reactor
is not designed to be operated under these conditions. This problem was extensively studied by Ray and co-workers [20].
11.2.5

Thermal Stability of Polymerization Reaction Masses

Since polymerizations are very exothermal, the potential temperature increase in


the case of loss of control of the reaction itself is often great enough to cause evaporation of some components of the reaction mixture or even a partial cracking of

563

564

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

the polymer chains. Hence the pressure of the system may increase, and cause the
rupture of the vessel and consequently heavy damage to the plant and/or its environment. In most cases the thermal stability of polymerization reaction masses is
not critical by itself: the main risk stems from the intended polymerization reaction. In polyaddition reactions as used for the production of resins, and especially
of hot melts, the reaction mass remains reactive even after the end of the polymerization itself. Often curing is followed by a decomposition of the products that is
accompanied by large gas releases, which means that decomposition may easily result in the explosion of the vessel containing the resin. This kind of product may
present critical situations in the case of storage or transportation in large amounts.
This problem goes beyond the scope of this handbook, however.

11.3

Specic Safety Aspects of Polymerization Reactions

Polymerization reactions form a well dened and specic class of reactions. They
present some special features linked to the reaction kinetics and also to the thermodynamic aspects. These topics are presented in this section together with the
factors that may aect the reaction rate.
11.3.1

Kinetic Aspects

The reactions taking place during the synthesis of a polymer are rather complex
in nature. The description of the chemistry of a polymerization reaction often
involves over 20 dierent elementary reactions. This means that control of the
overall reaction rate that governs the process safety may be rather complicated.
Nevertheless the kinetically determining step in polymerization reactions is the
chain growth reaction.
With respect to chain growth, two main types of reaction may be distinguished
(Table 11.1). One type is the addition of one monomer molecule at a time at the

Tab. 11.1.

Polymerization mechanisms.

Type of chain growth [a]

Reaction steps

Terminology for reaction

Monomer addition

Pn M ! Pn1

initiation
growth
termination
transfer
growth

polymerization
(radical, ionic, coordination)

Polymer addition
Pn Pm T Pmn X
[a] P  :

n active monomer molecule with chain length n; M: monomer; Pn :


bifunctional polymer molecule with length n; X: low molecular
condensation product.

polycondensation
polyaddition

11.3 Specic Safety Aspects of Polymerization Reactions

end of a growing chain until the chain is terminated. This is called a chain growth
polymerization. The active center may be a free radical, an ion, or an available coordination bond on a transition metal complex of the catalyst. Once the active center is created, the growth of the chain is very fast, which results in a very short
living time for the active chain in the order of seconds until it is deactivated
by termination. Thus the concentration of active chains is extremely low, at approximately 108 mol L1 . This renders these polymerizations very sensitive to
impurities. After termination a dead polymer chain remains, but in the case of
free-radical polymerization the dead chain may react again with further radicals.
The other possible growth mechanism involves two molecules carrying reactive
groups, which react together leading to the addition of monomers, oligomers, or
polymers. In this case the growth is achieved by the addition of longer elements
than in chain growth. This type of reaction is called step growth polymerization,
polyaddition, or polycondensation. With this mechanism, the growth of the chain
proceeds more slowly, so the lifetime of the active chain and therefore the polymerization time are longer. These are often equilibrated reactions, so that the low molecular by-products must be removed from the reaction mass in order to shift the
equilibrium toward the products.
These dierent chain growth mechanisms result also in dierent activation energies. These are in the order of magnitude of only 20 kJ mol1 for chain growth
polymerizations. But polycondensations and polyaddition present high activation
energies in the order of 100 kJ mol1 . Consequently the reaction temperatures are
very dierent: whereas polymerizations are often performed at modest temperature levels from 50 to 100 C, polycondensations require higher temperatures between 150 and 250 C. Since the activation energy dictates also the variation of the
reaction rate with temperature, chain growth polymerizations are less sensitive to
temperature excursions than step growth polymerizations are.
11.3.2

Thermochemical Aspects

Polymerizations are generally exothermal reactions with specic energies up to


3600 kJ kg1 , corresponding to an adiabatic temperature rise of up to 1800 K.
Some typical reaction enthalpies are presented in Table 11.2, together with the specic heat of reaction and adiabatic temperature rise obtained for mass polymerization. Most free-radical and ionic polymerizations have negative standard enthalpies
and standard entropies; thus at higher temperatures these reactions must be considered reversible [Eq. (15)].

Pn M Pn1

15

As for every reversible exothermal reaction, there is an equilibrium temperature at


which the chain growth and depolymerization rates are equal. This temperature is
called the ceiling temperature and is related to the equilibrium concentration of
the monomer according to Eq. (16).

565

566

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes


Typical reaction enthalpies and corresponding adiabatic temperature rises.

Tab. 11.2.

Monomer

Ethylene
Propene
Isobutene
Butadiene
Isoprene
Chloroprene
Acrylamide[b]
Acrylonitrile
Acrylic acid
Methyl acrylate
Methyl methacrylate
Vinyl acetate
Vinyl propionate
Vinyl chloride
Vinylidene chloride
Styrene
a-Methylstyrene
Ethylene oxide
Propylene oxide
Trioxane[c]
e-Caprolactam
2-Pyrrolidone

Physical
state [a]

Temperature
[ C]

CDHR
[kJ molC1 ]

CDHR
[kJ kgC1 ]

CDT ad [ C]

gc
lc
lc
lc
lc
lc
s
l c0
lc
lc
lc
lc
lc
lc
l c0
lc
lc
l c0
g
s c0
lc
lc

25
25
25
25
25
61.3
74.5
74.5
74.5
76.8
74.5
74.5
74.5
25
25
25
25
25
25
30
200
75

101.5
84
48
73
75
68
81.5
76.5
67
78
55.5
88
86
71
75.5
70
35
94.5
75.5
19.5
15.5
4.5

3620
2000
855
1350
1100
768
1147
1423
930
1100
550
1022
860
1135
780
672
296
2145
1300
216
137
53

1810
1000
428
676
559
384
574
721
465
435
277
511
430
542
390
336
148
1073
650
108
68
26

[a] Physical state: l: liquid; g: gas; s: in solution, c: condensed


amorphous, c 0 : crystalline or part crystalline.
[b] Solvent is water.
[c] Solvent is methylene chloride.

TC

DHR
DS 0 R ln CM; C

16

It is important to realize that the ceiling temperature is not a constant, but it is a


function of the monomer concentration. For most monomers, this equilibrium
concentration is lower than the detection limit of common analytical methods. An
exception is a-methylstyrene, with a ceiling temperature of 61 C for 100% monomer and a concentration of 2.2 mol L1 at 25 C.
In the runaway of a polymerization, if a temperature in the range of the ceiling
temperature may be reached, or in other words the MTSR may be close to the ceiling temperature (MTSR A TC ), then the safety analysis must account for the contribution of the depolymerization reaction, which produces low molecular species
and may result in a pressure increase. This can easily be realized with the criticality classes presented above, by choosing the temperature TD24 on the basis of the
depolymerization reaction.

11.3 Specic Safety Aspects of Polymerization Reactions

q kW

800

0.8

600

0.6

400

0.4

200

0.2

0
0

t (h)

Heat release rate (solid line) and monomer


conversion (broken line) during the polymerization of 5000 kg
vinyl chloride and 5000 kg water as a suspension. (after
Hamielec [21]).
Fig. 11.5.

The high enthalpy of reaction and the high concentrations often used in industrial polymerization processes lead to very high heat release rates. As an example
[21], the polymerization of vinyl chloride as a 50% (by weight) suspension in water
with a charge of 5000 kg vinyl chloride and 5000 kg water releases an energy of 5.7
GJ and the heat release rate is about 780 kW (Figure 11.5). This high heat ow
presents an engineering challenge in order to ensure a sucient heat transfer
coecient.
The high heat release rates observed in polymerization reactions do not represent by themselves the only safety engineering problem. A further issue is the
fact that the reaction dynamics leads to fast changes of the heat release rate during
the process. This in turn requires a fast-acting temperature control system, which
may be dicult to achieve for large reactor volumes. In the example given in Figure 11.5, after about 40 to 50 minutes of reaction time, corresponding to 5 to 10%
conversion, the heat release rate increases from 100 to over 700 kW. This is even
more dicult, in the sense that the reaction temperature should be maintained
constant in order to obtain the required properties of the nal product. The accumulated heat at this stage represents approximately 90%, or 5.4 GJ. This energy
could lead to an adiabatic temperature increase of over 1900 K if not controlled
by the temperature control system. The thermodynamic characteristics of the reaction and the heat transfer capability of the reactor may lead to a parameter combination giving rise to the parametric sensitivity as explained in Section 11.2.4 and
Eq. (11).

567

568

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

7.7 % MAA

q (W)
30

6.3 % MAA
20

1.7 % MAA

10

0
0

Fig. 11.6. Heat release rate as a function of


time for the copolymerization of methacrylic
acid (MAA) with styrene in emulsion with
dierent mass fractions of methacrylic acid.
The self-accelerating behavior corresponding

t (h)

to the gel eect is evident after 20 min.


Composition of the reaction mass: 418 g water,
120 g styrene, 10/8/2 g methacrylic acid, 0.505
g K2 S2 O8 , 7 g Na dodecylbenzenesulfonate.

11.3.3

Factors Leading to Changing Heat Release Rates

Some polymerization processes present a particular kinetic behavior: after a certain


time the reaction accelerates itself, leading to an increase in the heat release rate.
This can be exemplied with the copolymerization of styrene and methacrylic acid
in emulsion [22]. At the beginning of the polymerization, a fast increase of the
heat release rate is observed (Figure 11.6). This is due to the formation of latex particles that are essentially nucleated during the initial reaction phase: the reaction
rate is often proportional to the number of latex particles. For higher concentrations of methacrylic acid, a second acceleration of the reaction can be observed:
this self-acceleration is also called gel eect or the Tromsdor eect. It is due to
the fact that the viscosity of the reaction mixture increases and the termination reactions of radical chains become diusion controlled. Thus the concentration of
living chains increases and so does the heat release of the reaction. This phenomenon appears as a self-acceleration, and like other types of self-accelerated reactions,
this is also sensitive to small changes in the process conditions. This is shown in
Figure 11.6 by the changes in the initial concentration of methacrylic acid, which
cause amplied changes in the maximum heat release rate and also in the time
point where this maximum occurs. The maximum heat release rate increases
from 14 W kg1 with 1.7% methacrylic acid to 30 or 40 W kg1 when the concentration is increased to 6.3 or 7.7%.

11.3 Specic Safety Aspects of Polymerization Reactions

q (W)

20

10

0
0

Heat release rate as a function of


time for the copolymerization of methacrylic
acid (MAA) with styrene in emulsion following
a seeding process. The mass fraction of
methacrylic acid was varied: solid line, 10%;
Fig. 11.7.

t (h)

broken line, 4.2%; dotted line, 1.7%.


Composition of the reaction mass: 451 g water,
9 g styrene as seed (dP 112 nm), 108/115/
118 g styrene, 12/5/2 g methacrylic acid, 0.505
g K2 S2 O8 , 0.26 g Na dodecylbenzenesulfonate.

The same copolymerization performed as a seeding process shows a totally different behavior that implies dramatic changes in the heat release rate as a function
of time. In a seeding polymerization, the time required for the formation of the
latex particles disappears because a given amount of latex particles are added at
the beginning of the process [22]. Therefore the particles swell in the presence of
the monomer and only the phases of particle growth and monomer depletion can
be observed (Figure 11.7). This leads to an initial heat release rate, which remains
practically constant during particle growth. The reaction seems to follow a zeroorder rate law. Then after a period of time depending on the initial concentration
of methacrylic acid, the gel eect leads to an increasing reaction rate. Consequently
the heat release rate increases practically exponentially, even under isothermal conditions. The time interval after which this increase occurs and the maximum heat
release rate depend on the concentration of methacrylic acid. Such a behavior may
easily lead to a runaway situation if not anticipated. Additionally the particle size of
the seed aects the dynamic behavior of the reaction.
Therefore it is essential to study the thermal behavior of a polymerization reaction during process development. A safe process may only be designed if these
phenomena are thoroughly understood and if the corresponding engineering
means are used for scaleup. A well suited tool for this kind of study is reaction calorimetry [2326].

569

570

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

11.4

Cooling of Polymerization Reactors

Dierent technical means may be used for cooling industrial reactors. Among
them we consider three methods: direct cooling using the sensible heat of a feed
stream, which was treated in Section 11.2.3; indirect cooling using heat exchange
across the reactor wall or with internal cooling systems; and hot cooling using the
latent heat of evaporation. These latter two cooling techniques are discussed in
Sections 11.4.1 and 11.4.2. In Section 11.4.3, the problem of viscosity change is
examined.
11.4.1

Indirect Cooling: Heat Exchange Across the Reactor Wall

The heat transfer across a wall can be expressed by the general equation, Eq. (5). In
practice, the temperature dierence between the reaction medium and the cooling
system must remain within reasonable limits. One limitation is given by the dynamic stability in the case of a batch reaction. But another limitation is due to the
fact that too low a wall temperature may cause the buildup of a polymer lm, or
fouling at the inner side of the wall. In a homogeneous reaction mixture, even
without fouling, the resistance of the laminar heat transfer lm increases as the
wall temperature decreases. The result is that too low a cooling medium temperature may have adverse results, since the reduction of the heat transfer coecient
may overcome the benets of the higher temperature gradient. Increasing the
heat transfer area by using inserts such as cooling coils or other shapes of built-in
heat exchangers is often problematic. These inserts may enhance the formation of
a polymer lm at the wall and they also may have a negative impact on the agitation of the reaction mass. Further, they render the cleaning operations of the reactor more dicult. Another method, which is often used to increase the heat exchange area in low molecular reactions, is loop circulation through an external
heat exchanger. This technique may be inadequate if the polymers are sensitive to
the shear forces that will arise in a circulation pump. In certain cases reactors with
an increased height to diameter ratio are used in order to increase the specic cooling area.
The problem of the determination of the overall heat transfer coecient can be
simplied if one considers that the overall resistance to heat transfer consists of
several resistances in series [Eq. (17)].
1
1 dp dw df
1
1 dp 1


U
hR lp lw lf hC hR lp j
|{z} |{z}
depends on
reaction mass

17

depends
on reactor

The rst two terms, representing the liquid lm at the inner wall of the reactor and
any polymer deposit, only depend on the reactor contents, that is, on the agitation

11.4 Cooling of Polymerization Reactors

and on the physical properties of the reaction mass. Here the resistance of the internal laminar lm and of the polymer deposit at the wall play a key role. Therefore
the reactor should be cleaned regularly with high-pressure cleaner. The last three
terms depend on the reactor itself, especially on its heat exchange system, that is,
on the reactor wall, on fouling in the jacket and on external liquid lm. They are
often grouped into one term: the equipment heat transfer coecient (j). For the
description of the heat transfer coecient of the internal lm, there are several correlations available, the most popular of which is presented in Eq. (18) [27].
Nu C te  Re 2/3  Pr 1/3 

m
mW

0:14
18

This expression is valid for Newtonian uids; therefore with polymers its validity
must be veried. In this correlation, the dimensionless numbers are dened in
Eq. (19). Here the Reynolds number (Re) is expressed for a stirred tank where the
ow rate corresponds to the tip speed of the agitator.
Nu

hR  dR
l

Re

n  dS2  r
m

Pr

m  cp
l

19

The last term in Eq. (18) represents the ratio of the viscosity of the reaction mass at
reaction (bulk) temperature to its viscosity at wall temperature. It accounts for the
changes of the heat transfer coecient, when switching from heating to cooling.
This produces an inversion of the temperature gradient and therefore aects the
viscosity of the product close to the reactor wall. With reactions performed in solvents it can generally be neglected, but may become important in the case of polymers: the viscosity of the reaction mass is often important and its temperature dependence may give this term a value that cannot be neglected. Equation (18) can be
solved for hR, the internal lm heat transfer coecient. By grouping the terms in
an appropriate way, the heat transfer coecient of the reaction mass can be split
into two parts, one (z) representing the technical data of the reactor and the other
(g) grouping the physical properties of the reaction mass [Eq. (20)]. The gravity
constant g is introduced to rend the rst term dimensionless and to give the second the dimensions of a heat transfer coecient.
s
2/3 4/3
2 2
3 r l cp g
dS
te n
z:g
20
hR C
1/3
dR g
m
|{z}
|{z}
technical data
physical--chemical data
of the reactor

of the reaction mass

Thus, for a given reaction mass, the heat transfer coecient of the internal lm
can be inuenced by the revolution speed of the agitator and its diameter. The
value of z, characterizing the internal part of the equipment factor, can be calculated using the geometric characteristics of the reactor. Some typical values of the
agitator constant are given in Table 11.3. The value of g can either be calculated

571

572

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes


Tab. 11.3.

Typical agitator constants.

Agitator

Constant

Plate stirrer
Rushton turbine
Rushton turbine with pitched blades
Propeller
Anchor
Impeller
Intermig (Ekato)

0.36
0.54
0.53
0.54
0.36
0.33
0.54

0.01

1/U

0.009

slope = z.. =0.00192

0.008

1/(T) = 0.00802

0.007
0.006

/
(n/n0)-2/3

0.1

0.2
2

0.3

0.4
.

Wilson plot measured with toluene


in a reaction calorimeter. The reciprocal heat
transfer coecient is plotted against the
agitator revolution speed to the power 2/3.
Fig. 11.8.

0.5

0.6
.

0.7

0.8
.

0.9

The intercept with the ordinate represents the


reciprocal heat transfer coecient of the
equipment and either z or g can be determined
from the slope of the straight line.

from the physical properties of the reactor contents as far as they are known or
measured in a reaction calorimeter by the Wilson plot method [28, 29]. This parameter is independent of the geometry or size of the reactor. Thus it can be determined at laboratory scale and used at industrial scale. The Wilson plot consists of
the determination of the overall heat transfer coecient as a function of the agitator revolution speed in a reaction calorimeter. The Wilson plot (Figure 11.8) makes
it possible to verify that the correlation in Eq. (18) is valid: if the measures t on a
straight line, a validation is built into the method. The intercept with the ordinate
represents the reciprocal heat transfer coecient of the equipment, that is, the wall
and the external cooling system of the calorimeter. The slope is the product of z
and g, which allows the determination of either one of these parameters. In a rst
stage, z is determined by a calibration performed using a solvent with known physical properties. In a second stage g is determined during the actual measurement
with the reaction mixture.
Moreover, the contribution of polymer deposits to the overall resistance to heat
transfer may be important. Since the thermal conductivity of polymers is low, they

11.4 Cooling of Polymerization Reactors


Tab. 11.4. Factors inuencing the heat transfer with some typical values of heat transfer
coecients in an agitated reactor.

Type

Inuencing factors

Typical values
[ W mC2 KC1 ]

Internal lm
hR forced convection

stirrer: speed and type


reaction mass cp ; l; r; h
physical data, especially
r f T

water
toluene
glycerol

1000
300
50

water
gases
With d 1 mm,
PE
PVC, PS
With d 10 mm,
iron
stainless steel
glass
glass lined
With d 0:1 mm,
Gallert
Kesselstein
water
with ow
no ow
evaporation

100
10

1000
100
3000

water
with ow
no ow

2000
200

hR natural convection
(stirrer failure)
Polymer deposit

Reactor wall l/d

Fouling at external wall

External lm hc

thermal conductivity l
thickness of deposit
construction
wall thickness d
construction material
coating
thermal conductivity l
thickness of deposit
jacket
construction, ow rate
heat carrier, physical
properties, phase
change
welded half coil
construction, ow rate
physical properties

300
170
4800
1600
100
800
3000
5000

act as insulators, and thus even thin deposits may aect strongly the heat transfer
coecient, as shown in Table 11.4.
The resistance of the reactor wall and external lm (hc ) can be determined in
a cooling experiment realized directly with the production reactor lled with a
known amount of a substance (M) with known physical chemical properties. The
temperature TR of the contents of the reactor and the average temperature TC of
the cooling system are recorded during this experiment. A heat balance can be
calculated between two instants t1 and t2 : the heat removed from the contents of
the reactor is given by Eq. (21), and this is realized with an average cooling power
given by Eq. (22) with the average temperature dierence as expressed in Eq. (23).
Q M  cp  TR1  TR2

21

qEX U  A  DT

22

DT

TR1  TC2  TR2  TC2


lnTR1  TC1  lnTR2  TC2

23

573

574

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

The overall heat transfer coecient can then be obtained from the heat balance
equation [Eq. (24)].
U

M  cP  TR1  TR2
A  DT  t2  t1

24

This is a simplied method using only two points. A more accurate method is to
use more points by applying the dierential equation of Newtonian cooling, which
expresses the variation with time of the temperature dierence between reactor
contents and cooling system [Eq. (25)].
M  cP 

dDT
U  A  dt
DT

25

By integration, with the initial condition: t 0, DT DT0 T0  TC , one obtains


Eq. (26) with the thermal time constant tc of the reactor given by Eq. (27).


DT
t

ln
DT0
tC
tC


or

DT
DT0



t
exp 
tC

M  cP
UA

26
27

Thus a plot of the logarithm of the ratio of the instantaneous temperature dierence to the initial temperature dierence, as a function of time, should give a
straight line, as far as cooling is Newtonian. The slope of this line is the thermal
time constant of the reactor, from which the overall heat transfer coecient U
can be calculated.
Then the equipment heat transfer coecient j can be calculated from Eq. (28)
written for a clean reactor. If there was some polymer deposit at the reactor wall
during the cooling experiment, its resistance must be taken into account.
1
1
1

j U zg

28

For the calculation of the heat transfer coecient of the external lm some models
are also available. These models describe the hydraulics of the ow in the jacket or
in the half-welded coils. The results depend strongly on the technical design of
these parts of the equipment. Direct measurement is mostly preferred.
11.4.2

Hot Cooling: Cooling by Evaporation

Hot cooling, which uses the latent heat of evaporation of a solvent, is a very ecient technique: on one hand it is independent of the heat transfer at the reactor

11.4 Cooling of Polymerization Reactors

wall, and on the other hand the condenser can be designed independently of
the reactors geometry. This allows relatively high specic cooling powers to be
reached. In case a reaction cannot be performed at boiling temperature, it is possible to work under partial vacuum in order to decrease the boiling point and to
work at reux. Hot cooling can be used as the main cooling system for a reactor
working under normal operating conditions; it can also be used as an emergency
cooling system, in cases when the boiling point is reached during the temperature
increase following a failure of the main cooling system. Obviously, this is only possible provided the condenser is equipped with an independent cooling system and
the equipment has been designed for this purpose.
The boiling rate of the solvent, depending on the instantaneous heat release rate
of the reaction, governs the whole design of the reux system. Some technical aspects and limitations must be considered in the design of such cooling systems.
Too high a boiling rate could lead to ooding of the vapor tube, when the condensate ows down in countercurrent to the rising vapor. Further, the presence of
vapor bubbles in the reaction mass increases its apparent volume. The reaction
mass swells, and if its level is high enough to enter the vapor tube, again ooding
will occur. A method was developed for predicting these limitations [30, 31]. If the
boiling point is reached during runaway, like in scenario of criticality classes 3 or 4,
a possible secondary eect of the evaporation is the formation of an explosive vapor
cloud, which in turn can lead to a severe room explosion if ignited. In some cases,
there is enough solvent present in the reaction mixture to compensate for the energy release, allowing the temperature to be stabilized at the boiling point. This is
only possible if the solvent can be distilled o in a safe way, to a catch pot or a
scrubber. The thermal stability of the concentrated reaction mixture must also be
ensured. In most cases, however, the condensed solvent is reuxed to the reactor.
If the capacity of the reux system is sucient, all of the vapor produced by an
exothermal reaction can be conducted from the reactor to the condenser, where it
is entirely condensed. In such a case, the boiling point may act as a safety barrier.
In the opposite situation, if the ow rate is too high with respect to the capacity of
the system, a pressure increase will result. This may be due to ooding of the
vapor tube or to swelling of the reaction mass. This pressure increase may in turn
lead to the rupture of the weakest element in the distillation system, followed by
the release of a vapor cloud, which could be ignited and cause a vapor cloud explosion. Further, if the condenser capacity is too short, uncondensed vapor will pass to
the ventilation system, where it could cause a secondary incident, if it is not compatible with the design. For these reasons, it is essential to know the vapor ow
rate due to an exothermic reaction, which depends on the latent heat of evaporation of the solvent. The capacity of the reux system will be assessed using the
vapor velocity in the dierent parts of the equipment [Eq. (29)].
u

qRX
DHV rG S

29

If the diameter of the vapor tube is insucient for a given vapor release rate, the

575

576
Tab. 11.5.

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Limiting vapour velocity for dierent solvents.


Solvent

DHv [kJ kg1 ]


Tb [ C]
Mw [g mol1 ]
P [mbar]
rg [kg m3 ]
umax [m s1 ]

water

methanol

ethanol

acetone

dichloromethane

chlorobenzene

toluene

m-xylene

2260
100
18
1013
0.59
10.2

1100
65
32
1013
1.15
6.6

846
78
46
1013
1.60
5.3

523
56
58
1013
2.15
5.1

329
40
85
1013
3.31
4.5

325
132
112
1013
3.37
4.4

356
111
92
1013
2.92
4.8

343
139
106
1013
3.13
4.6

high vapor velocity results in a pressure increase in the reactor leading to a temperature increase and a further acceleration of the reaction. The consequence will be a
thermal explosion until the rupture of weak parts of the equipment allows pressure
relief. In order to avoid this type of reaction course, it is important to know the
maximum vapor velocity admissible in a given tube and consequently the maximum admissible heat release rate for the reaction. To predict whether ooding
will occur in existing equipment, an empirical correlation was established experimentally [31]. The experimental study was performed in the laboratory, in the pilot
plant and on an industrial scale with various organic solvents and water for tubes
with an inside diameter between 6 and 141 mm. The maximum allowable heat release rate is obviously a function of the latent heat of evaporation and of the tube
cross-section. It can be calculated by Eq. (30).
q max 4:52DHV 3:37  10 6 S

30

Calculations performed for dierent common solvents show that the limiting velocity remains relatively constant for dierent classes of solvents. Some values are
shown in Table 11.5. This allows the required vapor tube diameter d for a given
heat release rate for dierent solvents to be calculated (Figure 11.9).
The relative volume increase due to swelling of the reaction mass can be estimated using the Wilson correlation (Eqs. (31), (32) with the conditions: if u~ < 2
then K 0:68, a 0:62; or if u~ b 2 then K 0:88, a 0:40) [32, 33]. This correlation was rst established for air in water; it is easy to use and was found to describe with enough accuracy the swelling of a liquid by bubbles of its vapor.

aK
a

rV
rL  rV

HB  H0
HB

0:17

~0:1 u~ a
D
H

DH
~H r
D
s
g  rL  rV

31
u
u~ s
r
s
g
g  rL  rV

32

11.4 Cooling of Polymerization Reactors

5000

q (kW)

Water

4000
3000
Methanol
Ethanol
i-Propanol
Acetone
Other solvents

2000
1000
d (m)

0
0

0.1

0.2

0.3

0.4

0.5

0.6

Heat release rate at ooding as a function of the


vapor tube (riser) diameter for dierent solvents.
Fig. 11.9.

5
ug (m/s)

Water

4
3

Ethanol

Toluene

0
0

0.1

0.2
.

0.3

0.4
.

0.5

0.6
.

Maximum allowed vapor velocity ug across the


surface of the reaction mass as a function of its degree of
swelling a.
Fig. 11.10.

The correlation allows the maximum admissible heat release rate for given plant
equipment to be calculated, or equipment for the requirements of a given process
to be designed (Figure 11.10). They are both based on easily accessible physicalchemical properties of the boiling solvent and on geometric data of the reactor.
Such considerations make it possible to adapt the equipment or the process, that
is, the degree of lling of the reactor, to the safety requirements. This kind of measure often allows processes to be run under safe conditions, whereas a classical assessment would consider them to be critical.

577

578

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Nu

mPas

Fig. 11.11. Nusselt number as a function of


the apparent viscosity during reticulation of
poly(vinyl alcohol) in aqueous solution in a
laboratory reactor with an anchor stirrer.

Geometry VR 1:3 L, D 0:1 m, dR /D 0:95,


H/D 1:9, r 1000 kg m3 , l 0:65
W m1 K1 . After Schmidt and Reichert [38].

11.4.3

Importance of the Viscosity

In polymerizations the uid often does not behave in a Newtonian manner. In


such cases Eqs. (18)(20) do not apply as such, and modied equations must be
used. It could be shown experimentally [3436] that the shear forces are proportional to the agitator revolution speed, meaning that an average shear force in the
reactor can be used and the dynamic viscosity can be replaced by an apparent viscosity [37]. Such an example is illustrated in Figure 11.11, where the variation of
the Nusselt number Nu during a polymerization shows the decrease in the overall
heat transfer by a factor of three when the viscosity increases by over one order of
magnitude [38]. In mass polymerization an increase of the viscosity by six or seven
orders of magnitude is common. This means that the viscosity is a key factor for
the control of a polymerization reactor, that is, for its safety.
In fact the viscosity inuences both the heat balance and the mass balance. It
has been shown how the heat transfer coecient is aected by the viscosity. But
the energy dissipation by the stirrer is also strongly dependent on viscosity (see
Section 11.4.4). Furthermore, viscosity aects the molecular diusion, the mass
transport, the mixing time, or the residence time distribution, and therefore the reaction rate. Since the reaction rates inuence the chain length and particle sizes,
they have a direct eect on the polymer properties. In turn they aect the viscosity
and the shear forces there is a feedback eect. Such complex interactions cannot
be described by analytical equations, so empirical models must be used. Often

11.5 Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes

these models are very specic for a given reaction system and even for a reactor
geometry. Their use aords deep chemical and engineering knowledge and experience. To give an example, increasing the stirrer speed in order to improve the heat
transfer may result in an adverse situation: one reason is that the heat dissipation
by the stirrer is increased. But a further eect may arise at the same time: the mixing time is reduced, enhancing the mass transfer and resulting in an increase in
the reaction rate that leads to an eect opposite to the initial intention.

11.5

Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes

Chemical reaction engineering traditionally addresses the design of processes operated under nominal operating conditions. But if the same principles are used to
design the process to remain safe even under conditions deviating from the intended conditions, it becomes a strong tool for improving process safety [1]. For
this reason, in this section the dierent reactor types are analyzed with regard to
their safe operation and especially to the design in order to prevent runaway.
Some further risk-reducing techniques for stopping a commencing runaway or
mitigating its consequences are also presented.
11.5.1

Batch Processes

Batch processes are characterized by a closed mass balance. This means that during the reaction nothing is added to or withdrawn from the reactor. In fact we consider as batch processes those where the monomer and the solvent, if there is one,
are added at the beginning of the reaction. The initiator or catalyst is also added at
the beginning of an operation. We extend this denition to processes where a volatile compound is evaporated in order to shift the equilibrium to the products, as is
often the case with polyadditions or polycondensations. In these processes the control of the temperature is the unique way of controlling the reaction course. Dierent strategies of temperature control may be used in this situation.
An isothermal operation requires the cooling capacity to be sucient at any time
to compensate for the heat release rate of the reaction. Moreover, the dynamics of
the cooling system must allow sharp changes in the reaction rate, which are often
observed in polymerization reactions (see Section 3.3), to be followed. Due to the
high energy of reaction, this kind of process is only possible in diluted systems as
emulsion polymerization or polymerization in solution.
In most cases non-isothermal processes are used. A part of the energy of the reaction is used to heat the reactor to the desired process temperature in the so-called
polytropic reaction mode. A typical temperature control strategy is to use an adiabatic phase, during which there is no cooling, so that the correct initiation of the
reaction can be checked. Then, in a second stage, after reaching a specied temperature, the cooling system is switched. The correct choice of the initial temperature

579

580

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

and of the cooling system switching temperature is critical for the process safety.
This type of strategy is often used in polyaddition or polycondensation reactions,
where high reaction temperatures are desired. Advanced temperature control strategies allowing the optimization of productivity, but taking technical limitations of
the plant equipment into account, are proposed [39]. Great care must be used to
avoid working in the parametrically sensitive eld. Thus a thorough study of the
process by reaction calorimetry is essential for the safe design of such processes.
The aim of process design should be to develop processes that are tolerant to a failure of the cooling system. This is often a utopian dream, due to the high energy of
polymerization reactions.
In batch operation, the correct charge of the reactor is essential, and requires
great care by the operators, because this is often a manual operation. In every
case a batch process requires emergency measures to be taken in order to recover
control of the reactor when the cooling system fails, or at least to mitigate the consequences of a runaway. The scenario presented in Section 11.2 is a great help for
this purpose.
11.5.2

Semi-batch Processes

In semi-batch operation only a part of the monomer, or no monomer at all, is initially charged. The main part of the monomer is added to the reactor during the
process, allowing additional control of the reaction course and of the polymer properties by adjusting the feed rate. In such processes the accumulation of monomer
and therefore of heat is limited to a fraction of the overall heat. Such processes are
often used for emulsion polymerizations. The continuous feed also reduces the instantaneous heat release by the reaction and requires less cooling capacity. A correct choice of the concentrations and of the temperature even makes it possible to
achieve a so-called feed-controlled process. This means that the monomer entering
the reactor is immediately converted; that is, there is no monomer accumulation.
In such a situation the reaction rate is equal to the feed rate, which can easily be
adapted to the cooling capacity of the reactor (Figure 11.12). In the case of any failure, stopping the feed immediately stops the reaction and the heat production.
Thus the temperature can be stabilized, making it possible to design fail safe
processes.
The design of a safe semi-batch process requires a strict control of the accumulation of unconverted monomer. In fact the accumulation results from a balance
between monomer addition by the feed, and monomer conversion by the reaction.
Thus it can be inuenced by the feed rate, but also by the reaction rate, which in
turn can be governed by the temperature and the initiator or catalyst concentration.
These parameters must be optimized during process development. Here again, reaction calorimetry is of great help for the determination of the accumulation [40].
It can be calculated from thermal conversion by means of Eq. (4) obtained directly
from the calorimetric measurement and the actual amount fed. Just by varying the

11.5 Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes


q RX (W/kg)

60
50

X acc

0.3
0.2

40
30
20

0.1
t (h))

t (h)

10
0

0
0

10

10

12

Fig. 11.12. Heat release rate and accumulation obtained in a


semi-batch reaction for dierent feed rates: 2, 4 and 6 h.

feed rate and the process temperature, one can verify that the heat release rate of
the reaction never exceeds the cooling capacity of the reactor. A second constraint
is the maximum allowed temperature in the case of a cooling failure, that is, the
accumulation, and therefore the MTSR should remain below a given level (Figure
11.12) [41, 42].
In practice, emulsion polymerizations are often performed according to the
monomer feed process with an initial charge of the monomer, the remaining being
fed over time. Figure 11.13 represents a schematic example of an emulsion polymerization according to the monomer feed process [2]. In such processes three
phases may be distinguished: the initiation, the feed and the end of reaction. In
this example, the delay between initiator addition and continuous feed was varied.
Initiation
In a rst stage, an initial amount of monomer is added to the reactor. This addition
is immediately followed by the addition of the initiator. During the delay between
initiator addition and monomer feed, inhibition of the polymerization may occur.
This depends on the purity of the reactants and on the oxygen concentration remaining in the reactor. Then a fast increase in the thermal power follows: it is
due to formation of the particles. On an industrial scale, such a fast increase of
heat release rates may generally not be compensated by the comparatively slow
cooling system, and results in an accumulation of heat, that is, an increase in the
reactor temperature. But at this stage, the monomer concentration is still low.
Often the total amount of water was charged initially, conferring a high heat capacity on the system. Thus the resulting temperature increase during this stage remains low. In fact the initial charge must be optimized in such a way that the
initiation remains safe. In the case of emulsion feed polymerizations, the initial
contents of the reactor represent an aliquot of the total batch. The situation is similar to the monomer feed process, since the initial charge may be designed in such
a way that the temperature increase remains within critical limits. The cooling
capacity, and sometimes also the heat capacity, of the reactor are high enough to
limit the initial temperature excursion.
11.5.2.1

581

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Initial
i l monomer charge

dN/dt

Initiation

Optimal feed

Feed
d

Initial
i
monomer charge

dN/dt

Initiation

r too early
Feed start

Feed

dN/dt
Initial
i
monomer charge

582

Initiation

Feed start too late

Feed

Fig. 11.13. Schematic representations of the


molar ow rates of monomer in a semi-batch
emulsion polymerization. Top graph: the feed
is optimal; it is immediately converted. Middle
graph: the feed was started too early; the

t
reaction course is no longer controlled by the
feed. Bottom graph: the feed was started too
late; the accumulation results in a quasi
runaway situation.

Feed
After the particle growth stage of the emulsion polymerization is terminated, the
monomer concentration within the latex particles decreases and so does the heat
production rate. In the meantime, the temperature control system is able to reduce
the temperature of the jacket. When the molar ow rate (mol s1 ) of the monomer
11.5.2.2

11.5 Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes

depletion reaches a value corresponding approximately to the molar ow rate of


the intended feed, the monomer feed should be started (Figure 11.13, top graph).
This allows compensation in order to maintain the concentration constant; that is,
a quasi steady state can be achieved. The reactor is cooled by two methods: heat
exchange across the wall, and via the sensible heat of the cold feed. Here, the emulsion feed processes obviously show an advantage due to the higher heat capacity of
the emulsion compared to the monomer.
The right time point for starting the feed is an important safety-relevant parameter. If the feed is started too early during the particle formation period (Figure
11.13, central graph), an accumulation of monomer may result. This will cause an
increase in the reaction rate and result in an uncontrollable temperature increase
even a runaway reaction. Matching of feed rate and reaction rate, allowing control
of the course of the polymerization, is only achieved in the very late stages of the
feed time, if ever. If the feed is started too late, the situation may become even
worse (Figure 11.13, bottom graph): the monomer initially present is already converted and the heat release rate is low. But the jacket may still be at a low temperature due to the previous exotherm, and undercool the reactor. Since the feed is
increasing the monomer concentration at too low a reaction rate, an accumulation
will occur and may lead to a sudden wake up of the reaction, which in turn could
result in a runaway situation.
Final Stage
After the end of the feed period, the heat release rate decreases as a consequence of
the monomer depletion. This third stage is very similar to a batch reaction, because
the reaction rate can no longer be inuenced by the feed.
11.5.2.3

Practical Aspects
The diculty concerning the initiation on an industrial scale is that the actual initiation of the polymerization must be recognized before a great amount of monomer is added to the reactor. This can be realized either by chemical in-line analysis,
or by a heat balance on the industrial reactor [43]. If the initiation fails and the
feed is continued, it may lead to an accumulation of monomer that could react
spontaneously in an uncontrolled way. Thus the process becomes a batch reaction,
for which the reactor is not designed.
In a semi-batch reaction, overcooling, or too low a temperature, may be as critical as too high a temperature, because the reaction rate is lower and the resulting
accumulation may be important. If the temperature is adjusted to its nominal
value, the accumulated monomer may also react in an uncontrolled way, leading
to a runaway reaction. This may be due to degradation of the initiator which slows
down the reaction. Such eects can be detected by a heat balance on industrial reactors.
For polymerization or copolymerization processes performed in semi-batch reactors, the feed rate can also be adjusted to meet quality criteria [4448]. Advanced
techniques are proposed to control the feed rate by taking into account simultaneously productivity and safety criteria [49, 50].
11.5.2.4

583

584

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Thus not only does a safe process result from sound development, working out
the right process parameters, but on an industrial scale it must be checked that the
polymerization remains on the right path.
11.5.3

Continuous Processes

In continuous polymerizations, the main problem is the dynamic stability of the


reactor. The stability problems have various dierent aspects: the thermal stability
as introduced above (see Section 11.2.4), the concentration stability, the particle
number stability, and the viscosity stability. Even under isothermal conditions these
problems may lead to multiplicity or oscillatory behavior. It is worth emphasizing
the fact that stability and safety are in no case synonymous: a reactor may be unsafe even if working at a stable working point, or conversely it may be run safely at
an instable working point. But knowledge of stability limits of the reactor is essential for the design of a safe process.
Concentration Stability
In a continuous stirred tank reactor (CSTR) where a homogeneous polymerization
is being performed, the mass balance or the performance equation can be written
in a very simple way [Eq. (33)].
11.5.3.1

dX X

dt
t

33

If the reaction follows an autocatalytic kinetic equation, like polymerizations exhibiting the Tromsdor eect, then the conversion rate as a function of conversion,
dX/dt f X, shows a typical maximum curve [51]. The operating point is found
at the intercept of the kinetics line and a straight line with the space time reciprocal as the slope. This conguration leads to a multiplicity of solutions as represented in Figure 11.14 for several values of the space time. In a range of space
time between t1 and t3 , there are three solutions. The upper and lower solutions
are stable, whereas the intermediate one is instable. In such a situation, the CSTR
should be designed to be operated at the high conversion point (hot branch, or ignited reactor). This allows for a higher productivity and a safer behavior if the high
cooling capacity required can be achieved. If the reactor is operated at the lower
conversion point (cold branch), a small perturbation, for example of a feed pump,
may ignite the reactor, which suddenly jumps to the hot branch, with high conversion. This could lead to a runaway.
Particle Number Stability
The particle size stability is a special form of the dynamic concentration stability
[52]. If the emulsier is present at a concentration above the critical concentration,
new particles will be created. Thus the area growth rate, and therefore the emulsier consumption, are increased. Then the emulsier supply by the feed may be in11.5.3.2

11.5 Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes

dX/dtt

1
2

X
Fig. 11.14. Schematic representation of the
conversion rate as a function of conversion
(solid line) in an isothermal CSTR with a
polymerization presenting a gel eect. Three

dierent space times are represented by the


three operating lines (broken lines). Filled
circles represent stable operating points and
the white circle an unstable operating point.

sucient to ensure coverage of the particles surface. This stops the nucleation process of new particles. Since the particles are washed out by the reactor outlet, only
fewer, but larger, particles remain in the reactor. The specic interfacial area decreases until the emulsier consumption becomes lower than the supply. Then
the concentration increases, and a new cycle starts. These oscillations may occur
especially during start-up of the reactor. They result in oscillations of the conversion that impinge on the quality of the product. They can be avoided by using a
adequate seeding policy for the reactor.
11.5.4

Design Measures for Safety

Safety measures or risk-reducing measures must be considered under the aspect of


inherent safety. Kletz [53], who was the promoter of these ideas for a long time,
formulated some principles for reduction of risks:






intensication, using so little hazardous material that it will not matter if it all
leaks out;
substitution, using a safer material instead;
attenuation, using a hazardous material in a safer form;
limitation of the eects of failures, not by adding on protective equipment but by
equipment design or changing the conditions of use;
simplication, as complex plants provide more opportunities for human error
and contain more equipment that can go wrong;

585

586

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes




avoiding knock-on or domino eects;


making incorrect assembly dicult or impossible;
 making the state of equipment, such as open or shut, clear;
 designing equipment that is able to withstand incorrect installation or operation;
 making equipment easy to control.


Following these principles in a more specic way for polymerization reactions,


three levels of priority can be dened: in decreasing order, the rst priority is the
reduction of severity by design. As a second priority, technical measures for control
of the reaction to avoid runaway should be considered. The aim is to obtain a fail
safe process by reduction of the probability of occurrence of an incident. As last
resort only, emergency measures should be taken in order to mitigate the consequences of runaway. In any case, the basic principle remains: Avoid runaway
rather than mitigate its consequences.
With reference to this principle, dierent types of risk-reducing measures can be
considered for polymerization reactions (Sections 11.5.4.111.5.4.10).
Process Design
Semi-batch processes are preferred to batch processes where possible. This point
was made sbove (see Section 11.4). Continuous processes allow the inventory of reaction mass to be reduced, and represent an elegant way of reducing the severity of
a process.
11.5.4.1

Reactor Design
Many design elements are in fact preventive measures. Some of them will be mentioned here. One may consider building a reactor resistant to the maximum pressure even in the case of loss of control of the polymerization. Often the nal pressure obtained with polymerization reactions is not so high. Another important
element is the agitation. The agitator ensures uniform mixing over a large range
of viscosities, avoids local concentration of reactants that could lead to hot spots,
and ensures heat transfer. The agitation is also required for temperature measurement, that in turn ensures control of the reactor. In this context it is important to
keep heat exchange surfaces (and also the thermometer) clean.
Temperature is often the key parameter for process safety; thus redundant systems should be used, since failure rates in the order of magnitude of one per year
are reported for them. The temperature probe must be correctly located and the
temperature recorded so that trends can be followed. This is essential for safety as
well as for product quality. The rate of temperature change can also represent very
important information for process control. Utility-independent thermometers are
also very useful. The temperature of the cooling system (if possible at the inlet
and outlet of the jacket) should be monitored.
The process should be designed in order to provide adequate heating proles, especially to avoid inadvertent fast heating. An interlock may stop heating in the case
of malfunction.
When reux cooling is used, one must avoid deposits inside the condenser
11.5.4.2

11.5 Chemical Engineering for the Safety of Polymerization Processes

tubes. To do so, the condenser can be pitched to assist drainage, and must be sized
to prevent ooding. The process must be designed to avoid foam-up of the reaction
mixture (swelling; see Section 11.4.2).
Services are very important for the control of the reaction. Redundant systems
should be provided for electrical power, as well as compressed air or inert gases.
The electricity supply must be examined in detail during risk analysis: motors
that is, feeding and cooling pumps, agitators, vacuum, and feed will be stopped
if the electrical power fails. Moreover, instruments dependent on compressed air
become inoperative. For this reason, the fail safe position of valves (open for cooling, closed for heating) should be considered.
Failure of vacuum at reux may lead to the development of a hazardous situation: the boiling point, and thus the reaction temperature, increase and may end
up in a runaway situation.
Control of Feed
In semi-batch or continuous operation, the feed rate allows control of the reaction
course. Hence it plays an important role concerning the safety of the process. With
an exothermal reaction, it is important to be able to limit the feed rate by technical
means. One possibility is feed by portions, a method that is only applicable for
semi-batch reactors. This mode of addition is the traditional way of limiting accumulation. In this case, the addition must be controlled by the conversion: that is,
the next portion is added only if the previous portion has been consumed by the
reaction. Dierent criteria can be used to follow the reaction: the temperature, the
appearance of the reaction mass, chemical analysis, and so on. For a well designed
process, the additions can also be performed on a time basis.
Another possibility is to use a feed tank with a control valve and gravimetric ow.
The valve can be controlled by the weight of the reactor, by the weight of the tank,
by the level in the tank, or by a ow meter. The maximal feed rate can be limited by
the clearance of the valve or by a calibrated orice. If a centrifugal pump is used, it
is necessary to provide also a control valve to limit the ow rate. The ow control
strategies are the same as those described above. With a metering pump, the
through ow rate can be controlled by a stroke adjusting mechanism or a variable
speed drive acting on the stoke frequency. The control can be realized by a xed
adjustment or by through a ow meter.
11.5.4.3

Emergency Cooling
If the cooling system fails, water can be supplied from a hydrant to the cooling
jacket or coil, or an independent emergency cooling system can be provided. With
such a system, it is critical that the temperature does not fall below the solidication point of the reaction mass, or otherwise a crust would form, resulting in reduced heat transfer, which again may favor the runaway situation. The agitation
of the reaction mass is also critical in such a situation: large reaction masses behave adiabatically in practice, even if cooled on the outside. Here the injection of
nitrogen into the bottom of the reaction mass has proven to be helpful for an emergency mixing. Such equipment must be tested under practical conditions.
11.5.4.4

587

588

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Inhibition
This technique may be applied to catalytic reactions where an inhibitor can be
added in small amounts. Mixing is an especially critical factor here, since a small
amount of inhibitor has to be added and mixed into a large volume of reaction mixture [54, 55].
11.5.4.5

Quenching
Some reactions can be stopped by the addition of a suitable component. Dilution
by an inert and cold material may lower the temperature to slow down the reaction. For this type of measure, the critical factors are the amount and rate of addition and the temperature of the quenching material. The required empty volume
must be also be available in the reactor. Calorimetric methods are of great help in
the design of such measures, because they allow measurement of the heat of mixing, which is often important, and the thermal stability of the resulting mixture.
11.5.4.6

Dumping
This measure is similar to quenching, with the dierence that the reaction mass is
not kept within the reactor, but transferred into a vessel containing the inhibitor or
the diluting compound. This vessel must be prepared to receive the reaction mass
at any instant during the process. The transfer line is critical for the success of this
measure. It must be designed to allow an emergency transfer even in the case of
breakdown of the utilities. This measure is particularly suitable in cases where the
reaction mass must be transferred for workup after a normal operation.
11.5.4.7

Controlled Depressurization
If a runaway is detected in an early stage, where the temperature and the pressure
increase is slow, a controlled depressurization of the reactor can be considered. This
is only suitable for cases where a volatile solvent is present; the reactor is slowly
depressurized until evaporative cooling occurs. Obviously, a scrubber and/or a reux condenser must be installed and designed to work with independent utilities.
11.5.4.8

Pressure Relief
This measure will not be described in detail in this chapter. The design of venting
lines for reactions with thermal potential is a complex matter. There are examples
where pressure release was able to protect reactors from an explosion, but also
cases where a reactor exploded, even with an open manhole. This measure only
applies with reaction systems where the pressure still increases signicantly for
small temperature increases above the normal operating level. In addition, the discharge line must end in a catch tank or in a scrubber to avoid spillage with possibly
toxic or ammable material. The behavior of the reaction mass that is, the temperature and pressure increase under runaway conditions must be known. Critical factors are foaming and two-phase ow, which require specic design methods
[5659]. Special care must be taken to dene the runaway scenario against which
the reactor has to be protected. Emergency vent systems may also be designed for
liquid discharge (dumping).
11.5.4.9

11.6 Conclusion

T
Time to effect
Time to action
Alarm level

Effect

Time to discovery

t
Time to Maximum Rate
Fig. 11.15.

Chronological development of contingency measures.

Time Factor
Time plays a primary role in the eciency of a measure. The following steps must
be taken from the instant a failure occurs up to recovery of the control of the
process (see Figure 11.15): First, when a failure or a malfunction occurs, it must
be detected. The detection time can be inuenced by the choice of appropriate
alarm settings and instrumentation. But the most important is the choice of an
adequate parameter which must be monitored to detect a malfunction. The design
of alarms, interlocks, and control strategies is an important part of process design.
Once the alarm is switched on, some time is required for the measure to be applied. Quenching or dumping requires some time for the transfer of the mass, an
emergency cooling system must be switched on, and the cooling medium must
ow at the required temperature with the required ow rate. Finally, the measure
must become eective: Some time also elapses from the instant when the measure
was applied until its eects become sensitive to the process. This is especially true
with large reactors such as those used in polymerization processes. This time factor must be estimated for an eective design of safety measures, and compared
with the dynamics of the runaway of the desired reaction and of decomposition reactions. Here the TMR ad concept (Section 11.2.1) is of great help.
11.5.4.10

11.6

Conclusion

Even if polymerization reactions are critical from the point of view of thermal process safety, there are means to systematically identify the risks and to design the

589

590

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

reactors in order to minimize the risks. The systematic evaluation scheme presented in this text has proven to be well suited for risk identication. A method
based on the criticality classes and on calorimetric tools for process development
has been presented. Despite the fact that more advanced methods are available,
these nd only few applications in the industrial practice. This is probably not
due to their inherent quality, but may be an eect of long-term traditions in the
polymer industry, which render innovation more dicult.
References
1 R. Gygax, Chemical Engineering
2

4
5

7
8
9
10
11
12

13

14
15
16
17

Science, 1988, 43(8), 1759.


H. U. Moritz, Sichere Handhabung
chemischer Reaktionen, Dechema,
Frankfurt a.M., 1995, Vol. 3, p. 115.
J. A. Barton, P. F. Nolan, Safety of
chemical batch reactors and storage
tanks, ECSC, EEC, EAEC, Brussels,
1991.
N. Maddison, R. L. Rogers, Chemical
Technology Europe, 1994, 1112, 28.
P. A. Dunn, Guidance for the safe
production of phenolic resins, British
Plastics Federation, London, 1979.
R. Gygax, ESCIS (Expert Commission
for Safety in the Swiss Chemical
Industry), Lucerne, 1993, Vol. 8.
R. Gygax, Chemical Engineering
Progress, 1990, 53.
D. I. Townsend, J. C. Tou,
Thermochimica Acta, 1980, 37, 1.
F. Stoessel, Chemical Engineering
Progress, 1993, 10, 68.
C. Van-Heerden, Industrial Engineering Chemistry, 1953, 45(6), 1242.
N. R. Amundson, O. Bilous, AIChE
Journal, 1955, 1(4), 513.
R. Aris, Introduction to the analysis of
chemical reactors, Prentice-Hall,
Englewood Clis, 1965.
A. Varma, M. Morbidelli, H. Wu,
Cambridge University Press,
Cambridge, UK, 1999.
P. Hugo, Chemie Ingenieur Technik,
1980, 52(9), 712.
K. Y. Choi, W. H. Ray, Chemical
Engineering Science, 1988, 43(10), 2587.
K. Y. Choi, W. H. Ray, Chemical
Engineering Science, 1985, 40(12), 2261.
B. Hentschel, Chemie Ingenieur
Technik, 1979, 51(8), 823.

18 H. U. Moritz, Third Berlin Inter-

19

20

21

22
23
24

25

26
27
28

29
30
31
32

33

national Workshop on Polymer Reaction


Engineering, VCH, Weinheim, 1989.
H. G. Poersch-Parke, A. Avela, K. H.
Reichert, Chemie Ingenieur Technik,
1989, 61(10), 808.
A. Uppal, W. H. Ray, A. B. Poore,
Chemical Engineering Science, 1974,
29(4), 967.
A. E. Hamielec, Course Notes, Course
on Polymer Reaction Engineering,
McMaster University, Hamilton,
Ontario, 1980.
M. Klocke, Thesis, Universitat-GH,
Paderborn, 1995.
F. Stoessel, Journal of Thermal
Analysis, 1997, 49, 1677.
R. N. Landau, L. R. Williams,
Chemical Engineering Progress, 1991,
12, 65.
W. Regenass, 8th RC1 User Forum
Hilton Head SC, USA, Mettler-Toledo,
1996.
W. Regenass, Chimia, 1997, 51, 189.
VDI-Warmeatlas, VDI-Verlag, Dusseldorf, 1974.
J. R. Bourne, M. Buerli, W. Regenass, Chemical Engineering Science,
1981, 36, 347.
S. Choudhury, L. Utiger, Chemie
Ingenieur Technik, 1990, 62(2), 154.
J. Wiss, F. Stoessel, G. Kille, Chimia,
1990, 44(12), 401.
J. Wiss, F. Stoessel, G. Kille, Chimia,
1993, 47(11), 417.
J. F. Wilson, R. J. Grenda, J. F.
Patterson, Trans. Am. Nucl. Soc.,
1961, 4(37), 356.
J. F. Wilson, R. J. Grenda, J. F.
Patterson, Trans. Am. Nucl. Soc.,
1962, 5(25), 151.

Notation
34 M. F. Edwards, W. L. Wilkinson,

35
36
37

38

39
40
41

42

43
44

45
46

47

Chemical Engineering (London), 1972,


265, 328.
A. B. Metzner, R. E. Otto, AIChE
Journal, 1957, 3, 3.
H. U. Moritz, Chemical Engineering
Technology, 1989, 71.
A. Steiff, R. Poggemann, P. M.
Weinspach, Chemie Ingenieur Technik,
1980, 52(6), 492.
C. U. Schmidt, K. H. Reichert,
Chemie Ingenieur Technik, 1987, 59,
739.
C. Gentric et al., Chemical
Engineering Journal, 1999, 75, 31.
F. Stoessel, Chemical Engineering
Progress, 1995, 9, 46.
P. Hugo, J. Steinbach, F. Stoessel,
Chemical Engineering Science, 1988,
43(8), 2147.
F. Stoessel, O. Ubrich, Journal of
Thermal Analysis and Calorimetry,
2001, 64, 61.
J. Schmidt, H. Giesbrecht, Chemie
Ingenieur Technik, 1996, 68(9), 1144.
I. S. d. Buruaga, M. Arotcarena,
P. D. Armitage, L. M. Gugliotta,
Chemical Engineering Science, 1996,
51(11), 2781.
G. Arzamendi, J. Asua, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1991, 30, 1342.
A. Urretabizkaia, J. R. Leiza, J. M.
Asua, AIChE Journal, 1994, 40(11),
1850.
I. S. d. Buruaga, A. Echevarria, P. D.

48

49
50
51

52
53
54

55

56

57

58
59

Armitage, J. C. D. L. Cal, R. Leiza,


J. M. Asua, AIChE Journal, 1997,
43(4), 1069.
L. M. Gugliotta, J. R. Leiza, M.
Arotcarena, P. D. Armitage, J. M.
Asua, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 1995, 34,
3899.
T. J. Crowley, K. Y. Choi, Journal of
Process Control, 1996, 6(23), 119.
O. Abel et al., Journal of Process
Control, 2000, 10(4), 351.
R. S. Knorr, K. F. ODriscoll,
Journal of Applied Polymer Science,
1970, 14, 2683.
G. Ley, H. Gerrens, Makromolekulare
Chemie, 1974, 75, 563.
T. A. Kletz, Process Safety Progress,
1996, 15(1), 5.
ter, A. Steiff,
S. Kammel, U. Schlu
P. M. Weinspach, Chemical Engineering Science, 1996, 51(10), 2253.
H. Niemann, S. Lighart, S.
Duffield, A. Schipper, PPSS96,
Houston, TX, 1996.
J. Etchells, J. Wilday, Workbook for
chemical reactor relief system sizing,
HSE, Norwich, UK, 1998.
Guidelines for pressure relief and euent
handling systems, CCPS-AICHE, New
York, 1998.
J. Schmidt, F. Westphal, Chemie
Ingenieur Technik, 1997, 69(6), 776.
J. Schmidt, F. Westphal, Chemie
Ingenieur Technik, 1997, 69(8),
1074.

Notation

Symbol

Name

Practical unit

SI unit

A
A; P

heat exchange area


chemical
compounds
concentration
specic heat
capacity
diameter or
thickness
diameter
activation energy

m2

m2

mol L1
J kg1 K1

mol m3
J g1 K1

m
J mol1

m
J mol1

C
cP
d
D
Ea

591

592

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

F
g
h
H
DHR
DHV
k
k0
m_
M
MR
n
n
N
q
Q
r
R
S
S
t
T
u
U
V
X
z

molar ow rate
acceleration due to
gravity
heat transfer
coecient
height
molar enthalpy of
reaction
specic enthalpy of
vaporization
rate constant
frequency factor
mass ow rate
monomer
mass of reaction
mixture
order of reaction
revolution frequency
number of moles
heat release rate
thermal energy
(heat)
rate of reaction
universal gas
constant
cross-section
entropy
time
temperature
linear velocity
overall heat transfer
coecient
volume
conversion
equipment constant
(stirred tank)

mol h1
m s2

mol s1
m s2

W m2 K1

W m2 K1

m
kJ mol1

m
J mol1

kJ kg1

J g1

function of rate law


function of rate law
kg h1

function of rate law


function of rate law
g s1

kg

rpm

W
kJ

s1

W
J

mol m3 h1


J mol1 K1
L mbar mol1 K1
2
m
J K1
h

C
m s1
W m2 K1

mol m3 s1


J mol1 K1

s
K
m s1
W m2 K1

m3

m3

m2

Subscripts

Subscript

Meaning

Example

0
A; B; P; R; S

initial value
chemical compounds

T0
CA

initial temperature
concentration of A

Notation

AC
ad
C
ex
f
Feed
G
Loss
M
P
P
R
RX
S
TAmb
th
V
W

accumulation
adiabatic
coolant
exchange (heat exchange)
fouling
feed
gas
loss
monomer
process
polymer
reactor, reaction mass
reaction
stirrer
ambient
thermal
vapor
wall

Xac
DTad
TAmb
TC
qex
df
TFeed
rG
qLoss
CM
TP
lP
dR
qRX
dS
Xth
mV
dW

degree of accumulation
adiabatic temperature rise
ambient temperature
temperature of coolant
heat dissipation rate
thickness of fouling lm
specic weight of gas
Monomer concentration
process temperature
thermal conductivity of polymer
diameter of reactor
heat release rate of reaction
stirrer diameter
thermal conversion
mass ow rate of vapor
wall thickness

Greek

Symbol

Name

Practical unit

SI unit

a
g

relative volume increase


material constant for heat
transfer
dierence (used as prex)
heat transfer coecient
of equipment
thermal conductivity
dynamic viscosity
specic weight
surface tension
time constant
space time in continuous
reactor

W m2 K1

W m2 K1

W m2 K1

W m2 K1

W m1 K1
cP mPa s
kg m3
N m1 10 3 dyn cm1
h
h

W m1 K1
Pa s
g m3
N m1 ( kg s2 )
s
s

D
j
l
m
r
s
t
t

Acronyms
MTSR
MTT
TMR ad

maximum temperature of synthesis reaction


maximum temperature for technical reasons
time to maximum rate under adiabatic conditions (time to explosion)

593

594

11 Safety of Polymerization Processes

Dimensionless groups

Symbol

Name

Expression

Ne

Newton (power)
number

Ne

P
r  nS3  dS5

Nu

Nusselt number

Nu

hd
l

Pr

Prandtl number

Pr

m  Cp
l

Re

Reynolds number
(stirred tank)

Re

n  d2  r
m

Parameters
P power of stirrer
r specic weight of uid
nS revolution speed
dS stirrer diameter
h lm heat transfer
coecient
d characteristic length
l thermal conductivity
m dynamic viscosity
Cp specic heat capacity
l thermal conductivity
n stirrer frequency
d diameter of agitator
r specic weight
m dynamic viscosity

595

12

Measurement and Control of Polymerization


Reactors1
John R. R. Richards and John P. C. Congalidis
12.1

Introduction

Consistent polymer properties are of paramount importance to end-user manufacturers who must produce the polymer in its nal form and shape for the intended
application. These properties are the result of complex polymer architecture and
composition formed in reaction and perhaps further inuenced in isolation and
extrusion processes. Producing consistent, uniform, and in-specication polymer
for the end-user are the tasks of the polymer process measurement and control
systems.
Polymer processes, whether batch or continuous, rarely run under stable equilibrium conditions. However, in order to operate such processes safely and in order to
set the characteristics of the products optimally, a set of process manipulated variables must be kept constant or systematically modied over the duration of the reaction or in the course of the various reaction steps. The main process variables of
this type are temperature, pressure, concentration, amount, ow, and level. Speeds
(agitator, gear pumps, extruders), power input and viscosity can be of substantial
importance also.
This chapter will discuss various measurement techniques of importance to engineers and scientists designing and operating polymer reactors and associated
equipment. We will then discuss basic control concepts and conclude with more
advanced control strategies. We have attempted to expand and update the ne
chapter from the previous edition of this book [1].
12.1.1

Denitions

The rst step in the objective of obtaining constant or systematically adjusted operating conditions is the proper measurement of process variables. There are vari1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

596

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

ous organizations developing standards pertaining to measurement and control,


including the US National Institute of Standards and Technology (NIST), the
Deutsches Institut fur Normung (DIN), the International Organization for Standardization (ISO), and the International Electrotechnical Commission (IEC).
In measurement technology there are a number of standard measurement concepts [28]:









A measurement installation translates the measurement quantity to a measured


value.
The measured value consists of a numerical value and a unit of measurement.
The result of measurement consists of several measured values, which can be reproduced as a value or a curve of values.
The measurement follows certain measurement principles whose application results in measurement methods.
The measuring method is executed with a measuring installation, which consists
of dierent measuring instruments and auxiliary devices.
Measuring instruments are situated in the signal ow and are essential to the
measuring installation.
Auxiliary devices usually serve to provide the auxiliary energy which is needed to
provide measuring signals.
If the measuring signals pass through several measuring devices connected in
series, then a measurement chain is present.

According to Figure 12.1 a measurement installation translates the measurement


quantity to a measured value. Here we follow the connections of the sensor, transmitter, and transducer as described in Ref. 7:


The chain consists of a sensing element (sensor), a measuring instrument whose


input consists of the measured quantity and its output consists of the corresponding measurement signal.
 At the end of the chain lies the output unit, which provides the desired measurement value.

Measured
quantity
(process variable)
Sensing
element

Transmitter
(signal generator/
line driver)

Transducer

A typical process transducer [7]. D. E. Seborg,


T. F. Edgar, D. A. Mellichamp, Process Dynamics and Control,
Copyright 8 2003 John Wiley & Sons, Inc. This material is used
by permission of John Wiley & Sons, Inc.
Fig. 12.1.

Transmitted
signal
(to controller)

12.1 Introduction






Between the measured quantity and the measured variable to the output unit lie
transducers (see Figure 12.1), which process (transform and amplify) the signal
from the measurement instruments ahead of them and feed their signal to the
output measurement device.
Measurement transmitters are those devices which convert an analog input signal to an unambiguous standardized analog output signal [4]. The transmitter is
usually required to convert the sensor element output to the standardized form
compatible with, for example, a controller input.
Measurement transducers are devices which have input and output signals in
the same or dierent structure (analog/digital or digital/analog). Sometimes the
terms transmitter and transducer are used interchangeably.
One calls the measuring device, with its case and accessories, a measuring instrument.
The instrument gauge or indicator is the part of the measurement device whose
movement allows the reading of the measurement value.
To the measurement instrument also belongs a scale. Between the end points of
the scale lies the range, or span, of the measurement device within which individual values of the measured quantity are obtained.
In order to calibrate and adjust the scale standards are used, which associate a
precisely dened output measurement value to a measured quantity.

12.1.2

Measurement Error

Accuracy of a measurement is the degree of conformity of an indicated value to an


accepted standard or ideal value [4]. Repeatability is the closeness of agreement
among a number of consecutive measurements of the output for the same value
of the input. Each individual measurement x i deviates from the correct or ideal
measured value m [2, 8]. This dierence is called the measuring error or deviation
d i [Eq. (1)].
di xi  m

Measurement errors can be systematic errors, which are found in the measuring
method or in the equipment; with knowledge of the correct measured value these
errors can be compensated by a correction term or a correction factor. Random
errors, which oscillate in sign and amount, cannot be corrected. Averaging eliminates these errors. The simplest mean is the arithmetic average value x, which is
an estimate of the true mean value m [Eq. (2)].

n
1X
xi
n i1

597

598

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

The smaller the random errors of the individual measurements and the larger the
number of measurements, n, the smaller the deviation of the arithmetic average
from the true mean. The empirical sample standard deviation, s, is a measure of
the measurement error [Eq. (3)].

v
uX
n
u
u x i  x 2
t
i1

n1

With very large n, the discrete measurements x i can be thought of as continuous


measurements x and the sample standard deviation s becomes the true standard
deviation s of a Gauss normal dierential distribution function [Eq. (4)].
"

#
1
1 xm 2
f x p exp 
2
s
2ps

A tabulation or histogram of how often the various values of x i occur in replication


is approximated by this distribution. From the Gaussian distribution the statistical
condence of the individual values is obtained. From the cumulative values of this
distribution, 68.3% of all measurement values are within the interval x G s, 95.4%
are within x G 2s, and 99.7% are within x G 3s. Further statistical concepts can be
found in Refs. 5 and 8.

12.2

Measurement Techniques

The measurement technique to be chosen is principally determined by the measured quantity and by the accuracy with which the variable must be measured.
The measuring instrument produces a signal, which must be transformed in
such a way that it can be registered by an indicator or recorder and further processed. This requirement is fullled directly by some measuring methods; however, in most cases a measurement transmitter is operated between the sensor
and the measurement device. Pneumatic pressures between 3 and 15 psig, or between 0.2 and 1.0 bar, or electrical currents between 4 and 20 mA are used [7] as
standard signals. Pneumatic signals are transmitted in plastic tubing and a distance of approximately 300 m between the sensor and the transducer can be accommodated. Electrical direct current signals can be transferred over a distance of
a few kilometers. Electrical signals are much more commonly used today than
pneumatic signals. To accommodate larger distances the analog signals must be
converted to digital signals; in that case the distance between measurement transducer and receiver can be expanded practically at will. In the Sections 12.2.1
12.2.11 some particularly common measurement methods from operational practice will be discussed.

12.2 Measurement Techniques

12.2.1

Temperature

In polymer technology temperature is one of the very important variables of state,


probably the most important. Depending on the measurement range, it is measured with electrical or mechanical contact thermometers or with optical methods.
With contact thermometers one attempts to keep the thermal capacity of the
measuring device and heat transfer as small as possible so that actual temperature
changes can be obtained as soon as possible. Often the sensitive measurement sensors are protectively shielded. Here compromises must be made which are appropriate for individual cases.
The most widely used thermometer in polymer technology is the resistance temperature detector (RTD). For higher temperatures or with point measurements, the
thermocouple is often preferred. Mechanical contact thermometers (expansion
thermometers, rod thermometers, or bimetallic thermometers) are nearly always
used only for local measurements. For optical thermometers, radiation pyrometers
are used.
Resistance Thermometers
In resistance thermometers (or RTDs) one uses the dependency of electrical resistance on the temperature [2]. The resistance of metals almost always rises with
temperature. In practice one uses platinum thermometers. A light platinum wire
on a ceramic support is covered with a protective layer of glass, enamel, or magnesium oxide. This measurement resistance is the end of one so-called measurement element, which ends in connecting terminals. The whole assembly is in a
sleeve, which is solidly connected to the measuring point in the apparatus with
anges or screws (Figure 12.2).
For pure metals, resistance thermometry is governed by Equation (5), where R t
is the resistance at temperature t, R 0 is the resistance at the reference temperature,
usually 0 C, and a; b; c are coecients based on calibration points [3].
12.2.1.1

R t R 0 1 at bt 2 ct 3   

Resistance thermometer thermowell assembly.


1: Measuring resistor; 2: terminal block; 3: connection head;
4: protective pipe; 5: screw tap [1].
Fig. 12.2.

599

600

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

For example, platinum has a temperature coecient of resistance a 0:00385 W/


(W C) in the range 0 to 100 C. The measuring range of commercial-purity platinum thermometers is situated between about 200 and 850 C and the accuracy of
these thermometers is G0.15% of span over the full range [4]. Resistance versus
temperature can usually be described by just a quadratic function, which can be
linearized in measurement ampliers. If large temperature ranges are not present,
the linearization can often be omitted. The resistance is usually measured in a
bridge circuit [2].
Thermocouples
A thermocouple consists in principle of two wires made of dissimilar metals soldered together in two junctions, which form a closed circuit (Figure 12.3). At the
contact junctions a voltage gradient is produced and a current, which depends on
the temperature, ows around the circuit. So long as both junctions have the same
temperature the voltages compensate and no current ows; if the junctions have
dierent temperatures, then a voltage gradient is produced, which can be measured in an open circuit and which is approximately proportional to the temperature (although the relationship is nonlinear over large temperature scales). If one
of the two soldered connections is held at a constant reference temperature, then
the other connection can serve as a temperature probe.
Suitable metal pairs, which supply suciently large thermal voltages to deliver
12.2.1.2

Constantan
Copper

Copper

Measuring Junction
Reference Junction
Thermocouple wiring diagram [1].

Fig. 12.3.

12.2 Measurement Techniques

reliable measured values, are copper/constantan (type T), iron/constantan (type J),
chromel/alumel (type K) and platinum (70%)rhodium/platinum (94%)rhodium
(type B). Their thermal voltages permit measurements up to 371 C, 760 C,
1149 C, and 1700 C respectively [3]. The standard-grade error limits for the rst
three types are G0.8 C, G2.2 C, and G2.2 C respectively.
Thermocouples oer the benet that one can obtain point measurements and
they are also suitable for measurements of high temperature. The outside shape
resembles a resistance thermometer. The usually inevitable shield tube makes the
benet of the point measurement often invalid. A possibility to prevent this is to
solder together the head of the shield tube with a soldered joint; at the very least,
it is then possible that the components are less sluggish (with time constants of
a few seconds). If that is not possible, one must accept time constants of some
minutes.
Expansion Thermometers
The thermal expansion of gases, liquids, and solids is still used to build simple
thermometers, which indicate the temperature in the direct proximity of the measurement location. The most usual measuring media are alcohol and mercury.
However, mercury poses a health hazard and should only be used when necessary.
The measuring range with liquid-lled thermometers (mercury with a glass stem)
is situated between 200 and 370 C, with an accuracy of G1% of full scale, usually less than G0.5 C [4].
The principle of the thermal expansion of solids is used in bimetallic thermometers, which consist of two metal strips of dierent materials with dierent coecients of expansion rmly connected together. Temperature dierences bend these
bimetallic springs and they are usually wound in spirals or coils. The useful measuring range is from 73 to 537 C with an accuracy of G1% of full scale [4].
Bimetallic strips are used for temperature compensation in mechanical instrument
movements. They are also used in switching relays to indicate whether a limiting
value is exceeded.
12.2.1.3

Radiation Pyrometers
High temperatures are measured with radiation pyrometers, which capture the
radiation emitted by the object [4, 9]. They are important mostly for hightemperature, non-contact measurements. According to the StefanBoltzmann law
the intensity of radiation emitted by a black body increases with the fourth power
of the absolute temperature. According to Wiens law the wavelength at maximum
radiation is inversely proportional to the absolute temperature. One can build thermometers based on these two laws, by measuring either the radiation at all wavelengths or the radiation at specic wavelengths [4]. In the thermocouple pyrometer
(Figure 12.4) one collects the radiation emitted from the object on a blackened area
whose temperature rise is measured with a thermocouple. In portable devices an
eyepiece lens is behind the measuring area so that one can aim at the object.
Measuring errors result from space losses between object and measuring instrument; for well-known distances compensation can be made for the errors. Addi12.2.1.4

601

602

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Principle of the radiation pyrometer. 1: Radiation


source; 2: radiant heat; 3: collecting lens; 4: black surface;
5: thermocouple; 6: temperature indication; 7: eyepiece;
8: measuring instrument [1].
Fig. 12.4.

tionally most objects are not black-body radiation emitters; this can be corrected by
using the Planck radiation law to compare the radiation intensities for dierent
wavelengths.
Optical pyrometers can be used for temperature ranges of 7603500 C [4]. In
special cases (narrow-band and total radiation pyrometers) they can be used for
much lower temperatures (between 40 and 4000 C) if a non-contact measurement is desired [4].
Pyrometers are important also for qualitative observations, for example as automatic ame guards, and for protection in the combustion chambers of thermal installations so that, after the ame is extinguished, fuel oil or heating gas does not
enter the combustion chamber to form an explosive mixture.
12.2.2

Pressure Measurement

Not only is the pressure a signicant thermodynamic process variable, but pressure measurements are also fundamentally important for safety reasons. Besides
the absolute pressure in an apparatus, one is often interested in a pressure dierence, for instance in cases of ow measurements with orices, and level measurements.
Process equipment pressures are usually measured by the elastic deformation of
bellows, a Bourdon tube, a diaphragm, or a capsule [3].
Bellows pressure gauges (Figure 12.5) are very compact and permit linear
pressure/path relationships. They are particularly useful for the measurement of

12.2 Measurement Techniques

p1

Fig. 12.5.

p2

Bellows dierential pressure gauge [1].

pneumatic pressure signals and dierential pressure measurement, and have been
used in pneumatic controller feedback elements.
The gauges are available for pressures of 012 mbar (minimum range) and 0
140 bar (maximum range) [3]. For vacuum applications the range is 012 mbar
vacuum. Accuracy is G0.1% to G2% of span [4].
The Bourdon pressure gauge (Figure 12.6) is a versatile instrument. In this instrument a tube with an oval cross-section (Bourdon tube) is bent or coiled inside
the instrument. If the internal pressure rises, then the oval cross-section expands
and the tube increases its radius of curvature. At its end a pointer is attached,
which is carried by the movement of the free end. Pressure gauges are available
for pressures of 00.3 bar (minimum range) and 07000 bar (maximum range)
[3]. Above 100 bar the tubes are arranged in several windings. For vacuum applications the range is 01 bar vacuum.
In a diaphragm pressure gauge the elastic deection of a circularly clamped
metal disk is transferred to a pointer. Such devices are suitable for measuring
ranges of 00.5 mbar and 070 bar [3]. For vacuum applications the range is 0
0.5 mbar and 01 bar vacuum. They are also suitable for dierential pressure measurement if both sides of the diaphragm are connected with the respective measuring points.
Bourdon tube and diaphragm pressure gauge designs are easily calibrated and
have standard designs.
A capsule is formed by joining two or more diaphragms together, with the total
deection of the assembly equal to the sum of the deections of each capsule.

603

604

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Fig. 12.6.

P
Principle of the Bourdon pressure gauge [1].

Pressure sensor selection guidelines can be found in Ref. 3. Pressure sensors


have various transducers connected to them to convert the measurement into a usable signal. Strain gauges and piezoresistive and piezoelectric pressure transducers
are commonly used to produce the measured values.
Currently, smart transducers are used; they are characterized by inclusion of microprocessors and electronics to store ranges, calibrations and diagnostics, and for
other tasks of data handling from the eld instruments to the control room.
12.2.3

Weight

Balances compare unknown weights with one standard weight, or alternatively


with a well-known force. Balances for weight measurement are very reliable and
accurate instruments; their measuring accuracy is often better than G0.1% [4]. It
must be kept in mind that the gravitational attraction on the Earths surface can
vary by as much as 0.5% but this can be compensated by calibration standards
[4]. The hydraulic and electrical strain gauge load cells and the electrical strain

12.2 Measurement Techniques

gauge are now used as primary sensors. The strain gauge type of load cell is capable of a sensitivity of 1 part in 20 000 [6]. Other more accurate sensors are available,
such as the variable capacitance transducer capable of a sensitivity of 1 part in
1 000 000 [6].
Either bulk weighing of vessels or weighing platforms are generally used in the
polymer industry. Types of balances used include weighing platforms, portable
platform scales, and truck scales. Common methods of weighing include mechanical lever scales, spring-balance scales, and load cell weighing systems. Portable
bench scales have capacities from 10 to 1000 kg. Beam-type weighing platforms
have capacities from 200 to 5000 kg [4].
In electronic balances the force exercised by the load on the base is measured
with a force measurement cell (for example, an electrical strain gauge) and transformed into an electrical signal. This signal is processed within the balance in a
digital or analog fashion and is then displayed. These systems can be calibrated
and used in fully automatic installations. As force measurement cells one can use
pressure sensors with lower requirements for accuracy. These are installations in
which the weight is transformed into pressure pneumatically or hydraulically; one
can determine levels in tanks or reaction vessels by this method, which can also be
used to meter automatically the main ingredients of a batch process, for example
the water and monomer phase in an emulsion or suspension polymerization.
Strain gauges are used widely in force measurement cells. When a strip of conductive metal is stretched or compressed by a mechanical load, without reaching
its elastic limit, its electrical resistance changes. In order to use this principle, one
sticks strain gauges onto elastic cylinders or bending rods, whose deformation is
thus transferred to the strain gauges. An elastic cylinder carries four to eight resistance strain gauges, which are arranged in a bridge circuit. The load on the cell
then detunes the bridge and creates a measuring voltage proportional to the detuning. This conguration also provides compensation for resistance variations due to
temperature. Modern units contain almost exclusively digital balances for signal
indication and analysis. With these units one can meter in weights of ingredients
in a given order.
Belt balances (Figure 12.7) allow simultaneous conveying and weighing, so they
are used frequently as metering devices. In these balances, an endless conveyor
belt is designed to be the load part of a balance [6]. Weight changes are measured
by load cells, and then integrated over short intervals to give the rate of ow. Totalizers can give the total weight over a given time. The belt is covered continuously
with the material to be weighed. The feed requires a variable metering device, for
example a vibrating hopper or a screw-type feeder.
12.2.4

Liquid Level

Level measurements are used either to control level in vessels or apparatus, or to


measure throughput. Level measurements are important in order to estimate inventories and their movement, or to assure the smooth operation of processes. Fur-

605

606

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

slidegate valve

conveyor

motor balance bridge force receiver


Fig. 12.7.

data processing

Conveyor belt balance [1].

thermore, in batch processes, level measurements are important to limit lling and
emptying steps as well as for alarming. For continuous processes, they serve to
maintain a constant level in the vessels where the ow occurs (for example, the
sump in a rectication column or the contents of a chemical reactor). Flow measurements are indispensable to metering and feeding functions.
A great variety of level measurement techniques are available. These involve
point-contact, visual, buoyancy, oat, and hydrostatic methods, and radio-frequency,
ultrasonic, microwave, nuclear radiation, resistance tape, and thermal level systems [3].
Point-contact measurements of liquid level are basically length measurements.
For example, one observes the wetting of a dipstick through a sight glass in the
vessel, or the movement of a oat that follows the surface of the liquid in the reservoir. Similarly the point-contact level in a solid hopper can be measured directly
by a mechanical plumb line [4], which is attached at the end of a measuring tape
that is unwound from a barrel so that the plumb line hits the solid surface; markings on it permit the measurement of the length digitally. Likewise, the length of a
hanging string can monitor the position of a oat on a liquid surface.
In the oat method, a oating gauge is not introduced into the vessel itself but
into a dierent container, such as a side gauge glass, which is arranged in parallel
and communicates with the main vessel. In this way disturbances arising from the
movement of the uid (boiling or circulation) are avoided. Floating gauges can also
be used in order to indicate the position of the separation surface between two immiscible liquids.
In the buoyancy method, displacement bodies measure levels in liquid containers. By measuring the dierence in weight of a partially submerged body at various
degrees of submergence, one may determine the level of the liquid in which it is

12.2 Measurement Techniques

submerged [3]. The device fails if the weight or the volume of the displacement
body changes during the process, for example because of scaling or if the density
of the medium changes.
In the hydrostatic method, the pressure at the base of the liquid, which is related
to the height of the liquid above the base, is measured. The measured pressure
depends directly on the liquid height according to the Bernoulli equation or mechanical energy balance [1012] [Eq. (6), where z2 is the level at the surface of the
liquid, z1 is the level at the base, p2 is the pressure at the surface, p1 is the pressure at the base, r is the liquid density, and g is the acceleration due to gravity]. In
pressurized reservoirs one measures the pressure dierence p1  p2 between the
base and the gas space.
z2 z1

p1  p2
rg

In a variant of this method, an inert gas is bubbled through the liquid with a dip
tube. If the density of the liquid is known, one can also determine the level
through weighing.
It should be noted that in equations such as Eq. (6) a conversion factor may be
necessary in unit systems that are termed inconsistent. In the US Customary System (USCS) the force unit is the lb-force (lb f ) and in SI units the force unit is the
s2 is used in USCS
Newton (N). The conversion factor g c 32:174 lb m ft lb1
f
units to resolve expressions involving forces in lb f and masses in lb m so that Newtons law [Eq. (7), where F is force, m is the mass, and a is the acceleration] is satised.
F

ma
gc

In the SI unit system, which is used in this book, g c 1 kg m s2 N1 and so this
conversion factor is not necessary.
In polymer reactors one has to deal often with very viscous liquids or melts.
Here oating gauges or displacement methods fail. An alternative is level measurement with radioactive gamma-ray beams (Figure 12.8) that can penetrate metal
walls [4]. The entire reactor is traversed by gamma-radiation; its intensity is given
according to the BeerLambert law [Eq. (8), where I; I0 are the intensities behind
and in front of the object, e is the absorption coecient, r is the density of the medium and l is the path length.
I I0 experl

Radiation sources include cobalt-60 and cesium-137. Receivers are scintillation


counters. The specimen is usually arranged in a rod-like shape and installed on a
point-shaped detector, particularly if a continuous measurement is concerned. The
benet of the method is that it operates in a non-contact fashion. However, it re-

607

608

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Melt entrance

Radioactive
preparation

Counter

Screen

Melt exit
Fig. 12.8.

Level measurement using radiation [1].

quires extensive safety measures [4]. The specimen must be shielded with lead
against the environment, so that only the direction toward the detector is free.
Mounting, dismantling, and maintenance may be undertaken by trained personnel
only, and the radiation limiting values are to be checked constantly. For this reason
this method should be used only when other methods fail. The accuracy is 3 mm
to 1% of height span [4].
Other level-measuring methods are also possible [3]. Capacitance measurements
use the change in capacitance of a capacitor, which is built in a probe through the
vessel wall (Figure 12.9). Level can also be measured by the change in resistance of
a resistance tape on the vessel wall.
One can also obtain levels by introducing vibrating sensors into the container at
dierent levels until the vibrations are damped by the liquid (Figure 12.10).
Microwave radar level systems are also possible, which are not aected by density changes in the beam path as are ultrasonic beam techniques.
12.2.5

Flow

Flow measurements establish the volume or mass of a uid per unit of time
through the measurement device. The methods are similar for both liquids and
gases; nevertheless it must be considered that liquids have a substantially higher

12.2 Measurement Techniques

b
a

Electrical measurement of liquid level. (A) Capacitive


measurement; (B) conductivity measurement; a: electrode;
b: measuring instrument; c: material [1].
Fig. 12.9.

density than gases. Also, the density dependence on pressure and temperature
must be particularly considered with gases. Because of these considerations, different forms of implementation result [24]. Types of measurement systems include dierential pressure, magnetic, turbine, oscillatory, mass ow, ultrasonic,
and positive-displacement meters [3].
Direct owmeters are generally counters. They couple the number of selfrepeating periodic processes (for example, circulation) with time measurement.
The most widely used device of this type is the oval gear owmeter (see Figure
12.11). For cold water the ow ranges are 0.85 L min1 to 4162669 L min1

A
Mechanical measurement of liquid level.
(A) Vibration probes; (B) rotary wing probe [1].
Fig. 12.10.

609

610

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

V1

V2
A
Fig. 12.11.

Oval-shaped gear owmeter [1].

and for heavy oil (5300 cP) the ow ranges are 0.27.2 L min1 to 1673826
L min1 [3].
In the oval wheel counter, two oval wheels run in gears moving in opposite directions; the pressure drop along the device drives them. The wheels lock successively
and the volumes V1 and V2 convey them and release them again (Figure 12.11).
With each full rotation of the pair of wheels, the volume V 2V1 V2 is conveyed through the counter [1]. The devices can be calibrated and high accuracies
can be obtained (0.1% [4]); with the smallest types, inaccuracy is highest. The devices are very susceptible to contamination and must therefore be protected by ne
lters of solid particles.
Gases can be measured with the rotating lobe owmeter, which is similar to
the oval gear owmeter (see Figure 12.12). The dierence is that the rotating
lemniscate-like lobed impellers do not run directly on one another and are not
geared together. They are coupled through a gearbox.
The devices are calibrated and can be constructed for ow stream capacities between 2 and 4800 m 3 h1 [4]. They have good repeatability (0.015%) at high ow
rates [4]. They can be used for temperatures up to 205 C and pressures up to 83
bar [4]. The temperature and pressure of the gas are captured and processed so
that the volume is indicated in standard conditions of temperature and pressure
(STP). The measured variable is deduced from the speed of the rotors, which is obtained through a magnetic clutch from the pressure chamber.

A
Fig. 12.12.

Lobed-impeller owmeter [1].

12.2 Measurement Techniques

Among the indirect volume owmeters, turbine owmeters are the most important. They measure the speed of the owing medium from the speed of an impeller, or rotor. There are devices arranged in an axial or radial direction to the ow.
Turbine owmeters can be used for liquids, gases, and vapors.
The rotating vane meter, which is arranged in the radial direction to the ow, is
the most well known and is used for ows of 14800 m 3 h1 [4]. The measuring
range is 1:10 with an accuracy of about G0.1% [4].
The turbine owmeter with electrical impulse pick-up, arranged in the axial direction of the ow, is of importance for gas ows. It contains an impeller with
magnetic wings which, with each passage, induce a voltage surge in a solenoid
coil situated outside. The frequency of this alternating current is proportional to
the ow. Reproducible measurements require turbulent ow, because only then
does the slip not depend on the ow velocity. The measuring range also depends
on the viscosity of the owing medium.
There exist gas turbine owmeters for ows up to 4500 m 3 h1 [4]. Linearity is
G1% over a ow range of 20:1 [4]. Rangeabilities can be as much as 100:1. If one
wants total volumes using owmeters, for example for accounting purposes that
require high accuracy, then the instantaneous measurement must be integrated
with time. This can be accomplished with pneumatic or electrical counters.
Measuring methods which deduce the ow directly from ow characteristics are
very common. There are versatile methods being used, which all depend on the velocity of the owing medium. The most important are measurements with orice
devices, with suspended bodies, and according to a magnetic-inductive method. Beyond that there are owmeters which use the pressure drop of a owing liquid in a
capillary, and magnetic-inductive, ultrasonic, and Coriolis owmeters.
Restrictor devices such as venturi tubes, orice plates, and nozzles operate on
the basis of the Bernoulli equation [10, 11]. A venturi tube is depicted in Figure
12.13.
For incompressible uids without friction or pump work at points upstream (1)
and downstream (2) on a streamline in the ow, the Bernoulli equation becomes
Eq. (9), where z1 ; z2 are the levels at the two points, p1 ; p2 are the pressures at the

Fig. 12.13.

d1

d2

p1

p2

Venturi nozzle. d1 : Diameter of the pipe; d2 : diameter of the throat.

611

612

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

two points, v1 ; v2 are the average velocities at the two points, a1 ; a2 are the kinetic
energy correction factors at the two points, r is the liquid density, and g is the acceleration due to gravity.
p1
a1 v12 p2
a2 v22
gz1
gz2
r
2
r
2

The denition of the kinetic energy correction factor is the area average of the
cubed velocity v 3 over the average velocity cubed, v 3 [Eq. (10)] [10].

1 3
v dA
v3
A
a
3 3
v
1
v dA
A

10

Note that a 2 for laminar ow and a 1 for plug ow. For equal heights (horizontal restrictors) the Bernoulli equation becomes Eq. (11).
p1 a1 v12 p2 a2 v22


r
2
r
2

11

The continuity equation can be written at two points on a streamline in the ow


[Eq. (12), where A1 ; A2 are the ow areas at the two points, r1 ; r2 are the liquid densities at the two points] [10].
r1 v1 A1 r2 v2 A2

12

Since the uid is incompressible, Eq. (13) holds.


r1 r2 r

13

Combining Eqs. (11)(13) and eliminating v1 gives Eq. (14), where b is the ratio of
diameters d2 =d1 .
1
v2 p
a2  a1 b 4

s
2 p1  p2
r

14

To compensate for the friction loss and kinetic energy factor assumptions, the
velocity equation is modied to Eq. (15), [10] where Cd is an empirical discharge
coecient.
Cd
v2 p4
1b

s
2 p1  p2
r

15

12.2 Measurement Techniques

Therefore, for restrictors, the volumetric ow qv relationship is Eq. (16) [10].


s
Cd A2
2 p1  p2
16
qv v2 A2 p4
r
1b
The mass ow qm relationship is Eq. (17) [11].
Cd A2 p
qm rv2 A2 p 2 p1  p2 r
1  b4

17

For compressible ow, similar equations may be used. The mass ow equation is
modied to be Eq. (18) [6, 10, 12]. Y is a dimensionless expansion factor that is a
function of p2 = p1 ; b, and k, where k Cp =Cv is the ratio of specic heats of the gas
[6, 10].
Cd YA2 p
qm p 2 p1  p2 r1
1  b4

18

Note that Y 1 for an incompressible uid.


Both factors Cd and Y can be determined for dierent tube nominal sizes and
ow velocities with air or water, and can also be obtained from charts in Refs. 6
and 12, or tables in Ref. 2. Typically the data can also be used for other media, if
the Reynolds numbers are kept constant. The most important restrictors are the
venturi tube (Figure 12.13) and the orice plate (Figure 12.14). The discharge coefcient Cd is about 0.940.99 for a venturi tube and about 0.6 for an orice plate [6,
11].
The simplest implementation of a restrictor is the standard orice plate, which
also supplies the most accurate values (Figure 12.14). The orice is a sharp-edged
disk with diameter d2 in a pipe with diameter d1. The pressure tap positions relative to the plate vary depending on the desired design [6]. For so-called radius taps,
the pressure-measuring drillings are situated inside the anges in each case at a
distance of one pipe diameter upstream and half a pipe diameter downstream of
the orice [6]. The accuracy of the orice plates is G0.25% to G0.5% of actual
ow [4]. The rangeability with a measurement error of less than G1% of the actual
ow is 3:1, which can be improved with smart transmitters [4].
The orice plate is the restrictor most frequently used in practice. For the measuring accuracy of all standard orices it is essential that the edge sharpness be
maintained in continuous operation. If this is not the case, then the standard nozzles have advantages, and their permanent pressure loss is somewhat lower than
in standard orices. They also have advantages for very small throughputs and are
used for very dirty liquids.
In a venturi tube the so-called diuser is attached to the normal nozzle piece
and serves for backpressure gain. This has the smallest permanent pressure loss
among the various restrictors. The accuracy of venturi tubes is G0.75% of the uncalibrated rate and G0.25% of the rate calibrated in a laboratory.

613

614

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

d2

d1

p1

p2

Fig. 12.14. Orice plate and anges. 1: Orice plate; 2: ange


supports; 3: pressure measurement drill taps [1]. Note that the
pressure tap positions vary, depending on the desired design
[6].

All measurements with restrictors require turbulent, evenly distributed ow. In


order to smooth out disturbances in the ow stream, orices and nozzles require a
straight and smooth upstream piping length of between six and 40 pipe diameters
[6] depending on the nature of the upstream tting and between two and four pipe
diameters downstream to the nearest tting. Sources of error are clusters of gas
bubbles or dirt particles (in uids) or condensing liquids (for gases) in the dierential pressure tubes. For gases the pressure ratio p2 = p1 at the restriction must not
be less than about 0.53; otherwise sonic velocity is achieved in the restriction [10].
Measuring methods with oating bodies work with vertically arranged, inverted
cone-shaped or slightly tapered tubes, where the uid ows through from bottom
to top. In the rotameter, the ow holds thereby a oating body in equilibrium (see
Figure 12.15), which depends on the ow velocity and the lift of the body against
its weight.
The force balance is written as Eq. (19) [10], where FW is the (downward) gravity
force, FB is the (upward) buoyancy force, and FD is the (upward) drag force.

12.2 Measurement Techniques

FB, FD

FW

Fig. 12.15. Flow measurement with oat (rotameter).


a: Conical ow pipe; b: oat; FW : gravity force; FB : buoyancy
force; FD : drag force [1].

FW F B FD

19

If Vf is the volume of the oat, rf is the density of the oat, and r is the density of
the uid, the force balance becomes Eq. (20).
FD Vf rf g  Vf rg

20

The drag force is given by Eq. (21), where CD is the drag coecient, A f is the projected area of the oat, and vmax is the maximum velocity past the oat.
FD CD A f

2
rvmax
2

21

615

616

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Substituting the drag force into the force balance we get Eq. (22).
CD A f

2
rvmax
Vf grf  r
2

22

The volumetric ow rate qv can be related to the maximum velocity past the oat
by Eq. (23), where A t is the tube area at the point of constriction and A f is the oat
area.
qv vmax A t  A f

23

To size the rotameter, vmax can be eliminated between these two equations and the
expression simplied so that the volumetric ow rate qv is obtained as Eq. (24),
p
where Cd 1= CD is a discharge coecient with values between about 0.6 and
0.8 [9].
s
2gVf rf  r
24
qv Cd A t  A f
rA f
For a linearly tapered tube with the bottom diameter the same as the oat diameter, the area for ow is a linear function of the height of the oat h [Eq. (25)] [10].
dt2  d 2f d f ah 2  d 2f 2d f ah ah 2 A 2d f ah

25

Substituting this into the mass ow equation gives Eq. (26), from which the ow
rate depends almost linearly on the height of the oating element h and the viscosity of the medium; in each case it is calculated with the help of calibration curves,
which depend on the instrument and the calibration medium (air or water).
p
qm rqv rvmax dt2  d 2f
4



2p
rvmax d f a h
4

26

The oating elements are available in dierent forms; for simple gas measurements the oating element is a sphere; for uids one mostly nds a cylindrical
oating element (Figure 12.15), which is shaped downward like a cone and at the
upper edge like a at truncated cone-like disk. This disk is sharply grooved in the
side, in order to induce a rotation in the equilibrium position. This movement stabilizes its position in the center of the conical pipe.
The position of the oating element can be observed directly, if the conical guide
tube consists of glass or quartz. If that is not possible, then its position can also
be measured magnetically, if it contains a magnet and the pipe consists of a nonmagnetic material.
Rotameters are useful for ows from 0.01 cm 3 min1 to 920 m 3 h1 of liquid, or
0.3 cm 3 min1 to 2210 m 3 h1 of gas [4]. The measurement accuracy for industrial
rotameters is approximately G1% to G2% of full scale over a 10:1 range [4].

12.2 Measurement Techniques

Magnetic-inductive owmeters consist of one nonmagnetic, insulated pipe,


which is traversed by a magnetic eld. If a conductive uid moves through the
pipe, the ions contained in it are deected crosswise to the ow direction and to
the magnetic eld. Two electrodes, which are attached at the same height inside
the pipe, then indicate a voltage dierence, which is proportional to the ow velocity. The method is independent of the ow prole, density, viscosity, and contamination. Moreover it does not build up an additional pressure drop in the line. The
measuring accuracy is within G1% [1]. For the time being, there are still diculties for nominal pressures over 16 bar.
When a uid moves in a tube that is rotated, it experiences a Coriolis force proportional to its mass and velocity and to the angular velocity of the tube. In the
Coriolis owmeter, the tube is not rotated but vibrated. Vibrations in the tube are
set up and a small elastic deformation in the tube results from the Coriolis force.
The deformation magnitude is related to the mass ow rate. These owmeters
have the advantage that the measurement is independent of the temperature, density, pressure, viscosity, or ow prole [3]. The accuracy is high, G0.15% within the
range of 10:1 of full scale rate [4], but the initial cost is high. The ow range is 0
28300 kg min1 [4]. The high accuracy can be very useful for ingredients that are
precisely metered to polymerizers, despite the high cost. Because of their operating
principle, Corilis owmeters can simultaneously obtain the density of the uid.
12.2.6

Densitometry, Dilatometery, and Gravimetry

Density is the mass per unit volume of a substance. Specic gravity is the density
of the substance relative to a standard such as liquid water at 4 C. The density of
liquids is monitored by hydrometers, weighing a xed volume (density balance),
the Coriolis method (described in Section 12.2.5), and vibrating methods. Hydrostatic, displacement oat, sonic, and radiometric methods are among others also
used [4].
A hydrometer consists of a tube closed at both ends, with one end enlarged into
a bulb that contains ne lead shot or mercury to cause the instrument to oat upright in a liquid. In the glass tube is a scale calibrated so that the reading on it,
level with the surface of the liquid in which the hydrometer is oating, indicates
the number of times the liquid is heavier or lighter than water, that is, the specic
gravity of the liquid. Hydrometers have been connected photometrically or mechanically to produce a useable electrical signal [4].
The density balance operates on the principle of weighing a xed volume. In it
the liquid ows through a U-tube, which forms the load part of a balance (Figure
12.16). The deection of the balance can be indicated directly, and usually one uses
electrical or pneumatic transducers so that the measured values can be transferred
and processed further. Density balances must be installed so as to avoid vibrations.
In the tuning fork densitometer one utilizes the dependency of the frequency of
a tuning fork or a vibrating plate, which is excited to produce an under-damped
oscillation, on the density of the surrounding medium. The resonant frequency of

617

618

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors


Balance system
Indicator dial

Flow

U-tube
Fig. 12.16.

Flexible tube

Density balance [1].

an oscillating system is approximately proportional to the square root of the oscillating mass [4]. A vibrating ow U-tube may also be used for density measurement
[8].
Vibrating and density balance densitometers can also be used for compressed
gases (r > 2 kg m3 ). Gases at standard pressure are measured with gas density
balances, with which one determines the buoyancy of a closed hollow sphere lled
with a comparison gas.
A sonic densitometer consists of a device for measuring the speed of sound in
the liquid [4, 8]. The speed of sound c is given by Eq. (27), where E is the bulk
modulus and r is the mass density [4]. Unfortunately the liquid must be clear of
particles that might scatter the sound waves and limit the received signal.
s
E
c
r

27

The density of liquids can also be measured radiometrically, by the absorption of


gamma-rays in the medium. The intensity of the exiting radiation depends on the
density of the medium and is given according to the BeerLambert law [Eq. (28),
where I; I0 are the intensities behind and in front of the object, e the absorption
coecient, r the density of the medium and l the path length].

12.2 Measurement Techniques

I I0 experl

28

Unlike level measurements the radiometric measurement of the density requires


high outlet intensity and thus higher safety precautions. However, it has a broad
range of application and is particularly interesting for measurements in polymer
technology; one can measure very viscous melts, emulsions, and suspensions.
Dilatometers measure the volume shrinkage during the course of liquid polymerization reactions and are mainly used for laboratory measurement of monomer
conversion. They are based on the principle that polymers are denser than their
monomers. Volume changes are monitored as monomer is converted to polymer
by following the change in height of the solution inside a graduated capillary
tube. Conversion is monitored with a computer-linked photodetector that tracks
the meniscus in the capillary and records the height changes [13].
The percentage of total solids in a polymer sample can be determined by the
gravimetric method through moisture weight loss. The sample is loaded onto a
pan and the weight determined. Then it is put into an oven at high temperature
for a time to remove all volatiles. It is then reweighed and the percentage of solids
is determined.
12.2.7

Viscosity

Viscosities are of interest in polymer technology in order to follow the course of a


polymerization reaction or to monitor continuously the quality of a product. Viscosity m is the constant of proportionality between applied shear stress t and the
resulting shear rate g_ according to Newtons Law of viscosity [Eq. (29)] [11, 13].
t mg_

29

Viscosity may be constant (Newtonian), shear thickening (dilatant), or shear thinning (pseudoplastic) with shear rate. For polymer systems, solution or melt, the
viscosity can be related to the molecular weight of the polymer, as discussed in
Refs. 4, 8, and 13.
In most cases viscosity is measured by capillary viscometers or rotating viscometers. In a capillary viscometer one measures the pressure drop by means of constant laminar ow in a capillary; the constant ow can be achieved by a pump
and the pressure drop is obtained by a dierential pressure transmitter whose
plus and minus sides are connected to the capillary. The pressure drop is
then directly proportional to the viscosity according to the HagenPoiseuille law
[4, 11] [Eq. (30), where m is the viscosity, r is the capillary radius, l is the capillary
length, Dp is the pressure drop, and qm is the mass ow rate]. The capillary viscometer may also be employed in-line for monitoring of molecular weight in polymerizations, as described in Ref. 14.

619

620

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

pr 4 Dpr
8qm l

30

A method to obtain a measure of molecular size that is quick and cheap is the melt
indexer [13]. The melt index is dened as the number of grams of polymer extruded in 10 min through a capillary 2.1 mm in diameter and 8 mm long at a certain temperature and pressure (ASTM D1238).
Among the dierent possible ways to measure viscosities in rotating viscometers, the coaxial cylinder apparatus is the most commonly used in practice. The
measured liquid intersperses the annular gap between the stationary inner cylinder (bob) and the rotating outer cylinder (cup). Therefore a velocity gradient builds
between the inner and outer cylinders (Couette ow). The momentum, which is
transferred by this downward gradient to the inner cylinder, is directly proportional
to the viscosity. Deection is compensated by a torsion bar and the equilibrium deection is measured electrically. The measurement of the angular velocity of the
cup and the angular deection of the bob makes it possible to determine the viscosity [4, 11].
Besides the coaxial device, the cone-and-plate viscometer is also used. In this
device an inverted cone faces a solid plate and the apex of the cone just touches
the plate. The measured liquid is in the free gap. The viscosity of the measured
uid is computed from the torque on the cylinder-driving shaft [4, 11].
The Mooney viscometer, used particularly in the rubber industry, is a variant
of the cone-and-plate viscometer; it restricts the sample to a disk-shaped cavity
(ASTM D1646) [4].
Vibrating-reed viscometers can also be used for continuous in-line polymer viscosity [4]. The amplitude of the probe vibration depends on the viscosity of the
uid. As the viscosity of the uid increases, the resistance to probe vibration increases.
12.2.8

Composition

The composition of raw materials, nished products, and samples of the various
steps of a reaction is normally measured at the laboratory using the appropriate
physical and chemical analytical methods. However, sampling and analysis are
time-consuming and in many cases the result of the analysis is only of current
interest and too late for control decisions to be made. In order to monitor compositions continuously, one needs automatically functioning analytical instruments
that can continuously obtain and show the composition of a mixture. Some devices
are fast and precise enough to be able to generate signals for control loops. The
controllers would then adjust the desired values of other input variables such as
ow, temperature, or pressure in a cascade control scheme.
Optical methods are common [4, 8, 13]. Infrared (IR) spectrographic analysis
makes it possible in many cases to follow the appearance or the disappearance of
one or more characteristic absorption frequency bands. These frequency bands cor-

12.2 Measurement Techniques

respond to frequencies of vibrations of the bonds in the molecules. One must rst
analyze the spectrum of the IR radiation and then measure the corresponding frequencies. More recently the Fourier transform infrared technique (FTIR) has been
used for faster data acquisition and handling than traditional IR spectrographic
analysis. IR and FTIR can be applied to polymer solutions or solid lms for composition analysis and are particularly useful for copolymer composition determination.
Optical analytical devices are also built for measuring radiation in the ultraviolet
(UV) and the visible spectral region, but the spectral absorption bands obtained
here are usually so broad that these devices are used only for special tasks.
The refractive index (RI) of a mixture is a function of the composition of the mixture and the respective refractive indices of the constituents [8]. The mixture refractive index follows mixture laws such as the LorentzLorenz law. Operational
measuring instruments are usually dierential refractometers or critical-angle refractometers [4]. A large disadvantage in the method is that it only provides meaningful results when a two-component system is considered. However, a dierential
refractometer is commonly used as a concentration detector in the euent of a gel
permeation chromatography (GPC) column for molecular weight determination.
Raman spectroscopy is dependent on the collision of incident light quanta with
the molecule, inducing the molecule to undergo a change [13]. It is now being
used to provide a means of studying pure rotational and vibrational transitions in
molecules. Raman scattering of light by molecules may be used to provide their
chemical composition and molecular structure and is currently being applied to
polymers, as shown in Refs. 8, 15, and 16.
Apart from optical methods, one uses magnetic (for paramagnetic materials, for
example oxygen in diamagnetic gases) and electrical methods. Examples of the latter are conductivity measurements (of ionic liquids, for example purity of boiler
feeding water), ionization methods (for example, the ame ionization detector in
gas chromatographs or the photo-ionization of gases with UV light to measure
tracking of hydrocarbons in air), electro-chemical potential methods (for example,
pH measurements), and occasionally polarographic methods.
Nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) is based on the principle that when a
hydrogen-containing compound is in a strong magnetic eld and exposed to
radio-frequency signals the compound absorbs energy at discrete frequencies [13].
This technique can be used to measure chain molecular structure, copolymer composition, and copolymer sequence lengths. It can also deduce isotactic/atactic ratios and other structure variations, as shown, for example, in Ref. 17. Mass spectrometry and NMR are currently not in routine on-line process use, but can be
used to calibrate other on-line methods.
Many methods depend on the separation of a uid mixture. Among these, gas
chromatography (GC) stands out [8]. Suitable devices for on-line control were developed from laboratory gas chromatographs and operate very reliably. However,
they can be expensive because of the associated program controls. The principle
of gas chromatography is that a carrier gas (helium) is passed over a tubular column of a ne solid. A sample is injected into the carrier gas stream and the gas

621

622

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

euent from the column is run past a detector such as a ame ionization detector.
Calibration is based on the fact that, all conditions being equal, a given hydrocarbon will require the same length of time to pass through the column to the detector (elution time) [4].
A mass spectrometer source produces ions, and information about a sample may
be obtained by analyzing the dispersion of ions when they interact with the sample
using the mass-to-charge ratio. Sometimes mass spectrometers are used after a
separation step such as gas chromatography or liquid chromatography for fraction
identication.
12.2.9

Surface Tension

In emulsion polymerizations particularly, it may be of some interest to measure


the surface tension of the polymerization. The surface tension can give an indication of whether or not micelles are present, which is important in particle nucleation above the critical micelle concentration (CMC) [18, 19].
The on-line method used is usually the bubble pressure method. A dip tube is
inserted below the liquid surface and bubbles are formed by compressed gas. Bubbles formed within a liquid are compressed by surface tension. The resulting pressure rises with decreasing bubble radius. This increased pressure, in comparison
to the outside of the bubble, is used to measure surface tension. During the process of bubble formation and breakage, the pressure can be measured in the bubble. From the pressure oscillation the surface tension can be calculated.
12.2.10

Molecular Weight Distribution (MWD)

It is widely recognized that a reliable method of monitoring molecular weight distribution (MWD), and the various molecular weight averages (Mn ; Mw , and Mz )
during the polymerization process is of importance to nal polymer quality. The
polydispersity index is dened as the ratio of the weight to the number average
molecular weight [Eq. (31)], which is a measure of the spread of the MWD.
PD

Mw
Mn

31

Monitoring the molecular weight distribution or its averages from a batch or continuous polymer reactor in real time would be desirable. Monitoring and feedback
control of polymerizations can provide fundamental benets for improved quality.
Traditionally, gel permeation chromatography (GPC) or size-exclusion chromatography (SEC) has been used to determine MWD [8, 13]. In GPC/SEC, polymer
solutions are injected into one or more columns in series, packed with porous particles. The packing has small pores and during elution the polymer molecules may

12.2 Measurement Techniques

or may not, depending on their size, penetrate into the pores. Therefore, smaller
molecules have access to a larger fraction of pores than the larger ones, and the
chains elute in a decreasing order of molecular weights. For each type of polymer
an empirical correlation exists between molecular weights and elution volumes.
This can be used to calibrate the GPC/SEC, which allows the evaluation of average
molecular weights and molecular weight distributions.
Direct column calibration for a given polymer requires the use of narrow MWD
samples of that polymer. The chromatograms of such standards give narrow peaks
and with each standard is associated the retention volume of the peak maximum. There are a number of polymers for which narrow MWD standards are
commercially available. More recently triple-detector instruments have been designed which include a dierential viscometer, a light-scattering instrument, and
a dierential refractometer that monitors the column euent. A calibration curve
can be obtained from this arrangement as long as all signals are calibrated [13].
For on-line purposes, the viscosity measures previously mentioned (see Section
12.2.7) have been used as a proxy for molecular weight averages in on-line control.
Some vendors are commercializing more rapid GPC/SEC instruments for on-line
control, with certain instruments already available.
12.2.11

Particle Size Distribution (PSD)

The particle size distribution (PSD) can have a fundamental eect on the physical
properties of dispersions that are common polymer products. The measurement of
just the average particle size may not be sucient. For example, the presence of
populations of dierent sizes resulting in a multimodal distribution could have a
strong inuence on nal properties and may need to be controlled.
There are several particle size measurement techniques in use, such as optical
imaging, electron imaging, optical diraction and scattering, electrical resistance
changes, sieving, sedimentation, and ultrasonic attenuation [4].
Optical (larger than 1 mm) and scanning electron microscopy (SEM) techniques
literally give the clearest picture of a PSD. However, analyzing the images may be
tedious without image analyzers. Nevertheless, this method can be used as a check
or calibration on the indirect methods.
The Coulter-counter particle size analyzer (larger than 0.5 mm) is used for measuring volumes of individual particles. Particles are suspended in a conductive
uid, into which electrodes are placed. As a particle passes through an aperture between the electrodes, it displaces its own volume of electrolyte, and there is a measurable change in the electrical resistance of the system. The change becomes a
precise measure of particle volume. These volumes can then be put into size bins
and the PSD can be constructed.
Today there are two principal light scattering technologies that are commercially
available: light scattering intensity measurement (also known as static, or Rayleigh,
scattering) and dynamic light scattering measurement [also known as quasi-elastic

623

624

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

light scattering (QELS) or photon correlation spectroscopy (PCS)]. It should be


noted that light scattering techniques are applied not only to particle size measurement but also to macromolecule size measurement.
In static light scattering measurements, the light intensity scattered in solution
by a particle, which is small compared with the wavelength of the incident laser
beam, is proportional to the concentration multiplied by the molecular weight.
When the particles are very small compared with the wavelength of the light, the
intensity of the scattered light is uniform in all directions (Rayleigh scattering);
for larger particles (above approximately 250 nm diameter), the intensity is angledependent (Mie scattering). If the concentration of the particles in solution is
known or is measured during the analysis process, the particle size averages and
distributions can be determined.
Dynamic light scattering provides a relatively fast and simple method for submicron particle sizing [8]. When a beam of light passes through a colloidal dispersion, the particles or droplets scatter some of the light in all directions. Random
intensity uctuations in scattered laser light arising from the Brownian motion of
colloidal particles are analyzed to give either a simple mean size and polydispersity
index or complete distribution data, even for multimodal distributions.
Turbidimetry has been used traditionally in industry to obtain a measure of average particle size and even the entire PSD, and is a measure of the attenuation of a
beam of light passing through a suspended particle sample [8].
Acoustic attenuation spectroscopy measurements can be made without the need
for sample dilution and can be used in the particle size range of 10 nm to 100 mm.
As sound travels through a slurry or colloid, it is attenuated. The level of attenuation is related to the particle size distribution as discussed in Refs. 20 and 21.
Acoustic attenuation measurements can be made on high-concentration and/or
opaque samples [8].
Packed column hydrodynamic chromatography (HDC), a technique for separating particles based on their size by eluting in the order largest to smallest, operates
on a principle similar to that of GPC/SEC [8]. The sample under investigation and
a small-molecule marker solution are introduced so that the euent ow is not
interrupted. HDC has a dynamic operating range from about 20 nm to 1.2 mm.
An ultraviolet (UV) detector response is used to calculate the concentration of
particles of dierent sizes present in the sample. The subsequent computation of
particle size distribution requires a calibration procedure employing a particle size
standard.
Capillary hydrodynamic fractionation (CHDF) is a hydrodynamic method for
measurement of nanometer-sized particles. In this method, slurry containing the
particles is forced through a capillary. Flow rate through the capillary is highest in
the center of the capillary due to the laminar ow velocity prole. Larger particles
extend into the high-ow region while smaller particles travel closer to the wall of
the capillary. Larger particles are swept through the capillary ahead of the smaller
particles, producing particle size fractionation. The particles are detected at the end
of the capillary by a UV detector. The measurable particle size range for CHDF is
about 15 nm to 2 mm.

12.3 Sensor Signal Processing

For on-line control these techniques must be evaluated for speed, reliability, and
sample dead time [4]. As in the MWD techniques, manufacturers are moving
more toward on-line implementation of the more recent methods, but many of
these techniques still remain in the control laboratory.

12.3

Sensor Signal Processing


12.3.1

Sensors and Transmitters

Sensor signal processing involves operations such as amplication, compensation,


ltering, and normalization. As discussed (see Section 12.1), transmitters transform the signals leaving the sensor into a standardized signal, and the sensor
plus the transmitter are considered to be the transducer or measurement instrument [7]. Transmitters should be attached operationally as closely as possible
to the sensor location in order to minimize transmission error. To protect instruments against outside eects from contamination, damage, and corrosion, they
should be placed in sturdy housings. A measurement amplier is connected to
the signal source of an electrical sensor and converts the signal coming from the
sensor into the standardized direct current signal.
The pneumatic or electrical signals depict only the analog measured variable.
The direct measured variable is not always the desired result, however. Thus, for
example, one obtains from ow measurements with diaphragms a dierential
pressure, not the mass ow, qm , which for compressible ow in an orice is given
by Eq. (32), where Dp p1  p2 is the pressure drop between the taps upstream
and downstream respectively, r1 is the upstream density, Cd is an empirical discharge coecient, A2 is the area of the orice, Y is a dimensionless expansion
factor, and b d2 =d1 is the ratio of the orice to the upstream pipe diameter (see
Section 12.2.5) [10].
Cd YA2 p
qm p 2r1 Dp
1  b4

32

p
As can be seen from Eq. (32), the mass ow is proportional to the product r1 Dp.
As density and ow can be subject to variations during the process, the downstream pressure will change and so will the density, and the two measured values
are coupled together. Additionally, density is also a function of temperature so this
must also be measured and a correction added. A smart transducer provides functions beyond those necessary for generating a correct representation of a sensed or
controlled quantity. A smart transducer can be used in this situation to correct the
ow for pressure and temperature.

625

626

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

12.3.2

Converters

If one wants to use the analog signals for more complicated calculations or in
a process control system, one must digitize them and after processing transform
them back to analog signals, for example to drive the nal control elements or actuators. Converters are used for this purpose. Measurement converters transform
the analog signal into a digital one (A/D converter) or a digital signal into an analog one (D/A converter). Any decimal number can be converted into the binary system by summing the appropriate multiples of the dierent powers of 2. Equation
(33) demonstrates the conversion of binary into decimal numbers as well as that
of decimal into binary numbers; thus 10101101 (binary) is equivalent to 173
(decimal).
1  2 7 0  2 6 1  2 5 0  2 4 1  2 3 1  2 2
0  2 1 1  2 0 173

33

The raw binary sensor data can be encoded according to several binary formats,
such as: pure binary, twos complement binary, signed binary, binary coded decimal (BCD), ASCII, or Gray codes. In order to convert the digits of the decimal system to binary digits, which are required for digital technology, one can directly
code these digits. Very frequently BCD is used. Every decimal digit is assigned to
the corresponding binary digit. In the original binary code the number 35 would
be shown as 100011, whereas in the BCD code it would be shown as 0011;0101.
It must be cautioned that during this conversion a quantization error results,
because of round-o errors in the decimal places; for example, 1.354 V (analog)
might become 1:35 0001;0011;0101 (BCD). Many process control applications
use A/D and D/A conversions of at least 12-bit unsigned binary representation to
obtain a resolution of 1 part in 2 12 0.024% [7].
12.3.3

Indicators

The numerous measurement signals of a process-engineering unit must be indicated so that they can be used and also recorded in some fashion. They are therefore combined in a central control room; there they provide a current overview of
the state of the entire plant.
Indicators show the measured value in an analog or digital way. The analog representation consists of a pointer before a calibrated scale, and recently also in LED
displays and analog representations on monitors. Digital outputs are indicated as
number displays or on counters. Apart from the measured value, indicator instrument panels also contain alarm functionality (optical and/or acoustical), which indicates if a critical measured value is exceeded in order to automatically shut down
the installation. Once the signal is processed it is sent to the controller, the output
of which, the controlled variable, is then sent to the actuator.

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

In the past these functions were performed by panel boards consisting of indicators, alarms, strip-chart recorders, and single-loop controllers. Today, distributed
control systems (DCS) and data historians perform these functions (see Section
12.4.6).
12.3.4

Filtering Techniques

As mentioned above (see Section 12.1.2), during a measurement stochastic errors


can be introduced. The eects of process and measurement noise can be minimized by signal conditioning or ltering [7]. Analog lters have been commonly
used for many years. A high-frequency noise (low-pass) lter can be represented
by Eq. (34), where xt is the lter input, yt is the lter output, and tF is the lter
time constant. This equation can be discretized to produce a digital lter with sampling interval Dt [Eq. (35)].
tF

dyt
yt xt
dt

34

tF

yn  yn1
yn x n
Dt

35

When rearranged this gives the exponential smoothing lter in Eq. (36), where the
lter factor, 0 < a a 1, is dened by Eq. (37).
yn ax n 1  ay n1
1

a1

tF
Dt

36
37

This lter can be implemented in a digital computer. Other lters, such as a


moving-average lter, are also possible [7].

12.4

Regulatory Control Engineering


12.4.1

General

Measurement instruments supply information on the current operating conditions


of a plant. These form the basis to control the process and to keep conditions constant so that the optimal-quality results are obtained. For this purpose one uses
controllers which determine automatically the sequence of control events. For example, a process could be that of the tank shown in Figure 12.17. The tank has a

627

628

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

qv0
FT

LT
qv1
FT

R
Tank with liquid level height h, inlet valve with
volumetric ow qv0, and outlet volumetric ow qv1 through
a restrictor with resistance R.
Fig. 12.17.

stream owing into it through a valve and a stream leaving it through a restriction.
A more comprehensive example of a polymer process as shown in Figure 12.33
will be discussed later (see Section 12.5).
In order to be able to keep process or measured variables constant, or to change
them systematically, they must rst be measured continuously and recorded. Flow
rates into and out of the tank (denoted by the ow transducer, or FT) and the level
(denoted by the level transducer, or LT) are measured variables. One therefore obtains information about the instantaneous state of the desired measured variable to
be controlled, the controlled variable, and about its change with time. In the case of
the tank, this variable would be the level in the tank as measured by the level transducer. The controlled variable value must then be compared with the desired value,
called the set point. Any deviations from the set point, called the error, can
then be corrected through suitable actions. Devices that execute this comparison
and provide output signals, which can be used for the correction sent to the manipulated variable, are called feedback controllers or regulators. In the case of the tank,
the manipulated variable could be the ow into the tank measured by the ow
transducer. If one wants to have a process follow certain time-varying conditions
(as is the case often with batch processes), then one can use controllers to send
the suitable programmed sequence signals. Often measured or unmeasured variables that aect the process and cause deviations from the set point are called disturbance variables. In the case of the tank, this variable could be an uncontrolled
leak from the tank or a secondary ow into the tank.

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

LC

qv0

I/P

FT

LT
qv1
FT

R
Fig. 12.18.

Feedback level control on a tank.

The signals leaving the controller are used to aect temperatures, pressures, and
ow rates by means of actuators. Actuators are usually valves whose ow area
changes with the signal coming from the controller. Metering machines, or positive displacement pumps, can also be used as actuators.
Measurement, comparison, and adjustment constitute an entity called a control
loop. Very schematically one may describe the control loop in terms of sensors,
controllers, actuators, and the process to be controlled. Shown in Figure 12.18 is a
level control system for a tank. Broken lines denote control signals. The controller
(denoted by LC) receives the level signal from the level transducer (LT) that sends a
signal to the current-to-pressure transducer (I/P) that then applies a pneumatic
pressure to the valve diaphragm.
Shown in Figure 12.19 is the control loop pictured as a block diagram. In the
control loop the controlled variable y is continuously measured and compared
with the set point ysp ; it is desirable to have the deviation or error e ysp  y
made as small as possible. The controller then decides what control action to
make on the manipulated variable u. Disturbances in the process denoted by d
inuence the controlled variable y and are compensated for by the manipulated
variable u.
In contrast to the controlled system, the tank in Figure 12.17 is not under feedback control. It could be operated in a manual semi-batch mode, where the inlet

629

630

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Disturbance
Variable
Setpoint
ysp

Error
e
+-

Manipulated
Variable
u
Controller

Valve

Controlled
Variable
y

Tank

Level
Transducer
Fig. 12.19.

Block diagram of the tank level control loop.

valve is used to ll the tank to a certain level. The control consists of a sequence of
operating conditions, which must be carried out under a well-dened plan. It is
used around well-dened processes, for example to automate the loading step of a
batch emulsion.
By analogy with the control loop hierarchy, one can split the control chain into
the process to be controlled and the control system, as shown (for example) in Figure 12.18. In the given example, the process consists of the tank, which can be
lled, the control valve with the appropriate piping, the restrictor, the level and
ow transducers and perhaps a recorder; the control system covers the programmable controller, the signal transmission, and the I/P converter.
Expenditure for measurement, control, and actuator systems in the process industries is substantial. The proportional cost is higher the smaller the process is,
because the absolute expenditure depends only on the number of measurement
points and control loops, not on the size of the installation.
12.4.2

Process Dynamics

It is the task of the control system of a plant to drive the controlled variable (temperature, pressure, ow, and so on) to the desired values, by either constant or
prescribed trajectories. In order to accomplish this, the controlled variable must
be continuously measured and the dynamics of the process must be known. In
control technology one distinguishes processes with self-regulation and without
self-regulation. In the rst case the output variable y assumes a new equilibrium
state after the input variable u is changed; an example is the ow through a pipe
after a change at the control valve. Another example is the tank mentioned above:
when the inlet ow is changed a new level is reached, as long as the outlet ow has
a restrictor whose ow depends on the height of liquid in the tank. One calls such
systems self-regulating, because the output reaches a new steady state when sub-

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

jected to step-changes in the input. In the second case a change in the input does
not produce a new steady state. For instance, in a tank that is continuously fed and
drained by manipulation of an outlet valve, the level remains constant only if the
dierence between output ow and input ow is zero. One calls such systems
non-self-regulating, because the output does not reach a new steady state when
subjected to step-changes in the input.
First-order System
In many cases the relationships between plant inputs and outputs may be derived
in the form of a mathematical model, which can then be used to understand and
control the plant. For the tank example in Figure 12.17 the dynamic mass balance
becomes Eq. (38), where r is the liquid density, A is the cross-sectional area of the
tank, h is the height of liquid in the tank, and qv0 ; qv1 are the inlet and outlet volumetric ow rates [7, 22]. If we assume constant density this becomes Eq. (39).
12.4.2.1

d
rAh rqv0  rqv1
dt
A

dh
qv0  qv1
dt

38
39

The ow restrictor may be modeled, to a rst approximation, as a linear relationship between ow and height of liquid in the tank [Eq. (40), where R is the valve
resistance]. The material balance becomes Eq. (41).
qv1
RA

h
R

dh
Rqv0  h
dt

40
41

Since this is a self-regulating process, a steady state exists, governed by Eq. (42),
where the subscript s denotes the steady-state value. Subtracting Eq. (42) from Eq.
(41) yields Eq. (43).
0 Rqv0s  hs
RA

dh
Rqv0  qv0s  h  hs
dt

42
43

Since we are mainly only interested in deviations from the steady state, in this case
we may dene deviation variables by Eqs. (43), where u is the manipulated ow deviation variable and y is the controlled level deviation variable.
u qv0  qv0s
y h  hs

44

631

632

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

In terms of the deviation variables, our mass balance becomes Eqs. (45). This is in
the form of a rst-order system [Eq. (46), where the time constant is given by Eq.
(47) and the process gain by Eq. (48).
RA
t

dy
Ru  y
dt

dy
Kpu  y
dt

45
46

t RA

47

Kp R

48

The dynamic behavior of a dynamic system can be well represented through the
so-called step response. The dynamic evolution of the output variable can be
monitored in response to a step-change of the input. We may ask how this system
responds to a step-change of magnitude M in the input ow rate. The rst-order
system becomes that described by Eqs. (49), where Ht is the Heaviside step function dened by Eq. (50).
t

dy
K p MHt  y
dt

y0 0

0
Ht
1

if t < 0
if t b 0

49

50

The solution to this dierential equation, which may be found with the assistance
of Laplace transforms [7, 22] is Eq. (51).
yt K p M1  et=t

51

This result is plotted in Figure 12.20 (denoted by one tank) for the case of M 1
m 3 min1 , K p 1 min m2 , t 1 min. Note that the output is over-damped and
approaches a steady value after long times.
Second-order System
In a similar fashion one may analyze the system of two non-interacting tanks in
series, as shown in Figure 12.21.
The system mass balances are Eqs. (52), where the subscripts 1 and 2 denote
tanks 1 and 2 respectively [22].
12.4.2.2

A1

dh1
qv0  qv1
dt

dh2
qv1  qv2
A2
dt

52

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

1.2

1.2
u

0.8

y, m

1 tank (first order)


0.6

0.6

2 tanks (second order)


5 tanks

0.4

u, m 3 min -1

0.8

0.4

10 tanks
Infinite tanks

0.2

0.2

0
-1

t, min
Fig. 12.20.

Step responses of n 1; 2; 5; 10, and an innite number of tanks in series.

The outlet restrictors may again be considered linear as a rst approximation [Eqs.
(53)].

qv1

h1
R1
53

h2
qv2
R2
The material balances become those given by Eqs. (54), and at steady state they are
given by Eqs. (55).

R1 A 1

dh1
R1 qv0  h1
dt

 
dh2
R2

R2 A 2
h1  h2
dt
R1

54

633

634

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

qv0
FT

LT

h1

R1
FT

h2

qv1

LT
qv2
FT

R2
Fig. 12.21.

Two tanks in series without feedback control.

0 R1 qv0s  h1s
 
R2
h1s  h2s
0
R1

55

Subtracting Eqs. (55) from (54) yields Eqs. (56).


dh1
R1 qv0  qv0s  h1  h1s
dt
 
dh2
R2
R2 A2
h1  h1s  h2  h2s

dt
R1

R1 A1

56

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

Introducing deviation variables given by Eqs. (57), the mass balances become Eqs.
(58), which are in the form of two rst-order systems [Eqs. (59)] where the time
constants and process gains are given by Eqs. (60).
u 0 qv0  qv0s
y1 h1  h1s

57

y2 h2  h2s
dy1
R1 u 0  y1
dt
 
dy2
R2
R2 A 2
y1  y2

dt
R1
R1 A 1

t1

58

dy1
K p1 u 0  y1
dt

59

dy2
K p2 y1  y2
t2
dt
t1 R1 A1 ;

K p1 R1

t2 R2 A2 ;

K p2

60

R2
R1

These mass balances [Eqs. (58)] may be combined into one equation in y2 by differentiating the second and then eliminating y1 by successive substitutions [22] to
aord Eq. (61).
t1 t2

d 2 y2
dy2
y2 K p1 K p2 u 0
t1 t2
dt 2
dt

61

This is the equation of a second-order system. Again we may ask how this system
responds to a step-change of magnitude M in the input ow rate. The second-order
system becomes that described by Eqs. (62).
t1 t2

d 2 y2
dy2
t1 t2
y2 K p1 K p2 MHt
dt 2
dt

62

y2 0 0
The solution to this dierential equation, which again may be found with the assistance of Laplace transforms, is Eq. (63) [22].


t1
t2
y2 t K p1 K p2 M 1 
et=t1 
et=t2
t1  t 2
t2  t1


63

635

636

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

For the special case of equal time constants (t1 t2 t=2), the solution is Eq. (64).


2t
y2 t K p1 K p2 M 1  e2t=t  te2t=t
t

64

This result is plotted in Figure 12.20 (denoted by two tanks) for the case of M 1
m 3 min1 , K p1 K p2 1 min m2 , t 1 min. Note that the response of the two-tank
process is over-damped and slightly lagged compared with the single tank, producing an S-shaped curve.
High-order and Dead Time Systems
One may proceed in a similar fashion to obtain solutions for more and more tanks
in series with equal time constants, with the constraint that the total time constant is equal to the sum of the identical individual time constants so that t1
t2    tn t=n, creating systems of higher and higher order. These results
are plotted in Figure 12.20 for the cases with the numbers of tanks in series
n 1; 2; 5; 10; y with M 1 m 3 min1 , K p1 K p2 . . . K pn 1 min m2 , t 1 min.
As the number of tanks increases, the response approaches that of a pure delay or
dead time, y, equal to the total time constant of the innite tanks, y t.
12.4.2.3

First-order Plus Dead Time System


Since dead time is a frequently occurring phenomenon, many systems can be represented by a combination of a rst-order system plus dead time (FOPDT) system.
In the time domain the FOPDT system equation is Eq. (65).
12.4.2.4

dyt
K p ut  y  yt
dt

65

For a step-change in input ow rate of magnitude M the system becomes Eqs. (66),
the solution to which is Eq. (67).
t

dyt
K p MHt  y  yt
dt

66

y0 0
yt K p 1  ety=t MHt  y

67

This result is plotted in Figure 12.22 in original height h y hs variable for the
case of the FOPDT tank with parameters M 1 m 3 min1 , K p 10 min m2 ,
t 20 min, y 2 min, hs 4 m and t 0 10 min is the initial time of the stepchange in ow rate.
If at time t 0 in a system the input variable qv0 is increased by the amount Dqv0
and the output variable instantaneously changes by Dh, then we are dealing with a
self-regulating system without time delay. If the output variable follows with de-

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

16

16

14

14
h

12
Kp = h / qv0

h, m

10

hs

10

h
8

0.63 h

qv0, m 3 min-1

12

qv0
2

qv0

0
0

20

40

60

80

0
100

t, min
Fig. 12.22.

Step response of a rst-order plus dead time process.

lays, then delay elements are present such as storage/accumulation or ow lags. If


the response of the output variable begins also after a certain time y, then there
exists a system with dead time.
Figure 12.22 suggests a method to determine these parameters from a step test
experiment [6, 7, 22]. The parameters can be geometrically obtained from Figure
12.22 and this forms the basis for model identication. At time t 0 the steady-state
input to the process is stepped by an amount Dqv0 and the steady-state output
change Dh measured. Then the process gain is given by Eq. (68).
Kp

Dh
Dqv0

68

The dead time y is the delay in the response after the input step at time t 0 . The
time constant t is the time after the output has risen 0.63Dh above its original
steady value hs after the input step at time t 0 .
Dead time is always to be expected if there are transport processes in the system.
A pure dead time is observed during the metering of compounds with a weigh belt,

637

638

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

because for every adjustment at the entrance slide, the new quantity is only observed at the output after the residence time on the belt (Figure 12.7). Dead time
and time lags are to be expected in mixing control in a pipe, because in addition
to the transport time longitudinal mixing also plays a role. Higher-order lags are
often hard to distinguish from dead time, as shown in Section 12.4.2.3.
Integrating System
Suppose the situation of the tank in Figure 12.17 is that the euent ow restrictor
is replaced by a xed ow rate. This is a non-self-regulating or integrating process.
The mass balance is Eq. (69), as before [22].
12.4.2.5

dh
qv0  qv1
dt

69

However, this time the euent ow is ow controlled by a valve or pump, not the
height of liquid in the tank. At steady state for a xed value of qv1 Eq. (70) applies;
that is, at steady state, the inlet and outlet ows are exactly matched.
0 qv0s  qv1

70

Subtracting Eq. (70) from Eq. (69) gives Eq. (71).


A

dh
qv0  qv0s
dt

71

Introducing deviation variables [Eqs. (72)], the mass balance becomes Eq. (73),
where the process gain is given by Eq. (74).
u qv0  qv0s
y h  hs
dy
Kpu
dt
Kp

1
A

72

73
74

For a step-change in input ow rate of magnitude M the system becomes that described by Eqs. (75), the solution to which is Eq. (76), which is a ramp function
with slope K p .
dy
K p MHt
dt
y0 0

75

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

yt K p Mt

76

Thus the tank will overow or run dry if the inlet and outlet ows are not exactly
matched.
Integrator plus Dead Time System
With dynamic systems that are non-self-regulating one nds, likewise, step responses with and without dead time. An integrator plus dead time process would
be modeled like Eq. (77).
12.4.2.6

dyt
K p ut  y
dt

77

For a step-change in input ow rate of magnitude M the system becomes as in


Eqs. (78), the solution to which is Eq. (79).
dyt
K p MHt  y
dt

78

y0 0
yt K p Mt  yHt  y

79

This result is plotted in Figure 12.23 in original height variable h y hs with parameters M 1 m 3 min1 , K p 2 m2 , y 2 min, hs 4 m and t 0 10 min.
The parameters for this process may be obtained from a step test. At time t 0 the
steady-state input to the process is stepped by an amount Dqv0 and the gain K p is
found from the measured slope [Eq. (80)].
Slope

Dh
K p Dqv0
Dt

80

The dead time y is the delay in the response after the input step at time t 0 .
12.4.3

Controllers

Controllers are devices that are meant to keep a specic controlled variable constant despite outside disturbances. One dierentiates between continuous, digital,
and OnO controllers, depending on whether the output is continuous, discrete,
or ono. The great majority of controllers have been continuous, but the digital
controller is now commonplace due to the widespread use of computers and distributed control systems.
Referring again to Figure 12.19, the controller compares the measured value of
the controlled variable with the desired value, the set point, computes the manipulated variable, and inuences the actuator so that the set point and the controlled

639

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

25

25

20

20

15

qv0, m min

15

-1

h, m

640

Kp q v0 = h / t
10

10

h
hs

qv0

qv0

0
Fig. 12.23.

10
t, min

15

20

Step response of an integrator plus dead time process.

variable can be as close to each other as possible. Independently of design and application, one nds three basic functions, which can be simply represented mathematically: namely the proportional, integral, and derivative functions.
Proportional Control
The proportional controller (P controller) assigns to each value of the deviation a
specic value of the manipulated variable. For our tank example, the P controller
mode takes the form of Eq. (81), where qv0 ; qvs are the new output and the steadystate values of the ow rate respectively, K c is the controller gain, and hsp ; h are the
current level input height set point and measured value respectively.
12.4.3.1

qv0 t qvs K c hsp  ht

81

The steady-state value of the ow rate qvs , or bias, is the ow rate when the deviation from the set point is zero. The sign on the gain term, or controller action, is
adjusted to be either positive or negative to create negative feedback control in
which the controlled variable approaches a stable steady state. We may write this
controller in terms of deviation variables, according to Eqs. (82), where e is called
the error and u is the controller output, to obtain the deviation form [Eq. (83)].

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

e hsp  ht
ut qv0 t  qvs
ut K c et

82
83

Pure proportional controllers have the disadvantage that in order to change the
actuator, the controller needs a certain deviation; therefore this deviation can never
be entirely eliminated and is termed oset.
As given here the controller gain has units of ow/height or m 2 min1 . In commercial controllers the manipulated and controlled variables are often made dimensionless with the range and standard signal of the transmitter and actuator so
that the units of the gain would be, for example, %/% or mA/mA. Also, in older
controllers the term proportional band (PB) is used instead of controller gain
and is dened by Eq. (84).

PB

100%
Kc

84

Integral Control
The integral controller (I controller) assigns the integral over time of the error to a
specic change in the output variable. In the case of large errors over time, the
action is large; in the case of small errors over time, the action is small.
The I controller obeys Eq. (85), where tI is the reset time, in deviation variables.
12.4.3.2

1
ut
tI

et dt

85

The output changes until the error has disappeared. Pure integral-only controllers
have the disadvantage that they are sluggish for large tI and that they may be
prone to oscillation for small tI .
A disadvantage of integral control is reset windup. This results from the situation where, if the controller output saturates and the error remains large for an extended period of time, the integral gets large and does not recover immediately
even if the error then goes to zero or reverses sign. The integral has to be manually
reset in this situation in actual implementation.
Derivative Control
Derivative controllers (D controllers) are practical only in combination with other
controller modes. They provide a fast engagement at the beginning of the control
action. Here the derivative controller output is proportional to the rate of change of
the error [Eq. (86), where tD is the derivative time].
12.4.3.3

ut tD

det
dt

86

641

642

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

The derivative mode of a D controller causes theoretically a large change in output


of extremely short duration for a step-change in error. In practice, the eect of a
derivative controller is to cause a short increase in the output variable, which then
returns to the previous value.
PI, PD, and PID Control
These basic controllers are used in combinations; P, PI, PID, and also PD controllers are common. The appropriate equations are linear combinations of the selected components. The PI controller obeys the relationship of Eq. (87). It reacts
to a deviation with fast correcting action, and corrects the rest of the deviation
slowly. It kicks in immediately and operates very accurately in the long term.
12.4.3.4




1 t
et dt
ut K c e
tI 0

87

The PD controller obeys Eq. (88). It kicks in rst very strongly; the output then reverts back to a value that corresponds to the output of a P controller.


det
ut K c e tD
dt

88

If one combines all three controller actions, then a PID controller results. It obeys
Eq. (89). This is the universal type of controller, which acts fast and avoids lasting
oset.



1 t
det
89
et dt tD
ut K c e
tI 0
dt
The PID form implemented usually includes a derivative mode lter such as a
rst-order lter to eliminate noise, which would be written in the time domain as
Eqs. (90), where eF t is the ltered error and 0:05 < a < 0:2 is the dimensionless
lter constant [7].
deF t
eF t et
dt



1 t
deF t
et dt tD
ut K c e
tI 0
dt

atD

90

The PID controller may also use the rate of change of the measured variable (for
example, ht) instead of the error et to eliminate set point change derivative kick.
Derivative kick is mitigated if a derivative mode lter is used.
Digital Controllers
Modern implementations of controllers are not analog but digital due to the widespread use of computers and digital control systems. Digital control algorithms can
12.4.3.5

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

be derived from the continuous versions using standard numerical approximations


of the analog controllers. Digital signals are discrete in nature and arise from sampling continuous measurements at equal time intervals of width Dt, or they may
arise from naturally discrete signals such as, for example, from analyzers.
We may illustrate the nature of digital PID algorithms by starting with the ideal
PID controller [7, 22, 23] according to Eq. (91), where qv t; qvs are the new output
and the steady-state bias values of the ow rate respectively, and et hsp  ht is
the current error in the level height set point and measured value.



1 t
det
qv t qvs K c et
et dt tD
tI 0
dt

91

A simple digital form of this equation may be written for the nth time interval
using the rectangular rule of integration approximation to the integral and a rstorder backward nite dierence approximation of the derivative to yield the positional form, Eq. (92), where e n ; qv; n are the error and controller output respectively
at the nth sampling instant, and Dt is the sampling period.
"

qv; n


#
n
1X
e n  e n1
qvs K c e n
e i Dt tD
tI i1
Dt

92

We may write this equation for the (n  1)st sampling instant [Eq. (93)].
"

qv; n1


#
n1
1X
e n1  e n2
qvs K c e n1
e i Dt tD
tI i1
Dt

93

If we subtract this Eq. (93) from Eq. (92), we obtain the velocity form [Eq. (94)],
since it calculates the change in output.



1
e n  2e n1 e n2
qv; n  qv; n1 K c e n  e n1 e n Dt tD
tI
Dt

94

Solving for the output at the nth instant, we have a form [Eq. (95)] that calculates
the output directly.



1
e n  2e n1 e n2
qv; n qv; n1 K c e n  e n1 e n Dt tD
tI
Dt

95

One major advantage of the velocity form Eq. (95) over the positional form Eq. (92)
is that, as the summation is lacking, it has inherent anti-reset windup. Also, an initial value of the output bias is not required [7].
If the sampling period is small compared with the process time constant

643

644

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

(Dt f t) these integral and derivative approximations are accurate and the conventional tuning techniques used for continuous controllers discussed in Section
12.4.3.6 may also be used for digital controllers [7].
Controller Tuning
Controller parameters are tuned to provide both performance and stability and
there are many dierent rules for the tuning parameters of a control loop [6, 7,
22]. After deciding on the controller structure, one decides on the desired closedloop response criteria. Then one must distinguish between processes where there
is at least an approximate model with known parameters and the case when the
process model is unknown.
12.4.3.6

Process model is known An approximate model of the process may be obtained by


the step response test noted earlier (see Section 12.4.2.4) (or from rst principles).
When an approximate model of the process is known we may obtain the tuning
parameters directly. We use here the example of the rst-order plus dead time process, since its dynamics are so representative of the polymer equipment dynamics.
Here we have chosen for the tuning criteria to minimize the integral of the timeweighted absolute error (ITAE) [Eq. (96)] [7].

ITAE

96

tjetj dt

Tab. 12.1.

Minimum ITAE model controller tuning rules based on a FOPDT process [22].[a]

Controller type

Type of response

disturbance

PI

set point

PI

disturbance

PID

set point

PID

disturbance

[a] Tunings

Kc
 
0:49 t 1:084
Kp y
 
0:586 t 0:916
Kp
y
 
0:859 t 0:977
Kp
y
 0:855
0:965 t
Kp
y
 
1:357 t 0:947
Kp
y

tI

tD

t

 
y
1:03  0:165
t
 0:680
t
y
0:674 t
t

 
y
0:796  0:147
t
 0:738
t
y
0:842 t

should only be applied in the range 0:1 < y=t < 1:0.
B. A. Ogunnaike, W. H. Ray, Process Dynamics, Modeling, and Control,
Copyright ( 1994 Oxford University Press. This material is used by
permission of Oxford University Press.

 0:929
y
0.308t
t
 0:995
y
0:381t
t

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

1.2

ysp
1

Offset

y, m

0.8

PID
0.6

PI
0.4

0.2

0
0

10

15

20

25

t, min
Responses for step-change in set point with ITAE
tuned P, PI, and PID controllers on a rst-order plus dead time
process.
Fig. 12.24.

The minimum ITAE tuning rules based on a FOPDT process are given in Table
12.1 [22]. Note that the tunings in Table 12.1 should only be applied in the range
y
0:1 < < 1:0.
t
Figure 12.24 shows the dynamic response of P, PI, and PID controller types to a
step-change in the input of the rst-order plus dead time (FOPDT) process of Figure 12.22 with parameters K p 10 min m2 , t 20 min, y 2 min. For the
FOPDT example the tuning for the P controller is K c 0:595 min m2 , for the PI
controller it is K c 10 min m2 , tI 19:7 min, and for the PID controller it is
K p 0:691 min m2 , tI 25:6 min, tD 0:725 min. The derivative mode lter
was used for the PID controller with a lter constant of a 0:1. The control loop
was simulated numerically for Figure 12.24. It can be seen that the P controller
produces a long-term oset, which the PI controller eliminates, but with some
overshoot of the set point. The addition of the derivative action for the PID controller eliminates the overshoot and produces the best controller performance.
Process model is unknown If the process model is unknown, the continuous cycling method may be used [7]. The rules of Ziegler and Nichols [24] have proven

645

646

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors


Tab. 12.2. ZeiglerNichols controller tuning parameters based on the continuous cycling
method [7, 22, 24].

Controller type

Kc

tI

tD

0.5K cu

PI

0.45K cu

PID

0.6K cu

Pu
1:2
Pu
2

Pu
8

themselves useful in practice. For this test the controller is rst brought into automatic as a pure P controller with small gain, the reset time tI is set to the largest
value, and the derivative time tD is set to the lowest value. Then the gain K c is
slowly increased. When the controlled variable has an oscillatory response, the ultimate gain K cu has been reached and the oscillation has the ultimate period Pu . The
rules of Ziegler and Nichols then give the controller settings in Table 12.2. From
these starting values one can then nd the optimal tunings very quickly by small
systematic modications.
Figure 12.25 shows responses for a step-change in set point with P and PID controllers on the rst-order plus dead time process with parameters. The ultimate
gain for the P-only controller, found by trial and error, is K cu 1:68 m 2 min1 ,
and the ultimate period from Figure 12.25 is found to be Pu 7:4 min. The PID
controller is tuned with ZieglerNichols parameters from Table 12.2 of K c 1:008
m 2 min1 , tI 3:7 min, tD 0:925 min. Note that the PID response in Figure
12.25 has a much greater overshoot and much longer settling time than the ITAE
response given in Figure 12.24. Other alternative tuning rules have been developed
since the ZieglerNichols rules [7].
OnO Controllers
OnO controllers output the manipulated variable in discrete values (on/o, in/
out) at discrete time intervals. The ideal OnO controller is given by Eqs. (97),
where u max and u min are the on and o values of the output and et is the error
[7].
12.4.3.7


ut

u max

if et b 0

u min

if et < 0

97

Figure 12.26 illustrates an OnO controller applied to the FOPDT process with
parameters K p 10 min m2 , t 20 min, y 2 min. Controller outputs O and
On are u min 0 m 3 min1 and u max 0:2 m 3 min1 respectively. Although the
controller is very simple and there are no tuning parameters other than the on
and o values, it can be seen that continuous cycling results, which may or may
not be desirable.

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

ysp

1.5

PID control

y, m

1
P control
K c = K cu

ysp

Pu

0.5

-0.5
0

10

15

20

25

t, min
Responses for a step-change in set point with P
and PID controllers on a rst-order plus dead time process.
The gain for the P controller is the ultimate gain K cu and cycles
at the ultimate period Pu . The PID controller is tuned with
ZieglerNichols tunings.
Fig. 12.25.

A modication of the ideal OnO controller is the two-point controller, which


switches the output when an upper or lower limit value is exceeded, the dierence
between these two points being the deadband [6]. Limit signal transducers can be
used as two-point controllers (such as contact thermometers).
The benets of the two-point controller as compared with the continuous controller are that it is simple, durable, reliable, and cheap, requires no auxiliary
power, and does not lead to instability in the control loop. The disadvantages are
the wear on the actuator working parts, the cyclical oset, and the fact that large
power circuits must be switched. Two-point controllers are therefore hardly ever
used in an industrial environment.
Self-operated Regulators
Controllers which acquire sucient force from the measurement to move the actuator do not require auxiliary power. Such controllers have a simple and durable
construction, and many combine measuring instrument, controller, and actuator
12.4.3.8

647

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

1.2

1.2
ysp
1

0.8

0.6

0.6

0.4

u, m3 min-1

0.8

y, m

648

0.4
u

0.2

0.2

0
0

10

20

30

40

50

t, min
Responses for step-change in set point with an
OnO controller on a rst order plus dead time process.
Fig. 12.26.

functions. They have the advantage that they keep functioning if the auxiliary
power fails. Therefore simple pressure control valves of this type are suitable as
safety valves, in which a spring holds the plug of a valve in the seat, until an adjustable overpressure overcomes the force of the spring (Figure 12.27).
Here the exit pressure aects a diaphragm and holds a valve in an equilibrium
position against the force of a spring. If the pressure rises, this closes the crosssection of the plug against the seat, and if the pressure lowers it opens again. This
is also the method of operation of the pressure controllers in pneumatic transmission lines. Supply pressure-reducing valves are controllers without auxiliary power.
Simple ow controllers use the dierential pressure at an adjustable restrictor:
the plus and minus sides are on the two sides of a spring-supported diaphragm.
These controllers are used as backow (check) valves or as isolation valves, which
shut o if the ow is reversed or too high. Level controllers with oats are in condensate separators often coupled with simple temperature controllers as in Figure
12.28. These devices contain an electrical jump switch and operate therefore as
two-point OnO controllers. Controllers without auxiliary energy are used, where
it is not essential to have high control accuracy and when one must do without the
auxiliary power for safety reasons.

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

spring
(reference)

diaphragm

exit pressure
(controlled variable)

intake valve
(control member)
inlet pressure
Fig. 12.27.

Pressure controller with no auxiliary power [1].

Single-loop controllers with auxiliary power use compressed air or, more commonly now, electrical power to receive and transmit signals. These devices are
much more accurate than those without the auxiliary power; also they are not integrated in the measurement apparatus or the actuator. Distributed control systems
are rapidly replacing the single-loop controller panel boards unless only a small
number of control loops are involved.

Setpoint adjuster

lever
jump
switch

Fig. 12.28.

Electrical discrete temperature controller [1].

feeler
(staff of stretchthermometer)

649

650

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

12.4.4

Valve Position Controllers

The output signal of a controller is sent electrically or pneumatically to a valve positioner that modulates the supply pressure to the control valve actuator and must
make the stem position proportional to the input signal from the controller despite
loads on the valve [6, 25]. There the electrical signal must be converted to a pneumatic positioning pressure or the pneumatic signal must be brought to a higher
pressure in order to move the stem of the actuator reliably and to adjust the position of the valve accurately.
In the pneumatic position controller, which is attached directly to the valve actuator, the pneumatic adjusting signal output from the controller works on a membrane and summing beam [6]. If the pressure signal rises, then a connection to the
plant compressed-air network is opened to a pneumatic spool valve then to the
actuator that moves the valve stem downward until a compensating spring on
the summing beam holds the signal line pressure in equilibrium. Then the valve
stem lifts until a new equilibrium position that is sensed by a cam lever is
achieved. Thus a complete feedback loop exists where in this case the actuator is
the process, the stem position is the controlled variable, the input signal is the set
point, and the pneumatic amplier network is the controller.
Electro-pneumatic valve positioners are used with diaphragm-actuated, slidingstem control valves. The electro-pneumatic valve positioner receives an electronic
input signal from a control device and modulates the supply pressure to the control valve actuator, providing an accurate valve stem position [25].
12.4.5

Single-loop Controllers

Single-loop controllers, which used to be more prevalent, are still used in some applications, such as laboratory or pilot plant. They are a rectangular package that has
a faceplate for displaying the set point of a controller, to compare the set point with
the actual value, and to enable the switch from manual control to automatic control
or to cascade control. Single-loop controllers can be combined in a compact unit,
which is built directly into a panel board. The faceplates of pneumatic and electrical control devices are very similar to each other. The transition to process control
systems with newer display technologies is resulting in the disappearance of
single-loop controllers.
12.4.6

Digital Control Systems

Since the 1970s the hardware used in the implementation of process controls has
evolved from pneumatic analog technology to electronic analog technology to
microprocessor-based controls. Although pneumatic and electronic analog process

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

controls may still be in service in older facilities, almost all of the newer plants now
utilize microprocessor technology in implementing process control. Because of
rapid advances in computer technology and the increasing computation power
available on a single microprocessor, the hardware is becoming more powerful in
terms of available functionality. Excellent descriptions of control system hardware
is available in Refs. 4, 6, and 7 as well as in the technical literature provided by the
major vendors such as Honeywell, ABBBailey, Fisher Controls, and Siemens and
also in the specialized trade shows, publications, and books sponsored by the Instrument Society of America. From the perspective of polymer reaction engineering, there are four types of digital control hardware, which are listed in order of
increasing functionality, complexity, and cost:
1. Single-loop controllers are a stand-alone microprocessor-based version of the older
analog single-loop controller (see Section 12.4.5). They can operate independently or be part of a distributed control system and can execute the standard
PID algorithm but also increasingly cascade control and gain scheduling.
2. Programmable logic controllers (PLCs) were the rst digital technology to successfully compete with conventional technology in industrial control applications.
They were originally developed to replace hard-wired relay logic. PLCs are extremely important in batch control applications, because they are ideally suited
to program large and complex batch sequencing cycles using ladder diagrams
and a higher-level programming language. Because of their logic handling capability PLCs can also be used to implement process interlocks, which are designed to prevent process conditions that would unduly stress equipment (perhaps resulting in minor damage) or lead to o-specication product.
3. Personal computer (PC) controllers are appropriate for the control of a laboratory
or small- to medium-size pilot plant installations. The typical PC is augmented
by the appropriate input/output (I/O) interface software. Software tools are
available for the implementation of the previously discussed PID controllers using the PC. Advanced control algorithms can also be executed at the PC level.
The PC also provides graphic capability for the monitoring of the performance
of the control loop and can also provide data historian capability, which can be
very important for polymer process development.
4. The distributed control system, the process control architecture referred to as a
DCS, was introduced in the mid-1970s and has since become the standard for
large installations. The main concept behind the DCS is that microprocessorbased nodes are interconnected by a digital communications network often referred to as the data highway. A typical DCS installation handles seamlessly
process I/O from the eld, including interfaces with process analyzers (that is,
gas chromatographs), which are important in advanced control applications.
The DCS can be interfaced with PLCs, with operator stations for process monitoring and control including alarm management, with engineering workstations
for the system conguration activities, and also with a set of host computers
which can provide product quality information, data compression, reporting,
and archival capabilities, as well as advanced control calculations.

651

652

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

12.4.7

Actuators

Actuators govern the ow of energy and mass streams in the process [25]. Through
the actuators the controller output results in changes to the controlled variable
(temperature, pressure, ow, level, and so on) and thus the control loop is closed.
Actuators consist of the control positioner (for example, a valve positioner) and the
actuator element. The control positioner transfers the signal output of the controller in a controlled movement to bring the actuator element into a new position.
Examples of actuators are rheostats to set and control electrical current, valves,
aps, and metering pumps for liquids. The actuator, which is most frequently encountered in chemical process engineering, is the diaphragm valve (Figure 12.29).
The input actuating pressure lies on one side of a diaphragm and exercises a
force on it; the spring works against this force. The actuating pressure shifts the
position of the diaphragm so as to create equilibrium of forces with the spring.
The diaphragm is connected with the valve stem; the stem (and the plug) therefore
make a stroke proportional to the actuating pressure. Between the plug and the
valve seat a variable annular gap opens or closes, thus resulting in variable ow.
The seat and the plug are in a housing, which is solidly anchored and also holds
the stem. For high-temperature service the housing is cooled with ns in order to
protect the bushing packing. With dangerous material one uses valves with sealed
bellows and therefore no bushing is needed. Additional equipment, for example
position controllers or limit switches, can be attached to the valve as necessary.
In the pressure-free state the valve stem goes naturally to a terminal position. In
Figure 12.30(a), as the pneumatic controller output signal increases, increased
pressure on the diaphragm compresses the spring, thus pushing the stem in and
closing the valve further. Such a valve is termed air-to-close (AC). By reversing
either the plug/seat or the spring/air inlet orientation, the valve becomes air-toopen (AO) as in Figure 12.30(b). Normally the choice of AC or AO valve is
based on safety considerations. One chooses the way the valve should operate (full
ow or no ow) safely in case of a transmitter failure.
Standard diaphragm valves have a diaphragm area from 200 to 1000 cm 2 and a
stroke of 1530 mm [1]. Very large valves are equipped with diaphragms of up to
3000 cm 2 and have a 100 mm stroke. These large valves have large power requirements and operate with 3 bar pressure. In addition a valve positioner is needed. To
achieve higher strokes, specialized cylinders are used.
The valve stem, plug, and seat (called the trim) have dierent forms: ball, plug,
disk, or gate valves [7, 25]. Plugs are normally fabricated as rotationally symmetric
parabolic cones. There are numerous other plug shapes, which can be selected for
each individual case. The ow rate as a function of stem position, or lift, l, is called
the valve characteristic, f l. A valve characteristic may be linear, quick opening,
or equal percentage. The plug shape, seat, and cage primarily determine the valve
characteristic, the sensitivity to contamination, and utter avoidance.
To size a valve for liquids we may return to a modied form [Eq. (98)] of the
equation given for restrictors [7, 12, 25].

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

Diaphragm
with disk

Actuator
springs

Control
air
Diaphragm
casing

Yoke

Valve
stem
Stuffing
box
Plug

Seat

Direction
of flow
Valve
body
Fig. 12.29.

Diaphragm valve [1].

qv CV f l

r
Dp
d

98

Here qv is the volumetric ow rate, CV is the valve coecient, Dp p1  p2 is the


pressure drop across the valve, and d is the relative liquid density (specic gravity)
[Eq. (99), where r is the uid density at operating temperature and rw0 is the water
density at a standard temperature and pressure (usually 4 C and 1 bar)].
d

r
rw0

99

The valve characteristic 0 a f l a 1 is given by Eq. (100), where 0 a l a 1 is the


lift and 20 a R a 50 is a valve design parameter [7].

653

654

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors


Control air

Diaphragm
chamber

Spring
Diaphragm
chamber

Control
air

Valve stem

Plug

(b) Air-to-open valve


Seat
Diaphragm valves with dierent rest states: (a) air-to-close; (b) air-to-open [1].

(a) Air-to-close valve


Fig. 12.30.

8
l;
>
<p

f l
l;
>
: l1
R ;

for a linear valve


for a quick opening valve

100

for an equal percentage valve

In USCS units the valve coecient, CV , is the full open ow rate in gal min1 of
water at 60 F (15.6 C) that will ow through the valve with a 1 psi (6.89 kPa) pressure drop. In SI units the valve coecient (called KV ) is the full open ow rate in
m 3 h1 of water at 20 C that will ow through the valve with a 1 bar pressure drop.
International control valve standards are listed in Ref. 25.
For gases the pressure ratio p2 = p1 at the valve must not be less than about 0.53;
otherwise sonic velocity, c, is achieved in the restriction [10]. At the sonic velocity
the throughput cannot be increased as the valve cross-section continues to open
[10]. The pressure inside the valve must be lower than the liquid vapor pressure;
otherwise ashing or cavitation occurs.
Besides diaphragm valves, one frequently uses buttery valves (particularly for
gases in lines with large diameter), which are constructed with a stop (Figure
12.31) or without (Figure 12.32). Buttery valves without a stop (so-called regulating aps; see Figure 12.32) do not seal completely; their leakage ow is within 5
10% of the expected value when the valve is fully open.

12.4 Regulatory Control Engineering

Fig. 12.31.

Buttery valve with a stop [1].

Fig. 12.32.

Buttery valve without a stop [1].

655

656

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

With large nominal sizes and higher pressure, gate valves are used. It is advantageous that they have only a low-pressure drop and are insensitive against contamination. Gate valves have one large stroke; one cannot equip them with a diaphragm control drive, but the stem moves with gear racks, piston drive units, or
electric motors.

12.5

Advanced Control Engineering

The polymerization reactor is usually at the heart of the manufacturing process,


impacting both downstream processing and nal customer-related polymer properties. The following factors have contributed to the industrial signicance of polymer reactor control:


the need to improve xed-asset productivity by optimizing reactor yield and


uptime;
 the trend toward shorter manufacturing campaigns for the dierent polymer
grades manufactured in the same reactor, or toward more frequent on-line product transitions to reduce product inventories and hence working capital;
 global competition, which imposes tough requirements for polymer grade uniformity;
 safety and environmental considerations regarding the stable operation of a potentially thermally unstable reaction.
The measurement and control techniques discussed in the previous sections,
many of which are generic in nature, are not always adequate to meet the following
practical considerations specic to a polymerization reactor, which pose additional
challenges to the successful application of a control strategy:


Polymerization reactors are well known both theoretically and experimentally


to exhibit multiple steady states [26, 27] and in some cases they may also exhibit
oscillations in terms of monomer conversion and polymer particle diameter [28].
In other cases it may be necessary to choose an open-loop unstable state as the
reactor operating point. Furthermore, polymerization reactors can be highly exothermic and result in reactor thermal runaway.
 On-line measurements of polymer architecture such as composition, molecular
weight, and degree of branching which were discussed in Sections 12.2.8 and
12.2.10, are not always available and for some polymer systems may be simply
unavailable. In many cases the control engineer may have to rely on polymer
properties inferred from infrequent laboratory analysis of reactor samples or
from laboratory analysis of the nal polymer after it has experienced signicant
post-reactor processing, thus introducing large dead times in the control loop.
 The relationship between reactor operating conditions, such as monomer conver-

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

sion, temperature, residence time, polymer composition, and viscosity, and the
customer-related nal properties, such as tensile strength, elongation at break,
and processability in an injection molding machine, may not always be well dened. Variability in the polymer isolation process and long-term polymer structure changes such as aging may result in the fact that, although in some cases
the reactor may be operating on-aim within well-dened manufacturing specications, the nal polymer may not process satisfactorily when delivered to the
customer.
 The control system for a polymerization reactor must be suciently robust
to handle unmeasured disturbances, which impact polymer reactor operation.
These disturbances typically result either from trace amounts of polymerization
inhibitors left over after monomer purication before the polymerization reaction or from trace amounts of other compounds which may be present in a typical polymerization recipe and which may be aecting the reaction.
 A polymerization reactor often produces several grades (in terms of composition
and viscosity) of the same polymer and therefore the control strategy must be
easily adapted to a multi-product plant and in some cases to on-line grade transitions. In the case of a multi-product plant it may be necessary to operate the
reactor in terms of rather short campaigns in order to minimize the nishedproduct inventory and thus the working capital. In these cases the reactor control
system must be designed in such a way as to achieve fast startups while minimizing o-specication polymer formation.
The purpose of this section is to highlight several control engineering techniques,
some of which are known in the literature as advanced control, which can be
deployed to meet some of the challenging aspects of polymer reactor control.
These techniques have been extensively discussed in literature reviews such as
Refs. 2932 and in books [18, 19].
The discussion will be facilitated by focusing on the polymerization process
shown in Figure 12.33 [33]. Although the process is generic, the owsheet captures many of the elements of actual free-radical polymerization reactor installations. Monomers A and B are continuously added with initiator, solvent, and chaintransfer agent. In addition, an inhibitor may enter with the fresh feeds as an
impurity. These feed streams are combined (stream 1) with the recycle stream
(stream 2) and ow to the reactor (stream 3), which is assumed to be a jacketed
well-mixed tank. A coolant ows through the jacket to remove the heat of polymerization. Polymer, solvent, unreacted monomers, initiator, and chain-transfer agent
ow out of the reactor to the separator (stream 4), where polymer, residual initiator,
and chain-transfer agent are removed. Unreacted monomers and solvent (stream
7) then continue on to a purge point (stream 8), which represents venting and
other losses and is required to prevent accumulation of inerts in the system. After
the purge, the monomers and solvent (stream 9) are stored in the recycle hold
tank, which acts as a surge capacity to smooth out variations in the recycle ow
and composition. The euent (stream 2) recycle is then added to the fresh feeds.

657

658

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Monomer
(A)
Purge Valve
9

Monomer
(B)
Hold Tank
Initiator
(I)
Reactor

2
Solvent
(S)
Transfer
Agent
(T)

3
Coolant

Coolant
Separator
4

Inhibitor
(Z)
6
Polymer, Initiator, Transfer Agent
Fig. 12.33.

Copolymerization with recycle loop [33].

It has been found that the hierarchical approach summarized in Figure 12.34 is
very useful in the successful application of process control in a complex industrial
environment. Process knowledge, which is usually captured in an experimentally
validated mathematical model, is the cornerstone of a successful control strategy.
This is particularly true for polymerization reactors, where the in-depth knowledge
of process operation in terms of the eect of operating variables on polymer properties can be used to great advantage in the design of the control system and can
result in a much more straightforward (and therefore easy to maintain) strategy
than would have been possible otherwise (see, for example, the control strategy
discussed in Ref. 30). Process knowledge together with the appropriate sensors,
transmitters, and analyzers are the prerequisites for the design of the basic control
system to regulate pressure, temperature, level, and ow (PTLF). Only when the
elements of the regulatory control system are in place and are properly designed
and maintained can the control engineer attempt, in increasing order of complexity, the implementation of more advanced regulatory control strategies, multivariable model-based control algorithms, and on-line scheduling and optimization
strategies to compute set points for the regulatory controls. In many instances advanced control applications have failed in an industrial environment not because

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

SCHEDULING
AND
OPTIMIZATION
MODEL BASED CONTROL
ADVANCED REGULATORY
CONTROL
REGULATORY CONTROL (P,T,L,F)
SENSORS, TRANSMITTERS, ANALYZERS
PROCESS
Fig. 12.34.

The process control hierarchy.

the algorithms were necessarily faulty but because the basic regulatory control system performed poorly, either because of inadequate design or because one of the
critical measurements (that is, a process analyzer) was poorly maintained.
12.5.1

Feedforward Control

The traditional PID feedback controller, which was discussed previously (see Section 12.4.3.4), is very widely used, because it requires minimal process knowledge
for its design. In particular, a mathematical model of the process is not required
although it can be quite useful for appropriate tuning. Furthermore, if process conditions change, the PID controller can be retuned to maintain satisfactory performance. A properly tuned PID controller can be quite robust in maintaining good
steady-state operation in the face of unmeasured disturbances.
However, since control action can only occur if a deviation occurs between the
set point and the measured variable, perfect control is not possible. Therefore feedback control fails to provide predictive control action to compensate for the eects
of known disturbances. A more serious limitation, which is particularly important
for polymer reactor control, is that the controlled variable cannot always be measured on-line.
Feedforward control was developed to counter some of these limitations. Its
basic premise is to measure the important disturbance variables and then take
corrective compensatory action based on a process model. The quality of control is
directly related to the delity and accuracy of the process model. Two implementations of feedforward control which are widely used in polymer reactor control will
be discussed, namely feedforward control design based on steady-state models, and

659

660

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

ratio control. Furthermore, the powerful combination of feedforward and feedback


control will be considered, because it utilizes the best of both approaches: feedforward control works by reducing the eects of measured disturbances, and feedback
control provides the necessary trim to compensate for the eect of model and
measurement inaccuracies as well as measurement error.
Steady-state Model Feedforward Control
To illustrate this approach the polymerization process previously described in Figure 12.33 is considered. The presence of the recycle stream introduces disturbances in the reactor feed which perturb the polymer properties. The objective of
the feedforward control is to compensate for these disturbances by manipulating
the fresh feeds in order to maintain constant feed composition and ow to the reactor. Feedforward control of the recycle allows the designer to separate the control
of the reactor from the rest of the process.
As shown in Ref. 33, the feedforward control equations were obtained by writing
component material balances around the recycle addition point. For example, for
monomer A this balance is given by Eq. (101).
12.5.1.1

qn3 qna1 ya2 qn2

101

This equation is then solved in Eq. (102) for the fresh feed of monomer A since it
is desired to keep the goal ow of monomer A to the reactor (qna3 ) constant.
qna1 qna3  ya2 qn2

102

The recycle composition ( ya2 ) is typically measured by online gas chromatographs,


which may have signicant time delays. If a faster response time of the analyzer is
required, an infrared or Raman spectroscopy probe may be used. As discussed in
Section 12.2.8 ow qn2 is typically measured and controlled by manipulating the
recycle valve to maintain the desired inventory in the feed tank. Any disturbances
in the recycle composition or ow will cause variations in the fresh feed in order to
keep the reactor feed constant. Similar feedforward controllers are implemented
for monomer B and solvent, which are also present in the recycle stream.
As shown in Refs. 22 and 33, the performance of the feedforward control allows
perfect compensation of disturbances that can arise, for example, from a stepchange in the purge ratio, so that the reactor polymer characteristics (composition,
molecular weight) are unaected. Without the presence of the feedforward controllers the reactor dynamics and hence its control can be aected directly by the presence of three lags in series (reactor, separator, hold tank) and thus become unnecessarily more complex.
Ratio Control
Ratio control is a form of feedforward control which is widely used in the chemical
industry and has proven very useful in polymerization reactor control. As is evident from its name, its purpose is to keep the ratio of two process variables at a
12.5.1.2

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

Monomer B/A
Ratio Setpoint

RC

FC

FT
Monomer (B)

FT
Monomer (A)
Fig. 12.35.

Ratio control.

given value; hence it can be deployed when the objective is to maintain a certain
proportion (or stoichiometry) of reactants in the reactor.
The implementation of ratio control can be described by referring back to the
polymerization process in Figure 12.33 and to the discussion in Ref. 7.
Typically, ow controllers are designed for each of the reactor feed streams (for
example, monomer, initiator, chain transfer) and each one of these controllers has
a set point, which is dependent on the particular polymer being made. However,
when ratio control is implemented as shown in Figure 12.35, one of the reactor
feed streams (monomer A in this case) is chosen as the reference stream. The
measured ow rate of monomer A is then transmitted to the ratio station RC,
which multiplies the signal by the desired ratio KR (typically determined by the
polymer chemist) to calculate the set point ysp for the ow controller of monomer
B. Dynamic simulations for the polymerization reactor shown in Figure 12.33 and
reported in Ref. 33 showed that the selection of ow ratios as manipulated variables reduced the interactions among the output variables such as composition
and molecular weight. It is important that the ow controller for monomer B be
tightly tuned with short settling times so that when there are disturbances in the
ow of monomer A, any transient mismatches between monomer A and B ows
are minimized.
12.5.2

Cascade Control

Cascade control is also widely used in the chemical process industries and especially in cases where there may be nonlinear behavior in the dynamics of the con-

661

662

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

TC

Polymerizer
Coolant
TT
Polymerizer Feed

Feed Heat
Exchanger

Fig. 12.36.

Conventional temperature control of an adiabatic polymerizer.

trol loop. It also addresses the main drawback of conventional feedback control,
namely the fact that control action only occurs where the controlled variable deviates from the set point. Unlike feedforward control, which requires that disturbances be explicitly measured and a model be available to calculate controller
output, cascade control introduces an additional measurement and an additional
feedback controller. The secondary measurement is typically located so that it recognizes the upset conditions sooner than the controlled variable.
The concept of cascade control has been traditionally very much used for eective reactor temperature control. An example of the implementation of cascade
control is shown in Figures 12.36 and 12.37.
In many instances polymerization reactors are operated adiabatically. In the case
shown in Figure 12.36, in which only traditional feedback control is used, measurement of the reactor temperature is used to manipulate the heat exchanger
ow to cool the reactor feed so that the reactor adiabatic temperature rise is adequate to remove the heat of polymerization. This conventional scheme may regulate reactor temperature satisfactorily but disturbances that occur in the feed line
may result in a rather sluggish response of the temperature controller. Polymer
properties are very sensitive to temperature excursions and in many cases this
sluggish response of the temperature control loop may not be acceptable. Cascade
control as shown in Figure 12.37 resolves the problem by introducing an additional
measurement, namely the temperature of the reactor feed, and an additional controller. The cascade control structure has the following characteristics:


The output signal of the primary (frequently referred to as the master) reactor
temperature control loop serves as the set point of the secondary (frequently referred to as the slave) reactor feed temperature control loop.

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

Master
TC
Slave

TC
Polymerizer

Coolant
TT
TT
Polymerizer Feed

Feed Heat
Exchanger

Fig. 12.37.

Cascade temperature control of an adiabatic polymerizer.

The two feedback controllers are nested with the secondary control loop located
inside the primary control loop.
 There is one manipulated variable but two sensors and two controlled variables.
The secondary controller responds rapidly to any temperature disturbances in the
reactor feed line and provides improved reactor temperature control. As discussed
in Ref. 7, a similar cascade control scheme can be implemented in the case where
the reactor is jacketed and the reactor temperature is controlled by manipulating
the cooling medium (typically water) inlet stream. In this case the additional measurement is the temperature of the jacket, which is compared with a set point provided by the master reactor temperature controller. The resulting error signal is the
input to the controller for the cooling water makeup.
It is obvious from the preceding discussion that for a cascade control system to
function eectively, the secondary control loop must be selected and tuned so as to
have a faster response than the primary controller. According to Ref. 7, the secondary controller is normally a P or PI controller with derivative action hardly used.
The primary controller is typically a PI or PID controller.
12.5.3

FeedforwardFeedback Control

The combination of feedforward and feedback control provides a very powerful


practical strategy for the control of polymer properties such as composition and
molecular weight. Typically it is still fairly dicult to have on-line direct measurements of polymer composition, so the control design has to incorporate the avail-

663

664

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

able o-line reactor sample composition measurements obtained at the laboratory,


typically using IR or NMR techniques. Similarly, despite advances in size exclusion
chromatography/gel permeation chromatography technology (SEC/GPC), on-line
SEC/GPC is not routinely available for most industrial polymer reactor control
applications. In many cases the control engineer has therefore to rely on o-line
measurements of molecular weight. Typically measures of molecular weight used
in control applications are the inherent viscosity and/or the melt index. The latter
is very common in polyolen production and recent advances in capillary rheometry, as reported in the vendor literature, provide the capability of continuous measurement of melt index and viscosity during polymer production using on-line or
at-line instrumentation. It is also very important to establish appropriate set points
and specications for the inherent viscosity and melt index by relating them to the
underlying molecular weight distribution, as shown for example in Ref. 34.
Returning to the polymerization process shown in Figure 12.33 and following
the discussion in Ref. 30 (which dealt with an emulsion polymerization reactor)
as well as the previously discussed concept of the process control hierarchy, it is
very important to use process understanding (typically captured in dynamic simulations using experimentally validated models) in the design of the control system
for polymer composition and molecular weight. For example, it was shown for a
specic case, which is however typical of a wide class of continuous polymer reactors in industrial practice, that the reactor temperature control is crucial because
inherent viscosity is extremely sensitive to temperature variations. As discussed
above (see Section 12.5.2), cascade control can be eectively deployed to control
reactor temperature within very tight specication limits. Achieving good reactor
temperature control can become particularly challenging in multi-product semibatch polymerization reactors, because physical properties of the reactor contents
vary from run to run and within a run and the standard PID controllers used in a
cascade design may not be able to perform satisfactorily over the entire range of
operation required. In these cases more advanced temperature control strategies
based on adaptive control [7] or model-based control can be eectively used, as
shown, for example, in Ref. 35 for an industrial reactor and in Ref. 36 for a
laboratory-scale one. Moreover, adaptive cascade control strategies can provide
better performance without the need for retuning than a traditional PI cascade
control system in the case of jacketed stirred tank reactors in which multiple products are produced and the overall heat-transfer coecient is unknown and can vary
signicantly as a result of fouling, as shown, for example, in Ref. 37.
An additional diculty in the control of polymer properties is that in some cases
the control problem is multivariable, in the sense that there are interactions between the molecular weight and composition loops and therefore when a manipulated variable is chosen to control molecular weight it may also aect composition.
It is important to use process knowledge to validate the selection of manipulated
variables. For example, for the polymerization reactor shown in Figure 12.33, process simulations showed that one way to decouple polymer quality control is to
take advantage of the fact that polymer composition is naturally very sensitive to
changes in reactor feed composition but inherent viscosity is relatively insensitive

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

to reactor feed composition changes. As discussed in Ref. 33, there exists a much
more formal way for feedback controller design. It consists in creating an approximate linear multivariable model from the nonlinear polymer reactor model using
step test data and then using the techniques of relative gain array (RGA) and singular value decomposition analysis (SVD) (as described, for example, in Ref. 7) to
determine the best pairings of controlled and manipulated variables for robust
multi-loop control.
A typical control strategy for polymer composition, which can be implemented
for the reactor shown in Figure 12.33, is illustrated in Figure 12.38. The measurements used are the ows of the fresh monomer feeds, the recycle ow, the monomer composition of the recycle feed and the total monomer reactor feed provided
by two on-line gas chromatographs, and the polymer composition provided by laboratory analysis of reactor samples. The supervisory control consists of three levels
implemented in a cascade fashion:

Gas
Chromatograph
Feedback

Feed
Forward
Monomer FC
(A)

Polymer
Composition
Feedback

FT
Purge Valve
8

9
Monomer FC
(B)

FT
Hold
Tank

Initiator
(I)

Solvent
(S)

FC

FT
2

FC

FT

XT

FT

XT

Reactor

Lab

Transfer
Agent FC
(T)

XT

FT
4

Inhibitor
(Z)

Separator

6
Polymer
Fig. 12.38.

Copolymer composition control strategy.

665

666

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

1. Feedforward controller, previously discussed, which maintains the total monomer


feed rate and monomer A feed composition at the appropriate set points for the
specic polymer grade being produced. The feedforward controller can be easily
extended to n monomers by specifying the total monomer reactor feed rate and
the feed composition for n  1 monomers.
2. Gas chromatograph feedback controller, which uses the velocity algorithm for digital PID control, discussed in Section 12.4.3.4 to calculate ow correction factors
for the monomers from the gas chromatograph measurement of the actual
monomer feed composition. This controller provides the necessary integral
action so that the oset between the actual reactor monomer feed composition and its set point, which may be caused by owmeter inaccuracies or other
unmeasured disturbances, is minimized.
3. Polymer composition feedback controller, which updates the set points for the reactor monomer feed composition based on the laboratory analysis of a reactor
sample. This controller thus provides the necessary integral action so that the
oset between the measured composition of the reactor sample and the polymer grade composition is minimized.
It is important to note that these feedforward and feedback controllers have been
designed hierarchically, in the sense that each level in the structure will not activate
unless the levels below it are functioning properly. Furthermore, in practice extensive data validation checks must be incorporated so that robust performance can be
assured even when the gas chromatograph or laboratory analysis measurements
may be unavailable or faulty.
The control of inherent viscosity shown in Figure 12.39 uses the same approach
as the composition control. Depending on the polymer grade being manufactured,
the initiator or the chain-transfer agent may be used to control emulsion viscosity.
An inherent viscosity feedback controller adjusts automatically the set point of the
monomer to transfer agent ratio controller based on the measured viscosity value,
(Section 12.2.7) and provides the necessary integral action so that the dierence between the reactor inherent viscosity and the polymer grade inherent viscosity specication is minimized. As in the case of composition control, extensive data and
controller output checks must be incorporated in any practical implementation to
provide robust performance.
12.5.4

State Estimation Techniques

In the design of the composition and viscosity feedback controllers it is very important to establish whether the polymer reactor dynamics need to be taken explicitly
into account. The choice of sampling frequency balances the requirements for
good quality control versus the need to minimize analytical costs. Usually, when
the reactor residence time is much shorter than the sampling frequency, integral
control is appropriate, because the time between measurements is usually sucient for the eect of an adjustment to a process variable set point to be com-

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

Monomer to
Transfer Agent
Ratio Controller
Monomer FC
(A)

Polymer Inherent
Viscosity Feedback
Controller

FT
Purge Valve

Monomer
(B)

FC

FT

Hold
Tank
Initiator FC
(I)

Solvent FC
(S)

FT
2
FT

Reactor
3
Lab

Transfer
Agent
FC
(T)

XT

FT
4

Inhibitor
(Z)

Separator
6
Polymer

Fig. 12.39.

Inherent viscosity control strategy.

plete within this interval. In other cases the sampling dead time introduced by
the periodic analysis of polymer concentration, polymer composition, and molecular weight may necessitate the incorporation of on-line state estimators of polymer
properties.
Reaction calorimetry aims to measure heat released from a polymerization in
order to infer monomer conversion and polymerization rate (as reviewed, for example, in Refs. 8, 38, and 39). Careful measurement and balancing of mass and
energy ows are necessary for success of this technique. For example, the commercial MettlerToledo RC1 jacketed reactor acts as a calorimeter supplying mass balance, polymerization heat generation, and transport data.
On-line estimation may also be accomplished using rst-principles polymerization kinetic models implemented on-line in the form of an extended Kalman lter
(EKF) (as illustrated for example in Refs. 8 and 4042). It should be pointed out
that the choice of techniques for on-line estimation of polymer properties is still
an active area of research and is very much dependent on the specics of the polymer chemistry and available on-line instrumentation.

667

668

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

12.5.5

Model Predictive Control

The previously discussed single-loop and appropriately chosen multi-loop feedforward and PID feedback control strategies may not be adequate for the eective
control of polymer properties, particularly in the case when the polymerization
reactor exhibits strongly nonlinear dynamic behavior, or when there are strong interactions between the controlled variables, or when there are constraints on the
manipulated variables. From the advanced process control techniques such as internal model control (IMC), inferential control, and adaptive control that have
been developed by the academic process control community for these tough multivariable control problems, model predictive control (MPC) has reached the stage
where it is having a signicant impact on industrial practice. MPC algorithms are
rapidly becoming imbedded in the distributed control system (DCS) software libraries, which facilitates their use. As reported in a 2003 survey [43], by the end
of 1999 there were at least 4500 industrial MPC applications worldwide, mainly in
oil reneries and petrochemical plants.
The structure of MPC is shown in the block diagram of Figure 12.40 [7]. A mathematical model of the process is used to predict the current values of the output
(controlled) variables. The model is usually implemented in the form of a multivariable linear or nonlinear dierence equation. It is typically developed from data
collected during special plant tests consisting of changing an input variable or a
disturbance variable from one value to another using a series of step-changes with
dierent durations, or more advanced protocols such as the pseudo random-binary
sequence described in Ref. 7. The residuals (that is, the dierence between the pre-

Set-point
calculations
Set points
(targets)

Prediction

Predicted
Outputs

Control
calculations

Inputs

Process
outputs
Process

Inputs
Model

Residuals
Block diagram for model predictive control [7]. D. E.
Seborg, T. F. Edgar, and D. A. Mellichamp, Process Dynamics
and Control, Copyright 8 2003 John Wiley & Sons, Inc. This
material is used by permission of John Wiley & Sons, Inc.

Fig. 12.40.

Model
outputs

-+

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

dicted and actual output variables) serve as a feedback signal to the prediction
block and are used in two types of control calculations that are performed at each
sampling instant, namely set point calculations and control calculations.
A unique feature of MPC is that inequality constraints can be incorporated in
both the set point and control calculations. In practice inequality constraints arise
as a result of physical limitations on plant equipment such as pumps, control
valves, and heat exchangers. The set points for the control calculations are typically
calculated from an economic optimization of the process based on a steady-state
model. Typical optimization objectives can include maximizing a process function,
minimizing a cost function, or maximizing a production rate. The objective of the
control calculations in the control block is to determine a sequence of control
moves (changes in the manipulated variables) so that the predicted response
moves to the set point in an optimal manner, for example by following a reference
trajectory. The calculated control actions are implemented as set points to regulatory control loops. A detailed explanation of the dierent design choices that are
necessary for the eective implementation of design of the MPC controller is available in Refs. 7 and 22. It is also essential to point out that the quality of MPC is
very strongly dependent on the availability of a reasonably accurate process model
that can capture the interactions between input, output, and disturbance variables.
Although MPC control has become an established technology for tough control
problems in petrochemical plants, its application in polymer reactor control is currently transitioning from purely academic studies using simulated examples to applications in industrial reactors. Referring to the polymerization process previously
described in Figure 12.33 [33], several academic researchers (for example, in Refs.
4446) have designed and implemented MPC controllers. These controllers were
used successfully for plant startup, minimization of o-grade product during
grade transitions, and regulation around a set point. Recently reported industrial
applications of MPC in polymer reactors, for example in Refs. 47 and 48, have focused on the transition control requirements, which typically consist in completing
the transition in either a minimum time period or with minimum amount of ospecication product. MPC is well suited to the grade transition problem [49],
which often translates into aggressive manipulated variable moves, often against
manipulated variable limits or plant constraints. Depending on the specic process
reported, benets have also been achieved in product consistency or increased production rate.
12.5.6

Batch and Semi-batch Control


Operation and Variability
Batch reactors are the most common reactor used in polymerization engineering.
They may vary in size from a ve-gallon pilot unit to a 30 000-gallon (or greater)
production size [19]. Removal of the heat of polymerization is accomplished by circulating coolant through a jacket or by reuxing monomer and solvent. The main
advantage of batch reactors is the exibility to accommodate multiple products.
12.5.6.1

669

670

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

They are well suited for low-volume products and for products for which there
are numerous grades (as in specialty polymers), because each batch can be made
according to its own recipe and operating conditions without the costs incurred
when a continuous reactor is shut down and restarted. Process control of batch
reactors must address the main disadvantage of batch reactors versus continuous
ones, namely variability within a batch and/or variability from batch to batch. This
variability is particularly important in free-radical batch polymerization, where the
time of formation of a single chain is only a very small fraction of the batch time
and therefore inhomogeneity results from the fact that polymer chains are formed
under very dierent conditions during the course of the batch. This is especially
signicant for composition control in a free-radical batch copolymerization reactor
where, unless special control strategies are deployed, polymer chains formed early
in the reaction may contain a higher fraction of the more reactive monomer than
the chains formed later in the reaction (compositional drift). On the contrary, in
step growth polymerization (polyamides, polyesters), where the growth time of an
individual chain is approximately the batch time, the eects of the changing reaction environment, and hence within-batch inhomogeneities, are much less of an
issue, since all chains will see the same changing environment [19].
Operation in semi-batch reactor mode is very common in polymer reaction engineering practice. Typically, one way to address the issue of compositional drift in
free-radical batch copolymerization is to operate the reactor under the so-called
starved feed policy. In this case the monomer feed rate is automatically adjusted
to maintain a constant rate of reaction, as inferred for example by reactor pressure
(Section 12.2.2). In this starved feed operation the reaction environment is maintained constant during the batch and therefore the monomer composition in the
reactor feed is equal to the desired polymer composition. It is also possible to implement more sophisticated control strategies during the batch by establishing operating trajectories for initiator addition, monomer addition, and/or reactor temperature to achieve desired polymer properties in minimum time, to maximize
productivity, or to tailor the polymer molecular weight distribution. This is typically
accomplished by solving o-line an optimization problem using a kinetic model of
the process as shown, for example, in Refs. 5054. These essentially open-loop trajectories constitute a form of feedforward control and are then implemented as
part of the batch sequential logic and recipe management system using ladder
logic and binary logic diagrams as shown in Ref. 7.
If monomer conversion and molecular weight information is available during
the batch (for example, through on-line densitometry, energy balance estimation,
or on-line gel permeation chromatography) it can be incorporated as part of a feedback adaptive predictive control strategy, as for example in Ref. 55, to maintain
the molecular weight at a desired value, while bringing the reaction to a specied
monomer conversion in minimum time by manipulating initiator feed rate and
coolant jacket temperature. In addition, if a fundamental model of the process is
available including reaction kinetics and an energy balance, control moves during
the batch can be calculated by solving a nonlinear dynamic optimization problem
within the context of the previously discussed model predictive control to account

12.5 Advanced Control Engineering

for the wide variety of constraints typically encountered in batch systems. This
approach has been described [56] and applied recently [57] to a set of commercial
polymerization reactors exhibiting challenging dynamic behavior that prevented
conventional control from delivering optimum manufacturing performance.
Statistical Process Control
In many cases of batch and semi-batch polymerization control there are no on-line
measurements of polymer quality (for example, polymer composition, molecular
weight) during the batch and these measures of end-use properties are only available at the end of the batch. In this case recipe modications from one run to the
next are common. The minimal information needed to carry out this type of runto-run control is a static model relating the manipulated variable to the quality
variables at the end of the batch. As pointed out in Ref. 7, this model can be as
simple as a steady-state (constant) gain relationship or a nonlinear model that includes the eects of dierent initial conditions and the batch time. The philosophy
of statistical process control can be very useful in this case, since the polymer quality variable (for example the Mooney viscosity in elastomer manufacture) can be
plotted for each successive batch on a Shewhart (x-bar) chart with the upper and
lower control limits placed at three standard deviations above and below the target.
A point outside the control limits means that the batch is out of control and the
batch recipe and possibly the sequence logic must be adjusted for the next batch.
If the quality variable for the batch is within the control limits, no control action is
taken to prevent manipulations of the batch process based on stochastic variations
within it.
Very often in DCS-operated batch polymer reactors the primary process variables
such as pressure, temperature, level, and ow (Section 12.2.112.2.4) are recorded
during the batch as well as the quality variables at the end of the batch. However, it
may be very dicult to obtain a kinetic model of the polymerization process due to
the complexity of the reaction mechanism, which is frequently encountered in the
batch manufacture of specialty polymers. In this case it is possible to use advanced
statistical techniques such as multi-way principal component analysis (PCA) and
multi-way partial least squares (PLS), along with an historical database of past successful batches to construct an empirical model of the batch [8, 58, 59]. This empirical model is used to monitor the evolution of future batch runs. Subsequent
unusual events in the future can be detected during the course of the batch by
referencing the measured process behavior against this in-control model and its
statistical properties. It may therefore be possible to detect a potentially bad batch
before the run is over and to take corrective action during the batch in order to
bring it on aim.
12.5.6.2

12.5.7

Future Trends

Trends in industry, which reinforce the importance of measurement of polymer reactor process control, include the increasing emphasis by customers on receiving

671

672

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

a more uniform product with desired property specications from their polymer
suppliers; the increasing computing power provided by DCS manufacturers; and
the availability inside the DCS of advanced control modules such as the MPC so
that the implementation of nonlinear multivariable control is easier and faster. As
new polymer reactors are designed (for example, to manufacture polymers with
tailor-made properties using novel metallocene catalysts or living radical polymerization technology), it would be benecial to incorporate process control considerations in the process design phase, so that the controllability of the plant can be
established before it is actually constructed. Furthermore, it is expected that the
on-line control not only of average polymer properties but also of polymer distributions such as the particle size distribution, as shown for example in Ref. 60, and
the branching distribution will become important, together with recipe management, production scheduling, and production optimization. The instrumentation
and control methodologies that will be needed to be deployed to meet these needs
are a challenging and vibrant area of investigation for academic researchers and industrial practitioners alike.

Notation [61, 62]

Symbols
Symbol

Units

A
a
a
b
c
c
CD
Cp
Cv
Cd
CV
d
d
d
d
di
E
e
eF
f
F

m2
m s2
 1
C
 2
C
 3
C
m s1

J mol1 K1
J mol1 K1

gal min1 psi1=2


m
various

various
Pa ( N m2 )
various
various

N ( kg m s2 )

area
acceleration
resistance coecient based on calibration
resistance coecient based on calibration
resistance coecient based on calibration
speed of sound
drag coecient
heat capacity at constant pressure
heat capacity at constant volume
discharge coecient
valve coecient in USCS units
diameter
disturbance variable
relative liquid density (specic gravity)
dierential operator
discrete deviation or error
modulus of elasticity
controller error, ysp  y
ltered error
valve characteristic
force

Notation

g
gc
gc
h
Ht
I
Kc
K cu
Kp
KV
l
l
m
M
Mn
Mw
Mz
n
p
Pu
PB
PD
qm
qn
qv
r
R
R
R
s
t
T
t
u
v
v
V
x
xt
xi
xn
x
y
yt
y

gravitational acceleration
gravitational conversion factor in SI units
gravitational conversion factor in USCS units
height
Heaviside step function
radiant intensity
controller gain
ultimate controller gain
process gain
valve coecient in SI units
length
valve lift
mass
magnitude of step-change in input variable
number average molecular weight
weight average molecular weight
z-average molecular weight
number of measurements
pressure
ultimate period
proportional band
polydispersity index
mass ow rate
molar ow rate
volume ow rate
radius
resistance
valve resistance coecient
equal percentage valve parameter
sample standard deviation
Celsius temperature
thermodynamic temperature
time
manipulated deviation variable
velocity
velocity average
volume
input deviation variable
continuous input variable
discrete measured value
discrete input variable
sample mean
controlled deviation variable
continuous output variable
mole fraction

m s2
1 ( kg m s2 N1 )
lb m ft s2 lb f
m

W m2
various
various
various
m 3 h1 bar1=2
m

kg
various
kg mol1
kg mol1
kg mol1

Pa ( N m2 )
s
%

kg s1
mol s1
m 3 s1
m
W
s m2

various

C
K
s
various
m s1
m s1
m3
various
various
various
various
various
various
various

673

674

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors

Y
yn
ysp
z

expansion factor
discrete output variable
set point
space coordinate

various
various
m

Greek
Symbol
a
a
b
g_
Dp
Dt
Du
Dy
e
y
k
m
m
r
rw0
s
s
X
tD
tF
tI
t
t

SI unit

lter factor
kinetic energy correction factor
diameter ratio, d2 =d1
shear rate or rate of deformation
pressure drop
time interval
change in input deviation variable
change in output deviation variable
absorption coecient
dead time
ratio of specic heats, Cp =Cv
viscosity
population mean
mass density
mass density of water at reference temperature
population standard deviation
surface tension
summation operator
controller derivative time
lter time constant
controller reset time
shear stress
time constant

s1
Pa ( N m2 )
s
various
various
m 2 kg1
s

Pa s
various
kg m3
kg m3
various
N m1

s
s
s
Pa ( N m2 )
s

Indices
0
1
2
B
c
D
F
f
I
i

refers
refers
refers
refers
refers
refers
refers
refers
refers
refers

to inlet, reference, standard, or in front of


to datum, upstream, or outlet of tank 1
to surface, downstream, in throat, or outlet of tank 2
to buoyancy
to conversion factor or controller
to drag or derivative control
to lter
to oat
to integral control
to ith sample

References

m
max
min
n
p
s
sp
t
u
v
w
W
x
g_

refers to mass
refers to maximum
refers to minimum
refers to nth sample, tank number, or moles
refers to pressure or process
refers to steady state value
refers to set point
refers to temperature or tube
refers to ultimate
refers to volume
refers to water
refers to weight
bar above symbol refers to average
dot above symbol refers to time rate of change

References
1 A. Echte, Chapter 4: Me-, Steuer-

und Regelungstechnik, Handbuch der


Technischen Polymerchemie, WileyVCH, Weinheim, 1993.
R. P. Benedict, Fundamentals of
Temperature, Pressure, and Flow
Measurements, 3rd ed., WileyInterscience, New York, 1984.
D. M. Considine, Process/Industrial
Instruments and Controls Handbook,
5th ed., McGraw-Hill, New York, 1999.
B. G. Liptak, Instrument Engineers
Handbook, 4th ed., Process
Measurement and Analysis, Volume I,
CRC Press, New York, 2003.
D. M. Levine, P. P. Ramsey, R. K.
Smidt, Applied Statistics For Engineers
and Scientists Using Microsoft Excel and
MINITAB, Prentice Hall, 2001.
R. H. Perry (Editor), D. W. Green
(Editor), J. O. Maloney (Editor),
Chemical Engineers Handbook, 7th ed.,
McGraw-Hill, New York, 1997.
D. E. Seborg, T. F. Edgar, D. A.
Mellichamp, Process Dynamics and
Control, John Wiley & Sons, New York,
2003.
O. Kammona, E. G. Chatzi, C.
Kiparissides, Recent developments
in hardware sensors for the on-line
monitoring of polymerization
reactions, J. Macromol. Sci., Rev.

10

11

12

13

14

15

Macromol. Chem. Phys., 1999, C39,


57.
E. A. Avallone (Editor), T.
Baumeister (Editor), Marks Standard
Handbook for Mechanical Engineers,
10th ed., McGraw-Hill, New York,
1996.
W. L. McCabe, J. C. Smith, P.
Harriott, Unit Operations of Chemical
Engineering, 5th ed., McGraw-Hill,
New York, 1993.
R. B. Bird, W. E. Stewart, E. N.
Lightfoot, Transport Phenomena, 2nd
ed., Wiley & Sons, New York, 2002.
Flow of Fluids through Valves, Fittings,
and Pipe, Technical Paper 410, Crane
Co., 300 Park Ave., New York, NY,
1988.
F. Rodriguez, C. Cohen, C. Ober,
L. A. Archer, Principles of Polymer
Systems, 5th ed., Taylor and Francis,
New York, 2003.
M. P. Vega, E. L. Lima, J. C. Pinto,
In-line monitoring of weight average
molecular weight in solution polymerization using intrinsic viscosity measurements, Polymer, 2001, 42, 3909.
O. Elizalde, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua,
On-line monitoring of all acrylic
emulsion polymerization reactors by
Raman spectroscopy, Macromolecular
Symposia, 2004, 206, 135.

675

676

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors


jo, C.
16 M. M. Reis, P. H. H. Arau

17

18

19

20

21

22

23

24

25
26

27

Sayer, R. Giudici, Comparing near


infrared and Raman spectroscopy for
on-line monitoring of emulsion copolymerization reactions, Macromolecular Symposia, 2004, 206, 135.
F. J. Wyzgoski, P. L. Rinaldi, E. F.
McCord, M. A. Stewart, D. R.
Marshall, Poly(n-butyl acrylate-cocarbon monoxide-co-ethylene)
characterization by high-temperature
two-dimensional NMR at 750 MHz,
Macromolecules, 2004, 37, 846.
F. J. Schork, P. B. Deshpande, K. W.
Leffew, Control of Polymerization
Reactors, Marcel Dekker, New York,
1993.
F. J. Schork, Reactor operation and
control, in Polymer Reaction
Engineering, C. McGreavy (Editor),
Kluwer Academic Publishers,
Dordrecht, 1993.
A. K. Hipp, G. Storti, M. Morbidelli,
Acoustic characterizations of concentrated suspensions and emulsions. 1.
Model Analysis, Langmuir, 2002, 18,
391.
A. K. Hipp, G. Storti, M. Morbidelli,
Acoustic characterizations of concentrated suspensions and emulsions. 2.
Experimental validation, Langmuir,
2002, 18, 405.
B. A. Ogunnaike, W. H. Ray, Process
Dynamics, Modeling, and Control,
Oxford University Press, New York,
1994.
C. L. Smith, Digital Computer Process
Control, International Textbook
Company, Scranton, PA, 1972.
J. G. Ziegler, N. B. Nichols,
Optimum settings for automatic
controllers, Trans. ASME, 1942, 64,
759.
Control Valve Handbook, 3rd ed.,
Fisher Controls International, 2001.
A. K. Adebekun, K. M. Kwalik, F. J.
Schork, Steady-state multiplicity
during solution polymerization of
methyl methacrylate in a CSTR,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1989, 44, 2269.
W. H. Ray, C. M. Villa, Nonlinear
dynamics found in polymerization
processes a review, Chem. Eng. Sci.,
2000, 55, 275.

28 G. R. Meira, Forced oscillations in

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38

continuous polymerization reactors


and molecular weight distribution
control. A survey, J. Macromol. Sci
Rev. Macromol. Chem., 1981, C20, 207.
M. Embirucu, E. L. Lima, J. C. Pinto,
A survey of advanced control of
polymerization reactors, Polymer Eng.
Sci., 1996, 36, 433.
J. P. Congalidis, J. R. Richards,
Process control of polymerization
reactors: an industrial perspective,
Polym. Reaction Eng., 1998, 6, 71.
M. A. Dube, J. B. P. Soares, A.
Penlidis, A. E. Hamielec, Mathematical modeling of multicomponent
chain growth polymerizations in
batch, semi-batch, and continuous
reactors. A review, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res., 1997, 36, 966.
W. H. Ray, Process modeling for
polymerization process operation and
control, presented at the Tutorial on
Polymerization Reactor Control, AIChE
Annual Meeting, November, 2003.
J. P. Congalidis, J. R. Richards,
W. H. Ray, Feedforward and feedback
control of a solution copolymerization
reactor, AIChE J., 1989, 35, 907.
K. C. Seavey, Y. A. Liu, N. P. Khare,
T. Bremner, C.-C. Chen, Quantifying relationships among the molecular
weight distribution, non Newtonian
shear viscosity, and melt index for
linear polymers, Ind. End. Chem. Res.,
2003, 42, 5354.
R. W. Chylla, D. R. Haase, Temperature control of semi-batch polymerization reactors, Computers Chem.
Eng., 1993, 17, 257.
G. Defaye, N. Regnier, J. Chabanon,
L. Caralp, C. Vidal, Adaptivepredictive temperature control of
semi-batch reactors, Chemical
Engineering Science, 1993, 48, 3373.
D. Tyner, M. Soroush, M. C. Grady,
Adaptive temperature control of
multi product jacketed reactors, Ind.
End. Chem. Res., 1999, 38, 4337.
H. U. Moritz, Polymerization
calorimetry: a powerful tool for reactor control, in Polymer Reaction
Engineering, Vol. 248, VCH, New York,
1989.

References
39 T. F. McKenna, S. Othman, G.

40

41

42

43

44

45

46

47

48

49

50

Fevotte, A. M. Santos, H. Hammouri,


An integrated approach to polymer
reaction engineering: a review of
calorimetry and state estimation,
Polym. Reaction Eng., 2000, 8, 1.
K. B. McAuley, J. F. MacGregor,
On-line inference of polymer
properties in an industrial polyethylene reactor, AIChEJ., 1991, 37, 825.
M. F. Ellis, T. W. Taylor, K. F.
Jensen, On-line molecular weight
distribution estimation and control in
batch polymerization, AIChEJ., 1994,
40, 445.
M.-J. Park, S.-M. Hur, H.-K. Rhee,
Online estimation and control of
polymer quality in a copolymerization
reactor, AIChEJ., 2002, 48, 1013.
S. J. Qin, T. A. Badgwell, A survey
of industrial model predictive control
technology, Control Eng. Practice,
2003, 11, 733.
B. R. Maner, F. J. Doyle III,
Polymerization reactor control using
autoregressive-plus Voltera-based
MPC, AIChEJ., 1997, 43, 1763.
zkan, M. V. Kothare, C.
L. O
Georgakis, Control of a solution
copolymerization reactor using multimodel predictive control, Chem. Eng.
Sci., 2003, 58, 1207.
R. Bindlish, J. B. Rawlings, Target
linearization and model predictive
control of polymerization processes,
AIChE J., 2003, 49, 2885.
H. Seki, M. Ogawa, S. Ooyama, K.
Ahamatsu, M. Ohshima, W. Yang,
Industrial application of nonlinear
Model Predictive Control to
polymerization reactors, Control Eng.
Prac., 2001, 9, 819.
D. Bartusiak, R. W. Fontaine,
C. O. Schwanke, A. R. Gomatam,
Nonlinear Model Predictive Control of a polymerization reactor,
presented at the Tutorial on Polymerization Reactor Control, AIChE
Annual Meeting, November, 2003.
M. Takeda, W. H. Ray, Optimalgrade transition strategies for multistage polyolen reactors, AIChE
Journal, 1999, 45, 1776.
I. Saenz de Buruaga, P. D.

51

52

53

54

55

56

57

58

59

Armitage, J. R. Leiza, J. M. Asua,


Nonlinear control for maximum
production rate of latexes of welldened polymer composition, Ind.
End. Chem. Res., 1997, 36, 4243.
G. Maschio, T. Bello, C. Scali,
Optimization of batch polymerization
reactors: Modelling and experimental
results for suspension polymerization
of methyl methacrylate, Chem. Eng.
Sci., 1992, 47, 2609.
G. Maschio, T. Bello, C. Scali,
Optimal operation strategies to
control the molecular weight
distribution of polymer products,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1994, 49, 5071.
I. M. Thomas, C. Kiparissides,
Computation of the near optimal
temperature and initiator policies for a
batch polymerization reactor, Can. J.
Chem. Eng., 1984, 62, 284.
D. Tyner, M. Soroush, M. C. Grady,
J. R. Richards, J. P. Congalidis,
Mathematical modeling and optimization of a semi-batch polymerization
reactor, Proceedings IFAC Symposium
on Advanced Control of Chemical
Processes, Pisa. Italy, 2001, 3, 983.
W. E. Houston, F. J. Schork,
Adaptive predictive control of a semi
batch polymerization reactor, Polym.
Process Eng. 1987, 5, 119.
T. Peterson, E. Hernandez, Y.
Arkun, F. J. Schork, A nonlinear
DMC algorithm and its application to
a semi-batch polymerization reactor,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 1992, 42, 737.
J. W. Wassick, D. Coffey, B. Callihan, Nonlinear Model Predictive
Control of a commercial polymerization semi-batch reactor, presented at
the Tutorial on Polymerization Reactor
Control, AIChE Annual Meeting,
November, 2003.
P. Nomikos, J. F. MacGregor,
Multi-way partial least squares in
monitoring batch processes,
Chemometrics and Intelligent Laboratory
Systems, 1995, 30, 97.
T. Kourti, P. Nomikos, J. F.
MacGregor, Analysis, monitoring,
and fault diagnosis of batch processes
using multiblock and multiway PCA,
J. Proc. Cont., 1995, 5, 277.

677

678

12 Measurement and Control of Polymerization Reactors


60 F. J. Doyle, C. A. Harrison, T. J.

Crowley, Hybrid model based


approach to batch-to-batch control of
particle size distribution in emulsion
polymerization, Computers Chem.
Eng., 2003, 27, 1153.
61 I. Mills, T. Cvitas, K. Homann, N.

Kallay, K. Kuchitsu, Quantities, Units


and Symbols in Physical Chemistry (The
Green Book), Blackwell Science, 1993.
62 J. Inczedy, T. Lengyel, A. M. Ure,
Compendium of Analytical Nomenclature (denitive rules 1997), 3rd ed.,
Blackwell Science, 1998.

679

13

Polymer Properties through Structure1


Uday Shankar Agarwal

Since polymers display an incredible range of properties, their potential for applications is ever increasing. The link between polymer structure and the resulting
properties has long been realized, and emerged as the concept of tailor making of
polymers. In earlier times, developments were largely targeted on achieving the
desired properties through new monomers, copolymer and blend compositions,
physical and chemical additives, and control of polymer molecular weights, as
well as through structural changes derived from processing. In recent years, the
increased expertise in anionic polymerization and the emergence of controlled radical polymerization techniques have led to relatively easy access to several precisely
controlled topologies such as those of telechelic, block, graft, star-shaped, and several other branched homoploymers and copolymers with controlled molecular
weights. For example, phenomenal growth has been recorded in the area of synthesis of block copolymers, as well as in examination of their self-assembling characteristics leading to unique control of nanoscale morphology. This is providing tools for
development of properties suitable for applications extending from those requiring
mechanical toughness to electronic and biological uses. Another rapidly developing
area is nanocomposites, where the attainable range of properties is further expanded
by incorporating inorganic and organic nanoparticles in polymeric matrices.
In this chapter we aim to demonstrate the relationship of the structure of polymers with their thermal, solution, and rheological behavior. Besides providing a
general review of such behavior, we will emphasize some of the recent developments in these areas.

13.1

Thermal Properties of Polymers

The thermal behavior of polymers is dierent from that of simple compounds in


that, on heating, the transition of polymers from solids to liquids occurs not at
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

680

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

a sharp temperature, but over a range of temperatures. Such behavior is at least


partly attributable to the mixture of chain lengths of molecules that make up a
polymeric material. In addition to a crystalline solid phase that gains liquid-like
mobility at the corresponding crystalline melting point, polymeric materials display an amorphous phase that undergoes a gradual transformation to a liquid-like
state over a temperature range called the glass transition temperature.
13.1.1

Crystalline and Amorphous Polymers

Crystallization of polymers is important because it imparts several highly useful


properties such as strength, toughness, stiness, and solvent and chemical resistance. A polymer can crystallize when it is cooled from a melt, or concentrated
from a diluted solution. This is because the approaching chains may fold and
pack into a regular, long-range, three-dimensional, positional and orientational
order characterized by a certain unit cell of that polymer. Figure 13.1 shows the

Fig. 13.1. Arrangement of polyethylene molecules in the


orthorhombic unit cell of dimensions a 7:41 A, b 4:94 A,
c 2:55 A (from C. W. Bunn, in Fibers from Synthetic Polymers,
ed. R. Hill, Elsevier, Amsterdam, 1953).

13.1 Thermal Properties of Polymers

Fig. 13.2. Helical conformation of an isotactic vinyl polymer


crystalline chain (from F. Rodriguez, Principles of Polymer
Systems, 2nd Ed., McGraw Hill Intl., Auckland, 1982).

unit cell in a crystal of a commercially important crystalline polymer: polyethylene.


Here, the chains are extended in planar zigzag (trans) conformation, which corresponds to low energy. However, steric hindrances can lead to other chain conformations in crystals. For example, in the presence of bulky substituents, the vinyl
polymer chains rotate to take up a rotated helical conformation (Figure 13.2).
If a given polymer lacks a tendency to get ordered, the chains stay randomly
coiled and entangled during solidication (Figure 13.3). Such polymers (for example, poly(methyl methacrylate)) are called amorphous. Crystallinity is best detected
by wide-angle X-ray diraction (WAXD, Figure 13.4), where the peak positions
provide information about the repeat distances in the crystal lattice. Unlike small
molecules that display sharp peaks during WAXD, even crystallizable polymers
display broad WAXD peaks (Figure 13.4). This is because polymers are never

~10 nm

Fig. 13.3.

Lack of long-range order in an amorphous polymer.

681

682

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

fully
crystalline
material

amorphous
material
diffraction
intensity

semicrystalline
polymer
10

diffraction angle (deg)

32

Fig. 13.4. WAXD patterns of fully crystalline solids, amorphous


solid/melts, and semicrystalline polymers.

100% crystalline due to entanglements between chains, and are therefore called
semicrystalline. The extent of crystallization (xc ) can vary from nearly 100% for
polytetrauoroethylene or linear polyethylene to nearly zero for noncrystallizable
polymers such poly(methyl methacrylate). The extent of crystallization is determined by considering the variation of properties (r, such as density, specic heat,
and electrical resistivity) between amorphous phase polymer and crystalline phase
polymer to be linearly additive [Eq. (1)].
r 1  xc ra xc rc

13.1.2

Inuence of Polymer Structure on Crystallizability of Polymers

Since crystallization requires that the participating chains to come close together,
the spatial regularity and the packing possibilities of the polymers are the most
important factors in determining their crystallizability. For example, isotactic and
syndiotactic polypropylene are stereoregular, and show a higher tendency to crystallize than atactic polypropylene (Figure 13.5). Randomly arranged or bulky pendent groups reduce this tendency because they hinder the close alignment of the
polymer molecules that is necessary for intermolecular interactions. For example,

13.1 Thermal Properties of Polymers

isotactic

syndiotactic

atactic
The regularity of a polypropylene chain structure
decides its crystallizability. The isotactic and syndiotactic
polypropylene crystallize, but atactic polypropylene does not.
Fig. 13.5.

poly(vinyl acetate) with large pendent groups (aOaCOaCH3 ) is amorphous, but


crystallizes easily when hydrolyzed to poly(vinyl alcohol), which has small pendent
groups (aOH). Crystallizability is also induced by existence of functional groups capable of intermolecular hydrogen bonding (such as amides, urethanes, urea, and
so on) or functional groups capable of polar interactions (such as aCl and aCN).
Block copolymers have large segments of regular structure capable of participating
in crystallization, and hence show a higher tendency to crystallize than random
copolymers.
13.1.3

The Glass Transition Temperature

An amorphous polymer can exist in the glassy (hard, brittle, and sti ) or the rubbery (soft) state, depending on the temperature being lower or higher than the socalled glass transition temperature (Tg ). The glass-to-rubber transition at Tg is
associated with an increase in free volume resulting in an increase in cooperative
rotational and translational motion of the chain segments (2050 atoms), as the
thermal energy overcomes the intermolecular restraints imposed by secondary
bonding forces between polymer chains. This results in marked changes, such as
an increase in the number of possible chain conformations and an increase in the
free volume. This is manifested as jumps in the thermal expansion coecient (Figure 13.6) and specic heat (Figure 13.7), and a drop of a few orders of magnitude
in the mechanical modulus (Figure 13.8). Even as the chain segments gain mobility above Tg , the chain entanglements persist, imparting rubberlike elasticity (Figure 13.8). With further increases in temperature and the associated energy and
motion of the molecules, translation/slip of the entire molecules becomes possible.
A consequence of Eq. (1) is that the changes at Tg are less drastic in semicrystalline
polymers as the crystallites impart rigidity, even at temperatures higher than Tg .

683

684

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

melt
Specific
volume

amorphous
solid
crystalline
solid
Tg
Tm
Temperature

Fig. 13.6. Volume expansion (dilatometry) in amorphous and


crystalline polymers with increasing temperature.

13.1.4

Inuence of Polymer Structure on Tg of Polymers

The Tg of a polymer is important as it denes the maximum temperature at which


an amorphous solid polymer still displays structural rigidity. For a given polymer
structure, the Tg increases with an increase in molecular weight (M) [Eq. (2),
where Tg; y is the Tg of a polymer with innite molecular weight, and K is a constant]. Tg is aected by structural features of the polymer chains, such as chain
stiness and intermolecular forces.

Heat
flow
(W/g)

50

Tg

Tm

Tc

100

150

200

250

300

Temperature (C)
Heat ux during heating of poly(ethylene
terephthalate) (PET) at a constant rate in a dierential
scanning calorimeter (DSC), showing changes in specic heat
at Tg , crystallization exotherm at Tc , and melting endotherm at
Tm .
Fig. 13.7.

13.1 Thermal Properties of Polymers

glass
+ crystals
rubber
+ crystals

Log G
(MPa)

Tg

rubber
(entanglements)
Tm

liquid

Temperature (C)
Fig. 13.8. Inuence of temperature on mechanical modulus of
a semicrystalline polymer. The broken line indicates the
corresponding curve at higher crystallinity.

Tg Tg; y 

K
M

For example, while low Tg values are exhibited by exible chains such as polyethylene with easy rotation about the backbone, a higher Tg results from chain stiness
such as that resulting from cyclic structures in the backbone (as in BPA polycarbonate). This concept is used in enhancing the Tg of PET by partial replacement
of the aliphatic glycol in it with an alicyclic glycol, thereby making the polymer
more suitable for high-temperature applications [1]. While bulky side groups (for
example, in poly(a-methylstyrene)) enhance the Tg because of the resulting steric
hindrance, long and exible side groups decrease the Tg as they enhance the separation between polymer backbones and introduce additional chain-ends. Secondary
attractive forces (for example, polarity) enhance the Tg . The extent of syndiotacticity in polymers such as PMMA can be inuenced by the method of polymerization,
and in-turn inuence the Tg [2, 3].
When a random or alternating copolymer is made up of non-interacting monomers, its Tg can be calculated from the weight fractions (wi ) and glass transition
temperatures (Tgi ) of its components, by means of Eq. (3).
1
w1
w2

Tg Tg1 Tg2

When a polymer is desired to be exible at the temperature of use, this eect


(Eq. 3) can be used to plasticize a polymer internally (that is, reduce its Tg ) by
incorporating comonomers such as vinyl acetate and vinyl chloride. In the case
of block or graft copolymers, microphase separation of the blocks often leads to
separate glass transitions of the corresponding blocks [4, 5]. The case is similar
for immiscible blends. Plasticization can be achieved externally by addition of low
molecular weight, high-boiling organic compounds (plasticizers) that can enhance

685

686

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

inter-backbone distance and drastically reduce Tg . For example, dioctyl phthalate is


often added to turn the otherwise rigid plastic poly(vinyl chloride) into a exible
material [6].
13.1.5

The Crystallization Temperature and the Melting Point

When heated beyond its Tg , a crystallizable polymer undergoes crystallization that


is detected calorimetrically as an exotherm (Figure 13.7). The rate of crystallization
rst increases with temperature, reaching a maximum at the so-called crystallization temperature, Tc . With a further increase in temperature, the solid undergoes
a rst-order transition into a melt at Tm (Figures 13.7, 13.8), corresponding to zero
free energy change on melting [Eq. (4)].
Tm

DHm
DSm

The Tm is high for polymers with a lower DSm; this is due, for example, to chain
stiness in PEEK (poly(ether ether ketone), Tm 395 C) or to specic interactions
that persist into melts (nylon-6, Tm 228 C). Tm can also be high for polymers exhibiting high DHm values, for example through regular and frequent polar interactions. Random addition of a comonomer leads to reductions in both the Tm and
the extent of crystallization, while long homopolymer segments in block and graft
copolymers or in immiscible blends may crystallize into their respective crystalline
forms and display two melting points.
Heating a polymer above Tm to a melt allows its fabrication into the desired
shape in processing operations such as injection molding, extrusion, ber spinning and blow-molding. During cooling from melt, a semicrystalline polymer
undergoes crystallization at temperatures below Tm but above Tg . Since crystallization involves translation from a highly disordered melt to a highly ordered state
under viscous conditions, the extent, size, and perfection of crystallization depends
on crystallization conditions such as the rate of cooling and the temperature of
crystallization. For example, rapid cooling often results in a large number of crystals, as well as reductions in the extent and perfection of crystallization. On the
other hand, crystallization at temperatures just below Tm for long periods results
in larger and more perfect crystals.
13.1.6

Tuning Polymer Crystallization for Properties

Crystallization plays a major role in determining the thermal and mechanical behavior of polymers as it permits polymers to retain rigidity at temperatures exceeding the Tg . Crystallization also enhances the barrier properties and solvent
resistance, as small molecules cannot diuse through crystalline domains. Crystallization of polymers can be tuned, and thus can provide very useful control over

13.1 Thermal Properties of Polymers

the subsequent processing and nal properties. For example, crystallization from
dilute solutions can lead to disentanglement and high drawability in polyethylene,
producing bers with a very high modulus and strength [7]. Crystallization and
morphology development in polyethylene during its formation on heterogeneous
catalysts leads to a nascent state with special characteristics such as a high Tm
compared to molded polyethylene. One hypothesis attributes this to the inuence
of strain resulting from the temperature gradient at the polymerization site, in a
manner somewhat similar to strain-induced extended chain crystallization from
stirred solutions [8, 9]. Polymer molecules being formed at the heterogeneous
catalyst fragment surface experience strong elongational ow, which could inuence the nascent crystallization process [10, 11] Innovations in polyethylene reactor
technology are directed toward controlling the morphology and properties of the
polymerization product [12]. One expectation is that polyethylene as a nascent reactor product can be directly drawn into high-modulus, high-strength bers similar
to those produced via the solution route [13].
Crystallization in step-growth polymers such as polyesters and nylons is known
to assist their subsequent solid-state polymerization because exclusion of reactive
end-groups from crystalline domains enhances their eective concentration in the
amorphous domains [14, 15]. However, the condensation reaction between the last
fraction of end-groups may be hindered by crystallization [16, 17]. The possibility
and rate of crystallization can also be enhanced by processes that enhance orientation, such as shearing and ber drawing [18]. For example, partial replacement of
terephthalic units with isophthalic units in PET reduces crystallinity, so that no
crystallization in seen in 70:30 random poly(ethylene terephthalate-co-ethylene isophthalate) under quiescent conditions. However, heating its amorphous ber above
its Tg under a moderate tensile force results in rapid stress-induced crystallization
[19]. The reduction in crystallization by copolymerization has been employed to enhance drawability of melt-spun polyester and polyamide bers [20].
On the other hand, a high rate of crystallization during cooling from melts is
desired, as it determines the cycle time and thus the suitability of a polymer for
very important shape-forming processes such as injection molding. The crystallization rate is easily enhanced by reducing the molecular weight of polymers, but that
is also detrimental to the mechanical properties. Therefore, nucleating agents are
often used to enhance the crystallization rate. The activity of several heterogeneous
nucleating agents is related to oriented deposition of polymer chains on the surfaces of inorganic particles [21]. Nucleating agents such as talc, by virtue of their
highly oriented crystalline surfaces, induce epitaxial crystallization of polymers
such as PE and PET [22]. The activity of organic compounds (salts) such as sodium
benzoate for PET crystallization is related to formation of ionic chain-ends that aggregate in polymer melts to form nucleating clusters [23]. The crystallization enhancement that occurs on replacing a small fraction (< 1%) of the ester segments
in PET with amide segments was attributed to self-assembly of the amide segments [24]. These homogenous nucleators may oer an advantage in impact properties. Their incorporation in PET can be carried out by simple solid-state modication reactions, thus avoiding the degradation reactions accompanying melt-mixing

687

688

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

Fig. 13.9. DSC cooling scans of (i) PET


homopolymer (h 0:62 dL g1 ); (ii) PET
chemically modied in the solid-state with
ethylene diamine (EDA) vapor to replace
2.2 mol% of ester functionality with amide
functionality (nitrogen content 0.31%,
PETEDA-1: h 0:5 dL g1 , PETEDA-3:

h 0:61 dL g1 ); and (iii) PET melt mixed


with 0.3% talc. The modied samples undergo
crystallization at a higher temperature (that is,
sooner during the cooling process). (Reprinted
from Polymer, Volume 43, page 5709, Copyright
2002, U. S. Agarwal, G. de Wit, P. J. Lemstra,
with permission from Elsevier).

methods [25]. Figure 13.9 shows the enhanced tendency to crystallize of the thusmodied PET during cooling from melt.
The optical clarity of polymers generally decreases with the appearance of crystallinity. Semicrystalline polymers are generally opaque because of the scattering
due to the dierence in the refractive indices of the crystalline and the amorphous
domains. However, enhancement of the nucleation density with suitable nucleating agents can lead to reduction of spherulite sizes (below the wavelength of light)
and hence to transparent semicrystalline polymers. For example, the recently developed derivatives based on d-sorbitol dissolve in a polypropylene melt and are
thus easily dispersed. On cooling, these additive molecules aggregate, and provide
nucleation sites for ne PP spherulites [26]. More recently, nanoparticles (such as
clay) and carbon nanotubes are being explored as potential nucleating agents [27].
13.1.7

Morphology of Crystalline Polymers

Early X-ray diraction work in the 1920s indicated the polymers to be semicrystalline, with crystallites dispersed in an amorphous matrix. The longest dimension of
the crystallites in polymers is 550 nm, which is a fraction of the length of the extended polymers (up to 5 mm). Based on this, the crystalline morphology was
conceived to be of the fringed micelle type, where the long polymer chains pass
successively through the lengths of several crystalline and amorphous domains
(Figure 13.10).
Later work showed that crystalline domains are most often made up of at rib-

13.1 Thermal Properties of Polymers

Fig. 13.10. Fringed micelle model of semicrystallinity in


polymers. (Reprinted from Paul J. Flory, Principles of Polymer
Chemistry. Copyright 1953, Cornell University and Copyright
1981 Paul J. Flory. Used by permission from the publisher,
Cornell University Press).

bons like lamellae, within which the chains are largely folded (insets a and b
of Figure 13.11) and oriented along the smaller-thickness direction (@10 nm). The
lamellae grow to dimensions of approximately 1 mm by addition of segments to a
fast-growing direction (inset a of Figure 13.11). The growth in the thickness direction is by a not-so-regular stacking of multiple lamellae, with some interlamellar
links (inset b of Figure 13.11). The crystal thickness increases with the temperature
of crystallization, or with subsequent annealing at a higher temperature.
During cooling from melt or concentration from solution, polymers form spherulites which are spherical aggregates of lamellae (Figure 13.11). These spherulites

Fig. 13.11. Growth of a spherulite with


lamellar growth. (a) Lamellae grow as chain
segments (parallel to lamellar thickness
direction) are added successively in the fast
growth direction. (b) Lamellae are stacked

somewhat irregularly, with some interlamellar


links (adapted from G. Strobl, The Physics of
Polymers, Springer, Berlin, 1996 and J. M.
Schultz, Makromol Chem. Makromol Symp.
1988, 15, 339).

689

690

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

L1
L 11

Undeformed
crystals

(a)
Phase
changes,
twinning

(b)
Tilt, slip &
twist

(c)
Cracks formed,
some chains pulled
out of crystals,
more tilt, slip, twist

(d)
Fibrils formed

Increasing deformation of single crystals


Fig. 13.12. Mechanical deformation (drawing)
of spherulitic structures breaks the constituent
lamellae into blocks and tie molecules. The
blocks tilt, with the chains aligning along the
load axis, and make up highly oriented micro-

brils. (From A. Peterlin, in Macromolecular


Reviews, Volume 1 (ISBN 0470-68245-0).
Copyright 1967, John Wiley. Used by permission from the publisher, John Wiley & Sons,
Inc.).

grow radially from a central nucleus, to dimensions ranging from about 0.1 mm to
a few millimeters, until they meet the neighboring spherulites. Polymer chains are
oriented tangentially around each nucleus. On deformation of such material under
stress (for example, during ber drawing), the spherulitic structure is destroyed
and crystalline rearrangements lead to polymer chain orientation coinciding with
the stress direction (Figure 13.12). This imparts a high modulus and strength to
the bers in the axial direction.
13.1.8

Tailoring Polymer Properties through Modication, Additives, and Reinforcement

The properties of polymers are determined by the nature and composition of the
structural units, as well as the molecular architecture. Polymers are most often
made from the corresponding monomers. In comparison with developing new
monomers and polymerization methods, a less expensive route to tailor-making of
polymers is through blending, copolymerization, architecture control during polymerization, post-polymerization chemical modication, and additives. Detailed discussions on such possibilities are available in several reviews [3742]. Here we will
briey highlight two recent developments in the areas of block copolymers and
polymeric nanocomposites.

13.1 Thermal Properties of Polymers

FCC

PCC

micelle

HEX

cylindrical micelle

F surface (  )
gyroid (  )

resicle

P surface (  )
LAM
NLAM

PLAM

Fig. 13.13. Self-organization of block copolymers into various


possible morphologies (from S. Forster, T. Plantenberg, Angew.
Chem. Int. Ed. 2002, 41, 688).

New Morphologies through Block Copolymers


Traditionally, well controlled block copolymers were prepared by living anionic polymerization. However, the advent of controlled radical polymerization techniques
[28, 29] has led to more facile synthesis of block copolymers in large quantities.
The sizes of the blocks are controlled by the ratio of monomer to initiator, which
thus also provides control over their relative sizes. Since the blocks are covalently
bonded, their phase separation on the macroscopic scale is prevented. However, a
repulsive interaction between the constituent blocks can lead to chain segregation,
and thus self-organization into a variety of periodicities in the range of 1020 nm
[4, 5] (Figure 13.13). Self-assembling behavior of polymers leads to interesting
characteristics that can be gainfully employed in improvement of mechanical properties [30]. Shell long ago commercialized PIPSPI triblock copolymers in which
the glassy PS domains provided physical crosslinks, and thus elastomeric behavior,
even in the absence of chemical crosslinks [31]. Other morphologies may nd
applications in catalysis, membranes, electro-optics, production of nanoparticles,
absorption/release of drugs, and so on. For example, selective removal of one block
from a bicontinuous morphology (gyroid, Figure 13.13) leads to a nanoporous
13.1.8.1

691

692

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

structure with a network of interconnected nanochannels (diameter 2030 nm).


Metal plating of these channels can provide a very high internal surface area for
catalytic activity [32]. Homopolymers and block copolymers have also been used
to design novel materials through their capacity to organize organic and inorganic
nanomaterials [33, 36].
Polymeric Nanocomposites
Conventionally, high-modulus, high-strength bers are used as reinforcing materials in polymer composites, and llers such as CaCO3 , talc, silica, glass and carbon
black are used to reduce resin cost or modify electrical conductivity, dimensional
stability, abrasion resistance and other properties. In recent years, enhancement
of polymer properties by composite formation with nanoparticles has developed
as an area of intensive research. Nanostructured materials such as nanoclay, graphite nanosheets, carbon nanotubes, and polyhedral silsesquioxane (POSS) are being
explored as potential nanoscale reinforcing agents in polymeric matrices [43, 44].
In particular, single-wall carbon nanotubes (SWNTs) are unique among nanoparticles due to their large aspect ratio and their mechanical as well as electronic and
conductive properties. For example, the modulus and strength of nanocomposites
with 1 wt.% SWNT compare with those of conventional ber composites with 10
wt.% carbon bers [45]. Incorporation of 1 wt.% SWNT in PMMA is shown to result in a seven-fold increase in the strain to fracture [46]. In addition, several electrical, thermal, barrier, and crystallization properties are enhanced. For example,
threshold concentrations for electrical conductivity of SWNTs in polymers have
been reported to be as low as 0.1% [47]. Crystallization in PP, nylon-66, and PPT,
and thermal stability in PET, PPT, PBT, and nylon-66 have been shown to be enhanced by incorporation of nanoparticles. One critical issue is how to achieve a
good dispersion of the nanoparticles in the polymeric matrix. This is often dicult
by melt-mixing in the high-viscosity polymers. Better dispersion of nanoparticles
often requires either solvent processing, or mixing with monomers followed by
in-situ polymerization [4850].
13.1.8.2

13.2

Polymer Conformation and Related Properties

A large variety of polymer properties are attributable directly not to their chemical
nature, but to their macromolecular constitution that is, the long chains. In particular, several properties of polymers are related to, and can thus be estimated
from, the conformational characteristics of the long chains.
13.2.1

The Chain Conformation

Polymer molecules mostly exist as random coils in solutions and melts. Their largest dimension is much smaller than the fully extended chains, but several times

13.2 Polymer Conformation and Related Properties

2
1

R
Fig. 13.14.

End-to-end distance of a polymer coil made up of n segments, each of length l.

larger than the dimensions based on polymer density. The size of a polymer molecule is often described by its characteristic dimension: the root mean square endto-end distance, r 2 1=2 . Representing a polymer molecule as a chain made up of
n bondsof lengthl (Figure 13.14),
 it can be shown that Eq. (5) applies, where
1  cos y
1 cos j
and gj
are 1 for a hypothetical freely jointed
f y
1 cos y
1  cos j
chain, and are greater than 1 for real chains where the bond angle is xed at y and
rotation about the bonds is restricted unequally at some value of j between 0 and
2p (Figure 13.15).
r 2 hR  Ri f ygja 0 nl 2

The factor a 0 is 1 for the unperturbed coil dened in this way, and is larger (or
smaller) when a polymer molecule is expanded (or compressed) due to polymer
solvent interactions. Thus, for an idealized freely jointed chain in theta solvent,
we have r 2 nl 2 , and the corresponding mean square radius of gyration S 2
nl 2 =6. When one accounts for the steric eects that prevent distant chain segments
from overlapping (excluded volume eect), the dependence of r 2 1=2 is predicted
to be n 3=5 (closer to experimental observation), rather than n 1=2 [Eq. (5)]. This
polymer coil size is much larger than that based on polymer density, and hence
markedly inuences the viscosity behavior of polymers.

Possible restriction on bond angles (y) and on


rotation about the bonds at some values of f between 0 and
2p.

Fig. 13.15.

693

694

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

Fig. 13.16. Segments of a polymer chain in a liquid lattice.


(Reprinted from Paul J. Flory, Principles of Polymer Chemistry.
Copyright 1953 Cornell University and Copyright 1981 Paul J.
Flory. Used by permission from the publisher, Cornell University
Press).

13.2.2

Solubility of Polymers

Flory [51] and Huggins [52] were the rst to examine the case of overlapping
chains in solutions. They represented the chains of n segments by placing n beads
on the interconnected cells of a lattice (Figure 13.16), and the other cells were
occupied by solvent molecules. Statistical analysis of the possible conformations
allows calculation of the entropy, while the enthalpic interactions between the polymer segments and solvent molecules are represented by the so-called w parameter,
which is temperature-dependent: w < 0 represents good solvents, and w 12 represents the so-called y-condition where Gaussian statistics prevails. The corresponding free energy change for mixing per site is given by Eq. (6), where f is the fraction of polymers made up of n segments each.
DGm f
ln f 1  f ln1  f wf1  f
n
kB T

This allows the calculation of osmotic pressure by Eq. (7), where c is the mass concentration of the polymer of molecular weight M.




cR g T
1
2
p
ln1  f 1  f wf
M
n

Equating the derivative of the mixing free energy [Eq. (6)] with respect to f allows

13.2 Polymer Conformation and Related Properties

n1 < n 2

n1

C
n2

c
T
1/2

-line

Fig. 13.17. Phase separation in polymersolvent systems


predicted by FloryHuggins theory. The system exhibits UCST
behavior: that is, phase separation at temperatures below a
critical point C. Coexistence curves for two dierent molecular
weights are shown.

the calculation of two f values (for w values larger than a critical value wc ) corresponding to minimum energy, and thus the coexistence curve (Figure 13.17) that
describes separation of polymer solutions into two phases at low temperatures
(w A B=T > wc ) [53]. The molecular weight dependence of wc 0:5 n1=2
yields a downward shift of the curve in Figure 13.17, indicating an increasing tendency toward phase separation with increasing molecular weight of the polymers.
Extension of the calculations to the case of polymerpolymer blends [51, 52] suggests incompatibility at w values greater than wc 2=n for two polymers with an
equal number of segments. This strong tendency for phase separation of polymers
when no specic polymerpolymer enthalpic interactions (for example, favorable
hydrogen bonding) are present is attributed to the only small increase in entropy
on mixing of high molecular weight polymers. A detailed discussion on blending
of polymers and the resulting morphologies and properties is beyond the scope of
this review; the interested reader is referred to more specialized texts [5456].
13.2.3

Dilute Solution Zero-shear Viscosity

Rheology is the science of deformation and ow. Viscosity (h) is a measure of the
stress (t) required to make a uid deform (ow) at a desired strain rate [Eq. (8),
where g_ dvx =dy; Figure 13.18].
tyx hg_ yx

695

696

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

V
vx

Fig. 13.18. Simple shear ow between two parallel plates


separated by a distance y, and moving with relative velocity
V yg_yx .

A unique characteristic of polymers is that even a small concentration (c) of a high


molecular weight polymer can signicantly enhance the viscosity of a solution (h)
as compared to the viscosity of the solvent (hs ). This is because the expanded polymer coils in slowly deforming dilute solutions behave as rigid spheres with a radius of the order of r 2 1=2 , resulting in a large polymer volume fraction f [Eq. (9)]
with the corresponding solution viscosity (Einstein, for f f 1) given by Eq. (10).
4
f pr 2 3=2 cNA =M
3
h hs 1 2:5f

9
10

A polymers capacity to enhance solution viscosity is described in terms of its intrinsic viscosity ([h]):
h lim
c!0

h  hs
chs

11

Combining Eqs. (9)(11) with Eq. 2.1, and realizing that n @ M, one nds that
[h] has an M 1=2 dependence on polymer molecular weight. In reality, the factor a 0
[Eq. (5)] depends to a small extent on M, resulting in the MarkHouwink relation
[Eq. (12)].
h KM a

12

The constants K and a are obtained by tting experimental data for a given
polymersolvent system. The intrinsic viscosity [h] is conveniently measured by
observing the time for ow of a certain volume of solution (and solvent) through
a capillary, and thus provides an easy indication of the molecular weight from the
tabulated MarkHouwink constants [57].
Polymers as Dumbbells
More details of the rheological behavior of polymer solutions can be evaluated
by representing a polymer molecule as a dumbbell: that is, two beads connected
by spring (connecting vector Q , Figure 13.19). Their contribution to the uid
13.2.3.1

13.2 Polymer Conformation and Related Properties

v2

F(c)

v1

Fig. 13.19. Microscopic denition of polymer contribution to


stress on a plane, as the stress exerted by the dumbbell bead
above the plane on the bead below the plane.

stress [Eq. (10)] on any plane comes from the tensile or compressive spring force
(F c HQ, H being the spring constant) transmitted through the springs [58]
[Eq. (13), where n is the number concentration of the springs].
t  hs g_ nkB Td nhQF c i

13

For example, a linearly elastic dumbbell model representation (Figure 13.19) of


polymer molecules predicts Eq. (14) to apply, where l x=4H is a time constant
and x is the bead friction factor.
h hs nkB Tl

14

When it is desired to represent a real polymer as a dumbbell, l can be estimated


from the intrinsic viscosity measurement by means of Eq. (15).
l

hhs M
NA kB T

15

Polymers as Chains of Beads and Springs


A more realistic representation of polymer chains is the Rouse model [59], which
considers a polymer molecule to be a linear chain of N free-draining beads interconnected by springs (each of time constant lH x=4H), and predicts Eq. (16) to
apply.
13.2.3.2

h

NA kB TlH N 2  1
3
hs M

16

697

698

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

This implies that [h] has a linear dependence on molecular weight. This is not consistent with the experimental observations [Eq. (12)]. When hydrodynamic interaction and excluded volume eects between chain segments are considered, the corresponding Zimm model [60] correctly predicts the @M 1=2 dependence [Eq. (17)].
h@

NA 3=2 3
N l
M

17

13.2.4

Viscosity of Concentrated Solutions and Melts

The models discussed in Section 13.2.3 for dilute polymer solutions all predict
[h] to be independent of concentration; that is, they predict linear dependence
of viscosity on concentration. When the concentration of polymer in solution is
higher than the overlap concentration (c  @ 1=h @ M 1=2 ), the random coils get
entangled with each other (f b 1). This is responsible for a faster than linear increase in viscosity with concentration (Figure 13.20), which often follows the scaling relation of Eq. (18) [61]. That is, if h=hs is plotted against c=c  or hc, then the
curves of various molecular weights can be superimposed.
 
h
c
F  Ghc
hs
c

18

While accounting for the concentration eects by analyzing a single chain placed
in an eective medium made up of the other chains, the dependence expressed

12
10
8
viscosity 6
(cP)
4

dilute

C* semidilute

2
0

20

40
60 80 100 120 140
concentration (mg/mL)

Fig. 13.20. Concentration dependence of viscosity of synapse


(molecular weight 18.55 kDa) solution is linear at c < c  ,
c  @ 50 mg mL1 . Redrawn from Malvern application note no.
MRK511-01 (http://www.particular.ie/
m%20wt%20protein%20nano%20zs.pdf ).

13.2 Polymer Conformation and Related Properties

in Eq. (19) was obtained [62], indicating Rouse-like [Eq. (16)] linear dependence on
N at intermediate concentrations (Figure 13.20).


c 2l 6
N
h @ hs 1
24

19

The transition from the Zimm regime [Eq. (17), h @ N 1=2 ] at dilute concentrations to Rouse-like behavior [Eq. (16), h @ N] at the intermediate concentrations
is related to the hydrodynamic screening at high concentrations: the hydrodynamic
interactions between segments become negligible because the local velocity around
the beads falls quickly.
At even higher molecular weights and concentrations, the viscosity in concentrated solutions and melts goes from a linear to a 3.4 power dependence on M
[Eq. (20); Figure 13.21].
h @ c 4--5 M 3:4

20

This behavior is described by connement of a polymer molecule to its own tube


whose walls are dened by the network of surrounding entangled chains (Figure
13.22) [63, 65]. Hence, chain motion (including stretching and relaxation) is permitted only curvilinearly to the tube (reptation), while motion of the chain perpendicular to the tube is hindered. During ow, the relaxation of chain stretching
along the tube axis is instantaneous, while a nonrandom orientation of tube segments contributes to the stress.
13.2.5

Nonlinear Polymers

Modern synthesis methods have allowed preparation of polymers with a great variety of branching architectures, such as random, comb, uniform and nonuniform
star, brush, and dendritic [66, 67]. It is understandable that the conformations
and hence several properties of these structures can vary remarkably among linear
polymers of similar compositions and molecular weights. The compression of the
branched molecule compared to linear molecules of same molecular weight can be
quantied in terms of the factors dened in Eqs. (21) and (22), where the subscripts b and l represent the branched and the linear polymers.
g S 2 b =S 2 l

21

g 0 hb =hl

22

The factors g and g 0 can often be related, depending on the branching architecture.
For example, for star polymers with p equal arms [68, 69], the relationship is given
by Eq. (23).

699

700

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

Fig. 13.21. Variation of polymer melt viscosity with molecular


weight. (from C. W. Macosko, Rheology: Principles,
Measurements and Applications, Copyright 1994 VCH. Used by
permission from the publisher, John Wiley & Sons, Inc.).

3
2

0:2624 1  0:2624g 0 1:088 g 0 0:6087
p p2

23

Such characteristics of several other branched architectures have been examined


[70]. The molecular compression behavior by branching allows high loading of
the polymeric additives without the excessive viscosity enhancement associated
with polymers. As we shall discuss in Section 13.3.6, the rheological eects of

13.2 Polymer Conformation and Related Properties

Fig. 13.22. Connement of a polymer chains


motion in its own tube dened by a xed
network of surrounding chains. Back and forth
motion in the tube leads to tube renewal and

thus to the loss of the original tube orientation


and stress (adapted from M. Doi, S. F.
Edwards, The Theory of Polymer Dynamics,
Clarendon, Oxford, 1986).

branching are more substantial and are put to use in strongly owing polymer
melt systems.
13.2.6

Rigid Rod-like Polymers

Some polypeptides and para-linked synthetic aromatic polymers take up elongated


forms, forming rodlike structures (rather than exible coils). Their solution viscosity displays a strong dependence on the polymer molecular weight according to Eq.
(24), where L and R are the length (@M) and the radius, and rb is the bulk density
of the rodlike molecules [64].
h

2L=R 2
45rb lnL=2R  0:8

24

At higher concentrations (number concentration > 1=L 3 ), the motion of rodlike


polymers is highly hindered in the directions perpendicular to the rod axis, and
the viscosity increases spectacularly with mass concentration (r) and molecular
weight [Eq. (25)] [64].
h z r 3 M 6 =lnN

25

701

702

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

Due to this eect, the increase in molecular weight during their step-growth polymerization leads to a reduction in the reaction rate of such polymers [71], and provides the possibility of controlling the kinetics and molecular weight distribution
by orienting ow [72]. Spontaneous liquid-crystalline ordering of these polymers
at still higher concentrations allows their processing into very strong bers [73].

13.3

Polymer Rheology

In Section 13.2 we discussed the equilibrium conformations of polymers and their


inuence on the polymeric behavior. We shall now discuss the rheological properties of polymers associated with their very special characteristic that their conformation changes under imposed ows.
13.3.1

The Viscous Response: Shear Thinning

One important characteristic of polymers is their shear thinning behavior: the viscosity decreases with increasing rate of deformation (Figure 13.23). This behavior
at g_ @ l1 is attributed to the partial disentanglement of the chains as they get extended in the ow direction. Since the relaxation time increases with molecular
weight [for example, l @ M 1:5 at low concentrations; Eqs. (12), (15)] and with polymer concentration, shear thinning begins at lower shear rates for polymers with

Fig. 13.23. Shear thinning behavior of an ABS


polymer melt at three dierent temperatures.
Broken lines are power law ts and solid lines
represent the Cross model. (from C. W.

Macosko, Rheology: Principles, Measurements


and Applications, Copyright 1994 VCH. Used by
permission from the publisher, John Wiley &
Sons, Inc.).

13.3 Polymer Rheology

higher molecular weights and at higher concentrations. The shear thinning behavior is responsible for the processibility of many polymer melts. For example, high
strain rates of extrusion are employed lest they should undergo stress and thermal
degradation, and the circumferential shear (due to screw rotation) during extrusion
reduces the viscosity suciently to enable axial ow (due to the pressure developed) [74].
Empirically, the shear thinning behavior is most conveniently represented by the
power law relationship expressed by Eq. (26) [75] (Figure 13.23) or, more appropriately by a four parameter Cross model [Eq. (27), where ho and hy correspond to the
low (zero) and the high shear plateaus, and l and n < 1 correspond to the location of transition and the slope on a loglog plot (Figure 13.23)] [76].
h Kg_ n1

26

h  hy
1 lg_ 2 n1=2
ho  hy

27

It is interesting to examine the ability of the simple molecular models (Section


13.2.2) to represent the shear thinning phenomena. The linearly elastic dumbbell
and the Rouse models represent chain extension (unlimited at increasing g_), yet
these predict the viscosity to be independent of shear rate. The nitely extensible
nonlinear elastic (FENE) dumbbell model considers the connecting spring to
stien innitely as the extension approaches the maximum possible value Q o .
This permits prediction of the shear thinning behavior starting at (lg_ @ 1) [58].
Similarly, when one accounts for hydrodynamic interaction, the linearly elastic
dumbbell model also predicts shear thinning according to Eq. (28).
h  hs

nkB Tl1  x
1 2x1  x=2lg_ 2

28

13.3.2

Normal Stresses during Shear Flow

In contrast to simple uids under shear that generate stresses parallel to the direction of shear, polymeric uids also generate normal stresses perpendicular to the
ow direction [Eqs. (29), (30), where N1 and N2 are called the rst and the second
normal stress dierence, respectively, and are dependent on the shear rate].
N1 is positive, corresponding to a tendency of the polymeric uid to push apart
the two plates between which the uid is sheared (Figure 13.24). Such a tendency
of polymeric uids is manifested in interesting phenomena such as die-swell and
rod-climbing (Figure 13.25).
txx  tyy N1

29

txx  tzz N2

30

703

704

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

manometers
at various
radial positions
stationary
cone
fluid
rotating
flat plate

Fig. 13.24. When a polymeric uid is sheared between a cone


and a plate, stresses are generated that are also normal to the
ow direction, as is evident from the monomeric uid levels.

Fig. 13.25. Normal stresses in shearing polymeric uids are


responsible for their swelling on exit from a die.

13.3 Polymer Rheology

Fig. 13.26. Uniaxial extensional ow generated between a xed


plate and a plate moving at desired velocity (v), while the entire
geometry is held in a constant-temperature bath. Measurement
of the sample dimension and the required tension force allows
calculation of the elongational viscosity.

13.3.3

Extensional Thickening

A ow that converges or diverges is called extensional or compressional (Figure


13.26). For example, stretching of a lament creates extensional ow with the corresponding velocity gradient (g_xx dvx =dx) resulting in tensile stress [Eq. (31),
where he is called the extensional viscosity].
txx  tyy he g_xx

31

With an increase in ow time or strain at low g_xx, he increases to its asymptotic


steady-state value given by Eq. (32).
he 3h

32

However, many polymers show strain hardening, that is, an increase in he beyond
this asymptotic value at high strain rates (Figure 13.27). Such behavior of high molecular weight polymers is responsible for stabilizing stretching processes involved
in the production of lms and bers.

705

706

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

Fig. 13.27. Uniextensional extensional


viscosity (h
u , open symbols) and shear
viscosity (h , closed or half-lled symbols) of
low-density polyethylene (LDPE) as functions
of ow time after inception of the steady

extensional rate (_e) or shear rate (g_),


respectively. (from C. W. Macosko, Rheology:
Principles, Measurements and Applications,
Copyright 1994 VCH. Used by permission from
the publisher, John Wiley & Sons, Inc.).

13.3.4

The Elastic Response


Ideal Elastic Response
Polymeric materials often tend to behave as springs (that is, they have a tendency
to retract on stretching), thus displaying some degree of elasticity. An ideal elastic
material responds instantaneously to application or removal of stress, with the
strain (g) being proportional to the stress (Hookean), independently of the strain
rate [Eq. (33)]. Here, the constant G is the modulus of the elastic material.
13.3.4.1

t Gg

33

Rubberlike Elasticity
Elastic polymers contain a crosslinked network to restrain the gross mobility of
their chains. When the chain segments between crosslinks are deformed anely
in a macroscopic sample due to application of an external force, the resulting decrease in chain entropy brings in a springlike retractive force (with spring constant
3kB T=r 2 ) [77]. Generalization to a three-dimensional deformation to account for
cross-sectional area changes corresponding to an axial strain of a  1 results in
13.3.4.2

13.3 Polymer Rheology

Fig. 13.28. Stressextension curve for a


sample of natural rubber compared with the
ideal rubber prediction [Eq. (35)] (Reprinted
from Paul J. Flory, Principles of Polymer

Chemistry. Copyright 1953 Cornell University


and Copyright 1981 Paul J. Flory. Used by
permission from the publisher, Cornell
University Press).

the retractive force per unit deformed cross-sectional area according to Eq. (34),
where G Ne kB T, and Ne is the number of crosslinked chains per unit volume.


1
txx G a 2 
a

34

The a 2 dependence indicates that the chains become progressively harder to


stretch. As seen in Figure 13.28, this simple model based on (innitely extensible)
Gaussian chains fails to explain the extreme stiening behavior at very high strains
near the maximum possible chain extension.
13.3.5

The Viscoelastic Response

Elastic behavior in polymers is rubberlike and thus not Hookean, and viscous behavior is shear thinning and thus not Newtonian. Further, real polymers display
characteristics that are a combination of such elastic and viscous responses. This
is best illustrated by the Maxwell model [75, 78], which considers the viscoelastic

707

708

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

, 1

, 2

,
Fig. 13.29. The Maxwell model for a viscoelastic material
considers an elastic spring and a viscous dashpot connected in
series.

behavior to be a series combination of the Hookean elasticity as represented by a


linear spring and the Newtonian viscous behavior as represented by a dashpot (Figure 13.29). The stress (t) being the same for the spring and the dashpot, and the
total strain (g) being the sum of the strains of the spring and the dashpot, one obtains Eq. (35) or, substituting l h=G, Eq. (36).
dg dg1 dg2
1 dt t

dt
G dt h
dt
dt
tl

dt
dg
h
dt
dt

35
36

In Figure 13.30, we compare the creep and stress relaxation responses of such a
material with the responses of an ideal elastic solid and a viscous Newtonian uid.
It is easily realized from the creep behavior that a small value of h and large value
of G (and thus a small value of l) correspond to the viscoelastic response approximating to the viscous response. Further, the creep response of the viscoelastic
material at short times (for example, instantaneously) closely approximates to the
elastic behavior, because viscous ow occurs only over time. At long times, the accumulated viscous response represents the overall deformation. Similarly, the
stress relaxation behavior of the viscoelastic material suggests that l is a measure
of time taken for stress to relax to 1/e of the original stress, and hence this is called
the relaxation time of the material. The eect of material characteristics l and process time (t) are thus easily put together in the dimensionless parameter called the
Deborah number De, as in Eq. (37).

13.3 Polymer Rheology

o /

/o
1/e

o /G
0

time
(a)

time

(b)

(a) Creep behavior (strain


response to an applied step-stress to ) and (b)
stress relaxation behavior (stress response to
step-strain go ). The behavior of an elastic solid
Fig. 13.30.

De l=t

(broken lines with long dashes), a viscous


liquid (broken line with short dashes, and
dotted line), and a Maxwell viscoelastic
material (solid line) are compared.

37

De > 1 and De < 1 correspond to predominantly elastic and viscous responses respectively. De determines the level of shear stress that can relax during the melt
processing, and hence the residual chain orientation, morphology, and properties
in the solid-state article fabricated by melt processing.
The Maxwell model [Eq. (36)] can also be expressed in the integral form of Eq.
(38) [75]. That is, the stress can be looked upon as the sum of every incremental
strain g_ t 0 Dt 0 multiplied by the corresponding exponentially decreasing modulus
0
Gett =l .
t

Gett =l g_ t 0 dt 0

38

y

Linear Viscoelasticity in Dynamic Oscillatory Flow


When a sinusoidally varying strain (Figure 13.31) of frequency o and a small amplitude gmax is imposed on a uid according to Eqs. (39) and (40), the corresponding stress also oscillates [Eq. (41)], albeit with a phase delay (d, Figure 13.31) after
the imposed strain rate that can be decomposed into two strain-dependent terms
[Eq. (42)], of which the rst is the elastic contribution in phase with the strain
[Eq. (39)], and the second is the viscous contribution in phase with the strain
rate [Eq. (40)].
13.3.5.1

gyx gmax sinot

39

g_yx g_ max cosot

40

tyx tmax cosot  d


0

41
00

tyx G gmax sinot G gmax cosot

42

709

710

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

m ax

max

,
0

10

Fig. 13.31. Imposed sinusoidal strain (solid line), and the


corresponding sinusoidal stress (broken line) response of a
viscoelastic material.

G 0 tmax cos d=gmax and G 00 tmax sin d=gmax are called the storage modulus and
the loss modulus, corresponding to the elastic and viscous contributions, respectively. For the Maxwell model [Eq. (36)], their dependence on frequency is
ol 2
ol
00
. With an increase in frequency,
given by G 0 G
2 and G G
1 ol 2
1 ol
a polymer behaves increasingly like a solid (storage/elastic), G 0 ! G: that is, the
storage modulus equates to the elastic modulus. This single-mode Maxwell model
correctly represents the observed G 0 @ o 2 and G 00 @ o dependence in the terminal
zone (long time, small o), and a crossover at o 1=l (Figure 13.32). However, real
polymers display not a single time constant and a single modulus, but a spectrum

G', G''

crossover
defines (1/ )

log ()
Frequency response of a viscoelastic material.
Storage modulus (G 0 , solid line) and loss modulus (G 00 , broken
line) are shown.
Fig. 13.32.

13.3 Polymer Rheology

10

Gi (Pa)
3

10

branched

linear

10

-3

10

-1

10

i (S)

Fig. 13.33. Relaxation spectra for linear and


branched polyethylene (PE). The spectrum of
the branched PE includes a relaxation time that
is 10 times longer than the longest relaxation
time of linear PE. This is consistent with the

10

10

long relaxation times predicted for branched


PE. (redrawn from S. H. Wasserman in
Metallocene Catalyzed Polymers, Eds. G. M.
Benedikt, B. L. Goodall, BF Goodrich,
Brecksville, 1998).

of relaxation times (li ) and modulus parameters (Gi ) corresponding to dierent


modes of relaxation. The Maxwell model can then be generalized by considering
the stress to be a sum (superposition) of the contributions of each mode of relaxation, as represented by Eq. (43), where Gi and li can be found by carrying out a
multiparameter t of the stress response to step-strain or dynamic strain.
t

t
y

X
0
Gi ett =li g_ t 0 dt 0

43

These values of Gi and li constitute the relaxation spectrum of a polymer, and are
useful in correlating the viscoelastic behavior of polymers with their molecular
characteristics, such as long-chain branching in polyethylene (Figure 13.33) [79].
13.3.6

Inuence of Polymer Branching Architecture in Bulk Polymers

Polymer chemistry has played a very important role in providing polymeric material with pre-designed molecular architectures. In particular, the branching architecture has been seen to greatly inuence the rheological behavior of polymer
melts as the reptation of the arms is severely suppressed. Relaxation of the arms
can take place only by arm withdrawal, which is exponentially slowed with increasing arm length [63]. It is only after sucient movement of the arms that the motion of branching points (otherwise hindered by the network around them) can

711

712

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

slowly take place (Figure 13.34) [80]. Some spectacular eects of these entanglements in long-chain branched industrial polyethylene (LDPE) are the following:
very long relaxation times (Figure 13.33), greater extensional thickening (Figure
13.27), and greater shear thinning (Figure 13.35) [81, 82]. The extensional thickening is critical for imparting the characteristics necessary for lm blowing, blowmolding and foaming applications of polyolens, and the increased shear thinning
allows easier extrusion at high shear rates. Eorts have been made to enhance
processibility of polyesters by introducing branching, and lower melt and solution
viscosities are obtained. However, the solid-state properties were found to be poor
[83].
Hyperbranched polymers are compact, highly branched, three-dimensional macromolecules with a high density of end-groups [84]. Their compact structure results in inherently low viscosity, as evidenced by the value of the MarkHouwink
constant a being less than 0.5. Hyperbranched aliphatic polyesters have been applied as toughners for epoxy thermosets without a signicant increase in viscosity
[85]. Hyperbranched polymers can be used as rheology control agents during the
processing of polymers, for example to obtain a dramatic decrease in viscosity
[86], as lubricants [87], or for sharkskin elimination [88].
Dendrimers are a relatively new class of highly and regularly branched polymers
with well dened numbers of branching layers and a low molecular weight between branches. Dendritically branched polymers may have somewhat higher
molecular weights, yet lower intrinsic viscosity, than corresponding regular starshaped polymers, due to their dense internal structure [89]. They can display high
elasticity [90], and this makes them potentially interesting rheology modiers. The
large number of peripheral terminal groups contribute to their solubilities, and
oer potential for loading high functionalities when utilized as additives, for example for solubility enhancement, ber dyeability, crystallization suppression, and
suchlike [91, 92].
Dense grafting of side chains onto linear backbones, and homopolymerization of
macromonomers, are both used to synthesize macromolecular brushes. Steric repulsion of the side chains forces the main chain into an extended wormlike conformation, resulting in liquid-crystalline phases, and lower dynamic shear moduli
than linear exible coils in concentrated solutions [93, 94]. Densely grafted polymeric brushes on sliding surfaces have been found to reduce friction, and therefore have potential for providing biolubrication for articial implants [95].
13.3.7

Polymers as Rheology Modiers

Due to their large coil size and hence their great inuence on the shear and elongational behavior of solvents, polymers are used as rheology-modifying additives in
applications ranging from fuels, lubricants, coatings, and sprays to enhanced oil
recovery and turbulent drag reduction [96]. For example, macromolecular coils
of poly(alkyl methacrylate) and ethylenepropylene copolymers that expand with
temperature are used to oset the solvent viscosity decrease upon heating (Figure

13.3 Polymer Rheology

Fig. 13.34. Relaxation in a branched H-polymer melt involves


retraction of arms by uctuations, followed by crossbar
reptation as branch points move along the dilated tube
(Reprinted with permission from T. C. B. McLeish et al.,
Macromolecules, Volume 32, Page 6734. Copyright 1999).

complex
viscosity
(Pa-s)

frequency
(rad/s)
Fig. 13.35. Complex viscosity of linear (broken curve) and
long-chain branched (solid curve) polymers. Long-chain
branching results in stronger shear thinning properties.

713

714

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

Fig. 13.36. Temperature eect on intrinsic


viscosity of ethylenepropylene copolymers in
toluene. The calculated hydrodynamic volume
of EP-5 (Mw 322 000, ethylene 80 mol%)
increases from 5:6  1018 to 43:7  1018

cm 3 /molecule as the temperature increases


from 10 C to 50 C. (Reprinted with
permission from A. Sen, I. D. Rubin,
Macromolecules, Volume 23, Page 2519.
Copyright 1990, American Chemical Society).

13.36), resulting in atter viscositytemperature curves [97]. This kind of application in automotive lubricating oils is termed viscosity index improvement [96]. Extensional thickening by polymers is responsible for the use of polymeric additives
as anti-misting agents to resist uid breakup into minute droplets [98, 99]. Another application of polymers is as drag-reducing agents where a few parts per million of polymeric additives can locally enhance the elongational viscosity in order
to dampen turbulence, thereby enhancing uid ow by as much as 100%. At the
high deformation rates during such applications, polymers can undergo chain scission and thus lose their eciency in rheology modication [100]. Enhancement of
shear stability against such chain scission by way of control of chain architecture is
of much interest [101]. Once again, developments in living polymerization techniques in recent decades have provided access to new polymeric topologies. Some
of these have now been optimized suciently to yield polymers of high enough
molecular weight to be of interest for rheology modication [102].
13.3.8

Rheological Control with Block Copolymers

Nanophase separation of block copolymer melts introduces interesting rheological


behavior. For example, the transient elongational viscosity behavior of a triblock copolymer of styrene and olens was found to be strongly dependent on the initial
orientation of the cylindrical domains [103].
While conventional processing of polymers involves melting, block copolymers
such as PSbPnBA display melt-like behavior simply on application of pressure
at room temperature; this is due to pressure-induced miscibility of the blocks
(baroplastics [104]).
Precipitation and gelation of long-chain parans in waxy crude oils hinders
their ow and hence their recovery and processing. Flow characteristics can be im-

13.4 Summary

proved with addition of a diblock copolymer with a crystalline polyethylene block


and an amorphous poly(ethylenepropylene) block which self-assembles in the
oil. The former block provides nucleation sites for crystallization of the parans,
and the latter provides steric stabilization for the wax crystals [105].
13.3.9

Polymer-like Structures through Noncovalent Associations

As compared with the all-covalently linked monomers forming polymeric


structures, weak noncovalent associating interactions between macromolecules/
oligomers also provide a possibility of forming chainlike structures. Examples of
such interactions are van der Waals and Coulomb interactions, hydrophobic interactions, hydrogen bonds, and ionic bonds. Use of reversible associations like these
have been successful in tailoring rheological behavior. For example, polymers with
ionically associating groups have been described as useful drag-reducing agents, as
their shear stability is enhanced due to sacricial breaking of the reversible associations at high shear, and reassociation in appropriate low-shear conditions [106,
107]. Hydrophobically associating polymers (HEURs) are used for controlling the
rheological behavior of industrial coatings, since they provide sucient shear viscosity through network formation [108]. As compared to solutions of high molecular weight polymers that show divergent trends with solvent evaporation, linear
polymers and networks can be built by strongly associating 2u-ureido-4-pyrimidone
end-groups [109]. High sensitivity of the associating behavior to temperature provides opportunities for on-line tuning of rheological behavior.
Introduction of ionic groups or proteins into polymers (forming ionomers) leads
to physical associations at the temperature of use [110, 111]. For example, Surlyn
(DuPont) is a copolymer of ethylene and methacrylic acid that shows enhanced
zero-shear viscosity and elastomeric green strength. Viscoelastic characteristics are
also enhanced due to loss of associations at the appropriate dissociation temperature. Ion pair associations are exploited to obtain miscibility in otherwise immiscible polymers [112].
Molecules that are capable of spatial complementarity and weak reversible noncovalent interactions with each other can self-assemble from a less ordered state
(such as a solution) to an ordered structure (such as a solid crystal) without human
intervention [113]. In this manner, precise tuning of oligopeptide associating structures provides an completely new route to a hierarchy of structures such as tapes,
ribbons, brils, bers, and ber networks, which can be useful as materials [114
116].

13.4

Summary

In this chapter, we have discussed the interrelationships of the molecular structures of polymers with their thermal, solution, and rheological behavior. The ther-

715

716

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

mal response is largely determined by interactions at short distances, such as


symmetry and steric eects. On the other hand, the solution and rheological behavior is dominated by topological considerations such as the long-chain structure and branching. Thus, a large variety of polymer properties can be tuned
by characteristics such as (co)polymer composition, average molecular weight,
molecular weight distribution, branching architectures, reversible associations,
and (nano)additives. In the context of the present handbook, it seems appropriate
to emphasize once again the role of the emerging polymerization techniques in
achieving these characteristics in polymers.

Notation

a
c
c
De
f y
F c
g; g 0
gj
G
G 0 ; G 00
DGm
H
DHm
kB
K
l
L
M
n
n
N
NA
Ne
N1 ; N2
p
Q
R
Rg
S2
DSm
t

MarkHouwink constant
mass concentration of the polymer [kg m3 ]
critical overlap concentration of the polymer [kg m3 ]
Deborah number
factor for coiled chain dimension corresponding to bond angle
spring force in the connector of a beadspring model [N]
factors describing compression of branched polymer versus linear polymer
factor for coiled chain dimension corresponding to rotation about bonds
elastic modulus [Pa]
the storage modulus and the loss modulus [Pa]
free energy change on mixing [J]
spring constant in a beadspring model
heat of melting [J]
Boltzmanns constant [J K1 ]
MarkHouwink constant
length of bonds (segments) in polymer chain [m]
length of the rodlike molecules [m]
molecular weight [kg kmol1 ]
number of bonds (segments) in the polymer chain
number concentration of the springs
number of beads in the beadspring model
Avogadros number
number of crosslinked chains per unit volume [m3 ]
rst and second normal stress dierence [Pa]
number of arms in a star polymer
connector (spring) vector in a beadspring model
polymer chains end-to-end distance vector [m]
universal gas constant [J K1 kmol1 ]
mean square radius of gyration [m 2 ]
entropy of melting [J K1 ]
time [s]

Notation

T
Tg
Tg; y
Tm
vx
wi
xc

temperature [K]
glass transition temperature [K]
glass transition of a polymer with innite molecular weight [K]
melting temperature [K]
x component of velocity [m s1 ]
weight fraction of species i
extent of crystallization

Greek
a
a0
g_
g
d
h
hs
he
[h]
y
l
lH
x
p
r
rb
tij
f
j
w
wc
o

extension ratio of an elastic material


factor for polymer coil expansion due to polymersolvent interactions
shear rate [s1 ]
strain
phase delay in dynamic analysis
viscosity of a polymer solution [Pa s]
shear viscosity of the solvent [Pa s]
extensional viscosity [Pa s]
intrinsic viscosity of a polymer in solution [m 3 kg1 ]
angle between consecutive bonds in a polymer chain [rad]
time constant of a polymer [s]
time constant of a polymer segment [s]
bead friction factor
osmotic pressure [Pa]
polymer property such as mass concentration, density, specic heat
bulk density of a polymer
stress tensor [Pa]
polymer volume fraction in solution
angle describing rotation of bonds at xed y [rad]
Florys interaction parameter for mixing
critical value of w for phase separation
angular frequency [s1 ]

Acronyms
BPA
EDA
HEUR
LDPE
PBT
PE
PEEK
PET
PI

bisphenol-A
ethylene diamine
hydrophobically associating polymer (hydrophobically modied, ethoxylated urethane resin)
low-density polyethylene
poly(butene terephthalate)
polyethylene
poly(ether ether ketone)
poly(ethylene terephthalate)
polyimide

717

718

13 Polymer Properties through Structure

PMMA
PnBA
POSS
PP
PPT
PS
SWNT
WAXD

poly(methyl methacrylate)
poly(n-butyl acrylate)
polyhedral silsesquioxane
polypropylene
poly(propylene terephthalate)
polystyrene
single-wall carbon nanotube
wide-angle X-ray diraction

References
1 D. P. R. Kint, S. Munoz-Guerra,
2
3
4

7
8

9
10
11
12

13
14

15

Polym. Int., 2003, 52, 321.


K. Fuchs, C. Friedrich, J. Weese,
Macromolecules, 1996, 29, 5893.
E. S. Sang et al., Macromolecules, 2003,
36, 7994.
I. W. Hamley, The Physics of Block
Copolymers, Oxford University Press,
Oxford, 1999.
N. Hadjichristidis, S. Pispas, G. A.
Floudas, Block Copolymers: Synthetic
Strategies, Physical Properties, and
Applications, John Wiley & Sons, New
York, 2003.
J. K. Sears, J. R. Darby, Technology of
Plasticizers, John Wiley & Sons, New
York, 1982.
P. J. Lemstra, R. Krischbaum,
Polymer, 1985, 26, 1372.
H. D. Chanzy, E. Bonjour, R. H.
Marchessault, Coll. Polym. Sci., 1974,
252, 8.
J. T. E. Cook et al., Polymer 2000, 41,
8615.
U. S. Agarwal, P. J. Lemstra, Chem.
Engng. Sci., 2001, 56, 4007.
U. S. Agarwal, Ind. Engng. Chem. Res.
2004, 143, 7275.
G. Cecchin, G. Morini, A.
Pelliconi, Macromol. Symp., 2001,
173, 195.
K. Tsobkallo et al., Polymer, 2003, 44,
1613.
S. Fakirov, in Solid State Behavior of
Linear Polyesters and Polyamides, Eds.
J. M. Schultz, S. Fakirov, Prentice
Hall, New Jersey, 1990.
F. J. Medellin-Rodriguez, R. LopezGuillen, M. A. Waldo-Mendoza, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci., 2000, 75, 78.

16 B. Duh, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 2001, 81,

1748.
17 Y. Ma , U. S. Agarwal, D. J. Sikkema,

P. J. Lemstra, Polymer, 2003, 44, 4085.


18 G. Guerra, G. Titomanlio,

19

20

21
22
23
24
25
26
27
28
29
30
31

32

Macromol. Symp. Ser. 185 FlowInduced Crystallization of Polymers,


Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 2002.
U. S. Agarwal et al., Chapter 5 in
Polymer Science and Fiber Science
Recent Advances pp. 4366, Ed. R. E.
Fornes, R. D. Gilbert, VCH, New
York, 1992.
Y. Funatsu, N. Suzuki, M. Fukuhara, JP 2001011733 A2 20010116,
2001, Chem. Abstr. 134: 72858.
F. L. Binsbergen, J. Polym. Sci.,
Polym. Symp., 1977, 59, 1119.
H. G. Haubruge et al., Macromolecules
2003, 36, 4452.
R. Legras et al., Polymer 1984, 25, 835.
K. Bouma, R. J. Gaymans, Polym.
Engng. Sci., 2001, 41, 466.
U. S. Agarwal, G. de Wit, P. J.
Lemstra, Polymer, 2002, 43, 5709.
T. A. Shepard et al., J. Polym. Sci.,
Polym. Phys. 1997, 35, 2617.
A. R. Bhattacharya et al., Polymer,
2003, 44, 2373.
K. Matyjaszeweski, J. Xia, Chem. Rev.,
2001, 101, 2921.
C. J. Hawker, A. W. Bosman, E.
Harth, Chem. Rev., 2001, 101, 3661.
R. Adhikari et al., Macromol Rapid
Commun., 2004, 25, 653.
G. Holden, E. T. Bishop, N. R.
Legge, in Proc. Intl. Rubber Conference,
MacLaren, London, 1968.
T. Hashimoto, K. Tsutsumi, Y.
Funaki, Langmuir, 1997, 13, 6869.

References
33 S. I. Stupp, P. V. Braun, Science,
34

35

36
37

38

39

40
41

42
43

44

45

46
47

48

49

1997, 277, 1242.


R. B. Thompson, V. V. Ginzburg,
M. W. Matsen, A. C. Balazs, Science,
2001, 292, 2469.
Z. Zhang, M. A. Horsch, M. H.
Lamm, S. C. Glotzer, Nano Lett.,
2003, 3, 1341.
A. Jain et al., Macromolecules, 2002,
35, 4862.
G. G. Swift, C. E. Carraher, C.
Bowman, Polymer Modication,
Plenum Press, New York, 1997.
R. O. Ebewele, Chapters 5 and 9 in
Polymer Science and Technology, CRC
Press, Boca Raton, 2000.
D. R. Paul, C. B. Bucknall, Polymer
Blends: Formulation and Performance,
John Wiley & Sons, New York, 2000.
L. A. Utracki, Polymer Blends Handbook, Kluwer Ac. Pub. Dordrecht, 2003.
C. Vasile, A. K. Kulshreshtha,
Handbook of Polymer Blends and
Composites, Rapra Technology,
Shrophire, UK, 2002.
S. Al-Malaika, Reactive Modiers for
Polymers, Blackie, London, 1997.
E. T. Thostenson, Z. Ren, T.-W.
Chou, Composites Sci. Technol. 2001,
61, 1899.
H. C. Zeng, in Handbook of OrganicInorganic Hybrid Materials and
Nanocomposites, Ed. H. S. Nalwa,
American Scientic, Stevenson Ranch,
Vol. 2, pp. 151180, 2003.
D. Qian, E. C. Dickey, R. Andrews,
T. Rantell, Appl. Phys. Lett., 2000, 76,
2868.
Y. Sabba, E. L. Thomas, Macromolecules, 2004, 37, 4815.
S. Barrau et al., Macromolecules, 2003,
36, 5187; J. Sandler et al., Polymer
1999, 40, 5967; M. J. Biercuk et al.,
Appl. Phys. Lett. 2002, 80, 2767; Z.
Ounaies et al., Composites Sci. Technol.
2003, 63, 1637; O. Reghev et al., Adv.
Materials 2004, 16, 248.
M. Q. Zhang, M. Z. Rong, K.
Friedrich, in Encyclopedia of
Nanoscience and Nanotechnology, Ed.
H. S. Nalwa, American Scientic,
Stevenson Ranch, 2004.
L. Chazeau, C, Gauthier, G. Vigier,
J. Y. Cavaille, in Handbook of OrganicInorganic Hybrid Materials and Nano-

50
51
52
53

54

55
56

57

58

59
60
61
62
63

64

65
66

67
68
69

70

composites, Ed. H. S. Nalwa, American


Scientic, Stevenson Ranch, 2003.
G. Schmidt, M. M. Malwitz, Curr.
Opin. Coll. Interf. Sci., 2003, 8, 103.
P. J. Flory, J. Chem. Phys. 1942, 10, 51.
M. L. Huggins, J. Am. Chem. Soc.,
1942, 64, 1712.
M. Muthukumar, S. F. Edwards, in
Comprehensive Polymer Science, Vol. 2,
Eds. G. Allen, J. C. Bevington,
Pergamon, Oxford, 1989.
D. R. Paul, C. B. Bucknall, Polymer
Blends, Vols. 12, John Wiley & Sons,
New York, 2000.
L. A. Utracki, Polymer Blends
Handbook, Kluwer, Dordrecht, 2002.
O. Olabisi, L. M. Robeson, M. T.
Shaw, Polymer Polymer Miscibility,
Academic Press, London, 1979.
J. Brandrup, E. H. Immergut, Eds.,
Polymer Handbook, 2nd ed., Wiley,
New York, 1989.
R. B. Bird, C. F. Curtiss, R. C.
Armstrong, Dynamics of Polymeric
Liquids, Vol. 2, Kinetic Theory, Wiley,
New York, 1987.
P. E. Rouse, J. Chem. Phys., 1953, 21,
1272.
B. H. Zimm, J. Chem. Phys., 1956, 24,
269.
S. Onogi et al., J. Polym. Sci. Part C,
1966, 15, 381.
S. F. Edwards, M. Muthukumar,
Macromolecules, 1984, 17, 586.
P. G. de Gennes, Scaling Concepts in
Polymer Physics, Cornell University
Press, Ithaca, 1979.
M. Doi, S. F. Edwards, The Theory of
Polymer Dynamics, Clarendon, Oxford,
1986.
T. Perkins, D. E. Smith, S. Chu,
Science, 1994, 264, 819.
J. E. MacGrath, Anionic Polymerization: Kinetics, Mechanism and Synthesis,
ACS Symp. Ser. No. 166, Washington
DC, 1981.
K. A. Davis, K. Matyjaszewski, Adv.
Polym. Sci., 2002, 159, 1.
B. H. Zimm, W. H. Stockmayer, J.
Chem. Phys., 1949, 17, 1301.
G. S. Grest, L. J. Fetters, J. S.
Huang, D. Ritcher, Adv. Chem.
Phys., 1996, 94, 67.
J. J. Freire, Adv. Polym. Sci., 1999,
143, 35.

719

720

13 Polymer Properties through Structure


71 D. B. Cotts, G. C. Berry, Macro72
73

74
75

76
77

78
79

80
81
82
83
84
85

86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93

molecules, 1981, 14, 930.


U. S. Agarwal, D. V. Khakhar,
Nature, 1992, 360, 53.
L. Vollbracht, in Comprehensive
Polymer Science, Vol. 5, Eds. G. Allen,
J. C. Bevington, Pergamon Press,
Oxford, 1989.
A. C. Dierckes, W. R. Schowalter,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Fund., 1966, 5, 263.
R. B. Bird, R. C. Armstrong, O.
Hassager, Dynamics of Polymeric
Liquids, Vol. 1, Fluid Mechanics, Wiley,
New York, 1987.
M. M. Cross, J. Colloid. Sci., 1965, 20,
417.
J.-P. Queslel, J. E. Mark, Chapter 9
in Comprehensive Polymer Science, Vol.
2, Ed. G. Allen, J. C. Bevington,
Pergamon, Oxford, 1989.
J. C. Maxwell, Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc.,
1867, A157, 49.
S. H. Wasserman, in Metallocene
Catalyzed Polymers, Ed. G. M.
Benedikt, B. L. Goodall, BF
Goodrich, Brecksville, 1998.
T. C. B. McLeish et al., Macromolecules, 1999, 32, 6734.
H. A. Malmberg et al., Macromolecules, 2002, 35, 1038.
M. Gahleitner, Prog. Polym. Sci.,
2001, 26, 895.
N. Hudson et al., Macromolecules,
2000, 33, 9255.
C. Gao, D. Yan, Prog. Polymer Sci.,
2004, 29, 183.
R. Mezzenga, L. Boogh, J. A. E.
Manson, Composites Sci. Technol. 2001,
61, 787.
Y. H. Kim, O. W. Webster, Macomolecules, 1992, 25, 5561.
T. J. Mulkern, N. C. B. Tan, Polymer,
2000, 41, 3193.
Y. Hong et al., Polymer, 2000, 41, 7705.
D. M. Knauss, T. Huang, Macromolecules, 2003, 36, 6036.
J. R. Dorgan et al., Macromolecules,
2003, 36, 380.
P. Froehling, J. Polym. Sci., Polym.
Chem., 2004, 42, 3110.
C. R. Yates, W. Hayes, European
Polym. J., 2004, 40, 1257.
Y. Tsukahara et al., Polymer, 1995, 36,
3413; Adv. Polym. Technol. 2000, 11, 210.

94 B. Zhang et al., Polymer, 2004, 45,

4009.
95 J. Klein et al., Nature, 1994, 370, 634.
96 D. N. Schulz, J. E. Glass, Polymers as

97
98
99
100
101
102
103
104
105

106

107
108
109
110

111

112
113

114

115
116

Rheology Modiers, ACS Symp. Ser.


No. 62, Washington DC, 1991.
A. Sen, I. Rubin, Macromolecules,
1990, 23, 2519.
S. Nigen, K. Walters, J. Non-Newt.
Fl. Mech. 2001, 87, 233.
V. Bargeron et al., Nature, 2000, 405,
772.
J. A. Odell, A. Keller, Y. Rabin, J.
Chem. Phys., 1988, 88, 4022.
U. S. Agarwal, R. A. Mashelkar, J.
Chem. Phys., 1994, 100, 6055.
L. Xue, U. S. Agarwal, P. J. Lemstra,
Macromolecules, 2002, 35, 8650.
Y. Kobori et al., Macromolecules, 2003,
36, 1656.
B. Zhang et al., Polymer, 2004, 45,
4009.
H. S. Ashbaugh, L. J. Fetters, D. H.
Adamson, R. K. Pridhomme, J.
Rheology, 2002, 46, 763.
S. Malik, S. N. Shintre, R. A.
Mashelkar, Macromolecules, 1993, 26,
55.
R. M. Kowalik et al., J. Non-Newt. Fl.
Mech. 1987, 24, 1.
A. J. Reuvers, Prog. Organic Coatings,
1999, 35, 171.
R. P. Sijbesma et al., Science, 1997,
278, 1601.
W. A. Petka, J. L. Harden, K. P.
McGrath, D. Wirtz, D. A. Tirrell,
Science, 1998, 281, 389.
C. W. Lantman, W. J. MacKnight,
R. D. Lundberg, in Comprehensive
Polymer Science, Vol. 2, Eds. G. Allen,
J. C. Bevington, Pergamon, Oxford,
1989.
M. Rutkowski, A. Eisenberg, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1985, 30, 3317.
G. M. Whitesides, M. Boncheva,
Proc. National Acad. Sci. 2002, 99,
4769.
S. Zhang, D. M. Marini, W. Hwang,
S. Santoso, Curr. Opin. Biol. 2002, 6,
865.
A. Aggeli et al., Proc. Nat. Acad. Sci.
2001, 98, 11 857.
H. A. Lashuel et al., J. Am. Chem.
Soc. 2000, 122, 5262.

721

14

Polymer Mechanical Properties1


Christopher J. G. Plummer
14.1

Introduction
14.1.1

Long-chain Molecules

A polymer is made up of macromolecules, that is, long chains of covalently linked


chemical units, called monomer units. In many synthetic macromolecules, these
units are identical, and the term polymer implies their number per chain exceeds about 10 2 , although it may reach over 10 5 in many instances. Branched and
highly crosslinked architectures are also important in practice, but it is above all
the presence of long linear monomer sequences that leads to the unique properties
of polymers. For conciseness, therefore, the emphasis in the present overview of
mechanical properties will be on isotropic, chemically homogeneous polymers
composed of exible linear or lightly crosslinked macromolecules.
Long chains of atoms or molecules linked by single covalent bonds are usually
exible in that rotation about the bonds is relatively unhindered, so that they
have many internal degrees of freedom. The forces that oppose any attempt to
constrain the macromolecule, such as maintaining its ends at xed positions, are
therefore essentially entropic in origin. This entropic contribution to their mechanical properties is one of the key features of polymers; it gives rise to the phenomenon of rubber elasticity, for example, as will be discussed in Section 14.2. Another
characteristic of polymers is the important role of their glass transition temperature, Tg . Polymers with regular congurations, such as polyethylene (PE), may
crystallize, but generally remain partly amorphous, even at temperatures, T, well
below their melting point, Tm . Moreover, polymers with random congurations,
such as atactic polystyrene (aPS), often show little crystallinity at any T and are
consequently referred to as amorphous. In either case, a signicant proportion
of a polymer becomes glassy at T < Tg . The glass transition therefore has a pro1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

722

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Fig. 14.1.

Sketch of the low strain mechanical response of various types of polymer.

found eect on polymer properties, whereas in many low molar mass materials
it only has observable physical consequences if solidication is associated with extremely rapid cooling rates.
Figure 14.1 shows schematically the eect of T on the low strain mechanical behavior of various types of polymer, along with the principal regimes of behavior.
Below Tg , unoriented polymers are rigid solids with a Youngs modulus, E, of between about 1 and 4 GPa, whose low strain response is conditioned by the cohesive
forces between nonbonded atoms. In organic polymers, these are mainly due to
weak Van der Waals interactions so that, even below Tg , the moduli are much lower
than in ionic and metallic crystals as well as in three-dimensional covalently
bonded structures such as diamond. As T is increased above Tg , E drops by a factor
of more than 10 3 in amorphous polymers such as aPS, although the decrease is
less marked in semicrystalline polymers, whose Tm is typically very much greater
than Tg , and the reinforcing eect of the relatively rigid crystalline regions persists.
Remarkably, even in uncrosslinked amorphous polymers, the modulus remains
nearly constant as T is increased further. This gives rise to a rubbery plateau,
whose extent depends strongly on the molar mass, M, as indicated by Figure 14.1.
Thus, the plateau becomes eectively innite for an innite, crosslinked network
of chains, but disappears altogether when M is less than some critical molar
mass, Mc . Beyond the plateau there is a transition to viscous liquid behavior, a
transition that is dened by Tm in semicrystalline polymers.
14.1.2

Simple Statistical Descriptions of Long-chain Molecules

A real macromolecule contains bonds with xed valence angles, as shown in Figure 14.2(a) for PE. However, as one moves along an instantaneous snapshot of a

14.1 Introduction

Fig. 14.2.

Schematic representations of an isolated polyethylene chain at two length scales.

typical macromolecular chain, taking any bond as a starting point, the correlation
between the direction of the skeletal bonds and that of the starting bond decreases
rapidly. Thus, taken as a whole, a linear molecule resembles a long, exible piece
of string, as shown in Figure 14.2(b). It may therefore be modeled as a sequence of
N freely jointed bonds of length b, in which there is no correlation between the
vector corresponding to the nth bond, rn , and rn1 . The end-to-end vector R that
links one extremity of the chain to the other is then given by Eq. (1).

N
X

rn

n1

The magnitude of R in an unconstrained chain is uncorrelated with its direction,


so that its value averaged over a large number of arbitrarily chosen conformations
must be zero. Because thermal motion causes a real chain to change its local conformation every few picoseconds, for more familiar time scales it would therefore
be perceived as a fuzzy ball with hRi 0 and a time-averaged mean square endto-end distance given by Eq. (2) (rn and rm are uncorrelated so that hrn  rm i must
vanish for n 0 m).

hR2 i

N X
N
X
n1 m1

hrn  rm i

N
X

hrn2 i Nb 2

n1

For a real macromolecule, the value of b characteristic of the equivalent freely


jointed chain is greater than the mean length of the skeletal bonds, lo , owing not
only to xed valence angles but also to the presence of rigid units and steric hindrance to rotation about single bonds. If Nl is the number of skeletal bonds in the
chain, hR2 i Cy Nl lo2 , where the constant Cy is the Flory characteristic ratio,
also called the chain stiness [1, 2]. It is of the order of 10 in exible polymers
(7.3 in PE and 9.6 in aPS, for example [3]), but may be much higher for more rigid
architectures such as para-linked benzene rings. Cy provides the link between

723

724

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

molecular architecture and general models for macroscopic physical properties


governed by chain statistics, often expressed in terms of b Cy Nl lo2 /Rmax , where
R max is the maximum end-to-end distance of the chain (which depends on both lo
and the bond angles).
In the limit of large N, the freely jointed chain model implies the probability
density PR; N for a given R to be a Gaussian distribution [Eq. (3)], whence
the frequent use of the term Gaussian chain to refer to idealized exible linear
macromolecules [4].

PR; N

3
2pNb 2

3/2



3R2
exp 
2Nb 2

This result is a simplication in that it does not take into account long-range interactions and solvent eects, for example. It nevertheless provides a working description of conformations in solid and molten polymers, and hence forms the basis for
a wide range of theoretical models in polymer physics and mechanics, some of
which will be discussed in what follows.

14.2

Elasticity
14.2.1

Deformation of an Elastic Solid

The stress state associated with an elemental cube may be dened in terms of the
six independent quantities in Eq. (4), where the rst subscript refers to the direction of the normal to the plane on which the stress acts and the second subscript
refers to the direction of the stress (at equilibrium the net torque is zero so that
sij sji ).
2

sxx

6
sij 4 sxy
sxz

sxy

sxz

syy

syz 7
5

syz

szz

The deformation may likewise be dened in terms of the components of engineering strain [Eq. (5)].
2

exx

6
eij 4 exy
exz

exy

exz

eyy

eyz 7
5

eyz

ezz

The generalized form of Hookes law, which proposes a linear relationship between
stress and strain at vanishingly small strains, is then given by Eq. (6).

14.2 Elasticity

eij Eijkl skl

In an isotropic solid, there is no coupling between tensile and shear stresses, and
Hookes law takes the familiar form of Eq. (7), where n is Poissons ratio and G is
the shear modulus.
exx

1
n
sxx  syy szz ;
E
E

2exy 1 g

1
sxy
G

Moreover, it is easily shown that Eq. (8) holds, so that a complete description of the
small strain response requires only two independent parameters.
G

E
21 n

Similarly, the bulk (compression) modulus, K, is given by Eq. (9).


K

E
31  2n

It is implicit in such descriptions of small-strain elasticity that the stress is unaected by the deformation, which justies the assumption of linearity. For the
large deformations associated with rubber elasticity and shear yielding in glassy
and semicrystalline polymers, however, this is no longer valid, and it is more usual
to express deformations in terms of the deformation ratios, l, such that the point
x; y; z is transformed to l1 x; l 2 y; l3 z. If the coordinate system is dened with
respect to the deformed system, it is always possible to choose the axes so that
they are not rotated by the deformation. The shear components of the deformation
are then equal to zero, which permits considerable simplication. For example, the
incremental work per unit volume of undeformed material is given by Eq. (10),
where the fi are the applied forces along the axes of a unit cube of undeformed
material [5].
dw f1 dl1 f2 dl 2 f3 dl3

10

14.2.2

Thermodynamics of Rubber Elasticity

Perhaps the most striking dierence between rubbers and other materials is their
capacity for large reversible or nearly reversible deformations at their service temperature, and it is this aspect of their behavior that will be described here. The
commercial exploitation of natural rubber developed rapidly with the discovery
that crosslinking greatly improves its mechanical properties, giving the rst of
what is now a broad class of materials often referred to as elastomers. Elasto-

725

726

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

mers are characterized by exible chains, Tg well below room temperature, little or
no crystallinity in the undeformed state, and light chemical or physical crosslinking (through the presence of rigid glassy or crystalline microdomains, for example).
Although E drops signicantly as T is raised above Tg , K changes relatively little,
so that K g E and, from Eq. (9), n A 0:5. Volume changes may hence be considered
negligible compared with other types of deformation. This justies the use of the
Helmholtz free energy in the thermodynamic analysis of rubber elasticity, dened
by Eq. (11).
A U  TS

11

where U is the internal energy and S is the entropy. For a reversible change of
state, the rst law of thermodynamics gives Eq. (12), where dW is the work carried
out on the system and dQ is the heat transfer into the system, leading to Eq. (13).
dU dQ dW TdS dW

12

dA dU  TdS  SdT dW  SdT

13

The work done when a specimen subject to a force f undergoes an incremental


elongation dl is dW fdl. The corresponding change in free energy is given by
Eq. (14), from which Eq. (15) follow.
dA fdl  SdT
 
 
qA
qA
; S
f
ql T
qT l

14
15

From the identity of Eq. (16), one obtains Eq. (17), and hence Eq. (18).
 
 
q qA
q qA

qT ql T ql qT l
 
 
qf
qS

qT l
ql T
 
 
 
 
 
qA
qU
qS
qU
qf
f

T

T
ql T
ql T
ql T
ql T
qT l

16

17

18

Measurements of f T at large xed deformations, such as shown in Figure 14.3,


indicate that f T A CT for T > Tg , where C is a constant. The second term in Eq.
(18) therefore dominates under these conditions and the response is almost entirely entropic [4, 6]. (The increase in f with decreasing T below Tg is due to thermal contraction.)

14.2 Elasticity

Fig. 14.3. Tensile stress at constant extension (350%) as a


function of T in a crosslinked rubber (after Ref. 2).

Another characteristic of elastomers is that their temperature increases during


rapid deformation, for which dQ A 0. In this case, one can show that Eq. (19) applies, where Cl is the specic heat at xed l.
 
 
qT
T qf

ql S Cl qT l

19

Given that qf /qTl > 0 (Figure 14.3), T must indeed increase with l. It may also
be shown that the length of an elastomer subject to a constant force should decrease
as T is increased, which is again consistent with observation, albeit somewhat
counterintuitive, given that crystalline and glassy solids tend to become less rigid
on heating [4].
14.2.3

Statistical Mechanical Approach to Rubber Elasticity

The entropy changes that give rise to rubber elasticity may be modeled in terms of
the chain statistics introduced in Section 14.1.2. For a chain whose end-to-end vector is xed and equal to R, the number of conformations, WR, that the chain can
adopt is proportional to PR; N. From Eq. (3), one thus obtains Eq. (20), where k is
Boltzmanns constant and So is a constant.

727

728

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

S So k ln W So 

3kR2
2Nb 2

20

Hence, for constant U, the free energy is obtained from Eq. (21).
A TS A o  Tk ln W A o

3kTR2
2Nb 2

21

The magnitude of the restoring force on a chain with end-to-end vector R is therefore given by Eq. (22).
f

qA 3kTR

qR
Nb 2

22

The total free energy change when a large deformation is applied to the chain, so
that R x; y; z changes to RO l1 x; l 2 y; l3 z, is given by Eq. (23).
DA TDS

3kTRO 2  R2 3kTl12  1x 2 l 22  1y 2 l32  1z 2

2Nb 2
2Nb 2

23

In an elastomer the forces are transferred to individual chains through the crosslinks, which constitute the nodes of a continuous network. If the chains linking
these nodes are assumed to be freely jointed chains composed of N links of length
b, Eq. (2) implies the spatial separation of the nodes, R, to be given by Eq. (24) in
the undeformed state.
hR2 i hx 2 i h y 2 i hz 2 i Nb 2

24

Because R has no preferred direction, Eq. (25) holds.


hx 2 i h y 2 i hz 2 i

Nb 2
:
3

25

If there are nx chains per unit volume, then assuming ane deformation of the
nodes (so that they move as if xed to a uniform elastic background), it follows
from Eq. (23) that the total change in the free energy per unit volume, a, for a deformation l1 ; l 2 ; l3 is given by Eq. (26).
Da

nx kTl12 l 22 l32  3
2

26

From the incompressibility criterion, l1 l 2 l3 1. Hence, for a uniaxial extension


along x, that is l1 l, l 2 l3 l1/2 , Eq. (27) applies and, from Eq. (10), the

14.3 Viscoelasticity

force f1 acting on a unit cube of undeformed material (equivalent to the nominal


or engineering stress) is given by Eq. (28).


nx kT 2 2
Da
l 3
2
l
f1



qw qDa
1

nx kT l  2
ql
ql
l

27

28

This remarkable result implies that the deformation behavior depends only on the
number of network chains per unit volume and on T. The detailed chemistry of
the chain is therefore unimportant, with the proviso that the chains must be
much longer than the statistical segment length b. For very small deformations,
l 1 exx , and sxx is given by Eq. (29).
sxx A f1 A 3nx kTexx

29

Given that n A 0:5 and hence that E 3G [Eq. (9)], Eq. (30) follows.
G nx kT

30

There are many shortcomings with this simple treatment, and, as illustrated
in Figure 14.4, the behavior of real elastomers deviates markedly from Eq. (28),
particularly at large l. A particular diculty with Eq. (3) is that it predicts nite
probabilities for jRj > R max, which is clearly unphysical. To account for the nite
extensibility of the chains, and hence for the observed work hardening, it is necessary to chose more realistic expressions for PR; N, such as the inverse Langevin
function or the associated analytical approximations [4]. Moreover, in the case of
relatively sti chains such as DNA or certain polypeptides, the worm-like chain
model of Porod and Krattky may be more appropriate than the Gaussian chain.
Even if the chain statistics are correctly described, non-ane deformation of the
network junctions, long-range inter- and intra-chain interactions (entanglement),
specic interactions such as hydrogen bonding, strain-induced crystallization (observed in natural rubber, for example), the presence of llers, and so forth may
need to be taken into account in real rubbers and elastomers [79].

14.3

Viscoelasticity
14.3.1

Linear Viscoelasticity

The discussion has so far implicitly been limited to behavior in the rubbery plateau
regime in Figure 14.1, where the conditions for rubber elasticity in amorphous

729

730

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Fig. 14.4. Experimental stressextension ratio curve for natural


rubber along with a best t of the predicted behavior for
network described by the inverse Langevin function, and of
Gaussian network [Eq. (28)] with the same network parameters
(after Ref. 7).

polymers are met, namely long exible chains, weak intermolecular forces
T > Tg and anchoring of the chains to form a network (the nature of this anchoring in uncrosslinked polymers will be discussed in Section 14.3.3). The corresponding constitutive expressions [Eq. (28), for example] predict the response to
deformation to depend weakly on T and to be independent of the deformation
rate. Although this is reasonably consistent with experiment, the situation changes
drastically near Tg, for example, where time, t, becomes a very important factor,
and the mechanical behavior is said to be strongly viscoelastic.
In a linear viscoelastic material, the moduli and compliances Et; Gt; Dt, and
Jt (tensile and shear modulus and tensile and shear compliance respectively) are
functions of t, although they remain independent of stress or strain. Development
of constitutive equations for such materials is generally based on the idea that the
eects of small increases in stress or strain are additive, which is known as the
Boltzmann superposition principle [4, 10, 11]. A strain et may be considered to
result from a sum of step strains applied at time u and maintained for a time
t  u [Eq. (31)].
deu

deu
du
du

31

14.3 Viscoelasticity

In uniaxial tension, the Boltzmann superposition principle implies Eq. (32).


st

Et  u

y

de
du
du

32

Similarly, for a given stress history, Eq. (33) results.


et

Dt  u

y

ds
du
du

33

Linear viscoelastic materials thus retain a memory of their entire mechanical history although, conveniently for the experimentalist, the memory fades with t  u,
and for practical purposes the lower limit of integration in Eqs. (32) and (33) is
often set to zero. Equations (32) and (33) may be used to calculate the response to
an arbitrary deformation using Et or Dt determined from simple static experiments (creep or relaxation).
Another important class of experiments involves periodic tensile or shear strains
of the type et eo cos ot Reeo e iot . In a linear elastic solid deformed in tension, s oscillates in phase with e with amplitude Eeo . In a linear viscous liquid,
s hde/dt and hence varies as heo o sin ot heo o cosot p/2. In a linear viscoelastic material, however, intermediate behavior is observed [Eqs. (34), where
0 < d < p/2].
et eo cos ot

34

st so cosot d
It is hence possible to dene two dynamic moduli, the storage modulus, E 0 (or G 0,
in the case of a shear experiment), which gives the stress component in phase with
the strain, and the loss modulus, E 00 (or G 00 ), which gives the stress component out
of phase with the strain. Thus, in tension, Eqs. (35) is obtained, where E 0 ; E 00 , and
tan d are given by Eq. (36).
st so cosot d E 0 eo cos ot E 00 eo sin ot
E0

so
cos d;
eo

E 00

so
sin d;
eo

tan d

E 00
E0

35
36

Equation (35) is sometimes more conveniently expressed in complex notation as


Eq. (37), where the complex modulus E  is dened by Eq. (38).
st Reso e iotd ReE  eo e iot
E

so
cos d i sin d
eo

37
38

731

732

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Fig. 14.5.

The Zener model (or standard linear solid).

Viscoelastic materials are often modeled using linear combinations of xed


Hookean and Newtonian elements (springs and dashpots). Although such models
may not fully account for the complexity of real materials, generalizations of this
approach have been extensively developed and methods and approximations for
transforming between the dierent viscoelastic functions are widely available in
the literature [10, 11]. For the sake of illustration, one simple example will be considered here, namely the Zener element, a possible representation of which is
shown in Figure 14.5. At very high frequencies most of the deformation in a Zener
element is taken up by spring 1 and the limiting modulus Eo is equal to E1 . At very
low frequencies, where the stress in the dashpot becomes negligible, the deformation is taken up by spring 1 and spring 2 in series, and the limiting modulus
Ey E1 E2 /E1 E2 . However, at intermediate frequencies, the behavior becomes
strongly inuenced by h [Eqs. (39), where DE Eo  Ey and the relaxation time is
given by Eq. (40)].
E  Eo  DE
th

DE
Eo2

1  iot
;
1 o2t2

tan d

DEot
Ey Eo o 2 t 2

39
40

The behavior predicted by Eqs. (39) for values of E1 and E2 appropriate to the glass
transition in an amorphous polymer (compare Figure 14.1) is shown in Figure
14.6. The model accounts for the qualitative features of experimentally observed
transitions, namely a step-like drop in modulus as o decreases below t1, and
a characteristic peak in tan d. However, more complex models involving many
relaxation times, that is, a discrete or continuous relaxation time spectrum, are
necessary if more quantitative agreement with experiment is to be obtained (for
an example of a discrete relaxation time spectrum derived from a molecular model,
see Section 14.3.3) [10, 11].

14.3 Viscoelasticity

Fig. 14.6. Predictions of the Zener model for the dynamic


behavior in the vicinity of a transition (E1 2  10 9 Pa,
E2 10 6 Pa, t 0:05 s).

Similar behavior to that in Figure 14.6 is observed if the viscoelastic functions


are measured as a function of T at xed o, because the viscous response, which
tends to dominate the relaxation times, is a strongly decreasing function of increasing T, particularly close to Tg . The eect of increasing T is therefore equivalent to
that of decreasing o (or increasing t in a static experiment). Thus, in dynamic torsion temperature sweeps on poly(methyl methacrylate) (PMMA), the glass transition at about 120 C is associated with a clear peak in tan dT. As shown in Figure
14.7, other transitions may also be observed at T well below Tg in this type of experiment. These secondary relaxations are important features of both glassy and
semicrystalline polymers because they show that molecular motions are not entirely suppressed at T < Tg . Indeed, such motions play an important role in plasticity (see Section 14.4.1). Conventionally, the rst relaxation encountered as T decreases is labeled a, and may correspond to either the melting/crystallization
transition (for semicrystalline polymers) or the glass transition. The secondary relaxations are designated b; g, and so on, in order of their appearance as T decreases
further (see Figure 14.7). They may often be assigned to specic types of molecular
motion, such as side-group motions or cooperative motion of several main-chain
units, and often show an Arrhenius T dependence. Activation of side-group motions typically requires more energy than main-chain motions. Thus the mainchain relaxation in bisphenol-A polycarbonate (PC) occurs at about 80 C, which
is about 230 K below Tg (150 C), whereas relaxation of the aromatic side groups in
aPS is observed at 50 C, which is only 50 K below Tg (100 C) [5].

733

734

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Fig. 14.7. Dynamic behavior as a function of T of poly(methyl


methacrylate) (PMMA) tested in torsion at 10 Hz.

14.3.2

TimeTemperature Superposition

The idea of timetemperature equivalence introduced in Section 14.3.1 is of considerable practical importance because one would often like to predict the longterm response of materials on the basis of experiments carried out on a laboratory
time scale. This is to some extent possible in polymers, for which it has been
widely veried that viscoelastic functions determined at dierent T over a xed
range of o or t, slightly adjusted to take into account the eect of T and density r
on the elastic response [through Eq. (30)], superpose if the o or t scale is multiplied by a shift factor, aT T; Tr , where Tr is some convenient reference temperature. A typical master curve obtained in this way is shown in Figure 14.8 for stress
relaxation data from polyisobutene, taking Tr 66:5 C. The eect is to expand
the t or o scale of the measurement carried out at Tr , revealing the whole of the a
transition in this case.
Williams, Landel, and Ferry (WLF) observed that if Tr is set to Tg , the variation of
log aT with T  Tr is similar for a wide variety of polymers [10]. They rationalized
this in terms of the molecular response, starting with Doolittles equation [Eq. (41)]
for the viscosity, where A and B are constants. fv is the fractional free volume,
equivalent to the unoccupied volume divided by the total volume of the polymer
(the occupied volume includes that necessary to accommodate thermal vibrations).
ln h ln A

B
fv

41

14.3 Viscoelasticity

Fig. 14.8. Stress relaxation data for polyisobutene at dierent


temperatures T, as indicated and superposed onto the data for
66.5 C by shifting along the logt axis (after Ref. 7).

Equation (41) is based on the idea that the greater fv, the greater the molecular mobility (owing to reduced crowding), and the lower h. For T > Tg , fv is given by Eq.
(42), where af is the coecient of thermal expansion of the fractional free volume
and fg is the fractional free volume associated with the glass transition.
fv A fg af T  Tg

42

If the T dependence of all the relaxation times is assumed to be that of h in Eq.


(41), the shift factor for the scaled viscoelastic functions is given by Eq. (43), and
hence Eq. (44) follows.
aT

hT
hTg

B
T  Tg
g
2:303fg
C T  Tg
log aT 
1 g1
fg
C2 T  Tg
T  Tg
af

43

44

735

736

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Equation (44) is the well-known WLF equation. Universal values of the various
g
g
physical parameters in Eq. (44) lead to C1 17:44 and C2 51:26 K [10]. These
g
g
are of the same order of magnitude as C1 and C2 obtained empirically (34 and
80 K for PMMA, for example), and indeed, timetemperature superposition has
been found to work well for a wide range of single-phase polymers, with the proviso that it begins to break down for the relatively fast vibrational modes characteristic of the glassy state [12]. Moreover, although superposition may work for
T g Tg , at temperatures above about Tg 50 K the shift factors tend to show an
Arrhenius dependence rather than following the WLF equation.
14.3.3

Molecular Models for Polymer Dynamics

The starting point for molecular models for polymer dynamics based on the ideas
introduced in Section 14.2.3 is the Rouse model for an isolated chain in a viscous
medium, in which the chain is taken to behave as a sequence of m beads linked
by Gaussian springs [Figure 14.9(a)] [1316]. The chain interacts with the solvent
via the beads, and the solvent is assumed to drain freely as the chain moves.
Hence, Eq. (22) leads to Eqs. (45), where N 0 is the number of links between adjacent beads, z is a friction coecient per bead and ri is the position of the ith bead.
z

dri 3kT

2ri  rix  ri1 0


dt N 0 b 2

45

Rouse solved the m  1 simultaneous equations [Eqs. (45)] by transforming them


into a set of uncoupled equations for the normal modes of motion of the chain.

Fig. 14.9. (a) The beadspring model for the dynamics of an


isolated chain in solution; (b) sketch of the second to fourth
normal modes of motion (the circles represent xed nodes and
the arrows indicate coherent motion of the sub-chains dened
by the nodes).

14.3 Viscoelasticity

The moduli of a dilute solution containing n chains per unit volume may then be
expressed in terms of a discrete relaxation time spectrum, where each relaxation
time corresponds to one of the normal modes of motion [Figure 14.9(b)]. For simple shear, this leads to Eqs. (46) and (47), with tp given by Eq. (48) [1316].

Gt nkT

m
X

et/tp

46

p1

G  o nkT

m
X
p1

o 2 tp2
1

o2t



tp N 0 b 2 z 24kT sin 2

inkT
2

pp
2m 1

m
X

otp
1 o 2 tp2
p1

47

1
;

p 1; 2 . . . ; m

48

Because the length of chain corresponding to each Gaussian spring is the shortest
unit that can relax in the model, these expressions are only physically meaningful
for m g 1. In this limit, Eq. (48) may be replaced by Eq. (49), where zo z/N 0 is a
monomeric friction coecient and N mN 0 is the total number of statistical
segments per chain.
tp A

N 02 m 2 b 2 zo
N 2b2z
2 2 o
2
2
6p p kT
6p p kT

49

Hence, the longest Rouse relaxation time, tR , is proportional to N 2 . For t > tR ,


the motion of the chain becomes essentially diusive, and the diusion constant of
the center of gravity of the chains is given by the Einstein relation, Eq. (50).
DR

kT
Nzo

50

Rouse-like behavior is not in fact observed in dilute solutions, for which it is necessary to take into account the inuence of the chain on the motion of the solvent,
and deviations from Gaussian statistics arising from polymersolvent interactions
[17, 18]. These factors are incorporated in the Zimm model, which predicts the diffusion constant to be proportional to N n , for example, where n depends on the solvent quality, in better agreement with experimental data [4, 14]. Indeed, although it
was rst proposed for isolated chains, the Rouse model turns out to be more appropriate to polymer melts, where exible linear chain conformations are approximately Gaussian and hydrodynamic interactions are relatively unimportant [4, 14
16].
The Rouse model is nevertheless inadequate to describe the high-frequency response associated with bond rotations and local cooperative motions, important
for the glassy state (see, for example, Ref. 4). Moreover, as the chain length increases (or the concentration increases in a solution of long chains), the fact that

737

738

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Fig. 14.10.

(a) Schematic representation of entanglement constraints; (b) the tube model.

chains cannot cross one another leads to additional constraints on chain motion,
known as entanglement, which remain eective at T > Tg . Figure 14.10(a) shows
the origin of these constraints schematically for an arbitrary chain in a polymer
melt. The dots correspond to the nearest neighbors of the chain, which are assumed for the sake of illustration to intersect the plane of the drawing. Because
the chain cannot cross its neighbors, it cannot move very far in directions perpendicular to its local trajectory. Diusion is therefore limited to snake-like motion of
the chain along its own contour, called reptation [14, 18]. A convenient way of
representing this eect in three dimensions is to assume the chain to be trapped
in a tube with a primitive path length L, as shown in Figure 14.10(b), so that only
motion within or along the tube is possible. For an undeformed Gaussian chain,
the tube is also Gaussian, with an end-to-end vector R. The primitive path may
thus be represented by NL statistical segments of length a, such that L NL a and
hR2 i NL a 2 La. Because hR2 i must also equal Nb 2 , Eq. (51) follows.
L Nb 2 /a

51

The tube model forms the basis for detailed theoretical approaches to the dynamics
of an entangled polymer melt pioneered by Doi and Edwards [13, 14]. The present
discussion will be restricted to a simple description of some of its basic features.
Consider, for example, the relaxation behavior of a chain subjected to a step shear
strain at t 0. As shown in Figure 14.11, the applied strain results in a deformation of the tube, and hence of the chain trapped inside it. The rst relaxation occurs within the tube at times t < te , where te is the Rouse relaxation time for a
chain with Ne a/b 2 statistical segments, and hence a mean square end-to-end
distance equal to a 2 . At t > te , the constraints due to the tube begin to dominate
and the only way the stress can relax further relax is for the chain to escape
the deformed tube and re-establish a random (unperturbed) conformation. As
sketched in Figure 14.11, it achieves this through Brownian motion backward and

14.3 Viscoelasticity

Fig. 14.11. Relaxation according to the tube model (small


strain limit): (a) Rouse relaxation; (b) rubbery plateau; (c) to
(d) reptation.

forward along the tube. The time necessary for the chain to diuse a distance L
and hence relax fully is tD L 2 /DR , where DR is given by Eq. (50). Hence, Eq.
(52) is obtained from Eq. (51).
tD

N 3 b 4 zo 6p 2 N 3

te
a 2 kT
Ne3

52

Because tD , which is known as the reptation time, is signicantly longer than


te for large N, in Figure 14.11 there is an intermediate regime of roughly timeindependent behavior, which is identied with the rubbery plateau. Thus, entanglement may be considered to play an equivalent role in this regime to the chemical crosslinks in an elastomer. The greater N, that is, the higher M, the greater the
extent of the rubbery plateau (compare Figure 14.1).
By analogy with an elastomer [Eq. (30)], the small strain rubbery plateau modulus may be set equal to Ge ne kT, where ne is the entanglement density, assumed to play an equivalent role to nx in an elastomer. Ge may therefore be
expressed in terms of an entanglement molar mass, Me , according to Eq. (53),
where NA is Avogadros number.
Ge

rNA kT
Me

53

In terms of the tube model, Me is interpreted as the mass that corresponds to Ne


statistical segments. Values of ne and Me deduced from Ge are found to vary widely

739

740

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

according to chemical structure; ne A 4  10 25 m3 in aPS, which has relatively


bulky chains, but is nearly an order of magnitude higher in PC, which has compact, relatively rigid chains [19].
The network and tube models both imply entanglement to be ineective for
M < 2Me , so that Mc , the critical mass introduced in Section 14.1.1, may be taken
to equal 2Me . As well as dening the threshold of rubber-like behavior above Tg ,
Mc marks the transition from a regime in which the melt viscosity h m M (Rouse
dynamics), to a regime in which h m M 3:4 , characteristic of an entangled melt. The
original theory of Doi and Edwards predicts h m M 3 , but better agreement with experiment has since been obtained by incorporating the eects of primitive path
uctuations and constraint release (if all the chains reptate simultaneously, the
constraints in Figure 14.10(a) cannot be considered strictly permanent for times
of the order of tD ) [4, 5, 14]. Even so, in the limit of very long monodisperse
chains, for which the tube eectively remains xed, or free chains trapped in a
crosslinked network, the M 3 dependence is recovered. A strong dependence of the
viscosity on M is a general feature of entangled polymers and is of great practical
importance, because the choice of M in applications is often dictated by the need to
reach a compromise between fracture resistance, which tends to improve with M
(see Section 14.4.4) and melt processing, which is facilitated by low viscosities.
14.3.4

Nonlinear Viscoelasticity

Although it is a powerful means of investigating molecular structure and of basic


characterization, and provides a general indication of the inuence of M on ow
behavior, the restrictions imposed by linear viscoelasticity make it inapplicable to
a wide variety of practical problems. Nonlinearity is often associated with the phenomenon of shear thinning, that is, a reduction of the viscosity with shear rate in
steady ow, characteristic of many polymer melts at intermediate shear rates [15].
This contrasts with the Newtonian behavior implied by the Boltzman superposition principle for steady ow [Eq. (54), in a liquid, Gs must vanish as s ! y].

st

Gt  ug_ du g_

y

Gs ds g_ h

54

Newtonian regimes are nevertheless widely observed in polymer melts in the high
and low shear rate limits, where the viscosities are designated by hy and ho respectively. This is reected by the empirical expressions widely used in engineering
practice to describe the response to steady shear ow, an example being the Cross
model [Eq. (55)], which reduces to the well known power law of Eq. (56) when
hy g h g ho , with n 1/m 1 between 10 and 20 for most polymer melts.
ho  h
K g_ m
h  hy

55

14.4 Yield and Fracture

 1/n
s
g_

so
g_o

56

However, these simple empirical expressions are far from universal, and fail to account for eects specic to nonlinear behavior, such as the appearance of nite
rst and second normal stress dierences sxx  syy N1 g_ and syy  szz N2 g_
in steady shear ow. (For a linear viscoelastic material in shear, sxx ; syy and szz are
equal to the applied pressure, usually atmospheric pressure.) These may be linked
to the development of molecular anisotropy in polymer melts subject to ow, and
are responsible for the Weissenberg eect, which refers to the tendency for a nonlinear viscoelastic uid to climb a rotating rod inserted into it, as well as practically important phenomena such as die swell [20].
There has been considerable eort to develop phenomenological models for nonlinear viscoelasticity that provide a comprehensive description of such phenomena
by extending the formalism of linear viscoelasticity to include situations where the
viscoelastic functions can no longer be considered independent of stress or strain
[21]. These are exemplied by the K-BKZ (Kaye-Bernstein, Kearsley, and Zapas)
formalism, which includes a damping function in order to account for the acceleration of the relaxation rate at large deformations. The popularity of the K-BLZ
approach is partly linked to the fact that the DoiEdwards tube model, with the
so-called independent alignment approximation, leads to expressions of the
same form when generalized to large deformations, providing a molecular basis
for its interpretation (in terms of the tube model, a large deformation will signicantly increase L, giving rise to a supplementary relaxation process called chain
retraction on a time scale tR , during which L returns to its equilibrium value
[13, 14]). Phenomenological models, as well as expressions derived from the generalized DoiEdwards approach are able to account for many of the observed features
of polymer melts, and, although they are cumbersome, numerical techniques are
now powerful enough to permit their incorporation into complex ow simulations
of direct relevance to industrial practice.

14.4

Yield and Fracture


14.4.1

Yield in Polymers

The stresses and strains of practical importance for polymers at T < Tg or Tm are
often relatively large, and, unlike the small strains referred to in the preliminary
discussion of the glassy state in Section 14.1.1, they may result in signicant plastic deformation, in that the associated changes in specimen morphology are not
recovered after stress release over laboratory time scales. A plastically deformed
polymer with suciently high M is nevertheless able to return to its initial shape

741

742

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

when heated above Tg or Tm, so that such deformation cannot strictly be considered irreversible.
As the extent of plastic deformation increases with the overall deformation, pronounced softening occurs, even when adiabatic heating eects are negligible (as
will be assumed here). If fracture does not intervene, the force, f , on a specimen
tested at constant speed in tension typically reaches a local maximum at a strain of
a few percent, which is taken to correspond to a plastic yield stress, sy (typically
between 20 and 100 MPa in unoriented polymers). The subsequent yield drop is
at least partly geometric in origin, although many glassy polymers also show an intrinsic yield drop [5]. The true stress on the polymer is given by s A1
o lf , where
A o is the initial cross-sectional area of the specimen, so that Eq. (57) holds.


df
1 ds s
Ao
 2
dl
l dl l

57

Given that ds/dl is a decreasing function of l in the initial stages of deformation,


as shown schematically in Figure 14.12, A1
o f s/l > ds/dl beyond a certain
value of l, and df /dl becomes negative. The resulting instability leads to localized
necking in a tensile test, but if deformation continues beyond the yield point, the
neck is stabilized by work hardening (df /dl becomes positive again) and propagates to the rest of the specimen at roughly constant f . Global work hardening
then takes place, followed by rupture.

Fig. 14.12. Schematic of (a) the intrinsic stress-deformation


curve of a polymer and (b) the force per unit area of an
undeformed specimen observed as a function of total
deformation in a tensile test.

14.4 Yield and Fracture

In an amorphous glassy polymer, work hardening is considered to correspond to


stretching of the entanglement network invoked to account for the rubbery plateau
above Tg (see Section 14.3.3). This explains the recoverability of the deformation
above Tg (in the absence of an applied force, the network retracts to its equilibrium
conformation) and it is borne out by the observed correlation between the value of
1/2
l in the neck and the maximum extensibility of the network, lmax A Ne . In semicrystalline polymers, the evolution of the crystalline texture may also contribute to
work hardening, because the resolved shear stress on activated slip systems tends
to decrease as deformation proceeds at constant stress, as will be discussed further
(see Section 14.4.3).
The large strain response in the glassy or semicrystalline state is that of a nonlinear viscoelastic solid. However, both engineering and theoretical approaches to
plasticity in polymers have largely developed as an independent discipline, in
which sy plays a central role, in spite of its somewhat arbitrary denition (indeed
it is not always possible to associate sy with a maximum in the forcedeformation
curve [5]). This is because in practice the yield point, rather than the ultimate
strength, is usually considered to be the failure criterion for ductile materials.
For yield to occur at all, the global stress state must contain a deviatory component, so that pure hydrostatic stress states do not result in plasticity in a uniform
specimen. Indeed, in many types of material, including metals, yield is usually
well described by the Von Mises criterion, in which it is considered to be independent of the hydrostatic pressure, p sxx syy szz /3. With an appropriate
frame of reference, any multiaxial stress state may be expressed as Eq. (58), where
s1 ; s2 , and s3 are the principal stresses (compare Section 14.2.1).
2

s1

6
s 4 0

s2

7
05
s3

58

The von Mises criterion is then Eq. (59).


s1  s2 2 s2  s3 2 s3  s1 2 b 2sy2

59

It may be veried that sy is equal to the tensile yield stress by setting any two of the
principle stresses to zero. For
p comparison, in pure shear, s1 s2 and s3 0, and
the yield stress is ty sy / 3. Moreover, it is easily seen that Eq. (59) is independent of p. In fact, most polymers do show a pressure-dependent yield stress, an observation that is attributed to their relative compressibility, so that a negative value
of p signicantly reduces the space available for the molecules and hence reduces
their mobility. However, this can usually be accounted for by replacing Eq. (59)
with Eq. (60), where S and m are materials constants [5].
s1  s2 2 s2  s3 2 s3  s1 2 S  mp

60

743

744

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

14.4.2

Models for Yield

The yield stress in disordered solids is strongly dependent on T and the deformation rate, and eorts have consequently been made to describe it in terms of a
ReeEyring activated rate process, in which a rheological element jumps from
place to place by overcoming local energy barriers [5, 22]. For an activation energy
Q, and an attempt frequency n0, the jump rate n n0 expQ/kT. In the absence
of an applied stress, the jumps are in arbitrary directions, and there is no net deformation. However, an applied stress, s, alters the eective energy barrier height
for forward () and backward () jumps with respect to the stress axis, so that Eqs.
(61) apply, where x is the displacement associated with each jump and A is the effective area of the rheological element.




no
Q  sAx
n
sAx
exp
exp 
kT
2
kT
2


n
sAx
n exp 
2
kT

61

The strain rate in the stress direction is proportional to the net jump rate n  n ,
leading to Eq. (62), where V xA typically corresponds to a few repeat units and is
interpreted as an activation volume.
 


 
v
sV
Q
sV
A e_O exp 
exp
e_ m sinh
2
kT
kT
kT

62

s is then taken to equal sy when Eq. (62) is satised for a given strain rate e_,
which implies sy m log e_. This simple approach, which may easily be modied
to include a pressure-dependent contribution to the activation energy, is often remarkably successful in predicting the strain rate dependence of sy , as shown in
Figure 14.13(a) for PC. However, as shown in Figure 14.13(b), the agreement
is more limited in polymers such as poly(vinyl chloride) (PVC). Because the Ree
Eyring model includes no assumptions regarding the nature of the rheological element, changes in the slope of sy versus log e_, such as those in Figure 14.13(b),
have been attributed to secondary relaxations in the corresponding range of T and
e_. As pointed out in Section 14.3.1, the main secondary relaxation in PC occurs at
80 C, but in PVC it is at about 50 C. This suggests that a complete description of
yield may need to involve multiple activated rate processes [23].
Among the better-known eorts to provide a more microscopic description of
yield within the general ReeEyring framework is the approach of Argon, based
on metallurgical models, in which the energy barrier is associated with the elastic
displacements necessary to accommodate the elementary shear processes [24].
Another well known, but somewhat dierent, approach is that of Robertson, who

14.4 Yield and Fracture

Fig. 14.13.

sy /T versu loge_ in (a) polycarbonate; (b) poly(vinyl chloride) (after Ref. 23).

postulated that yield takes place when the average polymer conformation is equivalent to that at the glass transition [25]. He adopted a simplied model for a polymer chain such that skeletal bonds adopt either a high- or a low-energy state with
an energy dierence DE. At equilibrium, the proportion of bonds in the highenergy state is given by the Boltzmann factor, so that for a polymer below its Tg .
Eq. (63) holds, assuming the conformations at Tg to be substantially frozen in on
vitrication.
w

expDE=kTg
1 expDE/kTg

63

745

746

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

The value of w in the presence of an applied stress, wdef , is estimated by assuming


the stress to modify the energy barrier to DE  sv cos a, where a is the local orientation of the bond with respect to the stress axis and v is the volume swept out during the transition from the low to high energy state. From the expression for wdef ,
obtained by averaging the eective energy barrier over all possible orientations, a
stress-dependent structure temperature, Y, may be dened through Eq. (64).
wdef

expDE/kY
1 expDE/kY

64

The WLF equation [Eq. (44)] may be used to calculate the viscosity as in Eq. (65),
where hg is viscosity at Tg .
"

C1 C2
Y
g
 C1
hy; T hg exp 2:303
g
Y  Tg C2 T

#!
65

The strain rate is then given by Eq. (66).


e_

s
hy; T

66

Robinsons model has met with some success in regimes of T close to Tg where
the role of intramolecular barriers is relatively important. However, for T well
below Tg, intermolecular barriers are expected to dominate, so that phenomenological or semi-phenomenological approaches of the ReeEyring type are arguably more appropriate to the observed T dependence, as borne out by Figure
14.13.
14.4.3

Semicrystalline Polymers

In amorphous polymers, plasticity is associated with deformation at T < Tg .


In semicrystalline polymers, however, there is a further regime Tg < T < Tm ,
in which the amorphous regions are in the rubbery state and hence no longer contribute directly to yield. Plasticity is therefore dominated by the intermolecular barriers that oppose chain slip in the crystalline regions. This is of considerable practical importance, given that commodity semicrystalline polymers such as PE and
isotactic polypropylene (iPP) are typically employed at T > Tg . Considerable eort
has therefore been made to describe yield in semicrystalline polymers in terms of
crystal plasticity theory. In isotropic polycrystalline materials, ve independent
crystal slip systems are generally necessary for global plasticity, but this requirement is relaxed in polymers owing to the presence of the amorphous phase. Indeed, yield in polymers is thought to involve a relatively limited number of slip sys-

14.4 Yield and Fracture

tems with slip planes parallel to the chain axes (slip in planes perpendicular to the
chain axes would require rupture of covalent bonds).
The classical approach of Young to yield in lamellar semicrystalline polymers is
based on the nucleation of dislocations by thermal uctuations [26]. The activation
energy is calculated from the shear strain energy for a screw dislocation of width u
[Eq. (67), where b is the magnitude of the Burgers vector (usually the repeat distance along the chain), ro is the size of the dislocation core (about 4b according to
computer simulations), G is the shear modulus, lc is the length of the dislocation
in the direction of the Burgers vector (taken to equal the lamellar thickness) and s
is the shear stress].
DU

  
Gb 2 lc
u
 sbul
ln
2p
ro

67

The activation energy for the formation of the dislocation, DU  , corresponds to the
maximum of DUu, which leads to Eqs. (68) and (69).
u

Gb
2ps

DU 

  

Gb 2 lc
u
ln
1
2p
ro

68
69

Given DU  , one can estimate the critical stress for the formation of a dislocation
sc . Usually, it is assumed that DU  A 50kT, which gives a sc comparable with experimentally determined values of the shear yield stress, ty . The main objection to
the dislocation model is that the predicted temperature dependence of the yield
stress is much weaker than that observed experimentally, particularly at higher T,
and more recent eorts to describe yield have been based on thermally activated
helical motions of polymer chains within their crystals, believed to be associated
with the a relaxation, but which may occur below Tm [27].
In an isotropic polycrystalline polymer whose microstructure consists of stacked
lamellae arranged in the form of spherolites, the slip systems activated depend on
the local orientation of the lamellae with respect to the applied stress and, as deformation proceeds, these orientations are modied. To calculate the evolution of the
crystalline texture, one can consider the polymer to behave as a crystalline aggregate. Although the entropic contribution of chain orientation in the amorphous regions may also need to be considered, the major contribution to work hardening in
tension is rotation of the slip planes toward the tensile axis, so that the resolved
shear stress in the slip direction diminishes. This results in a ber texture in the
limit of large deformations, such that the crystallites are oriented with their c axis
(the chain axis) parallel to the stretch direction. Despite the relative success of such
models, they do not explicitly address the micro-mechanisms involved in the transformation of the spherulitic texture into a ber texture. One possibility is that the

747

748

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

repeated shearing of lamellar fragments renders them thermodynamically unstable because of their small size. Models for the development of crystalline textures
during drawing, based on this idea, thus explain the establishment of a new lamellar long period in highly deformed regions, which depends only on the deformation T and not on the initial lamellar thickness [27].
14.4.4

Crazing and Fracture

Rather than undergo homogeneous (non-cavitational) ductile necking, glassy


amorphous polymers often show brittle behavior in tension, in that they fail
abruptly prior to yielding and hence at a relatively low strain. In uncrosslinked or
lightly crosslinked polymers, this phenomenon is usually associated with crazing
[28, 29]. As shown in Figure 14.14, crazes are crack-like defects spanned by highly
drawn brils with lateral spacings of the order of 10 nm and a constant draw ratio,
close to lmax , which implies that bril extension takes place by ductile drawing at
the crazebulk interface. The presence of the brils means that crazes are capable
of bearing loads normal to their faces. Indeed, the stress normal to the faces of an
isolated growing craze, sc (the bril drawing stress), is approximately equal to the
global applied stress along most of the craze length. Hence, isotropic bulk samples
deformed in uniaxial tension may contain a high density of crazes whose planes
are parallel and perpendicular to the tensile axis. Even so, plastic deformation associated with crazing remains highly localized and contributes relatively little to the
overall deformation. Given that crazes may act as preferential sites for crack initia-

Fig. 14.14. Craze microstructure in a thin lm of amorphous


polycarbonate deformed in tension at 100 C.

14.4 Yield and Fracture

tion, this accounts for their association with brittle macroscopic behavior as dened above. Crazing and ductile necking may nevertheless co-exist, depending on
the relative stability of the crazes with respect to crack initiation.
Empirical criteria for the formation of crazes in multiaxial stress states, analogous to the von Mises criterion for yield [Eq. (59)], are based on the observation
that crazing is absent in both compression and simple shear, which is reasonable
given that one would expect cavitation to be favored by large values of p. A critical
strain to craze, ec A B/p, is generally found to provide a reasonable description
of craze nucleation, so that in terms of the principal stresses the criterion is given
by Eq. (70), where A; B; C, and D are constants.
s1  ns2  ns3 C

D
s1 s2 s3

70

Given that highly triaxial stress states are unfavorable to yielding [compare Eq.
(59)], crazing tends to dominate in highly constrained geometries, such as notch
tips, or in the vicinity of local stress concentrations in bulk specimens. This is not
inconsistent with brillation by ductile drawing, because the void formation associated with crazing releases constraints on plastic deformation at the microscopic
level.
The very small size of craze brils means that their surface energy is expected to
play an important role in craze formation. Hence, although the large hydrostatic
stress gradients associated with closely separated voids favor bril drawing, they
are oset by stress gradients arising from the surface tension at the void tips, G.
In kinetic models for bril formation, the brils are therefore argued to adopt the
characteristic spacing Do that maximizes the overall stress gradient and hence the
rate of bril extension. It has been shown on this basis that the craze stress
sc m G 1/2 , for a xed deformation rate [28].
There is evidence that polymers with high entanglement densities, ne , craze less
readily than polymers with low ne. One possible explanation for this is in terms of
the creation of surface associated with brillation. For a xed entanglement network, the creation of free surface must involve chain scission, as shown in Figure
14.15. The higher ne, the more entanglements are lost during brillation, the
higher the energy cost in creating the brils and hence the higher sc. This may account for the ductility of amorphous, high ne engineering thermoplastics such as
PC, in which crazing tends to be suppressed in favor of homogeneous deformation
(sy is not directly dependent on ne ). It follows that highly crosslinked polymers, in
which the inuence of ne and nx may be considered additive, do not show crazing,
although their ductility, and hence their toughness, is limited by the limit extensibility of the network [28]. The competition between homogeneous deformation
and crazing is also likely to be strongly inuenced by secondary relaxations, so
that the relatively low b relaxation temperature of PC (see Section 14.4.2) may also
contribute to its ductility. Indeed, shifting the secondary relaxation to higher T by
chemical modication at constant ne has been found to lead to embrittlement in
PC [30]. Similarly, polymers that craze easily, such as aPS and PMMA, typically
have relatively high secondary relaxation temperatures.

749

750

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

Fig. 14.15. Schematic of craze widening at the crazebulk


interface, illustrating the geometrically necessary entanglement
loss.

The macroscopic property of immediate practical concern is often not so much


craze formation as fracture resistance. In a cracked specimen, stress is concentrated at the crack tip, and the local stress state depends on the crack length. For
small global deformations, it may be expressed in terms of a stress intensity factor,
K, given by Eq. (71), where a is the crack length and F is a dimensionless function
of the specimen geometry [31, 32].
p
K F pas

71

In many fracture mechanics-based approaches, crack advance is taken to occur


when K reaches some critical value K c (equivalent energy-based criteria are also
widely used). K c may then be measured using a pre-cracked specimen, in which a
and hence K are well dened. In some cases (PMMA, for example) crack advance
is observed to proceed via breakdown of a single craze at the crack tip. By modeling
a craze as an orthotropic linear elastic body it has been shown that K c is given by
Eq. (72), where n is Poissons ratio, a is related to the craze anisotropy, sc is the
draw stress normal to the craze-bulk interface, vf is the bril volume fraction in
the craze, and sf is the stress to break a craze bril [33].
1/4

Kc A a

1  vf E
1  n 2 sc

1/2

p
pDo sf

72

This approach incorporates the stress-concentrating eect of cross-tie brils, widely


observed in crazes in glassy polymers (compare Figure 14.14). In the absence of
any stress-concentrating eect, that is, for a ! 0, a time-independent bril failure
criterion sf implies crack advance can never occur, because the stress in a given
bril can never exceed sc . This result has been conrmed by more detailed micromechanical modeling, and is important in that it provides a direct link between the

14.4 Yield and Fracture

Fig. 14.16. Fibrillar deformation zone at a crack tip in a bulk


specimen of semicrystalline high-density polyethylene deformed
at room temperature (thin section stained with RuO4 ).

macroscopic fracture behavior and microscopic quantities, which can be estimated


by direct observation of craze microstructures. Although Eq. (72) is not strictly applicable to the more usual case of multiple crazing, or mixed crazing and shear at
the crack tip, the guiding principle remains valid and serves to underline the
importance of entanglement, not only for craze formation but also for ultimate
failure.
Bulk semicrystalline polymers deformed in tension also show considerable localized micro-necking at T between Tg and Tm , in the form of either crazes or
craze-like deformation zones, such as that shown in Figure 14.16. As with amorphous polymers, these are thought to have a strong inuence on the ultimate failure properties. Although the details of the lamellar structure may vary widely, qualitative models for micro-necking in melt-crystallized semicrystalline polymers
above Tg show many features in common. Deformation is usually assumed to initiate in interlamellar amorphous regions, which stretch and cavitate, so that cavity
sizes are commensurate with the lamellar separation. The intervening material
is then drawn down to form the mature brillar structure. Again, a high degree of
entanglement and strong anchoring of the chains by the lamellae (that is, high M)
are expected to promote toughness in semicrystalline polymers [5, 34, 35].
To improve the fracture resistance of polymers that craze readily, but which may
have other advantages, such as cheapness in the case of aPS, a common strategy is
to increase the density and extent of localized damage (crazing, for example) by
creating local stress concentrations [36]. The greater the extent of local damage,
the greater the energy dissipation during crack advance, and hence the greater the
crack resistance. The presence of rubber inclusions in a glassy or semicrystalline
matrix results in considerable local mismatch in stiness. This increases their
stress-concentrating eect and provides local concentrations in the von Mises
stress or the hydrostatic stress, which will favor shear and craze yielding respectively. Cavitation of the modier particles is also thought to be important in tough-

751

752

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

ening and may in some cases change the local stress state suciently to promote a
change in mechanism (for example, shear to craze transitions in glassy polymers).

14.5

Conclusion

The aim of this contribution has been to link the basic macroscopic phenomena
associated with polymers with the unique features of their structure, the most obvious being the presence of long, exible molecular chains. The important role of
the conformational entropy of exible chains, not only for rubber elasticity but for
polymer dynamics in general, has been demonstrated. Moreover, the concept of an
entanglement network, which underpins much of the theory of polymer dynamics
in the melt, has also been shown to have important repercussions for the high
strain behavior of solid polymers, namely plastic deformation, crazing, and fracture.

Notation

A
Ao
a
a
aT
b
b
Cl
g
C1
g
C2
Cy
D
Do
DR
E
E0
E 00
E
Eijkl
f
fg
fv
G
G0

Helmholtz free energy [J]


cross-sectional area of a tensile specimen [m2 ]
Helmholtz free energy per unit volume [J m3 ]
statistical segment length of the primitive path (tube model) [m]
WLF shift factor
equivalent bond length (Kuhn length) [m]
magnitude of Burgers vector [m]
specic heat at xed specimen length [J kg1 ]
WLF constant
WLF constant [K]
characteristic ratio
tensile compliance [Pa1 ]
craze bril spacing [m]
Rouse self-diusion coecient [m 2 s1 ]
Youngs (tensile) modulus [Pa]
tensile storage modulus [Pa]
tensile loss modulus [Pa]
complex tensile modulus [Pa]
stiness tensor [Pa]
force [N]
fractional free volume at Tg (dimensionless)
fractional free volume (dimensionless)
shear modulus [Pa]
shear storage modulus [Pa]

Notation

G 00
G
Ge
J
K
K
Kc
k
L
l
lc
lo
M
Mb
Mc
Me
m
N
N0

shear loss modulus [Pa]


complex shear modulus [Pa]
plateau modulus [Pa]
shear compliance [Pa1 ]
bulk modulus [Pa]
stress intensity factor [Pa m 1/2 ]
critical stress intensity for crack advance [Pa m 1/2 ]
Boltzmann constant 1:38066  1023 J K1
tube contour length (tube model) [m]
length [m]
lamellar thickness [m]
mean length of skeletal bonds in a real macromolecular chain [m]
molar mass [g mol1 ]
molar mass per statistical segment [g mol1 ]
critical molar mass [g mol1 ]
entanglement molar mass [kg mol1 ]
number of beads in Rouse model (dimensionless)
number of statistical segments in a freely jointed chain (dimensionless)
number of statistical segments between beads (Rouse model) (dimensionless)
number of skeletal bonds in a real macromolecular chain (dimensionNl
less)
rst normal stress dierence (dimensionless)
N1
NA
Avogadros number 6:022  10 23
Ne
number of statistical segments in a chain of molar mass Me (dimensionless)
number of statistical segments in the primitive path (tube model) (diNL
mensionless)
n
number of chains per unit volume [m3 ]
entanglement density [m3 ]
ne
number of crosslinks per unit volume [m3 ]
nx
PR; N probability distribution of R in a chain with N links
p
hydrostatic pressure [Pa]
Q
activation energy [J]
Q
heat transfer (into a thermodynamic system) [J]
R
end-to-end vector of a linear chain [m]
maximum end-to-end distance of a real macromolecule
R max
vector corresponding to the nth bond in a chain [m]
rn
dislocation core radius [m]
ro
S
entropy [J K1 ]
T
temperature [K,  C]
glass transition temperature [K,  C]
Tg
melting point [K,  C]
Tm
U
internal energy [J]
u
width of screw dislocation [m]

753

754

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

u
V
vf
W

critical screw dislocation width [m]


activation volume (Eyring model) [m3 ]
craze bril volume fraction (dimensionless)
work (done on a thermodynamic system) [J]

Greek
a
af
G
g
DE
DU
DU 
d
dc
ec
eij
eij
z
zo
h
ho
hg
hy
Y
l
m
n
n
n
n0
r
sc
sf
sij
sij
sy
t
tc
tD
tR
ty
WR

craze anisotropy factor


coecient of thermal expansion of fractional free volume [K1 ]
surface tension at craze void tips [N m1 ]
shear strain
energy dierence (Robertson model) [J]
shear strain energy of screw dislocation [J]
activation energy for screw dislocation [J]
phase angle
critical crack opening displacement [m]
strain to craze
engineering strain
components of the engineering strain
friction coecient [N s m1 ]
monomeric friction coecient [N s m1 ]
viscosity [N s]
zero shear viscosity [N s]
viscosity at Tg [N s]
limiting high shear rate viscosity [N s]
structure temperature (Robertson model) [K]
deformation ratio (dimensionless)
pressure coecient (stress-dependent von Mises criterion) (dimensionless)
jump rate (Eyring model) (dimensionless)
Poissons ratio (dimensionless)
scaling exponent (Zimm model) (dimensionless)
attempt frequency (Eyring model) (dimensionless)
density [kg m3 ]
craze bril draw stress [Pa]
stress to break a craze bril [Pa]
components of the engineering stress [Pa]
engineering stress [Pa]
tensile yield stress [Pa]
relaxation time [s]
critical stress for the formation of a screw dislocation [Pa]
reptation time [s]
Rouse relaxation time [s]
shear yield stress [Pa]
number of conformations at xed R (dimensionless)

References

angular frequency (dimensionless)


proportion of high energy states (Robertson model)

o
w

Acronyms
aPS
iPP
K-BKZ
PC
PE
PMMA
PVC
WLF

atactic polystyrene
isotactic polypropylene
Kaye-BernsteinKearsleyZapas
bisphenol A polycarbonate
polyethylene
poly(methyl methacrylate)
poly(vinyl chloride)
WilliamsLandelFerry

References
1 P. J. Flory, Statistical Mechanics of

6
7

10

11

Chain Molecules, John Wiley, New


York, 1969.
W. L. Mattice, U. W. Suter,
Conformational Theory of Long Chain
Molecules, John Wiley, New York, 1994.
L. J. Fetters, D. J. Lohse, W. W.
Graessley, J. Polym. Sci., Part B:
Polym. Phys., 1999, 37, 1023.
M. Rubenstein, R. H. Colby, Polymer
Physics, Oxford University Press,
Oxford, 2003.
I. M. Ward, D. W. Hadley, An Introduction to the Mechanical Properties of
Solid Polymers, John Wiley, New York,
1993.
U. W. Gedde, Polymer Physics,
Chapman and Hall, London, 1995.
L. R. G. Treolar, The Physics of
Rubber Elasticity, Clarendon Press,
Oxford, 1958.
J. E. Mark, B. Erman, Rubber-Like
Elasticity, a Molecular Primer, John
Wiley, New York, 1988.
B. Erman, J. E. Mark, Structures and
Properties of Rubberlike Networks,
Oxford University Press, Oxford, 1997.
J. D. Ferry, Viscoelastic Properties of
Polymers, 3rd ed., John Wiley, New
York, 1980.
N. W. Tschoegl, The Phenomenological
Theory of Linear Viscoelastic Behaviour,
Springer Verlag, Berlin, 1989.

12 K. L. Ngai, D. J. Plazek, in Physical

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

21

Properties of Polymers Handbook (J. E.


Mark, editor) AIP Press, Woodbury,
NY, 1996.
M. Doi, Introduction to Polymer
Physics, Oxford University Press,
Oxford, 1996.
M. Doi, S. F. Edwards, The Theory of
Polymer Dynamics, Oxford University
Press, Oxford, 1986.
R. G. Larsen, The Structure and
Rheology of Complex Fluids, Oxford
University Press, New York, 1998.
R. B. Bird, C. F. Curtiss, R. C.
Armstrong, O. Hassager, Dynamics
of Polymeric Liquids, Vol. 2, Kinetic
Theory, 2nd ed., John Wiley, New York,
1987.
J. des Cloizeaux, G. Jannink,
Polymers in Solution: Their Modelling
and Structure, Clarendon Press,
Oxford, 1990.
P. G. DeGennes, Scaling in Polymer
Physics, Cornell University Press,
Ithaca, 1979.
L. J. Fetters, D. J. Lohse, R. H.
Colby, in Physical Properties of Polymers Handbook (J. E. Mark, editor)
AIP Press, Woodbury, NY, 1996.
H. A. Barnes, J. F. Hutton, K.
Walters, An Introduction to Rheology,
Elsevier, Amsterdam, 1989.
R. G. Larson, Constitutive Equations

755

756

14 Polymer Mechanical Properties

22

23

24
25
26

27
28

for Polymer Melts and Solutions,


Butterworths, Boston, MA, 1988.
B. Crist, in Materials Science and
Technology, Vol. 12 (E. L. Thomas,
editor), VCH, New York, 1993.
J. C. Bauwens, C. Bauwens-Crowet,
G. Home`s, J. Polym. Sci. A2, 1969, 7,
735.
A. S. Argon, Phil. Mag., 1973, 28, 839.
R. E. Robertson, J. Chem. Phys., 1966,
44, 3950.
R. J. Young, Introduction to Polymers, Chapman and Hall, London,
1981.
A. Galeski, Prog. Polym. Sci., 2003, 28,
1643.
E. J. Kramer, Adv. Polym. Sci., 1983,
52, 1.

29 E. J. Kramer, L. L. Berger, Adv.

Polym. Sci., 1990, 91/92, 1.


30 L. P. Chen, A. F. Yee, E. J. Moskala,

Macromolecules, 1999, 32, 5944.


31 J. G. Williams, Fracture Mechanics of

32
33
34
35

36

Polymers, Ellis Horwood, Chichister,


1984.
H.-H. Kausch, Polymer Fracture,
Springer Verlag, Berlin, 1985.
H. R. Brown, Macromolecules, 1991,
24, 2752.
C. J. G. Plummer, H.-H. Kausch, J.
Macromol. Sci. Phys., 1996, B35, 637.
J. J. Benkoski, P. Flores, E. J.
Kramer, Macromolecules, 2003, 36,
3289.
C. B. Bucknall, Toughened Plastics,
Applied Science, London, 1977.

757

15

Polymer Degradation and Stabilization1


Tuan Quoc Nguyen

15.1

Introduction

Most synthetic plastics and natural polymers are principally constituted of the elements C, H, N, and O, all of which are primary components of organic molecules.
As with smaller organic molecules, these atoms are attached by relatively weak covalent bonds that are susceptible to chemical attack, particularly to oxidative degradation. During their potential lifetime, engineering plastics are exposed to diverse
environmental factors which can act alone or in combination to adversely aect the
initial material properties. These changes generally occur over several years, but
can be accelerated or retarded in the presence of internal and external elements
temperature, and temperature variations. Environmental factors that contribute to
degradation include mechanical stresses, temperature variations, humidity, sunlight, oxygen, atmospheric pollutants, and microbial enzymes. Depending on the
structural level at which material changes occur, it is usual to distinguish between
physical, physicochemical, and chemical degradation.


Physical degradation, commonly known as physical aging, results from changes


in the thermodynamic state of the system (temperature, pressure, molar volume)
during the daily use of the material. During processing, chains may be oriented
and the sample inhomogeneously cooled, resulting in internal stress. With time,
the chains have the opportunity to relax from their nonequilibrium conformations to a state of lower free energy. Partly immiscible blends, for instance, can
remain in a homogeneous metastable state for an extended period of time. The
presence of stress or heat can accelerate the phase separation process. The resultant changes in orientation, free volume, internal stress, crystalline content, and

1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.

Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes


Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

758

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

phase transitions are known globally as physical aging. In principle, physically


aged samples do not aect chemical structure and can be rejuvenated by proper
thermal treatment.
 Physicochemical degradation involves diusion of small to medium size molecules either from the polymer (plastier or other additives) or into the polymer
(water absorption, solvent, surface-active liquids), resulting in changes in polymer properties. Exudation of plastier and surface migration of additives followed by washing are among the common problems encountered in natural
weathering. In the presence of surface-active agents, environmental stress cracking can also develop. Although preserving the structural integrity of the polymer,
physicochemical degradation is in general irreversible as a result of local changes
in chemical composition, and can result in severe alterations of material properties.
 Chemical degradation concerns irreversible changes in the chemical structure of
the polymer initiated by a number of activation agents frequently encountered in
outdoor weathering:
oxygen (causing oxidation), reactive pollutants (ozone, nitric oxides), enzymes
(causing biodegradation);
heat (causing thermal degradation);
photons (from UV or g-radiation), electrons and high energy particles (causing
photodegradation and radiative degradation);
mechanical stress (causing mechanochemical degradation).
In this review, we will focus exclusively on chemical degradation, with particular
emphasis on environmental degradation. It should be kept in mind, however, that
under practical weathering conditions, physical, physicochemical and chemical
degradation may happen simultaneously and in a synergetic way, in some cases
resulting in premature material failure.
Although the term degradation usually has a negative connotation, some polymer applications require degradability as an asset or even a prerequisite as, for instance, in biodegradable detergents in some biomaterials, and in the manufacture
of microelectronic circuitry. In fact, the growing importance of degradation and
stability assessment in plastic materials is largely motivated by two apparent contradictary interests:


on one hand, there is an increased consumer demand for quality and durability
to avoid the expensive labor costs of replacing deteriorated components;
 on the other hand, for some applications, the plastic should be able to degrade spontaneously and safely when disposed of, to reduce the solid waste
burden.
Obviously, this degradability-on-demand can be realized only with an adequate
understanding of the degradation and stabilization mechanisms.

15.2 General Features of Polymer Degradation

15.2

General Features of Polymer Degradation

Over 95 wt.% of polymers are synthesized from eight vinyl monomers, and most of
the remainder are from another couple of dozen monomers with diverse chemical
structures. Despite this relative simple chemistry, the problem of degradation and
stabilization of synthetic polymers is exceedingly complex. This complexity stems
from the structural organization of plastic materials, which occurs at dierent
levels:


At the molecular level, most commercial plastics are mixtures of macromolecules with diverse substances, which can be traces of solvent or catalyst residues,
pigments, llers, and a variety of additives.
 The macromolecules themselves can be blends of homopolymers or copolymers.
 As to the dierences in small organic molecules, even a simple homopolymer
presents a diversity in chain length and conguration. The presence of chain
branching, tacticity, monomer linking, or chain defects may all have important
consequences for the materials stability.
 Molecular chains can arrange themselves into amorphous, oriented, and crystalline domains of dierent sizes, shapes, and distributions. This intricate morphology is globally known as supramolecular organization.
Studying degradation requires not only identication of the diverse chemical reactions which induce structural changes in the polymer, but also the interactions between the numerous chemical species initially present in the sample or formed in
the course of degradation. Interdependence of the change in material morphology
that occurs upon aging, and its inuence on the rate of degradation, should be considered additionally.
15.2.1

Degradative Reactions

From the complexity of chemical processes, and the intricate relationship between
chemical, morphological, and environmental factors which control degradation,
it is safe to state that there are as many degradation mechanisms as commercial
plastic formulations. Obviously, examining in detail all the eects mentioned for a
given polymer system requires considerable eort. Fortunately, a large group of
polymer degradation problems share a number of common features. Most degradative reactions of polyolens, for instance, can be envisioned as the reverse process of vinyl polymerization, with four steps: radical initiation, depropagation (the
reverse of propagation), chain branching under oxidative conditions (produced by
intermolecular and intramolecular hydrogen transfer followed by b-scission), and
radical termination. Except for the mode of initiation, the thermal, photolysis, and
radiolytic degradation processes are similar in many respects and can be described

759

760

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

Initiation

PH X ! P XH

Radical conversion

P O2 ! PO2 

Propagation

PO2  PH ! POOH P

Chain branching

POOH ! PO OH

PO PH ! POH P

HO PH ! H2 O P

PO ! various chain-scission reactions

P P ! inactive products

PO2  PO2  ! inactive products

(9)

Termination

General oxidative degradation mechanism for


polyolens (PH designates the polymer, P a macroradical, and
X a radical of unspecied nature).
Scheme 15.1.

by the same reaction scheme, a simplied version of which, based on polyolen


degradation but applicable to other types of polymers with a carbon backbone, is
given as Eqs. (1)(9) in Scheme 15.1 [1].
Initiation
Covalent bond scission, with formation of free radicals or charged species, is the
starting process in any type of chemical degradation. This primary event requires
energy, which can be supplied by heat (thermal degradation), UV photons (photodegradation), high-energy photons or particles (radiolysis), mechanical forces (mechanochemical degradation), or reactive chemicals (solvolysis, enzymatic degradation). Heterolytic bond scission is restricted to degradation by reactive chemicals
and by enzymes in biodegradation. For the other modes of degradation, bond scission is mainly homolytic, except in some particular situations described in Section
15.2.2. Apart from its free-radical nature, homolytic initiation is generally a complex and less well-known process (radical X of reaction (1)). The exact mechanisms
of initiation depend on the polymer structure, the presence of internal and external
impurities, and the degradation conditions. Also, the mode of initiation may
change during the course of reaction. Under oxidative conditions, for instance, formation of hydroperoxides followed by their decomposition rapidly becomes the
prevalent mode of initiation.
15.2.1.1

Propagation
Once initiated, the alkyl macroradical can proceed through a number of possible
reaction pathways. In the absence of oxygen, some macroradicals can depolymerize
by unzipping, or they can abstract a hydrogen atom from a nearby molecule or
from another group inside the same molecule. In oxidative environment, the free
15.2.1.2

15.2 General Features of Polymer Degradation

radical combines readily with molecular oxygen to produce peroxy radicals, which
can subsequently abstract H atoms to re-form an alkyl radical. Radical conversion
reaction is extremely rapid and is diusion-controlled, owing to the diradical nature of molecular oxygen, with k2 @ 10 8 10 9 L mol1 s1 . Hydrogen abstraction
reactions, on the other hand, require a high activation energy and are the ratedetermining step with k2 /k3 > 10 6 . The activation energy for k3 depends on the enthalpy of reaction DH De PaH  De POOaH, where De is the bond dissociation energy. With De POOaH A 360 kJ mol1 , peroxide abstraction reactions
are endothermic with a rate constant decreasing rapidly with increasing CaH
bond dissociation energy, according to the sequence: tertiary CaH (De 385
kJ mol1 ) > secondary CaH (400 kJ mol1 ) > primary CaH (410 kJ mol1 ). This
behavior has been veried in the case of polyolens, for which it is found that
HDPE is more resistant to oxidative degradation than LDPE, which is itself more
resistant than isotactic polypropylene (iPP), owing to the increasing presence of
tertiary CaH bonds in the polymer [2].
Chain Branching
Hydroperoxide decomposition is the key step in polymer oxidative degradation and
has been extensively studied in a number of systems, using low MW analogs of the
polymers. Corresponding rate constants and activation energies can be found in
Ref. 2, p. 383. The fate of the hydroperoxides formed is diverse. The OaO bond energy is only approximately 170195 kJ mol1 and is easily cleaved by heat or UV
light below 340 nm according to Eq. (10).
15.2.1.3

D;hn<340 nm

POaOH ! PO OH

10

Cations of transition metals (Cu, Fe, Mn, Co, Ti) which may exist in the polymer as
contaminants or as catalyst residues can induce the decomposition of hydroperoxides and contribute to an increase in the oxidation rate at low temperature (Haber
Weiss reaction, Eqs. (11) and (12)).
POaOH M n ! PO  OH Mn1
POaOH M

n1

! PO2  H M

11
12

At high hydroperoxide concentrations, a bimolecular dissociation mechanism [Eq.


(13)] between hydrogen-bonded molecules (for instance, between adjacent peroxide
groups formed by an intramolecular abstraction reaction in PP) can also occur.
2POaOH ! PO2  PO H2 O

13

Apart from homolytic cleavage, the hydroperoxides can undergo a number of other
reactions such as addition to double bonds that may have been initially present in
the polymer or formed in the course of degradation [Eq. (14)] and radical-induced
decomposition [Eqs. (15) and (16)].

761

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

14

P POaOH ! PO POH

15

HO POaOH ! PO2  H2 O

16

POaOH aHCbCHa ! PO aHCaCHa



OH

The decomposition of hydroperoxides creates more radicals than are initially


formed by initiation, resulting in an autoacceleration of the degradation process
(chain branching). Additionally, initiation by hydroperoxides is autoregenerated in
the sense that, overall, the same quantity of peroxides is recovered at the end of the
decomposition cycle.
Polyalkoxy and polyperoxy radicals formed from hydroperoxide decomposition
are unstable intermediates, owing to the presence of an unpaired electron which
weakens the dissociation energy for bonds in the b-position by some 100 kJ mol1 .
Monomolecular b-scission is the main mechanism for a decrease in MW and accounts for the variety of oxygenated products observed during oxidative degradation (see Section 15.4.4.6).
Termination
Under anaerobic conditions, the alkyl macroradicals can recombine by combination and dismutation [Eq. (17)].
15.2.1.4

P P ! PaP or

PaH PaH

17

In the presence of oxygen, hydroperoxy radicals are the most abundant; this is a
result of their relative low reactivity in solid polymers. Recombination of peroxy
radicals can proceed through a tetroxide intermediate, giving peroxides, polymer
alkoxy radicals, and oxygen [Eqs. (18a) and (18b)], or it can take place through a
six-membered transition state which would lead to an alcohol, singlet oxygen, and
triplet excited carbonyl, which, upon de-excitation, produces the chemiluminescence observed in many oxidative degradations (compare the Russell mechanism,
Section 15.3.6).
2PO2 ! fPaOaOaOaOaPg ! fPO O2 OPgcage !


762

POaOP O2

18a

2PO O2

18b

As with smaller radicals, the reactivity of a macroradical much depends on the


electron density of the atom bearing the unpaired electron. If reactivity is low,
the chance of a radical being trapped before abstraction can occur increases with
decreasing reactivity. For radicals formed by degradation, the lifetimes follow the
order P < PO < PO2 . Free isolated PO2  in polypropylene may have a half-lifetime as long as 500 s at ambient temperature. To account for this exceptional stability, and in analogy to the post-gel eect in free-radical polymerization, it may be

15.2 General Features of Polymer Degradation

appropriate to include a monomolecular mechanism for radical recombination, in


addition to the classical bimolecular scheme [Eq. (19)] [3].
P; PO; PO2  ! trapped radicals

19

The various steps described by the general auto-oxidative degradation of Scheme


15.1 will be illustrated by the oxidative degradation of polypropylene (Section
15.4.4).
15.2.2

Some Nonradical Degradation Mechanisms

Although the majority of polymers degrade thermally or photochemically by a freeradical process, there are a few examples where covalent bond scission occurs by
electron transfer around a six-membered transition state. Thermal degradation of
poly(ethylene terephthalate) [Eq. (20)] and side group cleavage in poly(methyl acrylate) and poly(tert-butyl methacrylate) are some examples where b-scission of the
alkyloxygen bond takes place from a cyclic transition state without free-radical formation [4].

O
O

C
H2C

O
O

O
H

O
O

CH

20

O
O

CH2
Cyclization of side chains may also occur without bond scission as in polyacrylonitrile (see Section 15.4.6.3).
15.2.3

Physical Factors

Polymer degradation is highly dependent on chemical and physical factors. The


chemical factors will be examined in relation to thermal degradation (see Section
15.4.2). This section will be focused exclusively on the inuence of physical factors
on polymer degradation.
Polymer degradation can be observed in solution, in melt or in the solid state.
Degradation in solution is principally used with model compounds for kinetics
studies, whereas degradation in melt is frequently associated with processing con-

763

764

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization


Tab. 15.1.

Factors relevant to chemical reactions in solid polymers [5].

Principal factor

Inuences

Mobility of reactants

translational and rotational diusion of reacting groups


as function of
 temperature and macromolecular motions
(Tg ; Tb ; Tg ; . . .)
 size and shape of reacting groups
 free volume and conformation
 interactions between reacting groups and matrix
cage eect
macroheterogeneity (gradients of absorbed light,
oxygen concentration, . . .)
morphological heterogeneity (crystalline and
amorphous domains, phase separation in block
copolymers and blends)
microheterogeneity (distribution of reactive sites, free
volume)
selective depletion of reactive sites
crosslinking, chain scission, change in absorbance
change in crystallinity
excited energy transfer and migration
electron transfer
transfer of active sites due to chain reaction

Heterogeneity of the system

Change in matrix structure during


reaction
Factors other than mass transfer

ditions. Obviously, solid-state experiments are the most relevant to normal polymer
weathering conditions. It is also in this state that degradation kinetics reveals its
highest degree of complexity, as a result of interplay between physical, physicochemical, and chemical variables. From the chemical viewpoint, elementary reactions should depend on temperature and not specically on the state of aggregation. Chemical reactions in the solid do dier, however, from those in the gas or
in the liquid phase by the rate of transport of reacting species, a factor which is
further exacerbated by the heterogeneity of the reacting medium. Some prevalent
factors which may aect chemical reactions in solid polymers are summarized in
Table 15.1.
Glass Transition Temperature
In contrast to small organic molecules, long-chain polymers are characterized not
only by the center of mass diusion, but also by small-scale diusion of a few
monomer units. It is generally observed that even monomolecular reactions could
happen only if these motions are unfrozen. In the wider sense, the dependence of
reaction eciency on polymer morphological structures can be described in terms
of the free volume concept, and of diusion constants [6]. These molecular characteristics are themselves dependent on the thermal transitions in polymers, the
most important of which being the glass transition temperature.
The glass transition corresponds to the onset of large-scale motions of long seg15.2.3.1

15.2 General Features of Polymer Degradation

ments of the macromolecules (1020 monomer units). These liquidlike motions


require more free volume, resulting in a larger volumic thermal expansion coecient above the glass transition temperature (Tg ). Below Tg , intra- and intermolecular rearrangements are strongly hindered. This restricted mobility also limits the
diusion of oxygen, which is a controlling factor in oxidative degradation. Reactions which require a notable change in activation volume should depend much
on the Tg . This is the case for the Norrish II process, in which the transition state
involves a six-membered ring conformation (Section 15.5.5.2). In the photolysis
of vinyl ketone polymers and ethylenecarbon monoxide copolymers, it was observed that the quantum yield in solid lm above the Tg was identical to that in
solution, but decreased with temperature below Tg , to become negligible below
the b-transition temperature. Reactions which involve free radicals generally require little change in activation volume and should proceed equally well below or
above Tg , as is the case for the photo-Fries rearrangement (Section 15.5.5.3) [7].
Chain mobility has important implications for bimolecular reaction eciency.
Bimolecular reactions depend on (i) the frequency of encounter and (ii) the concentrations of the reactive species. Upon bond cleavage, macroradicals are formed
in pairs and can initiate degradative reactions only if they are suciently exible to
move apart. If the macroradicals are held rigid, as in thermosets or below the Tg ,
they may recombine by the cage eect without any detectable molecular change.
Mass transfer limitations are a function of the diusion coecient for each
species. Two situations can be encountered [6]:
At least one reactant is a small molecule (or radical). Diusion of small species,
such as oxygen or methyl radicals, in solid glassy polymer can be much more
rapid than predicted from the bulk viscosity of the medium. The internal viscosity of solid polymers can be very low and bimolecular reactions in the solid state,
even below the Tg , can be almost as ecient as in solution.
 Both reactants are polymeric species. In this case, the eective encounter rate
is highly limited by mass transfer and shows a marked increase above the Tg . Below the Tg , all the large-scale motions are suppressed although motion of short
segments or of side groups of the main polymer may persist and have an inuence on the rate of degradation. It is observed, for instance, that recombination
of macroradicals in PMMA, PS, and PVC can occur well below the Tg . A valency
migration mechanism [Eq. (21)], in which the unpaired electron is transferred
between neighboring polymers until another macroradical is encountered, has
been proposed [6].


a CHa aCH2 a ! aCH2 a a CHa

21

The rate constant for this radical relay transfer reaction has the same activation energy as that of the b-relaxation in the corresponding polymer. This result
again suggests that the kinetics of macroradical reactions in solid polymers is
sensitive to small-scale molecular dynamics characterized by the secondary
(b; g; . . .) transitions.

765

766

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

Polymer Morphology
Structural organization of a solid polymer can be characterized by three principal
supramolecular parameters: the content of the amorphous phase, the degree of
chain orientation in this phase, and the degree of crystallinity in semicrystalline
polymers. These parameters depend to a large extent on its processing history,
and on the glass transition (Tg ) and melting temperature (Tm ).
15.2.3.2

Crystallinity It is generally considered that only the amorphous regions in semicrystalline polymers can participate in the degradation reactions. The chemical inertness of the crystalline phase originates from the close packing of the polymer
chains (minimum free volume), from the rigidity of the crystal lattice, and from
the lack of oxygen to initiate oxidative degradation. Only small species such as hydrogen atoms can penetrate the crystal lattice. Any macroradical which may be created is virtually trapped in the crystallites as an inert species. From the eects mentioned, it is obvious that degradation stability parallels the degree of crystallinity. In
some infrequent circumstances, it has been observed that increasing the degree of
crystallinity in a polymer sample may increase the rate of photodegradation. Closer
scrutiny of the results has indicated that multiple light scattering by the crystallites, which increases the eective optical length, and hence the number of absorbed
photons for degradation, is the proper explanation for this unusual behavior. In
addition to the degree of crystallinity, the size of the crystallites can also inuence
the polymer stability through the dual action of chain orientation and presence of
tie molecules. A quenched LDPE, for instance, has a higher resistance to photooxidation than an annealed sample of the same degree of crystallinity, as a result of
smaller crystallite sizes and a greater number of tie molecules [8]. In iPP, a reverse
trend has been observed when the rate of oxygen diusion becomes the control
step (Section 15.4.4). It has been suggested that oxygen diusion may depend on
the type of amorphous phase, which is distinguished in PE as intralamellar, interlamellar, and interspherulitic (Ref. 6, p. 292).
Although it is well established that oxidative degradation of semicrystalline
polymers initiates and spreads in the amorphous interphase without aecting the
crystalline domains, it does change the density and crystalline content through a
process known as chemicrystallization. The best documented account of this phenomenon is found in isotactic polypropylene. At the beginning of degradation,
chain shortening from bond scission facilitates molecular rearrangement, leading
to an increase in crystallinity. For long degradation times the crystallinity decreases, sometimes with a shift toward lower Tm , even if the degradation temperature is too low to allow for a change in molecular conformation [9].
Chain orientation Drawing orients the polymer chains, changes the sample morphology and can inuence the rate of degradation in two ways:


Orienting chains increases the intermolecular interactions, while at the same


time decreasing the free volume and segmental mobility. Most of the orientation
experiments have been performed with semicrystalline polymers (iPP or HDPE).

15.3 Degradation Detection Methods

In many respects, the behavior of oriented amorphous phases shows qualitative


similarity to that of the crystalline phase. The reduction of molecular mobility
results in a decrease in the rate constant for chain propagation reactions. A decrease in free volume results in a reduction in the rate of oxygen diusion.
 Even at the same concentration of absorbed oxygen, an oriented sample retains
its mechanical strength better than an isotropic polymer and can survive a longer
period of degradation.
Hydrogen bonding Polar polymers such as the polyamides, aliphatic or aromatic,
are strongly hydrogen-bonded in the solid state. Polymers devoid of polar groups
can nevertheless develop hydrogen bonding during the course of degradation as a
result of formation of oxidation products (hydroperoxy, hydroxy, carbonyl, and carboxyl groups) which can then interact through the acidic hydrogen and the basic
oxygen groups. The eect is similar to crosslinking, with a reduction in segment
mobility and a decrease in gas permeability. In addition, hydrogen bonding
changes the activation energy for some chemical reactions, such as hydroperoxide
decomposition (Section 15.4.4).
Externally applied stress Most polymers in practical use are subjected to some
type of deformation process. Depending on the amplitude, the duration, and the
geometry of these deformations, the polymer morphology may change in a number of complex (although generally predictable) ways, such as chain orientation,
shear banding, and crazing. How these stress-induced morphologies interact with
environmental degradation factors is, however, less well documented.
In photo-oxidation, it is found that the rate of decomposition increased with applied stress. The main factors which aect the rate of decomposition following application of tensile stress are an increase in oxygen diusion and an acceleration of
chain scission. It is believed that the latter eect may result from a decrease in radical recombination rate, following the pulling apart of the formed radicals by the
applied stress before they can recombine again. Several investigations in the
1970s tended to favor a molecular interpretation for stress-activated chemical degradation (Section 15.7.1). However, recent investigations of polyolens tend to indicate that chemical evolution does not depend on mechanical stresses, which modify only the consequences of the chemical evolution and not the kinetics of the
chemical reactions [10].

15.3

Degradation Detection Methods

A few eects of outdoor weathering, such as discoloration and embrittlement,


are readily detectable by visual or manual inspection. Quantitative investigations
nevertheless require modern analytical techniques capable of probing material
changes at dierent levels, from determining macroscopic bulk properties to un-

767

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization


Tab. 15.2.

Hierarchy of degradation investigative methodologies.

Scale

Aspect investigated

Methodology

Macroscopic

tensile test, fracture energy


measurements
optical and electronic microscopy

Chemical

decrease in mechanical
properties with time
development of surface
microcracks
change in morphology
change in molecular weight
distribution
stable degradation products

Reactive intermediates

free-radical formation

Microscopic
Supramolecular
Macromolecular

DSC, TEM
GPC
oxygen uptake, FTIR, Raman,
NMR, impedance spectroscopy
ESR, chemiluminescence

derstanding molecular mechanisms. The hierarchy of methodologies which has


been applied to degradation investigation is summarized in Table 15.2.
Many analytical techniques used to inspect the cited properties are common
to the eld of polymer characterization: vibrational spectroscopy (FTIR, Raman),
magnetic resonance spectroscopy (NMR, ESR) and liquid chromatography (GPC,
HPLC). A few methods, such as oxygen consumption and chemiluminescence,
are more specic to oxidative degradation. Mechanical tests are frequently used in
combination with other analytical tools to asset the eects of degradation on mechanical properties.
15.3.1

Mechanical Tests

Many plastic materials are used for their load-bearing properties, and mechanical
testing occupies a dominant position among the dierent criteria for degradation.
Typical molecular consequences of degradation processes are chain scission and
crosslinking. These eects have a profound inuence on the mechanical properties
of the material. In general, a predominance of crosslinking over chain scission increases the tensile strength while decreasing the elongation at break and the viscoelastic ow of the material. The reverse eects are observed for chain scission. The
loss of toughness in semicrystalline polymers arises from oxidatve chain scission
in the amorphous region, which involves:


scission of tie molecules


recrystallization of lower MW polymer fraction following scission
 densication from increasing polarity.


In thermal aging of polypropylene, for instance, a rapid transition from ductile to


brittle behavior was observed before the appearance of carbonyl groups in the FTIR
spectra. Recent data nevertheless indicate that some of the delay in aCbO buildup
a

768

15.3 Degradation Detection Methods

Fig. 15.1. Change in elongation at break, weight-average MW


(Mw ), and carbonyl content as a function of degradation time,
in the thermo-oxidative degradation of unstabilized iPP.

may result from the loss, during the initial degradation stage, of volatile ketones
and carboxylic acids which hence elude detection by FTIR. Gel permeation chromatography reveals the presence during the induction period of chain scission,
most likely b-scission of alkoxy radicals, which accompanies loss in mechanical
strength when the weight-average molecular weight Mw drops below some value
of the order of 10 5 g mol1 (Figure 15.1) [11].
Degradation, particularly photodegradation, is a surface phenomenon which
aects essentially only the outer few hundred microns from the surface. Scanning
electron microscopy invariably reveals the appearance of multiple cracks and microcracks at the surface of degraded polymers, as in Figure 15.2.
The morphology of these cracks depends on the type of polymer and the degradation conditions. Crack formation normally occurs on unstrained material according to the following sequence:
Oxidation of the supercial layer ! change in material density
! volume contraction ! dierential deformation ! crack formation
Oxidized polymers show an increase in density owing to the presence of polar
functions. Densication of the degraded material creates internal stresses between
the outer layer and the intact interior. Ultimately, cracks will appear when the mechanical strength of the degraded layer falls below the dierentiial tensile stresses.
Water absorption from ambient humidity or from rain, followed by surface evapo-

769

Fig. 15.2. Thermally degraded polypropylene samples. Left:


macroscopic aspect, showing the interior of a water pipe
degraded in hot water (six months, 90 C). Right: microscopic
(SEM) view of an HAS-stabilized sample thermally aged in an
oven (54 days at 135 C [11]).

770

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

15.3 Degradation Detection Methods

ration, is another source of cyclic mechanical stresses which can favor crack formation in certain polymers. The spatial irregularities in oxidation are another source
of dierential stresses between degraded and undegraded domains.
Fracture usually occurs from surface cracks. Starting from the degraded layer,
these surface microcracks can easily propagate into the internal intact layer by
stress concentration at the crack tip. Some mechanical tests are more sensitive to
the outer layers than to the bulk properties, and this peculiarity should not be overlooked when interpreting experimental results. Tensile strength of degraded elastomers, for instance, shows a dierent behavior when compared with tensile elongation, because the former depends on the entire cross-section of the material,
whereas ultimate elongation is correlated with surface modulus because cracks initiated at the hardened surface immediately propagate through the sample (Ref. 10,
p. 557).
15.3.2

Gel Permeation Chromatography

Polymer degradation involves cleavage of bonds, resulting in a decrease in MW,


branching, cyclization, and crosslinking. These changes in the MW and MWD,
and their evolution with the extent of degradation, can give valuable insights into
the degradation mechanism. Before the advent of GPC, dierent MW averages
such as Mn ; Mv or Mw , were used routinely in evaluation of polymer degradation
processes. Determination of the number-average MW (Mn ) has the major advantage that it is directly related to the inverse of the number of molecular chains per
unit polymer mass [Eq. (22), where n i is the polymer molar fraction of molecular
mass Mi ].
Mn

X

n i  Mi

22

In polymer degradation experiments, it is convenient to dene the scission index s


as the number of broken bonds per initial macromolecule. Because each mainchain scission produces an additional molecule, the indice s is directly given by
the change in number-average MW regardless of the initial MWD and degradation
mechanism [Eq. (23), with n representing the number of polymer chains per gram
of polymer, and the superscript  referring to the initial conditions].
s n  n /n Mn /Mn 1

23

Pure chain scission seldom occurs without other competitive radical reactions,
except perhaps during the early stage of oxidative degradation. When chain scission and crosslinking happen simultaneously, the polymer molecular weight may
increase or decrease depending on the relative importance of each process. For
random scission and crosslinking, Flory and Charlesby have shown that a threedimensional network begins to occur at the gel point, when the crosslink density

771

772

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

k(i,j)
random scission
Gaussian scission
parabolic scission

j=0
Fig. 15.3.

j=i/2

j=i

Some commonly encountered scission probability distribution functions.

reaches one unit per weight average molecule. The soluble fraction (s) after the gel
point can be used to determine the relative yield of chain scission to crosslinking
during degradation (see Section 15.6.2).
Gel permeation chromatography (GPC), particularly in its multidetection version, is now a mature and well-accepted technique for MW characterization. The
capability of GPC to determine changes throughout the MWD, in addition to the
dierent MW averages, opens new possibilities for polymer degradation studies.
The scission probability as a function of position along the molecular chain, for instance, could be inferred from the MWD of degraded polymer [12].
In a given polymer where most of the covalent bonds have on the average the
same bond energy, it is expected that the rate of bond scission may not depend on
its position along the chain (random scission). Although this is generally true for
the thermal and photodegradation of several polymers, other bond scission statistics can also be observed, as shown in Figure 15.3 [12].
The Gaussian scission probability distribution function, with a preference for
mid-chain scission, is frequently encountered in shear-induced mechanochemical
degradation. The parabolic distribution, on the contrary, indicates a preference for
chain-end degradation. This phenomenon has been reported in the hydrolysis of
dextran, as a result of chain branching.
A fourth situation, not depicted in Figure 15.3, is encountered in some polymers
which have weak links at a chain end or a low ceiling temperature. In the former
situation, initiation starts at the chain end bearing the weak bond with volatilization of a monomer out of the reaction medium. In the second case, exemplied
by polyacetals, initiation also occurs at a terminal position, but the process contin-

15.3 Degradation Detection Methods

ues and the monomers keep being evolved until complete volatilization of the polymer (unzipping).
15.3.3

Fourier Transform Infrared Spectroscopy

Identication of the degradation mechanism, and its evolution with time, are
mainly based on analysis of the intermediate and nal chemical products. FTIR
proves to be particularly suited to that purpose. The infrared absorption intensity
A s is related to the square of the change in dipole moment (m) during molecular
vibration according to Eq. (24), where n is the frequency of the band center, and
Q, the normal coordinate of the vibration.
A s m n  qm/qQ 2

24

The dynamic dipole moments of oxidized compounds are high, owing to the polar
nature of the oxidation products, and FTIR provides a sensitive and quantitative
technique for the investigation of oxidative degradation.
Oxidized polymers show changes in the IR absorption spectrum over the whole
range of measuring wavelengths. Most noticeable are the appearance of complex
overlapping bands in the carbonyl (16001800 cm1 ) and hydroxyl (32003600

absorbance

0.8

0.6

degraded

0.4

undegraded
0.2

0
500

1000

1500

2000

2500

cm-1
Fig. 15.4. Evolution of the ATR-FTIR spectra of an unstabilized
commercial iPP, before () and after (----) 3 h of thermal
treatment at 120 C.

3000

3500

4000

773

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

cm1 ) regions (Figure 15.4). The content of carbonyl groups is an indirect indicator
of the number of scission events. The average ratio of the absorption coecient
of hydroxyl (aOaH) to carbonyl ( aCbO) functions is approximately 3.4:1, and this
value can be used to estimate the relative proportion of hydroperoxides to other oxidation products of degradation.
IR absorption bands in amorphous solids are rather broad, with extensive overlap. Direct identication and quantication of the numerous oxidation products,
most often of similar chemical structures, in a degraded polymer are dicult.
More precise conclusions about the nature of absorbing species can be obtained
by selective chemical derivatization. Selective modication of functional groups
with reactive gases, such as SF4 , NH3 , SO2 , or NO, results in a shift in absorption
band positions, which can then be compared with model compounds to allow for a
better chemical assignment of the absorbing species (Table 15.3) [13].
Chemical derivatization can also be used for structure elucidation in complex
mixtures. For instance, dimethyl sulde has been used to dierentiate peracids
from other peroxy compounds. The rate of conversion of dimethyl sulde into dimethyl sulfoxide is almost instantaneous with peracids [Eq. (25)], whereas it is
slow with sec- and tert-hydroperoxides [Eq. (26)].
a

R
R
R
R

OOH
C

CHOOH

Tab. 15.3.

CH3SCH3

CH3SCH3

R
R

OH
C

CH3SCH3

25

CHOH

CH3SCH3

26

Some common derivatization techniques for identication by FTIR.


Derivatization reaction

IR frequency [cmC1 ]

Carboxylic acid

O
RaCaOH NH3 ! RaCOO

1564

Carboxylic acid

O
O
RaCaOH SF4 ! RaCaF

1848
1841 (a-branching)

Hydroperoxides

RaOaOH NO ! RaONO2
1276 1290
the sharp and intense absorption bands of nitrates and nitrites can be
used to dierentiate primary from secondary and tertiary
compounds

Alcohols

RaOH NO ! RaNO2

Aldehydes

Functional group

774

778


NH
4

RaCHbO 2Ag(NH3 )2 OH ! RCOO


2Ag# 3NH3 H2 O
(Tollens reagent does not react with ketones)

15501555

15.3 Degradation Detection Methods

The carboxyl group, in the presence of hydroxyls, may be dierentiated by reaction


with silver triuoracetate [Eq. (27); Ref. 7, p. 76] or with triuoroanhydride [Eqs.
(28) and (29)].
aCOOH CF3 COOAg ! aCOOAg CF3 COOH

27

aOH CF3 CO2 O ! aOaCOaCF3

28

aCOOH CF3 CO2 O ! aCOOaCOaCF3

29

15.3.4

Magnetic Resonance Spectroscopy


Nuclear Magnetic Resonance (NMR)
NMR is an absolute and unique method of resolving the microstructure of polymer
species. This technique has been instrumental in the elucidation of degradation
mechanisms in several polymer systems, including poly(vinyl chloride) (PVC).
At around its glass transition temperature (81 C), unstabilized commercial PVC
starts to discolor with release of hydrochloric acid, according to the global reaction
of Eq. (30).
15.3.4.1

aH2 CaCHCln a ! aHCbCHn a nHCl

30

Because the thermal stability of PVC is substantially lower than one may expect
from its nominal structure, numerous studies have been initiated to identify the
defect sites responsible for this anomaly. After considerable controversy concerning the role, nature, and importance of possible irregular structures, the most
active sites for initiating PVC degradation were nally identied by 1 H- and 13 CNMR as internal allylic (Figure 15.5, I, II) and tertiary chlorine structures (III, IV)
[14].
It was believed for a long time that head-to-head radical addition to monomers is
a major route for formation of labile structures. Kinetic studies, in association with
NMR measurements, reveal that formation of internal allylic and tertiary chlorine
structures actually proceeds through an intramolecular or intermolecular chaintransfer reaction to polymer [Eqs. (31), (32); VC vinyl chloride].

HC=CH CH2Cl

CH2 CHCl CH2 CH 2Cl


|
CH 2 CC1 CH 2
Fig. 15.5.

(I)

HC=CH CHCl

(III)

CH 2 CHCl CH 2 CHCl
|
CH 2 CC1 CH 2

Major labile structural defects in emulsion PVC.

(II)

(IV)

775

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

CH2 aCHClaCH2 aCH2 Cl



P ! aCH2 a CClaCH2 aCHClaCH2 aCHCl ! aCH2 aCClaCH2 a
31
a

CH2 aCHCla

VC VC
P aCH2 aCHClaCH2 a ! aCH2 aCClaCH2 a ! ! aCH2 aCClaCH2 a
32
a

776

Electron Spin Resonance (ESR)


Most mechanisms for the degradation of polymers during processing, storage, and
long-term use include free radicals. The technique of ESR is therefore a logical
choice for the study of polymer degradation. Two kinds of free radicals are of key
importance in determining degradation kinetics: (i) the carbon-centered macroalkyl CaC aC; and (ii) the oxygen-centered alkylperoxyl ROO, alkoxyl RO, and
acylperoxyl R(CO)OO radicals. Most of these species have unique ESR spectra
which allow their unambiguous identication under favorable conditions. In addition to structure identication, the decay signal of the radicals with time provides
information about termination rates and reaction order.
At room temperature and in solutions, free radicals are too reactive, and their
concentrations too low, to be conveniently detected by ESR spectroscopy. To observe and quantify transient radicals, it is customary to transform the unstable species into stable nitroxide radicals with the spin-trapping technique. Spin-trapping
of a macroalkyl radical with pentamethylnitrosobenzene, for instance, can be represented schematically by Eq. (33). The structure of the parent radical could be deduced from the ESR spectrum of the spin adducts, using standard rules of spin
coupling and experimental coupling constants.
15.3.4.2

H3C
H3C
H3C

CH3
N=O
CH3

H3C
+

.R

H3C
H3C

CH3
N R
O.
CH3
33

15.3.5

Oxygen Uptake

Oxygen uptake provides a simple, yet highly sensitive means to monitor oxidative
degradation. A weighed amount of polymer is hermetically enclosed with a xed
amount of oxygen under controlled pressure. Oxygen consumption can be monitored by measuring volumetric change, or the decrease in oxygen content by gas
chromatography. The rst method cannot discriminate oxygen consumption from
the release of volatile gases (CO, CO2 , H2 O, and so on) and tends to underestimate
the amount of oxygen consumed. The second technique benets from the high

15.3 Degradation Detection Methods

photooxidation

oxygen uptake

thermal oxidation

oxidation rate

induction period

degradation time

Fig. 15.6. Oxygen uptake curves during photo-oxidation and


thermal oxidation of unstabilized polymers.

sensitivity and separation capability of gas chromatography which, with proper


care, allows determination of oxygen consumption rates down to 10 13 mol g1
s1 . The gas chromatography approach has been used to determine the instantaneous oxidation rate of elastomers even at room temperature, and reliable lifetime
can be predicted under ambient conditions without having recourse to extrapolation from accelerated testing [15].
Measurement of oxygen consumption is the starting point for several analyses of
polymer oxidation kinetics. The oxygen uptake curve for most polyolens shows an
induction period with a very slow oxidation rate, before reaching a steady state
with constant slope. The value of this slope has been often interpreted as the limiting oxidation rate of the polymer. The induction period is generally much shorter
in photodegradation than in thermal degradation (Figure 15.6). The main dierence stems from the dierent modes of initiation. The activation energy of primary
photochemical processes, 840 kJ mol1 , is generally much less than the energy
required for thermal activation (120200 kJ mol1 ). Because photodegradation
generally occurs at low temperature, photodecomposition of peroxides is slow and
this class of products tends to accumulate rather than being decomposed to initiate
chain branching reactions as in thermal degradation.
During oxygen uptake, part of the absorbed oxygen is transformed into hydroperoxides, while the remaining fractions are found in hydroxyl- and carbonylcontaining compounds formed by competitive reactions of P and POO radicals.
The relative importance of each process depends on the oxygen partial pressure,
and various kinetic equations have been derived to relate the rate of oxygen absorption (d[O2 ]/dt) to the formation of oxidation products, under low and high oxygen

777

778

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

pressure conditions. Kinetic information, and rate coecients for propagation and
termination, have frequently been obtained from the t of the oxygen consumption
curve at relatively low conversions. This procedure, however, is complicated by the
facts that intermediate oxidation products may be orders of magnitude more susceptible to oxidation than the starting material, and that degradation in solid polymers is fundamentally heterogeneous. Therefore, any obtained value can yield only
average information about the degradation process.
15.3.6

Chemiluminescence

As with oxygen micro-uptake, chemiluminescence is an ultrasensitive technique


for determining the rate of oxidation at the earliest stage of degradation. Oxidative
degradation of polymers is generally accompanied by weak photon emission, with
a very low quantum yield (approximately 109 ). The light-emitting reaction which
accompanies free-radical oxidation is generally attributed to an exoenergetic termination reaction of peroxy radicals according to the Russell mechanism [Eq. (34)].

R
R

O
C

O.
O.

R
R

O*
C

O
O

R
R
R

34

C=O* +

1O2

+ ROH
.
H = -460 kJ mol-1

The Russell mechanism requires one of the terminating radicals to be either primary or secondary so that a six-membered transition state can be formed. Such
a mechanism may be prevalent in PE and PA, but not in PP, where the chaincarrying radical is tertiary. For this polymer, more complex alternative routes for
chemiluminescence-producing reactions have been proposed [Ref. 10, p. 175].

15.4

Thermal Degradation

Industrial plastics are frequently exposed to elevated temperatures during melt


processing and in many engineering applications, some of which will be described
in Section 15.4.6. The glass transition temperature (Tg ) and the melting point (Tm )
of semicrystalline polymers are the most important thermal characteristics of polymers. These two parameters alone are generally not sucient to predict the mate-

15.4 Thermal Degradation

rials service temperature, if thermal stabilization is not properly controlled. Several


polymer systems produce toxic low molecular weight compounds when subjected
to heat, which can create hazardous conditions if they come into contact with a human body, either by ingestion or by breathing. Flammability of polymers used in
construction is another concern when the polymers are exposed to high temperatures. All these factors combined make thermal stability appraisal a necessity in
most application developments.
15.4.1

Thermal Stability

The notion of thermal stability is a vague concept, since it depends primarily on


the time scale of observation. A PMMA sample, for instance, can be stable at
300 C for a few seconds, but can withstand only a temperature of 150 C if the
heating time spans several hours.
To be able to compare thermal stability between polymers of dierent structures,
it is necessary to rely on some standardized system, such as the temperature of
half-decomposition (T1/2 ). The temperature of half-decomposition is dened as
the temperature at which the polymer loses half of its weight when heated in vacuo
for 30 min. Experimentally, T1/2 can be conveniently determined by thermal gravimetry (TG). From the TG curves obtained at dierent scan speeds, an Arrhenius
plot at constant weight-loss ratio is derived. The pre-exponential factor and activation energy determined are then used to calculate T1/2 .
15.4.2

Polymer Structure and Thermal Stability

Intrinsic chemical factors which inuence heat resistance include primary bond
strength, secondary or van der Waals interactions, hydrogen bonding, resonance
stabilization, the mechanism of bond cleavage, structure regularity, intrachain rigidity, crosslinking, and branching. Owing to the presence of multiple secondary
reactions, the eect of chemical structure on degradation kinetics is not easily rationalized from chemical rst principles. The actual degradation kinetics is highly
variable and depends not only on the polymer structure, but also on the reaction
conditions: sample size, internal or external unstable structures, and additives.
More specically, it is experimentally observed that the degradation temperature
and the product distribution can be controlled by changing the heating rate of the
polymer, as a result of competitive pathways for degradation. Apart from the primary eects cited, dierences in thermo-oxidative resistance can be discerned between dierent stereoisomers of the same compound (PMMA, PVC, and PP).
Notwithstanding this complexity, some semiempirical rules could be identied
by analogy with small organic model molecules, and by considering that thermal
degradation is a homolytic bond scission process initiated by thermally activated
molecular vibrations:

779

780

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization




The rate of thermal degradation is related to the number of pendent groups present on the polymer chain. Thus polyisobutylene (PIB) degrades faster than isotactic PP, which itself decomposes faster than HDPE.
 A rigid polymer backbone has less possibility of rearrangement and fragmentation and can withstand higher thermal energy.
 The heat resistance increases with the number of covalent bonds per repeat unit:
a crosslinked or ladder polymer can be broken only after scission of two or more
covalent bonds.
 The bond of lowest energy is the rst bond to be cleaved. Conversely, polymers
with multiple bonds and aromatic structures are less prone to thermal degradation.
Poly(para-phenylene), with its rodlike structure composed of highly delocalized pelectron orbitals, satises most of the requirements for high thermal stability. Possessing T1/2 > 400 C and an estimated melting point of 1400 C, PPP constitutes a
reference for heat-resistant polymer. Poly(para-phenylene) can be synthesized by a
number of routes, with the best heat-resistant material obtained by polymerization
of 1,3-cyclohexadiene, followed by dehydrogenation of the polymer formed according to Eq. (35) [16].
-H

n
n

35
n

Moldable polymers can be obtained by increasing chain exibility with substitution


of lateral groups, at the expense of decreasing thermal stability. Polyimides and
polyetherimides (V), with a semi-rigid structure and electronically stabilized aromatic rings, form an important class of melt-processible polymers with outstanding heat resistance (Table 15.4).
Apart from the decomposition temperature, the propensity for char formation is
another polymer thermal characteristic of practical importance. The char-forming
tendency generally shows a negative correlation with ammability: a sample with
the greatest char residue is also the least ammable polymer and the presence of
ame retardant additives also increases char formation. In the case of re, the
amorphous crust of char material that forms on the uid surface reduces the heat
ux to the burning uid, which in turn reduces the combustion rate.
15.4.3

Computer Simulation

Thermal degradation involves scission of covalent bonds which can be formally


written as Eq. (36).
k

A!BC

36

15.4 Thermal Degradation


Tab. 15.4. Chemical structure and thermal stability by thermogravimetry of some representative
polyetherimides
O
O

Ar

(V)
xAr x

Thermal stability [ C]

4,4 0 -biphenyl
4,4 0 -benzophenone
4,4 0 -diphenyl ether
4,4 0 -diphenyl sulde

Tg [ C]

1 wt.%
loss (air)

1 wt.%
loss (N2 )

5 wt.%
loss (air)

5 wt.%
loss (N2 )

247
239
227
209

500
490
480
470

515
485
480
470

530
530
513
504

543
523
523
505

According to Eyrings transition-state theory, the rate constant k is given by Eq.


(37), with kB Boltzmanns constant, h Plancks constant, DE0 molecular energy dierence at absolute zero between the activated complex and the reactant,
and qz and qA the molecular partition functions of the transition state and reactant,
respectively. The transition state is distinguished by a single negative vibration, a
characteristic which has been used to identify true transition states in computer
modeling.
kT kB T/hqz /qA expDE0 /kB T

37

With the increasing capabilities of computers and development of new numerical


methods, it is now possible to predict polymer properties computationally. In addition to saving time, computer-aided chemistry can sometimes provide new insights
into some decomposition mechanisms which are dicult to obtain by experimental techniques. Computer modeling has been used in an increasing number of
ways to simulate thermal degradation. A few representative examples are described
below.


Ab-initio calculations were performed on a series of model structures to predict


the eect of lateral alkyl substituents on the thermal stability of degradable polycarbonate. The optimized transition structures revealed that the Ca aO bond
dissociates rst, followed by abstraction of the b-hydrogen atom, developing a
carbocation character in the transition state on the Ca atom. Substituents which
stabilize the transition state will also accelerate the degradation rate [17].

781

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization




Molecular dynamics simulation has been conducted to understand the signicant reduction in ammability of polymer nanocomposites. Using graphite as a
model compound, it was found that polymer in an intercalated structure loses
fewer fragments generated by the degradation and retains its shape longer as a
result of repulsive nonbonding interactions between the polymer and the graphite layers. The fragments generated by thermal activation collide with the graphite and bounce back into the central unit cell, where they undergo recombination
reactions with other free radicals. The decrease in polymer fragments which can
escape as combustible fuel accounts for the observed improvement in re resistance [18].
 Force eld calculations with the MOPAC PM3 package [19] allow the prediction
of thermal degradation mechanisms. First, the smallest representative section of
the polymer to be investigated was selected. The program then calculated the
heat of formation and Gibbs free energies at dierent temperatures of the polymer and for dierent radical fragments. The kinetic barrier for bond dissociation
was estimated by stretching each individual bond to its breaking point, and plotting the heat of formation (enthalpy) as a function of bond extension. Calculations on the PA-6,6 structure identify the aCOaCH2 a bond as the one having
the lowest transition state energy, and the carbonyl carbon as the most susceptible site for radical attack. Upon dissociation, the methyl radical created folds
back and attacks the aCbO bond, forming cyclopentanone, in accord with experimental ndings [20].
a

782

15.4.4

Thermal Oxidative Degradation of Polypropylene

Isotactic polypropylene (iPP) is a major commodity plastic material which cannot


be utilized without thermal stabilizers. With a moderately complex structure, iPP
is frequently used as a model system to test the dierent theoretical and experimental approaches to macromolecular degradation.
Initiation
The homogeneous oxidation of PP follows the free-radical auto-oxidation mechanism depicted in Scheme 15.1. Under isothermal conditions, the oxygen uptake
curves display a pseudo-induction period during which oxidation is autoaccelerated. The duration for the induction period t i depends on the sample purity and
preoxidation history. For clean samples, t i is reasonably reproducible and is of the
same order of magnitude as the POOH lifetime, determined by iodometric titration. The temperature dependence of the induction time obeys an Arrhenius law
with an apparent activation energy of 105 G 15 kJ mol1 , which is the same as for
the decomposition of hydroperoxides. The corresponding rate constants are much
lower than for the other degradation processes and account for the induction period during which hydroperoxides accumulate before reaching a maximum. It has
long been recognized that residual ZieglerNatta polymerization catalysts, gener15.4.4.1

15.4 Thermal Degradation

0.3

1.2
oxygen uptake
(left scale)

mole O 2/kg

0.2

0.6

mole POOH/kg

peroxide content
(right scale)

0.8

0.1

0.4
0.2
0

10

20

30

40

0
50

degradation time [min]


Fig. 15.7. Oxygen uptake (left-hand scale) and hydroperoxide
formation (right-hand scale) in the thermo-oxidative
degradation of iPP lms at 130 C, with small () and large
(----) spherulites.

ally at the 120 ppm level, accelerate the solid-state degradation of PP. The negative inuence of polymerization catalyst residues depends not only on the type of
catalyst, but also on its concentration. The induction period stage is complicated by
the morphology of the sample. In iPP, for instance, a sample with small spherulite
sizes (< 100 mm), obtained by rapid quenching, has a short induction time (Figure
15.7). A large spherulite sample (350500 mm), obtained by prolonged annealing,
results in a signicant increase in the induction period. The dierence was explained by a dierence in the oxygen diusion rate in the oriented amorphous regions, which are more strained in large spherulite structures [21].
It was shown from decomposition kinetics and by treatment with dimethyl
sulde that peroxides consist of two types: a fast-decomposing one composed of
peracids, and a slowly decomposing one consisting of hydroperoxides and hydroperesters. During the induction period, the slowly decomposing hydroperoxides accumulate and the oxidation rate is controlled by the rate of decomposition, which
may be nally catalyzed by metal ion residues. The autoacceleration stage is controlled by the fast-decomposing peracids [22].
Regardless of the exact mechanism of bond scission, the mechanistic step for
initiation in PP can be described schematically by Eq. (38).

783

784

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

CH3
CH2 CH

+X

CH2

CH3

CH CH

CH2
38

CH3

CH2

CH2 C

Propagation
For PP, the radical conversion step with oxygen is given by Eq. (39).
15.4.4.2

CH3

CH2

CH2 C

CH3
C

+ O2

CH3
CH2

CH2 C

CH3
39

Hydrogen abstraction from tertiary carbon has an activation energy lower by approximately 15 kJ mol1 than an abstraction reaction on secondary carbon (Ref. 2,
p. 386), and is the predominant mode of formation of hydroperoxides in PP. In addition to energy considerations, the hydrogen abstraction rate constant is dependent on steric factors and polymer conformation. It is found, for instance, that k3
(Scheme 15.1) in solution is lower in a theta solvent than in a good solvent, owing
to increased steric repulsion in a contracted molecular coil [7].
Abstraction reaction in polymers can occur intramolecularly or intermolecularly.
The former possibility is important in polymers which possess lateral groups (PP
and PS), whereas it is nonexistent in linear polymers (HDPE). The possibility of
intramolecular H abstraction has been advanced as one of the reasons for the
high sensitivity of PP (in comparison to HDPE) toward oxidative degradation.
Infrared studies have revealed that more than 90% of hydroperoxides in PP are
hydrogen-bonded in sequences of two or more. This result supports an intramolecular hydrogen abstraction reaction, facilitated by a six-membered ring stereochemical arrangement [Eq. (40)].
CH3
CH2 C

CH3

CH3

CH2 C

O
O

CH2 C

CH2 C
O

CH3

OH
+ O2

CH3
CH2 C

CH3

CH3

CH2 C CH2 C
O
H
O
OH

40

15.4 Thermal Degradation

Chain Branching
Chain branching by homolytic decomposition of polymer hydroperoxides results
in formation of highly reactive polymer alkoxy (PO) and hydroxyl (OH) radicals.
The small and mobile OH can readily abstract hydrogen from a nearby polymer
chain, creating a secondary or tertiary macroalkyl radical. The tertiary alkoxy radical can abstract hydrogen intramolecularly, forming a primary alkyl radical as in
Eq. (41).
15.4.4.3

CH3

CH2
CH3
C
CH
O
CH2
H

CH2
CH

O
H

CH2

41

The polyalkoxy radicals can decompose further by b-scission, yielding ketones, aldehydes, and alkyl radicals, depending on the initial position of the radical [Eqs.
(42a), (42b), and (43)].

CH3
CH2

CH3
CH2

CH

O
CH3
CH 2

C
O

-scission

CH 3
+

CH 2

CH

42a

CH3
CH2

CH2

CH

CH3

42b

CH3
CH

CH3
CH
O

CH

-scission

CH3
CH

CH 3

H
+

CH

43

Similarly, the cleavage of peroxy radicals results in the formation of double bonds
along with aldehydes and ketones [Eqs. (44) and (45)].

785

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

CH3

CH3

CH

CH

-scission

CH

O
O
CH3

44

CH 3

CH

HC

CH

OH

O
CH3
CH2 C

CH3

CH2

-scission

CH

O
O

45

CH 3

CH3
C

CH 2

CH2

CH

OH

Termination
In an oxygen-decient atmosphere, vinylidene and vinyl compounds may be
formed from the disproportionation of polypropylene radicals [Eqs. (46) and (47)].
15.4.4.4

2PaCH2 aCH ! PaCH2 aCHbCH2 PaCH2 aCH2 aCH3

47

46

2PaCHaCH2  ! PaCbCH2 PaCHaCH3


CH3
CH3
CH3
a

786

In the presence of oxygen, the majority of recombinations occur between tertiary


peroxy radicals, to give dialkyl peroxides and oxygen [Eq. (48)].
CH 3
CH2

CH3

CH2

CH2

CH2

O
O

CH3

CH3

CH2 C

O
O

CH2

CH2

CH3

CH3

C
O

48
CH2

O2

H = -300 kJ.mol-1

Secondary Reactions
In oxidative degradation, it is convenient to make a distinction between primary
chemicals formed by reactions of the polymer peroxy radicals, and secondary products created in subsequent reactions of these primary compounds. Ketones and al15.4.4.5

15.4 Thermal Degradation

dehydes formed by b-scissions may react further with hydroperoxides to form a variety of oxidation products. The formation of peracids, for example, proceeds via a
multistep oxidation of aldehydes [Eq. (49)].

CH3
CH2

CH

POO.

POOH

CH3
CH2

CH

+ O2, PH

C.

O
OOH

CH3
CH2

CH

C
O

49

It should be emphasized that the reaction scheme of Eq. (49) is unlikely if hydroperoxides are distributed homogeneously over the whole sample. Owing to restricted mobility below Tm, the oxidation products cannot diuse away. Locally, hydroperoxides can reach suciently high concentrations for secondary reactions to
occur at a signicant rate. In a similar fashion, the formation of carboxylic acids,
esters and g-lactones proceeds through a complex series of oxidation reactions of
alcohols and ketones.
The aldehydes and ketones formed by b-scission can undergo Norrish type I
[Eq. (50a)] and Norrish type II reactions [Eq. (50b)] during photodegradation (see
Section 15.5.3).

CH 3
CH 2

C
O

I
rish
Nor
Nor
rish

CH 3
CH 2

CH

CH3CO

50a

CH3
II

CH

CH

CH

CH 3 + CH3COCH3

50b

For a long time, the similarity between thermal and photolytic products was a mystery because Norrish photoprocesses are absent in the former situation. By using
low MW model compounds, chemical derivatization, and 13 C-NMR techniques, it
has been assessed that a large fraction of the carbonyl-containing compounds
formed during oxidative degradation of PP are a-methylated acids. Such a carboxylic structure can only originate from the oxidation of macroalkyl radicals
[Eq. (51)], which can be formed either by a Norrish I photoprocess or by b-scission
of alkoxy radicals (Ref. 10, p. 583).

CH3
CH2

CH

+ O2, PH

or hv

CH3
HOO CH2

CH 3

O
HO

CH

CH

51

787

788

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

Once the structure of the carboxylic acids had been elucidated, the IR absorption
band which appears as a shoulder at 1740 cm1 in thermal or photo-oxidation of
PP, and was initially attributed to ester functions, was reassigned to an acidic
group hydrogen-bonded to a vicinal hydroperoxide (VI).
CH3

CH3
CH2

CH

CH

C
O

OH

OH

(VI)

Formation of Volatile Compounds


At least 40 dierent volatile compounds have been identied during the oxidative
degradation of iPP, some of which are important for spreading the degradation according to the infection mechanism (Section 15.4.5). The mode of formation of
the principal volatile products is indicated in Eqs. (52)(55) [23]. It is proposed that
CO and CO2 are formed by the decomposition of carbonyl and carboxyl radicals
following hydrogen abstraction from the parent compounds [Eqs. (52) and (53)].
Peracids formed by oxidation of formaldehyde can decompose into formic acid,
water, carbon dioxide, and triplet oxygen according to Eqs. (54) and (55).
15.4.4.6

CH3
CH2

CH

POO.

POOH

CH3
CH2

C.

CH

52

CH3
CH2

OH

CH3
CH2

CH

POO.

C.

CO

POOH

CH3
CH2

C
O

CH

C.

O
O

53

CH3
CH2

C.

CO2

H
O
H

C
O

OH
CO2

H 2O

54

15.4 Thermal Degradation

O
2

OH

OH
2 H

C
O

+
O

O2

55

15.4.5

Homogeneous versus Heterogeneous Kinetics

Degradation reactions in the solid state are spatially heterogeneous, not only across
the sample but also within the sample. At least two factors can account for the heterogeneity of the degradation:


Nonuniform distribution of the reactants (oxygen, additives, impurities): uptake


of oxygen and formation of reactive chemicals are the highest near the surface.
Additives distribution can also be inhomogeneous as a result of inadequate
blending or migration.
 Heterogeneous structure of the sample: oxygen (or any other chemical reactant)
can diuse more readily into amorphous than into crystalline domains, thus favoring oxidative degradation of the former regions.
Superimposed on this macroheterogeneity, which occurs on a micron scale, is microheterogeneity resulting from the low diusivity of macromolecular species. In
solid polymer, it is expected that most macromolecular constituents formed from
radical reactions are localized in microdomains of size not exceeding 1030 nm.
The preceding considerations indicate that degradation kinetics of solid polymers cannot be studied solely within the framework of homogeneous free-radical
kinetics. In spite of these complications, it has been found in many instances that
the homogeneous kinetics treatment of thermal oxidation gives a surprisingly good
t with experimental data [24]. It has been argued that the homogeneous kinetic
model may be applied to an inhomogeneous system by considering the parameters
as average values. It should be kept in mind, however, that the real concentrations
of degraded species may be much higher locally than the mean values averaged
over the bulk sample, and that extrapolating microscopic kinetics from macroscopic average data is a nontrivial problem.
The evidence for heterogeneous oxidation of solid polypropylene was revealed
by chemiluminescence measurements. Chemiluminescence from single polymer
powder particles revealed a large spread in the induction periods. The oxidation behavior changed with particle separation, and the result was interpreted as a result
of physical infection from a particle with the shortest induction period to its
nearest neighbors, causing rapid oxidation of the complete sample. The origin of
this infection was traced back to the formation of volatile compounds, more specifically acetic acid and formaldehyde, which have the propensity to accelerate oxidative degradation [25]. Highly mobile radicals, such as OH, can also diuse far and
spread the degradation.

789

790

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

Devising a chemical kinetics model which encompasses all sources of heterogeneity present in a solid polymer is a challenge. The starting point in most heterogeneous kinetics models is to consider that oxidation is initiated nonuniformly at a
few sites, presumably around catalyst residues or other impurity centers in the
amorphous region of the polymer. One approach to heterogeneous modeling was
by Monte Carlo simulation, based on the random-walk diusion of low MW reactive radicals. Another concept, called the epidemic model, utilizes the analogy between the spreading of oxidation through the amorphous region of solid polymer,
and the infectious contamination of a disease through a population. In this model,
three distinct polymer populations are assigned: the infectious oxidizing fraction
p i , the remaining unoxidized fraction p r , and the dead or oxidized fraction pd .
These populations may be described by a series of coupled dierential equations,
Eqs. (56)(58), which are developed by noting that oxidation can spread only if
there is unoxidized material within contact distance of the infected one.
dp r /dt bp r p i

56

dpd /dt ap i

57

dp i /dt dp r /dt  dpd /dt

58

Integration of the above system of dierential equations using experimental b and


a parameters give an excellent t with the chemiluminescence curve when dealing
with single particles, but the quality of the t deteriorated with groups of particles,
as a result of multiple-spreading processes [26].
By considering only the oxidized and the unoxidized fractions, a simplied
spreading model was developed to explain the time dependence of hydroperoxide
concentration during oxidative degradation of LDPE [27], expressed as Eq. (59),
where n is the number of oxidized domains, N the total number of amorphous domains, and r the rate coecient for spreading.
dn/dt r  n  r  n 2 /N

59

15.4.6

Applications of Thermal Degradation

Although the word degradation usually has a pejorative connotation, a number


of important industrial applications depend on this class of reactions to develop
new products or processes.
Analytical Pyrolysis
Pyrolysis of a polymer means thermal degradation in the complete absence of any
external reactant. Analytical pyrolysis, dened as pyrolysis conducted in combina15.4.6.1

15.4 Thermal Degradation

tion with some physicochemical separation technique (pyrolysisGCMS, for instance), has found a wide range of applications in biopolymers and synthetic polymers. Polymers pyrolyze by dierent combinations of three general mechanisms:
random scission (PE), depolymerization (POM, PMMA), or elimination of small
molecules other than monomer (for instance, HCl in PVC). Each polymer under
strictly controlled pyrolytic conditions provides a typical pattern of degradation
products, which can be used for ngerprint identication, composition analysis,
structure determination, or mechanistic studies [28].
Introduction of New Chemical Functionalities
Controlled thermal degradation of polyolens in the presence of peroxides has
been carried out in extruders or in continuous mixers, to reduce polymer MW and
sample polydispersity. The resulting material has more processing advantages than
the undegraded one. Based on the same principle, random chemical functionalization of polyolens with polar groups has been achieved by extruding the polymer
in the presence of peroxy ketals or peroxy esters [29].
15.4.6.2

Chemical Modication of Polymer Structure


Carbon ber is used in a variety of structural and electrical applications, and is
probably the most well-known example of high-performance material produced by
thermal degradation. Although carbon ber can be produced in several ways, including alignment of molecules of pitch in its mesophase state, the most economical way consists of hot-stretching high MW polyacrylonitrile (PAN) bers and
while heating under controlled conditions. The laments are rst oxidized under
tension at around 260 C in air, to convert the PAN precursor to a thermally stable
structure by an exothermic reaction (E a 3:5 kJ g1 , DH 2:5 kJ g1 ), according to Eq. (60) [30].
15.4.6.3

260C, air
C

C
N

C
N

60

C
OH

C
C
N

N
H

stabilized PAN

NH2

The carbonization step is carried out in an inert atmosphere (high-purity N2 ) above


1000 C to yield carbon bers containing 9395% carbon [Eq. (61)] and a tensile
modulus (E) of 140200 GPa. This grade is mostly used in sporting goods and in
composites.

791

792

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization


N

1000C, N2

61

To achieve bers in which the carbon crystals are further stretched and aligned,
graphitization takes place around 20003000 C. These graphite bers have a carbon content greater than 99% and a tensile modulus of 4001000 GPa. For comparison, the tensile modulus of carbon nanotubes is 1000 GPa, and of diamond
1200 GPa.
Metal Injection Molding (MIM)
Polyacetals have a low ceiling temperature, and are readily depolymerized by unzipping at low temperature (0.40.8% min1 at 222 C for POM). Owing to this
low thermal stability, polyacetals can be used only if end-capped with stable groups
(acetate or ether). This inherent thermal instability is exploited in an industrial
method known as metal injection molding, which allows ne metal powder
mixed with a polymer binder to be processed by injection molding, in much the
same way as thermoplastic materials [31]. In a procedure based on POM, the
binder is removed by thermal devolatilization according to Eq. (62)
15.4.6.4

HNO3 /150 C

RaCH2 aOan H ! RaCH2 OH n  1H2 CbO

62

Recycling
Polymer can be recycled by reuse of existing material (primary recycling), by regranulating the waste by mechanical means so that it can be melted and formed again
(secondary recycling), or by transforming the waste into new chemical compounds
(tertiary recycling) through chemical reactions. The last of these methods presents
several economic advantages in comparison to primary or secondary recycling,
since revalorizing steps can be avoided. Recently, thermolysis has been viewed as
a viable alternative to recovery for polymer recycling and numerous studies have
been directed toward this objective [32].
The term feedstock recycling has been used to describe this new class of plastics recycling technology, which breaks down solid polymers into a spectrum of ba15.4.6.5

15.5 Photodegradation

sic chemical compounds that can be reused as raw materials for the chemical industry. Vinyl polymers, when pyrolyzed at temperatures from 200 to 500 C in the
total absence of air, usually degrade to yield monomers (poly(methyl methacrylate),
poly(a-methylstyrene), polystyrene, polyisobutylene) or a wide distribution of molecular fragments (polyethylene and polypropylene). In order to reduce the process
temperature and to limit the range of products, particularly in the case of polyethylene, several catalyst cracking systems based on zeolites or clays have been developed. A newly developed technique in the recycling eld is thermolysis coupled
with reactive distillation.

15.5

Photodegradation
15.5.1

Absorption of UV Radiation by Polymers

Photo-oxidation is the most common mode of weathering for industrial polymers,


and diers from thermal degradation principally in the mode of chemical activation. In place of vibrational energy, the energy of the photon provides the driving
mechanism for free-radical generation. Photochemical processes are based on two
fundamental principles: the GrotthusDraper law, which states that only radiant
energy that is eectively absorbed can activate molecules, and the StarkEinstein
law, which asserts that one absorbed photon can induce photochemical reaction of
only a single molecule [33]. The rst law implies the presence of an appropriate
chromophore in the polymer, whereas the second law indicates that the formation
of photoproducts is linearly dependent on the light intensity, and that a photoreaction can occur only if the energy of the photon is sucient to overcome the corresponding activation energy.
For most organic molecules, absorption in the near-UV (190400 nm) involves
electronic transition from the highest occupied molecular orbital (HOMO) to
the lowest unoccupied molecular orbital (LUMO). Commercial polymers can be
broadly divided into two categories, depending on whether or not they contain delocalized p-electrons, sometimes combined with heteroatoms with nonbonding
valence shell electron pairs (O, N, S) in their chemical structure. Polymers
which contain carbonyls ( aCbO), conjugated polyenes ( aCbCaCbC a), ketenes
( aCbCaCbO), and sulfones (aFaSO2 aFa) belong to the rst group of chromophores and are capable of absorbing light in the near UV (190 nm < l max < 400
nm); see Table 15.5. Those from the second group possess only single covalent
bonds, such as CaC, CaH, CaO, CaCl, and CaF, and can in principle absorb light
only in the far UV (l max < 190 nm).
Owing to vibrational and electronic couplings, UV absorption bands of polyatomic molecules in the condensed state are generally quite broad, with width at
half-maximum commonly exceeding 6080 nm. Even with this broadness, polymers such as polyolens, polyacetals, poly(vinyl chloride), or polyacrylonitrile

793

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization


Tab. 15.5.

Principal chromophore groups in synthetic polymers[a].

Polymer

Chromophore

lmax [nm]

emax [L molC1 cmC1 ]

Polyesters
Polyaromatics
Poly(aryl ketone)s
Polydienes
Conjugated polyenes

aCbO
aFa
aFaCOaFa
aCbC a
aCbCaCbC a
a(CbC)3 a
a(CbC)10 a
aCbCaCbO
aFaSO2 aFa

188 (279)
200 (256)
250 (350)
185 (230)
217
263
432
220 (350)

900 (15)
4 400 (226)
18 000 (120)
8 000 (2)
20 900
@5  10 4
@2  10 5
2  10 4 (30)

a
a
a

[a] Values

Ketenes
Sulfones

in brackets refer to the secondary absorption band.

should neither absorb nor degrade when exposed to light with wavelength above
@230 nm. In practice, however, the UV absorption spectra of commercial samples
of all the cited polymers show a broad absorbance band which extends well above
the expected limits (Figure 15.8). Generally, these extraneous absorbances are weak
and can be determined only after proper signal processing. This situation is illustrated in Figure 15.9 for commercial additive-free lms of HDPE and iPP.

1.6
PSU, 1m
PET, 2m
PC, 2m
PS, 5m
PMMA, 20m
PVC, 100m

1.4
1.2

absorbance

794

1
0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
200

250

300
wavelength [nm]

UV absorption spectra of some common industrial


polymer lms, at the thickness indicated.
Fig. 15.8.

350

15.5 Photodegradation

3.0

2.0
absorbance

HDPE

iPP

1.0

0.0

160

180

200

220

240
260
280
wavelength [nm]

300

320

340

Fig. 15.9. UV absorption spectra of 50 mm-thick lms of


additive-free commercial HDPE () and iPP (---).

Far-UV spectroscopy indicates that the absorption edge of long-chain alkanes


starts at about 155 nm. Absorption at much longer wavelengths observed in commercial polyolens could be explained only by the presence of chromophore impurities and chemical defects formed during the synthesis, storage, and processing
of the polymer. The absorption peak at 180 nm recorded in HDPE, for instance,
has been attributed to vinylidene end groups, as revealed by independent FTIR
measurements (Figure 15.9).
Impurities in polymers can be classied as internal or external [7].
Internal impurities These are part of the molecular structure, situated either along
the chain or at chain end(s), and may consist of:


Anomalous structural units, which result from the kinetics of polymerization.


In-chain peroxides, formed during polymer synthesis. Free-radical polymerization is generally accomplished without strict exclusion of air and small amounts
of oxygen dissolved in the monomer will be scavenged by the macroradicals and
included in the polymer chain as peroxide linkages. Photolysis of these peroxide
groups gives alkoxy radicals, leading ultimately to hydroperoxides. Alternatively,
if polymerization has been carried at elevated temperatures, the peroxides incorporated will undergo thermal fragmentation and disproportionation to form phenyl alkyl ketone end-group chromophores.
 Carbonyl containing groups formed during material transformation. Processing,
with elevated temperature and high shearing stresses, provides ample opportunities for thermal oxidation. Even at ambient temperature, some polymers such


795

796

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

as isotactic polypropylene or cis-polybutadiene, can be readily oxidized if unstabilized.


External impurities Such impurities are contained in the sample but not incorporated in the polymer structure.
During synthesis, processing and storage, the polymer can be contaminated
or blended with a variety of external chemical species which may contain chromophore and photoreactive groups. Some typical external impurities found in commercial plastics are:


residual catalysts and initiators,


traces of solvents (aromatic solvents, in minute amounts, can act as photosensitizers (Ref. 26, p. 125),
 pigments, dyes, and additives,
 traces of metal, metal oxides, or metal salts from the reactor, processing equipment, and containers.


15.5.2

The Solar Spectrum

The majority of polymer bond dissociation energies are within the 290420
kJ mol1 bracket (allylic CaC being the lowest, and aCH2 aH the highest). The activation energy of photochemical reactions in the gas phase usually lies just a few
percent above the corresponding bond dissociation energy, while it can reach 40
kJ mol1 for diusion-controlled reactions in the condensed state. Therefore, depending on the type of bond to be broken, any absorbed photons with wavelength
shorter than approximately 420 nm for the weakest bonds, to 290 nm for the strongest ones, could promote chain scission.
The importance of photodegradation in outdoor weathering depends much on
the sunlight spectrum. The solar spectral irradiance at the top of the atmosphere
is well-approximated by black-body radiation with a temperature of 5770 K. The
Earths atmosphere, on the other hand, is practically opaque to any wavelength
shorter than about 290 nm as a result of ozone absorption. The UV range of solar
irradiation is commonly divided into three spectral regions of decreasing wavelengths denoted by UV-A, UV-B and UV-C. Although UV-B light is the most ecient at initiating photodegradation, its intensity at the Earths surface is fortunately very limited, owing to the screening eect of ozone, and accounts for
<0.5% of the total radiant energy of @1300 W m2 at noon in the southern regions
(Figure 15.10).
15.5.3

Photo-oxidation Prole

It has long been recognized that photochemical damage is more severe at the surface than in the sample interior. The reasons for this inhomogeneity are twofold:

15.5 Photodegradation

0.7
0.6

UV-C

UV-A

ozone absorption spectrum

0.5
W.m-2.nm-1

UV-B

top of the atmosphere

0.4
0.3
bottom of the atmosphere

0.2
0.1
0
250

300

nm

350

400

Fig. 15.10. Spectral irradiance of sunlight at the top () and


bottom ( ) of the atmosphere, in the summer at latitude
41 N. The dierence results from ozone absorption.

Penetration distance of light For transparent systems, the light intensity Ix decreases with penetration distance x according to the LambertBeer law according
to Eq. (63), where I0 is the incident light intensity, and a the absorption coecient,
which is proportional to the molar absorption coecient e.

Ix I0 expax

63

Because most radiation is polychromatic, the range of available a is broad. For


many materials, the propensity for degradation increases in parallel with the
absorption coecient when the light wavelength decreases. As a consequence,
the depth of penetration decreases for the wavelengths which are most eective
in promoting photodegradation. As the extent of degradation increases, more UVabsorbing substances are formed, which act as surface screeners and further increase the fall-o of the depth of the degraded layer.
For materials which scatter light, such as semicrystalline polymers, and for polymers which contain charges or pigments, the LambertBeer law should be replaced by the KubelkaMunk equation [Eq. (64), with K absorption coecient,
S scattering coecient and R reectance of the material].
K/S 1  R 2 /2R

64

797

798

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

Penetration distance of oxygen Oxidative degradation is a reaction between oxygen


and the polymer. The solubility and diusion coecient of oxygen in solid polymers are typically one order and two orders of magnitude less, respectively, than
in organic liquids. Because of this slow diusion of oxygen, the oxidative rate decreases rapidly with depth from the surfaces. The eect of oxygen diusion can be
modeled by Ficks second law, modied by the rate of oxygen consumption (k). It is
frequently assumed that the rate of oxygen consumption exactly matches the oxygen supply by diusion, that is, d[O2 ]/dt 0. In this steady-state situation, the
oxygen concentration prole does not change with time, resulting in a dierential
equation [Eq. (65)].

Dq 2 O2 /qx  kO2  0

65

The oxygen diusion constant, D, depends on the state of aging process, the reactant concentrations, and the sample morphology (orientation, crystallinity). It follows approximately an Arrhenius-type temperature dependence as in Eq. (66),
where D0 is a proportionality constant, and R the molar gas constant.
66

D D0 expE a /RT

In the case of iPP lm, for instance, the values given by Eqs. (67)(69) have been
determined (Ref. 6, p. 169).
Small-spherulite iPP:

D 26:0 exp43 900/RT cm 2 s1

67

Large-spherulite iPP:

D 3:5 exp38 500/RT cm 2 s1

68

1

69

Oriented iPP:

D 2:0 exp38 500/RT cm s

Free radicals react with oxygen according to reactions (2) and (3) of the simplied
degradation (Scheme 15.1). A simple approximation for kO2  is given by Eq. (70),
where C1 and C2 are constants [34].
kO2  C1 O2 /fC2 O2  1g

70

By combining Eqs. (65) and (70), the oxidation distribution can be calculated by
numerical methods and compared with experiments using some depth-proling
technique (microFTIR on microtome slices, ATR-FTIR, photoacoustic FTIR). The
frequently encountered U-shaped curve indicates a diusional regime, in which
the rate of chemical reactions is limited by oxygen diusion (Figure 15.11). The
temperature coecient of the oxidation rate, 105125 kJ mol1 , is much higher
than the activation energy for oxygen diusion (@40 kJ mol1 ). Thus, by lowering
the temperature, one can reach the kinetic oxidation regime, characterized by an
oxidation rate independent of sample size.

15.5 Photodegradation

0.6

Absorbance (1718 cm-1)

0.5
0.4
0.3
0.2
0.1
0.0
0

50

100

150

200

distance from exposed surface (m)


Fig. 15.11. Typical photodegradation prole for a weakly
UV-absorbing, 200 mm-thick polymer lm.

15.5.4

Inuence of Wavelength: the Activation and Action Spectrum

The actinic eects of UV and visible radiation on material are wavelengthdependent, owing to the spectral selectivity in the absorption of the incident radiation, and the quantum eciency of degradation. The absorption of a photon by a
chromophore promotes an electronic transition between two molecular orbitals of
dierent energies. Starting from the ground state, a transition to a dierent electronic state can be eected by changing the energy of the photon. It is therefore
logical to expect that the irradiation wavelength may have a profound inuence
not only on the rate, but also on the mechanism of photodegradation. The concept
of quantum yield, dened as the number of degraded molecules per absorbed photon, is widely applied in the photochemistry of small organic molecules. It is dicult to apply to industrial plastics, which are complex mixtures of species with variable photon absorption and dierent photophysical and photochemical properties.
Early investigations relied on the notion of an activation spectrum to characterize
the eect of the photon wavelength on the extent of degradation. The activation
spectrum of a material is dened by (i) the spectral absorption properties of the
material; (ii) the emission properties of the light source; (iii) the quantum eciency of the photoinitiated processes; and (iv) the type of degradation being measured.
Although simple to measure, the activation spectrum does not consider the
amount of incident radiant energy present at each wavelength, and is hence depen-

799

800

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

0.9

3.5

increase in absorbance
(left scale)

0.8
0.7

3.0

sample absorbance
(right scale)

0.6

lamp irradiance
(W.m-2.nm-1, left scale)

0.4

1.5

0.3

absorbance

2.0

0.5

1.0

0.2

0.5

0.1
0.0

2.5

280

290

300

310

320

330 340 350


wavelength [nm]

Fig. 15.12. Activation spectrum of a 700 mm


lm of unstabilized bisphenol-A polycarbonate,
based on the increase in absorbance at 310 nm
after accelerated aging with a borosilicate-glass

360

370

380

390

0.0
400

ltered xenon lamp. Superimposed are the


spectral irradiance of the irradiation source
and the UV-absorption spectrum of the
polymer (redrawn from data in Ref. [35]).

dent on the specic light source involved. The action spectrum is introduced to correct for this weakness by explicitly taking into account the eciency of light-induced
damage per incident photon, as a function of irradiation wavelength. Relatively
few investigations have been performed on polymer action spectra until recently,
as a result of the lack of suitable high-intensity, tunable, monochromatic source
for irradiation. The use of sharp-cut lters in pairs with half-height bandwidths of
approximately 20 nm does not usually provide sucient wavelength resolution.
The availability of large spectrographs now allows the recording of continuous activation and action spectra across the whole wavelength range of interest [34].
An action spectrum is a graph of the reciprocal of the radiant exposure required
to produce a given eect (for instance, yellowing index or increase in absorbance
at a standard wavelength) at each wavelength (Figure 15.12). All the data in such
curves are normalized to the datum at the most ecient wavelength. This kind of
plot gives crucial information on the spectral sensitivity of the material. Its knowledge is particularly important for proper comparison between outdoor weathering
and accelerated articial aging, for which the light source spectrum may dier signicantly from solar irradiance.
In most instances, the action spectrum decreases empirically with increasing
irradiation wavelength according to a logarithmic relationship (Figure 15.13B), as
given in Eq. (71), with l irradiation wavelength, and Sl relative spectral
damage [33].

15.5 Photodegradation

30

(A)

radiant energy [J.cm-2]

25

10C

50C

20
15
10
5
0
290

300

310

320

330

340

350

irradiation wavelength [nm]

(B)

ln(radiant energy /J.cm-2)

10C

2
1
50C

0
-1
-2
-3
290

300

310

320

330

340

irradiation wavelength [nm]


Fig. 15.13. Action spectrum of a 700 mm lm of bisphenol-A
polycarbonate, based on the radiant energy required for a 10%
decrease in transmittance at 360 nm: (A) linear plot; (B)
semilogarithmic plot.

350

801

802

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

ln Sl lna  bl

71

Based on absorption and energetic considerations, photochemistry has long relied


on the existence of a critical wavelength below which no reaction should occur
(Section 15.5.1). The question then arises of the limit of applicability of the logarithmic relationship when the irradiation wavelength is much greater than the absorption maximum.
15.5.5

Photodegradation Mechanisms

Photodegradation diers from thermal degradation mainly in the mode of initiation. All the other mechanistic steps bond scission, propagation, chain branching, and termination are similar to thermal degradation. Indirect dierences
may exist, however, between thermal and photodegradation as a result of variations
in experimental conditions, such as a higher temperature for the former mode of
aging which may result in a lower concentration of dissolved oxygen, a lower rate
of peroxide decomposition, or a change in material morphology.
Photoinitiation
It is practical to distinguish two types of initiation: primary, when the radiation is
directly absorbed by the functional group of the polymer; and secondary, when the
radiation is absorbed by certain of the oxidation products (peroxides, carbonyls).
For saturated polymers, such as polyolens, secondary initiation is the predominant mode of initiation, particularly in the latter stages of deterioration.
Formation of excited states following photon absorption constitutes the rst step
in any photochemical reaction. When light is absorbed by a chromophore, either
in-chain or external, the energy is used to promote an electron from the
ground state to an excited state. The excited state can relax back to the ground state
with release of extra energy in the form of a photon or heat. Photochemistry begins
if the energy stored in the excited state is used to drive a chemical reaction. The
rate at which this reaction occurs depends on the energy content (the exciting
wavelength), the chemical nature of the absorbing chromophore, and its environment. The chemistry of the excited state in polymers has been studied with model
compounds. In a real environment, however, the presence of additives, impurities,
residual catalysts, and so on can exert a decisive inuence not only on the degradation rates but also on the degradation mechanisms. The reactions are further complicated by the occurrence of additional chromophores which are formed during
photodegradation. Following the diversity of impurities which can be encountered,
and the complexity of ensuing reactions, there has been much controversy in the
literature about the true photoinitiation mechanisms. This debate, however, is essentially academic, since the initiation mechanism does not inuence the global
rate of photo-oxidation.
Although acting as an external agent, oxygen deserves a special situation, owing
to its presence in any practical weathering situation. Oxygen can be easily con15.5.5.1

15.5 Photodegradation

verted to the singlet state ( 1 Dg or 1 S


g ) by absorption of a photon, or it can be
formed during decomposition of secondary compounds. An important mode of
photoinitiation occurs via a charge-transfer complex between oxygen and the polymer (for instance, a polyolen), with formation of hydroperoxides [Eq. (72)].

R2
R1

R2
H

R1

O2

R2
CH+ -O2
R3

H.....O2

R3

R3

R1

R2
R1

C. .O 2H
R3

72

R2
R1

OOH

R3

In spite of the diversity in photoinitiation mechanisms, two principal modes of reaction can be identied in most commercial polymers: the Norrish photoprocesses
and the photo-Fries rearrangement.
The Norrish Photoprocesses
One common chromophore frequently encountered in a number of polymers is
the carbonyl ketone which shows a weak pp  transition band centered at 280 nm
but extending into the UV-B region. Polymers containing this chromophore undergo two types of photochemical reaction (Scheme 15.2):
15.5.5.2

the Norrish type I reaction, resulting in an a-cleavage with formation of two endpolymeric radicals and carbon monoxide;
 the Norrish type II reaction, which involves an intramolecular H-abstraction via a
cyclic six-membered transition state. The photoscission proceeds by means of a
short-lived triplet state and a biradical intermediate.
Photo-Fries Rearrangement
A second large class of polymers contains phenyl moieties, either in the backbone
(PPO, PC, PET, PSU) or as a side group (PS). Another common phenyl group
photoreaction, when subjected to UV radiation, is the photo-Fries rearrangement
(Scheme 15.3). Upon absorption of a photon, the n- or p-orbital of the chromophore is promoted to a singlet p  excited state. Bond scission occurs primarily at
aromatic ether CaO bonds, and causes rearrangement or degradation of the polymer backbone. Because the photo-Fries rearrangement proceeds in a caged environment, it is independent of free volume and is almost independent of Tg .
The photo-Fries mechanism can be promoted with light in the region above 300
nm (Figure 15.14), and accounts for the yellowing of the polymer observed at long
wavelengths. Chain scission, on the other hand, is promoted by light at shorter
wavelengths. Because photo-Fries products are easily photodegraded, only small
15.5.5.3

803

804

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

Carboxyl in pendent groups


sh
rri
No

CH2CHCH2CHCH2
R

O R

No
rris

CH2CHCH2CHCH2

hI

R
I

Carboxyl in backbone

rr
No

CH2 CH2 C CH2 CH2 CH2

No
rr

I
ish

ish

CH2CH2
R

II

R C

Scheme 15.2.

CH3

CH2 CH2 C CH3


O

CH2
C

CH3

O C O

C
CH3

CH3

hv

CH

* H
O

CH3
C

CH3

O. .C O

CH3

CH3

CH3

OH

C
CH3

CH3

C O

C
CH3

O
CH 3
hv

OH

C
CH 3

C
O

Scheme 15.3.

OH

.CH2 CH2 CH2

H
O
Norrish photoprocesses in carbonyl-containing polymers.
R

CH2=CCH2
R

CH2 CH2 C

CH 2
CH C

hv

Six-membered transition state


CH

.C

CH 3
C
CH 3

Photo-Fries rearrangement in bisphenol-A polycarbonate.

CH2=CH2

15.6 Radiolytic Degradation


9.E-4
8.E-4
7.E-4

quantum yield

6.E-4
5.E-4
4.E-4
3.E-4
2.E-4
1.E-4
0.E+0
250

260

270

280

290

300

310

320

irradiation wavelength [nm]

Fig. 15.14. Quantum yield for chain scission (o), eciency


of photo-Fries rearrangement (k), and absorption spectrum
(--D--) of bisphenol-A polycarbonate [34].

amounts of them remain in aged material, which shows a predominance of sidechain oxidation products.
Once photoradicals are formed, they can either recombine in the cage or diuse
to the outside for further reactions. The radicals formed can undergo a variety of
abstraction and decomposition reactions, resulting in a multitude of chemical
products. The propagation and recombination steps are similar to those encountered in thermal degradation, and will not be discussed further here. In the presence of UV > 240 nm and oxygen, the phenyl groups in PS, PPO, and PC can undergo ring-opening oxidation with formation of mucondialdehyde (Scheme 15.4)
[36].

15.6

Radiolytic Degradation
15.6.1

Interaction of High-energy Radiation with Matter

Understanding the eects of ionizing radiation on the properties of plastics materials is important in nuclear engineering, space research, radiation processing, and
radiation sterilization.
Radiation composed of photons or particles with energy much higher than those
encountered in electron bonding orbitals is referred as high-energy radiation (X- or
g-rays, high-energy electrons, protons, and charged particles). Owing to this excess

805

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

806

(A)

CH3

.CH2

PH

O C

O C

C
CH3

CH3

O
O

CH2

.C

hv/O2

O C

C CH3

C OH

OH

CH3

+ HCOOH + CH3COOH

(B)

.OH
1O

acids, esters

O
Scheme 15.4.

Chain scission (A) and ring-opening (B) reactions in bisphenol-A polycarbonate.

energy, high-energy radiation can penetrate much deeper into material to create
ions, superexcited states, and hot radicals. The degradative eects are also much
more extensive than with UV. The principal sources of high-energy radiation are
electron beam accelerators, which account for 90% of commercial radiation capacity; the remainder consist of 60 Co installations. 60 Co is unstable and decays to the
stable 60 Ni according to Eq. (73).
60

Cot1/2 5:27 y

60

Ni  b 

73

The nuclei of Ni atoms that result from this decay are in an excited state and immediately emit two g-rays of energies 1.332 and 1.173 MeV. The low-energy b  are
absorbed by the 60 Co housing and all the radiolytic eects result from the g-ray
emission.
Electron accelerators can deliver higher dose rates, whereas 60 Co sources are
characterized by a greater depth of penetration.
A fast electron loses most of its kinetic energy by inelastic collisions with electrons from the medium, producing energetic secondary electrons. Depending on
the energy of the radiation, many secondary electrons of decreasing energy will be

15.6 Radiolytic Degradation

blobs 100-500 eV

spurs <100 eV

primary

short tracks <5000 eV

branch tracks >5000 eV


delta rays

Fig. 15.15.

Schematic representation of a fast electron track.

created (d-rays). Owing to the augmentation of linear energy transfer (LET) with
decreasing kinetic energy, the fast electrons lost most of their kinetic energy near
the end of the track, resulting in local regions of highly reactive species called
short tracks, blobs, and spurs (Figure 15.15).
In 60 Co irradiation, the primary interaction is Compton scattering between the
high-energy photon and an atomic electron. Only part of the photon energy is
transferred to the electron and the resultant photon of lower energy is scattered.
The process will continue with creation of more scattered electrons and secondary
electrons (Figure 15.16). Except for the primary event, the eects of g-rays and accelerated electron irradiation are similar. From a single incoming g-photon or highenergy electron, a shower of secondary electrons is generated which is responsible
for most of the ensuing chemical reactions.
15.6.2

Radiation Chemistry

Radiation chemistry is now a well-established area of science that deals with chemical and physicochemical changes produced by the absorption of high-energy radiation (HER) by matter. The subject covers events that occur from the passage of the
ionizing particle to the completion of chemical reactions. To encompass the enor-

hv 2
hv 1
hv 0
e-

ehv 3
e-

Fig. 15.16.

Compton scattering and fate of the secondary electrons.

807

808

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

mous time span for the various processes, it is usual to distinguish between the
physical stage (1017 1011 s) when energy from the incident particle is deposited into localized regions of space (spurr), the physicochemical stage (1012
103 s) during which reactive species (ions, quasi-free electrons, excited molecules,
hot radicals) are formed and react within the spurs, and the chemical stage
(109 103 s in solution, several days in solid polymers) where stable species (radicals, trapped electrons, cations) diuse and react outside the clusters. The standard unit of absorbed dose is the Gray (Gy), dened as the energy imparted by the
high-energy radiation to a mass of matter equivalent to 1 J kg1 (1 Gray 100
rad). Molecular changes are characterized by a G factor, in units of mmol J1 , dened as the event yield per 100 eV of absorbed energy.
Although much discussion has occurred in the past on the relative importance of
radical and ionic reactions, it is now established that the major chemical changes
in irradiated polymers are accounted for by free-radical reactions [37]. In the early
stage of the reactions, the reactive species are concentrated in spurs and particle
tracks in a manner similar to their parent ionized or excited molecules. The kinetics at this point must take into account the inhomogeneous distribution of the
radicals, before they can diuse away. Ionizing radiation is unique in the sense
that reactions can be initiated randomly at any temperature. Cryogenic temperatures, at 4 K and below for instance, have been used extensively to prolong the
macroradicals lifetime for ESR measurements. Apart from the mode of initiation,
all other material changes brought about by high-energy radiation are governed by
radical reactions, in perfect analogy to those generated by other means, such as
photochemical, thermal, or mechanochemical degradation. As a matter of fact, despite the enormous dierence in HER energy (10 6 eV) and molecular binding energy (@5 eV), the chemical eects of HER can best be compared with those of UV
light with energy in the 520 eV range.
The eects of ionizing radiation depend greatly on the structure of the polymer,
the temperature, and the nature of environment. A 50% loss in ultimate elongation (a common measure of the eect of irradiation), for instance, can vary from
doses as low as 3.5 kGy for PTFE, to more than 4000 kGy for PS, polyimide, or
PEEK (Table 15.6). The unusual radiation sensitivity of PTFE is attributed to the
unique stability of peruoro macroradicals which favors chain scission over crosslinking. In the presence of air, these uorine-containing radicals are converted into
peroxy radicals which degrade readily into low MW fragments. PTFE can be crosslinked by HER when irradiated in an inert atmosphere above its melting point
(330340 C). Polymers containing phenyl groups owe much of their radiation resistance to excited-state energy transfer to the benzene rings, which act as excitedstate quenchers (see Section 15.6.3). Although energy transfer is the widely accepted protection mechanism in the HER degradation of aromatic compounds, it
does not explain why styrene does not show the same protective eect as polystyrene. One alternative suggestion is that H atoms resulting from the primary eect
of radiation are added to the aromatic rings, and are no longer able to produce secondary macroradicals by abstraction.

15.6 Radiolytic Degradation


Tab. 15.6. Relative radiation stability in air of major
commercial polymers (based on a 50% decrease in ultimate
elongation).

Polymer

Dose [kGy]

Polytetrauoroethylene
Polytriuorocholorethylene
Poly(methyl methacrylate)
Polycaprolactam
Isotactic polypropylene
High-density polyethylene
Poly(vinyl chloride)
Poly(ethylene terephthalate)
Poly(triethylene glycol dimethacrylate)
Low-density polyethylene
Polyurethanes
Melaminoformaldehyde resin
Polycarbonates
Polystyrene
Epoxy resin ED-10
Epoxy resin ETZ-10
Polyimides

10
30
300
600
1000
1000
1500
2000
2000
3000
3000
4000
5000
5000
15000
30000
100000

The two fundamental processes that result from radiochemical reactions


are chain scission and crosslinking, characterized by Gs and G x , respectively. If
Gs < 4G x , branched polymers can be formed and may eventually evolve into a
three-dimensional network structure. Based on the assumptions that:


the initial polymer MWD follows a random distribution,


cross-linking occurs by H-linking, and
 crosslinking and scission occur with random spatial distribution (without clustering),


Charlesby and Pinner have shown that the sol fraction(s) should follow Eq. (74),
where R [kGy] is the absorbed dose [37].
s s 0:5 0:96  10 5 /R  Mw  G x Gs /2G x

74

The CharlesbyPinner plot of (s s 0:5 ) as a function of 1/R gives a straight line,


with slope m 1/G x , and an intercept on the ordinate equal to Gs /2G x . Departure
of the plot from a straight line may originate from deviation from a random distribution, or from chemical heterogeneities in copolymers. Regardless of the shape of
the curve, the incipient dose for gelation is determined, by denition, from the sol
curve at s s 0:5 2 (Figure 15.17).

809

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization


1980 kGy

870 kGy

50%

s + s

810

38 kGy

100% SAN

70%

1.0
0.72
Gs/2Gx = 0.36

2000

10-3

(kGy/R)

2.10 -3

1000

(R/kGy)

500

CharlesbyPinner plot of irradiated


compatible PMMASAN blends. The sol and
gel fractions refer solely to the SAN
component in the mixture and are corrected
Fig. 15.17.

400

for grafting to PMMA. Large curvatures of the


plot for blends are interpreted as a result of
chemical interactions between the two
components (redrawn from Ref. [38]).

15.6.3

Radiolysis Stabilization

It has been known since the early days of radiation chemistry that some simple
organic compounds, such as benzene, halogenated hydrocarbons, nitriles, amines,
and alcohols, can protect the polymer from the deleterious eects of high-energy
radiation. Many of these antirad substances interfere at some stage with the radiolytic degradation scheme, as depicted in Table 15.7, to reduce damage to the
plastics. The most ecient present-day antirad agents are antioxidants which
act essentially in the chemical stage by scavenging free radicals in a similar way
to that in the other types of degradation. Aromatic compounds are highly ecient
at quenching excess energy of excited states formed by geminal recombination. Because most commercial antioxidants have aromatic rings in their structures, they
can also act as primary absorbers by diverting the radiation energy into harmless
vibrational energy, as in Eqs. (75) and (76).
g; e

P ! fP e gspur ! P  ! 2R




P Q ! P Q

75
76

Aromatic polymers owe much of their radiation resistance to this internal protection eect [40]. An ecient method of radiation protection would be to blend the

15.6 Radiolytic Degradation


Tab. 15.7.

811

Polymer protection scheme during radiolysis.

Radiolysis stage

Physical or chemical event

Protection means

Protection mechanism

Physical
Physicochemical

energy absorption
molecular ionization

sheets of lead or concrete


positive ion scavengers

geminate recombination

electron scavengers

dissociative states

electronic excited-state
quenchers

cleavage of CaH bonds

H atom donors

diusion and abstraction


reactions of mobile H
atoms
reactions of macroradicals

H atom acceptors

decrease in radiation intensity


transfer of one electron to
polymer cation without
subsequent excitation
acceptance of ejected electron
and lower probability of
dissociative recombination
divergence of excitation
energy into heat or longerwavelength electromagnetic
radiation
transfer of H atom to
macroradicals (reparation
mechanism)
acceptance of H atoms,
preventing formation of
more radicals
reaction with macroradicals,
formation of stable species
decrease in oxygen diusion
React with molecular oxygen
under irradiation
Disrupt oxidation chain
reaction by converting
peroxy radicals into stable
products
catalytic destruction of peroxy
radicals

Chemical

reactions of macroradicals
with oxygen
benzophenone derivatives

chain reaction of peroxy


radicals (radio-oxidation)

radical scavengers
surface coatings
oxygen absorbers
Antioxidants

peroxide decomposers

degradative polymer with a radiation-resistant one. Energy transfer (Forster type) is


ecient only at short range and the eect is most noticeable with compatible
blends, such as PMMA and SAN (Figure 15.17).
15.6.4

Applications

High-energy radiation can penetrate deeply into organic materials, and can initiate
reactions at low temperature without added chemicals or catalyst. These unique
features are exploited in an increasing number of industrial applications, particularly in the biomedical eld, in which chemical contamination or thermal degradation should be avoided [41]. Radiation sterilization of medical commodities, one of
the early achievements of radiation engineering, continues to increase its market
share to the detriment of standard methods such as chemical sterilization with di-

812

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

ethyl ether, or heat treatment. In the examples mentioned, the value of the nished
products is generally high and the cost of radiation processing does not enter into
consideration. In other applications, where the product is inexpensive radiation
processing can still be economically viable if the quantity of radiation energy required is low. Radiation treatment of food and radiation-induced grafting or crosslinking of certain plastics belong to the latter category. Food is commonly irradiated at low doses in the 0.110 kGy range, in ordinary boxes or containers. Food
preservation by irradiation is gaining acceptance for an ever-increasing number of
agrochemical products such as spices, vegetables, and processed meat. This technique is currently viewed as the most eective of the available alternatives (cold
storage, heat treatment, fumigants).
Radiation Sterilization
Disposable medical products are required by legislation to be sterilized prior to
use. Among the four basic methods of sterilization heat, ethylene oxide, gamma
irradiation ( 60 Co), and electron beam techniques the last has steadily increased
its market share, largely at the expense of the diethyl ether method as a result of
regulatory concerns about the quantity of chemical residuals. The Federal Drug
Administration (FDA) in the US allows a device to be labeled as sterile if less
than one device out of a batch of one million can show biological contamination.
The standard dose to achieve this level is 25 kGy. Medical plastics that need to be
sterilized must withstand at least this dose. The data given in Table 15.6 can be
used as an initial estimate in material selection. Materials which are likely to degrade, such as PTFE or POM, should be avoided. Polymers containing aromatic
groups have much greater radiation resistance than those with an aliphatic structure. Similar improvements can be obtained with crosslinks, and most thermosets and elastomers can withstand at least one radiation sterilization. The use of
antioxidant additives can signicantly oset the eects of radiation, and even a
radiation-sensitive polymer such as polypropylene can withstand several radiation
sterilization cycles when properly stabilized.
15.6.4.1

Controlled Degradation and Crosslinking


The reactions of chain scission, crosslinking, and grafting initiated by ionizing radiation have found many important applications in the plastics and rubber industries. Although high-energy radiation is destructive for most materials, this propensity can be usefully exploited in the controlled degradation of several polymers,
such as PTFE, PEO, PP and cellulose. The most well-known example of degradation application is the manufacture of PTFE powders. Undegraded PTFE is too
tough and slippery to grind. After submitting the polymer to a high dose range
(5001000 kGy), the degraded PTFE becomes brittle and can be converted to ne
particles while conserving its low surface energy. The PTFE powder is used as a
solid lubricant, or formulated as grease for high-temperature applications.
Radiation crosslinking is another way to tailor properties to specic applications.
High-energy radiation provides a clean and cost-eective method to achieve this
means. The technique has been applied in the crosslinking of high-purity medical
15.6.4.2

15.7 Mechanochemical Degradation

products, such as gloves and condoms, orthopedic ultra-high MW PE hip joints,


and biocompatible hydrogels. Other important industrial applications of radiation
crosslinking include the production of heat-shrinkable products, wires, cables, and
tubing.

15.7

Mechanochemical Degradation [42]


15.7.1

Initiation by Mechanical Stresses


Eect of Tensile Stress on Chemical Reactivity
The input of external energy, of either thermal or electromagnetic origin, is well
known to the organic chemist as an ecient way to promote chemical reactions.
Mechanical energy, although ubiquitous in everyday life, is rarely considered as a
bona-de source of chemical activation. The main reason probably stems from the
ineciency of this mode of excitation for small molecules where most of the applied mechanical energy is readily dissipated into heat and the work of bulk deformation, leaving little available as chemical potential. In polymer systems, on the
contrary, mechanochemical reactions are ubiquitous as a result of the unique propensity of macromolecules to store free energy upon deformation and to sustain a
high level of stress for a suciently long time for chemical reactions to occur. Mechanochemical degradation is ubiquitous in macromolecular systems and can be
encountered in practically any eld involving high MW polymers. The formation
of free radicals by mechanical stress has been detected during polymer processing,
analysis, weathering, and gel swelling. Chain scission has also been observed in
applications as diverse as drag reduction, rubber mastication, and mechanochemical synthesis. It was known for centuries that the application of stress under certain conditions, such as the combing of wool, the mastication of rubber, or the
kneading of dough, can improve the physical properties of a few materials which
were later recognized as being polymeric.
Following the application of stress, a molecular system will attempt to minimize
its total free energy by a series of congurational rearrangements, such as kink
annihilation, chain disentanglement, and orientation. According to molecular mechanics, the excess energy of stress (Es ) in a chemical system comes from several
sources, namely nonvalence and coulombic interactions, torsional deformation,
and angular and valence-bond strain energies. Among the dierent modes of molecular deformation, bond-angle distortion and valence-bond stretching have the
most profound inuence on the electronic density distribution, and hence on the
chemical reactivity. In the region of stresses of around 80 GPa, the valence angles
for CaC bonds will become deformed from their equilibrium positions whereas
bond stretching and rupture occur at some still-higher values in the vicinity of
740 GPa. Although stress-induced chemical reactivity can be explained only by
quantum mechanical calculations, as was done for the acceleration eect of water
15.7.1.1

813

814

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

during crack propagation of silica glasses, a qualitative picture can be gained based
on mechanical arguments. In carbocyclic compounds, Es originates principally
from valence-angle deformation and it is well known that ring strain could aect
the rate of some chemical reactions in a drastic way. For example, if the transition
state necessitates distortion of the valence-bond angle from y0 to y  , the valence
bond-angle contribution to the activation energy is given by Eq. (77), where ky is
the elastic constant for bond-angle deformation.
E ang 12ky y0  y  2

77

If, however, the same bond angle is already distorted from y0 to y under mechanical stress, the activation energy will be given by Eq. (78), resulting in a dierence of
DE ang [Eq. (79)].
E ang 12ky y  y  2
DE ang

1
2ky y0

78
 2

 2

 y  y  y 

79

In solid polymers, rate enhancement under stress has frequently observed, for
example in UV-photo-oxidation of natural silk, polycaprolactam, and poly(ethylene
terephthalate). However, quantitative interpretation is dicult in these systems
due to interdependence of several stress-dependent factors such as the rate of oxygen diusion or changes in polymer morphology which supersede the elementary
molecular steps. Similar experiments in the uid state showed unequivocally that
ow-induced stresses can accelerate several types of reaction, the best studied
being the hydrolysis of DNA and polyacrylamide. In these examples, hydrolysis
involves breaking of the ester OaPO and the amide NaCO bonds. The tensile
stress stretches the chain, and therefore facilitates the formation of a transition
state in which the bond length is increased for hydrolysis, thus enhancing the
rate constant for the process. Other documented examples of stress-induced chemical reactions are the acylation of cellulose and the addition of 4-hydroxy-2,2,6,6tetramethylpiperidine-1-oxy to rubber during mastication.
Breaking Strength of a Covalent Bond
Initiation in mechanochemical degradation involves homolytic scission, so one
basic question would be what level of stress is necessary to separate two chemical
moieties which have been attached by a covalent bond. The earliest account for this
problem was reported by de Boer in 1936 [42]. The potential of a bond under equilibrium is normally approximated by the Morse potential, given by Eq. (80) where l
is the length of the bond, l 0 is the equilibrium separation distance of the atoms, D
is the bond dissociation energy, a kf /2D 0:5 is a parameter which denes the
width of the potential minimum, and kf is the bond force constant in the neighborhood of the equilibrium separation.
15.7.1.2

Vl D1  expal  l 0  2

80

15.7 Mechanochemical Degradation


Morse potential
Morse potential for a stressed bond

1.0

mechanical potential

V(l)/D

0.8

0.6

0.4

0.2

D'

0.0

-0.2

-2

-1

l-l0

Fig. 15.18. The Morse potential of a bond under equilibrium


(----) and in the presence of an applied force equal to 0.6 fb
(----).

If the bond is under tension with a constant force fext pulling on either end, the
potential energy V 0 l will be decreased by an amount equivalent to the work performed by the mechanical force over the stretching distance from the equilibrium
position [Eq. (81); Figure 15.18].
V 0 l Vl  l  l e ; where C is a proportional factor

81

The potential function V 0 l has a minimum at l00 > l 0 , in accord with the intuitive
expectation that the bond separation should increase in the presence of a tensile
stress. The new activation energy (D 0 ) required to break the stressed bond could
be calculated from the principle of virtual work performed on the bond in going
from l00 to l b (Figure 15.19).
Rate of Stress-activated Chain Scission
From a chemical viewpoint, bond scission under stress is a particular case of a unimolecular dissociation reaction whose rate is enhanced by mechanical stress. As
such, it could be treated with Eyrings transition-state theory [Eq. (37)], which permits one to bring the treatment of rate processes within the scope of thermodynamic arguments. By combining de Boers thermodynamic formulation and the
transition-state theory, Tobolsky and Eyring in 1943 developed the rate theory for
thermally activated fracture of polymeric threads. When put into an Arrhenius15.7.1.3

815

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization


0.4

0.2

f(l)/Da

816

l0'

0.0
0

lb
1

lf
2

l-l 0
-0.2

-0.4

Fig. 15.19. Derivative of the Morse potential. The hatched area


corresponds to the bond energy under stress.

like form, Eq. (82) was obtained, where k c is the rate constant for bond scission,
U0 , the thermal energy for bond rupture, and c the molecular stress.
k c A expfU0  f cg/kB T 

82

Several attempts to relate the rate for bond scission (k c ) to the molecular stress
have been reported over the years. The simplest and still the most popular is a linear relationship [Eq. (83)] between the decrease in activation energy and molecular
stress [42].
f c bs

83

The factor b has the dimension of volume and is identied as the activation volume for the reaction.
15.7.2

Extrusion Degradation

To achieve useful properties, polymers are generally compounded with a variety of


additives, transformed into granulates, before being processed into the nal shape
for commercial exploitation. During each step, the material is exposed to a high
shear-rate and temperature. The two major sources of chemical degradation during
processing are therefore mechanical stresses, which tend to decrease with increased temperature as with the melt viscosity, and thermal reactions. As a result
of excessive pressure within the equipment in the course of processing, oxygen

15.7 Mechanochemical Degradation

from the air generally has no access to the polymer melt. Except during the initial
stage, when dissolved air can be used up at high rate, most of the degradation occurs under oxygen-decient conditions. This feature has been veried during multiple extrusion of polypropylene [44]. In this experiment, as in other similar experiments, the concentrations of oxidation products detected by FTIR were very low.
On the other hand, changes in the MW and MWD were always observed during
extrusion. Because the MWD is of the utmost importance for the rheological properties, it is important to know the molecular parameters which may inuence the
rates of chain scission and crosslinking. Oxidative b-scission of alkoxy radicals is
relatively unimportant in extrusion, as a result of lack of oxygen and low activation
energy (59 kJ mol1 ). The majority of chain scissions are caused by the b-cleavage
of alkyl radicals, with activation energies of 84117 kJ mol1 . Cleavage of a secondary alkyl radical or a tertiary radical produces a vinyl (H2 CbCHR) or vinylidene
group (H2 CbCRR 0 ), respectively. A kinetic model for PE crosslinking and scission
involving alkyl radicals under processing conditions has been developed, based on
and activation energy of 146 kJ mol1 for chain scission, and 96 kJ mol1 for crosslinking. As a result of the dierence in activation energies, crosslinking tends to
dominate at low temperatures and scission at high temperatures. Crosslinking reactions are attributed to the addition of alkyl radicals to vinyl groups, either initially
present during synthesis or formed by thermal scission.
15.7.3

Applications

One of the earliest industrial applications of mechanochemical degradation was in


the mastication of rubber, to reduce the MW of the latex to a level which could be
processed. Rubbers vulcanized with a conventional high sulfur/accelerator system
are known to be more resistant to fatigue than peroxide-cured rubbers and rubbers
cured by sulfur-free or low-sulfur systems. This behavior was associated with the
presence of polysuldic (aCaSn aCa) crosslinks in the conventional vulcanizate
[45]. Because the SaS bonds are more labile than the CaC bonds (see Figure
15.18), it is postulated that they can be easily broken under fatigue, resulting in
the release of local stresses during bond rearrangement.
Mechanochemical degradation creates free macroradicals in pairs, practically
without any side reactions, and most potential applications of this technique are
centered around the formation and subsequent reactions of these reactive species.
Elongational ow-induced degradation breaks polymer chains exactly at their center [42, 46]. This remarkable propensity is being explored in the authors laboratory
as a simple means of obtaining well-dened block copolymers. Polymerization and

CC
410 kJmol-1
Fig. 15.20.

CSC

CSSC

C(S)nC

350 kJmol-1

300 kJmol-1

260 kJmol-1

Bond dissociation energies in vulcanized rubber.

817

818

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

synthesis of block or graft copolymers by mechanical forces have been the subjects
of several reviews and books [47]. Although mechanochemical synthesis of inorganic materials has enjoyed wide industrial application, no similar development
has yet been witnessed with plastic materials.

15.8

Control and Prevention of Aging of Plastic Materials

It has been shown in the preceding sections that raw polymers are highly susceptible to degradative oxidation. The success of plastic materials, which nd applications in practically any aspect of life, relies heavily on the performance of polymer
stabilizers, 70% of which are used for polyolens. According to their principal protection activity, common polymer stabilizers are conventionally classied as antioxidants, photoantioxidants, photostabilizers, metal deactivators, antiozonants, and
heat stabilizers for PVC.
15.8.1

Antioxidants

Antioxidants prolong the useful lifetime of the polymer by trapping free radicals
(primary antioxidants) and by decomposing hydroperoxides (secondary antioxidants) formed during the course of degradation.
Radical Antioxidants
Since polymer degradation is initiated by free radicals, the most eective approach
in both heat and light stabilization would be to reduce the number of reactive radical species by scavenging. Secondary aromatic amines and substituted phenol derivatives are among the most popular radical-scavenging stabilizers. The stabilization action of these compounds is based on the formation of aminoxy and phenoxy
radicals, respectively, which can scavenge propagating radicals formed during degradation. Amine additives are converted into conjugated secondary products which
absorb visible light. For this reason, hindered phenols are preferred in applications
where discoloration is undesirable. Typical phenolic antioxidants are shielded with
bulky alkyl substituents in the 2-, 4- and 6-positions to reduce the reactivity of phenoxy radicals toward hydrogen atom abstraction reactions on polymer and mutual
coupling. The principal mode of action of hindered phenols is the transfer of a hydrogen atom to a propagating alkyl (R) or alkylperoxy (ROO) radical [Eq. (84)].
15.8.1.1

ROO

+ HO

R'

ROOH

R'

84

15.8 Control and Prevention of Aging of Plastic Materials

The phenoxy radicals are relatively long-lived and can undergo self-disproportionation, recombination with alkylperoxy radicals, or isomeric rearrangement followed
by recombination. The resulting compounds may have some stabilization activity.
Propionate-type hindered phenols constitute a special class in this category: during
reaction, the phenol is transformed into phenolic cinnamates, which are known to
be ecient chain-breaking antioxidants [Eq. (85)].

OH

CH CH2COR

CH 2CH 2COR

O
CH2CH 2COR

OH
O
CH=CHCOR

85

Hindered Amine Stabilizers (HAS)


With a few exceptions, such as hydroxybenzoate derivatives, most conventional
phenolic antioxidants suer from low photostabiliy and could not be used for photostabilization. This problem was solved with the introduction and development of
hindered amine light stabilizers (HAS) [49]. Because this class of compounds was
originally developed for photostabilization, they are frequently referred as hindered amine light stabilizers or HALS. HAS are commercialized under a variety
of structures, most of which contain one or several 2,2,6,6-tetramethylpiperidine
moieties linked together to form polynuclear species. The structure of a typical
commercial HAS, Chimassorb2 944, is shown in Figure 15.21.
The protection mechanisms of HAS are based on a complex series of chemical
transformations, with many unresolved details. The primary step includes oxidation in situ of secondary or tertiary HAS into nitroxides aNO by the various
oxidants present during oxidative degradation [Eq. (86)]. The substituent can be
H, CH3 , OR, or COCH3 , and the oxidative species 3 O2 , 1 O2 , O3 , POO, POOH,
PC(O)OO, or PC(O)OOH.
15.8.1.2

aNaR oxidative species !! aNO products

86

Stable nitroxide radicals are traditionally considered as the principal species which
account for the free-radical scavenging activity of HAS. Nitroxide radicals can trap
alkyl, alkylperoxy and acylperoxy radicals. The probability of direct radical scaveng-

819

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

H
N

N
N

N
N
CH3

CH3

CH2

N
Fig. 15.21.

(CH2)6

CH3

Structure of a typical commercial hindered amine stabilizer (HAS).

ing, such as in Eq. (87), is nevertheless limited as a result of the higher rate for
competitive reactions of R with dissolved oxygen and by self-recombination.
a

aNO R ! aNOR

87

As with the formation of peracids, it is suggested that scavenging occurs inhomogeneously and is enhanced in regions of accumulated hydrogen-bonded complexes, owing to the formation in situ of R [Eq. (88)].
a

820

f aNO    HOORg ! f aNO; HO; ROg ! f aNO; R 0 g

88

The formation of hydrogen-bonded associates with hydroperoxides or phenolic additives is favored by the resonance-stabilized dipolar structure of nitroxides represented by Eq. (89).

89

The transformed hydroxylamines and dialkylhydroxylamine ethers are assumed to


play a key role in the mechanism of stabilization of HAS, through a regenerative
inhibition cycle known as the Denisov cycle [Eqs. (90a)(90c)] [50].

NOCHCH 2 + ROO

NO + CH=CH + ROOH

90a

NO +

C=O + ROH

90b

NO + ROOCCH2

90c

Tertiary hydroxylamine ethers, the main constituent in degraded polypropylene,


lead preferentially to the formation of alkyl peroxides [Eq. (90c)].

15.8 Control and Prevention of Aging of Plastic Materials

There is increasing evidence that other regeneration mechanisms are involved,


such as scavenging of alkylperoxy or peracyl radicals by hydroxylamines and alkylhydroxylamines according to Eq. (91).
O.

NOCHR1R2 + ROO. (RCOO.)

N+

OCHR1R2 .... RO.

NO. + O=CR1R2 + ROH (RCOH)


O

91
Another proposed mechanism of action involves long-range energy transfer from
polymeroxygen exciplexes to HAS or HASoxygen complexes [49]. This process
is particularly ecient in inhibiting photoinitiation which takes place essentially
at the crystalline/amorphous interface, where the HAS is concentrated.
Basicity of HAS Secondary and tertiary HAS are relatively basic and may catalyze
hydrolysis of some polycondensation polymers, such as polycarbonate. HAS lose
their activity if they come into contact with strong acids, and hence cannot be
used to stabilize PVC or in formulations which contain halogenated ame retardants. HAS with an acylated amino group ( aNCOCH3 ) has a lower pK a and can
better resist an acidic environment.

Thermal stabilization with HAS As a result of its protection mechanism, HAS are
particularly eective in photodegradation. Recently, it has been assessed that HAS
can also be used for thermal degradation. In this case, however, HAS should be
used in combination with hindered phenols because many degradation products
of HAS, which are ecient antioxidants, can be formed only with light.
Peroxide Decomposers
Peroxides are responsible for the autoacceleration stage during oxidative degradation of polymers. Hydroperoxide decomposers, which cause the reduction of hydroperoxides to alcohols, comprise two main chemical classes: organic sulfur and
trivalent phosphorus compounds, generally used in combination with phenolic
antioxidants. The decomposition mechanism is complex and involves radical and
nonradical processes. During the course of decomposition, a mixture of oxidation
products, generally endowed with additional peroxidolytic properties, are formed.
For instance, the decomposition of a thioether in the presence of alkyl hydroperoxides can be represented schematically by a series of reactions [Eq. (92)] which involve thiyl RS, sulnyl RS(O), sulfonyl RS(O)2 , and perthiyl RSS radicals.
15.8.1.3

821

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

822

RaOaCaCH2 2 a2 S ! RaOaCaCH2 2 a2 SO


! RaOaCaCH2 2 aSOOH H2 CbCaCaOaR !    ! SO2 ; H2 SO4 ; . . .

92

Sulfur dioxide and sulfuric acid, both of which are also active hydroperoxide decomposers, are formed at the ultimate stage of transformation.
Organic phosphites are very eective hydroperoxide decomposers. Their peroxidolytic activity results from a sacricial transformation of phosphite (trivalent) to
phosphate (pentavalent), according to the general reaction scheme in Eq. (93).
RaOOH POR 0 3 ! ROH ObPOR 0 3

93

15.8.2

Photostabilizers

Outdoor weathering is the most common source of polymer degradation. The most
direct and ecient way to avoid photodegradation would be to prevent the photons
from reaching the polymer either by applying a paint or coating to the surface, or
by blending the polymer with strong light-absorbing particles such as carbon black.
This procedure, however, is inapplicable for situations where aesthetic appearance
or transparency of the material is essential.
UV absorbers The use of organic compounds with a high absorption coecient in
the UV but transparent to the visible, known as UV absorbers, should act in a similar fashion to paints, by protecting the polymer while conserving the optical clarity
of the material. Paints and coatings themselves are not stable to solar radiation and
are often compounded with UV absorbers to prolong their protection eciency. To
be useful, UV absorbers must strongly absorb at wavelengths harmful to the polymer, must harmlessly dissipate the energy that they absorb, and must persist in
the matrix for the expected lifetime of the article. Most commercial UV absorbers
are derivatives of benzophenone, benzotriazole, triazine, oxanilide, or cyanoacrylate
with aromatic substituents. All have a highly delocalized p-electron structure with a
high extinction coecient (e 10 00040 000 L mol1 cm1 ) in the near-UV region (290350 nm). The photostability of benzophenone-based UV absorbers is
conferred by intramolecular proton transfer in the excited state, and most likely
by a charge-separation mechanism in the case of a cyanoacrylate structure.

hv
O

heat

CN
COOR

Energy dissipation mechanism for a protic (left)


and a cyanoacrylate (right) UV absorber.

Scheme 15.5.

hv

heat

CN
COOR

15.8 Control and Prevention of Aging of Plastic Materials

Quenchers Quenchers are used to capture the excess energy of excited chromophores [Eqs. (94) and (95)], which is then dissipated as vibrational energy, before
they can initiate harmful reactions.

P ! P  ! radicals

94

P Q ! P Q

95

Eective quenchers are based on nickel complexes (phenolate, dithiocarbamate, dithiophosphate) and are used almost exclusively in polyolens at a concentration of
0.20.5%. Nickel complexes impart a green coloration to plastic articles and their
importance was signicantly reduced with the introduction of hindered amine
light stabilizers (HALS).
15.8.3

PVC Heat Stabilizers

In spite of its inherent thermal instability (see Section 15.3.4), PVC possesses several attractive properties, such as economy of production and processing, and the
ease of variation of its properties, with appropriate blending with other polymers
or additives, from hard and tough materials to elastomeric ones. Currently, PVC
ranks second only to polyolens in terms of worldwide production among industrial polymers. This technical success is the result of considerable research in the
eld of degradation and stabilization of this polymer since its introduction as a
commodity plastic in the middle of the 20th century.
The low thermal stability of PVC originates from the presence of labile structures and of the autocatalytic deleterious eect of the hydrochloric acid evolved.
Thermal stabilizers for PVC consist principally of metal carboxylates and organotin
compounds (primary stabilizers), used in combination for preventive and curative
functions. As with degradation, uncertainties continue to exist in the exact stabilizing mechanisms of these additives. There is evidence that organotin derivatives stabilize PVC by substituting the labile allylic chorine with a more thermally stable
thioether group [Eq. (96)].
C4 H9 2 SnSCH2 COOaC8 H17 2 aCH2 aCHbCHaCHClaCH2 a
! aCH2 aCHbCHaCHSCH2 COOaC8 H17 aCH2 a
ClaSnC4 H9 2 SCH2 COOaC8 H17

96

Hydrogen chloride is bound with metallic (Zn, Ca, Ba) organic acid salts with formation of the metal chloride and the corresponding free fatty acids. The formation
of polyene sequences can be prevented by combination reactions with thiol or maleate derivatives. Although ecient in blocking the degradation, most of the inor-

823

824

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

ganic stabilizers leave toxic residues and current research is focused on the development of new, less polluting, organic stabilizers.
15.8.4

Other Classes of Stabilizers


Metal Deactivators
Very often, thermoplastics contain minute amounts of metallic compounds which
originate from polymerization catalysts, contaminated llers, polymerization or
processing equipment, or metal contact (wire and cable insulators) during the use
of the polymer. The interactions between the polymer and metallic substances are
complex, but generally result in the accelerated aging of the material. Most metal
deactivators are bifunctional stabilizers with phenolic and nitrogen, or phenolic
sulde and phosphite, moieties in their structure, and act by a chelating action
which reduces the harmful eects of the metal ions.
15.8.4.1

Antiozonants
Diene-type rubbers are particularly sensitive to ozone attack and should be protected by antiozonants. Common antiozonants are aromatic diamines capable of
direct ozone scavenging by adduct formation.
15.8.4.2

15.9

Lifetime Prediction

Most of the additives used to protect the polymer from degradation are eventually
consumed during the stabilization processes. In addition to chemical loss, the stabilizers can also be depleted by precipitation, migration to the surface, and extraction. For all these reasons, the concentration of additives diminishes with time up
to a point where no protection eect could be observed. In general, the stabilization lifetime increases with the amount of added stabilizer, up to an optimum determined by the nite solubility of the additives in bulk polymers, or by secondary
reactions which may have adverse eects on the stabilization mechanisms (Figure
15.22).
Excluding disposable devices, most plastic materials are expected to perform reliability for many decades. In general, outdoor weathering of stabilized samples is
too slow to be useful for quality control or for formulation development. As a remedy for this aw, a number of accelerated weathering tests have been devised. Depending on the type of degradation, accelerated tests can be obtained by increasing
the temperature (thermal degradation), or increasing the light intensity (photodegradation) and/or the partial oxygen pressure (oxidative degradation). Owing to
its economic relevance, photoaccelerated aging is enjoying the most dramatic development, with numerous commercial systems based on a UV source or mirrors
designed to mimic the action of the Sun, with a several-fold increase in irradiation
intensity. Most of the time, results of accelerated aging show poor correlation not

15.9 Lifetime Prediction

0%

0.01%

0.1%

0.2

carbonyl index

0.15
0.5%

0.1

0.05

0
0

100

200

300

400

500

600

irradiation time [h]


Photo-oxidation of commercial polypropylene, in
the absence and in the presence of the indicated
concentrations of hindered amine stabilizer.
Fig. 15.22.

only with outdoor weathering, but also between dierent devices, or for identical
devices between dierent laboratories. This lack of correlation is not entirely unexpected, in view of the wide variability inherent in weathering conditions: biological disturbances, pollution, climate (temperature, humidity, wet periods); and
changes in the spectrum and intensity of the source with aging, and in the test duration. In addition to the external factors, more fundamental reasons for deviations
could be traced back to the bimolecular reactions between intermediate species,
whose concentrations in real conditions are too low to interact, or to diusional
processes of the reactants (oxygen, water, stabilizers) that become limiting factors
in accelerated conditions. By using conditions which mimic exact weathering conditions in terms of spectral distribution, temperature, and oxygen uptake, but with
a dierent photon intensity, it has been assessed that accelerated aging in polyolens is not mechanistically dierent from natural weathering. Therefore, an extrapolation procedure between these two modes of degradation is possible, providing
all the dynamics (diusion) factors could be kept under control. Identifying and
controlling all the dynamics factors in a real system is nevertheless a challenging
task.
To account for the poor reproducibility in accelerated aging, statistical approaches have been proposed, such as the nonparametric statistics which relies
on performance comparison with a control material. The control material should
be as similar as possible to the tested polymer in terms of structures, size, and
shape, and its weathering durability should be well established in the specied exposure test. One useful approach to reduce error analysis was to compare a test
property, not as a function of time or absorbed radiation, but relative to another

825

826

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

process going on in the aging material. The objective sought is to have the rates of
the two processes occur in the same relationship relative to one another under a
wide range of experimental conditions, from natural to accelerated test conditions.
The process of interest should be easy to determine and sensitive to low levels of
degradation, to minimize the extrapolation range. In thermal aging of nitrile rubber, for instance, it has been found that the ultimate tensile elongation shows good
correlation with the rate of oxygen consumption over the experimentally accessible
temperature range for mechanical measurements, which was 9671.5 C. At lower
temperatures, the time to failure was inconveniently long for measurement. Oxygen consumption, on the other hand, could be determined by gas chromatography
all the way down to room temperature. Based on indirect evidence that the chemistry underlying oxygen consumption is responsible for changes in modulus and
elongation values, a lifetime of 100 years was predicted for the elastomer in ambient conditions. It should be noted that an Arrhenius plot extrapolation, based
solely on the mechanical properties at elevated temperatures, predicted a lifetime
of 50 000 years, which is some 500 times longer than the correctly estimated value
[15].

15.10

Conclusions

This chapter has given a general description of some recent advances in the eld of
polymer degradation and stabilization. Despite a considerable volume of work and
equally impressive progress in the comprehension of the molecular mechanisms
which underlie polymer degradation, many challenging problems are still open to
further investigation. The ever-increasing complexity of commercial plastics, which
includes the use of copolymers, polymer blends, and dierent combinations of additives in their formulations, adds another degree of diculty to the already complex problem of polymer degradation. Each type of interaction between the dierent components in the formulation, both polymeric and nonpolymeric, may
inuence dierently the degradation process. In particular, the antagonistic and
synergistic eects between stabilizers in additive blends need better mechanistic
comprehension.
Two main areas where major advances can be expected in the future include integral characterization of the degraded polymer, and realistic modeling of degradation kinetics.
Most degradation and stabilization mechanisms reported in the literature are inferred from the observation of a few end products (generally carbonyl and hydroxyl
compounds, which can be easily monitored by FTIR). A comprehensive characterization of the starting material, and of the degradation products at dierent stages
of aging, is still lacking in most investigations. Such a complete chemical identication, which appears to be feasible with the modern analytical techniques available, is a prerequisite to establish a correlation between eects of specic structures on the behavior of signicant degradation intermediates.

Notation

The inhomogeneity of reaction sites, inherent in solid-state reactions, may lead


to distributions of reactivity and to time-dependent rate constants. These eects
should be recognized and taken into account when performing kinetics analysis.
This is consequential to the problem of stabilization, since additives need to diuse
toward degradation centers for the stabilization process to be operative. Some heterogeneous reaction models aimed toward a better description of radical chain processes in solid polymers have appeared in the literature. One of these models, the
infectious spreading reaction, has been examined in Section 15.4.5. Among other
advances in solid polymer degradation, one can cite:


the concept of polychronal kinetics which was introduced to explain the stepwise conversion of reactive species under isothermal conditions [6]; and
 the spongy micelle microreactor model in which the amorphous phase in a
semicrystalline polymer is depicted as formed by granule-core zones, surrounded by oriented domains close to the crystallites [51]. By applying dierent chemical kinetics scheme to each zone, with allowance for interzone radical migration, the autooxidation curve of polyolens can be faithfully reproduced.
It is found that the induction period for oxygen consumption corresponds to the
homogeneous oxidation stage, whereas the (exponential) autoaccelerated stage
may be interpreted as a result of heterogeneous oxidation spreading of low MW
peroxides. This model refutes the interpretation of chain branching as a source
of oxidation autoacceleration.
All these theories need to be conrmed by experimental verication and tested for
their general applicability to dierent polymer systems.

Notation

As
a
D
De
E
Ea
Es
E ang
DE 0
DH
h
I0
Ix
K
k

infrared absorption intensity [cmmmol1 ]


constant of the Morse potential [m1 ]
oxygen diusion constant [cm2 s1 ]
bond dissociation energy [kJmol1 ]
tensile modulus [GNm2 ]
energy of activation [kJmol1 ]
excess energy of stress [kJmol1 ]
valence-bond angle contribution to the activation energy [kJmol1 ]
molecular energy dierence at absolute zero between the activated
complex and the reactant [J]
enthalpy of reaction [kJmol1 ]
Plancks constant 6.62561034 [Js]
incident light intensity [Wm2 ]
light intensity [Wm2 ]
KubelkMunk absorption coecient [cm1 ]
rate of reaction [s1 ] (rst-order), [Lmol1 s1 ] (second order)

827

828

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

kf
kB
kc
ky
l
l0
Mi
Mn
Mv
Mw
N
n
n
ni
pd
pi
pr
Q
qz
qA
R
R
R
r
S
Sl
s
T
T1/2
Tg
Tm
ti
t1/2
U0
Vl
x

bond force constant in the neighborhood of the equilibrium separation of two chemical moieties [Nm1 ]
Boltzmanns constant 1.3801023 [JK1 ]
rate constant for bond scission [s1 ]
elastic constant for bond-angle deformation [Nrad1 ]
length of a covalent bond [nm]
equilibrium separation distance of the atoms in a bond [nm]
molecular weight of ith polymer [gmol1 ]
number-average molecular weight [gmol1 ]
viscosity-average molecular weight [gmol1 ]
weight-average molecular weight [gmol1 ]
total number of amorphous domains
number of polymer chains per gram of polymer [g1 ]
number of oxidized domains
polymer molar fraction
dead or oxidized fraction of polymer
infectious oxidizing fraction of polymer
remaining unoxidized fraction of polymer
normal coordinate of vibration [nm]
molecular partition function of the transition state
molecular partition function of the reactant
reectance
molar gas constant 8.314 [Jmol1 K1 ]
absorbed dose of radiation [Gy or Jkg1 ]
rate coecient for spreading [s1 ]
KubelkaMunk scattering coecient [m1 ]
relative spectral damage
scission indice
temperature [ C]
temperature of half-decomposition [ C]
glass transition temperature [ C]
melting point [ C]
induction period [ C]
half-life [s]
thermal energy for bond rupture [kJmol1 ]
Morse potential [J]
penetration distance [m]

Greek
a
b
l
l max
e

absorption coecient [cm1 ]


activation volume for a reaction [m3 mol1 ]
irradiation wavelength [nm]
wavelength of light absorption peak [nm]
extinction coecient [Lmol1 cm1 ]

Notation

m
n
y
c

dipole moment [Cm]


frequency of band center [cm1 ]
angle [rad]
molecular stress [GNm2 ]

Acronyms
ATR-FTIR
ESR
FDA
FTIR
iPP
GPC
HAS
HDPE
HER
LDPE
LET
HAS
HOMO
LUMO
MIM
MW
MWD
NMR
PA
PAN
PC
PEEK
PET, PETP
PIB
PMMA
PMMASAN
POM
PP
PPO
PPP
PS
PSU
PTFE
PVC
SEM
TG
VC

attenuated total reection FTIR


electron spin resonance
Federal Drug Administration
Fourier Transform infrared spectroscopy
isotactic polypropylene
gel permeation chromatogaphy
hindered amine stabilizer
high-density polyethylene
high-energy radiation
low-density polyethylene
linear energy transfer
hindered amine light stabilizer
highest occupied molecular orbital
lowest unoccupied molecular orbital
metal injection molding
molecular weight
molecular weight distribution
nuclear magnetic resonance spectroscopy
polyacrylamide
polyacrylonitrile
polycarbonate
poly(ether ether ketone)
poly(ethylene terephthalate)
polyisobutylene
poly(methyl methacrylate)
PMMApoly(styrene-co-acrylonitrile)
polyoxymethylene
polypropylene
poly(phenylene oxide)
poly(para-phenylene)
polystyrene
poly(ethersulfone)
polytetrauoroethylene
poly(vinyl chloride)
scanning electron microscopy
thermal gravimetry
vinyl chloride

829

830

15 Polymer Degradation and Stabilization

References
1 J. L. Bolland, G. Gee, Trans. Faraday
2

3
4

5
6

10

11

12
13
14
15

16

17

Soc., 1946, 42, 236.


Handbook of Polymer Degradation, S.
Halim Hamid, ed., Marcel Dekker,
New York, 2000.
D. S. Achilias, C. Kiparissides,
Macromolecules, 1992, 25, 3739.
A. Azapagic, A. Emsley, I. Hamerton, Polymers, the Environment and
Sustainable Development, I. Hamerton,
ed., John Wiley, London, 2003, p. 34.
M. Hasegawa, K. Horie, Prog. Polym.
Sci., 2001, 26, 259.
N. M. Emanuel, A. L. Buchachenko,
Chemical Physics of Polymer Degradation and Stabilization, VNU Science
Press, Utrecht, The Netherlands,
1987.
J. F. Rabek, Photodegradation of
Polymers, Physical Characteristics and
Applications, Springer Verlag, Berlin,
1996.
A. Torikai, A. Takeuchi, S. Nagaya,
K. Fueki, Polym. Photochem., 1986, 7,
199.
M. Elvira, P. Tiemblo, J. M. GomezElvira, Polym. Degr. Stab., 2004, 83,
509.
J. Lemaire, J. L. Gardette, J. Lecoste,
P. Delprat, D. Vaillant, in Polymer
Durability, ACS Adv. Chem. Ser., 1996,
249, 577.
B. Fayolle, L. Andoin, J. Verdu,
Polym. Degr. Stab., 2000, 70, 333; R.
Gensler, C. J. G. Plummer, H. H.
Kausch, E. Kramer, J. R. Pauquet,
H. Zweifel, Polym. Degr. Stab., 2000,
67, 195.
T. Q. Nguyen, Polym. Degr. Stab.,
1994, 46, 99.
L. Lacoste, D. J. Carlsson, J. Polym.
Sci., Polym. Chem. Ed., 1992, 30, 493.
W. H. Starnes Jr., Progr. Polym. Sci.,
2002, 27, 2133.
K. T. Gillen, M. Celina, R. L.
Clough, J. Wise, Trends Polym. Sci.,
1997, 5, 250.
J. P. Critchley, G. J. Knight, W. W.
Wright, Heat-Resistant Polymers,
Plenum Press, New York, 1990.
V. van Speybroeck, Y. Martele, M.

18
19
20
21

22
23

24
25

26

27

28
29

30

31
32

33

34

Waroquier, E. Schacht, J. Am.


Chem. Soc., 2001, 123, 10650.
M. R. Nyden, J. Gilman, Comp. Theor.
Polymer. Sci., 1997, 7, 191.
J. J. P. Stewart, J. Comp. Chem., 1989,
10, 221.
D. A. Gallagher, Scientic Computing
& Automation, June 1996.
T. A. Bogaevskaya, T. V. Monakhova, Yu. A. Shlyapnikov,
Vysokomol. Soyed., 1972, 14A, 1552.
P. Gijsman, J. Hennekens. Polym.
Degr. Stab., 1993, 42, 95.
S. Commereuc, D. Vaillant, J. L.
Philippart, L. Lacoste, J. Lemaire,
D. J. Carlsson, Polym. Degr. Stab.,
1997, 57, 175.
S. Verdu, J. Verdu, Macromolecules,
1997, 30, 2262.
P. Eriksson, T. Reitberger, B.
Stenberg, Polym. Degr. Stab., 2002,
78, 183.
M. Celina, G. A. George, N. C.
Billingham, in Handbook of Polymer
Degradation, S. Halim Hamid, ed.,
Marcel Dekker, New York, 2000,
p. 159.
F. Gugumus, Polym. Degr. Stab., 1996,
52, 159; Polym. Degr. Stab., 1996, 53,
161.
T. P. Wampler, J. Anal. Appl. Pyrol.,
2004, 71, 1.
M. Saule, S. Navarre, O. Babot,
W. Maslow, L. Vertommen, B.
Maillard, Macromolecules, 2003, 36,
7469.
J. P. Riggs, in High Performance
Polymers and Composites, J. A.
Kroschwitz, ed., John Wiley, New
York, 1991, pp. 2065.
B. A. Mathew, R. Mastromatteo,
Metal Powder Report, 2002, 57, 20.
W. C. McCaffrey, D. G. Cooper,
M. R. Kamal, Polym. Degr. Stab., 1998,
62, 513.
R. L. Feller, Accelerated Aging:
Photochemical and Thermal Aspects,
Research in Conservation Series, The
Getty Conservation Institute, 1994.
H. W. de Bruijn, in Handbook of
Polymer Degradation, S. Halim

References

35

36
37

38
39
40
41

42
43

Hamid, ed., Marcel Dekker, New York,


2000, p. 611.
A. L. Andrady, N. D. Searle, L. F. E.
Crewdson, Polym. Degr. Stab., 1992,
35, 235.
H. Zweifel, Chimia, 1993, 47, 390.
T. Q. Nguyen, Ph.D. thesis, No. 243,
EPFL, Lausanne, 1976; T. Q. Nguyen,
T. Gaumann, Radiat. Phys. Chem.,
1977, 10, 263.
A. Charlesby, Atomic Radiation and
Polymers, Pergamon, Oxford, 1960.
T. Q. Nguyen, H. H. Kausch, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1984, 29, 455.
V. S. Ivanov, Radiation Chemistry of
Polymers, VSP, Utrecht, 1992, p. 202.
I. Kaetsu, in Radiation Processing of
Polymers, A. Singh, J. Silverman,
eds., Hanser, Munich, 1992, pp. 149
186.
T. Q. Nguyen, H. H. Kausch, Adv.
Polym. Sci., 1992, 100, 73182.
S. N. Zhurkov, V. E. Korsukov, J.
Polym. Sci.: Polym. Phys., 1974, 22, 881.

44 V. A. Gonzalez, G. Neira-Velazquez,

45
46

47

48
49
50
51

J. L. Angulo-Sanchez, Polym. Degrad.


Stab., 1988, 60, 33; H. Zweifel,
Polymer Durability, ACS Adv. Chem.
Ser., 1996, 249, 375.
M. S. S. Coker, G. Scott, H. A. A.
Sweis, Polym. Degr. Stab., 1982, 4, 333.
T. Q. Nguyen, R. Porouchani, H. H.
Kausch, in Flexible Chain Dynamics
in Elongational Flow, T. Q. Nguyen,
H. H. Kausch, eds., Springer Verlag,
Berlin, 1999, pp. 185258.
A. Casale, R. S. Porter, Polymer Stress
Reactions, Academic Press, New York,
1978.
J. Pospisil, S. Nespurek, Polym. Degr.
Stab., 1995, 49, 99.
F. Gugumus, Polym. Degr. Stab., 1993,
40, 167.
E. T. Denisov, Dev. Polym. Stab., 1980,
3, 1.
G. E. Zaikov, Handbook of Polymer
Degradation, S. Halim Hamid, ed.,
Marcel Dekker, New York, 2000, p. 437.

831

833

16

Thermosets1
Rolf A. T. M. van Benthem, Lars J. Evers, Jo Mattheij, Ad Hoand,
Leendert J. Molhoek, Ad J. de Koning, Johan F. G. A. Jansen, and
Martin van Duin
16.1

Introduction
16.1.1

Thermoset Materials

The world of thermoset materials is characterized by a high degree of both diversity and complexity, often dicult for non-experts to oversee [1]. Let us rst ask
ourselves what thermoset materials have in common. Polymeric materials are divided into two classes, thermoplastic and thermosetting materials. The term thermoplastic refers to the ability of these polymers to become plastic, that is, to melt
and ow upon heating. In terms of viscoelasticity, a thermoplastic material can be
hard and elastic at room temperature, but it behaves like a liquid when heated to
a certain higher temperature. The expression thermoset or thermosetting is
sometimes erroneously understood to be exclusively a material which sets (becomes hard and elastic) upon heating, but there are many examples of thermoset
materials which have set without a temperature trigger, for example through irradiation (see Section 16.8.5). For the discussions in this chapter, the term thermoset will merely refer to the inability of this class of polymeric materials to behave like a liquid when heated. A thermosetting material can be hard and elastic at
room temperature and be heated above its glass transition temperature to become
softer, and deformable. The deformation, however, will be transient rather than
permanent: the softened material is still fully elastic and behaves like a rubbery
material.

1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

834

16 Thermosets

16.1.2

Networks

The molecular origin of thermoset behavior lies in the formation of a polymeric


network. Unlike thermoplastic materials, which consist of individual macromolecules that can move relative to each other over innite distances in the melt, the
polymeric chains in a thermosetting material are attached to each other and
can therefore not move any more relative to each other over greater distances.
They are bound together through so-called crosslinks and form an innite, threedimensional structure. A consequence of the presence of junctions between the
polymeric chains, other than the inability to behave like a liquid and ow, is the
inability of this material to dissolve in another medium such as a solvent. Solvent
or plasticizer molecules can migrate into the network structure, to swell it, but this
is limited to a maximum determined by the crosslink density.
The ideal network structure can be envisaged as a three-dimensional array of
crosslink points, each crosslink point being connected to at least three other crosslink points via linear polymer segments, which are called elastically active network
chains. In practice non-ideal network elements are also present, such as loops or
dangling ends (Figure 16.1). Network density, or crosslink density, is expressed as
the concentration of either the crosslink joints or the elastically active network
chains (those chains that are part of the innite structure and attached to crosslink
junctions at both ends) per unity of volume of the unswollen material.

EAN
Cross-link

Dangling end

Fig. 16.1. Network nomenclature: crosslinks, elastically active


network chains (EAN), dangling ends, and loops.

Loop

16.1 Introduction

16.1.3

Advantages

There are two obvious advantages in the material property of a thermoset compared
to a thermoplastic material: the network structure will ensure a higher resistance
toward unwanted penetration of chemicals (solvents, dyes, water, acids, bases, and
electrolytes) in use, and secondly, a thermoset has a high-temperature stability as it
retains its shape and (some of ) the properties at elevated temperatures. These are
not the main advantages of a thermoset material, however. The wide processing
window of thermosets has given them the present position in the performance materials market. A thermoset can be processed easily (shaped, cast, molded, poured)
as a liquid; the liquid is transformed into the nal thermoset material after the
processing, through a series of chemical reactions. The nal properties of the material are thus determined by the network formation reactions performed in situ.
As a consequence, the chosen molecular weight of the starting material can be arbitrarily low. The viscosity, in relation to the molecular weight of the (short) polymeric chains, is decreased strongly as well. In contrast, a thermoplastic material
derives its properties from the high molecular weight of its polymer chains which
allows the chains to entangle with each other. This high molecular weight in most
cases results in rather high melt viscosities for these polymers. A high processing
viscosity is a disadvantage with respect to both processing speed (lling the mold,
owing out) and wetting phenomena: dispersion of pigments and llers and even
ow-out over the walls of the mold or the substrate.
16.1.4

Curing Resins

In thermoset nomenclature the low molecular weight polymers (oligomers) are


referred to as resins. Apart from their relatively low molecular weight, typically between a few hundred and a few thousand grams per mole, resins are characterized
by the presence of reactive groups in the chains, ideally at least two per molecule.
These reactive groups form the chemical handles to connect the polymer chains
together through covalent crosslink bonds, via a chemical reaction. The process of
crosslinking is mostly referred to as cure or hardening. When the reaction proceeds, the gel point is dened as the moment in time when the rst molecule of
innite dimensions is formed in the polymer mixture. The viscosity of the mixture
then approaches innity and in this state the material is referred to as gel. The curing reaction can still proceed beyond this point to increase the crosslink density.
16.1.5

Functionality

The number of reactive groups present in one molecule is referred to as functionality. This term can reect both on a monomer and on a polymer. For example,
ethylene glycol is a two-functional monomer for a polyester (see Section 16.6),

835

836

16 Thermosets

and a linear epoxy resin with two glycidyl groups on each end is a two-functional
polymer (Section 16.4). An unsaturated polyester (Section 16.7) or EPDM rubber
(Section 16.9) can have much higher functionalities, that is, unsaturations along
the polymer chain. Functionality is an important concept to understand the role
of a polymer chain in the nal network. For example, a two-functional polymer of
a certain molecular weight can only be built in as an elastically active network
chain of that same length (at maximum, provided that it reacts at both groups). A
three-functional polymer chain of similar molecular weight, containing a branch in
the chain, can give a higher crosslink density because it has an internal network
junction as well. The junctions in the network can originate from a branching
point already present in the polymer, or from chemical reaction between polymer
strands.
16.1.6

Formulation

The mixture of the dierent constituents of a formulation for a thermosetting material is always rather complex and referred to as a system. Systems can be classied as either 1K (one component) or 2K (two components). In the rst case, all
the (co)reactive ingredients of the formulation are already mixed, but the network
formation is only started when it is triggered chemically or physically, for example
by a raise in temperature, by electromagnetic radiation, or by exposure to air (oxygen) or moisture. In the latter case the two components will immediately start
their chemical reaction once they are mixed with each other, with or without an
additional inuence from outside (such as a rise in temperature to speed up the
crosslinking reaction).
Independently of the systems reactivity (1K/2K), the combination of reactive
groups required to form the network can range from very simple to highly complex. Reactions can be between co-reactive groups of dierent chains of one resin
type, or between the reactive groups on one resin type with corresponding reactive
groups of another compound, that compound either being a chemical (monomer)
or another resin (polymer) that is added to the rst resin. In some resins only
one kind of reactive group A is present which is reactive with itself (A A ! AA);
in most resins, however, A is not reactive with itself and requires the presence
of an additional compound (B) of complementary reactivity to give a chemical
bonding reaction (A B ! AB). Dual-cure reactions also exist (A B C D !
AB CD) between mixtures of resins of dierent reactivities. In the next sections
the most important resin classes will be presented. Systems can be formulated
from just one one of them but also from a wide, almost innite, variety of combinations of these resins.
The systems are made more complex with the addition of additives to control the
chemical reaction, either to enhance it (catalysts, accelerators, initiators) or to slow
it down or inhibit it (stabilizers, inhibitors). Besides additives that control the network formation, other additives can also be used to inuence the nal properties:
llers, pigments, plasticizers). Formulation of thermosetting systems is a technol-

16.1 Introduction

ogy of its own and requires a deep insight into both the complex chemical reactions and the nal network structure in order to steer toward the desired material
properties.
16.1.7

Production

It is highly important to note, however, that the production of the resins themselves is in most cases far from as straightforward as would be expected for a simple low molecular weight polymer. Unlike the (linear) thermoplastic polymers, resins are designed to react to form networks; they contain several reactive groups
and often are branched polymers. Either by uncontrolled reaction or uncontrolled
branching, polymer molecules with a much higher molecular weight than intended, or even polymer networks, could already be formed during the production
stage (gelation). This should be avoided at all times, as the production facility
could be plugged and highly damaged in such a case. In each of the following section on the resin types a short description is given of the (mostly batchwise) production technology associated with them, and the measures for controlling unwanted, premature, reactions.
16.1.8

General Areas of Application

The areas of application of thermosetting materials are in coatings, rubbers, inks,


adhesives, laminates, press moldings, composite (glass-lled) moldings, mineral
wool, and electronic materials. A general overview of the main application areas
of the resins discussed in the following sections is given in Table 16.1 [1]. They
are found in a wide variety of markets (household, automotive, building and construction, electronics, paper and press) and have a collected industrial volume of
several tens of millions of tons.

Tab. 16.1.

General overview of thermoset applications.

Resin

Coating

Phenolic
Amino
Epoxy
Alkyd
Saturated polyester
Unsaturated polyester
Acrylate
Rubber

Structural
parts

Wood
and paper
composites

Adhesives

Inks

Elastic
rubbers

837

838

16 Thermosets

16.2

Phenolic Resins
16.2.1

Introduction

Historically, phenolformaldehyde resins (phenolic resins, phenoplasts) are the


oldest synthetic thermoset materials: as early as in 1910 the rst ones (bakelite
to their inventor Baekeland) were introduced. Who does not remember the black
telephones and light switches that were popular in the 1930s and 1940s? Phenolic
resins are based on hydroxy-aromatic compounds (phenol and phenol derivatives)
and aldehydes [2]. Furfural is occasionally used as aldehyde; but by far the most
widely used aldehyde is formaldehyde. Formaldehyde can be administered as an
aqueous solution (formalin), polymeric solid (paraformaldehyde) or solid adduct
with ammonia (hexamethylenetetramine, HMTA). The resins are formed by a
step-growth mechanism in aqueous solution.
Thermoset materials can be made from phenolic resins themselves, requiring
an acid or base catalyst or additional formaldehyde source, or in combination with
various other resins. An exhaustive list is not given here, but examples of combinations with all the resin types in the next sections are known (especially amino
resins, Section 16.3; epoxy resins, Section 16.4; alkyd resins, Section 16.5; and saturated polyester resins, Section 16.6).

16.2.2

Chemistry

The reactive group involved on the hydroxy-aromatic compound is not the hydroxy
group itself but the carbon atoms on the ortho (2,6) and para (4) positions relative
to the hydroxy group (attached to carbon atom 1). Unsubstituted phenol can therefore react with formaldehyde from three dierent positions independently, so
should be regarded as a three-functional monomer. If the phenol derivatives have
substituents on the ortho and/or para positions, their functionality is decreased accordingly. For example (see Scheme 16.1), cresol (methylphenol) is two-functional
when the methyl group is in the 2 or 4 position relative to OH (o-cresol and pcresol, respectively) but three-functional when in the 3 position (m-cresol). Further,
commonly used two-functional substituted phenol derivatives are p-tert-butylphenol
and p-tert-nonylphenol. The aliphatic groups on these monomers decrease the solubility of the resins in water but increase the solubility (compatibility) of these resins
with more hydrophobic solvents (hydrocarbons) and resins.
The aldehyde group of formaldehyde can react twice with an aromatic carbon
atom of a phenolic monomer and should therefore be regarded as a two-functional
monomer. After the rst reaction, the carbonyl group has been changed into a
hydroxy group. After the second reaction, the hydroxy group is either etheried
or substituted for a carboncarbon bond. The reaction pathways are displayed

16.2 Phenolic Resins

OH

OH

OH

OH

839

OH

HO

Phenol

m-Cresol

o-Cresol

p-Cresol

Resorcinol

OH

OH
Nonylphenol
p-tert-Butylphenol

Scheme 16.1.

Some phenolic monomers.

in Scheme 16.2 Starting from three-functional phenol and formaldehyde, a


branched structure is obtained in which the phenol moieties are linked together
by formaldehyde-derived bridges. These bridges can comprise either one methylene group (methylene bridge) or two methylene groups connected by an ether
oxygen atom (ether bridge). One formaldehyde molecule is needed to form
a methylene bridge; two are needed to form an ether bridge. The relative amounts

OH

OH

OH

OH

HO

OH
OH

OH

OH

HO

OH

HO

ether bridges

methylene bridges
OH

OH

OH

OH

OH
O

Scheme 16.2.

OH

OH

OH

Resol resin

Phenolic resin formation.

OH
O

Novolac resin

840

16 Thermosets

of these bridges are determined during the resin synthesis by the reaction
parameters.
Two reaction parameters are of specic importance: pH and molar ratio. When
phenol and formaldehyde are dissolved together in water, a pH of about 34 is
reached (phenol is slightly acidic). After prolonged heating, hardly any reaction is
noticeable. The reaction requires a catalyst, either an acid or a base, to reach a sufcient speed. Depending on the ratio between phenolic monomers and aldehyde,
the phenolic resins are classied as either resol or novolac types.
Resols
In a resol synthesis reaction, formaldehyde is used in excess over the phenolic
monomer. In the case of phenol (P), typical P/F (formaldehyde) ratios are between
1:1 and 1:3. Therefore the ready resin will still contain reactive groups derived from
single-sided reacted formaldehyde: hydromethylene groups (methylol groups).
Care must be taken not to let the reaction run too far, because the mixture can
form a gel. Acid catalysis, for example, is therefore not applicable, because the reaction will be out of control (proceed spontaneously toward the gel point). With
weak-base catalysis, however, it is possible to reach a more or less stable situation
(at fairly low temperature, below 60 C) in which most formaldehyde molecules
have reacted with phenols to form methylols, but hardly to form bridges. Catalysts
often used are alkali and alkaline earth oxides and hydroxides (such as potassium hydroxide, calcium oxide). ortho-Methylols are slightly preferred over paramethylols. The higher the pH, the higher the para content and the more ether
bridges are transformed into methylene bridges. If a higher molecular weight is
desired, the reaction can be allowed to proceed further in a slow and controlled
manner at 60 C, until the right viscosity is reached. A higher molecular weight
can be obtained more easily without risk of gelation by using two-functional phenol monomers, partly (together with phenol) or exclusively. Resols can be cured to
thermoset materials themselves by adding an acidic catalyst and/or increasing the
temperature.
16.2.2.1

Novolacs
Novolac resins are obtained by reacting formaldehyde with an excess of the phenolic monomer (P/F > 1:1). Either strong acids or strong bases can be used as catalysts. Acids are most widely used, but with bases a higher content of orthoortho
linkages can be obtained if desired for mechanical properties. Unlike resols, which
are mostly methylolated monomer species with some occasional polymeric species,
novolacs immediately form true polymer chains of predictable molecular weight.
In principle methylene bridges, being more thermodynamically stable than ether
bridges, predominate in the polymer chains. So the P/F ratio (P being in excess)
determines ideally the (number-averaged) molecular mass Mn . Novolacs cannot
form extensive networks by themselves because of the formaldehyde deciency. A
gel could possibly be formed, however, because of branches in the polymer chains
when a P/F ratio close to 1:1 is chosen with a three-functional phenolic monomer.
16.2.2.2

16.2 Phenolic Resins

The higher the Mn of the resin and the higher the functionality of the phenolic
monomers, the higher the risk of gelation during production. This can be calculated with the FloryStockmayer and related mathematical theories. One easy
way out is not to use phenol (three-functional) but, for example, p-cresol (twofunctional) as the monomer: only linear polymeric chains can then be formed.
Curing of novolacs requires addition of extra formaldehyde; mostly HMTA, typically 815%, is used as a solid formaldehyde source.
Epoxy-novolacs
Without extra formaldehyde, novolac resins are hardly reactive with other resins, as
the aromatic hydroxyl groups are relatively inert. They can be used to introduce
other reactive functionalities, however. The most important example of a functionalized novolac resin is in the reaction with epichlorohydrin (Scheme 16.3). The resulting resins contain glycidyl groups and can be used as epoxy resins (see Section
16.4). The advantage of these epoxy resins over classical bisphenol-A glycidyl resins
is that they contain more epoxy groups per unit of weight and have a higher functionality as a resin (one glycidyl group per phenolic unit). Both phenol- and cresol
based novolacs are used as epoxy resin precursors. Besides reaction with epichlorohydrin, phenolic resins are sometimes also reacted with alkyl chlorides or alcohols to etherify the aromatic hydroxy groups. In this way, their compatibility/
solubility in combination with other resins (or solvents) is enhanced.
16.2.2.3

OH

OH

OH

O
Cl

(n+2)
n
Scheme 16.3.

Epoxy-novolac resins formed with epichlorohydrin (ECH).

Discoloration
The major disadvantage of phenolic resins, both resols and novolacs, is the strong
yellow to black color of the resins, or the cured materials. The discoloration (the
monomers and sometimes the resins are colorless in principle) takes place when
the material comes into contact with oxygen, which is virtually impossible to
prevent. By oxidation of methylene bridges, for example, p-quinone puered structures are formed which have a high extinction coecient for visible light (Scheme
16.4 top). Azomethine structures also can be formed when oxidation takes place in
a resin which was cured in the presence of ammonia (for example, from hexa);
see Scheme 16.4 bottom.
16.2.2.4

841

842

16 Thermosets

1/2 O2
HO

CH

-H2O

OH

OH
NH

OH
1/2 O2

OH
N

-H2O
Scheme 16.4.

Oxidation of phenolic resins leading to discoloration.

16.2.3

Production

Phenol resins, both resols and novolacs, are exclusively made in batch processes.
In the production of novolacs, molten phenol is charged into the heated and stirred
reaction tank together with the weak acidic catalyst (for example, oxalic acid). At
95 C, the aqueous formalin solution is slowly added, while the reaction heat is removed through distillation of water at slightly diminished pressure. When all the
formaldehyde has reacted, the water is distilled o and the reaction with the excess
phenol is continued at higher temperature (140160 C). When the desired viscosity is reached, the excess of unreacted phenol is removed by distillation as well. The
molten resin is let down onto a cooling belt, and broken into small glassy lumps.
Resol resins are made at temperatures from room temperature to a maximum of
60 C. As in novolacs, molten phenol is charged rst into the reactor together with
the basic catalyst (for example, calcium oxide), after which the formalin solution is
slowly added with cooling of the mixture through water distillation. A higher vacuum (4050 mbar) must be used than with resol resins because of the lower reaction temperature. When the desired viscosity has been reached, the reaction can be
quenched by addition of a small amount of acid (to a pH of approximately 45).
Then water is removed through distillation, either to dryness or to a concentrated
aqueous solution. If the resol resin has sucient molecular weight to be a stable
solid at room temperature, the dry resin melt is processed to glassy lumps over a
cooling belt, like a novolac resin. Very low molecular weight resol resins (Mn < 200
g mol1 ) are dispensed as aqueous solutions; resins having higher molecular
weight (500800 g mol1 ) are often diluted with alcohol solvents (for better solubility).
16.2.4

Properties and Applications

Phenol resins have found their ways to numerous applications in varying markets:
wood glues, bonding agents for mineral and glass bers, laminates, molded parts,
coatings, inks, rubbers, matrix materials for grinding and brake composites. Their

16.3 Amino Resins

success is explained by their relatively low price and high degree of chemical and
thermal inertness. Thermal decomposition sets in only between 220 and 250 C,
depending on the composition. Phenol resins are quite stable to hydrolysis, even
at high pH, and are therefore suitable for making particle board for contact with
concrete castings. Once cured, phenolic materials are hard but brittle. To overcome
their brittleness, they can be combined with other resins in thermoset formulations. Their compatibility with other resins can be tuned through the choice
of phenolic monomer (resins based on nonylphenol can be dissolved even in
hydrocarbons), their molecular weight, and the degree of etherication. Due to
their discoloration they are mostly used in non-surface applications. For example, coatings based on phenol/epoxy systems are used as primers but not as topcoats. High-pressure laminates are composed of a pile of papers impregnated
with resol resin, on top of which a decor paper impregnated with a colorless
melamineformaldehyde resin (next paragraph) is placed, the stack being cured
together in a press.
Resols can also be used in combination with unsaturated rubbers such as EPDM
(see Section 16.9) which are cured cationically.

16.3

Amino Resins
16.3.1

Introduction

Amino resins are based on reactions of compounds containing amino, imino, or


amide groups with aldehydes [3]. As in phenolic resins, the most widely used
aldehyde is formaldehyde. In an aqueous environment a condensation reaction
between formalin and the amino, imino, or amide compound leads to highly
branched, low molecular weight polymers. Introducing an acid catalyst is usually
necessary to initiate further condensation reactions that lead to curing.
The commercial history of amino resins goes back to 1924 with the use of urea as
the amino source. In 1935 melamine (2,4,6-triamino-1,3,5-triazine)formaldehyde
(MF) resins were introduced, as more expensive but higher quality resins than the
ureaformaldehyde (UF) resins. These two resins are still the main amino resins
used to date. Applications exist of pure UF or MF, but also of physical or chemical
mixtures of melamine and urea resins, leading to melamineureaformaldehyde
(MUF) resins.
16.3.2

Chemistry

In principle the condensation reaction between formalin and the amino group,
referred to as methylolation and somewhat similar to the reaction of phenol and
formaldehyde (see Section 16.2.2), can take place at four positions on a urea mole-

843

844

16 Thermosets

NH 2
N

2HN

N
H

OH

Monomethylomelamine
H
N
N

(Mono)
NH2

OH
N

N
N

2HN

N
OH
H
N,N'-Dimethylolmelamine
H
N
N
HO

N
N
H

OH

H
N

N(

N
H

N(

N
N(

N
OH)2

OH)2

2HN

N
N

N(

OH )2

N,N,N',N'-Tetramethylolmelamine

N
N

N(

N(
N
)N

OH)2
(Penta)

OH)2
N

N(

OH )2

Hexamethylolmelamine
Scheme 16.5.

(Tetra)

OH)2

Pentamethylomelamine

2(HO

(Tri)

OH)2

N(

(Di)

OH

N,N',N'-Trimethylolmelamine

N,N,N',N"-Tetramethylolmelamine

HO

2HN

OH

N
H

OH )2

N',N'-Dimethylolmelamine

N(

H
N

N,N',N"-Trimethylolmelamine

HO

2 HN

OH

N
H

The nine possible methylol adducts of melamine and formaldehyde.

(Hexa)

16.3 Amino Resins

cule and at six positions on a melamine molecule. The methylolation reactions of


melamine and urea are fast and reversible at temperatures over 70 C. Melamine
actually dissolves in the reaction mixture due to this methylolation reaction. For
melamine nine dierent methylolated melamine molecules have been identied
(Scheme 16.5), each with its own molecular equilibrium constant. Both primary
(HOCH2 NH) and secondary methylols (HOCH2 NCH2 OH) are formed. In particular the tri- (primary) and hexa- (secondary) methylolated species are the most stable. In the polymerization reactions, depending on the molar ratio of melamine to
formaldehyde, any substitution state of melamine can be found. Therefore, MF
resins are usually highly branched. For urea four dierent methylolated ureas
have been identied (Scheme 16.6). The existence of a fth, tetramethylolurea, is
uncertain. The primary dimethylolated species is the most stable one and in polymerization reactions urea tends to react primarily as a two-functional monomer.
In accordance, UF resins with a low urea/formaldehyde ratio are only slightly
branched.
O
HO

N
H

NH2

Monomethyllurea
O
HO

N
H

N
H

O
OH

2(HO

)N

NH2

N,N-Dimethylolurea

N,N'-Dimethylolurea
O
)N

2 (HO

N
H

OH

Trimethylolurea
Scheme 16.6.

The four possible methylol adducts of urea and formaldehyde.

Polymerization Chemistry
In MF resins, melamine methylol groups condense with melamine amino groups
into methylene bridges linking two triazine moieties. Two melamine methylol
groups condense to a methylene ether, in short ether bridges (see Scheme 16.7).
The main reaction parameters are pH and the molar ratio of formaldehyde to melamine (F/M) and/or urea. Typical evolution of the chemical composition of a melamine formaldehyde resin during synthesis is shown in Figure 16.2.
In UF resins urea homocondensation results in methylene and ether bridges as
well, as shown in Scheme 16.8. In MUF resins, next to the homocondensations of
melamine and urea species, co-condensations can also take place, again via both
ether and methylene bridges (see Scheme 16.9) [4]. The critical parameters inu16.3.2.1

845

16 Thermosets

846

NH2

NH2
N
H2N

N
N

+
HO

NH2

N
H

NH2

N
N

N
NH2

NH2
N

2
2HN

Scheme 16.7.

N
N
N
H
H
"Methylene bridge"

NH2

N
N

N
N

H2N

NH2

N
N
H

OH

H2N

NH2

N
N

NH2

N
N
H

N
N
H
"Ether bridge"
Condensation reactions of amino resins: homocondensation of melamine.

NH2

0.8
0.7
Di
Mono

0.6
mol/kg resin

Tri
0.5
Ether

0.4
Tetra
0.3
0.2

Methylene

Penta
0.1
Hexa
0
0

20

40

60

80
Time (min.)

100

Fig. 16.2. The concentration of the methylol groups (solid


lines) and the methylene and ether bridges (broken lines) as a
function of synthesis time. (F/M 1:65, 95 C, pH 9.5). For the
labels on the methylol lines, see Scheme 16.5.

120

140

16.3 Amino Resins

O
+
H2N

N
H

HO

NH2

H2N

NH2

O
2

N
H

HO

N
N
NH2
H
H
"Methylene bridge"

O
H2N

NH2

847

O
N
H

N
H
"Ether bridge"
Scheme 16.8. Condensation reactions of amino resins: homocondensation of urea.

NH2

encing homo- and co-condensation, as well as homo- and co-condensation, are the
molar amounts of M, U, and F during each phase of the resin synthesis, temperature, and pH. Changes in the pH have a direct and substantial inuence on the
condensation reaction kinetics and, thus, on the number of methylene and ether
linkages formed. Changes in the pH of 0.3 can double the rate of an individual
reaction. In moderately alkaline media (pH 79) methylene bridges are formed
predominantly, while in stronger alkaline conditions (pH 910) primarily ether
bridges are produced. Unlike methylene bridges, ether bridges are susceptible to
hydrolysis. Equilibrium is reached after short reaction times. Therefore, a fairly
constant concentration of ether bridges is often observed, caused by similar rates
of formation and hydrolysis. Methylene bridges do not undergo this hydrolysis
and thereby increase in concentration during synthesis; see also Figure 16.2.

NH2
N
H2N

+
NH2

HO

N
H

NH2

NH2
N

NH2
N
2 HN

H2N

2HN

NH2

NH2
O

N
N

N
H

NH2

NH2
N

N
H

"Methylene bridge"
H2N

OH

+
N
H

+
N
H

OH

HO

N
H

NH2

H2N

N
N

N
H

N
H

"Ether bridge"
Scheme 16.9.

Condensation reactions of amino resins: co-condensation of melamine and urea.

NH2

848

16 Thermosets

16.3.3

Production

Amino resins are produced in batch processes at temperatures of around 90 C in


aqueous solution under alkaline conditions. The solid content (amount of dry substance: melamine, urea, and formaldehyde) in the reactor is around 5070% by
weight. For MF resins the pH during production is around 99.5 at the beginning
of the process when all the raw materials are added to the reactor, and will stay
around that value during resin preparation. For UF resins the rst phase of the reaction is similar, alkaline methylolation, but after some hours the pH is brought
down to around 5 to promote the bridge formation reactions.
When producing a MUF resin, dierent scenarios for adding the raw materials
to the reactor are possible regarding the moment of dosing. One should choose
dierent pH settings accordingly. Numerous recipes are described for synthesizing
a MUF resin. It is possible to simply use a mixture of ureaformaldehyde and
melamineformaldehyde resins, but usually melamine and urea are introduced
into the reactor at dierent times. Two major concepts have found general industrial acceptance. One starts with the synthesis of a UF resin, followed by a cocondensation step of melamine (UFM); the other starts with a MF resin and
co-condenses urea in the second stage (MFU). Mostly, in each case a nal urea
dosage is used to lower the molar ratio. The UFM concept is characterized by a
backbone of UF chains and a lower branching eciency of the melamine molecule. In the MFU concept the branching degree of the melamine molecule is increased and the melamine is more eciently incorporated into the polymeric
structure, resulting in a reduction of the dominant character of the urea backbone.
Both methods of production have their own merits in resin stability and in the performance in the dierent elds of application.
The desired degree of condensation of the resins is determined in the case of UF
and MUF by the viscosity of the reaction mixture. Typically resins have viscosities
in the range of 50400 mPa s. UF resins are milky white due to small crystallites of
linear UF segments; MUF resins can be milky white as well, but also clear. In MF
resins the degree of condensation is determined via the so-called water tolerance.
This value is expressed as the relative amount of water that can be added to the
resin while remaining clear, that is, not turning turbid because of phase separation
of water-insoluble higher oligomers. Increasing condensation times give rise to increasing molecular weight and, hence, lower water tolerance.
Because of their reactivity and intrinsic gelating potential, amino resins are characterized by a limited storage stability. In general an aged resin (more than one to
three months old) has a very high viscosity or is gelled and cannot be applied any
more. Typically acceptable storage times are one month, depending on storage conditions but also on initial viscosity, and/or water tolerance, and/or the chemical
structure of the resin. For some applications the resins are spray-dried and applied
as dry solid or redispersed solutions. Solid amino resins do not show this fast
ageing behavior because the polymerization reactions are halted by the strong decrease in molecular mobility (vitrication) of the polymeric system.

16.4 Epoxy Resins

16.3.4

Properties and Applications

Curing of amino resins proceeds readily in an acidic environment; an acidic catalyst is usually added to the amino resin just prior to use. As catalysts, ammonium
sulfate for UF and MUF and p-toluenesulfonic acid for MF are typical examples.
A cured amino resin is hard and brittle. Some degree of exibilization can be
achieved by adding glycols or polymers containing hydroxyl groups to the resin.
UF resins are much more sensitive to moisture than melamine resins. Applications which require a certain moisture resistance, either in swelling or hydrolysis,
necessitate the use of melamine (MUF or MF).
The majority of amino resins are used in combination with wood or paper. The
interaction with these materials is very good; amino resins are used as wood glues
in wood composites like particle board, plywood, and engineered lumber products.
Amino resins can also be the binder material in paper. Most money papers are
reinforced by melamine resins. A larger application in combination with paper,
especially for melamineformaldehyde, is as impregnation resins. Paper is impregnated with resin and hot-pressed, giving decorative lms for products like
worktops and laminate ooring with a very durable surface (hard, scratch- and
chemical-resistant).
Laminate ooring provides a very good illustrative example of the application of
melamine in combination with mainly paper and wood bers. This product has
acquired its own place among other oor coverings such as carpets, tiles and parquet. Going from the bottom to the surface of a laminate oor, one nds: a backing
paper impregnated with melamine resin; a substrate such as particle board where
the wood particles are glued together with MUF resin; a wood decor printed paper
impregnated with melamine resin, and a transparent overlay paper impregnated
with melamine resins. This pile of materials is then hot-pressed (typically at 150
200 C and 4060 bar) for between 30 s and 2 min. After sawing into pieces and
sanding, the laminate decorative ooring is ready for application in homes and
commercial remises, being very durable, scratch- and liquid-resistant, and easy to
clean.
Other applications include binders for molding materials such as electrical plugs
or dinnerware, binders for mineral and glass wool insulation and roong, ameretarding agents, and leather auxiliaries.

16.4

Epoxy Resins
16.4.1

Introduction

Epoxy resins also can look back at a long history of development, as the rst ones
became commercial in the early 1940s after their invention in 1938. The term

849

850

16 Thermosets

O
Cl

ECH
Scheme 16.10.

Glycidyl ether

O
O

Glycidyl ester

Epichlorohydrin (ECH) and glycidyl compounds.

epoxy refers to the presence of an epoxide group in the compound (monomer or


resin). This group is a three-membered cyclic ether (two carbon atoms and one oxygen atom in a ring) and is called an oxirane in ocial IUPAC nomenclature. Epoxy compounds can, for example, be made though oxidation of a carboncarbon
double bond. By far the largest industrial source of epoxy groups is epichlorohydrin (ECH). This compound contains a highly reactive, highly toxic, epoxy group
that can easily be attached to other molecules, including polymers, by a substitution reaction at the carbonchloride bond. Epoxy groups originating from reaction
with ECH are called glycidyl groups; examples are given in Scheme 16.10. The epoxy novolac resins, polymeric and polyfunctional glycidyl ethers, have already been
discussed (see Section 16.2.2). The most dominant class of expoxy resins comprises glycidyl ethers of bisphenol-A.
16.4.2

Chemistry

The synthesis of epoxy resins from bisphenol-A and epichlorohydrin (ECH) is, in
simplied form, a net substitution reaction of the chlorine group of ECH by the
aromatic hydroxy groups of bisphenol-A to give a diglycidyl ether with evolution
of hydrochloric acid; 1 mol of base is required per hydroxy group to neutralize
this acid. In more chemical detail, the aromatic hydroxy group is rst deprotonated
by the base and then reacts with the epoxy group of ECH. Then the chloride group
is eliminated by an internal rearrangement by which a new glycidyl group is
formed. The idealized reaction product is the diglycidyl ether of bisphenol-A
(DGEBPA), a crystalline solid, as shown in Scheme 16.11. In industrial practice
the compound is a liquid which contains a small amount of higher oligomers
(n 0:13), and is called standard liquid. These higher oligomers are formed
by reaction of aromatic hydroxy groups with the glycidyl group of DGEBPA. It is
also possible to purposely synthesize higher oligomers (n 220) by catalyzing
this reaction with, for example, quaternary ammonium salts or triethanolamine as
nucleophilic catalysts. The dierent ways of making higher molecular weight
polymers is described below (see Section 16.4.3). The closer the molar ratio of
ECH/bisphenol-A in the resin to 1:1, the higher the molecular weight. A higher
molecular weight results in a higher glass transition temperature of the polymer
and a lower number of epoxy groups per unit weight (see Table 16.2). In contrast
to epoxy-novolac resins, an epoxy resin of this kind is always two-functional, with

16.4 Epoxy Resins

Cl

OH

HO

- 2 NaCl

2 NaOH

Cl

851

DGEBPA

OH
O

n
Higher oligomers
Scheme 16.11. Synthesis of the diglycidyl ether of bisphenol-A
(DGEBPA), and higher oligomers.

glycidyl groups on both ends only. Some slightly higher functionalities can be the
result of side reactions (branching as a result of the aliphatic hydroxyl groups reacting with glycidyl groups during the polymer synthesis). This branching can be
minimized by using a selective catalyst such as triethanolamine.
Cure
For the chemistry of curing epoxy resins both the glycidyl groups and the aliphatic
hydroxyl groups are of importance. The higher the molecular weight of the resin,
16.4.2.1

Tab. 16.2.

Epoxy resin overview.

Resin

ECH/BPA[a]

DGE-BPA/BPA[b]

Mn

Tg [ C]

Standard liquid
1001 type
1004 type
1007 type
1009 type

0.16
2
5.5
14
16

1.33
1.15
1.07
1.05

2
1.4
1.14
1.12

360
900
1900
4300
5000

<10 (liquid)
6575
95105
125135
145155

[a] Molar ratio of building blocks in product. Applicable to Tay process


for the 1001 type.
[b] Molar ratio of monomers in Advancement process.

852

16 Thermosets

OH

HNu

Nu

O
O

OH

O
OH

Scheme 16.12. Reactions of glycidyl groups with compounds


containing active hydrogen groups, such as carboxylic acids.

the more hydroxyl groups are present in relation to the glycidyl groups. Epoxy resins can be cured themselves by addition of a (Lewis) acidic or basic catalyst. Tertiary amines and imidazolines are especially eective catalysts. They serve as a nucleophilic ring-opening initiator for a cascade of epoxyepoxy reactions, resulting
in ether linkages between the polymer chains. The glycidyl groups can also undergo ring-opening reactions with a wide variety of active hydrogen-containing
compounds, in close analogy to the synthesis reaction where the aromatic hydroxyl
groups acted as active hydrogen donors (see Scheme 16.12). Depending on the reactivity of the active hydrogen donor, a catalyst may be needed to eect a suciently fast cure reaction.

O
O

H
R1

H
R2

R1

OH

Primary amine

R2

Secondary amine
OH

R2
O

O
O

R2

OH
R1

R2

Tertiary amine
Scheme 16.13.

Reaction of amine groups with glycidyl groups, formation of tertiary amines.

Amines generally do not need a catalyst, as the reaction with epoxy resins occurs
spontaneously at room temperature. Therefore, amine curing agents can be used

16.4 Epoxy Resins

for epoxy resins only in two-component (2K) formulations. Low molecular weight
polyamines such as diethylenetriamine and triethylenetetramine are frequently
used as such. Because of their toxicity, they are also modied with amide groups
to lower their volatility. To their advantage, the functionality of these amines is
quite high. Not only do they contain several nitrogen groups in a small molecule,
but each NH counts as an active hydrogen donor in the reaction with epoxy
groups. A primary amine group, NH2 , is two-functional: after one reaction with a
glycidyl group a secondary amine group, NH, remains which can undergo an additional reaction with a glycidyl group, as shown in Scheme 16.13.
Phenolic resins can react in two ways with epoxy resins. Using the right catalyst,
the aromatic hydrogen groups can react with glycidyl groups, in analogy to the synthesis of higher epoxy resin oligomers. This applies to both resol and novolac type
resins (see Section 16.2.2). Methylol groups, as present in resol resins, can also react with the aliphatic hydroxyl groups of bisphenol-A based epoxy resins, with formation of ether linkages.
Carboxylic acids and anhydrides also can be used for curing epoxy resins. Carboxylic anhydrides can react spontaneously at room temperature with the aliphatic
hydroxyl groups of bisphenol-A based epoxy resins, with formation of carboxylic
acid groups. The carboxylic acid groups can then react further with the glycidyl
groups (see Scheme 16.12), at higher temperatures and using the right catalyst
such as a quaternary ammonium or phosphonium halide. Polyester resins (see
Section 16.6) can be used as a source of carboxylic acid functional polymers to
cure the epoxy resins.
16.4.3

Production

Three variations on the synthesis of epoxy resins from bisphenol-A and ECH exist
to date, diering in the ratio between these monomers and the viscosity of the
product resins, as determined by the removal of the sodium chloride formed.
Standard Liquid
The diglycidyl ether of bisphenol-A (DGEBPA) is made with a large excess of ECH
(6 equiv.) to minimize formation of higher oligomers. Bisphenol-A and ECH are
charged together into the reactor. Powdered base (NaOH) is added slowly to this
mixture at 60 C to make the reaction proceed, while salt (NaCl) is formed as a byproduct. After the exothermic reaction is nished the temperature is raised to
100 C while water (also a by-product of the reaction) is distilled o under reduced
pressure, and then the temperature is raised further to 120 C to drive the reaction
to completion. The salt formed and residual base are removed from the product
through washing with water. Finally all remaining volatile components, including
the excess ECH, are removed under vacuum (30 mbar). This technical grade (average n 0:16) contains approximately 90% DGEBPA (n 0), 9% dimer (n 1),
and 1% trimer (n 2).
16.4.3.1

853

16 Thermosets

854

Tay Process
With a much lower excess of ECH, and in the presence of a catalyst, it is possible
to make higher oligomers directly in a procedure similar to that for the standard
liquid, called the Tay process. Bisphenol-A and a stoichiometric amount of
NaOH (10% aqueous solution) are charged into the reactor, and ECH is added
with vigorous stirring at 45 C. The reaction mixture is heated to 95 C and is kept
at this temperature for another 12 h. The product, a viscous liquid at this temperature, is washed with water to remove the salt and catalyst, dried, let down over a
cooling belt and aked. Because the viscosity of the product is a limiting factor in
the water washing step, this process is applicable to lower oligomers only, maximum n 4, for example the 1001 type.
16.4.3.2

Advancement Process
When even higher oligomers are desired, it is important to remove the salts from
the reaction before the nal molecular weight is obtained. This is achieved in the
Advancement process (see Scheme 16.14). In this process the reactor is charged
with standard liquid resin, free of salts. Fresh bisphenol-A, in a specic molar ratio
to the DGEBPA for the desired Mn , and an appropriate catalyst are added. The polymerization is eected exclusively by consecutive reactions of the hydroxyl groups
of the bisphenol-A with the glycidyl groups of the DGEBPA. It is carried out at
higher temperatures than the Tay process, well above the glass transition temperatures of the targeted polymer; see Table 16.2. After the desired viscosity has been
reached, the product is let down over a cooling belt and aked to glassy pellets.
Unlike the Tay process, in which oligomers with every value of n are formed
(n 0; 1; 2; 3; 4; 5 . . .), the Advancement process yields polymers with predominantly (> 90%) even numbers of repeating units (n 0; 2; 4; 6; 8; 10 . . .) as a result
of the consecutive reactions between DGEBPA and bisphenol-A. The presence of
about 10% n 1 dimer in the standard liquid resin causes 10% of the Advancement product to have odd numbers of n.
16.4.3.3

HO

(n)

(n + 1)

OH

OH
O

n
Scheme 16.14.

Epoxy resin synthesis via the Advancement process.

16.5 Alkyd Resins

16.4.4

Properties and Applications

Epoxy thermosets have excellent mechanical properties: they are characterized by


a high hardness but relatively low brittleness (in comparison with phenolic and
amino resins). This is caused by the b-transitions in the bisphenol-A moieties
along the polymer chain. The higher the molecular weight, the higher the exibility of the network (the longer the elastically active network (EAN) chain) and the
lower the crosslink density when the cure reaction involves only the glycidyl
groups. If a high exibility is desired with a higher crosslink density, rubbery
resins can be used to modify the lower molecular weight resins. During cure they
separate as small rubber domains inside the thermoset matrix.
The lower molecular weight epoxy resins, when cured with, for example, amines
or anhydrides, are used as 2K adhesives and in liquid coatings. When cured with
phenolic resins, excellent hydrolysis resistance is obtained. Beverage and food
packaging cans are coated on the inside with such systems for good sterilization
performance. Epoxy resins are popular for their properties in many other coating
applications also, but predominantly in primers and coatings for indoor use. The
high Tg of the higher oligomers makes them very suitable for powder coatings
(see Section 16.6.5), especially when cured with dicyanodiamide or acidic polyester
resins. The presence of many aliphatic hydroxyl groups along the chain provides
good chemical interaction with, for example, metal surfaces. This results in excellent adhesion to metal substrates, and a high resistance to corrosion. The disadvantage of epoxy resins based on bisphenol-A or novolac is that they are very prone
to photooxidation at the aromatic ether bonds and are, thus, poorly resistant to
UV light during outdoor weathering.
An example of epoxy resins that cure when a strong acid is liberated is given
in Scheme 16.35 (see Section 16.8.5, on UV curing). Press moldings from epoxy
resins, catalyzed by tertiary amines for cure, are used in automotive and electronic
components. As they only react with their glycidyl end groups, they are relatively
insensitive to over-cure. They are furthermore dimension-stable, and are very resistant to heat and chemical inuences.

16.5

Alkyd Resins
16.5.1

Introduction

Alkyd resins can be described as polyesters containing unsaturated fatty acids.


Many of the chemical and technological aspects coincide with those of saturated
polyesters (see Secion 16.6). We discuss them here rst because the alkyd technology, itself originating from early in the 20th century, stemmed from the use of vegetable oils in the painting and graphic arts industry. In comparison with simple

855

856

16 Thermosets

vegetable drying oils, alkyds provide harder lms and much faster drying. As vegetable oils, they are crosslinked through an autoxidative drying mechanism by ambient oxygen from the air. They are compatible with a wide range of solvents and
other resins. They currently constitute a versatile and economic group of binders
for the paint industry, with a world annual volume of approximately 1.5 Mt.
16.5.2

Chemistry

Alkyd resins are essentially built up of three groups of components: polyhydric


alcohols, polyacids and (vegetable) monoacids. The polymerization process is by
esterication (see Section 16.6.2). Examples of typical alkyd monomers are pentaerythritol (tetramethylolmethane), trimethylolpropane, and glycerol as polyhydric
alcohols (Scheme 16.21, below), and mainly phthalic anhydride but occasionally
isophthalic acid, maleic anhydride, and adipic acid as polyacids (Scheme 16.22, below). The most commonly used monoacids are polyunsaturated fatty acids (the
main chemical species of which are oleic, linoleic, and linolenic acids; Scheme
16.15) that impart to the alkyd its drying properties, and benzoic acid which is
sometimes used to raise the Tg . The main vegetable oils of industrial relevance
are linseed oil, soybean oil, saower oil, and sunower oil. They all contain dier-

O
OH

Stearic acid

OH

Palmitic acid

O
OH

Oleic acid

O
OH

Linoleic acid

OH

OH

Linolenic acid

OH

Ricinic acid

OH

-eleostearic acid

Scheme 16.15.

Some vegetable fatty acids used in alkyd resins.

16.5 Alkyd Resins

857

Unsaturated fatty acid content of vegetable oils.

Tab. 16.3.

Fatty acid

Linseed oil

Palmitic
Stearic
Oleic
Linoleic
Linolenic
Ricinoleic
Eleostearic
Iodine number

6
4
22
16
52

Soy oil

Saower oil

11
4
25
51
9

Sunower oil

8
3
13
75
1

Tung oil

11
6
29
52
2

4
2
4
8

Castor oil

9
83
8

180

130

145

130

82
175

155

ent amounts of fatty acids (Table 16.3). The numbers given are merely indications,
as seasonal inuences aect the relative fatty acid contents. The concentration of
unsaturated groups in the oil is expressed by the iodine number (g I2 per 100 g
oil), based on the known addition reaction of iodine to unsaturated carbon bonds.
The fatty acids can be incorporated, along with the other polyester monomers,
into the resin as such. This is called the fatty acid process, but, if glycerol also is
desired to be present in the resin, it can be more economical for the vegetable oil,
that is, a triester (triglyceride) composed of glycerol and fatty acids, to react directly
with the polyester ingredients. In that case the oil cannot be introduced in the
polyesterication stage, as the oil itself is not compatible with the growing polyester. A kind of dispersion of oil-free polyester particles would then be formed in
the oil. These undesired systems are called glyptals. To avoid the formation of glyptals, the fatty acids in the oil have to be randomly distributed over the glycerol of
the oil and the polyhydric alcohols present in the formulation in a rst transesterication step. The resulting hydroxyesters can intermix in a second step with the
acids and then result in a homogeneous product. This alcoholysis process is depicted in Scheme 16.16.

C 17 H31
O

O
O
O
O

C 17 H31

HO

OH

HO

OH

HO

OH

+2

C 17 H31

Scheme 16.16.

HO

C 17 H31

C17 H31

OH
OH

The alcoholysis process for alkyd resins.

In a similar process, called acidolysis (Scheme 16.17), the glycerol from the oil is
distributed over the fatty acids and isophthalic acid. This procedure is not possible

858

16 Thermosets

O
CO2H

O
O

C17 H31
O
O
O

O
2 HO2CC17H31

+2

C17 H31

C17 H31
O
CO2H

O
O

CO2H
O

C17 H31

CO2H
Scheme 16.17.

The acidolysis process for alkyd resins.

with phthalic anhydride, since free carboxylic acid groups are required for this
transesterication reaction. Orthophthalic acid is not stable at the acidolysis temperatures (260 C) and will form mainly the more stable cyclic anhydride. The process is therefore primarily used in the production of printing ink resins, where isophthalic acid is the diacid of choice.
If a higher Tg of the resin is desired, for example to obtain harder coatings, the
chemistry of the alkyd resin can be modied after the polycondensation process by
incorporation of phenolic (see Section 16.2) and/or colophonium resins.
The Alkyd Constant
In contrast to radical-type polymerization, in the making of branched polycondensates like alkyds the build-up of molecular weight can be controlled to a large degree. The starting point in these calculations is the understanding that an innite
molecular weight (gelation) can in principle only be obtained if the average functionality F of the monomers is equal to or higher than 2.
This average functionality is dened as: F Ealcohol Eacid /M0 , in which
Ealcohol denotes the number of equivalents of alcohol groups, and Eacid the number
of equivalents of acid groups, while M0 denotes the total number of moles of
monomers in the system. In practice, alkyd resins are cooked with a surplus of
hydroxyl groups. This means that not all the hydroxyl groups will esterify and consequently the number of eective alcohol equivalents is equal to the number of
acid equivalents; in other words, Ealcohol Eacid 2Eacid . Thus, F 2Eacid /M0 . The
alkyd constant K is dened as 2/F, equalling M0 /Eacid , and should not be lower
than 1. In practice, an alkyd constant of 1.021.06 is recommended to avoid gelation regimes at all times.
16.5.2.1

Autoxidative Drying
A basic reaction scheme of the autoxidative drying process is depicted in Scheme
16.18. A catalyst is needed to give this reaction sucient speed; usually a cobalt(II)
salt is used. The diene moieties of the linolenic acids, especially, are involved in
this process. After formation of a conjugated hydroperoxide with molecular oxygen
from the ambient air, the hydroperoxide decomposes into oxy-radicals that can fur16.5.2.2

16.5 Alkyd Resins

Polyester

O
Oxygen, Cobalt (II)
Polyester

O
O

OH

Cobalt (II)
Polyester

Polyester

Polyester

Scheme 16.18.

O
Autoxidative drying of alkyds and oils.

OH

ther react with unsaturations of other fatty acids. Mainly by addition and recombination reactions of these radicals the nal network structure is formed. Side reactions during the autoxidation process can lead to yellowing.
16.5.3

Production

The alcoholysis process has lower raw material costs than the fatty acid process but
higher production costs, since it is a two-step process. The decision whether to produce from oil or from fatty acids is thus largely based on the amount of oil/fatty
acids in the formulation (see short oil/long oil resins, discussed in Section 16.5.4).
Regardless of the way fatty acids are incorporated, the main step of alkyd synthesis is the polyesterication. This process is quite similar to the process for saturated polyester resin production, and actually more or less the same equipment
can be used (Figure 16.3). The polyesterication of the alkyd raw materials normally proceeds at 240 C with the aid of xylene as a mode of transportation of the
water, by forming a binary azeotrope with it. The xylene and water vapors rise
through the column on top of the reactor and are condensed on top of a separator.
The xylene is pumped back into the reactor and the water is removed. Because of

859

860

16 Thermosets

vent
vacuum

distillation
column
inert gas

FC
oil out

T
condensate tank

TC
T
oil in

Fig. 16.3. Reactor design for production of polyester and alkyd


resins. FC, ow control; T, temperature measurement; TC,
temperature control.

undesirable volatile by-products that often form ternary azeotropes with water, the
reaction water cannot be disposed of in the sewage system without incineration.
Variables measured at regular intervals to control and, if necessary, adjust the
process are:


Acid value: a measure for the amount of acid groups still present in the reaction
mixture, expressed in mg potassium hydroxide needed to neutralize 1 g of solid
resin. This value drops throughout the process as the esterication proceeds.
 Viscosity: an indication of the weight-averaged molecular weight, usually measured by the torque of the reactor stirring motor or that of a separate rotor/stator
measuring device. The viscosity increases with time as a result of increasing molecular weight of the resin. If desired, a graph can be drawn plotting log viscosity
against acid value. This is a more or less straight line and enables the operator to
judge whether the resin will be within the specications, which show up on the
graph as a rectangle.
After reaching these specications, potential modications can be made, for example with silicones for better outdoor durability, or polyamides to impart thixotropy.
Finally the resin is cooled, diluted in solvent and/or emulsied, and if necessary
ltered.

16.5 Alkyd Resins

16.5.4

Properties and Applications


Short Oil Alkyds
Short oil alkyds contain less than 35% oil by weight, calculated as triglyceride.
These resins have a relatively high Tg and therefore will feel dry as soon as the
solvent has evaporated from the paint. Chemical drying through the unsaturated
fatty acids will be relatively modest and other crosslinking reactions will have to
be considered. Examples are etherication of the OH groups with resol (see Section 16.2) or amino resins (Section 16.3), either thermally (stoving) or by acid catalysis. Applications are in non-yellowing wood varnishes and protective coatings, for
example for steel constructions.
16.5.4.1

Long Oil Alkyds


Long oil alkyds can contain from 55% oil, even up to 80%. Long oil alkyds are
typically used for trade (professional painting) and DIY (do-it-yourself ) applications. Application is mostly by brush and roller and the paints are supplied in
white spirit.
Their Tg is low and resins will feel sticky several hours after the solvent has
evaporated. Chemical drying is intensive and as a result of this the molecular
weight builds up gradually in time. For a typical long oil alkyd resin, full chemical
drying is obtained in a period of weeks, and can be accompanied by some yellowing. Typical oils/fatty acids that are used are linseed and soybean. Since linseed
contains triply unsaturated fatty acids, it has more crosslinking potential but will
also smell and yellow more. For this reason linseed oil based alkyds are mainly
used for primers. For topcoats the oil of choice is soybean but saower and sunower are also used, the latter being superior to soybean with regard to yellowing
and smell. Other oils with very high unsaturation that are often used in primers
for semi-industrial applications, applied on-site, are sh oil (marine applications)
and tung oil (marine and industrial construction maintenance).
16.5.4.2

Medium Oil Alkyds


Medium oil alkyds contain, as the name already suggests, 3555% oil by weight
and are used in the higher-quality trade and DIY paints. In quick-drying properties
and yellowing they outperform the long oil alkyds and they are mostly dissolved in
white spirit.
16.5.4.3

16.5.5

Alkyd Emulsions

Alkyd paints dominated the architectural coating market for a long period until the
appearance of polymer dispersions or the so-called latex paints. Specically for wall
application waterborne paints based on poly(vinyl acetate) homo- and copolymers,
styreneacrylics and pure acrylic latexes almost completely took over the market
from the alkyd resins for both interior and exterior application. However, for

861

862

16 Thermosets

wood and metal application alkyd paints still enjoy the majority of the market
share, thanks to better overall paint performance. For the same application elds,
alternatives to the conventional alkyd paints were desired for environmental reasons: namely, to avoid the use of (neurotoxic) solvents and solvent emissions to
the air. From about 1980, aqueous alkyd emulsions have been developed and are
now breaking through in the market as environmentally friendly systems. Alkyd
emulsions can best be described as a dispersion of solventless alkyd resin droplets
in water (o/w). When the paint dries, the water evaporates and the emulsion
changes from oil-in-water (o/w) to water-in-oil (w/o). The paint properties of the
dried and autoxidatively crosslinked lm are largely comparable to those derived
from solvent-borne alkyd paints [5].
The Inversion Process
In order to keep this emulsion stable in time during storage, the particle size of the
droplets must be small enough (typically <2 mm) and surfactants must be used.
Alternatively to the use of additional surfactants, incorporation of surface-active
groups, such as polyethylene glycol derivatives, in the alkyd resin is also possible;
it is sometimes even more desirable not to have free surfactant molecules in the
resin from a paint quality point of view. The production of an alkyd emulsion
with built-in surfactants starts with a conventional alkyd polyesterication process,
in which acid- or hydroxy-functional surfactants are added along with the other
monomers. Care must be taken to keep the viscosity as low as possible to facilitate
the next step. After the polycondensation reaction is nished, the resin is cooled to
<100 C and water is slowly added to the hot resin to form a w/o emulsion. With
increasing water content, an inversion to an o/w emulsion will take place. The inversion is accompanied by a large increase in viscosity. After the inversion more
water can be added to reach the right viscosity at room temperature.
16.5.5.1

16.6

Saturated Polyester Resins


16.6.1

Introduction

Thermosetting polyester resins are almost as old as alkyd resins. The rst attempts
to make polyesters derive from the second half of the 19th century. In the beginning of the 20th century more and better-dened polyesters were made by Vorlander and later by Smith. Most of the polyester resins were based on glycerin
and aliphatic diacids as fumaric and adipic acids. From these times the rst application of polyester resins in paints and coatings was developed. Besides the modication with fatty acids (alkyd resins), which are cured by air, thermosetting resins
were developed which are cured by crosslinkers or other resin types. The choice
of monomers, more specically the ratio of polyacids to polyalcohols, determines the type of end groups, for a polyester these being either acid aCOOH

16.6 Saturated Polyester Resins

or hydroxy aOH. These functional end groups can react with epoxy resins (see Section 16.4), isocyanates, phenolic resins (Section 16.2), and melamine resins (Section 16.3).
16.6.2

Chemistry

Polyester resins consist of polyfunctional acids and polyalcohols [6]. These compounds esterify at higher temperatures with evolution of water (Scheme 16.19).
The chemical equilibrium for this polycondensation reaction is unfavorable. It is
important that water is removed from the reaction mixture continuously, shifting
the equilibrium to the right (see Chapter 4). The temperature for this reaction lies
normally between 200 and 260 C and the choice is dependent on the stability of
the raw materials used. This direct esterication reaction is far the most used
chemistry for saturated polyester resins. Polycondensation via transesterication,
as in Scheme 16.20 and primarily used in the synthesis of thermoplastic polyesters, is only occasionally used for resins. By varying the type and the molecular
ratio of the reactants, the molecular weight and structure of the polymer, and the
type and number of functional end groups, can be varied. Excess of acid functional
raw materials gives an acid functional polymer. Excess of polyfunctional alcohols
gives a polymer with hydroxyl end groups. If branching is desired, polyfunctional
raw materials are used. Mostly three- or four-functional polyhydroxyl compounds
are used. In practice a large variety of raw materials are available for the formulator

O
HO

R1

HO

OH

(n+1)

n
O

O
HO

R1

OH

R2

Scheme 16.19.

R2

R1

n
General esterication scheme for OH-polyester resins.

O
HO

R1

CH3O

OH

R2

(n+1)

R1

OCH3

n
O

O
HO

OH + 2n H2O

R2

R1

OH

+ 2n CH3OH

n
Scheme 16.20.

General transesterication scheme for OH-polyester resins.

863

864

HO

16 Thermosets

HO

OH

HO

OH

OH
HO

1,3-propanediol

2-methyl-1,3-propanediol

neopentylglycol

OH
OH

trimethylolpropane
OH

HO

OH

HO

HO

OH

1,2-propanediol

buteneglycol

OH

ethyleneglycol
HO

OH
OH

OH

HO

HO

OH

pentaerythritol
O

1,4-cyclohexanedimethylol
Scheme 16.21.

2,2-dimethyl-1,3-propanediol hydroxypivalic ester

Some polyol monomers used in polyester resins.

O
CO2H

CO2H

O
CO2H
CO2H

CO2H
terephthalic acid

isophthalic acid

phthalic anhydride

CO2H

HO2C

O
O

CO2H
adipic acid

HO2C

trimellitic anhydride

CO2H

CO2H

hexahydrophthalic anhydrid

cyclohexane-1,4-dicarboxylic acid
sebacic acid
Some polyacid monomers used in polyester resins.

Scheme 16.22.

to design the polymer molecule. Schemes 16.21 and 16.22 give an overview of the
most frequently used polyol and polyacid monomers, respectively. In principle, the
molecular weight distribution can be calculated, but for the more complicated formulations computer aid is needed.
The choice of diols depends on which properties the resin would get. Rigid and

16.6 Saturated Polyester Resins

cyclic diols will increase the Tg , melting point, and hardness of the polyester resin.
Long and exible diols will decrease the Tg and melting point, and improve the
exibility. Diols which are substituted on the b-position toward the hydroxyl
groups, such as neopentyl glycol, are normally more resistant against hydrolysis
and photooxidation. Besides a wide variety of diacids, several cyclic anhydrides are
available as well. Anhydrides react faster than the corresponding acids and require
less water to be distilled o. Aliphatic diacids will lower the Tg and melting point,
but give more exibility. Aromatic diacids give a higher Tg and hardness to the
coating lm and are more resistant toward hydrolysis. Aliphatic diacids impart
less UV absorbance to the resin and therefore enhance the UV resistance of coatings made from these resins. From aliphatic diacids, crystalline or semicrystalline
polyester resins can also be made.
16.6.3

Production

Most saturated polyester resins are produced in the melt phase. At temperatures
of about 200260 C and in the presence of a catalyst the diacids and the diols are
esteried by removal of water. The high temperature during the synthesis is normally sucient to remove the water eciently from the reactor by distillation,
under reduced or normal pressure. To remove the last percentages of water and to
complete the reaction, a stronger vacuum is applied at the end of the reaction.
In cases where the resins are to be supplied in a solvent anyway, azeotropic
distillation can be used to remove the water more eciently and at lower temperatures. Figure 16.3 describes the reactor design for polyester resin production,
which can also be applied to alkyd resin production (see Section 16.5). The product
resin can be either cooled and discharged via a cooling belt in case a solid delivery
form is required, or thinned with solvents.
Monitoring the Reaction
The conversion and progress of the esterication reaction are controlled by analyzing samples that are taken from the mixture. For the application of thermosetting
resins the amount of end groups is very important and has to be measured during
production. The concentration of end groups (aCOOH and aOH) is measured by
titration; several titration methods have been developed. The concentration is expressed as the acid value or hydroxyl value in mg KOH per gram resin (by
back-titration in the case of aOH). The removal of water by distillation is not
100% ecient and some diols, diacids, small oligomers, and side products of the
reaction at high temperature can be removed from the reactor with the water. In
order to reach the right specications, small amounts of either diols or diacids
can be added (corrections), as even in the early stages of the reaction a misbalance of the OH/COOH groups can be detected. Another important specication is the viscosity of the melt or of the solution, as an indication for the molecular weight. Both parameters are plotted for a typical polyester resin in Figure 16.4.
16.6.3.1

865

866

16 Thermosets

Fig. 16.4.

Evolution of acid number and viscosity with time during polyester resin synthesis.

16.6.4

Properties and Applications

The ratio of hard to soft monomers determines the Tg of the polymer. The reactivity during the curing reaction and network formation is determined by the
overall amount of end groups and the overall functionality.
The main application of these types of polyester resins is in thermosetting coatings. Thermosetting paints are formulated by mixing polyester resins (in solid
form, melt, or solution) with a crosslinker, pigments, and additives. These paints
will be cured to a coating lm, generally with stoving. Surface coatings based on
saturated polyester resins distinguish themselves from other resins by good adhesion on metals, good exibility (ability to be deformed together with the substrate
after painting), and hardness. Their resistance to hydrolysis is rather poor; their
outdoor durability is modest in comparison to acrylic binders but superior to epoxy
resins. Saturated polyester resins can be applied in all kinds of paint types. The
major application elds today include coatings for beverage and food cans, and
coated steel coils. Saturated polyester resins further play a dominant role in the
binders for thermosetting powder coatings, described in the next paragraph.
16.6.5

Powder Coatings

Powder coatings are, as the name suggests, paints in solid, powdery form [7]. All
the ingredients are solid materials, which are mixed in a hot-melt compounding

16.6 Saturated Polyester Resins

Fig. 16.5.

Powder coating production.

process (extrusion). Figure 16.5 depicts the powder coating preparation process.
Powder paints consist of a binder (polymer, crosslinker and curing catalyst), pigments, and additives. All these solid ingredients are mixed thoroughly in a premixer and fed into an extruder. The mixture is molten and homogenized in a short
period of time, typically in half a minute, to prevent premature crosslinking reactions. After the extrudate is cooled down, it is crushed and milled to the required
particle size, which is dependent of the application but is normally in the range of
about 50100 mm.
Application
Powder paints are commonly applied by electrostatic spraying on metal substrates.
The powder particles are charged inside the spray gun (Corona or Tribo) and adhere to the earthed metal object. Powder coating is ideal for coating complicated
three-dimensional objects because the powder particles can easily reach recessed
surfaces or even the backside of surfaces, following the electrical eld lines from
the gun to the substrate. Powder paint which does not reach the object or disassociates from the surface (overspray) can easily be gathered, recycled, and re-used
without loss of quality (Figure 16.6). The substrate, covered with a layer of powder
paint, is subsequently heated in a hot-air oven. The powder particles melt, coalesce,
and ow out into a lm.
In some special cases the powder paints can be applied by dipping. The object is
preheated and dipped into a uid bed of powder paint particles. The powder particles adhere to the preheated surface of the object and melt into a lm. Further
16.6.5.1

867

868

16 Thermosets

Fig. 16.6.

Powder coating spraying and recycling system.

heating causes the crosslinking reactions in the lm to give the required thermoset
properties. The processes of melting, owing, and curing take place in the same
cycle and this makes it dicult to obtain a completely at lm before the cure prohibits further ow. Powder coatings are therefore characterized by a certain visual
orange peel eect.
Crosslinking
Although many examples exist of thermosetting powder coatings (using mainly
polyamide, polyethylene, and polypropylene), most powder paints are thermosetting systems, which are cured at much higher temperatures (typically 180200 C)
than the extrusion temperature (90110 C). Because of these high curing temperatures, powder coatings nd their application mainly on metal surfaces.
The rst thermosetting powder coating systems were based on bisphenol-A
epoxy resins, which were cured by either amide/amine or carboxylic anhydride
crosslinkers (for the chemistry, see Section 16.4.2). The epoxy-based powder coatings show excellent application properties, such as ow, mechanical strength, and
chemical resistance. However, they have limited exterior durability and they show a
severe tendency toward yellowing. These disadvantages have greatly stimulated the
development of powder coatings based on saturated polyesters with carboxylic end
groups.
When cured with bisphenol-A resins, these polyester resins result in coatings
with much improved exterior durability with less yellowing. When cured with triglycidyl isocyanurate (TGIC) excellent outdoor durability is obtained and polyester
resin coatings are used, for example, in the building industry (facades). The mutagenic properties of TGIC have stimulated the search for safer crosslinkers, such as
b-hydroxyalkylamides, which are now taking over the market.
Hydroxyl-functional polyester resins are also used; these polyesters are cured
with aliphatic (for outdoor use) or aromatic (indoor use) polyisocyanates.
16.6.5.2

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

Advantages
The advantages of powder coating compared to the more classic type of coatings in
solution are clear: they are 100% solvent-free and thick layers up to 500 mm can be
applied in one step. Moreover, they are very cost-ecient owing to a very high application eciency, close to 100%, as over-sprayed powder can be easily recycled.
Last but not least, their mechanical properties are usually equal or superior to
those of their solvent-borne counterparts.
Powder coating can also be favorably combined with UV curing (see Section
16.8.5.2). In that case, the powder coating can also be applied to heat-sensitive substrates such as wood, paper, and plastics because the powder can melt and ow
from about 100 C. In addition, the melt/ow-out phase is easily separated (hot air
or infrared radiation) from the cure phase (irradiation with UV light) resulting in a
good ow. Binders for UV-curable powder coatings are either based on acrylated
saturated polyester resins (see Section 16.8.3.2) or on unsaturated polyesters (Section 16.7) in combination with vinyl ether crosslinkers (Secheme 16.34).
16.6.5.3

16.7

Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites


16.7.1

Introduction

Unsaturated polyester resins (UP resins) cover a broad range of products serving a
wide variety of market segments. They can be considered the most versatile of the
thermoset resins. By varying the resin composition, one can produce an amazing
range of properties in polyesters. Additionally, polyesters are capable of being processed by a number of dierent methods, varying from simple hand-lay-up contact
molding to highly automated compression molding. Glass ber reinforced UP resins are extensively used in building and construction; and in the transportation,
electrical, and electronic industries; and for sanitary and domestic applications.
The biggest use of these resins is in the construction industry, followed by transportation. The worldwide consumption of UP resins in 2002 was approximately
2.5 million metric tons.
16.7.2

Chemistry

The unsaturated polyester is a macromolecule with an Mn value between roughly


1000 and 3000 g mol1 , obtained from a polycondensation reaction (that is, a polymerization with the formation and elimination of water) between unsaturated- and
saturated dicarboxylic acids (or their corresponding anhydrides) and diols [8]. This
reaction and the most commonly used raw materials are represented schematically
in Figure 16.7. Mono- or trifunctional acids or alcohols or other monomers may be
incorporated optionally into the polyester backbone to tailor properties.

869

870

16 Thermosets
Unsaturated
dicarboxylic acids

Saturated
dicarboxylic acids

Maleic anhydride
Fumaric acid

Phthalic anhydride
Isophthalic acid
Terephthalic acid
Adipic acid

Glycols

Other

Propylene glycol
Dipropylene glycol
Ethylene glycol
Diethylene glycol
Neopentyl glycol
Propoxylated
bisphenol A

Benzoic acid
Ethylhexyl alcohol
Trimethylol propane
Dicyclopentadiene

POLYCONDENSATION
OH + HOOC

Unsaturated Polyester
Macromolecule

+ water

Reactive Monomers

Finishing ingredients

Styrene
-Methyl styrene
Methyl methacrylate
Vinyl toluene
Diallylphthalate
Triallylcyanurate

Inhibitors

hydroquinone / benzoquinone
tert. butyl catechol
Stabilizer
copper (I) naphthenate
Accelerator
cobalt- octoate or naphthenate
Thixotropic agent fumed silica
UV absorber
benzophenone derivatives
LSE agent
paraffin or wax

UP resin
Glass fiber reinforcement
Chopped rovings
Chopped strand mat
Woven rovings

Radical initiator
Methyl ethyl ketone peroxide
Benzoyl peroxide
Cumene hydroperoxide
tert Butyl perbenzoate

Fillers
Calcium carbonate
Aluminum trihydrate
Pigments / colorants
Titanium dioxide
Zinc sulfide

RADICAL POLYMERIZATION

Cured UP-based
composite
Fig. 16.7.

Unsaturated polyester resins: from raw materials to cured composites.

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

The preferred unsaturation in the polyester backbone is the fumaric double


bond, which results from using either fumaric acid or maleic anhydride as the unsaturated dicarboxylic acid. Under the reaction conditions normally applied to synthesize the polyester, most of the maleic (cis) double bonds isomerize to fumaric
(trans) double bonds. The unsaturated polyester macromolecule itself is either a
very viscous liquid or a solid. Usually this polyester is dissolved in a reactive monomer containing a double bond capable of copolymerizing through a radical polymerization with the (fumaric) unsaturations in the polyester backbone. The workhorse of the reactive solvents is styrene. The low-viscosity polyester solution (UP
resin) thus obtained is formulated with a number of ingredients that provide critical properties, such as storage stability, reactivity, thixotropy, UV resistance, and
color, before being sold by the polyester producer.
Crosslinking
The processor converts the liquid polyester by means of a radical polymerization,
in the presence of glass ber reinforcement and/or llers, into a three-dimensional
composite network as displayed in Figure 16.7. This so-called crosslinking or curing reaction takes place between the fumaric unsaturations in the polyester backbone and the unsaturation in the styrene monomer. The reaction is typically initiated by free radicals generated by the decomposition of peroxides. Depending upon
the type of peroxide (and optionally the accelerator used) the crosslinking reaction
may take place at temperatures as low as 10 C or as high as 160 C.
The rate at which these radicals are generated is one of the factors determining
how fast a resin gels and cures. The temperature development of a mass of resin
against time from the moment of (accelerator and) peroxide addition is an important characteristic of a polyester resin. This is illustrated for a typical curing process at ambient temperature in Figure 16.8. The portion AB is the induction period
during which free radicals produced by decomposition of the peroxide are being
absorbed by the inhibitor present in the resin. This is the so-called pot life of the
resin, during which processing of the part can take place. This time may vary from
a few minutes up to 20 h. At point B the inhibitor concentration has become low
enough for an appreciable proportion of the free radicals produced to initiate resin
polymerization. Due to heat of polymerization, the temperature rises. The exothermic peak D does not necessarily correspond to completion of the curing process.
As the resin solidies during the latter part of the curing process, the rate of reaction is greatly reduced (diusion-controlled). A post-cure at elevated temperatures
may be needed to reach full cure.
16.7.2.1

Styrene Emission
Actually more than 50% of UP resin consumption still involves open-mold techniques, hand lay-up and spray-up being the most important. During processing and
curing, styrene emission is considerable. Styrene (boiling point 145 C) is classied
as a dangerous substance according to EC Directive 67/548/EEC and is labeled
with the following R (Risk) and S (Safety) phrases: R10 (ammable), R20 (harmful
by inhalation), R36/38 (irritating to eyes, skin, and respiratory tract), S2 (keep out
16.7.2.2

871

872

16 Thermosets
Peak temperature

Temp (C)
150

35
25

Peak time

B
50

Fig. 16.8.

80

Time (min)

A typical curing prole of unsaturated polyester resins at ambient temperature.

of reach of children), S23 (do not breathe gas/fumes/vapor/spray). In 1992 the European Center for Ecotoxicology and Toxicity of Chemicals concluded in a study,
Styrene Toxicology, that the carcinogenic potential of styrene is so low that occupational or environmental exposure to styrene is unlikely to present any genotoxic or
carcinogenic hazard in humans. Styrene has, however, a proven neurotoxic eect.
Occupational exposure to high styrene concentrations may lead to symptoms like
drowsiness, headache, and tiredness. As a consequence the threshold limit value
(TLV) has been lowered signicantly since the 1980s in virtually all countries.
The UP industry reacted by developing so-called LSE (low styrene emission)- and
LSC (low styrene content) resins. An LSE resin contains paran or wax in such a
concentration that upon only a little styrene evaporation it forms a thin barrier lm
on top of the laminate, curtailing styrene emission. However, one aspect that warrants attention is the interlaminar adhesion of parts built up from several laminate
layers. Note that these LSE resins are only active in the static state when the surface of the laminate is at rest. During processing, when the surface is regularly disturbed, the eect of the lm-forming additive is far less.
LSC resins have a styrene concentration between 2535% versus the 4050% of
classical UP resins. Because of the lower styrene content, the evaporation during
processing and cure is considerably less. As the processing technique is determining the viscosity range of the resin that can be used, this property cannot be
changed. So, keeping the same resin viscosity at lower styrene content implies
that the viscosity of the unsaturated polyester must be reduced. This can be
achieved by reducing the molecular weight of the unsaturated polyester but, unfortunately, this leads to a strong deterioration of mechanical and chemical proper-

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

O
H2 O
O
80-100C
O

O
OH

OH

OH

100-150C

O
Glycols,
(un)saturated
dicarboxylic acids

Unsaturated Polyester with DCPD end groups


Polycondensation
Scheme 16.23.

Synthesis of DCPD end-capped unsaturated polyester resins.

ties. Another way is to replace the polar end groups of the polyester by apolar end
groups, which show good solubility in styrene. Dicyclopentadiene (DCPD) endcapped polyesters (see Scheme 16.23) are therefore the resins of choice to reach
the required properties. Of course, addition of paran to these resins will further
reduce the styrene emission.
The most obvious way to reduce styrene emission is to use another monomer.
However, there appears to be no real alternative that fullls all the technical and
economical requirements as well as being less toxic, and consequently styrene is
at most partially replaced in some cases.
Other elements which alone, or in combination, will contribute to less styrene
emission/exposure in the workplace are:


use of specially designed spray guns (for example, ow coaters), which reduce
the surface area of the resin that is sprayed, and consequently reduce emission;
 a change from open mold techniques to closed or semi-closed mold techniques;
in particular, the vacuum-assisted resin infusion technique, whereby a exible
lm is used as a counter-mold, is gaining popularity;
 proper and adequate ventilation;
 use of robots.
Vinyl Ester Resins
A special class of unsaturated polyesters, developed for composite applications in
corrosive environments, is the so-called vinyl esters and vinyl ester urethane resins.
The best-known vinyl ester is made by reacting the diglycidyl ether of bisphenolA (DGEBA; see Section 16.4.2) with a monocarboxylic unsaturated acid such as
methacrylic or acrylic acid; see Scheme 16.24. This addition reaction occurs at a
temperature of 120140 C. The vinyl ester urethanes, on the other hand, are synthesized from a low molecular weight (unsaturated) polyester diol, mostly based on
bisphenol-A, a diisocyanate, and a hydroxyalkyl (meth)acrylate (see also Schemes
16.30 and 16.31, Section 16.8.3.3). As for standard UP resins, the most commonly
used reactive solvent is styrene. Both types of products have only a few ester linkages (which are the points of greatest vulnerability to chemical attack) in the mole16.7.2.3

873

874

16 Thermosets

O
O
OH

O
Scheme 16.24.

HO

OH

OH
O

O
O

Synthesis of vinyl esters from methacrylic acid and DGEBPA.

cule and hence show improved chemical resistance, whilst the network built up
from the terminal (meth)acrylate double bonds results in a tougher, more resilient
resin structure.
In Table 16.4, the UP, vinyl ester, and vinyl ester urethane resins are classied in
order of chemical resistance.
16.7.3

Production

Unsaturated polyesters are produced batchwise in agitated stainless steel reactors


of up to 50-ton capacities (see Figure 16.3). The reactors are equipped with heating
jackets and internal heating coils to bring the raw materials to the required reaction temperature (190230 C).
The production starts by charging the raw materials into the reactor by the use of
pumps and meters for liquids such as most of the glycols, molten maleic anhydride, and molten phthalic anhydride. Solid raw materials, such as isophthalic
acid, are added manually by emptying big bags or automatically by pneumatic
transport from silos. All the reactants may be charged in one go except for a few
dicarboxylic acids which are somewhat more dicult to esterify. In the latter case
a two-stage method is applied in which the rst step is the reaction of such a dicarboxylic acid (for example, isophthalic or terephthalic acid) with a large excess of
glycol until a clear solution with a low acid number is obtained, followed by addition and reaction of the other raw materials. When the reactor is brought up to its
reaction temperature the contents are periodically sampled to determine the acid
number (a measure of the acid groups that have not yet reacted) and viscosity;
this may be done either o-line or in-line. The synthesis is continued until the
specied acid number and viscosity values are achieved. The distillation column
performs the separation of water from unreacted (low-boiling) glycols. During synthesis, inert gas (usually nitrogen) ows continuously through the reactor to prevent gelation due to oxidation and to aid removal of water. An alternative method
used to remove the water formed from the reaction mixture is to apply vacuum.

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

Reaction times vary from 8 to 30 h, depending on the raw materials used, the
degree of condensation or molecular weight desired, and the reaction temperature
employed.
After cooling, the unsaturated polyester is discharged from the reactor into the
so-called thinning tank, which has a preweighed styrene charge in it. The resin is
then nished with additives, tested for quality control, and pumped to storage.
16.7.4

Reinforcement

The majority of the UP resins are used in glass ber reinforced (GRP) applications.
Because E-glass oers sucient strength at low cost it accounts for more than 90%
of all glass ber reinforcements. It also provides good electrical resistance (hence
its name). Sizing is applied to the laments immediately after their formation to
ease processing, to protect the bers from breakage during processing, and to create better bonding between the ber and the resin matrix. Although it comprises
only 0.255% of the total ber weight, sizing is a dynamic force behind the performance of any berglass product. Sizing chemistry distinguishes each manufacturers product and determines the grade of berglass for dierent processing
techniques. Sizing can improve the wettability of the ber during resin impregnation, thereby reducing part-manufacturing time. Coupling chemistry to enhance
bonding between the glass ber and the matrix resin can also improve the overall
strength of the nal composite.
Glass laments are supplied in bundles called strands, rovings, or yarns. A
strand is a collection of more than one continuous glass lament. A roving generally refers to a bundle of untwisted strands wound in parallel to form a cylindrical,
at-ended package, similar to thread on a spool. Single-end roving contains only
one continuous strand of multiple glass laments. Multiple-end roving contains
numerous wound strands. Yarns are collections of laments or strands that are
twisted together.
Rovings, the most common form of glass ber, can be chopped or woven to create secondary ber forms used in composite manufacturing.
Mats are non-woven fabrics that provide equal strength in all directions.
Chopped mats contain randomly distributed bers cut to lengths typically ranging
from 4 to 6 cm and held together with a chemical binder. These mats provide lowcost polymer reinforcement primarily in hand lay-up, continuous laminating, and
some closed-mold applications. Continuous-strand mat is formed by swirling ber
onto a moving belt nished with a chemical binder that holds the ber in place.
Continuous-strand mat is primarily used in compression molding, resin transfer
molding, and pultrusion applications.
Woven rovings are made by weaving the untwisted rovings into cloth. Bidirectional woven fabrics provide good strength in the 0 /90 directions and allow fast
composite fabrication. To prevent laminates failing by interlaminar shear between
layers of woven rovings, these are generally interspersed with layers of choppedstrand mat.

875

Resin
type

UP

UP

UP

UP

UP

UP

UP

UP

VE

1A

1B

2A

2B

7A

neopentyl and halogenated neopentyl


glycol (min 80 mol%)[c] and a diol
with at least one secondary OH
group (max 20 mol%)[c]
hydrogenated bisphenol A[d] and
cyclohexane dimethanol
dipropoxy-bisphenol A and/or
dipropoxy halogenated bisphenolA
epoxidized bisphenol-A and/or
epoxidized halogenated bisphenolA

standard glycols[a]

standard glycols[a]

standard glycols[a,b]

methacrylic aid and/or acrylic acid

orthophthalic acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids
ethylenedicarboxylic acids

orthophthalic acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids
orthophthalic acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids
isophthalic acid, HET acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids
isophthalic acid, HET acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids
terephthalic acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids
isophthalic acid, orthophthalic acid,
ethylenedicarboxylic acids

standard glycols[a,b]
standard glycols[a,b]

Types of acids

Types of glycols

55

55

45

55

50

50

50

45

45

Styrene
content
[wt.%]
max.

110

130

120

120

140

120

85

120

85

Tg
[ C]
min.

90

110

90

90

110

90

60

90

60

HDT
[ C]
min.

75

60

50

65

75

50

60

50

60

Tensile
strength
[MPa]
min.

4.0

2.0

1.5

3.0

3.0

1.5

2.0

1.5

2.0

Elongation
at break
(tension)
[ %] min.

Classication of UP, vinyl ester, and vinyl ester urethane resins according to their chemical resistance (European standard EN 1321).

Resin
group

Tab. 16.4.

130

110

100

110

120

75

90

75

90

Flexural
strength
[MPa]
min.

876

16 Thermosets

VE

dialkoxy-bisphenol-A and/or dialkoxy


halogenated bisphenol-A (min.
90%), alkoxy (meth)acrylate
epoxidized novolac
methacrylic aid and/or acrylic acid

ethylenedicarboxylic acids

[a] Standard glycols: ethylene, 1,2-propene, diethylene, dipropene


glycols; neopentyl glycol, 1,3-butanediol, 1,4-butanediol and
corresponding halogenated glycols.
[b] May also contain cyclic unsaturated hydrocarbons.
[c] Related to the sum of the diol components.
[d] This diol deviates from the one mentioned in EN 13121; the diol
mentioned in this table is more commonly used.
Note: The chemical resistance of the resins increases on going from
group 1 ! group 8.

VEU

7B

50

50

150

120

120

105

75

75

2.5

3.5

130

130

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites


877

878

16 Thermosets
Tab. 16.5.

A comparison of reinforcing bers.

Reinforcing ber

Tensile
strength
[MPa]

Tensile
modulus
[GPa]

Specic
gravity
[g cmC3 ]

Properties

Aramide

28003000

85130

1.44

Boron
Carbon

3500
25003200

400
210700

2.55
1.751.96

Glass: E-glass

2400

72

2.54

S-glass

4500

85

2.49

Polyester

1050

10

1.38

Polyamide

1000

1.16

Ultra high molecular


weight polyethylene

3400

110

0.975

low density, good specic


properties, moderate cost
high modulus, high cost
high modulus, electrical
conductivity, high cost
good strength and
processability, low cost
high strength and good
processability
good impact resistance and
chemical properties
good impact resistance,
alkali resistant
low density, good impact

Surfacing mat, or veil, is used in conjunction with reinforcing mats and fabrics
to provide good surface nish. It is eective in blocking out the ber pattern of the
underlying mat or fabric. Surfacing mats are also used as the inside layers of corrosion resistant composites, providing a smooth, resin-rich surface.
Fibers can also be produced from carbon, boron, and aramid materials. Generally these bers exhibit higher tensile strength and stiness than do their glass
counterparts, as can be seen in Table 16.5. However, these specialty bers are
more expensive. Therefore they are typically reserved for applications demanding
exceptional ber properties, for which the customer is willing to pay a premium.
16.7.5

Fillers

Fillers not only reduce the costs of composites, but also frequently impart performance improvements which might not otherwise be achieved by the reinforcement
and resin ingredients alone. Fillers can improve re and smoke resistance by reducing organic content in composite laminates. Other important properties that
can be improved through the proper use of llers include water resistance, weathering, surface smoothness, stiness, dimensional stability, and temperature resistance. Calcium carbonate is the most widely used inorganic ller. It is available at
low cost in a variety of particle sizes and surface treatments.
Aluminum trihydrate is used as a ller when improved re/smoke performance
is required. When exposed to high temperatures this ller gives o water in a

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

highly endothermic reaction, thereby reducing the ame spread and development
of smoke.
16.7.6

Processing

Fabricators of unsaturated polyester resins use either open-mold or closed-mold


processes. The main open-mold processes are hand lay-up, spray-up, continuous
lamination, lament winding, and centrifugal casting. The most used closed-mold
techniques are hot-press molding and resin-transfer molding. Pultrusion and coldpress molding may be considered as semi-open or semi-closed processes. An overview of the processing techniques for UP resins, their possibilities and limitations,
is given in Table 16.6.
Irrespective of the process used to produce glass-reinforced composites there are
three basic principles in selecting materials for a particular end use [9]:


mechanical strength;
chemical, electrical, and thermal properties;
 cost/performance.


Mechanical strength The type of ber, the amount in the composite, and the way
in which the individual strands are positioned determine the direction and level of
strength that is achieved. There are three generic types of ber orientation:


unidirectional oriented bers, providing the greatest strength in the direction of


the bers;
 bidirectional oriented bers, with some bers positioned at an angle to the rest,
as with woven fabric: this provides dierent strength levels in each direction of
ber orientation;
 multidirectional or randomly oriented bers: this arrangement provides essentially equal strength in all directions of the nished part.
Chemical, electrical, and thermal properties The chemical building blocks of the
polyester, the molar ratio of maleic anhydride to saturated dicarboxylic acid, and
the choice and content of the monomer dictate to a large extent the mechanical
properties (rigid or exible), the glass transition temperature (Tg ) or HDT (heat deection temperature), and the thermal and chemical resistance of the cured products. Additives are available for use with many resin systems to provide properties
such as color, high surface nish, UV resistance, and low shrinkage.
Cost/performance If a large number of parts are to be made from one set of
molds, the lowest unit production cost is likely to be obtained by using compression or injection molding. In these processes, presses, tooling, and automated handling equipment can be applied to speed production cycles and reduce direct labor

879

metal rollers
or sheet

single GRP,
wood, etc

steel or
around
plastic
liner

ambient to
100
high

60110
low

5580
225

2535
225,
usually
210
ambient
to 40
high

2535
25

Filament
winding

Glass [wt%]
Laminate
thickness
[mm]
Cure temp.
[ C]
Styrene
emission
Type of mold

Continuous
lamination

mat, chopped rovings,


rovings
mat,
woven
rovings

Hand lay-up
and spray up

steel

hardened
steel die

ambient to 100150
100
high
low

5075
225

ambient
to 60
low

4065
250

mat, woven
rovings,
cont.
bers,
preform

Resin
infusion
(vacuum)

double GRP bottom,


or metal
GRP or
light
metal;
top, foil

low

2550

2550
110

mat, woven
rovings

rovings, mat
mat,
chopped
rovings,
woven
roving
1540
225

Cold-press
molding

Centrifugal Pultrusion
casting

Comparison of common composite process considerations.

Type of rechopped
inforcement
rovings,
mat,
woven
rovings

Tab. 16.6.

ambient
to 60
low

mat,
woven
rovings,
cont.
bers,
preform
2550
26

matched
metal

low

100170

2570
110

chopped
rovings,
mat

Hot-press
Resin
molding
transfer
(BMC/SMC)
molding
( p I 1 bar)

double
bottom,
GRP or
sti
light
GRP,
metal
top, ex.
GRP

ambient
to 60
low

mat,
woven
rovings,
cont.
bers,
preform
2555
26

Light resin
transfer
molding
( p I 1 bar)

880

16 Thermosets

Typical
products

high
operatordependent
one
smooth
surface
boats, garden
ponds,
containers,
shelters

low

roong
lights,
corrugated
sheets

up to 12 m
min1
low
good

>500 km y1 12000

11000

moderate

tanks,
pipes,
tubes

pipes and
tubes

moderate
low
good: inside good: two
smooth
smooth
surfaces

moderate

>1000

rods, tubes,
proles

up to 4 m
min1
low
good

>300 km y1

no

no

yes

no

yes

foam
panels
No. of
moldings to
justify the
investment
Production
rate
Labor content
Quality of
molding

no

no

yes

inserts

no. of crosssections
no

no

yes, externally
no

no

yes

continuous,
generally
generally
die dimen6m
6 m long,
sions (600
long,
6m
mm  250
6m
diameter
mm)
diameter

Molded in
ribs

width of the
machine

in principle,
none

Size
limitation

yes

generally
no
5005000

low

1005000

generally
no
generally
no
yes

moderate
to high
low
moderate
moderate
good; two
good; two
good; one
smooth
smooth
smooth,
surfaces
one semisurfaces
smooth
surface
truck
automotive, boat hulls,
wind mill
parts,
industrial,
wings
hatches,
electrical
covers
parts,
ventilator
housings

moderate

yes

yes

11000

yes

in principle, mold
none
dimensions

yes

press size

radomes,
panels

moderate
to high
moderate
good; two
smooth
surfaces

5005000

generally
no
generally
no
yes

mold
dimensions

automotive,
industrial,
electrical
parts

low
excellent;
two
smooth
surfaces

high

>10 000

no

yes

yes

press size

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites


881

882

16 Thermosets

costs. Conversely, if only a limited number of parts are required, the simpler processes such as hand lay-up or spray-up may be the cost-eective methods, since
they usually involve low-cost tooling and minimal fabrication equipment. Occasionally, the shape of the part dictates that a particular process is used. For instance, cylindrical objects can often best be made by centrifugal casting or lament winding, and components having constant cross-sections that require high
strength by pultrusion.
The main conversion techniques for UP resins are explained in Sections
16.7.6.116.7.6.10.
Hand Lay-up and Spray-up
Both hand lay-up and spray-up processes essentially involve placing reinforcement
and liquid resin onto the surface of an open mold. As the two names suggest, hand
lay-up involves applying the resin and reinforcement (for example, glass ber
chopped-strand mats) by hand, while spray-up uses spray equipment to deposit
resin and reinforcement (for example, chopped glass bers) onto the mold. These
relatively cheap techniques are often used to produce large, complicated, strong
composite parts such as boat hulls.
16.7.6.1

Continuous Lamination
Continuous lamination is another open-mold process. In this method resin is doctored onto a lm of cellophane or poly(vinyl alcohol) and glass mat or chopped rovings placed on top of the resin. A second lm is then placed on top of this, and the
sandwich obtained is passed through rollers, which compact and remove air. They
can also shape, as with corrugated type laminates. The sandwich is then passed
through a heat source for curing.
16.7.6.2

Filament Winding
Filament winding is a technique used for the manufacture of pipes, tubes, cylinders, and spheres and is frequently used for the construction of large tanks and
pipe work for the chemical industry. In the process glass bers are drawn through
a resin bath to impregnate them with resin. The impregnated rovings are then
wound under tension round a rotating mandrel. Generally the feed head supplying
the rovings to the mandrel traverses backward and forward along the mandrel.
By suitable design, the structures obtained, having a glass content of up to 80%,
can withstand very high pressures.
The lament winding process may be combined with spray-up. This hybrid process is called chop hoop. The reinforcement of the resulting laminate than consists of a blend of continuous and randomly chopped bers.
16.7.6.3

Centrifugal Casting
In centrifugal casting, resin, llers, and reinforcement are deposited against the inside surface of a rotating mold. Centrifugal force holds the material in place until
the part is cured. The interior surface of the centrifugally cast parts can be given an
16.7.6.4

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

additional layer of pure resin to improve their surface appearance and to provide
additional chemical resistance. Large-diameter composite pipes are produced by
this technique.
Pultrusion
Pultrusion is a technique used for producing continuous-ber reinforced sections
in which the orientation of the bers is kept constant during cure. The composites
are made by pulling reinforcement through a resin-impregnating bath and then
through a heated die, the interior of which has the desired shape. Pultruded composites, due to their generally high reinforcement levels (6075%), have exceptionally high mechanical properties parallel to the direction of pultrusion. Examples
of pultruded products are ladder rails, electrical equipment, insulator rods, light
poles, window proles, and gratings.
16.7.6.5

Cold-press Molding
Reinforcing material, which may be glass mat or woven fabric, is cut to shape and
placed in the GRP or light metal mold. Then the resin is poured in and the press
closed with a strong deceleration toward the end of the stroke. The resin displaces
air and impregnates the reinforcement. The heat of polymerization generated accelerates the cure of the resin, giving a relatively short cycle time.
16.7.6.6

Resin Infusion
In this process one GRP mold is used and a plastic bag or lm mounted along the
mold ange. Resin is pulled through the reinforcement that is placed between the
rigid and exible molds, using vacuum. Applications include large parts, which are
normally produced using contact molding. Resin infusion is a closed process and
thus limits the evaporation of styrene into the atmosphere.
16.7.6.7

Resin-transfer Molding
This method employs a male and a female GRP or metal mold, which are designed
to t tightly together with a rubber gasket seal. The reinforcement is placed between the molds. After the molds have been clamped together, catalyzed resin is
forced into the mold by pressure (or vacuum) until resin leaves the mold through
a vent hole. An overspill area is built into the mold to ensure that after trimming a
good-quality molded edge is left. Low-viscosity resins are necessary to keep the
pressure requirements moderate and to facilitate wetting-out of the reinforcement.
16.7.6.8

Hot-press Molding
With hot-press molding the most convenient method is to use a preformed molding compound to which all the necessary ingredients have been added. Two commonly used molding compounds are SMC (sheet molding compound) and BMC
(bulk molding compound).
SMC is composed basically of ve principal ingredients: unsaturated polyester
resin, shrink-reducing thermoplastic, reinforcement, llers, and additives (see
16.7.6.9

883

884

16 Thermosets
Tab. 16.7.

Typical compositions of SMC and BMC.

Ingredient

Function

Unsat. polyester styrene


t-Butyl peroxybenzoate
Zinc stearate
Magnesium oxide
Pigment dispersion
Calcium carbonate
Thermoplastic additive
Chopped rovings

Formulation [parts by weight]

resin
radical initiator
mold release
thickening
color
ller
shrink reduction
reinforcement

SMC

BMC

100
23
34
23
08
150200
520
50100

100
12
34
03
015
200250
520
4575

Table 16.7). SMC technology comprises two distinct manufacturing steps: compounding and molding. In the compounding operation all the ingredients, except
the bers, are mixed together to form a highly viscous paste. The paste is then applied to two carrier lms (usually polyethylene) to form a sandwich layer with the
glass bers in the middle (see Figure 16.9).
The compounded sheets are then stored to mature in a controlled environment;
in a period of three to seven days the viscosity of the compound increases from
about 25 Pa s to 25 000 Pa s or higher. This thousand-fold increase in viscosity is
obtained through a so-called thickening reaction. In chemical terms the added
magnesium oxide reacts with the carboxylic end groups of the unsaturated polyester to obtain longer polyester chains through complex salt formation. Moreover, the
obtained magnesium carboxylate salts cluster in an ionic lattice, giving rise to a fur-

Resin / filler
paste
Carrier film

Continuous strand roving

Paste
Chopper

Compaction rollers
Carrier film

Take-up roll

Fig. 16.9.

Schematic representation of the SMC machine.

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

ther viscosity increase. The rst part of the reaction, the salt formation, is irreversible, while the ionic forces break down within the lattice again upon heating in the
molding process and allow the compound to ow.
When the compound is ready for molding it is cut into pieces of predetermined
dimensions. The pieces are then stacked in a specic arrangement (charge pattern)
in the mold so that the ow of the material is optimal. The ow is achieved by the
compression action of the mold, which is normally a matched set of steel dies
heated to a temperature of about 150 C. During the molding cycle (at a pressure
of about 7.5 GPa), which is about 13 min long, the resin cures completely. When
the mold opens, the part is removed and trimmed before it is sent to secondary
operations, which may include cutting holes and openings using a water jet,
router, punch, or drill. Very often, dierent SMC parts are glued together to improve structural integrity as well as to provide space for hardware assembly.
In the past, molding compound growth into many high volume applications was
excluded because of high polymerization shrinkage resulting in surface defects,
warpage, internal cracks, and notable depression (sink) on the surface opposite
reinforcing ribs and bosses. The ultimate solution to the problem has been the
addition of certain thermoplastics to the formulation of the composite. These thermoplastics, also called low-shrink- or low-prole additives, are usually present at
only 25 wt% of the nal molded part or 720 wt% of the organic portion of the
formulation.
In all eective formulations two phases are formed in the cured composite: a
crosslinked thermosetting phase and a separated thermoplastic phase well dispersed throughout the resin matrix. Upon heating of the composite during the
molding process the thermoplastic is far above its glass transition temperature
and the thermal expansion counteracts the volume shrinkage of the crosslinking
unsaturated polyester. Upon cooling, micro-voids are created in the composite due
to a higher thermal shrinkage of the thermoplastic phase than the crosslinked thermoset. The best shrinkage control systems (low-prole and class A systems), those
with the most phase separation and micro-voiding, do not provide uniform pigmentation, particularly in darker colors. Shrinkage control systems that are less effective (low-shrinkage systems) provide reasonable pigment acceptance but at the
cost of reduced dimensional stability and surface smoothness.
A parallel technology to SMC is bulk molding compound (BMC). BMC consists
basically of the same ingredients as SMC (see Table 16.7). However, its production
method, appearance, and properties dier.
BMC is commonly manufactured by using high-speed plowshare mixers. The
dierent components of the paste are fed into the mixer and mixed until the compound is fully homogeneous. The chopped-glass bers are introduced at the end of
the process to prevent too much ber degradation.
BMC may be used in compression as well as in injection molding. In the latter
process the compound is conveyed from the hopper to the nozzle of the barrel by
screw rotation or plunger displacement. The metered charge is fed into the heated
mold by fast translation of the screw or plunger. Similarly to SMC-based composites, BMC products are characterized by stiness, temperature resistance, and di-

885

886

16 Thermosets

mensional stability. Due to the shorter glass bers, however, strength and impact
are lower.
Casting, Encapsulation, and Coating (Non-reinforced Applications)
Although the majority of UP resins nd their way to reinforced composites, there
are also some non-reinforced applications, such as the polyester resins widely used
for button manufacture. Here the resin needs to be colorless and color-stable after
cure. Furthermore, when cured the resin should exhibit good hot water resistance,
hardness, and impact resistance. Such resins are also used for encapsulation purposes. In most non-reinforced applications, however, use is made of resins with
high ller loadings of up to 85 wt%. Cultured marble, polyester concrete, and
auto-repair putties are examples of such applications. Yet another non-reinforced
application is that of coatings: gel coat and topcoat are typical coatings used for
polyester-based laminates, while special UV-curable unsaturated polyester resins
are used in high-gloss coatings for furniture.
16.7.6.10

16.7.7

Design Considerations: Mechanical Properties of Composites

Composite designers choose from a variety of ber reinforcement and resin systems (both thermoset and thermoplastic) to develop a part. Basically, the reinforcement provides mechanical properties such as stiness and tensile and impact
strength. The matrix material transfers the loads to the bers, and also protects
the bers from abrasion and chemical attack.
Thermoset matrices have E-moduli between 3000 and 4000 MPa while those of
E-glass reinforcements are about 70 000 MPa. The tensile strength of glass bers is
around 2400 MPa and that of an UP resin about 5060 MPa. The glass ber content of the composite is usually between 25 and 75%.
The bers may be oriented randomly within the resin, but it is also possible to
arrange for them to be oriented preferentially in the direction expected to have the
highest stress. Such a material is said to be anisotropic (having dierent properties
in dierent directions), and control of the anisotropy is an important means of optimizing the material for specic applications.
Consider a typical region of composite of unit dimensions constructed from
parallel and continuous arrangements. This region can be idealized as shown in
Figure 16.10 on the left-hand side, by gathering all the bers together, leaving the
matrix to occupy the remaining volume.
The total load applied in the direction of the bers to the composite (F// ) is
carried partly by the reinforcing bers and partly by the matrix according to the
generic Eq. (1).
F// Ff Fm

The ber and matrix phases act in parallel to support the load. In terms of stress

16.7 Unsaturated Polyester Resins and Composites

F//

Fig. 16.10. Loading of the composite parallel (left) and


perpendicular (right) to the direction of the bers.

(s) equation (1) can be rewritten as Eq. (2), where s// ; sf , and sm are respectively
the average stress in the tensile bar, the stress in the ber, and the stress in the
matrix. A is the cross-section of the test bar, A f the total cross-section of the bers,
and A m the remaining cross-section of the matrix.
s//  A sf  A f sm  A m

To what extent the stress is carried by the bers depends on the grip the matrix
has on the reinforcement. In the worst case, due to a total lack of adhesion between the ber and the matrix, there is no grip at all. The matrix solely then governs the properties, and consequently the composite shows a poor mechanical performance. The perfect grip, on the other hand, results from innitely long bers
with an excellent adhesion to the matrix. In this ideal case the strain (e) in the
bers is equal to that of the matrix (iso-strain conditions). Knowing that for a material with a linear elastic behavior s Ee, wherein E is the stiness or Youngs
modulus, we can derive Eq. (3) from Eq. (2).
E//  e  A Ef  e  A f Em  e  A m

For innitely long bers the volume fraction is directly represented by the respective cross-sections. Bearing in mind that the strain is the same in all cases, we rewrite Eq. (3) to get Eq. (4), where E// ; Ef , and Em are the moduli of the composite,
ber and matrix, and jf and jm are the volume fractions of the ber and matrix
(jf jm 1).

887

888

16 Thermosets

E Ef  jf Em  jm

This relationship is known as the rule of mixtures, predicting the overall modulus in terms of the moduli of the constituent phases and their volume fractions.
Using essentially the same approach, but for iso-stress conditions, it is possible
to calculate the corresponding relationship for the modulus perpendicular to the
ber direction. In that case the total grip of the matrix is not sucient to deform
the reinforcement, which usually has a much higher modulus than the matrix.
Here, as a rst approximation, the transverse modulus, E? , is determined by considering the matrix and reinforcement acting in series (see Figure 16.12, righthand side). In this situation it is not the strains of the reinforcement and the matrix that are equal, but the stresses (an idealization), as Eq. (5) states.
s? sf sm

The deection of the bers and the matrix add to give the overall transverse deection [Eq. (6)].
e? ef em

Since s E  e for small deformations, the Eq. (7) for the transverse modulus can
be derived.
1/E? jf /Ef 1  jf /Em

Inspection of these simple equations reveals that at the usual levels of ber addition the longitudinal modulus is dominated by the ber modulus but the transverse modulus is more inuenced by the matrix modulus. The prediction of transverse modulus is considered less reliable, in spite of its occasional agreement with
experiment.
In more complicated composites, for instance those with bers in more than one
direction or those having particulate or other non-brous reinforcements, Eq. (4)
provides an upper bound to the composite modulus, while Eq. (7) is a lower
bound.
The formulas above are related to continuous bers but in practice the bers
have a nite length. There is a critical length, equal to the shortest length which
will allow the stress in the ber to reach the tensile fracture stress. This length depends upon the ratio of the moduli of the two phases, the strength of the interfacial bond, and the shear strength of the polymer. Typical values for glass and carbon bers are about 12 mm; in fact it is not the ber length by itself but, more
precisely, the aspect ratio, that is, the ratio of length to diameter of the ber, that
governs the properties.
More detailed calculations of the mechanical properties of composites can be
found in Ref. 10.

16.8 Acrylate Resins and UV Curing

16.8

Acrylate Resins and UV Curing


16.8.1

Introduction

The term acrylate resins refers to acrylate-functional polymers. This means that
the reactive group, which can be either an acrylate or a methacrylate functionality
(Scheme 16.25), is still present in the polymer. (This is also the distinction from
acrylics, which are polymers prepared from acrylate monomers and in which the
acrylate functionality is no longer present.) These polymers are generally dissolved
in a reactive diluent or in a diluent mixture. Depending upon the application these
resins are cured with a peroxide initiator or with the combination of light and a
photoinitiator, the so-called UV curing [11]; see Section 16.8.5. When curing occurs with a peroxide, the peroxide is mixed with the resin and the mixture is then
cast into on a mold.

O
O R

Acrylate
Scheme 16.25.

O R
CH3

Methacrylate
Chemical structures of acrylate and methacrylate functionality.

The reactive diluent is required for tuning the resin formulation to the application viscosity. The nature of the diluent is partly dependent on the structure of the
resin. In the case of methacrylate-functional resins, methacrylate-functional diluents are mostly used, whereas in the case of acrylate-functional resins, acrylatefunctional diluents are commonly applied.
Between acrylates and methacrylates there is a great dierence in the homopolymerization rates. As a rule of thumb, it can be said that acrylates are ten times
more reactive than their methacrylate analogs. Mixtures of acrylates and methacrylates are not often used, as acrylates are not able to increase the rate of a methacrylate resin. In that specic case, considering the reactivity ratios of this copolymerization, the methacrylate will dominate both the rate and the composition of the
polymer formed.
The composite resin industry is the main exception with respect to the selective
choice of reactive diluents. Within this industry, styrene is used as well as reactive
diluent (known in combination with unsaturated polyesters). Methacrylates are
then often referred to as chemically erroneously vinyl esters.

889

890

16 Thermosets

16.8.2

Chemistry

The basic chemistry upon curing is the homopolymerization of a (meth)acrylate


functionality as is depicted in Scheme 16.26. This polymerization is a radical chain
polymerization. The propagating radical is carbon-centered, and therefore this
polymerization is sensitive to oxygen inhibition as oxygen can quench carboncentered radicals very eectively. As a result of this oxygen inhibition the top layer
is generally not as thoroughly cured as the bulk of the material.

Radical
O O O O O O O O
R

Scheme 16.26.

O O O O O O O O
R

Chain polymerization of acrylate groups.

The three-dimensional crosslinked network which is formed upon curing


(Scheme 16.27) consists of two main segments: the polyacrylate chain and the
polymer, to which some acrylate groups are attached. This schematic picture
clearly illustrates the methods by which the properties of the network can be
adjusted: the polyacrylate chain, the side groups, the number of crosslinks, and
the acrylate-functional polymer.

Polymer

Polymer

Polymer

Polymer

Polymer
Polymer

Scheme 16.27.

A network formed by polymerization on an acrylate resin.

16.8 Acrylate Resins and UV Curing

16.8.3

Production

Within the acrylate-functional resins many distinctions can be made, for instance
for functionality, polymerization speed, polarity, and so on. However, these distinctions generally do not result in dierent methods of production. The production
can be divided into three main classes, from each of which a characteristic example
will be given.
Epoxy Acrylates
The easiest acrylates to produce industrially are the epoxy acrylates; their preparation (see Scheme 16.28) starts with an epoxide-functional resin (see Section
16.4.2). In principle any epoxide-functional material can be chosen. In this reaction (meth)acrylic resin is added to the epoxide at elevated temperatures. (around
90130 C). The (meth)acrylic acid adds to the epoxide in a ring-opening reaction
resulting in an ester alcohol group. Basically this reaction is similar to the reactions used in the preparation of epoxy resins (see Section 16.4). The reactions can
be either acid- or base-catalyzed; base catalysis is the more frequently used, since it
limits the number of possible side reactions (for instance, transesterications).
Although these reactions can be carried out in solvent, industrially they are most
frequently performed in bulk. Generally these preparations are performed in a
batch-type process.
16.8.3.1

O
O polymer

Diepoxide
+

O
O

OH

HO
O polymer

O
O

Epoxy acrylate
OH

Acrylic acid
Scheme 16.28.

Preparation of epoxy acrylates.

Acrylated oils are a special type of epoxy acrylates. They are formed from epoxidized oils such as linseed oil, and (meth)acrylic acid.
Polyester Acrylates
The synthesis of polyester acrylates (Scheme 16.29) is a batch process as well. In
contrast to the preparation of epoxy acrylates this reaction is performed in a solvent, and generally acid-catalyzed. The preparations dier from the synthesis of
unsaturated polyesters (see Section 16.7), mainly because (meth)acrylates have
very reactive double bonds, which can easily homopolymerize. Consequently high
reaction temperatures cannot be used. Generally the maximum temperature that
16.8.3.2

891

16 Thermosets

892

HO

Polyester

OH

Polyester

Polyester acrylate

OH
Scheme 16.29.

Synthesis of polyester acrylates.

can be applied in these reactions is 130 C. In order to remove the water which is
formed in this condensation reaction in an ecient manner at these low temperatures, a solvent is selected which forms an azeotropic mixture with water. In most
cases toluene is the preferred solvent.
After the preparation of the polyester acrylates, the mixture is washed with water
and/or dilute base in order to remove the catalyst and excess acrylic acid. Next the
toluene is evaporated and the resin is obtained.
Silicone acrylates also are usually prepared via an esterication reaction between
a silicone diol and (meth)acrylic acid.
Urethane Acrylates
Urethane acrylates are produced in a batch-type fashion as well. Two procedures
can be followed:
16.8.3.3

HO

Inside-out (Scheme 16.30), or

Polymer

OH

Diol

OCN R N

OCN R NCO

O
O

Polymer

N R NCO

Isocyanate functional polymer

Diisocyanate
O

OH

Hydroxyethyl acrylate (HEA)

O
O

O
N R N

O
O

Polymer

O
N R N

O
O

urethane acrylate
Scheme 16.30.

Inside-out synthesis of a urethane acrylate.

16.8 Acrylate Resins and UV Curing




893

Outside-in (Scheme 16.31).

OH

O
O

Hydroxyethyl acrylate (HEA)


O

N R NCO

Isocyanate functional acrylate


OCN R NCO

Diisocyanate
HO

Polymer

OH

Diol

O
O

O
N R N

O
O

Polymer

O
N R N

urethane acrylate
Scheme 16.31.

Outside-in synthesis of a urethane acrylate.

Each procedure has its own advantages and disadvantages, which will be briey
discussed after a description of both methodologies.
For both procedures the reaction temperatures normally never exceed 90 C.
Many diisocyanates can be used in these reactions. In those cases in which more
than just statistical control is needed, isophorone diisocyanate (IPDI) is generally
employed which has two dierent isocyanate groups (primary/secondary). The
alcoholisocyanate reactions are generally catalyzed with Lewis acids such as
dibutyltin dilaurate (DBTDL). Tertiary amines can be used as well.
With respect to IPDI, it should be noted that with DBTDL as catalyst the secondary isocyanate is approximately 1020 times more reactive than the primary isocyanate. With a tertiary amine as catalyst, however, the primary isocyanate is about
ve times more reactive than the secondary isocyanate.
Inside-out
The preparation of a urethane acrylate according to the inside-out technology starts
with the polymeric diol. The reactor is charged with the diisocyanate, catalyst, and
stabilizer. Now the diol is added slowly and a strong exothermic reaction starts. The
rate of isocyanate addition is generally used to control the reaction exotherm in
such a way that the temperature does not exceed 45 C. The control of this exotherm is especially important when IPDI is used as diisocyanate. For a higher se16.8.3.4

894

16 Thermosets

lectivity, then sometimes even a maximum temperature of 35 C is chosen. After


complete addition of the isocyanate, the intermediate isocyanate-functional polymer can be isolated, although normally the subsequent reaction step is performed
in the same reactor. Next 2-hydroxyethyl acrylate (HEA) is added at such a rate that
the temperature rises to 6070 C. After addition of the HEA the reaction is normally stirred at 80 C until all the isocyanate has been converted.
Outside-in
The basic reactions are similar to the Inside-out methodology. However, the reaction sequence starts with reaction of HEA (the outside of the polymer) with the
diisocyanate instead of the polyol (the inside). The reaction vessel is charged with
diisocyanate, catalyst, and stabilizer to which the HEA is added, resulting in an
acrylate-functional isocyanate. Next the polyol is added, and a urethane acrylate
can be obtained.
16.8.3.5

Comparing Inside-out with Outside-in


The main advantages and disadvantages are summarized below.
The Inside-out advantages are: higher reactor lling; and the reactive group is
introduced in the last reaction step, thereby reducing the risk of gelation. The disadvantages are: high viscosities in the reactor from the start so that temperature
control becomes dicult; and oligomerization of diols via reaction of two diols
with a diisocyanate can occur, resulting in higher viscosities and a broader Mw distribution.
The Outside-in advantages are: reduced viscosity, and therefore improved cooling
and stirring; and consequently higher addition rates (shorter batch times) and a
higher selectivity. The main disadvantage is the higher risk of gelation as the reactive acrylate is in the reactor from the start.
For many urethane acrylates both methods can be used without any problems,
and in practice they are both used. Some disadvantages of the Inside out technology related to the viscosity can be overcome by performing the reaction in a reactive diluent. However, in that case, there is a higher risk of gelation.
In special cases only one method is available, namely in those cases in which the
higher selectivity of the Outside-in method is required. For instance, in the case of
a triol the Inside-out method will result in a gel, whereas such a three-functional
urethane acrylate can be made by the Outside-in method. An extreme example is
that the Outside-in technology makes it possible to use hydroxy-functional acrylics
(polymers with at least ten OH groups per chain) as the polymers in the preparation of urethane acrylates.
16.8.3.6

Stabilization
All the acrylate resins suer a severe risk of homopolymerization. One can even
safely state that without correct stabilization these resins cannot be made. The
most often applied stabilization package consists of a phenolic stabilizer such as
2,6-di-t-butyl-4-methylphenol in combination with air; it is especially the oxygen
in air that is required. Oxygen is a very ecient acrylate polymerization inhibitor
16.8.3.7

16.8 Acrylate Resins and UV Curing

and this is one aspect in which the preparation of acrylate resins diers from most
other resin synthesis.
Many resin syntheses are performed under nitrogen (no discoloration, and so
on) while here, without oxygen, the synthesis would almost be impossible. A direct
consequence is that the evaporation of the toluene in the production of polyester
acrylates is the critical step due to the reduced amount of oxygen and not the synthesis. For those cases an anaerobic inhibitor like phenothiazine can be used.
Dilution
The viscosity of the acrylate resins is generally not so high that dilution is required
for the synthesis or for discharging the reactor at ambient temperatures. Consequently most acrylate resins can be obtained without reactive diluent, leading to a
larger formulating freedom for the end formulator.
The selection of the reactive diluent is generally based on factors such as dilution
power, reactivity, tensile properties, surface tension (wettability), shrinkage, volatility, odor, color, and stability.
16.8.3.8

Safety
Almost all acrylates and many methacrylates are sensitizers. This means that an
allergic reaction can occur due to improper handling; over the years many examples have been reported where workers have become allergic due to repeated skin
contact. In order to minimize skin contact, gloves should be worn at all times and
all (meth)acrylates should be treated carefully, unless the producer has proven by
testing that a specic (meth)acrylate is not a sensitizer.
16.8.3.9

16.8.4

Properties

The properties of the cured resin can be varied to a large extent. However, as these
resins are regarded as expensive compared to the unsaturated polyester resins, they
are generally used in areas in which a higher demand or control on the properties
is required. An example of such an application is the chemical anchoring in which
methacrylate resins are used to attach steel for balconies, bridges and suchlike to a
concrete wall, oor or even ceiling.
In tuning the properties the reactive diluent plays an important role as well. For
instance, when the side chain of the acrylate diluent is changed from linear aliphatic to cycloaliphatic, the hardness of the network will increase without aecting
the exibility of the network. The hardness increases as well when the overall functionality of the diluents is increased; so going from a monofunctional to a difunctional diluent results in a large increase in hardness. However, in this case the network becomes harder and more brittle.
When cure speed (or polymerization time) is irrelevant, the choice between an
acrylate and a methacrylate gives another parameter for adjusting the hardness.
In general the hardness of a polymethacrylate is 100 C higher than that of the corresponding polyacrylate.

895

896

16 Thermosets

The polarity of the network also can be varied by manipulation of the side chains
of the reactive diluent. Both apolar rubbers and polar hydrogels can be obtained
through the correct choice of side chain substituent.
In the above-mentioned examples, it appears that most of the mechanical properties can be achieved by correct choice of side chain. This is, however, not correct.
Many of the basic mechanical properties, such as elasticity, elongation at break,
and modulus, originate from the polymer in the acrylate resin and not from the
side chain functionality.
Generally, epoxy acrylates yield hard, tough materials, while urethane acrylates
give elastic networks and polyester acrylates possess properties which lie between
urethane and epoxy acrylates.
16.8.5

Introduction to UV Curing
General Introduction to UV-initiated Radical Polymerization
A special area of application in which the (meth)acrylate resins described above are
used predominantly is UV curing. A UV curing resin formulation comprises a photoinitiator, that is, an organic compound that generates radicals upon UV irradiation [12]. The basic reaction scheme is depicted in Scheme 16.32.
16.8.5.1

hv
PI

Scheme 16.32.

O
O

Polymer

A UV-initiated radical polymerization.

This cure on demand, combined with exibility with respect to the properties of
the network, makes this system the most ecient process for the rapid production
of polymeric crosslinked materials with well-dened properties. This very eciency is the reason why photoinitiated radical polymerization is widely employed
in high-performance applications where emphasis is put on the mechanical as
well as the optical properties. For instance, modern dental restorative llers are
UV-curable materials. The aspherical lenses in CD applications are prepared via a
UV curing process. Contact lenses are nowadays prepared in the same way. The
Internet could not exist without UV curing, as the optical bres used for data
transport are protected by two UV-curable coatings. In stereolithography, threedimensional objects are prepared via UV curing, which makes this type of curing a
valuable aid in modern medicine. UV curing is not limited to apparently high-tech
applications, however. Most common glossy magazines have a UV-cured coating.
It should be noted that, due to the time control of curing, these resin systems are
ideally suited for fundamental kinetic investigations, especially combined with analytical techniques like real-time infrared spectroscopy. These investigations have

16.8 Acrylate Resins and UV Curing

led to the conclusion that the radical polymerization is dominated by a reactive


diusion-controlled process and that bimolecular termination is the main termination mode.
A standard UV-curable acrylate resin formulation consists of at least three ingredients: a photoinitiator, an acrylate resin, and a reactive diluent.
The UV curing process is strongly dependent on the photoinitiator. In fact, by the
choice of photoinitiator the chemistry can be altered completely. There are fundamentally dierent photoinitiators that can be used for three dierent chemistries:


radical curing, employing a radical photoinitiator;


cationic curing, employing a cationic photoinitiator; and
 base-mediated curing, employing a photolabile base.


Around 9095% of all UV curing processes are radical initiated polymerizations.


Consequently, radical UV curing will be discussed in more detail below, while cationic and base-mediated curing will be discussed briey in separate sections.
Photoinitiators for Radical Polymerization
The photoinitiator makes the resin formulation UV-curable. Only the development
of thermally stable but photolabile compounds enabled the development of UV
curing. For an ecient UV curing, the absorption of the photoinitiator should
match, at least partly, the emission spectrum of the light source used. Two main
types of photoinitiators are used: photoinitiators based on an a-cleavage process
(Norrish type I), and photoinitiators based on an electron transfer followed by a hydrogen abstraction process (Norrish type II). a-Cleavage photoinitiators are monomolecular initiators, of which a-hydroxy or a-alkoxy ketones and benzoyl phosphine
oxides are well known examples shown in Scheme 16.33.
Norrish type II photoinitiators are bimolecular initiators. Generally an aromatic
ketone is used in combination with a tertiary amine. Both aliphatic and aromatic
tertiary amines can be used. A well-known example of such an initiating system is
benzophenone with dimethylaminoethanol.
Irrespective of the initiating system, type I or type II, it is clear that at least two
dierent radicals are formed. Initiation proceeds in the case of type I via both radicals although at dierent rates. However, in the case of a type II initiating system
only the amine radical initiates and the ketyl radical can be considered inert with
respect to initiation. Consequently type I initiations are preferred when speed is an
issue. The advantage of a type II system is that it is less sensitive to oxygen inhibition than a type I, as the ketyl radical can react with oxygen thereby reducing the
active amount of oxygen.
16.8.5.2

Resin
All the acrylate resins described above in Section 16.8.3 can be employed in UV
curing. Low molecular weight materials are mostly used since they possess a lower
viscosity. In many UV applications thin layers are employed, which makes the
resin viscosity an important processing parameter.
16.8.5.3

897

898

16 Thermosets

O
OH

hv

OH

Type I Photoinitiators

hv

OH

OH

OH

Type II Photoinitiators
Scheme 16.33.

Dierent types of radical photoinitiators. S, singlet state; T, triplet state.

However, the urethane acrylates, which generally possess higher viscosities, also
have higher polymerization rates.
Unsaturated polyesters (see Section 16.7) can be used in UV curing as well, but
only in combination with a special reactive diluent system, which is based on vinyl
ethers. Kinetic analysis has revealed that in that specic case the fumarate forms a
charge transfer complex with the vinyl ether and a homopolymerization of this
charge-transfer complex takes place as depicted in Scheme 16.34. An advantage of
a charge-transfer complex radical polymerization is that it is less susceptible toward oxygen inhibition than methacrylate systems. This is illustrated by the fact
that the rst commercial UV powder system, in which the powder is sprayed
(much oxygen), melted, and then UV-cured, was based on a fumaratevinyl ether
system.
Reactive Diluent
In liquid UV curing systems there is even more emphasis on the judicious choice
of the reactive diluents, due to the applications viscosity requirements. The reactive diluent also has a large impact on the cure speed. An example concerns polarity: apolar reactive diluents polymerize more slowly than more polar analogs. Hydrogen bonds play a role as well, which is illustrated by the fact that monomers
which possess hydrogen bonds react faster than their analogs without hydrogen
bonding. However, monomers with hydrogen bonds generally possess a higher
16.8.5.4

16.8 Acrylate Resins and UV Curing

O
O

O
O

+
O

O O

O
O

O O

O
O O

Scheme 16.34.

Copolymerization of fumarate with vinyl ether via a charge-transfer complex.

viscosity. The functionality is another important factor, as higher-functional materials polymerize faster than lower-functional materials. The hardness or Tg of the resulting polymer is also important, as reactive diluents which give rise to high-Tg
polymers polymerize faster than monomers which result in low-Tg materials (assuming the same functionality). Obviously the basic functionality is important;
methacrylates react approximately ten times more slowly than acrylates.
N-Vinyl amides such as N-vinyl caprolactam are sometimes used as reactive
diluents as well, especially in those cases in which a high demand is put on the
polymerization speed. An example of this is the ber optic industry, in which the
cure process is performed at draw speeds around 30 m s1 (irradiation times are in
the order of milliseconds).
When an unsaturated polyester is used as resin, only reactive diluents containing
vinyl ether can be applied. Moreover, the molar ratio of fumarate bonds to vinyl
ether bonds should be around 1:1 because the crosslinking reaction is a strictly alternating copolymerization.
Curing Process
The cure process of a sheet covered with a UV-curable resin is depicted schematically in Figure 16.11. The basic process is very simple: a sheet is put on the conveyor belt and the resin is cured under the UV lamp. After irradiation the resin is
16.8.5.5

UV lamp

Conveyor belt
Fig. 16.11.

Representation of a basic UV curing process.

899

900

16 Thermosets

fully cured. When very thin layers or high speeds are employed, curing in air becomes more dicult due to the inhibiting eect of oxygen. In these cases nitrogen
inerting, that is, ushing the area under the UV lamp with nitrogen, can be used
to overcome this problem. Other gases such as carbon dioxide can be used as well.
A main disadvantage of acrylate polymerization is shrinkage. However, this
shrinkage process is well dened since it is directly related to the number of double bonds converted. In the lens applications the quartz molds are adjusted for this
shrinkage.
Cationic Curing
Besides photoinitiators which generate radicals, photoinitiators also exist which
generate a strong acid. These initiators enable the on-demand curing of epoxide
and hydroxy/epoxide mixtures. The initiators are sulfonium or iodonium based. A
cationic curing of an epoxy/alcohol system is depicted in Scheme 16.35.
16.8.5.6

BF4

PF5

hv

H + PF5

Strong acid

Iodonium salt
Sulfonium salt

O
H

+
H

R1

+
OH

R1

R OH

R O+
H

R1

OH
R O

+
H

R1

Scheme 16.35. Cationic photoinitiators and cationically


photoinitiated polymerization of epoxide resins.

The acid strength of the resulting acid is strongly dependent on the counter ion.
The acid strength of the system can be directly related to the polymerization rate
(stronger acid results in faster polymerization). Consequently water can reduce or
even inhibit these polymerizations. However, minimal amounts of alcohols or even

16.9 Rubber

water can enhance the cure speed. The highest rates are generally obtained in
those cases in which the molar ratio of alcohol to epoxide is 1:51:10.
Besides an epoxide system, vinyl ether systems also exist. The cationic vinyl
ether polymerization is among the fastest polymerizations known in the UV curing industry, especially since termination is almost absent.
Base-mediated Curing
Base-mediated UV curing is a recent development, since UV-labile bases have only
recently become commercially available. Depending on the base liberated and its
base strength, various kinds of organic chemistry can be used for the network
formation.
Weak UV-labile bases are commonly used in lithographic processes, in which
their main function is as an acid scavenger. In these processes the photochemically
liberated base scavenges a thermally formed acid and no polymerization will occur
on the irradiated areas.
16.8.5.7

16.9

Rubber
16.9.1

Introduction

In this nal section a class of thermoset materials will be introduced, elastomers or


rubbers, which has some distinct dierences from the thermoset resins presented
in the preceding sections [13]. First, most elastomers are characterized by very exible polymer chains and, as a result, the glass transition temperature of elastomers,
indicating the transition between a hard, rigid, glassy phase and a soft, mobile,
rubbery phase, is well below room temperature. Crosslinked elastomers are relatively soft materials in their actual application (typically with a modulus of 110
MPa; that is, in the Sh A (Shore A) hardness range), whereas most crosslinked
thermoset resins are hard materials (1 00010 000 MPa). Secondly, elastomers are
high molecular weight polymers (typically with a weight-averaged molecular
weight Mw ranging from 50 000 to 500 000 g mol1 ), resulting in a high melt viscosity. Therefore, the processing temperature is higher than for thermoset resins
and the processing equipment is much heavier. Thirdly, most elastomers have
a large number of sites per chain available for crosslinking (typically a functionality
of 1010 000 sites per chain). Consequently, the gel point is already reached at a
low crosslinking conversion and any crosslinking must be avoided during mixing,
processing, and shaping. Many rubber properties are directly related to the crosslink density; for example, the modulus, the elastic recovery, and the swelling resistance all increase upon increasing the crosslink density. However, these properties
are not determined only by the number of chemical crosslinks, but are also affected signicantly by the number of physical entanglements which are trapped
upon crosslinking.

901

902

16 Thermosets

Despite these dierences in chain exibility, molecular weight, and functionality,


elastomers have the formation of a three-dimensional network in the nal processing step in common with the thermoset resins such as the phenolic, epoxy, and acrylate resins. Crosslinking of a rubber renders it insoluble and, in addition, yields a
material which has strongly enhanced physical properties, such as tensile properties (modulus, tensile strength, and elongation at break) and elastic recovery (under both compression and tension).
Types of Rubber
The most important rubber is natural rubber (NR), with an average volume of
roughly 50% of the total world rubber production (approximately 15 500 kton y1 )
over the decade 19902000. NR is a relatively low-cost rubber collected as a latex
from Hevea brasiliensis, and yields excellent physical and dynamic properties, explaining applications ranging from tires (low heat buildup) to thin-walled, soft
products like gloves and balloons. Of the synthetic rubbers polybutadiene (BR)
and styrenebutadiene copolymers (SBR) have also found major applications in the
tire industry, while the latter is also used in foams and footwear. Acrylonitrile
butadiene copolymers, that is, nitrile rubber (NBR), have a high swelling resistance
because of their high polarity, making them suitable for applications with oil and
solvent contact. These so-called polydiene rubbers have unsaturation in the polymer backbone, making them relatively sensitive to oxidation, ozonolysis, and thermal degradation. Ethylenepropenediene terpolymers (EPDM) are much more
stable in this respect. Some other rubbers worth mentioning are butyl rubber,
which has a low air permeability used in inner-tire tubes, and silicone rubbers
and uor rubbers, which are high-performance rubbers (high heat and solvent
resistance).
In summary, the range of commercial rubbers is quite large, with each rubber
type being available in a large number of dierent grades. Because it is beyond
the scope of this overview to discuss all these rubbers in detail, we will zoom in
on one rubber only. EPDM (Scheme 16.36) was chosen for that purpose for two
reasons. First, EPDM has a very wide structural variation in
16.9.1.1

molecular weight (distribution),


long-chain branching (LCB) (distribution),
 chemical composition (including ethylene and propene levels, type and level of
diene, but also monomer sequence distribution),


yielding an almost countless number of combinations, many of which have specic application advantages, and making EPDM a good representative for rubbers
in general. Secondly, EPDM has a very good balance between processability, properties, and price, and has evolved since the early 1990s from a high-performance
rubber into a mature commodity-plus rubber. With its annual world usage of approximately 900 kton y1, EPDM is today the fourth rubber volume-wise after NR,
SBR, and BR, and its usage is actually the largest for a non-tire rubber.

16.9 Rubber

CH2

CH2

CH2
CH2

CH3
CH
CH2 CH2

CH2=CH2 + CH2=CH-CH3 +
ethene

propene

ENB

CH2
CH2
CH3

CH2
CH2

CH CH

CH2

CH2

EPDM

Polymerization and structure of ethylene/


propene/diene terpolymer (EPDM), with 5-ethylidene-2norbornene (ENB) given as an example for the diene.
Scheme 16.36.

16.9.2

Polymerization

EP(D)M is produced via insertion polymerization of ethylene, propene, and a diene


[14] (Scheme 16.36). Traditionally, ZieglerNatta-type vanadium-based catalysts are
used in combination with metal alkyl cocatalysts and sometimes promoters in order to obtain an ecient, well-controlled polymerization. The EPM copolymer
cannot be crosslinked with sulfur due to the absence of unsaturation, and the eciency for peroxide cure is not that high (Section 16.9.3). This explains why up to
10 wt% dienes are incorporated in the EPM chain; it is to allow sulfur vulcanization and to enhance the peroxide curing eciency. The diene should have two unsaturated bonds which have quite dierent anities for polymerization, in order to
prevent gelation during polymerization. 5-Ethylidene-2-norbornene (ENB) and dicyclopentadiene (DCPD) fulll this requirement, with the endocyclic norbornene
unsaturation being the most reactive for polymerization (ring tension!), and upon
incorporation they yield EPDM with pendent, unsaturated bonds that are susceptible to sulfur and peroxide crosslinking. 5-Vinylidene-2-norbornene (VNB) is sometimes used because the exocyclic vinyl unsaturation participates to some extent in
polymerization, yielding LCB EPDM with enhanced processability. Recently, metallocene catalysts have been developed and are applied commercially, which have a
much higher activity than the traditional catalysts and also have enhanced anity
for polymerization of higher a-olens like 1-butene, 1-hexene and 1-octene. The
ethene/a-olen copolymers thus produced are a new class of materials, namely
plastomers, bridging the gap between rigid polyethylene and elastic EP(D)M.
Traditionally, ZieglerNatta EP(D)M polymerization is performed in a solution
process using a volatile hydrocarbon as the solvent. The ethylene and propene
monomers are cooled prior to the exothermic polymerization, to avoid heating to
temperatures that are so high that the catalyst activity is signicantly reduced. All
the monomers and the solvent have to be puried: polar moieties especially have to
be removed, since they kill the catalyst. After polymerization the unreacted monomers are recycled and the polymer is recovered, a process which includes removal

903

904

16 Thermosets

of traces of unreacted monomers and residual solvent, deactivation and washing of


the catalysts, and rubber crumb formation. The activity of the metallocene catalysts
is so high that catalyst removal is not necessary. Finally, gas-phase technology has
been developed, and has recently been applied commercially, by which the polymerization is performed in a uidized-bed reactor with carbon black as uidizing
agent.
16.9.3

Crosslinking

Most EPDM applications involve some sort of crosslinking [15], about 80% via sulfur vulcanization. Sulfur vulcanizates have a relatively low thermal stability, which
explains the slow transition to peroxide cure in critical applications. The tensile
and dynamic properties of sulfur-vulcanized EPDM are superior, whereas the elastic recovery of peroxide-cured EPDM is superior.
Sulfur Vulcanization
Sulfur vulcanization is the traditional crosslinking method for unsaturated elastomers. It was developed by Charles Goodyear and Thomas Hancock in the 1840s.
Since then the sulfur vulcanization recipes have been further developed and
optimized and today sulfur is always used in a cocktail with accelerators (mainly
sulfur- and nitrogen-containing chemicals) and activators (zinc oxide, stearic acid).
EPDM is an apolar rubber with relatively little unsaturation in comparison to the
polydiene rubbers, and it has low solubility for the polar accelerators. As a result,
the vulcanization mixture may consist of up to ten ingredients, which allows for
ne-tuning of the crosslinking rate, the crosslink density, and the type of sulfur
crosslink. The last two determine the physical properties of sulfur-vulcanized
EPDM. In Scheme 16.37 a generally accepted mechanism for sulfur vulcanization
of EPDM is presented. First, sulfur reacts with the accelerators and the activators,
yielding a so-called active sulfurating species (its precise structure has still to be
elucidated). Next, the crosslink precursor is formed by substitution of one of the
allylic hydrogen atoms, yielding an alkenyl sulde. Note that the unsaturation of
EPDM is essential for activating the allylic position, but is not consumed during
vulcanization. Next, the crosslink precursor reacts with a second EPDM chain,
yielding the initial crosslink with a relatively high number of sulfur atoms in the
crosslink, which upon further heating converts into shorter crosslinks. In the case
of ENB as the diene, about 50 crosslink structures can be formed, because of the
variation in the length of the sulfur bridge (typically one to ve sulfur atoms), the
three dierent allylic sites (C3(exo), C3(endo) and C9) and the isomerism at C8/C9
(Entgegen versus Zusammen). For normal recipes about 2575% of the ENB units
are involved in crosslink formation. Zinc salts act as catalysts for all three reaction steps. There is still a debate on the exact nature of the sulfur vulcanization
reactions (ionic versus concerted). Oxidation may occur as a side reaction. Side reactions that are frequently observed during sulfur vulcanization of polydiene rubbers, such as cistrans isomerization, allylic rearrangement, and/or the formation
16.9.3.1

16.9 Rubber

S8 + accelerator(s) + ZnO + stearic acid


DT
soluble sulfurated
zinc complex
Sm X

EPDM

allylic
substitution
x2

pendent sulfur
(cross-link precursor)

disproportionation

Sn

initial cross-link

oxidation

oxidation
products

desulfuration

DT

devulcanization

Sp

matured cross-link
(p<n)

DT, diaryldisulfide

S
thiophene

Scheme 16.37. Products and generally accepted mechanism


for accelerated sulfur vulcanization of EPDM (X accelerator
residue; sulfur substitution at C3(exo) and C9 of ENB is just
given as an example).

of conjugated dienes/trienes, do not occur for ENBEPDM, because of the stability


of the tris-substituted unsaturation in ENB and its isolation from other ENB units.
Peroxide Curing
The mechanism of peroxide crosslinking is shown in Scheme 16.38. Upon heating, the peroxide decomposes into the primary alkoxy radicals, which may further
react to secondary radicals. These radicals abstract hydrogen atoms from the EPM
chain. In the case of EPM, crosslinks are formed by combination of two macroradicals, whereas in the case of EPDM crosslinks are formed via combination, but
also via addition of the macro-radical to the pendent unsaturation of a second
EPDM chain. The formation of CaC bonds explains the higher thermal stability
of peroxide-cured EPDM in comparison with sulfur-vulcanized EPDM with its
labile SaS crosslinks. The reactivity for peroxide cure increases in the series
ENB @ DCPD < VNB, because of the decreased steric hindrance at the unsaturation. The eciency of peroxide curing is enhanced by the addition of co-agents,
that is, chemicals with two or more unsaturated bonds, which are actually built
16.9.3.2

905

906

16 Thermosets

1/2 RO-OR
peroxide
decomposition

DT
RO

ROH

H-abstraction
EPDM

EPDM macro-radical (EPDM )


+ EPDM

+ EPDM
combination

addition

cross-link
EPDM

H-transfer

EPDM

cross-link
Products and mechanism for peroxide cure of
EP(D)M (DCPD is just used as an example; the formation of
tertiary free radicals is chosen arbitrarily).
Scheme 16.38.

into the elastic network, whereas the peroxide only initiates the crosslinking reaction. Note that in contrast to sulfur vulcanization, the EPDM unsaturation is consumed during peroxide cure.
Processing
EPDM is rst mixed with llers and oil on two-roll mills or batch kneaders, and
next the crosslinking chemicals are added at moderate temperatures. Then the
EPDM compound may be shaped and crosslinked in a hot (> 160 C) press or calendered into a foil, and cured in a steam autoclave. EPDM strips and proles may
be continuously extruded and subsequently crosslinked in a hot-air oven, a salt
bath, or an ultrahigh-frequency radiation unit.
16.9.3.3

16.9 Rubber

16.9.4

Properties and Applications

In Section 16.9.1 it was explained that EPDM is a very versatile polymer, because of
the large number of structural combinations. A broad molecular weight distribution (MWD) at a given viscosity is benecial for processability, but detrimental for
network properties (a large number of dangling ends). LCB has been introduced to
enhance processability. The combination of a narrow MWD with LCB yields superior materials. At ethylene levels above 55 wt%, the average length of the ethylene
sequences is suciently large to give rise to diuse crystalline regions, which give
higher hardness, modulus, and tensile strength to EPDM. At lower ethylene levels,
EPDM is a fully amorphous rubber. The type and level of diene determines the
crosslinking rate and density (Section 16.9.3). The latter in its turn determines the
tensile, elastic, and dynamic properties. It should be noted that EPDM, like most
rubbers, is hardly used as such, but always in compounds with llers and extender
oil, because of performance improvement and cost reduction. The addition of large
amounts (up to 150 phr) of reinforcing ller, mainly carbon black, results in greatly
improved physical properties and UV stability at the cost of increased compound
viscosity. To maintain good processability large amounts (up to 150 phr) of extender oil are added in addition to the ller.
Advantages and Disadvantages
The main advantage of EPDM over the polydiene rubbers, such as NR, BR, SBR,
and NBR, is the saturated character of the main chain. As a result, EPDM has a
relatively high resistance against oxidation, ozonolysis, heat, and UV light. This
makes EPDM especially suitable for outdoor and high-heat applications, such as
roof sheeting, window proles, automotive seals (for both doors and windows), radiator hoses, cable and wire insulation, and all sorts of technical items like seals
and tubes. The main disadvantages of EPDM are also related to the structure of
the main chain: actually being a hydrocarbon results in a relatively low oil resistance and poor adhesion to polar substrates (metal, glass, and polar polymers).
Most EPDM applications require elasticity and thus crosslinking. However, EPM
is also used without crosslinking, as an impact modier for crystalline thermoplastics such as polypropylene (PP) and polyamides, and as an oil additive.
16.9.4.1

Thermoplastic Vulcanizates
We started this chapter with a description of the fundamental dierences between
thermoplastic and thermoset materials; we will end it with an example of a subtle
blend of their respective properties. A disadvantage of the three-dimensional
network of EPDM, but actually of all thermoset materials, is the lack of recyclability. Crosslinked EPDM, both the waste from production and after use, cannot
be processed in the melt again like thermoplastics. Reclaiming technologies have
been developed for vulcanized rubber, degrading part of the network via hightemperature and shear treatment, but these technologies are less eective for
EPDM vulcanizates, probably because the EPDM chains are so stable. A break16.9.4.2

907

908

16 Thermosets

through in this respect has been the development of thermoplastic vulcanizates


(TPVs), which combine the elastic properties of thermoset crosslinked rubbers
with the melt processability of thermoplastics. The most important TPVs from a
commercial perspective are based on blends of EPDM and PP. Dynamic vulcanization of EPDM/PP blends results in a crosslinked EPDM phase, which is nely dispersed in a PP matrix. PP being the matrix in TPVs makes them melt-processable.
At high EPDM loadings the thin PP layers, surrounding the crosslinked EPDM
particles, act as a sort of glue and transfer the macroscopic stress to the rubber particles. Resol resins, that is, p-alkylphenolformaldehyde condensates produced at
high formaldehyde/phenol ratios and at high pH (Section 16.2.2) are used as the
main crosslinking agent activated by acids for the production of TPVs. In addition
to being melt-processable, TPVs have other advantages over thermoset crosslinked
EPDM, such as higher oil resistance, colorability (no carbon black reinforcement),
and co-extrusion with polyolen thermoplastic parts. The volume of TPVs is growing above the average for the rubber market, and they are partly replacing thermoset EPDM in technical goods and sealing systems.

Notation

Mn
Mw
Tg

(number-averaged) molecular weight


weight-averaged molecular weight
glass transition temperature

Acronyms and Abbreviations


1K
2K
BR
BMC
DCPD
DBTDL
DGEBPA
EAN
ECH
ENB
EPDM
EPM
HEA
HDT
HMTA
IPDI
LCB
LSC
LSE

one-component
two-component
polybutadiene butadiene rubber
bulk molding compound
dicyclopentadiene
dibutyltin dilaurate
bisphenol-A diglycidyl ether
elastically active network chain
epichlorohydrin
5-ethylidene-2-norbornene
Ethenepropenediene terpolymer
ethene/propene co-polymer
2-hydroxyethyl acrylate
heat deection temperature
hexamethylene tetramine
isophorone diisocyanate
long-chain branching
low-styrene content
low-styrene emission

References

MF
MPa
MWD
NBR
NR
PF
phr
PP
Sh
SBR
SMC
TGIC
TPV
UF
UP
UV
VNB

melamineformaldehyde
10 6 Pascal
molecular weight distribution ( Mw /Mn )
acrylonitrilebutadiene copolymer nitrile rubber
natural rubber
phenolformaldehyde
parts per hundred
polypropylene
Shore (hardness degree classes)
styrenebutadiene copolymer
sheet molding compound
triglycidyl isocyanurate
thermoplastic vulcanizate
ureaformaldehyde
unsaturated polyester
ultraviolet light
5-vinylidene-2-norbornene

References
1 a] D. Stoye, W. Freitag, Resins for

Coatings, Hanser Publishers, Munich,


1996. b] Z. W. Wicks Jr., F. N. Jones,
S. P. Pappas, Organic Coatings Science
and Technology, Wiley-Interscience,
New York, 1992, Volumes I, II. c] T.
Brock, M. Groteklaes, P. Mischke,
European Coatings Handbook, Vincentz
Verlag, Hannover, 2000. d] W. F.
Gum, W. Riese, H. Ulrich, Reaction
Polymers: Polyurethanes, Epoxies,
Unsaturated Polyesters, Phenolics,
Special Monomers and Additives:
Chemistry, Technology and Applications,
Hanser Gardner Publications, Munich,
2000. e] S. H. Goodman, Handbook of
Thermoset Plastics, Noyes Publications,
Norwich, 1999 (2nd edition).
2 A. Knop, L. A. Pilato, Phenolic Resins,
Springer Verlag, Berlin, 1990.
3 a] M. Dunky, P. Niemz, Holzwerkstoe
und Leime, Springer Verlag, Berlin,
2002. b] H. Diem, M. Gunther,
Amino resins, in Ullmanns
Encyclopedia of Industrial Chemistry,
Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 1999.
4 a] S. Tohmura, Journal of Wood
Science, 2001, 47, 451457. b] J. J. H.

Nusselder, Co-condensation of
Melamine, urea and formaldehyde,
in Proceedings of the 1998 TAPPI
Plastic Laminates Symposium, Atlanta,
Georgia, Tappi Press, Atlanta.
a] K. Holmberg, Progress in Organic
Coatings, 1992, 20, 325. b] A.
Hoand, Journal of Coating
Technology, 1995, 67(848), 113. c] G.
Hardeman, J. Beetsma, in 14th
International Conference, Coatings
Community and Care, Copenhagen,
1994, paper 17.
Ullmans Encyklopadie der Technischen
Chemie, Vol. 9, Wiley-VCH, Weinheim,
6th ed. 2004.
T. Misev, Powder Coatings, Chemistry
and Technology, John Wiley & Sons,
New York, 1992.
R. Vieweg, L. Goerden, Polyester,
in Kunststo-Handbuch, Vol. VIII, Carl
Hanser Verlag, Munich, 1973.
a] B. T. Astrom, Manufacturing of
Polymer Composites, Chapman & Hall,
London, UK, 1997. b] G. Akovali,
New Handbook of Composite Fabrication, Rapra Technology, Shrewsburg,
UK, 2001. c] D. Hull, T. W. Clyne,

909

910

16 Thermosets
D. R. Clarke, S. Suresh, I. M. Ward,
An Introduction to Composite Materials, Cambridge University Press,
Cambridge, UK, 1996.
10 a] A. K. Kaw, Mechanics of Composite
Materials, CRC Press, Boca Raton, FL,
1997. b] F. L. Matthews and R. D.
Rawlings, Composite Materials:
Engineering and Science, CRC Press,
1999.
11 a] Sita Technology Ltd., Chemistry &
Technology of UV and EB Formulations
for Coatings, Inks and Paints, Ed. P. K. T.
Oldring, 8 volumes, Wiley, London,
1998. b] J. P. Fouassier, J. F. Rabek,
Radiation Curing in Polymer Science
and Technology, 4 volumes, Elsevier,
London, 1993.
12 a] J. P. Fouassier, Photoinitiation,
Photopolymerization and Photocuring,

Hanser, Munich, 1995. b] K. D.


Beleld, J. V. Crivello, Photoinitiated Polymerization, ACS
Symposium Series Vol. 847, ACS,
Washington DC, 2003.
13 W. Hofmann, Rubber Technology
Handbook, Hanser Publishers,
Munich, 1989.
14 a] J. W. M. Noordermeer, Ethylenepropylene polymers, in Kirk-Othmer
Encyclopedia of Chemical Technology,
Wiley InterScience, New York, 5th ed.
2004. b] F. P. Baldwin, G. Ver
Strate, Polyolen elastomers based
on ethylene and propylene, Rubber
Chemistry and Technology 1972, 45,
709.
15 M. van Duin, Chemistry of EPDM
crosslinking, Kautschuk und Gummi
Kunststoe, 2002, 55, 150.

911

17

Fibers1
J. A. Juijn
17.1

Introduction
17.1.1

A Fiber World

Look around and see the ber world! Clothes in a wide variety of shapes and colors,
carpets and curtains in your house, sheets and blankets on your bed. Step in your
car and see the safety belts, and hopefully never see the airbags. Rely on the strong
cords reinforcing your tires, timing belt, V-belts. Enjoy many ber-reinforced composites in your leisure activities: tennis rackets, golf clubs, skis, the frame of your
racing bike. Go sailing and use those novel lightweight sails and strong ropes. Or
maybe youre a military man and wear a helmet and bulletproof vest based on new
advanced bers.
Fiber production is a large-volume business: around 60 million metric tons per
year. About 40% of this is natural ber: cotton and wool; the remaining part is
man-made, synthetic ber: polyester, polyamide, cellulose, acrylics, and so forth.
More than 90% is applied in textiles or carpets. Only about 5% is used in industrial
applications. And the new, advanced, high-modulus bers? Technically and
commercially very interesting, but we are talking of no more than about 0.2% of
the ber capacity!
You may become curious and study some yarns with a magnifying glass and discover that single bers are as thin as 1030 mm. With a pair of tweezers you unravel the structure and pull out bers a few centimeters in length or discover that
in some cases the bers have innite length. You may test yarns by pulling them
between your hands and cut your ngers when it is an aramid yarn!
Gradually, you start realizing that bers are a completely dierent class of polymer materials: dierent in shape, molecular structure, and physical and mechanical properties.
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

912

17 Fibers

17.1.2

Scope of this Chapter

This chapter has been written for polymer engineers, not for ber specialists. A
comprehensive impression of ber technology can be obtained from relevant sections in an encyclopedia [1] or more specic textbooks [25], but this would involve
reading hundreds of pages of fairly detailed text. This chapter had to be much
shorter but should nevertheless give a broad survey of the ber eld. Therefore,
clear choices had to be made. Natural bers will almost completely be neglected.
Man-made bers are still in part based on natural polymer (cellulose), but fully
synthetic bers have become more important. The choice was easy: we will pay
more attention to fully synthetic bers. Many of those are spun from solution but
melt-spun bers are growing more rapidly, especially polyester. Therefore, more
attention will be given here to melt spinning than to dry and wet spinning.
The advantage of this approach is that most polymer engineers are already familiar
with melt processing and will more easily recognize the details of a melt spinning
process.
The novel high-modulus, high-strength bers, especially aramid and gel-spun
polyethylene, deserve a special status. These yarns are spun from solution again,
and we will discuss the specic modications of the old wet spinning process that
were required to produce yarns stronger than steel.
This approach has led to the following arrangement of this chapter. It starts in
Section 17.2 with an introduction to ber terminology, because this will be new
for most polymer engineers. In Section 17.3 we see which properties are required
to make a polymer suitable as a ber material, and how simple the selection of a
spinning process seems to be. Melt spinning is discussed in some detail in Section
17.4, with attention to typical machine parts, rheology, and orientation during spinning and drawing. Examples of simple process calculations are given. The section
includes the large melt-spun ber materials polyester, polyamide, and polypropylene. Section 17.5, which is much shorter, and inevitably more supercial, contains
accounts of cellulose (rayon), cellulose acetate, acrylics, and poly(vinyl alcohol), the
large dry- or wet-spun bers. Then in Section 17.6 we discuss the typical dierences in process limitations between melt spinning and spinning from solution. The
chapter concludes with Section 17.7 on high-modulus, high-strength bers: aramid
and gel-spun polyethylene, but including carbon bers.
Finally, for those who have read this chapter as an appetizer, a full menu is provided in the References.
17.2

Fiber Terminology
17.2.1

Denitions: Fibers, Filaments, Spinning

Until the end of the 19th century all yarns were based on natural bers, such
as cotton and wool; all these bers are thin (10100 mm) and short (230 cm).

17.2 Fiber Terminology

For continuity in a yarn the bers must be twisted. This is the process we call
spinning producing yarn from bers, for example on a spinning wheel but
industrial equipment has been developed for spinning on a larger scale. More than
50% of the worlds yarn production is based on bers. Cotton is still ber material
number one, being used in pure cotton yarns but also in blends with synthetic
bers.
One natural ber has a much greater length: silk. About 1000 m of ber quality
can be unwound from one cocoon, and such laments are combined into a yarn.
This introduces the word lament a ber of (almost) innite length. And we
have met the rst spinning machine, the silkworm. Please note that spinning
has a second meaning here: the production of continuous laments; all synthetic
bers are spun as continuous laments.
A yarn spun from bers is called a ber yarn (Figure 17.1a), whereas a yarn
containing endless laments is called a lament yarn (Figure 17.1b). It seems
logical that all synthetic yarns would be lament yarns, but this is not the case. Filaments are often cut into (short) staple bers at the end of their spinning process,
and then spun again into a ber yarn, either as a blend with cotton or wool, or in a
fully synthetic product. The reason is that the brous character of a yarn is preferred in many textile applications, and that it is dicult to imitate these tactile
properties by treatment of lament yarns.
Finally, we must introduce the term cord a construction of two or more
twisted yarn ends (Figure 17.1c). For example, staple bers are rst twisted into a
thin yarn and two or three yarn ends are then twisted in the opposite direction
to form a corded yarn. This is a common construction for textile knitware or fabrics, and carpet yarns. Cords are also used in industrial applications. Filament
yarns are then twisted to high levels (several hundred turns per meter) and twisted
yarns are combined in a second twisting step again in the opposite direction to
form twofold or threefold cords. A well-known example is tire cord.
Strictly speaking, one should distinguish between ber and lament: a ber
has a limited length and a lament is essentially endless. To avoid misunderstanding, synthetic bers with a limited length are in most cases called staple bers. It

a
b
c
Fig. 17.1. (a) Fiber yarn (the construction shown is in fact a
loosely twisted cord); (b) lament yarn; (c) industrial cord.

913

914

17 Fibers

is common practice, however, to use ber also as a general term for ber, lament, yarn, and cord materials.
17.2.2

Synthetic Yarns

Synthetic cellulose yarns were developed between 1880 and 1910, rst from a nitrocellulose solution, and later as copper rayon and viscose rayon. The cellulosics
are often called half-synthetic because the raw material is a natural polymer.
The most important fully synthetic yarns were developed between 1935 and 1942
polyamides (PA66, PA6), polyester (PET), and acrylic yarns (PAN copolymers).
Another half-century later, many high-performance bers were introduced, for example aramid (PPTA), gel-spun polyethylene, and carbon ber.
All synthetic yarn processes are continuous, so endless laments are formed. For
lament yarns, the spinneret contains as many holes as the number of laments
required for that particular type of yarn. For synthetic staple ber production, the
spinneret contains thousands of holes and the laments are cut into bers at the
end of the process.
17.2.3

Titer: Tex and Denier

It is fairly dicult and inaccurate to measure the diameter of bers or laments. It


is much easier to weigh a certain length of lament or yarn. We thus determine a
linear density, or titer. The tex unit is ocially included in the SI system, and has
become the standard in Europe. The older unit denier stems from the silk industry
and is still common in the USA and in many Asian countries. The denitions are:
tex grams per 1000 meter (lament or yarn).
denier grams per 9000 meter (lament or yarn).
It is fairly common practice to use decitex (dtex) instead of tex (dtex grams per
10,000 meter). Numbers in dtex and denier dier by about 10%; for accurate relationships, see Table 17.1.
The diameter of a lament can be calculated from the lament titer if the density

Tab. 17.1.

Conversion factors for denier, tex, and dtex.

Multiply ; to obtain m

denier

tex

dtex

denier
tex
dtex

1
9
0.9

1/9
1
0.1

10/9
10
1

17.2 Fiber Terminology

is known. Using the denition of dtex (g 10 000 m1 ) and expressing density in
g cm3 , we can calculate the diameter D in mm from Eq. (1).
s
4 dtex
D 10
pr

For example, a polyester lament (r 1:38 g cm3 ) of 10 dtex has a diameter of


30.4 mm, and a lament of 1 dtex has a diameter of 9.6 mm.
For yarn titers it is useful to specify the number of laments. For example, an
aramid yarn type could be indicated as 1500 denier f 1000, which means that the
yarn contains 1000 laments, each of 1.5 denier. In dtex, this yarn type would be
1670 dtex f 1000, a lament titer of 1.67 dtex.
17.2.4

Tenacity and Modulus: g denierC1, N texC1 , or GPa

After having introduced the denier and tex units the next logical step is to express
breaking strength (tenacity) and modulus in g denier1 or N tex1 instead of in
Pascals (1 Pa 1 N m2 ), MPa, or GPa. Fiber engineers often deviate from using
the basic SI units and convert N tex1 to cN tex1 or mN tex1 , or even cN dtex1 :
1 N tex1 100 cN tex1 1000 mN tex1 10 cN dtex1 .
The unit g denier1 (g den1 , g d1 , gpd) stands for gram-force per denier.
In conversion factors to Newtons, the gravity constant therefore appears: 1
gf 9.806 650  103 N. In combination with the conversion factor from denier
to tex, this results in:
1 g denier1 8:826  102 N tex1 ;

or

1 N tex1 11:33 g denier1

For conversion of g denier1 or N tex1 to Pa or GPa one needs to know the density r of the yarn. The main conversion factors are given in Table 17.2.
Dierences in densities can be large, especially when we compare organic bers
(11.5 g cm3 ) with glass bers (2.5 g cm3 ) or steel cord (7.8 g cm3 ). Therefore,
aramid producers may argue that their product is ve times stronger than steel (in
g denier1 or N tex1 ), while steel cord producers can rightfully respond that steel
has the same strength (in GPa).

Tab. 17.2.

Conversion factors for g denier1, N tex1 and GPa (express r in g cm3 ).

Multiply ; to obtain m

g denierC1

N texC1

GPa

g denier1
N tex1
GPa

1
11.33
11.33=r

8:826  102
1
1=r

8:826  102 r
r
1

915

916

17 Fibers

Fig. 17.2.

Examples of cross-sections of bers and laments.

17.2.5

Yarn Appearance

Most natural bers have a non-round cross-section and low luster (Figure 17.2);
silk is the exception. Moreover, yarns spun from these bers have a high volume
(bulk) and ber ends make them hairy. All these factors are appreciated for applications in textiles and carpets. Synthetic yarn is most easily spun from round spinning holes, the lament yarns have a high luster, they are at (not textured), and
hairiness is absent. This may be perfect for industrial yarn applications, but it is
not desirable for most textile and all carpet yarns.
The cross section can be adapted by using proled spinning holes, for example
trilobes, triangles or hexagonal stars. Delustering can be achieved by the addition
of ne titanium dioxide or another dulling agent, thus producing semi-dull, dull,
or deep-dull yarns, as desired.
To give the yarns a voluminous appearance (bulk), a texturing process is required. For low-titer textile lament yarns this is often a false-twist operation: twisting by torsion, heat setting, and subsequently detwisting, in a continuous operation. For higher yarn titers the yarn may be stued into a hot chamber and then
pulled out with simultaneous cooling: this is called stuer box texturing, and is
the common process for staple ber and carpet yarns. An example of a textured
carpet yarn is shown in Figure 17.3(a).
Blowing with air can be used as a texturing process, but also to give the yarn
coherence. The yarn is led through a narrow channel or slit and air is blown perpendicularly onto it. At low yarn tension, air blowing creates lament loops. These
loops give volume to the yarn and air blowing can therefore be regarded as a texturing process. The eect of air impingement on a yarn under tension is an intermingling of the laments. This is called interlacing for improvement of the weavability of textile yarns. For industrial yarns the air impingement may be quite

a
b
Fig. 17.3. Textured and tangled yarns: (a) textured lament
carpet yarn; (b) a knot appears when a needle is moved
through a tangled yarn.

17.2 Fiber Terminology

vigorous, in a so-called tangling jet. If a needle is pulled through a tangled yarn a


knot is formed, typically after a pull-through length of about 10 cm. The eect is
shown in Figure 17.3(b). Tangled yarn packages can be easily unwound, and the
yarns are weavable; the tangling operation replaces a more expensive twisting aftertreatment.
17.2.6

Textile, Carpet, and Industrial Yarns

Further aspects of yarn appearance are the yarn titer and the number of laments:
there may be thin or thick yarn bundles. This will obviously depend on the application.
Textiles and carpets are often based on ber yarns cotton, wool, or blends, for
example cotton/polyester and wool/polyamide but 100% synthetic ber yarns
also nd wide application. Fiber yarns are hardly ever found in industrial applications.
Textile lament yarns have low tex values and a low number of laments, although there is a trend toward lower lament titers, as in microlaments (a1 dtex
per lament). Textile yarns with higher titers are found in home furnishing. Textile
yarns often have non-round laments and are often textured. Carpets can be produced from ber yarns as well as from lament yarns. The laments or bers are
proled and very thick, typically 1030 dtex. Carpet yarns are always textured. Industrial yarns, including high-performance yarns such as aramid and polyethylene,
are always synthetic lament yarns. They have high dtex values and a lament
thickness depending on the spinning process. Wet-spun yarns usually have thinner
laments than melt-spun yarns (this is also valid for textile yarns). Industrial yarns
are at (without texture) and have round laments, with only a few exceptions. A
survey is given in Table 17.3.
The mechanical properties of textile and industrial yarns dier considerably,
even if we neglect the inuence of texturing; see Figure 17.4. A textile yarn has a
high elongation (2050%) and a low tenacity (200400 mN tex1 ). Industrial yarns
(always at) have an elongation below 20% and a tenacity of 600900 mN tex1 .
High-modulus, high-strength bers (HMHS), like aromatic polyamide yarns and

Tab. 17.3.

Yarn composition in synthetic lament yarns.

Textile yarns
melt-spun
wet-spun
Carpet yarns
Industrial yarns
melt-spun
wet-spun

Yarn titer [dtex]

Number of laments

Filament titer [dtex]

20200
50200
ca. 1500

3200
50200
ca. 50

15
12
1030

5002000
5002000

100400
2502000

310
12

917

918

17 Fibers

Tenacity, mN tex 1

2500

HMHS yarn
2000

1500

Industrial yarn

1000

Textile yarn

500

Elongation, %
0
0

10

20

30

40

50

Typical stressstrain curves of textile, industrial and


high-modulus, high-strength yarns.
Fig. 17.4.

gel-spun polyethylene, have an even lower elongation (24%) and a much higher
tenacity (20004000 mN tex1 ). The initial moduli are accordingly low for textile
yarns, medium to high for industrial yarns, and very high for HMHS bers. The
stressstrain curve of a typical textile yarn shows an intermediate at section, indicating that the orientation could have been improved further still. The curves of
polyamide or polyester industrial yarns have the remnant of this intermediate
section although the yarns have been drawn almost to the limit. The aramid
and gel-spun polyethylene processes enable complete orientation. As a result, the
stressstrain curves have become almost straight lines.
17.2.7

Physical Structure

Most bers are semicrystalline. A few of them aramid and gel-spun polyethylene
approach 100% crystallinity. Examples of the ber structure of PET and PPTA are
shown in Figure 17.5. All bers have a uniaxial organization: properties in the
direction of the axis are completely dierent from those in the cross-direction.
This is an essential dierence from other polymer materials.
The crystallization of polymers in a spinning or drawing process diers from the
crystallization in quiescent melts, for example in extrusion or injection molding
processes. The conditions in ber production are highly anisotropic, and nucleation and growth rates are orders of magnitude higher. Therefore Avrami equations
from the literature and values from DSC studies cannot be used to describe ber
crystallization.
A direct result of the anisotropic crystallization conditions is that the crystalline

17.2 Fiber Terminology

Physical structure of bers: (a) semicrystalline


structure of poly(ethylene terephthalate), PET; the broken lines
are the borders of a bril; (b) paracrystalline structure of
poly( p-phenylene terephthalamide), PPTA.
Fig. 17.5.

part will become almost perfectly oriented in the axis direction. The remaining
amorphous regions are more disordered, and will determine the ber properties
to a large extent. Fibers drawn to a high ratio will also have a high orientation in
the amorphous regions between the crystallites. It is understandable that amorphous orientation will be moderate for most textile yarns and high for industrial
yarns.
The total result of crystallization and orientation is a measurable overall orientation in the ber direction, uniaxially. Fibers are always birefringent: the index of
refraction in the axis direction (n== ) is larger than the index crosswise (n? ). The difference is the birefringence: Dn n==  n? , and is a measure of ber orientation.
Orientation factors can be calculated from birefringence measurements ( f 0 for
random orientation, f 1 for complete orientation), and are often split into crystalline orientation ( fc A 1) and amorphous orientation (0 < fa < 1).
An understanding of the physical structure is important to explain ber properties. For example, diusion of molecules is rapid through large amorphous regions
and extremely slow in crystallites. Fibers with low crystallinity and a coarse structure will therefore dye fast and deep, but their chemical stability may be low because small molecules (oxygen, ozone, water, and suchlike) can rapidly diuse
into the laments.
For industrial bers the relationship between mechanical properties and physical
structure is important. With almost perfectly oriented crystals, the orientation of

919

920

17 Fibers

the amorphous regions largely determines the ber modulus and its tendency to
shrink. A high crystallinity, implying a low amorphous content, will contribute to
modulus and will reduce shrinkage. These factors combined give the ber engineer the possibility of developing yarns with high modulus and yet low shrinkage.
A typical aspect of a ber structure is bril formation. Fibrils are an arrangement
of many crystallites and amorphous regions in series, and are common in both
natural and synthetic bers (see Figure 17.5). Chains travel through many crystals
within a bril, but rarely transfer to neighboring brils. An eect of this structure
is the tendency of many synthetic bers, especially those with a high orientation,
toward brillation. This axial splitting of bers can be a disadvantage, but it can
be applied advantageously, for example to produce the aramid pulp used as a replacement for ne asbestos bers.
The word paracrystalline is used for aramid and gel-spun polyethylene. Amorphous regions are no longer present; rather, the discussion is about defects in the
crystal regions. Fiber moduli approach theoretical crystal moduli and shrinkage is
virtually absent. Indeed, this is a completely dierent class of materials.

17.3

Fiber Polymers: Choice of Spinning Process


17.3.1

Polymer Requirements

Fibers must have a reasonable thermal stability. This means that the melting and/
or decomposition temperature must be high, preferably above 200 C. This will allow easy ironing of textiles, curing of reinforced rubber at 190 C, coating of fabrics
with PVC around 190 C, and so on. All the large-volume bers are semicrystalline,
with crystalline contents of 30% or more. One can argue about the proper value of
the crystallinity, which depends on the way it is measured. Sometimes there is
discussion of whether a structure is really crystalline: for example, acrylics (PAN
copolymers) would rather have a kind of organized amorphous or defective
crystalline character.
Table 17.4 shows the well-known ber polymers, and a few which seem unsuitable as ber material, namely polystyrene and poly(vinyl chloride). The latter nds
limited ber application, but a special syndiotactic grade with some crystallinity is
then used. Polypropylene has a fairly low melting point but is nevertheless a large
ber product, because the material is cheap and versatile. Polyethylene is even
lower melting and is used only as a superstrong ber at ambient temperature.
17.3.2

Selection of Spinning Process

On paper, the selection of a spinning process seems simple. If the polymer melt
is thermally stable a melt-spinning process will be preferred, because this pro-

17.3 Fiber Polymers: Choice of Spinning Process


Tab. 17.4.

Properties of ber polymers.[a]

Polymer

Tg [ C]

Tm or Td [ C]

Crystallinity [ %]

Polyethylene

100

130140

Polypropylene
Poly(vinyl chloride)
Polystyrene
Polyacrylonitrile
Poly(vinyl alcohol)
Cellulose
Polyamide 6
Polyamide 66
Poly(ethylene terephthalate)
Poly( p-phenylene terephthalamide)

20
85
100
85
70/85
230
a50
a50
75

170
200 (d)
275 (d)
ca. 250 (d)
ca. 250 (d)
200250 (d)
225
260
255
ca. 400 (d)

>50
>80, gel-spun
>50
<10
0
ca. 30
4060
4050
4050
4050
3040
ca. 100

[a] T

g glass transition temperature, Tm melting temperature,


Td decomposition temperature.

cess is relatively simple and cheap. If a polymer is not melt-spinnable, a solvent


must be found which can be used in a solution-spinning process. If the solvent
can be easily evaporated, dry spinning can be applied. In many cases it will be
necessary to spin into a bath containing a nonsolvent, which results in coagulation
of the polymer solution. This is called wet spinning. In a single case viscose
rayon a chemical reaction taking place in the spinning bath is a further complication.
The preference for melt spinning is very strong. Attempts have therefore
been made to make solution-spun polymers melt-spinnable. For example, small
amounts of solvent/plasticizer can make acrylics melt-processable. Cellulose triacetate can be melt-spun if the residence time is held very short. These attempts have
not led to commercial processes, however.
If a choice can be made between dry and wet spinning, the trend is to favor wet
spinning. This may seem surprising because wet spinning is technically complicated. Organic solvents used in dry spinning are often highly ammable, however,
which considerably increases the processing costs.
New, advanced ber types are often spun from solution. Aramid, for example,
has to be spun from solution because the polymer does not melt, but the developed
process strongly deviates from standard wet spinning. The new process is called
air-gap spinning, or dry-jet wet spinning. In the case of polyethylene the choice
was made to spin ultra-high molecular weight polymer from a dilute solution.
This sounds economically unattractive, but the resulting ber is much stronger
than a melt-spun product. A new name, gel spinning, was introduced for this
process.
A survey of the most important ber polymers and the spinning processes applied is given in Table 17.5.

921

922

17 Fibers
Tab. 17.5.

The most important polymer ber processes.

Polymer

Spinning process

Polyethylene
Polypropylene
Acrylic copolymers

gel spinning (dilute solutions of UHMW polymer)


melt spinning (or brillation of melt-extruded lm)
dry spinning (e.g., DMF solvent)
wet spinning (e.g., NaSCN/water solvent)
wet spinning or dry spinning (solvent: water)
wet spinning
rayon: polymer is derivatized during dissolution in NaOH
lyocell: direct dissolution in NMMO
dry spinning
acetate in acetone/water
triacetate in DCM/methanol
melt spinning
melt spinning
melt spinning
air-gap spinning (solvent H2 SO4 )

Poly(vinyl alcohol)
Cellulose

Cellulose acetate

Polyamide 6
Polyamide 66
Poly(ethylene terephthalate)
Poly( p-phenylene terephthalamide)

17.3.3

Spinnability

What makes a polymer melt- or solution-spinnable? A theoretical prediction is


hardly possible [6]. Laboratory tests are in fact small spinning trials. This is the
way most ber producers will test newly developed polymers, or modications
and new grades of known polymers: on a small spinning machine, which may be
a one-hole laboratory machine. The reason is that in the initial stage of development often only small amounts of material are available.
The rst aspect of the test is whether the extrusion through the spinning holes
proceeds smoothly, without excessive die swell, and without extrudate distortion.
Modest problems may be solved by increasing the temperature in melt spinning
or reducing the polymer concentration in solution spinning. In more severe cases
one must probably conclude that the molecular weight is too high or the molecular
weight distribution too broad. Elastic behavior is more problematic in spinning
than in most other polymer shaping processes.
The second aspect of spinnability is whether the laments will break under their
own weight or if the spin-line stress is increased by imposing higher spinning
speeds. Filament breaks during spinning indicate too low a melt strength. This
problem can only be solved by increasing the molecular weight of the polymer
and/or the concentration of the spinning solution.
Obviously, the use of a high molecular weight polymer grade will be preferred. It
gives increased melt strength, and will usually give better yarn properties. Problems with die swell and melt fracture can make a compromise necessary, however.
For wet spinning there is an additional factor inuencing spinnability. The
thread formation process is complicated: it involves diusion of solvents out of

17.4 Melt Spinning

the lament and nonsolvent from the spinning bath into the lament, followed by
gelation and/or coagulation. Unstable coagulation can make the spinning laments weak. A polymer solution may therefore appear unspinnable until the
proper composition of the spinning bath has been discovered. With tongue in
cheek, one could say that melt spinning is for engineers while wet spinning is a
technique for artists.

17.4

Melt Spinning

The most important melt-spun polymers are polyester (PET), polyamide (PA6 and
PA66) and polypropylene (PP). A scheme for a melt-spinning machine is given in
Figure 17.6. We will follow the process scheme, from extruder to winder.
17.4.1

Extrusion

Some large-scale processes (for polyester and polyamide 66) use direct spinning,
which means that polymerization and spinning are integrated. In most cases poly-

Fig. 17.6. Scheme for a melt spinning


machine (reproduced from Ref. 5): a, extruder;
b, central lter; c, manifold (polymer lines);
d, spin-box with pumps and spinnerets;
e, cooling; h, interoor tube. In section I

as-spun yarns are wound separately (i).


Section II is a typical arrangement for staple
ber production: f, deection of bundles;
g, combination of bundles, which are laid
down in containers.

923

924

17 Fibers

mer chips are extruded, however. For melt spinning single-screw extruders are
used, no dierent from those applied in other elds of polymer melt processing.
Screw designs may vary considerably, and certainly depend on polymer type and
grade, but there are no typical melt-spinning screws.
Twin-screw extruders are necessary for blending, compounding, or reactive extrusion, but these operations are not usually applied in melt spinning. Moreover,
twin-screw extruders may not easily build up the high pressure necessary to
pump the melt through a long distribution system (see Section 17.4.2). And, of
course, twin-screw extruders are more expensive than single-screw extruders.
Complete de-aeration of the melt is an absolute requirement. Remnant undissolved gas will give small bubbles in the extruded laments and cause breaks in
the spin-line. Vacuum in the hopper would solve this problem but is technically
complicated. Spinning under nitrogen is more common. A proper screw design,
especially of the feed zone, and temperature control should ensure sucient deaeration.
The size of the extruders for commercial production varies between 90 and 150
mm screw diameter, with outputs of about 100600 kg h1 . This mass ow should
feed many spinning positions. For textile yarns with a low titer, the output per
spinneret can be as low as 1 kg h1 and consequently an extruder then should
feed at least about 100 spinning positions. For industrial yarns the output per bundle can easily go up to 50 kg h1 , and one would see about ten spinning positions
per extruder.
17.4.2

Polymer Lines and Spin-box

Each spinning position should receive polymer with the same time and temperature history because yarn processing and properties depend on molecular weight
in particular. Residence times of a few minutes between head extruder and spinning plate are common, and some degradation will always occur. Therefore, polymer line systems (manifolds) have simple splits (into two or three) and the same
length between the head of the extruder and all positions. An example is given in
Figure 17.7.
It is obvious now that the examples in Section 17.4.1 were inaccurate. The textile
machine would have 96 positions (3  2 5 ) rather than about 100, and the industrial yarn machine eight positions (2 3 ).
Many producers insert static mixers in their polymer lines, for example before

Fig. 17.7.

A polymer line system for eight spinning positions.

17.4 Melt Spinning

each split in the system. The disadvantages are an additional pressure drop and
fouling of the elements. There are special redistribution elements however, guiding the stagnant wall layer to the center of the line again, with only a modest pressure drop.
Fouling has already been mentioned: it is a very critical issue for spinning machines. Small particles of degraded polymer (gels) will cause lament breaks. Dead
pockets must be prevented and bends in polymer lines are therefore as smooth as
possible. A careful cleaning operation must be performed before a spinning machine is started. Not surprisingly, this is often carried out with high molecular
weight polyolens, which are highly viscous, very elastic, not spinnable, but eective as cleaning compounds. In some occasions (PA66) the distribution system can
even be completely dismantled in order to be cleaned by burning in an oven at
500 C or higher.
Polymer lines can be heated electrically, but temperature control is more accurate when a thermal vapor uid is used. The standard uid is a mixture of diphenyl and diphenyl oxide, with a boiling point around 260 C. Double-walled lines
are therefore almost standard.
The spin-box is a vapor-heated enclosure containing the spinning pumps and
the spinning assemblies. Each spinning position has its own metering pump. The
pump and spinning assembly are installed close to each other. The spinning assembly is inserted in a hole in the spin-box. Both top loading and bottom loading
are possible.
17.4.3

Spinning Pumps

Each spinneret of a spinning machine should be fed with a constant volume ow


of polymer melt because otherwise the titer of the resulting yarn bundle would
vary. This is done with positive displacement pumps: that is, gear pumps with low
tolerances. Their output should be independent of the pressure dierence over the
pump. A melt-spinning pump must ensure a constant output up to 400 or 500 bar.
Most pumps have one driven gearwheel and one co-rotating wheel, but two, three
or more co-rotating wheels are also possible. Having a combination of two (or
more) spinning pumps on one driving axis is also a fairly common practice. All
spinning pumps on a machine run at the same speed, and thus the linear density
of all yarn bundles is the same.
The capacity of spinning pumps is indicated by their volume per revolution, usually in cm 3 ; values of 0.550 cm 3 are common. They are operated at 1050 rpm.
For example, for a low yarn titer the required volume ow could be 50 cm 3 min1 ,
which would be delivered by a 2 cm 3 spinning pump running at 25 rpm; or a
heavy industrial yarn titer could require a 20 cm 3 pump at 3040 rpm. Note that
volume ows are adjusted while mass ows are prescribed. A recalculation is easy
when the density of the melt is known, but in practice a mass ow check is always
made.

925

926

17 Fibers

Melt-spinning pumps can be constructed from normal steel. Tolerances are not
too critical when melt viscosities are suciently high. Pumps are cleaned in hot
ovens at b500 C.
17.4.4

Spinning Assembly

The spinning assembly can be round or rectangular. It contains a lter package on


top of a supporting/distribution plate. The spinning plate is the bottom of the
spinning assembly.
Filtration
For production of bers, usually having diameters of 1030 mm, very ne ltration
is necessary. The rule of thumb is that particles of more than one-third of the eventual ber diameter will cause interruptions of the spinning or drawing process and
should therefore be removed. The particles that must be removed can be solid (catalyst remnants, dust) or gel-like (not fully melted or crosslinked polymer). Solid
particles can more easily be removed than gel particles. Pigments or delustrants
may be added to the spinning melt. Note that these must almost be submicronic
and should easily pass any lter.
Filtration can be applied in all stages of the process: in a central lter in the polymer melt line, or at the end of the line, in the spinning assembly. Central lters are
common in large-scale melt-spinning processes, for example, staple ber production. Two parallel lters may be used to enable lter cleaning without interruption
of the process. Rotating lters with continuous cleaning are also used.
Spinning assemblies always contain lters. In many cases it is the only place
where ltration takes place, but there may also be a combination of preltration
in a central lter and a last, and nest, ltration just above the spinning plate.
Filter packages are usually a stack of screens, going from coarse to ne in the
streamline direction, on top of a support plate with holes for further distribution
of the ow. Screens are plain-weave, or sometimes twill-weave, steel wire fabrics.
Their neness is indicated in mesh (threads per inch), openings per cm 2 , or pore
size in microns. For example, 325 mesh 16 800 opening s cm2 A 40 mm. 500
mesh (25 mm) ltration is common in melt spinning. For even ner ltration, steel
nonwoven materials are used, with a lter neness going down to 5 mm.
An alternative ltration method is a sand lter 15 cm thick, on top of supporting screens. Rather than sand, a sharp-edged stainless steel powder would
nowadays be used. The alleged advantage of a sand lter is the breakdown of gel
particles, which would pass through a relatively thin screen package.
17.4.4.1

Spinning Plate
The bottom of the assembly is the spinning plate: 530 mm thick. The number of
holes varies enormously. A hosiery yarn may have one or three laments, a carpet
yarn 60 laments, an industrial yarn 350 laments. For low lament numbers per
17.4.4.2

17.4 Melt Spinning

yarn bundle, two or more bundles can be spun from one plate. The number of
holes can go up to 100010 000 for staple ber production. The size of the spinning plates is chosen accordingly, and the plates can range, for example, from
round 60 mm textile plates to rectangular plates 1 m wide for staple ber production.
The spinning holes are relatively large: 200500 mm round is common, <200 mm
may be used for textile microtiter yarns, and >500 mm for some industrial yarns.
The holes are large in comparison with the eventual diameter of the laments.
This implies that a considerable draft (see Section 17.4.13.3) is applied in the
spin-line, reducing the lament diameter without however inducing much orientation.
It is impossible to manufacture 200500 mm holes in a melt-spinning plate,
which must be 530 mm thick to withstand the high spinning pressure. Moreover,
such a long narrow hole would give too high a pressure drop. In practice there is
always a backhole (pre-channel, counterbore), with a diameter of 23 mm. The
actual spinning capillary is usually short, with an L=D ratio of only 12.
If possible, spinning holes are made by drilling or punching, because these
are cheap operations. Very small and non-round holes, however, must be made by
spark erosion, making use of an electrode in the form of the hole. The simplest
shape of a hole  backhole spinning capillary (see Figure 17.8a) is rarely applied. At the least there is some smoothening of the entrance and especially of the
transition region to avoid turbulence ow (Figure 17.8b). Holes may have a tapered
section or even a trumpet form (Figure 17.8c). The backhole is always round, but
the spinning capillary may be proled. One can imagine how complicated it then
is to make a smooth transition zone.
The holes are positioned 510 mm from each other. This spacing is necessary
for the air-cooling process. Cold air must penetrate easily into the bundle, and
some mobility of the laments should be allowed without laments immediately
sticking as a result.

a, backhole
and spinning hole
Fig. 17.8.

Examples of spinning holes.

b, as a, but
smoothened

c, trumpet form,
tapering

927

928

17 Fibers

Fig. 17.9. Principle of a crossow quenching system


(reproduced from Ref. 5): a, spin-box; b, spinneret; c, lament
bundle; d, lter; e, air supply.

17.4.5

Quenching

The standard quenching or cooling system is crossow, in which cold air (at 15
70 C) ows from one side, perpendicular to the yarn bundle (see Figure 17.9).
The disadvantage of this system is that laments close to the blow-box cool faster
than those in the front of the yarn bundle (see Figure 17.10a). This can be minimized by adapting the drilling pattern and limiting the number of rows of
holes in the cross-direction (Figure 17.10b). An alternative is radial cooling (Figure
17.10c), usually outside to inside, with the disadvantage, however, that a column of
hot air will be enclosed in the bundle, again resulting in dierences in cooling
across the bundle.
Enforced cooling only takes place in the rst 0.51.5 m, whereas the total height
of the spin-line is 1.56.0 m. Cooling air speeds are in the order of 0.11 m s1 .
A standard spinning machine with a cooling height of 6 m requires at least a
four-story building, with chips handling on the fourth oor and extruders, spinboxes, and cooling on the third oor (the spinning oor). On the second oor one
would only see interoor tubes, or chimneys, through which the bundles
travel downward and cool further. The rst oor is the winding oor.
At high spinning speeds the yarn bundle attracts its own cooling air, by selfsuction. With only a few measures to avoid turbulence and ensure symmetric stability, this can be sucient for textile yarns. For industrial yarns the initial cooling

17.4 Melt Spinning

a, crossflow
circular drilling
pattern
Fig. 17.10.

b, crossflow
optimal cooling
of all filaments

c, radial cooling

Yarn cooling.

is always enforced, but the remaining necessary cooling air is attracted automatically by the bundle.
For highly viscous polyester and polyamide 66 yarns there may be no cooling
in the rst 0.10.5 m. On the contrary, an electrically heated ring or box, which
keeps the laments at the spinning temperature, would be positioned around the
bundle. The technique is called retarded cooling, and the device is a quench collar. In this way the spinning plate is kept at an even temperature and the orientation level is reduced as well as the variation in orientation between laments. This
results in applicability of higher draw ratios, and in higher tenacities of the yarns.
The cooling speed depends on the mass ow per hole and the temperature difference between the lament and the air. Of course, large bundles spun at high
speeds require much cooling air; this is a simple energy balance calculation. The
limiting step in the cooling process is the formation of a sublayer around the laments. Removing or refreshing this sublayer is the key for a fast and even cooling
process.
The laments in a bundle should not touch each other before they are solid, below the glass transition temperature or below the crystallization temperature. Polypropylene and polyamide 66 always crystallize in the spin-line, polyamide 6 and
polyester crystallize in the spin-line only at high speeds.
17.4.6

Finish

A yarn without spin nish cannot be processed; yarnmetal friction is too high,
and static charge would build up. A nish is therefore applied before the yarn rst
touches guides, rolls, and so on. Finishes can have sophisticated compositions, but
two components are always present: lubricants and antistatics. In water-based nishes emulsiers are a third essential component. Finishes are specic for certain

929

930

17 Fibers

yarn types: a polyamide nish cannot be used on polyester or polypropylene; a nish for polyester textile cannot be used on a polyester tire yarn.
Finishes must be adapted to the polarity of the ber polymer. They must spread
over the surface within a very short time. Another criterion is that the nish
should not interfere with later applications. For example, components which are
necessary in a textile nish could ruin the rubber adhesion of a tire cord.
Knowledge of nishes used to be proprietary, with most ber producers using
their own nishes and keeping the compositions secret. Commercial producers
have developed good general-purpose nishes, however, which have found wide
application. Only a few larger ber producers still develop their own nishes, especially for critical processes. One feature has remained: still, ber producers do not
reveal which nish is used or how it is applied.
Spin nishes often used to be solutions in white spirit, but for environmental
reasons this is no longer the case. Emulsions in water, or nishes without a diluent
so-called neat oils, with components of a suciently low viscosity are used
instead.
Application of nish requires special applicators. Fairly old-fashioned is a nish
roll, a porous ceramic roll which constantly takes up nish from a bath, which is
then transferred to the yarn that just touches the surface of the roll (see Figure
17.11a). More modern applicators accurately supply the required amount of nish
via a small gear pump, to stift or block applicators, through a hole or slit. The
yarn is spread as a ribbon over the applicator and takes up the nish (Figure
17.11b,c). At higher yarn speeds the even distribution of nish becomes increasingly dicult. An applicator with multiple slits or a nish wheel (a roll with small
holes under the yarn path) may then be applied.
Finishes of a dierent nature, so-called after-oils, may be applied at the end of
the spinning and drawing process to improve the yarn for a specic application,
for example to produce a wrinkle-free textile fabric, to make carpet yarns antistatic

a, finish roll
Fig. 17.11.

b, stift applicator

Application of nish.

c, block applicator

17.4 Melt Spinning

and/or non-soiling, or to enhance PVC or rubber adhesion for industrial yarns.


There is a distinct overlap with other nish-like aftertreatments such as sizes for
weaving and dips for tire cords.
17.4.7

Spinning Speed

Falling under its own weight a spinning bundle would reach a speed of 300
400 m min1 . In practice, spinning speeds of at least 500 m min1 are required
to obtain a suciently high tension in the spin-line. Much higher speeds can be
enforced, as long as the laments do not break under the constantly increasing
tension. Speeds of 40008000 m min1 have become common practice, especially
for polyester. This is called high-speed spinning (HSS), in contrast to LSS
(< 1000 m min1 ). The air friction can only build up modest forces in the laments. Even at high speeds the molecular orientation level remains limited, and
further drawing is always possible, or even necessary. For further information on
HSS see Ref. 7 and Section 17.4.14.
17.4.8

Winding

An old-fashioned winder, operating at 500 m min1 , was still a simple piece of


equipment. Modern high-speed winders, operating at 6000 m min1 or more, are
high-tech devices, the area of specialists. In order to make packages with a good
cylindrical shape, the traverse system of the yarn must be very rapid and smooth,
especially at the reversal points. A second problem is how to handle the very great
weights of the packages, for example, four packages of 30 kg each, wound on one
spindle, at >5000 rpm! A third problem is that threading in and transfer to a
new package must be fully automated; winders therefore have revolver systems
which simultaneously end the winding of one package and start the next one.
For textile production the capacity of winders has been increased by winding
eight or even 12 packages on one winder. For industrial yarns the standard number
of packages is two to four.
Winders are used at the end of the spinning process, LSS or HSS, or at the end
of an integrated process (spindraw winding; see Section 17.4.9), always at high
speed. Winders for separate drawing processes (see Section 17.4.9) usually operate
at a1000 m min1 . At these low speeds it is possible to wind and twist the yarn
simultaneously. This is done for textile yarns. For industrial yarns twist is often applied as a separate aftertreatment.
17.4.9

Drawing

A yarn spun at low speed (< 1000 m min1 ) still requires additional drawing. The
elongation is still a few hundred percent and the tenacity is too low. A yarn spun at

931

932

17 Fibers

high speed (> 4000 m min1 ) may already have sucient strength for textile or
nonwoven applications, but is never strong enough for industrial use. If additional
orientation is required, this can be enforced in the spin-line, in a narrow hot tube
where drawing takes place. This is called hot-tube spinning (HTS) and is applied
only for textile yarns. In most cases drawing is a separate operation. This can be
on a separate machine, or combined with the spinning operation, but then in a
separate step.
The drawing process is usually carried out in two steps: cold and hot drawing.
Cold drawing is the so-called neck-drawing step. For a stable process the position
of the neck should be xed, by tension and/or temperature. Hot drawing is distributed over a longer distance, in a more homogeneous deformation process.
The simplest setup of a drawing machine is a drawing pin (with one yarn wrap
around it) and a hotplate (the yarn loosely touches the surface) between two rolls
(see Figure 17.12a). The pin is heated to about the glass transition temperature,
while the hotplate is held at a temperature safely below the melting temperature.
The speed ratio of the two rolls is the adjusted draw ratio (for example, 5.4). The
yarn necks on the pin and completes a natural draw (for example 3). The remaining factor (1.8) is the draw ratio over the hotplate. One lets the as-spun
yarn decide how and where it wants to draw, which is not necessarily the optimum
situation.
More control is possible if the two steps are separated. As an example, drawing
in hot gas (steam or air, Figure 17.12b) is depicted, with a set of pins for the cold
drawing step and an oven for the hot drawing step. The scheme in Figure 17.12(c)
shows that drawing is also possible on rolls only, provided that these are heated to

a, pin-plate drawing
cold drawing on a static pin;
hot drawing on the plate

c, roll-roll drawing
a steamjet fixes the neck in the
cold drawing step

b, hot gas drawing


three-roller sets determine the initial, intermediate and end speed
cold drawing on 5 static pins; hot drawing in a oven, with hot steam or air
Fig. 17.12.

Drawing processes.

17.4 Melt Spinning

approximately the previously applied pin and plate temperatures, respectively. An


alternative is to insert a steam jet between the rolls, which xes the neck position.
Traditionally, spinning and drawing were two separate processes. A spinning
spool was made and then unwound again to feed a drawing machine. Later, the
two steps were combined. This technique is called spindraw winding (SDW).
The winding speeds on spindraw winders are always high. For example, a minimum spinning speed of 500 m min1 should be multiplied with a draw ratio (DR)
of 56, resulting in speeds of 25003000 m min1 . For better economics, speeds
of b4000 m min1 are preferred, which are achieved at spinning speeds of
b700 m min1 . Figure 17.12(c) shows a typical set of drawing rolls (godets) for an
SDW machine.
Textile yarns are drawn to moderate tenacity and still high elongation. A
(super)high-speed spinning process may fulll the demands; the term fully oriented yarn (FOY) is used for the product. If a drawing process is still necessary it
is often very simple, in one step, for example combined with a texturizing process.
High-tenacity industrial yarns always require extensive drawing, in most cases in
two steps, even if the spun yarn is already highly preoriented.
When higher draw ratios are applied the stressstrain curves become steeper: tenacity is increased and elongation is reduced (see Figure 17.13). We nd the endpoints of a series of curves on an envelope, often described with empirical relationships. A popular one for polyester and nylons is TE 0:5 constant (T tenacity;
E elongation). A demand to raise this factor, which implies a higher breaking
energy, cannot be fullled by adapting the draw ratio, but only by adapting a quality factor. In the example given this is an increase of the polymer molecular

Tenacity, mN tex 1

1000
900

Increasing Draw Ratio

800
700
600

Increasing Molecular Weight

500
400
300
200
100

Elongation, %

0
0

10

20

30

Stressstrain curves of polyester yarns: inuence of


draw ratio and molecular weight.
Fig. 17.13.

40

50

933

934

17 Fibers

weight. Figure 17.13 shows realistic values of T and E for polyester textile and industrial yarns, the latter being produced from a 50% higher molecular weight.
17.4.10

Relaxation and Stabilization

High orientation of the amorphous phase results in yarn shrinkage, for example in
boiling water or in hot air. The shrinkage can be partly relieved in a stabilization
step: a heat treatment at (almost) constant length (DR 1). If the heat treatment
is carried out at low tension the term relaxation is used (DR < 1). Almost zeroshrinkage yarns (pre-shrunk) can thus be produced. The equipment is the same
as for drawing: hotplates, hot ovens, or rolls, often installed as an additional step in
the drawing process.
17.4.11

Process Integration

It is expensive to let operators handle intermediate products and it is therefore necessary to reduce the number of process steps or to integrate process steps, in order
to remain competitive. The rst trend has been to increase spinning speeds and
get so much orientation that the drawing step can be omitted. This is the case for
textile yarns spun at high speed, fully oriented and spun-bonded polyester or
polypropylene nonwovens. A second trend is to combine spinning and drawing
(SDW) and, if possible, to include stabilization and texturing. An example of the
latter integration is spindraw bulk winding (SDBW) of carpet yarns. A third possibility is to couple polymerization with yarn production, by direct spinning for
example, in a continuous polyester polymerization unit coupled with staple-ber
spinning or a series of spindraw winders. This is the ultimate wish: for monomers going in and full yarn spools coming out.
17.4.12

Rheology

For the design of polymer lines, lter packs and spinning plates, rheological data
are required to make the proper calculations. Fiber polymer melts have a fairly
common rheological behavior: they are viscoelastic and shear thinning.
Shear Viscosity
Most rheological processes during spinning are determined by shear. It is important to understand the typical shear rates in spinning machines. We will use Eq.
(2), for the apparent shear rate, to work out a few examples.
17.4.12.1

g_app

32Fv
pD 3

17.4 Melt Spinning

935

10000

polymer lines

Melt viscosity, Pa.s

filters
spinning holes
1000

100
1

10

100

Shear rate, 1 s 1

1000

Fig. 17.14. Melt viscosity of polyester as a function of shear


rate. h 0:9, at 300 C and 100 bar. An indication of the shear
rate domains in a spinning machine has been added.

For a polymer line with a diameter of 4 cm through which a mass ow of 360


kg h1 (rmelt 1 g cm3 ) is pumped, we calculate g_ 16 s1 , a low-shear condition. For a ow of 5 g min1 through a 500 mm spinning hole, however, we calculate g_ 6790 s1 , a high-shear condition. In the lter package the pores can be
small, but the total ow is divided over as large a surface as possible, in order to
prevent a high pressure buildup. As a result, shear rates will be in the order of
1002000 s1 . Finally, in the metering pumps the shear rates between gearwheel
and housing may be in the order of 10 5 s1 . For melts with pronounced shear thinning, narrow tolerances may thus be required for a proper metering.
For appropriate calculations of the ow in spinning machines one thus needs a
rheological curve over about four decades of shear rate, such as Figure 17.14. A
zero-shear viscosity (h0 ) or a melt ow index (MFI) gives insucient insight.
The polymer molecular weight is the most important factor determining the
viscosity of melts. The scaling rule is h @ Mw3:4 . In many cases a solution viscosity
(for example, intrinsic viscosity, [h]) is used as a measure for polymer molecular
weight. Since for many exible polymers h @ Mw0:7 we can derive another scaling
rule, of melt viscosity as a function of solution viscosity: h @ h 5:0 . It is evident that
a higher melt temperature will reduce melt viscosity, but only small variations in
molecular weight can be compensated for by temperature adjustment.

10000

936

17 Fibers

Elasticity
Elastic behavior is the background of melt fracture just below the spinning plate,
which in practice means the immediate interruption of a running process. Elasticity can be controlled by avoiding the use of high molecular weight polymer. For
example, the common grades of polypropylene have a broad molecular weight
distribution and it may be required to remove the high molecular weight tail by
degradation, for example with a peroxide. The resulting ber grade is indicated
as controlled rheology.
17.4.12.2

Elongational Viscosity
Elongational behavior is induced in the entrance of the spinning hole and in the
transition region from backhole to actual capillary. In practice hardly any permanent orientation is built up in this way, however, because molecular relaxation is
rapid. Spinning hole proles are smoothened only to prevent the formation of
vortices which would lead to extrudate distortion. Promoting orientation already
in the spinning holes is not common for melt spinning. It could be benecial for
the orientation of melt-spun liquid-crystalline polymers, however, for example in
the production of carbon ber from pitch.
More important is the elongation in the spin-line, where uniaxial deformation of
the material obviously takes place. Measurement of elongational viscosity on laboratory equipment is very complicated. Fiber engineers may include it in developing
spinning models, thereby using the spinning machine itself as a rheometer, but
will usually keep the information they gather proprietary.
In situations of low elongational rate one can simply apply Troutons ratio [Eq.
(3), where hE is the elongational viscosity and hS is shear viscosity; the subscript S
is often omitted].
17.4.12.3

hE 3hS

At higher rates, and in contrast to shear thinning, strain hardening (increasing hE )


may occur, resulting in rapid orientation. In practice this is often induced or accompanied by cooling, solidication, and crystallization of the melt, making the
analysis of elongational behavior even more complicated.
Catastrophic strain hardening, resulting in breaking laments, is rare for meltspun polymers. Buildup of fairly high orientation in the spin-line has become
common, however, in modern high-speed spinning processes.
17.4.13

Process Calculations

Fiber engineers are notorious users of non-SI units: feet or yards instead of meters,
minutes or hours instead of seconds, grams instead of kilograms, and denier or
dtex instead of tex. Nevertheless, most process calculations are quite simple, without dicult conversions being necessary.

17.4 Melt Spinning

A few examples for a polyester spindraw winding process will show this, and
hopefully give an impression of how melt-spinning machines are designed.
The process concerns the production of an industrial yarn with a titer of 1670
dtex f 325. We assume that spinning holes are used with a diameter of 500 mm
and an L=D ratio of 1.5; there are 325 holes per spinning plate. There are eight
spinning bundles per extruder. The spinning speed is 800 m min1 and the spun
yarn is immediately drawn ve times on the same machine (an integrated process)
and then wound with a speed of 4000 m min1 .
Mass Flow
By denition 1 dtex 1 gram per 10,000 m. The output per bundle is then calculated from Eq. (4).
17.4.13.1

fyarn titer in dtex 10;0001 g  spinning speed in m min1


1670/10;000  4000 668 g min1

Note that the mass ow is constant in the process, from spinning pump to winder.
No mass is lost, in contrast to dry or wet spinning. For example, at the end of the
spin-line the speed is 800 m min1 , ve times lower than after drawing, but the
undrawn yarn still has a ve times higher titer. Also note that the volume ow is
not completely constant, because the density increases (by about 20%) when the
melt cools down, solidies, and crystallizes.
Eight yarn bundles make 8  668 5344 g min1 320.6 kg h1 , which
would require a 120 mm, maybe 150 mm, extruder. The unit produces about 7.6
ton day1, or about 2700 ton y1.
Volume Flow
The density of a polyester melt is approximately 1.18 g cm3 . The volume ow per
yarn bundle and spinning pump thus is 668=1:18 566 cm 3 min1 . This ow can
be achieved with a 20 cm 3 pump at 28.3 rpm.
17.4.13.2

Extrusion Speed and Elongation in the Spin-line


A volume ow of 566 cm 3 min1 is extruded through 325 holes, which is
566=325 1:74 cm 3 min1 per hole. The holes have a diameter of 500 mm
(0.05 cm) and their cross-section is p=4  0:05 2 0:001964 cm 2 . The extrusion
speed through the holes is (1.74 cm 3 min1 )/(0.001964 cm 2 ) 887 cm min1
8.87 m min1 .
The spinning speed is 800 m min1 , and the laments are thus accelerated in
the spin-line by a factor of 800=8:87 90. In practice this is viscous ow rather
than molecular orientation. Calling this a draw ratio is misleading; draft, drawdown or spin stretch factor are better notions.
17.4.13.3

937

938

17 Fibers

Pressure Drop over the Spinning Holes


For the calculation of shear rate it is essential to convert accurately to meters and
seconds in order to obtain shear rate in reciprocal seconds (s1 ). The formula is
given by Eq. (5), with Fv 1:74 cm 3 min1 and D 500 mm.
17.4.13.4

g_app

32Fv
pD 3

The shear rate in the spinning holes in this case is g_ 2363 s1 . In the rheology
graph (Figure 17.14) we see that h 220 Pa s at this shear rate.
We can now calculate the pressure drop over the spinning hole with Poiseuilles
law [Eq. (6)].
DP

128
L
Fv h 4
p
D

The result is 3119335 Pa 31 bar. The pressure drop over the much wider backhole would add only a few bars.
This is a reasonable pressure drop: not too high, but also not too low, because
this would lead to an uneven distribution of the ow over the holes, which would
result in lament titer dierences within a yarn bundle. For a lower melt viscosity (for example, 100 Pa s), narrower spinning holes (350 mm) would have been
necessary.
The pressure drop over the lter package would add 3050 bar, resulting in an
initial pressure drop over the spinning assembly of 6085 bar. The pressure drop
over the lter does increase during the lifetime of the spinning assembly. The assembly would be taken out of the machine at 200250 bar.
17.4.14

Polyester (Poly(ethylene terephthalate), PET)

Polyester and PET are almost synonyms. Other polyesters, such as poly(butylene
terephthalate) (PBT), poly(trimethylene terephthalate) (PTT), and poly(ethylene
naphthalate) (PEN), have hardly any signicance as ber materials.
PET Polymer
Textile-grade polyester has an intrinsic viscosity around 0.6 (degree of polymerization 100) and is spun at about 285 C, which is 30 C above the melting point.
Grades for industrial yarns have an intrinsic viscosity of 0.80.9 (degree of polymerization 140160) and must be spun at 300310 C. The main degradation problem for PET is hydrolysis: each water molecule gives one chain break in the PET.
There is no hydrolysis problem when a polymerization unit directly feeds the spinning machine. Handling of polymer chips requires closed systems, ultra-dry air or
nitrogen, among similar precautions. Thermal degradation is unproblematic for
textile yarn polyester, but becomes severe for industrial yarn polyester grades
17.4.14.1

17.4 Melt Spinning

yarn speed,
m min 1

6000

6000
5000
4000

4000

3000
2000

2000

1000

0
0

0.5

1.0

1.5

Distance from spinning plate, m


Fig. 17.15.

Yarn speed curves for LSS and HSS of polyester.

spun above 300 C. Even at a short residence time in the machine (below 10 min) a
total drop of 0.1 in the intrinsic viscosity must often be accepted.
Spinning of PET
PET is a slowly crystallizing polymer. It remains amorphous in the spin-line at
speeds below 3000 m min1 . At higher speeds nucleation takes place high in the
spin-line, at high temperature, and these nuclei grow rapidly on their way down.
The air drag forces deform the crystalline network in a neck-like fashion in the
spin-line (see Figure 17.15). This necking is more pronounced for higher speeds,
ner laments, and higher molecular weights. These as-spun yarns have a low
shrinkage even when the crystallinity is still low. The remaining draw ratio of
such yarns is below 2.
17.4.14.2

PET Staple Fiber


The majority of polyester ber production is for textile application, and most of
this is staple ber. Staple ber is produced by direct spinning from continuous
polymerization units based on pure terephthalic acid. The spinning plates have
20005000 holes, and the spinning speed is around 2000 m min1 . The bundles
are not wound but are laid down loosely in a container. Drawing (more than three
times) and texturing is a second, separate step: spinning bundles are combined
into a tow of several hundred thousand dtex and drawn, crimped, and heat-set collectively. Cotton-type ber is the standard: 0.52 dtex, drawn to 20% elongation, cut
to 3240 mm in length. Wool-type bers have a titer of 27 dtex; they are drawn to
40% elongation and cut to 40120 mm in length. Staple ber is delivered to the
customer in large bales.
17.4.14.3

939

940

17 Fibers

PET Textile Filament Yarns


Most textile lament yarns are also direct-spun. The output per bundle is small,
and therefore hundreds of spinning positions must be fed from one polymerization unit, making the polymer melt-line system very complicated. Winders make
four, six, eight, or even 12 packages simultaneously, and spinnerets and spinning
pumps are clustered accordingly.
Partly oriented yarn (POY) is a large product; spun at about 3500 m min1 , with
a round cross-section, and draw-textured (DR @ 1:8, at about 1000 m min1 ) in a
separate step. Fully oriented yarn (FOY) can be spun at b6000 m min1 , or drawn
in the spin-line (hot-tube spinning, HTS), or spin-drawn. Typical yarn titers are 30,
50, 76, 110, and 176 dtex, and the lament titers 23 dtex, although there is a trend
toward values of 1 dtex or lower.
17.4.14.4

PET Industrial Yarns


Direct spinning is not very common for industrial yarns because there are only
a few yarn types that would match the large capacity of polymerization units
(b25 000 ton y1 ). A further complication is that the polymer must be condensed
to a high molecular weight, but this can be achieved in deep-vacuum, thin-lm
nishers. In most cases chips with a textile viscosity are solid-state postcondensed, at a relatively low temperature (about 230 C), which takes many hours
but has the advantage that thermal degradation is minimized.
There is a limited eld of application for low yarn titers, 200550 dtex, in sewing
yarns and ne fabrics. Most industrial yarns have titers of 11002200 dtex. The lament titer is usually around 5 dtex, but yarns for safety belts have coarser laments (1015 dtex) and modern tire yarns may have ner laments (around 3
dtex).
Large spinning holes (350800 mm) are used to handle the high melt viscosities.
The standard process for PET is spindraw winding (SDW) at speeds of 4000
5000 m min1 . This is the cheapest process, especially when two, three, or four
bundles are combined on one set of spinning and drawing godets and one winder.
The yarns are strong (700850 mN tex1 ), but may have a fairly high shrinkage.
For applications such as nets, ropes, cables, and most fabrics (safety belts, conveyor
belts) this is an ideal combination. For some applications almost zero shrinkage
can be required (PVC-coated fabrics) and a separate, slow, drawing and stabilization process may still be applied.
Tire cord is a dierent case. Polyester is the most important reinforcing material
for radial tires. The cords run radially, from rim to rim, and their high modulus
reduces the deformation of the rolling tire, and thus fuel consumption. The properties of the reinforcement in the tire depend on how well the modulus is retained
during the dipping and curing processes. Therefore, tire yarns are always spun at
high speeds (> 3000 m min1 ), which gives lower shrinkage and somewhat lower
tenacity in the yarn. After dipping of the cords and curing of the rubber, these
yarns oer the best strength/modulus combination. To reduce costs, even these
17.4.14.5

17.4 Melt Spinning

yarns are spin-drawn, which implies winding speeds of at least 6000 m min1
(high-speed spin-draw winding, HSSDW).
The most important applications of polyester industrial yarns have been mentioned above: tires, other rubber reinforcement, narrow and wide fabrics, nets,
ropes and cables, and sewing yarns. It is not unusual for a company to list 20 different types of polyester yarn, each type being further divided into various yarn
titers and twist levels.
17.4.15

Polyamide (PA6 and PA66)

The former dierence in usage between the USA (PA66) and Europe (PA6) is still
evident. PA66 seems to be the larger-volume product but PA6 is still large in South
American countries, eastern Europe, and India. High-melting PA46 is gradually
nding application in airbag fabrics. Other polyamides (PA11, PA12) are not important as ber materials.
PA Polymer
Polyamide 6, melting point 225 C, is spun at 260280 C (290 C); polyamide 66,
melting point 265 C, is spun at 290300 C (310 C). Thermal degradation is relatively unproblematic for polyamide 6, but is more severe for polyamide 66 because
of the higher spinning temperature and the tendency of polyamide 66 to crosslink.
Filtration of gel particles is an issue for PA66, not for PA6. PA66 polymer meltlines must be burned out once a year because a crosslinked, charred polymer layer
is built up at the hot walls. High-shear conditions in narrower polymer lines can
help to remove the gel layer from the walls and prolongs the cleaning cycle.
Both polyamides evolve oligomer vapor upon extrusion from the spinning holes,
and snow-like deposits are formed on cold spots in the top of the spinning machine. Measures such as steam injection, suction, and regular manual cleaning
must be taken to keep these under control.
Polyamides are prone to oxidative degradation, resulting in yellowing. The nitrogen gas in the chips hoppers must therefore be completely free of oxygen.
The reaction of polyamide with water is an equilibrium. When the chips are too
dry, the polymer will postcondense in the spinning machine. When they are too
wet hydrolysis will take place. The equilibrium water content depends on the
molecular weight: for a higher molecular weight, the water content must be lower.
There is always some loss of molecular weight by thermal degradation. This can
be compensated for by postcondensation when the water content is adjusted to
slightly below the equilibrium level.
17.4.15.1

PA Spinning
Polyamides crystallize faster than polyester. At low spinning speeds polyamide 6
does not crystallize in the spin-line but fairly rapidly on the spinning spool, thereby
also attracting water. As a result, the packages increase in volume (grow) and can
17.4.15.2

941

942

17 Fibers

be unwound only with diculty when the storage conditions are not kept very constant. At speeds of 10004000 m min1 no proper spinning spools can be made.
Above 4000 m min1 the yarns crystallize suciently in the spin-line and stable
packages are built. Polyamide 66 crystallizes faster than PA6. As-spun yarns are always crystalline, even at low spinning speeds. Complete melting of the crystalline
chips is essential because remnant crystal nuclei can even cause spherulitic crystallization.
PA Staple Fiber
Staple ber is a large product, especially for applications in carpets. The production
resembles that for polyester staple. The spinning speed is about 2000 m min1 ,
which is not problematic because the as-spun yarn is not wound but laid down in
containers. The lament titer may be low (4 dtex, for velour carpet) but is usually
around 20 dtex. The cross-section is proled: it may be trilobal or a square with
holes.
17.4.15.3

PA Textile Filament Yarns


The yarn counts are lower than for polyester because the main applications are as
hosiery yarn (for example 20 denier: 22 dtex f 1 or 22 dtex f 5) or in ladies underwear (typical yarn titers 44 dtex f 10, 78 dtex f 28, or 78 dtex f 60). The processes
are, for POY, spinning at >4000 m min1 followed by a draw-texturing treatment
(at approximately 1000 m min1 ), or SDW at >5000 m min1 . The elongation of
nylon textile yarns is 4550%.
17.4.15.4

PA Industrial Yarns
Polyamide industrial grades have much lower melt viscosities than polyester, and
are therefore spun through smaller spinning holes (250400 mm). Polyamide yarns
can be drawn to elongations slightly below 20%, but subsequent stabilization to reduce shrinkage may add a few percent elongation. Tenacities are at least as good as
for polyester, but the modulus is much lower.
Polyamide is applied in fabrics, especially in airbags, where PA66 has an important advantage over other ber materials. Airbags are blown up with hot gas and
PA66 does not melt because it has a high specic heat and a high melting point.
In this respect, PA46 is even better. The high tenacity and breaking energy of polyamide yarns make them suitable for application in shing nets, ropes, and cables,
but the competition with cheaper polyester is erce. For rubber reinforcement PA6
has the disadvantage of its low melting point. Nevertheless it is still widely applied
in India and South America. PA66 is used on a large scale: in conveyor belts, rubber hoses, and tires. In radial tires PA66 cannot be used in the tire walls because
its modulus is too low, but it is present as a cap ply around the steel belt. In oldfashioned bias-belted tires, for bumpy roads, polyamide is the perfect reinforcement. Aircraft tires also have a diagonal construction, and usually contain many
layers of nylon cords.
Spindraw winding (SDW) is the standard process for the polyamides: spinning
speeds are 5001000 m min1 , winding speeds 30005000 m min1 . Drawing
17.4.15.5

17.4 Melt Spinning

usually takes place in two steps, cold and hot drawing, but one-step drawing is
possible for low yarn counts. For better economics it is essential to process two,
three, or four bundles on one set of drawing godets, and to wind them on one
winder.
Yarn titers are 200600 dtex for airbags and other ne fabrics, and 11002200
dtex for most other applications. Filament titers are around 5 dtex. Tenacities are
between 750 and 850 mN tex1 , and elongations between 18 and 25%.
17.4.16

Polypropylene (PP)
PP Polymer
Polypropylene is an addition polymer with a fairly broad molecular weight distribution. The strong viscoelastic eects make spinning through small holes, or slits in
proled holes, dicult. PP ber grades are therefore made by cracking the high
molecular weight tail by oxidative degradation, for example by the addition of peroxide in a twin-screw extruder.
Polypropylene is full of tertiary carbon atoms which give oxidative and light stability problems. Stabilizer packages are therefore always included in bers, with
their small diameters and high specic surface. The polymer is hydrophobic. Special treatments or additions are required to make polypropylene dyeable.
Polypropylene melts at about 175 C but is spun relatively hot, b75 C above its
melting point. Polypropylene is often spun from large and long spinning holes
(8001500 mm, L=D 35). It is evident that the low melting point is a limit for
industrial applications. A further disadvantage of polypropylene is its low creep
resistance.
17.4.16.1

PP Spinning
Polypropylene crystallizes fast, always in the spin-line, even at low speeds.
17.4.16.2

PP Staple Fiber
This is probably the largest-volume spun product, for application in carpets. The
usual machines resemble those for polyester and polyamide, with the spinning
speed around 1000 m min1 , collection of as-spun yarn in a container, and drawtexturing a tow of several hundred thousand dtex. Short spinning is an alternative: it involves a one-oor machine, holes at a very short distance from each other,
cooling over a short distance, and the spinning speed so low (@100 m min1 ) that
drawing and texturing can be included on the same machine.
17.4.16.3

PP Split Fiber
Much polypropylene ber is not spun, but produced from lm. A lm is blown, or
cast on a chill roll, drawn 610 times and then brillated. There are numerous
ways of slitting, brillating, and cutting. Split ber nds applications in twines
and ropes (as a replacement for sisal), cheap fabrics for bags and tarpaulins, and
carpet backing (replacing jute).
17.4.16.4

943

944

17 Fibers

PP Filament Yarns
The production machines can be normal spindraw winders, as for the other meltspun bers. But here also, compact machines have been developed, for example
for bulked continuous lament yarn (BCF, for carpet) with all the process steps on
one machine, at an end speed of a1000 m min1 .
Polypropylene is small in textile applications (in sportswear) but it has a reasonable position in high-tenacity yarns, in low-temperature applications such as ropes,
cables, and geotextiles. It should be added that polypropylene can be drawn to high
ratios (see Section 17.7.2). This results in very good tenacities, but the helix conguration of the isotactic chain in the crystals severely limits the modulus.
17.4.16.5

17.5

Solution Spinning
17.5.1

Preparation of Spinning Dope

If a polymer cannot be melt-spun, a solution must be made which can be spun.


Chemical ractions may be involved, for example the xanthogenation or acetylation
of cellulose. In general, the spinning dope is prepared in large vessels, not in extruders. Filter presses for very ne ltration are included in the equipment setup
and de-aeration is carried out in a storage tank just before pumping the solution to
the spinnerets.
Solution spinning implies the handling of large quantities of solvent. At a polymer concentration of 20% the total mass ow for dry spinning is ve times higher
than the polymer mass ow. For wet spinning there is a very large additional ow
of nonsolvent from the spinning bath.
17.5.2

Dry Spinning

The principle of dry spinning is shown in Figure 17.16. Dry spinning is not widely
applied; cellulose acetate bers are dry-spun, and whereas acrylics and polyvinyl alcohol can be dry spun, wet spinning is preferred.
The gas in the column is preferably hot nitrogen when ammable organic solvents are used. If the solvent is water (for poly(vinyl alcohol)), hot air can be used.
The column height is limited to about 5 m and the residence time of the running
laments in the column is about 1 s, during which most of the solvent must be
removed from the laments. Complete removal is not necessary because at a high
polymer concentration the laments solidify by gelation and can then be handled.
Removal of solvent can be completed in later process steps, for example during
additional drawing.
Control of gas ows in the column, avoiding turbulence or sticking of laments,
is important. Therefore, the hot gas ow would often be downward rather than in

17.5 Solution Spinning

Fig. 17.16. Scheme for dry spinning (reproduced from Ref. 6):
1, metering pump; 2, spinneret; 3, spinning bundle; 4, drying
column; 5, 6, 7, take-up system; 8, 9, inlet and outlet of drying
gas.

countercurrent, and spinning holes must be a few millimeters apart, as in melt


spinning.
Evaporation of solvent is a relatively slow process, slower than cooling in melt
spinning. It is therefore essential that the spinning laments are thin. The common approach is to use small spinning holes (50100 mm) and apply a low draft
in the spin-line. For example, both the extrusion speed from the holes and the
exit speed from the dry-spinning column would be around 300 m min1 . Even a
draft below 1 is possible, which means that the die swell eect is not completely
undone.
Another approach is a high-draft process, spinning from large holes (500 mm)
and taking up the yarn at relatively high speeds. For example, the extrusion speed
through the holes could be 2050 m min1 and the exit speed around 500
m min1 , which implies a draft of 1025. The draft in the spin-line is viscous
ow and only limited orientation is built up, a situation completely comparable
with melt spinning.
Cellulose Acetate
There are two types of cellulose acetate bers. When all three hydroxyl groups per
cellulose unit (see Section 17.5.3.1) are acetalized, cellulose triacetate is obtained.
Cellulose triacetate is spun from dichloromethane (DCM) plus 515% methanol
17.5.2.1

945

946

17 Fibers

or ethanol. Triacetate is a small product, mainly in the form of yarns with low titers
for textile applications.
Cellulose acetate contains approximately 2.5 acetate groups per cellulose unit,
and is actually produced by partially hydrolyzing the triacetate. The polymer is
spun from a solution in acetone/water (approximately 95:5). With a large excess
of drying air it is possible to remain below explosion limits. Nevertheless, all operations are carried out in closed equipment.
Secondary acetate has a remarkably poor crystallinity, in fact too low to survive
in a strong interber competition for textile applications. The main application of
cellulose acetate is as tow in cigarette lters.
Acrylics
Most acrylic bers are wet-spun, but dry spinning is also applied. The most common solvent is dimethylformamide, DMF. The polymerization of acrylics can also
be carried out in DMF and the polymerization solution can then be directly spun.
The boiling point of DMF is 153 C, making complete removal of solvent in the
spinning column almost impossible. Most dry-spun acrylic production is staple
ber, and the remaining solvent is then removed during tow processing.
Further information on acrylic bers is given in Section 17.5.3.2.
17.5.2.2

Poly(vinyl alcohol)
The preferred process for polyvinyl alcohol is wet spinning, but dry spinning is
also possible. The solvent is water and the polymer concentration is so high (25
50%) that solid chips can be produced at room temperature. These can be processed in a single-screw extruder, as for melt spinning. PVA dry spinning can
be a low-draft or high-draft process. The low-draft as-spun yarn has a better drawability. Very high draw ratios are possible for PVA, resulting in high tenacity and
modulus.
For more information see Section 17.5.3.3.
17.5.2.3

17.5.3

Wet Spinning

The principle of wet spinning is shown in Figure 17.17. Wet spinning is applied
for two large-scale ber products viscose rayon and acrylics and one smaller
product poly(vinyl alcohol).
The critical factor for each wet spinning process is how the coagulation process
in the laments proceeds. In the ternary diagram shown in Figure 17.18 the three
corners represent polymer (P), solvent (S), and non-solvent (N, from the spinning
bath). SD is the spinning dope composition on the line PS. The hatched area is
where phase separation takes place.
The route from SD into the separation region will determine how the coagulation will proceed. (Note that a path on the line SP represents dry spinning: solvent
is removed from the ber and the polymer concentration is increased; there is no
coagulation but there is gelation of the system.) If the amount of nonsolvent enter-

17.5 Solution Spinning

Fig. 17.17. Scheme for wet spinning (reproduced from Ref. 6):
1, metering pump for spinning dope; 2, spinneret; 3, spinning
bundle; 4, spinning or coagulation bath; 5, godet; 6, 7, inlet
and outlet of spinning bath; 8, drawing bath; 9, 10, take-up
system.

ing the ber is relatively small in comparison with the ow of solvent out of the
ber (path 1), phase separation will occur at high polymer concentrations. A homogeneous, dense structure will be formed; the continuous phase is polymer-rich.
This takes a long time, however, because diusion of solvent will become slower
at higher polymer concentrations. The opposite occurs along path 2: nonsolvent
enters relatively rapidly into the ber and coagulation occurs at low polymer concentrations. A heterogeneous, porous structure is formed; the continuous phase
has a low polymer concentration and the ber will be very weak. Path 1 is preferred, but ber formation is relatively slow then.

S
SD

1
2
1

N
Ternary diagram for wet spinning: P polymer,
S solvent, N nonsolvent, SD spinning dope. 1, 2,
coagulation paths (see text).
Fig. 17.18.

947

948

17 Fibers

It is noteworthy that coagulation is the general term for the solidication process in wet spinning, regardless of whether the solidication process is heterogeneous (coagulation) or homogeneous (gelation). Even aramid spinners use the
word coagulation (see Section 17.7.1.1).
In any case, solvent diusion and coagulation will be more rapid in the skin
than in the core of laments. Skin formation is an inherent problem for wet spinning (and also for dry spinning). The main eect is that the laments collapse: the
original round cross-section is transferred into a dog bone shape. Further information is available in Ref. 6, Chapter 4.
17.5.3.1

Viscose Rayon
CH2OH
O

H
H
OH
O

H
H

OH

(1) Cellulose
It is amazing to see how complicated the technology is for this rst large-scale
man-made ber. The complications are caused by the insolubility of cellulose (1).
Chemical modication was necessary to make the polymer spinnable. The rst
attempt was nitration of the hydroxyl groups, but cellulose nitrate proved more
useful as gunpowder than as a basis for ber manufacure. Xanthogenation proved
more successful, although the rst attempts were aiming at producing carbon laments for electric lamps, rather than textile bers.
In the modern process (Figure 17.19), sheets of wood pulp cellulose are swollen
in concentrated alkali and alkali cellulose is formed [Eq. (7), writing CellOH for a
cellulose hydroxyl group].
CellOH NaOH ! CellONa H2 O

The sheets are shredded and the white crumbs are aged, which implies depolymerization to a molecular weight which is suitable for textile applications or tire
cord. The material is then treated in closed equipment (batchwise or continuous)
with carbon disulde in order to xanthate the cellulose [Eq. (8)].
CellONa CS2 ! CellOCS2 Na

Byproducts give an orange-yellow color: yellow crumbs are formed. The degree
of xanthation (of cellulose) is low: fewer than 0.5 hydroxyl groups need be derivatized to accomplish dissolution in dilute alkali. The polymer concentration for a textile yarn would be around 9% and the alkali concentration 56%. For a tire cord
the polymer/alkali ratio is lower, both concentrations being 7%, for example. The

Fig. 17.19.

Spinning

Pulp

Relaxing

Aging

Shredding

Washing

Sulfidizing

CS2

Finishing Drying

Weighing

Viscose rayon process scheme (Enka tire cord process).

Stretching

Alkalization

Lye

Preparation

Pressing

Winding

Dissolving

Coning

Filtration

De-aeration

17.5 Solution Spinning


949

950

17 Fibers

spinning solution is then ripened, which implies a redistribution and slight reduction of xanthate groups. The eventual degree of xanthation would be below 0.3 for
a textile yarn and close to 0.4 for a tire cord. After ne ltration and de-aeration the
viscose spinning dope is spun into an acid bath, where the cellulose is regenerated
[Eq. (9)].
2 CellOCS2 Na H2 SO4 ! 2 CellOH 2 CS2 Na2 SO4

The spinning bath for viscose contains sulfuric acid (at about 10% concentration)
for the decomposition of the xanthate and neutralization of the alkali. Sodium sulfate is formed anyway, but is also dissolved in large quantities (about 20%) in the
spinning bath to control the coagulation process. A further addition is zinc sulfate
(< 3%), again to control coagulation.
The spinning solutions caustic plus acid are highly corrosive. The spinnerets
are made of gold/platinum, round, with diameters of a few centimeters only. The
capillaries are small (5075 mm) and close to each other (< 1 mm). The number of
holes must be large because the standard lament titer of rayon yarns is around
1.7 dtex. The freshly spun laments are very weak and a tube is often placed
around the spinning bundle.
Drawing is always carried out in a combined process, in most cases at least
partly before the complete decomposition of the xanthate groups. Draw ratios
may be low for rayon staple ber. Tire cord is drawn to an elongation of 1213%
and a tenacity of about 500 mN tex1 . Note that these are conditioned values; in a
wet state the high-modulus character is lost; the tenacity becomes lower (400
mN tex1 ) and the elongation much higher (25%).
A few alternatives for the derivatization of cellulose have been found recently: direct dissolution of cellulose has been developed. For textile lament yarns, dissolution in N-methylmorpholine oxide (NMMO) is possible. The process is applied by
Courtaulds and Lenzing. A solution in formic acid/phosphoric acid was found to
have lyotropic behavior and tire yarns with very interesting properties could be produced (patented by Michelin). It even proved possible to use phosphoric acid alone
(patented by AKZO), but the process was never commercialized.
Yarns spun from solution have a dierent crystalline structure (cellulose II) than
natural cellulose (cellulose I). The dierence is that cellulose I has two intermolecular hydrogen bonds formed parallel to the glucosidic bond, whereas cellulose II
has only one parallel hydrogen bond. The main eect is a large dierence in crystal
modulus: 130180 GPa for cellulose I, 6090 GPa for cellulose II. All attempts to
produce man-made bers with a cellulose I structure, and hence an even higher
modulus, have remained unsuccessful, however.
Applications of viscose rayon The main application of rayon is as staple ber.
Spinning is carried out from clusters of spinnerets and bundles are processed collectively as a tow. Rayon staple ber is applied unblended, but is also used in
blends with cotton and/or polyester, in outerwear. Filament yarns have become a

17.5 Solution Spinning

minor product; one may still nd them applied in lining fabrics. Rayon tire cord
has survived the strong competition with polyester, at least in Europe. Rayon has
an unproblematic adhesion to rubber, a high modulus, and a perfect fatigue behavior, and therefore remains the ideal reinforcement for high-speed radial tires.
Acrylics
The crystallinity of acrylic bers is rather ill-dened. Polyacrylonitrile (PAN) is
known to be atactic, but the very strong polar interactions of the nitrile groups
give PAN a denite crystalline behavior. In water a melting endotherm slightly below 200 C is measured and an extrapolated dry melting point could be as high as
320 C, above the decomposition temperature. This nding of melting point depression by water has led to suggestions that PAN could be melt-spinnable when
water, or another plasticizer, is added to the polymer. So far, the technique has
been considered too complicated for technical realization, however.
In practice, the crystalline character of pure PAN is a problem for dissolution,
drawing, and dyeing in various stages of acrylic processing. Therefore comonomers (in acrylics) are added to reduce the crystallinity. Yarns containing b 85%
acrylonitrile are called acrylics. Comonomers that are often used are methyl acrylate and vinyl acetate. Yarns with less than 85% acrylonitrile are called modacrylics. In this case halogen-containing comonomers are often used, such as vinyl
chloride, vinylidene chloride, and vinyl bromide, obviously to improve the ame resistance of the yarn.
For dissolution of acrylics highly polar solvents are required to disrupt the intermolecular bonds between the nitrile groups. Frequently used organic solvents are
dimethylformamide (DMF) and dimethylacetamide (DMAc). The polymer concentration is about 20%. The spinning bath is water, in most cases mixed with the organic solvent being used, in order to slow down the coagulation and precipitation.
An alternative is the use of concentrated solutions (50%) of sodium thiocyanate
(NaSCN) in water. The spinning bath then is a dilute solution of NaSCN in water.
Acrylic solutions have the tendency to gel with time, a thermoreversible process.
For spinning it is an advantage to have gelation rather than precipitation of the laments. As a result of the gelation, as-spun acrylic laments maintain the crosssection of the spinning holes, but are very porous. A density of 0.40.5 g cm3 is
usual, while the density of a drawn and dried ber is 1.17 g cm3 . The voids are
very small (0.11 mm), and collapse during drawing and drying.
Most acrylic production is for staple ber. Huge spinning plates with up to
60 000 holes are used, and tow drawing and crimping are included in the process.
Drawing takes place in a hot-water bath, which is possible because the wet glass
transition temperature is about 75 C. The above-mentioned porosity of acrylics is
used to control luster. Dried yarns are very lustrous but can be made dull again by
a hot wet treatment.
17.5.3.2

Applications of acrylics The largest application is in ber yarns for clothing (especially sweaters), home furnishings, covers, and blankets. The lament titers vary

951

952

17 Fibers

between 1.3 and 17 dtex, the higher titers being for carpets. Tenacities are modest
(200300 mN tex1 ), and elongations are between 30 and 60%. The tenacity may
seem low, but acrylics are still clearly stronger than wool.
Filament textile acrylics seem to have lost the competition with polyester and
nylon.
There is an interesting industrial application in outdoor fabrics, based on the
perfect UV stability of acrylics, which are used for awnings, tents, automobile upholstery, and outdoor furniture. These products are often pigment-dyed, for better
lightfastness. A further step is when hot drawing is applied. Yarns with low comonomer levels can be drawn to ratios of 10 or more. Such yarns are used as precursors for carbon ber production (see Section 17.7.3), but may also be applied as
such, for asbestos replacement.
Poly(vinyl alcohol)
PVA is produced by hydrolyzing poly(vinyl acetate). PVA ber is an almost exclusively Japanese product; some production takes place in Korea and China, based on
Japanese technology. The ber has Vinylon as a general name and Kuraray is the
largest producer (Kuralon). Poly(vinyl alcohol) is water-soluble, which makes the
choice of a solvent easy. And, of course, it has proved possible to make the bers
water-insoluble.
Wet spinning solutions contain about 15% polymer and are spun above 70 C,
because otherwise premature gelation would take place. The spinning bath (for
PVA) is an almost saturated solution of sodium sulfate in water, at 4050 C. Note
that this is not the usual solventnonsolvent situation. Diusion of water out of
the lament is rapid, diusion of the salt into the laments relatively slow. The
polymer concentration increases and solidicaton is by gelation. The solidication
is slow, however much slower than for viscose rayon, for example. Therefore, the
spinning speeds are low. Fairly exceptional are the vertical spinning machines,
spinning upward, with the spinning bath moving in co-current ow in a tube
around the yarn bundle (see Figure 17.20). The spinning holes are small (100
150 mm).
Hot drawing of PVA, at 210240 C, takes place after drying. Draw ratios (> 10)
and tenacities achieved (> 900 mN tex1 ) are high, and the resulting yarns are
highly crystalline (4050%) and no longer water-soluble. For staple ber the draw
ratios may be lower, and a heat treatment for 0.53 min at 210230 C is given to
further crystallize the bers.
For complete insolubility in water, the hydroxyl groups can be made to react with
formaldehyde to a maximum degree of 85%. This takes 1020 min, however, and
only seems interesting in tow processing.
An alternative spinning bath for PVA contains alkali (NaOH, b20%), which penetrates more rapidly into the laments. The polymer concentration in the spinning dope is somewhat higher (18%) and higher molecular weights are used.
The laments solidify more homogeneously and remain round. This process allows even higher draw ratios than spinning in a sulfate bath, for example
DR > 15 and tenacity > 1300 mN tex1 . For further improvement of water insolu17.5.3.3

17.6 Comparison of Melt and Solution Spinning

Fig. 17.20. Spinning machine for PVA (reproduced from Ref.


2c): 1, vertical spinning machine, spinnerets at the bottom; 2,
3, 4, spinning bath circulation; 5, 6, godets; 7, washing; 8,
drying; 9, drawing; 10, heat treatment; 11, winder.

bility, small amounts of boric acid may be added to the spinning solution, inducing
crosslinking between chains. This seems to be the preferred route to high-tenacity
lament yarns. The term gel spinning is often used for spinning PVA according
to this route (see Section 17.7.2).
Applications of PVA The largest application of PVA bers is in paper and nonwoven fabrics, where a fraction of water-soluble ber is often used as a binder. Further applications are in twines, ropes, fabrics (tatami mats), and tarpaulins. Gelspun, very strong, PVA bers have become an important replacement for asbestos
in cement reinforcement.
PVA lament yarns are used almost exclusively in industrial applications where
high strength is important, such as in shing nets, ropes and cables, reinforcement of (high-pressure) hoses, and conveyor and transmission belts. PVA is not
suitable as a tire cord, however, because of its inadequate fatigue behavior.

17.6

Comparison of Melt and Solution Spinning

Having given a rough technical outline of melt and solution spinning, we can now
make a comparison between the speed spinning controlling mechanisms for the
two processes: cooling for melt spinning, and diusion of solvents for solution
spinning. We rst make a simple analysis of the ber formation processes, neglecting sublayer eects outside the laments. An example of the situation is shown for
cooling (melt spinning) in Figure 17.21 (at the top).
Initially, the temperature will be at throughout the lament (at the spinning
temperature, for example 300 C) and the surrounding cooling air temperature is
assumed to be constant (20 C). Gradually a temperature prole will be formed in

953

954

17 Fibers

Tcenter

Toutside
0

D/2

Cooling of a filament
Fourier number Fo=at D 2
6 2
a ~ 10 m s 1
Simple approach: no sublayer

ccenter

coutside
0

D/2

Extraction of solvent from a filament


Fourier number Fo=Dt/ D 2
D ~ 109 m2 s1
Realistic approach: sublayer
Fig. 17.21.

Comparison of melt and solution spinning.

the lament; the surrounding air remains at 20 C. This situation is shown in the
gure. For solidication of the laments we would like to have a temperature in
the center of, say, 100 C. The initial temperature dierence (300  20 280 C)
must be reduced to 100  20 80 C. In relative terms, which are used in a Fourier
analysis of such a cooling process, the desired dimensionless temperature is
80=280 A 0:3.
For solution spinning, the analysis proceeds similarly, but now in terms of concentrations instead of temperatures. For example, we assume an initial solvent
concentration of 0.8 (polymer concentration 20%) and solidication at c 0:3

17.6 Comparison of Melt and Solution Spinning

(70% polymer concentration). We assume the spinning bath consists of pure nonsolvent; hence the solvent concentration c 0 around the laments. The desired
dimensionless concentration then is: 0:3=0:8 A 0:375, not very dierent from
the value for the dimensionless temperature in the cooling process.
We proceed to the Fourier analysis for the cooling and extraction/diusion processes. The dimensionless Fourier number for cooling is Fo at=D 2 , with a
thermal diusivity (a l=rCp ), t time required for cooling and D diameter
of a lament. The thermal diusivity is of the order of 106 m 2 s1 . The Fourier
number for diusion processes is Fo Dt=D 2 , with D diusion coecient,
t time and D diameter. Diusion coecients in dilute systems are of the order
of 109 m 2 s1 .
The dierence by a factor of 1000 between the values of thermal diusivity and
diusion coecient can only be compensated for by adapting the values of t=D 2 .
As a rst approximation, laments in solution spinning should, for example, be
made ten times thinner and process times ten times longer than in melt spinning.
For cooling we had a dimensionless temperature of 0.3. A Fourier plot then
shows a value of Fo at=D 2 0:1. If we have an average diameter in the cooling
process of 250 mm (2:5  104 m) we can calculate the necessary cooling time:
t A 6 ms. For wet spinning we would nd t A 50 ms. Experienced spinners will
say that the typical dierence between melt and wet spinning is correct, but that
both answers are one order of magnitude wrong. Both melt spinning and wet spinning are slower by a factor of about 10 than calculated with our model, which is too
simple.
The mistake that we have made is obvious: we have neglected the speed limitation in the sublayer, or, even worse, in sublayers that touch each other in a bundle
of laments. Figure 17.21 (at the bottom) is a graph showing a prole in the lament and in the sublayer around the lament. The example is for concentration as
the parameter, for solution spinning, but the same graph can be used for cooling
by using T instead of c.
Exact calculations become much more complicated, but a few qualitative statements can be made. In sublayers we are dealing with diusion: of molecules in
an air layer (cooling process and dry spinning) or of solvent molecules in a liquid
layer (wet spinning). The mobility of molecules in a gas is much greater than in a
liquid. For the three types of processes we thus have:


melt spinning: fast conduction in the lament, fast diusion in the gas sublayer;
dry spinning: slow diusion in the lament, fast diusion in the gas sublayer;
 wet spinning: slow diusion in the lament, slow diusion in the liquid sublayer.


After all, the consequences for lament titers and diameters and process speeds do
not dier very much from our rst rough estimate. Melt-spun laments may have
a titer of 15 dtex, but 2030 dtex is still possible. Their eventual diameters range
from 10 to 50 mm, but they are spun from much larger holes. Dry- and wet-spun
laments often have a titer of 1.7 dtex (13 mm), and are usually spun from holes

955

956

17 Fibers
Tab. 17.6.

Typical process data for melt and solution spinning.

Process

Typical spinning
hole size
[mm]

Average speed
in spin-line
[m minC1 (m sC1 )]

Height of spin-line
or length of bath
[m]

Residence time
in spin-line
[s]

Melt spinning
Dry spinning
Wet spinning

250500
50100
5075

3000 (50)
300 (5)
30 (0.5)

5
5
0.5

0.1
1
1

smaller than 100 mm. Wet spinning speeds are limited to a maximum of 300400
m min1 , whereas melt-spun yarns can be wound at speeds up to 8000 m min1 .
Dry-spinning speeds are in between, at 5001000 m min1 . Typical data are shown
in Table 17.6.
Not surprisingly, there are always exceptions to the rule. For example, acrylic
carpet bers up to 17 dtex are wet-spun, evidently from much larger holes and at
lower speeds than are indicated in Table 17.6!

17.7

High-modulus, High-strength Fibers

In the last three decades of the 20th century many advanced bers were developed
(see the surveys in Refs. 8 and 9). Carbon ber may be described as an inorganic ber, but is produced by aftertreatment of organic bers, usually acrylic
yarns. High-modulus, high-strength bers were developed from sti-chain polymers showing liquid-crystalline behavior in solution or melt. Aramid yarns spun
from solution became an important product. How exible-chain polymers can be
superdrawn was discovered, and gel-spinning of polyethylene was developed, adding a valuable product to the spectrum of high-tenacity bers.
17.7.1

Air-gap Spinning
Aramids
Aramid yarns (Kevlar of DuPont, Twaron of TeijinTwaron) are produced from
poly( p-phenylene terephthalamide), PPTA (2), which is specially developed for
ber spinning and not used in any other application. DuPont had experience
with poly(m-phenylene isophthalamide) in a ber product called Nomex for hightemperature applications. The polymer is produced in dimethylacetamide and the
solution is dry-spun. This cannot be done with the sti-chain parapara analogue
PPTA. The polymer does not dissolve in organic solvents. A special polymerization
route had to be developed, and the discovery of lyotropic behavior of concentrated
solutions in sulfuric acid then led the way to the production of a magnicent new
ber material.
17.7.1.1

17.7 High-modulus, High-strength Fibers

(2) PPTA (Kevlar, Twaron)


The polymerization of PPTA starts at low temperature (10 C) with a solution of
p-phenylene diamine (PPD) in a mixture of N-methylpyrrolidone (NMP) and calcium chloride [10]. The second monomer, terephthaloyl dichloride, TPC, is injected as rapidly as possible. A fast condensation reaction takes place, hydrochloric
acid being the condensate. Much heat is evolved and a high cooling capacity is required to keep the temperature below 50 C. An oligomer is formed that becomes
insoluble in the reaction medium at a degree of polymerization of about 10. In the
rubbery mass further condensation must be enforced by vigorous mixing with
a powerful stirrer. After neutralization, washing, and drying a yellow polymer,
with a degree of polymerization of 70100, is obtained in an irregular powder
form.
Dissolution of the polymer powder in water-free sulfuric acid can be achieved by
freezing the acid and blending it with the powder. This dry blend melts at 60
70 C. An alternative is direct dissolution in a kneader.
The key invention for aramid spinning was the discovery of the liquid-crystalline
behavior (lyotropy) of PPTAsulfuric acid systems at polymer concentrations above
10%. Morgan (Monsanto) was the rst to describe spinning of fully aromatic polymers from concentrated solutions (in organic solvents), but did not report their
liquid-crystalline behavior [11]. Kwolek (DuPont) patented optically anisotropic
solutions of PPTA in sulfuric acid [12] and Blades (DuPont) further specied the
use of an air gap in the spinning process [13].
An example of the liquid-crystalline behavior is shown in Figure 17.22, in which
the viscosityconcentration relationship of a solution in a shear eld is plotted. Domains of oriented chains are formed and these domains are easily oriented in a
ow eld (like tree-trunks in a river). An elongational deformation is much
more eective for achieving a high orientation. In Figure 17.23 the elongational
phenomena during spinning, and their eect on molecular orientation, are shown.
The polymer solution is spun at about 85 C. The polymer concentration is about
20%. Domains ow into the spinning hole and orient. The spinning holes are
shaped to promote elongational ow: they have a conical entrance and a tapered
capillary. In this way almost complete orientation is achieved. The laments are
quenched in cold water, which should not touch the spinneret because the spinning solution would then immediately freeze in. This makes an air gap between
the spinneret surface and spinning bath necessary. An air gap is more often applied in other wet spinning processes, but in this case there is an additional very
important function. A draft of 515 times is applied over the air gap of about
1 cm. The solidication in the cold bath is immediate: the end speed of the process
is already achieved at 1 mm below the water surface. The elongational rate in the
air gap is comparable with the situation of a drawing neck in cold drawing of

957

958

17 Fibers

Fig. 17.22.

Lyotropic behavior of PPTA in sulfuric acid.

Fig. 17.23.

Orientation of aramid in spinning hole and air gap.

17.7 High-modulus, High-strength Fibers

exible-chain polymers. One can imagine how benecial this draw over the air gap
is, to complete the molecular orientation in the laments.
Solidication of the aramid laments is called coagulation but is in fact a
simple freezing-in of the solution. It is not a speed-limiting step. The subsequent removal of sulfuric acid from the solid laments in the washing process is
diusion-controlled, however, and hence relatively slow.
Thus, the rest of the spinning process is careful washing, neutralization, further
washing, drying, and winding. The standard titer of aramid yarns is 1670 dtex f
1000 (1.7 dtex lament titer). The elongation at break is around 3%, the tenacity
2100 mN tex1 , and the modulus b 50 N tex1 (75 GPa).
Filaments of 1.7 dtex and density 1.45 g cm3 have a diameter of 12 mm. Assuming a draft over the air gap of 515 and a polymer concentration of 20%, and
neglecting changes in density, we can make an estimate of the spinning hole diameter by means of Eq. (10); hence D hole 60100 mm.
D hole Dlament DR=c 0:5

10

Fibers with an even higher modulus are produced by a post-treatment of PPTA


bers above 400 C under high tension, reducing the elongation to 1.52% and enhancing the modulus to above 100 GPa. Special bers for ballistics may be spun
through smaller holes, and have ner laments, for example <1 dtex.
The aramid process as described is a wet spinning process, but a fairly strange
one. Extrusion, polymer lines, and ltration are like those in melt spinning. The
heart of the spinning process, spinneretair gapspinning bath or coagulator,
is very specic for aramid, but would also be found on machines for other lyotropic
systems. The section after the coagulation again deviates from a normal wet spinning process. Since the laments are not deformable, high tensions can be applied
but drawing is not necessary.
The construction material for PPTA in the melt-spinning section can be a normal steel because 100% sulfuric acid is not very corrosive. In places with high
shear (extruder screw, spinning pumps), nitrated steel, stainless steel, or even ceramic inserts will be used, however. As soon as the acid becomes diluted, corrosion
becomes very severe. Spinning plates are therefore made of gold/platinum or with
capillary inserts of this material. The construction materials for the spinning bath
and washing sections are stainless steel, PVC, PP, or glass.
Technora There is one aramid product with a deviating composition. Teijins
Technora (3) is produced from terephthaloyl dichloride (TPC) and a 50:50 mixture
of two aromatic diamines: PPD (as in PPTA) and 3,4 0 -diaminodiphenyl ether. This
kinked monomer has the advantage that the polymer remains dissolved in the
polymerization solvent (NMP/CaCl2 ). The solution can be spun directly, but is not
liquid-crystalline! After washing and drying the yarn is drawn at high temperature
(> 500 C) to a high ratio (> 10). In fact Technora is an example of superdrawabil-

959

960

17 Fibers

ity (see Section 17.7.2), which is surprising for a fully aromatic polymer, but the
high temperature makes the chains drawable.
H

(3) Technora (x=y 0:5=0:5)


Applications of aramids Large elds of application for aramid yarns are: antiballistics (bulletproof vests, armored plates); reinforcement of rubber (high-pressure
hoses, conveyor and transmission belts; limited application in automobile tires
because the material is expensive, but wide application in bicycle tires, on account
of its puncture resistance); ber-reinforced composites (aircraft interiors, sports
goods); reinforcement of optical cables; ropes and cables; protective clothing (reworkers, metalworkers, butchers). Maybe the largest application of aramid ber,
however, is asbestos replacement, in clutches, brakes, and gaskets. To this end laments are cut into short bers and brillated in a mill. The resulting pulp can be
blended with the resins and minerals to produce the clutch faces and brake linings.
For replacement of asbestos in gaskets lament yarns can be applied, in the form
of thick cords or fabrics.

17.7.1.2

Other Liquid-crystalline Polymers

Higher moduli and strength than in aramid can be reached with polymers having
even stier chains. We may call them semi-ladder polymers. Examples are the
polyazoles polybenzothiazole (PBT, 4) and polybenzoxazole (PBO, 5); the latter
yarn is produced on small scale by Toyobo (Zylon). An other example is M5 (6),
a semi-ladder polymer with higher polarity, yet having a very high modulus; the
product is developed by Magellan Systems International, in the USA. PBO and
M5 are polymerized in polyphosphoric acid and air-gap spun from this solution.
N

(4) PBT
HO

N-H

OH

(6) M5

(5) PBO

N-H

17.7 High-modulus, High-strength Fibers

17.7.2

Gel Spinning
Theory
Some exible polymers can be drawn to (much) higher ratios than are achieved in
a standard process. In the 1970s many publications were issued on the superdrawability of, especially, polyethylene. Ward and co-workers (University of Leeds, UK)
showed [14] that polyethylene can be drawn 30 times, and that the modulus increased linearly with the draw ratio, up to values of 60 GPa, but the tenacities remained modest, a1 GPa. The undrawn laments or lms (strips) were melt-spun.
Too high a molecular weight gave spinnability problems, and, moreover, lower molecular weights were found to be more easily drawable. Careful drawing seemed to
be the key to high drawablity, in the sense that the drawing speed had to be low
and/or the drawing path long. In other words, one should have a low elongational
rate, e_ dv=dx. For comparison, elongational rates in common drawing processes
of melt-spun yarns are in the order of 50500 s1 . For superdrawing, values of
0.11 s1 are preferred, for example a homogeneous drawing on a hotplate of 1 m
at a speed of 1 m s1 (60 m min1 ).
Superdrawability also proved applicable to polypropylene and slightly more polar
polymers, such as polyoxymethylene (POM) [15].
At the same time Pennings (DSM, later of the University of Groningen, The
Netherlands) studied the ber formation from dilute solutions of high molecular
weight polyethylene. He started with bers formed in a Couette device: these were
stirring-induced ber crystals, with the famous shish-kebab structure [16]. The
best properties were obtained when bers were slowly withdrawn from a gel layer
on a rotor. The molecular weight was above 10 6 , the polymer concentration about
1%, the ber growth rate below 1 m min1 , the moduli around 125 GPa [17], and
tenacities far above 1 GPa.
Smith and Lemstra (DSM, The Netherlands) combined the ideas of superdrawability and working with dilute solutions of (ultra-)high molecular weight polyethylene, and added the essential function of a continuous spinning process [18].
Gel spinning was born.
To explain the concept of gel spinning and superdrawing, it is necessary to introduce the notion of entanglement of chains. If two chains form a loop, the disentangling of one of those chains depends on the length between the entanglement
point and the chain end. A short chain end will fairly rapidly diuse through the
network of neighboring polymer chains and slip through the entanglement point,
without chain break. The reptation time necessary for disentanglement scales
with (MW) 3 , according to De Gennes [19]. For a polyethylene chain end with a molecular weight of 100 000 (approximately 4000 monomer units), the time would already be in the order of one second, a very high value for a drawing process.
The consequences for gel-spinning are:
17.7.2.1

A high molecular weight is required for an eventually high draw ratio. Draw ratio
scales as DR @ MW 0:5 . In gel spinning the molecular weight is higher than in

961

962

17 Fibers

High molecular weight, dilute solution, few entanglements

Gel formation by crystallization

Extraction of solvent (before or during drawing) superdrawing

Gel crystals are melted and rebuilt, entanglements give coherence


Fig. 17.24.

Scheme for gel spinning.

superdrawing of melt-spun polyethylene by a factor of about 10. One may thus


expect a draw ratio of 3010 0:5 A 100, which is close to reality.
 The number of entanglements must be reduced, but a few should remain to give
the material coherence. This is only possible by working from a dilute solution.
Concentrations of 510% seem realistic; for ultra-high modulus products an
ultra-high molecular weight (g10 6 ), and an even lower concentration (25%),
will be selected to keep the material spinnable.
Figure 17.24 depicts a scheme for the gel spinning process.
Gel Spinning of Polyethylene
Gel-spun polyethylene is produced by DSM in cooperation with Toyobo (Dyneema)
and Honeywell, formerly Allied Signal (Spectra). From the relevant patents it is
fairly obvious that dierent solvents are used: a volatile solvent in the Dyneema
process and a nonvolatile solvent in the Spectra process.
A nonvolatile solvent must be completely removed before drawing, by extraction
with a volatile solvent. The dried laments have a xerogel structure, a dry, porous
structure which collapses during drawing. A volatile solvent can be partly removed
in the spinning step, but may well be further removed by evaporation and squeezing out in the drawing step.
Dyneema yarns have lament titers of 12 dtex, Spectra laments are coarser
(411 dtex). Filaments of 2 dtex with a density of 0.97 g cm3 have a diameter of
16 mm. How is this diameter produced? If we assume a draw ratio of 100 and a
concentration of 10% we can calculate the diameter of the undrawn gel laments
from Eq. (10) to be Dgel; undrawn Ddrawn DR=c 16100=0:1 0:5 506 mm. We
17.7.2.2

17.7 High-modulus, High-strength Fibers

Fig. 17.25.

Gel spinning process (reproduced from Ref. 8).

may further take into account that the density of the spinning solution is lower
than that of the drawn laments (@0.8 g cm3 versus 1.0 g cm3 ), and that there
may be some draft in the spin-line. A realistic estimate of the spinning hole diameter will thus be about 1000 mm, greater than in most melt spinning processes!
The spinning solution extruded from the large holes is above 100 C, in order to
keep the polymer in solution and to keep the viscosity acceptable. Fiber formation
for gel spinning by quenching is relatively rapid: solidication is by crystallization,
rather than by evaporation or extraction of solvent. Complete removal of solvent
from the thick laments proceeds much more slowly. The quench liquid can simply be water and the spinneret cannot be immersed in the water bath because the
spinning solution would then freeze in. An air gap must be used, as in aramid
spinning, but without the function of increasing the molecular orientation.
The extraction step depends on the solvent used. The nonvolatile solvent (highboiling, and acting as a plasticizer) must be removed completely before drawing.
One can imagine that most of a volatile solvent would be removed in the initial
stages of the drawing process (at 100130 C): at least, this is how DSM (and
Toyobo) illustrate it in a simplied process scheme presented in articles and
folders (see Figure 17.25).
The process scheme for gel-spun PE shows a stirred vessel for making up the
spinning solution, but the use of a kneader in a continuous operation should
be possible. It also suggests the integration of spinning and drawing, but this is
improbable. As discussed in Section 17.7.2.1. the superdrawing process must
be careful and slow. Even for very long drawing ovens, an end speed of
200 m min1 seems a limit. (As an example, at this speed, 3.3 m s1 , and an
oven length of 33 m one would have an elongational rate (_e dv=dx) of 0.1 s1 ).
The spinning speed would then have to be about 23 m min1 . This is technically
dicult and economically unattractive. The output per hole would be as low as 0.4
g solution min1 (0.04 g polymer per minute). A ten times higher output is technically feasible. The technical implication then is that spinning and drawing must

963

964

17 Fibers

be separate steps; there should be ten times more drawing than spinning positions. This can be realized if a collective drawing process is used, such as a warp
of yarns drawn in a wide oven.
Applications of gel-spun PE Many applications overlap with those of aramid.
Polyethylene has the advantage of its lower density and often a higher tenacity.
This is important in ballistics and protective clothing, where Dyneema and Spectra
nd wide application. A special feature in armored plates is the Spectra Shield
or Dyneema UD construction: arrangements of laments in unidirectional layers
bonded by thermoplastic layers in between; the UD layers are arranged crosswise.
This construction is more eective than woven structures in ballistic protection.
A second large application, especially of Dyneema, is in marine twine, ropes,
and nets, where it replaces polyamide and polyester yarns. Outstanding tenacity,
abrasion resistance, UV stability, and low density (oating in water) give it a competitive edge, even at about ten times the selling price of the melt-spun yarns!
Gel-spun polyethylene is too low-melting (about 140 C) to be applied in rubber
reinforcement. In composites the curing temperature should not exceed 130 C,
and a surface treatment is required for sucient adhesion. Finally, performance
under constant load is restricted because of creep limitations.
Other Gel-spun or Superdrawn Fibers
The ultra-high draw ratios for polyethylene are not found for any other polymer,
which may not be surprising because the interchain interactions in polyethylene
are so low. This makes molecular rearrangements in a drawing process easy. This
polarity concept was worked out by Smook and co-workers [20]. They took values
of maximum draw ratios from the literature and their own experience. For the
value of the polarity of a polymer the cohesive energy was taken, which is the energy required to make a polymer chain completely free from interactions with its
neighbors. This factor was made dimensionless by taking the ratio with RTd , Td
(K) being the drawing temperature, and R the gas constant. The best relationship
was found to be Eq. (11), where l represents the draw ratio DR; this is plotted in
Figure 17.26.
17.7.2.3

ln l max 360 expEcoh =RTd 0:5

11

Note the maximum value for polyethylene (PE) at ln l 4:6, implying a draw ratio
of 100. The polar polymers, polyester and polyamide(s), which are not superdrawable and not candidates for a gel spinning process, are at the other extreme. There
is an interesting group of polymers with intermediate polarity and drawability,
however: polypropylene (PP; DR 47.5), poly(vinyl alcohol) (PVA; DR 30), polyacrylonitrile (PAN; DR 28), poly-l-lactic acid (PLLA; DR 20).
The very good drawability of polypropylene was mentioned when discussing
that polymer; it is not gel-spun, but-melt spun bers are also highly drawable.
Poly(vinyl alcohol) is wet-spun, and special versions of this process, at Kuraray,

17.7 High-modulus, High-strength Fibers

Fig. 17.26.

(Super)drawability of exible-chain polymers (reproduced from Ref. 20).

with high molecular weight polymer, are indeed gel-spun; the bers replace asbestos in cement reinforcement. Polyacrylonitrile, or a copolymer with a low comonomer level, is drawn 1015 times in the production of precursor for carbon ber.
17.7.3

Carbon Fiber

Carbon bers are not directly spun but are the product of a complicated aftertreatment. Nowadays, most carbon bers (90%) are produced from an acrylic precursor.
Cellulose rayon is no longer applied as a precursor. Production from pitch has
been developed, but is still a small-volume business.
Carbon Fiber from PAN
Most textile acrylics contain 1015% comonomers. For carbon ber precursors
lower comonomer levels are used (about 5%); comonomers are selected that promote the reactions in the aftertreatment (methyl acrylate, itaconic acid). Wet spinning is preferred because the cross-section can be controlled better then. In dry
spinning skin formation can hardly be prevented and eventually the cross-section
collapses into a dog bone shape, which is not desirable in carbon ber applications. Precursor laments are drawn to much higher draw ratios (b10) than tex17.7.3.1

965

966

17 Fibers

tile yarns. Precursor laments must be free from solid particles; sharp ltration of
spinning solutions is therefore required. Textbooks even mention spinning under
clean room conditions.
The aftertreatment proceeds in three steps: cyclization, oxidation, and
carbonization/graphitization. All steps are carried out under tension. In the cyclization step (around 200 C) N-containing rings are formed, in a ladder structure:
PAN, Orlon, is transferred into Black Orlon. This rst step is still without
loss of material. In the second step this structure is made unmeltable by careful
oxidation and stabilization, at temperatures between 200 and 300 C. Some hydrogen is removed, carbonyl groups and double bonds are formed, and the aromatic
character is increased. The third step is a pyrolysis reaction carried out in an inert
atmosphere, at temperatures which are gradually increased from 400 to 1700 C
and further to 2800 C. Below 1000 C most volatile products are formed, such as
H2 O, HCN, NH3 , CO, CO2 , N2 , and so on. Note that the nitrogen content of PAN
is about 28%, while the weight loss of PAN to carbon ber is about 50%.
The term graphitization is not really correct because a true graphite structure
is not formed. The graphite layers, condensed ring systems, are indeed there, but
the layers are not strictly coordinated. This mist in the coordination of layers is
called turbostratic. Nevertheless, carbon bers are often referred to as graphite bers, especially in the USA.
Carbon Fiber from Pitch
Pitches can be produced from petroleum and coal tar, preferably from the rst
feedstock. A useful pitch should have a mesophase character, which means that it
must contain ordered, liquid-crystalline domains. The mesophase content can be
increased by solvent extraction. A pitch would typically have a molecular weight of
1000 (20 aromatic rings) and a melting point of 300 C.
Pitch can be spun at about 325 C and must then be aftertreated. The cyclization
step necessary for a PAN precursor can be omitted in this case. Stabilization by air
oxidation and carbonization/graphitization proceeds as for a PAN precursor, but
the amount of volatiles is much lower because the pitch does not contain nitrogen.
17.7.3.2

Applications of Carbon Fibers


Carbon bers are used almost exclusively in composites. Two main types are offered: one with high strength (1.93.9 N tex1 tenacity, 140 N tex1 modulus) and
one with a high-modulus (2.2 N tex1 tenacity, 280 N tex1 modulus). Carbon ber
moduli are much higher than those of aramid and gel-spun polyethylene.
17.7.3.3

17.7.4

Other Advanced Fibers

One class of HMHS bers has not been mentioned: liquid-crystalline polyesters,
thermotropic polymers, melt-spun. In the 1970s and 1980s many compositions
were studied, in most cases fully aromatic polyesters, in one case PET enriched
with large quantities of p-hydroxybenzoic acid (pHBA). Only one product sur-

Notation
Tab. 17.7. Survey of properties of HMHS bers (PET, PA, glass and steel are included for
comparison).

Fiber

Aramid (standard)
Aramid (HM)
Technora
Vectran
PBO
PE (standard)
PE (HM)
C-ber, HS
C-ber, HM
C-ber, pitch
Polyester
Polyamide
E-glass
S-glass
Steel

Density
[g cmC3 ]

Elongation
[ %]

Tenacity
[N texC1 ]

[GPa]

Modulus
[N texC1 ]

[GPa]

1.45
1.45
1.45
1.40
1.56
0.97
0.97
1.8
1.8
2.1
1.38
1.18
2.55
2.5
7.8

3.5
2.5 (1.5)
4.4
b3.3
1.5
3.5
33.5
1.52.0
0.7
0.22.0
1015
1825
1.83.2
4.0

2.1
2.1
2.2
2.02.5
3.7
2.62.8
ca. 3.5
1.93.9
2.2
0.51.0
ca. 0.8
ca. 0.8
0.61.2
1.2
a0.27

3.0
3.0
3.2
2.83.5
5.8
2.62.8
ca. 3.5
3.57.0
3.9
1.02.0
1.1
0.95
1.53.0
3.5
a2.1

5060
75 (115)
50
4662
180
90
120
ca. 140
ca. 280
19380
ca. 10
ca. 5
28
35
27

7287
109 (167)
72
6587
280
90
120
ca. 250
ca. 500
40800
ca. 14
ca. 6
72
87
210

vived and became a small commercial product: Vectra(n) polymer was developed
by Celanese; the ber is now produced by Kuraray. The polymer has a 75:25 composition of pHBA and HNA, the latter being the code for 2,6-hydroxynaphthoic
acid. Mechanical properties are on the level of a standard-type aramid.
There are many polymers with high-temperature resistant bers, most of them
with textile properties (low tenacity, high elongation) (see Table 17.7). Their application is in insulation, hot gas ltration, and suchlike. Large products are meta
meta aramid (Nomex, Teijin-Conex) and polybenzimidazole (PBI). Smaller products are poly(phenylene sulde) (PPS), several aromatic polyketones (for example
poly(ether ether ketone), PEEK) and aromatic polysulfones; see Reference 9, Chapters 8 and 9.

Notation

Symbol

Name

Unit

a
c
Cp
g_
D
D
DR

thermal diusivity
concentration (of spinning solutions)
specic heat
shear rate
diameter (of spinning holes)
diusion coecient
draw ratio

m 2 s1
(or %)
kJ  C1 kg1
s1
mm
m 2 s1

967

968

17 Fibers

E
Ecoh
e_
f
fa
fc
Fv
Fm
h
[h]
L
l
l
n
Dn
P
DP
r
R
T
T
Td
Td
Tg
Tm

elongation at break (in TE 0:5 )


cohesive energy
elongational rate
overall orientation factor (0 < f < 1)
amorphous orientation factor (0 < fa < 1)
crystalline orientation factor (0 < fc < 1)
volume ow
mass ow
melt viscosity
intrinsic viscosity
length (of spinning holes)
thermal conductivity
draw ratio (DR)
index of refraction
birefringence
pressure
pressure drop
density
gas constant
tenacity at break (in TE 0:5 )
temperature
drawing temperature (in Figure 17.25)
decomposition temperature
glass transition temperature
melting temperature

Acronyms
BCF
DCM
DMAc
DMF
DR
FOY
HMHS
HNA
HSS
HSSDW
HTS
LSS
MFI
NMMO
NMP
PA

bulked continuous lament


dichloromethane
dimethylacetamide
dimethylformamide
draw ratio
fully oriented yarn
high-modulus, high-strength bers
2,6-hydroxynaphthoic acid
high-speed spinning
high-speed spin-draw winding
hot-tube spinning
low-speed spinning
melt ow index
N-methylmorpholine oxide
N-methylpyrrolidone
polyamide

%
kJ kmol1
s1

m 3 s1 or cm 3 min1
kg s1 or g min1
Pa s
dL g1
mm
kJ m1  C1 s1

Pa or bar
Pa or bar
kg m3 or g cm3
8.3143 kJ K1 kmol1
mN tex1

C
K

C

C

C

References

PA66, PA6
PAN
PBI
PBO
PBT
PEN
PET
pHBA
PLLA
POM
POY
PP
PPD
PPS
PEEK
PPTA
PTT
PVA
SDW
SDBW
TPC

polyamide 66, polyamide 6


polyacrylonitrile
polybenzimidazole
polybenzoxazole
poly(butylene terephthalate); polybenzothiazole
poly(ethylene naphthalate)
poly(ethylene terephthalate)
p-hydroxybenzoic acid
poly-l-lactic acid
polyoxymethylene
partly oriented yarn
polypropylene
p-phenylene diamine
poly(phenylene sulde)
poly(ether ether ketone)
poly( p-phenylene terephthalamide)
poly(trimethylene terephthalate)
poly(vinyl acetate); poly(vinyl alcohol)
spindraw winding
spindraw bulk winding
terephthaloyl dichloride

Acknowledgments

The information in this chapter was gathered during 25 years service at Akzo Fibers Research and recently updated, extended, commented upon, and improved
by former colleagues now working for Acordis and TeijinTwaron.

References
1 Ullmanns Encyclopedia of Industrial

Chemistry, 5th Edition, VCH Verlag,


Weinheim, 1987: bers, A10, pp. 451
655, A11, pp. 184; high-performance
bers, A13, pp. 123; cellulose and
cellulose esters, A5, pp. 375459; silk,
A24, pp. 95106; wool, A28, pp. 395
421.
2 International Fiber Science and
Technology Series, Marcel Dekker, New
York: (a) Volume 7, M. Lewin, E. M.
Pearce (eds.), Fiber Chemistry, 1985
(polyester, polyamide, acrylic, polypropylene, polyvinyl alcohol, wool,
silk, cotton, rayon, cellulose acetate);

(b) Volume 4, H. A. Krassig, J. Lenz,


H. F. Mark (eds.), Fiber Technology,
1984 (from lm to ber); (c) Volume
6, I. Sakurada (ed.), Polyvinyl Alcohol
Fibers, 1985; (d) Volume 10, J.-P.
Donnet, R. C. Bansal (eds.), Carbon
Fibers, 2nd Edition, 1990.
3 B. von Falkai (ed.), Synthesefasern,
Verlag Chemie, Weinheim, 1981.
4 F. Fourne, Synthetische Fasern, Carl
Hanser Verlag, Munich, 1995.
5 M. Mayer, Chapter 17: Fiber
Extrusion, in F. Hensen (ed.), Plastics
Extrusion Technology, Hanser Publishers, Munich, 1981.

969

970

17 Fibers
6 A. Ziabicki, Fundamentals of Fibre
7
8

10
11
12
13

Formation, John Wiley, New York, 1976.


A. Ziabicki, H. Kawai, High-Speed
Spinning, John Wiley, New York, 1985.
T. Nakajima (ed.), Advanced Fiber
Spinning Technology, Woodhead
Publishing, Cambridge, 1994.
J. W. S. Hearle (ed.), HighPerformance Fibres, Woodhead
Publishing, Cambridge, 2001.
T. J. Veerman, L. Vollbracht, US
patent 4 308 374, 1981 (AKZO).
H. S. Morgan, US patent 3 414 645,
1966 (Monsanto).
S. L. Kwolek, Netherlands patent 6
908 984, 1969 (DuPont).
H. L. Blades, Netherlands patent 7
205 836, 1971 (DuPont).

14 G. Capaccio, T. J. Chapman, I. M.

15
16

17
18
19

20

Ward, Polymer 1975, 16, 469 (and


numerous other publications).
E. S. Clark, L. S. Scott, Polym. Eng.
Sci. 1974, 14(10), 682.
A. J. Pennings, J. M. A. A. van der
Mark, H. C. Booij, Kolloid-Z. 1970,
237, 336.
A. Zwijnenburg, Thesis, University
of Groningen, 1978.
P. Smith, P. J. Lemstra, UK patent 2
051 661, 1979 (Stamicarbon).
P.-G. de Gennes, Scaling Concepts in
Polymer Physics, Cornell University
Press, 1979.
J. Smook, G. J. H. Vos, H. L. Doppert,
J. Applied Polym. Sci. 1990, 41, 105
116.

971

18

Removal of Monomers and VOCs


from Polymers1
Mara J. Barandiaran and Jose M. Asua
18.1

Introduction

The polymerization of monomers rarely proceeds to completion and there is inevitably a level of unreacted monomer remaining in the polymer. The presence of residual monomer is undesirable, particularly when the monomers are toxic, which
is the case for vinyl chloride and acrylonitrile. Monomers such as acrylates and
methacrylates can also have strong (and oensive) odors, and the residual volatile
components may form an explosive mixture during transportation and storage.
Contamination with unreacted monomers is a problem particularly when the polymer is used for food packaging, as well as in biomedical applications and in interior paints. Moreover, polymers may contain small amounts of nonpolymerizable
compounds that result from impurities in the raw materials or by-products formed
from side reactions during the polymerization process. The presence of such nonpolymerizable compounds results in an increase in the level of the residual volatile
organic compounds (VOCs) in the polymer and can adversely aect its ultimate
properties. In addition, many polymers are produced in the presence of organic
solvents, which are considered VOCs and must be eliminated before use.
The increasingly strict environmental regulations [1, 2] and the higher market
sensitivity to environmental and health issues are pushing the polymer manufacturing industry to reduce the amount of monomers and VOCs in polymers. Reduction of VOC emission can also lead to better workplace conditions, reduce risks of
re, reduce nuisance, and lead to economic savings. The industrial importance of
VOC removal is reected in the large number of patents that can be found in the
literature. The open literature, however, is scarce. The review in 2002 by Araujo et
al. [3], which summarized the principal methods employed for reducing residual
monomer content, and the books edited by J. A. Biesenberger [4] and R. J. Albalak
[5] reviewing the various aspects of polymer devolatilization, must be highlighted.
Several denitions of VOC have been oered. The European Union (EU) in Di1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

972

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

rective 1999/13/EC [6] denes a VOC as any organic compound with a vapor pressure equal or greater than 10 Pa at 293.15 K. The U.S. Environmental Protection
Agency (EPA) [7] denes the term VOC as any organic compound that participates
in atmospheric photochemical reactions. Those two denitions can lead to contradictory situations. This is the case for acetone, an organic solvent common in polymer production, that is considered to be a VOC following the EU denition, while
it is exempted by the EPAs criterion.
The understanding of the origin of residual monomers and VOCs will help to
design strategies to polymerize up to very high monomer conversions (the higher
the monomer conversion, the less residual monomer) while simultaneously avoiding the formation of new VOCs by side reactions. However, economic constraints
that limit the polymerization time as well as intrinsic characteristics of the polymerization technique (such as solution polymerization) always yield systems containing VOCs. Therefore, post-treatments are necessary in order to fulll the legislation and market requirements. Both the polymerization strategy and the type of
post-treatment strongly depend on the polymerization process used for the manufacture of the polymer. The problems associated with monomer and VOC removal
in highly viscous polymers produced by mass and solution polymerizations are different from those encountered in low-viscosity, heterogeneous aqueous dispersion
systems. Therefore, this chapter will be organized according to the dierent polymerization processes. It is focused on polymers produced by chain polymerization.
In polycondensation, the problem concerns only very specic cases, such as the
removal of ethylene glycol in some poly(ethylene terephthalate) routes, or the removal of phenol in phenolic resins; the problems associated with these removals
are similar to those found in the treatment of polymer melts. Section 18.2 is devoted to monomer and VOC removal from polymer melts and solutions. Monomer
removal in polyolens is described in Section 18.3, and nally the treatments for
VOC removal in waterborne dispersions is discussed (see Section 18.4).

18.2

Polymer Melts and Solutions

Polymers produced by mass and solution polymerization, including the polycondensation processes, represent about 45% of the total synthetic polymer production
[8]. In a bulk process, polymerization at high conversions is complicated by the effect of viscosity on initiator eciency, monomer diusion, and heat transfer. The
eciency of the initiator radicals can be dramatically lowered due to the cage eect
resulting from the low mobility of the radicals, leading to a decrease in the polymerization rate. On the other hand, in polymerizations taking place at temperatures below the glass transition temperature of the polymer, the mobility of the
monomer molecules is restricted, causing a severe decrease in the polymerization
rate (glass eect).
The use of higher temperatures would reduce the viscosity of the system, thus
avoiding some of the drawbacks associated with high viscosities. However, high

18.2 Polymer Melts and Solutions

temperatures have deleterious eects on the properties of the polymer, such as a


decrease in the molecular weight and degradation of the polymer. Furthermore,
some free-radical polymerizations suer a substantial depropagation at temperatures above a certain level (ceiling point). This phenomenon is quite well known
for methyl methacrylate. Biesenberger et al. [9] showed that sustained exposures
in a vented extruder at temperatures higher than 250 C caused poly(methyl methacrylate) to depolymerize to methyl methacrylate.
On the other hand, in spite of the much lower viscosities of solution polymerization, the economically achievable conversion is limited because, due to the low
monomer concentration, the polymerization rate is extremely low at high conversions, and consequently unaordable process times are required.
18.2.1

Devolatilization

Polymer devolatilization is a separation process in which residual VOCs are removed from the polymer matrix by application of a reduced pressure (lower than
the equilibrium partial pressure of the volatile component), and/or heat. Stripping
agents are also commonly used.
Fundamentals
Devolatilization of molten and solution polymers generally involves rst the transport by diusion of volatiles to a polymer/vapor interface and then the transport of
volatiles to a gas stream through the boundary layer.
The rate of removal of the volatiles through the interface can be expressed by Eq.
(1), where A is the interfacial area and NVOC is the ux of the VOC through the
interface given by Eq. (2).
18.2.1.1

dVOC
NVOC A
dt

NVOC Dcjinterface

Equation (2) requires the concentration prole of the VOC in the polymer melt
that can be calculated from the material balance in the polymer melt. Assuming
that the convective ux is negligible, Eq. (3) expresses this balance, where D is the
diusion coecient of the volatile in the polymer matrix.
qc
 Dc
qt

The diusion coecient depends on both the temperature of the system and the
concentration of volatiles, and can be estimated through the VrentasDuda freevolume theory [10].
The boundary conditions representing the diusion process are:

973

974

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

t0

c c0

t>0

c interface ce

c 0 being the initial interface volatile concentration. In the devolatilization of polymer solutions and polymer melts, the diusion of the volatiles through the polymer is usually the rate-controlling part of the process [4]. Therefore, the volatile
concentration at the interface, ce , is in equilibrium with the concentration of the
volatile in the gas phase. The equilibrium concentration is related to the partial
pressure of the volatile in the gas phase, P1 , by means of Henrys law, Eq. (4),
where H, the Henrys law constant, depends on the temperature, pressure, and
nature of the volatile.
ce

P1
H

The interfacial area between the polymer and the gas phase is one of the key
parameters in the devolatilization processes, because the rate of VOC removal is
proportional to it. The devolatilizers are designed to maximize this interface area.
For free-bubble devolatilization, the area of the polymer lm that is exposed to devolatilization can be calculated, taking into account the geometry of the equipment.
Based on those principles, several models to describe the devolatilization in singlescrew extruders [1114] and twin-screw extruders [15, 16] have been presented.
However, bubbles are produced in most of the devolatilization processes. Bubbles can be formed when the polymer melt is exposed to a pressure lower than
the partial pressure of the monomer or the solvent in equilibrium with the polymeric solution. Those bubbles are composed of monomer and solvent. After formation, the bubbles grow by diusion of monomer or solvent from the polymeric
solution, and ultimately they separate from the polymer melt, releasing the monomer and solvent.
Bubbles can also be formed when stripping agents are introduced into the polymer melt/solution under pressure. If the vapor pressure of the stripping agent is
higher than the equilibrium partial pressure of the volatile, gas bubbles composed
mainly of the stripping agent will be produced. In this case, devolatilization involves diusion of the volatiles to the surface of these bubbles. The area of the
bubbles is determined by the interplay between bubble nucleation, growth, coalescence, and rupture. Under these circumstances the determination of the interface
area is not straightforward. Direct visual observation of foaming in dierent types
of devolatilizers has been reported by numerous authors [1721].
Several models for foam-based devolatilization are available. The fundamentals
are reviewed by Lee [22]. Bubble nucleation during devolatilization of polymer
melts has been explained by homogeneous nucleation [23, 24], heterogeneous nucleation [2527], and a mixed-mode nucleation [28]. Yarin et al. [29] considered a
secondary nucleation.
Models that account for the growth of the bubbles, assuming either a single

18.2 Polymer Melts and Solutions

spherical bubble growing in an innite sea of liquid [30, 31] or many spherical
bubbles growing together with a thin shell of liquid surrounding them [32], have
been developed. More complete models consider bubble motion, coalescence, and
rupture [26, 33, 34].
Implementation of Devolatilization
The foregoing equations show that devolatilization may be accelerated by acting on
the diusion coecient, the thermodynamic equilibrium, or the interfacial area.
The diusion coecient depends on the temperature of the system and on the
concentration of volatiles. An increase in the temperature results in an increase in
diusivity and a decrease in viscosity, both benecial for devolatilization. However,
many polymers are thermally sensitive, so there may be a practical upper limit on
the temperature to which the polymer may be exposed, as higher temperatures
may degrade the polymer. Heat stabilizers have been used to enhance the thermal
stabilization [35].
On the other hand, the diusion coecient through the polymer strongly decreases as the concentration of the volatile approaches to zero. This drawback can
be overcome by introducing an inert substance (usually water), which increases the
free volume of the polymer, enhancing the molecular diusion of the volatile to be
removed [3641]. Furthermore, the inert reduces the partial pressure of the volatile
in the gas phase, increasing the driving force for devolatilization. Adding an immiscible liquid to the melt presents the additional advantage that the total vapor
pressure of the system increases, and therefore the temperature and volatile concentration needed to produce bubbles in the polymer solution is lower.
Recently the use of supercritical uids in processing polymers has received
much attention, because supercritical devolatilization has the potential for producing high-purity products with lower energy [4244]. The high solubility of the
volatiles in the supercritical uid enhances the driving force for devolatilization.
When the polymer is exposed to the supercritical uid, it is swollen, and the free
volume in the polymer is increased so that diusion of the volatiles out of the polymer is enhanced.
18.2.1.2

Equipment
There exists a wide variety of devolatilization equipment. According to Biesenberger [4], the processes can be classied into two main categories: non-rotating
or still equipment, and rotating equipment, in which devolatilization is enhanced
by mechanical agitation.
Nonrotating equipment, such as the falling-strand [5, 29, 45, 46] (Figure 18.1)
and falling-lm [5, 47] devolatilizers, include mainly ash evaporators and other
equipment with specic congurations of the ash chamber, aimed at increasing the exposed interfacial area between the gas and the polymeric phase. In this
equipment, the polymer melt/solution is preheated before entering the ash chamber, where the conditions of pressure and temperature are such that the volatiles
boil. Vaporization of volatiles is prompted by continuous removal of their vapor
through the vacuum outlet port of the ash tank.
18.2.1.3

975

976

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

Feed

Vacuum

Strands
Heating
i jjacket

Devolatilized
l
melt
l
Fig. 18.1.

The falling-strand devolatilizer.

In those processes three dierent regimes can be distinguished [48]. Each of


them has a dierent rate-limiting mechanism, which depends mainly on the dierence between the equilibrium partial pressure of the volatile in equilibrium with
the melt (P1 ) and the total pressure within the vacuum chamber (P). This dierence (P1  P) is often called the degree of superheat, SH.
The rst regime, termed free boiling, occurs when SH is large and the liquid
viscosity is low. This usually happens under volatile-rich conditions. Vapor bubbles
initiate and grow very fast, causing convective mixing that enhances mass transfer
to the vapor phase. Under this regime, the temperature of the melt can rapidly
drop if there is not an external energy input, since the latent heat of evaporation
is provided by the sensible heat of the devolatilization mass. For example, under
adiabatic conditions an MMAPMMA melt at 250 C will drop approximately 15 C
for every 10 wt.% of the melt that vaporizes. As the melt temperature drops, P1 will
drop and the degree of superheat will diminish. On the other hand, melt viscosity
will rise, due to both the removal of volatiles and the temperature drop. These effects cause bubble growth and movement to slow down and the free-boiling regime
gradually fades out.
The second regime is termed bubble growth and the rate-controlling mechanism is the bubble initiation and growth. The volatile removal rate is slower than
in the previous case, and consequently cool-down is reduced. Melt viscosity increases due to depletion of the volatile.
In the third regime, where the viscosity of the melt is very high and the degree of
superheat has been reduced due to depletion of volatiles and temperature drop,
bubbles are hardly formed and existing bubbles grow very slowly. Under these circumstances, the rate of volatile loss is very slow, as it is controlled by the molecular
diusion at the melt/vapor interface. Therefore, for a very low level of volatiles,
ash devolatilizers are not ecient.

18.2 Polymer Melts and Solutions

Nonrotating equipment is ecient for low-viscosity polymer solutions containing large amounts of volatiles, and particularly useful when dealing with shearsensitive polymers. However, care must be taken to ensure that they do not have
stagnant areas where the polymer could degrade. Excessive foam expansion and
polymer entrainment in the volatile vapor stream could be serious problem. Those
systems are not operable with solutions that upon ashing retain enough solvent
to form a sticky mass, such as in the case of rubbery polymer solutions, because
the equipment has little self-cleaning and can become fouled up [49]. On the other
hand, low volatile concentrations can hardly be achieved with those equipment,
since very long residence times would be required to overcome their poor masstransport eciency, which would increase thermal degradation of the polymer.
Multi-slit devolatilizers [5052] were designed to overcome the problem of long
residence times of the polymer at high temperatures. In this process, the polymeric solution is fed through an assembly of heated slits which discharge into a
ash chamber where vacuum is maintained.
Rotating equipment is used for devolatilization of highly viscous polymer melts/
solutions. The rotating parts serve not only to spread and move the polymer forward along the devolatilizer but also to generate and renew the polymer/gas phase
interface. Typical devices are wiped-lm evaporators and screw extruders.
The wiped-lm evaporators (Figure 18.2) employ a rotor with an array of blades
attached to the rotor shaft which transport the polymer melt through the evaporator, forming lms. As the product goes down along the wall, bow waves developed
by the rotor blades generate a highly turbulent ow, resulting in optimum heat
and mass transfer. The melt and the vapor ow either in the cocurrent fashion

Feed

VOC removal

Heating
i
jacket

Devolatilized
t
melt
Fig. 18.2.

The wiped-lm evaporator.

977

978

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

Feed
hopper

Vacuum

Feed
Fig. 18.3.

Metering

Devolatilization

Metering

A single-screw extruder.

(mainly for removing highly volatile contents) or in countercurrent (for removing


low-volatility contents). The combination of the short residence time, narrow residence time distribution, high turbulence, and rapid surface renewal permits the
wiped-lm evaporator to successfully handle heat-sensitive, viscous (up to 10 4
Pa s) and fouling-type uids. This equipment is also used as a nal reactor in polycondensation reactions, where the low molecular weight species produced in the
reaction must be removed to achieve high molecular weights.
The screw extruders used for devolatilization (Figure 18.3) present a vent zone
with a deep channel, where the polymer is exposed to vacuum. Due to the clearance between the barrel and the screw ight, a thin layer of polymer is deposited
in the barrel as the screw ight rotates. Evaporation may occur either at the surface
of the rotating melt pool or at the surface of the deposit lms. Bubbles can be generated inside the melt pool. Due to high viscosity, they hardly diuse through the
pool. However, as the pool rotates, some of them reach the exposed pool surface,
increasing the devolatilization eciency.
Both single- and twin-screw extruders have been used for devolatilization.
Counter-rotating, non-intermeshing twin-screw extruders have been widely used
in the isolation of polymers from solutions, emulsions, and suspensions, and
in the devolatilization-driven reactive extrusion processes [53]. Co-rotating, intermeshing twin-screw extruders have been also used as bulk and solution nishing
devolatilizers [54]. One of the main advantages of the twin screw over the single
screws is its ability to oer additional surface removal for lm exposure and the
excellent interchange of pool and lm polymer. On the other hand, the area under
the vent of a single extruder is vulnerable to stagnation, while the twin-screw geometry reduces this possibility. However, design of twin-screw extruders is more
complicated and they are more expensive than the single-screw extruders.
Although selection of the devolatilization system is not an easy issue, Figure 18.4
presents a guide based on the heat sensitivity, viscosity, concentration, and economics.

18.4 Waterborne Dispersions


Preconcentration
(Dilute product)

Viscosity (Pa.s)

Concentration
(Viscous heat sensitive)

Flash evaporator

50

Devolatilization
(Highly viscous)

103

Trace devolatilization
(Very high viscosity)

2 104

5 104

Wiped-film evaporator

Falling
strand
evaporator

Fig. 18.4.

979

Vented extruder

Criteria for choosing the devolatilizer equipment.

18.3

Polyolens

Polyolens are nowadays one of the most important groups of commercial polymers, with a consumption of about 100 million tons per year, which represents
more than 40% of the total word production of polymers [55]. Because the main
monomers involved in the production, ethylene and propylene, have very high vapor pressure, these polymers are produced under pressure. Therefore, the residual
monomers are easily removed by depressurization and recirculated to the polymerization zone. However, in the slurry and solution processes the polymerization
medium is a solvent. In those cases, the polyolen solution or slurry leaving the
reactor is discharged into a vessel at lower pressure to ash o the solvent and unreacted monomers. The slurry from the polymerization reactor can also pass directly to a centrifuge where most of the volatiles are removed and recycled to the
reactor. Further removal of solvent residues is achieved by passing a heated stream
of inert gas (mainly nitrogen) through the bed of pellets.
In the gas-phase processes, the polymer is discharged into a cyclone separator,
from which residual monomers are recovered and recompressed.

18.4

Waterborne Dispersions

Probably the main step to eliminate VOC in the polymer industry has been the
substitution of solvent-based systems by waterborne products. Nowadays, about
5% of the polymers are produced by aqueous dispersion processes, mainly by suspension and emulsion polymerization [8]. The water-based polymers, however, are
not totally free of monomer and VOCs, since the reaction does not reach completion and VOCs arising from impurities in the raw materials or from by-side reactions can be present. There are two main ways to reduce the residual monomer
content in waterborne polymers: post-polymerization or/and devolatilization.

980

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

In order to develop ecient post-polymerization and devolatilization operations,


it is critical to know where the residual monomer and VOCs are located, that is, if
they are mainly in the polymer particles or in the aqueous phase. Table 18.1 (in
Section 18.4.2.1) summarizes the partition coecients (dened as the ratio between the concentrations of monomer/VOC in the polymer particles and in the
aqueous phase) measured for several monomers and VOCs in latexes. It can be
seen that the monomers are mainly located in the polymer particles. On the other
hand, water-soluble VOCs such as acetaldehyde and tert-butanol are mainly in the
aqueous phase. It is worth pointing out that the partition coecient decreases (that
is, the monomer partitioning shifts toward the aqueous phase) as the average
monomer concentration in the system decreases [56, 57].
18.4.1

Post-polymerization

Post-polymerization consists of adding, after the end of the main polymerization process, fresh radical-generating systems to polymerize the residual monomer.
Even though residual monomers may be post-polymerized using radiation [58, 59],
post-polymerization is mainly carried out using initiators.
In suspension polymerization, the initiator must be oil-soluble. Those initiators,
in order to be fed into the reactor, are commonly dissolved in an organic solvent,
which increases the VOC content. On the other hand, the most important monomers (styrene, methyl methacrylate, and vinyl chloride) polymerized in suspension
yield polymers with a high glass transition temperature (Tg ). The polymerization
temperature is usually below the Tg , and hence the polymerization rate decreases
sharply at high conversions due to the glass eect. Increasing the temperature of
the reactor above the Tg could be a way to improve the monomer conversion. However, this would imply temperatures higher than the boiling point of the water,
and in addition, long exposures to high temperatures could degrade the polymer.
Therefore, post-polymerization does not seem a promising way to reduce the residual monomer in suspension polymers.
In emulsion polymerization, any kind of free-radical initiation system may, in
principle, be used for post-polymerization. However, some alternatives seem to be
preferable. Thus, although both thermal and redox initiation systems may be used,
and attempts to enhance the activity of thermal initiators by using ultrasound have
been reported [60], redox systems are preferred because these systems generate a
higher ux of radicals, in particular under mild conditions, leading to shorter postpolymerization times. A wide variety of oxidants and reductants can be combined
in dierent redox systems [61, 62]. Ideally, radicals should have easy access to the
place where the monomer is located. Because the residual monomer is mainly located in the polymer particles [57], oil-soluble initiators seem promising. However,
as explained above, their addition would increase the VOC content. Consequently,
water-soluble redox systems are more convenient. Ilundain et al. [63] demonstrated
that independently of the water solubility of the monomer, water-soluble redox
initiators yielding hydrophobic radicals (such as organic hydroperoxides) were ad-

18.4 Waterborne Dispersions

vantageous for monomer removal by post-polymerization. The reason is that the


hydrophobic radicals can enter directly into the polymer particles whereas the hydrophilic radicals must undergo a number of propagation steps before becoming
hydrophobic enough to be able to enter into the polymer particle. These growth
processes take rather a long time, because under post-polymerization conditions
the monomer concentration in the aqueous phase is very low, and the oligoradicals
suer bimolecular termination leading to low initiator eciency.
Emulsion polymerization is commonly used to produce lm-forming polymers,
and hence it is generally carried out at temperatures above the Tg of the polymers.
Therefore, propagation does not become diusion-controlled [64], and the kinetics
of post-polymerization is not inuenced by the reaction temperature dierently
than the emulsion polymerization stage [65].
The main advantages of post-polymerization treatments are that they can be
carried out either in the polymerization reactor or in the storage tank, and no additional equipment is needed. However, only the polymerizable residual volatiles can
be eliminated, and in some cases new VOCs are produced from secondary reactions. Thus, formaldehyde is formed when sodium sulfoxylate formaldehyde is
used as the reductant [66] and acetone and tert-butanol are formed when tert-butyl
hydroperoxide is used as the oxidant [67]. In addition, inorganic water-soluble initiators may be deleterious to both stability and water sensitivity of the lm formed
with the latexes.
It is worth mentioning that some initiator systems may modify the polymer
microstructure [68, 69], which can be either a problem or an opportunity to extend
the range of properties achievable with a given aqueous dispersion of polymers.
Modeling Post-polymerization
The processes involved in post-polymerization can be summarized as follows. The
radicals that are generated in the aqueous phase must add some monomeric units
in order to become hydrophobic enough to enter into the particles. This critical
value is referred as z, and is a function of both the monomer hydrophobicity [70]
and the type of radical formed from the initiator. The radicals may suer bimolecular termination in the aqueous phase. On the other hand, the radicals inside the
particles can propagate, terminate, or desorb. Under post-polymerization conditions, however, the radical desorption rate is negligible because, due to the low
monomer content in the particles, the probability of generating small free-radical
species by chain transfer to monomer is very low. A mathematical model based
on the mechanisms summarized above is available [71]. Optimal strategies aiming
at achieving maximum monomer removal with minimum formation of VOCs have
been reported [71].
18.4.1.1

18.4.2

Devolatilization

Devolatilization of aqueous polymer dispersions is usually carried out using a


stripping agent (steam and nitrogen are the most commonly used; air can also be

981

982

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

Vapor +VOCs

Bubble
Aqueous phase

Polymer particle
Stripping agent
(steam, nitrogen,.)

Fig. 18.5.

The stripping of latexes.

used, but explosive vapor mixtures can be produced). Figure 18.5 summarizes the
devolatilization process in a stirred tank using a stripping agent, which is usually
fed in continuously until the volatile content is reduced to the desired level.
Modeling
From a microscopic point of view, devolatilization of aqueous-phase dispersions is
a mass-transfer process, which involves the following steps: (1) diusion of the
VOCs to the particle surface; (2) transfer from the polymer surface to the aqueous
phase; (3) diusion through the aqueous phase; and (4) transfer from the aqueous
phase to the gas phase (Figure 18.6) [72].
18.4.2.1

Fig. 18.6.

Processes involved in the devolatilization of waterborne dispersions.

18.4 Waterborne Dispersions

Assuming that the contact between the particles and the bubbles is negligible,
and that the ow of the gas phase may be described by a well-mixed continuous
system, the overall mass balances of the VOC in the dierent phases are given by
Eqs. (5)(7), where Vi is the volume of the phase i (w water phase, p polymer
particles, g gas phase); Ci is the concentration of the VOC in the phase i; Ci; ej
is the concentration of the VOC in the phase i that would be in equilibrium with
the actual concentration of the VOC in phase j; K pw represents the overall masstransfer coecient between the polymeric phase and the water phase, K wg is the
mass-transfer coecient between the aqueous and the gas phase; A pw and A wv are
the interfacial areas between the polymer particles and the aqueous phase and between the aqueous phase and the gas phase, respectively; y is the molar fraction of
the VOC in the euent; and G is the molar ow rate of the stripping gas.
Polymer particles:
d
Vp Cp K pw A pw Cp  Cp; ew
dt

Aqueous phase:
d
Vw Cw K pw A pw Cp  Cp; ew  K wg A wg Cw  Cw; eg
dt

Gas phase:
d
Vg Cg K wg A wg Cw  Cw; eg  Gy
dt

In the devolatilization of polymers in aqueous dispersion, the equilibria are expressed in terms of the partition coecient of the dierent VOCs between the
p
polymer particles and the aqueous phase, k w , and the Henrys law constant (H)
for the partitioning of VOCs between the aqueous phase and the gas phase. Therefore, the equilibrium concentrations can be calculated from Eqs. (8) and (9).
Cp; ew k wp Cw
Cw; eg

PT y
H

8
9

Tables 18.1 and 18.2 present the values of those coecients under devolatilization
conditions (residual VOC content lower than 5000 ppm) for some monomers commonly used in emulsion polymerization and for the main VOCs found in those
latexes after polymerization.
The polymer particle/aqueous phase interfacial area can be obtained from the
particle size measurements, but the total transfer area between the aqueous and

983

984

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers


Tab. 18.1. Polymer particle/aqueous phase coecients under devolatilization conditions
calculated by R. Salazar [100].

Monomer

Polymer system

T [ C]

kw

Monomer content of
particles (50 wt.% solids) [ %]

VAc
VAc
BA
n-Butanol
Acetaldehyde
tert-Butanol

poly(vinyl acetate)
VAc/BA/AA
BA/S/AA
VAc/BA/AA
VAc/BA/AA
VAc/BA/AA

65
65
65
65
65
65

10.5
10.9
240
2.5
0.5
0.5

91.3
88.2
99.6
71.4
33.3
33.3

gas phases is dicult to measure. The degree of dispersion of the gas in a liquid is
a function of several factors such as the geometry of the contact equipment, the
agitation device and speed, the viscosity of the medium, and the gas ow rate. In
addition, the physical-chemical properties of both phases, derived by the presence
of surfactants or electrolytes in the medium, aect the interfacial area. The determination of the mass-transfer coecients is not straightforward either. For the
water/gas phase, the uncertainty of the estimation of both the interfacial area and
the mass-transfer coecient is overcome through the evaluation of the volumetric
mass-transfer coecient, K wg A wg . Estimated values from dierent authors are presented in Table 18.3.
The polymer particles/aqueous phase mass-transfer coecient can be determined through the Frossling equation [73], where Sh is the Sherwood number, Re
the Reynolds number, and Sc the Schmidt number.
Sh 2:0 aRe b Sc c

10

It is worth pointing out that few studies took into account the pseudoplastic behavior of the polymeric dispersions [74, 75]. There is little and sometimes contradictory information about the presence of the additional gas phase on the solidliquid
mass-transfer coecients. Sanger et al. [76] observed that in a bubble column, K pw
increased upon increasing the gas ow rate. Grisa et al. [77], observed just the
opposite in a stirred tank; this was attributed to reduction of the eective power

Tab. 18.2. Henrys law constants at 65 C


calculated by R. Salazar [100].

Compound

H [k Pa]

VAc
Butyl acrylate
Acetone
n-Butanol

26
29
3
1.5

18.4 Waterborne Dispersions


Tab. 18.3.

Estimated mass transfer volumetric coecients.

Equation

Estimated
K vw A vw
[m 3 sC1 ]

Reference

K wg A wg 0:02218Pg =VL 0:5 u0:6


s
  
 2 1:11  0:5 
K wg A wg d i
d i Nr
me
d i us 0:447 mg 0:694
21:2
me
D
rD
s
me
 2 0:67  0:5  2 3 1:29
K wg A wg di2
rN
di
d
Nr
m
1:41  103 i
m
rD
D
s
 2 1:65  0:5  2 0:19  0:6 

K wg A vg di2
d Nr
m
N di
mus
Nd i 0:33
0:06 i
F
me
rD
D
g
s
us

4:4  106

118

0:14  106

119

0:91  106

120

0:83  106

121

5:3  106

122

F 1 2:0lN 0:5 0:67


K wg A wg 8:48  108 uG0:56G0:08 N 2:7G0:2

N > 30 rpm

per unit volume used to mix the dispersion. Kim et al. [78, 79] measured experimentally the K pw of vinyl acetate diusion into poly(vinyl acetate) and polystyrene
latex particles using a vapor-phase addition method. Values in the range of
5  107 7  107 cm min1 were obtained for diusion of vinyl acetate into 160
nm PS latex particles.
Rate-limiting Steps
For suspension polymers, which are commonly high-Tg polymers and present
small polymer particle/aqueous phase interfacial areas, the diusion through the
particle and the transfer from the particle surface to the aqueous phase are often
the rate-limiting steps [80]. The ease of removal depends mainly on the polymer
particle size, particle size distribution (the presence of large particles increases the
diusion time through the particle largely), and the presence of glassy particles.
High temperatures speed up devolatilization.
For emulsion polymers, the monomer devolatilization rate is often limited by the
mass transfer through the interface between the aqueous phase and the gas phase
[57]. For these systems, diusion in the polymer particles is fast because the Tg of
the polymer is low and the particle size is small. In addition, the mass transfer
from the particles to the aqueous phase is fast because of the huge interfacial
area. For water-soluble VOCs such as acetaldehyde and tert-butanol, the ratelimiting step is also the mass transfer through the liquid/gas interface. Therefore,
all the process variables that increase the interfacial area between the aqueous
phase and the gas phase, such as agitation, geometry of the sparger, or gas ow
rate, would improve devolatilization [81].
However, the stripping of emulsion polymers may cause a substantial fraction of
the surfactant added to the system to desorb from the polymer particles to form
foam, thus leaving the system susceptible to coagulation. Furthermore, the me18.4.2.2

985

986

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

chanical agitation and the creation of large gas/liquid interfacial areas promote coagulation. In addition, the solids content of the dispersion can vary due to either
the evaporation of some water or the condensation of steam.
Devolatilization under Equilibrium Conditions
Under some circumstances, such as when the bubble size is very small and low
gas ow rates are used, the concentrations of the VOCs in all phases are at thermodynamic equilibrium. In this case, the removal kinetics of the VOCs is given by
Eq. (11) [8284], where t is the removal time and k is the apparent removal rate
constant, given by Eq. (12) [84]. Mw is the water molecular weight, E is the mass
of latex in the devolatilizer, and X is the mass fraction of polymer in the latex.
18.4.2.3

C
ekt
C0
GMw H=PT
!
#
p rw
E X kw  1 1
rp

k "

11
12

This prediction was found to be valid for dierent processes, such as the stripping
of styrenebutadiene latexes when a constant steam sparge rate was used [83, 85],
and acrylic copolymers at dierent solids contents and steam sparge rates [84].
Equations (11) and (12) show that devolatilization is strongly aected by the thermodynamic equilibria of the VOCs between dierent phases. High values of the
polymer particles/aqueous-phase partition coecient imply that the concentration
in the aqueous phase will be low and hence it will be dicult to remove the VOC
from the particles. Similarly, a low value of the Henrys law constant means that
the concentration of VOCs in the gas phase is low and hence, devolatilization will
be dicult. Figure 18.7 shows the kinetics of devolatilization of vinyl acetate, acetaldehyde, and n-butanol in a VAc/BA/AA latex, and that of BA in a BA/S/AA latex
by stripping in laboratory-scale equipment, under equilibrium conditions. It can be
p
seen that the devolatilization of BA was slow due to the high anity (high k w ) of
BA to the polymer particles. The removal of n-butanol was also very slow because
of its high solubility in the aqueous phase and low vapor pressure (a low value of
the Henrys law constant).
Equipment
Although ash devolatilization has been applied for removal of high-volatility
monomers, such as vinyl chloride from poly(vinyl chloride) [8688] or butadiene
from polybutadiene [89], most of the processes described in the literature include
the use of a stripping inert gas (usually steam) to improve the devolatilization
eciency.
Several types of equipment have been proposed to allow fast devolatilization
without aecting the stability of the dispersion and avoiding foaming. Englund
[83] reviewed the dierent latex strippers used in commercial practice. Batch,
18.4.2.4

18.4 Waterborne Dispersions

Conversion

0.8
0.6
0.4
0.2
0
0

30

60
90
120
Time (min)

Fig. 18.7. Kinetics of devolatilization of vinyl


acetate, acetaldehyde, and n-butanol in a
VAc/BA/AA latex, and that of BA in a BA/S/AA
latex: g, acetaldehyde; k, VAc; c, n-butanol

150

180

removal rate by devolatilization from a


VAc/BA/AA latex; , BA removal rate from
BA/S/AA latex, under the same devolatilization
conditions [100].

semibatch, and continuous tanks, using countercurrent or cross-ow gas [9093],


packed or perforated columns in countercurrent ow [9498], and tubular devolatilizers [99] have been used.
Continuous steam stripping using countercurrent ow of an aqueous dispersion
and steam requires less steam than batch and cross-ow systems, although the
equipment needs considerable space. On the other hand, the column continuous
countercurrent stripper requires the least steam of all the processes, and little oor
space. This type of stripper is attractive because the short residence time allows
short exposure to high temperatures, decreasing the risk of degradation. They are
used extensively in suspension processes, such as the production of poly(vinyl
chloride). Those stripping systems, however, are dicult to apply to latexes, because of severe foam formation, and the risk of coagulation due to the shear and
the relatively high viscosity of the latex. The low Tg of most of the latexes is an additional drawback for using column stripping systems. In these cases, tank reactors are much more convenient.
The undesirable foaming can be suppressed by lowering the temperature, but
this reduces the recovery of the low boiling point substances. Chemical defoaming
agents may be used, but they may accelerate thermal degradation of the polymer
when it is processed at an elevated temperature (as occurs with the polyvinyl chloride) and their use adds contaminants to the latex. One way to control foam formation is by a sudden increase of the pressure. This method has been proven to be
very ecient in the stripping of acrylic latexes in tank reactors [100]. Many eorts
have been devoted to the design of the devolatilizer to overcome this problem. The
injection of the steam at a point in the autoclave such that it passes through the

987

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

dispersion uncondensed has been found very convenient [101]. In other cases,
the gas to be drawn o is passed through porous lter elements [102] or through
a condenser adapted to the top of the packed tower [94]. Other authors [90]
claimed to feed the aqueous latex as a spray to avoid the contact of the droplets
of spray with the side wall of the chamber, and therefore to avoid foaming, which
otherwise could cause ooding of the descending latex.
18.4.3

Combined Processes

Devolatilization is an adequate technique to remove both residual monomer and


nonpolymerizable volatiles. However, this method is of limited eciency for the
removal of very hydrophobic monomers, for which high ow rates of the stripping
gas should be used to appreciably reduce the monomer content, with the corresponding increase in cost, and risk of foaming and coagulation. Under these circumstances, combination of post-polymerization and devolatilization is an attractive alternative.
Some authors have proposed treating the dispersion initially by postpolymerization followed by stripping devolatilization [103105]. Taylor [106]
claimed a treatment in which devolatilization and post-polymerization proceeded
concurrently. Salazar et al. [57] have compared the performance of concurrent
combined strategies for removal of monomer and VOCs with those of other strategies including post-polymerization, devolatilization, and post-polymerization followed by devolatilization. The results obtained for the removal of BA and the
VOCs present in BA/S/AA commercial latex are shown in Figure 18.8. It can be

1
0.8
Conversion

988

0.6
0.4
0.2
0
0

30

60
90
120
Time (min)

150

Fig. 18.8. Inuence of the strategy on the eciency of removal


of BA from a BA/S/AA commercial latex: k, devolatilization;
g, post-polymerization; c, simultaneous post-polymerization
and devolatilization.

180

18.5 Summary

observed that the simultaneous process resulted in the highest eciency of removal for monomer. For the nonpolymerizable VOCs, almost the same eciency
was obtained in all the strategies using devolatilization.
18.4.4

Alternative Processes

In addition to those conventional techniques widely applied in the industry, other


alternatives that try to overcome the problems associated with the use of chemicals
in post-polymerization or the high energy consumption associated with devolatilization have been implemented. The modication of the unreacted monomer into a
harmless compound, or into a product easier to devolatilize, has been applied to
reduce the VOC content. Ozone was found advantageous for vinylic monomer,
because it can easily break the double bond and is innocuous [107, 108]. On the
other hand, it could also attack the double bond of the polymer chain, causing the
degradation of the polymer. Biological degradation through the use of peroxidegenerating enzymes was also shown to be able to reduce residual monomer in
latex [109, 110]. This process, however, is very slow.
Adsorbents, such as active carbon particles [111, 112], zeolites [111, 112], polymeric adsorbents [111], or ion exchangers [111], have been proven to be useful for
VOC reduction in latexes. This treatment, however, requires additional equipment
and the regeneration of the adsorbent.
Extraction of the VOCs with suitable solvents has been also extensively investigated. Treatment with organic solvents was found valid for particular cases, such
as the removal of high-boiling organic compounds [113] or preparation of polymeric hydrogels [114]. Application of supercritical uids to cleaning processes
was presented in 1998 as an alternative to monomer removal in the near future
[115]. Kemmere et al. [116, 117] studied the potential of a post-polymerization process based on supercritical carbon dioxide to remove methyl methacrylate from
poly(methyl methacrylate). This process is attractive since CO2 is very abundant,
relatively inexpensive, and environmentally benign on this scale of use.

18.5

Summary

For polymer melts and solutions, the diusion of the VOCs from the polymer to
the polymer/vapor interface is the rate-limiting step. This limitation is more pronounced for highly viscous melts. Therefore, the devolatilizers must be designed
to increase both the diusion coecient of the volatiles and the polymer/vapor
interfacial area. This is achieved by using stripping agents, and equipment with
rotating parts that generate and renew the interfacial area. Vented screw extruders are recommended for devolatilizing highly viscous systems. Wiped-lm
evaporators can handle polymer melts with viscosities up to 10 4 Pa s, and ash

989

990

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers

and falling-strand devolatilizers are recommended for low-viscosity polymers (viscosities up to 1 Pa s).
Residual monomer present in polyolens is easily removed by depressurization.
The solvent used in the slurry and solution processes is commonly eliminated by
ash evaporation and subsequent contact with a heated inert gas stream.
There are two main ways to reduce the VOC content in waterborne dispersed
polymers: post-polymerization and devolatilization. Post-polymerization can only
be applied to emulsion polymers. Water-soluble redox initiators yielding hydrophobic radicals have been found to be advantageous for monomer removal by postpolymerization. In suspension polymers the devolatilization is limited by both the
diusion through the particle (because of the usually high Tg of the polymer) and
the mass transfer from the particle surface to the aqueous phase (because of the
large particle size that results in a relatively small interfacial area). Therefore, the
temperature and the polymer particle size play an important role in the devolatilization eciency.
In the devolatilization of emulsion polymers, the mass transfer between the
aqueous phase and the gas phase is frequently the rate-determining step. Consequently, the agitation, the gas ow rate, and other process variables or design
characteristics that increase the interfacial area between the aqueous phase and
the gas phase will improve the devolatilization. However, care must be taken to
avoid foaming and coagulation. Column continuous countercurrent strippers are
often used in devolatilization of suspension polymers, while stripping in tank reactors is more convenient for low-Tg lm-forming latexes.

Notation

A
c
ce
D
di
E
G
g
H
K
p
kw
Mw
N
NVOC
P1
Pg
Re
Sc

interfacial area [m 2 ]
concentration of the VOC [mol m3 ]
volatile concentration at the interface [mol m3 ]
diusion coecient [m 2 s1 ]
impeller diameter [m]
mass of latex in the devolatilizer [kg]
molar ow rate of the stripping gas [mol s1 ]
gravitational constant [m s2 ]
Henrys law constant [kPa]
overall mass transfer coecient [m s1 ]
partition coecient between the polymer particles and the aqueous phase
water molecular weight [kg mol1 ]
agitation speed [s1 ]
ux of the VOC through the interface [mol m2 s1 ]
partial pressure of the volatile in the gas phase [kPa]
power applied to the system [W]
Reynolds number
Schmidt number

References

SH
Sh
Tg
ug
us
V
X
y

degree of superheat
Sherwood number
glass transition temperature [ C]
linear gas velocity [m s1 ]
supercial gas velocity [m s1 ]
volume [m 3 ]
mass fraction of polymer in the latex
molar fraction of the VOC in the euent

Greek
density [kg m3 ]
viscosity [Pa s]
eective viscosity [Pa s]
interfacial tension [Nm s1 ]

r
m
me
s

Subscripts
g
p
w

gas phase
polymer particle
water phase

Acronyms
AA
BA
S
VAc
VOC

acrylic acid
butyl acrylate
styrene
vinyl acetate
volatile organic compound

References
1 Protocol of Montreal, September
2
3

1997.
Protocol of Kyoto, December 1997.
P. H. H. Araujo, C. Sayer, J. G. R.
Poco, R. Giudici, Polym React. Eng.
2002, 42, 14421468.
J. A. Biesenberger (Ed.), Devolatilization of Polymers, Hanser Publishers,
Munich, 1983.
R. J. Albalak (Ed.), Polymer Devolatilization, Marcel Dekker, New York,
1996.
European Directive 1999/13/EC.

7 J. Brezinski, Paint and Coating Testing

8
9

10

11

Manual, 14th Ed., Ed. J. Koleske,


American Society for Testing and
Materials, Philadelphia, 1995.
http://www.apme.org.
J. A. Biesenberger, S. K. Dey, J.
Brizzolara, Polym. Eng. Sci. 1990, 30,
14931499.
J. L. Duda, J. S. Vrentas, S. T. Yu,
H. T. Liu, AIChE J. 1982, 28, 279
285.
G. A. Latinen, ACS Adv. Chem. Ser.
1962, 34, 235245.

991

992

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers


12 R. W. Coughlin, G. P. Canevari,
13
14
15

16
17

18
19
20

21

22

23
24

25
26
27

28
29

30
31
32
33

AIChE J. 1969, 15, 560563.


G. W. Roberts, AIChE J. 1970, 16,
878881.
J. A. Biesenberger, G. Kessidis,
Polym. Eng. Sci. 1982, 22, 832835.
G. P. Collins, C. D. Denson, G.
Astarita, AIChE J. 1985, 31, 1288
1295.
R. H. Secor, Polym. Eng. Sci. 1986, 26,
647652.
P. S. Mehta, L. N. Valsamis, Z.
Tadmor, Polym. Process Eng. 1984, 2,
103128.
J. A. Biesenberger, S.-T. Lee, Polym.
Eng. Sci. 1986, 26, 982988.
J. A. Biesenberger, S.-T. Lee, Polym.
Eng. Sci. 1987, 27, 510517.
R. J. Albalak, A. Tukachinsky, T.
Chechink, Y. Talmon, Z. Tadmor,
in Polymer Devolatilization, Ed. R. J.
Albalak, Marcel Dekker, New York,
1996.
A. L. Yarin, D. Lastochkin, Y.
Talmon, Z. Tadmor, AIChE J. 1999,
45, 25902605.
S.-T. Lee, in Polymer Devolatilization,
Ed. R. J. Albalak, Marcel Dekker, New
York, 1996.
J. H. Han, C. D. Han, J. Polym. Sci.:
Part B: Polym. Phys. 1990, 28, 711741.
J. H. Han, C. D. Han, J. Polym. Sci.:
Part B: Polym. Phys. 1990, 28, 743
761.
S.-T. Lee, J. A. Biesenberger, Polym.
Eng. Sci. 1989, 29, 782790.
R. W. Foster, J. T. Lindt, Polym. Eng.
Sci. 1990, 30, 621634.
N. S. Ramesh, D. H. Rasmussen, G. D.
Campbell, Polym. Eng. Sci. 1994, 34,
16851697.
J. S. Colton, N. P. Suh, Polym. Eng.
Sci. 1987, 27, 485492.
A. L. Yarin, D. Lastochkin, Y.
Talmon, Z. Tadmor, AIChE J. 1999,
45, 25902605.
R. E. Newman, R. H. M. Simon, 73rd
AIChE Meeting, Chicago, 1980.
H. J. Yoo, C. D. Han, Polym. Process
Eng. 1984, 2, 129151.
M. Amon, C. D. Denson, Polym. Eng.
Sci. 1984, 24, 10261034.
R. W. Foster, J. T. Lindt, Polym. Eng.
Sci. 1989, 29, 178185.

34 C.-T. Yang, T. G. Smith, D. I. Bigio,

35
36
37
38
39

40

41
42
43
44
45
46
47
48

49
50

51

52

53

54

55
56

C. Anolick, AIChE J. 1997, 43, 1861


1873.
P. Nising, T. Zeilmann, T. Meyer,
Chem. Eng. Technol. 2003, 26, 599604.
J. P. Skilbeck, US 5 380 822, 1995.
W. R. King, F. R. Feder, J. Naveau,
J. M. Mlinaric, US 5 478 509, 1995.
J. Barwich, O. Aydin, U. Erhardt,
W. Holtrup, US 5 772 851, 1998.
S. Carra, M. Morbidelli, E.
Santacesaria, G. Niederjaufner, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci. 1981, 26, 14971510.
J. S. Vrentas, J. L. Duda, H. C. Ling,
J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1985, 30, 4499
4516.
K. Ravindranath, R. A. Mashelkar,
Chem. Eng. Sci. 1988, 43, 429442.
S. Alsoy, J. L. Duda, AIChE J. 1998,
44, 582590.
H. B. Copelin, US 4 306 058, 1981.
J. T. McQueen, S. Krupinski, EP 0
798 314, 1997.
R. E. Neuman, US 4 361 462, 1982.
S. Kuorinski, D. Desroches, EP 855
410 A1, 1997.
Y. Fujii, C. Oda, US 4 361 462, 1982.
D. Todd, R. H. M. Simon, J. Lane,
J. A. Biesenberger, in Devolatilization
of Polymers, Ed. J. A. Biesenberger,
Hanser Publishers, Munich, 1983.
W. R. King, F. R. Feder, J. Naveau,
J. M. Mlinaric, US 5 478 509, 1995.
F. Balestri, I. Borghi, A. D. Dall,
C. Buonerba, S. Matarrese, A.
Mattiussi, EP 352 727, 1990.
P. L. Maffetone, G. Astarita, L.
Cori, L. Carnelli, F. Balestri,
AIChE J. 1991, 37, 724734.
G. Ianniruberto, P. L. Maffetone,
G. Astarita, in Polymer Devolatilization, Ed. R. J. Albalak, Marcel Dekker,
New York, 1996.
R. J. Nichols, J. T. Lindt, in Polymer
Devolatilization, Ed. R. J. Albalak,
Marcel Dekker, New York, 1996.
J. Curry, F. Brauer, in Polymer
Devolatilization, Ed. R. J. Albalak,
Marcel Dekker, New York, 1996.
P. Galli, G. Vecellio, J. Polym. Sci.:
Polym. Chem. 2004, 42, 396415.
D. Kukulj, R. G. Gilbert, in
Polymeric Dispersions: Principles and
Applications, Ed. J. M. Asua, NATO

References

57

58
59
60
61
62
63

64

65

66
67

68

69

70

71

72
73
74

ASI Series, Vol. 35, Kluwer Academic


Publishers, 1997.
R. Salazar, D. Alvarez, P. Ilundain,
L. Da Cunha, M. J. Barandiaran,
J. M. Asua, Progress in Polymer Colloids
2003, 124, 116120.
E. J. Ellis, L. Mager, GB 2 113 694,
1983.
P. J. Reilly, US 458 508, 1984.
L. Da Cunha, J. M. Asua, Spanish
Patent Application, 200 101 018, 2001.
G. S. Misra, U. D. N. Bajpai, Prog.
Polym. Sci. 1982, 8, 61131.
A. S. Sarac, Prog. Polym. Sci. 1999, 24,
11491204.
P. Ilundain, D. Alvarez, L. Da
Cunha, R. Salazar, M. J. Barandiaran, J. M. Asua, J. Polym. Sci. Part A:
Polym. Chem. Ed. 2002, 40, 42454249.
I. A. Maxwell, E. M. F. J. Verdurmen, A. I. German, Makromol.
Chem. 1992, 193, 26772695.
P. Ilundain, L. Da Cunha, R.
Salazar, D. Alvarez, M. J. Barandiaran, J. M. Asua, J. Appl. Polym. Sci.
2002, 83, 923928.
D. Becchi, E. Montesoro, L. M.
Saija, C. Sempio, EP 0767180, 1997.
L. Da Cunha, P. Ilundain, R.
Salazar, D. Alvarez, M. J.
Barandiaran, J. M. Asua, Polymer
2001, 42, 391395.
J. Tangpakdee, M. Mizokoshi, A.
Endo, Y. Tanaka, Rubber Chem.
Technol. 1998, 71, 795802.
P. Ilundain, D. Alvarez, L. Da
Cunha, R. Salazar, M. J.
Barandiaran, J. M. Asua, J. Polym.
Sci. Part A: Polym. Chem. Ed. 2003, 41,
37443749.
I. A. Maxwell, B. R. Morrison, D. H.
Napper, R. G. Gilbert, Macromolecules 1991, 244, 16291640.
P. Ilundain, D. Alvarez, L. Da
Cunha, R. Salazar, M. J.
Barandiaran, J. M. Asua, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res. 2004, 43, 12441250.
G. P. Quadri, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1998, 37, 28502863.
N. Frossling, Beitr. Geophys. 1938, 52,
170216.
P. Lal, S. Kumar, S. N. Upadilla,
Y. D. Upadhya, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.
1988, 27, 12461259.

75 Y. Kawase, M. Moo-Young, Chem.

Eng. J. 1987, 36, 3140.


76 P. Sanger, W.-D. Deckwer, Chem.

Eng. J. 1981, 22, 179186.


77 F. Grisa, A. Brucato, L. Rizzuti,

78

79

80

81
82

83
84

85

86
87
88
89
90
91
92
93
94
95
96

97

Can. J. Chem. Eng. 1998, 76, 446


455.
J. I. Kim, J. W. Vanderhoff, A.
Klein, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 1995, 58,
279290.
J. I. Kim, J. W. Vanderhoff, A.
Klein, Polymer Testing 1995, 14, 289
306.
R. K. S. Chan, C. B. Patel, R. Gupta,
C. H. Worman, R. E. Grandin, J.
Macromol. Sci. Chem. 1982, A17,
10451064.
ss,
D. Meier, H. J. Warnecke, J. Pru
Chem. Eng. J. 1997, 67, 4553.
C. B. Patel, R. Houck, R. Gupta,
R. K. S. Chan, J. Polym Sci., Polym.
Chem. Ed. 1979, 17, 37753779.
S. M. Englund, Chem. Eng. Prog.
1981, 77, 5559.
G. Mehos, D. Quick, Separation
Science and Technology 1994, 29, 1841
1856.
S. Omi, H. Endo, S. Shibata, M. Iso,
H. Kubata, Contemp. Top. Polym. Sci.
1984, 4, 909921.
P. J. Patel, W. Miringoff,
US 4 031 056, 1977.
Hoechst Aktiengessellschaft, French
Patent 2 318 176, 1975.
T. Yoichi, Y. Masahiro,
EP 0 890 582 A1, 1999.
S. Takao, JP 4 239 506, 1992.
B. P. Chandra, J. C. Greaves, V. G.
Lovelock, US 4 283 526, 1981.
F. Botsch, C. Heinze, H. Wolff,
US 4 158 092, 1979.
E. D. Hornbaker, A. Nugent, C. P.
Loechelt, US 4 184 924, 1980.
R. G. Nickerson, R. T. Bouchard,
P. J. Hurtubise, US 4 168 373, 1979.
T. Kano, H. Okada, S. Masuko, H.
Itagaki, US 4 526 656, 1985.
R. S. Miller, F. J. Doyle, US 4 130 527,
1977.
R. Scheiler, J. Walther, K. H.
Shoenberg, P. Rauth, US 4 007 022,
1977.
K. Nakano, M. Fukuda, M. Shinkai,
S. Aruga, US 4 369 092, 1983.

993

994

18 Removal of Monomers and VOCs from Polymers


98 H. Grosse-Wormann, B. Hentschel,

99
100
101

102
103

104

105
106
107
108
109
110
111

P. Rauth, K. H. Schoenberg, B.
Terwiesh, H. Winter, US 4 017 445,
1977.
L. C. Baughman, US 3 930 931, 1976.
R. Salazar, PhD Thesis, University of
the Basque Country, Spain, 2003.
K. Rostock, J. Birke, R. Wiedholz,
J. Bauer, T. Balwe, US 4 224 437,
1980.
O. Zajicek, J. Kirschner, H. Klapp,
R. Rompeltien, US 4 256 470, 1981.
A. M. von Arx, R. Studer, J. M. S.
Lorteije, P. L. J. Swinkels, EP 1 024
152, 2000.
binger, P.
J. Dobbelaar, W. Hu
Keller, B. Stanger, US 6 096 858,
2000.
P. Kelly, EP 0 650 977 A1, 1995.
M. A. Taylor, US 4 529 753, 1985.
R. A. Marshall, D. K. Parker, J. W.
Hershberger, US 5 498 693, 1996.
G. L. Burroway, D. K. Parker, J. R.
Purdon Jr., US 5 268 431, 1995.
G. C. Overbeek, Y. W. Smak,
US 5 292 660, 1994.
P. F. Nicks, M. A. Carver, J. M.
Relton, WP 91/15 520, 1991.
A. Nuber, A. Sanrer, D. Urban,
US 4 795 802, 1995.

112 R. Racz, Macromol. Symp. 2000, 155,

171180.
113 S.-L. Chen, T. H. Wong, R. N.

Gujarathi, US 5 516 818, 1996.


114 K. Nanri, T. Hirabayashi, Y.

115

116

117

118

119
120

121
122

Yamamoto, R. Amilla, H. Fujima, JP


200 364 125, 2003.
K. Jackson, J. L. Fulton, in Supercritical Fluid Cleaning, Ed. J. McHardy,
S. P. Sawan, W. Noyes Publisher,
New York, 1998.
M. Kemmere, M. Cleven, M. van
Schilt, J. Keurentjes, Chem. Eng.
Sci. 2002, 57, 39293937.
M. Kemmere, M. van Schilt, M.
Cleven, A. van Herk, J. Keurentjes,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res. 2002, 41, 2617
2622.
M. Bouai, G. Hebrad, D. Bastoul,
M. Roustan, Chem. Eng. Process. 2001,
40, 97111.
J. F. Perez, O. C. Sandall, AIChE J.
1974, 20, 770775.
R. S. Albal, Y. T. Shah, A. Schumpe,
N. L. Carr, Chem. Eng. J. 1983, 27,
6180.
H. Yagi, F. Yoshida, Ind. Eng. Chem.,
Process Des. Dev. 1975, 14, 488493.
T. Poizat, C. Jallut, A. Accary, J.
Lieto, Chem. Eng. J. 1992, 48, 4148.

995

19

Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers1


Christiane de Witz, Carlos Sanchez, Cees Bastiaansen, and
Dirk J. Broer
19.1

Introduction

Nano- and microstructures are essential for the growth of well-established technologies, such as microelectronics, but also for the development of emerging
new ones in the elds of biology, nanotechnology, and information and communication technology. Since the early 1970s the production of microelectronic silicon
chips has been a driving force of paramount importance for the development of
micropatterning techniques. Traditionally, this eld has focused on optical lithography in which a polymer lm is structured using light. The patterned polymer is
then used to implement and integrate the functional components of the microchip
in the silicon wafer. The semiconductor industry focuses on reducing the feature
size of transistors and on reaching higher integration densities for faster computation, higher performance, and cheaper production [1]. Besides microelectronics,
miniaturization and high-throughput production of complex structures are also
required for electro-optical and electronic devices (LCD, LED, FET), nano- and
micro-electromechanical systems (MEMS), denser memories, and biosensors or
biological arrays [2]. New patterning techniques and materials need to be explored
in order to sustain the historical trend in size reduction in the semiconductor
industry and in order to make real advances. For this, polymers are an extremely
attractive platform due to their ease of processing and their tailorability, which
allows ne-tuning of the properties for each application. As an example, the
possibility of patterning polymers with special functionalities such as electrical,
(semi-)conductivity, electroluminescence, piezoelectric, and/or dielectric properties
is important for the development of plastic electronics. Well-dened structured
polymer surfaces also nd their application in optical and electro-optical devices
[38]. For instance, special reectors, made of a polymer lm with a well-designed
relief structure and coated with a thin-lm metallic mirror, redistribute incoming
1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

996

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

light in a very controlled way and are widely used in reective and transective
liquid crystal displays. Periodic relief structures are also widely employed in transmissive gratings to control light in transmission or reection [7, 8]. First, we will
briey review dierent strategies for the patterning of polymer structures and, subsequently, we will focus on new patterning techniques such as photoembossing.
19.1.1

Patterning Techniques

Photolithographic techniques make use of electromagnetic (EM) radiation (UV,


DUV, EUV or X-ray photons) to generate a latent image in a photopolymer [9].
The image of a mask can be transferred, either by putting it in direct contact with
the photoresist and subsequently irradiating with collimated light or by projecting
the image with the help of appropriate optics. Methods involving multibeam holography have also been explored [10]. Independently of the irradiation method, the
EM radiation exposure induces a change in solubility in the exposed areas. A subsequent development step in a solvent removes material locally and a relief structure is obtained. This technique suers from certain intrinsic limitations such as
diraction or, in the case of projection lithography, the depth of focus. The resolution of optical lithography increases if the wavelength of the EM radiation is reduced. The use of KrF lasers (248 nm) allows the routine fabrication of features
in the order of 200 nm. In order to reduce the size of these features, shorter wavelengths need to be used. ArF excimer lasers working at 193 nm can lead to resolutions of 150 nm. Shorter wavelengths such as 157 nm (F2 excimer lasers) can be
employed. New grades of modied fused silica have been developed showing weak
absorption in this wavelength region, making possible the production of lithographic masks. Calcium uoride meets also the requirements for implementing
the optics for the illumination and projection systems [11]. More problematic is
the use of EUV and X-ray lithography, due to the lack of transparent materials
to generate the masks and the necessary optics for the lithographic process. One
possibility is to use masks with openings in a stencil instead of the conventional
lithographic masks consisting of metallic (for example, chromium) patterns supported on a transparent substrate. Reection-instead of transmission-based optics
also needs to be implemented. Besides the typical problems of UV lithography,
damage to the mask is also induced during exposure. Although the use of these
high-resolution lithographies (EUV and X-ray) has been demonstrated in a laboratory scale, their use in mass production is still restricted because of their high cost.
In all the cases described the development of appropriate polymeric photoresists is
of crucial importance. For example, the resolution can be enhanced by using resists with a nonlinear response that make possible the fabrication of features with
a size below the diraction limitation of the photolithographic technique [12, 13].
Electron beams (EBs) can also be employed for the ne-scale (tens of nanometers) patterning of polymer structures, because of their short (de Broglie) wavelength [14]. Here the charged character of the writing particles limits the resolution because of interparticle electrostatic interactions that produce scattering and

19.1 Introduction

therefore lack of resolution. Another important drawback of this technique is that


the patterning is performed with a writing procedure and, consequently, the production of structures is laborious and expensive; this restricts their use to very specic applications. Some projection systems are being investigated in attempts to
obtain a high-throughput production of patterned structures by EB lithography
[15]. Other related techniques involve ion or uncharged particle beams [16].
Other non-photolithographic techniques, such as imprinting (or embossing) or
cast molding, have had a large technological impact in dierent industrial sectors.
In the case of imprinting, a rigid master is pressed against an unstructured polymer lm [17]. Afterward the master is released and its inverse replica is obtained.
Some popular applications of this imprinting technique are the holograms such as
those used in safety features in the security industry (credit cards, passports, and
money) and compact disks (CDs) [18]. It is also possible to obtain these inverse
replicas by casting a polymer precursor onto the master; after curing this is released to obtain the desired inverse structure. These techniques can reach resolutions of tens of nanometers. The aspect-ratio of the replicated structures with high
throughput and reproducibility is limited to values of around 1, although higher
values have been reached. Among the physical origins of this limitation are the
adhesion forces between the mold and the inverse replica, and their mechanical
and thermal properties.
Nanomachining and nanomanipulation techniques using scanning probe microscopes (SPMs) have been shown to be feasible for the patterning of polymers on a
nanometer scale [19]. Polymer lms have been modied by using high-force AFM.
In this case the tip indents into the material, generating a hole in it. Surface proles consisting of not only lines and dots but also more complex three-dimensional
structures in a gray-scale fashion have been demonstrated. Attempts to overcome
the serial nature of this AFM-based lithography have also been made (Millipede
project from IBM) using arrays of independent cantilevers (up to 1024 tips). In this
case the hole formation rate (bit rate) is thermally assisted by heating the tip. Densities of storage up to 200 Gbytes inch 2 [31 Gbytes cm 2 ] have been achieved using this system. The movement of individual polymeric chains has also been controlled, showing the power of this new nanolithography. Other nanomanipulation
techniques under development involve highly focused beams (optical tweezers)
able to control the position of polymeric microbeads [20].
The techniques described above are known as top-down approaches that make
use of available technologies to reduce the size of the features of the patterned
structures. On the other hand, bottom-up techniques make use of the selfassembly concept to build up structures over several length scales. For example,
periodic templates are generated using polymer microbeads of monodispersed
size [21]. The steric repulsion between beads promotes the formation of controlled
three-dimensional packed crystalline structures. These templates, or equivalent
ones made of inorganic materials, can be used subsequently to generate the inverse polymeric opal also [22]. Another self-organization approach involves phase
separation of block copolymers [23]. In this case the dierent natures of the blocks
can induce their segregation, giving way to well-dened, long-range structures

997

998

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

(lamellas, spheres, cylinders) with sizes that range from several to hundreds of
nanometers, well controlled by the length of the dierent blocks. Although they
are intrinsically attractive, these techniques have important limitations for the advanced patterning of complex structures because of the diculty of controlling the
size, position, shape, and directionality of the growth structure.
Soft lithography is being investigated extensively for the large-scale generation of
relief structures in metallic substrates. In microcontact printing, which is a subtechnique of soft lithography, an elastomeric stamp with a relief structure is used.
The stamp is impregnated with a monolayer of a reactive ink containing, for example, thiols or silanes. The relief structure is then brought into conformal contact
with a noble metal substrate (silicon or silica may also have been used). In the contact areas, a reaction occurs between the ink and the substrate, and an ink monolayer is obtained which acts as an etch-resist [24, 25]. Although this procedure is
intended to be used to pattern metal layers, it has also been employed in the structuring of polymers. For example, the selective growth of polymer in the reacted
areas has been demonstrated [26]. The reacted monolayer on the substrate can
also act as a surface tension pattern to deposit polymers selectively.
We have briey reviewed some of the most signicant available technologies for
generating patterns in polymers. Each of them has specic advantages and deciencies with respect the feature size, processability, high-throughput capability,
cost eectiveness, and functionality of the nal patterned structure. These and
other new techniques need to be developed further in order to overcome existing
problems.
19.1.2

Photoembossing

As an example of a patterning technique in polymers, we will discuss in more


detail photoembossing, a photolithographic technique for the generation of polymeric relief structures. In this particular case, the relief structure develops as a result of a material ux induced by a local polymerization. The material ux deforms
the surface of the lm, which is permanently xed by the photoinitiated crosslinking process without the interference of a solvent development step [9, 27, 28].
Therefore this principle is attractive in an economic sense for applications that require the structuring of large surfaces.
The maskwise or holographic exposure of a thin lm consisting of a blend of
monomers in the presence of a photoinitiator induces a ux of material to the
exposed (high UV intensity) areas; this may be accompanied by a counterux of
other material to the dark (low UV intensity) regions [2932]. When the ux and
counterux are equally balanced in volume, a modulation in composition is obtained, whereas the surface of the lm remains at. This process is used successfully, for instance, to make volume holograms based on refractive index modulation [33, 34]. If there is an unequal volume ux, the surface of the lm will
become modulated because of a volume expansion of the exposed area and a corresponding volume reduction of the dark areas, or vice versa. This principle is ap-

19.2 Materials and their Photoresponsive Behavior

plied to make surface holographic gratings. The process in itself is understood and
can be described quantitatively in terms of the change in the spectrum of chemical
potentials of the various components during the UV exposure and polymerization
[35].
Enhancement of this eect can be achieved with a blend that consists of a polymer and a polyfunctional monomer. In that case the polymer forms a stationary
phase whereas the monomer diuses to the exposed areas, resulting in pronounced surface proles. A general drawback is that the structures form during
exposure. This causes changes of the light path during exposure because the deforming surfaces refract the light in a continuously changing way during the formation of the surface relief. It is possible to overcome this problem by creating a
latent image in the lm during which the formation of a surface relief is minimized. The structure is then formed in a subsequent processing step, for example
heating. This is established by using a blend of a polymer and a monomer which
has low monomer mobility during the formation of the latent image because of its
high viscosity or because of its glassy state. Diusion and polymerization are then
largely inhibited. The exposed areas contain a high concentration of reactive particles, such as free radicals, that are conned to a very localized space. Only when
being heated the mobility is greatly increased and diusion and polymerization are
enabled. This then very rapidly deforms the surface to its desired shape, controlled
by diusion parameters and free surface energy. The process, which we will refer
to further as photoembossing, is shown schematically in Figure 19.1. The blends
may also contain a thermal initiator that initiates polymerization in the dark area
simultaneously or later when heated at higher temperatures, thus xing the surface structure. An additional, but very important, advantage is that contact masking can be applied because the lm is solid and does not stick and thus cause deterioration in the mask and the lm.
An interesting feature of this process is that by the use of multiple lithographic
exposures before the thermal development of the structures, complex surface proles can be generated. For this multiple exposure technique the fact that the
surface prole is not formed before the thermal treatment is optimally benecial,
since the second masking step can also be performed on a solid, at surface, enabling easy mask alignment. In the rest of the chapter we will discuss structure
formation during single and multiple lithographic or holographic steps, and show
some examples of photoembossed structures. A newly developed method to enhance the aspect ratio of the relief structures will also be shown.

19.2

Materials and their Photoresponsive Behavior

A typical formulation for the production of photoembossed structures contains a


polymer base material, a polyfunctional monomer, a photoinitiator, and, optionally,
a thermal initiator. For the coating process, solvents are added. The blend is composed so that after evaporation of the solvent a solid, tack-free lm is formed, al-

999

1000

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

solid reactive blend


spun from solution
substrate, e.g. glass or plastic

solvents evaporated
at T < 80oC (in dark)

UV radiation at RT

photomask

free radicals immobilized by polymer


two-step heating at
T = 80oC and 130oC
solid polymer film
with fixed surface

Fig. 19.1.

Schematic representation of the photoembossing process.

lowing contact mask exposure. An example of a blend consists of poly(benzyl


methacrylate) as the base polymer and di-pentaerythritol tetraacrylate as the monomer. The polymer/monomer ratio is typically 1:1. Poly(benzyl methacrylate) is a
solid polymer and has a glass transition of around 54 C. It blends easily and homogeneously with the monomer. Polyfunctional acrylates like di-pentaerythritol
tetraacrylate are viscous liquids and basically act as plasticizers for the polymer. If
the monomer concentration is too high, the blend becomes tacky. Typically, thin
lms are formed by spin coating or by a doctor blade and the solvents are removed
by heating for 10 min at a temperature well below the decomposition temperature
of the initiators: in the case described, this is 80 C.
Figure 19.2 shows the dierential scanning calorimetry (DSC) traces of a sample
after application as a thin lm in the sample holder and drying at 80 C to remove
the solvent. From DSC the sample appears stable up to 120 C, above which the
thermal initiator activates the thermal polymerization of the acrylate monomer,

19.3 Single-exposure Photoembossing

Exothermic heat flux (mW)

2.5
2
1.5

1
0.5

60 min
10 min
0 min

0
-50

50

100

150

200

250

Temperature ( C)
Fig. 19.2. DSC traces of the reactive photoembossing mixture
(pre-heated in the dark at 80 C to remove solvents) measured
after 0, 10 and 60 min of pre-exposure with a UV lamp (365 nm,
5 mW cm 2 ).

which reveals itself as the large exothermic peak in the DSC thermogram. When
the sample is exposed to UV light before heating, polymerization already starts
above 30 C. An isothermal DSC scan for 60 min during the UV exposure at 20 C
showed no signicant conversion of the acrylate monomer. This indeed shows that
monomer mobility at this temperature is very limited, inhibiting further polymerization. Only when heated above 30 C, monomers are gaining diusional freedom
in order to allow propagation of the polymerization. Upon further heating, monomer conversion proceeds up to a temperature of around 8090 C above which a
small decrease is seen, most probably due to a diminishing concentration of free
radicals due to termination. At temperatures above 120 C the polymerization propagation rate increases again because of free radical generation from the thermal
initiator.

19.3

Single-exposure Photoembossing

The process of latent activation as demonstrated by photo-DSC is also exactly what


happens when a thin lm of the sample is exposed to UV through a mask. In that
case a latent image is formed at the exposed sites consisting of free radicals of the
photoinitiator with only minor conversion of the acrylate groups. Only after heating does further polymerization take place. The typical processing sequence has
been shown in Figure 19.1. First a thin lm is spun on a glass substrate. The lm
thickness is typically 3 mm after evaporation of the solvent by moderate heating at
80 C without premature polymerization. Cooled down to room temperature, the

1001

1002

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

lm is exposed to 365 nm light from a mercury lamp (365 nm bandpass lter, 2.5
mW cm 2 ) through a mask. After this exposure the surface deformation is present,
but is very small in relation to the desired structure. The exposed area contains a
high concentration of free radicals, immobilized by the viscous matrix. By heating
the lm to 80 C, well above the glass transition temperature, monomer mobility is
enhanced and the polymerization reaction sets in. This polymerization induces diffusion of the monomer to the exposed areas without noticeable counterdiusion of
polymeric material. This process swells the exposed areas, whereas the unexposed

Before
heat treatment

After heat
treatment (80 oC)
Fig. 19.3. Interferometric microscope picture of a sample
surface exposed with a UV dose of 0.2 J cm 2 through a
checkerboard mask (feature size 10 mm) before and after heat
treatment (5 min, 80 C).

19.3 Single-exposure Photoembossing

areas are depleted. Figure 19.3 shows interferometric microscope picture of a surface before and after the heating step. Before heating, but after UV exposure, the
surface remains relatively unstructured and at. Directly upon heating, the surface
develops itself into the relief that was imposed by the checkerboard mask. Note
that in these gures the aspect ratio is heavily exaggerated: in a lm of 3 mm
high, dierences of 1 mm are easily feasible. The structure obtained is xed permanently either by a ood UV exposure or by heating to 130 C, at which temperature
the thermal initiator nishes o the polymerization reaction.
The surface prole that is created is determined by a set of parameters. First of
all, of course, the mask dimensions are important, but exposure conditions (dose,
temperature) and heat treatment conditions have also been proven to matter. Some
examples of surface structures obtained by various mask congurations are shown
in Figures 19.4 and 19.5. The structure size can be varied between approximately 1
and 20 mm. Below these dimensions the structures become small and the process
is hindered by the normal limitations of lithographic processes, such diraction.
At larger dimensions the diusion lengths of the monomer become too great, resulting in high edges and deeper central parts of the relief (compare, for instance,
the two top AFM pictures in Figure 19.4), a phenomenon that is perfectly understood from the models available for this process [35]. The shape can also be affected to some extent by the exposure dose, as can be seen by comparing the two
lowest AFM structures in Figure 19.4, in which an overdose of UV light has reshaped the structures that are obtained.
The inuence of the exposure energy on the height of the structures is demonstrated in Figure 19.6. This gure again demonstrates that surface deformation of
the samples takes place only to a minor extent when they are kept at room temperature, even for a prolonged period of 24 h. The minor relief formation under these
conditions is practically independent of the UV dose, but during heating, in this
case in one step directly to 130 C, the structures develop and the UV dose appears
to be of great importance. Too low energy gives only a small eect, for the obvious
reason that photoinitiator conversion is low. A maximum in structure height is obtained at UV doses between 100 and 200 mJ cm 2 . At higher doses the structure
height decreases again. This is explained by the fact that at doses that are too high
(overexposure) some cross-exposure of the intended dark area cannot be avoided.
At the same time the exposed area becomes too crosslinked, thus hindering further
diusion in a later stage of the process.
Next to the UV dose, the periodicity also seems to have an inuence on the features height, as is demonstrated in Figure 19.7. In general, smaller dimensions
lead to a lower relief height. This can be understood in terms of monomer decit
at smaller pitches. At greater periodicities, for instance above 20 mm, the structures
have some problems lling the whole exposed area, and swelling occurs predominantly near the edges. The diusion in the reacting medium apparently occurs typically on a length scale of some micrometers. Further optimization outside this
preferred region is still possible, and an optimum balance between diusion and
polymerization reaction can be found at other diusion and curing temperatures.
However, comparing the results of the single-step (130 C) baking procedure with

1003

1004

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

Mask design

AFM of structure after heating step

590 nm
100 m

100 m

p = q = 8 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

480 m
100 m

100 m

50 m
50 m

p = q = 20 m

0 m 0 m

1260 m
0 m
100 m

100 m

p = q = 10 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

1020 m
510 m
0 m
100 m

p = q = 10 m
overexposure

100 m

50 m
50 m

Fig. 19.4. Examples of mask designs and the surface relief that
they generate after UV exposure and thermal treatment (10 min,
80 C; 10 min, 130 C).

0 m 0 m

19.3 Single-exposure Photoembossing

Mask design

AFM of structure after heating step

724 m
0 m
100 m

100 m

50 m
50 m

p = q = 10 m

0 m 0 m

102 nm
0 nm
100 m

100 m

p = q = 3 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

280 nm
0 nm
100 m

p = q = 10 m

100 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

1200 nm
0 nm
100 m

p = 20 m
q= 5 m

100 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

Fig. 19.5. Examples of mask designs and the surface relief that
they generate after UV exposure and thermal treatment (10 min,
80 C; 10 min, 130 C).

1005

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

1200

Lattice height (nm)

1000
800
600
400
200
0
0.00

0.10

0.20

0.30

0.40

Exposure energy (J/cm2)


Fig. 19.6. Surface relief heights after exposure through a line
mask with a periodicity of 20 mm and an aperture of 50% after
storage in air at RT for 25 h (c) and after a subsequent
heating step at 130 C in air for 5 min (k).

1400
1200

Lattice height (nm)

1006

1000
800
600
400
200
0
0.00

0.10

0.20

0.30
2

Exposure energy (J.cm )


Surface relief heights after exposure through a line
mask with periodicities of 5 mm (c), 10 mm (D), and 20 mm
(k). The lms were exposed at RT and heated to 80 C for
5 min, and subsequently to 130 C for another 5 min.
Fig. 19.7.

0.40

19.5 Complex Surface Structures from Interfering UV Laser Beams

the dual-step (80 and 130 C, respectively) reveals that the one-step process is about
as eective as the dual-step procedure. This leads to the conclusion that the balance in diusion and polymerization kinetics is in favor of diusion.

19.4

Dual-exposure Photoembossing

Figure 19.3 has already shown that the surface of the reactive polymer lm remains almost at before the heating step. This is conrmed in Figure 19.6, which
shows that the height of the structures before the heating step, even after prolonged storage at room temperature, remains below 100 nm. The fact that the pristine structures are small means that the optical behavior of the initially at lm is
hardly aected by the exposure. This is very relevant for controlling structure
shape during the exposure step. A surface that deforms redirects the rays of the
masked image, or in other words the surface proles start acting as a lens. But
the fact the surface prole remains almost unaected is of even greater importance
if one wants to employ a second exposure superimposed on the rst one. The procedure to perform this double exposure can be as follows. A rst exposure though
mask 1 is given at a dose somewhat smaller than the dose corresponding to the
maximum prole as shown in Figures 19.6 and 19.7. Then mask 1 is removed
and mask 2 is brought into place while the lm is maintained at room temperature. A second exposure is performed with a dose equal to the dose of the rst
exposure step. The lm now contains the latent images of two masks which will
develop during the heat-diusion step at 80 C or higher. Figure 19.8 shows some
examples of the masks that are used and the resulting surface proles obtained.
The structures that were presented individually in Figures 19.3 and 19.4 are now
superimposed, one on top of the other. The AFM pictures show that the formation
of complex structures is very readily possible and that the second structure is not
hindered in its resolution by the presence of the rst structure. In the experiments
shown, equal doses for the two mask exposure steps are used. Of course, one has
the freedom to choose them dierently and play with the dominance of each mask
step. In the case where UV doses are selected at the maximum sensitivity for a single exposure or higher dose, it must be realized that local overexposure of doubly
exposed areas then lead to smaller features as well.

19.5

Complex Surface Structures from Interfering UV Laser Beams

Patterned irradiation can also be obtained by means of holographic exposure. In


this case two beams (or possibly three or more) coming from a laser are made to
interfere in the area of the sample. In order to do this, a conventional holographic
setup is employed. The s-polarized UV beam (351 nm) from an Ar laser is split in
two equal-intensity beams. These are made to overlap again, obtaining as a result a

1007

1008

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

Mask used for


1st exposure

Mask used for


2nd exposure

AFM of resulted structure

212 nm
0 nm
100 m
100 m

50 m
50 m

p = q = 10 m

0 m 0 m

p = q = 10 m

148 nm
0 nm
100 m
100 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

p = q = 10 m

p = q = 3 m
204 nm
0 nm
100 m
100 m

50 m
50 m
0 m 0 m

p = q = 3 m

p = q = 32 m

150 nm
100 m
100 m

50 m
50 m

p = q = 3 m

p = q = 8 m

Fig. 19.8. Surface relief structures as measured by AFM after


two mask exposures of equal UV doses.

0 m 0 m

19.5 Complex Surface Structures from Interfering UV Laser Beams

Fig. 19.9.

Schematic representation of the holographic setup.

sinusoidal spatial modulation of the light intensity in the interference region (Figure 19.9). The period of the modulation can be adjusted by changing the angle between the two beams. In Figure 19.10 a sinusoidal surface relief grating is shown
with a periodicity of around 1 mm, such as is obtained by exposing the sample to a
holographic interference and subsequently heating to 80 C as described above.
Multiple holographic exposures can also be performed. As an example, Figure
19.11(a) shows a beat structure obtained by sequential exposures with two holographic gratings with close periods. First a holographic grating with a period of
1.5 mm is recorded. Afterward a second one with a period of 1.62 mm is registered.
The subsequent heating step reveals a beat structure with a period of about 20 mm,
the same as the beat that is obtained by addition of the two recorded sinusoidal

Fig. 19.10. Surface relief grating after holographic exposure


and thermal treatment (10 min, 80 C; 10 min, 130 C).

1009

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

Relief height (m)

1010

0.10
0.08
0.06
0.04
0.02
0.00

(a)

10

20

Position (m)

(b)
(a) Surface relief beat structure
due to sequential double holographic exposure
with two grating interference patterns of
dierent periods and equal doses and thermal
Fig. 19.11.

treatment (10 min, 80 C; 10 min, 130 C).


(b) Schematic representation of the result of
the addition of two waves of equal amplitude
but dierent periods, L1 and L2 .

intensity proles, as shown in Figure 19.11(b). In Figure 19.12 we see the result of
exposing a lm with two gratings perpendicular to each other, giving a square lattice.

19.6

Surface Structure Development under Fluids

The formation of surface relief structures starting with a at lm involves an increase in surface, which is counteracted by the free surface energy. Consequently

19.6 Surface Structure Development under Fluids

1011

Fig. 19.12. Surface relief structure due to sequential double


holographic exposure with two orthogonal grating interference
patterns of equal UV doses and thermal treatment (10 min,
80 C; 10 min, 130 C).

2.0

Relief height (m)

Relief height (m)

the surface energy is a limiting factor for the generation of these relief structures
[28]. A new process has been developed to reduce interfacial interactions, favoring
the formation of new surface and achieving in this way enhanced aspect ratios in
the photoembossed structures. The use of a contact uid during the development
of the relief structure enhances the aspect ratio of the photoembossed structures by
a factor almost 2. The eect of this process is shown in Figure 19.13. Irradiation of
the lm is performed through a lithographic mask (transparent and dark lines

1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0

2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
0.0

10

20

30

40

Position (m)
Fig. 19.13. Surface relief heights after exposure through a line
mask with a periodicity of 10 mm and an aperture of 50% after
development: (a) without silicon oil; (b) with silicon oil on top.

10

20
Position (m)

30

40

1012

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers

with a period of 10 mm). After the exposure and before the baking step, half of the
sample is covered with a drop of silicon oil, which wets the photosensitive lm but
does not diuse into it; the other half of the sample remains uncovered. The baking is then performed at 80 C for 10 min, after which the sample is cooled to room
temperature. The silicon oil is removed by rinsing the whole lm with heptane. It
has been checked by infrared spectroscopy of the lm and of the liquids employed
that neither the silicon oil nor the heptane swells or dissolves the photosensitive
lm. The photoembossed structure is xed by a second heating step at 130 C for
another 10 min. Figure 19.13 shows the surface prole of (left) the part cured in air
and (right) the part cured with silicon oil on top and subsequently rinsed with heptane. The relief height is noticeably higher (almost double) in the part cured in
contact with the uid. The dierences in shape of the developed surfaces are also
remarkable. Whereas the surface baked in air shows a rounded top part, as driven
by the minimization of the surface area under the action of the surface tension, the
one baked in contact with the uid shows a atter top part and sharper edges. In
addition, the top at part corresponds quite well to the irradiated region of 5 mm.
By using this special process, relief structures that reproduce the features of the
mask with improved delity have been obtained. The research presented in this
paragraph is patent pending (inventors: Dick Broer, Carlos Sanchez, and Cees Bastiaansen; applicant and owner: Dutch Polymer Institute (DPI)).

19.7

Conclusion

The generation of latent images by adjusting the monomer mobility during the UV
exposure step and the subsequent development of surface structures by polymerization at higher temperatures provide accurate control over polymer surfaces.
The fact that the surface deforms only after the exposure step prevents structure
blur by refraction and diraction defects, and enables multiple exposures, creating
complex surfaces by multiple mask steps before heat development, or by combined
holographic exposures. Reduction of interfacial interactions makes possible to obtain higher aspect ratios and more sharply dened features in the photoembossed
structures.

Acknowledgments

We acknowledge Mrs. G. N. Mol, Mr. H. Nulens, Sasha Alexeev (NT-MDT) and


Dr. B. van de Zande for their help, with the DSC measurements, the AFM measurements, and the interferometric microscope images. The research of Carlos
Sanchez, Cees Bastiaansen, and Dirk Broer forms part of the research program of
the Dutch Polymer Institute (DPI), project DPI#298.

References

Notation

Acronyms
AFM
CD
DPI
DSC
DUV
EB
EUV
FET
LCD
LED
MEMS
SPM

atomic force microscopy


compact disk
Dutch Polymer Institute
dierential scanning calorimetry
deep UV
electron beam
extreme UV
eld-eect transistor
liquid crystal display
light-emitting diode
micro-electromechanical system
scanning probe microscope

References
1 T. Ito, S. Okazaki, Nature, 2000, 406,
2

4
5
6

8
9
10

11

1027.
Y. Xia, J. A. Rogers, K. E. Paul, G. M.
Whitesides, Chem. Rev., 1999, 99,
1823.
P. Ehbets, H. P. Herzig, P. Nussbaum, P. Blattner, R. Dandliker,
Appl. Opt., 1995, 34, 2540.
D. C. Flanders, Appl. Phys. Lett., 1983,
42, 492.
X. T. Li, A. Natansohn, P. Rochon,
Appl. Phys. Lett., 1999, 74, 3791.
Y. B. Boiko, V. S. Solovjev, S.
Calixto, D. J. Lougnot, Appl. Opt.,
1994, 33, 787.
S. T. Han, Y. L. Tsao, R. M. Walser,
M. F. Becker, Appl. Opt., 1992, 31,
2343.
D. Schertler, N. George, Appl. Opt.,
1999, 38, 291.
H. J. Levinson, Principles of Lithography, SPIE, Washington, 2001.
M. Campbell, D. N. Sharp, M. T.
Harrison, R. G. Denning, A. J.
Turbereld, Nature, 2000, 404, 53.
A. K. Bates, M. Rothschild, T. M.
Bloomstein, T. H. Fedynyshyn, R. R.
Kunz, V. Liberman, M. Switkes, IBM
J. Res. Dev., 2001, 45, 605.

12 B. H. Cumpston, S. P. Ananthavel,

13

14

15

16

17
18
19

S. Barlow, D. L. Dyer, J. E. Ehrlich,


L. L. Erskine, A. A. Heikal, S. M.
Kuebler, I.-Y. Sandy Lee, D.
McCord-Maughon, J. Qin, H.
Rockel, M. Rumi, X. L. Wu, S. R.
Marder, J. W. Perry, Nature, 1999,
398, 51.
W. H. Teh, U. Durig, G. Salis, R.
Harbers, U. Drechsler, R. F.
Mahrt, C. G. Smith, H. J. Guntherodt, Appl. Phys. Lett., 2004, 84,
4095.
M. Aktary, M. O. Jensen, K. L.
Westra, M. J. Brett, M. R. Freeman,
J. Vac. Sci. Technol. B, 2003, 21, L5.
S. D. Berger, J. M. Gibson, R. M.
Camarda, R. C. Farrow, H. A.
Huggins, J. S. Kraus, J. A. Liddle, J.
Vac. Sci. Technol. B, 1991, 9, 2996.
W. He, D. B. Poker, K. E. Gonsalves,
N. Batina, Microelectron. Eng., 2003,
65, 153.
M. Heckele, W. K. Schomburg, J.
Micromech. Microeng., 2004, 14, R1.
M. T. Gale, J. Imag. Sci., 1997, 41,
211.
D. Wouters, U. S. Schubert, Angew.
Chem. Int. Ed., 2004, 43, 2480.

1013

1014

19 Nano- and Microstructuring of Polymers


20 D. G. Grier, Nature, 2003, 424, 810.
21 S. H. Park, D. Qin, Y. Xia, Adv.

Mater., 1998, 10, 1028.

30

22 D. Wang, F. Caruso, Adv. Mater.,

2001, 13, 350.


23 G. Widawski, M. Rawiso, B.

Francois, Nature, 1994, 369, 387.

31

24 B. Michel, A. Bernard, A. Bietsch,

25
26

27

28
29

E. Delamarche, M. Geissler, D.
Juncker, H. Kind, J. P. Renault, H.
Rothuizen, H. Schmid, P. SchmidtWinkel, R. Stutz, H. Wolf, IBM J.
Res. Dev., 2001, 45, 697.
Y. Xia, G. M. Whitesides, Angew.
Chem. Int. Ed., 1998, 37, 550.
ller, D. Appelhans,
T. Kratzmu
H.-G. Braun, Adv. Mater., 1999, 11,
555.
C. Croutxe-Barghorn, D. J.
Lougnot, Pure Appl. Opt., 1996, 5,
811.
O. Sakhno, T. Smirnova, Optik,
2002, 113, 130.
T. J. Bunning, L. V. Natarajan, V.
Tondiglia, R. L. Sutherland, D. L.

32

33

34

35

Vezie, W. W. Adams, Polymer, 1995,


36, 2699.
C. F. van Nostrum, R. J. M. Nolte,
D. J. Broer, T. Fuhrman, J. H.
Wendorff, Chem. Mater., 1998, 10,
135.
D. J. Broer, J. Lub, C. F. van
Nostrum, M. M. Wienk, Recent Res.
Dev. Polym. Sci., 1998, 2, 313.
C. M. Leewis, D. P. L. Simons, A. M.
De Jong, D. J. Broer, M. J. A. De
Voigt, Nucl. Instr. Meth. B, 2000, 651,
161.
R. T. Ingwall, D. Waldman,
Holographic Data Storage, Springer,
New York, 2000.
B. M. Monroe, W. K. Smothers, D. E.
Keys, R. R. Krebs, D. J. Mickish, A. F.
Harrington, S. R. Schicker, M. K.
Armstrong, D. M. T. Chan, C.
Weathers, J. Imag. Sci. Technol., 1991,
35, 19.
C. M. Leewis, PhD thesis, Eindhoven
University of Technology, Eindhoven,
2003.

1015

20

Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers1


Peter Schoenmakers and Petra Aarnoutse
20.1

Introduction

Polymer reaction engineers have basically two dierent needs for polymer analysis
[1]: they want to follow the polymerization process, and to characterize the resulting polymer. These two types of analysis can be classied as process analysis and
polymer analysis, respectively; dierent objectives are associated with each of them
(Table 20.1). Process analysis enables the chemical engineer to monitor the polymerization process. For example, (s)he may want to follow the monomer conversion or the polymer molecular weight during the reaction. Process control can be
realized if the results of the process monitoring are translated into specic actions.
Polymer analysis concerns the product that results from the polymerization process. For example, the physical and chemical (molecular) properties may be compared with given specications. The results of such analyses may also be used to
tune the polymerization process, either for future (batch) reactions or during a
continuous polymerization process. Arguably, the ultimate objective of the polymer
reaction engineer is to optimize the polymerization process, using either type of
measurement.
The dierent sets of objectives and requirements for the two types of analysis
imply that they are performed in quite dierent manners. Process analyses are
preferably carried out on-line (in the reactor) or at-line (in the immediate vicinity
of the reactor). Polymer analyses are typically performed in the laboratory. It is
also typical for dierent analytical techniques to be used (Figure 20.1). These will
be discussed in somewhat greater detail in subsequent sections of this chapter. We
will rst discuss the process analysis techniques (bottom left in the gure) in Section 20.2. The polymer analysis techniques will be discussed in Section 20.3.
It should be noted that Figure 20.1 deals with chemical analysis as does the remainder of this chapter. Physical measurements of, for example, the melt viscosity
of a polymeric product are very common (at-line) process monitoring tools, but
they are beyond the scope of the present chapter.
1) The abbreviations used in this chapter are

listed at the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers


Tab. 20.1.

Objectives of the two types of chemical analysis for polymer reaction engineering.

Engineering objectives

R&D objectives

Process analysis

Polymer analysis

process monitoring
process control
process optimization
polymerization mechanism
reaction kinetics
fast response
high precision (repeatability)
representative data

product characterization
product control
process optimization
reaction mechanisms
structureproperty relationships
quality and amount (detail)
of information
(often) high accuracy
(correct information)

Distributions

Analytical objectives

Multidimensional and
Hyphenated systems
Polymer
separations

Detailed molecular
information
Basic information
(e.g. conversion)

1016

NMR spectroscopy
Mass spectrometry
FT-IR
spectroscopy
Raman spectroscopy
Near-IR
spectroscopy

On-line

Monomer concentration (GC or LC)


Gravimetry, Titration

At-line

The main analytical techniques used


in polymer reaction engineering. A distinction
can be made between on-line (process) and
o-line (product) analysis (left to right in the
Fig. 20.1.

Laboratory

gure). On-line techniques typically provide


limited information, whereas more detailed
characterizations can be performed in the
laboratory (bottom to top in the gure).

20.2 Process Analysis

Moreover, this is not meant to be an exhaustive treatment of all the possible


methods of chemical analysis. For example, a very exciting possibility for the direct
monitoring of free-radical polymerization reactions in a research environment is
electron spin resonance (ESR) spectroscopy [2]. This allows a direct measurement
of the concentration of radicals in the reaction mixture. In many cases catalysts
are used in polymerization reactions, and determination of the fate of the catalyst
during the reaction and in the product polymer may require specic analytical
methods. For example, a variety of techniques exist for determining residual traces
of metal catalysts in polymers. These include X-ray uorescence characterization
for solid polymers, and atomic absorption (AAS) and emission (AES) spectrometry
for polymer solutions. The treatment in this chapter stops at the primary product
of the polymerization reaction. Detailed studies on the structure and morphology
of the ultimate polymeric product are assumed to be the domain of polymer technologists, rather than polymer reaction engineers. Methods for analyzing additives
are also beyond the scope of the present chapter.

20.2

Process Analysis

Analyses during a polymerization reaction can be carried out with the aim of
understanding the process (for example, the polymerization mechanism and the
kinetics) or with the aim of process control. The former concerns research measurements, for which the amount of information obtained and the accuracy of the
data are the prevailing criteria. The latter concerns true process analysis and the
response time is a prevailing criterion.
In principle, all kinds of spectroscopic techniques lend themselves to on-line
measurements. Only a very few are practical. Although low-eld NMR has been
used to measure various material properties by applying empirical relationships,
NMR is still not a realistic proposition for on-line measurements. Ironically, FTIR
spectroscopy suers from too much sensitivity. Typically, good spectra can be obtained only from very thin polymeric lms (or solutions). Attenuated total reection (ATR) probes, in which only a fraction of the IR light penetrates a very short
distance into the sample, reduce the problem of excessive sensitivity. However, they
aggravate the problems of variations in the baseline and nonlinear response. The
latter problem also obstructs the use of UV spectrometry for monitoring polymerization reactions. Of the remaining options, near-infrared (NIR) and Raman spectroscopy are the most attractive.
20.2.1

Near-infrared Spectroscopy

Near-infrared (NIR) spectra are not very informative. In comparison with conventional (mid-)IR spectra, they are much less useful for identifying unknown com-

1017

1018

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

pounds and for diagnosing minor variations in the sample. NIR spectra contain
fewer bands and much less resolution. Also, the absorption coecients (sensitivity)
are much lower in the NIR wavelength range (typically 8001200 nm). In contemporary applications of NIR spectroscopy, the lower sensitivity is turned into an advantage: it makes it much easier to deal with the presence of strong IR absorbers,
such as water, and it helps to keep the response strictly linear. Also, the spectra of
individual compounds of a mixture turn out to be perfectly additive in NIR spectroscopy. Finally, unlike mid-IR spectra, NIR spectra typically show plenty of baseline, which is essential for quantitative analysis. Thus NIR spectroscopy is perfect
for on-line analysis in almost all respects. The lack of resolution and of clearly
dened bands for specic components or functionalities remains a distinct disadvantage.
The combination of (near-)perfect linearity and spectral additivity and limited
specicity and resolution makes NIR a perfect match for multivariate calibration
methods or chemometrics. In this case calibration is not based on a single wavelength (band) per component or functional group (one variable, thus univariate),
but on many wavelengths or entire spectra (many variables, thus multivariate).
The resulting spectrum is thought to be a linear combination of the individual
spectra. In most cases, the spectrum corresponding to the desired property is not
known. For example, the number of hydroxyl groups in a polymer can be characterized using NIR and multivariate calibration [3]. This implies that the NIR analysis must be calibrated using a training set of samples with known concentrations.
The latter could be a set of (commercially) available reference materials or, more
commonly, a set of samples that are analyzed in parallel using an absolute (primary) method. The latter must be reliable and validated. Building good calibration models is a critical step in the process. If the sample exceeds the boundaries
of the training set, the NIR results are highly unreliable and may be grossly incorrect. In case of systematic deviations from the training set (for example, when
a dierent catalyst is used in the polymerization process), recalibration is necessary. The advantages of NIR in combination with multivariate calibration (rapid
on-line measurements) must be balanced against the disadvantages of indirect calibration.
NIR has been used to monitor the polymerization of acrylic acid [4], for the solution polymerization of methyl methacrylate (MMA) in toluene [5], for following
the emulsion polymerization of MMA and butyl acrylate [6], and for monitoring
the copolymerization of MMA and N,N-dimethylacrylamide (Figure 20.2) [33]. The
density of linear low-density polyethylene was monitored using NIR and a partial
least-squares (PLS) calibration model [7].
20.2.2

In-situ Raman Spectroscopy

Raman spectroscopy is based not on absorption of light, but on inelastic scattering.


The wavelength of the scattered light is slightly changed because of its interaction

20.2 Process Analysis

Absorbance [A.U.]

1.6

1.2

0.8

0.4
Offset
Correction
0

6000

5000

7000

Wave number [cm1]


Fig. 20.2. Use of NIR spectroscopy in-line
reaction monitoring of copolymerization of
methyl methacrylate and N,Ndimethylacrylamide [33]. Spectrometer:

BOMEM MB 155; the probe was connected to


the spectrometer using optical bers and a
BOMEM optical interface. The gure shows
calibration samples.

with molecules. The information obtained from Raman spectroscopy is in some


ways similar to that from IR spectroscopy (wavelength shifts in the micrometer
range) and in some ways very dierent (dierent selection rules). For example,
water is an infamous interference in mid-IR spectroscopy, but it is not detectable
by Raman spectroscopy. Raman spectroscopy shares some of the advantages of
NIR spectroscopy. It combines a relatively low sensitivity with a good linearity,
rendering it compatible with multivariate calibration. An advantage of Raman in
comparison with NIR is the much greater spectral resolution (narrower spectral
bands).
The greatest disadvantage of Raman spectroscopy in the analysis of polymers
and the monitoring of polymer reactions is the occurrence of uorescence, which
manifests itself as disturbances in the spectral background. Raman spectroscopy is
a relatively insensitive technique and because in light-scattering measurements
(other than absorption measurements) the sensitivity increases with the intensity
of the light source, lasers are commonly used in Raman spectroscopy. This also
implies that the incident wavelength is very well dened. In general, uorescence
eects are strongest at short wavelengths. Traditionally, Raman spectroscopy is performed with lasers in the visible range as primary light sources. In FT-Raman nearIR lasers are employed, which give rise to much less uorescence (Figure 20.3).
An attractive compromise is the use of a 785 nm laser, which reduces uorescence
while oering greater sensitivity than NIR lasers.

1019

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers


-3

4.5

x 10

Arbitrary Raman Intensity

1020

styrene
1,3-butadiene

3.5
3
2.5
2

poly(butadiene)
1.5
1
0.5
0
1610

1620

1630

1640

1650

1660

1670

Wavenumber

(cm-1)

1680

1690

1700

FT-Raman spectra recorded during copolymerization


of 1,3-butadiene and styrene [34]. Spectrometer: Bruker IFS66
FTIR/FT-Raman spectrometer with Nd:YAG laser (1.5 W,
1064 nm), N2 -cooled Ge detector. Early stages of the reaction
(only polybutadiene homopolymer formed).
Fig. 20.3.

20.2.3

At-line Conversion Measurements

Although chromatography is an incredibly versatile (set of ) technique(s) for performing analytical separations and quantitative analyses, the typical nature of a
polymerization mixture, containing both high molecular weight polymers and low
molecular weight monomers, causes serious complications. Polymer-containing
samples cannot be injected easily into simple gas chromatographs, because the
injector or, worse, the column will be seriously contaminated. Although several
elegant solutions exist (see Section 20.3.1.1), these cannot easily be implemented
and applied in at-line situations.
Liquid chromatography systems can deal more easily with the combination of
large and small molecules. Size exclusion chromatography (SEC; also known as
gel permeation chromatography, GPC) is especially suited for the analysis of polymers, which are separated on the basis of their size in solution. Therefore, SEC is

20.2 Process Analysis

Fig. 20.4. Use of SEC for conversion measurements.


Chromatograms of two polystyrene (Acros Organics,
Mw 1:4  10 5 g mol1 , PDI 2:6) calibration samples
(conversion x 0:027 and x 0:401). Reprinted from Ref. [8].

often used for measuring molecular weight distributions (see Section 20.3.3.1).
The mechanism underlying SEC separations concerns the partial exclusion of
larger molecules from pores of the packing material. By inserting a column with
very small pores (an oligomer column) in the separation system, it is possible
to create sucient selectivity between the monomers and the smallest oligomers
present in the reaction mixture. If suitable detectors (suciently sensitive and,
ideally, linear) can be found for both the polymer and the monomer, then the conversion can be elegantly measured by on-line SEC. The polymerization of styrene
is a good example (Figure 20.4) [8]. In this case, UV detection can be used conveniently.
There has been a recent trend toward performing fast SEC separations [9], inspired by the developments in combinatorial (polymer) chemistry and the associated high-throughput experimentation. Fast SEC allows molecular weight distributions to be measured in one or two minutes. From both a practical and a
theoretical point of view, the possibilities for fast SEC are much greater than was
commonly believed until very recently. Fast SEC oers less resolution than conventional SEC. It only oers a rough picture of the MWD and it can only be applied to
broadly distributed polymers. Yet the developments in fast SEC make it a feasible
technique for determining molecular weight distributions at-line.

1021

1022

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

20.3

Polymer Analysis
20.3.1

Basic Laboratory Measurements


Conversion
In the laboratory, residual monomer concentrations are typically measured by
some kind of chromatographic analysis; whether this is gas chromatography (GC)
or liquid chromatography (LC) depends largely on the type(s) of monomers used in
the polymerization process. Monomers that are gases or highly volatile liquids (for
example, alkenes, vinyl chloride, acrylonitrile) or UV-inactive (for example, acrylates) are not readily compatible with LC. On the other hand, nonvolatile monomers
(for example, diacids, diamines, bisphenol A) are not amenable to GC.
When GC is being used, possible contamination of the system (injector and column) with nonvolatile polymeric material is the main issue. One option is to allow
direct introduction of a polymer-containing sample (solution), but to conne the
polymer to a removable part (liner) of the injection system. On some injection
systems (specically programmable-temperature vaporizers, or PTVs), a series of
injections may be performed before the quantitative analysis of monomer is jeopardized and the liner needs to be replaced. Such an approach may be acceptable if
20.3.1.1

Fig. 20.5. Individual conversion proles of


methyl methacrylate (s) and vinylidene
chloride (c) in the batch solution
copolymerization of methyl methacrylate and

vinylidene chloride in dimethylformamide,


estimated by GC measurements of the vapor
composition of the reactor head space [35].

20.3 Polymer Analysis

the total number of analyses that need to be performed is fairly small. Another,
much more sophisticated, option is the on-line coupling of an LC separation of
polymer and monomer (for example, using size exclusion chromatography; see
Section 20.2.3) with a GC analysis [10]. A fully automated system may be built
that allows large numbers of samples to be analyzed. However, LC-GC systems
are complicated to develop and to use in practice. High-level expertise is required
if one is to opt for such a solution.
An easier solution, that also allows complete automation, is head-space GC.
An example is shown in Figure 20.5. This technique is based on measuring volatile components from the vapor phase above a nonvolatile matrix. In this case a
polymer-containing sample in a vial is placed in the system. The sample may be a
solid or a (viscous) liquid. In this case, the presence of a large amount of volatile
solvent may be a disadvantage. Water, especially, may cause insurmountable problems. In head-space GC the vapor phase may be analyzed after equilibrium with
the sample has been established (static head-space), or the sample may be purged
continuously and all volatile materials may be trapped at the column inlet, to be
released from there at the beginning of the analysis (purge and trap or dynamic
head-space). Head-space analysis (especially in the static mode) requires careful
calibration and validation, but once it is in operation fully automatic analyses can
be performed with relative ease.
20.3.2

Detailed Molecular Analysis


FTIR Spectroscopy
Infrared spectroscopy has long been one of the stalwarts of polymer analysis. One
reason is that polymers and IR spectroscopy are highly compatible. As a case in
point, thin lms of polystyrene have been used for many years as a reference sample for calibrating the wavelength scale of conventional IR spectrometers. In most
laboratories, conventional (dispersive) IR spectrometers have been replaced by
contemporary Fourier transform instruments. The latter typically yield a higher
resolution, a higher sensitivity, and a greater wavelength accuracy. The advent of
FTIR has spurred on the development of highly sensitive measurements on small
samples (for example, FTIR microscopy) and of very fast measurements.
The range of information that can be obtained from FTIR measurements is
summarized in Table 20.2. FTIR is still often used in polymer analysis, because
the measurements are easy and fast and because many dierent types of polymeric
samples can be measured with a minimum of sample preparation. However, FTIR
spectroscopy also has its weak points. The resolution in the spectra is usually not
limited by the quality of the spectrometer, but by the properties of the sample. In
samples of polymers many bands usually overlap and, while band assignments are
usually possible, the quantication of overlapping bands is dicult and prone to
errors. One signicant source of error is variation in the baseline of FTIR spectra.
Such variations can be attributed to the fact that in FTIR spectrometers the baseline and the sample are not measured simultaneously. Also, spectral artefacts, such
20.3.2.1

1023

1024

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers


Tab. 20.2.

Information that may be obtained from FTIR spectroscopy.

Type of information

Comments

Chemical composition

clear evidence on presence or absence of specic


functional groups
rapid conrmation of structure
chemical composition of copolymers, but
quantication can be dicult
useful only for low MW polymers
direct measurements on polymer lms
thicker objects though ATR or specular reection
(surface characterization)
easy characterization of powders (DRIFT)
IR microscopy for small spots
imaging techniques are emerging

End groups
Characterization of polymers
in many dierent forms

as scattering by the sample, may result in changes in the baseline. Other problems
are possible nonlinearity in absorbance (or reectance) versus concentration curves
and the large dierences in sensitivity for dierent absorption bands. In fact, nearIR spectroscopy is often preferred for routine quantitative measurements, because fewer problems are encountered with the linearity and with establishing the
baseline.
NMR Spectroscopy
Nuclear magnetic resonance spectroscopy probes the spins of specic atomic nuclei in a strong magnetic eld. The spin can be changed at very specic (resonance)
frequencies, which depend on the chemical environment of the nucleus. Thus,
NMR spectra provide very detailed chemical information on the structure of molecules (Table 20.3). The dierences between the spin energy levels (with and against
the magnetic eld) are very small. This implies that the spins are almost evenly
distributed across the dierent levels (Boltzmanns law). Therefore, NMR is an
insensitive technique. The dierence between the energy levels, and thus the difference between the populations of the dierent levels, and hence the sensitivity
of the NMR measurements, can be increased by increasing the eld strength.
Therefore there is a continuous trend toward ever-higher eld strengths (and evercostlier instruments) in NMR spectroscopy. This is especially the case since (in solution NMR) the resolution also increases with increasing eld strength. The two
most common nuclei that are studied in NMR spectroscopy are protons ( 1 H) and
carbon ( 13 C). The former has a natural abundance of almost 100%, but 13 C represents only about 1% of the carbon population. If only because 12 C cannot be observed by NMR spectroscopy, the sensitivity of carbon-NMR is signicantly lower
than that of proton-NMR.
NMR spectroscopy yields quantitative data on the number of protons or (with
some precautions) carbon atoms that have a certain chemical environment. This
can be directly translated into chemical composition data (see Figure 20.6). For ex20.3.2.2

20.3 Polymer Analysis


Tab. 20.3.

Information that may be obtained from NMR spectroscopy.

Type of information

Comments

Chemical composition

highly detailed information on chemical structure and


composition
accurate quantitative data (% of specic protons; % of
specic carbon atoms) at levels above about 1%
good, quantitative information on average chain
regularity (tacticity)
information on branching (at high branching levels)
easy distinction between random and block copolymers;
some information on average block length
information on network mobility
some information on polymer morphology
solution NMR gives the best resolution
solid-state NMR (powders, particles, or small objects)
routinely possible
polymer melts studied occasionally

Molecular architecture

Physical structure
Polymers in various forms

ample, the numbers of aromatic and aliphatic protons in a copolymer of styrene


and isobutene unambiguously dene the chemical composition. Much more detailed information is revealed by NMR spectroscopy about the specic structure of
the polymer. Many dierent measurement techniques have been developed that
reveal intricate details about the molecular structure [11], but these are beyond
the scope of the current chapter.
NMR spectroscopy can be used to study polymers in solution (solution NMR) or
as such (solid-state NMR). In the latter case, the resolution is typically much lower,
mainly because of sample anisotropy. To improve the resolution in solid-state NMR
the sample can be spun at a high frequency (in the kilohertz range) and at a
specic (magic) angle (54 ) relative to the magnetic eld. The sensitivity can be
increased by transferring magnetization from 1 H to 13 C nuclei. The resulting technique is referred to as cross-polarization magic-angle spinning NMR (CP-MASNMR).
Mass Spectrometry
Whereas (FT)IR and NMR spectroscopy have been essential tools for polymer analysis for decades, mass spectrometry (MS) only became truly relevant in the later
1990s, and the number of mass spectrometers in polymer analysis laboratories is
now increasing rapidly. Our current ability to characterize (very) large molecules
successfully can be seen as a small miracle. In many cases, we are now able to ionize polymer molecules and to transport large molecular ions through magnetic or
electric elds with great integrity. The possibilities of contemporary MS are fantastic. However, one must be aware that there are still severe limitations. The possibilities and limitations of polymer MS will be briey reviewed in this section.
MS has been used in polymer analysis for many years, but these techniques
20.3.2.3

1025

1026

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

Fig. 20.6. 188 MHz 13 C NMR spectra of poly(n-butyl acrylateco-carbon monoxide-co-ethylene) samples with dierent
monomer compositions (indicated in the gure) [36].

have relied on destruction of the polymer into smaller pieces or fragments.


Pyrolysis-GC-MS is a conventional method for polymer analysis and characterization. The pyrolysis stage yields small, uncharged fragments of the polymer, such
as residual monomers, which can be separated by gas chromatography (GC) and
identied by MS. Pyrolysis-GC-MS yields useful information on the composition
of (co)polymers, the presence of additives, and suchlike. However, the results are
dicult to quantify. Similarly, in secondary-ion mass spectrometry (SIMS), the
polymer is rst fragmented using a beam of primary ions. The resulting fragments
are charged and these fragments are subsequently analyzed by MS. SIMS can yield
very useful (organic chemical) information on polymer surfaces (static SIMS), or it
can yield depth proles of materials (dynamic SIMS). In these conventional applications of MS in polymer engineering, only information on molecular fragments is
obtained, but none on the intact polymer molecules.

20.3 Polymer Analysis

The main breakthrough in polymer MS has been the development of soft ionization methods. This implies that molecular ions are obtained and characterized.
During the formation of molecular ions, small ions (such as H ) may be abstracted from the molecule, or adducts may be formed with small ions (for example, Na ), but no fragmentation occurs and the resulting ion is highly representative
of the original polymeric molecule. Two important soft ionization techniques have
emerged in recent years, namely electrospray ionization (ESI) and matrix-assisted
laser desorption ionization (MALDI).
Electrospray ionization (ESI) ESI requires a polymer solution to be pumped
into the mass spectrometer, either as such or, conveniently, after a liquidchromatographic separation. In the latter case, a narrow, pre-separated fraction of
the polymer is introduced into the mass specrometer, which greatly enhances the
chances of obtaining useful mass spectra. The liquid is sprayed into the ionization
chamber under the simultaneous action of an electric eld of several kilovolts. The
solvent should have a signicant polarity and some ionic additives (salt or buer)
are typically present. It is not strictly necessary for the polymer itself to be dissolved in this polar solvent. Good results have been obtained by adding a separate
(immiscible) stream of solvent to the polymer solution through a T-piece just before the ESI interface [12].
The exact mechanism by which charged molecular ions are ultimately obtained
from the polymer solution has not yet been elucidated unequivocally. The spray is
formed at atmospheric pressure, but then passed into the vacuum part of the ionization chamber, where the volatile components evaporate. This may result in a
concentration of (nonvolatile) ions in very small droplets, which then become unstable and explode to yield a series of individual ions, including the charged polymers. An alternative mechanism, which seems to be supported by the fact that the
polar, salt-containing solvent does not need to be miscible with the polymer solution, entails the complete evaporation of all solvents, followed by ionization of the
polymer molecules in the gas phase.
In any case, molecular ions are formed that contain one (singly charged ions)
or more charges. The fact that multiply charged ions are being formed makes it
easier to analyze molecular ions of high molecular weight, because the behavior
of ions in mass spectrometers is determined by the mass-to-charge ratio (m=z)
rather than by the absolute mass. However, the presence of multiply charged ions
may signicantly complicate the resulting mass spectra and their interpretation.
Figure 20.7 shows an example of the application of ESI-MS for polymer analysis.
Table 20.4 summarizes the information that can be obtained using this technique.
Matrix-assisted laser desorption ionization (MALDI) In MALDI, the polymer is
mixed intensively (usually from a solution) with a matrix, and possibly with other
additives such as a salt. It is then deposited as a small spot on a target (MALDI
plate). The deposited mixture is irradiated by a laser pulse. The matrix is selected
such that it strongly adsorbs the laser light, heats up very rapidly, and induces the
transfer of a single charge (usually an adduct ion) to the polymer molecule. The

1027

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

Extracted masses for every scan

3000

2500

2000
mass value

1028

1500

1000

500

0
0

20

40

60

Fig. 20.7. Characterization of peruoropolyethers by on-line LC-ESI-MS [12]. LC


conditions: Column: Nucleosil silica (5 mm),
150 mm  2.1 mm i.d.; mobile phase:
0.120% methyl-t-butyl ether in 1,1,2trichlorotriuoroethane in 15 min; mass
spectrometry: Micromass time-of-ight MS

Tab. 20.4.

80
scan #

100

120

140

operated in negative-ion mode; capillary


voltage: 3 kV; desolvation temperature: 350 C;
source temperature: 120 C; cone-gas ow rate:
30 L h1 ; desolvation gas ow rate: 350 L h1 .
ESI coniditions: 20 mL min1 50:50 isopropanol/water added post-column; cone voltage: 50 V.

Information that may be obtained from ESI-MS.

Type of information

Comments

Absolute mass of molecular ions

limited to polar polymers with molecular weight below


ca. 25 kDa
structural formulas may be obtained in the case of highresolution MS
only for (homo)polymers with a very narrow
distribution in terms of molecular weight, chemical
composition, and type of functionality
prior separations (e.g., SEC, LC) allow analysis of more
broadly distributed polymers by ESI-MS
can be obtained from series of MS peaks (one of more
dierent end groups)
may be complicated by adduct ions
may be facilitated by high-resolution MS

Molecular-weight distribution

Combined mass of end groups


(homopolymers)

20.3 Polymer Analysis

resulting spectra are quite variable in terms of the observed ions and their intensities, but representative spectra can be obtained by summing or averaging the
spectra resulting from a large number of pulses. Only singly charged ions are observed and there is usually little or no fragmentation, although MALDI is often
found to be slightly less soft (that is, more likely to induce fragmentation) than
ESI [13].
Polymers that are amenable to MALDI must have some degree of polarity
polyethene and polypropene are still essentially incompatible with the technique.
Another essential requirement is that the polymers be narrowly distributed in
terms of molecular weight, chemical composition, and functionality. If the molecular weight distribution is not very narrow, then the smallest molecules will be
over-represented in the resulting mass spectrum (discrimination). If one type of
molecule is abundant, it may dominate the entire mass spectrum, completely suppressing the ionization of polymeric components present in lower concentrations
(ion suppression). Selective ionization may also be observed in the case of variations in functional groups or end groups.
MALDI cannot easily be coupled on-line to separation techniques such as liquid
chromatography (LC), but it can be elegantly coupled o-line. Because of the high
sensitivity of MALDI, one drop of LC euent may be sucient to prepare excellent
MALDI spots.
Table 20.5 summarizes the information that can be obtained using this technique.
Types of mass analyzers There are quite a few dierent types of mass analyzers.
Conventional high-resolution MS exploits magnetic-sector instruments. Quadrupole instruments have become the aordable standard for the analysis of fairly
small components (up to about 1000 Da), although ion-trap systems have some
specic advantages, such as the possibility of performing high-sensitivity tan-

Tab. 20.5.

Information that may be obtained from MALDI-MS.

Type of information

Comments

Absolute mass of molecular ions

limited to polymers with a certain minimum polarity,


up to quite high molecular weights, provided that
the sample is very narrowly distributed
only for (homo)polymers with a very narrow
distribution in terms of molecular weight, chemical
composition, and type of functionality
prior separations (e.g., SEC, LC; usually carried out
o-line) allow analysis of more broadly distributed
polymers by MALDI-MS
can be obtained from series of MS peaks (one of more
dierent end groups)
may be complicated by adduct ions or fragmentation
may be facilitated by high-resolution MS

Molecular weight distribution

Combined mass of end groups


(homopolymers)

1029

1030

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

dem MS (MS-MS) or multiple MS (MS n ) experiments with relative ease. The big
brother of the ion-trap instrument, the Fourier transform ioncyclotron resonance
(FT-ICR-MS, or simply FT-MS) spectrometer, oers extremely high resolution. It
has been gaining popularity, mainly thanks to the great advances made in protein
MS since the mid-1990s. However, use of FT-MS instruments is still the prerogative of the elite few.
In contrast, another type of mass analyzer that was quite uncommon until recently is now proliferating rapidly in the eld of polymer MS. Time-of-ight (ToF)
analyzers are based on the principle of measuring the time a specic ion requires
to travel a given length (in vacuum). The ight time is directly related to the m=z
value. The mass range of ToF analyzers is not fundamentally limited. Thus, polymers of very high molecular weight can be analyzed after soft ionization. ToF analyzers are now the preferred type of instrument for the characterization of (natural
and synthetic) macromolecules, in combination both with ESI and with MALDI.
ToF combines a high sensitivity (due to a favorable duty cycle) with a broad mass
range and a high spectral resolution and accuracy. High-resolution versions of ToF
analyzers exploit the so-called reectron mode, in which the length of the ight
path is doubled. In addition, ToF-MS instruments have become much more accessible and much more aordable in recent years. An example of the MALDI-ToFMS technique is shown in Figure 20.8.
20.3.3

Polymer Distributions

There are many ways to measure the average properties of a polymeric sample.
These will not be discussed extensively in this chapter. Among the techniques
used to measure average molecular weights are those that yield number averages
Mn , such as end-group titrations and end-group analysis by NMR. Such techniques work best at relatively low molecular weights. Static light scattering yields
a direct estimate of the weight-average molecular weight Mw . It works best for
relatively high molecular weights (above ca. 20 kDa). Measurement of the intrinsic
viscosity may be used to obtain the viscosity-average molecular weight Mv . If the
entire molecular weight distribution is measured, then all the desired averages and
the sample polydispersity (PDI Mw =Mn ) can be readily calculated.
Molecular Weight Distributions
The most important molecular distribution is the molecular weight distribution
(MWD) or, equivalently, the molar mass distribution (MMD). Size exclusion chromatography (SEC; also known as gel permeation chromatography, GPC) is the outstanding technique for measuring the MWD. In SEC, the retention time is related
to the molecular weight by constructing a suitable calibration curve (Figure 20.9)
based on the retention times (or volumes) of a set of narrowly distributed standards of known molecular weight. SEC separates on the basis of the size of molecules in solution (the hydrodynamic volume), rather than on the molecular weight.
Thus, to measure accurate (in SEC terminology, absolute) molecular weights, it
20.3.3.1

20.3 Polymer Analysis


100

Intensity (%)

104.1

104.1

788.0

1216.8

1645.6

2074.4

2503.2

2932.0

2402

2945

3488

Mass (amu)

Intensity (%)

100

104.1
104.1
104.1

773

1316

1859

Mass (amu)
MALDI-TOF-MS spectra of
polystyrenes, reective positive-ion mode,
DCTB as matrix and Ag as a cationization
agent. Top: PS with two dierent end groups or
Fig. 20.8.

adduct ions. The two dierent series of peaks


dier by 104.1 amu, the mass of one repeat
unit styrene. Bottom: PS with four dierent end
groups [37].

is necessary that the calibration standards be chemically identical to the sample


polymer. Polystyrene standards should be used to construct a calibration curve for
polystyrene samples, PMMA standards for PMMA samples, and so on.
Unfortunately, suitable standards are not available for all polymers. For a number of homopolymers suitable standards are commercially available. However, for
copolymers it is notoriously dicult to determine absolute molecular weights by
SEC. Even if copolymer standards were available, there are many dierent molecules (dierent combinations of molecular weight and chemical composition) that
exhibit the same hydrodynamic volume. Also, the size of polymer molecules in
solution is aected signicantly by other properties, for example the degree of
branching. For these reasons, SEC is often used to measure molecular weight
distributions relative to dierent standards, such as polystyrene. Such relative
measurements may be perfectly adequate for many purposes. For example, for
monitoring polymerization reactions and product specications the precision (repeatability) of the data tends to be much more important than their accuracy.

1031

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

10M

Polystyrene Molecular Weight

1032

1M
106
105

100K
104
10K

103
500
100

1K

50

100
4

Elution volume (ml)

10

SEC calibration curves for a series of columns with


dierent pore sizes (Polymer Laboratories, Church, Stretton,
Shropshire, UK; www.polymerlabs.com/gpc). Dierent columns
show good selectivity (shallow curves) across dierent
molecular weight ranges.
Fig. 20.9.

Detectors for size exclusion chromatography The most common detectors used in
SEC are the UV absorbance detector (for polymer molecules that possess chromophores) and the (dierential) refractive index detector (DRI or RI) for polymers that
do not (see Table 20.6). The latter is less convenient to use in practice, and less
sensitive. Therefore, the evaporative light-scattering detector (ELSD) is used increasingly for characterizing non-UV-active polymers at low concentrations (for
example, polymeric contaminants or polymers separated by comprehensive twodimensional liquid chromatography). A serious disadvantage of the latter detector
is that its response increases exponentially with increasing polymer concentration
and is, therefore, highly nonlinear. The response of the ELSD also tends to vary
more strongly with the molecular weight of the sample polymer than those of the
UV and DRI detectors.
A very important option is the combination of SEC with techniques that allow
direct measurement of molecular weight, such as viscometry or light scattering
(Table 20.7). This in principle eliminates the need for narrow standards of exactly the same polymer, and it alleviates the requirements on the SEC system, because slight variations in retention times due to variations in the ow rate or interactions with the column can be negotiated. This is true for viscometric detection,
provided that accurate MarkHouwink constants (K and a) are available to trans-

20.3 Polymer Analysis


Tab. 20.6.

General (concentration-sensitive) detectors for size exclusion chromatography.

Detector

Abbrev.

Strong points

Weak points

UV absorbance

UV

(Dierential) refractive
index

(D)RI

sensitive
highly linear
universal
(all polymers)

Evaporative light
scattering

ELSD

only applicable for UV-absorbing


polymers
not very sensitive
strong solvent signal
sensitive to temperature variations
needs reference cell
nonlinear response
response depends on polymer structure
and molecular weight

Tab. 20.7.

universal
(all polymers)
highly sensitive

Specic (molar mass sensitive) detectors for size exclusion chromatography.

Detector

Abbrev.

Strong points

Weak points

Viscometry

Vis

Light scattering
low angle
right angle
triple angle
multi-angle

LALS[a]
RALS
TrALS
MALS

applicable only for M > (ca.)


5000
accuracy relies on accuracy
of MarkHouwink
constants or on quality of
SEC measurements
sensitive to calibration
parameters (especially the
refractive index increment
dn/dc)
tedious calibration
procedure

Mass spectrometry
electrospray
ionization[b]

ESI

direct measurement of
intrinsic viscosity
absolute MW using Mark
Houwink constants or
the universal calibration
principle
direct measurement of Mw
(for M > (ca.) 10 000)
multi-angle LS provides
direct measurement of
the root-mean-square
radius (for M > (ca.)
50 000)
absolute molecular-weight
measurement
information on end groups

Matrix-assisted laser
desorption/
ionization[c]

MALDI

absolute molecular weight


measurement
information on end groups
applicable to narrowly
distributed polymers up
to very high M

only applicable to polar


polymers
multiple ionization
complicates spectra
best for M < (ca.) 20 000
only applicable to
moderately or highly
polar polymers
(very) narrowly distributed
samples are required (in
terms of MWD, FTD, etc.)

[a] Sometimes called low-angle laser light scattering (LALLS).


Analogously, RALLS, TrALLS and MALLS may be found.
[b] Electrospray ionization mass spectrometry can be coupled on-line
with SEC. However, this does require a miniaturized SEC system (ow
rate < 100 mL min1 ) or a ow splitting device after the SEC column.
[c] MALDI is usually combined o-line with SEC. Samples from the
euent can be collected manually or by using a fraction collector.
Devices to facilitate deposition directly from the SEC system onto a
MALDI target plate are commercially available.

1033

1034

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

late the measured intrinsic viscosity ([h]) for the specic polymer (in the specic
solvent used and at the specic temperature of operation) into the molecular
weight through M Kha . When measuring the light scattered by the polymer solution to obtain the (weight-average) molar mass, the refractive index increment
(dn/dc) of the specic polymer in the specic solvent (at the temperature of operation) must be accurately known. Both an on-line viscometer and a light-scattering
instrument must be calibrated using known standards.
Both viscometry and light scattering require an independent measurement of the
concentration of the polymer. For this purpose, one of the concentration-sensitive
detectors (most often refractive index detection) is used in combination with the
molecular weight selective detector. Using a combination of several detectors is
common practice in SEC. A particularly powerful combination is to use refractive
index detection (to measure concentration), viscometry (to measure the intrinsic
viscosity), and light-scattering detection (to measure molecular weight), all together.
A RALS detector is typically used instead of a MALS detector. Therefore, the rootmean-square radius of the polymer in solution cannot be measured directly and
the molecular weight of large polymer molecules (M > 100 000) requires an iterative correction procedure.
The on-line combination of SEC with electrospray ionization MS (SEC-ESIMS) and the o-line combination of SEC with matrix-assisted laser desorption/
ionization (SEC//MALDI-MS) are relatively recent possibilities. For the time being,
SEC-ESI-MS is limited to polar polymers of relatively low molecular weight. In
contrast, SEC//MALDI-MS is applicable to almost all polymers (polyethylene
and polypropylene being the most notable exceptions), up to very high molecular
weights. The main requirement is that the polymer samples subjected to MALDI
should be narrowly distributed in terms of molecular weight, chemical composition, and functionality. The major problems of MALDI are discrimination and ion
suppression. Discrimination implies that the sensitivity (response) of the MALDIToF-MS system varies with properties (for example, molecular weight, functionality) of the polymer molecules. Ion suppression occurs when a particular type of ion
is present in a very high concentration and the sensitivity of less prevalent ions is
(dramatically) reduced. Because MALDI requires narrowly distributed samples and
because it is a very sensitive analytical technique, its (o-line) combination with
chromatographic separations is highly attractive.
Functionality-type Distributions
Size exclusion chromatography can be used to separate polymer molecules according to their size in solution, and size can be converted to molecular weight by calibration. SEC cannot be used to separate polymers according to chemical composition or functionality. For this purpose, interactive liquid chromatography (i-LC)
may be used. In i-LC the molecules of the analyte polymers interact with the mobile phase and with the stationary phase in the column. Usually, thermodynamic
equilibrium is reached at any point in the column. The distribution of the polymer
molecules across the two phases can then be characterized by a distribution coecient (K c s =c m , where c s is the concentration of the polymer in the stationary
20.3.3.2

20.3 Polymer Analysis

phase and c m is its concentration in the mobile phase). The retention factor (k) is
proportional to the distribution coecient and to the phase ratio [Eq. (1), where VR
is the retention volume, tR the retention time, V0 is the column hold-up volume, t 0
the column hold-up time, Vs the volume of stationary phase in the column, and
Vm the volume of mobile phase.]
k

VR  V0 tR  t 0
Vs

K
V0
t0
Vm

Retention in i-LC is thus directly related to the thermodynamic distribution coecient. K can be expressed in terms of fundamental thermodynamic properties, that
is, the partial molar free energy associated with the transfer of one mole of analyte
from the mobile phase to the stationary phase (Dg), the corresponding partial molar enthalpy, and the corresponding entropy eect (Ds), according to Eq. (2), where
R is the gas constant and T the absolute temperature.
RT ln K Dg Dh TDs

Enthalpic (heat) eects arising from molecular interactions are reected in Dh.
SEC is a strictly entropic process; that is, Dh 0 and temperature has no signicant eect on the elution volume.
Separation between chemically dierent polymers can be achieved if dierent
parts of the molecules (dierent co-monomers, end groups, functional groups) exhibit dierent interactions with the mobile phase and the stationary phase in the
column. We can rewrite Eq. (2) for a homopolymer as Eq. (3), where we assume
that the partial molar free energy is built up from p contributions of monomeric
units ( p being the degree of polymerization) and the sum of all contributions
from end groups (or functional groups).
RT ln K Dg pDgmonomer 

Dgend groups

Because p is a large number for high Mr polymers, reasonable distribution coecients (and, therefore, reasonable retention factors) can usually be obtained only if
Dgmonomer A 0.
A special case is the situation in which Dgmonomer 0. In this case the distribution coecients and chromatographic retention factors are determined only by the
functional groups and they are independent of the chain length ( p). This situation
is known as liquid chromatography at the critical conditions or, simply, as critical
chromatography. It is eminently suitable for separating polymers based on functionality. Figure 20.10 shows examples of the separation of functional poly(methyl
methacrylate)s [14, 18]. All PMMA molecules without OH groups are eluted with a
retention time of around 4 min in Fig. 20.10(a), irrespective of the molecular
weight and (possible) other end groups present (provided that the Dg values for
all the end groups other than OH are either negligibly small or very similar). The
polymers with one OH end group are all eluted at around 5 min and the bifunc-

1035

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

HO-PMMA-OH (MD-1000X)

ELSD response

PMMA-OH 20,740
PMMA-OH 3,310
PMMA 28,300

PMMA 3,800

6
7
Time (min)

10
(a)

V37A1

V37A0

ELSD response

1036

V37A
V37B1
V37B0

V37B2

Time (min)
Fig. 20.10. (a) Separation of end-functional
poly(methyl methacrylate)s based on the
number of end groups. Column: 150 mm
long  4.6 mm i.d., home-packed with Hypersil
silica (3 mm particles, 100 A pore size); mobile
phase: 43% acetonitrile in dichloromethane;
temperature: 25 C; ow rate: 0.5 mL min1 ;

V37B
5

(b)
injection volume: 10 mL; sample concentration:
1 mg mL1 in dichloromethane; detector:
evaporative light scattering [14]. (b) Separation
of end-functional PMMAs prepared by RAFT
polymerization [18]. Mobile phase: 40%
acetonitrile in dichloromethane; other
conditions as in (a).

20.3 Polymer Analysis

tional (telechelic) PMMAs are eluted at around 8 min in Fig. 20.10(a). The elution proles of real samples can be translated into a functionality-type distribution
(FTD), provided the detector is suitably calibrated [1517].
The separation shown in Fig.10(a) has proven to be quite robust. However, this
is not usually the case for critical separations. Indeed, for carboxyl-functionalized
poly(n-butyl acrylates) it proved much more dicult to achieve genuine critical
chromatography [19]. Critical liquid chromatographic separations are not always
easy, but they can be highly rewarding, especially for determining FTDs.
Mass spectrometry (ESI-MS and MALDI-ToF-MS) is very useful for obtaining information on the total masses of various end group combinations present. In this
case Eq. (4) holds, where Mion is the observed mass for the polymeric ion, p is the
degree of polymerization, Mmon is the mass of the monomeric unit, Madduct is the
mass of the adduct ion (typically added as a salt to the matrix/polymer mixture)
P
and
Mendgroup is the sum of the masses of the end groups.
Mion pMmon Madduct

Mendgroup

Very accurate and precise values of Mmon and Mendgroup can be obtained by MALDI.
Complicating factors are:
P
uncertainty in the true end group mass, which may equal
Mendgroup , but also
P
Mendgroup nMmon (where n is an integer);
 the (broad) isotope pattern of large polymers, which, if not properly accounted
P
for, may cause errors in the values obtained for
Mendgroup;
 the possibility that several dierent end group combinations yield exactly or
P
nearly the same value for
Mendgroup.


It is very dicult to obtain quantitative FTDs by MS. Because the response factors
are usually dierent for polymers with dierent end groups, highly specic reference materials (of accurately known composition) would be required.
In some cases capillary (zone) electrophoresis can be elegantly used to separate
polymers according to functionality, and to obtain accurate FTDs. This is especially
the case if the end groups are charged (in a suitable buer solution) or if they can
be derivatized to yield ionizable groups. Under suitable conditions, the eect of
the molecular charge on the electrophoretic mobility can be much greater than
the eect of the molecular weight [20].
Chemical Composition Distributions (CCDs)
For a copolymer, Eq. (3) becomes Eq. (5), where the subscript i depicts the dierent
monomeric units.
20.3.3.3

RT ln K Dg 

X
i

pi Dgmonomer; i 

Dg end groups

1037

1038

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

It is dicult to achieve Dgmonomer; i 0 for one particular monomer (critical chromatography) by carefully adjusting the ratio of two components of the mobile
phase (a strong eluent and a weak eluent or nonsolvent). It is impossible to
nd conditions that are critical for several dierent monomers simultaneously.
Therefore, critical chromatography is much more useful for determining the
FTDs of functional (homo)polymers than for determining the CCDs of copolymers. In the latter case, two options are open. One is to nd conditions at which
the separation is critical toward one type of monomer, while the second monomeric unit does not show any interaction, so that it is eluted under SEC conditions.
Such conditions have been applied to block copolymers. The block for which critical conditions are maintained is made invisible and the separation reects the
block length distribution of the second block [22]. There is some discussion in
the literature on whether any eect of the invisible block on the retention of the
polymer molecule can be avoided [2123].
The alternative (and more common) way to analyze copolymers is to resort to
gradient elution. In this case the composition of the mobile phase is changed over
time. At the initial composition, both monomers are highly retained (negative Dg).
When the eluent becomes stronger, the critical conditions for one of the monomeric units will be approached. At a later point in time, this will be the case for
the second monomer. In this way, a blend of polymers can be separated into its
constituents. Copolymers will be eluted according to their composition (Figure
20.11). In principle, gradient elution liquid chromatography can be used to obtain
CCDs of copolymers. Again, proper calibration of the detector is a signicant issue
if quantitative data are to be obtained.
i-LC separations can also be coupled to spectrometers and other highly informative detection devices. The situation is similar, but not identical, to that described
for SEC. In many cases, gradient elution is used: that is, the solvent changes as a
function of time. In that case hyphenation between i-LC and viscometry or light
scattering is horribly dicult. Gradient elution is not used with such devices.
Thus, it is dicult to determine the (average) molar mass as a function of the
chemical composition hMr ijpol . i-LC//MALDI-ToF-MS is a feasible technique; iLC-Vis and i-LC-LS are not realistic options. SEC-FTIR and SEC-NMR can in
principle be used to obtain the average composition as a function of molar mass
hjpol iMr . In principle it is possible to combine viscometry or light scattering
with critical chromatography. However, since the latter technique is more practical
for relatively low molar masses and the detection devices are most suitable for high
masses, this is not a perfect match.
Both LC-FTIR and LC-NMR can be applied in combination with solvent gradients. In both cases there are some complicating factors. In the case of FTIR,
only solvent elimination interfaces can realistically be used. This implies that the
euent from the LC is sprayed into a (heated) evaporation chamber and that the
nonvolatile analyte polymers are deposited on a suitable substrate (for example, a
germanium disc). By moving the spray or the substrate, the entire chromatogram
can be recorded. Some authors have programmed the deposition conditions to obtain optimal results for gradient elution LC-FTIR. However, as was mentioned ear-

20.3 Polymer Analysis


18
16
14

Detector signal

12
10
8
6
4
2
0
-2
0

10

20

30

40

50

60

70

80

Time (min)
Gradient elution liquid
chromatography of a mixture (blend) of a
number of copolymers. Column: Supelcosil
Discovery C18 , 150 mm long  2.1 mm i.d.;
particle size: 5 mm; pore diameter: 180 A;
temperature: 25 C; ow rate: 0.2 mL min1 ;
injection volume: 5 mL; sample concentration:
Fig. 20.11.

1.5 mg mL1 ; gradient from 5 to 95% THF


in acetonitrile. Peaks from left to right:
poly(methyl methacrylate) homopolymer, 20%
polystyrene-co-MMA, 40% PS-co-MMA, 60%
PS-co-MMA, 80% PS-co-MMA, PS
homopolymer.

lier (Section 20.3.2.1), it is not easy to obtain accurate quantitative results for the
copolymer composition using FTIR. In LC-NMR a solvent gradient causes severe
complications associated with the suppression of the solvent signal. While suppression techniques for gradient elution LC have been developed and applied successfully, the interferences in the spectrum are more serious than they are in isocratic
separations. In either case, LC-FTIR or LC-NMR, the amount of additional information obtained is limited. The LC retention axis contains information on the
polymer composition. The information present in the spectra is related to this.
Although additional information on structural aspects may be obtained from both
FTIR and NMR spectra, the two information dimensions are far from orthogonal.
This is fundamentally dierent for the combination of i-LC with MS, either online (most commonly using LC-ESI-MS) or o-line (most commonly using LC//
MALDI-ToF-MS). In that case, the LC axis contains mainly structural information,
whereas the MS axis provides information on the molar mass. A disadvantage of
this combination is that fractions resulting from the i-LC separation are expected
to be narrow in terms of their chemical composition distribution, but may be quite
broad in terms of their molar mass distribution. In critical or pseudo-critical i-LC
the very purpose of the separation is to elute all the dierent molar masses as one

1039

1040

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

peak. Such broad fractions are not really compatible with MS. As mentioned in
section 20.3.2.3, biased results are anticipated from the MS analysis of broadly distributed samples.
Better results are anticipated if fractions that are narrow both in chemical composition and in molar mass are subjected to mass spectrometry. Such fractions can
be obtained from two-dimensional separations (see Section 20.3.3.5).
Degree of Branching Distributions
When polymer molecules are branched, their size in solution decreases. This is
progressively the case with an increasing degree of branching. This also implies
that molecules of equal size in solution (and thus equal SEC retention times) can
have dierent molecular weights, depending on the degree of branching. SEC
alone is not capable of revealing both the MWD and the degree of branching distribution (DBD), because the two distributions are confounded. Other information
is required to yield information on the two parameters simultaneously. This extra
information may be obtained from light scattering or from viscosity data, and both
of these techniques can be readily combined on-line with SEC, yielding so-called
hyphenated systems that is, SEC-Vis (size-exclusion chromatography with viscometric detection) and SEC-LS (light-scattering detection). Static light scattering is
most commonly coupled with SEC, but in recent years the on-line coupling of
SEC and dynamic light scattering has become more readily available. The instrumentation for static light scattering is typically distinguished by the type and/or
number of measurement angles. Thus, we have low-angle light scattering (LALS)
and right-angle light scattering (RALS), as well as multi-angle light scattering
(MALS) and triple-angle light scattering (TrALS). Often an additional L is added
to the abbreviations, signifying the use of a laser source (for example, multi-angle
laser light scattering, MALLS). In any case (viscometry or light scattering) a
concentration-sensitive detector, typically a refractive index (RI) detector, is also
installed on-line. Also quite common is the use of both viscometry and light scattering in combination with refractive index (RI) detection and SEC. Such a system
with three detectors is known as a TripleSEC system.
0
are obtained from the ratio of the intrinsic viscosity of
Branching parameters gvis
the branched polymer hbr (measured by viscometry) to that of the corresponding
linear reference polymer hlin (eluting at the same time) [Eq. (6)], or from the molecular weight of a linear reference polymer (as measured by light scattering) divided by the molecular weight of the branched polymer [Eq. (7), where a is the
MarkHouwink coecient].
20.3.3.4

hbr
hlin



Mlin a

Mbr

gvis

0
gLS

The average number of branches in polymer molecules as a function of the molec-

20.3 Polymer Analysis

ular weight can be estimated from Eqs. (6) or (7) and the ZimmStockmayer equation [24].
Complex Polymers (Multiple Distributions)
We have already encountered several examples of confounded distributions. SEC
may not suce to obtain the MWD of a copolymer, because the molecules eluted
at any one time may have dierent molecular weights and dierent compositions
resulting in equal hydrodynamic volumes. Likewise, in the SEC separation of a
branched polymer the molecules eluted at any one time may have dierent molecular weights and dierent degrees of branching, again resulting in equal hydrodynamic volumes. Just as the characterization of polymer distributions necessitates
polymer separations, the characterization of two-dimensional polymer distributions necessitates two-dimensional polymer separations. Only if two distributions
are fully independent do two separate one-dimensional separations suce. This is
the case if every chemical composition fraction exhibits the same MMD and every
molar mass fraction exhibits the same CCD. Because this is not usually the case,
one two-dimensional separation usually reveals (much) more information than two
one-dimensional separations.
20.3.3.5

Comprehensive two-dimensional liquid chromatography Two-dimensional liquid


chromatographic separations can be performed in the linear (heart-cut) format
or in the comprehensive mode. In the former case, one fraction (or a few fractions)
is (are) isolated from the sample and these are subsequently subjected to a second
separation. An advantage of this approach is that the specic fraction(s) can be
subjected to two (lengthy) high-resolution separations. A great disadvantage is
that only one or a few small fractions of the sample are extensively characterized.
In comprehensive two-dimensional liquid chromatography the entire sample is
subjected to two dierent separations. The word comprehensive is justied if
the nal (two-dimensional) chromatogram is representative of the entire sample
[25]. The recommended notation for linear (heart-cut) two-dimensional liquid
chromatography is LC-LC, whereas comprehensive two-dimensional liquid chromatography is commonly denoted by LC  LC [25].
In the case of polymer separations, the MMD is usually one of the distributions
of interest. The second most important distribution is usually either the CCD or
the functionality-type distribution (FTD). This implies that SEC and i-LC are attractive candidates for the two dimensions in comprehensive two-dimensional liquid
chromatography. These two techniques can in principle be coupled in two dierent orders (either LC  SEC or SEC  LC, with the rst dimension listed rst).
LC  SEC has a number of prevailing advantages [26]. These include (i) the possibility of performing high-resolution (gradient) LC in the rst dimension, (ii) the nite time of analysis in the second dimension, (iii) the greater choice of detectors
(because the separation in the second dimension is isocratic), (iv) the possibility of
changing the rst-dimension LC conditions without the need to re-optimize the
second-dimension conditions, (v) the relatively high concentration in the rstdimension i-LC system (not easily overloaded) and the relatively low concentration

1041

1042

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

in the second-dimension SEC system (more easily overloaded), and (vi) the greatly
reduced chance of breakthrough. If the rst dimension were SEC, the sample
(fraction) transferred to the second-dimension LC would be dissolved in a very
strong solvent, creating a great danger of detrimental breakthrough peaks [27].
A disadvantage is that the resolution in the second (fast-SEC) dimension is limited,
but the series of advantages prevails. Therefore LC  SEC is now the commonly
employed technique.
If we are to maintain the separation (resolution) that has been achieved in the
rst dimension in the eventual LC  SEC chromatogram, we need to collect a large
number of fractions. To maintain a reasonable overall analysis time, this implies
that the second-dimension separation should be fast and that the resolution that
can be obtained in this second dimension is limited. There have been signicant
developments toward fast SEC in recent years [9, 28] Moderate-resolution SEC
can be performed within one or two minutes. If we want to collect 100 fractions
from the rst dimension, this implies that typical LC  SEC analysis times are of
the order of two to three hours. Indeed, these are the analysis times commonly encountered in practice.
If we wish to transfer the entire rst-dimension fraction to the second dimension, then the rst-dimension column should have a much smaller internal diameter than the second-dimension column. Either a miniaturized rst-dimension
column can be used in combination with a conventional second-dimension column, or a conventional rst-dimension column can be used in combination with
a wide-bore (maxiaturized) second-dimension column. Both approaches have
been demonstrated successfully. The rst approach requires (very) much less solvent, produces correspondingly less waste, and is compatible with most existing
LC detectors, including the molar-mass selective detectors (viscometry, light scattering) that are of great interest in polymer separations. The second approach puts
fewer demands on the chromatographic (rst-dimension) system in terms of
extra-column band broadening and it yields larger separated fractions for subsequent o-line analysis by other methods (for example, NMR).
Figure 20.12(a) shows an outline of a typical LC  SEC system and Figure
20.12(b) shows an enlarged representation of the switching valve. A comprehensive
two-dimensional liquid chromatography system typically consists of two liquid
chromatographs that are interfaced by means of a switching valve. In the case of
LC  SEC the rst dimension often features a gradient elution system; that is,
the composition of the eluent can be programmed during the run. The valve is
congured so that while one fraction is being analyzed, the next fraction is being
collected (Figure 20.12(b)).
Figure 20.13 features a contemporary example of an LC  SEC separation [26]:
in this two-dimensional separation of a series of copolymer standards of known
molar mass and chemical composition, the rst (gradient elution LC) dimension
shows a high resolution, whereas the resolution in the second (SEC) dimension is
adequate. The two separations are seen to be nearly orthogonal (that is, separation
in the rst dimension is (nearly) completely based on the chemical composition,
whereas that in the second dimension is based on molecular size).

20.3 Polymer Analysis


2nd dimension

waste

PC

1st dimension

Detector (UV)
2nd dimension column

sample
Loop 1
6-way injection valve

Loop 2

1st dimension column

(a)

LC

P
Load

Inject

L1
L2

SEC

(b)
Instrumentation for comprehensive twodimensional liquid chromatography: (a) schematic of the
complete instrument; (b) preferred conguration of a 10-port
switching valve. Reprinted from Ref. [26] with permission.
Fig. 20.12.

Comprehensive two-dimensional liquid chromatography has seen a strong increase in popularity and in the number of applications in recent years. LC  SEC
has been applied to a large number of problems in polymer science. For example, the technique has been used to provide a detailed analysis of polystyrene
poly(methyl methacrylate) diblock copolymers [29], to analyze well-dened star
polylactides [30], and to study to the grafting reaction of methyl methacrylate onto
EPDM [31] or onto polybutadiene [32].
The main bottlenecks for the proliferation of LC  SEC (and other two-

1043

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

1.3

1
10
2

Time SEC [min]

1044

11

1.1
3

12

1
4
6

0.9

13

14

0.8

0.5

1.5

2
2.5
Time LC [hours]

Fig. 20.13. LC  SEC-ELSD contour plot of a


mixture of homo- and copolymeric reference
materials: PMMA 2900 (1), 6950 (2), 28 300
(3), 127 000 (4), 840 000 (5); S-co-MMA 20% S
(6), 40% S (7), 60% S (8), 80% S (9); PS 2450
(10), 7000 (11), 30 000 (12), 200 000 (13), 900

3.5

000 (14). LC (rst dimension): C18 column;


ow: 4 mL min1 ; gradient: 570% THF in
acetonitrile 0300 min (40 C). SEC (second
dimension): mixed C column; ow: 0.6
mL min1 THF. Figure reprinted from Ref. [26]
with permission.

dimensional polymer separations) are now in the development of suitable calibration procedures and the associated software. Because suitable hardware for
LC  SEC is already commercially available, signicant progress is expected in
this direction.

Notation

Acronyms
ATR
CC
CCD
CP-MAS-NMR
DRI
ELSD
ESI

attenuated total reection


critical (liquid) chromatography (or liquid chromatography at the
critical conditions of adsorption)
chemical composition distribution
cross-polarization magic-angle spinning NMR
dierential refractive index
evaporative light-scattering detector
electrospray ionization

References

FTD
FT-ICR-MS
FTIR
GC
GPC
i-LC
IR
LA(L)LS
LC
LC  LC
LC  SEC
LS
MA(L)LS
MALDI
MS
MMD
MWD
NIR
NMR
RA(L)LS
RI
SEC
ToF
TrA(L)LS
Triple SEC
Vis

functionality-type distribution
Fourier transform ioncyclotron resonance mass spectrometry
Fourier transform infrared
gas chromatography
gel permeation chromatography (same as SEC)
interactive liquid chromatography
infrared
low-angle (laser) light scattering
liquid chromatography
comprehensive two-dimensional liquid chromatography
comprehensive two-dimensional (liquid chromatography)  (size
exclusion chromatography)
light scattering
multi-angle (laser) light scattering
matrix-assisted laser desorption ionization
mass spectrometry
molar mass distribution (equivalent to MWD)
molecular weight distribution (equivalent to MMD)
near infrared
nuclear magnetic resonance
right-angle (laser) light scattering
refractive index
size exclusion chromatography
time-of-ight
triple-angle (laser) light scattering
SEC with light-scattering, viscometry, and refractive index detection
viscometry

References
1 J. A. Biesenberger, D. H. Sebastian,

3
4

5
6

Principles of Polymerization Engineering,


Kruger, Malabar, 1993.
M. Buback, M. Egorov, T. Junkers,
E. Panchenko, Macromol. Rapid
Commun. 25 (2004) 1004.
S. C. Rutan, O. E. de Noord, R. R.
Andrea, Anal. Chem. 70 (1998) 3198.
N. D. Othman, G. Fevotte, D.
Peycelon, J.-B. Egraz, J.-M. Suau,
AIChE J. 50 (2004) 654.
A. Cher, G. Fevotte, C. Novat, J.
Appl. Polym. Sci. 85 (2002) 2510.
R. A. M. Vieira, C. Sayer, E. L. Lima,
J. C. Pinto, J. Appl. Polym. Sci. 84
(2002) 2670.

7 M. Watari, H. Higashiyama, N.

9
10

11

Mitsui, M. Tomo, Y. Ozaki, Appl.


Spectrosc. 58 (2004) 248.
H. A. Lousberg, H. C. J. Hoefsloot,
H. F. M. Boelens, P. J. Schoenmakers, A. K. Smilde, Int. J. Polym.
Anal. Char. 7 (2002) 7692.
H. Pasch, P. Kiltz, Macromol. Rapid
Commun. 24 (2003) 104108.
J. Blomberg, P. J. Schoenmakers, N.
van den Hoed, J. High Resolut.
Chromatogr. 17 (1994) 411.
P. A. Mirau, Nuclear magnetic
resonance spectroscopy, in: R. F.
Brady (ed.), Comprehensive Desk
Reference of Polymer Characterization

1045

1046

20 Chemical Analysis for Polymer Engineers

12

13

14

15

16

17

18

19

20

21

22

23

and Analysis, Oxford University Press,


New York, NY, USA, 2003, pp. 181
219.
F. P. Fitzpatrick, H.-J. Ramaker,
P. J. Schoenmakers, R. Beerends, M.
Verheggen, H. J. A. Phillipsen, J.
Chromatogr. A 1043 (2004) 239.
X.-L. Jiang, P. J. Schoenmakers,
X.-W. Lou, V. Lima, J. L. M. van
Dongen, J. Brokken-Zijp, Anal.
Chem. 75 (2003) 5517.
X.-L. Jiang, V. Lima, P. J. Schoenmakers, J. Chromatogr. A 1018 (2003)
19.
R. Peters, Y. Mengerink, S.
Langereis, M. Frederix, H. Linssen,
J. van Hest, Sj. van der Wal, J.
Chromatogr. A 994 (2002) 327.
Y. Mengerink, R. Peters, C. G. de
Koster, Sj. van der Wal, H. A.
Claessens, C. A. Cramers, J.
Chromatogr. A 914 (2001) 131.
X.-L. Jiang, A. van der Horst, V.
Lima, P. J. Schoenmakers, J.
Chromatogr. A, submitted for
publication.
X.-L. Jiang, P. J. Schoenmakers,
X.-W. Lou, V. Lima, J. L. M. van
Dongen and J. Brokken-Zijp, Anal.
Chem. 75 (2003) 5517.
X.-L. Jiang, P. J. Schoenmakers,
J. L. M. van Dongen, X.-W. Lou, V.
Lima, J. Brokken-Zijp, J. Chromatogr.
A, 1055 (2004) 123.
K. Oudhoff, Capillary Electrophoresis
for the Characterization of Synthetic
Polymers, Ph.D. thesis, University of
Amsterdam, 2004.
J. Falkenhagen, H. Much, W. Stauf,
A. H. E. Muller, Macromolecules 33
(2000) 3687.
W. Lee, D. Cho, T. Chang, K. J.
Hanley, T. P. Lodge, Macromolecules
34 (2001) 2353.
H. J. A. Philipsen, J. Chromatogr. A
1037 (2004) 329.

24 S. Grcev, P. J. Schoenmakers, P. D.

Iedema, Polymer 45 (2004) 39.


25 P. J. Schoenmakers, P. Marriott, J.

Beens, LC-GC Europe 16 (2003) 335.


26 A. van der Horst, P. J.

27

28

29

30

31

32

33

34

35

36

37

Schoenmakers, J. Chromatogr. A 1000


(2003) 693.
X. Jiang, A. van der Horst, P. J.
Schoenmakers, J. Chromatogr. A 982
(2002) 5568.
S. T. Popovici, W. Th. Kok, P. J.
Schoenmakers, J. Chromatogr. A
(2004) DOI information: 10.1016/
j.chroma.2004.05.099.
H. Pasch, K. Mequanint, J. Adrian,
e-Polymers (2002) Paper No. 5,
CODEN: EPOLCI CAN 137:125589
AN 2002:181118 CAPLUS.
T. Biela, A. Duda, S. Penczek, K.
Rode, H. Pasch, J. Polym. Sci. Part A:
Polym. Chem. 40 (2002) 2884.
A. Siewing, J. Schierholz, D.
Braun, G. Hellmann, H. Pasch,
Macromol. Chem. Phys. 202 (2001)
2890.
A. Siewing, B. Lahn, D. Braun, H.
Pasch, J. Polym. Sci. Part A: Polym.
Chem. 41 (2003) 3143.
C. P. Beyers, H. F. M. Boelens, L.
Klumperman, J. A. Westerhuis,
Appl. Spectrosc. 58 (2004) 863.
F. Bandermann, I. Tausendfreund,
S. Sasic, Y. Ozaki, M. Kleimann,
J. A. Westerhuis, H. W. Siesler,
Macromol. Rapid Commun. 22 (2001)
690.
O. Kammona, E. G. Chatzi, C.
Kiparissides, J. Macromol. Sci. Rev.
Macromol. Chem. Phys. C39(1), 57134
(1999).
F. J. Wyzgoski, P. L. Rinaldi, E. F.
McCord, M. A. Stewart, D. R.
Marshall, Macromolecules 37 (2004)
846.
B. B. P. Staal, Ph.D. thesis, TU
Eindhoven, 2005.

1047

21

Recent Developments in Polymer Processes1


Maartje Kemmere
21.1

Introduction

Currently, many industrial polymers are being produced in organic solvents. A typical production scheme for conventional polymer processes is shown in Figure
21.1, for which three sub-processes can be distinguished: the polymerization of
the monomers, the shaping of the raw polymer, and the post-processing of the
polymer. A major drawback of polymer processes in organic solvents is the inecient removal and recovery of the solvents and monomers in each of the three subprocesses. Often the solvent recovery requires more process steps and energy than
the actual production process, as indicated in Figure 21.1. For example, in the production of butadiene rubber a typical production process applies a recycle of approximately four tons of solvent per ton of polybutadiene produced [1]. Another example is the production of elastomers such as EPDM (ethylenepropylenediene
copolymer), for which typically 20 wt.% of polymer is dissolved in an excess of hexane. Annually, these conventional polymer processes add substantially to the total
amount of discharged volatile organic compounds (VOCs) such as hexane and tolsolvent

solvent

solventt
PP

final
product

monomers
SR
polymerization

SR
shaping

Conventional polymerization (P), shaping (S) and


post-processing (PP) steps based on organic solvents,
including signicant solvent recovery steps (SR).
Fig. 21.1.

1) The symbols used in this chapter are listed at

the end of the text, under Notation.


Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes
Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

SR
post-processing

1048

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

uene. Approximately 20 million tons of VOCs are emitted into the atmosphere
each year as a result of industrial activities [2].
For these reasons, increasing environmental awareness demands more sustainable polymer processes. Currently, several technologies are being investigated to
develop cleaner processes. These include the reduction and/or recycling of solvents
by closed-loop operation as well as switching to solvent-free processes, for instance
melt-phase polymerization [3]. However, these methods have their limitations, because many industries require process liquids for operations such as reactions,
separations, and processing steps. Therefore, the possibilities of alternative green
solvents to replace organic solvents are being explored, for which important examples are aqueous solvents, ionic liquids, uorous phases, and supercritical or
dense-phase uids [3, 4]. Obviously, each of these approaches exhibits specic advantages and potential drawbacks. Ionic liquids (room-temperature molten salts),
for example, have a vapor pressure that is negligible. Because ionic liquids are
non-volatile, their commercial application would signicantly reduce the present
VOC emission. In general, ionic liquids can be used in existing equipment at
reasonable capital costs [5]. Nevertheless, the cost price of the ionic liquid itself is
substantial. In addition, the separation of ionic liquids from a process stream is another important point of concern. With respect to dense-phase uids, supercritical
water has been shown to be a very eective reaction medium for oxidation reactions [6, 7]. Despite extensive research eorts, however, corrosion and investment
costs still form major challenges in these processes due to the extreme operation
conditions required (above 647 K and 221 bar). Particularly, supercritical carbon dioxide has made its appearance as an alternative to organic solvents, because of its
tunable nature, its excellent wetting characteristics, and its low viscosity [3].
Besides alternative reaction media, process and product research has resulted in
a number of new classes of polymers, such as dendritic and conductive polymers.
At the same time the application eld of polymers has been extended, ranging
nowadays from bulk materials such as polyethylene and polypropylene all the way
to specialty products, for example for biomedical applications. These developments
ask for well controlled polymerization processes. In this respect ultrasound has
proven to be a clean and safe technology for generating radicals in situ during the
polymerization reaction.
In this chapter supercritical carbon dioxide will be discussed in more detail as
one of the most promising green solvents for polymerizations. Subsequently, the
possibilities and challenges of applying ultrasound in polymer processes are described. Finally, a short overview of the application potential of polymer processes
based on supercritical carbon dioxide or ultrasound technology will be given.

21.2

Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

A supercritical uid is dened as a substance for which the temperature and


pressure are above their critical values (see Figure 21.2A) [8, 9]. Above the critical

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

1049

1000

10000

280 K

solid

300 K

density (kg/m3)

supercritical
fluid

1000
pressure (bar)

800

liquid
100

310 K

330 K

600

400
400 K

10

gas

200

A
1
200

0
250

300

350

400

temperature (K)

30

50

70

90

110

130

pressure (bar)

Fig. 21.2. Projections of the phase diagram of carbon dioxide


A) in the pressuretemperature plane and B) in the density
pressure plane [8, 9].

temperature, the line representing vapor and liquid coexistence has disappeared.
Therefore, supercritical uids can be regarded as hybrid solvents because the
properties can be tuned from liquid-like to gas-like without crossing a phase
boundary by simply changing the pressure or the temperature. The unique properties of supercritical uids provide opportunities for a variety of industrial processes. In Table 21.1 [1013], the critical properties are shown for some components, of which carbon dioxide and water are the most frequently used as
supercritical uids. In polymerization processes, supercritical ethylene and propylene are also applied, where they act both as a solvent and as the reacting monomer [14].
With respect to the development of sustainable polymer processes, supercritical
carbon dioxide (scCO2 ) has signicant potential as a substitute for organic solvents. In addition to the environmental benets, scCO2 has interesting physical
and chemical properties from an engineering point of view. These include its relative chemical inertness, readily accessible critical point, and highly tunable solvent
behavior. Moreover, carbon dioxide is nontoxic and nonammable. In Figure
21.2B, the density of CO2 at dierent temperatures is plotted as a function of pressure. The graph clearly shows that the modication of the density requires only
small changes in temperature or pressure just above the critical point. In general
terms, scCO2 is a solvent with a low viscosity, high diusion rates, and no surface
tension [15]. The viscosity is in the range of 0.020.1 mPa s, where liquids have
viscosities of approximately 0.51.0 mPa s and gases approximately 0.01 mPa s,
respectively. Diusivities of solutes in supercritical carbon dioxide are higher than
in liquid solvents by a factor of up to 10. Binary diusion coecients of various
substances in scCO2 have been determined experimentally as a function of CO2
density [16]. Because of the high diusivity compared with ordinary solvents,
scCO2 is often associated with high mass and heat transfer. Additionally, the

150

170

1050

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes


Tab. 21.1.

Physical properties of various solvents [1013].

Solvent

Tc [K ]

Pc
[bar]

Polarizability
a [10C19 m 3 ]

Dipole moment
m [10C30 C m]

Methane
Ethane
Propane
Ethylene
Propene
Ethyne
Dimethyl ether
Sulfur hexauoride
Diuoromethane
Triuoromethane
Tetrauoromethane
Diuororethane
Hexauoroethane
Carbon dioxide
n-Hexane
Cyclohexane
Diethyl ether
Methanol
Acetone

190.4
305.3
369.8
282.4
364.9
308.3
400.0
318.7
351.6
299.3
227.6
386.7
293.0
304.1
507.5
553.5
466.7
512.6
508.1

46.0
48.7
42.5
50.4
46.0
61.4
52.4
37.6
58.3
48.6
37.4
45.0
30.6
73.8
30.1
40.7
36.4
80.9
47.0

26
45.0
62.9
42.3
62.6
33.3
51.6
54.6
24.8
26.5
28.6
41.5
47.6
27.6
118.3
109
87.3
32.3
63.3

0.0
0.0
0.1
0.0
0.4
0.0
1.3
0.0
2.0
1.7
0.0
2.3
0.0
0.0
0.0
0.3
1.3
1.7
2.9

Quadrupole moment Q
[3:16 D 10C17 J1/2 m 5/2 ]
0.7

3.0

0.7
4.3

above-mentioned properties are strongly pressure-dependent in the vicinity of the


critical point, making scCO2 a highly tunable solvent.
For application of scCO2 as a medium in polymer processes, it is important to
have insight into the specic system involved. In Section 21.2.1 a brief overview
of the interactions of carbon dioxide with polymers and monomers will be given,
including solubility in CO2 (Section 21.2.1.1), sorption and swelling of polymers
(Section 21.2.1.2) as well as phase behavior (Section 21.2.1.3) of polymermonomerCO2 systems. Subsequently, an overview of processes involving polymerization (Section 21.2.2) as well polymer processing (Section 21.2.3) in scCO2 will be
discussed.
21.2.1

Interactions of Carbon Dioxide with Polymers and Monomers

The thermodynamic properties of pure substances and mixtures of molecules are


determined by intermolecular forces acting between the molecules or polymer segments. By examining these potentials between molecules in a mixture, insight into
the solution behavior of the mixture can be obtained. The most commonly occurring interactions are dispersion, dipoledipole, dipolequadrupole, quadrupole
quadrupole, and specic interactions. For small molecules, the contribution of
each interaction to the intermolecular potential energy Gij r; T, is given by Eq. (1)
[12], where a is the polarizability, m is the dipole moment, Q is the quadruple

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

moment and SI represents specic interactions such as complex formation or hydrogen bonding.
"

#
mi2 mj2
mi2 Q 2j
Q 2i Q 2j
ai aj
C4 10
SI
Gij r; T A  C1 6 C2 6 C3 8
r
r kT
r kT
r kT

The interactions work over dierent distances, with the longest range for dispersion and dipole interactions. Note that the dispersion interaction depends on the
polarizability alone, and not on the temperature. Consequently, an increased polarizability of the supercritical solvent is expected to decrease the pressures needed to
dissolve a nonpolar solute or polymer. Furthermore, at elevated temperatures, the
congurational alignment of directional interactions such as dipoles or quadrupoles is disrupted by the thermal energy, leading to a nonpolar behavior. Hence, it
may be possible to dissolve a nonpolar solute or a polymer in a polar supercritical
uid. However, to obtain sucient density for dissolving the solutes at those elevated temperatures, substantially higher pressures need to be applied. Additionally,
specic interactions such as complex formation and hydrogen bonding can increase the solvent strength of the supercritical uid. These interactions are also
highly temperature-sensitive.
Solubility in Carbon Dioxide
The solvent strength of carbon dioxide for solutes is dominated by a low polarizability and a strong quadrupole moment. Consequently, carbon dioxide is dicult
to compare with conventional solvents, due to this ambivalent character. With its
low polarizability and nonpolarity, carbon dioxide is similar to peruoromethane,
peruoroethane, and also methane. These uids are very weak solvents for many
components. Additionally, the acidity of carbon dioxide increases the solvent
strength for weakly basic solutes. In general, carbon dioxide is a reasonable solvent
for small molecules, both polar and nonpolar. For many components, with the
exception of water, complete miscibility can be obtained at elevated pressures.
However, the critical point of the mixture, which is the lowest pressure at a given
temperature where CO2 is still completely miscible, rises sharply with increasing
molecule size. Consequently, most of the larger components and polymers exhibit
a very limited solubility in carbon dioxide. Polymers that do exhibit a high solubility in carbon dioxide are typically characterized by a exible backbone and high free
volume (hence, a low Tg ), weak interactions between the polymer segments, and a
weakly basic interaction site such as a carbonyl group [1720]. Examples of polymers that are soluble in carbon dioxide and incorporate these characteristics include poly(alkene oxides), peruorinated poly(propylene oxide), poly(methyl acrylate), poly(vinyl acetate), poly(alkylsiloxanes), and poly(ether carbonate).
To illustrate the inuence of the carbonyl group on the solubility of the polymer
in carbon dioxide, Figure 21.3 shows the dierence in cloud-point pressures for
polymethyl acrylate (PMA) and polyvinyl acetate (PVA) [17]. Structurally, these
polymers are very similar, but the carbonyl group in PVA is more easily accessible
to CO2 , making it more susceptible to complex formation. As a result, the cloud21.2.1.1

1051

1052

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

2500
Fluid

pressure (bar)

2000

PMA 31000

1500

O
1000

PVA 125000

O
CH3

O
CH3

500
Liquid + Liquid

poly(vinyl acetate) poly(methyl acrylate)

0
280

320

360

400

440

480

temperature (K)
Cloud-point curves of carbon dioxidepoly(methyl
acrylate) and carbon dioxidepoly(vinyl acetate) with polymer
concentrations of @5 wt.% [17].
Fig. 21.3.

point pressure of PVA is up to 1500 bar lower than that of PMA, even though the
molecular weight of PVA is four times higher than that of PMA, and its glass transition temperature is 21 K higher.
Sorption and Swelling of Polymers
Although the solubility of polymers in CO2 is typically very low, the solubility of
carbon dioxide in many polymers is substantial. When the polymer comes into
contact with scCO2 , the sorption of carbon dioxide by the polymers and the resultant swelling of the polymer inuence the mechanical and physical properties of
the polymer. The most important eect is plasticization, that is, the reduction of
the glass transition temperature (Tg ) of glassy polymers. The plasticization eect,
characterized by an increased segmental and chain mobility as well as by an increase in interchain distance, is largely determined by polymersolvent interactions and solvent size [21]. The molecular weight of the polymer is of little inuence on the swelling once the entanglement molecular weight has been exceeded.
The inuence of specic interactions of carbon dioxide with various groups in the
polymer on the swelling isotherms is shown in Figure 21.4 [22]. These polymers
all have a Tg of approximately 378 K. Carbon dioxide shows little interaction with
the phenyl groups in polystyrene (PS), resulting in limited swelling. Substituting
one of the CH groups in styrene with a nitrogen atom renders the polymer somewhat basic, thereby increasing the swelling level as well as the swelling rate. Building carbonyl groups into the polymer has an even stronger eect. In the case of
poly(methyl methacrylate) (PMMA), the swelling level is doubled as compared to
PS. Besides the enhancing interactions with carbon dioxide, the sorption and swell21.2.1.2

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

1053

20
PMMA

CH3

swelling (%)

16
O
PVP

12

O
CH3

poly(methyl methacrylate)

polystyrene

8
PS

4
N

0
0

20

40

60

80

100

120

poly(vinyl pyridine)

pressure (bar)
Swelling isotherms of poly(methyl methacrylate),
polystyrene and poly(vinyl pyridine) in carbon dioxide at 308 K
[22].
Fig. 21.4.

ing can also be increased by lowering the interchain interactions of the polymer.
This is illustrated by comparison of commercial semi-crystalline low-density polyethylene (ldPE) [23] (40% crystallinity) with highly branched amorphous polyethylene [24] (< 2% crystallinity). Although both polymers lack specic interactions
with carbon dioxide, the highly branched PE shows a strongly enhanced swelling
(up to 25 vol.%) in carbon dioxide, whereas the ldPE exhibits a low maximum
swelling (4 vol.%) at 323 K [25]. This is caused by the absence of crystallinity and
the increased free volume introduced by branching.
To study the CO2 -induced plasticization, dierent techniques can be applied, for
example, gas sorption and polymer swelling [26, 27]; in-situ FTIR spectroscopy
[28, 29], NMR spectroscopy [30], and dynamic light scattering [31]. Two new techniques for simultaneous sorption and swelling measurement have been proposed,
based on detection of the volume change of the polymer sample measured by mercury displacement [32], and on gravimetric measurement [33], respectively.
The sorption and swelling of a wide variety of polymers in scCO2 have been reported in the literature. For example, Liau and McHugh [34] have investigated the
swelling of PMMA and sorption of CO2 in PMMA at temperatures ranging from
313 to 343 K and at pressures up to 272 bar by using a camera to record the change
in length of the polymer sample. Wissinger and Paulaitis [26] have reported swelling and sorption in glassy polymergas systems for CO2 with polycarbonate (PC),
PMMA, and PS at temperatures between 306 to 338 K and pressures up to 100 bar.
Sada et al. [35] have studied the sorption and diusion of CO2 in glassy polymer
lms of PS and PC over a temperature range of 293 to 313 K and pressures up to
30 bar by a pressure decay method. Berens et al. [36] have investigated the sorption

1054

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

behavior of the glassy polymers poly(vinyl chloride) (PVC), PC, PMMA, and PVA at
298 K up to 700 bar in the presence of liquid CO2 through a simple gravimetric
procedure. Additionally, sorption and swelling data at 308 K have been reported
by Zhang et al. [37] and up to 100 bar for PMMA, PS, polyvinylpyridine and polyisoprene as well as for block copolymers of styrenemethyl methacrylate, styrene
vinylpyridine and styreneisoprene, respectively. Otake et al. [31] have measured
the swelling of a 50 nm monodisperse PS latex in water by CO2 by dynamic light
scattering at 298 K at pressures up to 350 bar.
In general, the sorption and swelling of polymers by CO2 are crucial eects in
designing polymer processes based a high-pressure technology, because important
properties such as diusivity, viscosity, glass transition, melting point, compressibility, and expansion will change. The plasticization eect of CO2 facilitates mass
transfer properties of solutes in and out of the polymer phase, which leads to
many applications: increased monomer diusion for polymer synthesis, enhanced
diusion of small components in polymers for impregnation and extraction purposes, polymer fractionation, and polymer extrusion.
Phase Behavior of MonomerPolymerCarbon Dioxide Systems
One of the requirements for the development of new polymer processes based on
scCO2 is knowledge about the phase behavior of the mixture involved, which enables one to tune the process variables properly to achieve maximum process eciency. Important parameters in the phase behavior of the system are the solvent
quality, the molecular weight, chain branching, and chemical architecture of the
polymer, as well as the eect of end groups, and addition of a co-solvent or an
anti-solvent. The literature available on the phase behavior of polymers in supercritical uids has been reviewed extensively by Kirby and McHugh [38].
The usual phase equilibrium issue in polymer systems consists of determining
whether phase separation occurs, and if it does, then what the phase compositions
are. Although measuring is still the most accurate way at present to obtain information about the phase behavior [3942], it is rather time-consuming. Most of
the experimental work described in the literature has focused on polymersolvent
systems rather than on non-solvents. For example, binary systems of linear and
branched polyethylenes in ethylene have been measured [40, 43]. In addition, the
eect of carbon dioxide as a non-solvent on polyolensolvent systems has been
studied [4447].
When thermodynamic models are used to correlate and predict phase equilibria, the experimental eort can be reduced substantially. Modeling of polymer
supercritical uid mixtures is particularly challenging, as the model has to be able
to describe the behavior of a mixture containing molecules covering a wide range
of molecular weights, which is often referred to as the asymmetry of the system.
Additionally, the proximity to the critical point is dicult to model. There exist several thermodynamic models suitable for the description of phase behavior of polymer systems in supercritical media; see Chapter 3 for a detailed description of the
existing models. However, the SanchezLacombe equation of state (eos) and statistical associating uid theory (SAFT) eos are the most commonly used.
21.2.1.3

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

The SanchezLacombe model [4850] is a lattice uid model in which each


component is divided into parts that are placed in a lattice. The dierent parts are
allowed to interact with a mean-eld intermolecular potential. By introducing an
appropriate number of vacant sites (holes) in the lattice, the correct solution density can be obtained. SAFT [5153] is based on the perturbation theory. The principle of perturbation theory is that rst a model is derived for some idealized uid
with accurately known properties, called the reference uid. Subsequently, the
properties of this model are related to those of a real dense uid. By expanding
this reference uid into power series over a specied parameter, the power terms
can be regarded as corrections or perturbations for the reference uid as compared to reality. Obviously, the more the reference model approaches reality, the
smaller the corrections are. Therefore, the key issue for applying perturbation
theory is deriving the most suitable reference uid.
In general, the choice of a certain model to describe the phase behavior of a
polymermonomerCO2 system is far from arbitrary, and depends on, among
other factors, the particular components involved and the required detail of the
description. The SanchezLacombe eos has the advantage that it is very tractable
and it is suitable for interpolation of data. On the other hand, the Sanchez
Lacombe model gives a poor description of systems containing specic interactions, because it is a mean-eld theory with mixing rules assuming a random
mixture. For that reason specic interactions can only be introduced through a
temperature-dependent interaction parameter. Modeling with SAFT provides a
more rigorous approach, although it is more computationally intensive. Many
non-idealities can be incorporated in calculations with this eos. However, similarly
to SanchezLacombe, description of the binary polymerCO2 system can be troublesome using SAFT. As an example the SAFT eos and the SanchezLacombe eos
have been compared for the poly(ethylene-co-propoylene)ethyleneCO2 system
[54]. Both models give a qualitative description of the increase in ethylenePEP
cloud-points upon addition of carbon dioxide as anti-solvent. For a quantitative correlation with the SanchezLacombe model, a temperature-dependent interaction
parameter is required. Additionally, the parameter is determined for each individual cloud-point composition. For the SAFT model, one temperature-dependent
interaction parameter suces for all compositions. For this particular system, the
description of the phase behavior with the SAFT model is in better agreement with
the experimental data than the description with the SanchezLacombe model (see
Figure 21.5).

21.2.2

Polymerization Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

With respect to the possibilities of carbon dioxide as a reaction medium for polymerization reactions, extensive reviews have been published by Scholsky [55],
Shaer et al. [56], Kendall et al. [57], and Cooper [58]. Typically, a division is
made between homogeneous and heterogeneous polymerization in scCO2 .

1055

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes


4000
SL

pressure (bar)

3500

3000

2500

2000

A
1500
310

315

320

325

330

335

340

345

temperature (K)

4000
SAFT

3500
pressure (bar)

1056

3000

2500

2000

1500
310

B
315

320

325

330

335

340

345

temperature (K)
SanchezLacombe (A) and SAFT (B) correlation of
the cloud-point curves for the ternary system ethylenecarbon
dioxidePEP containing 10 wt.% PEP, as a function of
temperature and mass fraction of carbon dioxide: y, 0.05;
D, 0.10; j, 0.15; b, 0.20 [54].
Fig. 21.5.

Both chlorouorocarbons (CFCs) and carbon dioxide appear to be very good solvents for amorphous, low-melting uoropolymers. Since environmental restrictions have limited the use of CFCs drastically, carbon dioxide has become a highly
viable alternative solvent for the production of amorphous uoropolymers [59]. Examples of polymerization of uorinated monomers in a homogeneous reaction
medium of scCO2 are the polymerization of uorinated acrylates (see, for example
Refs. 5961, uoroalkyl-derivatized styrene [62], uorinated vinyl and cyclic ethers
[63], and the telomerization of 1,1-diuoroethylene [64]. Other options to run a

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

polymerization under homogeneous conditions are to increase the temperature


and pressure until a one-phase system is obtained [65] or to add a co-solvent.
Except for certain uoropolymers and a few other examples of polymers that are
soluble in it, as given in Section 21.2.1.1, carbon dioxide exhibits a strong antisolvent eect for most high molecular weight polymers. This implies that the majority of the polymerization reactions, such as dispersion, emulsion, suspension,
and precipitation polymerization, involve heterogeneous polymerization. Examples
of dispersion polymerization in scCO2 are the polymerization of MMA [66] and
styrene [67]. Beckman and co-workers have reported the inverse emulsion polymerization of acrylamide in scCO2 [68]. Moreover, it is possible to synthesize
well-dened porous polymers by templating in scCO2 water emulsions [69]. Macroporous beads of trimethylolpropane trimethacrylate (TRIM) can be synthesized
by means of suspension polymerization [70]. Much work has been performed
on precipitation polymerization, such as the polymerization of vinyl ethers and
oxetanes [63], the continuous polymerization of vinylidene uoride as well as of
acrylic acid [71, 72], MMA polymerization initiated by ultrasound [73], the catalytic
polymerization of olens [74, 75] and the enzymatic polymerization to polycaprolactone [76]. An interesting extension in the application of scCO2 for polymerization purposes is the use of CO2 both as a reactant and as a solvent in a copolymerization with cyclohexene oxide [77].
From an engineering point of view several issues have to be addressed in order
to design polymerization processes based on scCO2 . The previous sections have
emphasized the importance of the phase behavior of the system as well as the
sorption and swelling of the polymer. Additionally, in catalytic polymerization processes the solubility and recycle of the catalyst are important. Moreover, when the
polymer-shaping step is to be included in the same equipment or the purication
of the polymer product, this will set additional requirements on the design. Obviously, mass and heat transfer have to be investigated. In general, supercritical uids have gas-like viscosities and diusion rates, which allow for fast mass transfer.
In addition, the thermal diusivity of supercritical CO2 is signicantly higher than
for gaseous CO2 . The need for forced convection in order to facilitate sucient
mass and heat transfer during the polymerization process has to be determined
for each particular type of polymerization. If the process involves a precipitation
polymerization, for instance, the eect of polymer deposition on heat transfer surfaces forms a potential point of concern. Given the scale of most commercial polymerization processes, a translation from a batchwise operation as it is usually performed on a laboratory scale toward a continuous process forms another important
consideration in the development of polymerization processes based on scCO2 . As
an example, it has been suggested that the process concept of the catalytic polymerization of olens in scCO2 should include a loop type of apparatus [78], as described by Ahvenainen et al. [79] (see Figure 21.6). Next to the requirements mention above, this reactor design allows adjustment of the residence time to relatively
long values in order to obtain a reasonable conversion.
Although many new polymerization reactions have been discovered in scCO2
since the early 1990s, the development of the engineering aspects of these pro-

1057

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

external recycle
CO2

catalyst

1058

polymer
monomer
Proposed process concept of a loop reactor used for
the catalytic polymerization of olens in scCO2 [77].
Fig. 21.6.

cesses and the step toward pilot scale and industrial application had only just been
initiated in the last few years. The commercialization by DuPont of the production
of Teon2 (polytetrauoroethylene, PTFE) in scCO2 is a promising example [80].
21.2.3

Polymer Processing in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

Applications of supercritical uids in polymer processing can be divided into three


areas: applications where carbon dioxide does not interact with the polymer; and
processing of swollen, or dissolved, polymers. Schematically, this is shown in Figure 21.7 [81, 82]. In the rst of these areas, when no interaction with the polymer
occurs, which is typically the case for crystalline and rigid polymers, supercritical
carbon dioxide can be used as a cleaning solvent. Applications in this category
include precision cleaning of surfaces, degreasing, particle removal, and dry cleaning. In particular, dry cleaning is being investigated for widespread industrial
application, because traditional processes based on perchloroethylene are under
pressure due to health and environmental issues. Current research in this area is
focused on the development of low-cost nonuorous CO2 -philic surfactants [18,
19] and on the development of membrane systems for the economical reuse of carbon dioxide [83].
In the case of moderate interactions of carbon dioxide with the polymer, substantial levels of sorption and swelling can occur. The swelling of the polymer signicantly enhances diusivities of solutes in the polymer matrix, allowing for rapid
extraction, impregnation, shaping, and blending processes. Extraction applications
include removal of residual monomers, solvents, and catalysts [84, 85]. An impor-

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

1059

polymer and supercritical fluid


no interaction

swelling of polymer
sorption and swelling

applications::
precision
i i cleaning
dry cleaning

i
applications:
i
extraction
impregnation
shaping
blending

dissolution of polymer

effects:
plasticization (decrease
r
Tg)
crystallization
i (increase Tm)
changes in mechanical
and surface
properties
u

applications:
removal of low Mw material to
i
improve
properties
fractionation
coatings / paint

Fig. 21.7. Interactions of supercritical uids with polymers,


and their applications in polymer processes [81].

tant application of impregnation of polymers is the dyeing of textiles and bers


[86, 87]. Other impregnation applications include impregnation of polymer matrices with drugs for the production of controlled drug delivery devices [88]. Advantages in this process are the low processing temperatures and the lack of organic
solvents, which need to be removed in post-processing steps. Applying scCO2 for
shaping purposes is advantageous because the material properties can be tuned
by varying the supercritical solvent density. This enables the removal of the solvent
without passing a liquidgas interface, which would cause the structures formed
to collapse [89]. With respect to blending, an interesting application is in-situ polymerization in an existing polymer matrix after impregnation with a monomer and
an initiator to form polymer blends [90]. This enables the formation of polymer
blends that cannot easily be obtained by conventional methods, for example due
to large dierences in the melting temperatures of the pure polymers.
Applications in the third category, where the polymer is dissolved in the
supercritical uid, include coating processes as well as fractionation. For example, various groups have worked on the RESS (rapid expansion from supercritical
solution)-based process for spray coating using supercritical carbon dioxide as a
solvent [9194]. The main advantage of these processes is the reduction of VOC
emissions. Methods of applying coatings from CO2 involve dip or spray coatings,
solutions of coatings in a CO2 atmosphere and dispersion coatings. An example
that has already been commercially developed is the Unicarb TM spray coating process [95], which can use highly viscous coatings and results in a narrow droplet
size distribution. A potential drawback of spray coating processes using supercritical carbon dioxide is the fact that most coating materials have a low solubility
in supercritical carbon dioxide. Consequently, co-solvents such as methanol are
needed to enhance solubilities. An alternative to the addition of co-solvents is the
use of stabilizers [96]. Typical stabilizer structures involve graft copolymers, peruoropolyether acid and polyether carbonates.

1060

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

An extensive review on polymer processing using supercritical uids by Kazarian [21] includes the applications mentioned above. To illustrate the possibilities
of polymer processing with scCO2 from an engineering point of view, two important applications will be discussed in more detail, namely extraction (see Section
21.2.3.1) and impregnation (Section 21.2.3.2).
Extraction
Commercial-grade polymers contain a range of additives and contaminants such as
residual monomer, solvent, and catalyst residue. Before application of the polymer
in the end-product, manufactures need to remove these impurities from it, for instance to meet environmental regulatory requirements or to improve the physical
polymer properties [58]. Supercritical uid extraction (SFE) has many advantages
over conventional cleaning techniques, such as a shorter extraction time, adjustable solvent strength by tuning the pressure, a wide range over which the extraction temperature can be varied, and less energy consumption [15].
A number of studies have been reported in supercritical extraction of polymer
additives, extraction of monomers and oligomers, and removal of residual solvent
from polymer foams [97], of which some examples will be given here. SFE can be
achieved in two ways: statically or dynamically. In a static extraction, the extraction
vessel is pressurized to the desired pressure with the extracting uid and subsequently left for a certain length of time, whereas during dynamic extraction the
supercritical uid passes continuously over the sample, extracting soluble compounds and depositing them in a suitable solvent or on a solid trap. Cotton et al.
[98] used dynamic extraction for the extraction of Irgafos 168 and Irganox 1010
from a commercial-grade polypropylene matrix. The rate of extraction can be
hampered by two factors: the diusion of the additive through the matrix, or the
solubility of the extracted material in the supercritical uid, can be limited. Similar
results have been obtained by Lou et al. [99] for the supercritical extraction of polyethylene by applying the two-lm theory. In general, if diusion through the polymer matrix is the rate-limiting step in the extraction process, an enhanced extraction temperature will increase the extraction rate, because the diusion coecient
increases with temperature. Moreover, the plasticizing eect will signicantly enhance the diusion rates. If the rate-limiting step is the solubility of the solute
(extracted material) in the supercritical uid, the extraction rates can be enhanced
by either increasing the pressure (solvent strength) or by increasing the uid ow
rate [58].
Another example of supercritical uid extraction is the extraction of liquid crystalline 4,4 0 -dibutylazobenzene from a polystyrene matrices [100]. Furthermore,
Sekinger et al. [101] have investigated the feasibility of using SFE for extracting additives from styrenebutadiene rubber (SBR) by determining the eects of density,
temperature, ow rate, and contact time on the extraction eciency. Kemmere et
al. [85] have developed a post-polymerization process which reduces the amount
of residual monomer in latexes using scCO2 . Typically, the method comprises a
counterow process, in which part of the residual monomer is converted by the
increased diusion inside the polymer particles due to the swelling by scCO2 . In
21.2.3.1

21.2 Polymer Processes in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide

1061

polymerization reactor

latex
:
/
F:1.11
kg/s
T:60 C

CO 2 from
supply tank
T: 15 C
P: 55 bar
F:: 0.796 kg/s

x
4 extractor

F:: 0.789 kg/s

P: 30 bar

T: 60C
P: 80 bar

MMA
T: 11C

latex

CO2 recycle
T: 11C
P: 30 bar

5 separator

P: 30 bar
F:: 0.0167 kg/s

3
HEX1
Start-up
pump

6 compressor

HEX2

1. Latex
pump
flow
4.0 m3/hr
head of feet
2592.0
.
power
. kW
12.5

2. Centrifugal
pump
flow
3.45 m3/hr
head of feet
995.7
.
power
. kW
3.44

3. Heat
exchanger 1
heating duty
80.5kW
.
U
850.0 W/m2K
Tm
. K
69.12
required area
1.4

4. Extractor

5. Separator
t

height
4.25 m
diameter
0.60 m
wall thickness
0.024 m

height
3.38 m
diameter
1.12 m
wall thickness
0.045 m

6. Compressor
s
(screw))
total power
53.66 kW
U

Fig. 21.8. Process ow sheet for the removal of residual


monomer from latex-products using scCO2 [84].

addition, the amount of residual monomer is further reduced by the extraction


capacity of scCO2 [102]. Figure 21.8 shows the ow diagram of the extraction process. A viability study, including equipment sizing and economic evaluation, has
shown that the removal of residual monomer from latex-products using scCO2 in
principle yields a process which is both technically and economically feasible, and
capable of meeting future requirements [85]. Other examples of extrapolation of
SFE results obtained on a laboratory scale toward production equipment are described by Brunner [103] and Perrut and co-workers [104].
Impregnation and Dyeing
The same properties that make scCO2 attractive for extraction purposes can be exploited in the impregnation and dyeing of polymeric materials [105]. By applying
supercritical conditions, it is possible to impregnate polymers with pharmaceuticals, avors, and fragrances, or with additives such as pigments, stabilizers, and
21.2.3.2

7. Heat
exchangerr 2
heating duty
(-)51.57
. kW
850.0 W/m2K
Tm
57.00 K
required area
4.52

1062

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

plasticizers. A wide variety of polymer systems have been impregnated using


scCO2 , for example PMMA [106], PS, PE, PC, PVC, and polypropylene (PP) [107],
and polydimethylsiloxane (PDMS) [108, 109], as well as poly(ethylene terephthalate) (PET) [110, 111].
The key parameter that determines the feasibility of the impregnation process is
the equilibrium distribution or partition coecient of the solute that is being impregnated into the polymer. There are two dierent methods of supercritical uid
impregnation of additives into polymer products. The rst involves diusion of a
compound that is soluble in the supercritical uid. The impregnation takes place
when a polymer matrix is contacted with the supercritical uid containing the
solute. On depressurization, the CO2 ows out of the polymer matrix, leaving the
solute trapped in it [112]. For example, Ma and Tomasko [113] have investigated
the impregnation of high-density polyethylene (hdPE) with the nonionic surfactant
N,N-dimethyldodecylamine-N-oxide using scCO2 . They have observed that the penetration and absorption into the polymer produces no structural changes or losses
of mechanical strength. However, as a result of the swelling by scCO2 , the wetting
properties of hdPE are changed permanently, in contrast to conventional techniques using an aqueous solution. In the second route to impregnation, the compound typically has a low solubility in the supercritical phase; dyeing is a typical
example (see, for example, Refs. 106, 107, 111, 114).
As described earlier in Section 21.2.3, impregnation applications based on scCO2
technology include polymer blending and the production of polymeric drug delivery devices. However, the largest application of impregnation with scCO2 at present is the dyeing of textiles and bers. The main motivation is the replacement of
large amounts of water in the dyeing process with benign scCO2 , which can reduce
the wastewater in the textile industry signicantly [85, 86]. The ease of recovering
the carbon dioxide by reducing the pressure and recycling it without the necessity
to clean the carbon dioxide provides a strong environmental advantage. For these
reasons, there has been a signicant eort to commercialize supercritical uid dyeing of PET [112], for which the rst pilot plant has been built [115].

21.3

Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

For the development of sustainable polymer processes, ultrasound is an interesting


technology, as it allows for polymerizations without the use of initiator. The radicals are generated in situ by cavitation events [116, 117], which make possible a
clean and intrinsically safe polymerization reaction. As a result of the high strain
rates outside the bubble, cavitation can also induce chain scission [118, 119], which
provides an additional means to control the molecular weight of the polymer
produced. In Sections 21.3.1 and 21.3.2 the physical background of ultrasoundinduced cavitation and radical formation will be described. Subsequently (see
Section 21.3.3), an overview of the several types of ultrasound-induced polymerizations will be given, namely bulk, precipitation, and emulsion polymerization.

21.3 Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

Finally, in Section 21.3.4, the breakage of polymer chains by cavitation will be discussed, including the possibility of synthesizing block copolymers.
21.3.1

Ultrasound and Cavitation in Liquids

Ultrasound passes through an elastic medium as a longitudinal wave, which is a


series of alternating compressions and rarefactions. This means that liquid is displaced parallel to the direction of motion of the wave. Ultrasound comprises sound
waves typically in the range of 20 kHz to approximately 500 MHz. The frequency
( f ) and the acoustic amplitude (PA; max ) are the most important properties to characterize the pressure wave. The variation of the acoustic pressure (PA ) of an ultrasound wave as a function of time (t) at a xed frequency is described by Eq. (2)
[120].
PA PA; max  sin2  p  f  t

The use of ultrasound can be divided into two areas: low-intensity, high-frequency
ultrasound (2500 MHz, 0.10.5 W cm2 ) and power ultrasound with a high intensity and a low frequency (20900 kHz, >10 W cm2 ); see Table 21.2. The rst
does not alter the state of the medium through which it travels and is commonly
used for nondestructive evaluation and medical diagnosis [121]. This type of ultrasound cannot be used for reactions. Contrarily, power ultrasound uses the energy
to create cavitations, which involve the formation, growth, and implosive collapse
of microscopic bubbles in a liquid. These bubbles are generated when the negative pressure during the rarefaction phase of the sound wave is suciently great
to disrupt the liquid. The implosive collapse of the bubbles can produce extreme
temperatures and pressures locally for very short times, due to compression of
the gas phase inside the cavity [122, 123]. These hot-spots can lead to irreversible
changes such as the formation of excited states, bond breakage, and the generation
of radicals. Power ultrasound is applied for cleaning purposes, treatment of kidney
stones, plastic welding, and chemical reactions [124].

Tab. 21.2.

Overview of dierent types of ultrasound, including the various applications.

Power ultrasound,
20100 kHz

Sonophoresis,
20 kHz, low power

Therapeutic ultrasound,
1 MHz, high power

Nondestructive ultrasound,
I2 MHz, low power

Sonochemistry
Welding
Cleaning
Cell disruption
Sterilization
Kidney stones

transdermal drug
delivery

therapeutic massage
controlled release

aw detection
medical diagnoses

1063

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

400
350
300

250

Grow
t

-6

pse
Colla

Radius (10 m)

1064

200
150
100
50
0

Formation
0

10

20

Hot-spot
30

40

50

60

70

80

-6

Time (10 s)

Fig. 21.9. Schematic representation of bubble


growth and collapse in water at ambient
pressure irradiated with ultrasound and
the resulting hot-spot due to adiabatic

compression. The radius of the cavitation


bubble as a function of time has been
calculated using the dynamic bubble model
based on the RayleighPlesset equation [136].

Sonochemistry comprises the chemical eects that are induced by power ultrasound. The ultrasound waves cause the molecules to oscillate around their mean
position in a liquid. During the positive-pressure cycle the distance between the
molecules decreases, while during the negative-pressure period the distance increases. At a suciently high intensity a critical distance between the molecules
is exceeded during the negative-pressure period, and a cavity is formed [125]. Due
to the presence of nuclei such as dissolved gases and solid impurities, cavities are
formed at far lower sound pressures than theoretically predicted [126]. After the
formation of a cavity, a critical acoustic pressure has to be overcome to initiate the
explosive growth of this bubble. This explosive growth is followed by an implosive
collapse (see Figure 21.9). During this collapse, the contents of the bubble are
heated almost adiabatically, which leads to local short-lived hot-spots in the liquid.
Depending on the specic conditions, bubble wall velocities, and pressures and
temperatures in the bubble, can increase up to 1500 m s1 , 200 bar and 5000 K,
respectively [127].
The acoustic pressure amplitude determines the growth of a cavitation bubble
and consequently the chemical eects upon collapse. The amplitude of the pressure wave can be measured directly with a hydrophone or calculated using a calorimetric method [128, 129], by which it is possible to determine the ultrasound
power (Q US ) that is transferred to the liquid. With the ultrasound power, the density of the liquid (r), the speed of sound in the medium (v), and the surface area of
the ultrasound source (AUS ), the acoustic amplitude can be calculated according to
Eq. (3). The ultrasound intensity is the power input divided by the surface area of
the source [130].

21.3 Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

PA; max

r
Q US p
2rv
2  r  v  IUS
AUS

The Blake threshold pressure (PB ) describes the critical pressure to initiate the explosive growth of a cavitation bubble [Eq. (4)] [131].
v
u2
4
s
u

PB P0  Pv  s  u  
s
t3
3
 Pv  R 30
P0 2 
R0

Equation (4) assumes that the external pressure (P0 ), the vapor pressure (Pv ), the
surface tension (s), and the equilibrium radius of the bubble (R 0 ) determine the
negative pressure in the liquid required to start an explosive growth of a cavity
[132]. The Blake threshold pressure is based on a static approach and is only valid
when the surface tension dominates all dynamic eects, such as mass transfer and
viscosity. The inuence of the medium characteristics and the physical conditions
on the implosion can be calculated with a dynamic bubble model [120, 133]. The
dynamic movement of a bubble in a sound pressure eld can be described with the
RayleighPlesset equation. By combining the RayleighPlesset equation with a
mass and energy balance over the bubble, the temperature and pressure in the
bubble can be calculated [134136]. The model also describes the dynamic movement of the bubble wall, which results in a calculated radius of the cavitation bubble as a function of time (see Figure 21.9). The explosive growth phase and the collapse phase of the bubble can be distinguished clearly. Moreover, when dynamic
eects are more important than the surface tension, the cavitation threshold can
be calculated with the dynamic model, while the Blake threshold pressure cannot
be used in these conditions.
21.3.2

Radical Formation by Cavitation

Because of the extreme conditions during a cavitation event, radicals can be


formed. Several parameters aect cavitation and thereby the polymerization reaction, since the radical formation rate is directly inuenced by the cavitational collapse. The number of radicals formed due to sonication is a function of the number of cavities created and the number of radicals that are formed per cavitation
bubble. The bubble wall velocity during collapse and the hot-spot temperature determine the rate at which radicals are formed, both inside and outside a single bubble. These two parameters depend on the physical properties of the liquid as well
as on the physical and chemical processes occurring around the cavity. The most
important properties and processes occurring in a cavitation bubble are depicted
schematically in Figure 21.10. The number of cavities is determined, for instance,
by the impurities in the liquid, the static pressure, the ultrasound intensity, and the
vapor pressure. This emphasizes the complexity of the inuences on the overall

1065

1066

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

Fig. 21.10. Schematic representation of a cavitation bubble,


including the processes and physical properties that determine
the cavitation process.

radical formation rate [137, 138]. In the following sections, the eect of the most
important parameters will be discussed.
Reaction temperature When the reaction temperature is altered, the liquid properties will change. Although these properties (viscosity, surface tension, sound velocity, vapor pressure, and so on) all have an inuence on the chemical eect of cavitation, the change in vapor pressure dominates the other liquid properties. As the
temperature is raised, the vapor pressure in the bubble is increased, which cushions the implosion of the cavity. This results in a lower local temperature inside
the cavity at higher overall temperatures. Consequently, fewer radicals are formed
per cavitation bubble. On the other hand, a higher vapor pressure can lead to easier
bubble formation due to the decrease in the cavitation threshold. In most cases,
however, an increase in reaction temperature will result in an overall decrease in
the radical formation rate. Therefore, ultrasound-induced reactions exhibit the opposite behavior to common radical reactions [139].
Static pressure A high static pressure can prevent the formation of cavitation bubbles, as the Blake threshold pressure increases. This implies that fewer or no cavitations are formed at higher static pressures. To counteract this eect a higher
acoustic pressure is required, which will result in a more violent collapse of a cavitation bubble.
Viscosity At increasing viscosities the growth and collapse of a cavitation bubble
is retarded, due to the higher drag of the liquid. At a certain viscosity the drag force
becomes too high and the bubble has insucient time to grow to a critical radius.

21.3 Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

If this radius is not reached, no collapse will occur. Additionally, the higher viscosity slows down the collapse, which makes it possible for heat to be transferred to
the liquid. Due to this heat transfer, lower hot-spot temperatures are reached and
subsequently fewer radicals are being generated.
Ultrasound intensity At rst the radical formation rate will increase to a maximum with increasing ultrasound intensity [137]. This is caused by the higher
cavitation intensity per bubble and the larger number of cavitation bubbles. At
ultrasound intensities that are too high, however, a cloud of cavitation bubbles is
formed near the ultrasound source, due to which the pressure wave is no longer
transmitted eciently to the liquid. As a result, the cavitation intensity and consequently the radical formation rate decrease with a continued increase in intensity
[137]. An optimum radical formation rate with ultrasound intensity can thus be
found.
Ultrasound frequency The frequency of ultrasound has a signicant eect on
the cavitation process. At very high frequencies (> 1 MHz), the cavitation eect is
reduced as the inertia of a cavitation bubble becomes too high to react to fastchanging pressures. Most ultrasound-induced reactions are therefore carried out
at frequencies between 20 and 300 kHz. Typically a frequency of 20 kHz is used
for ultrasound-induced polymerizations and polymer scission reactions [140].
21.3.3

Cavitation-induced Polymerization

Generally, free-radical polymerization consists of four elementary steps: initiation,


propagation, chain transfer, and termination. When ultrasound is used to initiate
polymerization, radicals can be formed both from monomer and from polymer
molecules. This implies that due to radical formation by polymer scission an additional elementary step is involved in ultrasound-induced polymerization, as indicated in Figure 21.11.
The radicals from polymer and monomer are generated by two dierent mechanisms. The monomer molecules are dissociated by the high temperatures inside
the hot-spot, whereas the polymer chains are fractured by the high strain rates outside the bubble [141]. The majority of the radicals in an ultrasound-induced polymerization reaction originate from the polymer chains [142]; see Figure 21.12. It
has to be noted that the radicals are only formed in the immediate vicinity of the
ultrasound source where cavitation occurs. Subsequently, these radicals are dispersed throughout the reactor. In the literature several types of ultrasound-induced
polymerizations have been reported, namely bulk, precipitation, and emulsion
polymerization.
Bulk Polymerization
Most ultrasound-induced bulk polymerizations are performed at room temperature [143]. This low temperature is chosen because radical formation induced by
21.3.3.1

1067

1068

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

Initiation
M + Cavitation

2 R

Ri = 2 k dmon [ M ]

Propagation

M n + M
Chain Transfer
to monomer
M n + M

to polymer
M n + Mm
Termination
by combination
M n + Mm

by disproportionation
M n + Mm
Polymer Scission
M n + Cavitation

Mn+1

R p = k p [ M ] [ M n .]

Mn + M

Rctm = k ctm [ M ] [ M n. ]

Mn + Mm

Rctp = k ctp [ M n . ] [ M m ]

Mn+m

Rtc = k tc [ M n .] [ M m .]

Mn + Mm

Rtd = k td [ M n. ] [ M m .]

Mm + Mn-m Rd = 2 k dpol [ M n ]

Fig. 21.11. Reaction mechanism of ultrasound-induced radical


polymerization, assuming intrinsic polymerization and avoiding
thermal initiation.

ultrasound appears to be more ecient at lower temperatures [128]; see also Section 21.3.2. In contrast to conventional thermal initiators such as potassium persulfate, ultrasound can initiate a polymerization reaction at ambient temperatures. It
should be noted, however, that the propagation rate increases with an increasing
temperature. Therefore, a suitable well-tuned system has to be chosen to optimize
ultrasound-induced polymerization. In the literature, several bulk polymerizations
initiated by ultrasound have been reported; examples are the polymerization of
methyl methacrylate [116, 144, 145], ethyl methacrylate [146], n-butyl methacrylate
[117, 141], and styrene [147]. Since the basic reaction kinetics are well known [144,
148] the ultrasound-induced polymerization of MMA is by far the most studied
system. Typically, the resulting molecular weight of the PMMA obtained is in the
range 1  10 5 6  10 5 g mol1 .
An important parameter during ultrasound-induced bulk polymerizations is the
viscosity. As the reaction proceeds, the polymer chains formed cause a dramatic
increase in the viscosity, resulting in slower growth and collapse of the cavity. As

3.0x10

-9

2.5x10

-9

2.0x10

-9

1.5x10
1.0x10

5.0x10

MMA
PMMA

3.5x10

-4

3.0x10

-4

2.5x10

-4

2.0x10

-4

1.5x10

-4

1.0x10

-4

5.0x10

-5

-9

-9

-10

Kd PMMA (1/s)

Kd MMA (1/s)

21.3 Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

Weight % PMMA
Radical formation rate constants from MMA and
PMMA as a function of the weight percentage of polymer
dissolved at a temperature of 293 K and an ultrasound intensity
of 62 W cm2 [142].
Fig. 21.12.

the cavitations become less eective, the radical formation rate both from monomer and from polymer will decrease. Subsequently, the reaction rate decreases as
shown in Figure 21.13. At a conversion of approximately 20% the collapse is no
longer suciently strong to induce hot-spot temperatures that are able to generate
monomeric radicals. Moreover, the strain rates outside the collapsing bubble are
not large enough to produce polymeric radicals by polymer scission [116]. As a
consequence, the polymerization ultimately stops at this conversion, which represents a serious drawback for the development of ultrasound-induced bulk polymerization toward industrial application.
Precipitation Polymerization
As described in Section 21.3.3.1, ultrasound-induced bulk polymerizations are
limited to relatively low conversions, because a strong increase in viscosity upon
reaction hinders cavitation. In order to obtain higher conversions, precipitation
polymerization forms a potential solution. Because the polymer produced is precipitated from the reaction medium, the viscosity and consequently the radical formation rate are expected to remain virtually constant. From this perspective, liquid
carbon dioxide is a suitable reaction medium, because most monomers have a high
solubility in CO2 , whereas it exhibits an anti-solvent eect for most polymers.
Moreover, CO2 is regarded as an environmentally friendly compound, which is
nontoxic, nonammable, and naturally abundant. Since higher pressures are required for CO2 to act as an anti-solvent [56, 149], the possibility of ultrasoundinduced cavitation in pressurized carbon dioxide systems has been studied [73, 150].
21.3.3.2

1069

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

10.0

Conversion (%)

1070

298 K
313 K

7.5

5.0

2.5

0.0

Time (h)
Fig. 21.13. Conversion development of an ultrasound-induced
bulk polymerization of MMA at 298 and 313 K [150]. The
broken lines indicate the initial reaction rate.

During pressurization of a liquid, the Blake threshold pressure [Eq. (4)] increases, which implies that higher acoustic pressures are needed to produce cavitations. Obviously, no cavitation occurs when the Blake threshold pressure exceeds
the maximum acoustic pressure that can be applied with the currently available
equipment. The vapor pressure of the liquid, however, can counteract the static
pressure (see Figure 21.14). As a result of this, the Blake threshold is reduced in
liquids with a high vapor pressure, such as CO2 , ethylene, and ammonia. This enables cavitation at increased static pressures [73, 150]. Additionally, the dynamic
movement of the bubble in pressurized CO2 has been calculated using the dynamic bubble model based on the RayleighPlesset equation. According to the calculations, the bubble exhibits a similar movement to that of water at ambient pressure. To validate these simulations, cavitation experiments have been performed
in pressurized CO2 MMA systems using the radical scavenger 1,1-diphenyl-2picrylhydrazyl [151]. The radical formation rate appears to be in the order of
1:5  104 s1 , from which no noticable dierence occurs upon varying the
MMACO2 ratios. Moreover, ultrasound-induced polymerizations of MMA in
CO2 -expanded MMA have resulted in high molecular weight polymers [151].
Emulsion Polymerization
The generation of radicals by ultrasound can also be applied in emulsion polymerization, which comprises a free-radical polymerization in a heterogeneous reaction
system, yielding submicron polymer particles in a continuous aqueous phase. Ultrasound can be applied for emulsication purposes as well as at higher conversions in the emulsion polymerization process.
21.3.3.3

21.3 Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

70
60

Pressure (bar)

50
40

Blake threshold H2O


Blake threshold CO2
Vapour pressure H2O
Vapour pressure CO2

30
20
10
0
275

280

285

290

295

300

305

Temperature (K)
Fig. 21.14. Calculated Blake threshold and vapor pressure for
water and carbon dioxide at 58.2 bar [73].

At the beginning of the polymerization, emulsication and nucleation govern


the course of the process. The monomer droplets have to be small enough to provide a negligible resistance to monomer transport from the droplets through the
aqueous phase to the growing polymer particles. Only in the case of sucient
emulsication, can intrinsic polymerization kinetics be assumed. This implies
that in conventional emulsion polymerization vigorous stirring is required to disperse the monomer droplets. When ultrasound is applied as an energy source
for emulsication, a very uniform emulsion of small monomer droplets is obtained without additional stirring. The high implosion velocity of the cavitation
bubbles ensures that the monomer droplets are well dispersed. A special case involves mini- or microemulsion polymerization. Depending on the surfactant system used and the emulsication induced by ultrasound, the monomer droplets
become so small that they can serve as nucleation loci. In ordinary emulsion polymerization, the main locus of nucleation is within the monomer-swollen micelles.
Typically, polymer particles produced by ultrasound-induced emulsion polymerization have a diameter of approximately 50 nm [152, 153].
During emulsion polymerization induced by ultrasound, the redundancy of initiator is advantageous in terms of process control and safety. Moreover, initiator
residues do not contaminate the product. In contrast to ultrasound-induced bulk
polymerizations, high conversions can be obtained in ultrasound-induced emulsion polymerization [154, 155]. Since a heterogeneous reaction system is involved,
in which the polymer is insoluble in the continuous aqueous phase, the viscosity of
the water phase does not increase upon reaction. The cavitation events occur in the
continuous phase, producing radicals mainly from water and surfactant molecules

1071

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

[156]. Subsequently, the oligomeric radicals enter the monomer-swollen polymer


particles and continue to polymerize. Examples of ultrasound-induced emulsion
polymerization are described for styrene [153, 155, 157], methyl methacrylate
[152, 156, 158161], and n-butyl acrylate [162] and the copolymerization of vinyl
acetate and butyl acrylate is also reported [154].
21.3.4

Cavitation-induced Polymer Scission

In terms of product properties, the molecular weight distribution is an important


characteristic of polymers. In the polymer industry a post-processing step is often
applied to alter the molecular weight of the polymers, for example for the peroxideinduced degradation of polypropylene [163]. In this process, fracture of the polymer chain occurs at a random site. An alternative method is ultrasound-induced
polymer scission, which involves a much better-controlled, nonrandom process
[119]. This enables relatively straightforward production of the desired molecular
weight as well as the formation of block copolymers, as described in Section 21.3.5.
It has been shown that ultrasound-induced polymer breakage is a direct consequence of cavitation because, under conditions that suppress cavitation, no degradation is observed. In this nonrandom scission process the polymer is fractured at
the center of the chain [164, 165]. This is clearly shown in Figure 21.15, in which a
polymer with a molecular weight of 90 kg mol1 is produced from a polymer with
an initial molecular weight of 180 kg mol1 . It is often thought that the extreme
temperatures inside the bubble upon implosion contribute to the degradation.

6
5

dwt/d(logM)

1072

0 min
5 min
10 min
20 min
40 min

3
2
1
0
4
10

10

Molecular weight (g/mol)


Fig. 21.15. Molecular weight distributions of an ultrasoundinduced polymer scission of PMMA into MMA with an initial
Mn of 18:0  10 4 g mol1 [151].

21.3 Ultrasound-induced Radical Polymerization

However, temperature degradation implies a random process and thus does not explain the scission in the middle of the chain.
Ultrasound-induced chain fracture arises from the high strain rates on the polymer chain upon implosion. The nonrandom fracture in the middle of the chain by
cavitation can only occur when the polymer chain is in a nonrandom conformation
and thus completely stretched [166, 167]. In the absence of an external force a polymer chain in solution is randomly coiled. Upon bubble collapse, the entire molecule will move along with the uid. However, due to the velocity prole near the
cavities, friction between the polymer chain and the liquid will occur. Under suciently strong ow conditions, the solvent drag force causes extension of the polymer molecule and nally full stretching. If the polymer chain is stretched, the
maximum stress due to the drag force will be in the center of the polymer chain,
which is in analogy with ow-induced polymer scission [168]. If the drag force on
the stretched polymer molecule exceeds the bond strength, scission will occur in
the middle of the chain; otherwise the chain is not fractured and a limiting molecular weight (Mlim ) is reached [169]. This limiting molecular weight is no longer
fractured as the forces acting on the chain are smaller than the force required to
break a bond.
The kinetics of ultrasonic scission can be directly ascribed to the implosion
velocity of the cavitation bubbles and the polymer that is fractured. The scission
rate and the limiting molecular weight are thus inuenced by the ultrasonic wave,
the solvent properties, and the polymer structure. The inuence of ultrasound intensity, liquid viscosity, and liquid temperature on the degradation rate and the
limiting molecular weight have been studied by Price et al. [170]. A higher intensity results in a faster scission and a lower limiting molecular weight. Lower temperatures and lower viscosities have similar inuences on the scission rate and
Mlim . These three eects can be ascribed to the higher implosion velocity, which
induces higher strain rates around the bubble and therefore lead to a lower limiting molecular weight and a higher scission rate.
The initial molecular weight of the polymer inuences neither the implosion velocity of a cavity nor the limiting molecular weight that is reached. However, the
molecular weight has a large inuence on the fracture rate of the polymer chains.
A higher scission rate is observed for polymers with a higher initial molecular
weight [170]. This is a consequence of the higher solvent drag force on the longer
chains. As a result, narrow molecular weight distributions can be produced by
ultrasound-induced polymer scission, because a high molecular weight polymer is
fractured faster. Independently of the initial molecular weight, a similar limiting
molecular weight is obtained for dierent experiments, as the nal conditions are
equal after several breakage events of the higher molecular weight polymers [167].
21.3.5

Synthesis of Block Copolymers

An interesting application of ultrasound-induced scission and polymerization is


the synthesis of block copolymers, which are used in many applications where dif-

1073

1074

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

Ph

Ph

Ph

ultrasound

Ph

)n

)n
ultrasound

Ph

Ph

)n

Ph

Ph

)n (

)n

)n

Fig. 21.16. The production of a block copolymer from two


homopolymers with ultrasound [117].

ferent polymers are connected to yield a material with hybrid properties [171], for
instance as a compatibilizing agent between immiscible polymers [172]. Anionic
and living radical polymerization reactions are the most important techniques for
synthesis of block copolymers. Alternatively, ultrasound can be used to produce
these block copolymers, for which two dierent methods are applicable.
The rst route to synthesis of block copolymers by ultrasound starts with the
dissolution of a homopolymer in a dierent monomer [173]. Subsequently, ultrasonic scission of the polymer chains generates polymeric radicals, which initiate
the polymerization reaction with the monomer present. In this way ultrasound
provides the controlled formation of block copolymers, examples of which are polyethylene with acrylamide [173], and PMMA with styrene [174]. Secondly, dissolving two dierent homopolymers in a nonreactive solvent can lead to block copolymers as well (see Figure 21.16). In this case, the polymeric radicals generated have
to undergo termination by cross-combination [170, 175]. If no cross-combination
occurs, the original homopolymers are reproduced again. The advantage of the
second method is that block copolymers can be produced from homopolymers of
which the polymermonomer systems are immiscible. Using this approach the
synthesis of the block copolymer of polystyrene and poly(methyl phenyl silane)
[170] as well as the block copolymer of poly(vinyl chloride) and poly(acrylonitrileco-butadiene) [171] has been described.

21.4

Concluding Remarks and Outlook for the Future

In this chapter, supercritical carbon dioxide and ultrasound have been discussed as
two examples of emerging technologies in polymer processes. Replacing the traditional organic solvents with supercritical carbon dioxide provides possibilities for

21.4 Concluding Remarks and Outlook for the Future

the development of sustainable polymer processes. Additionally, the tunability of


the solvent and the relatively easy separation of the polymer from the reaction
medium are important advantages. However, applying scCO2 as a clean solvent
in polymer processes is not the simplest route, because it implies, among other
things, high-pressure equipment, complex phase behavior, new measurement
techniques, and the development of novel process concepts rather than extending
the conventional technologies. Currently, there is a lack of integrated tools between
the research on a laboratory scale and the industrial-scale application, mainly
caused by the absence of pilot-scale facilities. Recent innovative tools, such as
supercritical reaction calorimetry [176] on the liter scale, could ll this gap by allowing the determination of engineering, process, scaleup, and safety data [177].
Additionally, several process design calculations have shown that polymer processes based on scCO2 technology can be economically feasible, depending on the
value of the product and the process conditions. Moreover, further developments
will reduce costs of supercritical application substantially. It is expected that the
major application of supercritical carbon dioxide will rst be in the food and pharmaceuticals industry because of additional marketing advantages, such as the
GRAS (generally regarded as safe) status. Nevertheless, the fact that DuPont is
commercializing the production of uoropolymers in scCO2 illustrates the possibility of applying supercritical uid technology in polymer processes as well. In
addition, the long-existing ldPE tubular process (approximately 2500 bar, 600 K)
proves that a high-pressure polymerization process performed on a large scale can
survive in a highly competitive eld.
With respect to controllability of polymerization processes, ultrasound has signicant potential as a clean and safe technology. After the production of most
types of polymers, catalyst and initiator residues contaminate the product. Since
ultrasound generates the radicals in situ, no initiator or catalyst is required to start
a polymerization reaction. In addition, high-temperature free-radical polymerization is emerging in order to avoid the use of initiators that will remain present in
the polymer chain at the end of the process [178]. The mechanism of thermal initiation at high temperatures is still not well described. However, in analogy with
initiation by ultrasound at low temperatures, high-temperature processes open
the route for the sustainable production of polymers composed only of monomer
units. An additional advantage of ultrasound is the intrinsically safe operation,
because turning o the electrical power supply will immediately stop the radical
formation and consequently the polymerization reaction. Besides polymerization,
polymer scission can also occur through irradiation with ultrasound, due to the
rapid ow around a cavitation bubble. At a suciently small chain length, further
fracture of the polymer is prevented. In this way ultrasound-induced polymer scission provides an additional means to control the molecular weight of the product.
At the moment the major challenge of ultrasound-induced polymer processes is
the scaleup, mainly in terms of energy conversion of the ultrasound generator
to the probe. Although no large-scale industrial polymerization process based on
ultrasound exists yet, commercial applications in other elds such as ultrasound
cleaning and sterilization prove that ultrasound is a readily available technique

1075

1076

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

and relatively simple to implement in existing industrial equipment. Still, the application of ultrasound for polymerization purposes requires a thorough, multidisciplinary understanding of both ultrasound parameters and liquid properties,
including physics, chemistry, and engineering.
In general, the various subjects in this chapter have been addressed from an engineering point of view, for which industrial application is one of the important
issues. Although signicant eort is being put into new developments by a large
number of research groups, the development trajectory from the concept idea, via
the laboratory, bench, and pilot scale, toward industrial implementation is often
long and not easy. To reduce the boundaries between the academic approach and
industrial practice, collaboration between industrial R&D, research institutes, and
universities is essential to reduce costs and to exploit existing know-how and experimental facilities, as well as to reduce the development time. Given the economics
of an emerging technology as compared to long-existing processes, it is a challenge
to implement new process concepts at reasonable costs. For these reasons, in the
short term the number of large-scale industrial polymer processes based on supercritical uid or ultrasound technology will be limited, for which stimulation from
government and research consortia can contribute substantially to facilitate the
development trajectory. Nevertheless, the progress made in research today will enable the development of sustainable and well-controlled polymer processes for the
future.

Acknowledgments

The author thanks Marc Jacobs and Martijn Kuijpers for their contribution to this
chapter.

Notation

AUS
f
IUS
P0
PA
PA; max
PB
Pc
Pv
Q
Q US
R0
Tc
Tg

surface area of ultrasound source [m 2 ]


frequency [Hz]
ultrasound intensity [W/cm2 ]
external pressure [bar]
acoustic pressure [bar]
maximum acoustic amplitude [bar]
Blake threshold pressure [bar]
critical pressure [bar]
vapor pressure [bar]
quadrupole moment [J 1=2 m 5=2 ]
ultrasound power transferred to liquid [W]
equilibrium radius of cavitation bubble [m]
critical temperature [K]
glass transition temperature [K]

References

speed of sound in medium [m s1 ]


polarizability [m 3 ]
potential energy [J]
dipole moment [C m]
speed of sound in medium [m s1 ]
density [kg m3 ]
surface tension [N m1 ]

v
a
Gij
m
v
r
s

References
1 International Institute of Synthetic

3
4

5
6
7
8

9
10

11
12

Rubber Producers, Inc., Internet


publication http://www.iisrp.com/
WebPolymers/
o1FinalPolybutadieneVer2.pdf.
D. T. Allen, D. R. Shonnard, Green
Engineering, Environmentally Conscious
Design of Chemical Processes, Prentice
Hall PTR, Upper Saddle River, 2002.
J. M. DeSimone, Science, 2002, 297,
799.
P. T. Anastas, Green chemistry as
applied to solvents, in Clean Solvents,
Alternative Media for Chemical Reactions and Processing, M. A. Abraham,
L. Moens (eds.), ACS Symposium
Series no. 819, Washington DC, 2002.
J. F. Brennecke, E. J. Maginn,
AIChE J., 2001, 47(11), 2384.
M. Modell, US Patent 4 338 199,
1982.
T. B. Thomason, M. Modell, Hazard
Waste, 1984, 1(4), 453.
S. Angus, B. Armstrong, K. M. de
Reuck, International Thermodynamic
Tables of the Fluid State. Carbon
Dioxide, Pergamon Press, Oxford,
1976.
R. Span, W. Wagner, J. Phys. Chem.
Ref. Data, 1996, 25, 1509.
R. C. Reid, J. M. Prausnitz, B. E.
Poling, The Properties of Gases and
Liquids, 4th ed., McGraw-Hill, New
York, 1987.
C. F. Kirby, M. A. McHugh, Chem.
Rev., 1999, 99, 565.
J. M. Prausnitz, R. N. Lichtenthaler, E. G. de Azevedo, Molecular
Thermodynamics of Fluid Phase
Equilibria, 2nd ed., Prentice-Hall,
Englewood Clis, 1986.

13 N. Ajzenberg, F. Trabelsi, F.

14
15

16
17

18

19
20

21
22

23
24

25

Recasens, Chem. Eng. Technol., 2000,


23(10), 829.
H. Orbey, C. P. Bokis, C. C. Chen,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 1998, 37, 4481.
M. A. McHugh, V. J. Krukonis,
Supercritical Fluid Extractions:
Principles and Practice, 2nd ed.,
Butterworth-Heinemann, Stoneham,
MA, 1994.
J. J. Suarez, I. Medina, J. L. Bueno,
Fluid Phase Equilibria, 1998, 153, 167.
F. Rindeisch, T. P. DiNoia, M. A.
McHugh, J. Phys. Chem., 1996, 100,
15 581.
T. Sarbu, T. Styranec, E. J. Beckman, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 2000, 39,
1678.
T. Sarbu, T. Styranec, E. J. Beckman, Nature, 2000, 405, 165.
S. G. Kazarian, M. F. Vincent, F. V.
Bright, C. L. Liotta, C. A. Eckert, J.
Am. Chem. Soc., 1996, 118, 1729.
S. G. Kazarian, Polym. Sci., Ser. C,
2000, 42(1), 78.
Y. Zhang, K. K. Gangwani, R. M.
Lemert, J. Supercrit. Fluids, 1997, 11,
115.
T. Hirose, K. Mizoguchi, Y. Kamiya,
J. Polym. Sci. B, 1986, 24, 2107.
T. J. de Vries, Late Transition State
Metal Catalyzed Polymerizations of
Olens in Supercritical Carbon Dioxide,
PhD thesis, Technische Universiteit
Eindhoven, Eindhoven, 2003.
M. A. Jacobs, Measurement and
Modeling of Thermodynamic Properties
for Processing of Polymers in Supercritical Fluids, PhD thesis, Technische
Universiteit Eindhoven, Eindhoven,
2004.

1077

1078

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes


26 R. G. Wissinger, M. E. Pauliatis, J.
27
28

29
30
31

32

33

34

35

36

37

38
39

40

41
42

Polym. Sci. B, 1987, 25, 2497.


R. G. Wissinger, M. E. Pauliatis,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 1991, 30, 842.
S. G. Kazarian, M. F. Vincent, F. V.
Bright, C. L. Liotta, C. A. Eckert, J.
Am. Chem. Soc., 1996, 118, 1729.
S. G. Kazarian, Appl. Spectroscopy
Rev., 1997, 32, 301.
T. Miyoshi, K. Takegoshi, T. Tereo,
Macromolecules, 1997, 30, 6582.
K. Otake, S. E. Webber, P. Munk,
K. P. Johnston, Langmuir, 1997, 13,
3047.
M. A. Jacobs, M. F. Kemmere, Th.
W. de Loos, J. T. F. Keurentjes, 4th
International Symposium on High
Pressure Technology and Chemical
Engineering, Venice, Chem. Eng.
Trans., 2002, 2, 779.
A. Rajendran, B. Bonavoglia, G.
Storti, M. Mazzotti, Annual AIChE
Meeting, 2003, San Francisco, paper
95F.
I. S. Liau, M. A. McHugh, in
Supercritical Fluid Technology, J. M. L.
Penninger, M. Radosz, M. A.
McHugh (eds.), Elsevier Science,
Amsterdam, 1985.
E. Sada, H. Kumazawa, H. Yakushiji,
Y. Bamba, K. Sakata, S. Wang, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res., 1987, 26, 433.
A. R. Berens, G. S. Huvard, in
Supercritical Fluid Science and
Technology, American Chemical
Society, Washington DC, 1989, p. 207.
Y. Zhang, K. Gangwani, R. M.
Lemert, J. Supercrit. Fluids, 1997, 11,
115.
C. F. Kirby, M. A. McHugh, Chem.
Rev., 1999, 99, 565.
J. A. M. van Hest, G. A. M. Diepen,
Solubility of naphthalene in supercritical methane, in The Physics and
Chemistry of High Pressures, Symposium
Papers, Society of Chemical Industry,
London, 1963, p. 10.
Th. W. de Loos, W. Poot, G. A. M.
Diepen, Macromolecules, 1983, 16,
111.
M. A. McHugh, T. L. Guckes,
Macromolecules, 1985, 18, 674.
M. Lora, M. A. McHugh, Fluid Phase
Equilib., 1999, 157, 285.

43 Th. W. de Loos, W. Poot, R. N.

44
45
46

47

48
49
50
51
52
53
54

55
56
57

58
59
60
61

62

63
64

Lichtenthaler, J. Supercrit. Fluids,


1995, 8, 282.
A. A. Kiamos, M. D. Donohue,
Macromolecules, 1994, 27, 357.
Y. Xiong, E. Kiran, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 1994, 53, 1179.
T. M. Martin, A. A. Lateef, C. B.
Roberts, Fluid Phase Equilib., 1999,
154, 241.
T. J. de Vries, P. J. A. Somers, Th. W.
de Loos, M. A. G. Vorstman, J. T. F.
Keurentjes, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res.,
2000, 39, 4510.
I. C. Sanchez, R. H. Lacombe, J.
Phys. Chem., 1976, 80, 2352.
R. H. Lacombe, I. C. Sanchez, J.
Phys. Chem., 1976, 80, 2568.
I. C. Sanchez, R. H. Lacombe,
Macromolecules, 1978, 11, 1145.
S. H. Huang, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1990, 29, 2284.
S. H. Huang, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1991, 30, 1994.
S. H. Huang, M. Radosz, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1993, 32, 762.
M. A. Jacobs, T. J. de Vries, M. F.
Kemmere, Th. W. de Loos, J. T. F.
Keurentjes, Recent Res. Devel. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 2002, 1, 171.
K. M. Scholsky, J. Supercrit. Fluids,
1993, 6, 103.
K. A. Shaffer, J. M. DeSimone,
Trends in Polym. Sci., 1995, 3(5), 146.
J. L. Kendall, D. A. Canelas, J. L.
Young, J. M. DeSimone, Chem. Rev.,
1999, 99, 543.
A. I. Cooper, J. Mater. Chem., 2000,
10, 207.
J. M. DeSimone, Z. Guan, C. S.
Elsbernd, Science, 1992, 257, 945.
M. Shaw, J. Ryan, C. Erkey, Abstr.
Am. Chem. Soc., 1997, 214, 243.
M. Poliakoff, S. M. Howdle, M. W.
George, High pressure chemical
engineering, in Process Techn. Proc.,
Ph. R. von Rohr, Ch. Trepp (eds.),
Elsevier, Amsterdam, 1996, p. 67.
Z. Guan, J. R. Combes, C. S.
Elsbernd, J. M. DeSimone, Polym.
Prepr. Am. Chem. Soc., 1993, 34, 329.
M. R. Clark, J. M. DeSimone,
Macromolecules, 1995, 28, 3002.
J. R. Combes, Z. Guan, J. M.

References

65

66

67

68
69

70
71

72

73

74

75

76

77

78

79
80
81

DeSimone, Macromolecules, 1994, 27,


865.
S. Beuermann, M. Buback, C.
Isemer, A. Wahl, Macromol. Rapid
Commun., 1999, 20, 26.
J. M. DeSimone, E. E. Maury, Y. Z.
Menceloglu, J. B. McClain, T. J.
Romack, J. R. Combes, Science, 1994,
265, 356.
D. A. Canelas, D. E. Betts, J. M.
DeSimone, Macromolecules, 1996, 29,
2818.
F. A. Adamsky, E. J. Beckman,
Macromolecules, 1994, 27, 312.
R. Butler, C. M. Davies, A. I.
Cooper, Adv. Mater., 2001, 13(19),
1459.
C. D. Wood, A. I. Cooper, Macromolecules, 2001, 34, 5.
P. A. Carpentier, K. A. Kennedy,
J. M. DeSimone, G. W. Roberts,
Macromolecules, 1999, 32, 5973.
P. A. Carpentier, J. M. DeSimone,
G. W. Roberts, Continuous polymerization in supercritical carbon
dioxide, in Clean Solvents, Alternative
Media for Chemical Reactions and Processing, M. A. Abraham, L. Moens
(eds.), ACS Symposium Series No.
819, Washington DC, 2002.
M. W. A. Kuijpers, D. van Eck, M. F.
Kemmere, J. T. F. Keurentjes,
Science, 2002, 298, 1969.
T. J. de Vries, R. DuChateau, M. A.
G. Vorstman, J. T. F. Keurentjes,
Chem. Comm., 2000, 263.
T. J. de Vries, M. F. Kemmere, J. T.
F. Keurentjes, Macromolecules, 2004,
37(11), 4241.
R. Kondo, K. Toshima, S.
Matsumura, Macromol. Biosci., 2002,
2(6), 267.
M. S. Super, E. Beluche, C. A.
Costello, E. Beckman, Macromolecules, 1997, 30, 368.
M. F. Kemmere, T. J. de Vries, M. A.
G. Vorstman, J. T. F. Keurentjes,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 2001, 56, 4197.
A. Ahvenainen, K. Sarantila, H.
Andtsjo, WO Patent 92/12 181, 1992.
G. Parkinson, Chem. Eng., 1999,
106(May), 17.
B. Bungert, G. Sadowski, W. Arlt,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 1998, 37, 3208.

82 Y. T. Shieh, J. H. Su, G. Manivan-

83
84
85

86

87
88
89
90
91

92

93

94
95

96

97

98

99

100

nan, P. F. Lee, S. P. Sawan, W. D.


Spall, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1996, 59,
695.
Y. W. Chiu, C. S. Tan, J. Supercrit.
Fluids, 2001, 21, 81.
S. Alsoy, J. L. Duda, AIChE J., 1998,
44, 582.
M. F. Kemmere, M. H. W. Cleven,
M. A. van Schilt, J. T. F. Keurentjes,
Chem. Eng. Sci., 2002, 57, 3929.
M. R. De Giorgi, E. Cadoni, D.
Maricca, A. Piras, Dyes and Pigments,
2002, 45, 75.
M. W. Park, H. K. Bae, J. Supercrit.
Fluids, 2002, 22, 65.
O. Guney, A. Akgerman, AIChE J.,
2002, 48, 856.
A. I. Cooper, Adv. Mater., 2003,
15(13), 1.
J. J. Watkins, T. J. McCarthy,
Macromolecules, 1994, 27, 4845.
R. C. Petersen, D. W. Matson, R. D.
Smith, Polym. Eng. Sci., 1987, 27,
1693.
Y. Chernyak, F. Henon, R. B.
Harris, R. D. Gould, R. K.
Franklin, J. R. Edwards, J. M.
DeSimone, R. G. Carbonell, Ind.
Eng. Chem. Res., 2001, 40, 6118.
R. K. Franklin, J. R. Edwards, Y.
Chernyak, R. D. Gould, F. Henon,
R. G. Carbonell, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res., 2001, 40, 6127.
J. Jung, M. Perrut, J. Supercrit.
Fluids, 2001, 20, 179.
C. Lee, K. L. Hoy, M. D. Donohue,
U.S. Patent 4 923 720, 1990; U.S.
Patent 5 027 742, 1991.
J. J. Shim, M. Z. Yates, K. P.
Johnston, Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 2001,
38, 3655.
H. J. Vandenburg, A. A. Clifford,
K. D. Bartle, J. Carroll, I. Newton,
L. M. Garden, J. R. Dean, C. T.
Costley, Analyst, 1997, 122, 101R.
N. J. Cotton, K. D. Bartle, A. A.
Clifford, C. J. Dowle, J. Appl. Polym.
Sci., 1993, 48, 1607.
X. W. Lou, H. G. Janssen, C. A.
Cramers, J. Microcolumn Separations,
1995, 7(4), 303.
M. D. Bermudez, F. J. CarrionVilches, G. Martinez-Nicolas, M.

1079

1080

21 Recent Developments in Polymer Processes

101

102

103
104

105

106

107
108

109

110
111
112

113
114
115

116
117
118
119
120

Pagan, J. Supercrit. Fluids, 2002, 23,


59.
J. K. Sekinger, G. N. Ghebremeskel,
L. H. Concienne, Rubber Chemistry
and Technology, 1996, 69, 851.
M. F. Kemmere, M. A. van Schilt,
M. H. W. Cleven, A. M. van Herk,
J. T. F. Keurentjes, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res., 2002, 41, 2617.
G. Brunner, Nato Science Ser. E, Appl.
Sci., 2000, 366, 517.
P. Mengal, J.-Y. Clavier, M. Perrut,
GVC-department, High Pressure
Chemical Engineering, March 35,
Karlsruhe, Germany, 1999, p. 279.
A. R. Berens, G. S. Huvard, R. W.
Korsmeyer, F. W. Kunig, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1992, 46, 231.
B. L. West, S. G. Kazarian, M. F.
Vincent, N. H. Brantley, C. A.
Eckert, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 1998, 69,
911.
Y. Wang, C. Y. Yang, D. Tomasko,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 2002, 41, 1780.
P. D. Condo, S. R. Sumpter, M. L.
Lee, K. P. Johnston, Ind. Eng. Chem.
Res., 1996, 35, 1115.
S. G. Kazarian, M. F. Vincent, B. L.
West, C. A. Eckert, J. Supercrit.
Fluids, 1998, 13, 107.
W. Saus, D. Knittel, E. Schollmeyer, Textile Res. J., 1993, 63(3), 135.
J. von Schnitzler, R. Eggers, J.
Supercrit. Fluids, 1999, 16, 81.
S. M. Howdle, J. M. Ramsay, A. I.
Cooper, J. Polym. Sci. B Polym. Phys.,
1994, 32(3), 541.
X. Ma, D. L. Tomasko, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 1997, 36, 1586.
S. K. Liao, P. S. Chang, Y. C. Lin, J.
Polym. Res. Taiwan, 2000, 7(3), 155.
D. Knittel, W. Saus, E.
Schollmeyer, Indian J. Fibre Textile
Res., 1997, 22, 184.
P. Kruus, T. J. Patraboy, J. Phys.
Chem., 1985, 89, 3379.
G. J. Price, Ultrason. Sonochem., 1996,
3, S229.
G. J. Price, Adv. Sonochem., 1990, 1,
231.
J. Niezette, A. Linkens, Polymer,
1978, 19, 939.
J. P. Lorimer, T. J. Mason, Chem.
Soc. Rev., 1987, 16, 239.

121 L. Kornet, A. P. Hoeks, B. J.

122
123
124

125

126

127

128

129

130

131
132

133

134
135
136

137
138

Janssen, J. M. Willigers, R. S.
Reneman, J. Hypertension, 2002, 20,
1165.
Y. T. Didenko, K. S. Suslick, Nature,
2002, 407, 877.
K. S. Suslick, Sci. Am., 1989, 260,
80.
A. Shoh, Ultrasonics, in Kirk-Othmer
Encyclopedia of Chemical Technology,
Wiley, New York, 1983.
M. P. Brenner, S. Hilgenfeldt, D.
Lohse, Rev. Modern Physics, 2002, 74,
425.
W. P. Mason, Physical Acoustics;
Principles and Methods, Vol. IB,
Academic Press, New York, 1964.
K. S. Suslick, Y. Didenko, M. M.
Fang, T. Hyeon, K. J. Kolbeck, W. B.
McNamara III, M. M. Mdeleleni, M.
Wong, Phil. Trans. Roy. Soc. A., 1999,
1.
M. W. A. Kuijpers, M. F. Kemmere,
J. T. F. Keurentjes, Ultrasonics, 2002,
40, 675.
J. M. Loning, C. Horst, U.
Hoffmann, 7th Meeting of the
European Society of Sonochemistry,
2000, p. 197.
U. Hoffmann, C. Horst, U.
Wietelmann, S. Bandelin, R. Jung,
Sonochemistry, in Ullmanns
Encyclopedia of Industrial Chemistry,
Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 2003.
T. J. Leighton, The Acoustic Bubble,
Academic Press, London, 1994.
Y. T. Shah, A. B. Pandit, V. S.
Moholkar, Cavitation Reaction
Engineering, Plenum, New York, 1999.
S. Hilgenfeldt, M. P. Brenner, S.
Grossmann, D. Lohse, J. Fluid Mech.,
1998, 365, 171.
K. Yasui, J. Acoust. Soc. Am., 1995, 98,
2772.
K. Yasui, Ultrasonics, 1998, 36, 575.
M. W. A. Kuijpers, M. F. Kemmere,
J. T. F. Keurentjes, Ultrasoundinduced radical polymerization, in
Encyclopedia of Polymer Science and
Technology, John Wiley, New York,
2004.
L. H. Thompson, L. K. Doraiswamy,
Ind. Eng. Chem. Res., 1999, 38, 1215.
J. M. Pestman, J. B. F. N. Engberts,

References

139
140
141
142

143
144
145
146

147
148
149

150

151

152
153
154
155
156
157
158

159
160

F. de Jong, Recl. Trav. Chim. Pays-Bas,


1994, 113, 533.
M. Ibisi, B. Brown, J. Acoust. Soc.
Am., 1967, 41, 568.
J.-L. Luche, Synthetic Organic
Chemistry, Plenum, New York, 1998.
G. J. Price, P. J. West, P. F. Smith,
Ultrason. Sonochem., 1994, 1, S51.
M. W. A. Kuijpers, M. F. Kemmere,
J. T. F. Keurentjes, Annual AIChE
Meeting, 2001, paper 341B.
G. J. Price, P. F. Smith, Polymer,
1993, 34, 4111.
P. Kruus, J. A. G. Lawrie, M. L.
ONeill, Ultrasonics, 1988, 26, 352.
G. J. Price, Chemistry & Industry,
1993, 75.
N. Erolan, F. Arisan, H. C
atalgilGiz, Angew. Makromol. Chem., 1995,
226, 53.
P. Kruus, Ultrasonics, 1987, 25, 20.
D. Feldman, Polymer News, 1995, 20,
138.
P. G. Jessop, W. Leitner, Chemical
Synthesis using Supercritical Fluids,
Wiley-VCH, Weinheim, 1999.
M. W. A. Kuijpers, Physics and
Chemistry of Ultrasound Polymer
Reaction Engineering, PhD thesis,
Technische Universiteit Eindhoven,
Eindhoven, 2004.
M. F. Kemmere, M. W. A. Kuijpers,
L. J. M. Jacobs, J. T. F. Keurentjes,
Macromol. Symp., 2004, 206, 321.
H. C. Chou, J. O. Stoffer, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1999, 72, 797.
S. K. Ooi, S. Biggs, Ultrason.
Sonochem., 2000, 7, 125.
G. Cooper, F. Grieser, S. Biggs, J.
Colloid Interface Sci., 1996, 184, 52.
C. Zhang, Q. Wang, H. Xia, G. Qiu,
Eur. Polym. J., 2002, 38, 1769.
H. C. Chou, J. O. Stoffer, J. Appl.
Polym. Sci., 1999, 72, 827.
S. Biggs, F. Grieser, Macromolecules,
1995, 28, 4877.
M. Bradley, M. Ashokkumar, F.
Grieser, J. Am. Chem. Soc., 2003, 125,
525.
H. C. Chou, W. Y. Lin, J. O. Stoffer,
Polym. Mater. Sci. Eng, 1995, 72, 363.
H. C. Chou, Y. B. Liu, O. C. Sitton,

161

162

163

164

165
166

167

168
169
170
171

172

173

174

175
176
177

178

J. O. Stoffer, Polym. Mater. Sci. Eng.,


1993, 69, 376.
Y. Liao, Q. Wang, H. Xia, X. Xu,
S. M. Baxter, R. V. Slone, S. Wu, G.
Swift, D. G. Westmoreland,
Ultrason. Sonochem., 2002, 9, 151.
Q. Wang, H. Xia, Y. Liao, X. Xu,
S. M. Baxter, R. V. Slone, S. Wu, G.
Swift, D. G. Westmoreland, Polym.
Int., 2001, 50, 1252.
A. V. Machado, J. A. Covas, M. van
Duin, J. Appl. Polym. Sci., 2001, 81,
58.
P. A. R. Glyn, B. M. E. van der
Hoff, P. M. Reilly, J. Macromol. Sci.Chem. A6, 1972, 1653.
B. M. E. van der Hoff, C. E. Gall, J.
Macromol. Sci. A, 1977, 11, 1739.
G. Madras, S. Kumar, S.
Chattopadhyay, Polym. Degr. Stab.,
2000, 59, 73.
M. W. A. Kuijpers, P. D. Iedema,
M. F. Kemmere, J. T. F. Keurentjes,
Polymer, 2004, 45, 6461.
A. M. Basedow, K. H. Ebert, Adv.
Polym. Sci., 1977, 22, 83.
J. A. Odell, A. Keller, J. Polym. Sci.
B, 1986, 24, 1889.
G. J. Price, P. J. West, Polymer, 1996,
37, 3975.
I. W. Hamley, Block copolymers, in
Encyclopedia of Polymer Science and
Technology, John Wiley, New York,
2002.
T. J. Mason, Sonochemistry, The Uses of
Ultrasound in Chemistry, CRC Press,
Cleveland, 1990.
H. Fujiwara, J. Tanaka, A.
Horiuchi, Polymer Bulletin, 1996, 36,
723.
G. Schmidt-Naake, M. Drache, M.
Weber, Macromol. Chem. Phys., 2002,
15, 203.
H. Fujiwara, Polymer Bulletin, 2001,
47, 247.
S. Fortini, F. Lavanchy, Th. Meyer,
Macromol. Symp., 2004, 206, 79.
F. Lavanchy, S. Fortini, Th. Meyer,
Organic Process Research Development,
2004, 8(3), 504.
P. Nising, Th. Meyer, Ind. Eng.
Chem. Res., 2004, 43, 7220.

1081

1083

Index
a
AAS, see Atomic absorbtion spectroscopy
AES, see Atomic emmision spectroscopy
Ab-initio calculation 781
Abstraction reaction 784
AC, see Air-to-close valve
Accelerated weathering test 824
Accumulation 556, 580
Acetaldehyde 89
Acid-catalyzed esterication and alcoholysis
86
Acidolysis 86, 100
Acid strength 900
Acid value 860, 865
Acoustic amplitude 1064
Acoustic attenuation spectroscopy 624
Acrylate resins 889
Acrylated oils 891
Acrylic bers 946
Acrylic solutions 951
Acrylics 951
Action spectrum 800
Activated anionic mechanism 348
Activation energy 565, 744, 747
Activation spectrum 799
Activation volume 744
Activity 18
Activity coecient 19, 29, 34
Actuator 629, 652
Adaptive control 664, 668
A/D converter 626
Additives 836
Adiabatic polymerizer 662
Adiabatic temperature rise 308, 546, 565
Adsorbents 989
Advanced control 657
Advancement process 109, 854
AES, see Atomic emission spectroscopy
After-oils 930

Aging prevention for plastic material 818


Agitation requirement 289
Agitator 289
Agitator power 534
Air-gap spinning 921, 956
Air-to-close (AC) valve 652
Air-to-open (AO) valve 652
Alarm 589, 626
Alcohol-isocyanate reaction 893
Alcoholysis, acid-catalyzed 86
Alcoholysis process 857
Alkyd constant 858
Alkyd emulsions 861
Alkyd resins 855
Aminolysis reactions 100
Amino resins 843
Amorphous orientation 919
Amorphous phase 682
Analog lter 627
Analytical pyrolysis 790
Analytical techniques, overview 1016
Analytical tools 12
Anhydrides 86
Anionic polymerization 325
Anisotropic crystallization 918
Anisotropy 886
Antagonistic eect 826
Anti-misting agent 714
Antioxidant 818
Antiozonant 824
Antirad 810
Anti-reset windup 643
AO, see Air-to-open valve
Apolar rubbers 896
Apparent shear rate 934
Apperant equilibrium constant 99
Applications of acrylics 951
Applications of aramids 960
Applications of carbon bers 966

Handbook of Polymer Reaction Engineering. Edited by T. Meyer, J. Keurentjes


Copyright 8 2005 WILEY-VCH Verlag GmbH & Co. KGaA, Weinheim
ISBN: 3-527-31014-2

1084

Index
Applications of gel-spun PE 964
Applications of PVA 953
Aramid 921, 956, 959
Aramid2/Kevlar2 5
Aspect ratio 888
Association behavior 326327, 330, 715
Association number 328329
Atactic polystyrene 721
At-line analysis 1015
At-line conversion measurement 1020
Atomic absorbtion spectroscopy (AAS) 1017
Atomic emission spectroscopy (AES) 1017
Attraction term 37
Autoacceleration 762
Automatic control 650
Auto-oxidation mechanism 782
Autoxidative drying 858
Auxiliary devices 596
Average branching density 491
Average copolymer composition 478
Average molecular weight 123, 269
Average number of radicals per particle 258,
260
Average sequence length 474
Average value 597
Axial-ow 289
Azeotrope 859
Azeotropic distillation 865
Azo initiator 154
Azomethine structure 841

b
Back-biting 67, 189
Backow 648
Backhole 927
Balances 604
Base-mediated curing 901
Basicity of HAS 821
Batch control 669
Batch copolymerization 478
Batch emulsion polymerization 251
Batch polymerization 204
Batch process 195, 579
Batch reactor 335, 669
Bead 216, 233, 238
Beer-Lambert law 607, 618
Bellows pressure gauge 602
Belt balance 605
Belt process 353
Bernoulli equation 607, 611
Bias 640
Bidirectional ber 879
Bifunctional initiator 334, 1035
Bimetallic thermometer 601

Bimodal distribution 343


Bimolecular deactivation 386
Binary format 626
Binomial distribution 456
Birefringence 919
Birth conversion 495
Bisphenol-A 850
Bisphenol-A glycidyl resins 841
Black body 601
Black orlon 966
Blake threshold pressure 1065
Blending process 1058
Block copolymer 335, 338, 342, 344, 351,
690, 714, 1073
Block copolymer application 691
Block diagram 629
Block length distribution 1038
Boltzmann superposition principle 730731
Boltzmanns law 1024
Bonds 114
Bottom-up technique 997
Boublik-Mansoori hardsphere equation 45
Branch point 504, 711
Branched architecture 472, 502
Branching 272, 445
Branching behavior 700
Branching distribution 672
Branching moment distribution 454
Branching parameter 1040
Branching process theory 13
Breakage 218, 229
Breaking strength of a covalent bond 814
Breakthrough in SEC systems 1042
Brittleness 855
Bubble coalescence 974
Bubble growth 974, 976
Bubble nucleation 78, 974
Bubble pressure method 622
Bulk (compression) modulus 725
Bulk molding compound (BMC) 883, 885
Bulk polymerization 1067
Buoyancy method 606
Burgers vector 747
Buttery valve 654

c
Cactus 127
Cage eect 765
Calorimetry 297
Capacitance measurement 608
Capillary electrophoresis 1037
Capillary hydrodynamic fractionation (CHDF)
624
Capillary number 221

Index
Capillary viscometer 619
Capsule 603
Carbenium ion 352
Carbon ber 791, 956, 965, 966
Carbon nanotubes 692
Carbon NMR 1024
Carboxilic anhydrides 853
Carboxylic acids 853
Carpet yarn 916917, 926
Cascade control 650, 660
Cascade theory 480482
Casting 886
Casting system 549
Catalan number 484
Catalysis by metallic compounds 87
Catalyst 451, 842, 1075
Catalyst activity 377
Catalyst deactivation mechanism 375
Cationic curing 900
Cationic photoinitiator 897
Cavitation 654, 1063
Cavitation-induced polymerization 1067
Ceiling temperature 172, 565
Cellulose acetate 944945
Cellulose rayon 965
Cellulose triacetate 921
Central lter 926
Centrifugal casting 882
CFD, see Computational uid dynamics
CHDF, see Capillary hydrodynamic
fractionation
Chain branching 761
Chain conformation 692
Chain growth 564
Chain-growth polymerization 11
Chain mobility 765
Chain orientation 766
Chain retraction 741
Chain scission 190, 714, 771, 803, 809
Chain transfer 166
Chain-transfer constant 167
Chain-transfer mechanism 374
Chain-transfer reaction 775
Chain transfer to hydrogen 386
Chain transfer to polymer 188
Chains of beads and springs 697
Chain walking mechanism 382
Characteristic ratio 723
Charlesby-Pinner plot 809
Check valve 648
Chemical analysis 1015
Chemical composition distribution (CCD)
390, 394, 1037
Chemical defect 795

Chemical defoaming 987


Chemical degradation 758
Chemical derivatization 774
Chemical distribution 341
Chemical engineering 14
Chemical heterogeneity 339
Chemical reaction engineering 5
Chemical resistance 874
Chemicrystallization 766
Chemiluminescence 778, 789
Chemometric analysis 301
Chromatographic retention 1035
Chromel/alumel electrode 601
Chromophore impurities 795
Chromophores 793
Classes approach 444
Closed-loop control 305
Closure problem 438
Cloud-point 1051
CMC, see Critical micelle concentration
Coagulation 294, 946, 959
Coagulation risk 987
Coagulative nucleation 253, 267
Coating process 1059
Coaxial device 620
Cobalt irradiation 806
Co-condensation 845
Cold drawing 932
Cold-press molding 883
Column hold-up volume 1035
Combined scission/branching 501
Comonomer distribution 344
Compartmentalization of radicals 254
Compatible blends 811
Complex owsheets 205
Complex modulus 731
Composite formation 692
Composition measurement 620
Composition of copolymer 292
Composition of monomer 292
Compositional drift 670
Comprehensive two-dimensional LC
instrumentation 1043
Compressibility factor 43
Compressible ow 613, 625
Compton scattering 807
Computational uid dynamics (CFD) 205,
290
Computer simulation 780
Concentrated solutions and melts 698
Concentration of monomer in the polymer
particles 258
Concentration of radicals in the aqueous phase
262

1085

1086

Index
Concentration-sensitive detector 1033
Concerted multidisciplinary approach 15
Condensation 11
Condensed mode 421
Conditional Monte Carlo sampling 502
Conductivity measurement 621
Cone-and-plate viscometer 620
Connectivity 472, 482, 502
Contact ion pairs 324
Contact thermometer 599
Continuos stirred tank reactor (CSTR) 584
Continuous lamination 882
Continuous operation 536
Continuous polymerization 204
Continuous steam stripping 987
Control loop 629
Control of feed 587
Control system 629
Controlled degradation and crosslinking
812
Controlled depressurization 588
Controlled reaction 546
Controlled thermal degradation 791
Controlled variable 628, 639
Controller 628, 639
Controller action 640
Controller gain 640
Controller output 640
Controller tuning 644
Conversion of monomer 291
Converter 626
Cooling 570, 689
Cooling belt 842
Cooling coil 570
Cooling experiment 573
Cooling rate 686
Cooling speed 929
Coordination catalyst 373
Coordination polymerization 12
Coordinator 7
Copolymer 225, 241, 243
Copolymer averaged rate, coecient for
propagation 183
Copolymer composition 338
Copolymerization 179, 338, 413, 451, 473
Copolymer sequence distribution 181
Copolymer-solvent systems phase behavior of
48
Copper/constantan electrode 601
Corded yarn 913
Coriolis owmeter 617
Couette device 961
Couette-Taylor reactor 288
Coulter-counter particle size analyzer 623

Counter 609
Covalent polarized bond 324
Covalent species 352
Crack advance 750
Crack formation 769
Crack tip 750
Cracked specimen 750
Craze-bulk interface 748
Craze bril 749
Craze length 748
Craze nucleation 749
Craze stress 749
Crazing 748
Creep behavior 709
Creep response 708
Critical-angle refractometer 621
Critical length for entry of radicals 267
Critical liquid chromatographic separation
1037
Critical micelle concentration (CMC) 264,
622
Criticality classes 558
Cross-aggregation 329
Crosslink denition 177
Crosslink density 834
Crosslinked polymer 748749
Crosslinkers 467
Crosslinking 272, 771, 809, 868, 871
Crosslinks 834
Cross model 703, 740
Cross-tie bril 750
Crystaf, see Crystallization analysis
fractionation
Crystal thickness 689
Crystalline domains 688
Crystalline morphology 688, 690
Crystalline orientation 919
Crystalline phase 682, 766
Crystalline polymer 681, 688
Crystallinity 1053
Crystallizability 682
Crystallization 680, 686, 918
Crystallization analysis fractionation (Crystaf )
369
Crystallization enhancement 687
Crystallization rate 687
Crystallization reduction 687
Crystallization temperature 686
CSTR, see Continuos stirred tank reactor
Cumulative distribution 407
Cure 835
Curing 564, 871
Cyclic monomers 346
Cyclization of side chains 763

Index

d
D/A converter 626
Damping function 741
Data highway 651
DCS, see Distributed control system
Deadband 647
De-aeration of the melt 924
Dead chain 467
Dead time 636, 639
Deborah number 708
Decomposition 337, 556, 564
Defoaming agent 987
Degradation detection method 767
Degradation reaction of nylon-6 100
Degree of aggregation 329
Degree of branching distribution (DBD)
1040
Degree of crystallinity 766
Degree of polymerization 126, 159
Degree of superheat 976
Delustering 916
Dendrimers 712
Denier 914
Denisov cycle 820
Dense grafting 712
Densimetry 297298
Density balance 617
Depolymerization 356, 566, 973
Depropagation 172, 973
Depropagation in copolymerization 188
Derivative controller (D controller) 641
Derivative kick 642
Derivative mode lter 642
Derivative time 641
Detection time 589
Detector for SEC 1032
Development process 2
Development trajectory 1076
Deviation 597
Deviation variable 632
Devolatilization 971
Diacids 865
Dialkyltin catalyst 89
Diaphragm pressure gauge 603
Diaphragm valve 652
Dibutyltin dilaurate (DBTDL) 893
Dicyclopentadiene (DCPD) 873, 903
Diethylene glycol 89
Diethylenetriamine 853
Dierential refractometer 621
Diusion constant 764
Diusion control 230
Diusion-controlled chain termination 165,
229

Diusion-controlled reaction 190


Diusivity 1049
Digital control system (DCS) 642
Diglycidyl ether of bisphenol-A (DGEBPA)
850, 873
Digraph 114
Dilatant 619
Dilatometer 619
Dilute solution 696
Dimensional temperature dependance 1003
Dimensionality 431
Dimethylol urea rate of formation 104
Diols 864
Dioxane 90
Dipole moment 1050
Direct esterication process 91
Dislocations 747
Dispersion polymerization 256, 1057
Dispersion term 4546
Disproportionation 166, 440
Distributed control system (DCS) 627, 651,
668, 672
Distribution coecient 1034
Distribution of active polymer chains 269
Distribution of feed 535
Distribution of inactive chains 269
Distributive properties 431
Disturbance variable 628, 640
Doi and Edwards model 738, 740
Doolittles equation 734
Dormant end group 345
Double-screw reactor 356
Drag-reducing agent 714
Draw ratio 748, 932933
Drawing 931
Drop coalescence 222, 235
Drop-in technology 373
Drop mixing 224, 240
Drop size 216
Drop size distribution 222223, 227
Drop stabilizer 214, 223
Dry spinning 921, 944, 955
Dual-exposure photoembossing 1007
Dulling agent 916
Dumbbell model 697, 703
Dumping 588
Dyads 64
Dyeing 1061
Dynamic control 553
Dynamic head-space 1023
Dynamic light scattering 624
Dynamic modulus 731
Dynamic oscillatory ow 709
Dynamic SIMS 1026

1087

1088

Index
Dynamic stability 584
Dyneema 962, 964
Dyneema process 962

e
EKF, see Extended Kalman lter
Elastic behavior 936
Elastic polymer 706
Elastically active network chain 121
Elastically active network junction 121
Elastomer 725, 727729, 739, 901
Elastomeric green strength 715
Electro-chemical potential method 621
Electron beam accelerator 806
Electron beam lithography 996
Electron spin resonance (ESR) spectroscopy
776, 1017
Electronic balance 605
Electro-pneumatic valve positioner 650
Electrospray ionization (ESI) 1027, 1033
Electrostatic spraying 867
Eleostearic acid 856
Elimination reaction 324, 337
Elongation rate 936
Elongational viscosity 936
Embrittlement 749
Emergency cooling 575, 587
Emerging technologies 7
Emulsication 1071
Emulsion polymer 985
Emulsion polymerization 249, 980, 1057,
1070
Emulsion polymerization reactor 286, 305
End conversion 494
End-to-end distance 723, 738
End-to-end distance of polymer coil 693
End-to-end vector 723, 727, 738
Energy dissipation by the stirrer 578
Energy dose 1003
Energy requirement 8
Energy transfer 808, 811
Enforced cooling 928
Enolization 345
Entanglement 729, 738740, 749
Enthalpy balance 292
Entropic free volume model 36
Environmental and safety issues 15
Environmental aspects 13
Environmentally friendly 255
Enzymatic polymerization 1057
EPDM, see Ethylene-propylene-diene rubbers
Epichlorohydrin (ECH) 108, 850
Epidemic model 790
Epitaxial crystallization 687

Epoxy acrylates 891


Epoxy resins 108, 849
Epoxy-novolacs 841
Equal percentage 652
Equation of state model 39
Equilibrium equations 259
Equilibrium monomer concentration 347,
354
Equilibrium morphology 274
Error 628, 640
Ester enolate anion 345
Esterication 86, 863
Esterication acid-catalyzed 86
Ether bridges 845, 839
Ethoxylation 351
Ethylene 451
Ethylene oxide 349
Ethylene-propene-diene (EPDM) 368, 902
5-Ethylidene-2-norbornene (ENB) 903
Evaporative light-scattering detector (ELSD)
1032
Exchange of bonds 115
Exchange reaction 66
Excited state quencher 808
Exothermic reaction 541, 565
Expansion factor 613
Expansion thermometer 601
Exponential smoothing lter 627
Exposure time 74
Extended Kalman lter (EKF) 667
Extensional thickening 705
External impurity 795
Externally applied stress 767
Extraction of VOC 989
Extruder 75, 76, 549
Extrusion 816, 866, 923, 937

f
Fail safe 587
Failure scenario 554
Falling-lm devolatilizer 975
Falling-strand devolatilizer 975
False twist operation 916
Fatty acid 855
Fatty acid process 857
Feedback controller 628
Feedforward control 659, 666
FENE, see Finitely extensible nonlinear elastic
Fiber modulus 915
Fiber polymers 920
Fiber reinforcement 886
Fiber tenacity 915
Fiber terminology 912
Fiber yarn 913, 917

Index
Fibers, denition 912
Fibril 748
Fibril extension 748
Fibril formation 920
Ficks second law 798
Filament 913
Filament number 915
Filament textile acrylics 952
Filament titer 914
Filament winding 882
Filament yarn 913
Fillers 692, 878
Film-formation temperature 273
Film-forming equipment 71
Filter constant 642
Filter package 926, 935, 938
Filtration 926
Finish 929
Finish roll 930
Finite element method 432
Finitely extensible nonlinear elastic (FENE)
dumbbell model 703
First dimension separation 1042
First-order system 632
First-order system plus dead time (FOPDT)
636, 645
First-shell substitution eect (FSSE) 64
Flame retarding agents 849
Flash evaporator 975
Flexibility 866
Flexibilization of amino-resins 849
Flexible foams 111
Float method 606
Flooding 575
Flory distribution 442
Flory-Huggins, multicomponent 70
Flory-Huggins theory 21, 30
Florys chain length distribution 387
Flow-induced degradation 817
Flow measurement 608
Fluidized-bed reactor 82, 417, 420
Fluorescence eect 1019
Fluoropolymer 1057
Foam 111
Foam formation 987
Foam-based devolatilization 974
Food preservation 812
FOPDT, see First-order system plus dead time
Force balance 614
Force eld calculation 782
Formaldehyde 108, 346, 838
Formalin solution 842
Formulation 250
Fouling 570, 925

Fourier analysis 954


Fourier number 955
Fourier transform IR spectroscopy (FTIR)
621, 1023, 1024
Fourier transform ion-cyclotron resonance
spectrometer 1030
Fractionation 1059
Fracture 741742, 748
Fracture behavior 751
Fracture resistance 740, 750751
Fragment 472
Fragmentation 178, 190
Fragmentation in polymer analysis 1027,
1029
Free boiling 976
Free-bubble devolatilization 974
Free ions 324
Free-radical polymerization 1067
Free-radical polymerization, heterogeneous
12
Free-radical polymerization, homogeneous
12
Free-radical polymerization mechanism 157
Free volume 734735, 764
FSSE, see First-shell substitution eect
FTIR, see Fourier transform IR spectroscopy
Fugacity 18
Fugacity coecient 19, 42
Fully oriented yarn (FOY) 933, 940
Fumaric acid 871
Functional monomer 250
Functionality 835
Functionality-type distribution (FTD) 1034,
1041

g
Galerkin hp method 434
Gas chromatograph feedback controller 666
Gas chromatography (GC) 297298, 621,
1022
Gas-phase process 416
Gas-phase reactor 420
Gas-phase stirred-bed reactor 417
Gate valve 656
Gauss normal dierential distribution function
598
Gaussian chain 707
GC, see Gas chromatography
Gel 272
Gelation 714, 837
Gel eect 193, 568569
Gel permeation chromatography (GPC) 622,
664, 771, 1020
Gel point 128, 771, 835

1089

1090

Index
Gel spinning 921, 961, 962
Gel-spun polyethylene 918 964
General-purpose nishes 930
Generation 487
Geometric similarity 295, 534, 536
G-factor 808
Glass lament 875
Glass transition 721, 732733, 735, 745, 683,
764, 901
Glassy polymer 742743, 750
Glycerol 856
Glycidyl group 841, 850
Glyptals 857
Gold distribution 333334
GPC, see Gel permeation chromatography,
see also SEC
Grade transition 669
Gradient elution liquid chromatography
10381039, 1042
Graft copolymers 232
Graph theory 502
Graphite nanosheets 692
Graphitization 966
GRAS (generally regarded as safe) 1075
Gravimetric method 619
Gray 808
Green solvent 1048
Grotthus-Draper law 793
Group contribution Flory model 36
Group contribution methods 35

h
Hagen-Poiseuille law 619
Half-bonds 114
Half-life 162
Half-sandwich metallocene 381
Hand lay-up process 882
Hansen solubility parameters 32
Hard sphere term 44
Hardening 835
Hardness 895
HAS, see Hindered amine stabilizer
HCSTR, see Homogeneous continuous stirred
tank reactor
HDC, see Hydrodynamic chromatography
HDPE, see High-density polyethylene
Head-space gas chromatography 1023
Heart-cut 1041
Heat accumulation 561, 581
Heat balance 292, 554, 559, 562
Heat-balance calorimetry 303
Heat-ow calorimetry 303
Heat loss 562
Heat release 559

Heat removal 194, 560


Heat resistance 779
Heat-resistant polymer 780
Heat-sensitive substrate 869
Heat-shrinkable product 813
Heat stabilizer 975
Heat transfer 214, 227, 235236, 242, 290,
539, 972
Heat-transfer coecient 293, 560
Heat-transfer resistance 400
Heaviside step function 632
Helmholtz energy 44
Helmholtz free energy 726
Henrys constant 974
Henrys law 974
Heterogeneous kinetics 789
Heterogeneous nucleation 252, 264
Heterogeneous oxidation 789
Heterogeneous polymerization 1055
Heterogeneous reaction model 827
Heterolytic bond scission 760
HEUR, see Hydrophobically associting
polymer
Hexamethylenetetramine (HMTA) 838
Hexamethylolmelamine 841
Hierarchical approach 658
High monomer conversion 972
High-density polyethylene (HDPE) 366
High-energy radiation 805
High-impact polypropylene 417
High-impact propylene/ethylene copolymers
368
Highly branched popylethylene 1053
High-modulus high-strength bers (HMHS)
917
High-pressure laminate 843
High-pressure liquid-liquid equilibria 25
High-pressure vapor-liquid equilibria 25
High-speed spin-draw winding (HSSDW)
941
High-speed spinning (HSS) 931
High-temperature gel permeation
chromatography 369
High-tenacity ber 956
Hildebrand theory of 32
Hindered amine stabilizer (HAS) 819
Hindered phenols 818
HMTA, see Hexamethylenetetramine
Holdup scaling factor 537
Hollow particle 273
Holographic photoembossing 1007
Homocondensation 845
Homogeneous continuous stirred tank reactor
(HCSTR) 335

Index
Homogeneous continuous stirred tank reactor,
oscillating feeds 343
Homogeneous deformation 749
Homogeneous nucleation 252, 266
Homogeneous polymerization 1055
Homolytic degradation 760
Hookean elasticity 708
Hookes law 724725
Hosiery yarn 926
Hot cooling 574
Hot drawing 932
Hot-press molding 883
Hot-tube spinning (HTS) 932, 940
Hybrid polymer particles 256
Hybrid polymer-polymer particle 273
Hydride elimination 385
Hydrodynamic chromatography (HDC) 624
Hydrogen bonding 767
Hydrolysis 866
Hydrometer 617
Hydroperester 783
Hydroperoxide 761, 783, 858
Hydrophobically associating polymer (HEUR)
715
Hydrostatic method 607
Hydroxyl value 865
Hydroxymethylation 102
Hyperbranched polymer 712

i
I-controller 641
Ideal elastic response 706
Ideal measured value 597
Ideal PID controller 643
IMC, see Internal model control
Implicit penultimate unit eect 186
Impregnation 1058, 1061
Increase in viscosity 195
Indicator 597, 626
Induction period 777
Industrial-scale SSP 82
Industrial yarn 916917, 924, 926, 928
Inferential control 668
Innite dilution 70
Infrared spectroscopy (IR) 620, 660
Inherent viscosity 664
Inhibition 170, 588
Initiator eciency 156, 972
Initiator residue 1075
Initiation 162, 581, 583, 760, 802
Inorganic powder 243
Inorganic solid 217
Input/output (I/O) 651
Insertion polymerization 903

Inside-out technology 893


In-situ Raman spectroscopy 1018
Instantaneous average molecular weight
269
Instantaneous property 387
Instrument gauge 597
Integral conrtroller 641
Integral of the timeweighted absolute error
(ITAE) 644
Integral of the timeweighted absolute error
tuning rules 645
Integrating process 638
Integrator plus dead time process 639
Interactive liquid chromatography (i-LC)
1034
Interfacial process 94
Interlacing 916
Interlocks 589
Intermolecular chain transfer 356
Intermolecular transfer to polymer 174
Internal impurity 795
Internal model control (IMC) 668
Internal viscosity 765
Interparticle heat transfer 400
Interparticle mass transfer 400
Intramolecular chain transfer 356
Intramolecular H abstraction 784
Intramolecular ring-forming reaction 67
Intramolecular transfer 189
Intraparticle heat transfer 400
Intraparticle mass transfer 400
Intrinsically safe operation 1075
Inventory scaleup factor 543
Inverse emulsion polymerization 256
Inverse polymerization 239
Inversion process 862
Ion pair 324, 352
Ion pair association 715
Ion supression 1029
Ionic liquid 1048
Ionic polymerization 323
Ionization constant 352
Ionization method 621
Ionomer 715
Ion-trap system 1029
iPP, see isotactic polypropylene
Iron/constantan electrode 601
Irreversible polycondensation 132
Irreversible termination transfer 331
Isolation valve 648
Isophorone diisocyanate (IPDI) 893
Isotactic polypropylene (iPP) 746, 798
Isothermal cloud-point curves 43
Isothermal operation 579

1091

1092

Index
ITAE, see Integral of timeweighted absolute
error

j
Jacobsen-Stockmayer theory 348

k
K-BKZ (Kaye-Bernstein, Kearsley, and Zapas)
formalism 741
Kevlar 956
Kinetic chain length 159
Kinetic energy correction factor 612
Kneaders 356
Kolmogorov length 221
Kubelka-Munk equation 797

l
Labile structure 775
Laboratory measurement 1022
Lactamate anion 348
Lambert-Beer law 797
Laminar ow scale 539
Laminar plug ow reactor 335
Laminate ooring 849
Laplace-Kelvin equation 78
Laser for Raman spectroscopy 1019
Late transition metal catalyst 373, 381
Latent heat of evaporation 574
Latent radical image 1001
Latex 987
LCB, see Long-chain branch
LDPE, see Low-densisty polyethylene
Length truncation 434
Level measurement technique 606
Life cycle analysis 9
Lifetime prediction 824
Limiting molecular weight 1073
Limiting swelling 259
Limiting temperature 347
Linear AB step polymerization 480
Linear chain 498
Linear energy transfer 807
Linear low-density polyethylene (LLDPE) 17,
367
Linear polycondensation, kinetically controlled
129
Linear polymer 268
Linear polymerization 435
Linear scission 473
Linear viscoelasticity 709, 729, 740741
Linearly elastic dumbbell model 703
Linoleic acid 856
Liquid chromatography (LC) 1022
Liquid-crystalline behavior 957

Liquid-crystalline polymer 960


Liquid-lled thermometer 601
Liquid level measurement 605
Lithium-based polymerization 327
Living anionic polymerization 690
Living chain 467
Living polymer 331
Living polymerization 325326
LLDPE, see Linear low-density polyethylene
Logarithmic relationship 800
Long oil alkyds 861
Long-chain approximation 410
Long-chain branch (LCB) 174, 371, 395, 902
Long-chain hypothesis 159
Longitudinal modulus 888
Loop circulation 570
Loop reactor 288
Lorentz-Lorenz law 621
Loss modulus 710, 731
Loss of control 563
Low angle light scattering (LALS) 1033, 1040
Low-density polyethylene (LDPE) 17, 153,
366
Low molecular weight polyamine 853
Low-pass lter 627
Low-pressure liquid-liquid equilibria 20
Low-pressure vapor-liquid equilibria 2021
Low styrene content resin 872
Lower critical solution temperature 24
Lytropic behavior 956

m
Macrocycle 348, 355
Macroheterogeneity 789
Macromolecular brush 712
Macromolecules empirical description 4
Macromonomer 175
Macroparticle 401
Macroscopic property 750
Magnetic-inductive owmeter 617
MALDI, see Matrix-assisted laser desorption
ionization
Maleic anhydride 871
Manipulated variable 311, 628, 640
Manual control 650
Mark-Houwink relation 696
Mass analyzer, type 1029
Mass balance 117, 290
Mass ow 613, 616, 937
Mass polymerization 972
Mass spectrometer 622
Mass spectrometry (MS) 1025, 1037
Mass-to-charge ratio 1027
Mass-transfer coecient 983

Index
Mass-transfer process 982
Master 662
Master curve 734
Mastication of rubber 817
Matrix-assisted laser desorption ionization
(MALDI) 1027, 1029, 1033
Maxiaturized second-dimension column
1042
Maximum drop diameter 219
Maximum technical temperature (MTT) 557
Maximum temperature of the synthesis
reaction (MTSR) 556
Maxwell model 707, 709, 711
Mean square radius of gyration 693
Measurement and control 13
Measurement chain 596
Measuring error 597
Mechanical energy 561
Mechanical energy balance 607
Mechanical modulus 683
Mechanical tests 768
Mechanism for radical entry 261
Mechanochemical degradation 813
Mechanochemical synthesis 818
Medium oil alkyds 861
Melamine resins 106
Melamine-formaldehyde (MF) resins 843
Melamine-urea-formaldehyde (MUF) resins
8
Melt ow index (MFI) 935
Melt index 620, 664
Melt spinning 920, 922923, 926, 953, 955
Melt viscosity 740
Melting point 686
Metal catalysts 373, 381
Metal deactivator 824
Metal injection molding (MIM) 792
Metallocene 5, 373, 451, 483
Metallocene catalyst 371, 379
Metastable morphology 275
Method of characteristics 131
Method of moments 198, 406, 408, 410, 413,
435
Methodology 9, 11
Methylene bridge 839, 845
Methylol groups 840
Micelle 251
Microdomain 789
Microemulsion polymerization 256, 1071
Microheterogeneity 789
Microparticle 401
Micro-region 7
Microscopic mass balance 72
Microstructure 326

Microstructure/property relationship 250


Microwave radar 608
Mid-chain radical 177, 190
Mid-chain scission 772
Midrange infrared spectroscopy (MIR) 297,
300
Mie scattering 624
MIM, see Metal injection molding
Miniaturized rst-dimension column 1042
Miniemulsion polymerization 256, 1071
MIR see Midrange infrared spectroscopy
Mixing 195, 227, 242, 289
Mixing rules 41
Mixing time 538, 540
Modacrylics 951
Model identication 637
Model predictive 671
Model predictive control (MPC) 668, 672
Model-based control 206, 664
Modeling of distributions 201
Modern process 13
Molar mass sensitive detector 1033
Molecular dynamics simulation 782
Molecular weight averages 622
Molecular weight distribution (MWD) 267,
331, 341, 622, 664, 771, 1021, 1030, 1031,
1072
Moment distribution 476
Monad 64
Monitoring techniques 298
Monodispersed micron-size particles 257
Monomer composition 292
Monomer concentration 258
Monomer droplet 251
Monomer feed 582
Monomer partitioning 259
Monomer reactivity ratio 181
Monomethylol urea rate of formation 104
Monomolecular deactivation 386
Monoradical assumption 446
Monte Carlo 202, 485, 790
Mooney viscometer 620
Morphology 217, 232233
Morphology of block copolymers 691
Morse potential 814
Morton-Flory-Huggins equation 260
Moving-average lter 627
Moving packed-bed reactor 82
MPC, see Model predictive control
MTT, see Maximum technical temperature
Multi-angle light scattering (MALS) 1033
Multiaxial stress state 749
Multidirectional bers 879
Multidisciplinary approach 7, 10

1093

1094

Index
Multiexposure photoembossing 1007
Multigrain model 401, 413
Multinomial distribution 120
Multi-objective goal 6
Multiphase stirred tank 542
Multiple distributions 1041
Multiple holographic exposure 1007
Multiple-site catalyst 392
Multiple steady state 656
Multiplicity 584
Multiplicity of solution 563
Multi-product plant 657
Multiradicals 467
Multi-slit devolatilizer 977
Multitubular polymerization reactor 543
Multivariable 664
Multivariate calibration 1018
Multi-way partial least squares (PLS) 671
Multi-way principal component analysis (PCA)
671
Multizone circulating reactor 425
Multizone reactor 419

n
Nanoclay 692
Nanocomposites 692
Nanomanipulation 997
Nanoparticles dispersion 692
Nanophase separation of block copolymer
melts 714
Nanostructured material 692
Narrow-band 602
Nascent crystallization 687
Natural rubber (NR) 902
Near-infrared (NIR) spectroscopy 297, 300,
10171019
Negative feedback 640
Neopentyl glycol 865
Newtonian uid 571, 708
Newtonian viscous behavior 708
Newtons law of viscosity 619
Nitrile rubber (NBR) 902
Nitrogen inerting 900
Nitroxide radical 819
NMR, see Nuclear magnetic resonance
Nomex 956
Non wovens 206
Nonlinear controller 311
Nonlinear polymer 272, 699
Nonlinear viscoelasticity 740741
Nonpolymerizable compounds 971
Nonradical degradation mechanisms 763
Nonrandom factor model 34
Nonrandom two-liquid (NRTL) theory 34

Non-reinforced applications 886


Non-self-regulating 631
Normal stress dierences 741
Norrish photoprocess 787, 803, 897
Novolac application 107, 840, 842
Nozzle 611
Nuclear magnetic resonance (NMR) 621,
775, 1024
Nucleating agents 687
Nucleation 747
Nucleation rate 295
Number-average chain length 412
Number fraction 489
Number of monomer units 473
Number of polymer particles 264
Numerical fractionation 202
Numerical inversion of generating functions
126
Nylon-6 98, 101

o
O-line analysis 1042
Oset 641
Olen copolymerization 388
Oleic acid 856
Oligomer column 1021
On-aim 657
One component formulation 836
On-line analysis 1015
On-line monitoring 296
On-line sensor selection 297
On-o controller 646
Onset temperature 308
Optical clarity 688
Optical pyrometer 602
Optical scanning electron microscopy 623
Optimization 306
Orange peel eect 868
Organic solvent 1047
Orice plate 611, 613
Orlon 966
Oscillatory baed reactor 234, 239
Osmotic pressure 694
Output unit 596
Outside-in technology 894
Oval gear owmeter 609
Oval wheel counter 610
Overcooling 583
Over-damped 632
Overlapping chains 694
Overshoot 646
Oxidation resistance 907
Oxidative degradation 798
Oxirane 850

Index
Oxygen diusion constant 798
Oxygen inhibitor 894
Oxygen uptake 776
Ozone absorption 796

p
PA, see Polyamide
Palmitic acid 856
Panel board 627, 650
Paper coating 256
Paracrystalline 920
Paran 872
Paraformaldehyde 102
Parallel lter 926
Parametric sensitivity 562, 580
Particle board 849
Particle fragmentation 401
Particle morphology 273
Particle nucleation 264
Particle size distribution (PSD) 223, 234
235, 294, 623, 672
Particle size stability 584
Partition coecient 259, 1062
Partly oriented yarn (POY) 940
PCA, see Multi-way principal component
analysis
PC-SAFT application 47
PD controller 642
Pendent chain 117
Pentaerythritol 856
Peracids 774, 783, 788
Performance 14
Peroxide 155, 774, 871
Peroxide curing 905
Peroxide decomposer 821
Peroxy radicals 762
Personal computer (PC) controller 651
Phantom network 122
Phase behavior 1054
Phase equilibria 18
Phenol 838
Phenolic resins 838
Phillips catalyst 373, 378
Phosgenation 94
Photodegradation 793
Photoembossing 9981001
Photo-Fries rearrangement 803
Photoinitiated radical polymerization 896
Photoinitiation 802, 897
Photo-ionization 621
Photolabile base 897
Photolithographic techniques 996
Photo-oxidation 793, 796, 855
Photoresponse 999

Photostabilizer 822
Physical association 715
Physical degradation 757
Physical properties 571
Physicochemical degradation 758
PI controller 642
PID controller 642, 645
PID feedback controller 659
Piezoelectric pressure transducer 604
Piezoresistive pressure transducer 604
Planar zigzag (trans) conformation 681
Planck radiation law 602
Plasticization eect 1052
Platinum thermometer 600
PLS, see Multi-way partial least squares
Plug 652
Plug ow reactor 335
Pneumatic position controller 650
Pneumatic pressure 598
Pneumatic signal 598
Point-contact 606
Poiseuilles law 938
Poisson distribution 333334, 750
Polar additive 326, 343
Polar hydrogel 896
Polarizability 1050
Polarographic method 621
Polyacetal 346
Polyacrylonitrile (PAN) 951
Poly(alkyl methacrylate) 712
Polyamide (PA) 917, 923, 941, 942
Polybenzothiazole (PBT) 960
Polybenzoxazole (PBO) 960
Poly(butyleneterephthalate) (PBT) 938
Polycarbonate 733
Polycondensation 11, 95, 132, 432, 481, 547,
863, 869, 972
Polydispersity 333, 335, 622
Polyester 687, 853, 891, 923
Polyesterication 859
Polyetherimide 780
Polyethylene (PE) 682, 687, 920
Poly(ethylene terephthalate) (PET) 685, 687,
938940
Poly(ethylenenaphthalate) (PEN) 938
Polyhedral silsesquioxane (POSS) 692
Polyimide 780
Polyisobutene 734
Polymer branching 711
Polymer coil size 693
Polymer composition 179
Polymer composition feedback controller 666
Polymer conformation 692, 784
Polymer degradation, physical factor 763

1095

1096

Index
Polymer distribution 1030
Polymer line 924, 935
Polymer melt 972
Polymer microstructure 249
Polymer microstructuring 995
Polymer morphology 766
Polymer nanostructuring 995
Polymer particle 252
Polymer processing 1058
Polymer reaction engineering development 5
Polymer reaction engineering disciplines 9
Polymer reaction engineering history 4
Polymer recycling 792
Polymer scission 1072
Polymer solution thermodynamics 18
Polymer-like structures 715
Polymeric additive 714
Polymeric uid 703
Polymeric material 3
Polymeric network 834
Polymerization-induced diusion 999
Polymerization kinetics 377, 383
Poly(methyl methacrylate) (PMMA) 154, 682,
685, 733, 1036
Poly(m-phenylene isophthalamide) 956
Polyolen 365, 979
Polyoxyalkylene 349, 353
Polyoxymethylene (POM) 346, 356, 961
Poly(p-phenylene terephthalamide), (PPTA)
956
Polypropylene (PP) 367, 682, 923, 943, 964
Polypropylene degradation 782
Polystyrene 153, 920
Polystyrene lms 1023
Polystyrene-poly(methyl methacrylate) analyzer
1043
Poly(tetrauoroethylene) (PTFE) 682, 812,
1058
Polytetrahydrofurane (THF) 356
Poly(trimethylene terephthalate) (PTT) 938
Polytropic reaction 579
Polyurea 109
Polyurethane 109
Poly(vinyl acetate) (PVA) 154, 217, 224, 232,
444, 458, 683
Poly(vinyl alcohol) 683, 946, 952
Poly(vinyl chloride) (PVC) 216, 230, 686, 744,
823, 920
Population balance 262, 408409, 414, 432
Porosity 231232, 237
Positional form 643
Post-polymerization 980
Post-processing 13
Post-treatment of VOCs 972

Pot life 871


Potassium alkoxide 350
Powder coating 866
Power consumption 289
Power number 236
Power ultrasound 1063
PRE, see Polymer reaction engineering
Precipitation 714
Precipitation polymerization 1057, 1069
Precursor particle 267
Predici 202
Prediction of the gel point 121
Pre-polymerized catalyst 401
Pressure drop 536, 938
Pressure limitation 546
Pressure measurement 602
Pressure-reducing valve 648
Pressure relief 588
Pressure temperature level and ow (PTLF)
658
Preventive measure 586
Primary initiation 802
Primary particle 401
Primary polymer 485, 503
Primary reactor 662
Primary recycling 792
Principle of equal reactivity 62
Principle of similarity 295
Probabilities of extinction 120
Probabilities of reaction 120
Probability generating functions 480
Process development 5
Process gain 632
Process or measured variable 628
Process scheme 5
Process system integration 6
Process under development 14
Production rate 116, 297
Product quality 290, 297
Productivity 583
Products-by-process 249
Programmable logic controller (PLC) 651
Propagation 162, 760
Propagation rate coecient 327
Proportional band 641
Proportional controller (P controller) 640
Propoxylation 351
Protection strategy 558
Protective coatings 861
Protective eect 808
Proton NMR 1024
Pseudo bulk 270
Pseudo distribution 445, 449, 451, 458, 473
Pseudo-kinetic rate constant 414

Index
Pseudoplastic 619
Pulsed-ow reactor 288
Pulsed-laser-induced polymerization 163
Pultrusion 883
Pure delay 636
PVT behavior of polymer melts 41
Pyrolysis 790
Pyrolysis-GC-MS 1026

q
Quadrupole instrument 1029
Quadrupole moment 1050
Quantization error 626
Quasi-elastic light scattering (QELS) 623
Quasi-steady-state assumption (QSSA) 159,
489
Quench collar 929
Quencher 823
Quenching 588, 927
Quick opening 652
p-Quinone structures 841

r
Radial cooling 928
Radial ow 289
Radiation chemistry 807
Radiation-induced grafting 812
Radiation pyrometer 601
Radiation sterilization 811
Radical antioxidant 818
Radical chain polymerization 890
Radical entry 260
Radical exit 262
Radical formation 1065
Radical photoinitiator 897
Radical polymerization technique 690
Radical reactivity ratio 187
Radical-scavenging stabilizer 818
Radical site 444
Radioactive gamma-ray 607
Radiolytic degradation 805
Radiometrically 618
Radius of gyration 502
Radius tap 613
Raman spectroscopy 297, 300, 621, 660
Ramp function 638
Random polymerization 57
Random scission 498, 771772
Range 597
Rapid expansion from supercritical solution
1059
Rapid stress-induced crystallization 687
Rate laws 158
Rate-limiting steps 985

Rate of crystallization 81
Rate of nucleation 85
Rate of polymerization 159, 258
Rate of termination 262
Rate theory 815
Ratio control 660
Ratio of specic heat 613
Rayleigh-Plesset equation 1065
Rayleigh scattering 623624
Rayon tire cord 951
Reaction calorimetry 302, 572, 580, 667,
1075
Reaction diusion 192
Reaction dynamics 567
Reaction engineering 14
Reaction injection molding (RIM) 111
Reaction injection molding process 349
Reaction order 329
Reaction temperature 1066
Reactive diluent 889, 898
Reactor blends 368, 417
Reactor temperature control 664
Recirculated loop reactor 343
Recirculating tubular (loop) reactor 353
Recombination 440
Recombination termination 498
Recursive method 68
Redox initiation system 980
Reduced uid density 47
Reduction of risk 585
Redundant system 586
Ree-Eyring model 744
Reux 575
Reux condenser 290
Refractive index 297, 621
Refractive index detector (DRI or RI) 1032,
1040
Regulating aps 654
Regulator 628
Reinforced composites 879
Reinforcement 875
Reinforcing material 692
Relative gain array (RGA) 665
Relative reaction rate 498
Relaxation 934
Relaxation time 702, 732733, 735, 737
Renewable resource 8
Repeatability 597
Replication 997
Replication phenomenon 401
Reptation 738
Reptation time 739
Reset time 641
Reset windup 641

1097

1098

Index
Residence time distribution (RTD) 235, 242,
287, 491
Residual monomer 971, 1060
Resin 835
Resin infusion 883
Resin stability 848
Resin-transfer molding 883
Resistance temperature detector 599
Resistance thermometer 599
Resols 107, 840
Restrictor device 611
Retardation 170
Retarded cooling 929
Retention factor 1035
Reversibility 347
Reversible alternating polycondensation with
FSSE 133
Reynolds number 219, 237
Rheological behavior 696, 715, 934
Rheological control 714
Rheological eects of branching 700
Rheology 294, 502, 702
Rheology modier 712
Ricinic acid 856
Right-angle light scattering (RALS) 1033,
1040
Rigid foams 111
Rigid rod-like polymer 701
RIM, see Reaction injection molding
Ring-opening oxidation 805
Ring-opening polymerization 346
Ring-opening reaction 852
Risk parameter 307
Risk-reducing measure 586
Root mean square end-to-end distance 693
Rotameter 614, 616
Rotated helical conformation 681
Rotating disk contactor 71
Rotating lters 926
Rotating lobe owmeter 610
Rotating vane meter 611
Rotating viscometer 619
Rouse model 697, 703, 736737
Rouse relaxation time 738
Rovings 875
Rubber 343
Rubber elasticity 721, 725, 727, 729
Rubberlike elasticity 706
Rubbery plateau 722, 729, 739, 743
Runaway incident 307, 553
Russell mechanism 778

s
Safe operation 307

Safe region 308


Safety 13, 290, 296
Safety barrier 575
Safety valve 648
SAFT, see Statistical association uid theory
Sampling of monomer units 504
Sampling period 643
Sanchez-Lacombe lattice uid theory 40
Sanchez-Lacombe model 1055
Satellite drops 221, 224
Scalability 533
Scale 597
Scaleup 237238, 295, 560, 569
Scaleup criterion 296
Schulz-Flory 61, 334, 336
Scission 762, 771, 785
Scission probability distribution function 772
Scission rate 1073
Seat 652
SEC, see Size exclusion chromatography,
see also Gel permeation chromatography
Secondary initiation 802
Secondary particle 401
Secondary reaction 786
Secondary reactor 662
Secondary recycling 792
Secondary relaxation 733, 744, 749
Secondary relaxation temperature 749
Secondary suspending agent (SSA) 231232,
243
Secondary-ion mass spectrometry (SIMS)
1026
Second-order system 635
Second-shell substitution eect 64
Seeding 569, 585
Segmental diusion 191
Segregated stirred tank reactor 336
Segregation 235, 241
Self-assembling behavior 690
Self-operated regulator 647
Self-polycondensation 119
Self-regulating 630
SEM, see Scanning electron microscopy
Semi-batch control 669
Semi-batch operation 580
Semi-batch process 196
Semi-batch reactor 335, 670
Semicontinuous reactor 254
Semi-crystalline low-density polyethylene
(ldPE) 1053
Semicrystalline polymer 682, 688, 722, 725,
733, 743, 746, 751
Semi-ladder polymers 960
Seniority/priority distribution 502

Index
Sensible heat 561
Sensing element 596
Sensitivity to inhibition 87
Sensitizer 895
Sensor 596
Sensor signal processing 625
Sequence distribution 179
Sequence length 478
Sequence length distribution 473
Sequential polymerization 57
Set point 628, 640
Set-point trajectory 306
Settling time 646
Shape-forming process 687
Shear compliance 730
Shear ow 703
Shear force 578
Shear modulus 725, 730, 747
Shear rate 938
Shear thickening 619
Shear thinning 619, 702, 740
Shear viscosity 934
Sheet molding compound (SMC) 883
Shewhart (x-bar) chart 671
Shift factor 734736
Shish-kebab structure 961
Short-chain branch 382
Short oil alkyds 861
Short-chain branching (intramolecular
transfer to polymer) 177
Shoulder 467
Shrinkage 934
Shrinkage control 885
Silicone acrylates 892
SIMS, see Secondary-ion mass spectrometry
Single charged ions 1027
Single-exposure photoembossing 1001
Single-loop controller 627, 649651
Single-screw extruder 924, 974, 978
Single-site catalyst 383
Single-train process 534
Singular value decomposition analysis (SVD)
665
Size distribution 220
Size-exclusion chromatography (SEC) 622,
664, 1020, 1021, 1033
Sizing 875
Skin formation 948
Slave 662
Slurry process 416, 422
Smart transducer 604, 625
Smith-Ewart Case 263264
Soft lithography 998
Solar spectral irradiance 796

Solar spectrum 796


Solid-state NMR 1025
Solid-state polycondensation (SSP) 80
Solubility 694, 1051
Solution NMR 1025
Solution polymerization 972
Solution process 416, 423
Solution spinning 921922, 944, 953
Solvent-based system 979
Solvent or bulk media eect 63
Solvent-separated ion pair 324
Solvent/transfer agent 167
Sonic densitometer 618
Sonic velocity 654
Sonochemistry 1064
Sorption of polymer 1052
Sound speed 1064
Span 597
Sparged reactor vessel 542
Spatial location of atoms in models of network
formation 128
Specic gravity 617
Specic heat 683
Specically programmable-temperature
vaporizer (PTV) 1022
Spectra process 962, 964
Spectra lament 962
Spectroscopic technique 299
Spectrum 1018
Spherolite 747
Spin stretch factor 937
Spin-box 925
Spin-draw bulk winding (SDBW) 934
Spin-draw winding (SDW) 933
Spinnability 922
Spinning 913, 918, 925, 931, 938
Spin-trapping 776
Spray coating 1059
Spray tower 343
Spray-up process 882
Spring 652
SSP, see Solid-state polycondensation
Stabilization 894
Stabilizer 216217
Staged models for describing rotating disk
contactor 76
Standard 596597
Standard deviation 598
Standard liquid 853
Staple ber 913
Stark-Einstein law 793
Star-shaped block copolymer 344
Starved feed 670
State estimator 667

1099

1100

Index
State variable 305
Static head-space 1023
Static light scattering 624
Static mixer 545
Static pressure 1066
Static SIMS 1026
Statistical associated uid theory (SAFT) 44,
47, 1054
Statistical copolymer 338
Statistical process control 671
Staudinger 4
Steady-state model feedforward control 660
Steam stripping 987
Stearic acid 856
Stefan-Boltzmann law 601
Stem position 652
Step growth 565
Step-growth polymerization 11
Step response 632
Steric factor 784
Stiening behavior 707
Stiness 887
Stirred-bed gas-phase reactor 421
Stirred-bed reactor 82, 417, 420
Stirred-tank continuous mode 286
Stirred-tank reactor 286, 537
Stirred-tank reactor batch mode 286
Stirred-tank reactor semibatch mode 286
Stirred tanks in series 542
Stirrer power 561
Stockmayers distribution 61, 388, 406
Stoichiometric coecient 115
Storage modulus 710, 731
Strain 709
Strain gauge 604605
Strain rate 1073
Strands 875
Stress-activated chain scission 815
Stress-concentrating eect 750
Stress gradient 749
Stress intensity factor 750
Stress relaxation behavior 708
Stress-induced chemical reactivity 813
Stress-induced morphologies 767
Strip-chart recorder 627
Stripping 985
Stripping agent 973
Stuer box texture 916
Styrene 871
Styrene polymerization 169
Styrene-butadiene copolymers (SBR) 902
Styrene-butadiene latexes 986
Sulfur vulcanization 904
Supercritical carbon dioxide 10481049

Supercritical uid 975, 989


Supercritical uid extraction (SFE) 1060
Supramolecular organization 759
Surface energy 259
Surface tension 622
Surface tension reduction 1010
Surfactant 251, 862
Surlyn 715
Suspension polymerization 213, 239, 980,
985, 1057
Sustainability 8
Sustainable integrated PRE 9
Sustainable new polymer processes 15
Swelling 575576, 1052
Synergetic approach 7
Synergistic eect 826
Synthetic cellulose yarn 914
Synthetic polymer 1
Synthetic polymer material 5
Synthetic staple ber production 914
Synthetic yarn 914
Synthetic yarn spinning 916

t
Tay process 109, 854
Tandem reactor technology 417
Tangled yarn 917
Taylored polymer 691
Technora 959
Temperature control 567, 579
Temperature measurement 599
Temperature rising elution fractionation (Tref )
369
Tensile strength 705
Terminal double bond incorporation 497
Terminal double bond (TDB) 444
Terminal double bond moment distribution
459
Terminal double bond propagation 454
Terminal model 180, 388
Termination 165, 324, 337, 477, 762
Tertiary recycling 792
Tetrahydrofuran 90
Tetramethylolmethane 856
Tex 914
Textile lament yarn 917
Textile yarn 916917, 924, 933
Thermal behavior 679
Thermal conversion 560, 580
Thermal degradation 778
Thermal expansion coecient 683
Thermal initiation 169, 980
Thermal oxidative degradation of
polypropylene 782

Index
Thermal polymerization of styrene 169
Thermal runaway 254, 546
Thermal stability 575, 779
Thermal stabilization 821, 975
Thermal time constant 574
Thermocouple 600
Thermocouple pyrometer 601
Thermodynamic model 1054
Thermodynamics 12
Thermoplastic elastomer 112
Thermoplastic vulcanizates 907
Thermoplastics 23
Thermosets 2, 833
Thermosetting 833
Thin layer resin 897
Throughput scaling factor 537
Time-averaged probability 258
Time constant 632
Time-independent bril failure criterion 750
Time-of-ight (ToF) analyzer 1030
Time-temperature superposition 734, 736
Time to maximum rate under adiabatic
conditions 557
Tire cord 940
Titer 914
Tobolsky and Eyring model 815
Topological scission 472
Topology 502
Total radiation pyrometer 602
Totalizer 605
Trail generating functions 127
Transducer 596597
Transesterication 863
Transesterication of diphenylcarbonate (DPC)
and BPA 96
Transfer of information 6
Transfer of proton 337
Transfer reaction 325, 338, 352
Transfer-to-monomer 168, 386
Transfer-to-polymer 449
Transformation variable 480
Transition metal 761
Transition-state theory 781, 815
Translational diusion 192
Transmitter 596597, 625
Transparent semicrystalline polymer 688
Transverse modulus 888
Tri-block copolymer 342
Triethylenetetramine 853
Trim 652
Trimethylolpropane 856
Trimethylolpropane trimethacrylate (TRIM)
1057
Trioxane 355

Triple angle light scattering (TrALS) 1033


Triple-detector instrument 623
TripleSEC system 1040
Tromsdor eect 568
Troutons ratio 936
True thermodynamic constant 99
Tube model 738739, 741
Tubular reactor 287, 343, 543, 546
Tuning fork densitometer 617
Tuning rules 646
Turbidimetry 624
Turbine owmeter 611
Turbulence 218, 235, 242
Turbulent regime 539
Twaron 956
Twin-screw extruder 924, 974, 978
Two component formulation 836
Two-dimensional liquid chromatography
1041
Two-dimensional separation 1042
Two-phase ow 588
Two-point controller 647

u
Ultimate gain 646
Ultimate period 646
Ultra-high molecular weights 257
Ultrasound 297, 299, 980, 1057, 1062
Ultraviolet (UV) absorbance 794, 822, 1032
Ultraviolet curing 869, 896, 899
Ultraviolet detector 624
Ultraviolet lamp 899
Ultraviolet lithography 996
Ultraviolet region 621
Unidirectional ber 879
UNIFAC model 36
Unimolecular reaction 130
UNIQUAC theory 34
Univariate calibration 1018
Unsaturated polyester resin 869
Unzipping 773
Upper and lower control limit 671
Upper critical solution temperature 24
Urea-formaldehyde (UF) resin 843
Urethane acrylate 892, 894
Uron UF resin 105
UV, see Ultraviolet

v
Valve characteristic 652653
Valve coecient 653
Valve position controller 650
Valve resistance 631
Valve stem 652

1101

1102

Index
van der Waals 722
van der Waals mixing rules 46
Vanadium catalyst 379
Vapor velocity 576
Velocity form 643
Velocity gradient 705
Venturi tube 611, 613
Vibrating ow U-tube 618
Vibrating-reed viscometer 620
Vinyl chloride 217, 220, 224, 227
Vinyl content 326
Vinyl ester resin 873
5-Vinylidene-2-norbornene (VNB) 903
Vinyl polymerization 541, 546
Viscoelastic response 707
Viscometric detection 1032
Viscometry 1033
Viscose rayon 948, 950
Viscosity 213, 229, 240, 571, 578, 695, 698,
702, 734, 740, 746, 860, 1049, 1066
Viscosity index improvement 714
Viscosity measurement 619
Viscous force 219
Viscous shear 218, 221, 243
Visible region 621
Vitrication 848
VK column 101
Volatile compounds 788
Volatile organic compound (VOC) 971, 989,
1047
Volume ow 937
Volume fraction 696
Volume fraction mixing rules 46
Volume scaleup factor 533
Volumetric ow 612, 616
Volumetric ow rate 294
Volumetric growth rate 294
von Mises criterion 743, 749

w
Water-based nish 929
Waterborne dispersions 979
Water tolerance 848
WAXD, see Wide-angle X-ray diraction

Weber number 218219, 237


Weight distribution in interfacial synthesis
96
Weight measurement 604
Weight-average chain length 413
Weight-average molecular weight 125
Weight-fraction sampling 486
Wet spinning 921922, 946, 955
Wicker-tube reactor 288
Wide-angle X-ray diraction (WAXD) 681
Wiens law 601
Wilson correlation 576
Wilson plot 572
Winders capacity 931
Winding 931
Wiped-lm evaporator 977
Wiped-lm reactor 71
WLF equation 736, 746
Work hardening 729, 742743, 747

x
Xerogel structure

962

y
Yarn appearance 916
Yield 725, 741, 743744, 746, 748
Yield drop 742
Youngs modulus 722, 887

z
Z-average degree of polymerization 126
Z-average molecular weight 125
Z-domain 480
Zener element 732
Zero-one system 268
Zero-shear viscosity 715
Ziegler-Natta catalyst 370, 372, 378, 903
Ziegler-Natta EP(D)M polymerization 903
Ziegler-Nichols controller tuning parameter
646
Zimm model 698, 737
Zimm regime 699
Zimm-Stockmayer equation 1040
Zylon 960

You might also like